Google This is a digital copy of a book that was preserved for general ions on library shelves before il was carefully scanned by Google as part of a project to make the world's books discoverable online. Il has survived long enough for the copyright to expire and the book to enter the public domain. A public domain book is one that was never subject to copyright or whose legal copyright term has expired. Whether a book is in the public domain may vary country to country. Public domain books are our gateways to the past, representing a wealth of history, culture and knowledge that's often diflicult to discover. Marks, notations and other marginalia present in the original volume will appear in this file - a reminder of this book's long journey from the publisher to a library and finally to you. Usage guidelines Google is proud to partner with libraries to digitize public domain materials and make them widely accessible. Public domain books belong to the public and we are merely their custodians. Nevertheless, this work is expensive, so in order to keep providing this resource, we have taken steps to prevent abuse by commercial parlies, including placing technical restrictions on automated querying. We also ask that you: + Make non-commercial use of the plus We designed Google Book Search for use by individuals, and we request that you use these files for personal, non-commercial purposes. + Refrain from automated querying Do not send automated queries of any sort to Google's system: If you are conducting research on machine translation, optical character recognition or other areas where access to a large amount of text is helpful, please contact us. We encourage the use of public domain materials for these purposes and may be able to help. + Maintain attribution The Google "watermark" you see on each file is essential for informing people about this project and helping them find additional materials through Google Book Search. Please do not remove it. + Keep it legal Whatever your use, remember that you are responsible for ensuring that what you are doing is legal. Do not assume that just because we believe a bk is in the public domain for users in the United States, that the work is also in the public domain for users in other countries. Whether a book is still in copyright varies from country to country, and we can't offer guidance on whether any specific use of any specific book is allowed. Please do not assume that a book's appearance in Google Book Search means il can be used in any manner anywhere in the world. Copyright infringement liability can be quite severe. About Google Book Search Google's mission is to organize the world's information and to make it universally accessible and useful. Google Book Search helps readers discover the world's hooks while helping authors ami publishers reach new audiences. You can search through I lie lull text of this book on I lie web at|http : //books . qooqle . com/| tU^AJ , jU^ou , /*s/~ @- ■ as are produced at a, grven point by the constant; tkttw of the water make the river plankton scanty in amounts but many water lakes produce an Hinnriwr number of pi— Aii— These have beea much ^lutird in ipiml years and abort thesn alike in ocean and fresh water has grown up a new atony r Plank- tology, the Planktonininde of the Germans. Among the forms of die open water aresome, primarily thefisie^ which manifest mdraduai power of imwemeut ariegnatp to make them independent of water movements, *tnm* and 'i^*"*"^ and stand hi marked contrast with the planEtm, far the latter is unable to regulate effectively its tnrarinn, aad is dependent upon, the whids and waves for its dwpersal. Typical plankton isms, in fresh water known fngrther as die Emnopiankfc found only in water bodies of some sme, whereas msmrtll lakes or ponds the circumscribed open-water area ennfairr* fife which am- wsts of migrants from shore and shallow water regions. Whereas on the land higher forms, especially dnmrsrir animals, depend or the higher fixed plants for food, in die water the higher types de- pend upon the smaller floating plant and animal organisms which transform inorganic materials and organic debris into available food substances. The floating organisms which taken together constitute the plank- ton are grouped into two purely artificial classes according to methods used in collecting. The constant use of fine nets (cL p. 74) for collecting plankton organisms led to a conception of this type of life that unconsciously assigned a minimum limit in sixe. Thus the organisms taken in the plankton net are all that the older authors included under the term plankton, an assemblage which should be termed more correctly the net plankton. It is well known through the work of many investigators during recent years and includes a great variety of Crustacea and Rotifera with many Pro- tozoa and Protophyta, and less regularly some other types. Within very recent times there has been obtained by more precise methods of collecting what has been termed by Lohmann the nannoplankton (dwarf plankton) with a sire limit he set arbi- trarily at 2$». It consists of the most minute organisms only, umtrnwcmx f those that Tig. i) paw through the »*«*«*, srf tfe*- foes* *gfe «fc»ws*> Swiss bolting cloth So. 25,* having «*«*** duut **»sw* ««$* (W> 0.05 torn, square. The tuamaphuikVM k vMsfyMM .% j.* RsstanMr then- j3Lku4 to aa* ftgjgsritttm* .uj the aec jwsk&Bao aumejaiailb ii» the saatav .rf ^'* ; $ jarii is «we towvfiitupfc ■*# tissue net fljiil -ja> dsw-jaiei xad •Hi&-.:uc 3* ihcnuitr be bwj. iguana.. Tie ffiussmumi aunrii«r ,«T sttttwwyanieiuui* iim* aw diMfftet & Anttt JLamut Mbi- 9 r&ttb. Witt,. »(«!» Cw&ttiilit. itu& Bweaifouurti ttvtflitr tumher'uT.uvur j^i^BitdBit 5«r iittff «: .water S4ltWw ;iJ»VAi«iljui«t jia-wiiU am*t'W"itJ6Titu«nv>Jjuito;im.-:ii im Eumstw liiktiis- w ilmwi.- times- : tnic irff mttt litaflittui. Avruxunq: ai- ming* J«*t Jjwisy ttie .vreijtm . »:' i& li^ijrtgmfc matter '.Yuies ;it rtirrat Wfowttttf; [«&» fmm augittiy Ikifc i'tSHftj*! tl*j 1^ ir at :inw& itWrtt ttiwr i tfeftt • if :' tli e= iirti rj ianiiton. bhl !i= ■ orDJnaitiy 5 r to- £ \ \m#& jfcv^twtl "fl'ite JHioom'. it in(((ietai£oiaiui:. m ;ma&xC imp******* \l*tti- sv&mtti&Afy Jrtrt- [imtfioUiv ami ■ titt ta*MU«*r d: \m wr- sjBWfctfft- itftffetttfc cw«r- nofp. "tcott\y itastr lujwmnwoU- ;«»(««- tfcMH*: fr'- tlfte ifrftMemA- irff aanatltr- inefcagv. I****** to* ■ , >f sfrnfeww.- art*: . -tatartbriiacL : iy. ' naropaKwcy - - w - - axe recorded in the following chapters have made vahuu- 12 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY tributions to the general and special problems of fresh-water biology. Fresh-water biological stations have aided by organized effort the conquest of the field. The activities of the Illinois State Laboratory of Natural History on the Illinois river, of the Wis- consin Geological and Natural History Survey on the lakes in that state, of the U. S. Bureau of Fisheries on the Mississippi, of Ohio State University on Lake Erie, of the University of Montana Biological Station on Flathead Lake in the Rocky Mountains, show the variety and scope of these interests. Unfortunately only the first three are active all the year through. Other uni- versities, notably Michigan, Indiana, Iowa, Colorado, North Dakota, and Cornell, have participated in the study of fresh-water life during part of the year or for a short series of years, and much emphasis has been laid upon the lake biological station as a factor in teaching biology. Few of these enterprises have had contin- uous existence or permanent support. Such institutions are slowly but surely gaining ground; their future development will aid both the investigations of pure science and the application of such dis- coveries to the solution of practical problems. The significance for man of the problems outlined in this chapter and their bearing upon the progress of social development have been discussed in the final chapter of the book. Save insects which moreover are primarily terrestrial forms, no type of fresh-water life has developed to the diversity and com- plexity attained by the same type in the ocean. Yet each type has achieved a variety well illustrated in the subsequent chapters. Only a few of those that occur in the ocean are unrepresented in fresh water and even strictly terrestrial groups like the mammals and flowering plants or aerial forms like birds have their aquatic representatives. In subsequent chapters each of these groups is discussed from the biological standpoint and in its especial rela- tions to fresh-water life as well as with regard to its relative impor- tance as a factor in the fresh- water flora and fauna. The records of science contain only scanty references to the types of fresh-water life and their distribution on the North Amer- ican continent, and regarding all other continents save one the records are even more fragmentary. Of Europe alone is the in- Jt.Ji INTRODUCTION 13 formation adequate to outline a picture of the life in fresh water. A comparison of the records shows conspicuously the uniformity of fresh-water life on the surface of the globe, especially among plankton organisms. Many of the forms discussed on later pages are identical with those that occur in Europe and many more are closely related species. The uniformity noted is not confined to Europe and North America, but extends, within the limits of records already made, to other continents also and even to the islands of the sea. It is most striking perhaps among the lowest groups as was emphasized by Schewiakoff for Protozoa. This uniformity is due in part at least to the ease of dispersal that the lower forms in the fresh-water fauna and flora enjoy. They uniformly have hard-shelled resting spores, gemmules, or eggs which are very resistant to adverse conditions, and are pro- duced in enormous numbers. These structures are carried from point to point on the feet of birds and other migrating animals and are blown about in the dust until suitable conditions, e.g., temperature and moisture, incite development and the beginning of a new life cycle. Fresh-water life includes both plant and animal organisms of various types. The number of groups represented among the plants is not so great as the animals furnish. For details on individual groups the student is referred to the appropriate chapter. The following plant groups are found in fresh water: Sduzomycetes Lowest type of plant life in the water; either or Bacteria saprophytic or parasitic in habit; found in great variety in different sorts of aquatic environment. For a general discussion of their relations to fresh water consult Chapter IV, page 90. Alga* Characteristic and abundant aquatic plants, nearly all free-living, found in all kinds of water bodies; represented by a great variety of genera and species. For Cyanophyceae or Bine-Green Algae, see Chapter VT page ico. For other classes of Algae see Chapter VI, pajr- 115- 14 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Higher Plants Among these plants which are more typically land organisms, a few species of various sorts have become a part of the fresh-water flora. In this change they have undergone important modifica- tions adapting them to an aquatic existence. No synoptic treatment of these forms has been at- tempted. For general biological relations involved see Chapter VII, page 178. Animals are represented in fresh water by many more types and varieties than are plants. A brief outline of the various animal groups indicates in general the part played by each in aquatic life and will serve to correlate the various chapters dealing with in- dividual groups. Zoologists are not agreed as to the number and rank of the subdivisions of the animal kingdom which should be recognized; and other texts will show some variations from the system used here. The student should bear in mind that the order in the printed text does not express the relationship between higher and lower groups and no arrangement in a linear series can show that relationship. The phyla are indicated by full-faced type. Protozoa Characteristic water-living forms with numerous or Single- parasitic types; represented in fresh water by celled Animals . f \. e , . A * j many species frequently found m great abundance ; in all regions and in all types of water bodies. The following four sub-phyla are usually recognized. Sarcodina The amoeboid Protozoa furnish both free-living and parasitic species. For the former see Chapter VIII, page 2*0. Mastigofhora Flagellate Protozoa include both free-living and parasitic species; forms of the first type are treated in Chapter IX, page 238. Infusoria Ciliate Protozoa include both free and parasitic species. For the former see Chapter IX, page 271. Sforozoa Exclusively parasitic forms; certain types are abundant in fresh-water animals everywhere. North American forms almost unknown. Group not treated in this book. INTRODUCTION 1$ Porifecm Preeminently marine; fresh-water bodies shelter a considerable number of characteristic siliceous forms all embraced in a single family, SpongflHdae. These are described in Chapter X, page 301. A group manifesting great variety and abundance in the sea, represented in fresh water by a very few widely scattered types, both polyps and medusae, all belonging to one class, the Hydrozoa; other classes confined to the sea. For Hydrozoa see Chapter XI, page 316. Includes crinoids, brittle-stars, starfish, sea-ur- chins, and sea-cucumbers; not represented in fresh water by a single known species. Four classes are recognized, all of which furnish arFUtwonnt important representatives to the fresh-water fauna. Tukbellaxia Common in salt and fresh waters; species found oa Feeb-uving ^ the latter generally insignificant in size. A few are terrestrial in moist environments. See Chapter XH, page 323. Tkematoda All species parasitic; many in or on fresh-water o* Flukes animals; with developmental stages, embryos (miracidia) and larvae (cercariae) that occur free- swimming in fresh water. See Chapter Xili, page 369. Cestoda Exclusively parasitic forms. Adults common in o* Tapeworms fresh-water vertebrates; developmental stages in various aquatic animals, mostly invertebrates; rarely with a free-swimming embryonic stage. See Chapter XITT, page 424. Nemeetina Mostly marine; a very few species of small size and simple organization widely distributed in fresh water. See Chapter XIV, page 454. Wwiwrtifiminthcg A confused group of three classes showing little similarity in structure and associated in a single phylum largely as a matter of convenience. All are well represented in the fresh-water fauna. i6 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Nematoda ok True Round- worms Gokdiacea or Hair Snakes acanthocephala or Thorny- headed Worms Trochelminthes or Trochal Worms Rotatoria or Wheel Animalcules Gastrotricha Coelhelminthes (Annelida) or Segmented Worms Chaetopoda or Bristle Worms Hirudinea or Leeches Both free and parasitic forms common in all sorts of environments; free- living species most abun- dant in fresh waters and in moist soils; parasitic species common in fresh-water hosts. For free-living Nematoda, see Chapter XV, page 459- For parasitic Nematoda, see Chapter XVI, page 510. Parasitic in young life in insects; adult stage free- living in fresh water. See Chapter XVI, page 535. Exclusively parasitic, without trace of alimentary system. In many fresh-water hosts. Adults in vertebrates; larval forms imperfectly known, parasitize invertebrates. See Chapter XVI, page 542. Among the most characteristic of aquatic or- ganisms. Favorite objects of study with the early microscopists. Microscopic free-living forms, very rarely para- sitic. Abundant in fresh-water bodies of all sorts; rare in the sea. See Chapter XVII, page 553. Minute free-living forms. Abundant in fresh water to which the group is limited. Imperfectly known. See Chapter XVIII, page 621. Two classes in fresh water both well represented; other classes exclusively marine. One sub-class (Polychaeta) confined to the sea save for rare types in fresh-water bodies near the ocean; the other sub-class (Oligochaeta) found mostly in fresh water and on land. See Chapter XIX, page 632. Both free-living and parasitic species, the former mostly in fresh water with a few species also on land in moist regions; rarely marine, as ectopara- sites of fishes. See Chapter XX, page 646. INTRODUCTION Aithropoda ClUSTACEA Ajuchnida Insecta 'entaculata Bryozoa ok Moss Animalcules Three of the five classes usually recognized are found in fresh water. Only one sub-class, Cirripedia or Barnacles fur- nishes no fresh-water representatives. The others are well represented in the fresh-water fauna. With few exceptions free-living forms. For Phyllopoda see Chapter XXI, page 661. For Cladocera see Chapter XXII, page 676. For Copepoda see Chapter XXIII, page 741. For Ostracoda see Chapter XXIV, page 790. For Malacostraca see Chapter XXV, page 828. Chiefly terrestrial with some parasitic forms. One or two spiders have secondarily invaded fresh water. Among the mites one sub-order, the Hy- dracarina, is exclusively aquatic. Nearly all species inhabit fresh water.- For Hydracarina, or Water Mites, see Chapter XXVI, page 851. Two aberrant groups often attached to this class are the following: Linguatulida, exclusively parasitic, occur rarely in fresh-water hosts. Tardigrada, minute free-living forms known as water bears; a few species not uncommon in fresh water. Typically land animals which in some cases (especially for developmental stages) have gone into fresh water and manifest secondary adapta- tions to aquatic life. See Chapter XXVII, page 876. Of two classes, one, the Brachiopoda, is exclusively marine. The other follows: Sessile animals, nearly always colonial; exclu- sively free-living; chiefly marine but with some fresh-water forms widely distributed. See Chapter XXVIII, page 947. 18 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Mottusca Of the five classes commonly recognized, three which are relatively small are not represented in fresh water. Two main classes Lamellibranchia (bivalves) and Gastropoda (univalves) common in fresh waters, widely distributed. See Chapter XXIX, page 957. Chordata Three of the four sub-phyla are exclusively marine in distribution; but the fourth, the Verte- brata, which is also the largest and best known, plays an important part in the fresh-water fauna. No attempt has been made to give a synopsis of fresh-water vertebrates. For a discussion of biological relations of the Vertebrata to aquatic existence see Chapter XXX, page 102 1. IMPORTANT GENERAL REFERENCES The literature on the subject is so extensive that only the most important and essential items are listed below. Many general papers of marked value had to be omitted for lack of space. All contributions bearing on a special phase of the subject have been listed at the end of the chapter on that topic. Longer bibliographies appear in Steuer, Wesenberg-Lund, Needham, and others. In general only the latest or most general paper of a given author is listed here. Antipa, Gr. 191 2. Das Ueberschwemmungsgebiet der unteren Donau. Bukarest. 496 pp., 3 charts, 23 pi. Apstein, C. 1896. Das SUsswasserplankton. Methode und Resultate der quantitativen Untersuchungen. Kiel und Leipzig. 200 pp., 5 pi. Banta, A. M. 1907. The Fauna of Mayfield's Cave. Carnegie Inst., Washn., Pub. 67; 114 pp. BntGE, E. A. 1895-6. Plankton Studies on Lake Mendota. I, II. Trans. Wis. Acad., 10: 421-484, 4 pi.; 11: 274-448, 28 pi. Birge, E. A. and Juday, C. 1911-14. The Inland Lakes of Wisconsin. Bull. Wis. Geol. Nat. Hist. Surv., 22, 27. 1914. A Limnological Study of the Finger Lakes of New York. Bull. U. S. Bur. Fish., 23: 525-609. Blochmann, F. 1895. Die mikroskopische Tierwelt des Susswassers. Ham- burg. 2 Aufl. Brauer, A. 1909. Die Stisswasserfauna Deutschlands. Jena. (19 parts by 32 authors.) Ekman, S. 1915. Die Bodenfauna des V&ttern qualitativ und quantitativ untersucht. Int. Rev. ges. Hydrobiol., 7: 146-204, 275-425, 8 pi. ■ 5. . omtoDccraaa; "9 Rvfbuth, B. oooe. Emfachste Lebezainnnen des Tier- und Pffananrrffurhrs. Braunschweig. 5 Auff., 584. PP-, r6 pi FobbbSv S. A* 19x4. Fresh Water Fishes and their Ecology. Crhana, HL Fdaax, F. A, 189:2-1904. Le Lemon, monographie limnoiogrque. 3. voL iopt. Handbucn. der Seenkunde. AUgexneme Linmologxe. Stuttgart, 249 pp., r pL, id figs*. Fniir, A. and TJLvba, V. 1^94-1902. Uhtexsuchungm uber die Fauna der Gewaaser Bahniens* Prag. Ftttinhattx, W. idofi. Life inPondft and Streams* London and 33ew York, 406 pp. S pL 3x1 text figs* Hhsbhx, \T. 1887- Ueber die Bmlimmiing des Planktons- ader des im Meem tTKihendett Materials an Pnangen und TierexL. ILnnn. wias. Untsxsuch. cL Deutacnen. Minere zu KieL V. Bericht, 107 pp., 6 pL Rsaothh, KL 1907. Da* Siisswasser. 3feudamm. 663 pp., 194. figs* Kazan), C. A. 1903, Plankton of the IQinoi* River, 1894.- £899. I, IL BulL UL State Lab. %t. Hist., 6: 95-629, 5a pL; 8: 1-360, 5 pL r.AMuwuTi B^mrr earn. Das Lebexi der Bfanengewasser. r^tprr^ XT ^d. ^ pp., t7 P*-, 279 ^8^ Lararans, H. inxr. Leber das ^annnpiankrnn und die Zentrifngiemng: klmnwtv* Wasaerprnben zur Gewinmuig; deseiben in lehendeui Zustande. Int. Rev. ges» BEydnibiaL, 4: r— 3^, 5 pL Mbbba?. Sm John and Pullah, L. 1910. BatbymetzicaL Survey at the Scottish Freshwater Lorhs Edinburgh. 6 vols. ^hedham, J. G. and Lloyd, J. T. 19x5. The Life of Inland Waters* ft ham. 43d pp., 244. tigs. Ostwaed, W. 1903. Theozstische Pknittonstudien. ZooL Jahrh., Syst., iS: 1H12. 1903. Zur Thenrie der SiJiwebevui gunge aowie der ^seczhachen Gewicbta- hg^tiimimTTgfn achwebender Ofganismen. Arch, ges. PbysoL, 94: 25X— 272. Pasckhb* A. roxj. Die Snsswaaseriiora. Deutachiands, Qsterreurhs und der Scfrweiz. Jena, (16 parts by various authors.) PUrrna, A. cooo. Die Emabrang: der Waaaertiere und der Staffinuahait der Gewaaser. Jena. r68 pp. Rbghaud, P. idor. La. vie dans Ies eaux. Paris* BannsftSD, J. E. 1894* ABioingiral Rxanrinatinir of Lake St. Qam BulL Mich. Fish Com., 9b. 4-; 60 pp., r chart ItoamTX, L C 1S95. Lakes of 3birir America. Boston. 125 pp., ^SFffk 1808. Rives af Sardi America. 3Jew Ycnk. 327 pp., 17 pL ScHHWiaaOTF, W". 1393. Ueber die gwaianmsche Verbrotung: der 3uas~ waaatr-Protnzoexi. Mem. Acad. So. Sfc. Peterabaiirg; 41, So. 3; 2dx pp., 20 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Shelfobd, V. £. 1913. Animal Communities in Temperate America. Chicago. 362 pp., 306 figs. Steuer, H. 1910. Planktonkunde. Leipzig and Berlin, 723 pp., 365 figs., 1 pi. 1910 a. Leitfaden der Planktonkunde. 382 pp., 279 figs., 1 pi. Stokes, A. C. 1896. Aquatic Microscopy for Beginners. 3d Ed. Trenton. 326 pp. Ward, H. B. 1896. A Biological Examination of Lake Michigan in the Traverse Bay Region. Bull. Mich. Fish Com., No. 6; 100 pp., 5 pi. 1808. The Freshwater Biological Stations of the World. Rept. Smith. Inst., 1898: 499~5I3> 3 pi- Wesenberg-Lund, C. 1908. Plankton Investigations of the Danish Lakes. Copenhagen. Dan. Freshwater Biol. Lab. Op. 5; 389 pp., 46 pi. 1910. Grundzuge. der Biologie und Geographie des Susswasserplanktons, nebst Bemerkungen iiber Hauptprobleme zu kiinftiger limnologischer Forschung. Int. Rev. ges. Hydrobiol., 3. 1-44. (Biol. Suppl., Heft 1.) Whipple, G. C. 1914. Microscopy of Drinking Water. 3d Ed. New York. 409 pp., 19 pi. Zacharias, O. 1 891. Die Tier- und Pflanzenwelt des Siisswassers. Leip- zig. 2 vols. 1909. Das Plankton. Leipzig. 213 pp. Zschokke, F. 1000. Die Tierwelt der Hochgebirgsseen. Denkschr. Schweiz. naturf. Ges., 37; 400 pp., 4 charts, 8 pi. 191 1. Die Tiefseefauna der Seen Mitteleuropas. Eine geographisch- faunistische Studie. Leipzig. 246 pp., 2 pi. Contributions to Canadian Biology. Fasc. II. Freshwater Fish and Lake Biology. (Various authors.) Sessional Paper No. 396. 191 5. Ottawa. 222 pp., 21 pi. JOURNALS American Naturalist. Especially Synopses of North American Invertebrates (older volumes), edited by W. M. Woodworth. Annales de biologie lacustre. E. Rousseau. Brussels since 1906. Archiv fttr Hydrobiologie und Planktonkunde. Stuttgart since 1905. (Con- tinuation of Forschungsberichte aus der Biologischen Station zu Plon; 10 parts, 1893-1903.) Internationale Revue der gesammten Hydrobiologie und Hydrographie. R. Woltereck. Leipzig since 1008. Transactions of the American Microscopical Society. T. W. Galloway, Ripon, Wis. Since 1880. ,^-iJt: CHAPTER II CONDITIONS OF EXISTENCE lbs ^BTIPOffi. £. *WTI[WMB Gownannrows df oamtemre ass* <*tf impOTifcBaKff' ^ieOt on «$ fear as tttey arifodt fife life amdl iBeanifa gnFacesBs ®£ «ongHHwn&. Tfe fssBBUt tmwirifesSgr (off sndki tffcttv i& Jar foam fay* TmTjjMmttannft.. NtfJOTllibrilSBf 3f H® snHDQa&r fcfisaBncTSSDrans saxS. raTffi&gra&£. ifforcHEfiQ limref £* rmurffa Basal & d*- smiffifi fif an afe care cf rx!aciira» •siflfflr trmnmon m&H£antH<& August, 190; Semotilus alramaculalus . . * : 5 • : County Line Creek . Semoliltts atromaculalus Rhinichthys alronasus. . . . Baltasoma nigrum Pimepkates nolatus Catostomus commersonii. . September, 1909, and April. IQIO Semotilus atromaculalus. . Chrosomus erylhrogaster . . Rhinkhlhys alronasus. . . . Boltosoma nigrum Catostomus commersonii. . SciiU-'iiber, 1900 Semotilus atromaculalus.. Chrosomus erythrogastcr . . Rhinichthys alronasus. . . Catostomus commersonii. . Pimephates nolatus Esox vtrmiculalus Lepomis pallidus Micrppterus salmoxdes Pomoxis annularis Moxosloma aureolum Abramis crysoleucas Nolropis cornutus Black-nosed dace Johnny darter Blackhead minnow... Blunt-nosed minnow. . Common sucker Pettibone Creek1 Horned dace. . Red-bellied dace. Black-nosed dace. ... Johnny darter Common sucker Bull Creek-Dead River Red-bellied dace Black-nosed dace. .... Common sucker Blunt -nosed minnow. . Little pickerel , Large-mouthed black Pike ; Chub-sucker Golden shiner Common shiner Cayuga minnow Tadpole cat : Schilbcodes gyrinus • -: erf PcttiboDE Creek tins t> would include the records fa Physical factors include bottom, currents, light, temperature, density, pressure, viscosity, etc. The size of bottom materials is an important condition of exist- ence. In streams the current sorts the materials, leaving the coars- CONDITIONS OF EXISTENCE 25 est in the swiftest current and the finest in the roost sluggish cur- rent. In the curves of streams the current is usually swiftest on the outside and most sluggish on the inside. Different animals ibovrtbt level rt the like. tend to occupy the different kinds of bottom materials (Fig. 3). Thus the differentiation of bottom constitutes an important differ- entiation of conditions of existence. The bottom of a swift stream eroding sandy soil is very unstable and the fauna very sparse. Such streams are essentially aquatic deserts and only a few burrowers are able to live in them. Sandy bottomed streams with sluggish current have a luxuriant fauna of burrowers and flora of rooted vegetation. Rocky and stony streams have rich faunas of clinging and hiding animals. In lakes and ponds the importance of bottom is determined by the strength of wave action and the amount of current. The fine bottom materials around the margin of a large lake are con- stantly moved about; the particles grind upon one another mak- ing the presence of bottom organisms impossible Thus the sandy 26 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY shores of the Great Lakes down to a depth of eight feet or more are usually almost entirely without bottom organisms. The character of terrigenous bottom is an important condition of existence chiefly where current or wave action is strong and becomes of little or no importance where there is no movement, as in the ' • VI..» FlO. 3. The form of bottom and size of bottom materials in a cross section of the North Branch of the Chicago River with distribution of animals, a to d natural sue. a, burrowing may-fly nymph (Hmtitmi* apT); b, small bivalve (Spkerium sUuminemm), two individuals, two views; c, viviparous snail (CewftJmii ta» Ugrum), seen from two sides; d, the long river snail, young and full grown (rUwocw tUfiahtm) J #, cross section of the stream with reference to a curve (/). (Original.) bottom of one of the Great Lakes. However, bottoms of soft muck containing putrescible organic matter occur in the absence of current and constitute a condition of existence sharply differentiated from terrigenous bottoms because they can support only certain types of organisms, mainly anaerobes, and but few of these. Many aquatic animals use the bottom materials in the construction of their cases, nests, etc. Thus the caddis worms (certain species of Moll ana and Geara) build cases of sand grains weighted at the sides by small pebbles. The horned dace and several other fishes associated with it use pebbles to build their nests. The pebbles must be of a cer- tain average size. Many animals form associations (memory) with ■ r V CONDITIONS OF EXISTENCE •7 reference to certain stones or pebbles under or Rear which they live (£.£.. mayfly nymphs) and thus work out simple homing paths. As has been stated, in streams the rate of flow is determined by voiume of water and slope of stream bed. In a comparatively straight stream the current is swiftest in the center at the top and least swift at the sides near the bottom : the center of the stream bed has a current intermediate between the two. Thus sluggish pardons of streams like the Fox River (Illinois may be swift enough at the bottom of the center to support some swift stream animals such as Hydropsychc and fieptagcnin.T There are back eddies about stones and other obstruction^ so that currents in streams are somewhat irregular. In lakes circulation is determined by wind and differences in temperature. A lake which is equal in temperature throughout has a complete circulation (Ti£. 4 A). Thr wind indicated by the arrow (IF) tends to pile the water up on one side. To compensate Fxu 4 The escalation of the water (At in a lake at equal torr lb rapceaems the direction oj the wind; h, (After fairge re. iB> in a lake ot r; ., tfcemociinc; //, tor this currents are started downward along the shore and a cir- culation across the bottom and upward on the other side is initiated . Very, shallow lakes and deeper lakes in the cold months of the year have a complete circulation. Lakes of unequal temperature are very different. For example a deep lake has a uniiorm tempera- ture for a time in the spring just after the ice melts, complete cir dilation takes place and the bottom waters arc aerated. As the 28 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY sun warms the surface waters they become so much lighter than the deeper colder waters that the currents set up to compensate for the piling up of the water by the wind can no longer flow to the bottom and a superficial circulation is accordingly set up (Fig. 4 B). A distinct thermocline (T) is thus established. The epilimnion (£) is warm and constantly aerated by circulation and the hypolimnion (H) is stagnant. In the autumn as the water gradually cools the thermocline gradually migrates to the bottom and the earlier, complete circulation (Fig. 4 A) is again established. In addition to the general circulation, waves and their action must be considered. As was noted in connection with bottom, the shifting of fine bottom materials eliminates most animals from sandy shores. On rocky shores in large lakes are representatives of some of the same animal species found in swift streams. The alternating current does not appear to exclude many such species. In small lakes and ponds the small wave action removes decaying organic matter and thus renders portions of the shores suitable for animals requiring or preferring a terrigenous bottom. The location of such shores which are usually sandy is determined largely by the form of the lake or pond and the direction of pre- vailing winds and inflow of water. Currents influence animals directly by bringing pressure against parts. Sessile animals respond to currents by changes in growth form. But few fresh water sessile animals have been studied in this respect, and the exact character of such responses cannot be stated, though sponges and polyzoa are known to vary greatly. Motile animals as a rule turn with their heads upstream and either move against the current, making progress upstream, or remain in one position by swimming enough to maintain themselves. Fishes under experimental conditions will often swim against a current which is stronger than their optimum until they are exhausted. Many fishes orient themselves by visual impressions of the bottom as they float downstream. Others appear to orient by differences in pressure on the two sides of the body or by rubbing against the bottom as they float down. Sight is probably ineffective during floods on account of sediment. Current is essential to the spinning of the characteristic cocoons and cases of some insects living in i,>*-~*i CONDITIONS OF EXISTENCE 29 rapids. They make a shapeless mass without it. A few animals rquire very complete aeration or they die very quickly. Suckers appear to die from lack of oxygen while the rainbow darter adds something to the water in which it lives which is not removed by artificial aeration and which kills the fish unless the number of fishes is small or the water changed often. Light penetrates clear water to great depths. During the cruise of the Michel Sars the penetration of sufficient light to markedly affect the most sensitive photographic plates in 80 min. was found at a depth of 1000 meters (latitude 310 20', June 5-6. Sun nearly over head; for methods see Murray and Hjort). No effect was obtained at 1700 meters with an exposure of two hours. Light sufficient to affect the plates in 2 hours lies somewhere between 1000 and 1700 meters. There were many rays of all kinds at 100 meters but least of the red. Though penetration is rarely as great in fresh water as in the sea, light may possibly penetrate to the bottom of Lake Baikal which is the deepest fresh water lake known (1300 to 1700 meters are reported). In temperate latitudes light does not penetrate so far vertically because it enters the water obliquely. The depth of penetration can easily be calculated for any latitude or season from the angle of declination of the sun, when the penetration in similar water is known for other latitudes and seasons. The most important factor limiting the penetration of light into fresh water is turbidity. Forel found the light penetration in Lake Geneva (Switzerland) greatest when the lake contained least sediment. Table II gives the depth of light penetration in Lake Geneva in March when it is clearest. Forel used much less sen- sitive plates than were used on the Michel Sars, the sun was much lower in the horizon and the locality 15 degrees farther north. Thus Forel's records show that light did not diminish notably in the first 25 meters, fell off gradually in the second 25 meters and then dropped off rapidly to zero for his plates at 1 10 meters. Fol and Sarasin with more sensitive silver salts than were used by Forel found that light reached 200 meters in winter. It is altogether probable that the plates and apparatus of the Michel Sars would show much light at three or four times the depth given by Forel. 30 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY TABLE II Showing Depth op Light Penetration in Lake Geneva (Switzerland) and Conditions Affecting the Same in Both Lake Geneva (after Forel) and Lake Michigan In the eighth column the relative results are given in seconds, in terms of the effect on the photographic plate, of exposures to the sun. Lake Michigan Rainfall Inches 2.0 2-3 2.5 2-7 3-5 37 3.6 2.8 3-0 2.6 2.6 2.1 Centi- meters 5-1 5.2 6.4 6.9 8.9 9 4 9.2 7-2 7-7 6.6 6.6 5-3 Velocity of wind at noon Miles per hour 17.8 20.0 20.4 19.4 l8.3 14.4 14.6 13-4 16.7 17.6 19.0 19.9 Meters per second 8.0 9.0 9.1 8-7 8.2 6.5 6.6 6.0 7 5 79 8-5 8.9 Month January. . .February. March .April. .May June July .August. . . . September .October. . . November . December . Lake Geneva, Switserland Rainfall and light Prec. in cm. 487 3.65 4.72 5-68 7.91 759 7.08 8.04 9.42 10.10 7-4 5 " Light limit at depth in meters I IO 75 • • 45 • • So Light and depth Intensity of light (March) at depth in next column 500 sec. 500 sec. 500 sec. 400 sec. 360 sec. 120 sec. 60 sec. 25 sec. 10 sec. 2 sec. o sec. • •■•••• Depth in meters O.O 19.6 25.2 45-5 555 65.6 75-6 857 95-8 1054 115-6 Little work on the depth of light penetration has been under- taken in the North American waters. In Table II the rainfall and wind velocity over Lake Michigan are shown and the rainfall for Lake Geneva (Switzerland). The greatest light penetration in Lake Geneva comes when the rainfall is low and when the mountains are still frozen. The Lake Michigan water commission found in a brief period of study that the greatest turbidity fell in January, February, March, and April. The table indicates that this is in months with high wind velocity. The great rainfall of the spring and early summer months tends to keep Lake Michigan turbid, so the greatest light penetration may be predicted for Aug- ust which has least rain and least wind. Various streams are normally so muddy that light cannot be ex- pected to penetrate more than a few feet and the fauna accordingly lives in very faint light. Others, as for example streams and lakes k .."%. •. ! CONDITIONS OF EXISTENCE 3 1 in some of the western mountains, are very clear and one can see to depths of 5 to 15 meters. Depth at which objects may be seen is measured by lowering a white disc 20 cm. in diameter known as the disc of Secchi. When light penetrates water the red rays are most rapidly ab- sorbed, then orange, yellow, etc. In the Michel Sars measure- ments there were scarcely any red rays at 500 meters, one-half the depth at which light was measured. Fol found off Nice that when down in 30 meters of water he could see a stone 7-8 meters away and a bright object at a distance of 25 meters. Red animals looked black, while green and blue green algae looked quite bright. In water there is no dawn or twilight. The surface of the water reflects practically all the light when the rays come to it very obliquely. Fol found that in 10 meters of water solar light dis- appeared quite suddenly long before sunset. In Funchal Harbor (Madeira) the Prince of Monaco used Regnard's apparatus in which a film is moved before an opening by clockwork, and found that at 20 meters in March the day lasted 9 hours whereas at 40 meters the film showed the effects of light for only about 15 minutes at 2 P.M. Light profoundly influences the migrations and distribution of animals probably largely because it has a marked effect on life processes. Unfortunately, however, with the exception of ultra- violet light which penetrates the atmosphere into low altitudes in minimal amount, very little is known of the actual physiological effects of light. Under experimental conditions animals usually avoid or select the blue end of the spectrum. Red usually acts as darkness or very faint light. Thus animals living in very strong light usually accumulate in blue or violet when exposed to spectrum colors. Animals living in darkness collect in the red. Animals living in moderate light usually wander about throughout the spec- trum but a majority congregate in the blue. Probably animals are affected through photo-chemical reactions which are brought about most often by the blue end of the spectrum. Daphnias select the brightest part of the spectrum which is the green or the yellow for most organisms, brightness being determined by some specific effect of particular wave lengths upon the light recipient 32 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY organs. Yellow is brightest to the human retina. In addition to color animals react to direction and to intensity of light. Prob- ably the majority of fresh-water animals react more strongly to direction than to intensity. Hydropsyche and Argia do not react to intensity at all but react to direction very sharply. Experi- mental conditions in which direction away from source accompanies a sharp decrease in intensity gives sharpest reactions with most aquatic animals. Animals react to intensity with reference to an optimum. The optimum usually corresponds to the usual light in their natural environments. The organism may often be modified by changes in the chemical character of the water, or even by rough handling (Daphnia, Ranatra), so that it selects a different optimum, or re- verses its reaction to direction of rays. Many animals react to shadows or small areas of illumination. Thus frogs will hop to a shadow in the middle of a sunny field and Amblystoma will follow a person along a sunny road. This type of behavior is doubtless an important thing under water but has been but little investigated. One of the topics which has absorbed much of the attention of limnologists is the daily depth migrations of certain Crustacea. They usually accumulate near the surface at night and in deeper water during the day. The causes of these migrations are very complex and light is an important factor. Dice has recently dis- cussed the matter in full. Light is probably important in confin- ing certain animals in deep water, in turbid streams, under stones and logs and in caves, ground water, etc. The early invention of the thermometer has led to quite com- plete investigation of temperature and an over-estimation of its importance in the direct control of the distribution of life in water. The tendency of modern investigation is to weaken the belief in its direct importance. * Stream temperatures are probably about the same at the various points in any cross-section, except the shallow sluggish margin on warm summer days. The extent to which daily, seasonal, and weather fluctuations in atmospheric temperature affect a lake is determined by the depth and size. Small lakes with incomplete OONmTTONS 'IF SaSTESCR ."Ol > ixcuiationr iir sHznmer aie coict ;tt the. bottom- ipgrn^ ieatea a iht ait^e- >niy r the seasonal temperature jhainjes jxtenct to he leefKsr rraits^TSibletlllJ. Dr summer the: crater ri diesHrfaia^LS.TOrmert. lrat if the^Trticai ve. hoc meters Table ECD when he ^emnerature >r nrra.Ytmuin 'tensity is recorded. These ire. irieriy lottom ~ceorris- iikl to not t heretore represent "he temneraturcs it rhe. same levei :n he men vrater: .^specially in the shallower situations -There the. suits '*neng* "T*"* TAHT ,rl III . EACPEKATniK >p Lake: vildHGAK A*TEK 1AJEUJ rvnfpi MTtttlf* nth in tfnmn • )*nth late "Ionrrri\L :me« seated Skr "em- tLSC "*enr* ;.trat>- *■ » .-MHCW5? .-"r«t t :X., ' i, «i . .6 :«. . Auj^. :0 ^crc Heer- ■ 0-. ; -S-5 ;&. 7- •j.y- I u- %7-i . vttf£. 5 jIOO v-.L. ■ Jlouay :s. j 7". -*: • * • i4^> .2- >? J.,. lUir. S : ^ •- % • ^eexxms. :D.;- • ' ■ * . "• -*:-;' J ofc OS. J . itllf. 0 :::o Jleex- :0.;- :*:* ia»<) - 1*. *# .43. ^ - T-S ?0'. 0" . '■ - .u . ?. >/? . .Hi . ; 1 23"; Jlear- : * ; j- ': . t it i ro& V1U(. I 31 >0 .\ . ->!«■ l&ZT . > • •8. J >0.^' ni oo 0?.- : .iUH. 0 ::o ^ear* o.r :8.j *■» * - ;o.-" tU ^O.o AUg. & t»»0. Scaitercri 10OQ3 ■B. J "«*i i Misit 4 re^K^^Ufer'.inirnai^ ,ire rioifciiothermic jt zokL-fiioorieet; .ind. lUefe "l femj»«Unr^A-anes mtb the surrounoim^ - emnerature. XIliizE- :tJ3aM a*ttt 'At4a .vitb ihe execution »t rhe naiELtee aid rare, iresif?- \TOUrreaU ire iot truly j-quaxic. ^ruiv iquatk .www-blocKte«i .ifti?n%i* wually iaa*e ck thick joverms^: «t fatv.vtxicir. ii ^[iwr'ctmfcfwct^r^t iwnt, A:ew:ishes maintairr io^C irriiDiffe ,Ai»vi^i te- -swvf fftro*fm£ riwiunr, jut or- most rcsir-vaier- umnaii «».**' i fr-550^ C a?f- rfpiwte^H«:K*: not turn back imm ii ~ttbsn xhfx encounter it and are ixfcen Dwraamfc without siting iht mmiHmr^rti^ T^iidi protect Ssbis from excesses uf other siriwianrafr normal at* ikh eirciramnen&. Meihant & & saturated bvnrucarbmi and has minor efiects upon organisms though ir rmey bt -pyssism in xht hrpahmnian of lakes in cpTwifkmibifc guaniiry. 3rai2K if carbon •numoriflfr occur ateo. Hydrogen siibmith: k isunfo- passem in -very small quantities in -foe buttons u: iukis and sewnis: rrnTrrgTTimiLWi streams. It is very abundant in -aah Mia- mid armf if ihe sea. It Teaute irnm Tiutpeiaciiois .and innr tnt -ranursiion of siibftifltf^ ibrnush Ttbe action of Uk burrterit wnhi pxey uwm trganir sulphur JLedsisr L Though very po&unoife h i tiih ordinarily present in sum merit quantity *1l> inumr jmua fiiimfiurt: ant J'dwbh, thnngh ife absorp- lion of osyjgen : rnftLuos iier amnirm if ink -gas wary maxenaBy. Carbon diraith: i -tin: mifi: ingjorrHTii .gas in rbssh neater. Sn small T]umrfrtkfr h i ^Hiffntia' rather -than ttour in rental 2d nninriir ' l -Ssjaptcs i>: na£sr milium uajjrjl mar ttt ntrnrftrr wilt inmost rairfinn of an «j>- pfra&to£ ■OBonit: o: trvicpn fdL ife cusjokl ^hmugi in* ^imsiaL mfwrii fay itenar- .tdt' stci: <>- ^ jt$^ re Jrtttfc n. l. csr «tuthv Ikucafota szot vs^ fikftiy tL> tiin*»||n ^rtaiatxnisr^ it patliop m »)iitt£ntt.aiiL U'taaxsm. nsuifiiasm xait it taking: oati ii- tsatflig «mipM& Jrur indmarr ~ wocl il Tnrtanir u± «huuihs- tvi ^u&aem^E wsighaD aeon* jkuxx; tJKTOraUr mut j«l orcciulr «e*cr«c. fitBKrfiili\ EL. !!Qk sobiticms ««i- «rfl fHit i#t tsirrrr: i mtufe fay ai immlltrr ikebiu. t imm'Iii%:iacetnr mtttt i#e Matt: wwtt may at ifil fat iJKTCaExajS^. "fen'-n- 4iiftiii«]t.- bbH ^i«uik«TiKx- Jwoaiy jm£ ^rttttat ItumfiBi januar: mxi\Ts& ntoiuit ^cvrel ban* uf nakaonn or ftwtffafiVl! vdii*e u Htiap i»qBmnD& hmc ol tut. iudifcit «mt uf ifae -matt important fkMnmtfittwwn^ ^SMix «& jirmihy abafinhy. favdeofso. «iqibiiit. sad xKtfaoaxraas mt^rtu^ ttttt uli^iit > afaaytim: a- tuucl Tmnmioaifaar as tshen mt nauk ^t left flagjgE anpha&ze salinity and density: Binge and Judas? dsnphasize oxygen. &1 these icteas hai*e imu#irrant bearing iir que&ifms if aquatic biology bur no - Ttir.iaHr r *±kt mmttbcr o: journal ^rccnrmj:"BsL T^at -»3»a*r c* itoraasv 5° FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY breeding places. The oxygen content decreases, particularly on the bottom. The distribution of the fish present in these ponds, in so far as breeding habits were known, was found to be corre- lated with the distribution of the bottom upon which they breed. This becomes less and less in amount as the ponds grow older. TABLE X Showing Quantitative Results of Examination of Factors Related to Quantity of Plankton Pond numbers — age-series No. of 2 14 28 collections Total carbonates in parts per million. COi, cc. per liter at bottom I38.800 O'.O 6.28 779 160.200 3-4 347 2450 160.300 2.7 2.78 3550 1 2 Oxygen, cc. per liter at bottom Bacteria per cc 4 2 On the whole the carbonates, CO2, and bacteria are greater in quantity according to age. Oxygen on the whole is less. The increase in quantity of animals with increase of soil fer- tility supports Knauthe's contention that with fishes productivity of water is directly correlated with the richness of the soil. The weak place in Knauthe's ideas lies in the fact that as quantity in- creases quality decreases. The game basses and sunfishes give way to the more inferior types and these are gradually succeeded by bullheads, mud-minnows and dogfish. This is due to the destruc- tion of breeding bottom for the desirable fishes by putrescible organic matter which results in much carbon dioxide, hydrogen sulphide, ammonia, and lack of oxygen. The German carp comes into such a series rather late and thus productivity in carp is no doubt correlated with a fertile substratum. The amount and kind of rooted vegetation are very important to animals. Of all the aquatic situations which present themselves the largest lakes have fewest attached plants, and these are all algae. Cladophora, Chara and filamentous algae are the most com- mon. These do not appear to have been recorded below about 25 meters; some of them require solid bodies for attachment and are probably most abundant on the rock outcrops of shallow water. The vegetation of young streams consists largely of holdfast "A! CONDITIONS OF EXISTENCE 51 algae similar to those among the rocky shores of a lake. These are of importance to animals. Sluggish streams have rooted aquatic vegetation. The vegetation is used as breeding places. Eggs are stuck into plant tissues by the predaceous diving beetles (Dytiscidae) and by the water scorpions (Ranatra). Eggs are attached to plants by the electric light bug (Belostomidae), back swimmers, may-flies, caddis-flies, water scavengers (Hydrophilidae), long horned leaf beetles (Donatio), snails, and many fishes {Umbra, and probably Abramis). Young animals are often dependent upon plants for shelter, to escape from enemies, etc. Many insects must come to the surface for oxygen. The most important of these are the Dytiscidae (adults and larvae), the Hydrophilidae (adults and larvae), the back swimmers, Zaitha, Belostoma, Donacia, snails, Ranatra, and Haliplidae. Some, for example Zaitha and dragon-fly nymphs, lie in the vegetation and wait for their prey. Different kinds of vegetation have different values for animals. The bulrush is barren for the following reasons: (1) hardness makes it a bad place for eggs; (2) there are no clinging places; (3) there is little shade; (4) it gives a high temperature in summer; (5) there is no great addition of oxygen by vegetation; (6) it does not afford a suitable place for securing food. Equisetum is unfavorable for similar reasons. EXodea is excellent; Myriophyl- lum, good; water-lilies and Char a, only fair. Animal Communities Plants and animals select their habitats through physiological characters. Sessile plants and animals have disseminules which usually come to rest in a great variety of conditions and grow to maturity only in those conditions that are suitable to stimulate development. The physiological character of the reproductive bodies and external conditions are responsible for the distribution. Animals select their environments by one of three methods: (1) by wide dissemination of reproductive bodies and selective survival, (2) by turning back when the environment in which they move about is found to change, and (3) by selection after trial in connection with migration. •_. . 52 H-WATER BIOLOGY Numbers of animals select the same environment because of physiological similarity. All the animals occupying a relatively uniform habitat constitute an animal community. A physiological agreement exists among the animals of a community. The rapids community of a large creek is in a general agreement in reactions to certain factors, and disagreement in respect to factors differ- ing in intensity vertically. In Fig. 5 is shown a noteworthy agree- ment in reaction to bottom and current under experimental condi- POSITIVE REACTIONS HYDROPSYCHE OR RAPIDS COMMUNITY tions. The preference for hard bottom in these experiments means the avoidance of sand as only sand and hard bottom were present in the experiments. Animals living under stones were under stones in darkness in the experiments. The snail (Goniobosis) which lives on stones was found on stones in the experiments. The darter (Etkeostoma) and the crayfish {Cambarus) which live among stones were found among stones in the experiments. Thus the different t t*:f t?k»:f IS Or EXX5XENCE s differ in their irfa lions to bottom and are in dBagrecment ^"wm * to their vertical cfislrilmtian in nature. Turning tO TCMCtXBS to HRii^ ODC ™ns a K 1H I fflfl***1 "*^ {fifiCfCUOe. .ASBBials living beneath stones show a ptefcterae for weak fight; those Jrang >d ... ,, ... . ,, 1 . , sandy bottom. Vertical dashes ind; - and lakes are thus filled as well as drained <*t, the r^ion of emerging ««<*»- and all become swamp and finally dry land, submerged vrput™. stippDngin- c J J dicatMtbcrtBlonoldctp water or the Streams gradually erode their way down {wffigjg* ^Mt^ti^ SSi to sea level and become meandering base ^Z^mS^SS^S^. level streams with fine silt bottom, sluggish l0rigi™1 J current and an abundance of vegetation. The base level streams and dry land are the ultimate fates of all bodies of fresh water. With the changes enumerated, there is always almost complete change of animal and plant life. The physiological requirements of the life of the first stages of the process are entirely different from those of the last. 60 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY IMPORTANT REFERENCES Adams, Chas. C. 1913. Guide to the Study of Animal Ecology. New York. Birge, E. A. and Juday, C. 1914. (See list in Chapter I.) Forbes, S. A. 1877. The Lake as a Microcosm. Peoria Science Assoc. Forel, F. A. 1892-1004. (See list in Chapter I.) Henderson, L. J. 19 13. The Fitness of the Environment. New York. Hill, L., Moore, B., Macleod, J. J. R.f Pembrey, M. S., and Beddard, A. P. 1908. Recent Advances in Physiology and Biochemistry. London. Johnstone, James. 1908. Conditions of Life in the Sea. Cambridge. Mayer, A. G. 1908. The Swarming of the Atlantic Palolo. Carnegie Inst. Pub. 102. Moore, J. P. 1809. A Snow Inhabiting Enchytraeid. Proc. Acad. Nat. Sci., Phila., 1809 • i25_I49» Bibliography and general remarks on snow-inhabiting animals. Murray, Sir John and Hjort, J. 191 2. The Depths of the Ocean. Lon- don. Needham, J. G. and Lloyd, J. T. 1915. (See list in Chapter I.) Packard, W. H. 1907. The Effect of Carbohydrates on Resistance to Lack of Oxygen. Am. Jour. Physiol., 18 : 164-180. Regnard, P. 1891. (See list in Chapter I.) Rosenau, M. L. 1914. Preventative Medicine and Hygiene. Sec. II, Ch. 1. Boston. Shelford, V. E. 1913. (See list in Chapter I.) Shelford, V. E. and Powers, E. B. 191 5. An Experimental Study of the Migrations of Herring and other Salt Water Fishes. Biol. Bull., 28 : 315-334. Ward, H. B. 1806. (See list in Chapter I.) Wells, M. M. 191 5. The Reaction and Resistance of Fishes in their Natural Environment to Acidity, Alkalinity and Neutrality. Biol. Bull., 29 : 221-257. 1915a. The Resistance and Reactions of Fishes in their Natural Environ- ments to Salts. Jour. Exp. Zool., 19 : 243-283. Whipple, G. C. 1898. Classification of Lakes According to Temperature. Am. Nat., 32 : 25-53. _~e* * CHAPTER m METHODS OF COLLECTING AND PHOTOGRAPHING By JACOB REIGHARD Professor of Zoology in the University of Michigan; Formerly Director of the Lake Laboratory of tho U. S. Bureau of Fisheries, at Put-in-Bay, Ohio Methods of Collecting L Vertebrates i. Fish must be collected under the state laws which usually forbid the use in inland waters of any apparatus except hook and line or dip or lift nets held in the hand. In most states licenses to use nets for scientific purposes may be obtained either from the state fish commission or from the game and fish warden. (a) Seines are long nets with a weighted lead line attached to the lower edge and a cork line attached to the upper edge so that the nets remain upright in the water. When the net is so stretched that it forms rectangular meshes " square mesh" is the length in inches of one side of a single square. For use in brooks or for col- lecting small shore fishes, seines twelve or twenty-four feet long and four or five feet in depth are suitable. The former should be of one-quarter inch square mesh, while the latter may be of one-half inch square mesh. For larger fish, seines of fifty and one hundred feet in length, five to nine feet deep and of inch mesh should be used, but larger seines are not easily handled by two persons. The longer seines should be of the twine ordinarily used for such purposes and knotted at every crossing. For the shorter lengths the excellent and cheaper " common-sense' ' minnow seines which are woven to resemble coarse burlap may be used. Very serviceable seine* may be made of a good quality of heavy bobbinet whid be had of dealers in dry goods. All seines are muc* efficient if provided with a bag at the center, as is the Ha?™" 61 mm 62 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY lecting seine, but seines of this form are expensive and not abso- lutely necessary. Seines can be used only where the bottom is free from large stones or deadwood and the water not much obstructed by vegeta- tion. A brail, or stout pole, is fastened by a double half-hitch to both cork and lead lines at each end of the seine so as to extend from the cork line to the lead line and keep the seine stretched between the two lines. The seine is then operated by two persons each of whom holds a brail in such a way that the lead line is kept close to the bottom which it sweeps, while the seine forms an arc of a circle between the two brails. At the end of the haul the seine is best landed on a gently sloping bank by seizing the lead line and drawing it in first to the bank. Where the bank does not afford a suitable landing place a short seine may be " tripped" in any depth of water by quickly pulling up the lead line until it lies in the same horizontal plane as the cork line. The seine sag- ging between the two lines retains the fish. A short seine may be thrown or cast from a boat in deep water and immediately drawn in and tripped. Small surface-swimming fishes are caught in this way. Where a long seine is to be used in water too deep to wade, a heavy weight is attached to the lower end of one brail so as to keep it upright in the water. To the same brail a short rope is so fastened that it extends loosely from one end of the brail to the other. To the middle of this short rope, or bridle, is attached a long hauling rope. The end of the seine is then carried out into deep water by means of a boat and the free end of the hauling rope brought back to shore, from which the seine is hauled in by means of the rope. If a hauling rope and weight are attached to each brail the seine may be set in the water at any convenient distance from shore and parallel to it and may then be hauled to shore by means of the ropes. (b) Trammel nets consist of one web of fine twine of about one inch mesh between two webs of coarse twine of about six inches mesh. A length of one hundred feet and a depth of six or eight feet is convenient. The fine-meshed web is much deeper than the coarser ones and all three are attached between a single cork line and a single lead line. The net is "laid" in a boat METHODS OF COLLECTING AND PHOTO GRAPHING 03 I see below under gill nets) and is set by stretching it aiong the seaward edge of vegetation or other shelter in which tish lurk and from which thev cannot be taken with other nets. The net mav \ye fastened to stakes or allowed to float in water of about its own depth, where it stands upright like a fence. The risk are then driven from their shelter toward the net, which thev strike with such force as to carry the nearly invisible, fine web through the meshes of the coarser webs, so ;is to form pockets in which the fish are held. The trammel net is oasiiy transported and very effective, especially in slightly turbid water or at night. c ; Fvke Yets. A fvke net is made like a seine, but at its middle is left a circular opening bordered by a hoop of wood or iron. To the hoop is attached the pot. a series of truncated cones of netting open at both ends. The smaller end of the lirst cone leads into the iarger end <>f the second cone and this often into a third. The last cone of the pot is closed at its smaller end by a olraw string. Both ends of the lead and cork lines should be tied into loops and the net should be 'laid" in a boat see below under gill nets) and taken to the place of setting together with two stout poles of suitable length, a rope and a heavy stone or other anchor. The loops at one end are slid over a pole which is then thrust or driven into the l>ottom. The net is then paid out from the boat rowed in the direction in which it is desired to set it. When the pot is reached it is thrown overboard. When the other end of the net is reached it is fastened to a pole set in the bottom in the manner aireadv described, but the net is left 'iuite slack between the two poles. The pot is then picked up. the rope attached to the terminal funnel and the whole pulled usually toward the shore. : The pull causes the net to bend into a V the wings of which stretch from the pot to the poles. The anchor is now attached to the end of the rope and thrown overboard. If the water is yow1 it into shonl vater. fliey iiiqht !>e < aught .ia hey shoal water by iu»tting the net the other .vay about. 64 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY stake and the anchor dispensed with. Fykes are usually set across the mouth of a small bay or inlet but may be placed anywhere. In running water the net may face either up or down stream. It may be necessary to set a row of stakes across the stream above the net to catch drift wood. When fish attempt to enter the bay or inlet across which the net is set, they follow the wings of the fyke and enter the pot from which they are unable to escape. The net may be left set for a long time and the fish taken from it at intervals by lifting the pot and loosening the draw string. The wings of a fyke may be from fifteen to fifty feet long according to its location, but for brook use fykes are made without wings. Fie. 9 Showing one end of a gill net as set when used in the cod fishery on the Massachusetts Coast, i, end of the net. 2, anchor line. 3, anchor. 4, buoy line. 5, buoy. (After Goode.) The fyke is an excellent net for catching turtles, but should then be modified as indicated in the section on turtles (p. 66). (d) Gill nets are made of very fine cotton or linen twine and of various meshes. Inch or two-inch square mesh and a length of one hundred or one hundred and fifty feet are useful for collecting. The nets are intended to be left out for days, at least, on the bottom in deep water. They stand upright in the water (Fig. 9) and the fish strike them usually at night and become entangled in the meshes, so that they are commonly dead when the nets are lifted. A small rope of at least the length of the net is attached to one end of the cork line and a stone or other heavy weight to serve as an anchor is made fast to the other end of the rope. The anchor -•^i MfZCTfflBS < OF JQlIJiXCTNvX ***tt> THOTTW5KATHHCG fc isrfiieac 'irfafie -i»it.iiHc:.tBerDaBe-xizcrQihy tnitec sezr it. Tie ^k; is tiBnr QxmdBf> ''aaod' iiy ourin^ i: iaocck one carte iifcrr * fabe namrarr *>: :.i£ cxtmnn^: iat li.isTW: ^accessary a «e*p bte lie; ^trttcmai ex:- iisM/^raiti: Betirefr fcce. an^anc tad inns. ¥Hwr tfiecDDGEset -one ti: bfii kvss Tecrsec & 'second anc tqaa! aiicbar JnBemhh. jDEawp'-atacCBQc: 'as maifc: ias: tx bRvtxm: ince &nnnnwr tff 33L T»ci5 may »e assessa. aapeturr t«c a «c lane asec tas 1a sanjBe iBt: mfab z-mag&L par- «- aKCBwr fees and aKara**. ;l:is xxsiTfissoni: D aa- be-.- -see: or jl " GZtxnsg board* oxrr r n^e iet: \ka^r uHEclia- *iaev Tk- woirt may w. must uoce & bates: iskkt <&:' ^SBOoofar. mara-axd -coccol &rc9ss fe Eerrr 0:* bfc kxia: vrsfte tixe «t: 1- o hk et: Tie* «e: -broniGd jk et: iritfc^ i: is transom: Bflh ^^fa!•*tlIaL-wa5,t^t^9S5.ii- nirror.'iefi: txmRettd^: tio: pats- o: ^ aaaeear srtress faBt-sixaabrA m*/ix -tk&ol T»: raapfr jaKawr is bmwn: nttt md ias bee *xu mitt mb. bet *rkl to: tat aKdwrr inse arc betr bet ibc: a*-: piar_ : "be*:? icoa: " Wwr bttestcoawc lasdoxir .inat.mas j&ear. pier, ca o rsoa~ti :razbE(fe^j^^ :Ut-«utt£: -to:- tot atriaee i&:':br: *«a«r i~~mii*^ aasrey i:ja»d:a: tbie :tret -tat *: bias is iaseoect. &. T»ee «: ddool a ^«fret as ia Soar. Wfiwr. *b»e -aac *.' ■ bar. bcoskl a*t»r~ tost i- -miked *:tie «e: :is -luiabac unt; i«ac b»r econoi iagowr inuwi onen 7ise ssc noaay '■fre pcbcdcaht frctr bfr: «t: *r jaifina^ m far. ioat mte ami tfatee rjmtwr iifte-- a- 'prarr^rnx. «wa: jr beo niimniy tJm^:bB>iaiuc:bJBe XKftx mr:< $: - h&- i&t: jdossl ovr ctaxr. alonwnn- br par. o: bt tic: r|»i:'.iMis'-»Wf ^.^^WQBJWJtr: a ill xtxts ma br: maen t^' t^^U'-jfrtt ■.*&*& Imo ■ <2». tKr « bos 3 6teod^.tOTK-o:*fcbfc ^H8k ratttiU wthr t> \wtr. drceteer omtati. Tk ovsm is timi- -Gaitr- of ;*t^*i> >tt*V'- ,» v > Ida* -a^vrr c jetting Ijk^ fm. o: bje ^5^iw£^r*"^«»lrtt•. ^-r«»wv^hle-:t» vrrait oatucc am. -rtnwra o: fc :Wt .lii*'-- vjfe«>r':«av V.-"t»o F OLLECTETG \KD. TODTOGRAHHXG >7" o enter 'he oox hrouen tie viinacr >t lettinc. ma ire hereoy avea ;rom Ltowning vnicn vouul nsue i 'hev ouul lot reacn heidr. Hiey may oe-removea hroujin_ he :iri.iit -he tionyenience- »i the t oileetar. [L lyVTTRTEBBAIES Invertebrates ire o >e otiectea a tiree itnations: a: he ixmatic "efijetanon ;>oraerms he ^ norc. .a he »Den vater. )evomr his pcetation-zone. ma »n he bottom* o hat he iQparatns uitanle ^o each ot :hese ^tuations irrav >e i-eoarateiv • onsKiereti. 't a onvement o onsnicr irst hose rrethous lc&gneu or malitative 'w>rt. .or 'inning »ut vrcat >rganirtms ire iresseni, uui econn hose methods >v -vhicn he nimner »r juantrty >r >rsjan-- 3ms present .11 u ;;mt -oiume t»r vater >r 'inuer :. mit .urea. >i -ur- ace mav *>e neterminea. i. "jiiecrinq n llitorai "v qeumon : . :lv aio *t&x. The uir> net FIs. oj .a iiere 01 greatest use; Tt' :t i omcai iettea >ag. mout joe out a: iiametcr .inil 'tqnteen: -ncnes ieeo ^ttacnea o k. _ f tout -m^. »t irass -r ron, irmiv ixed o 1. .tilt, voocten lanate even. >rr*iqiit :eet ionij. Hie owerthira «>t he let. nav «ttt*n >e uivaata^eousiy inert '\rrtJt;:hin. otton loth o etain: mailer organisms, v .orm 01 his ,iet mantert :o *eranini? lat .-urraces. -uca ir i«fl£. ;lw tona*. )anks. *tc. .3 oao ;hnwni P5v?r . 01. 't has ;i *«emi-< ircuiur rm .nrt .1..- hallow war »t aavas vith: u jottom it Co. .1 >r > )otana 10th* ifcta »n»- :.ak* mantes. Hie con mas nav ;e naae )V ursr ilarfcRniith: Hie )ai*s ire oid is mnnow iitr ibcs jv leanas. n. ifthintf .irwie r >v naii-«->raer louses. :, ;6» niUtttmP .titter lauaac >tants. TfttL ucm xeta namr .arm* Ifwbla :•> :.he ;ialtea *ye- :xnur je oiieececL lircettyi >r- y Tw v.ircer.i "lie lanaies isea *n: ixxi. 68 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY aquatic vegetation may be obtained and searched for smaller organisms. Many forms that are detected with difficulty in the field appear in abundance in the water of small \ dishes containing aquatic plants, when allowed to B stand undisturbed for some days (annelids, flat £k worms, rotifers, hydras, protozoa, etc.). Sub- ™ merged vegetation which grows in deeper water and cannot be reached by other means may be obtained by dragging behind a boat the grapple (Fig. n) described as follows by Pieters (1901): "This is made by passing four or five bent steel wires through a piece of ij-inch pipe and bending ^■rip'p^"?*?^?) back the free ends to make hooks. The pipe was Ktm"1 filled with lead to make it heavier and a rope fastened through the loops of the wires." 3. The cone dredge. Many organisms are too small to be readily collected with dip nets and many escape when aquatic vegetation is gathered. These may be readily obtained by this ingenious device of Professor E. A. Birge, which may be run among aquatic plants where the townet cannot be used. The cone dredge (Fig. 12) now used by Professor Birge consists of four parts. A. The body is a cylinder of sheet copper three inches in diameter and one inch deep, wired at its lower edge to form a lip on the outside. A brass wire bent into a V with an eye at its apex is soldered by its free ends inside the body while its apex extends upward like the bail of a pail. B. A cone of brass wire netting of about twenty meshes to the inch fits over the bail. ^S^nfuSJd-iliteriw™ Its base is soldered to the body and its apex ^^jlTi™™^ to the eye of the bail which projects through bJJj by pr*S" it. Two flat loops of wire soldered to the outside of the body serve for the attachment of cords. C. The net is a conical bag of cheesecloth eighteen to twenty- METHODS OF COLLECTING AND raDTOOTAPHEKJ 69 two inches long and may, by altering the dimensions, be cut out according to the directions given for the townet. It should be faced with strong muslin for two or three inches at each aid. It is tied by its upper end over the flange on the body. D. The screw tip consists of the screw top of a kerosene oil rm^ extended by soldering to the male screw a copper cylinder an inch and a quarter long. The cylinder is wired at its top to farm a projecting flange over which the tip of the net is tied- The cap is weighted by soldering to it a lead ring of about two ounces. Two loops of wire soldered to the outside of the screw tip serve far the attachment of cords from the Loops on the body and these support the weight of the screw tip and take the strain off the net. This net may be readily dragged behind a boat among dense water plants by means of a cord attached to the eye. The cone fends off the water plants and lessens the amount of debris altering the net and clogging it. The net may also be thrown from shore to a distance of thirty or forty feet and safely hauled back through thick vegetation. It may also be run at some depth or along the bottom by attaching a suitable weight to die line, two or three feet in front of the cone. When a haul has been made the screw cap is removed so that the contents of the net fall into a cup or jar of water. Several successive hauls may be united When the foreign matter winch always alters the net has settled to the bottom of the jar, the clear water containing the entomostraca is poured into a metal funnel with a long neck made of brass wire gauze of about forty meshes to the inch (Fig. ti'k The neck, which serves as a filter, terminates in a tin ring which is corked. When the entomostraca have been: filtered from the water the cork is removed and the catch wrahed into an eight-dram homeopathic vial, short form, in which: it is preserved. When many catches from different localities are to be kept sep- arate, Professor Birge uses flat bags, one by three inches* made by stitching together on the sewing rrmrhfrrg pieces of India linen. Before going into the field the bags are numbered and strung am a thread so that they may be pulled off in order. The catch: m 70 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY poured through an ordinary tin funnel into the bags, which are then tied and placed in the preservative. An "improved" form of cone dredge has been described by Wol- cott (1901), who has worked out a standard type of holder for cone dredge, dip net, sieve, and scoop. A folding-cone dredge is sold under the name simplex plankton net. Its cone is made of cloth. The plankton pump may also be used for collecting free swim- ming forms among aquatic vegetation. In making collections along the margin of a pond or stream, or in the puddles of a bog or half-dried ditch, it is advantageous to use a dipper with a cane or short bamboo handle. One may fasten to such a handle a wide-mouth bottle, a dipper with fine metal gauze bottom, a pruning hook or other apparatus for securing samples of the plant or animal life in such places as are somewhat inaccessible. A shallow glass dish or white soup plate is very useful in examining immediately refuse obtained from the margin or bottom of such pools. By some such means the heavier particles of sand and silt may be separated from the collection before it is preserved. B. Bottom Collecting The dredge that is commonly used in deep-sea work is of little value in fresh water owing to the relative barrenness of lake bottoms. The larger bottom vegetation may be obtained at any depth by the use of Pieters' grapple already described. For the smaller organ- isms that live in the superficial ooze of the bottom, the cone dredge or the townet may be used. A weight heavy enough to bring the line to the bottom is attached to the towline two or three feet in front of the net. The cone dredge when attached to a weighted line may be made to run along the bottom by weighting the screw tip, but in that case it is well to fasten a band of cloth about the base of the wire cone so as to leave only the upper part free. The net, while admitting water through the tip of the wire cone, then glides over the bottom without scraping up mud. A townet mounted on runners, as shown here (Fig. 13), has been found very useful by the writer for taking organisms just above soft bottom. From the iron ring which supports the mouth of the METHODS OF COLLECTING AND PHOTOGRAPHING 71 net four pieces of half-inch band htm extend radially for about three inches and then turn and run parallel to one another for some distance beyond the tip of the net. Here they are bent inward and riveted at the center. To collect organisms that live in the bottom it is necessary to use some form of dredge that will bring up the bottom material. To bring up the superficial ooze the weight attached to the townet line or cone dredge line may have the form of a rake, or be other- . wise irregular, so that it stirs up the ooze and drives animals from it to he caught in the net. For animals that cannot be thus dislodged the writer ha^ used a triangle dredge (Fig. 14). This consists of a bag of one-fourth- inch square mesh netting, or burlap, or other coarse material, lined at the bottom with muslin and hung from a wrought iron frame which may be made by any blacksmith. The frame consists of an equilateral triangle, twelve to fifteen inches on each side, of heavy band iron, and of three stout iron rods, one extending from each angle of the triangle at right angles to its surface, to a distance of about three feet. The edge of the triangle is formed into large saw-teeth bent slightly out- ward so that they tend to dig into the bottom. An eye at each comer serves to attach a rope which extends to the hauling fine. The rods serve to keep the triangle upright when the net is drawn along the bottom, so that the mouth of the bag is open and the teeth plow into the bottom. Another useful type of dredge has the form of a triangular or quadrangular pyramid, whose side and slant height are each about six inches. A number of stout steel wires, about six on each side, are soldered together so as to form the apex of the pyramid, while their opposite ends are bent slightly outward beyond its base, so that they project like the teeth of a comb. The framework thus 72 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY formed is covered with wire cloth and the apex of the pyramid is filled with lead to the depth of an inch and a half. An eye at each angle serves to attach a cord. This dredge is very effective in collecting bottom mollusca. C. Open Water Collecting — Qualitative Methods i. The townet is the simplest device for collecting the plankton organisms which abound in the open water. The following direc- tions for making a townet are modified from Kofoid (1898). The completed net (Fig. 15) consists of a conical bag of India linen or better of silk bolting cloth hung from a ring which is sup- ported by three cords. The bolting cloth may be number 12, 16 or 20 and is to be had from dealers in mill supplies, but discarded cloth may often be obtained from flour mills. Before cut- ting the cloth should be shrunk by boiling in soapsuds and then pressed. A pattern for cutting two nets twelve inches in diameter from a yard Fig. 15. Simple townet . .111. 1 1 • • /▼*.. ,\ without ^jcket^A. wire 0f forty-inch wide bolting cloth is given (Fig. io). dFaW9ew?totopoiSL The cloth has been doubled lengthwise (with the line*1 lSfod5edw2oS warp) and is shown with the fold at the right and Kotow.) ^e two £ree gjges at the left. With a radius equal to the length of the cloth two arcs are struck from the points a and b as centers. These arcs, which form the tops of the completed nets, must be equal in length to one-half the circumference of the net hoop and these lengths may be most readily determined by rolling the net ring along the arcs. An additional width must be allowed on the piece d, since this is in two parts and has two seams. This is accomplished by cutting the two pieces apart along the line ab a quarter of an inch to the right of the diagonal. The pieces are then formed into cones and closed by a French seam along the side and by the seam across the apex. The top of the net is finished by sewing on a band made of a doubled strip of butcher's linen, cut bias and provided with a heavy cord sewed into its upper margin. The net is attached to the ring by over-cast stitches of heavy thread* The ring r (Fig. 15) of METHODS OF COLLECTING AND PHOTOGRAPHING 73 No. 5 spring brass wire, standard American gage, has three pairs of wire rings h soldered on it at equal distances to hold the drawlines dl in place. To the drawHnes at their junction a short cord wl may be attached for the support of a weight. If the net is used in this form the catch must be removed from it by turning it inside out and sousing the tip in a bottle of water. It is more convenient to cut off the tip of the net along the line ij and tie into it a screw tip like that described above for the cone dredge, but without the weight. A short glass tube closed by a rubber stopper or a bucket like that of the plankton net may be used in place of the screw tip. Provided with a bucket the net is identical with the plankton net except that it lacks the canvas cone. The townet may be dragged behind a boat either at the surface or submerged to any depth by means of a weight attached to the weight line. When the haul is completed the net is soused in the water or water is thrown on its outer surface, until the contents are washed to the tip of the net, which is then turned inside out and the contents obtained by rinsing the tip in a bottle of water, or allowing them to fall into preserving fluid. The pro- cedure for a net provided with a bucket is described under the plankton net and cone dredge. 2. Plankton Cylinders. Various forms of apparatus have been designed for collecting plankton from a rapidly moving boat. These are made with a very small opening for the entrance of water and with a large filtering surface. They are designed to reduce the pressure of the water on the filtering surface. They are described by Steuer and others. They are chiefly of use in the sea or in other situations accessible only to large vessels and are little em- ployed in fresh water. The plankton cylinder is one form of such apparatus in which a torpedo-shaped metal jacket admits water through a small opening on its conical end and carries the filtering gauze in the interior or on its other end. Fig. i6. Showing method of laying out a patten for cut- ting two townets from a yard of cloth forty inches wide, a-b, line along which doth is to be cut. c-d, the two net patterns, e-f, seam by which the bottom of the net is closed if no bucket is attached (see Fig. 15). f-*» line of attachment ofbucket. t-j, line along which net is cut off when bucket is used. (After Kofoid.) 74 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY D. Quantitative Methods in Open Water i. The Quantitative Plankton Net. The plankton net and pump are intended for the collection of plankton for quantitative inves- tigations. The plankton net differs from the townet described in that its rim extends upward into a truncated cone of canvas (Fig. 17), and that it is provided with a removable bucket. The canvas cone hinders bottom ooze from entering the net and also hinders the slopping out of the contents as the net is drawn above the surface. It serves further to lessen the diameter of the net opening, so that a larger fraction of the column of water above the net opening is filtered and less of it is pushed aside by the resistance of the filtering gauze. The plankton net (Fig. 1 7) in use at the University of Wisconsin is here first described with the permission of Professor Birge. The ring which supports the net is about ■ ; - rr&$ seven inches in diameter and from this ' measurement the other dimensions of the apparatus may be roughly measured on the figure. The canvas cone stretches from the net ring to an upper ring and both rings are of one-eighth-inch spring brass wire. Three eight-shaped pieces of lighter wire are strung on each ring through one opening, while the other opening receives the eyes on the ends of three connecting rods which hold the two rings together. The upper support- ing ring has three brass rings soldered to it for the attachment of the draw lines. The canvas cone and the band, which is ordinarily sewn to the top of the net, are in this case cut from one piece of shrunken canvas. This is sewn around the upper supporting ring and is attached to the inside of the lower ring by means of a tape sewn to its out- side. The bolting cloth net (No. 16 or No. 20 cloth) is sewn to plankton ik£. METHODS OF COLLECTING AND PHOTOGRAPHING 75 ul photographs.) the inside of the band, with its margin turned back over its outer surface for the fraction of an inch. By this construction the canvas cone folds conveniently for transportation, while the inner surfaces of cone and net are continuous and smooth, so that plankton organisms do not readily lodge on them. If convenience in transportation is not important the cone may be better made of sheet brass. The original feature of this lj£*gg5ife-#nrf™ net is the bucket (Figs. 18 and 19), which is made of telescope tubing of two sizes. The smaller size (two inches in internal diameter) is used to make the headpiece shown attached to the net in Fig. 17. This (Fig. 19, a) is one \ and three eighths inches long and is I fastened to the net by means of a brass band clamp (Fig. 19, b) made of , two pieces, with wings at the ends through which pass clamp screws. A pin soldered into the headpiece fits a hole in each half of the clamp • . ' and prevents its turning when the I ', bucket is twisted to remove it (seen ' near the upper margin of Fig. 19, a). L1 Three brass rings soldered to the out- I ■. J side of the band clamp serve to attach "~ cords which extend to the lower sup- F,™9n pS&^^^p^T porting ring of the canvas cone and %g&%gTj£^Z carry the weight of the bucket. Z?VUj&£4U«^N The bucket (Fig. 18) is made of tele- K& do— aupminn """ """ff scope tubing of a size which fits over !^]£B^'ta?fS't£^f'loolapt>1" tnat use(* *or tne neadp>ece. Pieces are cut from the sides of this so as to form four windows separated by strips about one-half inch wide. These strips are strengthened by soldering to the inside of each a semi-cylindrical rod about one-quarter inch in diameter (Fig. 19, A). 76 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The bottom of the bucket which is conical and ends in a tapering spout is shrunk into place flush with the lower edge of the windows, after heating the bucket in a jet of steam. A taper plug of brass, with a long stem (Fig. 19, i) which ends in a milled head, is inserted from within and closes the spout. The edge of the bucket has an L-shaped incision which receives a pin soldered to the outside of the headpiece so as to form a bayonet catch which holds the bucket in place on the headpiece. The four windows in the bucket are closed by a single piece of bolting cloth, held in place by a band clamp at top and bottom (Fig. 19 d, e) and by four side clamps g screwed between the windows. The holes for the screws are conveniently burned through the bolting cloth with a hot wire. A cheaper bucket described by Kofoid (1898) is shown in section in Fig. 20. It is a cylinder of sheet copper around the top of which are soldered two light-wire rings, which serve to hold in place the string s, which ties the tip of the net to the bucket. In the sides of the cylinder are cut three equidistant windows, each one and one- ■ iiii half by one and three-quarters inches, which are |\ ^ closed by brass wire gauze wg, soldered to the /^ edges. Gauze containing two hundred meshes Fie. 20. Simple townet .. • « n r ..i • backet as seen in sec- per linear inch answers very well for these win- tion. b, conical bottom. _, . , . # rf>, drip point, it', wire dows. The bottom of the bucket is a cone of rings soldered to top of m whkftipof nrt^tS copP^ yn^1 a central opening which continues tSettwobwirf riSTH i11^0 a short, obliquely-pointed tube /. The open- for^mp^^bSckS! ing is closed by a rubber stopper with a wire y^ie^thSe^mdowt handle which extends above the top of the bucket cut in sides of bucket. i . 1 , • . i Tberubberstopperwith and IS bent into a loop. wire handle is seen at . ... center of bucket. (After The net is constructed like the townet, except Kofoid.) * that the tip is cut off at the point ij (Fig. 16) and the silk slit along the dotted lines between gh and ij to allow for the fitting and fastening of the bucket in place. The plankton net is drawn from the bottom to the surface, and the organisms that have been caught in it are washed into the bucket by throwing water onto the outside of the net, or by sousing it in the water. The net is then lifted above the water, METHODS OF COLLECTING AND PHOTOGRAPHING 77 the bucket removed, and the water allowed to drain from it. When only so much water remains as fills the conical bottom of the bucket, the stopper is drawn and the contents allowed to fall into a suitable container. Organisms adhering to the inside of the bucket are then rinsed into the container with a little filtered or distilled water from a wash bottle. If the contents are to be preserved they may be allowed to fall directly into a bottle which contains the preservative or fixing fluid, so concentrated that the addition of the plankton brings it to its normal consti- tution. Ninety-five per cent alcohol may be used and in that case the plankton may be allowed to fall from the bucket into about three times its own volume of alcohol, so that it is preserved in alcohol of about 70 per cent strength. If it is desired to use a fixing fluid before preservation in alcohol, the stronger picrosulphuric acid may be diluted with two volumes of water and three volumes of this may be used to one of plankton, so that the latter is fixed in Kleinenberg's solution. Other fluids may be used in like manner, adapted either to the plankton as a whole, or to special groups of plankton organisms. The plankton is then best caught in a strainer made by removing the bottom of a short eight-dram homeopathic vial and tying bolting cloth over the neck (Fig. 18). The plankton may be kept in this strainer by tying bolting cloth over the bottom, and the strainer may then be passed through fixing fluids and grades of alcohol. The fluids may be made to enter the strainer by withdrawing the air by means of a pipette held against the bolting cloth (Reighard, 1894). Plankton nets may be made closable and various devices have been used for this purpose (e.g., by Marsh, 1897). Such a net may be lowered, drawn upward any desired distance, then closed and drawn to the surface. It thus filters only that part of the column of water through which it is drawn while open, and aids the inves- tigator to determine what forms occur at various depths. Although the plankton net may seem to filter a vertical column of water, the base of which is equal in area to the net opening, it does not in practice do this. The resistance of the net gauze causes a certain part of this column to be pushed aside. The part 78 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY pushed aside not only is greater as the net moves faster but is increased as the net becomes clogged and is therefore greater toward the end of the haul than at its beginning. The filtering capacity of the net gauze is further liable to change with age, as its pores clog and its threads loosen and tend to obstruct the openings. Although elaborate methods have been devised for determining the errors of the plankton net, no one of them is satis- factory. 2. The Plankton Pump. The difficulties encountered in the use of the plankton net for accurate quantitative work have led to the development of the plankton pump, which is now largely used in conjunction with the ordinary plankton net and which, used in that connection, has nearly displaced the closable plankton net (Birge, 1895; Marsh, 1897) in fresh water. This may be any pump which delivers at each stroke a known and constant volume of water. The water is drawn through a hose which extends from the pump to any desired depth and may terminate in a metal cone, closed by very coarse wire netting, which serves to exclude foreign bodies from the hose. From the pump the water may be conveniently delivered through a shorter hose to some device for filtering the plankton from it. For this purpose a plankton net is used. The net may be suspended in air and the water pumped into it, but some small organisms are thus forced through the net gauze and lost, and others are doubtless injured by the impact of the stream of water and the weight of the water in the net. This is avoided if the net be held under water with only the canvas cone above the surface. The whole operation may be readily carried out by one person if the net be supported in the water by a wooden float surrounding the cone (Fig. 23) and the delivery hose be attached to the net (Kofoid, 1897). When sufficient water has been pumped, the net is taken up and the catch removed and treated in the usual way. The end of the suction hose may be allowed to remain at any desired depth during the pumping. The pump is calibrated so that the volume of water delivered at each stroke is known. The number of strokes made during any haul is counted, so that a simple calculation gives the total volume of water pumped. *;ij. :*L:im m rwnrJUTim.. AKI> SBOTWaaSfflWG 7t Tie «d of Ike iiaat may aisr» be lowered xo near the bottom and *™y "riiffr: wtiifc jMimjiinf kTrpragrcss be sfrwrty QX&WXl HpWSTtl Xt £ unimui TBtg. 3e "ttik way is pmnprd £ vertical roinnm of matter inma Hie bottom no tbe surface, and the volume of pump may be retcncd id £ nWmnri iaav lie camuaBcn. iattowm^ farms of briefly. uz F+mycc pmmt Tardyce. 2808 . This invention of Protesttns "Ward and Foniyee is showii in perspective kT^. -21 and in sec- tion CFig. .22,. li ^isprarucaliy £ iorce pump. . . . Tbe cyfrnaer "Fxc. £i ^ordyce tpnopna jAittrr Hmtycc m lAittr tanfcAce of thepmmois-ekvenbytbrceandone-baH 347I cubic inches per stroke. Tbe stroke of tbe piston is r^trmt^ iniength and is regulated by a lock nut as shown in tbe plate. Tbe calves used are iraeiy-ground check valves, to which ii is believed tbe accuracy of tbe working of tbe apparatus is largely due. Tbe pomp is connected with tbe water by a bose one and one-ball incbes in diameter, whose lower aid is adjusted to tbe various ver- tical zones of water by means of attachment to a floating block..'' For fAtmnfc tbe water Foniyee uses tbe device shown in Fig. 21, at tbe nght of tbe pump. This is similar to tbe device already de- scribed in connection with tbe Wisconsin plankton net. and is used in tbe same way. It is provided with a rim to which a cover of wire netting may be attached to exclude ioreign matter. A net 80 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY of bolting cloth may be attached outside the wire gauze filter, and the whole instrument is then adapted for the various work of the ordinary net. On account of its cheapness and portability a pump of this form is probably best adapted for work not carried on from a station especially equipped for aquatic biology. (A) The clock pump has been used for some years at the Uni- versity of Wisconsin (Juday, 1004). At Wisconsin the pump is fixed to the bottom of the boat and the water, drawn through a half-inch garden hose, is pumped into a submerged plankton net of No. 20 bolting cloth. (c) The thresher tank-pump, a double-acting force pump with two cylinders each six by nine inches, has been used by Kofoid (1897). The mode of using the pump is shown (Fig. 23). This pump is fastened to the boat and is too heavy to be carried or to be used apart from a permanent mounting. 3. The Water Bottle. To obtain small samples of water for the study of the nannoplankton a water bottle may be used. Many complicated and expensive forms of these bottles have been devised (see Helland Hansen) for use at all depths in the sea. The bottle described by Theiler appears to be the simplest and least expensive of them. For use in fresh water a Meyer's bottle (Fig. 24) serves fairly well and is easily made. A stout glass bottle of one or METHODS OF COLLECTING AND PHOTOGRAPHLNG 8l two liters capacity, and with a good-sized neck is provided with a tight rubber stopper to which is attached the draw-cord by which the bottle is to be lowered and the stopper drawn. Beneath the bottle is attached a weight a little heavier than needed to sub- merge the empty stoppered bottle. The bottle may be lowered to a depth of a hundred feet or less and the stopper removed by jerking on the draw-cord. E. Quantitative Study of the Net Plankton If the plankton net were a perfect instrument it should catch all the organisms contained in the vertical column of water through which it is drawn, that is, in a column of the diameter of the net opening and equal in height to the distance through which the net is drawn. But the net filters only a part of the column of water through which it is drawn, a part which depends on the age of the net, the rate at which it is drawn and upon the rapidity with which it becomes clogged while being drawn. If the net is of the form described above, is cleansed by throwing a stream of water on it after each haul and is drawn at about the rate of one meter per second, it niters about 40 per cent of the column of water which it traverses. Hence, '0 know the total amount of plankton in the column of water traversed by the net, we must multiply the amount actually taken by two and one-half. This number is called the coefficient of the net. The coefficient depends on the construction of the net, on the fineness of the gauze used, and on the rate at which the net is drawn, and must therefore be determined by calculation for each net for the different rates. Not only does the net filter but a part of the water and a different part at different times, but it removes from the water filtered only ho"ie. tfit* ' - .. . . . , . .. t, ..■' Wiley udjoooj a part 01 the organisms contained m it. iwen the finest gauze permits a leakage through it of very many small organisms. Owing to the sources of error indicated the net method is useful chiefly with the larger organisms, such as cms- 82 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY tacea. Smaller organisms escape in variable quantity and the smallest are not caught at all. When the pump is used a known volume of water is drawn from a known source and all of this is filtered, so that the source of error arising from a varying and uncertain net coefficient is eliminated. The leakage error remains uncorrected so long as a net is used to separate the plankton from the water. The plankton obtained by nets whether directly or by aid of the pump may be treated quantitatively by the following methods: (a) The volume may be obtained by allowing the alcoholic material to stand for 24 hours in gradu- ated tubes (carbon tubes of the chemist) until it has settled, when the volume may be read off. There is thus obtained in cubic centimeters the volume of Fl2ii 1 P^ Steuer. 1910. (See list in Chapter I.) Theiler, A. 1914. Ein neuer Wasser- und Planktonschdpfer nach Fried- inger. Int. Rev. ges. Hydrob. u. Hydrog. Biol. Suppl. Band 6, Heft 4. Ward, H. B. 1806. (See list in Chapter I.) Ward, R. H. 1895. Improved Methods of Collecting Aquatic Micro-organ- isms. Amer. Mo. Micr. Jour., 16: 33-41* 1 pi. Whipple, G. C. (See list in Chapter I.) Wolcott, R. H. 1001. A Modification of the Birge Collecting Net. Jour. Appl. Micros., 4: 1407-1409, 4 figs. CHAPTER IV BACTERIA By EDWIN O. JORDAN Professor of Bacteriology in the Umhersity of Chicago Bacteria are unicellular organisms, for the most part very small. Considerable differences in size, however, are observed. A certain large, rod-shaped species studied by Schaudinn measures from 50M to 6om in length and from 4m to 5m in width. On the other hand the bacillus of influenza averages about 0.5*1 in length and 0.2 fi in width. The average rod-shaped bacterium, such as is found in water and soil, measures about 2m in length and about 0.5M in diameter. Some microorganisms are known to exist which are so small that they will pass through the pores of the finest Berkefeld filter and remain invisible under the most powerful lenses, but it is not surely established that all these so- called ultramicroscopic organisms belong to the group of bacteria. For the methods of studying bacteria, special laboratory man- uals or guides should be consulted. A number of such guides are in existence, among which may be mentioned Heinemann (191 1) and Frost (1905). In any case a proper familiarity with laboratory methods can be gained only with the assistance of a skilled labora- tory instructor possessed of individuality and resource. Bacteria are generally classed as plants rather than animals, but, as is well known, the dividing line between animals and plants is an entirely arbitrary one, and there is no general agreement among naturalists respecting what shall constitute a determina- tive plant or animal characteristic. It is largely considerations of convention and convenience that place them among the plants. From their lack of chlorophyl and the fact that they multiply by division or fission the bacteria are classed as SckizomyceUs or fission fungi. Within the group of bacteria themselves classification is, for practical purposes, especially important, but because they are so 90 BACTERIA 91 minute in size and the observable differences in structure are so slight, any classification grounded on morphological characters, such as that of Migula (1897), meets with many difficulties, and would seem at present to be premature. Because of the great prac- tical importance of physiological qualities, bacteriologists have come to lay great stress upon bacterial functions, and considera- tions of convenience have often led to groups being established on physiological characteristics. The practice of dealing with bacteria in related groups is growing. For the identification of specific and group characters the Report of the Committee of the Society of American Bacteriologists on Method of Identification of Bacterial Species should be consulted. The forms of bacteria are very simple. The complex and elabo- rate structures found among certain other groups of unicellular organisms (diatoms, desmids, radiolaria) do not occur among bac- teria. Three principal type forms are recognized: the sphere (coccus or micrococcus), the rod (bacillus), and the spiral (spirillum Fig. 30. Forms of Bacteria. and spirochete) (Fig. 30). Closely resembling these are certain filamentous organisms known as Trichomycetes, which connect the bacteria with the higher fungi or moulds. The minute size of bacteria renders the study of their finer structure somewhat difficult, but a few features have been clearly determined. Most species, perhaps all, are provided with a cap- sule or outer layer of gelatinous substance originating from the cell-membrane and seen in stained preparations surrounding the cell like a halo. The capsule is much more prominently developed in some species than in others. The cell-membrane is chiefly re- markable for its chemical composition, differing as it does from the cell-membrane of the higher plants in not being composed of cel- lulose. The nature of the cell-substance of bacteria has been the object of much discussion from the standpoint of its relation to the 92 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY nuclear substance of higher cells. It has been held by different observers that a bacterial cell is to be compared either to a free nucleus or to an unnucleated mass of cytoplasm, but these views have now been practically abandoned. It seems to be clear from the researches of recent investigators that the chromatin substance instead of being gathered together in a definite nucleus, as in the cells of most higher forms of life, is fragmented and distributed irregularly through the body of the cell. The bacterial chromatin is usually present in great abundance, varies in amount and in position in different kinds of bacteria and occurs most frequently in a finely-divided condition. Not only are particles of chromatin scattered through the cell, but other granules that react to stains in special ways are present in the cell substance, particularly in certain species. The physiological significance of these so-called metachromatic granules, as they occur for example in the diphtheria bacillus, is unknown, but it seems probable that they are to be looked upon as reserve food substances. Many forms of bacteria show independent movement, distinct from the oscillating or trembling movement exhibited by all minute particles suspended in water and known as the Brownian movement. The power of motility depends upon the possession of long, fragile, filamentous appendages termed flagella. In the case of certain large spirilla, flagella can be seen on the living, unstained cell, but ordinarily special methods of staining must be applied to demon- strate their presence. The position of the flagella on the cell body differs in different species. Some species possess a single flagellum at one pole, as is the case with the cholera spirillum; others have a flagellum at either pole; others have polar tufts of flagella; and still others possess flagella attached to the sides as well as the ends of the cell (typhoid bacillus) (Fig. 30) . In certain nonmotile bacteria, such as the anthrax bacillus, no flagella have been observed. Under certain conditions some bacteria pass from the ordinary or vegetative stage into a highly resistant state, known as a spare or endospore. The spores of bacteria are approximately spherical or oval, are stained with great difficulty with the ordinary aniline dyes and resist destructive agencies, such as heat and chemical disinfectants, much better than the vegetative forms from which BACTERIA 93 they spring. A single cell, as a rule, gives rise to but one spore, so that spore formation can not be looked upon as a process of multi- plication. It is generally considered that the bacterial spore is a resting stage, physiologically similar to an encysted amoeba and serving to tide the species over a period of hard times. Not all bacteria are spore producing; in fact the number known to form spores is rather limited. Great adaptability is shown by bacteria to extremes of tempera- ture. Some species have been found multiplying in the water of polar seas at or near the freezing point, while others have been found living in the water of hot springs at a temperature of 790 C. Most of the ordinary bacteria found in pond or river water multiply abundantly at a temperature of about 200 C. When water is frozen, most of the bacteria that it contains are killed at once. A small proportion survive, but in gradually diminishing numbers, so that at the end of a few weeks clear ice is practically sterile. Bacteria contained in masses of organic matter, however, may have their life in ice considerably prolonged. Bacteria not only adapt themselves to great extremes of tem- perature, but to varied sources of food supply. Many species can content themselves with relatively simple chemical compounds, such as the ammonium salts of the organic acids. Others require for their development complex nitrogenous substances. The nitri- fying bacteria, so abundant in most soils and waters, obtain the energy necessary for their development altogether from inorganic compounds. On the other hand, certain bacteria are entirely dependent upon particular organic compounds present in the bodies of the higher animals, and can thrive only in the presence of blood serum or similar fluids. Fundamental differences exist among bacteria in respect to their relative need for oxygen. Some, the obligatory aerobes, require free oxygen for the maintenance of their life activities, while others, the obligatory anaerobes, do not grow except in the almost complete absence of free oxygen. There are also some, the facultative anaer- obes, that can multiply either in the presence or absence of free oxygen. The anaerobic bacteria, as a class, thrive best in the pres- ence of substances capable of undergoing reduction or fermentation. 94 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The addition of glucose or nitrate, for example, to ordinary nutrient broth will enable certain species of bacteria to grow under condi- tions otherwise unfavorable. The relation between anaerobic life and food supply is an intimate one. The anaerobes, in a word, are those organisms able to obtain their needed energy from the simple splitting of organic compounds without oxidation. If a microorgan- ism is so specialized to an anaerobic mode of life that the presence of oxygen, except in minute quantities, interferes with its habitual method of attacking food substances, it is an obligatory anaerobe. In a modified form, therefore, Pasteur's conception of fermentation as "life without air" is not very far from the modern view. Those decompositions of organic substances that are usually termed putrefactions and are characterized by the evolution of malodorous gases such as hydrogen sulphide and the production of substances like skatol, indol, mercaptan, etc., are due to the agency of anaerobic bacteria. In fact, researches indicate that the putre- factive decomposition of native proteins is wholly the work of the obligatory anaerobes. As is well known, the ooze at the bottom ot ponds and streams is peculiarly the home of such anaerobic decom- positions. Bacteria are everywhere present in natural bodies of water. They are more abundant as a rule in surface waters than in ground waters. Deep well waters and spring waters in certain regions often contain very few bacteria, perhaps only five to ten per cubic centimeter, while the water of lakes and ponds usually contains several hundred, and ordinary river water contains numbers that at times rise into the thousands and tens of thousands. As a general rule, sewage-polluted waters contain more bacteria than pure waters. An excessively polluted stream, such as the Chicago River once was, may hold as many as several million bacteria per cubic centi- meter. The number of bacteria in a river water varies greatly at differ- ent seasons of the year, being generally larger in the colder months than in summer. Probably this is due in part to the winter in- crease in current caused by rains and melting snows which prevents sedimentation; in part to the heavy rains of winter which wash into a stream numberless germs from cultivated lands, and partly also BACTERIA 95 to the lower temperature of the water in winter which favors the continuance of bacterial vitality. In highly-polluted rivers the processes of decomposition are retarded by cold weather; in con- sequence, bacteria together with their food substances travel for a greater distance down stream in winter than in summer. This condition has been shown to exist, for example, in the Illinois River which is heavily polluted with Chicago sewage. Besides these important seasonal fluctuations, daily and hourly changes may be noticed, depending upon the amount of rainfall, the velocity of the current, the direction and force of the wind and perhaps the germicidal action of sunlight. For these reasons, it is necessary, in order to interpret correctly the sanitary significance of the bacterial content of any body of surface water, to make re- peated examinations under a variety of circumstances and with particular attention to the effect of modifying conditions. In the case of ground waters (wells, springs, etc.), the number of bacteria is less affected by changes in external conditions, but here also great caution is necessary in drawing conclusions from a limited number of observations. The following table gives some conception of the number of bacteria that may be found by the gelatin plate method in various bodies of water. Great variations occur and any such tabulation can have only an approximate value. Per cubic centimeter Sewages or sewage-polluted waters 100,000 to 1,500,000 Rivers not highly polluted 1,000 to 10,000 Lakes and ponds not highly polluted 100 to 1,000 Pure spring waters 5 to 50 The enormous number of bacteria which such figures show to be present in all natural bodies of water comprises many different kinds. There is no special and characteristic class of "water bacteria," but germs from the air, from the soil, from decomposing animal and plant substances and from the healthy and diseased tissues of animals and plants may at times find their way into water. The bacterial flora of a given stream or pond is therefore 96 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY constantly changing, and varies from time to time not only in the number, but in the nature of the individuals composing it (Fig. 31). Little work has yet been done upon the changes in the kinds of bacteria in river or lake water due to the shifting seasons and other factors, but there is no doubt that important differences do exist. Many varieties of bac- teria have been isolated from water. During the course of a study of the bacteria in the water of the Illinois River the writer found that out of 543 cultures, 17 well-defined groups and 41 subgroups were represented. These groups include a number of pigment- producing or chromogenic (origin].} forms, some of which are among the most common inhabitants of water, and also a number of bacteria closely related to organisms associated with the production of disease in the higher animals. Among the bacteria commonly found in natural waters may be mentioned B. fiuo- rescens vars. liquefaciens and non-liquefaciens (the green water bacillus), B. subtilis (the hay bacillus), B. mesentericus (the potato bacillus), B. proteus and B. cloacae (commonly associated with the decomposition of vegetable and animal matter), B. liquefaciens, B. hyalinus, B. violaceus, and many chromogenic and non-chromo- genic micrococci; in polluted waters, B. colt is usually found in large numbers and organisms of the B. proteus type and strepto- cocci are more abundant than in normal waters. It is well known that the germs of several of the principal infec- tious diseases of man are commonly conveyed in drinking water. Typhoid fever and Asiatic cholera are familiar examples. Both the typhoid bacillus and the cholera spirillum have been found in water, although, partly because the technical difficulties of investi- gation are considerable, partly because the longevity of these organisms in water is limited, positive findings have not been very BACTERIA 97 frequent. Under ordinary conditions there is no reason to suppose that pathogenic bacteria multiply in water or that they retain their vitality for more than a few weeks. In polluted soil, however, they may live much longer than in water, and a river may be con- tinuously polluted during a long period by bacteria that are washed into it from accumulations of fecal material. Other pathogenic bacteria occasionally water-borne are the dysentery bacillus and the anthrax bacillus. Since the search for specific pathogenic bacteria in a water is hardly ever likely to be crowned with success, various indirect means for determining the purity of a water have been proposed. The most useful of these analytical methods is the test based on the determination of the relative number of Bacillus coli. This, the colon bacillus, is a normal inhabitant of the healthy human intestine and is found in large numbers in fresh sewage where, by appropriate methods, it is usually detected in each y^^^ c.c. ex- amined. Since it is also present in the droppings of many of the larger domestic animals and hence occurs in garden soil and in pastures, its occasional presence in water does not necessarily in- dicate possible or even probable pollution with fecal matter of human origin. The researches of many investigators, however, have shown that the relative abundance of Bacillus coli in water is a very satisfactory criterion of the sanitary quality of such a water. If, for example, it is found uniformly present in a water in each i c.c. sample, the water is looked upon as distinctly suspicious. In cases, however, where it is rarely found in i c.c. samples and only occasionally when quantities as large as 10 c.c. or even 50 c.c. are examined, the water is usually considered potable. The bacteria in water stand in important relations to the life of other aquatic plants and animals. It is a familiar fact that but for bacterial activity the nitrogen and carbon in complex organic com- pounds once bound would remain forever locked up and unavail- able for the nutrition of other forms of life. As is well known also, the first steps in decomposition or the breaking down of organic substances are due to bacterial agency. Ammonia and ammoni- acal compounds are among the chief nitrogenous products of this decomposition. The processes of disintegration and oxidation do 98 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY not end with the production of such a relatively simple compound as ammonia. Further oxidation of the ammonia to nitrites takes place and the nitrites in turn are oxidized to nitrates. The for- mation of nitrites and nitrates, like the formation of ammonia, is due to bacterial activity; this process is known as mirifeaUion. Special and peculiar varieties of bacteria are concerned in the proc- ess of nitrification. One species is able to oxidize Airnnnnm to nitrite, but is unable to carry the process of oxidation any further. At this stage of decomposition a second species takes up the work and completes the process by oxidizing the nitrites to nitrates. If we follow the fate of the nitrogen introduced into a sewage- polluted river, we find that there occurs first a breaking down of the albuminous compounds and a consequent increase in the amount of "free ammonia" in the water; further down, nitrites begin to appear and eventually nitrates are found. A river water in which the process of nitrification has occurred and which is therefore rich in nitrates affords a peculiarly favorable medium for the growth of plant life and often "blooms" with a myriad of microscopic algae. The presence of a multitude of algae in- fluences in its turn the life conditions of aquatic protozoa and of higher animal organisms. At times when through the advent of low temperature or other unfavorable conditions the algae die off, the albuminous compounds constituting their dead bodies undergo decomposition; ammonia, nitrites, and then nitrates are again formed, and the nitrogen cycle begins anew. The food supply of the whole plankton of fresh-water streams and ponds is therefore dependent upon the activity of bacteria, and the share of these organisms in producing or modifying the conditions under which all aquatic life is possible can never be ignored. BACTERIA 99 IMPORTANT REFERENCES ON BACTERIA Clemesha, W. W. 191 2. The Bacteriology of Surface Waters in the Tropics. London. Horrocks, W. H. 1 001. Introduction to the Bacteriological Examination of Water. London. Houston, A. C. 1913. Studies in Water Supply. London. Jordan, E. O. 1003. The Rinds of Bacteria Found in River Water. Jour- nal of Hygiene, 3:1. Migula, W. 1000. System der Bacterien. Jena. Ohlmuller and Spitta. 19 10. Wasser u. Abwasser. 3d ed., Berlin. Prescott and Winslow. 1913. Elements of Water Bacteriology. 3d ed., New York. Report of the Committee on Standard Methods of Water Analysis to the Laboratory Section of the American Public Health Association. Savage, W. G. 1906. Bacteriological Examination of Water Supplies. London. CHAPTER V BLUE-GREEN ALGAE (CYANOPHYCEAE) By EDGAR W. OLIVE Curator of the Brooklyn Botanic Garden The blue-green algae are found principally in fresh waters, although numerous forms occur also in the sea, and are almost universally distributed over the whole earth. In moist climates they are particularly abundant, growing in almost every conceiv- able situation as gelatinous masses or strata on rocks, stones, the trunks of trees, damp ground, etc. Many of them occur abun- dantly in both marine and fresh-water plankton. The peculiar phenomenon of "water-bloom" (or "working " or " blooming" of the lakes, "breaking of the meres," "Flos aquae," "Wasserbltite") is due to the sudden appearance in lakes and ponds of a surface scum formed of vast quantities of certain plankton species of these organisms. This frothy scum, forming the so-called "water- bloom," is of common occurrence in midsummer in quiet waters, especially after a protracted period of heat. Disagreeable "pig- pen" odors and bad tastes are caused by such masses when decay sets in, due, according to Jackson and Ellms, to the decay of highly nitrogenous organic matter in which partially decomposed sulphur and phosphorous compounds play a large part. The occurrence of blue-green algae in public water supplies often thus becomes of great economic importance; and Moore has found in this connec- tion that such algal growths in reservoirs may be readily eradicated or their growth prevented by the use of a dilute solution of copper sulphate. In addition to their importance as polluting organisms in water reservoirs, some recent observations appear to indicate that cer- tain plankton forms of blue-green algae are sometimes used as food by fish fry. Their indirect importance in this respect may be regarded as well established, since Birge has shown that the com- IOO SEUE-GEEEK ALGAE 101 man plankton Crustacea, winch themselves iorm the basis of lite food of many small nshes. depend to -a great extent upon Apkam- jomtmon, Anabama, and other blue-green algae for their own sus- tenance. Some species of Cyanophyceae have became adapted to living in Jiot springs; these organisms, in tact, together with certain sulphur bacteria, constituting the sole organic Jilt of thermal springs. According to the carefnJ observations of SetchelL the blue-green algae grow in same abundance in thermal waters up to 6£c C, and scantily in springs showing a temperature as high as 75°- The varied colors — shades of yellow, orange red. pink, blue, and blue green — shown by the siliceous deposits around certain hot springs of the Yellowstone Park, are due in great part to the presence of brilliantly colored blue-green algae within the deposit. Weed has discussed the part played by these algae in the formation of carbonaceous and siliceous rocks about bot springs. Same of the Cyanophyceae, principally of the genera Scytomema. Sdgomema, and Nosioc, are found associated with certain fungi to farm lichens; while still others, notably Nastoc and Anabaena, occur regularly endophytically in the roots of Cycads and in the leaves of AsoUa and other water plants. Like the bacteria, with which these algae are supposed to show dose relationship, most of the Cyanophyceae possess cell walls which became much swollen and mucilaginous in their outer layers. Thus most of the filamentous forms became invested in either a thin mucous sheath or a tough, iameliose sheathing tube. Many of the colonial forms consist of masses of cells embedded in a thick, jelly-like matrix, the external surface of which is often covered with a thin cuticle. Much dispute has arisen in recent years as to the nature of the contents of the cells of these algae. On examination with the compound microscope, one usually notes a number of granulat bodies, apparently of two kinds — numerous small granules and a few larger, clear ones. In the shorter-celled species, the smaller and mare numerous granules frequently lie in regular double rows, on cither side of the cross walls which separate the cells. In the 102 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY longer-celled forms, such as Nostoc and Tolypothrix, the small granules generally occur abundantly in all parts of the peripheral protoplasm. These minute granules are generally regarded as the "cyanophycin granules" (Borzi), and they are probably albumi- nous in their nature and serve as reserve food. The few larger granules mentioned above are more hyaline and transparent than the cyanophycin granules, and they appear to lie in or near the center of the cell. These larger granules have been called by Palla "slime globules"; by Zacharias "Centralkorner." Their function is in dispute. The cells of favorable forms of the blue-green algae, e.g., Oscil- kUoria, show two more or less evident portions of the protoplasm — a peripheral layer, to which the pigment is confined and in which the cyanophycin granules lie, and a central colorless part, the so-called " central body." The majority of recent studies on the subject maintain that the central body is a nucleus, although this conclusion has been several times disputed. Carefully stained, thin sections show, however, that it is made up of both chromatic and achromatic substances. Moreover, Macallum and others find in the central body complex proteid substances containing phos- phorus and " masked" iron to a marked degree, which they regard as characteristic constituents of chromatin. Fischer claims, how- ever, to have demonstrated by means of a tannin-safranin stain that the central body is filled with certain carbohydrates, of the nature of glycogen. The central body divides according to some, by simple amitotic division; while others believe that the division is mitotic. At any rate, the division of this nucleus, or central body, precedes the division of the cell, and, as in other lower plants, the two processes appear to take place independently of each other. Cell division is accomplished in these forms in the same manner as has been described for many other filamentous Thallophytes, by constric- tion: a ring-formed wall grows in from the outer wall, similarly to the dosing of an iris diaphragm, and finally cuts the cell in two. The varying shades of color shown by these organisms are caused by varying mixtures of the green chlorophyll and the reddish or bluish phycocyanin, the pigments being apparently nonfinrri to HLDIH5EEEN ALGAE ICXJ the- peripheral cytoplasm. The phycocyanin may readily be ex* tracted by killing the plant, when the plasma membrane at' once allows the dissolved pigment to pass out through the ceil waiL When plants axe dried and pulverized, then soaked in water, a. solution of the bluish coloring matter is thus readily obtained. A. qnkkerinethod is to place the blue-green aigae in chloroform water (made by shaking up a small quantity of chloroform in water; allowing, it to settle, then decanting the water, which is- then used in the experiment), or in water containing a few «lrops of carbon bisulphide, for a short time. Death of the plants at once ensues and the dichroic piiycocyanin passes out into the surrounding: water, leaving the rtfaments bright green from the remaining chlo- rophyll pigment- Sap vacuoles occur sometimes in the cells of file Cyanophyceae, particularly in the older elongated cells of such forms as T In the higher, filamentous Sormospneae. short one- to few-ceiled iilar menu, known as hormogonia. are reguiaiiy ^et free and these frag- ments form new plants. Spherical *r qriinuricai resting: spares- axe formed in some species by the growth in -jze >i the vegetative <:eifa- and by the thickening >f the wails. Heterocvsts ire soecial ceils ieveioDed in *>me forms- from urn- ifijy .Tgetative :etls. whose -igninrance is rut wed ludezstoocL. TTietr firotoniasmic contents apparently ^oon lie and one or two polar thickenings uspear in the :etL Tmoudteeay tfcagr me ar. times connected with the breaking m >f "-he rnamntSi iht raw, thw narraaUv occur at the basai ends- omv or tbr 104 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY A few of the Cyanophyceae show remarkable oscillating, gliding, or rotating movements, the cause of which has never been satisfac- torily explained. In Oscittatoria and Spirtdina, these movements are particularly conspicuous. CYANOPHYCEAE (MYXOPHYCEAE, PHYCOCHROUOPHYCEAE, SCHIZOPHyCBAE) Algae possessing more or less of a blue-green color; free-floating or living in gelatinous masses or strata; sexual reproduction unknown, reproducing asexu- ally by means of cell division, the daughter cells either soon separating into more or less independent cells, or remaining adherent to form filaments or plates or solid colonies. The vegetative cells each made up of two more or less easily distinguishable parts: a colored peripheral cytoplasm, which contains the bluish or reddish phycocyanin, in addition to the chlorophyll pigment, and also generally a number of minute granular bodies — the "cyanophycm gran- ules"; and the colorless "central body," which is the nucleus of the celL Embedded in the central body, in addition to the chromatic and achromatic substances, there usually occur a few large, globular, transparent bodies — the so-called "slime globules." Sap vacuoles sometimes occur in the cyto- plasm. Thick-walled resting spores are formed in some species; heterocysta are also found in certain forms, which are peculiar cells, whose protoplasmic contents apparently soon die and whose significance is but little understood, i (15) One-celled plants, living either free or united into colonies by being embedded in a common gelatinous matrix. Order Coccogoneae Thuret . . 2 a (24) Cells generally free-floating or forming a gelatinous stratum; not differentiated into base and apex. Family Chrooccccaceaz . . 3 3(8,11) Cell division in one plane only 4 4 (7) With wide mucous covering 5 5 (6) Cells elongate, each with a special mucous coat. Gloeothtce Nageli. Cells oblong or cylindrical, with thick, sometimes lamel- lose, gelatinous membrane; single or united into micro- scopically small colonies, which are enclosed after the manner of Ctoeecapta within the gelatinous membrane of the mother cell. On wet rocks, rarely floating. Cells little longer than broad, many adhering together to form large, irregular colonies, enclosed by a common mucous matrix Aphanolhtce Nageli. ■ '•-if ■■'■ Cells oblong, dividing only at right angles to the long bjqs ; forming irregular, gelatinous colonies which some- times grow to be an inch or more in diameter. At margins of lakes and on wet rocks. Fin. u. AfttmMm ImwHn Nlgeli. X icon. (OrlgbwU BLUE-GREEN ALGAE OH* with rtiin cell walk. »5 NigdL x sometime; forming mail families of tww o tour united in a raw or chain CcO-sa Mjacratatfca Utnaf. Xaij. tOrtjvaL) 31 (20 ai) Cdb enveloped in a common gelatinous matrix. Apkanocapsa Nlgeli. fj^m 1 «;» »"?2».'ji '•» Cells globose, forming irregular colonies* rnctoaetl in * thka. riocnogeneoui integument. Differing from inly in its globose cells. In stagnant Fig. 40. iltawKitu treHUa ttahenaon*. X 4S* ia (20, 31) Cells globose, reddish purple, arranged in a thin gelatinous stra- tum Porphyridium Nlgeli. Common on damp ground and at the bale of damp wiUa. 23 (11) Cells solitary or a few arlhwing together in a group, not forming a definite layer Ckroococau Nlgeli. Cells globose o BLUE-GREEN ALGAE 107 24 to Ceils epiphytic; with a distinct base and apex. Family Chamaesiphonaceae. Only one genus. . . Chamacsiphan A. Braun and Grunow. Cells small, ovoid, pyrtf arm, or cyhndrical; Attached by their base and generally widening upwuds to their free apex. Solitary or aggregated; sheaths present; ceil walls very thin; aefl content* homogeneous, hiae- green. violet, ar yellow: reproduction by one-ceiled, non-motile ceils which are successively cot aft from the upper portion of the plants, gradually escaping from the open apex. Common on Qrd(\y>mmm and other algae in ponds. FlC 42. Gfuoow. After Wcat.j X 2S(D Plants filamentous: filaments ample or branched; consisting of one or more rows of cells generally enclosed within a more or less evident aheath. Asexual reproduction by means of hormogonia. and more rarely by axnes. Order Batmummtme Thuret . . 26 26 (64J Filaments cyiindricai. sometimes narrowed at the Suborder *7 53 J Filaments not branched. 28 i£ '43; Filaments consisting of a angle row of cells, addom (SpiruUna) one-ceiled: not branched: hetemcysts absent: sheaths vari- able, more ;n^;iHu!]imMUing U-*-*- L-LLULL* 1MMMA. J^ J- ill Mil 1,1— 1-J-M i x f * H ' L L V ' ■ 1 1 il* B Fie. 45. A, OscilkUoria prolifica Gomont. B. Oscillatoria limosa Agardh. X 465. (Original) 35 (33 » 34) Filaments without sheaths, twisted into a regular spiral. Arthrospira Stizenberger. Filaments commonly without a sheath, differing from Oscillatoria in being regularly spirally coiled, and from Spindina in being many-celled. Living singly or form- ing dark-green slimy strata in stagnant water. Fie. 46. Arthrospira jenneri Stuenberger. X 500. (After GomoDt.) 36 (32) Filaments not showing oscillating movements; sheaths firm. . 37 37 (38) Filaments free and simple, free-floating or forming an expanded stratum Lyngbya C. Agardh. Filaments many-celled, straight or bent, each enclosed in a firm, generally hyaline, sometimes lamellose, membrane. Free-nont- ing, or forming densely intricate, floccose masses, or an expanded stratum. Frequently abundant in plankton. Fig. 47. Lyngbya major Meoeghinl X 46s. (Original.) BLCE-GBEE.V ALGAE S3e> »JAA pmnimhtait: F:d» iiraniin nlitwy: At at hi thin, cntortm*. Iin» c ip*i -ii the riUm^nr -itnuj^tit. jvortinw* a little i die .ipkai cell jliitrtly tfcrirtawii in 1 "~y*i,** JW (20) Several filaments in i .tmmon sheath sriiich is frequently branched. Subfamily V vuxnamEae . . 40 io 141. 42) Sheaths Xten colored; iamellose: filaments few or many, loosely aggregated Mrilhin the common sheath- Sdrimtkrix S" Several [iliuncotl axta—d in +1 (40. 43.) Sheaths hyaline, fused with adjoining 3*) A middle nodule present on the raphe of both valves. ... 11 See also 40 and 65. ia (33, 36) Girdle view symmetrica] with reference to both a transverse and a longitudinal axis 13 13 (26) Valves not arched or keeled; usually symmetrical with reference to a straight or a sigmoid raphe. Family Naviculaceae . . 14 Valves symmetrical with reference to a straight or curved middle line; girdle symmetrical with reference to both axes; a straight or curved raphe ; a central and two end nodules present. 14 (15) Cells without inner partitions; raphe and valves straight. ... 16 15(14) Raphe and valves sigmoid PU uro sigma W. Smith. Pm. jj. Plmmifru sumwlm W. Smith. X 300. (After Smith.) 16 (19) Cells linear, oblong, with rounded nodules, the two end ones turned toward one side, the prominent costae not punctate. . . 17 17 (18) The costae interrupted by a plain band at the center. Stauropkra Ehrenberg. 18(17) The costae not interrupted at the center. . Pin n uiaria Ehren berg. Smith. X600. (Oriental.) 19 (16) Cells more lance-shaped, the end nodules not turned toward one side. Striations composed of lines of individual dots. . 20 128 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 20 (23, 24, 25) Central nodule small, rounded, or slightly elongated. ... 21 21 (22) No lateral longitudinal areas of transverse septa. . . N auricula Bory. A form which grows in gelatinous tubes is regarded by some authors as a different genus Schizonetna but others regard it as a true Navicula. Fig. 77. Navicula rkynchocepkala Kutzing. X 557. (Original.) 22 (21) Two lateral longitudinal areas of transverse septa. Mostly imbedded in a gelatinous pseudothallus. . . . Mastogloia Thwaites. In shape, Mastogloia resembles Navicula, but is distinguished from it by the gelatinous envelope and the presence of lateral, transverse, siliceous septa or plates which divide the lateral regions of the cells into small compart- ments. There are transverse striatums on the valves. It is not a very common genus in America. Fig. 78. Mastogloia smithii Thwaites. X about 300. (After Smith.) A iB 23 (20, 24, 25) Central nodule broad, extending to near the margin of the valves. Stauroneis Ehrenberg. Stauroneis occurs frequently in all bodies of water and is a constituent of the diatomaceous flora which forms large siliceous deposits at the bottom of lakes. Fig. 79. Stauroneis anceps Ehrenberg. X 600. (Original.) 24 (20, 23, 25) Central nodule elongated to a short rod. Borne on gelatinous stalks Brebissonia Grun. Fig. 80. Brebissonia sp. X 580- (Original.) Central and end nodules elongated, enclosed with the raphe between two longitudinal, parallel, siliceous ribs. Frus- tules sometimes borne in gelatinous tubes. Vanheurckia Brlbisson. Fig. 81. Vanheurckia rhomboides Ehrenberg. X 370. (After West.) 26 (13) Valves asymmetrical with reference to the raphe or to a longitudinal axis; raphe arched, or nearer one margin than the other. Family Cymbellaceae . . 27 27 (28) Valves greatly convex; girdle side elliptical or oval. Amphora Ehrenberg. ^ Van Heurck regards Amphora as one of the most difficult genera of diatoms and notes that over 200 species have been placed in this genus. It is believed that it origi- nated from Cymbella. B Fig. 82. Amphora ovalis Kutzing. a. Valve side; *. girdle side. X600. (Original) 25 (20, 23, 24) *8 (27) Valves flat or only slightly convex 29 THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE 129 29 (30, 31) Raphe straight or bent, ending in the middle of the valve ends. Cells free Cymbeila Agardh. CymbeUa varies in shape from that of a typical Nomad* to one strongly arched, and they have sometimes been styled as asymmetrical Noviadas. Some authors include the genus Cocconema under CymbeUa, but the name Cocconema is the older name and should be retained. Wolle reports 25 species of CymbeUa. Fig. 85. CymbeUa cuspidal* Kutiing. X 60a (Original.) 30 (29, 31) Cells much as in CymbeUa, but usually larger and borne on gelatinous stalks. Cocconema Ehrenberg. Fig. 84. Cocconema lamtotamm Ehren- berg. X 375- (After West.) 31 (*9> 30) Raphe straight, not ending in the middle of valve ends. Cells living in gelatinous tubes Encyonema Ktitzing. Flo. 85. Emcyonema ouerualdH R&benhorst. X 150. (After WoDe.) 32 (12, 36) Girdle view asymmetrical with reference to a transverse axis, the outline being wedge-shaped. Family Gomphonemaceae . . 33 33 (35) Girdle side straight Gomphonema Agardh. Fig. 86. Gomphonema acuminatum Ehrenberg. a. Valve side; 0. girdle side. X 600. (Original.) ,1*, M.mtjt^iJ.iUJ'f.nUUrtbliUUJ •_■ T»mnmm.»ttJiT«nj»'njM< Mi'iiMMiHR' B 34(11,38) A middle nodule and a raphe present on but one valve. . . 35 35 (33) Girdle side curved; otherwise similar to Gomphonema. Rhoicosphenia Grunow. The two valves are unlike in shape and in the fact that the lower valve possesses a raphe, a central and end nodules, while the upper valve possesses only a pseudo-raphe and is without nodules. Fig. 87. Rkoicosphenio curvala Grunow. a. Valve side; ft. girdle side. X 380. (After Schdnfddt.) A B 36 (32, 37) Girdle view symmetrical with reference to a transverse, but not to a longitudinal axis, the cells being arcuate and attached to higher algae Family Cocconeidaceae. Only one genus known Cocconeis Ehrenberg. Valves oval or elliptical, symmetrical with reference to both axes; raphe straight with middle nodules but without end nodules. Markings of faint longitudinal punctate lines; girdle and end views both curved. Fm. 88. Cocconeis peiicums Ehrenberg. X600. (Original) 130 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 37 (36) Girdle side geniculate. Valves straight, linear, or fusiform; frus- tules either Free or stalked. . . Family Aoinakthaceae. Only one genus. Acknanikes Bory. Cells so curved that the two valves are not alike, the one concave with raphe, middle and end nodules; the other convex, without a middle nodule, but witli a pseudo-niphe. Girdle view symmetrical with reference to a transverse axis. Cells smile or in bands, ^\ mostly on gelatinous stalks. <5yVvV\ ^'r cc"5 may ** so':,arv' though they usually form long, sessile chains ot ^\y\jJ bands attached to the surface of green algae- The genus includes both marine r ) and fresh-water forms. ■J— ^ Fig. 89. Adumdlia talis Kiluing. X Son. (Original.) 38 (11, 34) No middle nodule present on either valve, except in Ceroiomis, or at most consisting of a slight, ring-like elevation. . . 39 39(40,41,63) Valves asymmetrical with reference to a longitudinal axis, in that on one margin there is a longitudinal row of bead-like thickenings (keel points) while on the other margin they are lacking Family Nitzscbjaceae. Only one genus NUuckia Hassall. Valves linear, sometimes curved, keeled, with canal raphe. Cells rhomboidal in cross sec- tion. c— - "'■ ' ■'■ ■""'"■ *ii 1 ■ niw ..,.-^ Fm.90. Nituiku Umarii Smith. X S»- . --> (Original.) 40 (39, 62) Valves with median, sigmoid keel, compressed, strongly arched, bearing raphe Family Ahphiproraceae. Only one genus Amphiprora Ehrenberg. 41 (39, 63) Valves symmetrical with reference to a longitudinal axis . . 41 41 (47) Valves each with two wing-like keels, strongly costate, with pscudo-- raphe but no nodules. . . Family SurirellaCeae . . 43 Cells mostly large, ovate, or elliptical . 43 (44) Ceils bent in saddle shape Campyloducus Ehrenberg. Though the shape of the cells seem* more or lea* tri- angular, they are in reality rirculnr, and their seeming angularity is due to the curvature of the frustulea. It is a very large genus, some 01 species having been recorded', the species are mostly marine, though a number are found in fresh water. Tbeir lane sbe makes them " the ■<»■'—" 44(43) Cdh not bent or spindly twisted. THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE 131 45 (46) Valves showing a wave-like margin in girdle view. Cymatoplema W. Smith. This is a luge diatom which is easily recognized by the unrfnlat- A ing outline of the girdle side. The genus is rather small, and WoUc reports but seven species. mmrknttmm^mt^ t^m^mm^mim^ ) B Pic. 93. Cymttephmta W. Smith a. Valve side. b'. girdle X 600. (Original.) 46 (45) Girdle view without wave-like margins Surirelia Turpfn. 'dC* ^^^*jmM/?/7/Jm% This genus is widely distributed ^ ^ A and of frequent occurrence in all re- gions where diatoms are found. Some species are very large and conspicu- ous, especially in the plankton. » Fig. 94. SmrrtUa sp. Smith. «. * Valve nde. b. girdle side. X 585. (Original.) 47 (42) Valves without keels 48 4^ (59) Cells without deep inner partitions sometimes with imperfect septa. 40 49 (55) Valves with transverse costae 50 5° (54) Valves symmetrical with reference to a transverse axis. Family Diatomaceae . . 51 Cells symmetrical with reference to both axes, borne in long chains; transverse striations distinct and uninterrupted except in some cases by a longitudinal plain band. 51 (52, 53) Valve side oval or linear, transverse marking* uninterrupted, girdle side rectangular, cdls mostly in zig-zag chains, some- times in short filament Diatoma de Candollc. 4 chip Dt§tcma tkngwtmm Agawfli. a. Valve girdle side. X about 300. (After W. 132 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 53 (S'i S3) Characteristics similar to those of Diaioma except that the cells are borne in ribbons Denlkula Ktltzing. tThe vajves are marked by heavy ribs which are in reality shallow , I,,., i, septa, between which are delicate striae. Ii raj 3 Dmtiada occurs on wet rocks and in fresh water: «nm»«»mj« aba in H"-"^ brackish water. - F&9&- Oaawaaa imJU* Srakh. a. Valve side. I, sirdk side. * * X600. (Original.! 33 (5"i 52) Characteristics as in Denticvla except that the striatums are in- terrupted in the middle Odimtidium Ktltzing. Many place the members of this genus with Diaioma, while ' the interrupted striae and the formation of short 61a- I A-* others regard the interrupt 1 / 1 Cr ments instead of agog d I I / S in a separate genus. I V 'J Frc 97. «. 1. OitmMmm Smkh. X 570- (OrigiiiaU 54 (S*>) Valves asymmetrical with reference to a transverse axis. Family Mebidionaceae. Only one genus. Meridian Agardh. Both valve and girdle sides wedge-shaped, forming ring. like or fan-shaped hands; a nations uninterrupted. There are imperfect tnnsvene septa which are con- spicuous an the valve side but show only laterally on tire girdle side. Between these on the valve side art fine Van Heurck thinks this genus ought to be suppressed. It diflrrs from Dialtma only in the cuneate shape of the FavoR. Vtaiawa csawfrMM Haas. Xjoo. (After Swath.) 55 (49) Valves without transverse costae. . Family FkacejUIACEae . . 56 Cell of much the same structure as Diiitmt. Transverse striations r— wp~»H of separate 56 (S7> 5s) CeDs very slender, not united in bands, either free or attached at one end, forming clusters on higher algae. Synedra Ehienherg. ■ -,-, 1 tV. »- Symmhw aswM W. Snath. ^^^"■*B^,^^-sssra^awa.ia™—^^=^»*"*" X »•». (OrigrasL) 57 (56, 58) CeOs forming bands or zig-zag chains. . . Froplaria Lyngbye. FragBWif « a cotnannn gna. oc- crtmrag hi ponds, teaenurta. and rake* P. ammaiBM has born known to occur * b tuck Quaruiiks a* to form water ram the surface of a lake. Fit isa. fwwiia* 1* THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE 133 58 (56, 57) Cells arranged in the form of a star. . . . Asteriondla Hassall. The radial arrangement of the cells is due to tht presence at the inner ends of small mucous cushions which unite the cells in this manner. The cells are linear, unequally enlarged at the ends, capitate in the valve view and truncate in the girdle view. The valves are marked with delicate striations. Asteriondla is common in ponds, lakes, and water reservoirs. It is especially frequent in the plankton, probably on account of the radial arrangement of the cells, which would make it easily buoyed up by the water. FW. 101. AskriondlagraciUimaBtSbttt- X 188. (After Schrtter.) 59 (48) Cells with interrupted inner partitions. Family Tabellariaceae . . 60 Valves linear, oblong, or elliptical, inflated at the center. Girdle side rectangular, with two or more longitudinal partitions perforated at the center. "iliillliiMiiWuwmw 60 (61) Cells slender, valves with only punctate striations. Tabellaria Ehrenberg. The inner partitions appear in the girdle view as distinct lines which are not always equally developed or opposite each other at the two ends of the cell. At the interruption of the partitions at the center the valve sides show an inflation. The zig-zag chains of Tabellaria are conspicu- ous in almost all collections of algae. Fig. 102. Tabellaria fenestrate Kutzing. a. Valve side. b. girdle side. X 600. c. showing characteristic arrangement of cell. X about 150. (Original.) •N*HMU#U«MUUlMMMll ^yUU*.^ mt.tui' B 61 (60) Cells broader, with distinct transverse costae. . . Tetracydus Ralfs. Aside from the interrupted inner par- titions there are also transverse septa which appear on the valve sides as costae, between which are very faint striae. The 3 septa are more numerous, and the cells more cruciform than in Tabellaria; they occur also in bands instead of in zig-zag chains. Fig. 103. Tetracydus locus tr is Ralfs. a. Valve side. b. girdle side. X 300. (After Smith.) 62(39,41) Valves asymmetrical with reference to a longitudinal axis, the cells being more or less arcuate. Family Epithemiaceae . . 63 Valves curved, usually with dotted transverse striations, sometimes also with transverse tostae. 134 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 63 (64, 65) Transverse costae coarse, converging, projecting inward, often with lines of dots between. . . Epilhtmia Brgbisson. Fig. 104. EpitktmU tmgid* Kfitsuw. X380. (Original.) °4 (03, 65) Transverse striations punctate; end nodules present, but raphe wanting Eunotia Ehrenberg. rr^t' %&MMM\ Ag. 105. Emmotia pecHmsUs DSwyn. X 625. (Original.) $5 ($3> 04) Valves crescent-shaped, the raphe very near the concave margin, with end and middle nodules. . . . Ceratoneis Ehrenberg. There is but a single species. Fig. 106. Ceratoneis mu Kiltzing. X 600. (Original.) Class n. Chlorophyceae Color, a chlorophyll-green. This group includes by far the greater number of forms of algae in fresh water. It is so large and the characteristics of the different members so varied that no characterization of the group as a whole will be attempted. i (253) Plants fine, relatively small 2 In regard to the Ckaraceae the uncertainty of their nature and systematic position is fuDy understood, but for convenience they will be considered at the end of the CMoropkyceae. 2 (67) Plants of unbranched, septate filaments, slippery to the touch; or plants of single cells of two exactly symmetrical parts, some- times united into filaments. Chlorophyll in spiral bands, central plates, or star-shaped bodies. Order Conjugates . . 3 Filamentous or unicellular algae whose reproduction consists only in conjugation, that is where the contents of two ceDs which are exactly alike, or at most differing only slightly in reference to size, unite to form a single cell, the zygospore. Some authors would place the Badttatiaceae under this group on account of the union which takes place before the formation of the spore, but as they differ in many respects from the dis- tinctive members of this group they have been placed in a group by themselves. 3 (59) Plants unicellular, occasionally united into filaments; cells constricted at the middle or not; one-half of each cell exactly symmet- rical with the other half; 2, 4, or 8 individuals from a germi- nating zygospore Family Desmtdiaceae . . 4 The membrane mostly furnished with tiny protuberances and pores, both with a definite arrangement; chromatophore radiating from or including one or more pyrenoids. Asexual reproduction by the separation of the halves of the cell, between which two new halves are formed, each attached to and identical with one of the older halves. In sexual reproduction two cells come together, throw off their membranes, and their contents unite to form a zygospore. This is usually furnished with conspicuous colorless spines. 4 (22) Cells after division united into filaments 5 THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE «35 5 (11) Cells cylindrical, with no constriction, or at most a very shallow and broad constriction, giving a slightly undulating outline. 6 6 (7, 8) Cells not longer than broad, sometimes with a very shallow, broad constriction; chromatophore central, with 6 to io rays about a pyrenoid Hyalotheca Ehrenberg. Filaments long, often twisted, and slippery to the touch. The different diameters of the cells nearly equal, varying from 20 to 35 /*. The median constriction often very slight. Chromatophore in each cell-half of radiating plates placed about a pyrenoid. A broad gelatinous envelop is always present but it is in- visible without reagents. Hyalotheca is frequent among filamentous forms of the Conjugate . Flo. 107. Hyalotheca dissitiems Br6bia«on. a. side view. b. end view. X575. (Original.) 7 (6, 8) Cells but little longer than broad, attenuated at the end. Leptozosma Turner. Filaments long, cateniform; not twisted, or but slightly so. Joints united by a strongly marked suture; near to Bambuscina Klitzing, but differing therefrom in the suture. Fio. 108. Ltptotosma catemulala Turner. X 300. (After Turner.) 8 (6, 7) Cells much longer than broad 9 9 (10) Chromatophore a central plate containing a row of pyrenoids. Gonatozygon de Bary. Length of cells 100 to 200 /*; breadth 10 to 20 u, much like a cell of Mougeotia except that the membrane is covered with minute projections; Pn. 109. Gonatotyton ralfsii de Bary. cells sometimes slightlv swollen at the ends. X about 230. (After de Bary.) 10 (9) Chromatophores consisting of several parietal spiral bands. Genicularia de Bary. Diameter of cells 17 to 22.5 p; length 10 to 20 times as great. Membrane cov- ered with fine projections as in Gonatotygon. Fto. no. Cmkularia spirotaema Brebisson. X 265. Spiral chromatophores with many pyrenoids. (After de Bary.) 11 (s) Cells not cylindrical 12 12 (19) End view of cells circular, oval, or elliptical, rarely triangular. . 13 Cells not deeply constricted at the middle 14 13 (16) 14 ds) Cells cask-shaped, placed end to end, with a shallow narrow con- striction at the middle; end view circular, with two oppo- sitely placed projections Gymnozyga. The membrane frequently shows longitudinal stripes. Chromatophores in each cell-half composed of a number of radially-placed plates arranged about a pyrenoid at the center. Flo. in. Gymnotyga br ibissonii Nordstedt. X 568. (Original.) 136 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 15 (14) Cells not cask-shaped, with a narrow, shallow, central constriction; end view elliptical or triangular, ends tapering or round. Spondylosium Archer, Cells 10 ID up broad: S to 9^ long, tells tapering towards the ends. Membrane smooth or with slight prominences A pyrenoid in each cell-half, about which radiate (ram 4 to 6 chlorophyll plates- The cells of the filaments an united, by the dose adher- ence of the apices of the cells. The filaments are frequently twisted and enveloped in mucus. Fiu. 1 ■6(13) Cells deeply constricted in the middle 17 17 (18) Cell-halves acutely pointed or oval; upper and lower surface of each end furnished with a spine which meets a similar one on the adjoining cell; end view fusiform. . . Onychontma Wallich. Narrow spues frequently present, iromatophorc, compos Omyduntma occurs ii chroma toph ore, composed of radiating pi " vamps and p 18 (17) Cell-halves oval in outline, with a deep central constriction; cells united into filaments by small tubercles. Sphaerotosma Archer. Cells n to 33fi broad and about half as long, aid view elliptical; membrane smooth or with tiny warts near the ends of the cells. Spkarroieima is distinguished from Sffndyfotium by the cells being united by tubercles Instead of by their apices directly. S. mtcknm var. UJlalum Wolle is reported by Woile u occur- ring in such quantities as to color the water green. Fie 114 5**M"amm awtliHi— Haifa, X about joo. (After de Buy j 19 (ia) End view of cells triangular or quadrangular, seldom oval . . 20 so (31) No space at the center between the transverse septa; cells slightly and narrowry constricted Desmidium Agardh. ■~^ at the cotter as to give a scalloped latent ) outline to each cell. End view with aa many *y uyrenoids aa there are angles, from etch, of which radiate two chlorophyll plain. THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE x37 B 21.(20) Ad oval opening at the center between the transverse septa. Aptogonum Ralfs. Filaments often twisted, cells slightly longer than broad, with three or four projections on each end which exactly meet others on the adjoining cells, some- times slightly constricted. Several py- renoids in each cell, from which radiate the plate-like chromatophores. The genus Aptogonum is included by many under Desmidium, but the space at the center between two adjoining cells, the lack of the narrow central construc- tion, and the greater length of the cells would seem to distinguish it from Des- midium. Fig. xi6. Aptogonum baileyi Ralfs. a. side view. b. end view. c. optical section. X 435. C (Original.) 32 (4) Cells not united into filaments 23 23 (33) Cells not constricted at the center, or at the most only very slightly so 24 34(25) Cells crescent-shaped; tapering toward both ends. Closterium Nitzsch. Cells varying from short, thick cells swollen in the middle to very slender cells sometimes bent in the shape of an S. Membrane smooth, or longitudinally striated, rarely with a yellow hue. Chromatophores in each cell-half of several radially-placed plates, including one or more rows of pyrenoids; at each end a large vacuole containing moving granules. FIG. 117. Closterium moniliferum var. conamum Ehrenberg. X about 300. (Original.) *5 (24) Cells cylindrical or fusiform 26 26 (27, 28) Chromatophore one or more parietal, spiral bands. Sfrirotaenia Br6bisson. Cells straight, oblong, cylindrical, or fusiform, with rounded ends. tophores one or several parietal bands with pyrenoids. Chroma- Fig. xi8. Spirotaenia minuta Thuret. X 365. (After West) 37 (26, 28) Chromatophore star-shaped, one in each cell-half. Cylindrocystis de Bary. Cells with rounded ends, often oval in outline. Chroma- tophores two, star-shaped, many rayed, each enclosing a pyrenoid at the center. Fto. 119. Cylindrocystis dipbspora Lunddl. X 375. (Original) 38 (26, 27) Chromatophore straight, simple, or multiple 29 i3« 29 (3°) FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Chrornatnphore a single axial plate with one or more pyrcnoids. NagdL 30 (29) In each cell-half several chlorophyll plates. 31 31 (32) Margins of plates entire; pyrenoids central in each cell-half. Pemum de Bary. Ce& sometimes slightly constricted at the middle, rounded or trun- cated at the ends; length 3 to 9 tines the breadth; membrane smooth, punctate, or longitudinally striated; about a huge pyienoid in each crl half. 32(31) Margins of the radial plates of the dmxnatophoie scalk)ped; pyrenoids several and scattered Netrimm Nigeti. shaped much as in Pimium, The scallops of the outer margin of the chiomatophores pyrenoids not large and forming a center about which the chlorophyll plates as in Ptmmm, but small and scattered. 33(23) 34(42) 35(38) 36(37) 37(36) Cells constricted at the center 34 Constriction at the sides slight and usually gradual 35 Length of cells usually not more than six times the breadth. . . 36 Central constriction very gradual and shallow; a slight incision at the ends Tetmemorus Ralfs. Cells straight, fusiform, or cylindrical, sfighuy and broadly constricted at the middle; ends rounded, each with a slight finear incision; length 4 to 6 times the diameter. Chroma- tophore axial with a single row of pyrenoids. Fta-uj. Trtmtmttms gmulttmi Ralfs. X465. (OrigaaL) Cells short, ends truncate, constriction rather abrupt, but not deep; chromatophore of longitudinal bands; pyrenoids many, scattered. PlcHrotaeniopsis LundeU. This is regarded by Brehisson as a CafaryJimWf, by de Bary '-^^ as a Plcmoiaenimm and by West as a Ctmwrimm. Formerly Wifle recognised the genus, PlemeimmUpnt, but now includes it Cosmarium. 1*4- Pltmwtmmm^u mutfai Land, X 130. (AftcrdeBsry.) txrL.£iM- THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE 139 38 (37) Length of ceils many times the breadth 39 39 (40, 41) Cells before the middle constriction swollen, but without longitu- dinal flutings; chromatophore of radially-placed plates, with pyrenoids. PUurotatnium Lundell. Cells straight, cylindrical, somewhat taper- ing toward the truncate ends. Membrane * smooth or with small warts; at each end a 125. PUurotaemum noduhsum Rabenhont. co^rless vacuole with dancing particles as in X 17s. (Original) Ckstenum. 4° (39> 41) Cells before middle constriction swollen and with longitudinal flutings; chromatophores of longitudinal radial plates. Docidium Lundell. Cells tapering somewhat towards the ends; no vacuoles with moving granules; membrane either smooth or with minute protuberances and even with spines in certain regions. t=aKBitiftf(ftiUt'-\w'. ■ . .IB " .'""11 j;_=^iw?Bacr '&'*&&&-*- Flo. 126. Docidium bacuium BrtbiMoa. X 545* (Original.) 41 (39, 40) Shape of cells much as in Pleurotaenium, but apices broadly cleft or with bidentate processes Triploceras Bailey. Cells large, walls covered with rings of furcate processes or small, perpendicular longitudi- nally-placed plates. Sometimes confused with Docidium. Fid, 127. Triploetras graciU Bailey. One-half of a cell. (After Cushman.) 42 (34) Constrictions at the sides deep and abrupt 43 43 (44) End views of cells 3 to several angled or rayed. Staurastrum Lundell. Side view hour-glass shaped; membrane smooth or with warts or spines; chromatophores in each ceil-half consisting of radially-placed plates about a central pyrenoW, two ^__ —.-^ plates extending into each arm or angle. •-**'&&&&& *Kf £ Fig. 128. Staurastrum cnnulismm NlgeH. X6oa- «>*■*' ' A 44 (43) End views of cells compressed or elliptical, oftei ?r» center 45 (48) Cells at end with notches or linear incision*. .... 140 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 46 (47) Cells disc-shaped, each cell-half with three or five lobes, the lateral ones of which are more or less deeply cut . MicrasUrias Agardh. Celts broadly oval or rounded in out- line. Middle constriction deep, some- times furnished with spines; lateral lobes often one or more times dichotomousty divided, the last divisions usually fur- nished with spines. Chromatopbore the form of the cell, in which are scattered several pyreooids. Fie. i» Micrtskrias ftfUfin Brfbason One hJf of a cell. X jdj. (Original.) 47 (46) Cells at ends with an incision or undulation, end view elliptical with one or two prominences on the sides. . . Euastrum Ralfs. Cells oblong or elliptical, with deep, middle constriction, and variously incised, concave, or undulating margins. End view Oman oval, with one or more rounded projections. Membrane some- ■: -'*■'_-- :-a^ timet with warts or spines. Cbiomatophore axial. . Ettailnim tltians Kilting. X J**- (Original.) 48 (45) Cells at ends without notches or linear incisions 49 49 (54) Cells without spines 50 50 (51) Cells free. Cosmarium Corda. Cells elliptical or circular, sometimes with more or leaa ■''S&vi; IriT^K 1 undulating or tapering margins; middle constriction deep and '"JtJiBkj' "' SmtP* ■ i) linear; end view oval or drcular, often with rounded projec- H tions Chromatopbore in each cell-half, usually of radiating plates about one or more pyrenotds; membrane often punc- 51 (50) Cells united by branched gelatinous stalks, forming colonies . . 53 53 (53) Colonies loose, not encrusted with lime . . . Cosmocladium Nageli. Cells as in Ceimarimm, but borne by dichotomously or trichotomously branched gelatinous stalks, which are The colonies are Invested in an indistinct gelatinous mass, less dense the ecus. It is sometimes found in Fn.131 QiiiMiM THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE 141 S3 (51) Colony a compact cushion; stalks encrusted with lime. Oocardium Nagelt. Cells broad, middle constriction slight, chromatophores two, pyrenoid in each. Stalks closely placed so that the enveloping cylindrical Lime sheaths make a honeycomb-Like structure. They are sometimes branched and imbedded in the free end 0/ each is a single cell, placed transversely. It occurs where water trickles over limestone rocks, and is also reported as Flo. IM. Oacariium itralum NUeli. X 485. Nlgdi. X 54 (49) Cells with spines . 55 (56} Two or four spines on each cell-half . . . Arthrodesmus Ehienberg, General characteristics as in Coimarium, eicept thai each cell-half is fur- nished with two or four long spines, and the end view shows no lateral rounded prominences. The spines in Atlkrodamui are all arranged in one plane, while in Xanlkid- ium they may be arranged in two planes. Fro. 134. Artkniama armtriaa Ehranbarf. X about 150. (Original.} 56 [55) Two rows of strong spines on each cell-half 57 57 (58) Spines simple Xanlkidium Ehrenberg. Cells oval or nearly round, with deep, narrow, central constriction; end view elliptical, often with protruding sides: membrane with two rows of strong, horn-like spines; chromatophore parietal, more or less divided, with several 135, XaMkidium fasciculetui* Ehrenberg. X about soo. (Original.) 58(57) Spines branched Sckizocanlhum Lundctl. Characteristics simitar to those ol Xanlkidium, except that the Bpines are thick, short, and branched at the ends. West believes that ScaitocanlkuiH should be included under Xanlkidium as the only difference is in the spines, and there is too much variation in these, he thinks, to mate separate genera. Mlj) Plant filamentous, cylindrical, only one individual originating from a germinating zygospore . . Family ZygnemaceaE . . 60 Cell cylindrical, united into filaments, usually found near the surface of the water. Chro- Mtophores different in different genera, but all with several pyrenoids. Reproduction sexual, "muring by the conjugation ol cells in two parallel filaments, ladder-like, or lateral, between two ■oghbonng cells of the same filament. Parthenogenesis may occur. 14a FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 60 (64) In conjugating the whole of the contents of the conjugating cells passes into the zygospore. Subfamily Zvgnemxae . . 61 61 (6a, 63) Chroma tophores two, axial, star-shaped; a pyrenoid in the center of each. Zygnema de Bary. Conjugation other ladder-like or lateral: Zygospore whbii one of toe conjugating tells, or m Ihe conjugating tube. According to CoffiDS aptanoapores nay take the peace of Kyeo- tporea, also resting akinetes with granular contents mod rti«-fc»wH nembnde mr/ be found. 62 (61, 63) Chromatophore one to several parietal, spiral bands, with many pyramids. Sptrogyr a Link. Conjugation ladder-like or atersL Zygospore in one of the conjugating cdh. ParLhcnosporca may be formed. 63 (61, 61) Chromatophore an axial plate, with several pyrenoids. Debarya Wittrock. !Q CeOs lone; conjugation ladder-like; zygospore between the con- jugating cells; the middle layer of the (pore membrane yellow, wit* three parallel longitudinal grooves, connected by radial striatinna. 64 (60) In conjugation only a portion of the contents of the conjugating petal passes into the zygospore. Subfamily Mesocah feaz . . 65 THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE Hi 65 (66) Chramatophore an axial plate, with several pyrenoids. Zygospore lens-shaped or flattened and angled, in the conjugating tube. Afougeotia Wittrock. the Conjugation ladder-like or between two adjoining ceils of the same filament. Zygospore in oniugnn inflated conjugating tube, separated from the conjugating celk by two or more transverse Fta. 140. Ifeaffatia sp. a- showing the surface of the chlorophyll plate, b. showing the edge of the chlorophyll plate. X about 500. (Original.) 66 (65) Vegetative portion as in Mougeotia but zygospore not known. Gonatonema Wittrock. Aplanospores produced between two transverse mem- branes near the center of an elongated cell. Spore membrane double. Fig. 141. Gonwhnwmn vmtokomm Wittrock. X ajo. (After West.) 67 (2) Plants unicellular or of few cells. Chromatophore one or more parietal bodies, rarely central 68 68 (iqo, 249) Plants unicellular, or of few cells united into minute families; frequently imbedded in gelatinous substance. Order Protococcates . . 69 Each ceil carries on all functions independently, and complexes may be regarded as an aggre- gate of individuals. Three forms of reproduction may occur: r, purely vegetative; 2, by asexual zoospores; 3, by isogametes. More than one method frequently occurs in one species; the vegetative reproduction may be by simple fission or internal division. 6q (89) Vegetative cells or colonies for a portion or the whole of their exist- ence motile Family Volvocaceae . . 70 70 (77) Cells single or in clusters, not forming a definite colony 71 71 (72) Cells spindle-shaped; chromatophores several, indefinite, with two or more pyrenoids and a pigment spot. Cklorogonium Ehrenber£ Cells with two cilia; membrane very thin, pigment sp«*J iaV anterior part. Numerous vacuoles and several pyrenoMt p Division transverse. Reproduction by isogametes. Wflle this genus a section under Chfomydvmonns. F10. 142. Chhroftmium euekhntm Ehrenher*. a. a cluster o* X about 300. (After Ehieuberg.) b. single cell. (After SM- 3 144 72 (71) 73 (74) 74 (73) 75 (76) FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Cells ellipsoidal or nearly spherical 73 Membrane widely separated from the chromatophore but connected with it by protoplasmic strands. Two cilia present. Sphaerdla Sommerfeldt Chromatophore netted, with two or more pyrenoids and a pigment spot. Asexual reproduction by longitudinal division, sexual by isogametes. A palmella condition may occur. SpkaereUa often assumes a red color,- due to the presence of hemato- chrome, and is reported in a few cases as being the organism causing "red rain." It was also supposed that 5. nivalis caused the phenomenon of "red snow," but the form described by Chodat shows the chloroplast as lying close to the membrane, so this is probably a Chlamydomonas. Fig. 143- Sphaerdla pluvialis Flotow. X about 600. (After Schmidle.) Membrane not separated from the chromatophore 75 Two cilia and a pyrenoid present. Color rarely red. Chlamydomonas Ehrenberg. Cells ellipsoidal or spherical; chromatophore single, hollow, parietal; a pigment spot and. two cilia at the anterior end. Reproduction by vegetative division, also by copulation of gametes which are either alike or slightly unlike as to size. Zygo- spore green or red. The products of the vegetative division may pass at once into a motile state with cilia, or may be non-motile, according to conditions in the sur- rounding medium. Fig. 144. Chlamydomonas ohioensis Snow. X xooa (Original.) 76 (75) Structure as in Chlamydomonas but with 4 cilia. Some include this genus under Chlamydomonas Carleria Diesing. The shape of the cells in the different species differ rather more than in Chlamydomonas; the structure of the cells, however, is identical, except for the cilia. Species also occur in much the same localities as Chlamydomonas but are less frequent. Fife 145- Carleria obtuso Dill. X about 475- (After DHL) 77 (7°) Cells united to form a colony of definite shape which is constantly in motion 78 78 (79) Colony not surrounded by a gelatinous envelop. Spondylomorum Ehrenberg. Colony of 16 cells loosely united, their anterior ends all pointing toward one point. The cells are obovate, with 4 cilia at their anterior ends, a pyrenoid, and a pigment spot. A new colony of 16 originates by successive division From a vegetative cell. Fig. 146. Spondylomorum quatemarinm Ehrenberg. (After Stein.) 79 (78) Colony surrounded by a gelatinous envelop 80 80 (83, 88) Colony not spherical or spheroidal 81 the FBsm-wvra* ( atffcliiinitc »»iw*i»> mi li»iw.'. MltiAi* nat> *»*»1 . « . to... 8"t 'i,kTOVflt»Ti^trriO|i«.V1rf-i , Hi . Ufi FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 6 (84, 85, 87) Colony spherical or ellipsoidal ; cells of two types, vegetative and gonjdial, which lie in the anterior and posterior parts of the colony respectively Pleodorina Shaw. Colony consists of a spherical or elliptical coenobium of _ reenish, bi-flagellate cells of two types, vegetative and gonidial, in the anterior and posterior parts of the colony respectively which lie in the periphery of > hyaline gelatinous surrounded by a common hyaline envelop. reddish stigma which ii more prominent dor part of the colony. No connecting 5- _M cells; nonsexual reproduction by gonidia which formed by increase in size of a part of the cells of a colony. 87 (84, 85, 86) Colony spherical, of 8 or 16, 32 or 64 cells evenly scattered near the surface of a gelatinous sphere. . . F.udoriaa Ehrenberg. Cells spherical or oval, with two cilia and a pigment spot. Chroma tophore single, parietal. Vegetative re- production by repeated division, forming at first a plate-like daughter colony, which later becomes spher- ical. Sexual reproduction by a pear-shaped antbero- zoid and a spherical oosphere. The cells he at the surface of the gelatinous sphere and the cilia project at right angles to the surface. All of the vegetative cells may become transformed Into oogonia and antheridia; in each of the latter 64 antber- oxoids are formed. The ripe oospores are brownish with a smooth external membrane. The habitats of Exdorina are ponds, ditches, and lakes. Flo. 1 Bmieriw dttom Ehienberx. (After Stria.) annected by protoplasmic Clan Cells very small, round or pear-shaped, . . pair of cilia, a single chromatophore and two or more contractili and asexual; in the latter certain cells (parthenogonidia) within tb< * colony. Sexual reproduction reproduction sexual enlarge and through .... ... r J — union of a fusiform ; oospore spherical, with red contents and a spiny membrane. 89 (69) Colonies not motile in the vegetative condition 90 Cells in colonies, generally sessile and enclosed in a definite gelatinous envelop, or borne on gelatinous stalks. Reproduction asexual by zoospores, or sexual by isogametes. . . . Family Tetrasporaceae . . 91 n inflated, attached colony. Cilia THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE 147 * (93) Colonies macroscopic or microscopic, expanded or intestiform, cells arranged in fours Tetraspora Link. Fio. iij. Tampan ttftamUa Ktluinf . j jo. (After NM»iJi. ) 93 (93) Colonies pear-shaped, attached, cells irregularly placed near the surface. Apiocystis Nageli. Chromatophore single, parietal with a pyramid. Division in three directions. A spherical soospore with two cilia may originate from each cell and escape from the gelatinous vesicle. X 7S. (Alter NKaeli.) 04 (qi) Cells spindle-shaped, clustered 0 the ends of gelatinous stalks. Chlorangium Stein. Chromatophore one or two longitudinal bands; the cells may detach themselves and become soospores with two cilia and a pigment spot Large numbers of motile individuals may be formed in each cell, though copulation is not known. Chhraniium Cieok :teokowiki.) b. (After Stein.) 95(90,131,175) Cells with a thick, often indistinct gelatinous covering, uniting several together into greater or smaller free swim- ming, rarely attached colonies. Reproduction by fission or internal division; in a few instances by zoospores and isogametes Family Palmellaceae . . 06 96(10; 107) Cells embedded in more o inous tubes, strands, or cells 97 (100, 101) Cells scattered throughout a gelatinous tube or strand. . FKESH-WATER BIOLOGY 99 (08) Cefls distributed throughout a structureless, cytmdrkal, branched gelatinous colony Palmadactjiom Nageti. CeO» vkoiol; gekUiooBB tabes hondwJ or mi™ The pint o loo (97) CeDs two or four in series, at the ends of attached, dkbotomou&ty branched stalks; chromatophores several. M iscMococaa Nigeli. o fooi. without pyrenoids. fapaxhtdian by PK.15S. V^monWniWiNlicL X abost 1B0. lAftrr EabnkoM.) i (97, too) Cells in radiating series, often branched, held together by gelatinous strands Dictyocyttis ' 102 (96, 107) Cdb at the surface of an invisible gelatinous mass and borne on fine, radiating gelatinous strands 104 103 (104, 105, 106) Cells reniform, four on a stalk, two borne near the adjoin- ing ends of the other two. . . Dimoropkococau A. Braun. i pari***], cadi 1 The filaments which bear the cells are thought by nut hat this need! further inreitigation Luce colonhs may become fragmented into mailer colonies. This alga n not very frequent, and occur* in larger lakes rather than Fto. 159. Vimtrttm THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE 149 104 (103, 105, 106) Cells single, spherical, or oval. Dir.tyospkaerium NHgeli. Chromatophore tingle, parietal. Reproduction by internal division. FX1. 160. Dkt*>,H»triMI f*kMl*m Wood. X (To. (Original.) M5 (103. ra*. 106) Colonies much as in Dktyosphaerium except that the cells are in clusters of four which are held together by the rem- nants of the mother-membrane Tetracoccits West Some regard this as a young stage in Dictytxpharrium 106 (103, 104, 105) Cells clustered, grape-like, imbedded in the rather firm, often yellow gelatinous strands. . . Botryococcus Kiltzing. West's eenus tmfraiala is probably a BiHryneoaus wbere the gelati- nous envelop is somewhat contracted. JOO In old cultures of BotryfKixats, and often in nature, an orange or reddish oil is produced which Hives the cells that color. The alga is found very frequently in pools, ponds, and lakes; it !)"t&f?ftj--5 has been known to form the water bloom on lakes of small ■jggispi dimensions. Fig. 161. Botryacaccui *™mtt Kutzing. X sbont joo. (Original-) 107 (96, toi) Cells not at the surface of a gelatinous mass but distributed through it 108 108 (109) Colonies cylindrical, branching; gelatinous envelop somewhat rigid and often lamellate Paimodietyon Ntlgeli. r-r-i '- "'»■ j--,,-. Cells in groups of two and lour, the groups sur- V* " *.* a'/ii- rounded by Kriatfnoos vestries which are united to ", . • d* ■ ? '.i ■'■' -- a a * e it \l\ i"nn tl,e :ylinrtriral colony, and give a more or less „T - .-«s';^;.»-''o iojo - "n*7 netted appearance to the gelatinous portion. Repro- '""*-"«i*L» ,""."" v' durtion by means of resting spores with brown walls; .+" :a ■»-,'- S*".y these spores jterminate and produce a new colony. fid;* a^ i- -- West states that ihe outer coat often becomes very *•■*»•£ •£■** lough and of a brown color. Palmodictytn is a r-Stf-T&'r very rare alga in America, but Collins reports it ♦5*^3'*^'"" Fro. 161. Pota*M*m iwiHi Kfintng. X are. 100 (108) Colonies of no definite shape, of the shape of the individual ceDs, or more or less angled and showing a dark gelatinous layer be- tween the cells. Cells often isolated no no (137, 128) Colonies irregular in in (120) Cells not in clusters ira (ns) Gelatinous envelop containing concentric lameUss cells Pg>\ £?){4i — -' -- >-- ■ ■ ■ j ■ >S*'\S' ^dXiOfcn !■■■■■ i niafaaT .», ■*> fc^. ni -jr ■■!■! iuBpl. x.»« ■ ®§ _„_____ 11$ (in) Gdatinous envelop not contaawag CBfUfc bawftse about (he cells- 116 116 (117) CftaliiWH ms fnfWjjning ■EgMOl erf the ■■■«■» A ■! another cefl. ScaaaaoUanrjnr A. Bran. WWi ntihtat , mfihiH 1 iIimu which ~" "ITi 1 -1 ----- -11 --M| if-ihip iii 117 (116) Gelatinous mm not containing segments of the antecedent ■other* 118 (119) Ceflt throughout the gelatinous mass formed by the outer layers of the cell walls PoimtBa Lyngbye. tapbofe pnictal, mot ■ ^radd. Reproduction by tttiiion a t "— to Wife, by mcroKKBpora. miiToaxnjmra, and imgMcHa. 1 19 (1 18) Ceils at the surface of the gelatinous mass. Dictyotfkaeropsit ®Cdb free or MtncnBd, round or *t~f*1*'1 One or two cnat-ahsped fv'V'S pnriettl cnromUopbora intoit RqauduOii not wdl known. fi-VW Fte-rt*- Pin||-»*«>»*-»/»l1»nT-tnlii XjJJ. (AftsSdwjieM.) laoflii) Cefls in dusters, usually of eight, sometimes four or sixteen; mostly floating THK FRKSH-WATFH urMff T\ i#- .„g j,/„».l,»w. V*-. f » • !• ■..f-., I #. , ■ I 1 l« ' J. , »• 1 24, 1 [Jr' YlU rat inh**^**-*** 25 { i*ft^ Vita /-»v*c«**»i,\t-tft»«»rvp/l ■;^. »,..-.," .»» « .1. .. • n .. . • ,' 1 ' »• 1 ■ ,• t , . • .. • • z. « * • « t '* *.. . j.' .„.:! ■ • M .9 vv+i\» i&f-'iel ■*'• **• — ' — u . — *>— ; »i-«*-J ft -1c *• »-- .n :*•■ *•> ■y ■ 1 , • ■ <*-»« -*•*.'<• tP- *«^.0w f*1"-' '^' * " J** ,|,**, *liai. *ii % .* _. .-»-. .fi & * V ** V* 150 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 113 (114) Cells spherical Gloeocystis Nageli. The enveloping gelatinous substance showing a concentric lamella te structure. Reproduction by repeated cell division, several generations of cells often re- maining enclosed in the original mother-membrane. According to some authors reproduction also occurs by bidlliate zoospores. ■""" authenticity of this genus is doul""* ' " '" .. itidty of this genus is doubtful as the non-motile stage of certain — — — species oi CUamydamonas answers this description. (I) (*) Fiq. 163. ChaeyiHi waitulomi SUtii. X IfB- (After Nlgeli.) 114(113) Cells elongated Daclytothece Lagerheim. %. Chromatophore a parietal plate lying only on one side of the cell; no pyienoida. , ]i;ij*i Gelatinous substance often lamellate. Fig. 164. Dociylolktcc bramii Lagerhefni. X nbout 370. (After Lagerham.) 115 (112) Gelatinous envelop not containing concentric lamellae about the cells 116 116 (117) Gelatinous mass containing segments of the antecedent mother cell SckitocMamys A. Braun. Cells spherical, scattered in a gelatinous mass together « with the visible remnants of the old membranes which ^1 are split into distinct segments. West believes that it is the formation of the huge amount of gelatinous material that causes the firmer portion of ^_. the membrane to become ruptured, and that this takes -. < — * "Sjjfs — ^i»vv phtce previous to the formation of the two or four daughter iGSk atSi sF'ys K^H cells- S. idoliitosa is the only species reported in WW G|l MM W America, and this occurs as a pale green irregular mass ^^ ^^y_ \\s^— j_, either free or adhering to water plants. 117 (116) Gelatinous mass not containing segments of the antecedent mother- membrane. 118 118 (119) Cells throughout the gelatinous mass formed by the outer layers of the cell walls Palmetto Lyngbye. Chromatophore parietal, with a pyrenoid. Reproduction by division in three directions. and according to Wille, by macroxoospores, mi crozoo spores, and isogametea. 119 (118) Cells at the surface of the gelatinous mass. Dictyosphaeropsis Schmidle. ®Hfe Cells free or attached, round or elongated. One or two disc-shaped parietal chromatophores present. Reproduction not well known. m. 166. Diclycif tuurofiu paUln* Schmidle. X JJJ. (Afttr Sckntktk.) iso fin) Cells in dusters, usually of eight, sometimes four or sixteen; colonies, mostly floating in THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE 151 121 (124) Cells spherical 122 122(123) Chromatophore single Sphaerocystis Chodat. Colonies large; clusters widely separated from each other. Gelatinous envelop invisible without reagents. Chromatophore thin, parietal, with a pyrenoid on one side and an opening on the other. Reproduction by internal division. Sphaerocystis is almost universally found in the plankton and is one of the most conspicuous and beautiful of all the plankton forms. Sometimes the colonies are very large, consisting of many clusters. Fig. 167. Sphaerocystis schraeteri Chodat. X 520. (Original.) 123(122) Chromatophores many, parietal Chlorobotrys Bohlin. Cells spherical, in a gelatinous matrix, as in Sphaerocystis, but the chlorophyll in many parietal discs. Fig. 168. Chlorobotrys regularis Bohlin. X 300. (After West) 124 (121) Cells not spherical 125 125 (126) Cells crescent-shaped Kirchneriella Schmidle. Cells in clusters, as in Sphaerocystis, but strongly crescent-shaped. In reproduction internal division takes place trans- versely and the four or eight daughter cells are set free by the breaking of the cell wall. Several species occur in the plankton. They also occur in ponds among water plants. Fio. 169. Kirchmriella obesa Schmidle. X 600. (Original.) 126(125) Cells oval or bluntly pointed Oocystis Nageli. Cells oblong, single, or two, four, or eight in a gelatinous envelop; in some cases many clusters in a colorless gelatinous matrix. Chromatophore single, parietal, with an opening on one side, or of many small discs. Pyrenoids present in some species. Cells' single or in dusters, as in Sphaerocystis, but ellipsoidal in shape. Oocystis is frequently found in the plankton where it is usually in large gelatinous colonies similar to Sphaerocystis and Kirchneriella. In other localities the cells are generally solitary. Fio. 170. Oocystis solitaria Wittrock. X 600. (Original.) 152 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 127 (no, 128) Colonies somewhat cubical, showing a dark, gelatinous layer between the cells Gloeotaenium Hansgirg. Oils globose or flattened, colonies of two, four, or eight cells, with wide lamellate walk. Reproduction by aplanospores. Fig. 171. CUtoUumum loUdsbcrgcriammm Hansghg. X 220. (After Tranteau.) 128(110,127) Colonies the shape of the individual cells 129 129 (130) Cells reniform, colony of the same shape or oval. Nepkrocytium Nageli. Cells single or in clusters, as in Sphaerocystis, but reniform in shape. Nepkrocytium resembles Oocystis except that the cells are curved. It is widely distributed but not very abundant. Flo. 172. Nefkrocytimm agtwdkiammm Nlgdi. X 580. (Original.) 130(129) Cells fusiform Elakatotkrix Wille. X Cells elongated, fusiform, gelatinous sub- stance dense, often lamellate. y Fig. 173. BUhaMkn* vtridis Wflle. X 575. ' (Original.) 131 (90, 95, 175) Cells without a thick gelatinous envelop holding them together; sometimes adhering to each other after di- vision. 132 i32 (i37> i55> 174) Reproduction by fission only, or rarely by fission and internal division. . . Family Pleurococgageae . . 133 133 (x34* *35» 136) Reproduction by fission in one direction only, forming equal cylindrical cells, the length being one and one-half to three times the breadth Stickococcus NSgeH. q m S Chromatophore a parietal plate lying only on one side of the cell, O "of with no pyrenoid. Reproduction by simple fission, the cefls sometimes ^. ^«a» ^ adhering to each other after the division, but not forming perfect ^ ^ *" filaments. I ^ FK.174. Slkkfcau hmdUmis KageE. X abort «oo. (Original.) 134 (133, 135, 136) Reproduction by division in three directions. Cefls spherical or, if in small complexes, somewhat angled. Pleurococcus MeneghinL Cells either single or in small dusters of two, four, or more crib which later fall apart. Chromatophore a thin lining to the mrmhranr with one side, and with or without a pyrenoid. Pitmwctxcmi is the chief imrU Hurat of the green coating on the berk of old wood* anc I7S- •^ '_ ml 'Ja&t THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE Plairococcus . but sometimes forming Pseudo-pitHrococats Snow. 136 (i33. 134. 35) Reproduction by fission in three directions and by inter- nal division PaimeUococcus Chodat. a parietal plate, without a pyramid. In addition tu reproduction by fusion An orange-red oi 74) Reproduction by internal division only. d by a Family Chlokellaceae . . 138 ellipsoidal, or irregular. Membrane Cells spherical; chroma lophor one pyrenoid 1 single, hollow sphere with . . . CUoreiia Beyerinck. on one aide, with a single pyrenoid . ZeacUmlia Brandt has been (riven to this same genus audi dates the name of ChimUa by nut year,, but the name CMonUa » appropriate. Cells spherical, chromatophore of many parietal discs, each with a pyrenoid Eremospkaera de Bary. Size relatively huge: ctaomatoptaofes many, parietal; mirlnis "ominent. Reproduction by internal drvMian. The cells are targe, spherical, and conspicuous The nucleus is spended in the middle of tbe cell by strands oi proto- among Dcamida in Spjasrjnmi swamp-. . Fas. 170. fTiiinjiia 11 iiiitii ill Bar] X tis (Origasal.) Cells spherical or irregular; chromatophores many, angular, radially arranged; many pyienoids in each. Examtrosfkatta Moore. Plant mngBfme oi a single cell, in mature condition varying in outline irom spherical and elliptical to irregular and eccentric iotms. Chramatopborcs large, angular, usually radiately ar- ranged, closely lining the wall. Pyrenoids minuii nimmiiBis in each ehromatopbon. MultrplkBtinn hv (aplaaoapores) which escape by t the cell wall. Reaction to all enemai itmuiii nraative JIB. 179. Ema—as— . srtau Mm X 160. (After Moor.) Cells spherical or elongated, membrane with hairs, spines, or reticulate markings 143 .154 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY <43 (M7) Cells spherical 144 m* Cells perfectly spherical, the spines 01 reticulate markings project- ins; but little. Chromatophores usually several. Reproduction by internal division. West also reports reproduction rarely by fission and by (oospores. The genus needs further investigation. F10. iso. Twauri* niliu Brinsch. X about 160. (Alter Xtrasch.) Reproduction occurs by division in one or two directions and by autosporea. Cbodat also reports the formation of loogonidia with four cilia. GoUnkinia has been known to occur in great quantities almost pure m large tanks of water; it also occurs in the plankton, though not very abundantly. Chromatophore parietal, with one Sir Ray Lancaster believes that bis ArckrrinU Mloxi de- scribed in 18S5 and referred to the Protozoa is identical with Guimkinia radial* described by Cbodat in 1894, and with RkkitruUa botryoida described by Lemroermann in 1898. If tins be true the name Arektrimt claims precedence over the other two generic names. Fie 1S1. flatwasasie raauta Cbodat. X 6»j. (OrianuJ.) 146 (144, 14c) Cells in colonics of eight, sixteen, thirty-two, sixty-four, or more cells; bristles long, only on the outer surface of a col- ony RichierieUo LenunennuTO. Bristles comparatively coarse and in length many times the diameter of the cells. Chromatophore single, parietal, with a single pyrenoid. The cells are usually clustered in groups of four which are aggregated into larger colonies. Bat little is known of its reproduction except that vegetative division has It is found in the plankton of large lakes. 147 (143) Cells somewhat elongated. 148 148 (149, 150) Bristles four, two at each end or one at each end and two at the center, each with a basal swelling. . Lagtrkeimia Cbodat. Cells rfflpaninal. with four spines on short pedicels. Chrumatophore single, parietal, with a amgk pyrenoid. Reproduction by interna! Cbodat and West rrcograr the genna LfghtimU but it k very doubtful whether the presence of only four spines with basal swellings is Wsnlcasnt, to remove it from the genus Ci**-j/- -*--■-■ and have not the basal si ™ Fro. 1*3. lasn-liiani asaarara it Caodat. X ut (Afcar Ckodat.) THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE 135 (133, 134, 136) Characteristics as in Pleurococcus, but sometimes forming short filaments Pseudo-pkurococcus Snow. 1 the ei the filamentous state it resembles a small form of StireocUmium, but is distinguished from it by the absence of aoospores. Chodat regards a form similar to this as a true Plenrocoaiu and believes that short filaments are characteristic of that genus. ■3U ('33. *34, I3S) Reproduction by fission in three directions and by inter- nal division Palmtllococcus Chodat. _ , il plate, without a pyrenoid. In addition to reproduction by fission aj division, a rejuvenescence of the cell contents may occur, accompanied by a cast- ing 08 of the mother- membrane. An orange-red oil is sometimes present- 's? (tji, 155, 174) Reproduction by internal division only. Family Chlorjlllaceae . . 138 138(141, 151) Cells spherical, ellipsoidal, or irregular. Membrane smooth 139 130 (140, 141) Cells spherical; chromatophore a single, hollow sphere with one pyrenoid ChioreUa Beyerinck. .a^ _ Cells spherical or somewhat elongated; chromatophore lining the mem- fflfl r^^Bl b1311^ "P™ nn ont >*ie, with a single pyrenoid. VT9 F^^M The name Zoochlortlla Brandt has been given to this same genus and ante- J&Kr d31" the nBme ot CUoreUa by some years, hut the name CUortUa seems gt ^"'^ more appropriate. Fro. 177. GkWtoip. X 600. (Original.) 140 (139, 141) Cells spherical, chromatophore of many parietal discs, each with a pyrenoid Eremosphaera de Bary. Size relatively large; chromE 1, parietal; nucleus „., ., -r— jous. The nucleus is ipended in the middle of the cell by strands of proto- 1 roor four daughter individuals may originate by succes- division of the contents and are liberated by the rupturing of the mother membrane. Eremosphaera is almost constantly found among Desmids in Sphagnum swamps. Fro, 178. Ermmtkam liridis it Bary. X II]. {Original.) Mi (i39) '4°) Cells spherical or irregular; chromatophores many, angular, radially arranged; many pyrenoids in each. Excentrospkaera Moore. Plant consisting of a single cell, in mature condition varying in outline from spherical and elliptical to irregular and eccentric forms. Chromatophores large, angular, usually radiately ar- ranged, closely lining the wall. Pyrenoids minute, numerous in each chromatophore. Multiplication by non-motile spores (aplanospores) which escape by the dissolution of a part of the cell wall. Reaction to all external stimuli negative. Fib. 179. Fjcmlroipkmro viridii Moore. X 160. (After Moore.) U> (138, 151) Cells spherical or elongated, membrane with hairs, spines, or reticulate markings 143 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 143 (147) Cells spherical 144 (145, 146) Cells solitary, membrane with short spines 0 % Cells perfectly spherical, the spines or reticulate markings project- DOS but little. Chromatophores usually several. Reproduction by internal division. West also reports reproduction rarely by fission and by zoospores. The genua needs further investigation. Fig. i So. Tnckisti about 160. {After Relnach.) r45 (144, 146) Cells solitary, bristles long, rigid, scattered over the entire surface Goirnkinia Chodat. Reproduction occurs by division in one or two directions and by autospores. Chodat also reports the formation of zoogonidia with four cilia. Goirnkinia has been known to occur in great quantities almost pure in large tanks of water; it also occurs in the plankton, though not very abundantly. Chromatophore parietal, with one pyrenoid. Sir Ray Lancaster believes that his Arcktrinia holtoni de- scribed in 1885 and referred to the Protozoa is identical with Goirnkinia radiala described by Chodat in 1894, and with Kickleridla botryoidu described by Lemmermann in 1898. If this be (rue the name Archerinia claims precedence over the other two generic names. FIG. 181. Gottnkinia radiala Chodat. : 615. (Original.) 146 (144, 145) Cells in colonies of eight, sixteen, thirty-two, sixty-four, or more cells; bristles long, only on the outer surface of a col- ony Richteridla Lemmermann. Bristles comparatively coarse and in length many times the diameter of the cells. Chromatojilorc single, parietal, with a single pyrenokf. The cell: are usually clustered in groups of (our which are aggregated into larger colonies. But little is known of its reproduction except that vegetative division has n the plankton of large lakes. 147 (143) Cells somewhat elongated 148 148 (149, 150) Bristles four, two at each end or one at each end and two at the center, each with a basal swelling. . Lagerheimia Chodat. Cells ellipsoidal, with four spines on short pedicels. Chromatophon Chodat and West recognize the genu whether the presence of onW four spin remove it from the genus Chodatdla a and have not the basal swellings. Fn. 183. Ltfkamia fenaauii C Lagerkeimia but it is very doubtful X ITS. (After Chodat,) THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE 157 164 (165) Reproduction by zoospores: chroma tophore of many radially- placed rods or segments united beneath the surface. Scotinospkaera Klebs. Zoospores fusiform; their production preceded by a contraction of the dire mi tophore to the center, about which there is a granular substance; zoospores penetrate some water plant or germinate in the water. Resting cells occur which have one or more thicken- ings of the membrane. It was Erst found in the dead leaves and branches of ' Hypnum. and its normal habitat is probably in the "'"" ]es of some higher water plant, but it occurs frc- ltly in the water and may be cultivated with ease. 193. StotiMoipkaera paradota Klebs. X about 365. 165 (164) Reproduction by copulatiot zoospores. .... of isogametes and in s by 166 (167) Chromatophore a parietal layer with many pyrenoids, later show- ing a network. Membrane with cellulose projections. Cklorochytrium Cohn. Cells spherical or slightly irregular; chromatophore with many inwardly projecting portions containing many pyrenoids. The zoospores are liberated singly; the gametes escape together while still enveloped by the inner lining to the membrane in which they copulate. Chiorochytrium occurs in the intercellular spaces of Ltmna. In some spedes a cellulose projection extends to the surface of the epidermis at the point ot penetra- tion of the zoospores, but is not found in all. i" (166) Chromatophore dense, with many starch grains; membrane lamel- Endosphatra Klebs. ■1 irregular, found in the tissue of water plants, internal divisions occur, giving rise to eight or sizteen with two cilia and a pyrcnoid. The zygospore pene- itercellular spaces of Palamogelon if it is present, but be found, time it is found as large resting cells in the tissues mU Klebs. ouog cell; b '68(156, 161) Cells with a thin stalk-like projection on c either free or attached After Kltr*)1"™" or both ends, . . . . 160 !f*9 (170) Cells free, linear, curved, or spiral, ends with a spine or stalk-like projection Ophiocytium Nageli. Chromatophore single, parietal, with no pyrcnoid. Reproduction by means of zoospores, eight of which are formed in a single cell and are liberated by the end of the cell being thrown off like a cap. Though the habitat of Ophiocytium is the same as for a number of other Protococcactae, it is not so frequently found. When it does occur, however, in a body of water it may be abundant. Fit 196. OpkuKltiuM laMiari A. Bruin. X 600. (Original.) '70(169) Cells similar, but shorter and attached 171 156 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 155 (x32) !37j 174) Reproduction by the formation of zoospores only, or by isogametes Family Protoooccaceae . . 156 156 (161, 168) Cells spherical 157 *57 (i58) Chromatophores many, parietal Botrydiopsis Bora. tjSwfak^^ Chromatophores without pyrenoids; zoospores amoeboid, with SkSJaiSi V jj a single cilium, a pigment spot, and one (sometimes two) chroma- fJWPS ^te%. tophores; frequently they germinate within the mother-membrane tSSSr ^^^> without a motile period. A J^J O^v Fi°- l89- Botrydiopsis eriensis Snow. a. vegetative cell; b. zoospores. &f V«X^ XS80. (Original.) ^^ x58 (157) Chromatophore single 159 159 (160) Chromatophore parietal Chlorococcum Fries. +*/ Chromatophore with a circular opening and a pyrenoid; zoospores t « ^ oval, with two cilia, a pyrenoid, and a pigment spot. Aplanospores ^V"~~ may form from non-liberated zoospores. An undescribed form . ( v which greatly resembles Chlorococcum has isogametes. It should be \^ vtf' placed in a different genus. w 9 Fig. 190. Chlorococcum infusionum Rabenhorst. a. vegetative cell. A B 0. zoospores. X 625. (Original.) 160 (159) Chromatophore central with radiating strands. Radiosphaera Snow. K Except for the nature of the chromatophore this genus resembles Chlorococcum, but at the center is a pyrenoid from which the chromatophore radiates. Zoospores with two cilia and a pigment spot are formed. Fig. 191. Radiosphaera sp. Snow. a. vegetative cell; A \ I \ V p. zoospores. X 580. (Original.) B 161 (156, 168) Cells more or less irregular, elongated, or tubular. . . . 162 162 (163) Cells free, more or less inflated or tubular, usually with a long, colorless cylindrical portion Protosiphon Klebs. Chromatophore a parietal, net-like layer, with pyrenoids. Under conditions threatening drought, red resting spores are formed. In absence of light or increase of water bi-dHated zoospores are formed which on coming to rest produce spherical cells, or they may copulate and produce star-shaped zygospores. Fig. 192. Protosiphon botryoides Klebs. X 75* (After Klebs.) 163 (162) Cells endophytic, rarely free, irregular, often with cellulose pro- jections 164 THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE 157 164 (165) Reproduction by zoospores: chromatophoie of many radially* placed rods or segments united beneath the surface. Scotinospkaera Klebs. Zoospores fusiform; [heir production preceded by a contraclion of the chromatophore to the center, about which there is a granular substance; zoospores penetrate some water plant or germinate in the water. Resting cells occur which have one or more thicken- ings of the membrane. It was first found in the dead leaves and branches of ' Bypnum, and its normal habitat is probably in the tissues of some higher water plant, but it occurs fre- quently in the water and may be cultivated with ease. 193. Scptimitkaoa fandtoa Klebs. X about 165. (After Klebs. 1 165 (164) Reproduction by copulation of isogametes and in some cases by zoospores 166 166 (167) Chromatophoie a parietal layer with many pyrenoids, later show- ing a network. Membrane with cellulose projections. Chiorochytrium Cohn. Cells spherical or slightly irregular; chromatophore with many inwardly projecting portions containing many pyrenoids. The zoospores are liberated singly; the gametes escape together while still enveloped by the inner lining to the membrane in which they copulate. Cklorochylrium occurs in the intercellular span*, nf Lemna. In some species a cellulose projection to the surface of the epidermis at the point of penetra- tion of the zoospores, but is not found in all. ids Flo. 194. CUoHckytriaM lit in the ti: Chromatophore dense, with many starch grains: membrane lamel- late Endosphcera Klebs. rise to eight or sixteen The zygospore pene- ipaces of Paltmegeloti if it is present, but iund as large resting cells in the tissues j. a. young cell; 4. nmeta; t. union , c. X about 40c (After Klebs.) 'AS (156, 161) Cells with a thin stalk-like projection on one or both ends, either free or attached 169 lv9 (170) Cells free, linear, curved, or spiral, ends with a spine or stalk-like projection Ophiocytium Nageli. Chromatophore single, parietal, with no pyrenoid. Reproduction by means of zoospores, eight of which are formed in a single cell and are liberated by the end of the cell being thrown off like a cap. Though the habitat of Ophiocytium is the same as for a number of other Protococcactoe, it ts not so frequently found. When it does however, in a body of water it may be abundant. Fig. 196. Optoec -jxUare (Original.) '70 (160) Cells similar, but shorter and attached. i58 tRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 171 (172, 173) Cells single, attached; oval, cylindrical, fusiform, or curved in shape. Chromatophore single and parietal. Ckaracium A. Braun. Cells oval, pointed, or rounded at the ends, straight or curved, sessile or stalked; attached to a substratum with or without a disc. A pyrenoid usually present. Reproduction by zoospores which have two aha, a pyrenoid, and a pigment spot. Ckaracium is very common on filamentous algae in all localities. The shape is greatly influenced by the direction of the rays of light. Fxc. 197. Ck&ndmm longipcs Rabenhorst. X 600. (Original) 172 (171, 173) Cells as in Char actum, but the chlorophyll in many small, parietal discs CharaciopHs Borzi. The color is pale green. The zoospores are liberated by the wall of the upper portion of the cell becoming dissolved. According to West, apiano- spores may be formed, each of which becomes a gametangium ana pro- duces two or four gametes. Ckaraciapns is less frequent than Ckaracium but b found under the same conditions. Fig. 198. Cmwriapsis sp. X 600. (Original.) 173 (171, 172) Cells attached, the new generation clustered at the free tip of the empty mother cell. Sciadium A. Braun. ThaHus of six to eight cylindrical cells, radiating from the tip of a sessile, empty, cylindrical membrane; reproduction by six to eight ■oospores with two dfia each, which attach themselves at the tip of the mother-membrane after the removal of a cap which liberates the Lemmermann unites Sciadium with Oplnacydum because rarely in Opkiocytimm the new generation develops from one end of the parent ceQ, but the sessile characteristic and the basal disc of Sciadium would seem to separate it from Opktocytium where these characteris- tics are not found. 199- A.B X600. (After Rahcnhoist.) 174 (132, 137, 155) Reproduction by fission and by zoospores. Family Chlorosphaeraceae. Only one genus known. Chlorosphocra Klebs. CeOs usually in small cefl complexes, originating by fission in three directions. Chromatophore parietal, with a pyrenoid. Zoo- spores usually eight in number, originating by successive internal divisions. These have two dfia and a pigment spot. Each vegeta- tive cell may become a resting spore. In 'tis vegetative state CMamphaera resembles greatly Plema- caccms tulgaris, but it is aquatic, rather than aerial. It is a common form in ponds and lakes, though rarely found in such quantities as to be noticed, unless developed in culture. Ffccxn. CUmiphm Uautris Sao*. X $*S- (Orifiaal) 175 (oa 95» 131) CeDs without a gelatinous envelop or stalks; doteJy united to form structures of definite shape (coenobia). . . . 176 176 (187) Coenobium usually a duster of definite shape and structure, formed by the union of four, eight, sixteen, or thirty-two non- motile cells arising from internal division* Family Coelastraceae. . . 177 177 (182, 186) CeDs radially placed or forming dose dusters. 178 :hjrW-. THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE 159 178 (i79, 180, 181) Cells spherical Coelastrum Nageli. Cells aphcrical or slightly angled; chromatophore a hollow sphere, open at one side, with a pyrenoid opposite the opening. Codastnim occurs in all bodies of water, and is found in the plankton. It is very resistant to unfavorable conditions, persisting long after most other algae have perished. Fig. »i. Codastnim sfkatricum Nlgdi. X 0». (Original.) 179 (178, 180, 181) Cells cordate or reniform Sorastrum Kutzing. Chloroplast parietal, with a single pyrenoid. Cells on short stalks radiating from a gelatinous center, but both center and stalks usually hidden by the cells. A new coenobium from each cell. Sorastrum is of less frequent occurrence than most of the other 1 of the Corlastractat, but is found in most localities where » ey are found, especially in the sediment al id occasionally in the plankton. Fib. xa. SamHnm itwwbnmi Nagdi. X 600. (Original.) ;o A nkisirodcimtu rather than with the Codoslractat, Fig. idj. SiltMiirum tracili Reuisch. X JttJ. (Original.) 181 (178, 170, 180) Cells club-shaped or elongated, forming a star. Actinastrum Lagerheim. * 182 (177, 186) Cells in one plane 183 183 (1S4, 185) Cells four, eight, or sixteen in one or two parallel or zigzag rows Scenedesmus Meyen. yrenoid. and the best known of t being found in almost all localities found. Its adaptation to various 184 (183, 185) Cells grouped in fours, forming a rectangular plate of sixteen or more cells Crucigenia Morren. I afncvIaSa Chodat. X 10 i6o FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 185 (183, 184) Cells four together, never forming larger plates. From two to five spines on the external margin of each cell. Tetrastrum Chodat Schmklk regards those forms with spines simply as different species of Stourogenia. 186 (182, 177) Cells four, lying in two planes Tctradesmus Smith. This coenobium resembles a Scenedesmus rolled up, and in the size, shape, and structure of the cells they are the same. Fig. 207. Tetradcsmms wisceusieusis Smith. X 1500. (After Smith.) ^WC*S3M^7SS»« 187 (176) 188 (l89) Coenobium a coarse net or a concentrically-arranged circular disc of cells, formed by the joining together of zoospores while within the mother-membrane, or still within the liberated inner lining of the same. . . Family Hydrodictyaceae . . 188 Coenobium a free-swimming circular plate of cells, one layer in thickness Pediastrum Meyen. The cells arranged either with intercellular spaces or not; marginal cdls with one or two pointed projections; inner cells angled or concave; chromatophore parietal, with one pyrenoid, and perforated at one side. Reproduction by means of zoospores which are cast out together with the inner lining of the mother-membrane, and within which they form a new coenobium. An alga which greatly resembles a two-celled Pediastrum was formerly described as Euastrum by Schmidle, but Lagerheim places it in a new genus Euastropsis. The mode of reproduction is the same as for Pedi- astrum; the zoospores, however, arrange themselves in pairs instead of in a single plate, and form a number of new individuals which are set whOe 1 free within the inner layer of the mother-membrane. Fie. 208. Pediastrum baryanum Meneghini. X 600. (Original.) 189 (188) Coenobium a coarse net Hydrodictyon Roth. Nets large, each mesh bounded by five or six cylindrical cells; the chromatophore reticulate, parietal, with numerous pyrenoids; asexual re- production by zoospores, those from each cell forming a new net; sexual reproduction by many isogametes. The zygospore produces two to five large zoospores which in turn give rise to a new net when they germinate. In the early stages the nucleus is single, but later divides rapidly so that the cell is multi- nucleate. As the nets are formed within the cylindrical mother-membrane they are cylin- drical in shape for some time, but later become torn and irregular. The nets occur as a very thick light green scum on the surface of ponds exposed to the direct rays of the sun. The dif- ferent modes of reproduction have been proved by Klebs to depend largely on the coalition in environment, and that by varying these condi- ditioas the different phases to development can be produced. Fig. 309. Hydrodictyon remauamm X 100. (Original.) 190 (68, 249) Plant of septate filaments, or of closely-arranged cells, forming plates or cylinders, one or more layers thick; attached or free-swimming Order Coofenrales . . 191 Reproduction asexual, sexual or both in the same species. 191 (106, 246) Plant in adult form a macroscopic, fiee-swirjuning plate or hollow cylinder of cells; in early stages of ten filamentous and attached. Family Ulvaceae . 19a THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE i6t 102 l IQ3J Plant cylindrical, llatteneti. or branched, ut a simnic layer oi cells. reproduction by zoospores and isogametes. JimtorotMrphn Link. 133 l.!03) 1'iant in the aiiult staue a thin, memnranaceous ij [04 ( LQiJ : 'KromatoiihoiT a liiin. j,an«al iininz L> yrenoid. .fetuntrama Wittmrk. ■"..- r.i.int it. c.iTiv 4!j«« .1 tvitjiiw »arjt ,ir .--. muter, r-'oimirw ';oi. sj6> Plant !il*wnt™i« ':ii> rilnm^ftt* fin*. mft"ttv unhmnrhiil. ...... ilt hf. ;ifl> :-'l:itT""i'-= wm-rnllv i;nhT5)TK-hrt1. HrnrruunnhaK a tnw. ,,jj-;«.ti| .-:;rv'! f.iatp ■■"■ r-.lirKlW. r.Lrelv n cuL i.r rtf «wnl -msll -il**\nrt .Hi**. wwhrni(Worl#-*Mtw«rf'in«o**a«i»f»r. -■■*■ 1 62 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 199 (211,212,213) The chroma topbore single, a parietal plate or cylinder. 200 200 (205) Filaments without gelatinous envelop 201 201 (204) Filament always simple, composed of a single row of cells. . 202 202 (203) Cells cylindrical. Reproduction by zoospores and in some cases by resting spores Hormidium Kutzing. Zoospores formed singly in each cell; they have two cilia but no pig- ment spot. Resting spores occur with reduction of moisture. Fig. 213. Borwudium miens Meneghini. X 400. (Original.) 203 (202) Cells but little longer than broad. Reproduction by zoospores and isogametes Ulotkrix Ktttzing. ftsfAtr. Lr-Wt*- r*4Rv Cells relatively short; chromatophore lining the entire membrane, or only a part, with a pyrenoid. Reproduc- tion by zoospores and isogametes. Zoospores with four cilia and a pigment spot; gametes smaller, with two cilia, capable of germinating without copulation. Ulotkrix occurs frequently among other algae in ponds* lakes, and watering troughs, though not often in great quantities. The resemblance to Hormidium is great, though the species of the latter genus are apt to be somewhat smaller, and the length of the cells relatively longer in proportion to the breadth. Ulotkrix yields readily to cultivation, and different phases of its development may be controlled by changes in the environment. Flo. 214. Ulotkrix Monaia Kfktsing;; «. vegetative filament. X 335. b. macTOiootpore. X388. c. mioomoipote. (After Kkbs.) 204 (201) Filament at first simple, later becoming a solid mass of many cells. Sckuomeris Kiltzing. 1 ri *■ ^ THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE 163 Plant in early stale* like I'lnthrii. later forming a slender, solid parenehymatou* lihment: reproduc- lion by zoospores, tine from rarh r.>ll Quantities of ihe Borwpores are liberated Irom a filament at a time. Itie wrill« beromine partially ^elal- inoiii, tui-t -howini; a parenrhymatons -trurture after (he liberation. ibe same ;i« I'lntkrir. but firm* siirh as are found in and « : -pot, n ,m, .WMrim^KUtriri.^ ij 205 (200) Filament with gelatinous envelop 206 :o6 (joo) Culh not in distinct pairs 207 lay (>o»> Cells oval, gelatinous envelop homogenous. Uormosporn Brfliisson. rounded. Gelatinous sheath showing radial fibrillar stnic- Radinfilnm Schmidle. L'hmmatophore jingle, parietal, with onepvrenoid >periw united hy short m-cki Filament" unbranrhed. Kepmdiirtiiin by simple rlivWrm. Will' inrlurte« iVimwImt mil R.uiinfilam with nnmnfOi, a Renin ate* from the 01 (Tided by oriental membrane" "till visible. Iririnul i (ioo. 2T5. 3Til Chmmatorihore axial, with rounded rl.-ar =i .. end. i'hnbtfmtmrt • i|ament« -hurt, mr -swimming. (Vlls i-.lindricnl, rounded V the md* — »■* b pair separated (nun [he next by .in ippnremre empty «pacr Iteprndv. hm 'he memhnne ifh-r which the part- bccomr separated. pmbahhV hv 1 i64 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY rrvzp- tW) injWtTi MC 2(199,211,313) Chromatophore a parietal network. Microspora Lagerheiin. Chromatophores band-like or netted and thickened at intervals; membrane often becoming fragmented into H-shaped pieces. Repro- duction by macroaoospores and microioospores. Filaments free, unbranched; sometimes resembling Conferva. Mem- brane thick, somewhat gelatinous, and distinctly made up of H-sbaped •■mum Lagerhebn. pieces, the ends of the H either just meeting or overlapping. Reproduc- X ms> (After Wot.) tion by macroaoospORs with four cilia, and microzoosporea with two cilia. 213 (199, 211. 212) Chroma tophores many, parietal, disc-shaped. Filaments fine, unbranched, rarely (.Aeronemum) branched. Repro- duction by mono-ciliate zoospores. 214 214 (215, 216) Filaments unbranched, at first attached: no pyrenoids. Tribonema Derbes and Solier. t green, soft to the touch. Length of cells one to several times the ~'te middle. Chromatophores from two to many, small, parietal. Reproduction by zoospores, one or two of which are formed in a cell and liberated by the membrane falling into H-shaped pieces. Zoospores obovate, asymmetrical, with two chromatophores in minor Kleba. the anterior part, one rilium. and no pigment spot. X 800. (Original.] Resting cells may occur. 215 (214, 216) Structure of cells and zoospores as in Tribonema; filaments composed of segments of 4 to 8 cells; each formed from the contents of a single vegetative cell, the ruptured wall of which is visible at the end of the segment. Division rarely longitudinal Bumiileria Bond. Filaments usually short. Zoospores the same as in Tribonema, but liberated through a dis- solved portion of the membrane, instead of through a circular split dividing the membrane into two portions. Resting cells may be formed. €S3SSSSSSSSSSSZ 216 (214, 215) Structure of cells and zoospores as in Tribonema. minute, richly branched, easily passing into a unicellular condition. Aeronemum Snow. Chromatophorea pale, ■ and closely applied to brine. Reproduction by «oo- sparcr. which have a single dli- um, a small chrcmatophore, and a pigment spot. They move with an amoeboid motion. This may be the same as UnutSU Cerncck, though the brandling as described in that form. ""WrfSarl) THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE 165 217 (198, 218) Plants of unbranched, free-swimming, more or less gelatinous filaments, the cells very long; chlorophyll parietal and sur- rounding a number of large conspicuous vacuoles which show as a row of lighter areas; pyrenoids numerous. Re- production by heterogametes. Family Sphaeropleaceae. Only one genus known Sphaeroplea Agardh. Fro. 234. SpkatropUa annulina Agardh. X 1133. (After Rauwenhoff.) Cells cylindrical, tapering; length eight to twenty times the breadth, several nuclei present. Oogonia and antheridia formed from vegetative cells, the oogonia containing many oospheres, and the antheridia a very large number of antherozoids with two cilia; these are liberated through holes in the mem- brane and enter the oogonia through similar holes; the oospores are red and have a thick, rough membrane. On germination each produces one to eight zoospores with a pigment spot and two cilia. Spores may be produced parthenogenetically . 2l8 (198, 217) Plants of unbranched, more or less gelatinous, filaments, attached in early stages; cells short, cylindrical, or swollen; chromatophore single, parietal, with one pyrenoid. Repro- duction by means of zoospores with two cilia and by hetero- gametes Family Cylindrocapsaceae. Only one genus known Cylindrocapsa Reinsch. Reproduction asexual and sexual; asex- ual, by zoospores and akinetes; sexual, by means of oogonia, each with one oospore, and antheridia, each with two anthero- zoids; oospore red in color. This is a very rare alga though it is reported by Collins as occurring in Massa- chusetts and by VVolle as occurring from New York to Florida. Fig. 225. Cylindrocapsa imohtia Reinsch. a. vegetative filament; b. formation of anthero- zoids; c. oogonium with antheroaoids. X 575. (After Cicnkowski.) 219 (197) Filaments coarser, mostly branched 220 220 (233) Chromatophore with irregular, linear, or net-like perforations. 221 221 (230) Zoospores biciliate Family Cladophoraceae . . 222 Filaments mostly branched, harsh to the touch, generally attached; chromatophore parietal, with irregular, net-like perforations; contents granular; numerous pyrenoids. Nuclei many. 222 (223) Filaments never branched except at the attachment. Chaetomor pha Kfitri&f, Filaments attached by a branched, rhizoid-like organ. Reproduction by meant of Toe species of this genus are mostly marine. 223 (222) Filaments usually branched 166 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 114(117) Branches abundant 915 335 (226) Plants large, tufted; reproduction by zoospores. Cladopktira Klltzing. Plant frequently veiy large; diameter □( much greater at the base than at the ends; the length of the rails one to twenty times the diameter; reproduction by zoospores, many being formed from a vegetative cell; these with two or four cilia The number of species of Cladephora is very luge, and they are found in fresh, brackish, and salt water, but prob- ably In the greatest abundance along the shores of lakes where they are constantly washed by tbe waves. Some •pecks are believed to be annual and some perennial. FiQ. ijti. Clafeffars fbaintt Kutiina. X Bj. [OrigiaaU Plant forming pulvinate coatings, cells of two kinds, one light and one dark. Cklorotylium KUtzing. fug less chlorophyll, thus giving a ment of light and dirk. Chromatopbore band-shaped, antral reproduction by bidliate (oospores which are formed in great numbers 117 (124) Branches not frequent, rarely wanting 318 128 (22g) Branches long, scattered; reproduction by resting spores. Pitkopkora Wittrock. CeQs long, cylindrical; akinetes formed by the end of a cell being separated by a thicker and darker, while the membrane i tbe whole be- IEEZ aw (228) Branches short, attenuated, infrequent sometimes rhixntd-like, sometimes lacking altogether. . . RJuModtmrnm Kfitzing. THE. FRESH-WATER ALGAS-1 167 230(221) Zoospores with a circle of alia, near the smaller end. Family Okdogontacrar 231 Plants or branched or un branched filament* attached in eartv staaaa: , hmmatophore wiffr i rTBcatMZ~hnmr~ or net^iike perforations and several nyrenmds: .nemoi-an* often with trammm* lamaaam at one end of a cell. Reproduction by mesaa ot zoospore* with a nrct* of nlt*-ne«r itif niwiler end and by heteroHpunetes. . . . ' )edfifomum Link, _^i C232) Phmt not branched >*!» » * ar ■Si :1 C !.( Plant* either monoenom or rtioenotw in the latter r;u* the n lament* i»*armff antheildla may •>e r.ormal filament*. i,r tinv filament* ot o«norM ht»rne «;in«rtv in vi -rotative rHU* ;hev .ave n imwn or cilia alrfwit a rolorle** «»v>t at the inferior end. >>'ftntontnm «-..-nir» in almoat all hudiea of .vater uid -i-vrml - >ecie« rire ; -maUv l-»imd toaether. ;. «v> .atJve frtantenr. « .itviwm. /i format*** of *nth**i*tt*r ., r. out cj3. >riafaal-i :?2f2^t) Plant branched: jiuUmttoutf* Aqafdtw •.lYnt nf the celU Hear- iiff a looir <*nlorle«« h*ir wnllen ; r J he h.»«# ;\ ep«ytnrtio*» »« mflwi** jw«w» 1 1 »e dwa rf male* '•rv frt-onenr J ivutfti n«»f «o eo?w- ■:,on **. t i.'HAf^nfum H fi.imd »'l o^*er the or!d j. ; >d *• >meflw*>* .i-nira in txrejit- ouafW- • tp* ri .mnletefv c> »vee- ,:-,? S'lhfneravif hi*4M!f •-lait** wiff» a fe^f|»#^i' ■ 1 »aMi%e'- - il^e>oft#*v fwwwf- ,t he* *!*&«»: - V.i ■TO" 2.1 T : Mafl*1 T»t^ **■ 1 68 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 233 (220) Chromatophore a single equatorial band, with one pyrenoid. F2a merits branched, attached, frequently with a gelatinous cov ering. Reproduction by zoospores and isogametes. Family Chaetophoraceae . . 23J 234 (342) The zoosporangia of the same form as the vegetative cells; th< larger species usually bearing long hairs. Subfamily Chaltophoreae . . 23; a3S (a39) Plant attached, differentiated into base and apex 23* 236 (237, 238) Filaments imbedded in a firm, gelatinous matrix, forming t spherical or an irregularly branched, ribbon-like thalhc attached at the base Chaetophora Shrank Filaments radiating from a common center, usually terminating in 'h two dlia and a pigment spotnea •■ . Ckidopfon piiifgrmis Agardh. 237 (a36> a38) Filaments not imbedded in a firm gelatinous matrix, tin branches irregularly placed, of the same size as the principa Myxonema Fries Plant either several centimeters long, at (ached, or very minute and free, often passing into a palmelli condition. Sexual reproduc tion by means 0! isogametes with two dli and a pigment spot; asexual, by zoospore with four cilia, and by akinetes. Myxan/ma is widely distributed, the mi croscopical forms occurring almost univer sally on mosses and liverworts in damp local Hies, while the larger forms are frequent ii running water. They have been known t completely cover the beds of streams. Th smaller forms are microscopical, and can b detected only after portions of the mow and liverworts are placed in culture and M yiDRtmo allowed to develop. It will then sometimes cover the top of n film inutepl THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE Flint attached by a disc of ceils. 169 r tufts, smaller than the main .... Drapornaidia liory. a long, colo rlesa hair. No fertiliation In Drupmaldia the photosynthesis takes place principally in the tufted blanches, aa the diloraplait of the principal aiis is reduced to a small, equatorial band in each cell. All form! of DrupanuUia are large and are found in much the same localities aa the larger Flo, 131- Dmfamaldia #hm«a Agardli. X about so. (OrigiaaL) 19 (135) Plant epiphytic adhering throughout to other plants. . . . 340 iifl (141) Plant oi irregularly branched filaments, setae or hairs not abundant. IltrposUiron Nftgeli. Plant small, cells with a parietal chronutophon-. _ pyrenoid, and frequently a bug colorless hair; re- production by means of egg-shaped aoosporea, with four cilia and a p' in a single cell. spot, two spores being formed 170 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 241 (240) Individual cells flask-shaped, each with a long slender hair from the smaller portion Chaetosphaeridiutn Klebahn. Chromatophore parietal, with one pyrenoid. Repro- duction by no- spores, four of which are produced in a cell. Horizon- tal divisions of the cells also occurs, the lower of the daughter cells pass- ing gradually to the side of the upper one. Chaetosfhaeridium is widely distrib- uted in the United States though rarely occurring in quantities exceed- ing a few cells at a time. These are usu- ally attached to fil- amentous algae and are inconspicuous, though the long setae are usually somewhat promi- nent Fio. 236. Ckaetosphaeridium pringsheimii Klebahn. X about 42s. (After Hazen.) 242 (234) The zoosporangia different from the vegetative cells. °r. r family Chroolepideae . . 243 243 (244, 245) Plant minute, tree-like in its branching; reproduction by zoospores Microthamnion Nageli. Branches from the upper end of a cell and not sepa- rated by a membrane; obtuse at the tip; color pale; chromatophore a parietal band with no pyrenoid. Zoo- spores formed in zoosporangia at the ends of filaments. Fig. 237. Microthamnion hutsingianmm Nigeli. X 600. (Original.) Plant coarse, irregularly branched, partly erect and partly creeping on stones and trees; when aerial, often colored red by haematochrome. Membrane thick; reproduction by zoospores and gametes Trentepohlia Martius. Chromatophores many, irregular discs, without pyre- noid s; gametangia and zoosporangia mostly terminal; gametes and zoospores similar, being egg-shaped, with two cilia and haematochrome, but no definite pigment spot. A palmella condition may occur. These are sometimes referred to as the aerial algae because they exist principally in the air and form often bright -colored incrustations on the bark of trees and stones. They are not infrequently found in connection with lichen fungi. As the TrenUpoMias are principally aerial, the lib- eration of the zoospores and gametes can occur only at the time of a rain or in the presence of a heavy dew. Fig. 238. Trentepohlia voainoi Hariot. X 125. (After Collins and Hariot.) 244 (243, 245) THE FRESH-WATER ALGAE 171 24S (243. 244) Structure as in TrentepoMia but many of fhe crfh having setae. Nyl/iti/tw Harlot There is hut one specie* o! this irenus described, and the nnly point of rliiiinction l*t»m this and TtnilrpeMia is ihe rsthrr llwi^vT ~™ coane and unsegmented setae Fw, net. ,V}iminw tmtv*hta Harlot. X no. (After Hitrtrrt.) 246(191.106) Plant an attached n Eermmatton Ihr '«sporr divide*, pmrliirinif* number of cells, in each one of which a zoospore is firmed; ihese rL-produce the [«rrti« plant Fin. t n. C/Jftort- •'• (147) Plant a disc, of one or more layers in thirkness, adhering through- out to a substratum, often hearing gelatinous hairs. Kepro- ilurtmn oy means of zoospores and in some instances: hy isogametes Family MYconwACT.AF.. Only one genus recorded here f'Mfn Crmtari. [■Mrtt 1 di=e of ridtatrmr mm of n-flV * rin(rhr i^r-r ir, thirkn^*< nn tV mnrrin ™d ^vrnrl fn fhe "tddh-: ■ Tj-iimtonho"- simdr, hut thinVme/? so as Arqmnnc* •nnrtl 1« m Ctfrnrkirit rTerpf that mem, r.rine inrt bain no- 3ior» ^htfno-n and the nafn I hr-<=e hri-r nlr,. -""1 irise fW -it 'th? n-ntir of the ■ |:' hut TS>$Z ™ "■""■' by partial starvation. Plants which have already formed bladed leaves may be induced in like manner to bring forth the ribbon form. In view of such results it is not unreasonable to suppose that both the floating and the submerged leaves may easily have developed during the past from aerial leaves and that both kinds are useful to many 184 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Many of the delicate submerged plants will wither rapidly when taken from the water and exposed to the air. This occurs be- cause the outer layer of tissue or epidermis, as it is called, is thin and allows the water contained in the plant rapidly to pass into the air as vapor. If a plant which bears both floating and sub- merged leaves is exposed it will be noticed that the latter wilt and dry out much more rapidly than the former. Examination will show the cuticle of the floating leaves to be thicker and much less permeable to water, if at all so, than that of the submerged leaves, while special openings may be discovered through which water vapor escapes instead of passing off all over the surface as in the submerged leaves. These special openings are called stomata and are the same in structure as those which occur on the leaves of land plants. The size of these openings may vary from time to time according to the needs of the plant. Each opening is sur- rounded by two cells, called guard cells, which also vary in size and shape according to the amount of water they contain. When turgid they become somewhat kidney-shaped, curving away from the opening and thus making it larger. When flaccid because there is little water in the plant they tend to straighten out and thus make the opening smaller. Thus, by the activity of these stomata whose action depends upon the amount of water in the plant, the amount of water passing from the plant by transpiration is regulated. The number of stomata occurring on the exposed surface of a floating leaf may be quite large. One author counted the number of stomata present in the area of i sq. mm. at Ave different loca- tions on the upper surface of the floating leaves of one of the Poia- mogeions. He found a minimum of 216 and a maximum of 276 with an average of 255 per sq. mm. It is evident that stomata are intended for leaves which must endure exposure to the air, but they do occur, though rarely, on the submerged leaves also (Fig. 260). Sometimes only one or two submerged leaves of a given plant will have them and again several specimens of the same species may be examined without finding any at all. The only explanation- for the occur- rence of such structures on submerged leaves is, that the ancestors THE LARGER AQUATIC VEGETATION 185 of the plants bearing them were adapted to life on land or at least lived under exposure to loss of water by transpiration. Other openings in the leaf have also been found in some species. These occur at the apex of the leaf more frequently in the submerged leaves than in the floating ones. The opening does not show any special structure, as is true of stomata, and is formed by the decay and failing away of the tissue at the apex, so that the conductive vessels in the veins of the leaf become exposed to, and in direct communi- cation with, the water. In some cases this disin- f tegration of tissue at the apex may go so far as to change to a marked degree the shape of the apex, making it rounded instead of pointed (Figs. 261 and 262). The formation of the opening seems to occur before the leaf matures but is seldom found on the young leaves. In addition to the species already known as bearing these openings the writer may mention that of Vailisneria spiralis on whose half- grown leaves he has observed them. Some authors have suggested that the passage of water through the conduc- tive tissue is facilitated and that the excretion is aided. This is really a """*""■' supposition and has never been proved. The presence of an earthy coating on the leaves and stems of some water plants may be commonly ob- served. This mineral incrustation appears Bke a coating of mud on the leaf in many cases, while in others it is not so conspicuous Mid is only noticeable when the plant is handled. Only the submerged organs seem to bear the incrustation, even the lower surface of floating leaves being less favor- able to its formation and much less fre- cfently bearing it. Potamogelon peetinatus is seldom, if ever, Ucrusted, while other species of this genus usually are. Chora is ?:&": K"St«y 186 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY seldom found without an incrustation, while Vallisneria is never found with it, although the two plants frequently grow side by side and essentially under the same conditions. The leaves of Vallisneria are very flexible and almost always bending with the current, hence, a deposit of solid matter is prevented. It seems probable, however, that the physiological processes going on in the plant determine largely whether or not an incrustation is to be formed. The coatings are not firmly fastened to the leaf and may be easily scaled off or loosened by bending the leaf. The presence of the coatings seems to make little difference to the plant as the tissue beneath appears of a healthy green color though frequently of more delicate tint than the unincrusted areas of the leaf. In all cases known the substance of the incrustation has been found chemically to be the neutral carbonate of lime, which, of course, is insoluble. Microscopic examination by polarized light has revealed the presence of minute crystals in the incrustation formed on Chara and the same may possibly prove to be the case with plants of other families. The chemistry of the formation of this incrustation is not known. There is usually present in the water the soluble bicarbonate of lime which by loss of carbon dioxid is changed to the neutral or insoluble carbonate. Some have supposed that as the plants withdraw carbon dioxid from the water to use in the process of starch manufacture, this insoluble neutral carbonate is formed and deposited on the leaf. This proc- ess may be expressed chemically thus : Soluble Insoluble CaH2 (CQ8)2 = CaCQ, + CCfe + HjO Another explanation may be that the oxygen liberated by the plant in starch making acts catalytically upon the bicarbonate to change it to the neutral carbonate. The former process would more likely occur in water containing a larger amount of the carbonate in solution which would be precipitated except for the solvent action of the carbon dioxid in the water. The latter process would be more probable in water containing very small amounts of the bicarbonate which would remain in solution in the absence of the carbon dioxid. /ki^&*Mi THE LARGER AQUATIC VEGETATION 187 Since the escape of oxygen and withdrawal of carbon dioxid are simultaneously in progress during the time the plant is making starch, both processes may operate to precipitate the neutral carbonate. If the plants secrete an alkaline carbonate this would immediately upon its escape from the plant decompose the soluble bicarbonate in the water with the formation of the neutral insol- uble carbonate. It is uncertain, however, that such an alkaline carbonate is secreted by the plant and not much emphasis can be placed upon this hypothesis. The most recent explanation rests upon the discovery that a soluble calcium salt of succinic acid is present in the cell sap of Chara. The occurrence of this salt in the sap of other plants has not been determined, but as succinic acid is a very probable by-product in the ordinary processes of plant physiology, its wide distribution may reasonably be expected. As the calcium salt escapes from Chara by osmosis it is most likely decomposed with the formation of the insoluble carbonate. Possibly the incrustation offers protection to the plant in some way, but this seems hardly probable, and at present one can only say that its formation is a consequence of processes in the plant and that its presence is of little benefit or of harm to the plant. Various plant organs are often found to be covered with a gelati- nous coating. This may occur on the lower surface of floating leaves as in species of Nymphaea. Young leaves and growing tips are often encased with it. In the axils of leaves arising in a rosette around a shortened stem it is likely to occur. Seed coats are often slimy and in some fruits the seeds at maturity are em- bedded in a mass of gelatinous substance which on swelling rup- tures the ovary walls and allows the seeds an exit. Some plants, as Brasenia pel lata, have special glands to furnish the slime, but often, as in leaf axils, there are no distinct structures for furnishing this substance. Many of the algae are embedded in a mass of slime just as the eggs of frogs are. Amphibious plants and those sub- ject to temporary exposure, as in the case of plants which grow in tide-water, are doubtless protected from too rapid loss of water by such covering. It may also serve as a protection for young buds and leaves against devouring animals. It is quite possible that the gelatinous masses in which seeds are found embedded are of i88 FBESH-WATER BIOLOGY very different composition from the slime which occurs on the lower surface of a floating leaf. The occurrence of the latter may be accidental so far as the plant is concerned and have little im- portance in its welfare. In the algae and even with delicate parts of higher plants such a coating I may serve to retard the ex- change of liquids, thus pre- venting plasmolysis, or in like manner it may enable the plant to maintain a cell sap of much greater density than ^^J^^JSSTSl&^SZ that of the surrounding water utoGfeo (Fig. 263). Quite a number of terrestrial species are especially adapted for retaining and digesting as food small animals which are so unfor- tunate as to wander into the traps borne by the plant. Few aquatic species have acquired this habit but there are some mem- bers of the genus Utricu- laria remarkable for the special organs developed to secure animal food. The bladders are generally re- garded as modified leaves, and structures resembling stomata have been found on them in some cases. The bladders have small openings guarded by hairs and closed by a sort of trap- ™ttew.t«. (ma ma..) door which permits small animals in the water to enter but which prevents any escape for the victims (Fig. 264). These plants may float free, so far as roots are concerned, but, as with Ceratopkyllum, accidental attachment or rather anchorage fre- quently occurs through entanglement with other plants or by being partly buried in the mud. All of the species raise the inflorescence above the water and Utrkularia inflate sends out whorls of leaves with inflated petioles Fig. 264- Utricularia* THE LARGER AQUATIC VEGETATION 189 from the flower-stalk to serve as floaters. As there are land species of Ubicularia which also have bladders, it seems quite probable that the aquatic forms have been derived from the land species. Some authors have suggested that, being without roots and re- quiring more nitrogenous food than can be obtained from sub- stances in solution in the water, these bladders have been developed to secure animal food. It is just as probable that the aquatic forms are merely using structures that were characteristic of their ancestors, which were land plants. Why the land species have developed such structures has never been demonstrated. Few, if any, of the flowering water plants depend upon seed repro- duction. Vegetative reproduction by runners, tubers, buds, stem fragments, etc., is particularly prominent among these aquatics. Seed reproduction is, however, common and many are the con- trivances utilized for securing the transfer of pollen and cross pollination. In some few cases, as Ceratophyllutn, Naias, and Zannichellia, pollination occurs under water and the pollen is transferred by the water. The wind is an important agent in the transfer of pollen espe- cially for many of the Potamo- F,G- *6s- "'JM.^ &3£ f tributk>n by getons (Fig. 265). The stamens and pistils of Potamogeton crispus do not mature on the same plant at the same time. As the pistils mature first they must receive pollen from some other plant and by the time the stamens of their own plant are ready to shed pollen, they have been pollinated and are no longer receptive to pollen. The Pollination of Vallisneria spiralis has become a classic illustra- tion of the remarkable capacity for adaptation possessed by some Plants. The individuals of this plant are of two kinds — one bearing stamens and the other bearing pistils only. The staminate flower cluster is enclosed in a sac which finally ruptures and the staminate flowers immediately rise to the water surface. After a #£3S^ "^ — "" 3^~-.^^^// t. .. -r — > » » ' ;/— ^ »». _ ia-vi. "^i>- 100 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY ■-If- Fio. 366. Vallisneria spiralis. short exposure to the air the flowers reflex the sepals to form a little boat which floats about with the dehiscing stamens exposed to the air, so that whenever the boat lodges by a pistillate flower some pollen is deposited upon the receptive stigma. The pistillate flower is solitary upon a long stalk, which, rising from the leaf axils, elongates very rapidly until the flower floats on the water surface, when the stigma is soon exposed to receive the pollen from the passing boats of staminate flowers (Fig. 254, page 181, and Fig. 266). Sometimes where Vallisneria is abundant the water surface is completely covered by the staminate flowers, just as Lemnay the duckweed, often covers certain areas. As soon as the pistillate flower is fertilized the stalk contracts to a spiral, thus drawing the flower under water to mature the fruit. To what extent Vallisneria is propagated by seed is not known. It has been necessary for the writer to take hundreds of these plants from the lake for experimental pur- poses and a seedling has not as yet been found. The plants growing in water 2.5 to 3.5 meters deep frequently do not flower at all but readily propagate by runners. As previously mentioned, Zannichellia palustris conducts its pollination under water (Fig. 267). The staminate and pis- tillate flowers stand in the same axil. The fio. 267." ZamnickeUioPaiustris. Pollination occurs under water. filament Of the Solitary Staminate flower Anthers are raised alwve the ' stigmas by the long filament. elongates to raise the anthers above the x about 8. (After Gobd.) stigmas of the pistillate flowers. The pollen is heavy enough to slowly sink after escaping from the stamens and in still water may pollinate the flower of its own plant, but in running water is usually carried to a neighboring plant. The pollen grains of aquatic plants differ in one particular from those of land forms in that they have only one coat. Perhaps this »* * THE LARGER AQUATIC VEGETATION 1 91 is because they are little exposed and do not need protection against a rapid loss of water. Very few species develop a showy corolla under water, but Heter- anthera graminea is one which has a fairly conspicuous flower under water. Most of the attached flowering plants are perennial, and vegeta- tive propagation is very common. Naias flexilis is an annual. There is a period of rest for water plants just as for land plants and as in the latter so in the former this period occurs during the cold season. Not all of our perennial aquatics make special prep- aration for passing the winter, and some, as Ranunculus aquatilis, Ruppia, and Zannichellia, may be found in normal condition even during the winter. The drifting fragments of CeratophyUum often become attached by accidental lodgment and pass the winter in the vegetative condition. Some Potamogetons, Ranunculus aquatilis, and others will con- tinue to grow uninterruptedly all winter if planted in aquaria and kept at favorable temperature in the greenhouse. Vegetative reproduction is the conspicuous method of propa- gation among the larger aquatics, and although many of the species produce seed there are few which could not easily persist if seed production were to be discontinued. In some cases fruit formation has been abandoned. Elodea and Potamogeton robbinsii rarely fruit. The rhizomes of most of the water plants are well developed and represent a considerable portion of the vegetation. In some cases, as in Potamogeton perfoliatus, if a plant be taken carefully from the soil fully one-half the fresh weight of the plant will be found to consist of roots and rhizomes. With the approach of cold weather the stems and leaves gradually disin- tegrate but the rhizomes remain alive and pass the winter buried in the mud and in the spring send up Fig a6g P^Zgaonpec^us.\^o^in shoOtS from the buds previously November with winter buds. (After Innisch.) formed (Fig. 268). Heteranthera graminea has long black rhizomes that are cord-like and often quite tough. The young plants seem in some cases to rise from the runners adventitiously. Among I92 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY the Nymphaeaceae large tubers are common and young plants of Nymphaea alba may sometimes be found floating about attached to a tuber. The swamp plants, such as Typha and Scirpus, also have exten- sive rhizome systems which are important means of wintering and acquiring new territory. Some plants have winter buds or hibernacula which form in autumn, separate from the parent plant, often drift to a new locality, and finally sink to pass the winter in a dormant condition only to commence a new generation the following spring (Fig. 269). Such winter buds are commonly formed by Utricularia, PotamogeUm crispus, P. zosterifo- liusy P. pusiilus, P.frasii, and possibly others. The sinking of those winter buds may be ac- complished by the intercellular spaces becom- 1**. Paia^etan crises. «« Ejected with water, as is the case with K4ud IRSftStwl the autumn plants of Lemna minor. S^^S^^viS8. Aside from special organs of propagation nus) quite a few plants acquire new stations by means of the fragments of vegetative parts accidentally set adrift. It is common to find floating stems of Elodea, from the nodes of which adventitious roots have risen. These roots grow straight downward and the stem makes little growth in length while the roots are seeking the soil. A fragment of Elodea was found floating in Lake Erie which had an adventitious unbranched root 45 cms. in length. The roots do not branch in some species until the soil is penetrated and then a system of lateral branches develops to anchor the plant. In PotamogeUm perfoliatus the adventitious roots usually arise from the nodes of new rhizomes which develop in the leaf axils of the cutting. With land plants the development of roots on the seedling is as marked as the growth of stem and leaves, but in several water plants the root development is subordinated to that of the stem and leaves, while in some species a genuine functional root is not developed. The rudiment of a root may be present as a part of $k\iSlk'jf umtih**^* „ THE LARGER AQUATIC VEGETATION 193 the embryo in the seed, but in germination this rudiment is sup- pressed in its development and never gets to be a real root. The seeds of Ranunculus aquatilis will germinate either on land or in water but the development of the seedling is not alike in each case (Fig. 270). The seed leaves are similar, except that those of the land seedling are a little wider in b proportion. The true leaves of Fic.a7o. Ranunculus aqua- the land plants have broad, seg- F!G-271 •£"'*"?#?!! tilts A Seedling ger- lucens. Seedling minkting in water, b. mented blades, while the water r*L^£*)£Si£ Seedling germinating on , ' „ primary ^bearing land.7A£terABkenasy.) form has Only a few thread-like ^Wa^ngT' branches with little indication of a distinct blade. Potamogeton lucens and Naias major send out a primary root from the seed upon which a cluster of root-hairs soon develops to help anchor the plant. But this primary root is not lasting and is soon succeeded by adventitious roots which spring from the joints of the runners which developed in the meantime (Figs. 271 and 272). Ceratophyllum furnishes a very interesting instance of suppressed root development. There is present in the embryo of the seed a rudimentary root, but it never develops into an organ of attachment or serves for the entrance of mineral salts. When the seed germinates this rudiment of a root pushes out far enough to let the plumule rise from between the emerging cotyle- dons and then its growth practically stops (Fig. 273). So far as known, wiing y&TiiZ- adventitious roots never appear on ^S^^ST^ISSm Garing^dS^^f this plant. ^anXu^S* root-hairs. (After * ^i. cB-j ^' imisch.) ^ Nuphar and Brasenia the seed- (After s***** ling escapes from the seed by pushing out a plug which before germination occupies the passage intended for the exit of the young plant. The seeds of Utricularia commence to germinate in the muddy substratum, but as the embryo emerges the newly formed tissues 194 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY are so buoyant that the seedling rises to the water surface often carrying with it the remains of the old seed. By vertical distribution is understood that which exists in a plane more or le^s perpendicular to the earths surface and may be illustrated by the distribution one may observe in passing from valley to mountain-top or by comparison of species found at vari- ous depths in lake or ocean. Horizontal distribution is, of course, in a plane more or less conformable to the earth's surface and is such as one notices in passing from east to west or north to south, etc. Now the factors which determine the horizontal distribu- tion of water plants are: first, the chemical composition of the water, a factor which gives the two large divisions of fresh and salt water plants; second, temperature which gives zones of plant life such as arctic, temperate, tropical, etc.; third, competition among the plants themselves, a factor which is likewise influential in vertical distribution though perhaps to a less degree; and fourth, the nature of the substratum, which is, of course, most influential in the distribution of species which grow rooted to the bottom. To what extent chemical composition of the water is a factor in the distribution of fresh-water plants cannot at present be stated. Sulphur springs and waters having unusual composition are not, of course, fresh water. By the latter term is understood such as occurs in the rivers and lakes and such as may be used as drink by the animals, so far as chemical composition is concerned. Such waters differ, of course, in the quantity and quality of constituents; but whether such differences are in themselves independent of other factors, sufficient to determine distribution, cannot at present be stated. Suppose we should find that the water of some lake in Wisconsin is considerably different in chemical composition from that of a lake in New York and a species of Potamogeton, for example, which is abundant in the Wisconsin lake but unknown to the waters of the New York lake, be taken to the New York lake and planted there. If this plant grows well in the New York lake we would say that, other conditions being equal, the difference in chemical composition of the water in the two lakes is not a determining factor in the horizontal distribution and that the absence of the * *'~a.A. THE LARGER AQUATIC VEGETATION 195 Wisconsin species in the New York lake must be attributed to some other cause or causes. Experimental evidence is lacking for stating to what extent the chemical composition of the water becomes a determining factor in fresh water. The important influence of temperature on distribution is at once apparent, although the influence exerted by it is much farther reaching than is at first supposed. Of course, the forms of the arctic waters would be "cooked" by the heat of the tropical waters. It has recently been ascertained that the colder waters support a more abundant plankton than the tropical waters, and one writer has explained this fact upon the basis that the colder waters are richer in nitrates and nitrites because the decomposition of organic matter proceeds much more slowly and the organisms causing decay are not so numerous and less active. Such considerations offer a glimpse of how indirectly, yet effectively, the various factors may operate to determine distribution. The competition of species for space may be considered a factor in horizontal distribution, although it operates quite locally and does not work to modify the flora of large areas. Chara is infre- quent on the alluvial bottoms where other species are present in abundance, but this is not because it prefers poorer soils but because it is prevented from occupying the soil of its choice by the other species. The character of the substratum is an important factor; in fact, it is possible to predict the nature of the bottom from the species that are found growing in it. Among the islands of western Lake Erie Potamogeton heterophyllus is common on the reefs and pebbly shores but is not noticeable in the coves with a good soil substra- tum and so prominent is it in the former places that its presence Nay be considered characteristic of the flora. Light cannot be counted a factor in horizontal distribution be- cause there is always sufficient illumination within the limits estab- lished by other factors. In vertical distribution light is probably the most important factor. The amount of illuminating power lost in passing to a given depth is quite variable in different waters. Fol and Sarasin found in Lake Geneva, in September, light at x7o meters, and at 120 meters a photographic plate was darkened. 196 FRESH- WATER BIOLOGY In April they were able to detect light at 250 meters. Of course the clearness of the water has much to do with the penetration of light rays. One can see deeper into the water of Lake Superior or of Lake Huron than into that of Lake Erie. The latter is shal- lower with much of the bottom clay, so that the water always holds minute particles in suspension which greatly interfere with the penetration of light. The red and yellow rays contained in the beams of sunlight are more readily absorbed than those of higher refrangibility, as the blue and violet, but whether this is of any importance in determining the vertical distribution cannot be stated. Schimper gives 6 meters as the maximum depth for phanerogams, although the lower forms, such as Chara and Nitella, are said to have been found as deep as 30 meters. Temperature is of little importance because the variations are so slight within the limits established by light. This is not so much the case with the free- swimming, lower forms, but only the larger plants are considered here. It is impracticable to attempt an elaborate classification of water plants according to their habitat or adaptation to environment. In some localities distinct zones of vegetation may be observed which are apparently determined by the depth of water. Magnin was able to distinguish four zones in the lakes of the Jura. First is the littoral, with a maximum depth of 3 meters, which may be divided into Phragmitetum with Phragmites communis as typical and Scirpetum with Sett pus lacustris, sedges, Equisetum, etc., as representative. A second zone, the Nupharetum, extending to 3 or 4 meters, is composed of plants with large floating leaves such as are common among the Nymphaeaceae. The third zone, the Pota- mogetonetum, in water 4 to 6 meters deep, is characterized by presence of several species of Potamogeton, especially perfoliatusy crispus, lucens, and others. The fourth zone, Characetum, occupies deep water, 8 to 12 meters, where Chara, Naias, and some mosses cover the bottom. The flora of almost any lake may be regarded as composed of zones and even rivers and small streams show plant societies, but a grouping for one locality is frequently inapplicable to some other. THE LARGER AQUATIC VEGETATION 197 and the depth of water for a species varies much according to clearness and other factors which may be incidental to a particular region. It is possible to make a general grouping which will indicate the important conditions and varieties of environment. To some one of the groups thus established any aquatic plant may be assigned. I. Plants without attachment. (a) Plankton, free swimming, microscopic. (6) Macroscopic, possibility of attachment by accidental lodgment, as Lemna, Ceratophyllutn, filamentous algae common on plants in coves. H. Plants attached to substratum. (a) Submerged, algae as Chara and Cladophora, and phan- erogams as Vallisneria, Elodea. (b) Partially submerged, usually with floating or emersed leaves, as Nymphaea, Bidens beckii. DL Swamp plants or marsh forms with roots and rhizomes under water but leaves usually emersed though able to endure inundation and temporary submersion. Sometimes representatives of each of these three classes may be found in one small lake, especially if the water gradually deepens from a marsh or low shore as in Lake St. Clair where the wholly submerged species become so abundant as to form an aquatic meadow. Potamogeton perjoliatus, P.foliosus, P. zoster aefolius, Val- luneria, Naias, Chara, Nitella, Elodea, and Myriophyllum may be found in dense patches covering the bottom. In such formations the struggle for space must be severe and from observations during three summers on Lake Erie I should say that Vallisneria is a con- queror. Naias flexilis may be found in distinct formations in which other species are very infrequent but being an annual the creeping rootstocks of Vallisneria may easily invade its territory. In many of the small inland lakes the water plants are important agents as soil collectors. The aquatic meadows tend to filter the water so that suspended matter sinks to the bottom. As the lake gradually becomes filled and the water grows more shallow a suc- cession of plant societies occurs. The aquatic meadows yield to the 198 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Potamogetons with floating leaves and especially the Nymphaea- ceae which are followed by amphibious species until finally the bog vegetation appears which may later support the ordinary terrestrial plants. It may be supposed that aquatic phanerogams have descended from aquatic or from land species. The former supposition im- plies that the plants, as they are now, represent the maximum of complexity in structure that has thus far developed. The latter supposition implies that the simpler vascular system is not to be considered as foreshadowing a more elaborate structure to be evolved in the future but is a reduced form of more highly developed structure present in the terrestrial ancestors. Perhaps some spe- cies have had land ancestors, while others have descended from aquatic forms. Considering the whole list of fresh-water plants, it is noteworthy that the abundant groups are algae and phanerogams. Bryophytes and pteridophytes do occur, but infrequently in comparison with the former groups, the thallophytes and spermatophytes, which include a large percentage of aquatic vegetation. Would the great plant groups be represented in this proportion if the evolution of aquatic forms had proceeded as in the case of land plants? Does not a water environment insure greater uni- formity of conditions and would not the evolution proceed more slowly and the intermediate forms more likely persist in such en- vironment? How could the great groups of monocotyledons and dicotyledons ever become differentiated from ancestors living wholly submerged? How could the seed habit so essentially like that of land plants ever be acquired by the descendants of sub- merged forms? On the other hand if water forms have been derived from land forms, why are not the bryophytes and pterido- phytes which are frequent in moist localities better represented in the aquatic flora? The change from aquatic structure to ter- restrial must be much more difficult than from terrestrial to aquatic. When a water plant is suddenly exposed, the loss of water by drying is so rapid that the plant must die, while a land plant may endure submersion for a considerable period. In one case the change of environment causes a sudden demand for a complex vascular system •';, fc*^.fL .'■ 1 uuttoftk. jkit°. THE LARGER AQUATIC VEGETATION 199 that Hie plant is unable to supply. In the other case the land plant may persist and gradually reduce in complexity structures already present. Thus it is that the reduction of the vascular system has proceeded in the same manner in both the dicotyle- dons and monocotyledons, so that the simplest stem structure is alike for members of either group. In Ceraiophyllum the vascular system has become so simplified that its dicotyledonous relation- ship cannot be established by the stem structure. How is the presence of stomata on submerged leaves to be ac- counted for? It can hardly be supposed that they are developing in anticipation of the time when the species is to have a transpiring surface. More likely is it that these stomata are reminders of the time when the species had an exposed surface. In the genus Utricular ia there are land as well as water species and the presence of bladders characterizes both varieties. It is hardly probable that submerged plants accustomed to the food supplied in solution by the surrounding water should acquire an appetite for animal food and develop such elaborate and unique organs for securing nitrogenous nourishment. In some cases, as in Lemna, the ancestry is not so obvious and convincing evidence is difficult to obtain. The pollination of Zannichellia under water has been previously mentioned (Fig. 267). In such cases the evolution of stamens and pistils cannot be regarded as having occurred in wholly submerged plants. Much less difficult it is to understand how land plants with stamens and pistils already developed could gradually be- come adapted to an aquatic habit before these organs would dis- appear by reduction. It is now known that the roots of several of our genuine aquatic species bear root-hairs whose presence certainly testifies to the absorbing activity of the roots and the lingering terrestrial habits necessitating such organs. It must be noted that the foregoing discussion is purely theo- retical and the intention has been to awaken interest in the study of the aquatic flora rather than to offer a theory of origin for which any originality could be claimed. Experimental evidence may be obtained that roots are organs 200 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY for absorption.1 It is possible by means of very simple apparatus to actually measure the water which a root absorbs in a given time. In one experiment of the writer's a small cutting 20 ceutimeters long bearing a root 14 centimeters long was used and this un- branched single root absorbed 5 cubic centimeters of water in 24 hours. Another method can be used to demonstrate that roots are organs of absorption. A certain substance, namely, lithium nitrate, which is soluble in water, is offered in solution to the roots. The lithium in this compound burns with a rose red flame and very small traces of this substance in plant tissue may be detected by burning portions of the tissue and observing the color given to the flame, and by using the spectroscope the test becomes very delicate. In this method it is only necessary to enclose the root in a bottle containing the lithium nitrate solution by means of a flexible stopper made by saturating cotton in melted vaselin. After a time portions of the stem which could not possibly contain lithium, unless it had passed to it from the roots, are burned and the flame observed with the spectroscope. Such tests have been made re- peatedly and the presence of the lithium may always be traced through the plant to whatever distance the tissue used in the test allowed it to travel in the plant. There can be no doubt then but that the roots are organs for absorption and that sub- stances absorbed by them are conducted upward into the stem and leaves. The distance that the lithium travels in a given tissue probably does not represent exactly the rate of ascent of the up- ward current but indicates a rate of ascent which is less than that of the water passage through the plant; that is, water travels upward a little faster than the lithium which it holds in solution. Mention has been made of the fact that when cuttings of Ranun- culus aquatilis are left to drift in the water, new roots arise from the stem at the nodes. These roots grow directly downward and do not branch until after penetrating the soil, when they then commence to branch repeatedly, and as the main root pushes through the soil 1 It is not strictly correct to speak of roots as organs for absorption. The struc- ture of roots is such that solutions can pass into them. However, the term is so commonly employed as to make it impracticable to use other phraseology here. i*Atf*r t this reten- [e nor per- i here are two one hand • i hem , while the the soil into Like water iao others 1 such condi- plant are the nitrogen, ■ i it is hardly □ >ugh of those e plants cannot to a certain ilch they absorb. "i cessary for ivater in solution freely swimming hich they live for he water and de- i. but Lcmtia has BtoCB in much greater WS. One invesli- ■ , >o per cent of potas- While the mineral resl- ;n which the Lemtta In the respective propor- However, the fact that from the water alone and n the soil to thrive is no animals are herbivorous (Trowing in clayey, sandy, gravelly, ion one would say that the lest variety of species. Wherever the 202 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY nodes in length be detached and left floating, roots will spring forth from the nodes or joints of the stem in from 6 to 10 days. While the roots are lengthening toward the bottom the stem does not increase in length but quickly resumes its growth after the root has penetrated the soil. More roots then arise from the newer nodes of the stem and as they also enter the soil the plant is drawn farther down and finally becomes firmly anchored. The roots of such fragments do not branch before reaching the soil but do so very shortly after the substratum is penetrated. Numerous lateral roots then arise and form in succession as the main root advances. The roots are well supplied with hairs; those arising from the floating fragments are often covered almost their entire length with root-hairs. In one instance a root was found to be clothed with root-hairs for a distance of 45 centimeters, which was practi- cally its entire length. Since this plant ordinarily grows rooted in the soil whatever growth it makes under natural conditions must be regarded as the normal growth and there is no escape from the conclusion that the growth becomes abnormal when sand is substituted for soil. How is the superior growth of plants rooted in the soil to be accounted for? Is it possible that the soil furnishes plants rooted in it with food materials that are not available to plants suspended in the water standing over it? In 1850 it was discovered that liquid manure loses its color if drained through a layer of soil sufficiently thick. Not only does the solution lose color but the organic and inorganic matter originally in it is considerably re- duced after filtering through the soil. This property or capacity of soil to withdraw salts from solution is now well established although not well understood. For a time authors were not agreed as to whether the retention or fixation of salts by the soil is a chemical or a physical process. Now it is generally under- stood that both chemical and physical processes operate to this end. Some substances seem to be held much more firmly by the soil than others. Various investigations go to show that most soils absorb the oxids, salts of the alkalis and alkaline earths of potassium, ammonium, magnesium, sodium, and calcium in the ^ v.. , ... '»** THE LARGER AQUATIC VEGETATION »3 order given. It must be remembered, however, that this reten- tion of dissolved substance by the soil is neither absolute nor per- manent. We may suppose that in the case of a lake there are two opposing processes operating in which the soil on the one hand tends to withdraw salts from the water and retain them, while the water on the other hand tends to bring salts from the soil into solution. As a consequence of those two processes the lake water contains certain salts in much greater proportion than others which seem to be hrmlv held bv the soil. ]ust how such condi- tions influence the plant is only partially known. It seems as though the substances needed by the plant are the ones most firmly retained by the soil. — especially the nitrogen, phosphorous, and potassium compounds — and yet it is hardly possible to say that the water doe* not contain enough of those substances in solution for the larger plants. While plants cannot select certain substances and reject others they can to a certain extent regulate the amount 01 a substance which the\ absorb. It is evident that all of the substance* absolutely necessary for the growth of plants must be present in the water in solution because there are so many forms which live as freely swimming objects and depend wholly upon the water in which they live for food. Lemna, the so-called duckweed, lives in the water and de- pends upon the water only for food tmineral.-. but Lemna ha~s been analyzed and found to contain substances in much greater proportion than does the water in which it grows. One investi- gator found the ash of this plant to contain 13.10 per cent of potas- sium, and 8.73 per cent of phosphoric acid, while the mineral resi- due obtained by evaporating some of the water in which the Lemna was growing contained those substances in the respective propor- tions of 3.97 per cent and 2.619 per cent. However, the fact that Lemna can obtain all the food necessary from the water alone and that some other plants must be rooted in the- soil to thrive is no more remarkable than the fact that some animals are herbivorous while others are carnivorous. Water plants may be found growing in clayey, sand\ , gravelly, or loamy soil. From held observation one would sav that the loamy soil supports the greatest variety of species. Wherever the 204 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY soil is very sandy the species may be abundant and likewise where the substratum is distinctively clay or gravel. From field observa- tion alone it would hardly be possible to say that the quality of the soil is the determining factor, because sand and gravel are more common where other factors come in to influence growth and species selection. The loamy soil is most abundant in the coves and bayous where the water is quiet and it is in just such places that plants make good growth and wealth of species abounds. Plants which would perish in exposed situations make excellent growth in the protected coves and we cannot be certain from field observation whether the difference is to be attributed to the soil or to the more favorable locality. By direct experiment, however, it is not difficult to ascertain what quality of substratum favors growth. In such experiments it is very desirable to have condi- tions as nearly like those in nature as possible. Three types of soil were selected, clayey, sandy, and loamy. A large rectangular glass aquarium was used to contain a substratum of each one of the given soil types. Then the three aquaria were placed upon a submerged platform so that the aquaria themselves were also sub- merged. This arrangement made the aquaria similar in all condi- tions except as to the quality of soil, and differences in the growth of plants in each aquarium could be very easily referred to the varying quality of soil. Two types of plants were tested in this way — one was VaUisneria, a typical water plant of the phan- erogams, and Chara, one of the higher algae. The latter does not have roots but simple structure called rhizoids which help to secure attachment. With both of these plants the best growth was made in the loamy soil and the poorest in the clay soil, while the sandy soil which of course contained some organic d6bris supported a medium growth. In the case of Chara an equal number of plants of equal size were planted so that the dry weight of the total growth in each aquarium might be compared. If the poorest growth in clay be taken as one, then that in sand would be about 2.06, while that in the loamy soil would be about 3.33. The total dry weight is of course a fair indication of the relative amount of growth made and there can now be no doubt but that the quality of soil is much concerned with the plant growth upon it and that THE LARGER AQUATIC VEGETATION 205 of these three types of soil the loamy one is capable of supporting the best growth. That soil is necessary for good growth has been previously men- tioned and explained. The interesting question arises — why is it that plants artificially anchored but not allowed to root in the soil are unable to make a good growth? It surely must be a matter of nutrition, because the soil could hardly be so potent an influence in any other way. When the plants are artificially anchored all other conditions are the same as with plants rooted in the soil except that the roots of the suspended plants are exposed to light and are unable to absorb nourishment from the soil. That light in some measure retards root development and thus diminishes the absorbing capacity of the plant is certain, but this factor is entirely too small to account for the stunted growth of plants denied a soil substratum. Chemical analysis has been employed for the purpose of securing if possible some clue to the reason why these plants cannot make normal growth unless rooted in the soil. Vallisneria spiralis, the eel-grass, whose elaborate arrangement for pollination has been described, was selected as a typical water plant of wide distribu- tion. The history of the material to be analyzed must, of course, be known, and in this case a large number of small plants of uniform size were carefully taken from the lake bottom and trans- ferred to submerged boxes which were alike, except that one con- tained soil and the other did not. The roots of the plants arti- ficially anchored in the box without soil were not permitted to touch the box, but dangled in the water, and thus from the water only could nourishment be taken. After a certain time the plants were gathered and carefully washed, only the living specimens, of course, being saved. In order to establish a basis for comparison the volume of each group of plants was obtained by immersion in water and measuring the displacement. The volume of the plants rooted in soil was taken to be just twice the volume of the plants artificially anchored. This material was then dried out and the dry weight taken, which, for the plants rooted in soil, was 52.7 grams and for those suspended 37.2 grams. These figures show at once that the suspended plants are relatively much heavier than 206 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY the others. Further analysis discloses the reason for this. The suspended plants were found to contain relatively twice as much starch as the others. This means that the suspended plants, though dwarfed to one-half the normal size, still contained the same weight of starch that they would have contained if allowed to grow as the others did in the soil. Evidently the retarded growth cannot be because of any scarcity of starch. Since this process of starch- making is one of the very vital processes of the plant it is im- portant to know that being artificially anchored does not disturb this fundamental function of the plant. However, as a conse- quence of this fact, it is evident that the suspended plants must soon become overcrowded with stored starch and this result in itself may be a reason for further disturbance of vital processes with eventually fatal consequences. The proteid content of the suspended plants was found to be smaller, suggesting that sufficient supply of nitrogenous food was not available for them. This shows that the suspended plants must have very soon fallen into an abnormal condition in which the two very fundamental functions of starch-making and of pro- teid synthesis were not properly balanced. The analysis showed further that the suspended plants contained a relatively smaller proportion of mineral matter, which of course indicates that they were unable to secure and use as much mineral food as they needed. The elements most deficient in the suspended plants were potassium and phosphorus, two of the most essen- tial substances which are no doubt much concerned with the man- ufacture of food materials. So far, then, as present knowledge is concerned we can say that the plants are dependent upon the soil for a sufficient supply of certain substances, especially nitrogen, potash, and phosphorus. When the plants are compelled to take all their nourishment from the water an abnormal condition soon arises by reason of a dis- proportion between proteid synthesis and starch manufacture which is manifested by a retarded growth and final death. That such statements are not conclusively proven must not be overlooked and just why they cannot be regarded as beyond doubt would be tedious to explain here. .-.• > „1 km, . THE LARGER AQUATIC VEGETATION 207 The natural conditions of our lakes and rivers are undoubtedly changing from decade to decade. The extensive destruction of forests that has occurred in the lake region and along tributary streams has certainly indirectly affected the plant and animal life in the lakes, although at present it cannot be stated in any detail how such influences have operated. The same may be said in regard to the vast volume of organic matter that constantly comes to the lakes and rivers as sewage from the cities. The influences which operate to regulate or determine the food supply of the water are numerous. Adequate knowledge is only possible by a thorough study of the food relations among the animals themselves, between the animals and plants and between the plants and the soil. Cycle of matter. — Animals cannot organize food from inorganic substances but must use, as food, matter that is already organized, either as vegetable or animal substance. Plants, however, can and do organize food, using both the mineral salts occurring in the soil or water, and the gaseous carbon dioxid which occurs in the air and in the water. The dependence of the animals upon the plants is at once apparent and the dependence of the plants upon the earth and air is also apparent. The most important influence exerted by plants in fresh-water biology is undoubtedly concerned with their nutrition but they are also important in other ways. As geological agents in the formation of marl. — The formation of lime incrustations by water plants has already been considered, so that it is only necessary to state here that considerable evidence has been brought forward to show that the large marl deposits in the marl lakes have accumulated as already described through the ac- tivity of plants, especially Chara. As aerating agents. — Both animals and plants must have air to breathe, and in running water or open lakes there is usually suffi- cient oxygen dissolved in the water to support the respiration of the organisms present. In the still waters of coves and bayous, however, conditions are different. It is in such places that organic debris tends to accumulate, and, in decay, overcharges the water with the gases of decomposition, especially that of carbon dioxid. Of course, whatever animal life is present under such conditions 208 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY still further reduces the oxygen supply and increases the carbon dioxid. The green plants on the other hand during sunlight are constantly using the carbon dioxid for making starch and giving off oxygen as a waste product of the process. In this process the volume of oxygen released equals the volume of carbon dioxid used, so that an aquatic meadow, growing vigorously in a still- water cove, would be very efficient in keeping the water well aerated and much to the advantage of all the animal life finding food and shelter there. As affording shelter and refuge for small animals. — In these aquatic meadows many kinds of young fish spend their early life during the period when they require protection from enemies. Here, too, many of the smaller animals pursued by enemies find temporary refuge or are able to evade their pursuers. As a base of attachment for algae. — Wherever the larger plants occur may be found also many smaller and more lowly organized forms which use the larger plants as supports. The simple forms, which are usually algae, would be unable to live as free swimming individuals, and since many of them are used as food by the animals it is important that they should be allowed to develop abundantly. The dead as well as the living larger plants may be useful in this way and only direct observation will reveal to one how much of importance the larger plants are in this one particular. As organizers of matter and distributors of nourishment for the plankton. — If, as formerly supposed, water plants take their min- eral food from the surrounding water and not from the soil at all, then it is evident that during the growing season these rooting aquatics would be continually diminishing the food supply of the free swimming plants, or the plant plankton, and this would, of course, result in a decreasing food supply for the animals dependent upon the plant plankton for nourishment. In view of the evidence now at hand it is certain that these larger plants rooting in the bottom absorb inorganic matter from the soil and organize this material into plant tissue which can be used as food by the animals and also by parasitic and saprophytic plants which can also be used as food by the animals. This, then, is perhaps the most important rfile of the larger aquatic plants, in that their life work results in an -r^^mWi THE LARGER AQUATIC VEGETATION 20Q actual contribution of organic matter to the food supply of the animal life. There is no doubt but that in a body of water like lake Erie this contribution of organic matter made from soil and air constituents that would otherwise remain unused could be meas- ured in tons even in a single growing season. In the marshes and shallow places immense quantities of plant debris are constantly occurring and with changing wind these masses of organic matter are carried far out into the lake, where, during the period of slow decay, they furnish food to hosts of small animals and in the decay yield valuable mineral salts, thus enrich- ing the water to the advantage of the free swimming forms. IMPORTANT REFERENCES ON HIGHER AQUATIC PLANTS Brittox. N. L., and Brown, A i8q6-q8. Illustrated Flora of the Northern United States, Canada, and the British Possessions. 3 v. New York Conard, H. S 1005 The Waterlilies: a Monograph of the Genus Nym- phaea. Carnegie Inst, of Wash., Pub. No. 4. Coultek, J. M., Barnes, C R, and Cowles, H. C. 1911. Textbook of Botanv. Vol. 2. New York Ekgler, A. 1000-f. Das Pflanzenreich. Leipzig. Ekgler, A., and Prantl, K. 1887+ (See list in Chapter VL.) Gluck, Hugo. 1005-06. Biologische unci morphologische Untersuchungen uber Wasser und Sumpigewachse. 2 v. Jena. Kerner, A., and Oliver. F. \Y. 1895. The Natural History of Plants, their Forms, Growth, Reproduction and Distribution. 2 v. in 4 New York. Morqng. Thomas. 1886. Studies in the Typhaceae. Bull Torrey Bot. Club, 15: 1-8, 73-81. 1892-93. The Naiadaceae of North America. Mem. Torrey Bot. Club, v. 4, No. 2; 65 pp., 55 pi. Pieters, A. J. 1894. The Plants of Lake St. Clair. Bull. Mich. Fish Com., No. 2; 10 pp. Map. 1901. The Plants of Western Lake Erie with Observations on their Distri- bution. Bull. U. S. Fish Comm., 21 : 57-70. 10 pi. Pond, R. H. 1005. The Biological Relation of Aquatic Plants to the Sub- stratum. Rept. U. S. Com. of Fish and Fisheries 1903: 483-526. Warming, J. E. B. iqoq. Oecology of Plants; an Introduction to the Study of Plant Communities. Oxford. CHAPTER Vm AMOEBOID PROTOZOA (Sarcodina) By C. H. EDMONDSON Assistant Professor of Zoology, University of Oregon The minute animals consisting of but a single cell' throughout their existence are commonly called Protozoa. They are world- wide in their distribution, swarming the seas from the surface to great depths and being found abundantly under almost all condi- tions of moisture in fresh water as well as in the fluids and tissues of other animals where many exist as parasites. The Protozoa may be grouped under the following subphyla: Subphylum I. Sarcodina. — Moving by means of temporary extensions of the protoplasm, called pseudopodia. Subphylum II. Mastigophora. — Provided with one or more whip-like processes, called flagella, as organs of locomotion or for securing food. Subphylum III. Infusoria. — Locomotor organs in the form of fine hair-like structures, called cilia, present during the entire ex- istence or during the embryonic stage only. Subphylum IV. Sporozoa. — Without true organs of locomo- tion; usually reproducing by spores. Parasitic. No free living forms. It will be observed that the above grouping is based upon the organs of locomotion. This basis has been found a convenient one for classification and study, little difficulty arising except in unusual cases where species are found to possess more than one kind of motile organs or where species pass through distinct phases during their life cycle. Of all the Protozoa those representing the highest degrjee of simplicity of structure and the greatest general- ization of life processes, if not the oldest in point of time, are to be found in the group possessing pseudopodia. These form the sub- ject of the present chapter, the flagellate and ciliate forms are considered in the next, and the parasitic Sporozoa do not properly call for attention in this work. 2IO i J» I II SAACODDTA) 211 Previously unknown on account of their diminutive 92c these organisms at once attracted the early maskers with the microscope, Ahi—igli Leeuwenhoek as early as 1675 iniriaterf the study of Procaaoa by Ins discovery oc FtrfecdZo. an imnsodan, without dciohc Rosei's description oc JL moeoa prvtems under the name ~ Der kkine Procens.~ in 1755. represents the irst recorded observa- tion ot a. fresh-water protoanon. of the group Sarcodma. In 1&55 Dnjardin called die vsori. transparent ^nhwfanre am- poang the bodies of marine Protozoa, which he then had vader observation, sarcode. but it was not unci 138-5 that Bntschil arst employed me term Saruxtina, and included under it ail forms at Protozoa which move fay means ot pnstrnsiaos oc prornpfcwm from Ma& a£ the SaroxSna. are verv rrrrrnire in aae~ Verv few or them can. be yen by trie Tnairffrf eye and acne can be sndied with any degree at ^nrearrion without the aid or a, compound mkrosaipe- Tbese forms vary greatly in general appearance. Marry *j£ them are naked masee* of arntapiasn ivrtdirfy to be gfflimiar when tmft placed uuder the microscope bur «on assume mg variable shape* pintjrufmg: from the body, with more Respiration in the Sarcodina is performed by an interchange of gases through the body wall. Oxygen is received from the sur- rounding water and carbon dioxid transmitted to it by osmosis. The symbiotic relationship between algae and some forms of Sar- codina, without doubt, has an important respiratory as well as nutritive function, the plants furnishing oxygen and carbohydrates to the animals, while the latter supply carbon dioxid and nitroge- nous waste for the algae. Reproduction in the Sarcodina takes place either by the division of the body into two parts, a process commonly called fission; by the separation from the parent of one or more small masses of protoplasm known as buds; or by the production of swarm spores. In fission, or simple cell division, which is common among fresh- water forms, the nucleus divides first and this is followed by the separation of the cytoplasm into two parts, each of which encloses a portion of the original nucleus. Growth proceeds until maturity is reached, when the process of division is repeated. When an envelop is present the enclosed body may divide by fission after which one portion creeps out at the aperture and con- structs a new shell about itself. If the envelop be chitin and with- out distinct elements it is gradually developed at the periphery of the newly separated individual, but if it be of regular chitinous or siliceous plates, these elements, in some cases at least, are de- veloped in the cytoplasm of the parent and pushed out to form the new envelop of the separating bud. That the nucleus is concerned with cell division has long been known. Recent observations, however, have thrown light upon the presence of extranuclear material scattered throughout the cytoplasm in many Sarcodina as well as other protozoa. This material has the form of minute granules termed ''idiochromidia" ' %.' %&&£L*^i AMOEBOID PROTOZOA (SARCODINA) 217 and results from the transfusion of part of the chromatin through the nuclear membrane or from the breaking up of the nucleus into small granular bodies which become diffused through the cyto- plasm. In some Sarcodina a number of buds may separate from the parent, each enclosing a quantity of idiochromidia which is built into a nucleus. This extranuclear material apparently has a functional value in reproduction and may be compared to the micronuclei of Infusoria. During the quiescent state of encyst- ment the bodies of many Sarcodina break into swarm spores. These are minute organisms each with a portion of the parent nucleus and provided with flagella or pseudopodia as motile organs. The swarm spores may fuse with each other and develop into an adult form or, in some cases, they may develop without fusion. Conjugation, in the form of a temporary union or a permanent fusion of the bodies of two individuals of the same species, has been observed in some Sarcodina. After temporary union and separation, in a few cases, swarm spores have been observed to be developed from both conjugants. In most of the instances of permanent conjugation reported there is no clear evidence that the fusion resulted in a union of the nuclei of the individuals, as is the case in true conjugation. Actual fusion of the nuclei, however, has been observed in the common "sun animalcule," Actinopkrys sol. Here two individuals come together, fuse, and become encysted. Nuclear changes take place which follow in a general way the processes of maturation and fertilization after which mitotic division results in the formation of daughter cells. Many kinds of Sarcodina are exceedingly abundant and collect- ing them is not a difficult matter. Other forms are rare and only occasionally obtained. Everywhere among wet mosses and in sphagnous swamps many fine examples of shell-bearing species will be found, some inhabiting no other localities. Some prefer dear, fresh water, while others thrive in stagnant ponds and ditches. By carefully collecting submerged decaying vegetation from shal- low water and allowing it to stand in the laboratory for a few days many of the Amoeba and Diffiugia types are usually found. 2l8 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The ooze at the bottom of ponds or lakes is the habitat of nu- merous shell-bearing as well as naked forms. Others, like the Heliozoa, are commonly found among algae, diatoms, or mosses and may be collected with these plants. Inactive or encysted forms gathered during cold seasons of the year will become active on being placed in a warm laboratory. Shallow aquaria are best adapted for preserving quantities of living Sarcodina. For those species which require it, the water may be kept fresh by algae or other aquatic plants, but for many forms the water may be allowed to become stagnant, replenishing it only as evaporation takes place. The Sarcodina may be studied with a considerable degree of satis- faction, as it is possible to keep them under observation for an in- definite time, owing to their slow movements. For detailed study a good compound microscope including an oil immersion lens is necessary. Concave microscopic slides on which living forms may be isolated and retained for extended observation are useful. Methylenblue, used as an intravitam stain, is successful in render- ing the nuclear elements visible, especially in species without shells or with transparent envelopes. When permanent mounts are desired the following method, rec- ommended by Benedict in the Journal of Applied Microscopy, Vol. VI, p. 2647, may t>e employed: "Smear a glass slide with albumen fixative, as in preparing for the mounting of paraffin sec- tions. Then place on the surface of the film of fixative a drop or two of water containing the forms which it is desired to stain. Let nearly all the water evaporate by exposure to the air of the room until only the film of fixative remains moist. The slide can now be immersed in Gilson's or any other fixing reagent and then passed through the alcohols, stains, etc., in the same way that mounted sections are handled." • The above method is recommended for other Protozoa as well as for Sarcodina. As a rapid fixing agent, the fumes of osmic acid have been found satisfactory. By careful manipulation of fine dissecting needles under the microscope, the shells of many forms may be isolated, arranged as desired and, when dried on the slide, permanently mounted in balsam. AMOEBOID PROTOZOA (SARCODINA) 219 KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER SARCODINA 1 (161) Pseudopodia without axial filaments. . . Class Rhizopoda . . a 2 (144) Pseudopodia lobose, sometimes pointed but never anastomosing. Subclass Amoebea . . 3 3 (21) Without shells Order Gymnamoebida . . 4 4 One family recognized. Characteristics of the order. Family Amoebidae . . 5 5 (6) Body and pseudopodia bristling with minute spicules. Dinamoeba Leidy. Representative species Dinamoeba mirabUis Leidy 1874. Very changeable in shape with many tapering pseudo- podia. Papillae-like projections often appearing at the pos- terior extremity. Entire body sometimes surrounded by a jelly-like envelop. A contractile vacuole and two nuclei present. Habitat standing water. Size may reach 200 /*, including pseudopodia. Fig. 274. Dinamoeba mirabUis. x 100. (After Leidy.) 6(5) Body smooth, without spicules 7 7 (8) Body usually enclosing symbiotic bacteria. Large size. Nuclei many. Pelomyxa Greeff. Representative species Pdomyxa palustris Greeff 1870. A very large form moving slowly by broad extensions of the ectoplasm. Endoplasm enclosing sand, brilliant corpuscles and bacteria; with numerous vacuoles in the ecto- plasm. Nuclei may number 1000 or more. Habitat ooze of ponds and sphagnous swamps. Maximum length 2000 m- P. carolinensis Wilson, described in American Naturalist, Vol. 34, p. 535, is apparently without symbiotic bacteria. Fig. 275. Pdomyxa palustris. X 25. (After Pcnard.) 8 (7) Body not enclosing symbiotic bacteria 9 9 (10) Ectoplasmic membranes produced between the pseudopodia. Hyalodiscus Hertwig and Lesser. Representative species. . . . Hyalodiscus rubicundus H. and L. 1874. Body discoidal, moving by extending thin sheets of ecto- plasm which are penetrated by ray-like pseudopodia. En- doplasm reddish-yellow in color enclosing numerous vacuoles and one or more nuclei. Habitat ooze of ponds, not common. Size 40 to 60 m* Fie. 276. Hyalodiscus rubicundus. X 315. (After Penard.) to (9) Ectoplasmic membranes not produced between the pseudopodia. Amoeba Ehrenberg . . 11 *i (14) Pseudopodia sharply distinguished from the body 12 12 (13) Pseudopodia lobe-like Amoeba proteus Leidy 1878. Very changeable in form, usually with numerous pseudo- podia. The nucleus is always single, oval and of large size. Contractile vacuoles one or more. Habitat both stagnant and clear water. Size, one of the largest species of the genus; may reach 300 m or more when extended. Fig. 277. Amoeba proteus. X 100. (Original from a preparation.) 220 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 13 (12) Pseudopodia ray-like Amoeba radiosa Ehrenberg 1830. Body spherical, with pseudopodia more or less rigid, not withdrawn and reformed rapidly. Nucleus spherical. Habitat, very common among algae; widely distributed. Size, usually less than 100 n with pseudopodia extended. Fig. 278. Amoeba radiosa. cv, contractile vacuole. X 100. (After Leidy.) Pseudopodia not sharply distinguished from the body 15 Contractile vacuole spherical 16 Posterior extremity villous Amoeba Umax Dujardin 1841. Slug-like, usually moving with the broad end forward. Pi- " . _ .. . 14 (11) 15 (20) 16 (17) 17 (16) 18 (19) Endo- plasm filled with brilliant granules. Contractile vacuole usually single. Nucleus changeable in form. Habitat ooze of ponds. Size, large individuals usually less than 100 ji. Fig. 279. Amoeba Umax, x 225. (After Penard.) Posterior extremity not villous 19 Surface wrinkled, large size. . . Amoeba verrucosa Ehrenberg 1838. A sluggish species, moving by a slow rolling motion. Pseudo- podia short, broad lobes. Body proper enclosed by a delicate membrane. Surface marked by lines crossing each other re- sulting in a wrinkled appearance. Habitat sphagnous swamps. Large individuals may reach 300 n in length when extended. Fig. 280. Amoeba verrucosa. X 100 (After Leidy.) 19 (18) Surface not wrinkled, small size. . . Amoeba guttula Dujardin 1841. Body usually oval in outline, moving with the broad end forward. Pseudopodia short, broad lobes produced by sudden expansions of the protoplasm. Nucleus single and one large contractile vacuole. Habitat stagnant water. Size 30 m- Fig. 281. Amoeba guttula. X 400. (After Penard.) Contractile vacuole not spherical. . . . Amoeba striata Penard 1890. Moving rapidly by broad extensions of ectoplasm but not changing form rapidly. Usually from two to four longitudinal lines on the surface. Two contractile vacuoles often present, the anterior one changeable in shape. Habitat among algae; not abundant. Size, from 30 to 60 m. Fig. 282. Amoeba striata. X 250. (After Penard.) 21 (3) With shells Order Testacea . . 22 22 (103) Pseudopodia thick, finger-like, rarely filiform. Family Arceludae . . 23 23 (96) Pseudopodia thick, sometimes pointed 24 24 (35) Shell membranous, more or less flexible 25 25 (32) Membrane covered with organic or foreign particles 26 26 (29) Shell membrane double Diplochlamys Greeff . . 27 27 (28) Hemispherical to cup-shaped, loosely coated with organic and siliceous particles Diplochlamys fragilis Penard 1909. 20 (15) Color gray, spotted with black. Inner membrane very fragile but capable of distention. Nuclei usually from 30 to 4a Vacuoles numerous. Habitat mosses. Penard. Pseudopodia short and thick. Diameter 70 to 125 «• Not common. Reported from Ontario by Dr. Fio. 283. Dipiocklamyt Jragilu. x 150. (After Penard.) AMOEBOID PROTOZOA (SARCODINA) 221 28 (27) Hemispherical to cup-shaped, densely coaled with organic particles. Diplocklamys iimida Penard 1909. YeUowisb-gray or brown. Inner membrane very delicate, flexible but resstant. Nucleus single. Vacuoles numerous. Pseudopodia ^TTcT*f;:\ large at the base, pointed, rarely extended. Diameter 45 $i~ Habitat \>si&*3 monod. Reported from Ontario by Dr. Penard. Fig. 2b4. DtpUcUamys iimida X 275. (After Penard ) 29 (26) Shell membrane single 30 30 (31) Hemispherical; slightly or not at all flexible . Parmulina Penard. Representative species Parmulina cyathus Penard 1902. In this species the shell is rigid but in P. obiecia Gruber it is flexible Ler'.v about the aperture. Shell is coated with hue particles of sand. dirt, et c. Pseudopodia are broad, rounded lobes extending from the aperture. *!*V~J;7^F Nucleus and contractile vacuole each single. Habitat among mosses. \C^r Diameter 45 M Fig. 285 Parmulina cyalku,. x 275 (After Penard.) 31 (30) Commonly ovoid or hemispherical, but very changeable. Carycia Dujardin. Representative species Carycia flava Greeff 1866. The membranous covering is dome-shaped but very changeable in 0-^_ form. Pseudopodia very short and thick. Vacuoles numerous, '.'o « Nucleus single, usually concealed by the granules of the eudopiasm. ■O'.'-.M' Habitat among mosses. Diameter bo to 100 u ric. 256 Corycia jiaia x 210 (After Penard.) 32(25) Membrane without foreign particles; regularly punctate. 33 33 (34) Patelliform; slightly flexible Microchlamys Cockerell. Representative species. Microchlamys patella Claparede and Lachmann i860. Shell circular from dorsal or ventral view convex above with a very large aperture beneath. Pseudopodium single. Contractile vacuoles numerous. Nucleus single. Habitat among momes in swaxnpb. Diameter 40 m- Ho. 2^7. Aiicroduamyi patelia. x 310. (After Penard.) 34 {33) Commonly dome-shaped, but exceedingly flexible and changeable. Cochliopodium Hertwig and Lesser. Representative species. . Cochliopodium bilimbosum Auerbach 1856. *\ The membranous covering is capable of great expansion, especially at 'S?&& the aperture. Pseudopodia pointed, usually numerous. Nucleus and contractile vacuole each single and large. Common among algae. t ^ Diameter of envelop 25 to 50 M- TJ^* *,u 2*& LochUopodimm biUmbomm. «. nucleus. X 300. (After Leidy. > 35 (24) Shell membranous, rigid 36 36 (45) Shell discoidal 37 37 (44) Shell with regular markings more or less distinct. No foreign par- ticles attached. Aperture central 38 jr- 38 (43) Shell with regular, distinct punctae. Aperture small. Arcdla_EtatDbcTg . . 39 59 (42) Periphery of shell without projecting point* 40 222 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 40 (41) Shell strongly convex Arcdla vulgaris Ehrenberg 1830. Shell may be smooth or with regular undu- lations. Protoplasm united to the inside of the ., shell by delicate threads. Pseudopodia long, ')','^*\ ,:'_Ja straight and very transparent. Contractile S§H 3- ijfl vacuoles numerous. Nuclei two, opposite in ""i.^sT1?'-' af/ position. This species shows great variation in • and lorm. Very common in pond water, .meter So to 140*. .189. Arctllamltorii. Lateral and inlerior views jl the same individual. X 1 so. (Alter Lady.) 41 (40) Shell very flat Arcdla discoides Ehrenberg 1843. Shell smooth, regularly punctate, with a large circular aperture. It ^^sS2£"9aw. k B ^y species, the pseudopodia seldom being observed. Contractile ^f!£3**jT?^^^ vacuoles numerous. Nuclei two. Common in pond water. Diameter Fig. 290. Arcdla diicoidei- X 175- (Alter Penard.) 41 (39) Shell periphery with projecting points. Arcdla denlata Ehrenberg 1830. When viewed laterally the shell has the appearance of a Crown, , . ,,' the teeth-like points being produced from the base of the low Q ■.) ( dome. Nuclei two; contractile vacuoles numerous. Habitat 1 " bogs and swamps. A rare species. Diameter 13] to 184(1. la dniaia Lateral and inlerior views at the same indi- vidual, x 100. (After Leidy.) 43 (38) Shell with punctae sometimes indistinct. Aperture very wide. Pyxtdicula Ehrenberg. Representative species Pyxtdicula cymbalum Penard 190s. Shell patellilorm, brown In color, with distinct punctae. Aper- ture round, nearly as wide as the diameter of the shell, bordered by a narrow rim. Contractile vacuole single. Nuclei probably two. Pseudopodia not observed in this species. Identified by F10. soi. Pyiidicda cym- Penard in material from Summit Lake, Colorado. The only spe- Wasv xra (After riesof thegenus thus farreported from North America. Diameter p™nU 8j to go p. Habitat mosses. •u. 44 (37) Shell without regular markings, but with foreign particles attached. Aperture eccentric Centropyxis Stein. Representative species Centropyxis acukata Stein 18.C.7. || j* Shell compressed laterally, resulting in both mouth and fundus being eccentric Color some shade of brown. Slender spines \^* usually developed from the fundus. Nucleus single; contractile vacuoles two or more. The species is very shy, sometimes ex- tending a single large pseudopodium. A common species among algae. Diameter 88 to 360 p. Fie. 193. CaUnpyxii taiUaU. X 150. {After Leidy.) 45 (3fi) Shell not discoidal 46 46 (51) Shell spiral, compressed, largely composed of minute, curved, rod- like plates Lecquereusia Schlumbergei . . 47 47 (48) Shell primarily of sand grains, few plates. Lecquereusia modesla Rhumbler 1845. ... , l>^.,. This species has a short, broad neck, slightly turned to one side. r-/y£gffj* Nucleus single. Pseudopodia few, large and long. Found among i~-,^v; .. >^-,J .- mips. Length from taj to 150 ». lata. Xi«. (After Penard.) ■-•a* '■ AMOEBOID PROTOZOA (SARCODINA) 33j 48 (47) Shell of rod-like plates. 49 49(50) Plates slender, elongate. . . Ltcquereusia spiralis Ehrenbcrg 1840. The neck in this specie) is prominent and turned sharply to c side. The siliceous plates are cemented very closely to- ....!,! .-... 1 ...j j! ametlnwa gether, forming the shell. Rand and diatoms may at be incorporated with the plates. I'seudopodia few, it large. Habitat sphagnous swamps, Length 115 tt F10. 19s. £«fiu™u>s spiralis, x it], {Alter Penan). ) 50 (40) Plates thick, short Lecquercusia episiomium Pcnard 180,1, In this species the neck is very sharply distinguished from the rounded shell and very abruptly turned tu one side. The shell Is clear, without foreign particles attached. Habitat sphagnoui swamps, Fia.996. UcqucrnuiatpisUimium. x ijo. (Alter Padard.) 51 (46) Shell not spiral 51 51 (57) Shell chitinous, transparent, structureless, with no foreign particles or formed elements attached. . . Hyalospfunia Stem . , 53 53 (54) Surface of shell with undulations. . Hyalosphcnia elegans Leidy 1874. The shell is flask-shaped, compressed, brownish In color, transparent. Two minute pores, opposite each other, are In /'"©■"'&■■■ I 1 the base of the neck. Protoplasm colorless. Nucleus single. \ ■' llVl ' Pseudopodia lew. Common in sphagnous swamps. Length from 90 to 100 n. Fio. J97. Byalcspklnia ftttaiu. x ijo- (Alter FlttnL) 54 (53) Surface of shell without undulations 55 55 (56) With pores through the fundus. . Hyalosphenia papilio Leidy 1875. Shell ovoid or pyriform, compressed, yellowish In color. Slight variation in size, shape and constitution shown in this species. Pro- toplasm not filling the shell but attached to the inner surface by pro- toplasmic processes. Endoplasm always containing chloropflyl. Pseudopodia often numerous. From two to six small pores about the border of the fundus. Common in sphagnous swamps. Length 1 .- , Fie. 198. Hyaloipknia pafilit. X 100. (Alter Leidy.) 50(55) Without pores through the fundus. . HyalospfuniaeuwatcStaniUsy, Shell exceedingly transparent and greatly compresaol. ' r, often hut one. Habitat Fsc 199. ByUtptmif to be dear water. A fare species. Length IS* Xjeo. (After UMy.) 57 (32) Shell chitinous, more or less densely covered with foreign particle* or formed elements. 58 58 (75) ShdJ primarily of foreign partkieav. . 224 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY ^- 59 (7z) Shell without internal partition or diaphragm. Difflugia Leclerc . . 60 60(61) Aperture not central Difflugia conslrkta Ehrenberg 1841. ^& Shells of various forms from nearly spherical to oval and don- jpisSBHfl gate. Aperture always eccentric Pseudopodium single, rarely ^&~y-^sV- observed. Spines sometimes developed from the fundus- This _j2gjrouao' species is closely related to Cenlropyxis aculeata. A common . species, widely distributed. Large forms may reach aoo h in Fia 30a Difupa iwMtt length. Most individuals are very much smaller. 61 (60) Aperture central 6a 6a (6g) Shell typically spherical 63 63 (66) Margin of aperture smooth 64 64 (65) Neck deeply constricted; aperture small, with margin always re- curved Difflugia urceolata Carter 1864. This species is without spines, but a variety, D. wceetott var. alia, may possess a few short stubby spines developed from the fundus. The protoplasm does not fill the shell. Pseudopodia numerous; nuclei many. Found in the ooze of pond water. Large forms reach a length of 350 a, Fio. 301. Difiofia laudato. X vs. (After Leidy.) 65 (64) Neck, when present, not deeply constricted; aperture wide, with margin seldom recurved. . . . Difflugia kbes Penard 1893. ,Vj.; ■" ■» In many respects this species resembles the preceding one. f*Tft/^,1:Ya "" ,n'n' recurve(l collar is sometimes present but the aperture is much larger. The shell is very fragile. Nuclei sometimes more jBYfifErtRrt than 100. Found in ooze at the bottom of ponds, lakes, etc VJVy , ., '-.-/i'' Very large, some reaching 400 p in length. Fig. soi. Difufia Ida. X to. (After Penard.) 66 (63) Margin of aperture not smooth 67 67 (68) Margin with numerous teeth. . . . Difflugia corona Wallich 1864. Shell composed of large sand grains but very smooth and regular in outline. Teeth usually more than twelve in number, very evenly arranged. Nucleus single. Pseudopodia numerous and large. From six to nine spines usually developed from the fundus. A very common species in ooze of ponds. Length, with spines. 100 to 150 ». Fro. joj. Diffuria bijm Oral view. X 00. (Alter Leidy.) 68 (67) Margin with few blunt lobes. . . . Difflugia iobostoma Leidy 1S74. Shell ovoid or nearly spherical, usually with a quadrilobate aper- ture- However, the lobes are somewhat irregular, a trilobate aperture sometimes appearing. Pseudopodia few. Found among algae and in the ooze of ponds: common. Avenge length 150 «. Fio. 304. Dffutit Mmmw*. Oral view. X 105. (After Rdmondmn.) 69 (6a) Shell never spherical 70 AMOEBOID PROTOZOA (SARCODIXA) 2^ 70 (71) PyuftnuL with posterior border usually rounded. Diffiugia pyriformis Perty 1552. This very common species is exceedingly variable in farm Add Penard recognises six varieties* van domic DHkwgm tyrifi X 60. (After Lair. ) reaching a length of 450 *. The posterior border is usually rounded but some forms may approach the acuminate type. Found everywhere in the ooae at ponds and lakes. 71 (70) Elongate, cylindrical with posterior border acuminate. Difflugia jcuminata Ehrenberg 1S50. SheQ cylindrical, the slightly broader posterior extremity taper- ing to an acute point ending in a knob-like process. Very widely distributed with other species of the genus. Large forms may reach a length of 275 n. Frc. 306. Difimiia wwnti x us. After Leady.; 72 (59) Shell with internal partition or diaphragm. 73 73 (74) Shell with deeply constricted neck and transverse, perforated parti- tion at the point of constriction. . Pontipdasia Rhumbier. Representative species. . . . Pontiguiasia spcctabilis Penard 1002. 74 (73) Resembling Dijflugia pyriformis in appearance, except for the deeply constricted neck. The internal partition has one round opening and one or two other apertures, the latter being dosed by transparent opercula. Pxudopodia few. bug, and move rapidly. Found with species of DijHuqui. Average length 150 >*. Fee. 307. Ptmtigmiasia sptciabilis. x too. After Penard.) Shell with a short neck: aperture partially closed by a transverse diaphragm . Cucwrbitdla Penard. ive species. . . CucurbitdU mespUiformis Penard 1902. The neck is quadrilobate wfth an undulating margin. On the inside of the neck is a transverse peristome covered with sand grains, resulting in the rounded aperture being much smaller than the diameter of the neck itself. Pxudopodia numerous, straight. Found at the bottom of ponds and lakes. Length from 125 to mo *. Fsc. jofl. C if ■■•/« x tas. U ) 75 (58) Shell primarily of formed elements. 76 76 (81) Shell not compressed, of small siliceous particles* aperture lunate with inferior and superior lips. 77 77 (78) Shell hemispherical or elliptical superior lip with pores. Large size. BulUmda Penard. Bullimda indica Penard 1907. SheO brownish, of small «Bceous plates, dosefy rrmmred to- ber. Superior np slightly overlapping the inferior lip* Nudei numerous. Diameter igo to 200 *. Habitat Fbj. 309. x 110. After Peaacd.) 78 (77) Shell hemispherical, superior lip without pores. Small size. PUgi&pyxis Penard 79 226 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 79 (80) Inferior lip rounded, dipping far into the interior of the shell. Plagiopyxis collide Penard 19 10. r" Fig. 310. Plagiopyxis caUida. X 150. (After WaOes and Penard.) 80 (79) Inferior lip triangular, slightly dipping into the interior of the shell. Plagiopyxis labiata Penard 191 1. -'VCvX Brown in color. Smaller than the preceding species. Nucleus sin- ■* \ f .^i gle- Pseudopodia not observed by Dr. Penard, who reports the species ' ' V? from Australia and Vancouver, B. C. Diameter 80 to 88 m- Fig. 311. Plagiopyxis labiala. x 155. (After Penard.) 81 (76) Shell more or less compressed; aperture not lunate 82 82 (83) Plates quadrangular Quadruldla Cockerell. Representative species. . Quadruldla symmetrica F. E. Schultze 1875. In this species the shell is normally pyriform, one variety 3 being short and another long. The plates are very transparent, r usually regularly arranged in transverse and longitudinal series. r* whv Pseudopodia few. Common in sphagnous swamps. Length rr ^,MM from 80 to 140 m- Fig. 31a. Quadruldla symmetrica, cv, contractile vacuole. X 175. (After Lekiy.) 83 (82) Plates not quadrangular 84 84 (91) Shell pyriform, sometimes ovoid or rounded, compressed with round, oval, or irregular plates Nebela Leidy . . 85 85 (88) Shell pyriform 86 86 (87) Neck long, narrow; plates round. . Nebela lageniformis Penard 1890. Body of shell oval, prolonged as a tubular neck. There are no lateral pores through the shell as in some species. The plates are round and very clear. Pseudopodia few. Found commonly JKVXSI among mosses; very abundant in some localities. Length 125/1- Fig. 3x3. Nebela lageniformis. X 175. (After Penard.) 87 (86) Neck short; plates round or oval. . . . Nebela collaris Leidy 1879. In this species, large, round, and oval plates are usually inter- ^cy ^?dpy« mingled. Sometimes foreign elements enter into the composition °^-^&^J3^sS °* shell. It is a very common species, found abundantly in sphagnous swamps and presents many variations in size and form. Large individuals average about 120*1. Fig. 314. Nebela collaris. X 150. (After Leidy.) 88 (85) Shell not pyriform 89 89 (90) Shell rounded, border of aperture smooth. Nebela flabeUum Leidy 1874. The transverse diameter usually equals or exceeds the length, but apparently transitional forms between this species and the preceding one are sometimes observed. Possibly this is but a variety of Nebela collaris. The plates are similar in the two species. Habitat sphagnous swamps. Length 50 to 100 m- Fw.315. Nebela JUbetlmm. x 150. (After Leidy.) AMOEBOID PROTOZOA (SARCODINA) **) 90 (89) Shdl ovoid; border of aperture crenul&te* sbeD is very clour with round or oval plaits the ArftMMMWMM . PktytatudU mUmUu. X ee (After PeaaM,) 228 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 99 (98) Small size; foreign elements small. Phryganella hemisphaerica Penard 1890. Shell hemispherical, composed of small diatom shells and sand grains. Pseudopodia usually slender, some- times thick. Found in the ooze of ponds and lakes. Diameter 40 to 55 u. m Fig. 321. Phryganella hemisphaerica. x 250. (After Penard.) Shell chitinous, without or sparsely covered with foreign ele- ments 101 Shell occasionally with foreign elements attached. Aperture ter- minal Cryptodifflugia Penard. Representative species. . . Cryptodifflugia aviformis Penard 1890. This species has a transparent, yellowish or brownish shell without foreign elements attached. Ovoid in form. The protoplasm does not fill the shell and pseudopodia are seldom extended. Found in marshes. Length u6 to 20 u. Fig. 323. Cryptodifflugia oviformis. X 450. (After Penard.) IOO (97) 101 (102) 102 (101) Shell without foreign elements. Aperture terminal or subterminal. Platoum F. E. Schultze. In 1875 Schultze described a form under the name Platoum parvum. Ovoid with smooth envelop without structure, slightly elastic, aper- ture terminal or subterminal. Penard, more recently, observed numerous empty shells and inactive organisms which he provision- ally refers to this genus. Some had undulating envelopes with apertures terminal or directed obliquely. Nucleus and contractile vacuole each single. Pseudopodia not observed. Length 16 to 21/1. In preserved material from Alaska, G. H. Wailes found forms which he considers within this genus, probably P. parvum. Thus far this is the only record of the genus in North America. 103 (22) Pseudopodia delicate, filiform, usually branched, and pointed. Family Euglyphtdae . . 104 Fio. 323. Platoum parvum X 725- (After Penard.) 104 (107) 105 (106) Shell flexible, transparent Pamphagus Bailey ios Shell spherical Pamphagus hyalinus Ehrenberg 1838. The aperture of the shell is very large and capable of great dilation. Protoplasm is clear, colorless. Nucleus spherical; contractile vacuole single. Pseudopodia numerous, straight, and pointed. Found in clear water. Diameter of shell 30 to 48 u. Fio. 324. Pamphagus hyalinus. cv. contractile vacuole. (After Leidy.) Xaoo. 106 (105) Shell ovoid or elongate. Pamphagus mutabilis Bailey 1853. Body very changeable in form. Protoplasm enclosing brilliant granules. Nucleus large, spherical. Contractile vacuoles, one or two. Found in clear water. Length of shell 50 to 70 m. Fio. 325. Pamphagus mutabilis. X 165. (After Penard.) 107 (104) Shell rigid 108 xo8 (113) Shell retort-shaped. 109 AMOEBOID PROTOZOA (SARCODINA) 229 io9 (110) Plates small, round, more or less covered by foreign particles. Campascus Leidy. Representative species Campascus cornutus Leidy 1877. This species has lateral processes developed from the fundus. In common with other species of the genus, a delicate, transpar- ent collar surrounds the aperture, extending perpendicular to it. In common with the genus Cyphoderia, the bodies of all species of this genus enclose minute yellow or brown granules very re- sistant to reagents. Apparently a very rare species. Leidy re- ports it from but one locality, China Lake, Wyoming, at an altitude of 10,000 feet. Length 112 to 140 u. Fig. 326. Campascus cornutus. cv, contractile vacuole. X 150. (After Leidy.) 1 10 (i°Q) Plates small, regular, not covered by foreign particles. Cyphoderia Schlumberger in 111 (1*2) Fundus rounded or mamillate. Cyphoderia ampulla Ehrenberg 1840. Plates round or oval, cemented together in diagonal rows, E resenting a hexagonal appearance. The plates do not over- ip. Minute perforations exist between the plates, appearing ' as fine punctae. Pseudopodia few but very long. Found among mosses, ooze of ponds and lakes. Length 6x to 195 m. . , ^ , ^. Several varieties of this species are known. v* Fie 327. Cyphoderia ampulla, cv, contractile vacuole. X 160. (After Leidy.) 112 (in) Fundus tapering. . Cyphoderia ampulla var. papillata Wailes 191 1. This variety resembles the type species except in the shape of the fundus. The plates are sometimes set very close together in this variety but do not overlap. Found in ooze of lakes. Length 1 13 to 135 m. Fig. 328. Cyphoderia ampulla var. papillata. X150. (From a prepared mount.) "3 (108) Shell straight 114 XI4 (115) Shell without distinct plates, chitinous, covered with sand, dirt, etc Pseudodifflugia Schlumberger. Representative species. v \ Pseudodifflugia gracilis Schlumberger 1845. ^'^^JTllJiJlltWJ. -^ Shell ovoid, elongate, usually yellowish or brownish. Pseudo- podia numerous, very long and delicate. Found in the ooze of z. ---^c^ggyQy rgJEflfr» ponds, lakes, etc. Length 20 to 65 m« / ™]y Fig. 329. Pseudodifflugia gracilis, n, nucleus. X 250. (After Leidy.) 1IS(ii4) Shell with distinct plates 116 I!6 (119) Shell not compressed, with a short flattened neck. Plates round or oval Sphenoderia Schlumberger . . 117 x*7 (118) Margin of neck dentate. Sphenoderia dentata Penard 1890. This species may be known by the elongate-oval form of the shell and the presence of the teeth. The plates overlap, giving the appearance of a hexagonal design. Found among sphagnum. Length 35 to 50 u. Fio. 330. Sphenoderia dentata. X 310. (After Ptnard.) 230 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 118(117) Margin of neck not dentate. Sphenoderia lenta Schlumberger 1845. j*/^^ Shell ovoid or rounded with large, round imbricating plates. The aper- «f^#lRSV ture consists of a narrow, elongated opening, extending between two lateral points opposite each other. Pseudopodia are numerous and very long. Habitat sphagnum. Length from 35 to 50 m- Leidy describes a species rer under the name S. macroUpis, differing from other species by the angular plates composing the shell. Habitat sphagnum. Length 24 to 39 p. ^* Fig. 331. Sphenoderia lenta. cv, contractile vacuole. X 300. (After Leidy.) 119 (116) Shell compressed, without a neck 120 120 (137) Aperture terminal 121 121 (136) Margin of aperture dentate 122 122(125) Plates elongate-elliptical; margin of aperture finely dentate. Assidina Ehrenberg . . 123 123(124) Large size, rounded. . . . A ssulina seminulum Ehrenberg 1848. v-»«RC25»V Adult forms of this species are chocolate brown in color. Con- tractile vacuole single. Nucleus very large, elliptical. Pseudopodia seldom observed. Common in sphagnous swamps. Length 60 to 88 m. Fig. 332 A ssulina seminulum. cv. contractile vacuole. X 290. (After Leidy.) 124 (123) 125 (122) 126 (133) 127 (130) 128 (129) 129 (l28) I30 (127) Small size, oval Assidina minor Penard 1890. This species is also brown in color but clearer than the preceding one and the aperture is more regularly crenulate. The hexagonal design formed by the imbricating plates is very symmetrical. Found among mosses. Length 35 u. Fig. 333. A ssulina minor. X 300. (After Penard.) Plates round or oval; margin of aperture with prominent denticles. Spines often developed. . . . Euglypha Dujardin . . 1 26 Aperture circular 127 Spines at apex only 128 Spines, one or two Euglypha mucronata Leidy 1878. The shell not compressed; plates imbricating, arranged in longitudinal, alternating rows. The fundus tapers to a point which is provided with one or two spines. Found in sphagnous swamps. Reported from North America only. Length 108 to 140 ». Fio. 334- Euglypha mucronata. X 165. (After Leidy.) Spines in a tuft Euglypha cristate Leidy 1874. Shell elongated, very little compressed if any, with plates arranged as in preceding species. Pseudopodia rarely extended. Habitat sphagnous swamps. Length 33 to 84 m- Fic. 335. Euglypha enstata. X 425. (Alter Leidy.) Spines not at apex only 131 AMOEBOID PROTOZOA (SARCODINA) «I 133 (126) 134 (i35) 131 (13a) Spines lateral. Euglypka brackiata Leidy 1878. Thb species may be known by the straight shell, elongate and cylindrical. Plates oval, imbricating in a regular manner. From four to six large, long spines are developed, representing prolongations of some of the lateral plates. Habitat among sphagnum. Length 104 to 128 *. Fie. 336. Euglypka braduata, x 180. (Alter Lady ) 132 (131) Spines usually absent, scattered when present. Euglypka alvcolata Dujardin 1841. Shell ovoid, elongated, very slightly compressed if any. Plates round or oval, imbricating, presenting a regular hexagonal design. Nucleus large, spherical; contractile vacuoles two in number. Pseudopodia numerous, long and straight. A common species in the ooze of ponds, among algae and mosses. Length 45 to 100 *. Fie. 337. Euglypka aheolata. x 375- (Original, from a prepared mount.) Aperture oval * 134 Plates bordering aperture denticulate. Euglypka ciliata Ehrenberg 1848. Shell compressed, elongate-ovaL Plates oval or round, imbricated. Needle-like spines are produced from the entire surface or in a line around the lateral border of the shell. Habitat sphagnum. Length 40 to 00 u. Fig. 338. Eugiypha ciliata. X 250. (After Penard.) 135 (*34) Plates bordering aperture lobed. Euglypka compressa Carter 1864. Shell greatly compressed, formed of elliptical plates, imbricating and presenting a hexagonal design. Numerous spines, fusiform in shape, are produced from the lateral border of the shell. Habitat sphagnum. Length 70 to 132 m- Fie. 339. Eugiypha compressa. X 225. (After Leidy.) 136 (121) Margin of aperture not dentate. Shell oval, compressed. Placocista Leidy. Representative species Placocista spinosa Leidy 1874. This species may be known by the long, awl-shaped spines which are movably articulated in a tine about the lateral border of the shell. Plates oval, imbricating in a regular manner. Habi- tat sphagnum. Length 100 to 136 m- Fig. 340. Placocista spinosa. X 170. (After Leidy.) 137 (120) 138 (143) Aperture not terminal 138 Shell elongate-oval, usually compressed; aperture subterminal. Plates rounded Trinema Dujardin . . 139 139 (140) Oral extremity broad. Trinema camplanatum Penard 1890. This species is short and broad, the anterior end usually as broad as the posterior extremity. Aperture oval. Habitat mosses. Length 30 to 40 M- Fig. 341. Trinema camplanatum. X 50a (After Penard.) 140 (139) Oral extremity narrow 141 2J2 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 141 (142) Plata distinct, large size. . . . Trinema endutys Ehienberg 1836. The aperture is circular in this species mad surrounded by a num- ber at rows of very raiaute di'"" " ud long, usually few in numl of the genus and is found everywhere among rr Phj. 341. rww wswyi. X jio. {After F 2(141) Plates indistinct, small size. . . . Trinema lineare Penard 1890. where they may appear as minute unci illations. The aperture is round. Habitat a* other species. Length 16 to ao * 143 (138) Shell shaped as Trinema; aperture subtenninal; plates elongate. Corylhicn Taianek. Representative species Corythion dubium Taranek 1S82. ■ In this species the shape of the aperture is characteristic, its border rep- ^a^Bi^b resenting two unequal arcs placed together, the ulterior one the longer. ^■^B^™*^ -j^j pia^j „B ffac together but not overlapping. Habitat mosses. Length 35 to 40 b. Fig. 3ii. Cerytium inbixm. *. jjj- (After Penard-) 144 (2) Pseudopodia usually anastomosing 145 145 (158) Pseudopodia very delicate, usually finely branched. Subclass Fonuninifera . . 146 146 (147) Body without a covering; pseudopodia formed from any part of the surface Biomyxa Leidy. Representative species Biomyxa vagam Leidy 1875. The body moves slowly but continuously, no distinction between ectoplasm and cndoplasm being observed. Pseu- dopodia long, branching and anastomosing, always chang- ing. A granular nucleus and a number of contractile vacuoles are present. Habitat sphagnous swamps. Large individuals may measure 480 >» between the tips of the Riomjxo tarou. x 65. {Alter Penard.) 147 (146) Body with a distinct covering 148 148(153) Pseudopodia extending from more than one aperture. . . . 149 149(151) Envelop elongate, compressed. . . Amphitrtma Archer . . 150 150 (151) Envelop transparent, with no foreign particles attached. Amphitrtma flavum Archer 1878. j. ,u .» -. Pseudopodia straight, unbranched, extending from the opposite ■"V?*5srT P°'e* °* the envelop- Protoplasm always enclosing chlorophyL J\'J&*'?\] Nucleus single. One or more contractile vacuoles. Habitat Fig. 346. Amfkiirrmn jtmm. x 15s. (After Penard.) 151 (150) Envelop with foreign particles attached. * Amphitrema wrightianum Archer 1870. In this species the apertures at opposite poles an sur , „ — n.-iist--.-— - rounded by short collars. Chlorophyl always present. EY'aV< »»Jc— — Pseudopodia often branched. Nucleus siugfe. Contractile ^ -^s7^.«*i-r*«>~. vacuoles one Or more- Habitat mown Length 65 to 70 aw Fio. J47. Amtkilnmm ■riraliiaiw. X nj. (Afsar Pill Ml AMOEBOID PROTOZOA (SARCODINA) *33 X52 (i49) 153 (148) 154 (155) Envelop spherical Diplophrys Barker. Representative species Diplophrys archeri Barker 1868. In this species the pseudopodia, which are long and branched, extend from opposite poles of the envelop. The protoplasm always encloses a large spherical globule usually yellow or brown in color. A nucleus and one or more contractile vacuoles are present. Habitat sphagnum; Diameter 8 to 20 *. Fig. 348. Dipbpkrys archeri. X 120a (After Penard.) Pseudopodia extending from a single aperture 154 Envelop very flexible, changeable in shape. LieberkUhnia Clapardde and Lachmann. Representative species. . . LieberkUhnia wageneri C. and L. 1858. The envelop is normally pyriform but changeable in shape. Pseudopodia long, anastomosing, extending from a protoplasmic peduncle at the aperture. Nuclei as many as 200. Contractile vacuoles numerous. Habitat mosses. Length 06 m- Fig. 549. I itbtrkuk-Ui wageneri. x 130. (After Penard.) z55 (x54) Envelop rigid or slightly flexible 156 156 (i57) Body filling the envelop Gromia Dujardin. Representative species Gromia fluviatilis Dujardin 184 1. , , Envelop spherical or ovoid, seldom changing shape. The outer ... v iVj' S- '■ surface of the envelop is covered by a delicate sheath of proto- vjv> -^$*W /J&\ plasm in which minute granules circulate. Pseudopodia numerous, '^^w^^i^' anastomosing. Habitat among aquatic plants. Diameter 00 to ^.^sM^^fc---- 250 M- This species is identical with Gromia terricola Lekly. ""3*"^*^^^* Fie. 350. Gromia fimiatilis. x 25. (After Lekly. ) 157 (156) Body not filling the envelop Microgromia R. Hertwig. Representative species. . . Microgromia socialis R. Hertwig 1874. Envelop rigid with a short neck. Pseudopodia long, anastomosing, aria- ing from a peduncle at the aperture. Sometimes colonies are formed. Habitat standing water. Length 20 m- Conn reports a form from Con- * ^Ssfls^-— Bccticut which he refers to this species with some doubt as to its identity. Fig. 351. Microgromia socialis. ct, contractile vacuole; *, imdcns X 545. (After Hertwig.) 158 (145) Pseudopodia ray-like, soft, and anastomosing when touching. Subclass Protoomyx* . . 159 159 (160) Body amoeboid; endoplasm colorless. . . Nuclear ia Cienkowsky. Representative species. . . . Nuclear ia simplex Cienkowsky 1865. \ \ I // Body normally spherical but capable of changing shape. Pseudopodia \WJ/r arising from all parts of the body. Nudeus central, contractile vacuoles than one. Diameter 20 to 50 m- Reported by Conn from Connecti- Fte. 35a. NwdcarU simplex, x 250. (Alter Coaav) 234 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 160 (159) Body amoeboid; endoplasm red or brown. VompyrdJa Cienkowsky. Representative species. . . Vampyrella lateritia Cienkowsky 1865. Body spherical or elongated. Pseudopodia arising from alt parts of the body or Itom one point. The nucleus and contractile vacuole usually con- cealed by [be content! of the endoplasm. A gelatinous sheath sometime! surrounds the body. Habitat among algae upon which it feeds. Diameter 1$ 10 80 ,.. Fig. jsj. VamfyrtOa laUritia. X 150. (After Conn.] 161(1) Pseudopodia with axial filaments Class ActinopocUt. Fresh-water species included in one subclass. Subclass Helioioa . . 162 No central capsule between endoplasm and ectoplasm. Pseudopodia ray-like. 162(165) With no external envelop . . . . Order Aphrothoracicla . . 163 163(164) Nucleus single A ctinop hrys Ehrenberg. Representative species Actinophrys sol. Ehrenberg 1830. Body spherical with protoplasm highly vacuolated. Usually one contractile vacuole which rises and pushes out the surface as a rounded globule before bursting. Pseudopodia extending from all parts of tbe body. Habitat pond water among aquatic plants; very common. Diameter 40 to 50 ». tlO.su- AUi-Kfkrys ul. n, mntmclik vicuote. X 1*5. (Altar LekJy.) 164 (163) Nuclei many A dittos pJwrium Stein. Representative species. Actincspkoerium tichhornit Ehrenberg 1840. \^J3SafffT$tnm&& Protoplasm vacuolated with very large vacuoles about the 5^aKwHfin»lt£--' periphery. Nuclei scattered throughout the endoplasm. Psendo- iSifSHB-"'" podia extending from all parts of the body. One or more con- 93 tractile vacuoles. Habitat among aquatic plants. Not common. ■Be--?" Average diameter 100 to .100 m. Some have reported individuals 165 (162) With an external envelop 166 • One genus reported in North America. . . . Actindopkus Schultze. With a pedicel. Representative species. . . Actitwiophus minulus Walton 1005. Pseudopodia very short, extending from all parts of tbe body. Nucleus single, in the posterior region. Contractile vacuole not observed. Diameter of body with en- velop 13 a. Length of pedicel jo *. Habitat river water. Described by Walton . a, contractile yacuale; «, and— I X no. (Aftat WaltoaJ AMOEBOID PROTOZOA (SARCOD1NA) 235 167(166) Envelop wilh more or less closely united spicules 168 168 (175) With a thick protoplasmic envelop in which are imbedded skeletal elements in the form of spicules or plates. Order Cfaalarothoraca . . 169 169 (172) Skeletal elements loosely c 170 {171) Spicules chitinous, radiating between the pseudopodia. Hclcrophrys Archer. Representative species. . . . Heteropkrys myriopoda Archer 1869. In this species tbe envelop is mucilaginous, its outer border pre- senting a villous appearance due to tbe arrangement of the spicules. Kay-like pseudopodia penetrate tbe envelop. This organism is known to take possession of spicules from species of related genera, probably from discarded skeletons, and make them a part of its owd envelop. Endoplasui usually green with symbiotic algae. Nucleus single. A contractile vacuole is not always observed. Habitat marshes and standing water. Diameter jo/i. Frc. 3JJ. Hatrnplays myrutaia. X 190. (Afto Feoard.) 171 (170) Spicules siliceous, scattered through the envelop and surrounding the bases of the pseudopodia. . . . Rapkidiophrys Archer. Representative species. Rapkidiophrys eiegans Hertwig and Lesser 1874. The spicules are semicircular, wilh their convex surfaces toward tbe body and pseudopodia. Nucleus single. One contractile vacuole. Chlorophyl sometimes present. Often numbers of these individuals are grouped into colonies, joined by protoplasmic processes. Habitat among aquatic plants. Diameter jo». R. viridii Archer differs from R. cltgam in the fusiform spic- ules and the constant presence of symbiotic algae. Fie. iSS. X150. 172 (169) Skeletal elements closely united, forming a compact envelop. 173 s, globular, completely surrounding the body. Pompholyxophrys Archer. Representative species. . . Pompholyxophrys punicea Archer 1869. -s about the body. Endopiasm rad- io contractile vacuole. Pseudopodia very fine and indistinct Habitat among aquatic plants in ponds and in swamps. Diameter 15 to 30 «. Leid v records this species from New Jersey as Byahlampe ftmatroia Greeff. Ftc. 359- Pamplulyzepkrp m ultra, x aoo. (After Peraud.) 336 FRESH-WATER HIOLOGY 174 (173) Spicules siliceous, in the form of plates and delicate 1 spines AcantkocystU Carter. Representative species. . . Acanlhocyslis chattopkora Leidy 1874. ire of two lengths, the lone widely forked at the distal < iiially no contractile vacuole. pro enclosed cbloropbyl. Hab Diameter of body 50 to 60 «. F10. 360. AuntkacyfUl dutlopluri. oval, arranged tangentially. The t among aquatic Clatiiruiina Cienkowsky. One genus reported in North America. Envelop with a stalk. Representative species. Clathndina elegans Cienkowsky 1 Envelop more or less chitinous, perforated by numerous Urge, irreg- ular openings. Protoplasm not filling the envelop. Nucleus single. One or more contractile vacuoles. Pseudopodia very delicate, appar- ently without aiial filaments. Habitat spbagnous swamps and among aquatic plants; very common in some localities. Diameter of envelop IMPORTANT REFERENCES ON PROTOZOA, ESPECIALLY SARCODINA BihscHLi, O. 1883. Protozoa. In Bronn's Klassen and Ordnungen dea Thierreichs, vol. 1, pt. 1-3. Leipzig. Calkins, G.N. 1901. The Protozoa. New York. 1909. Protozoology. New York. Cash, J., and Hopkins, J. 1905-1900. The British Fresh water Rhizopoda and Heliozoa. 2 parts. Ray Society, vol. 75. Cockebell, T. D. A. 1911. The Fauna of Boulder County, Colorado. Univ. Colo. Studies, 8: 227-256. Conn, H. W. 1905. A Preliminary Report on the Protozoa of the Fresh Waters of Connecticut. State GeoL and Nat. Hist. Survey, Bull a; 69 PP-- 34 pl- AMOEBOID PROTOZOA (SAROODINA) 137 Edmondson, C. H. 1906. The Protozoa of Iowa. Proc Davenport Acad. ScL, 11: 1-124; 29 pi. 1 91 2. Protozoa of High Mountain Lakes in Colorado. Univ. Gold. Studies, 9: 65-74. Hempel, A. 1808. A list of the Protozoa and Rotifera Found in Illinois River and Adjacent Lakes at Havana, El. Bull. 111. State Lab. Nat. Hist., 5: 301-388; 5 figs. Landacre, F. L. 1008. Protozoa of Sandusky Bay and Vicinity. Ohio Acad. ScL, 4: 421-472. Leedy, Jos. 1879. Fresh-water Rhizopods of North America. U. S. Geol Surv. Territ., vol. 12; 324 pp., 48 pi. Penard, E. 1002. Faune rhizopodique du bassin du leman. 714 pp., figs. Geneve. 1004. Les Heliozoaires d'eau douce. 341 pp., figs. Geneve. 1005. Les Sarcodines des grand lacs. 133 pp., figs. Geneve, 191 1. Rhizopodes d'eau douce. British Antartic Expedition, 1007-9, 1: 203-262. (Includes a list of Rhizopods from Canada.) Watles, G. H. 191 2. Fresh-water Rhizopods and Heliozoa from the States of New York, New Jersey, and Georgia, U. S. A.; with Supplemental Note on Seychelles Species. Jour. Linnean Soc, Zoology 32: 121-161; 1 pi. Wailes, G. H., and Penard, E. 191 1. Rhizopoda. Proc. Roy. Irish Acad., Clare Island Survey, Part 65; 64 pp.; 6 pL CHAPTER DC FLAGELLATE AND CILIATE PROTOZOA (mastigophora et infusoria) By H. W. CONN and C. H. EDMONDSON Professor of Biology, WesUyan}University Assistant Professor of Zoology, University of Oregon By early observers the term Infusoria was applied to all minute organisms found in water, including not only unicellular animals but many minute plants and not a few multicellular animals, as rotifiers, sponges, etc. Later the term was restricted to those one- celled animals which are commonly found in standing water and which move by means of long whip-like processes called flagella or by shorter, hair-like structures called cilia. At the present time the flagellated forms are included under the subphylum Mastigophora and those possessing cilia, throughout their entire existence or during their embryonic stage only, are grouped under the subphylum Infusoria. Mastigophora and Infusoria are of almost universal distribution, occurring in fresh and salt water, abundant in clear pools and streams as well as in stagnant bodies of water and also in infusions of plant or animal macerations. Some are parasitic, living upon or within the bodies of other animals. In the Mastigophora flagella are the characteristic structural features. These structures are slender, flexible, whip-like processes drawn out from the body, commonly at one end. The flagellum when single is usually directed forward, and by a lashing movement, a corkscrew twisting, or a mere vibration of its free distal end draws the body forward. Flagella may be numerous and often one or more are directed backward or trail at the side in addition to those extended in advance. That a close relationship exists between flagella and pseudopodia is easily observed in a number of forms. Some low flagellates 238 FLAGELLATE AND CIL1ATE PROT020A *& possess well-defined pseudopodia, and the flagella of these f onns have the appearance of permanent, specialized pseudopodia endowed with the power of vibration. The interchanging of pseudopodia and flagella has been referred to in the case of Vampyrella under Sarcodina. The origin of the flagellum has been traced in some forms to the region of the nucleus, which may be considered as evidence in favor of its homology with the axial supports of pseudopodia. Cilia, which are the conspicuous and for diagnosis the special struc- tural feature of the ciliates, as contrasted with flagella, are short, hair-like processes. They arise from the ectoplasm, not origina- ting from the deeper regions of the body as do flagella. Cilia may be evenly distributed over the surface of the animal or restricted to certain regions or zones. Often fusion of cilia takes place form- ing vibrating membranelles or large bristle-like cirri or setae. By tufts of cilia certain forms may be temporarily attached to supports. Suctoria, in transition from the embryonic stages to the adult, lose the covering of cilia which is replaced by hollow tentacles, capable of extension and retraction. The tentacles may be pointed or dis- tinctly capitate, the prey being pierced by them and its protoplasm drawn through the hollow tubules into the body of the suctorian. In Mastigophora and Infusoria the protoplasm is similar in structure to that of lower Protozoa, being alveolar in character. However, in these groups, the protoplasmic contents of the body are not arranged in zones to the extent found in Sarcodina. Great variation exists in the consistency of the body both in flagellates and in ciliates. In some the body is soft and flexible, the ectoplasm permitting rapid changes in shape or even the formation of pseud- opodia; others are enclosed by inflexible membranes, sheaths, or well-defined plates. Cup-like loricae are sometimes developed, to the inner surface of which the animal may be fixed, from which it may project, and into which it may retract. In a few of the flagellates a delicate collar is formed about the base of the flagellum. The collar is very transparent, variable in size, and capable of being retracted into the body protoplasm like a pseudopodium. Many flagellates and ciliates are free swimming, while some may be temporarily fixed by cilia or flagella or by the adherence of a 240 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY surface to some support. Others are attached by stalks or pedicels which may be rigid, flexible or, in some forms, as Vorticella, may contract spirally. Special organs of defense are provided in a few flagellates and many ciliates in the form of trichocysts or stinging, thread-like structures. In at least one genus of flagellates, Poly- krikos, the stinging threads are highly specialized, resembling nematocysts of Coelenterata. As in Sarcodina, one or more con- tractile vacuoles are usually present in the flagellates and ciliates, their function being similar in all Protozoa. Nuclei are present in all Mastigophora and Infusoria but con- siderable structural variation exists with respect to them in these two groups. In some flagellates the nucleus consists of scattered or grouped particles of chromatin without a nuclear membrane, while in many of the higher Infusoria it consists of a highly differ- entiated, branched structure. Infusoria differ from other Proto- zoa, with a few possible exceptions, in the possession of two kinds of nuclei in each cell, a macronucleus and a micronucleus, the former being concerned with the vegetative functions and asexual division, the latter with sexual division. The macronucleus is the larger and often varies greatly from the regular spherical type; the micronucleus is usually very small, spherical, and in close contact with the macronucleus. In but one flagellate, Polykrikos, has this differentiation into two nuclei been found. In the key which follows, wherever the term nucleus is mentioned, reference is made to the macronucleus. In many forms of Mastigophora and In- fusoria as well as Sarcodina, the nucleus encloses a spherical body which functions as a division center. During the resting stage of the cell the division center resembles a nucleolus in appearance, but during mitosis it elongates, forming a spindle, and indirect division comparable to that in the Metazoa occurs in some of the more complex forms. The endoplasm of many Mastigophora encloses colored corpuscles or chromatophores, green, yellow, and brown being the prevailing colors. The chromatophores themselves often enclose deeply staining pyrenoid bodies which probably have to do with the con-; struction of starch. Other inclusions as oil droplets, paramylum granules, allied to starch, and pigment spots are common in those FLAGELLATE AND CILIATE PROTOZOA 241 forms containing chramatophores. The red "eye-spot" is usually located at the anterior end of the body near the base of the flagelhim and probably functions as a sense organ, being stimulated by rays of light. Chramatophores, oil droplets, and pigment spots may sometimes be found in Infusoria but are much less common than among the flagellates. Generally speaking, the physiological processes in Mastigophora and Infusoria are carried on precisely as in Sarcodina. The pres- ence of chlorophyl in some of the flagellates makes possible the synthesis of food from inorganic elements, but in many of these forms and in nearly all of the ciliates distinct mouths are developed, sometimes permanently open and sometimes open only while food is being ingested. The symbiotic relationship exists with algae in some species of ciliates also. Among Mastigophora food is often whipped down by the flagellum to the soft ectoplasm at its base where ingestion takes place. The delicate collars present in some flagellates assist in food getting. Among ciliates the vibrat- ing cilia, membranelles, and membranes serve to draw food toward the animal by arousing currents of water. In Suctoria the tentacles are organs for securing food, their distal extremities being provided with openings through which the protoplasm of the prey is drawn. Respiration and excretion are similar processes in all Protozoa. The contractile vacuoles assist in the excretion of waste fluids and probably of gases. In some Infusoria there are definite points on the surface where waste solids pass from the body. Among the Mastigophora, longitudinal fission is the predominating method of reproduction, only a few forms dividing transversely. Usually the chromatophores, " eye-spot' ' and pyrenoids, if present, divide as well as the nucleus during reproduction. The flagellum sometimes divides longitudinally, and in other forms is cast off, new flagella being developed as the cells separate. In some cases the "eye-spot," pyrenoids, and flagella are duplicated before a division of the cell commences. Many colonial forms of Masti- gophora illustrate a highly specialized type of cell division similar to that shown in a metazoan ovum. Among Infusoria simple division is the predominating method of reproduction. Division may be longitudinal, transverse, or diagonal, both nuclei dividing 242 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY during the process, new structures such as mouth parts and con- tractile vacuoles usually being formed as division goes on. The production of swarm spores is common among the flagellates, occur- ring either in the free swimming or encysted condition and develop- ing into the adult either directly or after the fusion of two of them has taken place. Swarm spores are produced in a few species of ciliates during encystment. Conjugation occurs in both Mastigophora and Infusoria. In some cases the fusion is permanent; in others it is temporary, the cells separating after an interchange of micronuclear material. Conjugation may often be followed by either encystment or the production of swarm spores, or both. Gametes of unequal size are frequently produced, in some cases union between two small gametes taking place, in others a large and a small one uniting. Among Vorticellidae there is a complete fusion of the free-swimming micro- gamete with the fixed macrogamete. In some of the more compli- cated flagellates, as Volvox, phenomena closely resembling sexual reproduction occur; sex cells are differentiated from somatic cells, ova and sperm are developed, and new colonies are produced as a result of fertilization. Encystment occurs in Mastigophora and Infusoria as in Sarcodina, the condition sometimes being pre- ceded by conjugation or followed by the formation of swarm spores. In general, methods of collecting, studying and preserving Sarcodina may be employed for Mastigophora and Infusoria. However, these latter are often free-swimming, swift-moving forms, and before any satisfactory study of them can be made their move- ments must be retarded. An aqueous solution of gelatin will check the movements without killing the animals if a solution of the right consistency is used and this may be obtained by trial. Egg albumen may be substituted for gelatin. A drop of very dilute methyl alcohol added to the water containing Protozoa will usually nar- cotize them. Evaporation of water from under the cover glass will gradually retard their movements but the larger forms will soon be crushed by the weight of the cover unless the latter is supported by wax feet, bits of paper, or very thin glass. Fine capillary tubes broken into short pieces make useful rollers on which the cover . . -* FLAGELLATE PROTOZOA (MASTIGOPHORA) 243 glass may be supported and the protozoan, if under the proper pressure, may then be rotated for study from various aspects. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER MASTIGOPHORA i (131) Flagellated forms with animal characteristics predominating. Class Zoomastigophora . . 2 Confessedly a poor definition, but no better can be given. The beginner will often be in doubt whether forms under consideration are flagellated animals (Mastigophora), or flagel- lated plants (unicellular algae), or less frequently flagellate stages (spores) of Protozoa and Protophyta. Even authorities are not in agreement regarding the position which should be assigned to specific forms; thus the Volvocina are included in both Protophyta and Protozoa in this book. 2(118) Without protoplasmic collars. . . Subclass LissoflageData . . 3 3 (36) Very plastic, often producing pseudopodia. Order Monadida . . 4 4(15) Not forming colonies and without lorica. 5 5 (12) Pseudopodia present; nagella, one or two. Family Rhizomastigidae . 6 (9) FlageHum single 6 7 C°aQQ\^>iv 7 (8) Pseudopodia lobe-like or pointed, sometimes branched. Mastigamocba Schultze. Representative species. .... Mastigamocba longifilum Stokes 1886. • Body very changeable in shape, often producing distinct pseudopodia; movements usually slow, repent, but sometimes the animal glides forward rapidly without pseudopodia being formed. FlageHum long, very active. Nudeus small, near the anterior extremity; contractile vacuole single, anterior in position. Length 12 to 30 m- Standing water, among decaying vegetation. Fig. 162. MtH&mmka UmgiJOmm. X 1000. (After Conn.) 8 (7) Pseudopodia ray-like, often capitate Actinomanas Kent Representative species Actinomanas vernalis Stokes 1885. Body subspherical, changeable in shape, free swimming or temporarily attached by a short stalk. Pseudopodia few, radi- ating from any part of the periphery, simple or branched. Nucleus subcentral; contractile vacuoles several. Diameter about 20 *- Shallow ponds in early spring. Fig. 363. A 0, contractik (After StoketJ 9 (6) More than one fiageHum. 244 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 10 (n) Pseudopodia ray-like with swellings along their course. Flagella directed forward Acineiactis Stokes. Representative species Acineiactis mirabilis Stokes 1886. Body suhsphericaJ, solt, md plastic. Short, lobate pseudopodia often id addition to capitate rays. Flagella subequai arising at some distance from each other. Nucleus central; contractile vacu- oles two. Diameter about 1 j ,1. Stagnant pond water. 11 {to) Pseudopodia lobe-like. Flagella two, one trailing. Ctrcobodc Kraas. Representative species Cercobodo sp. Species not determined. Fig. 365. Cmtbeit i|>. 12 (5) Plastic but not forming pseudopodia. Flagellum single. Family Cercokonadldae 13 (14) With a posterior tail-like filament Cercomonas Dujardin. Representative species. . . Cercomonas longicaudata Dujardin 1841. Body elongate-ovate, fusiform, terminating posteriorly in a long, tail-like filament about c " twice the length of the body. Nudeua spher- ical subceutral Length 10 r- Vegetable 14 (13) Without a tall-like filament Oikomonas Kent. Representative species Oikomonas steinii Kent 1880. contracted, about * . Vegetable bfnjhmi Social. 15 (4) 16 (21) 17 (20) 18 (19) FLAGELLATE PROTOZOA (MASTIGOPHORA) 245 Often forming colonies and often with lorica 16 Lorica present Family Bikoecidae . . 17 Not forming colonies 18 Body attached in lorica by thread-like peduncle; with peristome process. Two flagella Bicosoeca James-Clark. Representative species Bicosoeca kpteca Stokes 1885. Lorica subcylindrical with a very short neck in front; drawn out to an acute point where attachment is made with the pedicel. Body ovate, obliquely truncate in front and projecting slightly beyond the margin of the lorica when fully extended. Flagella unequal. Nucleus near the middle of the body; two con- tractile vacuoles. A chestnut-brown color of the lorica indicates old age. Length of lorica 15 to 18 m- Pond water among algae. Fig. 368. Bicosoeca lefkca. cv, contractile vacuole; n, nucleus. X 840. (After Stoke*.) 19 (18) Body not attached by thread-like peduncle, no peristome process. Flagellum single Codonoeca James-Clark. Representative species Codonoeca inclinata Kent 1880. Lorica ovate, attached obliquely to a pedicel twice its length. Body attached to the posterior, inner surface of the lonca without a peduncle. Not projecting beyond the margin of the lorica. Flagellum extending considerably beyond the aperture. A nucleus and a contractile vacuole in the posterior region of the body. Length of lorica 15 p. Pond water. Fig. 369. Codonoeca inclinata. cm, contractile vacuole. X 810. (After Kent.) (17) Forming colonies, with peristome projection. ..- / Stylobryon dc Fromentel. Representative species. . . Stylobryon petiolatum Dujardin 1838. Each lorica wineglass-shaped, pointed posteriorly, attached to a pedicel which arises from within the cavity of the awociatrd lorica. Body plastic Flagella two, unequal in length. Length of lorica 30 to 50 *. Pond water. Often subdividing by spores. Fte.370. Stylohym ce. X;$ CAftex 346 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 31 (16) Without lorica; one or more flagella. Family Hetekoiustigidae . . 21 93 (39) Not forming colonics. 13 23 (a6) Flagellum single 34 34 (35) Flagellum directed forward Leptomonos Kent. Representative species Leptomonos sp. tBody pointed anteriorly and very flexible. Flagellum long and active. Often parasitic. Fig. 371 represent! a form reported by Conn, taken from a watering trough, and assigned to this genu* with some doubt. Species not determined. F10. J»I. Ltploaonal ip. x Sjj. (Alter CoonJ 35 (24) Flagellum trailing Shynckomonas Kleba. Representative species Rkynchomonas nasula Klebs 1SS6. Body ovate, slightly compressed, anterior end prolonged into a movable process. Mouth near the anterior end. Nucleus central. Contractile vacuole anterior. Frenh 36 (23) Two or more flagella. 37 17 (38) Body free or attached by an attenuated posterior end; spherical to ovate, with one chief flagellum and one or two secondary ones. Moderately flexible. Monas Ehrenberg. Representative species Monas fiuida Dujardin 1841- FLAGELLATE PROTOZOA (MASTIGOPHORA) 247 28 (27) Free, like Monas, but with the anterior end oblique. Physomonas Kent. Representative species Physomonas elongata Stokes 1886. Body elongate-ovate, changeable in shape; free-swimming or temporarily attached by a very short pedicel Flagella two, unequal. Contractile vacuole anterior in position. Length about 12 m. Swamp water. Fro. 374. Physomonas elongata. cv, contractile vacuole; n, nucleus. X 1000. (After Stokes.) 29 (22) Forming colonies. Two flagella 30 30 (33) One zooid upon the end of each branch. 31 31 (32) Pedicel rigid Dendromonas Stein. Representative species Dendromonas virgaria Weisse 1845. .4Uv iAt\MUAUAMtSi.,. Body of zooid pyriform, compressed, with an anterior, lip-like projection from the base of which arise the two unequal flagella. Nucleus single; contractile vacuole one or two. Colony branching dichotomously. A colony may include over one hundred zooids. Length of zooid 8 to 10 /1. Pond water. tt., Fig. 375. Dendromonas virgaria. Colony X 160; single zooid X 935 (After Blochmann.) 32 (31) Pedicel flexible Ramosonema Kent. Representative species Ramosonema laxum Kent 1871. Zooids pyriform, compressed, obliquely truncate anteriorly. Pedicel very slender, threadlike. A colony may includetas many as twenty or more zooids. Length of zooids 8 p. Pond water. Fig. 376. Ramosonema laxum. cv, contractile vacuole; ft, nucleus. single zooid X xooo. (After Kent.) X350; 33 (30) Many zooids upon each branch 34 34 (35) Stalk short, branching dichotomously once or twice. Cephalothamnium Stein. Representative species. . . Cephalothamnium caespitosum Kent 1880. Zooids irregularly pyriform, in clusters of two or three or as many as six or eight on the summit of a simple or slightly branched pediceL Pedicel very short. Length of zooid about 6 *. Fresh water, attached to Cyclops, 1 F».377-v Cephalothamnium caespitosum. x 875. (After Conn.) 248 FRESH-WATER biology 35 (34) Stalk long, stout, greatly branched. AtUhophysa Bory de St. Vincent. Representative species AtUhophysa vegetans Miiller 1786. life Bodies attached in rosette-iike dusters, each zooid pyriform in shape, obliquely truncate in front, with two flagelia of un- equal length. Clusters attached to a branched pedicel or free swimming, moving through the water in a rolling motion. In older stages the pedicel becomes dark brown in color. Length of zooid 5 to 10 j*. In stagnant water. Fig. 378. Antkopkysa vegetans, x 500. (After MuBer.j 36 (3) Sometimes plastic but not producing pseudopodia 37 37(60) Chroma tophores not present; flagelia often numerous 38 38 (49) Flagelia usually two, one usually trailing; very minute forms. Order Heteromastigida . . 39 39 (40) Flagelia three in number, one directed forward. . . Elvirea Parona. Representative species Elvirea cionae Parona 1886. Body ovate to elongate, laterally compressed. The shorter ^""-^"••^H^ — — -^ flagellum directed forward. Mouth and nucleus anterior. ^T^^^^^ Fresh water. Fig. 379. Etrina cionae. X 1200. (After Conn.) 40 (39) Flagelia two in number 41 41 (42) Both directed forward Dinomonas Kent. Representative species Dinomonas vorax Kent 1880. Body persistent in shape, subpyriform, widest posteriorly, slightly curved. Flagelia subequal, longer than the body. Length 15 **. Hay infusions. Fig. 380. Dinomonas max. X xooo. (After Conn.) 42 (41) One flagellum trailing, the other directed forward ,43 43 (46) Body spiral or oblique 44 44 (45) Body not spiral, anterior end oblique; very flexible. PhyUomitus Stein. Representative species. . . . PhyUomitus amylophagus Klebs 1886. Fig. 381. PkyUcmlms §myi§tk§gui. X 1375. (After Coul) ■-■ -» FLAGELLATE PROTOZOA (MASTIGOPHORA) 249 45 (44) Body spiral, elongated Spiromonas Perty. Representative species Spiromonas angusta Dujardin 1841. Body five or six times as long as broad. Fla- !;ella subequal, as long as the body, one directed orward; body sometimes temporarily attached by one. Length 10 $u Hay infusions. Fig. 38a. Spiromonas angusta. X 1000. (After Coon.) There is doubt as to the identity of Conn's form. 46 (43) Body neither spiral nor oblique 47 47 (48) Kidney-shaped to spherical; flagella arising from a ventral depres- sion, one trailing. Food absorbed by a dorsal vacuole. Pleurotnonas Perty. Representative species Pleurotnonas jaculans Perty 1S52. Body kidney-shaped, very small; sometimes attached by the pos- terior flagellum. Contractile vacuole anterior; nucleus posterior. Length 5 to 9^ Stagnant water and infusions. Movements jerking and leaping. Fig. 383. PUuromonas jaculans. X xooo. (After Conn.) 48 (47) Pear-shaped to spindle-shaped; flagella arising from the anterior end, one trailing. Food not taken in by a dorsal vacuole. Heteromita Dujardin. Representative species Heteromita ovata Dujardin 1841. Body ovate, widest posteriorly. Flagella unequal, the trailing one twice as long as the anterior one. Length 25 to 40 jk River water with aquatic plants. Fig. 384. Heteromita ovata. x 500. (After Coon.) 49 (38) Flagella usually numerous, frequently arranged in groups. Order Phytomastigida . . 50 S<>(S3) Flagella two in number 51 51 (52) Body expanded into two wings; flagella long. Trepomonas Dujardin. Representative species Trepomonas agilis Dujardin 1841. being prea UkcUteral nt poi rard 0 Flo. 385. Trepomonas agiiis. X 450. (After Coon.) curve backward nearly to the middle of the body. Length 20 *. Pond water. 250 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY $2 (51) Body not laterally expanded, sometimes attached by a stalk. Flagella arising from the anterior end. . . Ampkimonas Dujardin. Representative species Ampkimonas globosa Kent 1880. Body subspherical, attached by a filamentous pedicel. Flagella equal, twice the length of the body. Diameter 12 m- Pond water. Fig. 386. Ampktmomu ghbos*. X 875. (After Kent.) Conn reports a form, found abundantly in the fresh waters of Connecticut, which he assigns to this genus, with some doubt. Although never attached by a pedicel, the two equal flagella would seem to place it here. 1 53 (50) Flagella four in number 54 54 (55) With a deep, vertical furrow CoUodictyon Carter. 55 (54) Without a vertical furrow 56 56 (57) With three flagella directed forward, one trailing. Body pear-shaped, rounded in front, acute behind. . Trichomastix Blochmann. Representative species Trichomastix sp. American species observed have not been de- termined. Fig. 387. TrickiMtUx sp. X 750. (After Conn.) 57 (56) With all four flagella directed forward 58 58 (59) Body ellipsoidal, with two thread-like processes at the posterior end Hexamita Dujardin. Representative species Hexamita inflate Dujardin 1838. Body plastic, posterior end bifid, giving rise to the trailing, flagella-like processes by means of which it may be temporarily fixed. Length 10 to 15 *. Pond water and infusions. Ito.188. B csMrite fatjUfe. X«7$. (After Coan.) FLAGELLATE PROTOZOA (MASTIGOPHaRA) 251 59 (58) Body obovate. obliquely truncate in front; or subpyriform or sub- spherical with a rounded front Teiramitus Perty. Representative species TelramUus variabilis Stokes 1886. Body changeable in form. Fiageila subequal, inserted near the middle of the an- terior border. F.nriopiasm granular. Contractile vacuoles two, near the front border. Food received at any portion of the surface. Length 18 to 25 p. Stand- ing water with decaying vegetation. Fig. 589. THrmmtus variabilis, x 250. (Alter Stokes.) 60 (37) Chromatophores usually present. Fiageila one or two. Order Euglenida . . 61 61 (87) Elongated forms usually with pointed posterior ends. Chromato- phores usually green. Paramylin bodies present. Family Euglenidae . . 62 62 (69) Naked or with very thin cuticle 63 63 (68) Flagellum single 64 64 (65) Attached by a branched stalk, usually surrounded by a jelly-like en- velop Colacium Ehrenberg. Representative species Colacium steinii Kent 1880. So far as has been determined, no members of this genus have been reported in North America. Several species have been reported in Europe. Usually attached to Cyclops or other fresh-water crustaceans. F 10.390. Coiacimm stemii. X 350. (Alter Kent.) ^f 65 (64) Not attached and not surrounded by a jelly-like envelop. Large forms, spindle-shaped, usually green, with an eye-spot. Euglena Ehrenberg . . 66 66 (67) Body rounded anteriorly, surface smooth. Euglena viridis Ehrenberg 1830. Body usually rounded anteriorly with a colorless, tail-like posterior pro- longation. Surface smooth. Nucleus central, contractile vacuole anterior. Length 50 to 75 m. Common. The chlorophyl may at times be lost and the species, no doubt, may then exist on organic substances. Fie. 391. Euglena tiridis. en, contractile vacuole: », nucleus; pom, paramylum; si, stigma, x 400. (After Blnrhmann.) 67 (66) Body cylindrical; surface beaded. Euglena spirogyra Ehrenberg 1830. Body elongate, cylindrical, with a pointed, tail-like prolongation. Periphery covered by oblique rows of minute bead- like elevations. Color bright green. Nucleus central, with an elongated starch- like body anterior and posterior to it. Eye-spot near the base of the flagrllnm. Length 100 to 200 m- Among algae. Fig. 392. Emtfma tpinxyra. x 50a (After Coon.) 252 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 68 (63) Flagella two; body spindle-shaped when extended; chromatophores disk-shaped Eutreptia Perty. Representative species Eutreptia viridis Perty 1852. Body very changeable in form. Flagella equalling the v ^ tz>^ v body in length. Eye-spot present. Length, when extended, 100 p. Pond water. Fig. 393. Eutreftia riridis. X 50a (After Coan<) 69 (76) With a thick cuticle or lorica 70 70 (76) Lorica present 71 71 (72) Lorica beaker-shaped or tube-shaped Ascoglena Stein. jfe. 72 (71) Lorica spherical or cylindrical, smooth or spiny. Trachelomonas Ehrenberg . . 73 73 (74, 75) Lorica smooth, colorless . . Trachelomonas lagenella Stein 1878. Lorica colorless, oval or elliptical, smooth. An obliquely projecting neck. Length 20 to 35 n. Fresh water. "-^ Fig. 394. 7 rachdomonas logeudla. x 60a (After Stein.) 74 (73 j 73) Lorica spinous, brown. . . . Trachelomonas hispida Stein 1878. Lorica elongate-oval, with ends broadly rounded. Surface cov- ered with minute, sharp-pointed spines. A short, tube-like neck sometimes present. Brown in color. Length 30 to 36 m. Pond water, with other species of the genus. Fie. 395. Trachdowunas hispid*. X 40a (After Conn.) 75 (73» 74) Lorica smooth, brown. . Trachelomonas volvocina Ehrenberg 1833. Lorica nearly spherical, surface smooth, usually without a neck. Flagellum long. Color brown. Diameter 30 m- Very common among algae and other aquatic plants. Fig. 396. Ttachdomonas vohocina. x 450. (After Edmoodson.) 76 (69) With a thick cuticle but no lorica 77 77 (78) Not flattened, ellipsoidal, with a pointed caudal process. ChloropeUis Stein. Representative species ChloropeUis hispidula Stein 1878. Surface of the body ornamented with mi- nute spines arranged in longitudinal rows. Endoplasm green, with an eve-spot. Length 55 !*• Fresh water, among diatoms. tztia/ pjo 39? Cktmfdtu kuptdmi*. x 60a (After Conn.) 78 (77) Flattened 79 •V*jL."if TLAGELLATE PROTOZOA (MASTIGOPHQRA) .253 70 (84; Posterior border acute or with a caudal appendage Be &> (81 Ellipsoidal, sughtiv flattened; posterior end acute. longitudinally or spirally marked Lepacindis Perty. Representative specks Ixpocmdissp. This gams is very closely related to, if not irtontiratl with, the preceding one. The form here represented is assigned to this genus by Conn, with •erne doubt . Spcririi not determined. Fig. j9&. Lepecinciu sp. x 1000. (Alter Coon.) 81 (6o> Round to pear-shaped, asymmetrical, much flattened; caudal process present Pkacus Nitzach . . &2 82 (83) Caudal process moderate; not large. rov Pkacus plcvronectes Kitzsch 1816. Tail-like projection usually curved. Surface longitudinally striated. Endoplasm green, enclosing one or more large, amylaceous bodies. Flagel- ium arises trom a cleft-like mouth on the anterior border. Length 25 to Among aquatic plants. 7i **• Fio. 39c,. Fkacm plauemutcs. X 450. (After Conn.) 83 (82) Caudal process long; size conspicuous. PhacMS iongicaudus Ehrenberg 1838. Recognized by its large size and long caudal pro- jection. Body frequently twisted on its Wigimdinal axis. .Length 100 u- Fig. 400. Pkacus iamgicmuAns. X310. iAiter Conn.) Posterior end evenly rounded 85 Resembling Pkacus but without caudal appendage. Representative species 84(79) 85(86) Cyclautsra Stokes. Cydanura orbiadota Stakes 1886. Body ovate or auborbicular, thick, compressed, with a longitudinal keel across the right-hand side. Color green. Contractile vacuole and eye-spot anteriorly placed. Length about 50 m- Stagnant pond water. Fig. 401. CydamuraeriMcadaia. X 32s. (After Stokes.) 86 (85) Oval in outline, rigid, flattened. Chxomatophores green, two in number, lateral in position. . . . Cryptogfena Ehrenberg. Representative species Crypioglena pigra Ehrenberg 1831. Flagellum single, short. Chxomatophores band-like, following the contour of the body. A scarlet eye-spot near the anterior extremity. Length 1 2 m. Fresh water. Fig. 40. Crypta&ena pigra. X 1500. CAfter Conn.) 87 (61) Colorless forms without eye-spots. Often very plastic 88 88 (101) Body elongate, usually with striped membrane. Nutrition sapro- phytic. Plagella usually two. Family Asxashdae . . 89 254 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 89 (94) Body flexible; one or two flagella 90 (93) Flagella two 91 (92) Secondary flagellum very small, directed backward. . Astasia Ste Representative species Astasia trichophora. Ehrenberg 18, /^d^rr^X^^r--^ Body elongate, usually wider posteria ^ Primary flagellum very thick at the base 1 xeissSsS^ jong Nucleus central; contractile vacuole Fio. 403. Astasia trichophora. X 410. teriorly located. Length, when extended, 30 (After Conn.) 60 m Common among diatoms and algae. 92 (91) Secondary flagellum about half as long as the primary; both fk directed forward Distigma Ehrenoe Representative species Distigma proteus Ehrenberg 18, Body very plastic; when contracted, distended in < or two regions. Endoplasm with dark-colored corpusc Nucleus central; contractile vacuole in the anterior regi Length, when extended, 95 m- Pond water. ■ * * Fig. 404. Distigma Proteus, cv, contractile vacuole; *, nod ph, pharynx. X 330. (After Stein.) 93 (90) Flagellum single; body elongate, tapering posteriorly. A long tul lar pharynx Atractonema S Representative species Atractonema tortuosa Stokes 10 Body flexible but persistent in shape, color! enclosing oblong dark-bordered corpuscles. 1 j»^^ >)f^?^s^_Q gellum about half as long as the body. Movenu ~ * ~ J*-' — " rotary on the long axis. Length 50 to 80 0. vegetable infusions. Fig. 405. Atractonema tortnosa. X 625. (After Stol 94 (89) Body not flexible 95 (98) With longitudinal or spiral ridges 96 (97) Elongate or crescentic, with four longitudinal ridges; flagella, fc unequal Sphenomonas Si Representative species. . . Sphenomonas quadrangidaris Stein 10 Body subfusiform, with the ridges forming a quadrate outline in tion. Long flagellum stout, four times the length of the shorter one. large amylaceous corpuscle usually enclosed in the endoplasm. Length 4 Fresh water. Fig. 406. Sphenomonas quadrangularis. X 400. (After Butschtt.) 97 (96) Nearly ellipsoidal, with many spiral ridges. 98 (95) Without ridges Tropidoscyphus S FLAGELLATE PROTOZOA (MASTIGOPHORA) 255 99 (100) Resembling Sphenomonas, but without ridges; flageila two, unequal. Clostonema Stokes. Representative species Clostonema socialis Stokes 1886. Body fusiform, with a short, rounded posterior prolongation. Primary flagel- lum as long as the body; secondary, about one-fourth as long. A long, pha- ryngeal passage present. Length about 20 p. In standing water. Fio. 407. Clostonema socialis. X 600. (After Stokes.) 100 (99) Resembling Clostonema, but with a single flagellum. Menoidium Perty. Representative species. Menoidium pellucidum Perty 1852. Body lunate, obliquely truncated at the anterior extremity. Pos- terior end rounded. The short side of the body thin and sharp, the long side rounded. Flagellum equalling the body in length. One or more amylaceous corpuscles usually present. Length 40 to 60 m. Fresh water. Fig. 408. Menoidium pellucidum. X 500. (After Senn.) 101 (88) Body rigid or plastic, usually symmetrical; one or two dissimilar flageila deeply sunk in the body. Nutrition holozoic. Family Peranemidae . . 102 102 (109) Body plastic 103 103 (108) One flagellum 104 104(105) Oval, flattened, very flexible; distinct pharynx and rod-like organ ■ back of the mouth Peranema Dujardin. ) Representative species. Peranema trichophorum Ehrenberg 1838. Cuticle finely marked spirally. Flagellum very long, vibratile at the tip only. Nucleus central. Fig. 409. Peranema trichophorum. X 250. (After Conn.) Conn reports a number of undetermined forms which bear considerable resemblance to the above species and should, without doubt, be assigned to the genus Peranema. I05 (104) Flask-shaped; neck-like anterior end with elongated pharynx and rod-like organ 106 256 io6 (107) Without sand grains attached. . . . Urceoius Urceoins cydosLommm Stem 1878. Anterior cxtiemity obfiqueiy truncate reaching the postenor extremity Fwgrffnm body. Length 50*. Fresh water. Identical with nm its as long the end as the 410. U\ (Ate Cam.) 107 (106) With and grains attached. re species. . . Urceofopsis Stokes. Urcedafsis s*lmt*sa Stokes 1886. Ui Body flexible and elastic, with a short, anterior, neck-like prolongation, isery covered with sand grains. Movements are rapad, the body at an angle with the antrrior end downward. The long nagefium at its tirx Food particles are drawn into the oral aperture force. Length 20 p. Among 411. x 625- (After Stokes.) 108 (103) Two flagrfla, one traflmg; mouth depressioo oblique. Heteronema Dujardin. . Heteromema acus Ehrenberg 1840. Body very plastic, long as the body and Nucleus central; extended, 501k Fresh when extended. Primary nageDum as twice as long as the secondary, traflmg one. vacuole in the anterior extremity. Length, Fie 411. B* N (After Coaa.) other forms reported by Conn should, without doubt, be to this genus. The species are ondrtrrmmrd. 109 (102) Body rigid. no no (in) One nageflum; body flattened, usually furrowed and keeled. Petalonumas Stein. . . Pdahmonas pUurosigma Stokes 1887. pointed; lateral borders sigmoid. Dorsal by a narrow, longitudinal furrow. Length Body ovate, the posterior and ventral surfaces each 15 to 20 ik Standing pond X 6s$ (After Stokes.) irLaJft fi I&-J9L FLAGELLATE PROTOZOA (MASTIGOPHORA) 257 in (no) Two flagella, unequal 112 112 (113) Body with spiral ridges Tropidoscypkus Stein. 113(112) Body without spiral ridges 114 114(115) Trailing flagellum very prominent, curving around the anterior end Anisonema Dujardin. Representative species. . . . Anisonema acinus Dujardin 1841. Body wider posteriorly, flattened ventrally; anterior vi- bratile flagellum short. Mouth near the base of the an- ,^^^__^ tenor flagellum. Length 25 m« Among diatoms. Common. F.r -- '--* -•-— v r«« The genus Metanema Klebs resembles Anisonema but is ric. 414. Antsonema actnus, x 5°°« *i__:vT~ (After Conn.) flexible. 115(114) Trailing flagellum not prominent 116 116(117) Primary flagellum carried obliquely forward, vibratile only at its end. Body ovate or angular with dorsal side concave. No protrusile pharynx Notosolenus Stokes. Representative species . . Notosolenus orbicularis Stokes 1884. Body with a broad, shallow, dorsal concavity; the ventral surface convex. Movements somewhat eccentric, the convex surface usually directed down- ward. Nucleus to the left of the center of the body. Contractile vacuole near the anterior end. Length 10 to 12 m- Bottom of shallow ponds. Fio. 415. N otosolenus orbicularis. X 1000. (After Conn.) 117(116) Primary flagellum not carried obliquely forward; pharynx pro- trusile. A strong furrow on the ventral surface. Entosiphon Stein. Representative species. . . Entosiphon sulcatus Stein 1878. Body oval, flattened; anterior border oblique, with a concavity at the bottom of which is the mouth leading into a long tubular pharynx. Nucleus posterior. Contractile vacuole anterior. Length 22 m- Pond water, among aquatic plants. Fig. 416. Entosiphon sulcatus, • X 500. (After Conn. 118(2) With protoplasmic collars. . . Subclass Choanoflagellata . . 119 n9 (122) Not forming colonies 1 20 258 FRESB-YATZR BUjOGY 110I121) No locks, witi of witlnst a sulk. Representative specie* Mf**ng* « iii(i») With tarka, with or whboat a tUlk. - . Salpim&cca James-Clark- Representative species. . . . Stdpimgpeca tamaUari* Stein 1878 Lories campinaiate, panted uualniurlj. slightly constricted anteriorly. Pedicel reiy slender awl short- Zooid Mitf sftmg the brio. I-eagt h id lorica i]lo:<>. Attached to £*itfyJu. 122(119) Forminga 123(118) Without stalks 114 124(127) Colonie* enclosed iu a Beiatiwms mass. 125 125 (126) Forming a flat colony in an irregular jelly. . Proitrosfxmgui Kent. Representative species. . . . ProUroiPonpa haeckdi Kent 1880. Zooidi pyriform. plastic: collar long, each zooid bearing a single flagel- Itim. Colony may am tain as many as fifty or sixty aootds, but often not more than sir or right. The gelatinous support voy transparent. Length Of xootd 8 * Frrsh water. Fig. 419. PnUrnttmti* ImtduU. X J7J. 120 (125) Colony disk -shaped or arising from a funnel-like, open jelly tube. FkalanMerium Cienkowsky. Representative species. . . Phalansltrium digUatum Stein 1878. Zooid 9 ovate, plastic. Flagellum two or three times the length of the body. JeJhr mua coarse, granular, digitilorm, and often branching. Length of zooid 18 m. Fresh water. FLAGELLATE PROTOZOA (MASTIGOPHORA) 259 137(134) Colony wee. not eadoaed by jelly. Hirmidium Petty. Representative specks HirmMtiwn i*a*e Perty 1852. included in the cokey- L'u- ics describes a lam * ah fifty oi body, returned !»' Suies, 6 m 1 - r- Posd ■ FK.43I. 1/lMll.M. Sulk simple, many individuals bonic at the end of the stalk. Codosiga James-Clark . Representative specks Cedesiga ooUyiis Enrenberg 1838. equalling the body in length. Kern reg-jrt£ that prcviuu& to encyeunent the collars and fiifrllj oi tiiis i|nm mar Ik withdi*»n iau> the iMwuipiaim; ul the tiodits. •tub' tin latter Uxumc covered with radiating nteudupodia Ckta- uanaliy tht pteudupodia are uroduced while the collar is Mill ei tended quints art turned during encyjtunenl. 130 (1*9) Stalk blanched, with single individuals or groups on the end of each branch Codurutdadumt Stein. Representative specks. . Codvnodadium umbtilalim Tatero »868. 131 (1) riant characteristics evident; chiomaUipnores usually present: oiten producing colonies. Class Phjl — — *1ttui — ■ - ' I2 133 (305) Body without a shell iormed of plates: chromatophores yellow, brown, or green. . . . Subclass Pk;Ku*ifeu«U . . 133 134 (137) Body usually naked but may be enclosed in a jelly n z6o FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY I35(>36) FlageUum single; two chroma tophores. . Cfaomtdina Cienkowsky. Ckrjsomsnuis Stria is very closely related to thii genua. Under the name Ckrjtemeiuu piilthra Stokes describes ■ (pedes as follows: Body elongate-ovate or obovate, somewhat flexible, three times a* Ions ai broad, tapering and slightly constricted posteriorly, __ . _ curved toward one side anteriorly. Frontal border ob- liquely excavate. Surface covered with minute hemi- ■ *■££*•*?■"; ("J*1- x *°°- spherics] devatious. Flitdluni scarcely equalling the (After States.) body in length- Nudeus ovate. Contractile vacuole. two. anterior. Length 35 to 40 m. Color green. Mann '36 (135) Flagella, two; two chroma tophores. . . . Ochromonas Wysotzki. Representative species. OckromOHOS sp. Specie* not identified. Fb. 41J. O&mmtm w*. X leoo. (After Ou.) ■37 (>34) Body enclosed by a membrane ot lorica 138 138(157) With a membrane. 139 130(146) Not forming colonies. 140 140 (141) With a dose-fitting membrane of plates; nageUum single. Aftiilomirwis Petty. Representative spedes. MalLmumax sp. Body einnaalfd. enclosed by a membrane of overlapping plates which bear bear, 1 lender spinet. Two elongated, yeT lowbn-green dirornatophores are within the body. X son (After Cons.) 141 (140) With a finn cuticle; two rhp-Hn 1<2 143 (145) Without chrotnatopborr*. 143 143 (144) Body oval, truncate or concave anteriorly, atdoajag refractive bodies. Cyatkommuu or Fromrntel. Representative species. . Cyatlmmimai Inmaila Ac Fmagatd 1074. but sngbtrr bapM a* ( ■.■ii/kwwkjiu. .nit. wRhiptMUffTC andwiunt retnwtiwr, ■«bwi. rtytWWB KtowbMg Remesenuiuvft saeoct ' i vp mwm cvma I ■'-Eiaaxwrj Jl^r. ' 'tilnirmnsi 1 ilium nn in : jranra-. .mum ij^lii**. liiaivrrtnaw iinbertifcit i:i a.i;«aaia: !*»(r4*' \" (153) Colony in a gelatinous mass; variable in shape, thread-like, riiscoi- dal or round, hollow or sac-like. Individuals with two equal flagella Spongomorws Stein. Representative species Sponganumas discus Stein 1878. *&**> ^ Colony discoidal, gelatinous mass granular; zooida subspheroidal. Flagella two or three times the length of the body. Length of zooida 8 ». Fresh water. Fig. 431. Sfmitmntai dixm. X too. (After BOtachli.) 153 (152) Colony formed of jelly-like tubes, closely approximated; individuals as in Spongomonos Rkipido&enAron Stein. Representative species. Rhipidodendron spUndidttm Stein 1878. Tubules forming an erect branching colony. Zooids ovate or ellipti- cal, usually in the distal extremity of the tubules. Flagella equal, twice the length of the body. The lubes being hollow are probably secreted or exacted from the entire surfaces, rather than the posterior extremities of the aooids. The tubes are usually rusty-brown in color and have > granular appear- ance. Sometimes as many as two hundred tubes are bound together Length of body 1 1 it. Fresh water. Fio. aja. IMfUedtnifim tUndUwi. xijo. (After Sum.) 154 (i47) Individuals not imbedded in a gelat %- '55 ('5°) Fonning spherical colonies. About fifty individuals held loosely "^ together, each with a delicate membrane, often spiny. Fla- gella two, unequal Svff y g. Ehreaberg. Representative species Synura mdla Ehrenberg 1833. Membranes pyriform, often with posterior atalk-like pro- jections; surfaces spiny. Zooids nearly filling membranes. Color bands two, extending along the lateral borders. Length of body $0 g. Pond water. X600. (Alter Coao.) FLAGELLATE PROTOZOA (MASTIGOPHORA) 263 156(155) Forming annular colonies; individuals closely united. Flagella two, unequal Cydonexis Stokes. Representative species. . . . Cydonexis annularis Stokes 1886. From ten to twenty zooids, not in contact in older colonies, leav- ing a central, circular space. Zooids obovate, about twice as long as broad. Length of zooid 10 to 15 /*• Marsh water. Fio. 434. CycUmoxis annularis. X 6as. (After Conn.) 157(138) Withalorica 158 1S8 (163) Not forming colonies 159 159 (162) Lorica sessile 160 160 (161) Lorica beaker-shaped; usually with a peristome process. Epipyxis Ehrenberg. Representative species. . . . Epipyxis uiriculus Ehrenberg 1838. Lorica is truncate or slightly everted anteriorly, widest centrally and pointed posteriorly. Body occupies about one-half the cavity of the lorica, and is at- tached by a thread-like pedicel to one side of the lorica. An eye-spot usually present. Nucleus central; contractile vacuole anterior. Length of lorica about 40 /*. Attached to water-plants. Fio. 435. Epipyxis utriculus. X 650. (After Stein.) 161 (160) Lorica urn-shaped Chrysopyxis Stein. Representative species. . . . Chrysopyxis urceolata Stokes 1886. Zooid occupying the center of the lorica, but in no way attached to it. Flagella two, long, diverging. Yellow chromatophores often present. Nu- cleus centrally located; contractile vacuole posterior. Length of lorica 12 /*. Attached to algae. Fio. 436. Chrysopyxis urceolata. X 1200. (After Stokes.) 264 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 163(159) Lorica with a pedicel Derepyxis Stokes. Representative species. . . Derepyxis amorpha Stokes 1885. Lorica flask -shaped. Pedicel about one-tenth u long as the lorica. Zooid occupying the center of the lorica, subspherical, with the front border pointed. Endoplasm with two greenish-yellow color hands. Length of lorica »5 to 30 1£. Attached to algae. 163 (158) Forming colonies; loricae beaker-shaped. One primary and one secondary flagellum Dinobryon Ehxenberg. Representative species. . . Dinobryon sertularia Ehienberg 1838. Loricae joined to each other without separate pediceLi; the younger individuals being attached by their posterior ends to the inner, "anterior edges of the older loricae. Zooida at- tached to the bottoms of the loricae by transparent, elastic ligaments. Chrornatophores and eye-spot present. Length Fig. 43S. Dim 164 (133) Chromatophores green Order ChloroflaaelUda . . 165 165(168} Flagella four; not forming colonies 166 166(167) Body enclosed by a lorica Tetraselmis Stokes. Representative species. . Tetraselmis limnetis Stokes 1887. Lorica broadly oval, zooid nearly filling the lorica, green in color. Flagella exceeding the lorica in length. An amylaceous corpuscle pos- teriorly located. Length oi lorica 15 ». Pond water. F10. 4M- TOnidmii limntth. x S40. (After Stokes.) FLAGELLATE PROTOZOA (MASTIGOPHORA) 265 1*7 (166) Body not enclosed by a lorica Carleria Diesing. 168(165) Flagella usually two; often forming colonies 160 169 (180} Not forming colonies 170 170(177) Body with closely attached cuticle 171 171 (172) Usually without chroma tophores; occasionally a colored eye-spot. Ellipsoidal, two contractile vacuoles. . Polyloma Ehrenberg. Representative species Polytoma ttvdla Ehrenberg 1838. Flagella. two, equal, longer than the body, both extending forward 'L '■■ ''' " — "i at their bases. Endoplasm usually granular. Flagella. ith loop-] 173(171) With chroma tophores. . . , 173(174) Chroma tophores numerous; Representative species. . . X400. (After Stakes. 1 le flagellum trailing. Trenlonia Stokes. . Trenlonia fiageltata Stokes 1886. Body ovate, the anterior border oblique and somewhat bilobate, the posterior ex- tremity obtusely pointed. Flagella sub- equal in length, one emending forward, often rapidly and spirally vibrating. Mouth and pharynx conspicuous- Nu- merous green chro ma tophores. Length 60 H. Pond water. 1 J4 (173) Chromatophores few, sometimes wanting 17S '75 (176) Spherical or elliptical, with one large chromatophore. An eye- spot present CMamydomonas Ehrenberg. Representative species. Chlamydomonas pulviscvlus Ehrenberg 1883. mydtrmvnai fniviiatiuj. 266 FRESH WATER BIOLOGY 176 (175) Elongate, spindle-shaped, cfaranatophores two, ribbon-shaped; eye-spot obscure. Cktaramprnm Stan. Represen tati ve tpttia. CkbxaMpiiM sUntorinum Ehreubeig 1838. 177(170) Cuticle separated f«wn body mass. 178 178(179) Cuticle smooth. Btumetococtus Agardli. 179(178) Cuticle rough. Cixmbsmum Stein. 180(169) Forming colonies. 181 181(186) Colonies plale-like with flagella upon one face ouly 182 183 (185) Colonies in a four-sided plate with envelop closely adherent. Cells four or sixteen Gonittm M uller . . 183 183(184) Four cells- Gvnium lociale Dujardin 1838. 184(183) Sixteen cells Gvnium ptdoralc Mailer 1773. Id ths fptoH ouh of the axtan ecus of the colony produces s daughter colony of rinmi cctfa. Ai the diughler colonies develop, s itomdiiy lhifting of (be ceu* t*to pbec resukinc in individual* of the adult colonics lying to one pbne. ^J^ 185 (182) Colonies in a rounded plate with envelop swollen, oval, or spherical. Sltpkanetpkaera Cohn. Representative speck*. . . Slepkanospkaera piurialis Cohn 1853. 186 (181) Colonies spherical, ellipsoidal, or flattened, with flagella not confined to one face. 187 187 (190) Colonies with cells crowded together. 188 FLAGELLATE PROTOZOA (lIAS TIGOPHURA) 369 i*)0 UttS' Protoplasmic processes connecting cells usually distinct, roles of coluny not differentiated by arrangement of vegetative ami gonidial colls Volvox Leeuwenhoek . . 199 in i '-.'o;' Colonies with distinct protoplasmic processes connecting the cells 100 .,of;oj) Protoplasmic processes very stout 101 jot fjoi) Colonies dioecious Volvox pcrglobator Towers 100R. V.'-iY.wi'i" '.;?#-■-. riilmics nftcn cicecdinj; t mm. in diameter. Ovii nr ■ ",j.f{*:^, (i ,.; .- ?' ..-_£-■ mii|»'rm* not infrequenlly numbering several hundred in a ■ ■' '■'-,'!®',*e ****" colony- Very mmmjn in the United States. ■%• ',.-■■* ™'"«£»?k| ' ■" ;-i% ' = o.*«S Fm.«i. IWw orrtbftafer. Colony nith eight daughter cnrnnl.ia. ', .sWP.i « jM0 Cilia and pmlaiila*mic pfoccMCSBOt ifauwo. x)a (Front :io:) Colonics monoecious Patau: globular Lecuwcnhock 178S. " i'i ■ \iunvii E'iru|.:/i -i1" i>'-. Almul one-half the size ol [he preceding Mtecica, and ran- :.;„• fewiT reiirttiiittiv.- r, II,. Tl: - specie* probably occurs in the United State* but, i< 10, ,,..':■ !'•-.. iS'Uii.Jline 1 1 . . . : . I'jfcur prrglolmlgr. j .'oo.! Protoplasmic processes slender. . Volvox aureus Ehrcnberg 1838. ■; -A:*'. European speaa but probably occurring in the United States also. Diameter : 19-jF Colonics apparently without protoplasmic processes connecting the cells Volvox spermatosphara Powers 1008 Monoecioui forma with ripe iperrn* arranged in bundle* of j», grouped in sperm spheres in the colonies Mature colonies often exceed 600 u in diameter. Widely dis- tributed in the United States. Fio. 4SJ. Fanu rttnufaiatoro. Colony with two daufbttr Usually with an outer membrane or shell in the form of plates; iwvi„ ......iiv furrowed; flagella two. Usually colored. Subclass DmoflagelHda . . 206 1 around the body. 207 at 1 the left e, a longitudinal c 11 cross furrow to FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY j^ 193 (19a) Colony flattened, horseshoe-shaped, with poles differentiated by * arrangement of cells. Tails at posterior end. Representative species Plalydorinc r Kofoid. oid 1809. Colony slightly twisted in a left spiral. Cells sixteen or thirty-two imbedded in a transparent, gelatinous matrix and surrounded by a distinct sheath. Each cell has two nagella, an eye-spot, a nucleus, and a single chromatophore. Tails, in sixteen cell colonies, are " colonies five tails are t by i- Plankton Fig. 449. Ptatyitrhw a on the II and lakes. 194 (191) Colonies spherical or ellipsoidal; cells differentiated as to size and function 195 195 (19S) No protoplasmic processes connecting the cells. Small vegetative cells at the anterior pole, large gonidial cells at the posterior pole PUodorina Shaw . . 196 196 (197) Cells sixty-four or one hundred and twenty-eight, about equally divided between large and small. Pleodorina califamica Shaw 1893. Colony spherical, with gonidial cells two or three times the size uf the vegetative cells. Cells biflage!- late, not in contact with each other. Reproduction asexual, by gonidial cells, in this and other species of the genus. Found in ponds, ditches, and streams. Fro. 450. Pladahna alifmua. (After Shaw. 197 {196) Cells thirty-two, rarely sixteen or sixty-four. Vegetative cells, four in number. . . Pleodorina ittinoisensts Kofoid 1808. Colony ellipsoidal with cells arranged in five circles; the polar circles with (our cells each, the other three circles with eight cells each. The gelatinous sheath enclosing the colony is of two layers. Gonidial cells much larger than vegetative cells, the latter always directed forward during movement. Each cell with two B-g»ll», an eye-spot, a nucleus, and a single chromatophore. Average length 113 M. Plankton of livers. Flo. 4]i. Pltttrmt FLAGELLATE PROTOZOA (MASTIGOPHORA) 269 198 (195) Protoplasmic processes connecting cells usually distinct. Poles of colony not differentiated by arrangement of vegetative and gonidial cells Volvox Leeuwenhoek . . 199 199 (204) Colonies with distinct protoplasmic processes connecting the cells 100 aco (103) Protoplasmic processes very stout '201 301 (203) Colonies dioecious Volvox Perglobator Powers 1008. Colonies often acceding i mm. in diameter. Ova o oosperms not infrequently numbering several hundred it sTdK»A°'*jK3fc colony. Very common in the United Stales. >*»* .*JW°"o*60'4^ FI0.4S1. Vcbtx ftrtltialfr. Colony with eight daughter coenobia. V£Mr<««B Cila "d pral"pla.niic proceSMSimt .howo. x Jo. (From a ^.'■.Vo'^W prepuedmountV. 302 (aoi ) Colonies monoecious Volvox globalor Leeuwenhoek 1788. The common European species. About one-half the size of the preceding species, and con- taining fewer reproductive cells. This species probably occurs in the United States but, if 90, in much less abundance than Voivox ptrilobaUtr. 203 (200) Protoplasmic processes slender. . Volvox aureus Ehrenberg 1838. A typical European species but probably occurring in the United States also. Diameter about 850 j.. 204 (109) Colonies apparently without protoplasmic processes connecting the cells Volvox spermatospkara Powers 1908. Monoecious forms with ripe sperms arranged in bundles of 31, grouped in sperm spheres in the colonies Mature colonies often eiceed 600 11 in diameter. Widely dis- tributed in the United States. F10. »s 3. VoJni ipcrmaio'pliara. Colony with too daughter toenobia, five egg cells and one sphere of spenn bundle*. X80. (From a SDedmen.l >°5 (13*) Usually with an outer membrane or shell in the form of plates; body usually furrowed ; flagella two. Usually colored. Subclass Dinoflagellida. . . 206 206 {209) Without a membrane around the body 207 207 (308) Cross furrow extending only around the left side; a longitudinal furrow extending from the central end of the cross furrow to the under part of the body Hemidinium Stein. 270 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 208 (207) Cross furrow extending entirely around the body; often flattened. Gymnodinium Stein. Representative species. . Gymnodinium fuscum Ehrenberg 1838. Body oval, compressed, pointed interiorly. Color light brown. An eye-spot reported by Petty. Length 60 to 80 m. Fresh water. Fig. aSA- Cymucdinium fuscum. X 325. (Alter Blochmann.) 209 (206) With a membrane around the body 210 210(211) Membrane delicate, homogeneous; body without processes, often flattened Glenodinium Ehrenberg. Representative species. Glenodinium pulvisculus Ehrenberg 1838. Fig. 455. Glenodinium puhucuku. X 500. (After Stein.) 211(210) Membrane of distinct plates 212 .k- 212 (213) Plates without horn-like processes, polygonal, 21 in number. Peridinium Ehrenberg. # Representative species. Peridinium tabulatum Ehrenberg 1838. Body ovate, with convex dorsal and concave ventral surface. Plates showing a delicate reticulate structure under high magnification. Color yellow, green, or brown. Length 45 to 60 u. Fresh water. Fio. 456. Peridinium labulahm. X jao. (After Stein.) .& 213 (212) Plates with long, horn-like processes ^erflltyfltSchrank. Representative species. . . . Ceraiium hirundtnala Mtiller 1786. Body somewhat quadrilateral, the anterior segment bearing two nearly straight processes and the posterior segment a single short one. Color brown or green. Length 90 to 170 m. Fresh water. Fio. 457. Centimm kitundinelU. X $1$. (After Stein.) !>.■«- Cllim PROTOZOA (djfosoiua) INFUSORIA i (soB) Gka present daring all stages of mwnre a da-/ • .Body usually nuitonnly covered with cilia. 3 !xo4 1 Cjfaaai 4 i5Q^ Without an andakuiag membrane about the mouth Mouth closed except when taking iood Suborder ^j— —-— — -~- j Willi a shell 01 numerous plates arranged in zone, around the bodv Cilia projecting between the plates CoUps Niusch. Representative species . Caieps tortus Ehranberg 1S1S. y aha larger uur ■i itdully hwrini; *|mul: L™gm oo a. Pond b (5 Without a shell 7 U= > With tentacie-like processes i. 8 (g i Tentacle process single addition to the cilifl 8 lieomemo Stokes. .... lUomtwu dispar Stokes 1885. 9 (E) Tentacle processes more than 10(11) Tentacles very long and extending between the cilia. Actmoboius Stein Aatnoboiui radians Stein 1867 Body ovale or subglobiMe. (he ant _. ducco. As a mom-like projection which carries the tnoutn ■oil bean the retractile [entides and cilia. Nucleus "le vacuole iargt. 272 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 11 (10) Tentacles short, few in number, extending from about the mouth. Mesodinium Stein. Representative species. Mesodinium pulex Clai»arede and I«achmann 1858. Body turbinate, conical, and tapering anteriorly. A wreath of strong cilia on a constriction halfway between the middle of the body and the base of the snout-like proboscis. According to Claparede and T^rhmann three long stylate processes extend in front of the mouth. Length 15 m- Habitat, reported by Claparede and I.achmann, salt water. Fig. 461. Mcsod Pmitx. x 810. (After Kent.) 12 (7) Without tentacle-like processes 13 13 (34) Body round, or ovate, or elongate in outline, symmetrical. . . 14 14 (15) Cilia of body confined to two (rarely one) many-rowed crowns or circles. Body thimble-shaped, with broad end forward, from the flattened center of which rises an elevation bearing the mouth at the apex Didinium Stein. Representative species Didinium nasutum duller 1786. K- -''ST cv* Body oval, broadly rounded posteriorly. One wreath of cilia near the base of the proboscis, the other posterior to the middle of the body. Nucleus band-like. Contractile vacuole posterior. Length zoo to 175 #1. Among decaying vegetation. Fig. 46a. Didinium nasuimm. cv, contractile vacuole. X 95. (After Blochmann.) 15 (14) Cilia not limited to two crowns or circles 16 16 (27) With pharynx absent or slightly developed 17 17 (22) Anterior end rounded, not oblique 18 18 (21) Without a terminal bristle 19 19 (20) Ellipsoidal to ovate, rounded at both ends. Mouth anterior, leading into a short pharynx. Uniform ciliation. Eolophrya Ehrenberg. Representative species Eolophrya sp. Species not determined. Fig. 463. Eolcfkrya sp. X 300. (After Conn.) 20(19) Elongated, cylindrical, narrow in front, mouth terminal or subter- minal. No pharynx. Cilia longer at the anterior end. Nucleus divided into small pieces. . . Chaenia Quennerstedt Representative species Chaenia teres Dujardin 184 1. Forms observed from the fresh waters of Connecticut are provisionally placed here. F10.464. Chaenia tons. X 350. (After Conn.) .chjulte pkotozo* '^infusoria/ 2j? zsj -vatf Witt, fc-ttrrmtua. imstit Similar \i- Moiopttryi. u inapt. 'Vratriiih- Ciaparede anc: .Lachmann. f&qmaKruuitivt j$pcc*er 'hnnnuu. jarzu. Ciapareat anc. .Laciimajii ifcs*\ lt»KT oouqutr finaityj xioMcrio* un&U: obliqueo direcieti wiie: a xef: li ugrcabior. 1>* fciov forwaxi! movement or sud- ac;i jcajj^ i > uu-. tad-, Moutr. 01. :. smaf' drcula'- prominence »•, ui-.~ Axueriu: en- wtrugtr ^c *. Poa<. water Boktnttrtwti c: r-.ioiu.-. agree, wit:, tin. genu- deep: tha* oniy the anterior iwi<-uuru.3 i.-> cilia lei H- .41-.. biiMu.n~}aTU~ > 4^; iAILc: '.urn.. 22 ti; 23 1^4 «. *i Anterior enu obliqu-. Will, l spira Mjrte- o ioiij.*. ciin. ui tune" siu-. o: :. nug*. extending ironi Ui*. ameritr uorae" i.j lb', puiLeriu* extremity Perispirt. btein. Jiuauvt sj>eae^ / tnspjr.: sirepuoaonu. Stoke:- 1886 l>ou" tiuups.iu-ova.1'. C-iiu. o. Up genera curiae ver> nut. Proiopia&r. nlir- wit: ua:i,- colore*-" corpuscles: Length 80 *.. buuiuiu^, wale: wit:, atiiiagnur:. *7*>*e- 2bc -.Alter MOkc... 24 t^3 r^ 126 WiUiuui a spirit series v. da.. 2~ Bkiugaiea. witii mourn sagnu> o:* on-, siu-.' uaiiorn. cilia tioi. Nu- cleus auigi*. Endta ys Hill Representative speue: Ln.ua }, y«y„ Eiirenberg 1S3C. Imxij iniia.ie-., aieiijf: ar.ieru-rv Oitei. colored grceL LeugtL aooL. joc ,. Stagiiar.: v>ulv: 1 1. . 4' i^n«,At.-.v . pMf~ 1 Alter Loiil. 26 1,25' Eiougai-. sac-liK-„, muutL occupying: Ur oiiiiqu-. suriact. Pharym siigntr. devciupf'., sometime.- with rod- Nucleus bead- ing Spiithidium Lmjardii.. Representative specie- SpiUnuiiuv. spdtuuli* Dujardir. 1S4:. \ er> difiicu:: Ltitncly 27 u6 2Q 1.32" 30(31: i : - 40. With phaxyni weL uevciope.- Body greaiiy elongate . Bocrv liatiene^ > ujfiiugiuaj iron iorm.- o; tiit genu.- opamtuiMtt. ijHUni*- ^y. \ Alter Luni.. 2,v 20 30 Flaiik-sha|>eL wit:, au tiongaie:. necii-liKi anieno: enc I'rouoscis blur*., retrdctii*. ]\ioutL termini." itiddm-: mt«. z long piiaryn: . Tiu\,nu**phyliun. 'Jiapireci-. and .Lachmanr:. Kjepre&entaiivt specie-. 7 ici*.nLU*phyliun. ucnylldsium Stokes 18S4. l>uu.\ eu:n*. o: it:, unit .a.- io.ip; a- urua-J. neck slender: phdryngCL: pasaa^v inJi?i:ri'-t. uarnw, longitudinally stri- j-^. V^-- ut'- r-'--- nf surfa-.-' joii^ vibratinr independently. Ij r-rft*^B^ Nuclf" iv.-. , s!u;--.entr::! L'viutxartil*. vacuole posterior. Lenct :.. t-xteade . : j~ : . : 5.': ^ Bottom of shallow pools. Iiw.j'j;. 7 rlit,Huupr.j.lmn. HunyLu^iuT) ,. . . contractile vacuole. «Mk%, macrooucleu? y iSC (Aher Scatos.) rr»oo' 272 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 1 1 (io) Tentacles short, few in number, extending from about the month. Maadhdmm Stein, thre species. Maadimimm ptdex Qa;«arecat and Lachmann 1858. Body CDBBcal x&i tapering anterkerjr- A oi tne body vreathof strong cSaon extend in front of tne Fas. 461. 12 (7) Without tentacle-like processes. 13 13 (m) Body round, or ovate, or elongate in outline, symmetrkaL 14 Ud5) Ciha of body confined to two f rarely one) many-rowed crowns or circles. Body thimble-shaped, with broad end forward, from the flattened center of winch rises an elevation bearing the mouth at the apex. Didimum Stein. nasuium Vtuuer 1786. Body oral, broadly founded posteiioily, base of the pn>hcwcrv the other posterior Xndeas band-like. Contractile vacuole vegetation. Fic.462. IHft ct. One wreath of dSa near the to the middle of the body. posterior. Length 100 to 175 *. X 05. (After Blodunann.) 15 (14) Cilia not limited to two crowns or circles. 16 16(27) With pharynx absent or slightly developed 17 17 (22) Anterior end rounded, not oblique. 18 18 (21) Without a terminal bristle 19 19 (20) Ellipsoidal to ovate, rounded at both ends. Mouth anterior, leading into a short pharynx. Uniform ciliation. Hohphrya Ehrenberg. Representative species Hohphrya sp. Species not determined. Fig. 465. EtUfkrya fp. X 300. (After Coon.) 20 (19) Elongated, cylindrical, narrow in front, mouth terminal or subter- minaL No pharynx. Cilia longer at the anterior end. Nucleus divided into small pieces. . . Chaenia Quennerstedt Representative species Chaenia teres Dujardin 1841. Forms observed from the fresh waters of Connecticut are provisionally placed here. Fn.464. Chaenia torts. X 350, (After Conn.) -. "-J.* ctllxtr nmraftx. {&&&>*&. *H rr (e#) With \ terminal Mini* ^mi!u>< \\\ /AtM#**r>v ,»* au^i* fftnrfV iHJi/Mwl^ *,TM»vt< ^»^vr>J '^lAiU' JJi*^*Jt,; "*»*■. \.i«. c *«*■ .^tat^t; A^fiu^' I'^r. ..:*•„ 136 Xuuift&ta!".. . *■!*,: uui*JV bxtgc'u; %«: nil- bluv u^Ci^i ta.i4.Uu: i\-- ltcu n tnuftc JLuCuu * riL *: . £• «..*fcjr»... *&*+■- .i/liUTi vh'*i*. .o «4».--- *i>e hi>VX ilil Lieut . -2" ^ &W KtldCa:' lVj^.i.jr *cHi».*l. A^^tUiiiL iJUi HJiit 276 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 47 (46) Body flattened ventrally, convex dorsally. With a long neck and usually a tail-like prolongation both of which are hyaline. Mouth a slit at the base of the neck, often invisible. Nuclei Representative species Lionotus wrzcsniowskii Kent =0X5===—^, FlG. 479. Litmila) 4° (35) Mouth usually somewhat posterior, and often with a pharynx; body oval or kidney -shaped 49 49 (50) Body completely ciliated, cylindrical to ovate, rounded posteriorly. Mouth about one-third of the way from the anterior end; pharynx with rods Nassula Ehrenberg. Representative species Nassula ornata Ehrenberg 1838. Usually some shade of red or brown in color. Nucleus large, spherical, posteriorly looted. Contractile vacuole single. Length 100 u. Among algae. Fk. 4B0. Stinla mala. Id act ol feeding. X J"i- W« 50(49) Body not completely ciliated; cilia ventral only 51 51 (56) Body flattened 5a S3 (55) Mouth in the anterior half of the body 53 S3 (54) Body with convex dorsal and flattened or slightly concave ventral surface. Pharynx with rods ChUodon Ehrenberg. Representative species. ChUodon cucuiiulus Mtlller 1786. . The lip-like extension prominent, a groove leading from it to the ■tfJijUfJ liji mouth. Nucleus oval near the inner end o( the pharynx. Contractile joSSEfiHiSfc vacuoles numerous. Length us to 200 ^ Stagnant water and among 54 {53) Body with ridges on dorsal and ventral surfaces, crenate in cross section, pharynx with rods Chilodorwpsis Conn. Representative species. Chilodoaopsis crenula Conn 1005. Flo. 4S1. CkiiaknwpiU cr 55 (52) Mouth in the posterior half of the body Opisihodon Stein. 56 (51) Body not flattened 57 CILIATE PROTOZOA (INFUSORIA) 277 57 {58) Body purse-shaped Phastdodon Stein. 58 (57) Body ovate or nearly spherical in outline with a slight lip at the anterior end. Mouth at the base of the lip with no evident pharynx. Cilia ventral in six rows. . . . Hexotrieka Conn. Representative species Hexotrieka globosa Conn 1005. FlC 483. Btlebu.Ua flobosa. Later; 5g (4) Usually with an undulating membrane or membranes about the mouth. Mouth always open. . . . Suborder Trichostomina . . 60 60 (87) Peristome usually absent; with or without undulating membranes. 61 61(70) Without an undulating membrane; pharynx present 6a 6a (65) One or two broad zones of strong cilia about the body; with a tail- like tuft of cilia 63 63 (64) Two broad zones of strong cilia about the body. Body cylindrical, with mouth posterior leading into a short pharynx. An- terior part of the body uniformly ciliated. A band of strong cilia near the middle and posterior end. Urocentrum Nitzsch. Representative species. Urocenlrum turbo Miiller 1786. Body broadly r< 64 (63) With an oblique circle of strong cilia near the anterior end. Body somewhat pyriform, rigid, finely ciliated. Two groove-like canals encircling the body. Mouth ventral, posterior to the grooves and leading into a short pharynx. Calceolus Diesing. Representative species. . . Calceolus cypripedium James-Clark 1866. Fiu. 48;. Cakatui cytripatiui 278 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 65 (63) No zones of strong cilia about the body 66 66 (67) Mouth covering the whole oblique anterior end. Body usually oval or purse-shaped. Ltucophrys Ehrenberg. Representative species. .... Ltucophrys palula Ehrenberg 1838. Body oval; pharynx tubular, curved. Nucleus band- like, central. Contractile vacuole posterior. Length joo «. Among algae. Fro. 4B6. rsMMfiry, fttta. x iSo. (After Kent.) 67 (66) Mouth at some distance from the anterior end. 8 (69) Body ellipsoidal, dilation regular, mouth a crescent-shaped or spiral slit leading into a pharynx. . . . Ophryoglena Ehrenberg. Representative species. Ophryoglena atra Ehrenberg 1838. Body with posterior extremity pointed. Endoplasm usually opaque, with a dark blue pigment spot in ' the anterior region. Nucleus round, posterior; contractile vacuole central. Length 1 35 to 1 jo f. Stagnant water. Flo. 4S7- Ofkrytllma tin. et. contract!] t n m_ 69 (68) Body laterally compressed, ovate, with the dorsal surface rounded. Mouth one-third of the distance from the anterior end, with a few, long, fine cilia on its superior wall or roof. Colpoda Mttller. Representative species Colpoda campyla Stokes 1886. Length of body 55 «. Standing water with dead F10. 48!. CdrWa amfylt. x 600. (After Cobb.) 70 (61) With one or more undulating membranes. 71 71(76) One membrane present ji 71(75) Mouth not terminal 73 ■k- 73 (74) Body not flexible; mouth lateral, triangular, following a small peri- stome and with an undulating membrane in front. Body similar to Colpoda, but less compressed. . Col iridium Stein. Representative species Cotpidtum striatum Stokes 1886. Body twice as long as broad, striated longitudinally, an- terior extremity curved ventrally. Nucleus subcentral; fe contractile vacuole posterior, often leaving several small Hi vacuoles after contraction. Length jo*, ufariooa. IB.4S9. Wttammri+m, x sue. (Afuc Ednwadson.) CILIATE PROTOZOA (INFUSORIA) 279 74 (73) Body very flexible and changeable in shape. Ovate, covered with fine cilia, with a long bristle extending from the posterior border. Mouth ventral with a vibratile and retractile hood- like velum Saprophilus Stokes. Representative species Saprophilus agilaius Stokes 1887. Body twice as long as broad, compressed, obliquely truncate in front ; cilia very short and fine. Body longitudinally striate. Nucleus sub- central. Contractile vacuole posterior. Length of body 35 to 45 p. Infusions containing animal matter. Fig. 490. Sopropkilus agitatus. x 300. (After Stoke*. ) 75 (72) Mouth terminal with a delicate membrane. Body ovate, elastic; anterior extremity obliquely truncate. . . Trichoda M tiller. Representative species Trichoda pur a Ehrenberg 1838. Length 40 n. Often found abundantly in old infusions of pond water. Swift moving, usually rolling on its long axis. Fig. 491. Trichoda pur a. macn, macronucleus. X 400. (After Kent.) 76 (71) 77 (78) Two membranes present 77 Body elongated, rounded in front, contracting into a tail behind. One side somewhat flattened, the other convex. Mouth triangular, near the anterior end DaUasia Stokes. Representative species DaUasia frontata Stokes 1886. Body five times as long as broad, ventral surface convex, dorsal slightly concave; taper- '•--■- «sr"1 -•"=' -s^-^-*. - *?* Posteriorly to a retractile tail-like prolonga- * ;rai Aloutn no: posterior ti the euiudir of the body &u toS' Not Hunuundo: by ;. wric or gettUnou--< shealii jL_ no i,gi ■ PcriBunnf oblique, ttutiy eiougateL. siigou> liai "*■ boLr. encu- or BiiRiiuv truncate*! it. iron: by ti short pnarynx, ciuaituL regular P SepWBeE.ta.tJvt; speck; /'jraraurtiun. ..^.uadtin 91 (oo; Pcnsiome no; obliqut 9; 02 vp7 With oni- or more membrane:, well developed 111 the perisionn . 9;. 93 iQ4i Peris totm- very broau am. conspicuous, occupyttjp Lh-, enttrt right Mil! Bociy ova., Uaiieueti vcntxaliy. convex doraaliy. an- iens; et)j obiiqti; posterior cut. acmi A lui: 01" ioot; ciii" eitenuf iron) uu. posteiio; eni. Lcmliddion Peny. c species. Lenujoilion btdiinum Peny 1S40. I Nucleus cioujumm. curved m tin- postern: re^i:::. n: tisctiic vacuole opoosiu- uit qucieu- Wuei, stimuiat itpidiv baLfcwaid rotating ou its tout an.-. Length 5. 94 V95- Peristome 1101 oroau ami conspicuous. . . .95 95 (96 Without -o. uuig, poster it ir Drisu-. 1'erisuunt parallci to th< nghi Siut win. a utrgt projecting memurant bociy aval, flat- tened uorso-ventraliy. Cilia very ionc.. FiaiTotuma liujardin. Representative specie:. I'icuroncm^ thryscuis Ehreobcrc. i$,iS. * .elat-Iikt.. Nucleus centra!, ijistractik ',3.;u:ik. aiitcrinr. Length ;j to i.'j t Fresh »atc: Stukc; recognize- lira separate peii- fra. Uutnetiautntidiun:, with iunc, sctost brisLle.- amc-up thtL cih;. jm tlit wholf liodj . am: BoiknyiUtm... with a long tennina] tui: ji cili.; Butschii jjUlc- then. im::. under PJowobcthj 382 FRESH WATER BIOLOGY 96 (95) Like Plautmcma but with a shorter peristome and one or more long posterior bristles. Cyclidium Ehrenbeig. Representative species. . . . Cyclidium glaucoma Ehrenberg 1838. Fig. soi . Cydiiimm iIiwhh. (After E. 97 (92) Without an oral membrane. Body ovate; mouth ventral at the posterior end of a longitudinal groove which bears on its right-hand border a row of large, arcuately curved setose cilia Himinfehing in length toward the mouth. A long bristle extending from the posterior end of the body. Cledoclema Stokes. Representative species. . . . Cledoclcma aasnthoaypla Stokes 1884. Often very abundant among Ircsh water algae. TrichocyMs ut numerous and very stout. Length of body is* no. 501. OfttertcuM sc X87J. (After Stoket.) (89) With a lorica or gelatinous sheath. 99 99 (too) Enclosed in a lorica. Animal similar to Pleuronema. Lorica oblong- ovate, hyaline, with tapering extremities, the terminal aper- tures about half as wide as the center.of the sheath. Animal very active within the lorica Calyploiricka Phillips. Representative species. . . . Calyptotricha inkaesa Stokes 1885. . CthfUidm Mwn, ; ico. [After Ke&kott.) 100 (09) Enclosed in a gelatinous sheath to which the animal is not attached. Body ovate; mouth ventral, at the end of a groove on the margin of which is a series of strong cilia. A tuft of long, curved cilia extends from the anterior extremity. Cyrlolophoiis Stokes. des. . . . Cyrtolopkosis mucicola Stokes 1885. A itrange form not uncommon among al«se. When the animal comes to rest, a transparent, Kicky substance items to be exuded from the body which becomes granular, due to excreta, bacteria and other foreign bodies which adhere to it- When disturbed the animal glides out of its covering and another if Constructed. A temporary colony may be built up by the adherence of several gelatinous ""'l". Length of body 15 u. F10. so*. CjtHUthiUmKlaU. X ■». lAtlar StcfcaO Month at the posterior end of the body let CILIATE PROTOZOA (INFUSORIA) 283 » (103) Body flattened, oval, with spiral furrows. Peristome with a vi- brating membrane posterior leading into the mouth. A tuft of long bristles at the posterior end of the body. Cinetochiium Perty. Representative species. CinetochUum margaritaantm Ehrenberg 1838. . OmteckUim martarilacmm. x 500. (Aim- BUtschli.) 103(101) Body nearly oval, ventral surface flat, ciliated; dorsal surface curved, with three longitudinal grooves. Mouth posterior on the left side, with a small, vibrating membrane. Microtkorax Engelmann. Representative species. . . Microtkorax sulcatus Engelmann 1802. jfiSggJgj^ Associated with the preceding specici Length 40 to 60 «. ^JP"'Wf Fig. jotj. Uicrollurax mfcoMu. x jio. (Alter Kent.) «4 (3) An adoral zone present consisting of cilia fused together into mem- branellae Order Heterotricha . . 105 ioj (120) With a uniform covering of cilia 106 106 (115) Peristome not confined to the anterior border of the body. . 107 '07(112) Peristome a long, narrow furrow 108 108 (in) With an undulating membrane 100 iog (no) Body flattened, narrow and hook-like in front. Mouth near the middle of the body at the end of the narrow peristome. Membrane 11 at on the left wall of the peristome, on the right an undulating membrane. Colored. . Blepharisma Perty. Representative species. . . Blepharisma lateritia Ehrenberg 1838. : r8o. (Alter Stein.) 284 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY no (109) Body spiral, cylindrical, somewhat pointed at both ends, but con- tractile; peristome spiral with the mouth near the middle of the body. Meinbrandlae on the left side of the peri- stome, a membrane on the right side. M do pus Claparede and Lachmann. Representative species. Metopus sigmoides MiiUer 1786. Cilia usually longs' at the posterior end. A mats of dark pigment gran- ules in the anterior extremity. Nucleus oval, central: contractile vacuole posterior. Length too to too ., At the bottom of aafnatona, Mtlnpidti aiuminaiis Stokes differs from the above species in the posterior, tail-like prolongation from which extend a Dumber of long bristles. It is also Fig. 508. UOofm lirawisti. c Without an undulating membrane. Body greatly elongated, cyl- indrical, contractile. Peristome reaching to the middle of the body. Strong membra nellae on the left side of the peri- stome. Body spirally striated. . . Spirostomum Ehrenberg. Representative species. . Spirostomum ambiguum Ehrenberg 1835. Body ten to fifteen tunes 1 broad, but readily contracting in . . spiral body. Nucleus roonilifot m. Con- tractile vacuole posterior, extending for- ward as s canal. Extended body may reach 2800 * in length. ~ aquatic plants. toasbort 112 (107) Peristome a broad triangular area, deeply sunken. . 113 (114) With an undulating membrane on the right side of the peristome. Body cylindrical or purse-shaped, sometimes contractile. Peristome broad in front extending one-third the length of the body Condylosloma Dujardin. Representative spedes. . . . . Condylosloma palms Muller 1786. Body broadly ovate, widest posteriorly. ...trading about half the length of the bot, . _ _ tractile vacuole irregular. Lengtb 100 «. Stagnant water. Fio. Jio. CaUjUilom* fains, awn. d ■;LA.T. -tM-UtUfD Zl. .. litorSU . -Lt . ^ f 286 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 122 (123) Equatorial region of the body bearing a circle of long, fine bristles. Body spheroidal with a spiral wreath of strong cilia about the anterior border. Mouth anterior, marginal. Halteria Dujardin. Representative species Halteria grandinella Muller 1786. Nucleus round, central, with contractile vacuole near. Moving by a rotary motion accompanied by sudden leaps. Length 25 m. Common in pond water. Fig. 514. Halteria grandmeOa. cv, contractile vacuole; mac*, macronucleus. X 400. (After Kent.) 123 (122) Without long, fine bristles, otherwise very similar to Halteria. Strombidium Clapar&Le and Lachmann. Representative species. . Strombidium claparidii Kent 1882. -cv Body somewhat elongate, tapering posteriorly. Length 80 *. water. Pond Fig. 515. Strombidium claparidii. a, contractile vacuole; n, nucleus. X ioo. (After Kent.) 124 (121) Body in a lorica 125 jk 125 (126) Lorica mucilaginous, attached to some support. Body ovate to pyriform, attached in the lorica by a pedicel. Mouth ante- rior, surrounded by a wreath of long cilia. Tintinnidium Kent. Representative species. . Tintinnidium fluviatilis Steih 1867. The lorica has an uneven surface, frequently with incorporated foreign particles. Body sometimes attached to the bottom, sometimes to the side of the lorica. Length of lorica 125 m. Attached to aquatic plants. Fio. 516. Tintinnidium fluriaHUs. X aco. (After Entx.) 126 (125) Lorica chitinous; otherwise as Tintinnidium. . . Tintinnus FoL 127 (2) Body not uniformly covered with cilia 128 128 (169) Cilia setae-like, usually limited to the ventral surface. Dorsal surface sometimes with bristles. Body flattened. Order Hypotricha . . 129 129 (130) Ventral side uniformly riLiate, except sternum; a group of stronger cilia behind peristome and near posterior end. Trickogaster Sterki. 130 (129) Ventral surface not uniformly ciliate 131 131 (166) Many border cilia , 132 132(157) Ventral cilia numerous, in rows. 133 133 (152) Ventral cilia bristle-like 134 134 (x43) Usually more than two rows of ventral cilia 135 135(140) Five or more rows of ventral cilia 136 CILIATE PROTOZOA (INFUSORIA) 287 136 (137) Peristome with an undulating membrane, body flexible. Three or more frontal styles. Five to twelve anal styles in an oblique row extending to the left. Peristome an elongated triangle. Urostyla Ehienberg. Representative species Urostyla Irkhogasler Stokes 1885. Ventral surface with closely approri mated rows of fine alia. Anal styles tea or twelve in number. Nucleus single, according to Stokes. Contractile vacuole single, to the left of the peristome. Length 150 to 300 a, Vegetable infusions. Bemkiptoslyla Stokes agrees with Urostyla, but (After _ Connloundtwonucleiinhisforniandstatesthat Conn.) it may be a variety of Urmtyta grandis Ehreoberg. 137 (136) Peristome without an undulating membrane 138 138 (139) Elongate, rounded at both extremities, not flexible; five nearly straight rows of ventral cilia. Peristome on the right-hand margin, extending back of the middle, with a row of long cilia or membranellae. Nuclei four to six in number. Homoslyla Conn. Representative species Homoslyla etlipika Conn 1005. 139 (138) Kidney-shaped, with six oblique rows of ventral cilia, the posterior row the stronger. No frontal, ventral, or anal styles. Border cilia forming a complete row around the periphery. Peri- stome reaching to the middle of the body. External para- sites on Hydra Kerona Ehrenberg. Representative species Kerona pedicidus MUller 1786. H° {135) Less than five rows of ventral cilia 141 141 (14a) Body elongated anteriorly into a neck; rounded behind, very con- tractile. Peristome narrow, extending to or beyond the middle. Membranellae long. Two or three oblique rows of ventral setae. No frontal or anal styles. Stkhotrkha Perty. Representative species Stichotricha secunda Perty 1849. Marginal setae long and slender. Nuclei two, with the contractile vacuole between. Often a mucilaginous sheath is secreted by the animal, from which it may project the anterior half of the body or may entirely vacate it and swim freely in water. Length about 300 m. Among sphagnum. Fn. 510. SHckelriika ucumia. X 1)5- (After Conn.) 288 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 142 (141) 143 (i34) 144 (145) 145 (i44) 146 (151) 147 (150) 148 (149) 149 (148) 150 (146) 151 (i47) Body elliptical to ovate, flexible. Three unequal rows of ventral cilia; frontal styles numerous. No anal styles. Marginal setae uninterrupted Eschaneustyla Stokes. Representative species. . . Eschaneustyla brachytona Stokes 1886. Anterior extremity slightly curved to the left with a con- striction beneath the front border. Frontal styles about twenty-five in oblique rows. Nucleus not observed. Con- tractile vacuole canal-like along the left-hand border. Length about 200 p. Standing water with dead leaves. Fig. 521. Eschaneustyla brachytona. X 200. (After Stokes.) One or two rows of ventral cilia 144 One row of about seven large ventral cilia. Long border and anal cilia ' Balladina Kowalewsky. Two rows of ventral cilia; body not elongated in front. . . 146 Body prolonged posteriorly into a tail-like process 147 Body not flask-shaped 148 No anal styles; body narrow, elongated, sometimes contractile. The border setae pushed in on the ventral surface. UroUptus Stein. Representative species UroUptus musculus Mliller 1786. Body slightly elastic; tail-like process short, conicaL An- terior end curved slightly to the left, the posterior to the right Frontal styles three or four. Length 200 n. Among aquatic plants. Fie. 522. UroUptus musculus. X 150. (After Conn.) With a row of seventeen anal styles upon the left side. In other respects like UroUptus Amphisia Sterki. Body flask-shaped, otherwise very similar to UroUptus. Platytrichotus Stokes. Representative species. . Platytrichotus opisthobolus Stokes 1886. Frontal styles five. Nucleus single, posterior. Contractile vacuole single. The posterior tip of the body is changeable in form. It may be bifid, truncate, or rounded. Long hispid bristles are developed from the dorsal surface. Length 190 tu Among sphagnum. Fie. 523. Platytrichotus opisthobolus. X 200. (After Stakes.) Body not prolonged into a tail-like process. Elongated, rounded at both ends. With two uninterrupted rows of cilia on the ventral surface Holosticha Wrzesniowski. Representative species Holosticha vcrnalis Stokes 1887. Frontal styles five or six. Anal styles from five to eight, usually branched. Dorsal bristles numerous. Nuclei two; contractile vacuole central Length 190 *. Shallow pools, observed with algae. Fie. 524. EoUsHUka wmaHs. x its. (After Coon.) '■or***** "tL~» 152 (133) 153 (156) Ventral cilia setae-like, of ten in interrupted rows 153 Ventral setae in more than one row 154 C1UA.TE PROTOZOA (INFUSORIA) aB« *3* (J53) Body elongate-oval, with rive id eight frontal styles : ventral setae usually arranged in two or more rows, the inneT rows having but tew aeiae. Ana] styles rive or six. two of which are near the posterior border i'icurotruiu; Stein. fteprtsemativt'speaes i'teutBtriuu: Umi^tUk: Ehrenberf 1S3S. taagular m outlint with slightly rounded ends. Thret or four oblique row? of ventral seiac running irom left tii right, and three row? parallel to the peristome border. Anal styles five or six. Border cilia uninterrupted. Qnyciiodromm Stein, itative species. . Onycitoaromu.' grMtdis Stein iSju. OnycMoaiamopsts lieziiis Stokes difiers irom Steins lonn in naving j soil, uexibie body FlO. 53b- tjfcJHMdr— MIJ frAIUU. X US- lAJIr-j Qhul.I 6 ('53.1 Ventral setae in one oblique row. Body elongate-oval. Five or sis frontal styles and as many anal. Peristome triangular, curved, with an undulating membrane. Gastrostyh Engelmann. Representative species. . . GtutrostyL: sicinii F.ngelmann 186;. Body evenly roundn] 3: each eitremily. Thm very ir. ht. oblique to». do: projecting beyond thi border. Nuclei iour. Contractile vacuole near the middle of bit body on the iefi skit. Length 1J0 u. Fresh water Fie. 517. Gaitrostyia lUmii. X 13 j. lAIict LdinonusoE 7(132) Ventral cilia lew, not in rows 15ft 8 (165) Not produced posteriorly into a tail-like process 150 g (162) Body flexible 160 o (161) Border cilia uninterrupted. Narrow, elliptical, rounded at both ends. Five ventral setae and hve anal styles. No caudal bristles. Inner right wall ol" peristome bent toward outer left wall. Oxytricha Ehrenberp. Representative species. . . . Oxytricka pcli'umelia Mullet 1786. Marginal setae set well in on the ventre] surface. Anal styles arisirw: neat the posterior border and e\- -^.L~ ,~r ~-<^'V^j" ^-J^tS^ tending nearly their entire: length beyond it. Nuclei ^Eag^Ij^*jj£!^&«f twu. Contractile vacuole on the ielt side. Length So c jig. QntrkiaJtUiamiUa. x jjj. OpisUulridu Rent resembles Oxylritlu in general (Altai Cam-) rh.^nrriain but has three caudal setae. 290 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 161 (160) Bonier cilia interrapled at the posterior end. Frontal styles, tigh t or ten. Five ventral sets* and five anal styles. No caudal bristles. Dorsal hispid setae usually present. Tatkysoma Stakes. Representative spedes- . . . Tackytoma parristyla Stokes 1887. Body mitow sntegody fanning ■ neck-Eke ration. Ten terioriy. Doml ««*t minuts. Styles m tbis Harm tit. very Fb. £•«- Tactyumt fnii&a. X tso. CAtter State*.) 163 (159) Body not flexible. 163 163 (164) With caudal setae. Elongate-oval in shape with eight frontal, five ventral setae, and five anal styles. Caudal setae usually three, long. Peristome triangular, with an TiTv4nl»ting mem- brane; the inner wall bent away from the outer wall. Stytonydua Stein. Representative species. . . . Stytonyckia notophtxa Stokes 1885. Front bonier obfiqudy mmatc on the left sde. Peristome ntendrag neatly to the noddle of the body. Caadml xtar Nudei two. Length 110 In 160 p. Pond Fk. sjo. StyUmyM* —Ufitn. a, omit notik y-hdIe ; m 164 {163) Without caudal setae; with inner wall of peristome bent toward the outer wall. like Stytonyckia in other respects. Histrio Sterki. Representative species Hislrio tretiusticiu Stokes 1887. 165 (158) Produced posteriorly into a tail-like process. Body flexible, with eight ventral setae and five anal styles at the base of the tail. Urosoma Kowalewsky. Representative species. Urosoma sp. OLIATC PROTOZOA (INFUSORIA) 2tJI No caudal setae. Body rounded or oval, dorsal suriacc usually lunowed. Peristome in the posterior region in the kft- lateral border, its right border prolonged into a triangular. lip-like extension. Usually three frontal styles, iour or five ventral aetae. and five or more anal styles. Aspidiscti Ehrenberg. RepMaeniativc species. . Aspidisca costal,: Dujardin 1S41. Nucleus id-Like. 168 (16'/: Caudal setae usually tour in number Body oval, with dorsal convex surface furrowed. Peristome broad, on the left side, extending backward to or beyond the middle of the body. Frontal styles six or eight, a lew scattered ventral setae, and rive anal styles fyfflnfot Stein. Representative species Expiates cnaron Mflller 1786. Frontal styles seven : ventral acta? three. ^, Ljik: IWJ'W deusband-UbL. LeDjrth 80 «. Pond water, iering from Eupialcs patella Ebrenbcrg b size and (n-ealer number of frontal style: L fit. SiJ hMpiaici that™. Ventral vi in process ol divulon a, contractile vacuole; 1 macronuckus. X 300- (After K~~~ w 160 (i>8) Cilia usually limited to the adoral zone, sometimes with additional rings of cilia. Body cup-like or cylindrical Order Peritridia 170 170 (1931 No lorica present 171 171 lieloj Without a stalk 173 172 (i75l With a permanent secondary ring of cilia at the posterior end enclosing an adhesive disk 173 173 (174) Body short, barrel-shaped, with the posterior end discoidal, the inner border of which is supported by a horny ring, the peripheral zone oi which is radially striated and denticu- late; the outer border surrounded by a wreath of cilia. Adoral zone extends spirally around the flattened end. Mouth eccentric. Parasitic iorms. . . TrUhadina Stein. HspresenLative specie; Trichodiiu pedicuius Ehrenberg iS»o. Commonl.i observed Kfiding utj and down on the tentacles of Iresh-water Bydn. Height of body 70 * rlt. 53:- Jrtt*v4iiu fediaatti. lndniduak>adnereDt U tentacle 01 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY I'/S (i72) Without a permanent secondary ring of cilia 176 176(177) With two rings of stiff, spinous processes. . . Hastatdla Erlanger. Representative species Hastatdla radians Erlanger 1890. Flo. 536. Bmlaldla radian 177(176) Without rings of stiff, spinous processes 178 178 (179) Posterior end elongated, usually attached; peristome slightly de- veloped. Ciliated disk small. . . . Scyphidia Lachmann. Representative species Scyphidia fnmenleUU Kent 1882. R \ longitudinally striated. On water snails. Flo. 537- ScypUdi* frtmaUUii. a. contractile vacuo!*; m. Gerda Claparecle and Lachmann. Representative species. Gerda sigtnoides Kellicott 1885. Anterior region narrowed, usually curved. Surface finely striated trans- versely. Nucleus not observed. Length, extended, 150 n. Adherent to Iresli-water plants. Flo. jjB. IMi liimaUti. X 160. (After Kellicott 0 180(171) With a stalk. . . . 181 (186) Stalk unbrancbed. . CILiATt SROTOZaA (INFUSORIA 2Q3 :*&2 tX$3 Stalk retracrik Jioay beli-shapeu . cuud;- oiteu ringed A series o: stronc ciu*. encircle the central elevated ciliary disk. .Mouxi eccenxxi: .betweei tht peristomt am. ciiian disk. Nucleus bantHikL, curvec 1 orticeli: Ehrenberg. sntauvt* specie.^ Voniodi^ campanul Ehrenberg 1&3S. Booy oroacii> campanula!-. , greath dilate., antenorh . suriact smooth. Stall: thkK, nw c: six time* tru* iciyrt.\ o; the bod\ Lndopiasm often ■opaque witii granule, .uenjrtii of bod 15c ^ Pona water Soda. Mw. s 30 •- 1 oruccuu uimpanuu vAlter kern. 163 U82 Stalk not retractile 1S4 1S4 (185 With an operculum Body ellipsoidal to ovate; the ciiian disk upon a stalk, dosing like a ikl Nudeus snor; or band-liki . Pyxidium Ken; Jtepresentauvc specie-. Pyxidium ramosum Stoker 1887. Body vasiiorm, wioest centrally, scriace smoot:.. Ciliary disk slightly exserted witn two circles of long tuu- tili« Peaicr. very short Length o! oouy about xoo „. Poric. wate: on rooUei> oi Ltmn<* H«. 54-. ?yxitiiun> ramoiurr. \ 33=,. 1 Alter uonn. 185 (184* Without an operculum. Body elongate-ovate with suriacv usu- ally transversely striata stalk shor: . JRjiabdostyia Ren:. Representative specie.- . Ejiabdostyui venudis Stoker 1887. Bod> widest centralis, constricted below the peristomt- border. Ciiian circle* two. Nucleic band-likt. Length 50 ~ Attached to ^ycfaps and Cypris iii earls spring. Ho. 541. Kjuriawsiyid vcmaii.. ex, contractile vacuuu. x boo. (Alter Stokes. ■ 186 (181) Stalk branched 187 294 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 187 (190) Sulk retractile. 188 8 (189) Zooids contracting independently. Bodies bell shaped. Central muscle interrupted at the union of the stalk and the branch. Ciliated spiral forming about one and a half circles. Nu- cleus horseshoe-shaped Carchetium Ehrenberg. Representative species. . . . Carckerivm pciypinum Kent 1883. Colonies often reaching ■ height of one-eighth of an inch. At- tached to the under surfaces of stones or floating sticks in fresh- water pools or running streams. The colony may be the temporary host of Ampkiltptm mcttafii. Length of zooids Some interesting work baa been done on the nucleus of this species by Miss M. Greenwood. (The Journal of Physiology, Vol. XX, pp. 417-454.) It was found that the normal activity causes a drain on die organism which, if not offset by sufficient repair due to the lack of nutrition, results in the more fluid char acter of the macrosomes of the nucleus. 180 (188) Zooids contracting together. Bodies very similar to Carchesium but central muscle continuous, causing all of the zooids to contract together Zoothamnium Stein. Representative species. . . . Zoothamnium adamsi Stokes 1885. Bodies about twice aa long as broad, tapering to the pedicel; finely striated transversely. Length of tooids 60 11. Reported from Niagara River. Attached to too (187) Stalk not retractile. "7E.MTF 'l.T/.W/i-.-i arLA»7 4\ 3E ' 11.12.1 ;fk1l££ J .i»l!-.«nari?r! . -ut^h.- ••• ■»•>«-• »-. ..).. . ^-.*..^. _, — *..* * •^, SenT&iiiY* - rw»r i**c ■ **"t l«V*»«*P^ • »r-«- *-** ■■».»• . .T J. ■■ t'ttAA . *-« - . .. • •■ ll • »^4 aW^ A*» ■ * l«« P* ^ _1* *^ ^^ » , <■■*.*■ ■ B --*V, .. .« » . • .-1. » -« .« . _ a - « " *.*.♦•. * „: i i-— «; ^., i 9 J" \t\ uilfi*!- •*! l«->tlfO.^TV »\f-«l ^ »• .f»t..l ,*»*«„> 1 ~. ..w ~ «V ! «.J -i *... A . .1 5» - I ...! I ...H. I 1 *r" -*v *' 1* - _ * 4 4 . - -. t .-• ... .« . ... 4. -«.. "■4 •• 1*l- «■ • - « ^ 4 * ' I "■ • ' » • .1 14 4 f-. -.1 -I. - I — .'A*T -• .. .. .t «» - — 296 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 195 (196) * # (i9S) 197 (194) 198 (205) 199 (202) 200 (201) Animals growing in clusters, attached or free-floating, enclosed in a mucilaginous jelly. Zooids attached to a branching stalk, each secreting a jelly-like tube which may remain distinct or fuse with its neighbor forming a jelly mass. Zooids similar in anatomy to Vorticella. Usually green. Ophrydiutn Ehrenberg. Representative species. . . Ophrydiutn eichhornii Ehrenberg 1838. Bodies very plastic, finely striate transversely. Clusters hemispherical, of closely approximated individuals. Some colonies may include as many as one hundred zooids, although this large size is uncommon. Division of the body has been observed to take place in a transverse direction, which is a rare occurrence in this family. The anterior portion swims away and settles down to form a new colony, or probably conjugates with some fixed zooid. Length of expanded zooids 250 to 500 it. Fresh water. Fig. 546. Opkrydium eichhornii. cv, contractile vacuole; macn, macronucleus. X 50. (After Kent.) Animals solitary; similar in other respects to Ophrydiutn. Ophridinopsis Kent. Lorica chitinous 198 Lorica not decumbent 199 Lorica sessile 200 Lorica with a hinge-like valve that closes the opening when the body retracts. Lorica elongate, subcylindrical. Body elongate with ciliary system as Vorticella. Thuricola Kent. Representative species Thuricola valvata Wright 1858. Lorica four or five times as long as broad, with the valve at some dis- tance from the aperture. Length of lorica 120*1- Fresh water; also reported from salt water. In Thuricolopsis Stokes the lorica is provided with a support for the valve. Otherwise as Thuricola. Fig. 547- Thuricola vahata. X 150. (After Kent.) 201 (200) Lorica without a valve. Representative species. Vaginicola Clapar£de and Lachmann. Vaginicola leptosoma Stokes 1885. Lorica broadly vasiform, twice as long as broad, inflated posteriorly. Zooid elongate, projecting one-third its length beyond the lorica. Peristome twice as broad as the body. Surface transversely striate. Length of lorica 120 m. Pond water. Fig. 54S. Vapmcola Uptosoma. «?, contractile vacuole. X no. (After Stokes.) 202 (199) Lorica with a pedicel 243 CILIATE PROTOZOA (INFUSORIA) 297 203 (204) Tfldcn- Without an operculum. Zooid like Thuricola; adherent to the bottom of the lorica in a sessile manner or united by a con- tinuation of the supporting pedicel. . Cothurnia Ehrenberg. Representative species Cothurnia pkctostyla Stokes 1885. Lorica curved, two and one-half times as long as broad, finely striate longitudinally, also with transverse markings. Divided posteriorly into two uneaual parts by a curved, chitinous partition to which the zooid is attached. Zooid not protruding much beyond the aperture when extended; transversely striate. Length of lorica 110/u. Marsh water. Fig. 540. Cothurnia pleciostyh. cv, contractile vacuole; macn, macrooudeus. X 250. (After Stokes.) 204 (203) With an operculum of chitin developed beneath the peristome and closing the lorica when the animal is retracted. Pyxicola Kent. Representative species Pyxicola carteri Kent 1882. Lorica subcylindrical, three times as long as broad, anterior margin slightly oblique, walls undulate. Pedicel very short. Zooid extending beyond the aperture. Length of lorica 00 m- Fresh water. Fie. 550. Pyxicola carteri. X 270. (After Kent.) 205 (198) 206 (207) Lorica decumbent 206 Animal adherent to the posterior extremity of the lorica. Platycola Kent. Representative species Platycola decutnbens Kent 1882. Lorica oval, depressed. Zooid extending considerably beyond the aperture, the exserted portion being at right angles to the portion within the lorica. Length of lorica 00 ik. Fresh water. Fig. 551. Platycola decumbens. X 200. (After Kent.) 207 (206) Animal adherent to one side of the lorica which often has a valvular aperture. Zooid adherent to the margin of the aperture. Lagenophrys Stein. Representative species. . . . Lagenophrys vaginocola Stein 1851. Lorica elongate with two semilunar, lip-like processes partially closing the aperture. The processes are raised when the zooid is extended and lowered when it is retracted. Zooid adherent by its narrow peristome to the edge of the aperture. Length of lorica 70 n. Fresh water. Stylohedra Kellicott differs from Lagenophrys in having an erect lorica with a pedicel. Fio. 552. Lagenophrys vaginocola. X 210.. (After Maupas.) FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 909 309(310) Tentacles branched. Animals solitary, sessile, discoklal. or sub- spberical, with the surface of the integument indurated. Tentacles flexible, non-con tractile, finely perforate at their ex- tremities. Increasing by gemmation. . Dendtoconuies Stein- Representative species. . Dendrocomeles paradoxus Stein 1851. 'tentacles equal id length to the diameter of the body, Dual!)- bvt or la* in Dumber. The distal terminations of the tentacles are capable of great cipanvon and. by means of theje. other Protozoa art captured and the pio- toprasm of (heir bodies absorbed into the body of the host. Nucleii* (ubtriarujurax. Diameter of body 80 ji. Frnli water, tometimea attached to Gammanu f%la. a iresh- water shrimp. Tie. S£3. Dnirtcrmda fndtoa. X 1J0. f Altar »ein.) aio (309) Tentacles un branched, contractile. 311 (3 zo) Without a lorica Je an (213) Withastalk. Body spherical or pear-shaped. Tentacles knobbed, scattered, or in groups. In some species the animal may become detached from the stalk and live a free life. Podobkrvq Ehrenberg. Representative species Podopkryafixa Miiiler 1786. Stalk slender but rigid. Tentacles slender, scattered over the surface of the body, usually not Longer Chan the diameter of the body. Nu- cleus oval, central. Contractile vacuoles often I wo. Diameter of body ss»- Attached to aquat- 313(312) Without a stalk 314 314 (215) Forming colonies. Animals fused, forming an erect, branching colony. Several colonies may be connected by a creeping stolon. Suctorial, capitate tentacles borne on the ends of the branches Dendrosoma Ehrenberg. Representative species. . . Dendrosoma radiant Ehrenberg 1838. a number of erect branches .1 branched. Nudeus ribbon- 0 tbe branches. Contractile vacuoles nu- _ . of colony 1000 to 1500 *. Attached to aquatic plants. Height of c 115 (314) Not forming colonies. ai6 CHJATE PKOTOZOA (INFUSORIA) 299 216 (217) Tentacle one. consisting of a single, movable anterior process. Parasitic on Cyciops . . Rhyncheta Zenker. 217 (2t6) Tentacles numerous , 218 S (219) Body spherical, never fixed; knobbed tentacles arising from all sides. ..... Sphaergpkrya Claparede and Lachmann. Representative species . . . Sphaeropkrya magna Maupas 1881, equal in k-nprlt: II been observed to take pL of body 40 11. Fresh watt 219 (218) Body irregular; knobbed tentacles arising from the lobes of the margin of the body. Attached by the broad, lower surface. Trichopkrya Claparede and Lachmann. Representative species. . . Trichopkrya sinuosa Stokes 1886. Body flattened with iobed margins. Usually not more than five lusters of tentacles. Nucleus hranchrd. Contractile vacuoles lumeruus. Length 55 «. Attached to aquatic plants. F1G-SS7- Tridufkrya sauuit. X u;. lAilia Stakes.) 220(211) Withalorica 221 221 {224) Lorica sessile 222 222 {223) Usually cup-shaped or subspherical ; tentacles suctorial, sometimes in groups Solenopkrya Claparede and Lachmann. Representative species Solenopkrya pern Stokes 1885. Lorica irregularly cubical or satchel-shaped, hyaline, widest at the base 01 attachment, narrowing anteriorly, with the sides somewhat concave. Zooid oval, not attached to Iwttom of lorica. Tentacles arising from the entire frontal border. Two individuals often in the same lorica. Height ol lorica 40 11. Width and length nearly the same us height. Attached to aquatic plants in standing water. Fie. sj8. Stlenafkiya ptra. X 115. (After Stokes.) 223 (222) Posterior end of the body prolonged into a projection. Attached to Epistylis. Two to five long, simple tentacles. Urnuia Claparede and Lachmann. 3 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 224 (221) Lorica with a stalk. Body may or may not fiM the lorica. The end of the lorica may be open or provided with slit-like openings through which the tentacles extend. Tentacles suctorial, knobbed, scattered, or in groups. Acineta Ehrenberg. Representative species Acineta fluviatilis Stokes 1885. Lorica subtriangular, compressed, very delicate, widest an- teriorly, tapering to the attachment with the stalk. Stalk shorter than the lorica. Two anterolateral openings for the tentacles. Zooid usually filling the lorica. Length of lorica 40 to 80 m- Attached to aquatic plants. Fig. 559. Acineta JluviaUlis. X315. (After Stokes.) IMPORTANT REFERENCES ON MASTTGOPHORA AND INFUSORIA See list of general works under Sarcodina, p. 236; also the following: Dangeard, P. A. 1902. Recherches sur les Eugleniens. Le Botaniste, 8:97-357; 4 pL, 53 figs. Kent, S. 1880-188 2. A Manual of the Infusoria. 3 vols. London. Kofoid, C. A. 1898. Plankton Studies, II. Bull. 111. State Lab. Nat Hist., 5:273-300; 12 pi. 1899. Plankton Studies, III. Bull. 111. State Lab. Nat. Hist, 5:419- 440; ipl Palmer, T. C. 1905. Delaware Valley Forms of Trachelomonas. Proc. Acad. Nat Sci., Phila., 57: 665-675; 1 pi. PdWERS, J. H. 1007. New Forms of Volvox. Trans. Amer. Micr. Soc. 27:123-149; 4 pi. 1908. Further Studies on Volvox, with Descriptions of Three New Species. Trans. Amer. Micr. Soc., 28: 141 -176; 4 pi. Roux, J. 1901. Faune Infusorienne des eaux stagnantes des environs de GeneVe, 149 pp., 8 pi., 4to., Geneve. Stokes, A. C. 1888. A Preliminary Contribution Toward a History of the Fresh Water Infusoria of the United States. Jour. Trenton Nat Hist Soc., 1:71-344; 13 PL CHAPTER X THE SPONGES (PORIFERA) By EDWARD POTTS,* Media, Pa. The zoophytes or plant animals of the old zoologists or, as they are now more correctly designated, the separate groups of sponges and coelenterates, are represented in the fresh waters of North America through a very narrow range both of genera and species. Sponges alone constitute the topic of this chapter. The student of fresh-water sponges must not expect to find them resembling in ap- pearance the familiar forms of commerce, which in fact are exclu- sively of marine origin. Nor should he look for shapeless masses of jelly; such may be found, but they are not sponges. Yet as animal organisms, sponges, whether fresh-water or marine, are essentially alike. Infinitely variable in form and external appearance and in the character and constituents of their skeletal structure, the vital parts that have clothed them, or do still clothe them if examined in life, are composed alike of protoplasm or sarcode. This forms the delicate tissues, structureless except when viewed through powerful lenses, and builds up the inert framework whether it con- sists of tough elastic fibers, as in the commercial sponge, or is the fairy-like structure of flint or lime belonging to other sponges found in the ocean, or forms skeletons, as in our fresh-water forms so far as known, always of silex. The active life work of sponges Jt is impossible to see with the naked eye and very difficult to study even under the microscope. Certain collared cells by means of waving flagella feed the sponge, reject intrusive matter, and create The death of Mr. Potts just after the first manuscript of the chapter had been submitted laid upon me the duty of bringing it into conformity with the other chapters °t the book without his help. I have endeavored to do this with the least possible change from the original. To make sure that no error was committed in the process I secured the aid of Dr. N. Annandale, Calcutta, India, for whose kind assistance I *& deeply indebted. For the present form of the key Mr. Potts is in no wise responsible. 1 am also indebted to Professor Frank Smith for valuable unpublished data in regard to distribution.— Henry B. Ward. 301 302 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY the currents that traverse the canals of the body. While the action of these flagella is invisible to the unaided eye, their effect may be seen if some finely divided carmine is added to the water. The particles are sucked into the little pores over the surface and after long wandering, having proved indigestible, are ejected from the larger orifices. The skeleton of these siliceous sponges, the only part that can be easily preserved for study, is composed of spicules or little needles of hydrated silica (opal), averaging about one one-hundredth of an inch in length, fasciculated or bound together side by side, but break- ing joints, to form threads of considerable thickness along the princi- pal lines of the sponge growth but thinner in the connecting links that make the interspaces. The binding material along these threads is not strong and its composition is not certainly known. The terminal spicules projecting around the sponge uphold the filmy dermis a little above the firmer body of the sponge. Where the larger channels unite to form the efferent osteoles the out- flowing currents stretch this dermis into little cylindrical tubes or towers, technically called chimneys, with terminal openings through which one may often see rejected particles shot out as from the crater of a volcano. A few fresh-water sponges in some situations seem to be essen- tially perennial; others die in hot countries at the onset of the sum- mer season, or among us at the coming of winter, or are broken up by floods, floating ice, etc., so that for a season they disappear from view. The ordinary annual revival of sponge life, the growth after winter or after a period of desiccation, is provided for by the germination of many seed-like bodies, called gemmules; these may generally be found when the sponge matures, fixed as a pavement layer at the base of the sponge or distributed amongst its tissues. The living cells enclosed in these are protected by a firm chitinous coat or shell that is again surrounded by a crust composed of minute air cells, which float the gemmules and promote their distri- bution to distant places. A variety of minute spicules is normally found embedded in this crust as described under individual species in the key. Whenever the favorable season arrives, that is in most regions THE SPONGES (PORIFERA) 303 when spring comes or when, in dry regions, the occasional floods reach them, the gemmules in the pavement layers are supposed to germinate where they were deposited; the floating kinds, set adrift, lodge upon any suitable surface and begin their seasonal growth. Each gemmule is provided with a foramen, or a f oraminal aperture, sometimes plain, but often more or less tubular, through which the growing cells usually escape by amoeboid action and appear as a delicate creamy film surrounding the gemmule. Sometimes, however, they escape by the rupture of the whole gemmule. Where this is part of a pavement-layer or one of a group of detached gem- mules the escaping currents flow together as a filmy mass, sometimes rounded up like a small pea, otherwise as a spreading film or like the wandering trail of slime left by one of the larger snails. The appearance of the young spicules is nearly coincident with the escape of the cells and they at once begin to arrange themselves according to the habit of the species, forming a network over the supporting surface, upon which is built a superstructure suggesting that of our modern steel-framed buildings. Special interspaces become the chambers lined with the collared flagellate cells already mentioned. The action of these flagella creates currents of water flowing in through myriads of almost invisible pores in the cover- ing, bearing food particles to nourish the growing sponge and then carrying off and discharging useless matter through the larger rumps by the efferent osteoles already mentioned. The study of fresh-water sponges should begin here and follow the cycle of growth from gemmule to gemmule, watching, if it be possible, even the development within their own especial cells of the various classes of spicules, observing in the autumn the gradual gathering together of the germ cells before they are shrouded in chitin or committed to the waters within their floating crusts. Under favorable conditions and constant as well as careful control much of this work may be made independent of the seasons, after germinating the fresh gemmules in shallow glass dishes at home, and in a small way afford excellent opportunity for study; but it will not be found practicable to grow sponges in aquaria excepting as small fragments in very large bodies of water or in vessels in which the water is constantly or frequently renewed. 304 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Those who wish to gather specimens for their cabinets or design to determine genera and species must await the maturity of the various specimens. Observation seems to make it probable that the rarer, filmy sponges complete their growth and mature their gemmules earlier than the more lusty, massive forms. The gem- mules of the former have often been seen in August or September resting in slender lines upon standing or floating timbers from which the rest of the sponge has disappeared, though the coarser forms are frequently immature late in November. These dates hold true for the northern United States generally and would of course vary in other parts of the world; but there are undoubtedly individual regions of extreme or atypical climatic conditions within our own area where the sponge calendar when worked out will show a distinctly individual aspect. A hint as to hopeful localities for collecting may suffice. Do not waste time in hunting along sluggish streams or in shallow, muddy ponds, where, even if the sponges start to grow, they will soon be suffocated by gravitating particles of earthy matter. A reserva- tion should perhaps be made in favor of the lower sides of floating timbers that have long lain in the water, since here gravity protects instead of injures the sponges. Only one other caution seems neces- sary. As all known fresh-water sponges are siliceous the student will probably fail to find them in waters strongly impregnated with carbonate of lime, though they are recorded from such places. Perfect drying is to be recommended. The proper classification can be as readily determined from dry as from fresh sponges and it is only when a specimen has some novel character or specific form that it is worth while to preserve it in alcohol. When a wrapper is necessary for transportation or otherwise, be sure to use soft paper, rather than cotton or sawdust. Other features having proved indeterminate or unreliable, the system is based upon the shapes and positions of the minute spicules found embedded in the gemmule crust. As these can only be sat- isfactorily seen when the impenetrable crust is made transparent or removed, three microslides from each specimen must be pre- pared to determine the forms of the skeleton, the dermal or flesh, and the gemmule spicules. THL SPONGES (PORIFERA 305 Provide a hall doaen or more short ifisi tubes with a stand made by boxing holes of suitable diameter in a piece of inch board. Prist make sure that yon have in hand parts 01 the same sponge only. Place in the nrs; tube a dozen or niore clean gemmules. some of them cut in naif witn a snar]> knife, and about an equal bulk from the remainder of the sponge : cover with a few drops of strong nitric acid thai has been previously brought to a boil in another tube and set aside, the purpose being lu corrode away the crust but not the chitin 01 the gemmuie^ In a few minutes, when most of the gemmuies incline tu settle at uie bottom, pour on the acid into the next tuoe, wash careiuii y witn several lots of pure water, replace it with alcohol and set the tube aside to settit. Put into the acid hi the second tube a smaL quantity of all part* of the sponge, adding more add if necessary, and boii carefully over a spirit lamp to tnorough disintegration. Wnen that is effected hi! this tube also witn water ana set it aside to settk. Tne smaller spicules settle very siowiy. It may be weli to shake the tube a little in order to separate the darker parades from the pure white. When the mass has settled, carefully pour off the water with the impuri- ties, wash the residue with fresh water and let it stand, after which a mount may be made irom thi> tube Spread tne spicules eveniv and not too thickh on a slidv. and let uieni ury uioroughiv before adding balsam and a cover gias- This amount will of course fur- nish an epitome of the sponge but wiii not show the exact relation^ of the minor spicule* to the gemmuie- Thi> can only be seen after two or more application* of aicohui to tiit nrst tube have removed the acid mixture; to keep out the air. cover with benzoi until iuliv ready for the baisan.. Distribute a lew 01 the gemmuies, with some spicules, upon a second slide and mount in balsam before the air penetrates them. A fragment of the dry ihmy dermis mounted in balsam will determine the presence or absence of dermal spicules and hx positively the standing of the sponge according to the key. If all the smaller spicules disiinguisned uy tnis process are acer- ates, that is, more or less cylindrical, wnetner straight or curved. smooth or spined, pointed or abruptly tenniiiateu. the specimen under examination niay unhesitatingly be piaceu in the genus Sport- gilla. All others, uniess entirely novci, wih snow some modification 306 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY of the birotulate form, i.e., two little wheels or rotules connected by a shaft, and on the numerous variations of these parts depends the position of the species in the key. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER SPONGES i (n) Gemmules with acerate spicules only. . . SpongiUa Lamarck . . a Spongillidae with long spindle-shaped skeleton spicules, macrcscleres. having painted or rounded end*, and often also with minute simple flesh spicules, or micrraderes. Gemmules naked, or with external air-cell layer containing rhabdi. or rod-oke spicules. a (5) Sponge branching. 3 Abnormal forms of S. lacuslrit occur in which there ai 3 (4) Flesh spicules smooth SpongiUa aspmosa Potts 1880. Sponge evergreen, entrusting, thin, sending out numerous long, Blender waving branches from a relatively thick basal membrane. Gemmules few, in scattered branches. Skeleton spicules smooth, straight or slightly curved, rather abruptly pointed. Dermal spic- ules minute, smooth, straight or curved, slender, gradually pointed. From dear ttancUng water in New Jersey and Virginia. eleton *pn Spantilla oifiioia. Four types of ■) ordinary skeleton spicules abruptly p nted at both ends; s fixured 4 (3) Flesh spicules spined SpongiUa lacustris (Li Brandies cylindrical or dant. Gemmules either without a granular oust. 1745- tapering', and rigid. Prefers rapidly running water. Very abun- pparendy wanting or abundant throughout the sponge, with or Skeleton spicules smooth. Dermal spicules pointed spined iter- ates. Geramule spicules whether few or many generally cylin- drical, more or less curved, rather sparsely spined. From Boston, Mas., to McDonald Lake, Alaska, in an infinite number of situa- tions and variety of forms. The variety pauperevta Bowerbank, made an independent spedes SpongiUa paHpinula by Carter, " is perhaps that one of this group of synonyms about whose identity nilh S.tacmlrii there may be most hesitation. Its character ia some- what anomalous, aa its locality and associations are peculiar. Grow- ing originally in the ponds and reservoirs tributary to the Boston Water supply, Bailey wrote in 1856 that it grew abundantly in the waterpipes by which the dty was supplied with water from ■ small lake. The minute acerates were san! to have been smooth which would separate it clearly from S. lacmlris, but Potts waa unable to secure material from the original locality winch bore out the con- 5 (3) Sponge without branches 6 6 (9) Gemmules in layers or groups. 7 THE SPONGES (POKIFERA) 3°7 7 (B) Tubules of gemmules turned upward or outward from the groups. Spongilla frapiis Leidy 1851. Sponge encrusting in subrirculsr patches, thin at edges, occasionally one or more inches thick dot the middle In the most varied situations, apparently prefemnp standing walcn-. though also in running water. Abundant. Gemmules abundant, primarily in one or more pavement layers. Also in compact groups surrounded by a cellular parenchyma charged with aubcylindrical spined acerates Skeleton spicules smooth, slightly curved, rather abruptly l""'*^ True dermals wanting- Found in most ol the United States. ". 3 Frc. 561. StmUf frapiit. A. Section of group of ■emmake; a. curved ioruniiul tubules, always nU - ward: f, envelop with accraie spicules. Xn. B. Three types ol spicules figured here: skeleton spicules, abruptly pointed; variable parenchymal spicules, aubcylindrical. nibsptned; spilled, spberkal j Potts 1887. 8 (7) Tubules of gemmules turned inwards in the groups. SpongiUo iglovifor Sponge brown, thin, encrusting- Gemmules in compact hemispherical groups of d . twelve or more, resting on the fiat side, surrounded by a parenchyma of unequal cells, charged with numerous coarsely spined spicules nearly as long as the rather few. km strongly spined skeleton spicules. On the lower side of timbers in cedar swamps. New Jersey. S. macktyi. Carter from Newfoundland, may belong here. Frc. jf>3 . SftmtiUa itimjtrma. A. Lateral ,rTaWinvi«ble.l X K. ( _ lea" nearly equally long, h 9 (6) Gemmules not in layers or groups 10 10(11) Dermal spicules birotulate. . . . Spvn^iUa novae-terra?. Pons 1886. Sponge encrusting, gemmules rather numerous, very large, crust absent or inconspicuous. Skeleton spicules relatively few, slender, gradually pointed, smooth or microspined. Dermal spicules very abundant, minute, birotulate. Gemmule spicules smooth or irregu- lar, furnished with long spines, frequently located near the eitremi ^^- ties. Placed by some in genus Epkydalia. Found only ii <*e *'/f\\\' jicuks of SpomtiMa a idy micraapuied ikelct FKESH-WATER BIOLOGY 308 11 (10) Dermal spicules acerate. Crnwrnrlff ahondant- Skeleton ^_ ai—rroui Gcnmk IJioyltl spined, Imw. carnal Baepgdar1 only Ina bradiiab water of aoaabweatern. Florida. SpcngiUa wapuri Potts 1889. (1) Gcmmule spicules of birotulate type, more or leas modified. Sub-family Meyemhae Vejdovsky . . Aperture* of gernmules no t provided with filamentous appendages Rotules of gemmuk birotulatea nearly equal Gemmule birotulates of a single class 1$ (47) 14(46) 15(37) 16 (19) Margins of rotules entire, »-*-, smooth, not serrate. Trochospongtila Vejdovsky . 17(18) Skeleton spicules smooth. . Trockospongiiia leidyi (Bowerbank) 1S63. Sponge of a peculiar light gray or dnh color, encrusting thin. persistent Gemmules numer- ous, each surrounded by a capsule of skeleton spicules. Skeleton spicules short, smooth, robust. Dermal spicules wanting. Cnnmulc spicules short, birotulate, margins entire and eiflected. From Louisiana ai well 11 original field of discovery near Philadelphia.. Generally distributed in the Illinois River (ram the mouth to La Salle according to F. Smith. apace around tbt loraminal aperture (a), more lhan one being sometimis preaent. X 50. B. Four tras nl tpiculea figured here: smooth skeleton spicules, abruptly pointed; ■«, with rounded lenninuiora abort birotuliio. with entire margini; same with rotule Iwuled or eiflectad; lace of rotule- group of rotulaaaa they appear anon tha surface of the eawunuka. x 100. (After Potts.) 18 (17) Skeleton spicules strongly spined. TrotJuipongiUa horrida (Weltner) 1893. Sponge encrusting, white, gray, yellow, or brown. No gemmuk spicules except birotulatea which are smooth, margined, low, small Lives in standing or flowing water. Rare. F. Smith found one specimen each i n the Illinois River neat Starved Rock and in the Big Muddy River in southern Illinois. Fie 566. rra^itnaeiBa *> ula. X 180 Brrotasalc gams skeleton apic- Xaoa. (Attar THE SPONGES (PORIFERA) 309 19 (16) Margins of rotules serrated or incised. . Ephydatia Lamouroux. . 20 Spongillidae with gemmuk spicules of the birotulate type that are uniform or variable in length but not definitely of two classes, long and short, and that have finely or deeply cut margins. 20 (35, 36) Dermal spicules if present neither birotulate nor stellate. . . 21 21 (22) Rays and spines of birotulates subdivided and microspined. Ephydatia subdimsa (Potts) 1887. Sponge massive, encrusting, compact. Gemmules few. Skeleton spicules smooth or microspined, abruptly pointed. Birotulates very numerous, robust, shafts frequently spined; rays short but subdi- vided. From St. Johns River near Palatka, Florida. Fig. 567 . Spicules of Ephydatia subdimsa. Three types of spicules figured here: smooth and spined skeleton spicules; long, massive gemmule birotu- lates, spined and subspined; rotules of same. X zoo. (After Potts.) 22 (21) Rays and spines of birotulates entire 23 23 (24) Margins of rotules very finely serrate. . Ephydatia millsii (Potts) 1887. Sponge encrusting. Gemmules small. Skeleton spicules nearly straight, slender, rather abruptly pointed, entirely microspined. Gemmuk birotulates very numerous, very symmetrical, their shafts usually smooth. Rotules sometimes microspined. From Sherwood Lake, near Deland, Florida. Fig. 568. Spicules of Ephydatia miUsii. Three types of spicules figured here: microspined skeleton spicule; mature gemmule birotulates with smooth shafts; probably immature forms with less notching on the rotules; face of rotulates laonulate or delicately notched, and without cays. X ioo. (After Potts.) 24 (23) Margins of rotules coarsely dentate 25 25 {32) Length of birotulates not more than twice the diameter of rotules. . 26 26 (31) Shafts of birotulates generally smooth 27 27 (30) Skeleton spicules smooth 28 28 (29) Shafts of birotulates much longer than diameter of rotules. 5. ..«;..;, _-: ^'-. " $•' ■' - Ephydatia fluviatilis (auctorum). Sponge sessile, massive, rarely throwing out short branches an inch or less in length. Pre- fers ■frMiriing water. No vesicular cells in parenchyma. Gemmules numerous throughout. Skeleton spicules smooth. Dermal spicules wanting. Rotules of gemmule spicules not deeply indented. Numerous varieties the occurrence of which in North America has not been accu- rately recorded. The form which Potts describes as present generally throughout the eastern and middle United States is declared by Weltner to be Ephydatia miiUrri, the second following species. The true E. fluviatilis is found in Michigan and Illinois, and is fairly common though not so abundant as E nuiUeri {fide F. Smith). jIO FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY ig (28) Shafts of birotulates slightly if any longer than diameter of rotules. Epkydalia japonica (Hilgendorf) 1883 Modi like E. /Ivrial-Ju. Dermal spicules wanting. Birotulates witb smooth shaft, short, never forming more than ■ single layer on the gemmule. Rotules deeply indented. Gem- mule with 111011, straight, broad, very delicate foramina! tubule. In Potomac River, near Washington, D. C. Fie. J69. Efkyiaiia i*pt*k*. Gemmule. X it; biratoJates, X ik; sfccktiv'ipicuJet. 30(27) Skeleton spicules microsptned except at tips. ■" ~" *"* ***0-S - ■" !'R.'T">«i Epkydalia miitkri (Lieberkuhn) 1856. Sponge cushionlike, rarely branched. Vesicular cells abundant * J ~^&& J- in the parenchyma. Dermal spicules wanting. Shafts of gemmule *»y /-?V^r** Te birotulates not, or barely, longer than diameter of rotules. Rotules Z/vCjl* deeply indented. Eastern and Central United States; Nova Scotia; ir # • »\^ Fio. 570 Spicultsol Epkydalia mOtini. Three typ™ of spicules figured here; skeleton spicules, X i?o; birotulatr icmmule spicules; same mal- formed; group of rotulu; single rotules shoving an ordmaiy distribution of the rays. X )S°- (After Potts.) 31 (36) Shafts of birotulates with enormous spines. Epkydalia robusta (Potts) 1887. .. •_. j^^ Sponge massive, encrustuJif, thin. Gemraulea scarce. Skeleton -nriiOv\PV Shafts abounding in spines askmg as rays of the rotulea. Collected f 31 (15) Length of birotulates more than twice the diameter of the rotules. . 33 33 (34) Birotulates two or three times longer than the diameter of the rot- ules Epkydalia subtilis Weltner 1S05. Sponge thin, encrusting. Skeleton needles extremely slender, scsnti! ~ Ml spicules wa be, Birotulat. spilt nearly tc :t publiihod. THE SPONGES (PORIFERA) 3" 34 (33) Birotulates many times longer than diameter of rotules. Ephydatia crateriformis (Potts) 1882. Sponge encrusting, thin. Gemmules small, white, very numerous. Granular crust of gem- mules extremely thick, the foraminal tubes in a crater-like depression. Skeleton spicules slender, gradually pointed, sparsely microspined. Birotulates very long and slender, shafts abundantly spined. Rotules of three to six short recurved hooks. In shallow water, rapidly flowing; Schuylkill and Delaware Rivers, Pennsylvania. Found by F. Smith in the Sangamon River, 111. Annandale places this species in SpongUla owing to the imperfect development of the rotules (see Fauna of British India; Fresh-water Sponges, 191 1, p. 83). Bowerbank, in 1863, described, under the name of SpongUla bail- ft . 5°) Foraminal tubule shorter; tendrils, one or two, enveloping the tubule Carterius latitenta Potts 1881. Sponge often encrusting stones in rapidly running water. Gemmules numerous. Cirrous ap- pendages at first flat and ribbon-like, becoming slender and rounded, and occasionally subdivid- ing. Skeleton spicules smooth: or sparsely microspined, gradually pointed. Dermal spicules long, entirely spined. Birotulates stout, shafts with numerous long pointed spines. Rays of rotules deeply cut and sometimes recurved. Annandale believes this and the following species should be assigned to Epkydalia. In Pennsylvania, western New York, and Illinois River. late A B Fio. 58a. Carterius Umttmia. A. Partial section of gemmule; (a), foraminal tubule short; (ft).birotu ; (4), one or two lone and broad, ribbon-tike cirrous a ins eo nexe rotate; types of spicules figured ■pined dermal*. Xioo. (After Potts.) skeleton spicules; ppendam. Xio. (After Pott*.) B. i bwotwates variable m length; fact of l"v, **& P t" !» THE SPONGES (PORIFERA) 315 50 (48, 49) Koraminal tubule still shorter; tendrils, three to five, very long and slender Carlerius tenosperma Potts 1880. Sponge forming irregular masses creeping upon and around water plants and roots, less fre- quently encrusting stones. Gemmuies rather numerous Foraminal tubules about one-fourth the diameter of the gemmuies Tendrils as much as half an inch lone. Skeleton spicules slen- der, very sparsely microspined. gradually pointed. Dermal spicules siender. nearly straight, entirely spined . Biro! urates with cylindrical shafts, abundantly spined, rotules often irregular. New Jersey and Eastern Pennsylvania. t; spined gemmuk birotiuj IMPORTANT REFERENCES ON FRESH-WATER SPONGES Annandale, N. 1009. Report on a Collection of Fresh-water Sponges from Japan. Annot. Zool. Japon., 7: 105-112, pi. 2. 1009a. Fresh-water Sponges in the Collection of the United States Na- tional Museum. Part II. Specimens from North and South America. Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus., 37: 401-406, 1910. Fresb-water Sponges in the Collection of the United States National Museum. Part IV. Note on the Fresh-water Sponge Ephydatiajaponica, and its Allies. Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus., 38: 640-650. 1911. Fresh-water Sponges in the Collection of the United States National Museum. Part V. A New Genus proposed, with Beleromeyenia radio- spiculata Mills as Type. Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus., 40: 593-594. 1011a. Fresh-water Sponges, Hydroids and Polyzoa. Fauna British India. »5i PP-. 5 pl- Carter, H. J. 1881. History and Classification of the Known Species of SpoDgiUa. Ann. Mag. Nat. Hist, (5), 7: 77-107, pl. 5-6. Pons, Edward, 1883. Our Fresh-water Sponges. Amer. Nat., T7: 1193-6. 1887. Fresh-water Sponges; a Monograph. Proc. Acad. Nat. Sci., Phila., 39: 15&-279. pl. 5-1*. 1890. Fresh-water Sponges. Microscope, 10: 140-143, 161-163, 193- 196, 257-263. 307-310; Pl- 5-6. Weltner, W. T895. Srmngillidenstudien TJI. Katalog und Verbreitung der bdanaten Susswasserchwamme. Arch. f. Nat urges., (pt. I), 61: 1 14-144. CHAPTER XI HYDRA AND OTHER FRESH- WATER HYDROZOA By FRANK SMITH Professor of Zoology and Curator of the Museum, Unmrsity of Illinois The student of the animal life of the sea is continually in contact with a great variety of organisms which have radial sym- metry and are often striking in appearance, diversity, and abun- dance. These were formerly included in a great group, Radiata, but are now separated into two very distinct branches (phyla), the Coelenterata and Echinodermata. The latter phylum, which includes the well-known starfishes and sea urchins, is wholly un- represented in fresh water, while the former, which includes the hydroids, jellyfishes, and corals, with thousands of species in the seas of to-day, has in fresh water scarcely a dozen species and these are relatively insignificant in appearance. The fresh-water Coelenterata are all included in the class Hydrozoa, and hydra is the only one whicn is abundant, widely distributed, and well known to the ordinary student of zoology. Because of its abun- dance it is the type form commonly used in zoology classes as an introduction to a knowledge of the phylum. Among the more obvious structural or morphological characters of hydra is the sac-like body with the capacious chamber which is at the same time body cavity and digestive cavity and of which the mouth is the only opening to the exterior. The animal is attached by one end and at the other shows the mouth surrounded by a circle of tentacles which are evaginations of the body wall and are hollow, their cavities being continuous with the digestive cavity. The body wall as well as that of the tentacles is com- posed of two cellular layers, the ectoderm and entoderm, sep- arated by a thin, noncellular mesogloea and bounded externally by a delicate cuticula. In some species there is an obvious dis- tinction between an adoral part of greater diameter and more 316 HYDRA AND OTHER FRESH-WATER HYDROZOA 317 granular opaque entoderm, and a narrowed paler aboral part which is termed the stalk. In other species designated in the key as " not stalked," there is no clearly marked division into such regions. Highly contractile fibers formed by certain cells in both ectoderm and entoderm may bring about either a great elongation of the body and tentacles to thread-like proportions or their contraction to an almost globular form. Certain kinds of ectoderm cells, which are most abundant in the adoral half of the body, especially in the tentacles, give rise to the characteristic ne- matocysts or " nettling cells " of different shapes and sizes. These contain a fluid secretion which passes out through a thread-like extension of the sac wall, that is forced out when the cell is stimu- lated. The combined action of a number of these nematocysts on the small organisms encountering them results in the loss of activity or even death of the organisms and so permits their cap- ture and appropriation as food by the hydra. Spermaries and ovaries develop in the ectoderm layer and at a time of year which seems to be fairly constant for a given species but differs in different species. After fertilization the ovum passes through the early stages of development while still in the ovary and becomes enclosed by a chitinous envelop which has a charac- teristic shape and surface for each species. This envelop which often is spiny is referred to in the key as the embryonic, chitinous membrane. In some species the embryos are freed from the parent organism and drop to the bottom, while in others they are fastened by the parent to the substratum to which it adheres. The develop- ment is direct. In one species {Hydra oligactis) the individuals are said to be of separate sexes, or dioecious, but in others hermaphro- ditism prevails. Asexual reproduction by budding is the preva- lent mode of multiplication and very rarely the formation of two individuals by a process of fission has been observed. Hydra has long been an object of interest and experiment because of its notable powers of regeneration and form regulation and there is now an extensive literature dealing with these phenomena. Hydra individuals ordinarily maintain an independent existence but in various related groups colonies which often include many individuals arise by asexual reproduction. In some such colonies, 318 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY besides hydra-like forms or hydranths, another type of individuals is produced which become medusae and separate from the colony as free-swimming forms that develop germ cells which in turn pro- duce a generation of individuals of the hydranth type. In other colonial forms the germ cells are formed by individuals that re- main as members of the colony. All the species of Hydrozoa which have a complex colonial organization are with one exception marine. In the fresh-water colonial hydroid Cordylophora, many of the individuals or zooids are nutritive and provide food for the colony and by budding increase its size while other individuals form germ cells; there are no medusae formed. Among the obvious structural features in which this form differs from hydra are the following: the tentacles are not hollow but the entoderm forms a core of large cells which occupies all the space enclosed by the ectoderm and mesogloea; the tentacles are more numerous than in hydra and are irregularly distributed; the cuticula is thick and forms a support- ing skeleton for the colony. Four genera of fresh-water Hydrozoa form free-swimming me- dusae. Two of these occur in Africa but the two following genera are each known in North America and Europe. Edward Potts first discovered the Microhydra and it has been studied chiefly by him. The hydranth form has no tentacles and it lives independently or forms simple colonies of two or three individuals. The medusae have been seen by him to arise by budding from hydranths but have not been observed when older than a stage attained two or three days after being freed. They have but eight tentacles and no marginal sense organs. Craspedacusia was first found in the Regent's Park Gardens, London, England, in 1880, and its only occurrence in North Amer- ica thus far recorded was in Washington, D. C, in 1907 (Hargitt). Only its medusa stage is known with certainty but what is supposed to be the hydranth form is very similar to that of Microhydra. The medusa has more than eight tentacles and has marginal sense organs. The hydra is usually found adhering firmly by the base to sub- merged objects over which it moves slowly and may be found at HYDRA AND OTHER FRESH-WATER HYDRQZOA 319 various distances from the surface, but not infrequently is sus- pended from the surface film or even drifts about unattached and thus often becomes a component of the plankton. The hydras multiply so rapidly when conditions are favorable that they often take heavy toll from the plankton organisms, especially the ento- mostracans and small worms. Since they are probably little used as food by animals useful to man and since they compete with young fish for food, their economic relations to man are unfavor- able. The most favorable conditions for Cordylopkara are in brackish water and there it attains most luxuriant development but it thrives also in fresh water, although the colonies are there less stalwart and the ascending branches are usually not more than half as large as in colonies from brackish water. It was first known as a brackish water form from Europe and its appearance in fresh water is of comparatively recent date. It has been known for a number of years in the United States, near the Atlantic Coast, where it occurs in both brackish and fresh water. The first recorded appearance in the Mississippi Valley was in the Illinois River in 1909, but it is now known in several states of that region. This form is a plankton feeder and thus competes with young fish for food. Its most vigorous colonies are found where there is considerable current and in company with Bryozoa it not infre- quently invades the pipes of water systems, impedes the flow, and at times vitiates the water itself. Microkvdra is found associated with biyozoans on the surface of stones in running water near Philadelphia, and is apparently not an abundant form. In the search after hydra if pond-lily leaves and coarse sub- merged vegetation be collected from bodies of water in which hydra occurs, and allowed to stand a few hours or days in glass jars, specimens are likely to be found attached to the vegetation or to the sides of the jar or even suspended from the surface film. Hydra may be kept in good condition for long periods of time in well aerated aquaria, if supplied with sufficient food, preferably small entomostracans and worms. At the proper season and tem- perature they may reproduce sexually as well as by budding. For ordinary purposes a corrosive sublimate and acetic acid 320 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY mixture either hot or cold gives sufficiently good results as a fixa- tive, but for certain cytological studies special methods are recom- mended; for these one must consult the literature. Occurring most frequently attached to submerged sticks or twigs Cordylophara may also be looked for on the submerged surfaces of walls and piers and also on stems of coarse vegetation. Fixation may be accomplished as with hydra. It has recently been shown that the Linnaean systematic names in common use for species of Hydra must be dropped for the earlier ones of Pallas. Recent literature which deals with the results obtained by several investigators who have worked on Hydra shows such conflicting views concerning the status of certain sup- posed species of this genus, that any classification or key dealing with them must be regarded as tentative. The chief difficulty is with Hydra oligactis Pallas (H. fusca L.), which by some is believed to have been applied in the past to two specifically distinct forms while others uphold a contrary view. The treatment of the species of Hydra in the following key is based chiefly on the papers of Brauer, Downing, and Koelitz. KEY TO NORTH-AMERICAN FRESH-WATER HYDROZOA i (10) Hydranths with tentacles; no free swimming medusae at any stage of the life history 2 2 (9) Tentacles in a circle about the oral end; do not form true colonies; have power of slow locomotion. . . Hydra Linnaeus . . 3 3 (6) Body not definitely stalked; extended tentacles not very much longer than the body 4 4 (5) Green; three kinds of nematocysts; embryonic chitinous membrane spherical, with minute elevations; spermaries limited to oral third of body; sexual activity more frequent in summer. Hydra viridissima Pallas (H. viridis L.) 1766. 5 (4) Pale yellow, gray, or brown; four kinds of nematocysts, diameter of largest 0.0105-0.013 mm.; embryonic chitinous membrane spherical, with coarse branched pointed spines; spermaries only on distal third; sexual activity more frequent in sum- mer Hydra vulgaris Pallas (H. grisea L.) 1766. 6 (3) Body definitely stalked ; extended tentacles much longer than body. . a 7 HYDRA AND OTHER KRESH-WATER HYDROZOA 321 7 (8) Gray, brown, or reddish; three kinds of nematocysts; diameter of largest less than 0.0105 mm.; embryonic chitinous membrane spherical, with very short spines; spermaries on any part of body except the stalk; sexual activity more frequent in winter. .... -M-ydra oligactis Pallas (H.jusca L.) 1766. By some it is claimed that B. Mgatlis is strictly dioe- cious and is in this way distinct from the following Flc 581- Hydra atiiactii. (a) Nenutocyils. lb) Embryonic chitinous membrane. X «■ (Alter Brauer.) 8 (7) Gray or brown; four kinds of nematocysts, diameter of largest less than o.oi mm.; embryonic chitinous membrane plano-con- vex, with only convex side covered with spines; spermaries limited to the oral third of the body; sexual activity more frequent in autumn Hydra polypus Linnaeus 1758, Besides the differences between B. olitattis and B. polypiu mentioned above the latter is said to be somewhat smaller and the validity of any of the differing characters mentioned above is disputed, with the possible exception of the difference in the number of different kinds of nematocysts. B. pallida Beardsley, a very pale form in Colorado, and B. i.otida Elrod, a very large red form in Montana, may prove to belong to the species listed above, ai similar VI " "*'' are known to occur in Europe. x"jo. ~Ti!Ku~ OoOQ' a the body of the hydranth; form true Cordyiop/mra Allman, e species, C. lacialrii Allman, which fresh water near Philadelphia, Pa., Woods Hole, Mass. It has recently been found in the Illinois River at Havana, and by Mr. W. Donaldson in the Mississippi River at Granite City and East St. Louis, III., in the Arkansas River at Little Rock, Ark., and in the Red River at Shreveport, La. Fig. j85. Cordytop fairs lltsxMi, (o) A branch from colony. About twice mi large u is common in fresh .ifr ill F*male reproductive rooidi with embryoe ugn of development. X 10. (Alter 10(1) Hydranths without tentacles; free swimming medusae are formed. . n 322 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY ii (12) Hydranth form' most frequently seen; medusae rarely found and have but eight tentacles Microkydra Potts. But one species, M. ryderi Potts. first described from near Philadel- phia. Pa., but since then found in different localities in Europe. The medusae have been seen only when in a very early stage and the adult stages are not known. Flft. ,87. M icrckyira ryderi. (al Young medusa. X 40. (After Moore from Potui.) (») Hydranths and embryo. a J X «. (After Ryder from Potts.) 12 (11) Hydranth form rarely seen; medusae have more than eight tentacles. Cra$Pedacusta Lankester. But one species, C. ttmerbyi Lankester, known in Europe and America. Found only in aquaria according to earlier records, but large numbers were collected by Professor if Car- man in September. 1916, in a creek near Frankfort. Kentucky, the first record of their occurrence in other than artificial sur- roundings, A second species, C. iawaii Oka, has been found iu a river of China Fie. j88. CrospcdacMsla itrtxrbyi. X about 4. (After Hargitt.) Limnocnido GOnther is the only other known genus of fresh-water medusae and its distribution so fat as recorder] is limited to the Eastern Hemisphere. Limnocnida tanganyicae (Bohm) iSSj is found in Africa; Limnocnida indica Annandale lull, in India; Limnocnida rkodtsia Boulenger 1911, in southern Africa. IMPORTANT REFERENCES ON FRESH-WATER HYDROZOA Bratjek, A. 1909. Die Benennung und Unterscheidung der Hydra -Arten. Zoo). Anz., 33: 790-702. Downing, E. R. 1005. The Spermatogenesis of Hydra. Zoot. Jahrb., Anat., 21: 379-4*6. Hahgitt, C. W. 1008. Occurrence of the Fresh-water Medusa, Limnoco- dium, in the United States. Biol. Bull., 14: 304-318. Nutting, C. C. iooi. The Hydroids of the Woods Hole Region. U. S. Fish Com. Bull, for 1899: 327. Potts, E. 1006. On the Medusa of Microkydra ryderi and on the Known Forms of Medusae inhabiting Fresh Water. Quar. Jour. Mic. Sri., 50: 623-633; 2 pi. Smith, F. 1910. Hydroids in the Illinois River. Biol. Bull., 18: 67-68. :taptt.t? -,tt ■:"»K If* ". ni*r»irifl 1 1 v* ;■_■ .-....%• ■•■ . : ! . - --*- i< ,. .ir»-» 7 . ' / •* ■ •!»- • ' [ ' in . •;jjj|^f»fi J ,\- I" ' ■ ir J ... rt_!» '-■- l ■ : — **t.-.,- t.r. • n,.j ».i—T^^fciT» »■***• » ■• •• i* •, i'J ■*"»t"iH f^it j :' ' *"■■ ■ *■ - : .-»»*"»▼ t" 5 ■ '■ . -i~« •- •- . ■ *■* ••! ■ 1 «»•■■■ j i»i ■'.• * 1*^ . -If i « l " 1 >» • •T-' * ■ »■*" •■•<-»»' 1 ■.*»»• • • » »■•■■ Vk .".I ^ .« i-' ■.l^«» V- if W . - Hi" ■ • \ii \\ t .**■<" 1 ' i. yx^-in ..■"i- ■• I f . ■ . - »TTI -1 1 1 .f'l ri . • .t . . >. « ■ I. . ,-.»s r . .*•«<* #»■ j t ^b 7- '■ • • .1 ' ' 1 f »££fc 'ill' '«■! li' *■■• 1-. . ■ .^»% iM'i ^1 «» ... t» #■■ »■• "■"."_ . ■» * * ■ • ■ - 1 » ' i ' I My '■■«. •» ^,w- • «.,»... • . _ . • ^- r i>.r.i.>, 1 ,1 ... v. 1^ ■- . •- ■ ■I 1 . ■ 1 " • • , v~*t"*f\\f***i *"! 1 "* "" —»--■-■-..■ —^ - I ■-■ -- ■ .«i~. -*.. r- . t'l '■ ■'" "«»• • 324 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY larger fresh-water forms are usually inconspicuously colored, gray, brown, or blackish or are entirely free from pigment. The smaller forms are often brilliantly colored, yellow, orange, red, or rose; and a few appear green due to the zoochlorellae or symbiotic one-celled plants which live within the mesenchyma. The color is more or less affected by the food contained in the intes- tine. This is especially true of the non-pigmented or very trans- parent forms and in many cases examination with a lens will be necessary to show whether pigment is actually present or not. The anterior end is often modified so as to suggest the form of a head, either by the presence of the various special sense organs, a pair of lobes or cephalic appendages, or by a groove or constriction separating it from the rest of the body. Eyes may or may not be present. If present, the usual number is two, though some forms have four and one genus of planarians, Polycelis, is characterized by the possession of a large number of eyes. Accessory eyes or pigment spots are common among certain species. The normal eyes are usually bean-shaped and are black in color although there are many exceptions. Acces- sory eyes are usually more or less irregular in shape as well as in position. A pair of sensory pits occurs in the anterior region in many forms. These may be round, oblong, or slit-shaped, and very shallow or deeply sunken. They are connected with special brain ganglia, are usually provided with long cilia, and are re- garded as olfactory organs. A few forms possess a statocyst (otocyst) or balancing organ. It consists of a membranous sac filled with a fluid in which a strongly light-refracting statolith (otolith) is suspended. The non-pigmented, light-refracting organs found in Stenostomum posterior to the brain and connected with it by nerves are of three types. They may consist (i) of a va- riable number of spherical bodies arranged in the form of a convex organ, the so-called saucer-shaped or patelliform organ, (2) of a vesicle which contains a strongly light-refracting lens- shaped body on its wall, or (3) of a hollow capsule-like vesicle. The epidermis consists of a single layer of ciliated cells. The cilia are conspicuous in the rhabdocoels, which are enabled THi: FREE-LIVLWi Fi-ATWORMS fTURBELLARIA 325 .1 thereny to move ireer* through the wate:, anu t> the unaider. eye 100& much li&e iniuson^ Piananans nave, a uniiorm gliding movement but a-.» noi swim aooui unsupported iu addition to the cilia, remar&abiy long sensory nair* are present 111 a lew iorm>. The Turbeiiarij. art* richi\ supphc.i with various kina* oi giand>. 5iime giand* occur ah over tne uog\ anu. art- especial iv numerou* near tne anterio: an«.: posterior enu>. Utne: gianas iorm the rod-snapeu uodie- o- rnabdite- wmcii are either nomogeneou- anu uniiorniiv iignt-reiracuiu: \ rnaDdoid:^ , , or consist oi a n valine outer iayer enciosmg a une granular suostance uiiammite* The lormer are extremer variai>ie iii snap-. \ spindle . egg-, rou-. or club-snaj>ec/ ana originate either in uermai giana ceil* or m sin- gie-cellea gianu> within tne mesencnynia. esj>eciaiiy in tne anterior end wnere tne tracth tnrougn whici: tney pa.v» to tne sunace mav appeal a.- conspicuous hue.- Tm- rnammite> are loun^ only ir. tne mesenchyme bti'.i otne; giano> proauce tne pseuao-rhal •- dites whicn are irreguiai in snap. . granuiatea in structure, anci have a low ligM-reiracung powe: A lew iorms nave nematocys^. or stinging ceil.-., simitar w tno^r 01 tiir coeienterates, m place 01 rhabditer Adnesivr ceii^ ana adnesive papihae are present in many lorm^,. especially at tne posterioi enu 01 tne oody. The external oj>eniiig:r. moutn. genitai pore, anu excretory pore* are extremely variable in position In piace 01 tne usuai uou\ cavity of higner animals, the space between the bou\ and internal organs is hiieu with a peculiar connective tissue calieu mesencnynia ^parencnxTn^ in the smaller iorms litis tisstu: consist 01 a lew scatterea suspensorv strands and tne space between is hheu witn fluiu in otner> there is a network, which enclose* spaces hhea with liuiu and richly supphed with ceil.-. Tne cei^ may ue vacuoiatea or otiierwise modined. Tne musculature include* oana* 01 circular, longitudi- nal, and diagonal muscie* in tne ooci\ wah Tnere are also mu>- cie& which extend tnrougn the mesencnynia o: connect with the internal orgai^ The- digestive apparatu* includes the mouth pharynx, anci intestine, ah 01 which pia\ ah important part ir. classification ana lurnisn a reauv means ol distinguishing the two great groups 01 iresn-water lurbeliaru*. 326 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY In rhabdocoels (Fig. 589) which include smaller forms, the mouth may be placed at the anterior end or at various points on the ventral surface. The pharynx is represented by three general types, simple, bulbous, and plicate. In the bulbous type a muscu- lar membrane divides the pharynx from the surrounding mesen- chyma; the plicate form does not have the dividing membrane, but consists of a cylindrical tube lying within a pharyngeal cavity which opens to the exterior through the mouth. The simple and plicate types of pharynx lie more or less lengthwise and the organ appears as a tube parallel with the surface of the body. The bulbous pharynx is more variable and includes three types, the rosette-shaped, the cask-shaped (dolioliform), and the variable. The intestine has the form of a simple sac; it consists of a blind cylindrical tube, median in position. It is sometimes provided with short lateral diverticula. The walls are thin. In triclads (Fig. 590) the mouth is on the ventral surface usu- ally just posterior to the middle of the body. The pharyngeal region ordinarily shows externally about the middle of the body, either as a more heavily pigmented or as a lighter colored area. The pharynx is a cylindrical, very muscular tube which lies within the pharyngeal cavity except when protruded while feeding. In a single genus, Phagocata, there are many pharyngeal tubes instead of one. The intestine is thin-walled as in the rhabdo- coels but has three main branches, a single one extending forward, and two passing back, one on either side of the pharynx to the posterior end of the body. Numerous lateral diverticula are found especially in the anterior region. These may anastomose with each other or remain distinct. The protonephridial system (water-vascular system or simple kidney) possesses one, two, or four principal canals, with a general antero-posterior direction. The number and position of the open- ings is variable. The nervous system includes two principal brain ganglia and two main longitudinal nerves with numerous lateral branches. In many forms the longitudinal nerves may be seen as two light lines on the ventral surface. Reproduction is both sexual and asexual. The Turbellaria are hermaphroditic with the female organs distinct from the male. THE FREE-LIVING FLATWORMS (TURBELLARIA) 327 Both sets of organs have a common genital pore or are provided with separate external openings. In many cases the male organs mature earlier than the female and degenerate as the latter develop so that a study of various stages 01 growth is necessary to give complete knowledge of the organs. The rhabdocoels show great diversity in structure ranging from those with simple ovaries and testes to those with an elaborate system 01 accessory glands and ducts that much resemble those of the triclads. The male copu- latory apparatus or cirrus, is often remarkably complex and may, as in DaUyeliia, present the chief characters for identiheation of species. Some rhabdocoels produce two kinds of eggs, the thin-walled transparent summer eggs which may undergo development within the body of the parent, and the thick-walled winter eggs which have a hard, brown shell and develop in the outer world. In other species only the hard-shelled eggs are produced. In the Catenuli- dae asexual reproduction by the formation of buds, or zooids at the posterior end of the body is met with commonly. More than one bud may be produced before separation takes place. Planarians (Fig. 500; show less variation in the structure of the sexual organs. The testes, usually numerous, lie both above and below the digestive tract and extend from anterior to posterior end. The seminal vesicle opens into the muscular bulb-like cirrus, the apex of "which projects into the male genital atrium, which in turn leads into the common atrium. Two ovaries are placed far forward. The numerous yolk glands open into the oviducts as they pass back and either unite to form a common duct which enters the genital atrium or open separately into the posterior part of the uterine duct. Fertilization apparently occurs in the uterus which lies just back of the pharynx. Some triclads manifest only sexual reproduction; others have regular alternating periods of sexual and asexual reproduction; while a number du not have a definite liie evele since sexual ma- turity occurs at irregular intervals and often only among a limited number of individuals. In these forms reproduction is ordinarily asexual. Dendrocoelum lacteum attains sexual maturity and de- posits its cocoons during the winter months. In Pianaria maculate 328 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY and Planaria agilis sexual organs begin to develop early in the autumn and mature in the spring. After the cocoons are depos- ited the reproductive organs degenerate and reproduction is again carried on by transverse division into two pieces with subsequent regeneration of the missing parts in each piece. The division plane in most planarians passes just back of the pharynx. In Planaria velata there is a division into pieces of various sizes which encyst in a slime layer in response to unfavorable con- ditions. This slime layer hardens into a shell-like covering. Entire animals may also encyst. Asexual reproduction among planarians may occur at any time of the year and in many species is the usual method of propagation. The factors which control the development of sexual maturity are not fully understood although the food supply unquestionably plays an important part. Turbellaria undergo no metamorphosis during development but emerge from the egg, resembling the parent except in the lack of sexual organs. In viviparous forms the young develop within the mesenchyma of the parent and make their way to the exterior through the body wall in the posterior region. Flatworms are extremely responsive to external influences and the larger forms especially give interesting and specific reactions to various kinds of stimuli. If a dish in which they are quietly gliding about is jarred even very slightly, it will cause them to stop and contract until quiet is restored, or if at rest and the dish is moved they respond by becoming active as soon as the disturb- ance ceases. Violent disturbance induces a highly excited condi- tion with a loss of their more delicate reactions. After being disturbed the animals continue moving about for some time, this period depending on the strength of the stimulus and the physi- ological condition of the animal. Naturally it depends also upon the species since some are more active than others. They come to rest in some sheltered spot, normally in groups. light plays an important part in determining their resting place as they show decided negative phoiokinesis. The length of time of the resting period varies greatly. The animals are much more active at night than in day time; this is probably due to their feeding habits. THE FREE-LIVING ELATWORMS (TURBELLARIA) 329 If the worm is in a normal condition a delicate mechanical stimulus induces a positive reaction, i.e., the animal pauses mo- mentarily, then turns towards the source of the stimulus and glides forward in that direction. A negative reaction is usually given in response to a strong mechanical stimulus. In this case the animal turns away from the source of the stimulus. The positive and negative reactions are given not only in response to weak and strong mechanical stimuli but to changes in tempera- ture and to various chemical stimuli. The food reaction is essen- tially a positive one. If food is placed in a dish where planarians are gliding about, as they pass near enough to receive the stimulus supplied by the juices of the tissues, they give a positive reaction similar to that following delicate mechanical stimuli. This reac- tion brings them to the food and as they pass over it the anterior end closes over the food as if testing it. This process completed, the animal moves ahead sufficiently to bring the mouth opening over the food. The pharynx is extruded and the feeding process begins. An interesting reaction is given where a planarian falls dorsal side down, as it rights itself by forming a more or less complete spiral. There is a constant secretion of slime over the entire body and especially on the ventral surface. Irritation causes an increase in the quantity discharged. The slime layer and rhabdites probably serve the purpose of protection to some extent and aid in holding the prey. Some Turbellaria occur in shallow quiet pools only; others in larger ponds, lakes, or rivers, while a few species seem to prefer swiftly flowing spring-fed brooks and streams. They are found not only in all kinds of water but under varying temperature conditions as well, since they may be collected during the winter from beneath the ice and also are found in hot springs with a temperature of 470 C. They collect on the under side of stones, sticks, and leaves, conceal themselves among algae and in debris. or cling to the stems of Chora, CeratophyUum, and other hydro- phytic plants. Certain forms are found near the surface in com- paratively open water, and others in the mud or sediment at the bottom of ponds or lakes. Peat bogs and swampy places often furnish a large number of forms. 33© FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The regions occupied by different species of planarians are ap- parently determined by temperature and food supply to a very great extent. Those species which are adapted to low tempera- tures become sluggish and inactive in higher temperatures, or the reverse, and so will be less likely to find food than forms especially adapted to that temperature. If the food supply is limited this will necessarily lead to a crowding out of those less perfectly adapted to the environment. The development of any one species in a particular region is consequently limited by com- petition with other species already established in the area. In some cases two or more species may be found in almost equal numbers in the same pond as Planaria maculata and Dendrocodum lacteum. In such cases a variety of food usually seems to be abundant, thus reducing the competition which would otherwise lead to the elimination of the weaker. Cannibalism sometimes occurs among individuals of the same species when food is scarce and different species are especially likely to prey upon each other. Planaria agilis is a voracious feeder, and will exterminate a culture of Planaria velata or Planaria maculata in a comparatively short time even if other food is provided. This may account in part for the fact that certain species are always found alone. Ordinarily a pond or stream shows no evidence of the presence of Planaria even though large numbers of them may be hidden away under stones or leaves. However, one sometimes finds them moving restlessly about in great masses, either all in one general direction or in disorder. Voigt has conducted some inter- esting experiments with European forms under natural conditions which would indicate that these apparently concerted movements are the result of a response to some stimulus which may promise food, and cannot be regarded as indicating the possession of any inherited tendency toward periodical wanderings. The marine Turbellaria, like the fresh-water forms, hide under stones and among seaweeds. Some find shelter within the shells of molluscs and a few are parasitic. The land planarians are in general characteristic of tropical and sub-tropical regions where they attain a considerable length and are usually brilliantly colored. In this country one may THE FREE-LIVING FLATWORMS (TURBEULARIA 331 sometimes mid them in greenhouses and gardens, under flower pots or boxes, in moist woods under bark and old iogs. or in any moist sheltered place. They are easily overlooked because of the similarity in their appearance to young snails. Rhabdocoels are especially abundant in pooL or ponds which contain much algal or other vegetation. A lens is often neces- sary to distinguish them from other minute organism.- They may be collected by means of a Birge net or other apparatu> used in collecting small animals or simpiy b\ gathering carefully plant material, sediment, or debri> from tru- pond> where they live and exposing this material in shallow dishes in the laboratory. The larger triclads are easily collected as they cling to the stone or leaf which conceals them when il is lilted irom the water and they may then be removed with the point of a knin, or washed off into a large-mouthed jar. When aigae or debris which con- tains them is disturbed, they contract, remain motionies* until the disturbance ceases, and then come to the suriace and crawl about excitedly, thus being easiiy picKea up with a large-mouthed pipette. Most Turbellaria are easily kept in culture:* if the water is kept pure. Rhabdocoels should have a supply of unicellular and fila- mentous algae such as diatom^. Sfrirogyru. eu., and small animals like rotifers. Crustacea, and insect larvae, as they use both plant and animal food. Pianarians* are largely, if not entirely, carnivo- rous and thrive in aquaria which arc supplied with running water so that they may be given a constant supph of food. If this is not possible, they may be kq>t in ordinary aquarium jars or shal- low dishes with or without aigae . They will live for weeks, with- out food but become greath reduced in size. They take food readily, especially at night, and should bo feu once or twice a week on earthworms, snaiis, liver, or almost any soft fiesny animaj tissue. The water should be changeu alter each feeding. Small forms are easily studied under tht* microscope if slightiy compressed by the cover glass through tru- absorption 01 tht surplus water with niter paper A few quina- seeci^ addcti ti- the water are of great assistance as they iorm a jelly which re- tards movement without injury to the animal Celis or hollow 332 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY slides are convenient for work with large forms. Anesthesia may be induced by the use of a solution of one-tenth of one per cent of chloretone, or even less with some species. For preservation hot corrosive sublimate may be used, or a cold solution of the sublimate to which five per cent of glacial acetic acid has been added. Lang's fluid, Chichkoff's mixture, and 30% HNO» fol- lowed after one minute with 70% alcohol, are all useful killing reagents. Formol is useful for preservation of external characters since the animals retain their shape and color in it better than in most reagents. The larger planarians are especially valuable for study in laboratories where attention is given to animal be- havior. Certain forms also afford excellent training in exactness of observation. The lack of well defined and unvarying external characteristics makes it difficult to identify many Turbellaria. A large part of the material ordinarily collected is sexually immature whereas, as has been noted above, a knowledge of the structure of the sex organs is necessary in certain genera for identification. Preserved material if immature is especially difficult to identify since the body becomes distorted in shape and the color is usually so modified as to be unreliable. The differences in color and form between several of the species of planarians while definite are so slight as to be apparent only after a comparison of living material. In other cases there is a wide variation in color be- tween individuals of the same species. Until comparatively recently descriptions of many species of Turbellaria were extremely meager. The confusion which has arisen as a result is due to the lack of conspicuous external char- acteristics which would serve for identification. THE FREE-LIVING FLATWORMS (TURBELLARIAi 33; KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER TUK8ELLAR1A JNL'LUDIN; THI LaNI' PiAXARMSt 1 V7& Intestine a sinmc blind tuU. , median in positioi. Urdc- R&ftbdocoalida . . ; mare than J tew. millumtei: in icugij Tin: loliomui: licuic- ( Fig - . at... jdc $.», faciliuic j nMitTWimm ol liniruirr in in; i», (jtcjj outer;, kualioovjdiUj ]»■ 354) ■ Dupun: r»f j rUDiuiar. at. 2 (77) Phwyni simple, cask-sliapeu or roscLiivsiupf!. Connective Lis body cavity poorly tn.-veiupc. auooriier RhabdocoeiR Hmuk liliei with ii periviatetal IW TltCK ioTUL, tWJBC--.il. UU iLLUSisury 11 a of tbt Older. inning [lubduun:l^ 334 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 4 (17) Pharynx simple 5 5 (30) Protonephridia with one principal branch, median dorsal in position. Family Catenulidae . . 6 Without eyes but with ciliated pits, noo-pigmented light-refracting organs, and in one genu) a statocyst. The mouth lies on the ventral side of the anterior end. The pharynx opens into 6 (7) With one statocyst and pre-oval circular groove. Catenula. But one species supposed to occur in America. Catenula lemnae (Anton Duges) 1832. Length of single specimen 1 mm. Barely 1 to 4 or S looids in a chain. Delicate, white thread-like. Head region set oil by a circular groove lined with long cilia. Intestine abort and not continuous through chain of Graff regards the European species C. lemnae as prob- ably identical with the species which was collected in the vicinity of Philadelphia and very incompletely de- scribed by Leitly under the name Anottka gracilis. Until further collections of the Philadelphia form have been made this must of necessity be a matter open to question, and C. lemnae be admitted to the list of Ameri- can species tentatively. )) Chain tit V mat. M) anterior end:*, brain ''^SS^After'alraiak.) ™ a.cK Grifl.l 7 (6) Without statocyst or pre oral circular groove. With ciliated pits. . 8 8(19) Ciliated pits well developed. Without proboscis. Stcnostomum. . 9 9 (18) Head region not at all or only slightly set oS from rest of body. . 10 10(17) Integument colorless. 11 11(14) Wall of digestive tract free from pigment. 13 THE FKEF-I.IUNG FLATWORMS (TURBELLARTA1 335 2 (13) Anterior end bluntly pointed, ciliated pits about a? lar iron end of body as width of body at that point. Posterior end taper- ing uniformly to a blunt point. SlenosUmmm icucops (Anton Duges) I" al becomes larp.'. ahypkh and okir. The ax-lobed I*. The oval-shaped & which consist oi many closrly compacted lobes. vesicle which leads through a shori canal to lh( "'ie dorsal surface Abuniian', uu plants ■t such as small takes or pond!.. K. V., Ill, Mich, Neb. UU o( prwooeplin/iiiin'. X 10c. i 13 (12) Anterior end very bluntly rounded with ciliated pits very near the end. Posterior end of body narrow and forming a long slender tail, somewhat spatulalc in shape, except when- division has recently taken place, in which case the tail is shorter and more pointed. . . . Slenostomitm speciosum Stringer 1913. Length S.15 mm. A lance rhabdocoel which moves rather slowly and very gracefully. The abated pits are placed close to the blunt anterior end, much farther forward than in A. Iiucupi. also are deeper and narrower than in the latter form. The mouth is about as far from the an- terior end as the diameter of the body at that point, and is surrounded by glands. The pharynx has delicate longitudinal striatums. The intestine shows many large highly refractive color less bodies, probably fat globules Nothing dehnile can be said of the light-refracting organs which were difficult to identify because ol the unusual size of the animal. A few apecimens collected from pond with S. Ituteps, Lincoln, Neb. ..... _,. dilated pit; fr, bruin; ph. pharynx glands: e.egK. X 45. (Original.) 14(11) Wall of digestive tract pigmented 336 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 15 (16) Pharynx yellowish-brown. Intestine except gland cells bright yellow. Stenostomum tenuicauda von Graff 191 1. Length in chains of 4 zooids 1.5 mm. Slender. Posterior end tapering to a slender tail (\ to A of entire length). Point of tail set with adhesive cells. Integument colorless and contains masses of small rhabdites measuring up to 4 Pi. in length. Excretory pore nearer to intestine than end of body. Two patelliform organs 1 2 m across and composed of loosely joined spherical bodies. Rochester and Cold Spring Harbor, Long Island, N. Y. >%0i n Fig. 594. Stenostomum tenuicauda. An undivided chain of four zooids: rk, rhabdites; ig, intestinal glands; ep, excretory pore; pk I, II, pharynx. X 40. (After von Graff.) * 16 (15) Intestine yellowish-green between the round glistening oil drops. Stenostomum agile (Silliman) 1885. Length of single individual 0.75 mm. Chains of two zooids measure 1 .5 mm., those of five, 4 mm. Light-refracting organs lens-shaped. Rhabdites small. Posterior end bears adhesive cells. Pharynx long and provided with glands throughout its entire length. Sexual organs similar to 5. leucops. Monroe Co., N. Y. Fig. 505 shaped organ Lens-shaped . Stenostomum ante, (A) Anterior end extended; wgr, ciliated pit; to, lens- m; escm, protoneporidium; pk, pharynx; do, intestine; g, brain. X 65. (£) d organ. X 125* (After von Gran.) •£>• B 17 (10) Integument bright yellow. . . . Stenostomum grande (Child) 1002. Length of chains of 4 to 6 zooids 2 to 2.2 mm. Pre-oral region, especially the rounded beak-like portion, white. Integument bright yellow, pharynx somewhat darker yellow, intestine deep orange-yellow. Rhabdites small, especially numerous in anterior end. Two patelliform organs composed of about 25 spherical bodies. Posterior portion of nearly cylindrical muscular pharynx sometimes shows folds as a result of contraction. Intestine slightly lobed. Rochester, N. Y. Brackish water, Falmouth, Mass. Fto. 506. Stenostomum grande. (A) Anterior end: Wfr, ciliated pit; so, patefliform organ: pk. pharynx; rf«, intestine (£) posterior end: •#, excretory pore. X55. (After Graff.) THE FREE-LIVING FLATWORMS (TURBELUUOA) ■uistomum adulter Leydig 1854. Length 6 mm. Width about otie-tliirtietli the length. Very ._j._ —•.-... .l_..ji:. :.L , .-l Head region. slender, white, thread-like with snake-tike ... broader than the rest of the body with blunt point — - Posterior aid abruptly rounded. Asexual reproduction Brackish water. Falmouth, Mass. (8) Ciliated pits shallow. A club-shaped proboscis is present. RkynckoscoUx, Only one species. Rhynthoscolex simplex Lddy 1851. long cylindrical davale proboscis; boscis shows longitudinal and nun fragments of vegetable matter and coniervae at the bottom of dear brooks in the vicinity of FhwadcUpa. Von Graff regards the European species R. ogdoaki Sekera iSK8 u probably identical with this American form. 30 (5) With two lateral branches of the protonephridium. Family Micbostoiodae . . at Mouth a longitudinal slit OD ventral surface, intestine occasionally with tide lobes. Proto- nephridial branches open in anterior end. Testes and ovary either paired or unpaired, with two ventral sexual pores, the male posterior to the female. With or without eyes and dilated pita. 31 (34) The intestine extends dorsally and anteriorly beyond the junction with the pharynx. Subfamily Microstomia a e. Only one genus Microstomum , , 33 23 {33) With two reddish-yellow pigmented eye spots. MicTosiomum linear* (Matter) 1773. Length of single individual* id to 18 cooids with a length of 9 . Very active. Color yeOowxaa length of a to 11 mm. brown, rarely rose-colored, with t , always darker than the body. Pre-oral portion of in testate short. Two small ciliated pits. Nettle cxUs or nematocysts in place of rhabdites. Male sexual organs with paired testes; slender chitinoiis spicule of copulato/y organ with curved r" it. Ovary unpaired and median in position, fresh and brackish water. Monroe Co. and ftc.S)B. MawwdwBww Baatn, (A ) anterior portion of acham: e. ey«: tf, cihat— ■ -**- --" ' — tin ol iiuenine: m. mouth I.Uter von CraB.) (S) Ch 338 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 93 (39) Without eyes. Mkraslomum caudaHtm Leidy. Length i.j to 3 mm. Commonly in chains of a to 8 zooids. Nematocysts in place of rhabdites. Color of integument white, in- testine yellow. Ciliated piti directly dorsal to mouth. Pre-oraJ portion of intestine short. Anterior end bluntly rounded. Porte- lior end narrower, bluntly pointed, tail-like, dented. In standing water and small brooks, Monroe Co., N. V.; near Philadelphia, and in West Twin Lake, Charlevoix, Mich. 1. brain; »». pharynx; (». ciliated 34 (91) Pharynx opens into anterior end of the intestine, which has short lateral diverticula Subfamily Macrostoiqnae. Only one genus Macrostomum , , 95 95 (36) Chitinous portion of copulatory organ a broad straight funnel with the slender point bent at a right angle or nearly so and bearing on its convex side the small opening. Veaicula seminalis and vesicula granulonun connected by a narrow tube. . Macrostomum appendkulatum (0. Fabricius) 1B36. ■■:■* Tliia is the form known M U. kyilrix Oersted i&u. Length 2 mm. Unpigmented, transparent. Body Battened especially at the ends. The apatulate posterior end set with adhesive papillae. Rhabdoids and Ion* sensory hairs conspicuous. Two eye*, black. ProtooepKridial tubes open on median dorsal tide back of the slit-like mouth. Teste* and ovary both paired. Asexual reproduction not known. In running and standing water. MonroeCo., N. V.; Lin- cob, Neb. ■mm affimUcIahm J*; *t, pharynx: it. -, g and J. rash 1. "After von Orafl.) . (Altar Luther. J THE FREE-JJVING FUTOORMS (TURBELLARIA 339 j6 \2$ Qriiinnns spicule of anus a straight wrow tube tapering to a iriabiy curved point. Yesknia srmmahs and gnumkram aepararrH by a short constriction. v^iibmaii) i8iU. 601. Ma *. ere if' iato the maatb canty . i*. Xico (After SBbbkc (B Mate oopaoaorr t«. veaaua gzaaaknm: <*. iB. J. attcr van Gn£ th 1.5 am. Cofer jBmyisfc- wmtc intestine ycaiowish. Bnu- est through midair Posrerkvr en.i nanuweti R na brines preser.t m in- try.umn : in huge numbers, either smjriy or in twos and times Rhab dite tracts conspicuous in anterior end. Intestine with auerai envrr ticuLi Protonephndnxni coenmurv cates through a pore with mouth cavity Chitmous anaa somewHa: variable. Manioc Co, X. Y.; brack - t&h water. Fahnomh. Mass. 27 (4' With a long cylindrical bulbous pharynx. . Family Prokhyxchedai . pharynx is remarkably large. The mouth is in the anterior enc. Testes with numerou> Ovary not paired. Two sexual pores, the female pore on the ventral side. Themak the month or unite with i:. Only one genus. Prorkynckus M. Schultrc 2$ 28129) Without eyes Prorkynckus stagmaiis M. Schultzc 1851. Length to 6 mm., common ty much smaller . White, thread-like. Two cili- ated pits With numerous pear-shaped glands in the intearument. Pharynx about a of total length of both-, rhotonephrkhnm with tour principal branches, two dorsal and two ventral. Chitinous portion of cirrus straight and stiletto^ shaped Monroe Co.. X. Y.; brackish water. Falmouth. Mass FiG-Oc PimmjmAms satfaaii' c«. dutmous stftetto»^>. bolb-hke amis: ts.«emi- : ds. ductus seauuahs: t. testis foibde: opening ot male sexuxl organs rato pocket; m, ovary; c, mature egx X 15 lAner too Grail 340 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 29 (28) With two very small eyes, yellowish by transmitted light, whitish by reflected light, lying just before the brain in the widest re- gion of the pharynx. . Prorkynckus applanaius Kennel 1888. Length 4 mm. White. Body much flattened at both ends. Pharynx very muscular. In- testine a slender straight tube with one diverticulum extend- ing anteriorly under the phar- ynx and numerous slender very closely set lateral diverticula. PnrhMkmsaPfimlm. Fkomifc. X 20. (After KenneL) Greenhouse. University of Ne- braska, Tjnrnm, Neb. 50 (3) Female sexual organs divided into ovary and yolk glands. Male sex organs complex Section Lecithophora . . 31 Ovary in general small and simple. Yolk glands extremely variable, elongated, lobed, or forming a network which anastomoses. Chitinous portion of male copulatory organ very complicated and variable in form. 31 (74) Proboscis either lacking entirely or if present without a definite sheath Subsection Liporhynchia . . 32 This division contains the greater part of the fresh-water Turbellaria. 32 (61) With a cask-shaped pharynx parallel to the ventral surface or slightly inclined and with the end directed forward. But one genital pore Family Dalyelltdae . . 33 With the exception of the genus Opistomum, which is not represented in this country, the pharynx is typically cask-shaped and opens into the anterior end of the intestine. The genital pore opens on the ventral surface posterior to the mouth. Ovary simple. Yolk glands variable, female receptaculum seminis and a simple uterus are present. Testes always paired. Chitinous portion of male copulatory organ often very complex. Pigment eyes usually present, but without other sense organs. Protonerjhridhim consists of two principal branches which open on the ventral surface. Rhabdoids and glands of integument prominent. 33 (60) Without a separate pocket for the chitinous part of the cirrus. . 34 34 (59) Sexual pore in posterior third of body. The paired yolk glands un- branched and separate. . Dalyellia Fleming 1822 . . 35 This is the one commonly known as VorUx Ehrenbexg 1831. THE FREE-LIVING FLATWORMS (TUR.BELLARIA) 341 35 (3°) Tin.- cfaitinous portion of the male copulatnry organ is represented merely by the chionous tube of the ductus eiacukioritt;. Dtiyeliiti inermis von Graff IQII. Lenpho.6mm. Flattened. Fowerinrcnd modinctl into a kind ot adhesive din k Color while by reflected hirtit. Intestine very hrcsui ami yellow in nikir Eyes dull yelk» Accessory pifrmcnl spots imsrularly jn-oupfii arc very quick. Rochester, N, V. lory ottaa enlarged: 4 (Alter VOD Uraflj 36 (35) Provided with true chitinous o 37 (38) Chitinous portion of c Scarcely 1 mm. long- Closely re with very small dermal rhnbdites. Brownish mesenchymal oil s pigment not so abundant as in /J. tkusi Intestine redd ish-ochri -yelk™ . Seraal pore » just posterior to the intestine in the beginnum ol the nut third of the ■' ■ r, N. y. It mpuUlory ooruT enlarged: tk, chiton skula eranuknun- (After vtn Graff.) 8 (37) Chitinous portion of cirrus consists of more than one piece. . . 30 isists of a number of transverse spines 342 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 40 (41) Spines of unequal size and shape set in a basal piece. Dalydlia dodgti von Graff IOII. Length rarely more tban 1 mm Integument colorless. Intestine greenish from contained ilgae. Mesenchym* mottled with sepia-brown pigment. Eyes black. Found very commonly. Rochester, N. Y. Pic. 606. DaiytUia dodfii. {A) Ventral view slightly compreawd. X Sj. (B) Mile eopulatory «ni ■uougly compmwed. Explanation of figures: At, buna copulalrii; ik, chitinooa organ; e». adhesive papjilae; 1, Intestine; e, egg; b, brain; or, ovary; to genital pore; if. grasping papillae of pnaryu; tg, vraicula granulorum; mr mouth; m&, male genital canal; fk, pnaryu; pt, ditui; pi, meaenchym* pig- enlarged.' (Alter von Grafl.) 41 (40) Spines of same size and shape, arranged loosely in a ring without a basal piece 42 42 (43) With a crown of about 16 spines, tapering from base to the point. Dalydlia castmani von Graff 1911. spherical bodies which contain d brown granules in a clear brown fluid. Rhabdites short and relatively thick and rounded at both ends. Rochester, N. Y. U) Ventral 100. yp) Malecopula- Eiplanati™ at fifatrt : jpuiBiru: b€4, blind sack of buna; r at blind sac; t. egg; 1. brain; m, .. . ...ovary; go. genital pore; n, reoepla- ti, yolk gland; dj, commoa atrium: t, opening H. veaicula grauuloruru; if, aperm mast; ch, pharyni; it, granuks of secntloo. (After too THE ntEE-LIVING rXATWOUS (TDBBEU-MOA) 343 43 (41) With a crown of S spines, tterfcrnrrl new the middle and tapering to BPC points at both ends. DaiytBia iUigdti tSffliman) 18S5. Lrwgth a.t, nwo. Color Bjjn bMN. ni«lot* mm bureoB urerior end. Basal piccr erf tat tube vbka and ptared b the Hit M (39) Chhtnous portion of cirrus bears two longitudinally placed stalks 00 one end of which either one or two longitudinal terminal branches are set. The terminal branches may be set with (5 (46) Each chitinous stalk bears two terminal branches, one set with spines and one with no spines. Dalydiia fjtrdiidi von Graff iqii. SimiUi m n and color to D. rtoot bot more slender, villi ■ kngii uD ud 1 be nterss be pes leiortotbeseraal pore. Tbrcsg Ground tocml ~m stupe udmasm 10S to 140*. YcJt giiods i«« *-« in D . rioai liu w nb a "— — -> yolk dud but are dm lobcd, burly Botched. ^4wui& X 4J°- ■! fcl Oidioaa Swa nj. ductH — pjatpfc Mr. ovlr itAfcd: w. oner bnaca with no aay 344 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 46 (45) Each chitinous stalk bears a single terminal branch set with spines. 47 47 (50) The spines on the terminal branch are jointed 48 48 (49) Each spine consists of three joints. Stalk long, somewhat variable in shape Daly cilia rlicesi von Graff 191 1. Length 1 mm. Whenswiro- ming freely the ulterior end is broadly rounded, in crawling, !| truncated as shown in figure. 1 Integument colorleni with or region appears dear white and the ventral surface lighter ir Fic. 610. Datydlie rbui. alifhtly compreastd: U. totes; yolk gland; rr, vesicula semiiu oi yolk gland; ic, buna co ■■ - gtniul pore; t, egg; «. : 6o. (A) Male eoptila- , - rat us: pr. dmis lube; met, male genital canal, a, opeo- -*-— I, abort Sg ..too. (O Merfiin veniral grooved piece (at*) turned back; ft. variation is (talk. X 600. (Alter THE FREE-LIVING FLATW0RM5 (TURBELLARIA) 345 40 {48) Each spine consists of two joints. Stalk much reduced and variable in shape. Dalydiia articulate von Graff 191 1. euluged. (Af Ftc. 611. DalytOU artictUala ... ke, ban& copulaXrix; ck, chitinam put of male JlUiMi portloa al amis ■howuig variation Ena 15), Much 50 (47) The reduced spines on the terminal branch are unjointed and consist of but one piece 51 51 (51) The dorsal transverse bar bears a row of fine spines. Doiyctlia n. ' ' Fib swimmins. of extremely slender form, similar to D. resti. Anterior aid of the chitinotis portion of dma Dot sharply defined. Differs from D. ratii chiefly in structure of the cbitinous organ, the stalk of which is not so broad 01 flails in that form. (>nr terminal branch of this organ bears eleven curved teeth, the other seven of the same type and one which is larger and three sided. The trans- verse bar bears a row of straight, sharply pointed spines. Brackish water, Falmouth, Mas. nrrfqaW,.;, ft. ifouxc. (After v« 346 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY $2 (48) The dorsal transverse piece between the longitudinal stalks has a single median chitinous spine 53 S3 (54) The median point is rudimentary; much shorter than the terminal branches Dalyellia viridis (G. Shaw) 170.1. Length 5 mm. Unpigmented except during the maturing of the egg; when there a a brownish pigment, but with a continuous layer oi 100- chlorellae under the integument giving the characteristic green color. Rochester, N. V. DatytUia *i<\dii. Chitinous paction of timis: it, two-parted lUlk: Xm 54 (53) The median point is as long as the terminal branches. . 55 (56) One terminal branch is not jointed but consists of a single piece shaped like a plow-share, and does not have spines. Dalyellia armigera (O. Schmidt) 1861. Length 0.6 to r, •"— "'ih-gray. P1 e length ol . . „ Color yellowish, reddish, or Pharynx very Urge, almost one-fourth h of body. Anterior end blunt, tail with adhesive papillae. Swims actively at the surface of stand- ing and running water. Brooks, Monroe Co., N. Y., Lake St. Clair, Mich. Fig. 6 r 4. DalyrUisarmifera. U) Irving, ui (5) chitinom portion of dim): m, median branch with 3 to g (mostly 7 or ft) spines; - stuped like a plowshare; 1, dorsal and is. Balk. X foo, (After von Grafl.) ventral cross pieces; 56 (55) Both terminal branches bear a row of plates or spines. TBS I'HHH-LTWTHG. gEJCCWTOWS QCO BW rx Am») 34^- ig- (.^fl TrtTlllillni ^fflffl tri rniLp mm WTlliirai hnmrtr iiniike :fw iitbwn in ah*p*. Oaiyetlui ram Jim ( iouf. cytt. teF«.al> or iew n osr. *. Y . in tonka uw ;* Bb. io. HHw*lM .ifc— . .i .i^mly .a 1 deferens; », yolk gland; », n; i, brain; /ire, ventral longitudinal nerve; ar. pharyn- crvr of brain; tid, duct of yolk gland; tnHj and rs» tb" a of anterior nerves. X 6. (After Ton Graff, Vo.1 Luther.) (S) Front 7U Graff, Vo.1. WoodwortK.) 74 (3>) With a genuine proboscis which lies within a sheath and communi' cates with the exterior through an opening at the anterior end. Pharynx rosette-shaped. Subsection Calyptohhynchia . . 75. A sinatl group easily recognized by the m THE FREE-LIVING FLATWORMS (TURBELLAR1A) 353 75 (76) With a single sexual pore Family Polycystididae. Two ovaries, two yolk glands with finger-like lobes, and two compact testes. Bursa copu- latrix small and without a separate external opening. Single genus thus far found in America Polycystts. Only one species known in America. . Polycystis roosevdli von Graff 1911. Length a mm. Anterior end of body transparent, the rest of the body faintly led reddish. A subcutaneous brown pigment between the longitudinal muscle fibers " ir less striated appearance. The extremely flexible proboscis lies a froi of the The rr European species P. gaetli portion of male copulatory organ. Fig. 616. Patycyitii nwjtwfli. Cb Mi), and ihe duels leading from the the beginning of the second third of the body ai the second and last third of the body. Posterior end very cmi:r. Closely resembles the the structure of the chitinous 76 (75) With two sexual pores, the male posterior to the female. Family Gykatrictdae, One or two ovaries, with yolk glands and one compact testes which lies on the left side. Only one genus known . Gyratrix. Single species known in America. Gyratrix hermapkroditw Ehrenberg 1831. Length a mm. White in reflected light. Eyes black. Without rhabdoids or pigment. Capable of contracting into a ball, or extending to almost double its length as long as it remains actively swimming. Stiletto -sheath of male copulatory organ a short wide tube. The very large bursa copulatrix has a separate dorsal opening to the exterior. Egg capsule oval. From peat bog, Rochester, Monroe Co., N. Y. One subspecies CyroJrtx htmapkrodilus htrmafihrodilus Ehrenberg. Stiletto-sheath with a hook on the end. The egg capsule is gradually reduced to its stalk and is much elongated. Rhabdoids occur in the terminal cone of the proboscis. . male and £ , female (coital pores. X 30. (After von Graff.) (SI Stiletto-sheath with straight lube. o, opening of stiletto •heath; eh. cbitiixw stiletto of cirrus. Much enlarged. (After Halle*.) (C) Gyratrix acnuaatafiau opening of kief: □1 proboscis; 354 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 77 fa) Pharynx either variable or cylindrical and lying within a pharyngeal pocket. Connective tissue well developed. Suborder Allo«ocoela. The intestine is an irregular nc mostly with aide lobes and an anterior and posterior branch. It divides to form a ring in the median ventral region, thus enclosing the slender cylindrical pharynx which is similar in position and appearance to that of the planarians. No fresh-water representative of this Suborder has been definitely established for this country. It seems clear that some must exist in this region and be found on further study of the American fauna. 78 (1) Intestine consists of three main branches, one an anterior branch median in position, and two running to the posterior end of the body, one on either side of the pharyngeal region. Order Tricladida . . 79 Mostly larger than in the preceding order. Pharynx usually median ventral in position, elon- gated, cylindrical, and lying within a pharyngeal pocket with the free end directed posteriorly. Compare figures of a typical Triclad (Fig. 590) and Rhabdocoel given on page 333. 79 (104} Found in fresh-water ponds or streams. . . Suborder Paludicola. Only one family Planakhdae . . So a (103) Pharynx, one 8r 1 (82) With an adhesive disk on anterior end Dettdroeoelum. Only one species known in this country. Dendrocoelum lacteum Oersted 1844. Greatest length 11 mm., breadth 1 to 3 mm. Color milk-white, creamy, yellowiah, or in larger older specimens sometimes roseate. No pigment except in eye spots. Very translu- cent. Intestine colored by contained food. A slight constriction just behind the plane of the eyes sets oS the head and produces the rounded, cephalic appendages. Posterior end rounded, Lateral margins nearly parallel when at rest or contracted. Median adhesive disk extremely variable. Usually about one-third of the broad- est diameter of the head. Inconspicuous in small specimens. It is not a true sucker but consists of a depression into which the glands open and with the margin somewhat raised. Two eyes normally but from one to six accessory ,, eyes are common. Mass,, Mich., Perm.. Wis. What is probably a variety of this species is described as a non-pigmented eyeless Dendro- coelum collected from Mammoth Cave and ad- joining caves in Kentucky. •lew; fc", ceputatory bursa; i; flti.ilttaglMod; tttnt. eiutal pore; ft iff, oviduct; (Alter Woodworth.) li) Without an adhesive disk on anterior end 83 THE FREE-LIVING FLATWORMS (TURBELLARIA) 3SS 83 {102) Normal eyes two or none Planaria . . 84 84 (101) With two normal eyes (sometimes with one c placed accessory eyes) more irregularly 85 85 (94) Anterior end more or less pointed with angular cephalic append <6(gt) Anterior end bluntly pointed, angle formed by lateral margins of head not less than 60 . Cephalic appendages blunt. Body about as wide just back of appendages as immediately in front of them 87 Angle formed by lateral margins of head much greater than 60°. Cephalic appendages very inconspicuous, almost entirely wanting in young specimens. Planaria Jormanii (Girard) r8sa. Planaria fcrtmanii Length uf n Color r irly unfi .., breadth 1 inconspicuous gray area gray to slale-blaii, >. . „ „ oq each cephalic appendage. Eye* gray with a tent ol black pigment on the median aide. Body comparatively thick. Ovaries two, ventral, somewhat lobed and situated about halfway from anterior end to pharynx. Testes four or five on each side, un- paired, dorsal and irregularly distributed from region of ovaries to posterior end of pharynx- Does not multiply by fission. Found in small streams in Mass., Penn., Md., Va, and near Washington, D. C. The species described by Curtis (1900) under the name Planaria simpliciasima and later by Stevens un- der the same name clearly must be regarded as syn- onymous with the species established by Girard in 1S5J under the name P.forematmii. This species also appears under the name P. tumbril in various papers dealing with the physiology of planarians. toe sketch of lartte mature >pecimen: ip, genital pore; fk, ■8 (87) Angle formed by lateral margins of head about 60°. Cephalic ap- pendages distinct. Anterior margin of cephalic appendages of about same length as posterior margin 89 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 356 89 (90) Color blackish to purplish or brownish by reflected light, blackish or gray by transmitted fight. With many irregular spots entirely free from pigment. . Planaria mactdata Leidy 1848. Length 15 mm. Immature specimens average about 8 to 11 mm. In small specimens the pigment occurs in isolated patches and spots. In larger specimens the pigment patches are confluent chiefly in the median region leaving the clear irregular areas which give a very spotted appearance to the animal. Smaller spots of deep brown or black scattered among the larger patches. Frequently with a light median streak. Posterior half of cephalic appendages with non- pigmented spots. Ventral surface much lighter than dorsal. almost entirely free from pigment. Reproduces freely by transverse fission posterior to pharynx. Sexually mature specimens not common in most localities. Sluggish, Much less active than those nearly related species which might be confused with it. Found commonly among algae and water plants or under stones where water is comparatively quiet. Mass.. Perm., III., Mich., Neb. 30 Ptmaria nucmlah. Ml Fran lit *, mouth. X about JJ. (After CuriL 90 (89) Color dark reddish-brown to grayish-brown. Uniformly pigmented. Planaria gonocephula Duges 1830. Greatest length 35 mm. Usually not over 11 nun. Girard describes the color of this species as often of a blackish-brown. Pos- ricular appendages free from .„_.ter on ventral than on dorsal plane joining the apices of the Re- antero-poaterior d Sexual OExanl, longitudinal fcf, patxlls: trf.vas deferens; af. genital -'-lis aaninalii; m, mouth; uld. duct of 1 stands; Mr1, ducts of onus glands: Murhcnla; ■ '"— ■"* -3^7— 91 (86) Anterior end rather sharply pointed. Angle formed by lateral mar- gins of head not more than 60°. Cephalic appendages long, slender, sharply pointed, with anterior margin shorter than posterior margin. Body distinctly narrower back of ceph- alic appendages than just in front 9a THE rJLTJL-lJVTSSG FLkTWOSMS (TVKSEUUXtJCi 92 (03) Angle of bead 50" to oc\ Color 1 black by reflected bghi. very dart scpu-farown «hw« . rUaiana a&iis Stringer iwi. Mannr ^imiw rollerterl navr mm- ' ■ Iminli oi s> nan. Caka usually r vanrty foand only lb Ottr 5 sharply demvd notv^iajnneortil owls ' -wo. almost hkii niflmetii frranutes. .. v the anftaaznncr of a wr> dost- net in sfajrhriv pomrrr u outer anterior rotnon and placed e bur with ihr anterior marirrns of ccnuahc npneadaffes. AT if head with ccjihali.- ot appendac*!' Own *I any noini posterior to ihrm a.-pp: in large iqwvinMms which ut or about same width thntujrh pharyngeal rojnori . Mature specimen? mu,h htnadet runpnrtKinaltv than immature .Viecual reproduction the usual method oi propagation in nM totalities. Very rrsJkss and active. Collected from small ponds and sprirur-tni brooks either among algae or on sandy bottom and oftm where mm flows swiftly N>h„ Mo., S. nak_ Wis, and Oal FK.6». Pimanitt&i. utt lmnuon sprdmea hwnW* XS. ri*i Sexual ettaa*. annul view; a. uirrw. Hi, uneoatabe; P. oviduct: £ f, Knttal pwt: a. atrium: n\ Mfniul veaick: »a\ va drfcxens: fi. conn Turner.: la. limit ol atrium. Murh m 93 (92) Angle of bead about 45s. Color reddish to ycllowish-bnnrn. Plaueria darotocepkaia Woodwonh 1807. Length oi immature specirnens 1 3 mm. Head about one-SKth at tolal length of hody. Vai formly colored. Posterior uhtjim of auricular appendages fire from pigment. Sometime* a narrow right median streak. Pigment in spots ot patches, not a network or evenly diatrihated as in P. seifci; ventral side much lighter than dorsal. Eyes just anterior to plane joining auridej. Intestine usually with accessory posterior intestinal trunki which arise either al the root of the pharynx like the two normal posterior trunks or exist as parallel branches of the Fib. 6 jj. PltmtBit aaratettaala from Ufa. X 1. (After Woodwutth.) 04 (85} Anterior end dearly not pointed 95 95 (too) Anterior end truncated 06 96 (99) Margin of anterior end with a median anterior and two latent rounded projections giving a sinuous outline g; 3SS FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 97 (98) Color gray Pianaria vdata Stringer 1909. Length of nature specimens 15 mm. Color of dorsal si white to a very dark gray almost black. Under lens, a i , rocnt granules- extremely variable in number. Much lighter In (root of ej ... _t - appendages, lighter on ventral surface, over pharynx, and near lateral manna Preserved material often appears colorless and oval in shape. Encystmcnt of ** 3 98 (97) Color brownish-red mottled with purplish dots except at margins. Pianaria unionicola Woodworth 1897. Length of the one specimen (preserved) from which the description was made 3.8 mm., breadth 1.8 mm. Probably 8 to 10 mm. long when alive and extended. Purple dots occur — Red colur absent over an elongated posterior median area extending nearly to the posterior axis of the animal. Appearance of posterior end suggests an injury oc transverse division. Color of alcoholic material a deep rusty red. Found creeping on the mantle of U*ie alttiut in Illinois River. F10.O3C. Naaaria mlmktU from life. About X 3. (After Woodworth.) 99 (06) Margin of anterior end uniformly curved, not sinuous. Color white. Pianaria trumala Leidy 1851. Length 10 to 11 mm. Thickness sBght. Translucent. Digestive tract variously colored >,.. :. — 1 1 ..., . ihaped eyea situated far back and near together. Pharynx much position in actually mature specimens. Intestine with little anas- tomosis of branches. Ovaries two, sometii lobed. Testes many. Uterus large with si running to left side, dorsal to vasa def erentia ana oviducts and entering atrium laterally. Asexual reproduction by fission . Small stream Bryn Mawr ^■'''fy^U'y nfj campus: rivulet at Newark, Delaware. MilkarT' _i A comparison of descriptions of P. tnttaata {■■"IV'JSmTt ft/ Leidy and P. manrfaiw Stevens and Boring leave* WW but n'ttle doubt that they are identical. The \ x8S9 '^ blackish-white color mentioned by Leidy evidently ■J -f''i*Jf.'j U wa* due to '°°*' contained in the digestive tract Ma^B J , and not to body pigment since the margin b de- rafSJJf*/ *. acribed as translucent. tp- Fm.636. Plamtriatrwta. MlFromtiw. X.4- (n) Donal view of Kxual organs: a, atrium: c, cirrus; tf. genital pore; ti, oviduct; pk. pharynx; I. teatta; •■ 100 (95) Anterior end rounded in preserved condition (living condition not known) Pianaria simplex Woodworth 1897. Length 4 mm., greatest diameter i.S mm. Color of alcoholic specimen ocher-yellow. Pig- ment located in spots ol nearly uniform sire, distributed uniformly over all parts of the body; do dear areas surrounding eyes or at sides of bead. General shape ovate. Broadest at one- fifth the total length from the anterior end. tapering from hen to rounded posterior extremity. Anterior end rounded, set off from the rest of the body by slight lateral indentions at the level of the eyes. No evidence of cephalic appendages. Mouth om-tbh-d of total length from posterior THE FXE£-IJVI\C FLATWORMS CTTJRBFU-AJRI.V $$$ ftoodwmlh (84 ■- Withooirycs. - - - ngtr. about 5 ram., oreadtr. 4 mn ij- coovei. inhpnoui Eye no* like of faiui nfiBnacttt upor. t be k. KaaoJCls Ltret n Pi&naria itUigincsus Leidy 1S3I- fr"dy ova!. diiUAi. inienorty tia;. superior!* mou- ir. tbetr ordinary position a slighiti premier i.iir iper suriace Mouth 3 httk posterior to the ccntet- r Pembenuu. New Jetse; . 102 (83) Normal eyes many, arranged so as to suggest a coronet pear the inarRiii of truncated head and extending back near the lateral margins to a somewhat variable distance. PaiyMlis. Only one species known in this country. Poiycdis t-or&Hobi (GiranP iSqi. Length S mm., breadth 1 mm. Color fuliginous or sooty, uniiolm. somewhat darker on the inliiii dorsal region than on uaupnj. Elongated lanceolate. Anterior margin truncated. ■ml Ij biiobed or nddatotiag. Tbe numerous eyes are arranged as a coronet or as an arc ot a circle, tin arrangement being dependent to some extern on sin. Pharynx elongated, cenlral. Collected neat Fun Bridgtr, Wvominp.. It is quilt possible, as Hallei notes, that this is 3 synonym of the European r"«Jy.<*u nerd. Fie 6jS P^yttUt awa. From hie. X J. (Alin Guard.! 103 (80) Pharynges numerous Pkagecota. Only one species known in this country. PhagmaLs gracilis (Haldemanr 1840. This aperies was found and recorded by Haldemari; it was hrst adequately described by Lady to whom it is otdinarily attributed. Largest specimens 35 mm. long. 4.5 mm. wide. Color shiny black by reflected light, green- ko-gray by transmitted light. Varies from black to a reddish-brown on one hand or to a light Bay on the other. Small specimens at times almost milky-while. Ventral side lighter than curia!. Lateral margins nearly parallel. Widest through pharyngeal region Anteriorly sides converge slightly up to about the region of eyes where the diameter increases to form the head with its rounded cephalic appendages. Posteriorly wl*» converge to a point. Eyes two with elongated circum-ocular areas. The numerous pharyngeal tubes lie in a common chamber and own separately into the intestinal tract. When extruded they reach the exterior a single orifice. Pools and rivulets, Mass., Perm., Ohio, Wis. m land. . . Suborder Tenicola . . 105 The so-called land planarians are forms which in a biological sense stand very near the water-living species. They occur only in very moist localities anil under circumstances may be taken for fresh-water forms. In general appearance they resemble minute, delicate slugs When examined under the microscope the structure appears clearly to lie that of a llalworm lather than of a muUusk. Tbe lew known specie* are widely and sparsely distributed. They 360 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY are likely to be transported in tropical or subtropical vegetation and to make their appearance suddenly and in considerable numbers in greenhouses or in moist shady nooks that have been planted with exotic species. Of one form indeed the proper habitat is not known. Walton has worked out a key and synopsis of the few species reported from North America and ad- jacent islands. In modified form this is followed here. Almost no records of the occurrence of these forms on this continent have been published, and their numbers as well as their range are sure to be considerably extended when attention is directed to them. 105 (1 10) Eyes either absent or numerous; length more than 40 mm. . . 106 106 (109) Head anteriorly not broader than remainder of body. Family Geoplanidae . . 107 107 (108) Posterior part of head with eyes in two rows; sides margined with orange Geoplana nigrofusca (Darwin) 1844. Length 50 mm. Found in Mexico; reported also from South America. 108 (107) Posterior part of head with eyes in one row; sides margined with light brown Geoplana stolli (von Graff) 1899. Length 60 mm. Thus far known only from a single specimen collected in Guatemala. 109 (106) Head anteriorly broader than the body. . . . Family Bipaltdae. Only one species Pyocephalus kewense (Moseley) 1878. Color dorsally yellow or greenish-yellow with five dark violet longitudinal lines. Length 80 to 250 mm. An introduced - „ - Df . . . - * * • j species found in not houses. Its original Fig. 640. Pteocepkfus Kewe»se Anterior end. home is unknown. X 1. (After von Graff.) *-*-.«v^».. 110(105) Eyes two in number; ventral suckers absent; length less than 30 mm in Rarely the eyes are apparently absent but even here they may be demonstrated in sections. Ventral suckers do occur in the related family Cotyplanidae. Known from Africa and New Zealand. in (114) Eyes small, marginal sense organs present. Family Rhynchodemidae . . 112 112 (113) Color dorsally light brown with two darker longitudinal stripes and transverse area at posterior two-thirds of body. Rhynchodemus sylvaticus (Leidy) 185 1. Length not over 10 mm. Common in places de- scribed by Leidy (1851) in Pennsylvania and redis- covered in Ohio by Walton (1004). Frequents under A side of slightly decayed boards, stick*, etc., in com- pany with snails, the young forms of which it closely re- sembles. Range, Eastern "^ww^KSBSCT^^ United States. B Fro. 641. Rkynchodtmus syhaticus. (A) Dorsal view of individual from Philadelphia, Pa. X 5. (£) Individual from Newport, R. I., showing arrangement of esophagus and structure of intestine. X about 5. (After Guard.) 113 (112) Color dorsally uniformly dark blue. Rhynchodemus alrocyaneus Walton 191 2. Length 30 mm. Only two specimens of this form have been reported. Found at Gambler, Ohio, under decayed boards. 114 (111) Eyes well developed; marginal sense organs absent. AmUy plana cocker etti von Graff 1899. Color dorsally bluish-black with light yellow median stripe longitudinally and yellow " neck band." Length 17 mm. Represented only by two known specimens found in Jamaica. THE FREE-LIVING FLATWORMS (TURBELLARIA) 361 The following is a list of those forms which are not sufficiently well known to be given their proper place in the key. Order Rhabdocoelida Section I Hysterophora Family Catenulidae Micros to mum philadelphicum Leidy 1851 Microstomum var labile Leidy 1851 Section II Lecithophora Subsection Liporhynchia Family Typhloplanidae Typhloplanid from Canandaigua Lake, N. Y., von Graff 191 1 Typhloplanid from Irondequoit, N. Y., von Graff 10 11 Mesostoma patter soni Silliman 1885 Family Dalyelltdae Dalyellia bilineata (Wood worth) 1896 Dalyellia marginatum (Leidy) 1847 Derostoma elongatum Schmarda 1859 Subsection Calyptorhynchia Rhynchoprobolus papillosus Schmarda 1859 The following Rhabdocoels are of very doubtful position and relationships Vortex (?) cavicolens Packard 1883 Plagiostoma (?) planum Silliman 1885 Acmostomum crenulatum Schmarda 1859 Order Tricladida Dendrocoelum sp. Pearl 1003 A brief description of these doubtful species will serve to promote their re- discovery and further study. Each description is taken from the original account of the species which is also the only record of it yet published. Microstomum philadelphicum Leidy 1851. Body linear, slightly attenuated posteriorly; head conoidal with the apex surmounted by a small oval papilla; tail obtusely rounded. Respiratory fovea subhemispherical, placed at the base of the cone of the head. Mouth oval, projectile; esophagus keg-shaped, intestine narrowed, cylindroid, dilated at the commencement. Colorless, translucent, ciliated, in- creasing by transverse segmentation, always observed in the process of forming two segments. Length 0.9 mm. Found in water of marshes and ditches near Philadelphia. Microstomum variable Leidy 1851. Body broad, linear; anteriorly and posteriorly obtusely rounded. Respiratory fovea longitudinally oval, lateral. Intestine very broad. Colorless, increasing by twos. Length from 0.3 to 1 mm. No nematocysts or rhabdites. Found with Microstomum philadelphicum. Also a chain of 4 individuals was collected in algae culture from shore, Charlevoix, Mich., by Dr. H. B. Ward. Typhloplanid from Lake Canandaigua, N. Y., von Graff 191 1. Length 1 mm. Anterior end set off from the rest of the body by depressions at the sides, prob- ably sensory pits. Broadest through middle of body which measures about one-fourth the length. Spindle-shaped rhabdites in glands and tracts of anterior end. Pigment is present in the form of large reddish-brown granules which mostly lie lengthwise of the body, sometimes branched, and enlarged at posterior end. The pigment forms a reticulation between and passes over the irregularly shaped eyes. Eyes twice as far apart as they are distant from the margin of the body. Pigment of eyes the same as that of the body, only much closer compacted so that they are deeper in color. The mouth lies in the anterior third of the body. In the uncompressed animal the pharynx $te FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY shows as a typical rosette-shaped pharynx. This form If unusual in that the rosette-shaped pharynx does not lead into the intestine from its ventral side, but opens into its anterior end so that when compressed its axis becomes directed forward. Intestine yellowish and extending almost to the posterior end, and having the general shape of the body. ft __.... i; M, pharynx; freefy, showing: the dorsm] pigmentation. ipreswd with pharynx directed forward. tMtiv fin ■ntenor branches of protonep] rhabdite glands. (After voi Typhbplanid from Irondequoit, N. Y., von Graff ion. Length o.s mm. Without pigment and color- less apart from the brownish-red eyes and the oil drops of the intestine. Eyes irregular in shape and almost twice as far from the side of the body as from each other. The mouth lies on the boundary between the first and second thirds of the body. The anterior end shows many tracts of rhabdites. Collected from a reedy swamp. Fig. 6.3- Typhloplanidrromlrondequoit.N.Y. tA, The animal slightly compressed. X S°- IB] Male oopulalorT organ. X 3»o. an. eye: 6c, bursa copula- tin; dr. gland cells, ds, ductus scminalis; /, (at drops: rr, ovary; (d, genital pore; U, granular flands; Ai. graaular secretion: m. muscles: ph, pharynx; a, tracts of rhabdites: «. tastes. (After von GraBJ Mesosioma patiersoni Schmarda 1885, Length 3 to 3.5 mm., 0.6 mm. broad through middle. Color in reflected light brownish except anterior to the eyes which appears grayish from the rhabdites. Intestine yellowish. Body fluid with many cells which contain granules. Eyes directly above the brain. Pharynx rosette-shaped, not far from middle of body. F10. 044. UaeiUma foUrriam W, 70B1 gland: m. uterus; at, bu -— *— " -o. (Alter SOhmxa.) *f, trscu of rhabdites: **, *i. pharynx; t. ctow *, THE FREE-LTVING FLATWORMS (TURBELLARIA) (Woodworth) 18516. 363 Length 0,96 mm., breadth 0.34-0-31 mm. Anterior end truncated, posterior end pointed. Pharynx doliouform, in anterior third ot body, traversed by two prominent, lateral, nearly lon- gitudinal bands of light chocolate-brown, and numerous other pale indistinct longitudinal lines. Zoochlorellae in central part of the body, posterior fifth free from them, trans- parent-brown. Egg dark chocolate, 110 0 x ").. The figures given here are those which were in possession of Woodworth with the material when the description was written and the species named. FIC64;. Dalytllia bUixcata. .i.compipaeti. ; ■■esiculas. ■liimlis: 0 id sketch' by Ward.) DalyeUia marginatum (Leidy) 1847. Blackish, narrow lanceolate, anteriorly truncate; marginate margin delicately striate; mouth large; pharynx large and oblong; eyes two, anterior, distant, each consisting of two round masses of black pigment in contact with each other and of which one is larger than the other; generative orihee one-fourth the length of the body from the posterior extremity. Length 7 mm. A single specimen found in ditches near Philadelphia, Pa. Digestive cavity having a cecum upon each side of the proboscis. The cirrus has a yellow color and consists of a round granu- ss with a moderately long and bent spiculum pro- , . . . ■ from its posterior part. This is the form de- scribed by Leidy under the name Prosloma marginalum. Fro. 646. Dalytllia martinalum. X about 10. (After Girard.) Derostoma elongatum Schmarda 1859. The body is long, ribbon-shaped, flattened. Posteriorly uniformly tapering. Color red- dish-gray. Length 1 mm. Without eyes. Mouth opening elliptical. Pharynx long, cask- shaped. From brackish water in swamp, New Orleans, La. r* Length j mm. Without eyes. t, round, externally set with small papillae. Mouth opening central. Phar- ,bout ynx rosette-shaped. From brackish water, Hoboken, N. J. Vortex (?) cancolens Packard 1883. Found in X cave, one of the Carter caves, Kentucky, Body flat, elongated, narrow lan- ceolate-oval, contracting in width much more than is usual in Vorltz (Dalyellia]. Pharynx fa situated much farther back from anterior end of body than is usual in Vortex, being placed a bttle in front of the middle of the body: it is moderately long, being oval in outline. The body behind suddenly contracts just before the somewhat pointed end. The genital outlet FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Plagiosloma (?) planum Sillimau 1885. Length 1.5 mm., breadth end. Pharynx lies within L and transverse muKlc layers. Radial muscle fibers pass from the base of the pharyni to the body wall. Without eyes or other sense organs. The poorly developed brain lies in front of the phar- ynx as a transverse band. The intestine is capacious and has short lateral diverticula. This species probably belongs to the genus Prathynckm. Acmostomum erenulotum Schmarda 1859. Mouth opening in anterior 1 both longitudinal iss from which is located at the end of the first third of the body. The ovaries form a large spherical mass in the posterior part of the body. The cirrus is short knife-shaped and has a slight double curve. Found in brackish water, Hoboken, N. j. F10. 6;n. Acmetlammm crnmlaimm. From life. X about to. (Alter Scbniuda.) Dendrocoelum sp. Pearl 1903 Agrees with description of Dndraudnm latleum, except in respect to the color. Cofor ranges from a light grey to nearly black, and is uniform. Found about Ann Arbor, Mich. IMPORTANT REFERENCES ON NORTH AMERICAN FRESH- WATER TURBELLARIA Gbaff, L. von. 1882. Monographic det Turbellarien. I Rhabdocoelida. Leipzig. 1904-191 2. Bronn's Klassen und Ordnungen des Tierreichs. IV. Bd., War- mer: Vermes, Turbellaria, Acoela, and Rhabdocoela. Leipzig. 191 1. Acoela, Rhabdocoela und Alloeocoela des Ostens der Vereinigten Staaten von Amerika. Zeitschr. f. wiss. Z00L, 99:321-428. Taf. I- VI. StLLDiAH, W. A. 1885. Beobachtungen uber die Susswasser-Turbelarien Nordamerikas. Zeitschr. f. wiss. Zoo)., 41 : 48-78; Taf. 171, IV. Woodworth, W. McM. 1897. Contributions to the Morphology of the Turbellaria II. On some Turbellaria from Illinois. Bulletin Mus. Comp. Zool. Harvard Coll., 31 : 1-16; 1 plate. CHAPTER Xm PARASITIC FLATWORMS By HENRY B. WARD Professor of Zoology in the University of Illinois The parasitic worms do not all belong to a single systematic division. Coming in many cases from widely separated groups, they often show much closer relationship to certain free-living forms than to each other. But because of a likeness in manner of life these forms were grouped together by early students of ani- mal life as the Helminthes and in fact were long regarded as related by reason of similarities in appearance and habit. There are five such groups, usually ranked as classes; they are Trematoda or flukes, Cestoda or tapeworms, Nematoda or roundworms, Acan- thocephala or proboscis-worms, and Gordiacea or hair-worms. In any given host only a few parasitic species may be found or again the number of individuals and species of parasitic worms in a single host may be very large. I have taken 5000 flukes from a single fish (Amia), and even larger figures are recorded. At a given time the variety of species may be limited; yet as the kinds of parasites change with the food, the season, and the region, the total number found in a certain host may be very large; thus over one hundred species of parasitic worms are reported from man and thirty or forty from some well-known and widely-studied fish or aquatic birds. Some parasites are found in more than a single host species, a few infest a wide range of animals, and others occur in one host only; all in all, parasites are far more numerous than free-living animals both in number of individuals and of species. The abundance of parasites varies greatly under different con- ditions of existence. Desert animals are not without them, but they are much more numerous and more varied in water-living animals than in hosts from any other habitat. Representatives of some or all groups of parasites occur in the various aquatic vertebrates and invertebrates, and while in a 365 366 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY certain sense they are not inhabitants of fresh water, they infest aquatic animals and their life histories form a part of aquatic biology. To be sure some species of parasites never come into contact with the external world but are transferred from host to host with the material in which they are living and others are en- tirely dependent upon terrestrial animals as hosts. Such parasites have no direct relation to fresh-water life and will be entirely omitted in the present discussion. However, in the large majority of parasitic forms the parasitic stage alternates with a longer or shorter non-parasitic period. During this period of free existence the species is a dweller in fresh waters alongside of their normal inhabitants, possessed of similar organs of locomotion and other adaptations to a free existence, often unrecognized in their true nature, and properly regarded as members of the shore or bottom fauna or plankton. This fact alone compels their consideration in any discussion of aquatic life. Contrasted with this stage is the parasitic period which is more extended, usually embracing almost all of the life history. In it the worm remains with its host, dependent upon the latter for protection, locomotion, and subsistence, showing structural modi- fications which aid in maintaining this dependence and indicating by the absence of organs calculated to provide for successful inde- pendent activity the changes which the parasitic habit has induced in its original structure. As already indicated most parasites show distinct adaptations to the conditions under which they live. To be sure some, such as certain small parasitic nematodes, are indistinguishable from their free-living relatives, but such instances are rare. The large majority have lost organs usually found in free forms and have gained structures of significance only for a parasitic existence. Furthermore, both loss and gain are relative and graded, rather than absolute and unrelated. Thus in some flukes the alimentary system is about as well developed as in the free-living Turbellaria, and of much the same type (cf. Figs. 678 and 6395); in other flukes the system is greatly reduced (cf. Microphallus, Fig. 697); and finally in the cestodes it is entirely lacking. The same condi- tions prevail in the threadworms. Most of the true Nematoda PARASITIC FLATWORMS 367 have a well-developed and functional digestive system; in Mermis the system is active during early life and becomes inert and de- generate in the adult stage. Finally in the Acanthocephala there is no trace of an alimentary system at any stage in the life-history. The gains are no less marked. Hold-fast organs, like suckers and hooks, enable the parasite to maintain its position against the con- stant and vigorous movements of the host. Such organs of simi- lar structure appear in widely separated groups, e.g., suckers in flukes and threadworms. While these structural likenesses between parasitic worms of different groups are striking and important, they are in a real sense superficial and do not serve to conceal more than tempo- rarily the fundamental differences in structure between the various groups. The flatworms (Plathelminthes) are soft-bodied, usually elon- gate and somewhat flattened forms. In the phylum are included the free-living Turbellaria (Ch. XII) and Nemertina (Ch. XIV), as well as two classes of parasitic worms: the Trematoda or flukes, and the Cestoda or tapeworms. The other three classes of para- sitic worms named previously are grouped together under the phylum Nemathelminthes or roundworms, which forms the topic of a separate chapter. The structure of each group will be dis- cussed separately, but certain biological features are general enough to deserve brief mention first. Aquatic animals possess some external parasites; among them the species of ectoparasitic flatworms, rare in fresh water, belong to a single subdivision of the flukes or Trematoda; all other flukes and the Cestoda which are all parasitic live as endoparasites in some part of the host organism where they find better protection than on the surface. The most common place of residence is the alimentary canal or its adnexa, air-bladder, lungs, liver, etc. Parasites occur regularly in the body cavity and other serous spaces, in the kidney and bladder, in the sex organs, in the heart and blood vessels, encysted in the skin, connective tissue and muscle, and finally in the nervous system, even entering the eye or brain and its cavities. Parasites may be collected by opening an animal in a dissecting 368 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY dish of suitable size and examining the contents of various organs. The parasites usually betray their presence by sluggish move- ments of the body which make even minute objects conspicuous in a mass of debris. A watchmaker's lens held in place at the eye by a spring is of service in recognizing and sorting out the smaller forms, and long bristles or a camel's hair pencil are useful in pick- ing out the forms for study and preservation. Doubtful objects should be examined under a higher magnification whereupon the firm, definite outline of a parasite enables the student to distinguish it even when motionless from partly digested fragments of food, blood clots, or other foreign bodies of similar size and texture. Parasitic flatworms may be kept some hours in weak normal salt solution for examination or even in tap water, but deteriorate so that for careful study material should be preserved as soon as possible. For preservation an aqueous solution of corrosive sub- limate is most satisfactory, and the precise method of handling suggested by Looss gives results well worth the extra time and trouble because of the greater ease with which future work may be carried on. Because of the great similarity in external form be- tween different types, a determination can be safely reached only after a worm has been stained and mounted in toto, or sectioned in case of large and opaque specimens. The parasitic flatworms have received relatively little attention in North America; it is consequently a difficult matter to prepare a synopsis that is of value to the student, for from our knowledge of the group in other parts of the world it is safe to assert that the known forms do not constitute more than a small fraction of those that actually exist on this continent. Another difficulty which presents itself is the impossibility of defining clearly the limits of the topic. I have endeavored to include in the key all North American parasitic flatworms thus far recorded from fresh- water animals whenever the record permits of any reasonable interpretation. I have omitted a few records so brief or indefinite that a diagnosis was impossible. There is included also a consid- erable number of parasites from distinctly land animals, the life history of which is certainly bound up with stages parasitic in the fresh-water fauna. On the other hand I have omitted all clearly PARASITIC FLATWORMS 369 marine species and all from hosts commonly frequenting the sea and most fikely to become infected there. The parasitic flatworms fall readily into two great classes, the Trematoda or flukes and the Cestoda or tapeworms. Some authors would make a third intermediate group out of the few forms which are known as Cestodaria and resemble the flukes in having a simple body and the tapeworms in details of internal anatomy. In this work they are treated with the tapeworms. As apart from these few cases flukes and tapeworms can be fairly readily distinguished, it is advantageous for the student to have each group treated sep- arately in a distinct section of the chapter; and to this treatment the following brief synopsis may serve as an introduction. Body soft, flattened, shaped more or less like a simple scale, leaf. band, or ribbon Phylum PlatJbelminthes. The external surface may have hooks, spines, or scales, or be provided with warts or rugosities, but it does not possess a tough, shiny, smooth, resistant cuticula. In a few cases the body is cylin- drical, conical, or spindle-shaped and does not display the charac- teristic flattening mentioned in the key. Intestine present Class Trematoda . . page 369. Intestine absent Class Cestoda .... page 424. Sometimes the intestine is so rudimentary or so thoroughly con- cealed by other organs that its presence is difficult to determine. It is, however, the only absolute diagnostic characteristic which in the last analysis separates a fluke from a tapeworm. Trematoda The trematode or fluke is usually flattened, oval, seed-shaped, or rarely rodlike, attenuate, or globular in shape. With few ex- ceptions one finds on the surface one or more cup-shaped suckers. The number and arrangement of these constitute a means of sub- dividing the group. Careful examination under magnification dis- closes pores or openings and also in some cases hooks or spines on the surface. Many of the flukes are transparent and permit the observer to identify the main internal organs. The alimentary system which usually starts at the forward tip 370 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY of the body or close to it and in the anterior or oral sucker is com- monly shaped like a tuning fork (triclad). More rarely it is rod- like (rhabdocoel), or branching (dendritic). A sphincter, the pharynx, is ordinarily found on the esophagus and the true digestive region consists of the two branches, the ceca or crura, which vary greatly in length. The excretory system (Fig. 651) usually opens at the opposite end of the body, and is I-, Y-, or U-shaped. The main branches are distinct, containing in life a clear fluid with a slightly yellowish or bluish tinge. The finer branches can be traced only with difficulty. They terminate in the essential SftS^^rieS; excretory elements known as "flame cells" t™«i^oin^mx'S!a(^ which may be distinguished readily only in ia Wright.) jjjg jjyjjjg animals under high magnification. In the larger tubes one finds commonly highly refractive granules of excretory material. Of the nervous system one can usually see irregular masses (ganglia) right and left of the alimentary canal, near its anterior end. They are joined to form a sort of collar around the esopha- gus, and from them nerves pass anteriad and posteriad throughout the body. Further details of structure can be followed only by special methods and in well-preserved specimens. Special sense organs are not common. A few of the ectopara- sitic trematodes, which are rare in fresh water, have pigmented eye-spots near the brain, and the free-swimming stages of endo- parasites show similar structures which with rare exceptions are wanting in the adult internal parasites. The reproductive system is the most conspicuous part of the worm but is exceedingly complicated and often difficult to follow. Yet it is the most important feature in the classification of the group. Most flukes are hermaphroditic, and contain complete organs of both sexes. The arrangement of these organs in a simple, typical case is given in the accompanying diagram (Fig. 653). In many species an enormous accumulation of eggs in the uterus PARASITIC FLATWORMS 371 obscures all other structures in the body. The eggs are covered with a firm chitinous shell which is often opaque but in other cases is transparent enough to permit one to follow the gradual development of the enclosed embryo. The development of most ecto- parasitic trematodes is simple and not different from that of free-living flatworms. There emerges from the egg-shell in due time a ciliated larva which swims about in the water until it finds a new host to which it attaches itself. In endoparasitic trematodes the life cycle is more complicated in all cases and ex- tremely involved in some. Only a general outline of conditions can be given here. The eggs of the fluke reach the external world in the feces or dis- charges from the host. Within the egg-shell is developed a minute larva, the miracidium, evidently * adapted by its ciliated covering to HkhSTi 3 free existence. Sooner or later the £££"£ ^ t^l. „,, Mm: *•,'.)■ egg arrives in water where the shell 2&f^T*s38ki£& 1.11 • p. yalk reservoir. (Original.) opens and the larva escaping swims about in search of a new host. The latter is not the species which shelters the adult but an intermediate host which for almost all flukes is a mollusk, in the tissues of which the miracidium changes to an irregular sac (sporocyst); this produces within itself a new gen- eration (redia) which also in this host produces a third generation (cercaria). The miracidium possesses an eye-spot (not always pigmented) and often a boring apparatus at the anterior end. These structures are lost in the metamorphosis into a sporocyst, a stage so simply constructed that the young rediae escape by the rupture of the wall. A redia is characterized by the presence of a 37* FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY rhabdocoel intestine with pharynx, an oral sucker, and usually a birth pore. The redia generation may be repeated and either this or the sporocyst generation be eliminated, so that the cycle may become modified in either direction. When development within the mollusk is completed and the transfer to the adult host takes place, the transfer may be direct if the mollusk is eaten by a suitable host. Yet this is not the usual method since the ordinary cercaria possesses a well-developed swimming organ in the tail which characterizes this stage and is cast off when the larva reaches a new host or a place of encyst- ment. This swimming tail is reduced in a few types and wanting only very infrequently. In other cases various modifications, such as bristles, folds, branches, lateral membranes, etc., increase its functional value. The cercaria usually deserts the snail and actively seeks out its primary host, but after reaching the outer world it may also encyst on vegetation or force its way into a second intermediate host, an aquatic arthropod or small fish, and encyst there. Here it rests, a small immature encysted distome, until the tissue is consumed by a suitable host, whereupon it is set free in the alimentary canal and seeks its final location to attain after a period of growth the adult form and full maturity. Life histories are known among trematodes only in the most fragmentary way and the field offers inviting prospects to the student. As appears from the account just given two free-living stages recur in the development of most flukes. The miracidium nor- mally depends on active migration through the water to reach and infect the secondary host. In spite of the constant and abundant production of such larvae their occurrence in plankton or other fresh-water collections is not recorded. This may be due to the extreme delicacy of the larvae which go to pieces almost as soon as collected. When infected snails are kept in an aquarium, the cercariae swarm out at certain times in great numbers and can be seen swimming actively about in the water. They conduct themselves under such circumstances like true plankton organisms: protozoa, rotifers, and entomostraca in the same aquarium. Yet although PARASITIC FLATWORMS 373 sudi larvae are produced in great abundance and infected mollusks are also abundant and widely distributed, there are few records of nrrraTiaf in reports on aquatic life. Leidv found cercariae free in the Delaware RiveT and in a Wv- azning pool. Wright discovered the remarkable anchor-tailed oer- caiia among weeds, and I have taken several forms including the striking Cercaria gargonocephal<2 in the tow with a plankton net. None the less among the fresh-water organisms that are least known one may well list the free-swimming stages of parasitic worms. From this survey of the life history it is evident that the degree of trematode infection depends: first, on the presence of water at the time when the cercariae or miracidia swarm out; and second, on the occurrence of mollusks in the region to act as intermediate hosts. Hence flukes are rare in arid areas and also in regions lacking in lime where mollusks are all but wanting. In general, infection is seasonal and may be traced to the climatic conditions because periods of excessive moisture permit the swarm- ing of the larvae, whereas during dry months the egg-shells remain unbroken. The study of the adult parasites has shown that in most cases observed the flukes produce eggs continually and seem to display equal reproductive activity in all parts of the year. The number of flukes found in a given host does not appear to vary seasonally although it does vary widely in individual hosts. The fishes, amphibians, reptiles, birds, and mammals that occur in and around various fresh-water bodies shelter a multitude of species of trematodes. The group has never been studied care- fully on this continent and data available include mostly casual or fragmentary observations on a few of its members. Pratt made the first general list of these species. Since then a number of students of individual genera or groups of flukes have added to the count. Even this has only made a start at recording the North American species in the region which has been studied and one can hardly venture to predict the number of species in parts of the country where no collections at all have been made. The total trematode fauna of North America is greatly beyond any present records and cannot be estimated from the data at hand. 374 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Even concerning the forms listed it must be confessed that our knowledge is very imperfect. In preparing the key I have followed the plan so admirably formulated by Looss and worked out in various groups by Braun, Liihe, and Odhner. The data on larval forms (Cercariae) are adapted from Cort and Faust. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER TREMATODA i (169) Adult forms; sex organs developed and functioning 2 2 (28) Posterior organs of attachment powerfully developed; those at ante- rior end absent or if present poorly developed and paired. Chitinous hooks and anchors almost always present. Subclass Monogenea .3 Excretory pores anterior, double, dorsal; uterus short usually containing only a single egg. Development simple, direct. Most forms are ectoparasitic on body surface or gills. In fresh-water hosts found in urinary bladder (Amphibia) or respiratory passages (turtles). 3 (8) Posterior organ single. Vagina unpaired. No genito-intestinal canal. Order Monopisthocotylea Odhner . . 4 4 (5) Two suckers at anterior end, entirely independent of the oral cavity. A single large posterior sucker. Family Tristoiodae van Beneden 1858. Monogenetic, ectoparasitic trematodes with a single large round terminal sucker, often armed with hooks, and with two smaller yet conspicuous lateral suckers at the anterior end. Mouth ventral just behind anterior suckers. Many forms parasitic on gills of marine fishes; a few reach fresh water through the movements of migratory fish. Only species reported from North America. Nitzschia sturionis (Abildgaard) 1704. Reported by Linton from gills of sturgeon (Acipenser sturio) at Woods Hole. May be carried at times into fresh water. 5 (4) Anterior end expanded, bearing special structures of some sort and yet never true suckers alone. Family Gyrodactylidae van Beneden and Hesse 1863 . . 6 Small, slender, elongate trematodes with anterior end variably provided with specialized structures, only rarely true suckers and then associated with other special organs. Posterior disc without suckers, usually with two or four huge hooks in the center and a considerable number of small marginal booklets. On the skin and gills of fishes. The genera reported from fresh water all fall in the section of the family in which the an- terior end is provided with two or four retractile cephalic tips in which open ducts of numer- ous dermal glands. 6 (7) Posterior disc with two large central hooks. No eyes. Gyrodactylus von Nordmann 1832. Anterior end provided with two lateral contractile lappets. Large central hooks of pos- terior disc turned ventrad, shaped like fish hooks and bound together at the roots by a special damp piece. Marginal hooks sixteen, simple. Viviparous. On skin and gills of many fresh-water fish, especially Cyprinidae. At times numerous enough to destroy the external dermal layer and leave the fin rays naked. May cause death of host. Reported only twice in North America; from young lake trout in Maine and small-mouthed black bass, Ontario, Pan«H» Species uncertain. Cause of serious epidemic among young fish at hatchery (Craig Pond); also on wild fish in same stream. PARASITIC FLATWORMS 375 7 (6) Posterior disc with four large central hooks. Two pairs of eyes. Ancyrocephalus Creplin 1839. Anterior end bluntly triangular with two inconspicuous lobes on each side, but no distinct cephalic lappets. Posterior disc bears four large, heavy hooks and clamp, and fourteen or sixteen small marginal hooks of which two lie before and two behind the large hooks. Ovi- parous. On the guls of many fresh-water fish. Two species, determination doubtful, reported by Cooper from Ontario, Canada. On the gills of young black bass. Also from rock bass and sunfish. 8 (3) Posterior organs multiple (two to many parted). Vagina double. Genito-intestinal canal present. Order Polyopisthocotylea Odhner . . 9 Suckers at anterior end, if present, open into oral cavity. Posterior end with variable but well-developed organs of attachment consisting of hooks and suckers grouped on a terminal field or disc. 9(12) With two Qral suckers and with genital hooks 10 10 (n) Posterior disc with eight, less often four (five) small peculiar sucking organs. Family Octocotylidae van Beneden and Hesse 1863. Elongate, flattened ectoparasitic trematodes. The posterior organ of attachment has — usually in two parallel symmetrical rows — eight, more rarely four or six, small suckers braced with a characteristic chitinous framework or armed with hooks. Extra hooks occur often on the disc. Genital pore always armed with hooks. Eggs supplied with one or two long fila- ments. On gills of marine and fresh-water fishes. These parasites are rare in fresh water yet no doubt other genera than the two cited here do occur. The American representatives are not well known and only the first is more than an accidental member of the fresh-water fauna. For this reason no effort has been made to incorporate them in the key. Mazocraes Hermann 1782. One species, formerly known as Octobothrium sagitlatum, is reported by Wright from the sucker (Catostomus teres). Plectanocotyle Diesing 1850. Reported from the gills of Roccus amerkanus which enters fresh water to spawn so that this parasite may be taken at times in that habitat. 11 (10) Posterior disc with a large number of small suckers. Family Microcotylidae Taschenberg 1879. Elongate ectoparasitic trematodes with two small anterior suckers connected with the oral cavity and with the posterior end expanded into a foot-like region bearing a multitude of minute suckers. Eggs with large filaments at both poles. Body and posterior organ of attachment symmetrical. Microcotyle van Beneden and Hesse 1863. A genus parasitic on the gills of marine fishes. G. A. and W. G. MacCallum report three species from the rock bass (Roccus Uneatus) which ascends rivers along the Eastern Coast for spawning. Hence these parasites might be taken in fresh water, though no record of such an occurrence has been found. 12 (9) Anterior end pointed, without suckers or other special organs. Family Polystomtdae van Beneden 1858 . . 13 Elongate, flattened monogenetic trematodes with simple anterior end, and with prominent adhesive disc at posterior end. Posterior disc with hooks and either two or six large powerful suckers. Mouth subterminal, intestine triclad, often dendritic, with anastomoses. Male genital pore and uterine orifice median, ventral, postpharyngeal. On body surface, gills, and in urinary bladder of amphibians; in pharynx and cloaca of rep- tiles. 376 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 13(37) Posterior disc with sii suckers. 14 (36) Posterior disc terminal; suckers large. Potystoma Zeder 1800 . IS Six suckers in ■ circle or in two rows somewhat separated in Che median line. In the center of each sucker ■ small hook, and others on anterior and posterior manias of shield; between posterior acetabula two huge books. Vagina double, one pore on each side Dear the ante- rior end. Eggs without pour filament. Genital atrium with circle of hooks. Several species in reptiles and amphibians. Not common but widely distributed. P. inlixtrrimmm Zeder, type of the genus, is not reported from North America. American species worked oat by S tankard. All North American forms fall in the section of the genus characterized by the presence of " ' — ' ' --.j- - - - -*- --- '-— > ^j name should be given. o these forms a Polysloma (Polystomoidts) Ward. ■5 (33) Great books present on caudal disc and well developed 16 16 (21) Genital books of equal length 17 17 (18, 11) Not more than 16 genital hooks. P. (Polystomoidts) hassaM Goto 1809, Length 1.3 to imm.; width0.4too.65mm. Cauda] suckers 0.1 » to 0.16 mm. in diameter. Caudal disc with 18 hooks, the largest 0.115 mm. and the smallest o.ojj mm. long. Cir- rus books 0018 mm. long with a winglike process at the middle. Uterus contains only a single large egg measuring o. 1 1 by 0.15 mm. 8 by 3. 18(17,11) Genital hooks 33. 19 (k>) Acetabula large, adjacent, not contiguous; pharynx smaller than oral sucker. . . P. {Pdystomoides) coronatum Leidy 1888. Body 3.15 by 0.03 mm. Caudal suckers 037 mm. in diameter. Caudal disc with one pair of great books, 0.131 mm. long, one pair of intermediate hooks, 0.051 mm. long, and small books, 0.01 mm. long. From the common food lerraptn (Leidy), FxlSm. fatfrJtsM Xu. (Aits suniiardj i'lRASITTC iLATWORMS mtt h. «itu .1 friiLirr S: .V,lin*.1 < 378 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY aS (h) Genital hooks 33 in number. P. {Pdyslorrwides) opacu; Stunkard 1916. suckers 04 mm. in Length 3 to 4 mm., width aJloiu diameter. On caudal disc many small booklets 7 tt „__„. _ „, larger pair, 7s !• long; no great books present. Genital coronet of 31 (33?) equal hooka. Egg oval. 0.25 by 0.1 mm. Vitellaria of large compact follicles under dorsal surface from pi to caudal dtoeexcept overovarian complex; 1 to obscure internal organs and render body 01 In esophagus of Trumyr favi and of Malacademmys UnmrH; Texas. 16 (14) Posterior disc overhung by a nap bearing four hooks. DiplobotMrium F. S. Leuckart 1842. s two books on each side. from St. Lawrence River. n tha gills of the lake sturgeon {Acipemcr ruiicamdiu) »7 {13) Posterior disc with two suckers Sphyranwa Wright 1879. Caudal lamina considerably wider than slender body, with two im- mersed suckers, two large books behind tbem. and sixteen small books arranged seven along each side of the lamina and one in each sucker. Two contractile bladders anteriorly, each with a dorsal pore. No lateral vaginae. Oviparous. F10. 6JJ. Sfifnmm (After Wrijht and PARASITIC FLATWOUCS 370 38 12 Organs o: attar: rrmen : om or lw\ suckers o: wnjcti liu anient) : is aiway^ singa aac median, witiiou: chitinotL- hooks or anchors, accessory suckers rare buuaassDigenea 20 Kinniay amm -empty o> a smgi- port a: o: near posuxio: enu Lieru* usualiv Jong, containing jnaase* 01 egg raren onr ~ lew lievdopmoci complex, will, alternation of Justs and most olteu a*so 01 generation. Withxare rxfrrpf ion* acbdu cndoi wtrasu 1 c in viscera organ*, usual! \ alimentary system of ver- nthrafp-.. itniarrrl adult* occur iu mouusks and insects winch axe the normal hosts tor young tor ary to izee living jarvai stages *ee section on Cercari~. 171 U70: in tins kev J9 ^30 Anterior sucker no: perioral t mouth on mici- ventral surface no urai or venirai sucker: . Uruer Gastarostamaxa Odhne: Pharynx and eaopnagus preaen: intestine aaccuiatu, simpi-.. Yitcliaria lateral in anterior region 01 Doa \ . <*enn glands benina intestine, in posterioi regio:. Tester two. cirrus eion KBLtf, pore ventrai near posterior enc ovarv sunpu., opposite or in Iran: oi anterior testis Singie lamiiv. Bucephaudae Pocbt 190;. Oniy genus known. Bucepnaius von Laer i82t. Anterior end bears iargc sucker with ventra, orinoi an^ smai. muscular papillae at laierai angle Tnr adu::, better known as KjiU+ero**>mum, nas been reporter oni\ iron; Canada tnougn to juuge irom uic abundance o; tiu cnaracterisiK. two-tailec cercaria it must occur irequentty 11 1 oinci region.- Stomacn, intestine, anu ceca oi black uas» ana Hoif-oiom^ nigrun: haiiy stages encysted in young biark bass, rock u*uo, perc:., an oral sucker, another sucker if present media: 1. behinu mouth on ventral surface or ai postexioi end Order Prosostomata Odhncr . ; 1 31 (36) Intestine simple, rhabdocoei , oral sucker very pooriy developed ventral sucking organ a powerful, conspicuous, adhesive disc or a series of smaller sucker^ Suborder Aspidocotylea Monticclli. Terminal or subtexminai moutii surrounded dv tunnei-snaped expansion oi skin, but no: h> true sucker. Holdfast organs ventral, usually in iorm of lar^t sucking disc distinctly sc: ofi irom body and subdivided into numerous sucking alveoli, oul neve: carrying chiunou- nook> or anchor :>. or in place of disc singiL series ui small disconnect cu sucker >. Alimcntan canal simple, rnabdocoel. Sexual organs simple Deveiopmeni wiiii or without alternation oi hosu and generation r>. Endoparasitu, or rareiv ectoparasitu . in mollusk> and cold-blooded vertebrates. forms not numerous, httie known, grouped togetner at present inti> a singie family. . . AfiPiDoGASTkiDAF Poctie 1007 . . 3; FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Adhesive organ oval, composed of four rows of alveoli. Aspidogaster von Baer 1836. s of quadrangular sacking grooves. Margin notched, with at organs. Month terminal; intestine extending into posterior end. Sexual pore median; in depression between ventral shield and fore- body. Onry snail; testis single, same mat as ovary. Uterus moderately long; ova large. In fishes and moHusks. Representative American species. A spido goiter amckkola v n fresh w 1 Baer 1826. The common North A concMctla v. Baer, is aha the most c idae. From pericardial and renal c - -r group; St. Lawrence River; Havana, Illinois; North Judson, In- diana; Iowa; Pennsylvania. Kelly reported thirty-seven cut of forty four specie! of Unionidae and 4 r per cent of the 1577 individuals : parasitized by this species. Occasionally found in " t has been introduced the inti which as taken as food. Flo. 661. AiMmUmcm^— . aad idk Uckl left oat. C!""x'^™(AltaSul™ 3.10*) Adhesive disc oval, composed of three rows of alveoli 34 34 (35) Mouth subtenninal, not surrounded by buccal disc. Cotyiospis Lady 1S57. Ventral shield much as in AspiiaivUr, save that the alveoli are in three longitudinal rows, the central alveoli being elongated transversely. Marginal sense organs present, also two ryes. Ovary dextral, smaller than single testis in posterior aid. Ova not numerous, large. Of several species known, CMytoipis iwiirwu Leidy 1857, is most frequent. It is adherent to surface of boat in angle between inner gill and visceral mass (Kelly); or branchial cavity (Leidy) of many species of Unionidae: Havana, 111.; Grand Rapids. Midi.; Lake Chataoqua, N. Y.; Cedar River, la.; Schuylkill River, Pain. Kelly examined over 1600 individuals of 44 species which belong in 14 separate host species arid found iS per cent infected. The number in a single boat is small. Representative American species. Cotylaspii coktri Barker and Parsons 1914. 1 the Intestine of PARASITIC FLATWORMS i, siuToiiruiei! by expanded buccal disc. iotyiogdssrr Wonucelli 1843. Ventral dis. composed oi tingle median raw of Ktoovti greatly elongated transversely and aur- " ml [on- oi small, circular alveoli Moutn ■nOflU LdB g ptrpiMryni. and esophagu.'- Ovary and two testes jusi behind it iorm linear series posterior to center oi body Laurel . canal present. Embiyv with iatf posterior auckrr ; development unknown Parasitic in intestine oi Danes. Single North American species. ColyioguOfr occidental is Nickerson 1400. B. Diagram iaow- £ represented, as straightened he ie i'orked; oral sucker distinctly developed; ventral sucker if present simple 37 In one genus (Cryplonimimu together; in a lea genera it is rounding the sexual port:, but i have * complex, many-parted st The forms embraced under ti the ventral sucker consists of two s lore or Its.- intimately connected with a genital sucker aui no case does it consist of a aeries oi small sucking organ* 0 in the four suborders which folk™, stand in aharp contrast witn tnose oi cue suooruer /tspiuocotylea just preceding. In fact the latter are so dis- tinct in general appearance, in structure, and in development, thai thry have regularly been grouped heretofore apart from the order* which follow They were generally included under the Monogenea tp. 374) until Monticelli revived the original view that they should be regarded as an independent subdivision oi equal rant intermediate between the Monogenea and the Digenea (p. 379). Their very recent inclusion in the latter group has been well justined; j n witb that the striking differences noted above must be kept clearly ii The forms which follow fall naturally into four groups ranked here a.-, sulio easily distinguished by a single ejiemal icainre. the adhesive apparatus. I'otisi: which in number and arrangement art characteristic of each group Thus the t in addition to the oral and ventral suckers a special adhesive organ behind tl special organ is variable in form and character. In the amphistomes one find terminal sucker, but no other adhesive organs The dislomcs possess an ora sucker but none iurther back, while finally the munostume, have only one sui ogimed groups arc already beginning to break up under the in it subdivision, distributing its members aiuonn other groups. .: they a 382 FRESHWATER BIOLOGY 37 (48) No ventral sucker present; oral sucker only adhesive organ present. Suborder MamtamW Zedcr . . 38 Endnparasitie trematodes with flattened bod; and single sucker which surrounds mouth at anterior end. Intestinal crura often unite m posterior end of body. Genital pore usually ventral or marginal m anterior region, or rarefy median posterior. Life history relatively m- known. For drreiopmental stages see 174 (183) m this key. Forms not well known, though frequent especially m reptiles (turtles) and birds; rarely also ■unraak North American records scanty. Host of the forms described from tins continent as " Mooostooiuni" cumot be located lion depends. It is indeed likely that some of them were wrongly placed in this croup and more complete knowledge of their structure will result in their transfer to some other section. Until the specimen* are restudttd they most all be regarded as uncertain. Soch doubtful " - ■• u Jfawamusp. in Stiles and HassaH's Catalog (1904) and the following: ' I Stafford from bullhead. If. ojferm Odhner contends that the monostomes are isolated members of other groups that have lost all suckers save the oral and that they should be classed in the various families from which Ihey have sprung. For practical reasons it win be necessary to retain the group at least until its forms are much better known. 38 (45) With two compact testes, and follicular viteUaria. 39 39 (44) Body elongated. Not parasitic in dermal cysts 40 40 (41) Intestinal crura connected at posterior end. Testes near posterior end, within crura, asymmetrical. Ovary between testes, and intercecal but opposite to them. Family Cycxocoeudae Kossack 1911. Large monostomes with thick, muscular body, somewhat flattened. Esophagus short, no pharynx. (Kossack designates the structure which lies near the mouth as the pharynx; I have Called It tbe oral sucker. He says these forms do not posse* an oral sucker.) Intestinal branches simple or with small ceca on tbe inner side connected at posterior end by continuous arch. Genital pore median, ventral to and neat oral sucker. Receptaculum seminis and Laurer's canal noting. ViteUaria well developed, lateral and sometimes dorsal to intestine: transverse duct just in front of posterior testis. Uterine coils numerous, regular, transverse, occu- pying space between posterior testis and fork of intestine. Eggs numerous, without polar filaments. Air passages of water birds; frequently reported as in body cavity. Only American genus. . . . Cydocortum Braiides 1892. Intestinal crura simple, genital pore near sucker, or at anterior margin. Cirrus sac small, rarely extending beyond fork of intestine. ViteUaria eitracncal from fork of intestine to posterior end, not continuous with opposite side. Reproductive glands in posterior region in arch of intestine at comers of triangle. Ovary smaller than testes, on side opposite them. Uterine coils do not extend laterad beyond the intestinal branches. Eggs thick-shelled, large. The species designated by Leidy as "probably Monoitoma mulabile Zedcr" belongs here if his determination be accepted. It sras collected from the gray snipe (Gallixoto mlitni). Pro. 664. CydtetOum swMKfr. X j. (After Knack.) 41 (40) Intestinal crura end blindly at posterior end. Testes symmetrical, in posterior region, outside of crura. Ovary intercecal, between testes. . . . Family Nctocotylidae Lflhe 1909 . . 41 a with elongated flattened body tapering and rounded at both ends. On PARASITIC FMTWORMS *» ■:.,. JU ,M.l-[( ,i™( •.■.fTal <,"•*: 3«4 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY anterior to center. Vitellaria In seven symmetrical groups, marginal in anterior region. Testa symmetrical. Ovary in front, strongly lobed. Coils of uterus irregular, mostly lateral In posterior half of body. Eggs very small. Representative American species. .... Collyridum cotei Ward. history is unknown; the supposition that avian insect para- sites act as the intermediate host is citrrmely improbable. It attacks only ^oung sparrows and infected birds are found only during or just after a wet period (Cole). The parasite has been found again in Boston, Mass. These specimens differ dearly from the European form in numerous minor details, such as ovary, yolk glands, dermal spines, etc., and demand recognition as a distinct species under the name given here. 45 (38) With elongate tubular testes and vitellaria. Family HERONH£II>AE Ward . . 46 Moderate siaed mono; tomes with thick, eloogate. soft body somewhat flattened, tapering both towards painted anterior and bluntly rounded posterior end. Skin smooth. Oral sucker weak, pharynx large, esophagus short, ceca simple, extending to hut not united at posterior end. Vitellaria compact, tubular, shaped like inverted V. Uterus in four longitudinal re- gions. Genital pore ventral to oral sucker near anterior tip. Testes tubular, lobed or with abort branches, united into V-shaped organ with apex antoiad. Copulatory apparatus poorly developed. Lungs of reptiles. Northern North America. Two genera imperfectly known which may prove to belong in a single genus. 46(47) Vitellaria extend only half way from ovary, to posterior end. Seminal receptacle present. . . Heronimus MacCallum 1902. Oral sucker small, pharynx large, no esophagus, simple intestinal crura which reach the posterior end but do not unite. Ovary oval or bean-shaped, lateral in anterior third of body; receptaculum present but no Laurer 5 canal. Uterine loops intracecal; terminal section of uterus sacculate. Vitellaria small, elongate, not follicular. tubular (?). Genital pore ventral to oral sucker. Testes V-shaped with coarse lobes, in median third of body, with median stem directed antoiad. Fro. MS. Bwr^mmicUyirm. From at ■howia, raak awawal at — ">- — — (AftaTktcCaawanJ PARASITIC FLATWORMS 385 47 (46) Vitellaria extend from ovary to posterior end of body. Seminal receptacle absent. . . . Aorchis Barker and Parsons 1014- Oral sucker small, weak, pharynx large, esophagus short, intestinal ceca long, not united at posterior end. Ovary entire, just behind fork ol intestine. Vitellaria compact, tubular, ■ tarsely lobed or with short irregular branches extending almost itire length of body. Two divisions of uterus looped or coiled around intestinal ceca. Other two divisions straight longitudi- nal tubes. Terminal division conspicuous, heavy, dark band length of the body in the median plane. Testes tubular, irregularly lobed. Genital pore ventral, :rior tip of body. Eggs with short polar stalk at one Type species. Aorchis extensus Barker and Parsons 1914. Lungs of Cfayicmys marjiisafo, Mississippi River (Minnesota) and also, in various turtles from Michigan, Indiana, Illinois, Nebraska. Flo. 669. Aarckii txlauia. Only anterior portion of testa ahowa in drawing. X 8. a. Embryos in utenu; aate conspicuous eye ipoU. 48 (37) Ventral sucker present, usually single though varied in form and position; never represented by numerous small organs in The acetabulum or ventral sucker proper is a closed organ, not possessing any inner opening or connecting with any special organ or system. It may be so insignificant in size as to be difficult to distinguish, in which case the form is erroneously diagnosed as a monostome as has often occurred. On the other hand it may be as wide as the body or wider and so powerful is to distort the form of the animal. It may be sessile or be borne on a stalk or peduncle. In some species a special secondary sucking organ is developed around the genital orifice ■nd this may even become so highly differentiated as to exceed in site or include the true ven- tral sucker. Those forms which possess this highly developed adhesive organ ordinarily have Ihe body divided into two distinct regions. In location the acetabulum is near the posterior end in the group of amphistomes and at or interior to the center of the body in the disfomes and holoslomes. The latter are readily recognized by the peculiar adhesive organ and the separate regions of the body even though the details of form are very variable in different genera. 40 (61) Acetabulum terminal or subterminal and posterior to the repro- ductive glands. .... Suborder Amphistomata Nitzsch. Endoparasitic treroatodes with oral opening anterior and terminal. Oral sucker powerful, oval or more elongate, often with two dorso-lateral muscular pockets. Acetabulum conspicu- ous, much larger than oral sucker, at or very near posterior end. Body muscular, thick, little flattened and often conical, tapering anteriad. Skin without spines but regularly provided *ith sensory or glandular papulae. Eicretory bladder sacculate, with median ventral pore rear posterior end. Genital pore ventral, median, in anterior region. Testes large anterior lo small ovary. Vitellaria follicular, lateral, paired. Uterus simple, with few coils. Eggs numerous, small, plain. Development complex with alternation of generations and hosts- Only family recognized. Paramphistomidae Fischoeder iooi . . 50 50(61) Oral sucker terminal; acetabulum simple, not divided 51 51 (51) No postero-lateral pockets on pharynx. Subfamily Paramphistominae Fischoeder 1001. None of these forms is parasitic as adults in aquatic animals. One species occurs in domea- ticruminants in North America. The redia and cercaria develop in some fresh, water snails as u known of the related European forms. Compare 185 in this key. 386 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 51 (51) Postero-latexal pockets present on pharynx. . 53 (56) Testes two, more or less deeply lobed. Subfamily Cladorchhnae Fischoeder 1901 . . 54 Ainphistomes with mote or teas strongly flattened body, and with acetabulum usually con- spicuously ventral, rarely only terminal. Testes branching or lobed. Cirrus sac incom- plete or nearly wanting. In this subfamily belongs possibly the " Ampkuiama frandt Diesing"of Leidy from the terra- pin which does sot seem to conform to the species designated. The description is inadequate 54 (55) Pharyngeal pockets small, not affecting external boundary of oral sucker Stkhorchis Fischoeder 1901. Body noticeably attenuated anteriorly, broadly rounded posteri- orly. Margins rounded, dorsal surface high, arched, ventral flattened. Acetabulum ventral. Pharynx lacking; crura not much separated (rom lateral margins. Cirrus sac small, genital sucker not conspicu- ous. Vitellaria well developed, mostly behind testes and median to crura, as well as partly dorsal and ventral to same- North American species. Stkhorchis subfriquttrus (Rudolphi) 1814. One species, St. subiriqutlrui, the true Anpiisfoi Rud. In intestine of the beaver; Quebec, Ontario. mpkisloma siMriqiutrum Fig. B70. SUcirrckii a 55 (54) Pharyngeal pockets large, conspicuous, modifying greatly outline of oral sucker Wardius Barker and East 1015. 3 with prominent pharyngeal pockets, and 'topbagus well developed, without differ- Testes slightly lobed, tandem, regions; crura long and wavy, testes slightly lobed, tande ■ of body. Ovary median, behind testes near posterior suck pore posterior to bifurcation of intestine. Vitellaria extend 01 Genital pore , side crura from oral to posterior sucker. 56 (53) One or two testes, spherical, . PAKASmc PLATWOHMS 5S; 58 (57) ViwUsria consist of small scattered lateral follicles. Cirrus present. . . Subfamily Schizamphistominae: Looss i Representative North American genus. Allassostonm Stunkard 1016 . . Large oral invaginations open independenll; agcal bulb composed oi concentric muscle h glands mrdian, near center of Ifixiv Both lesi uttered lateral iollides, in posterior region wit into oral sucker, do preoral sphincter: esoph- icllae. Hermapbioditk dun present. Genu > anterior to ovary. Yitellarin consist of small median follicle.- also. Laurer s canal open* in 59 (60) Large worm (ov 1. long) with small suckers. AUiisstislomii mtignun; Stunkard 1016, Length 10 to 12 mm., breadth ,1 to 5 mm., thickness 1,5 to 1 mm. Living worm dear, slow-movins. capable- oi great extension. Acetabu- lum siu> terminal, ovoid, wider anleriad, 1 tu j.j mm. lone by 1 mm. wide. Oral sucker terminal, o y to 1.35 mm. lung by o.u to o.y mm. wide; oral pockets arise at posterior end oi oral sucker by separate lateral openings and extend dorsad and caudad. Testes oval, 0.17 to o.j5 by 0-4; to o.u mm., long axis transverse, located near center of body and slightly oblique. Ovary median, spheri- cal or oval, o.iu to 0.35 by o.ji to 0.57 mm. in diameter. Vitelline follicles small, sparse, anterior]. Hirjual, but iiosterioily also intracccal. No receptatulum seminU and nc vitelline reservoir. Bigs 0.1 by o,ii in intcatine ., Missouri 60 (59) Small worm (length about j mm. or less) with large suckers. AUassoUoma panwn Stunkard 191 6, From Cktfydra lapnUuia. Urbana, ill. FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 61 (50) Oral sucker, subterminal; acetabulum divided by transverse ridge into two pockets. . . . Subfamily Zyoocotyunae Ward. Representative American genus. Zygocotyle Stunkard 1916. Acetabulum consists of ulterior put extending dorsad and interim! into body, and posterior overhanging lip bearing on each aide conical projection. Posterior end of esophagus surrounded by muscular bulb in which fibers are not arranged in concentric lamellae as in other atnphistomes. Vitellaria weU developed, with large folKcles. in extracecii! region from oral sucker to acetabulum. Uterus and germ glands intracecal. Eggs numerous, 0.14 by o.oSj mm. Type species. . . Zygocotyle ceraloso Stunkard 1016. From intestine of Anas ptalyrkynclus; Nebraska. 61 (49) Acetabulum conspicuously ventral and usually anterior to center of body. Reproductive organs completely or largely posterior to acetabulum 63 63 (160) No holdfast organs present except oral -and ventral suckers. No sharp separation between anterior region with holdfast organs and posterior region with genital organs. Suborder Dutomata . . 64 64 (150) Hermaphroditic distomes 65 65 (148) Ovary anterior to testes 65 66 {107) Coils of uterus do not extend posteriad beyond testes, or at most not beyond the posterior testis 67 Bunodera (103 in this key) and Cryptogonimus (106) are exceptions. 67 (106) Acetabulum a single typical sucker which may be stalked or united with special genital sucker but Is not divided 63 68 (105) Not more than two testes present 69 69 (74) Both ovary and testes dendritic; uterus limited to a restricted mulastt: TiFTWaSM- "i-nmi ■ VtgiiiiiMii kfl'iiiir- Wjo^. ;:i s, living usually by pairs in cyst -like cavities. W,(p. 384). is regarded by Odhner as properly ■ 390 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 73 (70) Dbtomes moderate in size, thick bodied; ovary and testes lobed or coarsely branched; uterine coil chiefly lateral to acetab- ulum Family Troglotbeiiatidae Odhner 1014. Distomes of snail to moderate size with compressed body. Skia with spines in groups. Ventral surface flat, dorsal arched. Musculature and suckers poorly developed. Intestinal crura do not reach posterior end. Excretory bladder V-shaped, or tubular. Genital pore close to acetabulum. Cirrus sac lacking. Testes symmetrical, post acetabular. Ovary dextra), immediately in front of testes, lobed or branched. Laurer's canal present. Vitel- laria very extensive, covering dorsal surface save for narrow median strip. Uterus long, in open loops, or shorter in tight coil; eggs in first case small, in second moderately large. Paraaites of birds and cami> " The manostnme, CvUyridmt this family. Only American genus Paragonimus M. Braun 1899. Bo* walls. Testes lobed, symmetrical, in hindbody. Ovary lobed, lateral, pretesticular, and postacetabular. Vitellaiia extend en- tire length of body, lateral and dorsal. Laurer'a canal and rudimentary receptaculum present. Uterus in coil, postace tabu- lar, apposite ovary. Eggs large, thin-shelled, laid before cleav- age begins. Encysted, in pairs usually, in lungs of mammals. Single American species. Paragonimus kditcotti Ward 1008. Parasitic in dog, cat, and pig. Ohio, Illinois, Wisconsin, Minnesota, Kentucky. Confused in records with the human lung fluke (P. wtsttrmanii Kerbert) which has been positively determined in North America only in a few human cues, all of which are probably imported from Asia. F10. 677. _ Pv ieUiatli. Total pirpamrioii, vt ted on the lei! side and omitted 74 (69) Ovary and testes entire or lobed but not dendritic 75 75 (8a) Oral sucker surrounded by a reniform collar open ventrally and bearing a series of strong spines. Family Echinostomidae Looss 1902 . . 76 erful, 11 anterior end. . _.„ untied laterally and dorsally by on or "collar" which carries large spines ("spikes") definite in number and arrange- " Corner spines" on ventro-median lobe usually differ from others, ij., "marginal spines." Skin in anterior region at least richly provided with fine dermal spines. Pharynx and esophagus present; intestinal crura extend almost to posterior tip. Excretory bladder Y-shaped with numerous lateral branches. Genital pore median, near acetabulum or between it and fork of intestine. Cirrus and cirrus sac well developed- Germ glands postacetabular, usually median; ovary pretesticular, sometimes lateral. VheUaria lateral, well developed, reaching posterior end. Uterus between ovary and acetabulum, with scanty lateral loops, or none. Laurer's canal present, receptaculum aeminis absent. Eggs Luge, thin shelled, not numerous. Development with alternation of hosts and genrnuooa. For characteristic: cercariae see 134 (110) in this key. Parasites of intestine, larely of gaU ducts, in manunajl and birds. 76 (81) With well-developed oral sucker. Parasitic in intestine. ... 77 77 (80) Anterior region not enlarged. Spines in a double row. .... 78 ■PARASITIC FLATWOtMS 76 (79) ' Utera* long and much coiled Eaunasioma Rudolphi 1609. fa dtnwale body; Collar with double unbroken row of t sac reaches- ordinarily center of when contracted ii lies ir mil Vesical* present Viteilaria lateral, post testicular. 1 riuch coiled. Eg*r- large. twined, not tripaniu Par; prostatic in places toward* median lint I'lem. A mixed group of unphtt to detmnme there, true plan in ttn imniiy Several u iron the Buukrat nr more pcriecUy described by Barker tt aiii 70 (78) Uterns afaon. coils few. open. . Eckinophorypkium Dietz igog. d North A I [Lady' i. large Subfamily EanNOCHASMlNAr Odhner loto. :11 developed, c .abula: Tested median, Viteilaria lateral, a julv confluent along median line. * Representative American species s- Sltpkanoprora gilbert! Ward. s reported by Gilbert (mm the loon l(nB»J immtr) and from Bonaparte 5 gull Harm phiiaddpkw, near Ann Arbor. Michigan, probably belongs lu this garni?. I: cannot be lAtumailomo ipmuleatm Rud., as Fit 67S. 5itaaw*w«((lfcrfi. X Tct (Original.) 81 (76) Oral sucker degenerate. Parasitic in gall duels. Pegosomum Ritz 1903. Echirjostomes of moderate size with lance-shaped muscular bod} Collar poorly developed. with single row of blunt spines. SLin spinous. Ural sucker entirely degenerate. Pharynx preaent- Fork of intestine nut near acetabulum which is powerful and near center of body. a Line, only in Irunl oi genital pure In gall duels of Ardeidar. Uniy out ape atftntm Wright from Artie* minHir. a irora pharyni ti. posterior end, confluenl Is short Eggs large, nut numerous. s reported from North America as DiiU/mum 82 (75) Oral sucker without collar and spines 85 it represented in the key is found in the ACANiHucRAsatiiAt where the large :al sucker opens at the anterior tip and is surrounded by a crown of promi- i—iairfaiiim Lurtmorium iCobbold. was taken from the alimentary canal of an Alligator miitishpiemis that died in England. According to Odbner CryfitogoniMw and CaectWAfu are members of this family which have lost the crown of spines Deropriilis may also be related to it. 83 (04) Genital glands median in linear series in posterior region of body. 84 depoutei 392 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 84 (91) Uterus between ovary and acetabulum, possessing an ascending ramus only. Testes ordinarily behind ovary and close to it, or rarely (Leucerutkrus) near acetabulum and separated from ovary by coils of uterus 85 In Dcropriitis hiipida, a peculiar distome found in Aciptnstr in Europe and reported once by Staflord in the lake sturgeon from Canada the arrangement of the germ glands differs from either plan noted in the key line above. Two oval testes are median in posterior end; median □vary lies near large receplaculum, separated from acetabulum and testes by about equal distances which are rilled by uterine coils. Uterus has short descending ramus which extends posteriad from ovarian complex to anterior testis, and long ascending ramus from this point to genital pore □□ median anterior margin of acetabulum. Vitellaria are eitracecal, in uterine region. Cirrus sac and seminal vesicle, nearly median and postacetabular, are both well de- veloped, but rather distinctly separated. The relationship of the genus is not dear and the American record needs con ruination, hence this form is not included in the key. 85 (88) Body muscular; cirrus sac present. Family Azyghdae Odhner iqii . . 86 Infra-medium to large distomes. More or less elongate, flattened, with thick, muscular body. Suckers powerfully developed. Skin smooth, on contraction drawn into irregular transverse folds. No prepharynx. Pharynx powerful, esophagus very short, intestinal crura reach posterior end. Excretory bladder Y-shaped with very long branches reaching even to anterior end. Genital pore median, in front of and above acetabulum; genital sinus spacious. Uterus with ascending limb alone, extending direct from ovary to genital pure in closely laid e loops. Laurer's canal present; receptaculum seminis wanting. Vitellaria follic- . ral, eitracecal, not reaching to posterior end. Eggs 43 to 85 u lung, with cap; when jsited they contain each a ripe embryo, regularly nondliated. Stomach parasites of fishes. 86 (87) Germ glands form series in posterior region; ovary anterior, not fax separated from testes Asygia Looss iSog. Distomes of moderate size or larger, with slightly flattened, much elongate, nearly cylindri- cal muscular body, rounded at botb ends (Fig. 652). Genital pore close to acetabulum. Onus sac present. Seminal vesicle long and coiled. Uterus intercecal, in center third of body. Vitellaria extend at least between acetabulum and posterior testes. Ovary and testes behind middle of body. Main stem of excretory bladder splits behind testes; lateral branches do not unite in anterior region. Eggs 45 by 11 i> with thin shell and albumen covering. A ty/ia is a powerfully muscular type and is usually much distorted in the process of preser- vation so that a lot of specimens taken from the same host at the same time present marked external differences in the preserved condition. Such extreme specimens have been the bass lor various new genera, e.r., l/feiadiilomum of Leidy and Stafford, Mimodiilmmm of Leidy tnd Hatiallim of Goldberger. The same factor has led to the separation of too many as species. Despite many records of its occurrence the common European A ■ lucti { - A , ItreHeaUt) has not been found in North America. Several species peculiar to this continent occur in Amiacaha, Mieropltrut satmaidri and delomieu, Eiax Indus and Tttiadatiu, Ambleflila rupenVu, Salte- linui namaycmi, Lunaptrca, Lola lota, Sdmo itboto. Maine, St. Lawrence, Great Lakes, Wisconsin. 87 (86) Testes just behind acetabulum, separated from ovary by coils of uterus Ltucerulkrus Marshall and Gilbert 1905. Anterior end rounded, posterior end pointed. Oral sucker ventral, promi- nent, acetabulum one-half as large. Intestinal crura slender, straight, ex- .._j 1... . , Excretory vesicle fork! "" ,. -.., j each other. Uterus at between intestinal cr ofbody. Vitellaria L . . „. ..„ One species known (L. mkrepleri) from mouth and stomach of black bass and bowfin in Wisconsin and Indiana. Odhner advocates the association of this genus with Atygia from which it differs primarily only in the fact that the testes have moved from their original place behind the ovary and have been drawn anteriad by the shortening of the sperm ducts to a location a tittle posterior to the acetabu- lum. This is the relation they hold in Btmiunu, marine distomes descended from the Axygiidae. "SKKSS PARASITIC FLATWORMS 393 8S {85) Bod; fiat, thin, transparent ; no arms sac present. Family Ofisisokchqdae i-uhe 1901 . . 89 Onega!!- flattened transparent dislorne* with wok musculature. Suckers close tcauther and lay «ok Intestinal crura reach lully or nearly to pusteriof eod. Excretory bladder Y-shaped with short branches and Jong stem. Genital pure close in front uf acetabulum. No arras or omit uc. Coikd seminal vesicle. Germ glands in aeries in posterior region, ovary in front uf testes. Viteltem outside intestinal crura, moderately developed, not reaching p**l"'"r aid. Uterus lung, preovarian, in transverse loops, mostly postacetabular. Eggs very numerous, small, light yellowish brown in color. Parasites of gall |i iu| of Amniota. An important nstrasite of man. CiomtrtJii.' i 89 (go) Neither uterine coils nor vitetlaria extend anieriad beyond acetabulum Opistorchis R. Blanchard 1805. Anterior aid conical, posterior end broader. Main stem of eicretory bladder S-shaped, pMsinfc between testes, anterior forks of V short. Viteliaria in groups. In gall ducts of mammals, birds, and ('\ nsbts Y'ouu" distomes encysted in skin and con- nective tissues. especially subdetmal tissue of babes. 1; best known 0. pitudajeiinau Ward taoi in tbe cat. Fie. 6ao. OfislitnAi, f..a*i. Small to moderate sized distomes with abort, compressed body tapering anieriad. Skin spinous. Testes slightly lobod, nearly symmetrical. Coils of uterus compact, extending clearly over crura to margins. Vitellaria compact, extending anterior to acetabulum. A single American species tl . Lompitim (Stiles and Hassalll irom the liver of cat. New York, Maryland. District ol Columbia Peculiar in extent and arrangement of vitellaria and in position of testes. May need to be transferred to a new genus when its structure has beat ■racked out. Fro. 681. Kilwlii ctm, Magnified . (After Stiles and Haasall.) 91 (84) Ovary anterior, near acetabulum, separated from one or both testes by coils of ascending and descending rami of uterus. Subfamily Telorchhnae Looss 1899. . 92 somewhat flattened body. Small to middle sized distomes with slender, elongate, spinous. Anterior region very mobile; posterior regiun stable. Acetabulum small, in at Pharynx present, esophagus variable, crura king. Testes tandem, both in pus one there and the other not far behind ovary. Caurer's canal and receptaculum exit. ViteUaria lateral, elongate, outside intestinal crura. Uterus in coils or I ovary and testes or when one testis is near ovary, between ovary and posterior end ur In the mtwtinr of reptiles. 394 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 92 (oi) Genital pore anterior to and near acetabulum; cirrus sac very long extending far behind acetabulum to round ovary. Tdorckis Ldhe 1809. Small to middle sized dlstomes. Musculature light; hence worms translucent. Testes close together, near posterior end, separated from ovary which lies at the end of the cirrus sac and near the center of the body, by a mass of uterine coils. Excretory vesicle long, median, extends antariad about to ovary where it forms two lateral branches. Species distinguished by length of esophagus and direction and extension of uterine coils. C'fcorchU Luhe with esophagus and having uterine coils entirely intercecal, grades into Tdmckis ft. Mr. LUhe (without esophagus and with uterus coiled beyond ceca), and cannot be accepted as a valid subgenus. Apparently confined to reptiles; six or more species in North America. Revision of genus by Stufikard. Fig. 68a. Tebrchis nudius. Ventral view. X a8. (After Stunkard.) 93 (q2) Genital pore dorso-lateral, separated by marked interval from ace- tabulum. Cirrus sac entirely preacetabular. Protenes Barker and Covey 191 1. Two species, P. I' plus Barker and Covey and P. angustus (Stafford) in North America. Krotn Chrysemyt marginal* and C. picla. 94 (Kj) Ovary lateral; testes either median or slightly lateral 95 95 (q6) Ovary separated from acetabulum by coils of uterus. Plagioporus Stafford 1904. Small, fuftlform dtstomes with acetabulum larger than oral sucker and anterior to middle of length. Skin smooth. Pharynx and esophagus present; crura extend to posterior end. Testes median, close together in center of postacetabular region. Ovary small, lateral, just in front of anterior testis. Uterus from ovary to acetabulum. Genital pore lateral, on level of Intestinal bifurcation. Cirrus sac large, preacetabular, obliquely transverse. Vitellaria lateral, from esophagus to posterior end. Only species known Plagioporus serotinus Stafford 1904. Intestine of large-scaled sucker (Moxcshma macroUpidatum) in Canada. 06 (05) Ovary close to acetabulum, at least not separated from it by coils of uterus 97 97 (104) Testes large, in posterior region of body, separated from ovary by small uterus with few eggs; or when eggs are numerous, they extend beyond testes into posterior end (Bunodera only). . . Family Allocreaoiidae Odhner 1910 . . 98 Distomes of small to moderate site; body attenuated and mobile anteriorly. Suckers well developed. Pharynx and esophagus present; crura long, but not reaching posterior end. (ienital pore near acetabulum or not more than hallway to oral sucker, median or slightly lateral Ovary lateral, behind but not far from acetabulum. Testes large, proximate, in C interior region halfway or more from acetabulum to posterior end. ViteUaria lateral. Eggs rge Parasites of fishes; rarely of higher vertebrates. 98 (103) Uterus short with few coils, between anterior testis and acetab- ulum. Subfamily Allocreadhnae Odhner 1905 . . 99 Acetabulum at end of first third or fourth of total length. Excretory bladder single, on- divided* sac-shaped, rarely pyrifornv Genital pore preacetabular. median or sogntry lateral. Oimm and sac lane, well developed. Testes large, proximate, median or oblique in poster kg region. Ovary spherical or tobed. csose between acetabulum and testes, not ■— *»» Vkd- lana lateral, weM developed, partly covering crura, often confluent behind testis. Eggs not numerous, usually large. PARASITIC FLAXVTORMS Ewphijaif long, not dnidinp until jus: bocrr the acetabulum Ei cioon bladder very abort, endnw a: posterior miqnn of posterior teats Ovary qpimcal. linenal; riteliaria exclusively ventral Cirrus ud k pruaaic well dr\tuipai iicniul pan- median. EBB Sebajrij. Maior i' with light yellow shell. minnow . and gall-bladder t>: r I-u-f- region. Laki tint. Ontario. Lake »: genu?, by Wnliin a- o; A. cawtmMmt Oissan nncystcd lr. MaynA nvmph •Hint Say) with egg* and living miraruti.i in baity cavity nymph (Cooper J Representative American species. Aliocreadittm lobatmm YV&liin iooq. Length j to 7 mm., breadth i to : .; mm Sucker? equal, ojn in o.: mm in diameter. No pftphanrni: pharynx o.jj to o..: mm lone by Tese? lobed; dmi= sai extend? tk- center oi acetabulum. Omv Bpbencal; nteliaria postovaria;. proiusi. confluent behind posterior Keceplaculutn large, piiiinnn. between ovary and anterior testis Fit. 6B.,. Alwtnviim Uterus iqdicueii b] iocs (99) Six oral papillae surround 101 (102) Genital pure anterior 10 fork Bifurcation ol intestine insl a Crepidosiomum Braun 1000. to acetabulum Eirrctorv bladder lanjrt. round, median, ball way from acetabulum M posterior end Vild- lana confluent behind teste*, lleru- sbori. with few tots, between ace- tabulum, ovary", and anterior testis. Li intestine of treah-watcr nabes. Several species nut adequately described Representative American species. Lrtpidostomi Probably the best known specie? in iunftsb. darter, eti Immature iortns encysted 11 lamer cyst- contain mini' egg- ah-eadv ei jecii taken irom Mayfly nymph* (Uaatmu 39^ FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Body uniform in width or slightly constricted behind oral sucker which is noticeably larger (0.335 mm.) than the acetabulum (0.375 mm.) located about at center of body' Ovary posterior and dose to acetabulum, slightly lateral. Vitellaria from pharynx to posterior end. Uterus tubular, short, with few eggs. Genital pore midway from acetabulum to oral sucker. Cirrus large, with broad lumen at anterior end. Cirrus sac reaching t Representative American species. Acroltchanus petatosa (Lander) 1903. "Thisisthi LoossthatI use the :ldoyc i^ecuic demonstration '' (Stafford). Thecc of Odhner that Air, pttalosa is a synonym of Act. lintoni appears tc 103 (98) Uterus dorsal to both testes, extending nearly to extreme posterior end Subfamily Bunoderinae Looss 1002. Small distomes, with elongate body, and smooth skin. Anterior region small, muscles moderately developed. Oral sucker with circle of six muscular mammiform processes, often a collar-like expansion. Acetabulum equal to or Larger than oral sucker. Pharynx and esophagus present, crura long. Genital pore between ventral and oral suckers. Ovary close behind acetabulum and lateral. Testes oblique, in posterior half of body. Uterus with descending and ascending rami in sacculate form, dorsal to testes in posterior region. Laurel's canal and receptaculum seminU present. Vitellaria lateral, well developed, eitcnding from pliaryni to Cauda! end. Eggs Bunodero Railliet 1896. anterior to acetabului Testes oblique, far bac reaching posterior end. rami, greatly enlarged, covering testes on ventral side of body. body. Vitellaria not confluent, not tenia with descending and ascending coiled, extending to posterior cod and Recorded in North America. Bunodero luaopercoc (0. F. Mailer} 1776. 104 (97) Talcs small, i PARASITIC FLATHC»HS 397 center of body, separated from ovary by dense • coils with masses of eggs; no eggs posterior to 1 Stafford 1905. E3w* . . center, with lateral auricle on each sde of covered with fine scales. Acetabulum smaller than oral 3 of anterior hail of body. Pharynx present; crura I. Excretory vesicle very loii£. extending nearly to .0 short lateral branches directed anteriad. Testes ofc- tigue, near renter at body: amis sac large, extending from posterior margin cd acetabulum to genital pore located between suckers and posterior to fork of intestine. Ovary poataretabuiar, dcxtral. Laurer's canal in fork of excretory duct: wall thick. Vheharia continuous from right to left both above and be- low crura and excretory duo, eitending anteriad to posterior margin of acetabu- lum- Eggs 31 by 17 11- Only species known. . Auridistomum cbdydrac Stafford 1900. Intwrinj of Ckdydra serpaUuui. 105 (68) Testes numerous, in two longitudinal series. Pleorchis Railliet 1806. Inframedium sized distomes with oval, somewhat flattened body. Sin spinous. Suckers small, equal, separated by only one-fourth body length. Oral sucker subtenninal. Prepharynx prominent, pharynx small, esophagus extended, crura with single branch directed anteriad. Excretory system unknown. Genital pore preacetabular. Cirrus sac absent (?). Testes numerous in two rows near median plane in posterior half of body. Vitellaria in two broad lateral hands from acetabulum to posterior end. Other organs con. fined to small area between anterior testes and fork of intestine mostly, be- hind acetabulum. I'terusshon; ova scanty, 46*1 long. Reported by Leidy from lungs of musk turtle {Aromochdys odorala Latr.) as Morunlomn itaHt. Shown by Stiles and Hassall to he distome, somewhat like Disloma poiyorckis Stossicb. Position and relationship de- pendent finally on more perfect knowledge of structure which awaits dis- covery of new material. Fig. 6B8. Plmnkuut Tj.j-ift-^ (Alter Stiles.) 106 16?) Acetabulum represented by two small suckers set close together in depression on mid-ventral surface near center of body; genital cloaca opens between the two suckers. Subfamily Cryptogoniminae Osbom 1003. Very small, spinous distomes of uniform width throughout, with bluntly rounded ends- Oral tucker very large and prominent. Ventral sucker double, minute, withdrawn into pocket; genital pore between the two. Prepharynx, pharynx, and short esophagus present; crura extend to anterior margin of testes. Excretory vesicle V-shaped, fork at oviduct, anterior FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY branches reach to posterior margin of pharynx. dorsal, in posterior third of body; seminal vesii _ . drrusorsac. Ovary ventral, proximate to testes, slightly lobed; Lanrer's canal (?); vitellaria lateral, in centra) region. Uterus with descending ramus on right, slightly coiled, extending to posterior end, ascending ramus returning on left, crossing anterior to ovary and passing on right to genital atrium. Eggs small, dark, about 10 by '° /•■ Type genus. . . Cryptogonimus H. L. Osbom 1903. The genus has been placed in the Acantbochasmidae; see note under 8a (75)- Even if that action be justified it occupies a position suffid- cntly isolated to demand rank in a separate subfamily as inn" Only species known in North America. Cryptogonimus chyli Osbora 1903. In stomach and intestine oi Microfltrus dotomitu and AmNefliirt ruptstris; Lake Chautauqua, New York; St. Mary's River, M'-1"—- ■ Canada. Young distomes encysted in small blade bass, rock b minnows (Cooper). Fig. 689. Crypto/ar. 107 (66) Coils of uterus extend well beyond testes into posterior portion of body 108 108 (iog) Mouth surrounded by a crown of six muscular papillae which are outgrowths of oral sucker Bunodera. See note under 66 in this key and description with figure under 103. 109 (108) Mouth without crown of papillae no no (rrs) Vitellaria represented by small solid more or less lobed organ on each side of body Just anterior to ovary. Family Gorgodertoae Looms 1901. Muscular distomes with slender mobile anterior region and flattened posterior region. Suckers muscular; acetabulum especially projects noticeably beyond surface of body. Skin without spines but often with fine papillae. Esophagus long without, or short with pharynx. Crura simple, extend to posterior end. Excretory bladder simple tubular, extending from dorsal pore near posterior end to region of ovarian complex. Genital pore median, between acetabulum and fork of intestine; without male copuUtory organs. Ovary lateral, post- acetabular; Laurcr's canal or receptaculum seminis present. Testes lateral, oblique or sym- metrical. Uterus in numerous open loops chiefly postovarian. Eggs relatively large with thin, faintly colored shell. Only one subfamily reported in North America. GORGODERINAE LOOSS 180O . . Ill Small to submedium in size, sometimes slender, sometimes broad In posterior region. Esophagus relatively long, without muscular pharynx. Testes more or less oblique and within intestinal crura. Laurcr's canal present but no receptaculum seminis. Vtteuaxta. not tax In urinary bladder and ducts ui" ashes and amphibians. PARASITIC FLATWORMS 399 in (114) Body elongate, lanceolate without conspicuous well marked anterior and posterior regions na in (113) Testes subdivided, forming on one side a series of four and on the other five parts; in all nine separate lobes. Gorgodera Looss 1S99. Testis on ovarian side has five parti; the opposite testis lies further an- teriad and is divided into four parts only. In well-developed adults these organs are completely concealed by the coils of the uterus filled with dark implete : black dder uf various Amphibia: North America. Rana and Salaaiandra (?). Representative American species. Gorgodera minima Cort 1913. 113 (112) Two simple testes, elongate-oval, not divided. Gorgoderina Looss 1002. Testes are elongate and have irregular notched margins but do not divide into sections. VitelUria have only few lobes. Much like the former genus. Adults are difficult to distinguish after the uterine coils cover the testes. Found in the bladder of Amphibia: Bufo, Rana and Satamandra (?). Three species known from North America. Representative American species. Gorgoderina attenuate Stafford 1902. Body elongate; slender anterior region distinct from broad poste- rior region Pkyllodislomum M. Braun 1809. No sharp line of division marks the transition between the two regions of the body. The vilellaria are solid masses only slightly indented marginally. The testes are oblique, well separated from each other, and only weakly lobed if at all. In urinary bladder ol fishes and amphibians. Representative American species. Phyllodistomum omerkanum Osborn 1003. One species (P. amtricanum Osborn) reported from North America ' " mblysloma; two others doubtful from pike {Ejox lucita), bull-head eiurus nrbulosus), and perch (Perca flaceicetu) in Canada. . Ventre! view. X 16. (After 115 (no) Vitellaria composed of distinctly separated follicles. 400 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 116(119) Vitellaria confined to extreme anterior region of body, not ex- tending posteriad further than acetabulum 117 117 (118) Vitellaria extend across entire body in anterior region, reaching nearly to acetabulum. Genital pore on ventral surface. Subfamily Brachycoeiunae Looss 1809. Intestinal crura short, not extending posteriad to acetabulum. Genital pore median, between Ovary L Licular. Uterine coils till is recorded from North A Testes lateral, entire posterior region. _^„ _., A single species Bratkycodium haspilaU Stafford Genital pore marginal. Subfamily Pleurocenetinae Looss 1809. Intestinal crura of variable length. Genital pore sinistral, often marginal. Cirrus sac Large, pyriform, with coiled vesicula seminalis and muscular cirrus. Eggs 33 to 40 fi long. Intestines of Anura; a single species in Ckamdion. The family description as written by Odhner will not take in the American genus which Looss and he think should certainly be included here. Until more data are available it is unwise to make a new place for this single genus. Only North American genus yet described. Loxogenes Stafford 1905. Small distomes, with broad, thick, heart-shaped body In- dented at posterior end. Skin spinous. Suckers small, poorly developed, nearly equal; acetabulum near center of body. Pharynx present; esophagus very short; crura short, some- what inflated, not reaching even to center of body. Excretory vesicle divides near pore, lateral branches inflated, terminat- ing behind testes. Ovary pyramidal, lobed, preacetabular, between testes, slightly dextral. Vitellaria ventral, extend across entire body from pharynx nearly to acetabulum. Laurers canal and small receptaculum present. Uterus chiefly post acetabular, with longitudinal folds in two groups one on each side of body. Testes oval, small, lateral at ends of crura, in line with acetabulum or slightly posterior. Cir- rus sac long and narrow, preacetabular, sinistral, with coiled cirrus. Sexual pore dorsal, sinistral, midway between center Frc. 6oj. Ltxtttaa arramw and margin at level of fork in intestine. Ova small, 14 by bora.) of various frogs. The single setts, Minnesota, Ontario. 118 (117) Vitellaria consist of small groups of follicles lateral to pharynx in extreme anterior region. Caecincola Marshall and Gilbert 1905. Very small distomes; anterior end truncate, posterior end bluntly rounded. Entire body spinous. Oral sucker very large, acetabulum much smaller. Mouth terminal, prepharynx and esophagus equal, rather long, pharynx prominent, ceca short but wide. Excretory vesicle Y- shaped, extending antetiad beyond pharynx. Testes very large, ovoid, in posterior half: no copulatory organs; seminal vesicle large, bipartite. Ovary lobed, anterior to right testis; vitellaria scanty, far anterior, lateral to pharynx. Uterus poorly developed, a few open loops, above and be- hind testes, extending nearly to posterior end of body. Receptaculum semints dorsal to ovary. Assigned by some to the family Acanthochas- midae; see note under S3 (7s) in this key. Type species. Catcinccla parvuius Marshall and Gilbert 1905. One species known (C.parrtdtu) in ceca and stomach of large-mouthed black baas in Wisconsin. Fro. tea. CmdmaU pmrmlus Ventral view, owy drawa unrwhat to one A la show Badniyukg parta. X 91- {After MarshaD and Gilbert.) 119(116) Vitellaria not confined to extreme anterior region 120 PAftASmC FLfcTWGftMS i £"" fiBml dtr.urott dak-uif i*iiJ -aii-v** :*jQy witr. Dijiiin _: .- trur rtfiij: uuiiumf 4i*iiiciiJ^i"> o.vj:m. S.*iJ.c=? *n*.J' ^:c^:^,r>,;jl phajvr.i ■ ■ )>Wiiui i~i.r._ Jj jwi»B o.KSi. diattiCLf l'xtfJiniy^c loader tluir. ph-iya^ paiiiil.1 ^tliibuljiT BL.LI: ryi =yj.i^ Lili-Ri. ■.- ji-iil;^; ..^ti-jjju.uii. Ov^rv li. imm (.■ let: ttif pjnuyiii. Teiua. oblnju'.- k. otaiif: nr U ictus reaching posIctuji eo>- Viuiiaru uu., suur:. iron un. i>i uiiiauiii; u uea: ovary. Cirrus inuid kite ■/ euentiwg tuueriad i> vv«ri E*fci •- by - "- i- Type specie:. 1'rouitierui. liMpiidHum Slafiurd 1904. TwH""' of AwMaflim miioiri- - MjLiidl, ' 'iiiiaft ■ 113 (120) Lausiimii cruri e; .3 roseue ii. ttaiLc: of buciy. Leiuroiitriitm MatiurtL 1904. -j.dfJ Only spedes known. CuiUriKorium iuwits i^MucLallum) j LtelikalL worm;. 1 lo jjuni.lnii^. Su<_ktr_. rdjmtii sniali mid »eak IK jty dw[Jy lubcd Acini u.r vitdUriu niuii or less coii- fluc-i.t iiu(urtiiii: it lubtJu: jjjibmuii.i ij tht org-ir. Egtts very uumertHj a, small, 1-yrifk.rrr.. ,;-5 l>y ; ; ,.. mill thkk brown slieli. LitrsUiu of £ji.t J«;ii(.-, .liLvi.-rf' J ;'..".- ri/'riiFT .IwUepii/ri rvfcilri, .luiKiKa t*ry.ij>.; Onlark.. L'iuwdi i»ua .Wa . bursai vie. Mjgniir.. 1Al[et FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY n coils but not in form of a ccn ia6 126 (129) Genital pore near oral sucker on left margin of body. Subfamily Prosthogonjhinae Ltihe 1909. . . 127 Small to medium sized distomes with body somewhat flattened and elongate. Skin spinous. Pharynx present, esophagus variable, crura half or three-quarters length of body. Excretory bladder Y-shaped, sometimes with caudal vesicle. Genital pore marginal, dorsal or anterior to Oral sucker. Cirrus sac long, slender, cylindrical, extending to or beyond intestinal bifur- cation. Testes behind acetabulum and ovary. Ovary close to acetabulum, viteilaria extra- cecal in central portion of body. Receptaculum seminis and Laurer's canal present. Uterus In coils in posterior region, chiefly behind testes. 127 (128) Testes symmetrical; ovary lobed; uterine coils pass between testes. Prosthogonimus Lube 1S99. 8 (127) Testes oblique or tandem; ovary entire; uterine coils do not pass between testes Cepkalogonimus Poirier 1886. Genital pore dorsal or anterior to oral sucker. Uterus passes from ovarian complex directly rxisteriad between crura and testes, on right side of body, forms mass of coils behind testes and passes anteriad on left to genital pore. Viteilaria not always entirely extraoecal. Testes round or irregular. Eggs numerous, moderate in size, development unknown. Two species in intesUne of frogs, Toronto and Montreal; and of soft-shelled turtles {Aspidontdts and Amyda), Minnesota. Mainmnl. (After Nickenon.) 139(126) Genital pore anterior to acetabulum, from nearly median to marginal in position. Family Plagiorchtidae Lithe char, emend. . . 130 (Syn. LtpoicrmoiiAat Odhner igio.J More or less elongate distomes with moderately flattened to cylindrical body; rarely lOcht- faioma) strongly flattened. Skin usually spinous over entire body. Prepharynx, pharynx, and esophagus present: crura very variable in length. Excretory bladder typically Y-shaped with median stem dividing into two short branches behind complex of Mehlis' gland. Genital pore usually just In front of acetabulum, slightly left of median line. Cirrus sac crescentic, Swerful, with prominent longitudinal fibers, containing cirrus, vesicle, and prostate; rarely xtwfrnu) reduced. Ovary on posterior margin of acetabulum, dextral, rarely sinistral Testes usually oblique, rarely symmetrical or median, dose behind ovary. Laurer's canal present, except in Pnmmamotcts; receptaculum seminis variable. Viteilaria lateral, variable in extent. Uterus extends poateriad to end of body and then anteriad to pore, simple or com- plicated by culls filling posterior region. Eggs very numerous, small, thin-shelled, measure PARASITIC FLATWORMS 403 130(139) Rcceptaculiim seminis present (.except Plagierckis); crura reach posterior end (except Styphladora) 131 131 (138) Vesicula seminalis fills greater pen of cirrus sac; pars prostatica follows after it and is very short Subfamily Plagiorchunak Liihc 1909. . . j.32 132 (135) Genital pore near oral sucker 133 133 (134) Testes median or nearly so Pneumonoeces Loose 1902. Medium aixed diatomes, with body elongate, thick, and only slightly flattened, tapering an- teriorly. Acetabulum small. Ural sucker large, pharyni wdl developed, esophagus abort, in- testinal crura long, en tending to posterior end (Jenital pore just behind oral sucker, median, ventral. Cirrus sac greatly elongate, reaching acetabulum. Ovary- near acetabulum. Testes postovarian, slightly oblique Large seminal receptacle between teste- and ovary. NoLaurer's canal. Vitellaria lateral in middle region of body. Uterus much coiled, extending to extreme posterior end. Eggs numerous, small, dark shelled In lungs of Anura; widely distributed and abundant Develop perhaps from XipJudiooer- jariac North American species well worked out and described with key by Con Representative American species. Pneumonoeces coloradensis Con 1015. PneumobUes Ward. 134 (133) Testes lateral and symmetrical or nearly s Much like PnetimOfioeicf but body larger, thicker, with testes luued, elongate, lateral and symmetrical or only slightly oblique. Efiracecal longitudinal lolds of uterus pronouncedly longer than in Pntwmonoeas. Ovary lobed. Vitellaria with many very small adni in each group. Eggs small. In lungs of Anura. Two species in North America: P. iongifirzus, P. braiplexus. Cort, who grouped these in Putvmautus, called attention to their close relationship. The points of resemblance constitute also characteristic diilriem:,^ from other species in PnotMonatca aufheient to justify their being made an independent genus. Type species PneumobUes longiplexus (Stafford) 1902. 404 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 135(132) Genital pore near acetabulum 136 136 (137) No conspicuous pharyngeal glands. . . . Plagiorchis Luhe 1809. Bod); elongate oval, somewhat attenuated at both ends, covered with minute spines. Pharynx and esophagus of approximately equal length, crura reach posterior end, or near it. Genital pore just an- terior to acetabulum, median or slightly sinistral. Cirrus sac curved around and reaching posterior margin of acetabulum, with targe vesicula seminalis. Testes round to oval, oblique, separated by uterine brunches. No receptaculum seminis. Ovary spherical, at inner end of cinus sac. Vitellaria with many closely crowded folli- cles usually reaching posterior end. Uterine coils partly pretesticu- lar, chiefly post testicular. Eggs numerous. amphibians, reptiles am North American species. Plagiorcftis proximus Barker 191 5. Reported from the muskrat in North America. FlO. 701. Platitrckis Stssmhu. Ventral view. X n- (After Barker J 137 (136) Conspicuous pharyngeal glands present. Glyplhdmins Stafford 1905. Small, oval distomes with rounded ends and cylindrical body. Skin spinous. Acetabulum smaller than oral sucker, anterior to middle of body. Pharynx and esophagus present, pharyngeal glands conspicuous; crura nearly reach posterior end. Testes small, spherical, at center of body, post- acetabular, nearly symmetrical. Genital pore median between acetabulum and fork of intestine. Cirrus sac overlaps acetabulum in part. Ovary small at left of acetabulum, receptaculum seminis present. Uterus with numerous short transverse coils within crura between testes and posterior end, spread- ing somewhat beyond ends ol intestine. Vitellaria lateral from fork of in- Single North American species known. dytUidmins quieta (Stafford) toco. In intestine ol Canadian frogs. FM. 701. GlyStManu (Dials. Magnified. (Attn SuffordJ PAKASinC FLATWORMS 138 (131) Vesicula seminalis at inner end of cirrus sa end by long, tubular pan; prostatica. Lied to outer Styphlodora Looss 1800. Body somewhat attenuated anteriad, but broadened posteriorly, with rounded ends. Skin covered with fine spines. Pharynx and esophagus present; crura do pot reach posterior end. Genital pore median, preacetabular. Cirrus sac encloses coiled vesicula seminalis. Cirrus pow- erful. Testes oblique, dose together in center of body. Viidlaiia poorly developed. Receptaculun ent. but small. Uterus iniercecal. but spr beyond ends of crura. Eggs numerous. One North American lurm described by Goldberger as SlypUodora basaminsii from the liver (?) of Purrmiif <j»- yurr dgnW Sc onion: uj< tfeis s-i |kocu: 1—uiur': maa! [«■—«■• it^cpU-^jlum ■ of urrtfe. m>". nfjuTLvC 11. Ninlr. Aidct>^ "n^ Urva. *"_^t ir. SMZjiar* a a c 10111! inii tin jetiW'ae. di tot wui l",-T*,'Vf* u.v ate Uiadcd ir. tolj: a.nd y bint K«j«ti«. 11- i jjefwna. jetisr u> Mr £i>'ui: tt Jl*: «i ;"j_:i(i i' ir. ■hcfitiv driirai. 1 eKireoi' iM»J r^ri^^:-4 i^' '■lT-i^t :h:^" ■..:::".-_-' h ucar onleti><; nnugi:. o; j*jsi*xw: ioitip Vittliarb latcrc ru.rua.l-! I'Leru-. i'. anierL.r rcsio:. oi luiy. nudtratel :u; ijt«.i=«iiul«r out wiii. :. siutie i^jp lie: wet Singit American specie-. UasstLssi-j iruoii/r l»tiie» and Hassall 1S94. 159 (64] JDfcioim-a of Kef)ttra.Lt: *eier Ittmiiy .>i.his"1u^lhlatiija: Uxjss 1S90. 160(63) Special adhesive organ behind aceiaouiujr. .Vruerior region with holdiav. organs uaualiy disiiiiciiy scjiaraif.': irorr. [wsierior region with genua, ia. buborutT Holostomata Luht. itas disLuicliy uinuic itLu l«\. kjuoii- Anterior reci.'r. ^un <» tup-ilinted, MH'uj* iio niaeaiii ui(>;. 5u.ii.ers jjuuriy fitvi'mut-'i. ',,:.: wiih jxvuliiv rx>=.- ■ocUbulsi writing urga: I'ualcri.i: reti"!- cyinnlrltsi .■: uviii ■" Intestinal irura citend ' t end Eiuelory Liaddtr b iurrr. ..:' iitu>. - iictwuri. lienii^l pjre a: a unLij m, in.: urrii: Ov-iry anil ixaLa !:. x-Av~ ir. jjusie.-io: rc£ior. ij iiirv'ti^j.:! l"u:c sU>:; with jew, \ try w.-g.... ihia JitUfi eep No .uon- btnijpj with islermedjati hu>t but without alienation of 4IO FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 161 (166) Adult forms with developed sex organs. . i6z (165) Do. sal surface without special suckers. . . 163 (164) Anterior region flat, with foliate margins sharply set off from posterior region Hemislomum Diesing 1850. Anterior region more or less in the form of a cone opening an- teriorly and ventrally. Acetabulum often covered by special ven- tral holdfast organ, not larger than oral sucker, in one case entirely lacking. Sexual pore dorsal. North American species. Hemislomum craterum Barker and Noll 1915. Length 0.7s to 1.89 mm. Cephalic region 0.61 to 0.79 mm. long by 0,41 to 0.49 mm. wide. Caudal region 0.2S to 0.47 by 0.10 to 0.36 mm. Adhesive disk large, flattened cone with crateriform top, without papillae. An unnamed species is recorded from Didtlpkis virsiniana by C. Curtice. 164 (163) Anterior region cup shaped, with anterior circular entrance. Strigea Abildgaard 1790. Frequently called Holeslemum, a name of later date. Anterior region sharply set off from posterior by circular groove. Flattened lateral region united ventrally to a cup, with mouth at anterior end. Concealed in this cup small acetab- ulum and posterior adhesive organ in form of a papilla extending to] mouth of cup. In genital pore a well developed genital cone; opening terminal. North American species Slrigea cornu (Rudolphi) 1819. Recorded from Ariea herodias in Maryland by Stiles and Hassall. Another species described by Leidy as HoUslamum mitidum from the small intestine of Rana pipiens is according to Stafford a distome, and if so could not be placed here. 165 (161) With row of suckers on dorsal surface. Poiycotyle WUlemoes-Suhm 1871. Type species Poiycotyle ornata Willemoes-Suhm 1871, 166 (161) Larval forms; sex organs wanting or only partly developed. . 167 •e noted bete an well as later. . PARASITIC FLATWORMS 411 167 (t6R' Larval forms with an oval sucker-like depression on each side of the oral sucker TctracotyJr Filippi 1S54. Body pyriform or oval. Or. each side of oral sucker ar. oval groove, not muscular, with pores of special (cystogenous ? gianbU. Encysted in mollnaks and vertebrates. European forms belong to various species of Slrigta. Rnttger found these larvae m Limnaec slagnalis and ied them it- ducks: ten days later he obtained mature hoktttomids t specie* not given . Leidy recorded T. typicn from Limnaea caiascopimm and Pkysa kdrrosiroptu: . small-mouthed black bass, pike, and other fish from Canada to Iowa. Not a few of the larger cysts contain two worms, one usually much smaller than the other. Cooper found a form in the optic lens in young Micro pUrus dolomicu which he identified as DiphsUmudum volvens 1 von Nordmann . 160 li^ Larval forms: sexual organs entirely wanting or at most only partly developed. 170 A few encysted forms are described that contain eggs and are apparently sexually mature. 170 (171) Young flukes, encysted or free, always without caudal appendage. Agamodistomum Stossich 1892. Many immature forms whose relationship to adult types has not yet been determined. The group is artificial, temporary, and collective, including all agamic flukes with two suckers. Agamic forms in other groups have been given special names as noted in connection with the description of the adults. Forms of this sort are mentioned frequently without specific names. Named forms are also on record, e.g. A. apodis 'Packard i8»2i from the ovisac of A pus from Kansas, a unique record of a distome in a phyliopod crustacean, but without data adequate to fix the species. All forms described as encysted cercariae belong in this subdivision rather than in the next since the two marks of distinction l*etween the two are the tail, which is cast of! when the larva encysts, and the cystogenous glands, pure larval organs, that are emptied in this process and disappear. Various species which belonc here have been recorded without description under other names as ' "Hclerostomum echindlum Dieting "' of Leidy from the oviduct of Paludina ''quite common," and Dislomum centra ppcndiculalum of the same author from Helix arbor ta. 171 (170) Caudal appendage present, usually simple, sometimes modified. even greatly reduced, rarely absent. Cercari in different species. All of these constitute useful specific characters. Very few North American species have been described and the brief records that exist are in most cases adequate only for the definition 01 groups rather than species in the true seiw. Most of the following subdivisions of the key are to be regarded in that light. Some names in use like Cercarij bUmtola Iiald. can hate e*vii ^\o general significance since the original reference contains no data that will fiv the species. 412 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 172 (173) Mouth opening some distance from anterior end, near center of ventral surface. Intestine rhabdocoel. Gasterostomous or rhabdocoelous cercariae. Alimentary canal short, simple, rod-shaped. Swimming organ in the form of two long narrow appendages directed obliquely right and left from posterior end of body in the only known type. Larval stages of Bucephalidae, such as the well-known Bucephalus Polymorphic von Baer of Europe. Not yet reported on this continent though the adult (see 29 in this key) is known here. 173 (172) Mouth opening at or very near anterior end of body. Intestine triclad Prostomatous cercariae . . 174 174 (183) Only one sucker, and that around mouth opening. Monostome cercariae . . 175 All vet studied have a pair of lateral pigment spots on the dorsal surface, the simple eyes. Some have also a medium pigment area between the lateral eyes or slightly anterior to them. 175 (178) Cercariae without median eye in cephalic region 176 Under the designation "median eye" is included always an optic cup with pigment lining and an optic cell; part of these are found in certain developmental stages but in species in- cluded under this heading disappear so that the structure never becomes complete. 176(177) Six pairs of large gland cells in tail. Cer carta urbanensis Cort 19 14 Length 0.27 to 0.54 mm., width 0.11 to 0.2 mm., tail 0.2 to 1.2 mm. long and 0.05 mm. at base. Develops in rediae. An active swimmer. Encysts on solid objects. Cysts shaped like thick discs. Moves over surface by aid of two pro- jections one at each postero-lateral angle of body and with cuticular knob in tip. Heavily pigmented, especially near anterior end. A pair of lateral eyes; intermediate pigment nucleus present in later stages, but no optic cup or cell at any time. Cystogenous glands abundant. From Physa gyrina at Urbana, Illinois. Fig. 713. Cercaria urbanensis, mature, ventral view. Cystogenous glands not shown. X 70. a, posterior locomotor projection. X 216. (After Cort.) 177 (176) Six groups of paired gland cells in tail, each pair dove-tailing into the one next anterior Cercaria kanadensis Faust. Cercaria 0.4 to 0.46 mm. in length, 0.1 to 0.16 mm. in width. Tail 0.4 to 0.45 mm. long by 0.03 to 0.04 mm. diameter at base. This species possesses no median pigment area in cephalic region. Glands of posterior locomotor organ large and prominent. Cercariae and rediae nose. Germ balls arise from central germinal rachis in subdistal region of redia. rom liver of Lymnaea prjoxima Lea, Bitter Root River, Corvallis, Montana. asm Fi 178 (175) Cercariae with median eye or median pigment area in cephalic region. Larger species than preceding 179 179 (180) Distinct mobile, evertible spinose pharynx. Cercaria peUucida Faust. Length 0.4 to 0.7 mm., width 0.18 to 0.2 mm. Tail 0.5 mm. in length, 0.07 mm. in diam- eter at base. No large gland cells in tail. Rediae provided with multispinose evertible piercing organ in prepharynx region. Germ balls arise from central germ cells in distal region of redia. From liver interstices of Physa gyrina Say, Bitter Root River, Fort Missoula and Corvallis, Montana. 180 (179) No evertible spinose pharynx mentioned (imperfectly known species) 181 P&fcASIIlC FLArWQKMS 423 1S1 (18* ) Bethy (lack brown, or blackish. Cercaria hyalocauda Haldeman 1842. Very mwrkctlv known The ioirn describee under this name by Evans ,iSSo has a bod)' DjR mm. tone and 04 mm. (tide with a uii 0.55 mm. lone and o.: mm. wide in maximum. QrK 0.33 mm. in diameter Body dark brown or blackish. Two eye spot! and smaller. Ice dwtsad piflracni nut- uetweei. Tail semiuaasparent. corrugated when contracted, active tone after detachment iruni body Eians' descriptior. of the lisinp organism show- il is much lite C ariojienji! though easily diatmRunfaahie by creaier ur of larva and cytt. Haldeman 's account if entirely inadequate tD differentiate the form and sutaces only ti> place it in this group. Taken in numbers from Fkfa kdtraimfta hay by Evans spots Dear them Produced ir bright urangc-culored spunxvsts which are cylindrical a bluntly rounded at tk end:. Leidy tall* thi- a UunoiU/ma. and all data given agree with tune cercaria Abundant in Puuu/rh'u paniiu iuund near Philadelphia, Pa. 183(174) More than one sucker 184 184 (150) Oral sucker well developed; genital aLrium nut modified. 1S5 185 (190) Second sucker ventral and at posterior end of body. AmphisLome cercariae. . . 186 aria oi Parampkiil CJutoa iMfOkc: prcxsi. dtswuc: ocv^jl j d^aiu j' bpuus ao= *vf L3L.U1U1I . ,, »07 Let:. arm airec;i" irw r'LaryiJ-. rq-io: excrciury biaacie- eltui-. . uipaluv ('." gnu: tii&eiiah.>: wt«.j»-.'u.7fi-iw Tans:. i,)'HIHI » fMUM i*i. UUOa •iMlii£> at 1 «rl ftLaaj.l.i. L^~,~ so; 120,1, *o6 tech uiiu«vcio{je ... eKonsuiry ^iaaut? Lju»l ist*rdk.» ■.:.-.. u-. tiuimte!'. :■: ! IttvcikKe >:. ajxiroQ-ji- 1.-... .-m;,.. u-;. (■!;»»► ?ij,»Fr.- ni.i -.■tiy^lut!' Sl>i--t ci"o^s jiiji ii. Ir..v. r. nr.tr.-.: »u . ti- Eiot1,i:> n^ciii ■_:.."... 4i:.: .. Urf." iT'~sf d.'rsz' «rJ [-■- 4i8 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 309 (308) Twelve stylet glands on each side. Cerearia polyadetui Coil 1914. Encysts readily. Tail activr, easily detached, somewhat larger than last species. Oral sucker smaller, stylet glands more numerous. Body iso larger than former spedes. Genital system marked out by S-shaped uclear mass, elongate and dorsal lo acetabulum. aio (104) Cauda] pocket distinct, provided with hooks or spines that a mostly situated in posLero -lateral sacs 2 Body length 0.3.S to 0.40 mm., width o.ifi to 0.17 mm. Tail small, 0.16 mm. in length, 0.04 mm. wide at base. Body obovate, muscular; cuticula thick. Caudal pocket lined with spines. Excretory bladder large, muscular, bicornuate; tubules dendritic. In long oval sporu- cysts in liver of Lymnaeu pnxima Lea, sloughs of Bitter Root River, Fort Missoula, Montana. an (211) Digestive tract provided with special glands, in addition to stylet glands. Ceca developed 313 213 (214) Glands along entire course of digestive tract. Three median spines on lip of caudal pocket. . Cerearia glandulosa Faust. Body length 04s mm., width 0.3 mm. Tail length 0.3.1 mm. by 0.05 to 0x16 mm. at base. Body oblong-ovate, acetabulum slightly behind center of body, smaller than oral nicker. Esophagus long, ceca short, unicellular glands along entire digestive system. Cuticula delicate. Eight cephalic glands. Body filled with cystogenous glands. In sporocysts, in liver of Pkyta tyriiw Say, Bitter Root River, Corvallis, Montana. 214 (213) Glands in pharynx region only, spines confined to pockets of caudal pocket 215 115 (216) Ceca attenuate, excretory bladder with long median shank. Cerearia diaphana Faust, Body oblong-ovate to ovate. Acetabulum median, about half size of oral sucker. Pharynx small, surrounded by great mass of unicellular glands. Cephalic glands £, anterior to cecal width 0.10 to O.ii mm. Tail 0.15 mm. in length by 0.04 mm. wide at base. In oblong sporocysts in liver tissue of Lymnaea proiima Lea, Bitter Root River, Corvallis, Montana. 216 (315) Ceca inflated, excretory bladder bicornuate, inflated. Cerearia micro pharynx Faust, Body minute, ovate, covered with fine spines. Acetabulum mid-ventral, smaller than orat sucker. Pharynx extremely small, esophagus short, ceca inflated. Digestive glands in pre- pharynx region only. Body length o.iS mm., width o.oq mm. Tail 0.14 mm. in length by 0.03 mm. at base. In oval sporocysts with well -developed excretory tracts. Liver of Lymnata pnxima Lea, Rattle Snake Creek, Missoula. Montana. 317(301) Tail modi&ed, not of simple form. 318 PARASITIC FLATWORMS axg (220) Eye spots present Ceruiria raizmosa Faust. Body length 0.19 mm., width on mm. Tail o. fin-folds. Stylet delicate, at Lea, sluughs of Bitter Root 1 in length by 0.04 mm. wide at b*«. n somewnal smaller. F.sophagui long, ceca short. tubule* multi-dendritic. Tail with lateral raffled polygonal sporocysts in liver of Lymnttra proximo r, Fort Missoula, Man o (219) Eye spots lacking sit a Cort 1914. 1 {«s) Stylei small, without thickened region. Cercaria hemtiopkw Body oval, 0.3 E mi small spines. Tail ; / ' \ length, with fin hall a- Produced in orange-colored, elonf much twisted together. In PMysa long, 0.14 mm. wide, densely covered with oul length of body, extensile to double body vide along ventral surface of distal half. Oral jimlum 0.0411 mm. in diameter. Stylet small, 2 (221) Stylet heavy Cercaria platyura Leidy I Length oA mm., I branous alae 0.14 mi stylei. Acetabulum with broad, costate, ! mm., tail o.ifi by 0.06 mm. at base, width with mem- . head rounded, oral sucker large (0.08 mm.) with heavy il nearly as long as body, stout, tapering, corrugated, /ith Lymiuiea, at Fort Bridger, Wyo. 223 (218) Tail short and peculiarly modified. . . . Microcercous cercariae. Tail short, stumpy, with powerfully developed muscles. the Cotylocerrous cercariae of Dollfus the organ is still further modified into a type of sucker. This latter group develops in sporocysts and is mostly marine. Only species thus far recorded in North America. Cerearia trigonura Cort 1014. Body 0.21 mm. long, 0.06 mm. wide. Tail 0.05 mm. long by 0.014 mm. wide. Oral sucker 0.049 mm. long by O-Oiu mm. wide. Acetabulum just hack, of center of body, 0.04 mm. in diameter. Cuticula covered with fine spines. Tail short, blunt, easily detached, triangular, folded into groove. Just anterior prominent gland open- ing into the bead of this groove. Stylet dorsal to oral sucker. Stylet glands small but numerous. Eicrelory system bicomuate. thick walled. Free in tissues of ter<1l snails: rediae in same host. No tendency to encyst Found in Campdoma decision from Hartford, Coda. FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY These cercariae develop in rediae which have collar, birth pore, and posterior locomotor appendages. They are characterized by the conspicuous collar and spines, also found in the adult distome. The esophagus is long and the ceca reach to the posterior end of the body. The tail is long and powerful. 225 (228) Collar spines in a single, if sometimes slightly irregular row. . 336 226 (217) Collar spines 42, rounded at both ends; excretory trunks doubly reflexed in cephalic region Cercaria biflexa Faust. Acetabulum in posterior third of body. Great number of cephalic Elands in 2 series, 50 to 60 in each series, lateral to digestive ceca. Excretory tubes reflexed twice in cephalic region preliminary to entering lateral trunks. Bladder long, with median swelling; scaleriform anas- tomosis of excretory tubules in tail. Body length 0.45 to 0.5 nun., widtho.ijtoo.it mm. Tail about same length as body, powerful. Encysts within redia. Redia with "feet" in posterior third of body. In liver tissue of Pkyta syrmi Say, near Buckbouse Bridge, Bitter Root River, Montana. 227 (216) Collar spines 36, acute at distal end; excretory trunks arising from triangular anastomosis in cephalic region. Cercaria trisolenata Faust. lateral trunks. Excretory bladder obtruncate. Acetabulum spinose in posterior third of body. Readily encysts in Ira state, easily drops tail. Body length 0.45 mm., width 0.1 mm. Tail short, about 0.1 mm. Rediae with lateral "feet" about one-third distance from anterior end. In liver of Pkyia tyrina Say and Plarurbis trnoltit Say. Entire length of Bitter Root 228 (235) Collar spines in mature cercariae in two alternating rows; excre- tory trunks reflexed once 239 329 (230) Excretory bladder long, attenuate; 43 equal spines. Cercaria rubra Cort 1914. Cystslarge, spherical, thick- walled, transparent. Collar has forty-three equal spines in two alternating rows; four spines on each ride of mid- ventral line point in. Encysted above gills in Camftlema drtisum, Hart- ford, Conn. No redia found. Known only in encysted stage which fa Fro. 71s. Crtcuria mart hi AumtiiiUtmmm stan find Irom ryst, rentra view. X i)0. (After Cort.) 330 (229) Excretory bladder ovoid to depressed spheroid, excretory trunk reflexed almost entire length 331 PARASITIC F1ATW0RMS 421 S31 {a«l Tail simple, unmodified Cercaria trivolvis Cort 1914. Both rediae and cercariae in Plomariii * iiitii-i, Uibini, Illinois. Moves actively in free water and on solid bodies: found encysted in sunf bos! with rediae and cercariae. Nuclei of sei organs in two masses, connected by slender thread. Collar carries thirty-seven equal spines in two alt ematinK rows; two or three spines near mid-ventral line point inward. / Fig. ii(,. Cm. 132(231) Tail with lateral fin-folds Cercaria refiexa Cort. Though without oral spines in the stage originally discovered and described this species probably belongs here among Echinostomid cercariae. For description see 197 (198) in this key. 233 (104) Tail simple but heavy, when contracted exceeding in breadth the body Rhopalocercous cercariac listed from North America. Cercaria (Rhopahccrca) tardigrada Leidy 1858. Reported by Leidy from Ano&tmia species. The true R. tariifraio is Dill. dttfUcatirm v. Baer renamed and is the larva of Pkyiiaiiiiomum /Mum according to Uiht. Perhaps Leidy's (earn is the larva of some American species in that genus. No North American cercariae have yet been well described which fait into this subdivision though both of the species listed by Liihe for Central Europe belong to genera, AUocradimm and Pkylitiuttmam, which are reported here. These are not closely related genera and the grmip of cercariae does not appear to be a natural one as at present constituted. Note that Odhner believes that the larva of fkyiiodislomum foiium occurs in bunches, as stated in i8y (186) of this key. 334 (19a) Tail well developed and highly modified 335 335 (340) Base of tail envelops body of young distome. Cystocercous cercariae . . 236 336 (337) Chamber globular, small. Tail simple, slender. European type. Cercaria macrocerca Filippi 1854. These forms of which several have been described in Europe are the young forms of Gorfo- im iiiar (no in this key). The adults have been reported from this country, but this larval form is yet to be identified here. 337 (336) Chamber large; round. Tail flat, forked, anchor-shaped with broad terminal flukes; powerful swimming organ. . . 138 is the distome is thus eversed. The adults are unknown. 422 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 338 (230) Distome fills three-fifths of stem of anchor. Cercaria wrightii Ward 1916. Length 0.75 mm- width o.ijj mm. Flukes measure 0.5.1 by 0.1 nun. Young uabtUiri- at equal intervals around one pole of the sphere EdSSaiuST6™1' lMur and provided with special muscles that serve to push the hooks out and then away from the center so as to open up tissue and force the larva through it. In most cestodes the onchosphere, surrounded by two or more membranes characteristic in form in particular groups, is retained within the egg-shell until the mass is brought passively into the alimentary canal of a suitable host. Here the onchosphere is set free by digestion and bores its way out of the alimentary canal into the body cavity or vascular spaces. It may remain there free and undergo further development, or by active or passive migration reach a point where it encysts and remains fixed during the period of growth. During this period it develops to one of the larval forms of the group. These forms differ in different subdivisions of the class Cestoda. Among the lower forms they are small, oval or elongated, spindle-shaped, solid-bodied larvae known as plerocercoids, and in the highest groups of cestodes they become large fluid-filled vesicles known as cysticerci or blad- der-worms. Other types occur among other kinds of cestodes. These larval forms almost without exception develop in an inter- mediate host. In some cases the larva wanders out later and achieves actively the infection of the adult or final host, but in most instances it is held in the body of the intermediate host until the latter is eaten. Thereupon it is set free by digestion, migrates to the organ which is its normal scat, and enters upon a period of growth that brings it to the fully matured adult form. 428 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Certain important changes have occurred during this larval growth period. These are most marked in the bladder-worm ces- todes. The fully developed cysticercus shows a completely formed scolex that corresponds in detail with the scolex of the adult ces- tode save that it is reversed and lies turned into the internal cavity of the bladder. When the bladder-worm reaches its final location the head is everted and appears with the armament of suckers and hooks that characterizes the adult. This scolex attaches itself in the region appropriate for the adult and the bladder remnant is lost by digestion while the neck continues to grow in length until it has produced a full-sized adult worm. The formation of pro- glottids and the growth within them of the reproductive organs proceeds slowly as the worm lengthens, the oldest proglottids being found regularly at the end furthest from the scolex. The life histories of North American cestodes are entirely un- known and can only be inferred to be similar to related species that have been studied in the Old World. The evidence fur- nished by the latter indicates clearly that tapeworms are not bound up with an aquatic existence in some stage as are the flukes. Certain cestodes have aquatic larvae and others bladder-worm stages in aquatic invertebrates, or vertebrates, but many of the species parasitic in birds and mammals pass the larval period in terrestrial hosts (insects, land snails, birds, mammals) and have no relation to the aquatic fauna at any time. Such forms do not belong rightly in such a synopsis as this; but the data available are insufficient to mark out clearly which forms belong to the fresh- water fauna during some phase of their existence and which are entirely unconnected with it. Cestodes are found as parasites in all types of fresh-water verte- brates. The adults occur most frequently in the alimentary canal or pyloric ceca. Certain kinds, chiefly larval forms, are found in the body cavity and the encysted stages, the bladder-worms, may be encountered in almost any tissue, even in the brain; yet they are most frequent in connective tissue and seem to find the liver a preferential location. Usually only a few cestodes are found in an individual host, but they may occur in such numbers that the cavity of the alimentary canal is stuffed full and the wall of the body « JC IS JL PARASITIC FLATWORMS 429 is markedly distended. The distribution of various species is prob- ably nearly concurrent with that of the particular hosts. North American cestodes are very imperfectly known and the large part of the data available concerns species parasitic in birds and mammals. Because of the lack of definite knowledge it has been necessary to decide upon somewhat artificial limits, and the synopsis has been made to include all cestodes reported in North America from fresh-water hosts and all likely to have develop- mental stages in fresh-water hosts even though such stages have not yet been identified on this continent Among the various hosts from which tapeworms are reported the water birds are most difficult to group correctly. Many of them visit both fresh and salt-water bodies, and most of them feed at times and places on terrestrial plants and insects either intentionally or incidentally. Consequently, the source of a given infection is difficult to deter- mine and some errors have no doubt been made in these cases; yet, thanks to Ransom's careful and extensive work, avian ces- todes are better known than those from any other host group in North America. The data on North American cestodes are not only scant}' but also so indefinite as to be of little value in the attempt to prepare a systematic outline of the group. Early references are to "ces- todes" or " Taenia, v and even in later years the same habit has prevailed. Most existing records of the occurrence of tapeworms in aquatic hosts cannot be referred to known genera. For these reasons the appended synopsis must be presented with an apology. Among the Proteocephalidae I have been able to depend on the work of La Rue and for bird cestodes I have made free use of Ran- som's monograph. Outside of these groups there is little definite knowledge of the North American forms. KEY TO NORTH A.MERICAX FRESH-WATER CESTODA 1 (122) Adult worms; sex organs developed. 2 2 (7) Body simple, not divided into joints or proglottids. A single set of genital organs. Subclass CestodaxU . . 3 The few forms In eluded here are often designated the monozootk cestodes, and sometimes are regarded as a separate class intermediate in position between Trematodes and Cestodes. In external appearance they resemble the flukes but are readily distinguished from them by the entire absence of an alimentary canal. The internal structure is much like that of tape- bat the ftexual organs are never duplicated. 43° FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 3 (4) Anterior end not peculiarly modified. No suckers, hooks, or special- ized scolex region AmphUina Wagner 1858. Large, oval, flattened forms, parasitic in body cavity of fishes. Anterior end usually notched, but occasionally extended in the form of a small papilla bearing the pores of a group of uni- cellular glands. Male genital pore at posterior end. No cirrus sac present. Female pore slightly anterior to male pore, separate from it. Uterus long, uterine pore at anterior end. Embryo with circle of ten hooks at one pole. Not yet reported from North America but present. 4 (3) Anterior end with unarmed, poorly developed adhesive organ, imper- fectly set off as scolex from rest of body. Family Caryophyllaeidae Claus 1885 . . 5 Body elongate, flattened, with nearly parallel sides and primitive scolex. Neck may be present or wanting, as also a caudal appendix. All genital pores ventral, median, near poste- rior end; cirrus anterior; uterus and vagina open together into a genital atrium. 5 (6) Caudal appendix present in adult. Two distinct sucking grooves on rudimentary scolex Archigetes Leuckart 1878. Sexually mature in oligochaetes. A form which undoubtedly belongs here has been described to me as found in native earthworms. It has not been recorded in the literature. The species known are 2 to 6 mm. long and parasitic in the body cavity of Tubificidae. 6 (5) No sucking grooves present. Caudal appendix lacking in adult though present in larval form. . Caryophyllaeus O. F. Muller 1787. Expanded anterior end very mobile, irregularly folded but without definite sucking grooves. Intestinal parasites of Cyprinid fishes. Larvae parasitic in body cavity of Tubificidae. 7 (2) Body multiplex, usually divided externally into joints or proglottides ; always containing successive sets of reproductive organs generally corresponding to such subdivisions even in cases where external proglottid markings are lacking. Subclass Cestoda s. str. . . 8 Elongate, ribbon-like forms in which the reproductive organs are serially duplicated, each set constituting a reproductive unit, usually though not always set off from adjacent units by internal septa and external boundaries. These forms are often spoken of as the true tapeworms, or polyzootic cestodes. 8 (29, 30) Scolex with a single terminal or with two opposite sucking organs, never with four suckers or accessory proboscides. Order Pseudophyllidea . . 9 Scolex rarely armed with hooks, never provided with rostellum, or extrusile proboscides. The two sucking grooves sometimes combined by complicated growth of their margins into a funnel-shaped or tubular organ which may be united with that of the opposite side to a termi- nal sucker of peculiar form. External jointing is rarely lacking, but often indistinct in certain regions at least. Uterine pore present, on the surface of the proglottid. Uterus in the form of rosette-shaped coils or of a large sacculate uterine cavity. Characterise fish parasites in one or more stages of the life history. Luhe places the Caryophyllaeidae (see above), as the first family under this order, grouping them as monozootic Pseudophyllidea in contrast with all other families as polyzootic For practical reasons they are treated here under the Cestodaria. 9 (28) Adult forms with developed reproductive organs 10 The larval forms are sometimes hard to distinguish from adults. Consult also 38(9). 10 (13) Eggs thin-shelled, without lid. Uterine pore ventral; cirrus and vagina open dorsal and posterior to uterine pore, or margi- nal. . . . Family Ptychobothriidae Luhe 1902 . . 11 Scolex with two separate bothria, rarely replaced by a pseudoscolex. No neck; external segmentation always present but incomplete or obscured by secondary folds in many cases. Reproductive organs single in each proglottid. Cirrus and vaginal pores posterior to uterine pore, marginal or median and then on opposite surface from uterine pore. Ovary and shdl gland median; testes in two lateral fields. Uterus in form of a single spacious cavity, never ^> PARASITIC FLATWORMS 4£X of a rosette. Eggs thin-shelled, without lid. Embryonal development in uterus; all eggs of an entire worm may be in many cases at the same stage of development, at a given season. Lube makes two subfamilies, Ptychobothriinae and Amphicotylinae. ii (12) Genital pore on surface of proglottid. Bothriocephalus Rudolphi 1808. Scolex distinctly elongated, bothria not well developed. External segmentation incomplete between successive proglottids; serrate marginal incisions distinct but markings on surface of proglottids often imperfect or wanting. Vitellaria in cortical layer, continuous from pro- glottid to proglottid, as are also testes. No seminal receptacle. Beginning of uterus a con- voluted canal (uterine duct) which opens into spherical uterine cavity. Uterine pore median, ventral; orifice of cirrus and vagina median, dorsal. Many entries under this name really belong in other genera of the family. A revision of the group is necessary before one can say which are true species of this genus. 12 (11) Genital pore at margin of proglottid. Abothrium van Beneden 1871. Scolex not elongate, with two bothria powerful but not deep. Segmentation uncertain among older proglottids because of surface wrinkles; even oldest proglottids much broader than long. Nerve trunks near margin, dorsal to cirrus and vagina. Testes exclusively be- tween nerve cords in two lateral fields. Vitellaria irregular, also in two broad lateral fields, mostly between longitudinal muscle bundles, separated at proglottid limits. Ovary reniform, ventral, median. Shell gland dorsal to ovary. Uterine sac in ripe proglottids filling almost entire medullary region. Uterine pores ventral, in median longitudinal furrow on strobila. Representative North American species. Abothrium crassum (Bloch) 1779. Reported from salmon in Lake Sebago, Maine; not uncommon in the Great Lakes trout. 13 (10) Orifice of cirrus and vagina on same surface as uterine pore and an- terior to latter or marginal. Eggs thick-shelled, with lid. Family Diphyllobothriidae Liihe 19 10 . . 14 Scolex and sucking organs variable in form, or replaced by pseudoscolex. Segmentation usually distinct. Receptaculum seminis sharply set off from vagina near inner end. Uterus long, convoluted tube, in form of central rosette; without uterine sac except in Haplobotk- rimm. Eggs thick-shelled with lid. 14 (27) Genital pore on surface of proglottid 15 15 (24) All genital pores exclusively on one and the same surface of the strobila 16 16 (19) Scolex very short, not set off from the rest of the worm. Subfamily Ligulinae Monticelli and Crety 1891 . . 17 Scolex roughly triangular, more or less drawn out to a point with contraction of worm. Bothria median, small, weak. Genital organs in adult fully developed just behind scolex. Testes form dorsal layer in lateral fields of medullary parenchyme. Yolk follicles in lateral part of cortical area. Ovary median, ventral; shell gland median, dorsal. Adult in intestine of water birds; larva in body cavity of teleosts, attaining full size and forming advanced rudiments of sexual organs, found occasionally in water, having been set free by rupture of abdominal wall of intermediate host. 17 (18) External evidences of proglottid formation limited to anterior end or entirely lacking Ligula Bloch 1782. When fully grown jointed only at anterior end, but the divisions do not agree with the in- ternal segmentation of reproductive organs. Bothria poorly developed. Larvae without segmentation and without bothria, live chiefly in Cyprinids. Adults in water birds; stay in definitive host only brief. Several species have been reported and described by various authors, all too briefly to permit of positive identification. The parasites come from chub, sucker, and trout; New York, Pennsylvania, Maryland, Yellowstone Park, Arizona. J32 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 8 {17) Proglottid formation evident externally throughout entire worm, even in larval condition. . . Schislocephalus Creplin 1829. Apei of scolex pitted, retractile. Bothria poorly developed. Segmentation complete. Suckers and proglottid; At least one adult and birds; larvae in abdomen 0 North America. No records have been 19 (16) Scolei more or less elongate, distinctly set 30 (21) Scolex similar in form to first pioglottids, separated by sharp boun- daries; no unjointed region (neck). Subfamily Haplobothrtinae Cooper. Proglottid formation evident externally only in anterior part of strobila. Large median dorsal and two smaller ventro-lateral excretory vessels. Both vitellaria and testes medullary. Cirrus covered with minute spines. Uterus sharply divided into uterine duct and large uterine Type and only genus Ifaplobnthrium Cooper 1914. f - Scolei small, simple; rectangular, excavated dorso-ven (rally to form simple bothna, and also slightly laterally. Apex slightly extended to form low pyramidal disc; posterior end of scolei modified as auricular appendages which with edges of apical disc bear minute spines. No neck. Proglottid* elongate and auricu- lae decrease posteriad until segmentation near end is indicated only by successive sets of reproductive urgans. Large median dorsal and two small ventro-lateral excretory trunks. Testes small, numerous (So) in 1 lateral fields. No genital sinus. Cir- rus and vagina open close together well anterior on ventral sur- face. Uterine pore ventral also, anterior to posterior end of uterine sac. Ovary horse-shoe shaped, ventral, posterior. Large yolk-reservoir. Uterus in 1 regions formed very early, viz.: coiled thin-walled uterine canal and capacious uterine sac which when filled occupies almost entire central field of proglottid. Eggs with opercula, carrying ciliated larva. Type species. Eaplobotkrium globuliforme Cooper 1914. ^~~i'~...UZ.\.."~^ ^.a'.ZZ. Intestine of Amia rata. The uterine sac and the armed dmis beginning of proglottid forma- It certainly shows some points oi resemblance to the Tnaenopho- tkm ; X 11; d. smallest plpro- rinae and has been included in a new subfamily which at present cercoidobteivrd; X II. (After stands isolated in a position intermediate between that and the Cooper.) following family. 31 (20) Scolex separated from first proglottids by unjointed region (neck). Subfamily Diphyllobothriinae Luhe 1910 . . 21 Proglottid formation always evident externally. Genital organs single or double in each proglottid. Vitellaria cortical; testes medullary in position. Vas deferens with muscular bulb before entrance to curus sac. No spines on cirrus. Adults in intestine of Amniota; larvae so far as known in fishes, reproductive organs want- ing at, time of transfer to definitive host. 22 (23) One set of reproductive organs in each proglottid. Dipkyltobothrium Cobbold 1858. The most famous member of this genus is the broad fish tapeworm of man, D. latum, commonly referred to as Botkriau phoius lotus, though it is very distinct from that genus as reference to the section will show. This species has become established on the North American continent, having been introduced no doubt by immigrants from infected territory in Europe. Possibly related species [Dibothrium] corducps Leidy 1871. Length of adult i in.; scolex cordiform i by oh to o.B mm., neck short. Widest about ■S to 15 cm. from bead, where proglottids are 7.5 mm. long, 4.5 mm. broad, 0.3 mm. truck. PARASITIC FLATWOR1IS 433 Gcaatal pores mnrnari, ventral, approximated but distinct; cirrus pore most anterior- Gmu bqpe, ewaL Testes in lateral fields, dorsal Vagina with reside near distal H Ovary pos- terjar, ventral, transverse to main axis. Shell-gland dorsal, near ovary and j***mrw to it- Uteras in lateral coals, approaching form of rosette. Ova 70 by 35 jl Adult in white pefican: larvae in muscles and body cavity of trout; Yellowstone *.«W The name of tins form cannot be accepted as THbdknwm is only a synonym of Bethri*- Jrihatav and the location of the grarital pares rules this species out of that genus as at pit-scut defined Furthermore its exact position and true relationship must remain uncertain until its structure is better known. 23 (22) Two sets of reproductive organs in each proglottid. DipLogonoporus Ldnnberg 1802. Very large rntfodrs parasitic in whales, seals, and occasionally in man. The human parafatr, D. gramiis. j±> reported by Ashfard and King from Porto Rico so it may casDy reach the southeastern coast of North America isee also Spargamatm m»m\tmi) 24 {15) Genital pores of different proglottids found on both surfaces of strobHa, ahernatmg irregularly from proglottid to proglot- tid. . Subfamily Ctathocephaltxae Lhhe 1S09 . . 25 Scolez unarmed, variable in form, not longer than wide, with two Trw^an or one apical snrring organ in form of acetabula. External proglottid limits not -ma-rfc— y or absent- Geni- tal organs single in each proglottid: aB pores median Vagina and uterus open in r*wn*n* female genital atrium provided with sphincter and located posterior to male pore. Adults in 25 (26) Apical sucking organ single, undivided by transverse fold. CyalkocepkaJus Kessler 1868. Scolea with single apical sucking organ in farm of a cup. and without evidence in shape or structure of its origin from fusion of two bothria located us surface. Proglottid limits distinct externally. Sphincter of iemak genital atrium poorly developed. Adults in nshes. Type species, CyaihocephaJus tmncaius (Pallas) 1781. Reported by Linton from pyloric ceca of common whiteush. Lake Superior. 26 (25) Apical sucking-organ single but divided by transverse fold indicating its double origin- .... Botkriomonus Duvernoy 1842. Scolex large, approximately spherical, with single apical sucking organ Eke acetabulum. yet divided transrerserr by a fold which inrrica.lrft its origin from two bothria typical of faamTy. Xo external proglottid boundaries. Sphincter of female genital »<>im« weal beveaopod. la Adpmstr axyrkymdnts; Wabash River. Indiana Type species. Botkri^monms shericmis Duvernoy 1842. 27 (14) Genital pore at margin of proglottid Subfamily Tmaexophoxtxaz Lube iSqq. Scolex always with typical bothria. not very deep: flattened apex of scolex projects above fr*«Wi» as a mare or less distinct annular cap. Marginal genital pares alternating irregu- brJjr: in— «n» pare, median on ventral surface, anterkir to marginal genital pare. Repro- daCLJue organs single in each proglottid. No muscular bulb at inner end of cirrus sac Re- ceptacahmt *»■■■»»">. small Uterus in criik, but never in rosette form, somewhat rmlarprri near ats terminm. Aduks in iwiwriw of nshes and Trutrinr turtles kr\-M is fishes, mostly unknown. Type pr*"** Tri^cnophams Rudolpbi 1793. ^rl** -mjtih t thiee-pointed hooks. Xo external pripottid markings. Testes occupy aS medullary layer not takex by other organs. \ nellaria cjctinuyu* tl ourtica] layer. iLterrupted caAjr at genital pares. Orarj and shell gland adjacent i:. margin bearing frzrtt&l part.. Uter- aae pore usually not median but an surface at right cc Ttwria^. hut when marginal pore is suns- aad tict ma. Addas in int-^iw of ashes; larva encysted in nshes. Present in Sarin America; no nputdcd a* yet. 434 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 28 (9) Immature forms; sexual organs wanting or at least as yet only partly developed Sparganum Diesing 1855. Larval stages, without sex organs; not yet at a period in which specific determination is possible. Many undescribed forms in various hosts; three known forms are listed below. The first named is not yet reported for this continent; the second and third are definitely recorded for United States of America. Sparganum mansoni (Cobbold) 1882. Large forms, 8 to 36 cm. long; 0.1 to 12 mm. broad. Two longitudinal grooves on dorsal surface; one median longitudinal groove on ventral surface. In connective tissue and body cavity of man. Japan. The probable adult, Diplogonoporus grandis has been reported from Porto Rico. Sparganum proliferum (Ijima) 1905. Small form, 1 to 12 mm. long, 2.5 mm. broad. Body usually irregular in form. Multipli- cation in cysts by formation ot supernumerary heads and transverse division. Encysted in tubdermal connective tissue and elsewhere; in man, Florida, U. S. A., and Japan. Sparganum sebago Ward 1910. Length 25 to 36 mm., breadth 1.8 to 0.36 mm. Head with keyhole-shaped bothria. Body elliptical in cross-section with slightly thickened margins. No segmentation developed and no sex organs. In spleen and body cavity of Salmo sebago; Maine. 29 (8> 3°) Scolex with two or four sucking grooves, and also at apex four protrusile proboscides armed with many hooks. Order Trypanorhynchm. The four long slender cylindrical proboscides are conspicuous enough to render the deter- mination of adult or larva easy. The adults are found in the spiral valve of sharks and rays; the larval forms occur encysted in migratory fish. They are among the rarest of finds in fresh-water collecting and are present in North America though no species are recorded as yet. 30 (8, 29) Scolex with four sucking organs (exceptionally replaced by a pseudoscolex) but without extensile proboscides. No uterine pore 31 31 (54) Vitellaria with very numerous follicles, distributed on each side in longitudinal marginal zone, rarely in the entire surface zone of the proglottid Order Tetraphyllidea. Sucking organs 4, cup-shaped, small, or very mobile stalked or unstalked modified bothridia. Small apical sucking organ frequent. Pseudo-scolex exceptionally present. External seg- mentation evident, but less conspicuous at end of chain. Genital organs single in each pro- glottid. No uterine pore, but uterus opens in median ventral line by rupture of wall. Testes numerous. Ovary posterior, median, usually with two wings. Eggs thin-shelled, without lid; embryonal development in uterus. Adults in intestine of cold-blooded vertebrates. Only family in North America in fresh-water hosts. Family Proteocephaltdae La Rue 1911 . . 32 Heads small. Suckers sessile and without accessory areola. Fifth sucker functional, ves- tigial, or lacking. No rostellum. Genital organs in general as in other Tetraphyllidea. Genital pores marginal, irregularly alternating. Vitellaria lateral, follicular, follicles closely grouped about a central conducting tubule. Ovary bilobed, posterior. Oocapt, ootype, shell gland, and uterine passage present. Uterus with lateral outpocketings and one or more pre- formed ventral uterine openings. Vitellaria, testes, ovary and uterus within the inner longi- tudinal muscle-sheath. Habitat: In fresh-water fish, amphibians, and aquatic reptiles. 32 (53) Head without lappets or folds of tissue around suckers. .... 33 33 (46) Testes in one broad mass between vitellaria; parasitic in fresh- water fish Proteocephalus Weinland 1858 . . 34 Head globose or conical, flattened doreoventrally. No rostellum. No spines or hooks. Suckers circular or oval. Fifth sucker functional or vestigial, rarely lacking. Musculature well developed. Eggs with three membranes. * ' _ .- . TiMisnc FiATvcmjis 435 *Ui' jTinioimia] fiti^ err eibciu funics. Umcic ve lop- ing actual organ* quadrate or nearly an; ripe pro- glottids quadrate or much longer than broad. Head large, 1.0 to 1.1 mm. broad at hear of aurk- en. Sucker* about o..u by 0..10 mm. Teaim large, numerous, wo l« 150. Orrua-poucho.jito no colli of duitut ejaculatoriua, 60 literal oulpocketini UUti with 40 to 60 lateral out pocketing* 01. In fnteatine of Ancittndcn p&rtww llolbr., locality not known. Fro. 14), OaUfMnla inaVi lAiierTJTti! Senles with four tuckers situated on the flat anterior (ace of the head, Many Irregular Hon and lappet* of tisane about margin of anterior eurf ace; may enclote tucker* aa In a corolla No rontellum. No hooka nor spinet. Neck broad, abort. Habitat; In Sllurida*. Martha li and Gilbert report the occurrence of two apecie* In the common bullhead. I have aii undacribed specie* taken from a channel-cat at Muford, Neb, 54 (31) Vitellaria condensed, in a single mass, in medulUry layer, usually " «ly posterior lo ovary, rarely anterior to It. Order Cydophyliidaa , . 5} a the center an apical organ of re . rare on tuckers. Segmentation well devrl open, oury rarefy abaent (Fimbrianklar] ; proglottid* aet free after full maturity. No uterine pore; tardy a secondary connection to the exterior pennita the «capc of ova Taala* to ntadul iary layer, ordinarily "■ETfptT Ovary nilobed; viteilarluin compacl, alngla, near wvary 440 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY with shell gland between. Eggs thin-shelled, no lid; onchosphere with one or more mem* branes. Bladder- worm in vertebrates and invertebrates. The great majority of forms commonly designated Taenia are included here. Number and form of hooks on which older systems are based form unreliable means for the distinction of species. In immature forms the organs utilized in this key are undeveloped and a deter- mination can only be approximate. 55 (117) Body flattened. Distinct and regular external boundaries corre- sponding to internal grouping of organs in the strobila. 56 56 (57) Suckers carry on anterior and lateral surface auricular appendages. Vitellarium anterior to ovary. Family Tetrabothriedae Fuhrmann 1907. Scolex unarmed, without rostellum. Neck short. Proglottides except oldest always much broader than long. Reproductive organs single in each proglottid. Genital pores unilateral; genital cloaca deep. Cirrus-pouch small and nearly spherical, united with genital cloaca by muscular cloacal canal. Eggs with three transparent en- velopes. Adults in birds and mammals. Type genus. Tetrabothrius Rudolphi 1819. With characters of the family. Scolex unarmed, quadrate. Suckers large. Sexual pore always dextral. ... . The hosts are aquatic birds, largely marine. Nearly twenty species Fie. 744. Tetrabotkrtus are described, a number of which occur in North American birds: 32^ (After Lube*)1 ^U' &***, heron» loon>» that frequent fresh-water bodies. 57 (56) Suckers simple without appendages of any sort. Vitellaria not anterior to ovary but posterior to it, or in the same trans- verse plane with it 58 58 (59) Genital pores median, on flat surface of proglottides. Family Mesocestoididae Fuhrmann 1907. Scolex without rostellum or hooks. Suckers unarmed. Reproductive organs single in each proglottid. Genital pores median on ventral surface. Vagina opens in front of or beside cirrus-pouch. Eggs in terminal proglottides inclosed in single thick-walled egg-capsule. Adults in mammals and birds. Type genus Mesocestoides Vaillant 1863. With characters of the family. Few species; almost never in aquatic forms. No North American records although the genus occurs here. 59 (58) Male genital pores at margin or very close to it. Female pores when present similarly located 60 60 (104) Female genital pore present and located near male pore. ... 61 61 (103) Uterus transverse or irregular, not elongated in median line of proglottid 62 62 (102) Reproductive organs simple in each proglottid or if genital pores are double, the organs are also double 63 63 (64) Scolex provided with three to many rows of hooks. Family Dipyliditdae Luhe 1910. No forms in fresh-water hosts. 64 (63) Scolex provided with one or two rows of hooks or without any hooks 65 PARASITIC FLATWORMS 441 65 (70) Rostellum hassock-shaped with a multitude of very small hooks arranged in a double row. Family Davaineidae Fuhrmann 1007 . . 66 Scolex with rostellum usually broader than high and armed with very many minute hammer- shaped hooks. Margins of suckers usually with small hooks. Genital organs usually «"ff*», rarely double in each proglottid. Testes numerous. Onchosphere with two thin membranes. 66 (67) Uterus divides into numerous separate parenchyme-capsules. Davainea R. Blanchard 1891. Rostellum armed with double row of hooks; dorsal excretory vessels present. Reproductive organs single in each proglottid. Genital pores unilateral or occasionally irregularly alternate. Uterus breaks down into egg capsules each containing one or several eggs. Adults in mam- mals and birds. Numerous species; mostly in scratching birds. D. anatina is reported from the domestic duck in Europe. No North American records. 67 (66) Uterus not breaking up into separate parenchyme-capsules. 68 68 (69) No parauterine organ; uterus sac-shaped. Rostellum broader than scolex with several thousand hooklets. Ophryocotyle Friis 1870. Rostellum broader than rest of scolex; suckers armed only near anterior border. Reproductive or- gans single in each proglottid. Uterus sac-like, per- sistent. Three species in European shore and water birds some of which occur in North America. Fig. 745- OpkryocotoU protons. Head and neck with retracted and extended inrundibulum; magnified. (After Stiles.) 69 (68) Uterus coiled in posterior end of proglottid; thick-walled para- uterine organ in anterior region. Rostellum small; with not to exceed a few hundred hooklets. Idiogenes Krabbe 1868. Small cestodes. Genital pores unilateral. Cirrus-pouch very large, with retractor. Para- uterine organ develops in front of uterus; eggs finally pass directly into it from uterus and it is transformed into single thick-walled egg capsule. Adults in birds. A few species in water birds; none recorded as yet in North America. 70 (65) Rostellum sac-like, or lacking 71 71 (82) Not more than four testes in each proglottid. Family Hymenolepididae Fuhrmann 1907. . . 72 Scolex armed with 8 to 40, usually 10 hooks, with points directed posteriad when at rest, on a more or less elongated rostellum which rarely is rudimentary and unarmed. Genital pores strictly unilateral in entire strobila. Genital ducts dorsal to excretory ducts and longi- tudinal nerve. Female glands median. Onchosphere with three membranes. Adults in birds and mammals. 72 (73) In each proglottid normally 4 testes. . . Oligorchis Fuhrmann 1906. A single species in North America; not reported in aquatic birds. 73 (72) In each proglottid normally less than four testes 74 74 (79) In each proglottid normally three testes 75 442 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 75 (76) Strobila broad, lancet-shaped. Ovary and vitellarium ante-poral, alongside of testes Drepanidotaenia RaiUiet 1892. Scoles very mull, with 8 hooks. Neck wanting. No accessory sac in genital atrium. Type species Drepanidotaenia lanceolate (Bloch) 1782. Adult in intestine of ducks and geese; cosmopolitan. Bladder- worm in various Cyclopidae and Diaptomw. 1 ji M * 4 proglottid; v, uterus; vl, vitdlaria; vasiiia; magnified. (After WolflnttgeU 77 (78) Suckers entirely unarmed, or at most armed with hooks on margin only Hymenolrpis Weinland 185S. Rostellum well developed, rarely rudimentary or absent. Accessory sac generally wanting in genital atrium. Rarely as abnormality 2, 4, 5, or 6 testes in a single proglottid. Chiefly in A very large genus; about 50 species occur in aquatic hosts found in North America. Among them a few are definitely reported lor North America. B. cemprtsia (Lin ton) 1891 from the scoter and canvas-back. //. /imu in which Taenia fiium from rnolrfi, imaltti. Dorsal view Fuhrmann places Linton's both terrestrial and aquatic; nearly X SraSi A X*ta» 33J£ x7& MB of the species are found in North Amerf- (After Krabbe.) can host species. 81(71) At least six testes normally in each proglottid 83 444 * FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 83 (&3a) Rostellum entirely lacking. Scolex unarmed, very muscular. Family Anoplocephaudae Kholodkovsky 1902. Not found in fresh-water hosts. 83a (83) Rostellum present and armed with one or two rows of hooks. Family Dilepididae Fuhrmann 1007 . . 84 With rostellum armed with single or double crown of hooks rarely in broken zig-zag row, exceptionally rudimentary. Points of hooks directed posteriad. Suckers unarmed. Genital pores marginal (see 84 just below). Sex organs in each proglottid simple or double. Uterus sacculate or lobed, simple. Onchosphere with three membranes. Many genera chiefly found in birds, rarely in rep- tiles or mammals. 84 (85) Genital pores submarginal, dorsal, but never as far as half way from margin to median line. Trichocephaloides Ssinitsin 1896. Rostellum powerful with single crown of hooks. Genital pores unilateral, subdorsal. Cirrus short and thick with long bristles; no seminal vesicle. Testes few, in posterior region of seg- ment. Uterus sac-like; eggs few. Adults in birds. Few species in shore birds; parasites not reported from North America. 85 (84) Genital pores distinctly marginal 86 86 (93) Genital pores uniformly unilateral 87 87 (88) Rostellum with single crown of hooks. Lateriporus Fuhrmann 1007. Rostellum armed with single crown of 12 to 16 hooks (120 to 170 /u long), with long dorsal and short ventral root, and well-developed blade. Proglottids broader than long. Genital canals pass dorsal of longitudinal excretory vessels. Testes 12 to 30 in number, situated pos- terior and lateral to ovary and vitellarium. Uterus sac-like, filling entire medullary paren- chyma in terminal proglottids. Adults in birds. Five or more species, found in Europe in Anseriformes; not yet reported for North America. 88 (87) Rostellum with double crown of hooks; rarely rudimentary and un- armed 89 89 (92) No spines on base of cirrus 90 90 (91) Testes not in front of but behind ovary and vitellarium. DUepis Weinland 1858. Rostellum armed with double crown of hooks having long dorsal and short ventral root and long blade. Inner longitudinal muscle layer consisting of numerous bundles. Proglottids broader than long. Genital canals pass dorsal of the longitudinal excretory vessels and nerve. Vas deferens coiled, seminal vesicle not developed. Testes in medullary portion typically numerous (40 to 50), but may be reduced in number (7). Uterus sac-like with few or numer- ous outpocketings. Adults in birds and mammals. Many species from various birds including fresh-water types found in North America. D. tramfuga from the spoonbill determined for North America by Ransom. D. wrilaleralis for the green heron by Stiles and Hassall, and by A. J. Smith; also for the little blue heron by Lekly. 91 (90) Testes very numerous, entirely surrounding the female glands. Cyclorchida Fuhrmann 1907. Rostellum armed with double crown of hooks, which have a very large dorsal root and small hook portion. Genital canals pass between longitudinal excretory vessels. Cirrus-pouch communicates with genital cloaca by narrow canal opening upon large papilla. Uterus ventral, growing laterally between the excretory vessels into the cortical parenchyma and filling entire proglottid. Adults in birds. In heron, crane, etc., in Europe. Not recorded for North America. PARASITIC 445 92 (89) Root of cirrus with one or two pairs of powerful hooks lying in special pockets; genital canals pass between longitudinal excretorv vessels. Gryporkynckus Nordmann 1832. (Syn. — Acmmtk&ewrms Fnhrmann 1907.) Genital canals pass between the longitudinal excretory In genital atrium lateral to root of cirrus two special pockets with one or two pairs of powerful hooks in each. Uterus sac-like. Aduhs in birds. Three species or more in herons; not reported from North America. Fig. 752. Grypfkymckm rkriimwtristrttms. ProakXtid with contacted cirrus-pouch; short heavy hooks in pockets at opening of cirrus-poach into genital cloaca. MagnirirO. v After Qerc.) 93 (86) Genital pores not unilateral but alternating 94 94 (97) Genital pores regularly alternating 95 95 (96) Rostellum with single crown of hooks. Less than 30 proglottides; scolex large; no neck Amocbotaenia Cohn 1800. Proglottids much broader than long. Testes rather numerous (12 or more), in posterior portion of segment. Uterus sac-like, fills entire medullary portion of terminal proglottids. Adults in birds. Four or five species, some in shore birds that occur in North America. Fig. 753. Antoebototnia. Anterior end, magnified. (After von Linstow.) Fig. 754- Amoeboiaenia cuneata. a, dorsal view; b. ventral view; magnified. (After Cohn.) 96 (95) Two rows of hooks on rostellum. Cydustera Fuhrmann iqoi. Rostellum with double crjwn of hooks. Longitudinal musculature in three layers. Geni- tal canals pass between the longitudinal excretory vessels and open into a very muscular cloaca I canal. Testes numerous, scattered throughout entire dorsal medullary portion of proglottid. Ovary and yolk gland surrounded by ring-like uterus with secondary branches. Eggs with two shells. Adults in birds. C. capito, the type species, is reported by Ransom as found in the roseate spoonbill in North America. 97 (94) Genital pores alternate irregularly 98 446 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 98(99) Uterus sac-like Anomotaento Colin 1900. Rostellum with double crown of hooks, with long dorsal and short ventral root, and long blade. Genital pores nor anterior border of segment. Genital canals pass between the longitudinal excretory vessels and dorsal of the nerve. Vas deferens coiled, seminal vesicle ' absent. Testes numerous, in posterior portion of segment (or rarely laterally on both sides of the female glands). Adults in birds and European hosts of othi 09 (98) Uterus branching and in ripe proglottids incompletely divided into numerous small communicating compartments.. . . .100 n of hooks on the rostellum. Ckoanolaenia Railliet 1896. Soolex small. Rostellum armed with single crown of hooks usually with long dorsal and short ventral root. Proglottids numerous, rarely less than 30; oldest often longer than wide. Genital pores irregu- larly alternate near anterior border of proglottid. Genital canals pass between longitudinal excretory vessels and dorsal of nerve. Vas deferens coiled, seminal vesicle absent. Testes numerous, in posterior region of, or more rarely laterally on each aide of, the female glands. Uterus subdivided into numerous small communicating chambers incompletely sepa- rated by partitions infolded from wall so that in some cases eg gs appear almost as if isolated in parenchyma. A dozen species or more from North American hosts; land, shore and water birds represented. Ch. _, .,.,,.,, infmiibultim is common in chickens and is recorded ^HfSH^..^^-*^ for North America generally. C*. fmta occurs in a . number of aquatic birds; it Is reported by Linton from gulls at Yellowstone Lake. . Hook ed° (AfteT Minified; BCg- 101 (too) Rostellum armed with double crown of hooks. Motto pylidium Fuhrmann 1899. Reproductive organi single in each proglottid. Genital canals pass between longitudinal ex- cretory vessels and dorsal to longitudinal nerve or to both excretory vessels. Testes numerous (10 to 40 or more), behind ovary and vitellarium or laterally on both sides of latter. Vaa deferens coiled; seminal vesicle absent. Uterus breaks down into egg capsules, each con- taining usually one egg. Adults in birds. A dozen species in European hosts which include some shore birds found in North America. 102 (62) Reproductive glands simple, central in each proglottid; ducts and pores double, one set on each side. Diptopotthe Jacobi 1896. Rostellum armed with single c n of ten hooks. Suckers unarmed. Inner iongituduial posterior portion of proglottid. PARASITIC FLATWORMS 447 with strong books. Female glands single, median; two vaginae. Eggs with three The type species, D. loevis, from various ducks and geese found in North America. No record of any species on this continent. Fig. 757. Dipbpostke laevis. Optical section of ripe proglottid; vd, vas deferens; /, testes; u, uterus vL, viteUana; ov, ovary; w, seminal vesicle; v, vagina; X 22. (After Jacobi.) _ 103 (61) Uterus with median stem and lateral branches; female genital . glands in posterior end of proglottid. ^* Family Taeniidae Ludwig 1886. Scotex usually with well-developed rostellum armed with double crown of hooks, rarely with rudimentary unarmed rostellum. Suckers unarmed. Terminal segments longer than broad. Reproductive organs single in each proglottid. Genital pores irregularly alternate. Vas deferens coiled, seminal vesicle absent. Testes numerous, scattered. Double ovary poste- rior, median, posterior to which is the yolk gland. Egg with thin outer membrane, and thick brown radially striated inner shell. Adults in mammals and birds. l Taenia Linnaeus 1758. Forms rightly included here are as adults characteristic parasites of higher carnivorous land animak and the larval forms (cysticerci) also occur in land-living herbivorous or omnivorous mammals. Eggs are distributed widely by surface waters. Larval stages occur rarely in aquatic mam- mals, e.g., Cysticercus fasciolaris the bladder-worm of Taenia crassicollis of the cat which Stiles and Hawaii, and later Linton also, have reported from the musk rat. 104 (60) Female genital pore not adjacent to cirrus and male pore. . . 105 105 (112) Proglottids without lateral appendages. Female genital pore is entirely lacking. Family Acoleidae Fuhrmann 1007 . . 106 Thick-bodied cestodes with rostellum usually armed. Proglottids short. Musculature very powerful. Cirrus sac very large; cirrus armed with strong spines. Eggs with 3 mem- branes. In birds. 106 (in) Hermaphroditic forms 107 107 (no) Male and female genital organs simple 108 108 (109) Testes numerous; seminal receptacle very large; uterus a trans- verse tube anterior to ovary. Male genital pores regularly alternate Acoleus Fuhrmann 1899. Scokx small with armed rostellum. Reproductive organs single. Cirrus-pouch passes ventral of longitudinal excretory vessels and nerve. Vagina closed, functions as very large — »mma1 receptacle. Adults in water birds. Type species Acoleus armalus Fuhrmann 1899. From the black-necked stilt; parasite not reported from North America. 109 (108) Testes few; seminal receptacle very small; uterus encircling ovary; male pores irregularly alternate. Gyrocodia Fuhrmann 1899. Rostellum armed with single crown of hooks arranged in zig-zag row having eight angles. Reproductive organs single in each proglottid. Cirrus-pouch passes between longitudinal excretory vessels and dorsal of nerve. Uterus ring-like, with numerous outpocketings, and with opening in terminal proglottids both dorsally and ventrally in median line of posterior margin. Adults in birds. In water birds; not reported in North America. 448 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY no (107) Male reproductive organs double and female single in each pro- glottid with two vaginae functioning as large seminal re- ceptacles Diplophallus Fuhrmann 1000. Large forms with small scolex and armed ros- tellum. Testes numerous, in two lateral 6elds fully separated by median female glands. Cir- rus sac powerful, cirrus slender, very long. Vagina a blind transverse canal. Uterus at first transverse tube: later irregular, and finally taking in entire medullary region. Type species. Diplophallus polymorph™ (Rudolphi) 1 8 19. Fio. 758. DiptopkaUus. Schematic transverse From thc black-necked stilt: parasite not re- section of npe proglottid; /, testes; «, uterus; sr, _„j4Wi r,rtW% xi«-4k Am«^^> •eiiu^f«*p^er^.ovaV;^vitella^ (After corded from North Amenca. WofflhUgeL) in (106) Dioecious, entire strobila male or female; male with a double set, female with a single set of reproductive organs in each proglottid Dioicocestus Fuhrmann 1900, Female thicker and broader than male. Vagina irregularly alternating, reaching almost to the edge of the segment. Testes numerous, divided more or less plainly into two symmetrical groups. Eggs with three envelopes. Male ducts paired in every proglottid. Adults in birds. Type species Dioicocestus paronai Fuhrmann 1900. Several species from grebe and ibis; parasite not recorded from North America. 112 (105) Proglottids carry lateral foliate or digitate processes. Female genital pore, when present, separate from marginal male pore. . . Family Amabiliidae Fuhrmann 1007 . . 113 Rostellum with simple crown of hooks. Proglottids short with lateral margins prolonged into processes. Musculature weakly developed. Cirrus sac large; arms spinous. Duct united with receptaculum seminis, designated as accessory vagina, opens in cases on surface or on margin opposite male pore. In water birds. 113 (114) Male sexual organs double in each proglottid. Accessory vagina with surface opening. Uterus a network. AmabUia Diamare 1893. Scolex very small with armed rostellum. Male reproductive organs double with one pore on each side of proglottid. Cirrus armed with strong spines. Testes numerous, in median field. Female organs median, single set in each proglottid. Uterus forming network con- sisting of dorsoventral ring with dorsoventral anastomoses. Accessory vagina opening ven- trally, communicating (?) with canal from excretory system opening on ventral surface of pfOgkottkl in median fine. Adults in birds. Type and only species AmabUia lameUigera (Owen) 1832. 1x4 (1x3) Male organs single in each proglottid. Uterus sac-like.. . . 115 115 (116) Rostellum thick, powerful. Male pores alternate irregularly. Female pore, when present, on surface of proglottid. Schistotaenia Cohn 1900. Rostellum very large, armed with heavy hooks. Between rostellum and suckers an annular thickening covered closely with small three-cornered hooks. Testes numerous, dorsal, rior, across entire width of proglottid, reaching maturity later than female glands, and vitellarium large. Male duct runs between excretory canals, accompanying vagina ends blindly near cuticula. Type species S. macrorkynch* m the horned grebe. Parasite not recorded from North PARASITIC FLATWORMS 449 Rostellum long, slender. Male pores alternate regularly. Female pore, when present, always marginal. Talria Kowalewski 1904. Rostellum with single crown of to to 14 large books ud behind tbem numerous rows of Email conical hooks. Sticker* and posterior portion of head covered with minute spines. Segments Dot numerous. Cirrus- pouch Urge. Testes not numerous. Hale and female canals pais be- tween longitudinal excretory vessels. Distal end of vagina instead of opening to exterior turns posteriad into next following proglottid and opens into seminal receptacle there. Seminal receptacles median; ac- cessory vagina present opposite cirrus-pouch, sometimes with opening. Adults in birds (Urina tores). The type species {Talria bitemh Kowalewski 1404) occurs in the homed grebe and has not been reported [or North America. In 1887 Leidy reported Taenia icoloprnd'a Diesing from this host and that specie* is placed here by some authors. Flo. 7J9. Takia Urtmh. Forma major: proglotUds with lateral appendages, X 30. (After Kowalewski.) 117(55) External division of strobile, into proglottid^ lacking. .... 118 11S (iiq) Anterior portion of strobila folded and coiled to form large pseudo- scolex; strobila grooved transversely, without true pro- . glottid limits. . . Family Fimbriariidae Wolff htlgel 1898. Scolex small, unstable, frequently lost, with rostellum armed with single row of hooks. Pseudoscolex conspicuous. Strobila with transverse grooves which produce appearance of segmentation. Three pairs of longitudinal excretory vessels. Reproductive organs not segmentally arranged. Genital pores marginal, irregular, generally unilateral. Testes numerous, arranged in transverse rows. Uterus not persist- ent, breaking down into a large number of egg sacs. Egg spindle-shaped with thin transparent shell. Adults in birds (Anserif ormes) . Type genus Pimbriaria Frolich 1801. (Syn. — Epiiion Linton iSQl.) Two well-known 'pedes both occur in North American water birds; a third, F. plicala (Linton) 1 89 2 is recorded from the American scoter. 9(118) Scolex small, simple. Strobila round or nearly so. Without pro- glottid boundary except at extreme posterior end. Family Nematotaentidae Lithe ioio . . ijo filiform end of strobila a Scolex unarmed, without rostellum. I separate proglottid; visible externally; thi "' independently - ' ■- e trunks, open ir 1 genital atrium marginal FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY n) Two testes in each proglottid Nematotamia Luhe 1890,. Strohila thicker near anterior end becoming tMnnaaf ttnd eventually filiform, circular in crosa-section. Neck short, rirnis-pouch long, passing within longitudinal muscle layer. Vas deferens long, with ventral loop between ovary and excretory canals. Two testes, dorsal and symmetrica]. ViteUarium almost exactly in center of body. Ovary ventral, nearly median; uterus horseshoe-shaped, breaks up early into numer- ous capsules with i to 4 eggs, usually 3, in each cap- sule becoming ultimately 13 to 30 small dark uterine Records of it a occurrence in North America are open to question. ' Type species. Nematotamia dispar (Goeze) 1782. , Fig. 761. rYtsufaOMid disfar. ripe proglottid: Magnified. :riiiri»; 0 >) One testis in each proglottid. Cylindrotaenio Jewell 1916. Strobila thickest near center, becoming thinner towards both ends. Neck long. Single testis round, on aporal side of proglottid just dorsal to transverse diameter. Cirrus-pouch short, ending at longitudinal muscle layer. Vas deferens abort, nearly straight. Uterus breaks up into capsules ,# each containing 4 to 6 eggs, becoming enclosed later in two conical organs, one dorsal and one ventral, which are large transparent uterine cap- Type spedes. Cylindrolaenia amertcana Jewell 1916. Perhaps Taenia pulthdia Leidy 1851 belong* 123 (1) Larval forms; reproductive organs undeveloped 123 Usually small and uruustmented though some bladder-worms reach considerable su .,. .!._!__, _g 0f proglottid format! ysted but there On the whole these larvae show little from adults by the absena tree forms. Trrpanorhynchj. (p. 434). 133 (124) Four long proboscidea covered with hooks. Very rare but easily recognized. 124(123) No proboscides with hooks present 125 125 (126) ScOlez and sucking organs hardly differentiated at all and tie latter when present never more than two. Larvae of Paendophyllidea. (See also Spartamm, p. 434.) The anterior end of these and other larvae b often rolled in so that its a PARASITIC FlATWOtMS 06(115) Fow sackcxs on the smlcx of the bm. CyHkrrtms . TkkiJrftkkmbnvfnef utiat ckwjmicsiic in [be oncer ac die nuts tkr nvnbnt wn«n Jka*T ^■■■■^ * put of the u^anxn: & 1*7 ftrfl) Eisirr Exm jnfii paceuLbiLoa caane. Seoiea irrwgmated lU "~" apex M bottom ot" infoidmg. ju-rfcing puuvo axe like Che true plerocermid!! nidi 4 iHrrahrihi Lout ptommeiiEly ,ir PrDteacepnaJlnne. lisu of ( '. j-:. kiiiajilHe* from miBo One uprdkl aim kaoatn. 13 Grjfmrkymdma buh Inn Hutjftrf u die bra of Oiirptf jr suae allied joiui xbwali izS Ct'Ti Spaas m larva between fclda oc tiseac. Scouex in natural poti&Bm, Birnwnded by qpst. Cy&uisratnL. EnanBr "rait anU appendage m 1 poM-frror haflaw of the cysL, and an die Uil dre nnbrj- Etaxnci ihuniimitv Tiumdy on die m vaipniQai layer hetneen Che cynt md die *-nl**^ thndt *i Very fcfmt annas Cydopnyfliifea-. Retadoaafan bu.nuu the i-yn-i'i-i— -nnj m if the unuix 45 2 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY REFERENCES ON NORTH AMERICAN PARASITIC WORMS IMPORTANT GENERAL WORKS Cobbold, T. S. 1864. Entozoa. 480 pp. 82 figs. London. 1879. Parasites. 508 pp. London. Diesing, C. M. 1850, 185 1. Systema helminthum. Vienna. 2 vols.; 679 and 588 pp. Dujardin, F. 1845. Histoire naturelle des helminthes, ou vers intestinaux. Paris. 654 pp. Atlas, 12 pi. Lexdy, J. 1904. Researches in Helminthology and Parasitology. Smith. Inst., Misc. Coll., vol. 46, Art. Ill, 281 pp. (Reprint of Leidy's contribu- tions from 1845 to 1891. With a bibliography.) Linstow, 0. von 1878. Compendium der Helminthologie. 382 pp. 1889. Nachtrag. 157 pp. Hannover. Looss, A. 1 901. Zur Sammel- und Conservirungstechnik von Helminthen. Zool. Anz., 24: 302-304, 309-318. Smith, A. J. 1908. Synopsis of Studies in Metazoan Parasitology. Univ. Penn. Med. Bull., Feb., 68 pp. 10 pi. Stiles, C. W., and Hassall, A. 1894. A Preliminary Catalog of the Para- sites Contained in the Collections of the U. S. Bureau of Animal Industry, U. S. Army Medical Museum, etc. Vet. Mag., 1: 245-253, 331-354. 1 902-191 2. Index-Catalog of Medical and Veterinary Zoology. (Authors.) Bur. An. Ind., Bull. No. 39; 36 parts, 2766 pp. Wright, R. R. 1879. Contributions to American Helminthology, Proc., Can. Inst., n.s. x: 54-75, 2 pi. trematoda Braun, M. 1879-93. Trematodes. Bronn's Klass. u. Ord. d. Tierreichs, Vol. 4, 925 pp., 34 pi. Leipzig. Cooper, A. R. 191 5. Trematodes from Marine and Fresh-Water Fishes. Trans. Roy. Soc. Can., (3) 9: 181-205, 3 pi. Cort, W. W. 191 5. Some North American Larval Trematodes. 111. Biol. Monogr., 1: 447~532; 8 pi. Looss, A. 1894. Die Distomen unserer Fische und Frdsche. Biblth. Zool., Heft. 16, 296 pp., 9 pi. 1899. Weitere Beitrage zur Kenntniss der Trematoden-Fauna Aegyptens, zugleich Versuch einer natiirlichen Gliederung des Genus Distomum Ret- zius. Zool. Jahrb., Syst., 12: 521-784, 9 pi. LOhe, M. 1909. Parasitische Plattwurmer. I: Trematodes. Siisswasser- fauna Deutschlands, Heft 17, 217 pp., 188 figs. Odhner, T. 1910. Nordostarrikanische Trematoden. I. Fasdoliden. Swed- ish Zool. Exp., 23 A; 170 pp., 6 pL PARASITIC FLATWORMS 453 1911-1913. Zum natiirlichen System der digenen Trematoden I-VI. Zool. Anz., vols. 37-42. Pratt, H. S. 1900. Synopses of North American Invertebrates, XII. The Trematodes. Part 1. Heterocotylea. Am. Nat., 34: 645-662; 50 figs. 1902. Part 2. Aspidocotylea and Malacocotylea. Am. Nat., 36: 887-910, 9S3-979J 8 pl. Stiles, C. W. and Hassall, A. 1008. Index-Catalog of Medical and Veter- inary Zoology. Subjects: Trematoda and Trematode Diseases. Hyg. Lab., Bull. No. 37, 401 pp. CESTODA Braun, M. 1894-1900. Cestodes. Bronn's Klass. u. Ord. d. Tierreichs, Vol. 4, p. 927-1732, 25 pl. Leipzig. La Rue, Geo. R. 19 14. A Revision of the Cestode Family Proteocephalidae. 111. Biol. Monogr., 1: 1-350, 16 pl. LtfHE, M. Parasitische Plattwurmer. II, Cestodes. Stisswasserfauna Deutschlands, Heft 18, 153 pp., 147 figs. Ransom, B. H. 1909. The Taenioid Cestodes of North American Birds. U. S. Nat. Mus., Bull. 69, 141 pp. Stiles, C. W. and Hassall, A. 1912. Index-Catalog of Medical and Veteri- nary Zoology. Subjects: Cestoda and Cestodaria. Hyg. Lab., Bull. No. 85, 467 pp. CHAPTER XIV THE NEMERTEANS By WESLEY R. COE Sheffield Scientific School of Yak University Among the fresh-water animals of the northern half of the United States occurs a slender little worm of a beautiful reddish color belonging to the group of Nemerteans. These worms can be easily distinguished from the other flatworms (Platyhelminthes) by the slenderness of the body, and from the other groups of worms by their perfectly smooth, ciliated bodies and their leisurely creep- ing movements. The presence of the proboscis armed with a formidable calcareous stylet which can be thrust out of the opening at the anterior end of the body is proof that the worm is a ne- mertean. These nemerteans live along the shores of lakes and streams, as well as in pools and artificial basins of water and aquaria. Quiet, shallow areas of water with a dense growth of water plants are particularly favorable. The worms may be found creeping over the stems and leaves of the water plants, among the dead leaves and debris at the bottom, on stones and objects in the water, and oftentimes beneath the stones along the shore. The under sides of floating leaves, as lily pads, particularly those par- tially decayed, often harbor numbers of these tiny worms. They are, however, local in distribution and are seldom found in abun- dance over a very wide area. When common in a shallow inlet a few yards wide, a further search for a mile along the shore of a lake or stream may fail to reveal a single specimen. The worms are usually from 10 to 18 mm. in length when fully extended, but may contract to a small fraction of their former length. They rarely exceed i mm. in diameter. The color varies considerably, shades of red, orange, or vermilion being most com- mon, while the smaller specimens are often pale yellowish or flesh colored. The anterior half of the body is more brightly colored 454 -'.1*4 f"fiir~ "'•!' V^'Tmf J*f THE NEMERTEANS 455 than the posterior portion, where the in- testinal lobes and reproductive glands modify the brilliancy of the coloring. Some individuals have a cast of reddish brown. On the anterior end of the body are usually six black pigment spots, or ocelli, arranged symmetrically in three pairs (o, Fig. 765). Smaller specimens may have but four ocelli, and occasional irregularities occur in which the number may be five, seven, or eight. It is to the internal organization of the body, however, that one must look for those characters which are mainly used in the classification of the nemerteans. These structures must be studied in most species by means of serial sections, but, , fortunately, the fresh-water forms are so nearly transparent that the principal or- gan systems of the body may be studied in the living animal. It is only necessary to place the worm on a slide with a small drop of water and flatten the body be- neath a cover glass. When such a speci- men is examined under the low powers of a microscope the principal anatomical features are easily made out. Particularly characteristic is the probos- cis, a strong muscular organ (/>, Fig. 765) contained in the rhynchocoel and en- closed by the proboscis sheath. This organ extends from the anterior extrem- ity nearly to the posterior end of the body. Fro. J6^. Sliclwilfmma nttrum (Leidy). Diainam o! living indt- K C pyloric cecum: CF, ccpbalic ' 456 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Back toward its posterior third, the proboscis is armed with a needle-like calcareous stylet (s) resting upon a solid conical basis. Beside the central stylet there are two lateral pouches each con- taining 2, 3, or 4 accessory stylets of size and shape similar to the central stylet. The proboscis is considerably longer than the sheath in which it lies coiled and to which it is attached at both ends. By means of its powerful musculature it can be thrust out of the anterior end of the body. This process of eversion turns the ante- rior part of the proboscis inside out and brings the central stylet to the end of the everted organ, where it constitutes a formid- able weapon of defense or offense. After eversion the retractor muscle at its posterior end withdraws the proboscis to its original position. The mouth and proboscis open together through the rhyncho- daeum (r) at the anterior end of the body. The esophagus leads into a broad stomach, and this into the intestine with its numer- ous lateral lobes. At the anterior end of the intestine a pair of pyloric ceca (c) extend forward to the brain. The short rec- tum leads to the opening at the posterior end of the body. The nemerteans feed upon other worms and soft-bodied animals of various kinds. The central nervous system consists of the four cerebral ganglia and a pair of large longitudinal lateral nerves (In). These are easily seen in the living worm. The excretory system extends the entire length of the body as a series of delicate tubes with several efferent ducts leading to each side of the body. The three longitudinal trunks of the blood vascular system are often distinctly seen in the living animal. The fresh-water nemerteans are hermaphroditic, and usually protandric. The gonads are arranged serially along each side of the body between the intestinal lobes. Each gonad bears both male and female genital products, which are discharged when mature through a small pore opening on the side of the body. The male sexual elements are formed first, and in the smaller and evidently younger worms the gonads are filled with developing spermatozoa. Later, and after the discharge of a portion of the spermatozoa, the eggs begin their development. »l- i:S i* TV.*: -i WTiJt »■ c ; r. .mUsiI :i .. »U .. .. .l- .. a ... .-.-i.. Um i LT.£"*: a 1' V» J.*** •» tin . *. . i... . .. i . . ...i . .ir. reran r : :.: cii j i*,.iu .1 . .•<»...-. <. ..|.", . ._ . . ■ •...- IOTXI1'. .11 ■> '1 . i. ■ I . ••!.-. ;• ..!««:. •..«.,.«»■. . . I. ;.. . .*. S'. ll-!CrUU#V.U — III ■■.• vk#ili.*..i: . .-■ .i - ,. .+ - - . ■ -I "....-. . .. ■' cei'OiJu. :■. ii«.»^v- . . «■. . i . -,i'.r.. . i... . . . , Will :: ai..» <-••• . ■. \.« ?.■* ••:!• ..i.,;.-.*. ' .. j. , . t- j. 1 :V t%i:: ; •: 'i-.i!-. ml I >«t.l.. .. :.. .„ .n ■;....■;_ . ■ - ;_ Will .11 'J.*1—.: I V* ••'/ : ■ i :i. i .^' . ' .•.«.. . -„ ■ . i • j • i_. L: V Y'\*T: i: t '*. :•. ■! ju ■ . . »;.•.*..! . «. f . * u . JiiUri.it. /r « r. ^•.».'u*..?- . ■ i'. "■.... :.^- .. *.. . .... a.. i:;t; u«vri#.^«itr ..t « ■ . .a-. :.^i ,. j .':r wui.u- ■. '■. *.■ ..i . ,. » .._.:,....- . • _ I'.» i\<2 ■ r. 'r»l.i . : ■-.!•• :■...* . .•_•-.. * . ■ U \T ti i\l ••■•-■.. i ■■. i u • . . :.. . . \t « : ■ l'JLl'Ll lli J'.'U"'.. .* P- ^.»«.-.- »..■..■ ! . — : .„.-.' ... ^»-- .Hj^iiOt":!:- ■■■. ^'.if.'.-i: -f..-:'. i .... :■...■:■.' ii":w j*t*i;» ii. '■ . -.../!.. .:!».....■> .* ' ■ i. *.*V Ill --■ 1 J l" .■»!' » »■ . t .. ... - -- ' . , I 1 . . ■ t * . . - i . * ' .-.".*.•» — - J - . . _.. ■ / If. I -l i"- .">v . 1. J- .■ . * .»».■.. ■ . , j ifi .■ " . . i.x ■ ._ . '-'- - -> - -• • .. . . JlV-tllLi I'.'i... ..'I ' ..ii tt' >«-ir ■ '.*-■... • ■ ■ - — J. t.kt'i++tftr)i' '•*** -~l f . < ,11.1 m J%1 *yjJkV^ ^* 1" -•> 1 //. ti. i 1^- "?L1— J ■ » 14. . ,,_ aM. .J-t~ - .— . .v.*. 1 ■ .. . Ut/3.1 «w- ...... »• ..» 45* FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY But whether the nemerteans from these widely separated local- ities represent a single or several distinct species is not yet defi- nitely known. Since fresh-water nemerteans similar to ours are found in England, Germany, and other parts of Europe, and in Asia and Africa, a careful study of specimens from many Ameri- can localities is necessary to settle the question of nomenclature. For it is not improbable that some of the localities mentioned have f>ecn stocked with forms transported from other p: xts of the country, or from other quarters of the world. The importation of cultivated water plants furnishes ideal conditions for the intro- duction of the nemerteans associated with them. A recent study indicates that the species found in Connecticut Is identical with that recorded by Montgomery from Pennsylvania. This species differs in certain anatomical details from any of the described exotic forms, but is evidently synonymous with Leidy's Ema rubra. Since there is nothing in the published descriptions of specimens from other North American localities to indicate a spe- cific distinction it is at present possible to recognize but a single species, to which the name Stkhostemma rubrum (Leidy) should be applied. IMPORTANT REFERENCES ON FRESH-WATER NEMERTEANS Uoitma, L. 1808. Beitritge zur Anatomie und Histologic der Nemertinen. [Stiihtsltmnta gratctme ( Btthmig) , GeonemerUs chalicophora (Graff} .] Zeit, f. wto. Zool., 64: 479~564* Detailed account of the structure of a fresh-water form. BOttOKlt, O, 1805. Die Nemertinen des Golfes von Neapel und der an- grenaenden Mceres-absehnitte. Fauna u. Flora v. Neapel, Monogr. 22. Important monograph on the European nemerteans. Clttt.n, C\ M. toot. The Habits and Natural History of Stichostemma. Am. Nat., j$: 075-1006. HAKTMrYKK, R. tooo. NcmertinL Die SQsswasserfauna Deutschlands, Heft. lot 47^8. MoNTOOMKtY, T. H., J*. 1805. Stkhostemma eUhardi nov. gen. nov. spec. £in Bcitrag aur Kenntnis der Nemertinen, Zeit. f. wiss. Zool., 59: 83-146. Anatomical study of a fresh-water nemertean. t$oo\ Stkk+skmma asmsonatum a. sp., a Fresh-water Nemertean from tVntuytvania* Zool. Ant, to: 43$-43& Description of a fresh-water nemertean from Pennsylvania. VJi-Oi^TO* v. hirh v !>k» »;,,.*%"»..r.f — ■■ -■ • • "-Wljf.ll^ H "•«■ *r '• " '■ I"" " x " ' • ■ - ■ • • i ■ YfT »\ ■•imi.v'«»<' ■ " . ■■—*-' ■ ■ i • ^ -_ ■ .. » * p**?l^ IMTtm? i • I t * . I • • i I" . . ■ - •«»■.. i ..»»- » ■•!«'S»lt* results in characteristic appearances, such as the more pronounced striation of the dorsal and ventral surfaces, the interruption and variation of the striations near the lateral lines, and the presence on the lateral fields of various longitudinal striations. In some genera the striations are compound, that is, each transverse striation is resolvable into a row of dot-like markings, either round or elongated. These secondary markings may be again resolvable, the result being a very complex series of exceedingly minute markings. The trans- verse striations are usually more or less plainly interrupted near the lateral lines. Oblique striae, such as are to be found in the large parasitic nematodes, sometimes occur in the fresh-water species, in some Mermithidae, for instance. The longitudinal striations are of two kinds: (1) True stria- tions of the cuticula due to certain stiffening structures or "wings," and (2) internal markings due to the attachment of the cells of the muscular layer and of the lateral fields. The longitudinal stria- 464 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY tions, when they are really cuticular structures, are likely to appear in some multiple of four. Since they occur on each side of the two lateral lines, and, naturally, in a symmetrical way, the smallest number possible is four. Two on each side of each lateral line would make eight in all, a state of things exemplified in Iota. In Diplogasier the number is about sixteen to thirty-two, and ap- parently these numbers also prevail in some Dorylaimi. The various elements of the cuticula originate in certain cells in the longitudinal fields, which early in the development of the em- bryo become separated from the ectoblastomere group of cells. One of the first two somablastomeres, the primary ectoblastomere, divides and spreads systematically over the endoblastomeres. By further divisions the primary ectoderm thus formed gives rise among other things to the cuticula. The nuclei of the ectoblast cells destined to form the cuticula of the embryo arrange themselves in longitudi- nal lines. Increasing, and functioning from these lines they become specially active at each moult in producing a new layer of cuticula. At moulting time the activity of the cuticula-forming cells in the lateral fields is indicated by an increase in the size of the nuclei and the growth from them of excessively fine elements forming the cuticula. The lateral fields appear to be the leading members of this group of cuticula builders. This is in harmony with the greater abundance and variety of the lateral cuticular structures. In the course of its development a nematode sheds its skin about four times, — and often appears to be about as active during the moulting period as at other times. In some species the changes that take place at the time of moulting are of . a striking character, reminiscent of the metamorphoses in other groups, though no true metamorphosis takes place. Thus we have in the last moult of the males in some species of Iota a marked alter- ation, viz. y the loss of the oral spear. This so alters the appear- ance of the male that one unfamiliar with the facts would not class the adult males in the same genus as the females. During the moulting period the cuticula is thicker and looser, — sometimes very loose. The lining of the mouth and esophagus, as well as that of the rectum, is shed at the same time as the outer cuticula. At this time, therefore, the mouth parts take on unusual FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 465 appearances. If the pharynx is armed with teeth these are often seen in duplicate. In a moulting Dorylaitnus, for instance, one may see the old spear or tooth and behind it a second smaller one, and in some cases even a third. The nature, or the presence, of stria- tums may become more evident, or less evident, at the moulting period than at other times. Remnants of old skin attached to newly moulted individuals have sometimes given rise to erroneous deductions and to errors in taxonomy. The nervous system centers in the so-called nerve-ring, which in free-living species encircles the esophagus near the middle of the neck. This ring is composed of interwoven nerve-fibers which, taken together with the groups of nerve cells immediately in front of and behind them, form what is undoubtedly a rudimentary brain. (See Rhabdolaimus) Eyes, or rather eye-spots, are known in one or more species of the following fresh-water genera: Dorylaitnus, Diplogaster, Spilophora, CyatholaimuSy Chromadora, and Monhystera. The visual organs in their most complete form consist of well-defined subspherical cuticular lenses placed in front of collections of reddish, violet, or blackish pigment-granules. Usually two such organs are placed symmetrically, one on either side of the esophagus, between it and the body wall, and in a dorsally sublateral position. Nerves pass backward from the eyes to the nerve-ring. It is doubtful whether the lenses form images that are perceived, though no doubt the more perfect of the lenses found in nematodes are capable of form- ing excellent images. Probably the lenses serve merely to collect and condense light. Usually the eye-spots are mere collections of pigment without lenses. Eye-spots, or what appear to be such, may occur embedded in the esophagus. It is probable that the great majority of species, even when without specialized visual organs, perceive light by its direct action on the nervous system. A few experiments will convince anyone that many eyeless species distinguish the direction from which the light comes. There is no satisfactory evidence that nematodes hear. At various points on the surface of the cuticula there are found innervated papillae and setae, which appear in most cases to be tactile organs. Sometimes, however, they are associated with glands, as, 466 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY for instance, in the case of the supplementary organs of the males. These papillae, hairs, and setae all belong to the same general class of structures, but various terms are applied to them in accordance with their size and location. The special hairs found on and near the lips are known as cephalic setae, in contradistinction to the large hairs or setae sometimes found at the posterior extremity, the caudal and terminal setae. The setae are no doubt mainly tac- tile in function, though it seems a | certain that some of the ce- phalic setae and papillae serve 2 also as organs of taste and F10.768. Head of a nematode (diagrammatic), i.side smell. ew; a, front view, showing triangular mouth opening # # in the middle. The ventral tide to the right in x shows Xhe similar Organs found On the ampulla and excretory duct. As the right side of the ° itfJUS j^ ** «eneral surface of the body «£^^ are called hairs or somatic equal size. (After cob'oT setae These probably f oUow a definite law in their distribution, but are so small that the exact distribution is difficult to make out and has been studied in but few cases. While it is not established that their distribution accords with a segmentation theory, this matter is worthy of care- ful study. Sometimes the hairs occur in harmonic repetition on successive groups of annules. The papillae of the cuticula are setae that do not project beyond the surface, or not far enough to entitle them to be called setae. They should not be confounded with pores, or with mere projections of the surface of the cuticula. Neither of these latter are innervated. Tactile structures sup- plementary to the sexual organs are found on the tail end of the male both in front of and behind the anus, generally toward the ventral side. They are much more rare in the female, being located, when present, near the vulva. What are known as the amphids or lateral organs are of such widespread occurrence among free-living nematodes as to make it seem certain that their function is of fundamental importance, but what the function is remains a mystery. The amphids are two lateral, symmetrically-placed external cephalic organs. The ex- terior part has the form of a circle, spiral, helix, or elongated figure. FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 467 the helix or spiral being the fundamental form of the main cuticular outer lateral markings that serve so good a purpose in characterizing species. These external markings are undoubtedly in some species connected with internal series of lateral organs arranged in two rows, one along each lateral field, extending throughout the length of the body. One more or less plausible theory concerning the amphids is that which proposes to regard them as breathing organs. It is only very exceptionally that they are known to have special direct con- nection with the central nervous system. Such connection would be expected, if, as some suggest, they are organs of sensation. Their apparent homologues found in some parasitic nematodes seem rudimentary. Possibly they are organs of equilibration. In describing the digestive system it is necessary to consider the mouth parts, the salivary or mouth glands, the esophagus, the in- testine, and the rectum. Roughly speaking, the mouth parts may be divided into two main groups: those adapted to biting and those adapted to sucking. The various forms of the pharyngeal cavity in the biting group are shown in the adjacent illustrations, together None Conoid Concave- Cyathiform Cyathiforra, Cylindroid Compound conoid then Cylindroid Fig. 769. Forms of the pharynx. (After Cobb.) with their corresponding nomenclature (Fig. 769). The formation of the pharynx in the sucking groups is more uniform. The soft-lipped species are intermediate in form and are adapted to seizing and swallowing various microscopic organisms, both plant and animal. The mouth cavity or pharynx is usually more or less strongly lined with cuticula, and often furnished with cuticular parts serving various purposes according to the food habits of the species. Where the lips are muscular and mobile, not infrequently they are sup- plied with rather complicated gripping organs arranged like the jaws of a lathe chuck. This arrangement of the mouth parts is well illustrated in Enoplus; the reverse motion for ripping tissues open is shown in Ironus (Fig. 781). Mononchus (Fig. 782) shows the development of six muscular lips with opposing pharyngeal 468 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY teeth used in seizing prey. There are a number of genera in which the pharynx is armed with from one to three prominent teeth of prob- lematical function. In some of these cases the teeth are the outlets of an equal number of glands located in the wall of the esophagus. The secretions of these glands are probably salivary in nature, or possibly in some cases venomous, or even, as has been suggested, excretory. These suppositions rest on structural and food-habit considerations, rather than on an examination of the nature of the secretions. The saliva theory is strongly supported by the nature of these glands, whether their form, numbed, position, or structure is considered, but they sometimes empty through fang- like projections in carnivorous species that one would think could profit by the use of venom in much the same way that serpents do. The nematode esophagus is an organ of which every cross-section is usually substantially circular, though the diameter may vary much in the various parts. The central canal is usually trique- trous in cross-section (Fig. 766). The lining is uniformly cuticular and varies considerably in thickness in the various species. In the simple cylindrical form of esophagus, radial muscles, the contraction of which accomplishes the act of swallowing, everywhere pass from the lining of the organ to the exterior cylindroid wall. The action of these muscles is peristaltic, first creating the necessary suction, and, after the food is sucked in, rapidly forcing it along toward the intes- tine. The act of swallowing is often lightning-like in its rapidity. In addition to this general radial musculature the esophagus some- times presents spherical or ellipsoidal muscular swellings, or bulbs, often supplied with a central cuticular valve, for exerting more pow- erful suction than could be produced by the narrower tubular part. The presence of bulbs denotes certain methods of feeding, — either the lips need to be fastened securely to the source of food in order to facilitate the stabbing action of the oral spear, or it is necessary to exert unusual suction in order to ingest the food. There may be one, two, or three of these bulbs, or none. The corresponding forms of the esophagus are shown in the accompanying illustration (Fig. 770), to which the appropriate names are appended. In rare cases the esophagus is not clearly marked off from the intestine, but there nearly always exists between these two parts of the all- FREE-LIVINCi NEMATODES 469 mcntary canal a distinct constriction, known as the cardiac con- striction. In the immediate vicinity of this constriction small organs are sometimes found, apparently of a glandular nature, tfrmgh their functions are still veiled in obscurity. Here also occur definite nerve cells which are probably to be regarded as the center of an involuntary nervous system. m /'\ m < (v & (h /\ C^liodroid CouoiJ iuMiur;:. Ciuvaic Dorylidnioi • Oxyuroid Khabdiioki Tylenchoid Aphelenchou Fig. 770. Forms of the esophagus. (After Cobb.) The intestine is a tubular canal extending from the esophagus to near the anus. Usually rather uniform in diameter, it is occasion- ally somewhat expanded just behind the esophagus to form a rudimentary stomach, if one may judge from the histology of this part of the organ. The cells at this part of the intestine are often markedly different in structure and chemical reaction from those farther back. In almost any species a sufficiently careful examina- tion will show that some of the anterior cells of the intestinal tube differ from those farther back, and hence it appears certain that the anterior part of the intestine serves a digestive function, while the remaining part serves as an intestine proper. There are also well differentiated cells in the wall of the posterior part of the intestine, indicating here also a subdivision of functions. The intestine ends in a short tubular conoid region leading to the anus, and known as the rectum. This part is more or less muscular and serves to extrude the feces. In Dorvlaitnus and its congeners, just preceding the rectum there is a short very distinct part of the alimentary canal known as the pre-rectum. In spite of the definiteness of its structure its function is unknown. Emptying near the anus there are usually to be found a number of small unicel- lular glands, called anal glands, perhaps serving as accessories in defe- 470 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY cation. The anal muscles are muscular strands passing from the transverse slit-like anus to the body walls near the lateral fields. There is no vascular circulatory system. These organisms are so small that the colorless "blood" is aerated without the need of special vessels. The movements of the body serve to propel the body-fluid irregularly about through the body cavity and among the organs. The main locomotive movements of nematodes are due to the alternate action of two antagonistic sets of muscle, dorsal and ventral, extending nearly the full length of the body, and acting on the lateral thickening of the cuticula as a fulcrum. The move- ments are serpentine, but in a dorso-ventral plane. As the result- ing body-curves are usually wider than the space between the cover glass and the microscope slide, it follows that the micro- scopical view of these nematodes is usually a lateral view. Locomotion is accomplished by the aid of friction on surrounding solid objects, such as the stems or roots of plants, grains of sand or other particles. Comparatively few of the aquatic species can swim, and even these seem uneasy and frightened when they find themselves floating free in the water. Most of the aquatic species are supplied with three unicellular caudal glands and a terminal spinneret, whose main, and probably sole, function is to cement the tail temporarily to various objects. From this attachment as a base the nematode moves its head in various directions in search of food, or of its mates. Some species, for instance some species of Ckromadora, attach themselves alternately first by the head by suction, and then by the spinneret, executing movements like those of the common caterpillars known as "inch-worms." The excretory organ of the free-living nematodes consists of a uni- cellular* gland, the renette, lying in the body cavity, not far from the junction of the intestine and esophagus. It empties through a duct leading forward to a ventral excretory pore, usually located some- where between the lip region and the intestine. There are a number of genera in which the renette has not yet been seen. Its homologue in the large parasitic species is renal in nature, — at least in one case. Through the study of the free-living species the supposed excre- tory function of the lateral fields, long believed in, has been dis- * Rarely two to many-celled and double. FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 471 proved. The apparent connection in the parasitic species between the excretory organ and the lateral fields is incidental, the action of the body muscles tending to locate such long slender tubular organs in the region of least motion, namely the lateral region. In these parasitic species the organ is often bifurcated a little be- hind the excretory pore (apparently on account of the increased size of the whole organism), and thence backward the tubular elements are attached to or lie in or near the lateral fields. This suggests that the mystery surrounding the excretory organ in some of the free-living species may perhaps be solved by search directed toward the discovery of a bilaterally symmetrical renette. Dorylaimus, a genus containing some of the largest free-living nematodes, is a case in point. The renette cell often has smaller companion cells in its immediate rear. The caudal glands, so common in the tail end of the free-living nematodes, serve to cement the tail end to any convenient object. In thus attaching themselves nematodes sometimes show great skill and pertinacity. The terminus of the tail bears a minute spinneret through which the secretion of the glands is forced out, and by means of which its flow may be regulated, much as in the case of spiders. The secretion is a cementing substance insoluble in water. The caudal glands are normally three in number and are usually located single file in the anterior part of the tail, or somewhat farther forward in front of the anus. Two of the ducts often unite to form one duct; sometimes all three unite. Just in front of the pore in the spin- neret the ducts may enlarge to form one or more ampullae. Caudal glands are absent in most of those species in which the males are supplied with lateral caudal flaps constituting the bursa. It is possible that the secretion of the bursal ribs, or tubes, is of the same general character as that of the three caudal glands, and that these two sets of glands are homologous. The ribs of the bursa, when the full complement is present, consist of three groups. This is at least suggestive. The females of such species sometimes have lateral pores on or near the tail. The sexual organs originate from a few cells set off for the pur- pose early in the development, which for a time remain rather quiescent near the center of the body. As the nematode ap- 472 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY proaches maturity these sexual cells resume their activity and begin to divide and to produce a symmetrically two-parted elon- gated group of cells, one part extending forward and the other backward. Primarily the sexual organs of both sexes are double, and the normal development at»first always forecasts a double organ. This forecast is often fulfilled, but in many species one of the halves has deteriorated or become vestigial. Where this is the case the symmetry of the early development is soon lost and the group of developing sexual cells then becomes one-sided. At the last moult, or the penultimate, the sexual opening in the cuticula makes its appearance. This is always on the ventral side, and in the male invariably corresponds with the anus; in the female it is independent and nearer the middle of the body, usually very near the middle when the internal organs are double and symmet- rical, and farther back, or more rarely farther forward, when there is only one ovary. The female sexual system is very commonly double, each half of it being tubular and consisting of (i) an ovary, (2) a seminal receptacle, (3) a uterus, (4) a vagina; this latter of course in common with the other half of the apparatus. These parts may lie in linear succession in the body cavity, or, as is more often the case, the series may be folded near its middle, that is, between the ovary and the uterus, so that the ovary is reflexed and extends back toward the vulva. The more usual forms of female apparatus are as follows: 1. Of two parts, each reflexed. 2. Of two parts, each outstretched. 3. Single and reflexed. 4. Single and outstretched. When the organ is single it may extend either forward or back- ward from the vulva, though it usually extends forward. Letting F represent the vulva, - an outstretched organ, and ' a reflexed organ, the various forms may be abbreviated as follows: *F* -F- T F* -F F- and this is the form in which the facts are presented in the measure- ment formulae for the females, except that F is replaced by the per- centage measurement figure representing the position of the vulva. FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 473 As the male organ may be either double or single, outstretched or reflexed, the corresponding abbreviations for the usual forms of male apparatus are as follows: -M =M CM -M -M- and this is the form in which the facts are presented in the formulae for males. As the testes always he in front of the sexual opening, the datum point of the reference signs in this case is the point where the testes join the vas deferens, not the sexual opening, as in the females. The percentage figure representing the extent of the male sexual organs dates from the anus. Species with re- flexed testes are comparatively rare among fresh-water nematodes, the commonest forms being -M- and -M. The blind, free, or distal end of the female sexual tube is usually found to contain only cells of extremely small size, observable with difficulty. In consequence little is known about the primordial sexual products in these free-living species. The interior of the main part of this segment of the tube, the ovary, is filled with devel- oping oocytes, which generally soon arrange themselves in single file. The oocytes increase rapidly in size, so that they are ripe by the time they reach the entrance to the uterus. At this point they undergo synapsis, meet the spermatozoa, and are fertilized, and then receive their shells, cuticular coverings acquired in the uterus. The sper- matozoa usually collect together at the end of the uterus, which, in some instances, has a special form adapted to their reception, and in all cases must be at least physiologically adapted to attract and retain them. Some species have special receptacles for the sper- matozoa in the shape of large tubular branches of the uterus, — genuine spermathecae. The entrance to the uterus from the ovary is narrow, and this slender part of the sexual tube is armed with dehcate annular muscles adapted to moving the ova on into the uterus. The uterus varies much in size. Frequently in the small species a single egg completely fills it; in the larger fresh-water species each uterus may become large enough to carry a score or more of eggs. In the larger parasitic species this capacity is enormously greater, so that the number of eggs in the uterus may reach tens of thou- sands, or even hundreds of thousands. 474 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The vagina is usually short and more or less muscular, especially near the vulva, where its wall is usually thicker. At the thickest part it suddenly diminishes in massiveness, and in the case of the double-ovaried species forks to form two short tubular branches which join the uteri. The walls of these two short tubes, as well as those of the part nearer the vulva, are supplied with encircling muscle fibers which by their peristaltic action force the egg onward and outward in the process of deposition. The vulva is a trans- verse slit-like opening whose length varies up to about one-half the width of the body. Muscular fibers radiate from its cuticular margin to the ventral submedian parts of the body wall, and serve by their contraction to open the orifice. The subspherical to elongate eggs are covered with cuticular shells of varying thickness, usually smooth, but sometimes bearing projections. In the greater number of fresh-water species the eggs are deposited before segmentation begins, but in some genera fully developed embryos are formed in the eggs before deposition. A few species are viviparous. The period of gestation varies widely. In some cases the formation of the embryo occurs within the space of a few hours to a day or two, in other cases weeks are necessary. The structure of the testes resembles that of the ovaries, but the resulting sexual cells, the spermatozoa, are smaller. The pri- mordial germ cells at the blind end of the testis multiply to form the grandmother-cells of the spermatozoa, which grow to a con- siderable size, so that it is usually easy to locate the part of the testis where they are maturing, — generally the middle or proximal part. These grandmother-cells, or spermatocytes, have the num- ber of chromosomes characteristic of the males of the species, and they proceed to the formation of the spermatozoa by a process of sudden double division of the chromosomes such that each sper- matocyte gives rise in most of the known cases to four spermatozoa, two with half the number of chromosomes characteristic of the females and two with one less chromosome than this. All these spermatozoa are supposed to be potent, but there is a dearth of experimental evidence. The oocytes follow a similar course but only one of the last FREE-LTVTNG NEMATODES 475 four female cells is potential, the other three being the so-called polar bodies which are left at the periphery of the egg to disinte- grate and disappear. The polar bodies are to be looked for in eggs that have just entered the uterus, and can be observed to advantage only in stained specimens, though they may sometimes be seen in the living material. The fundamental facts connected with fertilization and inheritance in animals were first worked out largely through the instrumentality of the eggs of various species of nematodes. In this respect they are classical objects. V {] V ) < zo Fig. 771. Forms of spicula. 1. Broad, tapering, blunt. 3. Elongate. 3. Slender. 4. Setaceous. 5. Elongated, tapering. 6. Elongated, arcuate. 7. Elongated, bent. 8. Fusiform, slightly arcuate. 9. Arcuate, strongly cephalated. 10. Sickle-form. 11. Hamate. 12. L-shaped. (After Cobb.) The male intromittent organs, the spicula, are usually two in number, and in nearly all free-living species the two are identical in form and size. Each spiculum is usually a straight, curved, or bent, elongated framework of cuticula, commonly one to two times as long as the anal body diameter. Exceptionally it may be very long and slender. The main portion of its shaft is usually of uni- form size, while the free or distal end commonly terminates in a somewhat blunt point, which, however, may be variously modified. The anterior or proximal end is often swollen or cephalated, for the attachment of muscles. The muscle for protruding the spiculum more or less insheaths it, and is attached to the proximal end of the spiculum and to the body wall, or to an accessory piece, near the anus, so that its con- traction moves the spiculum toward the anus and thus protrudes it. The retractor muscle is attached to the proximal end of the spiculum and thence usually passes forward and toward the dorsal side of the body, where it is attached to the body wall; its con- traction thus tends to pull the spiculum back into the body. It is usually rather easy to observe these retractor muscles of the spicula, but difficult to observe the protruding muscles. In order that these muscles may act to better advantage the spicula often slide in grooved pieces of cuticula named the acces- 476 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY sory pieces. These accessory pieces are usually from one-fourth to two-thirds as long as the spicula themselves, and not uncommonly possess an inward or backward extending apophysis whose function is to anchor them firmly in position, or serve for the attachment of special muscles. Long-necked unicellular glands are often seen to empty into the cloaca near the distal ends of the spicula. These probably serve a special purpose at mating time. The form of the spicula and of their accessory pieces is useful in distinguishing the various species, and as these organs are usually viewed in profile the various terms used to describe them are understood to apply to this aspect. The various forms and terms are shown in the accompanying illustrations, Fig. 771. Among the male accessory organs the bursa is, in a number of genera, the most important, though there is no trace of it in the greater number of the fresh-water genera. The bursa is a thin, trans- parent flap-like expansion of the lateral cuticula of the tail end of the male, and serves as a copulatory clasping organ. It may consist of two distinct halves, one on each side of the tail, and each ending short of the extremity, or the two parts may extend to the extremity and coalesce to form a continuous flap encompassing the tail. The bursa springs from the submedian or lateral regions, though it is usually on the ventral side of the lateral lines and, furthermore, is bent toward the ventral side. Typically the flaps spring from the body somewhat in front of the anus, grow wider as they pass backward, and reach their maximum development about opposite the anus; thence onward they usually diminish, — though in some cases not very much. In its maximum development the bursa may possess flaps as wide as the body itself; from this maximum it varies to rudiments that may easily be overlooked (pp. 484, 493). The bursa functions as a male clasping organ through the pres- ence of muscular fibers adapted to close it ventrally, and through the presence of so-called ribs which appear to be in the main, if not altogether, tubular outlets for a cement-like secretion used to fasten the male more or less permanently to the female at mating time. No chemical examinations have been made of the cement substances of the bursa and the caudal glands, but both are insol- uble in water and seem otherwise similar. Some genera in which FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 477 no bursa is developed, nevertheless have papillae, as they have been called, located according to the same general law as the ribs of the bursa. (Diplogaster, Cephalobus.) One striking fact will be forced on the attention of the collector of nematodes early in his work, and that is the comparative rarity of the males. In many of the species the males have never been seen, and in most species the females are from five to twenty times as common as their mates. There is reason to think that in some species the males are very short-lived, and that this is the reason they are so rarely seen. The males are often so much smaller than the females that they are easily overlooked, or mistaken for young, so that in such cases the rarity of the males may easily be over- estimated. In a few species the males appear to be more common than the females, at least at times. Hermaphroditism and par- thenogenesis are frequent. (See p. 495.) As the ova approach the narrow duct leading to the uterus they rapidly acquire yolk of a distinctly granular character. In the case of the numerous species having reflexed ovaries, the oviduct is located near the flexure, and is so small and short that it is usually impossible to see it except when the organs are immature. Passing through the oviduct, the ovum enters the uterus, where for a short distance the cells of the uterine wall are unusually well developed, apparently to furnish the material for the shells of the eggs. Here too the eggs are fertilized. The proximal limit of the shell-gland is often very definite. The rest of the uterus is thin-walled and connects with the vagina through a narrow muscular duct, mainly responsible for forcing the eggs into the outer world. The eggs at the time of deposition are usually soft and pliant, so that they easily pass through the vulva, even when relatively large. The fresh-water nematodes are typical of the entire group of free-living nematodes in that while most of them are oviparous, some are ovi- viviparous and others viviparous. The eggs in most of the known fresh-water species are smooth shelled. In the segmen- tation the first division is a slightly unequal one, one blastomere giv- ing rise to the somatic tissues, the other to the sexual organs. There are various organs that have been observed in the free- living nematodes whose functions are problematical, such as (1) the 478 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY double organ in the females only of some species of Oncholaimus, located in the posterior part of the body and connecting with the exterior through openings in the subdorsal region; (2) the gland- like pair of organs seen in the females of Diplogaster, and apparently also of Rhabditis and other related genera; and (3) the long-necked paired glands sometimes emptying into the male cloaca. It is conceivable that some of these serve a sexual function, such as the secretion of a substance whose odor or taste is of service in enabling the nematodes to locate their mates. < •--■ W> — ->a& Fxo. 772. Diagram in explanation of the descriptive formula used for nematodes; 6, 7. 8. io, 6 are the transverse measurements, while 7, 14, 28, 50, 88 are the corresponding longitudinal measurements. The formula in this case is: 7. 14. 28. 50. 88. 6. 7. 8. 10. 6. The measurements are simply percentages of the length, and the formula, as printed in the key, may be regarded as somewhat in the nature of a conventionalized sketch of the nematode with dimensions attached. The measurements are taken with the animal viewed in profile; the first is taken at the base of the pharynx, the second at the nerve-ring, the third at the cardiac constriction (base of the "neck"), the fourth at the vulva in females and at the middle (Af ) in males, the fifth at the anus. (After Cobb.) It seems reasonably clear that fresh-water nematodes have marked seasonal development, at least in some species. Adults of many species can be found at all times of the year. Freezing does not necessarily kill them. Although the fresh-water nema- todes are so widespread, and so abundant at all seasons, it is not always easy to isolate them for examination without the use of special methods. Few of these nematodes exceed two to three milli- meters in length, and they are so slender and transparent as to make it practically impossible to examine them without the aid of a lens. However, when special methods are employed they may easily be collected. A few centigrams of mud or sand from a place where nematodes are believed to exist is disseminated in a watch glass of water, and the sediment examined carefully for the characteristic wavy non-progressive motion exhibited by these little organisms. When discovered, the specimens are captured with a fine-pointed pipette or medicine dropper and ejected with a minimum of other FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 479 material into a second watch glass, from which they are removed on a very fine-pointed needle and placed in a drop of clear water on a microscope slide. These operations are best performed on the stage of a dissectingmicroscope, under a lens magnifying five to ten diameters. To collect specimens in large numbers it is best to make use of more elaborate methods. A coarse sieve with meshes two to three millimeters across is used to remove objects larger than nema- todes. To gather the nematodes, the material that comes through Fio. ItS- Meaiuririf: the Icnjrth of roJled ikof a crooked . .. To obuin the pcicenun Slum u-ct; m. . ooly two to tbne minutes- 'Alter Cobb.) this coarse sieve is passed through sieves of finer and finer mesh until the limit of fineness is reached. About the finest mesh ob- tainable is that of the finest miller's bolting silk (0.25 to 0.5 mm.), which, when stretched over appropriate rings made of bottomless dishes will allow fine mud to pass through while it will retain all but the smallest nematodes. By successive sifting* practically all the nematodes can be secured. The sifting can be supplemented by gravity methods. Aquatic nematodes are lighter than sand and heavier than water. If the water containing the nematodes be violently agitated and then be allowed to rest for a few seconds the sand will have subsided to the bottom, and the nematodes may be decanted off if the pouring Ijc managed expeditiously. Then, if the nematode containing water 480 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY be allowed to rest for from two to four minutes in a vessel two to three inches deep the nematodes will have largely settled to the bottom and the supernatant muddy water may be carefully de- canted away. The residue will contain an abundance of nema- todes that may be captured as described above. Fresh-water nematodes are so active that it is practically impos- sible to examine them without first anesthetizing or killing them. They may be rendered unconscious by the use of a small amount of chloroform dissolved in water. Ether, chloral hydrate, tobacco smoke and other anesthetics and narcotics are also used in this way. Specimens treated thus are wonderfully transparent, and display to a maximum advantage certain features of the anatomy. Permanent preparations may be made by killing and fixing with Flemming's solution or Bouin's solution, washing, and then chang- ing to water containing 5 per cent glycerine and very slowly evap- orating in a closed, preferably warm, space such that the solution becomes fully concentrated in the course of a few days. The cuticula of some nematodes is so thin and flexible, and at the same time so impervious, that this evaporation process sometimes has to be prolonged to several weeks to prevent crumpling, but many kinds can be successfully treated in two to three days. If the specimens have been blackened by the Flemming's solution, they may be satisfactorily bleached in a few hours or days by adding a few drops of dioxide of hydrogen solution to the glycerine in which they lie after evaporation. They are removed to pure glycerine one by one as they become bleached, and then are mounted in glycerine jelly. Specimens treated in this way make excellent material for examination, but may deteriorate in the course of years. Again, the specimens may be killed by suddenly heating in water on a glass slide until they become motionless, and can then be examined at once, or evaporated as above de- scribed in 5 per cent glycerine. The residue from the subsidence and sifting methods, already described, may be added suddenly to an equal volume of boiling- hot concentrated solution of corrosive sublimate and allowed to cool. When the specimens have remained in this solution for twenty- four hours or more they may be picked out one by one on the point :lx.ti .'-":.■ FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 481 of bamboo splinters and differentiated into alcohol, and thence successively into acid carmine in 70 per cent alcohol, 70 per cent alcohol with 1 to 2 per cent hydrochloric acid, absolute alcohol, oil of cloves and Canada balsam. The specimens thus treated are more permanent than those resulting from the glycerine treatment described above and are the only satisfactory ones for many cyto- logical studies. These various treatments may affect the relative proportions Of the Organism dif- Fic.774. Skeleton camera luckla drawing used to , . . .. , r 1 compute the nematode formula. (After Cobb.) ferently, especially thOSe Of the The head end lies to the left. This five, the following formula. neck. It is therefore best when So 86 mj 46 9$ . . — — .81 mm. noting measurements of speamens 2* s-2 1-A xa4 4*3 for descriptive purposes to indicate how the specimens were treated. The student cannot expect to examine the finer details of the anatomy or indeed to make satisfactory progress without the patient use of a good oil immersion objective under favorable conditions. The formula is made to convey much additional information, by interspersing suggestive signs. Thus the successive signs in the ad- <= ij.-il-^-l' «.__«•- ,,^jacent formulae indicate lips,1 papillae on the lips,2 a pharynx of uniform £= Ji --T,iv" "%""»*" -7 t£i' — " diameter without armature of any **»*■ kind,3 no amphids,4 a renette whose 100* no* MO * VfO ± 1000 ± ttam flam «rrr tlam £,?E2. Cmszmim* ««-»— ut excretory pore is located a little behind ■Utartn fast VMa taaala Uam * * zrzz= ^e nerve-ring,5 about 600 transverse ~ ~ 7:7 T.~ striae resolvable into rows of dots,6 — -—- no wings to the cuticula,7 a median esophageal bulb two-thirds as wide as the middle of the neck,8 a cardiac bulb three-fourths as wide as the base of the neck,9 two symmetrically reflexed ovaries, occupying 71 per cent of the length of the body,10 no caudal glands or spinneret,11 a single outstretched testis occupying 63 per cent of the length of the body,12 a bursa beginning in front of the anus and including the entire tail,13 4 bursal ribs or supplementary organs on either side in front of the anus, and 5 ribs on either side behind the anus.14 1 Conventionalized contour of the front of the head. * Conventionalized contour of the Kps. * Conventionalized outline ft the pharynx. 4 Absence of mark indicate 482 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER NEMATODA 1 (64) Intestine normal and functional throughout; anus present in both sexes. 2 The forms which are included here are typical nematodes. They possess an alimentary canal which is complete and functional during the entire life of the individual. They are free living in the adult as well as in the larval stage of existence. With the free-living forma are sometimes found parasitic forma so similar in structure that a knowledge of their source ii needed to determine whether the species is parasitic or not. No note is taken of the parasitic forms and the following statements apply only to the true free-living nematodes. They art all relatively small in siie and so transparent that the internal structure can be made out clearly in the living animal. In these respects as well as in detail of internal structure they stand in distinct contrast to the other group included under the alternative heading in the key. Families which include only parasitic species are not mentioned in this key. 2 (13) Oral end armed with protrusible spear or sting 3 3 (8) Spear with bulbous base 4 4 (5) Cuticula with 70 to 100 coarse, retxorse annules Iota Cobb. Genus consisting of a considerable number of species, found in swamps and in acid Boils. These nematodes are covered with retrorse scales, or bristles, so that it is practically im- possible lor them to move in any other direction t*"" forward. Near the head the remarkably large and powerful spear can be seen through the skin. When, in order to make punctures, this spear is thrust out, the nematode is not pushed backward, because of the friction which its scales offer to surrounding soil particles. But often the males of Iota lose the spear at the last moult and become relatively longer and more slender and smoother, and then they loch very Representative species Iota oclangulare Cobb 1914. r h. j' _b -«° n , mm Male unknown. Habitat: Dismal Swamp, Va, /. cutkulartube 1 . body muds: :1« ofbody wall; ng: J.lij uf taophagua; r. nerve-m a, cuticula; t, one of tbe eL. — . — „ #, mublateral modification of tbe cuticula; y, uuous; q, iuvjjiui muaincaimi , tenniaua. (Alter Cobb.) 5 (4) Cuticula with 200 or more finer or almost invisible annules 6 ing amphids. * Oblique line, conventionalized drawing of the outlet of the excretory duct, placed just behind the measurements relating to the nerve-ring. ' Character of the line running through the formula (see adjacent table) , and dots placed on either side of the line. ' Absence of short horizontal lines above and below main line, such marks being used when wings are present. ' Horizontal stroke under two-thirds of the nerve-ring width measurement. ' A corresponding stroke under three-fourths of the width measurement for the base □( the neck. u Single quotation marks around the measurement indicating the position of the vulva, and 71 used as an exponent. u Ab- sence of spinneret mark, — an angular sign used to indicate spinneret. u Dash in front o( the M and 63 used as an exponent. u Curved marking under the transverse anal measurement, extending to the end of the formula line of the male. '* 4 and 5 used as sub-figures before and after the anal diametral measurement with ditto marks to Indicate that the ribs occur on both sides. FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 483 6 (7) Esophagus with a distinct median bulb, and a more or less distinct posterior swelling. Males with bursa. . TyUnchus Bastian. Genus consisting of numerous species, many of them parasitic in plants and sometimes highly injurious. Aquatic species arc rat het uncommon. A single species found parasitic in a marine alga. Principally owing to its economic importance the genus has a very extensive literature. Representative species. . Tyknckus dipsaci Kflhn 1857. f- £ ■ -Jv^"! * *"^j - *!,- n~ This species is found t- i- parasitic in onion and hya- _ cinth bulbs, and in a num- ber of other plants, and is very harmful. The spear, b, i. Fig. II, is shot forth by the muscles. /. and is used to puncture the cells of the bast plant. The speat is tubular, and the juices of the host art sucked through the speat into the intestine by means oi the bulb, t. Often referred to in literature as Tyinukiii df-.aslilrit. Habitat: Europe, America, Australia, and probably throughout the temperate regions. FlG- 776. Tytaulmi iifteci. Kdhn. I, ■ female: II. bead of the same more highly —• rf-«i-r- HT. ta3 at a male; IV, view from below, of the female senul opening: V. 1 ofthe neon and then- accessory parts: ' a female, showing bow the body-cavit} < female sexual opsone; ' "ig-bulbiVI. front view n through Ibe middle of mpletdy by the ovary |>) for moving the spear forward: f, poamci oryeiand: i, hind end of spear, three-bulbed' rvaiy: a. right section of an eggTi. ani£!™ wn^Soft&cuticuU; I J (6) Esophagus with only one swelling, corresponding to the median bulb of Tyltnckus. Males without bursa. . . Aphdenckus Bastian. This genus closely resembles Tyiendau. from which it guished by the absence of the bursa on the males, and by the less developed posterior portion of the esophagus. This latter is so deteriorated that it cannot be distinguished from the intestine. The oral spear also is usually less strongly developed than in TyintttiM, and its posterior extremity is Less Likely to present bulbous swellings. As in TyUncliui, so here, some of the species are known to revive years after having been dried up and con- verted into "dust." In the dirt or dust adhering to seeds and plants they are often transported long distances Many of the species, therefore, are now cosmopolitan. Like Tyttndnu, this genus Representative species. Apkdendtus mkrttaimus Cobb il Habitat: Douglas Lake, Fin •;■;•/. AHdexbu 484 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 8 {3) Spear without a bulbous base 9 9 (10) Esophagus with a median bulb; males with bursa. Dolkhodorus Cobb. This genus is distinguished from Tylnckus by the peculiar lobed buna without ribs, by the relatively long and slender oral spear and peculiar lip region, and by the presence of a double sexual organ in the female. There are few Tylenchi the females of which possess two ovaries. Representative species. . . . Dolkhodorus heterocephalus Cobb 1914. If— * . 25 -'■' . V ■ ■-"■*■ *' ■ _ The transverse striae are resolvable with high " * Ojt if ij i< 'i powers under favorable conditions into rows of exceedingly minute, somewhat irregular elements. i— l ■ fi *., • "., "fj ■ JtJ'i* v The flaps of the bursa are striated in much the same ■* - L- manner as the cuticula.and the margins of the Baps are distinctly thickened. The sper- matozoa are small and numerous and it ap- pears that the reduction divisions take place in a short segment of the testis not far from the blind end. The organs obscurely figured in connection with the bead appear to be the outlets of glands located in the neck. The "cardiac swelling" * appears to have the same structure as in some species of Ty- lenclms, in which it is known to be caused by the presence of glands exterior to the esoph- agus, and therefore not properly to be re- garded as a cardiac swelling of the ordinary kind. la the Tylenchi mentioned, these glands empty through a minute duct which enters the esophagus, passes through the median bulb on the dorsal side of its valvular apparatus, and, continuing, empties into the pharynx at the base of the spear. These so- called salivary glands are designated at r in I, under Tytauhus dipiaci (Fig. 776). Similar structures may occur in the present species. Inequality of the ovaries is characteristic of a vast number of species of nematodes and may have a deep morphological signifi- cance. It is nearly always the posterior ovary which is the smaller. Every degree of inequality exists even to the extinction of one ovary. The smaller branch may pro- duce smaller and what appear to be inferior eggs, and may even cease to function as a reproductive organ and function merely as a minor part of the other branch, serving, for instance, either as an citension of the uterus, or as a seminal receptacle. Habitat: Douglas Lake, Michigan; Silver Spring, Florida. Flo. 778- Dtlkhtima tutmafUui, 1, nearly aide view of a female; II, lateral view of surface of bead, more highly enlaixed: 111. sagittal section of head; IV, dorso- ventral view of head; V, front view of head; VI. side view, posterior extremity of. male: VII, ventral view of posterior extremity of female; VIII, ventral view at posterior extremity of male. papilla; i. cephalic organ of unkrowD lianin- - ' ■— -A spear: «. mtdiait Bulb: y pore; *. cardiac swell- end of posterior ovary; if accessory piece; r, left flap of ion; r. vaginal muscles; w, uterus; a. vulva; y.anua. (After Cobb.) 10(9) Esophagus with only an elongated posterior swelling; no bursa. . 11 FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 485 11 (12) Pharynx simple, male supplementary organs not in fascicles. Dorylaimus Dujardin. Genus consisting, no doubt, of hundreds of species, and inhabiting soil, fresh water, and, to a limited extent, brackish water. They feed 50 far as known on vegetable matter, most commonly, it h believed, on the roots of plants which they pierce by means of the hollow oral spear. Representative species. Dorylatmus jecundus Cobb 1914. Habitat- Algae, Potomac River, Wash- ington, D. C. Dorjioiimit fraindu!. 12 (n) Pharynx with complicated radiate framework, male supplementary organs in fascicles Actinoiaimus Cobb. Genus represented in all parts of th world, and proposed lor species similar to Dotyiaimui labyrinihailomm, in which the pharyni is more or less immobile, radially striated and elabo- Representative species. Actinoiaimus radiatus Cobb 1913. e-.s- is wide as the cor- responding portion of the neck . It continues to have this width for some distance. Considerably in front of the middle of the neck it eipands rather suddenly. The cells of the brownish intes- tine contain granules of variable size, arranged so as to give rise to a rather obscure tessellation. The tail of the female is concave- o the 1 rfrfina ' Immediately in front of the anus are two veil- ed side by side. In addition to these there are raised and conspicuous groups lie distance from the posterior group to the end te two equal, sliehlly arcuate, rather acute t twice as long as the anal body diameter. The ail carries a number ol innervated papillae, at i sit and probably quite a number of others. Habitat: Roots of plants and among algae, Potomac River and its banks, Arlington Farm near Washington, D.C.; Douglas Lake, Mich. pillae; pk, pharyni- 13 (2) Oral end without protrusile spear or sting 14. 14 (37) Pharynx armed with one or more refractive, cuticular teeth. . . 15 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY r of teeth three, equal, small, mobile, well forward near the mouth. . Ironus Bastian. Genus with about six known species, confined to fresh water, though there is a very similar genus, ThaUosirtmus de Mao, for the reception of "rn*1fr marine forms. Some species hermaphro- ditic. Salivary glands in esophagus. Representative species. Ironus amtricanus Cobb 1 914. 5£. rably It is unlikely that more than one is contained in the uterus at a time. Habitat: Deer Bottom, Pikes Peak region, Colorado. I, bead and anterior portion of neck; II. head, lateral view "teeth" ex- truded; Ill.bead, "teeth"witadrawn with second act formed in preparation for the next moult; IV, tail cod of teeth, shown citnided: b, . cephalic seta; J. ampoid; r , . r _. ], toothkt: t, toothfct; k, esophagus; i, lining of esophagus; j. nerve-Tina; a, intestine; /, anus; m, caudal gland; a. terminus. (Alter Cobb.) 16 (is) Number of teeth one; or more than one, and unequal 17 17 (12) Teeth, at least one of them, usually massive; thick, more or less papillate lips closing over the capacious pharynx. ... 18 Main tooth dorsal (sometimes all nearly obsolete); lips thick, armed with papillae; no setae. .... Mononchus Bastian. Genus of a score or more species, some in fresh water, others in soil, where they hunt and devour nematodes and other small organisms. The movements, especially those of the head, are often very active. The males are very rare. The name Mononchus indicates the presence of a single pharyngeal tooth, but sometimes there are one or two additional teeth; sometimes all air absent. The relatively powerful lips can be everted, and are utilized to grasp the prey and force it against the pharyngeal tc speaes the wall of the pharyn* •— — — — ->f —; den ti nidations. Some species ai Representative species. Mononchus major Cobb r (■=• !. h Ti aFT TT-" "— This elegant sped .lecies are figured e derived from Australian head; IV, tide view of Ml: V, details of male papillae, a, month; *. lip-papilla: t, lip: d, aopbagus; *, nerve-rina; /.pfcaf- vnccal tooth: 1, innervated papilla of (kin: *. esophagus; t. base at pfaLyni- ;'. cardiac coUum; k, intestine: I. Senin in testicle: at, blind end of testicle: a, vas deferens; g, lip; t, mouth opening; », cjaeulatory duct; 1, naeula; •. ejnculatoiy duct; I. sow saury piece; a, pot-anal papillae, i. apicula: a>. ejaculatnry duct; a, ventral raw male papilb*; £T^: a/ three anal (lands. (Alia Cobbl FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 4S7 ig (18) Mam tooth subroedian. Lips thin; setae present 10 o (21) Males without bursa. OntkoiMmu Dujardin. Genus of numerous species, nearly all marine. A few species only in brackish and fresh water, Cosmopolitan, extend- ing well into the polar seas Some attain a length o( Ij to .10 mm. The indivtiliial* The pharyngeal iwih vary in number. form, and sin-, and afford good sprcifh characters. The segments of the eso|ina rus frequently contain much hranched "salivary" elands emptying through the pharyngeal teeth. The female sometimes possc*ies a pecn- liar pair of relatively lantr organs of un- known significance emptying through pore- toward the tail end. Representative species. Ondulaimus punrtatus Cobb 1914. E-lfc- . rr difficult In observe the finet details of the cutu ul.i on account of the presence in it of ■■■/»« dotJit, e/e- mtnti. which are arranged t* bmtilvdiml froups, of which the widest are the lateral (Croups. The longitudinal arrangement of tie granules is continuous throughout the body. Iiut it is most marked on the lateral fields. There are sis lips. _ Habitat: Fresh-water ponds. Cape 1, Dominion of Canada. # '■■ " 21 (20) Males with bursa. Onckolaimelius de Man. Much like Omhttaimtu, but males have narrow bum- Spicula unequal, or equal. Two species known ; the type 0. laltadosictu de Man is marine. Representative species. OrscholaimeUus htterurus Cobb 1914. £=*J — H — Ti 'Ti" 'sui '-*-■ certain doubly refractive gra lui, since there are 1 ■mpMd varies from that 01 the spicula, winch in the type s| Habitat: Freab-water pood n I, sale view of head: H, * view of tail end of male; IV, pbarros; d. Iff t flap of bursa; j iFfimij piece; a. unpaid; pBhij, lateral sets; i.spinoei '. esophagus; f. left spiculi i, malt pcot-mnsl seta and I- I Ihfnlim tC " ' ItrCutST) 488 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 99 (17) Teeth small, often only one, then dorsal; lips with inconspicuous papillae; pharynx of moderate size 93 93 (36) Esophagus with one or two bulbs 94 94 (95) Bulbs two, spinneret absent Diplogasttr M. Schultze. Genus with more than a score of known spcdes, mostly found in fresh in soil and between the sheaths of grasses, etc. Some species hermaphro- ditic. Anumbcrof the species appear to be at least facultative parasites. They are often found in dead insects and cater- G "liars, whose death they apparently ,ve caused. Other species are found in decaying mushrooms, IMMtl excreta and foul pools. Many of the species are easily reared in decayed meat and va- rious other culture media. Many thrive best in the presence of bacteria. Representative species. Diplogasttr factor Bastian 1865. #'U _ h:ivt iviBindric Lmd, bumiiiinn ;i an: ven,- promm 'tTk-Y-i™!,- K Href..!. !■= ■e-nr..;; ... eicrelurv l"Tr: :. valvut acbul!,: J, L.DgiJumn.il m .ifmticu ' the k«xiiit-: *, intr*Tlr]L: J I any accentuated, ii Cyolkolaimus Basilar sinaiiL'T.. iu:arly iill marine bill (ound al-u laimi :m fi.imi! in nil tn.|iic.d ami Irm- pcrati- sua.*, ami !hi injli vidua In lire in: mer..ii-. tn nnw habitat' hoth sexr* ii.uml i:. ih.- intrstin.-. TWud: n..i rJiiiH-n in !hi snH-u-n hiTt figured, the «■■ ni-iit «vm.- always prrsrnt, and is ufrci Representative species. t \iitiwUimm truncutus Cobb 1914. llabilai: Silver Springs, Flu. ii: 1 1 ■ i.- miilillr M Ih.' ho.lv shnivhe tulitulat m..ri.ini.-= .m.1 pun- ,i. Mil.mf.Hiit, .t|.^H. fl;, ; -., U.i-,1 [sipiM..: ...imr.hi.l. ,;, ilni-v,! r™i!*i ; ..!.■■ it:.: rcph.i'i. -J':. 1 i nnr "I th.- nvrlvi- ri1- .,[ id;- it -.:!'■ :'■ : ,-. :iir,iil, ■.iilimnliiin phan r ciTillf-lti; *, lw«( the pSjtiP.: i. eiii. ■ uljilftn dnrt; ./. inn-rir..-: i. nni- of 'K- : a-, fantliin •>! thx- 1>- dlgtjllils i. ninlc (fluid 49° FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 29(28) Pharynx less conspicuously ribbed; cardiac bulb distinct. ... 30 30 (35) Dorsal tooth well developed 31 31 (34) Pharynx cyathiform then conoid, joining esophagus indefinitely. 33 32(33) Amphids spiral, inconspicuous slits or none. . . Chromadora Bastian. Genus, aquatic, mostly marine bat abundant in fresh water*. Twenty to thirty species known. Found in American fresh waters, do species yet described. Species highly developed, usually of small size. Many possess eye-spots near the head. The males usually have a number of pairs of special unicellular glands emptying through slender ducts into the cloaca. These glands are usually arranged in series of pairs toward the dorsal side of the body some distance in front oi tbespicula. Amphids, fairly well developed, usually difficult to we because of their peculiar form and position; far toward front of head, usually seen more or less in profile. Cardiac bulb relatively shorter than in Spiiopkora, and not so distinctly subdivided. Males usually have well-developed series of ventral supplementary organs; such organs are less common and less well developed on males of Spiio- pktna. Lateral elements ol the transverse striae sometimes modified, but rarely reaching degree of differentiation shown in Spilopkora. Representative species. . Chromadora minor Cobb 1893. j? 1 1 ' * >'lV " ' t> .'«" "it "' ' "* Habitat; Pacific Ocean, 1- 1 . 1 1, -u ■ California, and Australia. !? A ■■#/■ y ■■■ ■ i'.r4*Sy •>•''» — FlCi. 780. Cknrmadim Minor. I, male of Ckremadara minor: II. ok ol the ventral accessory organs of the same nematode. Ill and IV, head and anal region of the umc nematode. a. pharynx: ft, rye-spot r c. esophagus; a1.*, ventral supplementary organ; t nerve-ring; /. excretory pore; f, aland of supplementary organ; i, renette cell: ;. organ of unknown nature, accessory to the rmcttc celf; i, blind end of testicle; I, cephalic seta; m. rib* oi pharyngeal o — : — - — '"-■ a, dorsal tooth; a, pharynx; g, one ol Ibe striae of the cut seta; 1. dorsal eye-spot, (.intestine; n.ooeof the ventral : ,-,-.—. organs; > eiaculatory duel; w, one of the supplementary organs; t. nam; 7, Wl spiculum; i. accessory piece. 33 (32) Amphids spiral, well developed. Ackromadora Cobb. Genus proposed for the reception of Cknm- advra minima Cobb and similar soil and fresh- water species. Distinguished from Ckrmmmdmrm by the presence of well-developed spiral am- phids. The dorsal tooth is farther back and is opposed by a small ventral "pocket" as shown in the figure of Admmadtra minima. Species found, probably, in all parts of the world. Known from Australia, Fiji, and various parts of United States and Europe. Representative species. Ackromadora minima (Cobb) 1914. Male unknown. Habitat: Soil, El Paso, Texas. Potomac River, Washington, D. C. Fip. 7S9. j .. 1 ffl pbaryagKl t. pharyoi; t. cutkular markings: a. aw nerve cell: j. nerve-ring; a. spianctet: I. pore ; ■ , flerurc ol ovary : a. oae of the cauc t. bund end of posterior ovary; p. anui:f. r, rnhra; I, one of the grannies ol the in egg. (After Cobb.) FREE-LIVIKO NEMATODES 491 34 (31) Pharynx cyaLhiiorm then prismoid. ending behind very definitely; amphids distinct. . EihmoLiirmis de Man. Genus of two known specie*, one European, one American. Closely rdatiil In Ctrtmattra, from which it is readily distinguished hy the narrow uniform ■rmr portion of the pharynx, which is usually jnd.il hy a comparalively distinct pharyngeal Labi il pa pill. if. apparent 1) I!. Onrhus Ihu mK .vis wide, and one-1 Habi 1.11 : Spring. ttashinp.i Q Country Club. Chev) Chase, jultu ;. twmnine oi Ihe intestine; *. renett* s ni unnclliiliLr oiy.in-. "J unknown significance: 0. one ni thccelks»i ihe intesline: p. subcuticuL; ;; h. spinDcm. v, one oi the caudal glands; Dorsal loolh minuu, amphids circular. . . . Microtaimus de Man. (icnus oi few species from Europe and North America. Representative species. il u reiki im us fluvial il i s Cobb 1014- The eKKs appear to be deposited be- fore Mgmcntatiun beprins Specimens appear in lie »houl eqn.-illv numerous; asmiuthcrdilTircnrrhasbeendeieclcri. ihi'y an included, lor the [weseni undn the same name and description. Habitat: Maple River. Michigan. esophagus; h. nerve-rin,:; i, t frnlh; j. preliminary porrinrti oi 1 49J FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 36 (23) Esophagus plain Cryptonckus Cobb. tf>" — tJT^S Pp Differi from Cytindrolaimus de Man in the (aim of the amphids, and the strongly developed esophagus with its various regions, in the presence of a dorsal tooth at the base of the pharynx and in the absence of setae. -.t- ph Single species. . . . CrypUmchus nudus Cobb 1913. (_£ s.i '....p,.* .?.'" V .-.....> n_ At a point about two * " ' *■ '■* body widths in front of the cardia the nature of the esophagus suddenly change*, the lining becoming notably less massive, and the radial structure becoming relatively more massive, and at the same time changing its character, so that there is a rather striking contrast between this short posterior section and the main portion of the esophagus. Wing space one-third as wide as the body. The anterior part of the intestine for a distance equal to the body radius consists of small cells packed with granules and possessing larger and differ- ently formed nuclei. Eirgs four times as long as the body is wide, one-fourth as wide as long, and comparatively thick shelled; Habitat: Found about the roots of aquatic plants, Potomac River, Arlington, and in Douglas Lake, Mich. Fin. ■jyi. Cryfltmikui **dus lb, lip region; pp, labial papulae: », amphfd; fit. pharynx; on, onchua or tooth; ft, esophagus; sp. spinneret. (After Cobb.) 37(14) Pharynx without teeth 38 38 (49) Esophagus with bulbs 39 39 (41) Amphids circular or nearly so ; pharynx compound, much elongated. 40 40(41) Cuticular external marking of amphid circular. . . Plectus Bastian. Genus of about thirty species mostly about plants. Some aquatic, none marine. Some species, perhaps most, parlhenngenetic or hermaphroditic. Obscure labial papillae usually present. Representative species Plectus lubifer Cobb 191-4. Ca I- it., Bsv , ■»■ . at. . j First lateral pore of the 11 ' '1*1^ u i-i IJ — cuticula immediately behind the Lateral organs, whence & '* ■ ■1J|Sc 1'- 'I? >,1 1 > " — similar, somewhat smaller l_ j. t.ir- u it <^J pores, totalling about two hundred, form four subme- n rows. Six rounded, rather massive lips sur- :nd the short, napiform vestibule leading to the pharyna. Amphids transversely elongated or roundish, open behind. There is an obscure, pos- terior, more or less dosed, elon- gated, triquetrous pharyngeal chamber not indicated in the . PUOuhMlt. Male. :, lateral organ; d, pharynx: «, posteru chamber of pharynx; cue cell; ), jUoauW (?) cell: », cardiac bulb; 0. spermatocyte; p, flexure in- FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 41 (40) Chitinous marking of amphid not circular. . . nd intestine. Ovary single in Ckrancgailtr, double in Piectui. ! species known. . Chronogaster gracilis Cobh 1913. Chronogaster Cobb, posterior like bulb^ XI, * ^ spinneret. (After Cobb. 4.3 (39) Amphids apparently absent; pharynx simple. . 43(44) Esophagus with two bulbs; males with bursa. Rhabditis Dujardin. Genus of numerous species, some parasitic, especially in insects. Several marine species and a number in fresh water. Common in decaying matter. Reproduction wonderfully varied, ranging from parthenogenesis, through hermaphroditism of varying degree to com- plete bi-seiuality. Many species microbivorous. In some species there is a marked alternation of generations. Bursa better developed in specie; of Rkabdtiis than in any other fresh-water nematodes. Other genera presentine. this feature are Tyienckus. Dolkkodorus, and (hicholaimtUus . Bursa fFifi. 111! consists of two thin lateral eitensions of cuticula containing rays or ribs, often tubular, constituting outlets of cement glands, always well supplied with nerve endings form of bursa and arrangement of its rays form good generic and specific characters. Representative species. Rhabditis cylindrica Cobb 1898. S- J»- Flo. 706. RkaMMs cytindrica Cobb, female; II. side view of attached ma! c. base of pharyn ■; ITT. ventral view ie of the ribs of t x, blind end of rentred ovary; y 494 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 44 (43) Esophagus with only one well-developed bulb; males withou bursa 4 45 (46) Pharynx long and narrow Rhabdolaimus de Mas Genus of four known species, three European, one American. Representative species Rhabdolaimus minor Cobb 1914 4* 24 25. "ill" "V." "1." > »«.. The cuticula appears to be destitute of any but very fine transverse stnations, most clearly visible near the head. Careful focussing appears to indicate the presence on the outer margin of the head of almost invisible papilla-like organs which may perhaps be the representatives of cephalic setae. There are no lips. The thin-shelled, smooth eggs are relatively large and elongated and have been seen in the uterus one at a time. They are about four to five times as long as the body is wide and about one-fifth as wide as long. They appear to be deposited before segmenta- tion begins. The eggs are so large in proportion to the size of the ovaries that they push the ovaries first to one side and then the other as they develop, so that both ovaries may occasionally appear to be either in front of or behind the vulva. The specimen figured was so twisted that the head presents the dorso- ventral view, and the tiny amphids («) therefore appear in profile. The figure shows well the typical distribution of nerve cells, large numbers in front of and behind the nerve-ring, a smaller collection in the cardiac region, and other collections in the anal region. The long, slender spinneret is characteristic of the genus. The figure illustrates the general features of the cen- tral nervous system, which m nematodes consists of a ring of nerve fibers encircling the esophagus, and hav- ing connected with it a number of more or less spherical nerve cells, shown dark in the figure. Under favorable circumstances each one of these cells can be seen to be connected with others, and directly, or indirectly, with the ring of fibers. The whole, therefore, constitutes a rather complicated, coordinated system of nerve cells. In many species the cells, such as those shown at c and A. are arranged in longitudinal groups, and even where the groups are not apparent, as here, the connections among the cells are undoubtedly systematic and cor- respond with the longitudinal grouping that is evident in other genera. From the central nervous system extend forward and backward nerves, — ventral, dor- sal, lateral, and to a lesser extent submedian, connected by commissures. Special collections of nerve cells occur on the ventral side near the cardia, vulva, and anus. The exterior indications of the nerves are found in papillae and setae, usually corresponding in position with the main branches of the nervous system. Habitat: Mud, Beach pool, Pine Point, Douglas Lake, Michigan. Fig. 797 • Rhabdolaimus minor. I, lateral view of female; II, bead of the same, showing araphid. The bead in I b twisted, so that the amphid appeals at if ventral, or nearly so. a, amphid; b, long, narrow pharynx; c, anterior group of nerve cells; d, nerve-ring; e, cardiac bulb: /, wall of the intestine; g, flexure in anterior ovary; k, posterior croup of nerve cells; i, body cavity; j, hunen of intestine; I, ovum: /, blind end of posterior ovary; m, egg; », flexure a posterior ovary ; o, cuticula; P, caudal glands; q. subcuticular r, vulva; s, rectum; t, anus; «, nerve cells (?); t, duct of caudal glands; », spinneret; x, up region. (After Cobb.) FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 495 46 (45) Pharynx not long and narrow 47 47 (48) Striae not resolvable into rows of dots Cephalobus Bastian. Genus of numerous species, frequent about the higher plants, doubtless often at least "semi- parasitic" Occasionally species in fresh water. Common in decaying vegetable matter. Some species are parthenogenetic, others hermaphroditic. Found on the surface of insects. Cephalobus resembles Rhabdilis, but may readily be distinguished by the form of the pharynx and the nature of the male caudal armature. The pharynx of Cephalobus is almost never cylindroid or prismoid as in Rhabdilis. On the contrary it tends to taper more or less regularly from the base of the lips backward. Though simple in form the pharynx is usually compounded of two or three series of short cuticula elements separated from each other by transverse breaks. In a considerable number of species the lips arc modified so as to bear more or less complicated forward pointing cuticula appendages. • Such forms are intermediate between tne typical Cephalobi and other genera, such as Acrobdes and WUsonema. The males of the Cephalobi do not possess a bursa, at most showing faint indications of such a structure. Nevertheless the papillae or ribs found accompanying the bursa in Rhabdilis are present in Cephalobus, though they sometimes are less numer- ous than on typical Rhabdites. Not infrequently the ovary functions in the first instance as a testis. Spermatocytes appear in the young ovary even before an external sexual opening exists. The developing spermatozoa descend the oviduct and enter the uterus. Later the oocytes de- velop and are fertilized by the spermatozoa previ- ously produced in the same organ, — at least this happens in some instances, and hence is assumed to happen in all. So far no differences have been dis- covered between spermatozoa produced in this way by these syngonadic females and those produced by the rarely occurring males. It is therefore fair to as- sume that the sperm cells so commonly produced in this way are potent. As in Rhabdilis the renette often takes the form of two long slender lateral ducts ending blindly near the anus. Some species may be revived after remaining months or even years in a dry condition. Representative species. Cephalobus sub-elongalus Cobb 1914. * 1 ♦ is. i./ 2). it *i« •4.J The thin, transparent, colorless layers of the naked cuticula are traversed by about seven hundred plain, transverse striae, resolvable with high powers without very much difficulty. There are three rather distinct, bluntly conoid lips, which are rounded in front; each of them apparently has two inconspicuous innervated papillae. The intestine is composed of cells of such a size that probably only about two are required to build a circumference. The nerve-ring surrounds the esoph- agus obliquely, and is accompanied by nerve cells, of which the greater number are behind the nerve-ring and in front of the cardiac bulb. Habitat: Moss Bog, W. End of Douglas Lake, Mich. Fig. 798. Cephalobus sub-don gaius. Lateral view of a female. a, lips; b, pharynx; c. anterior portion of esophagus; d, posterior extremity of anterior portion of esophagus; e, nerve-ring; /, cardiac bulb; g, beginning of intestine; h, one of the cells of the intestine; t, lumen of the intestine; j, excretory pore; k, cardiac valvej /, re- nette cell; m, flexure in single ovary; n, cuticula; o, ovary; p, spermatozoon in uterus; q, vulva; r, nucleus in ovum; s, body cavity; /, anus; u. ripe ovum; v, unripe ovum; w, oocyte; x, blind end of ovary; y, rectum; s, terminus. (After Cobb.) 496 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 48 (47) Striae resolvable into rows of dots, altered on lateral fields. Teratocepkalus de Man. Interesting genus of lew species, with movable cuticular lips. Species have thus far been found only in fresh water and wet soils, but the genus appears to have a world-wide distribution, at least in temperate regions. Tcrateccphalus seems related to Cephatebiu from which, how- ever, It differs strikingly in the formation of the lips and pharynx. It is difficult to determine the functions of the movable cuticular labial elements (a). The most reasonable assumption appears to be that they are biting organs. , Representative species Teratocephalus cornulus Cobb 1914. ■■'isrt Tbe cuticula is traversed by about isoo transverse striae, resolvable into rows of minute dots, which are modified on the lateral Gelds. The movements of which the lips are capable are plainly indicated in Figs. II and IV. The relatively large eggs are ex- tremely mobile, so that they pass out through the relatively small vulva without difficulty. Contact with water, however, appears to harden the shell so that after deposition the eggs have a more definite and rigid form. These phenomena are characteristic of the eggs of many genera, especially those in which the eggs are of relatively large size. In the present species the eggs are deposited before segmentation begins. The general form of the tail, and its termi- nus, would seem to suggest the presence of caudal glands, but none have been seen. The cardiac bulb so strongly developed in this species is similar to that found in Rhabditii, Pleclus, Ctptvdobus, etc. It consists of three movable valves rolling against each other, that can be pulled back- ward by appropriate muscles. The arch over them meanwhile remains rigid; thereby a vacuum (suction) is produced. The minute striation on these valves has suggested that they are triturating organs, but the food habits would not seem to necessitate such an assumption. It seems more likely that the striatums are due to such a disposal of the cuticula as will give to the organs tbe necessary strength and efficiency. These valves act rapidly, often several Habitat: Maple River, Michigan. Fie. 799. Ttmoctplulus comfiu. I, lateral view of a female; II. lateral view of bead, 1 highly mm«niD«i; III, front view of bead; IV, ■ ' -: ■' ': -it opts; V, cuticula inPEd; . (After Cobb.' '^1 lie 'inloUnl blind cod . of the cells of tbe u 49 (38) Esophagus without bulbs. 50 (57) Pharynx none Si (56) Caudal glands and cephalic setae present. FKEE-LTYTNG KEMATODES 5a (ss) AmphitiE spim. 53 (54) Male supplementary organs papillate. Bastiana de k Xiinal in honor of the EnciiiJi namiulupa Hem?- Charlton HjjHpti 1637—1914. Go an of «lender nanatodes with rather aimpi:- mams pans. Malr? with ■ ventral n ■null auppianesiisry atf&ns exlfndiun ovct the greater pan of the leturth of the body a doaen ^W"***> fcnown Occur? in Luroiit. America, Japan, and AusuuMl lathee species Bastigma exilis Cobb 1 I-4-VH" The moderately thick layers of - traversed by about eudil nun CMtknla to that the enlin larersd wings are present, the optical tractive kmETtudinaJ lines opposite the lateral helds, separated from each other by a distance somewhat greater than the width alone of the annulet of tbecutirult. There is a circlet of at least sii cephalh ■etae, of which the four suhmediari are the lunger, and ale numrwhai longer thai the head is wide. Possibly each of these latter is accompanied by a sooner seta. thus nafcjnc ten in all. Apparent h which is twice as long as the anal body diameter, extends inward and forward. The tail is conoid, but la] FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY supplementary organs protusile tubes. Aphanotaimiu de Man. a Genus of fresh-water nematodes, of which nearly a dozen species axe e known. Hermaphroditism occurs. Representative species. _, Aphanolaimus spiriferm 3 Cobb 1914. Viviparous. Two embryos and de- veloping egg have been seen in each uterus at the same time. Eggs, about as king as body is wide, and less than half as wide as long. Habitat: Potomac River, Wash- ington, D. C. lajrnified; IV. male siHrifam jnd of ferr ... opening; b, ampbkt; c. lumen of esophagus; d, pigmented pye-ipota (?); 1. intestine; /, nerve cell) 1. rectum: a, nervr-tinEi 1, anus; 4, esophagus; I, ill- daJ gland; fi, duct of caurtiil gland; n. glandular body it hue of neck; o, ipiu- ncrtt; f, ejscuUtorvduct; «, intestine; r, anterior end of cloaca; rr right spiculum; ■e cells (?); *i male supplementary _ ns. (After Cobb.) Amphids circular or ellipsoidal Tripyla Bastion. Genus of toward twenty fresh-water species, some at least carnivorous. Representative species. Tripyla lata Cobb 1014. $"'A — h — t? — T7 'jri-"'— of pharynx at a point re- moved from anterior extremity a distance a little greater than radius of bead, inward-pointing dorsal tooth, having a length about equal to width of one of the annules of cuticula, proving that pharynx extends backward a dis- tance equal to width of head. In some specimens not far behind this point dis- fold in lining of esopha- Lxxes. Habitat: Alpin Mountain, Colorado. Fig. 803. Trifyta ImU. a, labU papilla: I, lip: c, amph matocoon: t, spermatocyte of ante /, base of esophagus, pseudo-bulb; ■naj; k, cuiieula; i, l 'sophaius; *, intest ■ , msle supplement Bald FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 499 de Man. 56 (si) Caudal glands and cephalic setae absent. . . . Alaim The species of this small genus have a rather simple structure. All are slender. Some appeal to be parthenogenetic. Representative species. Alaimus simplex Cobb 1914. Very minute striatums in subcuticula at extremities, under favorable conditions. Obscure traces of lateral wings. Eggs ap- parently deposited before segmentation be- gins. Whether two testes or only one not determined. Broad, rounded, blunt end of testis, located as far behind base of neck as latter is behind anterior eitremity. Habitat: Big Lake, Fla. Fic.Soj. AUimm !»*». a. lip iranoo. ft, pharynx; e, amphid; d, amphid. enlarged; r, group of spermatccoa at posterior portion of ovary ;/. blind end of ovary; ST male supplementary papillae- k, left spiru- dd; i. tsrUBDOSE )• submedian elevation or Sap *, nerve [ioa; a. posterioi gas: p, modified cells of 57 (50) Pharynx present. . £=:i- Behind each amphid. at a distance equal to the width of two to three annules of the cuticula. there is a short seta. The ovaries are moved backward and forward tn accordance with stage of development of eggs. These latter appear to be deposited before segmentation begins. Notwithstanding the slenderuesa of the tail caudal glands and a spinneret are present. Habitat: Roadside pool Douglas Lake, Michigan. Fig. Ic i [he esophagus; I. nerve-rind; *. cuticula. i. nucleus 1; j. vulva; k, blind end of posterior ovary; I. en; m, 14 of the intestine; a. one of the cells of the nil of the 500 FRESHWATER BIOLOGY 59 (58) Cavity small, amphids usually well developed 60 60 (til) Form of cavity conoid, open in front; circular amphids considerably behind it Monhystera Bastian. A large, aquatic genus of which about one hundred Species are known- Many purine, Some found in soil. Many species ieed upon diatoms. Probably no other nematode genus is so widespread as Mtnhyslcra. In any collection from land or from fresh or salt water the first specimen to come to view often proves to be a Itonkyilera. The species art very numer- ous and the individuals surprisingly so. Brightly colored eye-spots are more common than in any other fresh-water genus. Representative species Monhystera sentiens Cobb 1014. The striae are more readily visible toward the extremities, especially the posterior extremity. The lips appear to be three in number, and are longi- tudinally striated or fluted. The anterior portion of the intestine is somewhat bulbous in form, and is separated from the esophagus on the one side and the true intestine on the other, by a pair of constrictions. This portion may perhaps be looked may perhaps be k rongly developed c fields vary in wid The lateral fields vary in width in different parts of the body. A little in front of the anus they are about two- fifths as wide as the correspond- ing portion of the body, and contain rather numerous scattered nuclei of such a size that about eight would be required to reach across the field. A little Farther forward the field is narrower. Anteriorly it is wider again. The blind end of the anterior testis b located a short distance behind the nerve-ring, while the blind end of the posterior testis is located about as far in front of the anus as the ter- minus is behind it. The testes are broad and in some parts appear to fill up the main portioD of the body Habitat: Sand bar off Plummet's Island, Potomac River. Fio. Bos. UimkyUrrn M* flew of head of the same; I ■.pharynx; », nibmedian cephalic seta; c. lateral cephalic t if eaonhariu; I, esophagus; 1, lubcephilic setae; i, lumen ' striated lip region; m. ■ry; t*. die three c „ .. - 1 the intestine; >, vulva; w, m the spermHa— 1, vaginal xbmto; >, ovum. (After Cobb.] nAi , side view of posterior extremity of a iphid; /, li :; j, nerve cells; *, nerve-- with anluhid: I, blind a beginning of iutntioe: I.l.» na*'*'" bona ouUafa of (be eg FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 5<>I 61 (60) Form ol cavity various, closed in front, amphids opposite it. . 6a 61 (63) Lateral organs or amphids inconspicuous Trilobus Bastion. Fresh-water genus of which about hall a dozen species are known. Known to feed upon d»toni« in one cue and upon rotileis in another. Hermaphroditism occurs. Representative species Trilobus longus (Leidy) 1851. &«;' !. Ti tr •;, • •— *• ' The Hps bear papillae but then- number is not Ke It » w * . * , ,,_ known. The intestine frequently contains dhtomi " * ** *■* *"'" in large numbers, indicating that these are a common source of nourishment of this species. The longitudinal fields are distinctly developed, a ' about one-lourtb ax wide as the body. From the slightly elevate " ' want at tight angles to the ventral surface fully half way acn each uterus at one time. These are somewhat ellipsoidal and it pass through at least the early stages oi segmentation before t the vagina present the peculiarity of being very thick, and 0 centric Layers so that the organ is considerably broader than it presents tile peculiarity of staining strongly with carmine. Trilobus lengus, the only American fresh-water nematode outside the Sfermilkidat that had been adequately characterized previous 10 the inception of this chapter, was described by the famous Philadelphia naturalist, Dr. Joseph Leidy, in 1B51. At that time extremely little was known about the free-living fresh-water nematodes, and no one dreamed oi their vast number and variety. The peculiar male supplementary organs of Trilobus did not fail to attract atten- tion, and it b owing to this fact that Leidy's name is associated with the striking species selected as a representative of the genus. Habitat: Mud about the bases of aquatic plants, in pools, ditches, rivers, and lakes through- out the country. iin shelled, being about two- is long. The eggs appear to ing deposited. The walls of mposed of six to seven con- t is deep. Its internal wall F10. 806. Tnhtui fenew. I, male; 11, bead, lateral view: III. head, lateral vi— : TV h* mentaxy organ; VI, posterior supplementary organ; V] a, lateral aeta; ft, papilla: c, submedian *eta; d. pharynx; f, lateral organ; /, tooth; t. u ago; i, nerve-ring: j. eiaetory pore; *T body muscles; I, glandular {?> »«""■ — «»* end anterior testidt; 0, totide: f, junction oi tcsticaa; v, Mind-end p ' Kipplemenlary or a; t, cavity of supplementary organ; h, left spiculwx, », acmory p ins; 1, terminus; s, apex of supplementary organ. (Alter Cobb.) FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Single species known Anenchus monhystera Cobb 1913. E"H--ft~1»--1}-,b- 1 Lateral Gelds occupied by about forty internal ellipsoidal bodies, rather equally spaced in two aeries. - --'-* - --, ;-fLyr > 1 — - Cardia slender, as long as the neck is wide. The twenty tubular male supplementary organs are con- tinued to the head by a series of about seventy minute ventral depressions. Habitat : Mud about the roots ol aquatic plants, Potomac River. Fig. Sol- AimdiMi mmkyslm. outh opening; b. pturyni; c, cephali 1; /, cellular b «Ui jt.^ :nd of intestine: *, renetu ; ■, blind end ol ttstide; - oneoftne <. mouth opening; (, cephJic seta; c, ddtlanu dement, anterior portion of pharym; i, phmirm. ', •pin! unphid; /, radial aum-nlitant ol soph- mpplnneuUlj ataam; q. taut; r, if r unify piece; r, one gf the caudal lUnds; I, tenninm; a, riant •^fcuhim. (After Cobb. J FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 503 64 (1) Posterior region of intestine atrophied; anus vestigial or absent. Family Meemtthidae . . 65 The forms minded in this group are of some sue, being notably larger than those in the first section of the nematodes. These often reach 10 to 20 an. in length. They are mote or leas opaque so that the internal structure cannot usually be determined by super- ficial examination of the firing animal. The intestinal region of the alimentary canal is re- duced to a mere cord of cells without any cavity, or may be entirely wanting for a portion of the length. The anus if discernible at all in the female has the form of a mere shallow dent in the external surface of the cuticula to which the vestigial remnant of the intestine is attached. In the male the terminal portion of the intestinal canal persists as the genital duct cloaca and the anus functions as its orifice, but the intestinal tube is atrophied in front of the point at which the sexual canal joins it. These forms are parasitic in larval life and do not feed during the adult stage of their existence. The latter may be passed either in water or in the soil, though the species are more frequently reported from the latter. By virtue of likeness in habit and to some extent also in external form Mermithidae are often regarded as related to the "hair snakes " (Gordiacea) to which, however, they bear no real structural resemblance. They are the so-called " cabbage worms " which from time to time enjoy transient newspaper notoriety on account of their supposed poisonous character whereas really they are harmless. The American Mermithidae are very little known. TV following key to the established genera will be of service to the student in allotting any of his discoveries to the proper genus. 65 (66) Hypoderm with only two longitudinal fields; cuticula with criss- cross fibers; spicula two N comer mis von Linstow. 66 (65) Hypoderm with more than two longitudinal fields 67 67 (78) Longitudinal fields six. 68 68 (73) Cuticula without criss-cross fibers 69 69 (70) Spicula two Mesomermis Daday. Representative species Mesomermis virginiana Cobb 1014. There are minute longitudinal striations throughout the body. These are interrupted on the lateral fines where there is a distinct wing. There is no distinct pharynx. The mouth pore is very minute and is located a tittle toward the ventral side of the middle of the front of the head. The cuticula is penetrated on the head by a number of innervations which end in minute depres- sions on the surface of the head. Near the mouth opening there is one of these depressions on the dorsal side, and apparently a similar one on the ventral side, while nearer the outer margin of the head there are two ventral submedian and two dorsal submedian similar depressions. Pores occur also here and there on the body, as well as on the neck. The lateral organs present the following appearance when seen from the side: They appear to project from the surface of the body very sfightly, beginning as a tube having a length about one-third as great as the ail responding diameter of the head. This tube has very thin walls, and, a short d'^amr in, apparently near the surface of the body, a second element appears in the form of a circle inside that representing the contour of the outer tube. This appears to constitute a sort of core in the midst of which are a number of refractive elements, resembling nerve fibers, which pass in- ward and backward toward the lumen of the esophagus. Some of these elements are longer than others. The focus passing inward picks up one, then two. then several more, so that by the time a view is obtained that is wholly inside the body there are seen a half dozen or more of these elements. It is impossible in this view to pick up the internal connections of these refractive elements. The lateral fields are about one-third as wide as the body. The tail of the male bears several series of innervated papillae These papillae are arranged on the ventral submedian fines as well as on the ventral line. The ventral papillae just in front of and just behind the anus are double. In the submedian rows there are four on the tail — one opposite the anus, one a little farther back, a third near the middle of the tail and a fourth considerably farther back. In front of the anus on each side there are eight submedian papillae occupying a distance more than twice as great as the length of the tail; the distance between the successive papulae increases with the distance from the anus, so that the space between the seventh and eighth is about two-thirds as great as the diameter of the body. Of the median papillae on the tail there are three, two near the anus and one just in front of the middle of the tail with pos- sibly a fourth farther back. Of the median papillae in front of the anus there are two near the anus, and ten additional ones about coextensive with the submedian papillae, and distributed in the same manner. There are two outstretched testes, the posterior a little shorter than the ,3 — \ — %\\ =r? — f^x, '•—- Habitat: Cranberry bog, Arfington Farm, Virginia. FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY *, mouth opminc: *, literal orpin', i, aophuiu; if I. blind end uiH« ituide *, toudc i. iuocK tMtfclt; i. ventml lupptiOTnm-y chiuk m, iu&u. mta 0. IpiCBluB. ( Alter Cobb.) FREE-LIVING NEMATODES 505 70 (69) Spiculum single 71 71 (72) Vagina of the adult cylindroid, S-shaped. . . Limnomermis Daday. 72(71) Vagina tubular (?) not S-shaped Pseudomermis de Man. 73 (68) Cuticula with criss-cross fibers 74 74 (77) Vagina of the adult S-shaped 75 75 (76) Spiculum single Paramermis von Linstow. 76 (75) Spicula two Mermis Dujardin. 77 (74) Vagina of the adult not S-shaped Bathy mermis Daday. 78 (67) Longitudinal fields eight 79 79 (80) Cuticula without criss-cross fibers Hydromermis Corti. 80 (79) Cuticula with criss-cross fibers Eumermis Daday. IMPORTANT REFERENCES ON FREE-LIVING NEMATODES Bastian, C. 1865. Monograph of the Anguillulidae. Trans. Linn. Soc, Lond., 25: 73-84; 5 pl- Butschli, O. 1873. Beitrage zur Kenntnis der freilebenden Nematoden. Nova acta caes. leop., 36: 144; 11 pl. Cobb, N. A. 1913. New Nematode Genera Found Inhabiting Fresh- Water and Non-Brackish Soils. Jour. Wash. Acad. Sci., 3: 432-444. 1914. The North American Free-living Fresh-Water Nematodes. Trans. Amer. Micr. Soc, 33; 69-134; 8 pl. De Man, J. G. 1884. Die frei in der reinen Erde und im siissen Wasser lebenden Nematoden d. Niederlandischen Fauna. 206 pp.; 34 pl. Jagerskiold, L. A. 1909. Freilebende Susswassernematoden. Stisswasser- fauna Deutschlands, Heft 15; 46 pp.; 65 figs. Maupas, E. 1899. La mue et l'enkystement chez les N6matodes. Arch. zool. exper. (3), 7: 562-628; 3 pl. 1900. Modes et formes de reproduction des Nematodes. Arch. zool. expe>. (3), 8: 462-624; 11 pl. Micoletzky, H. 19 13. Freilebende Sttsswassernematoden der Ostalpen. Sitzber. Kais. Akad. Wi3s. Wien, Math.-naturw. Kl., Abt. I, 122 : 111- 122, 543-548. Steiner, G. 1913-1914. Freilebende Nematoden aus der Schweiz. Archiv. Hydrobiol. und Planktonk., 9: 250-276, 420-438. CHAPTER XVI PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS By HENRY B. WARD Professor of Zoology in the University of Illinois The roundworms or Nemathelminthes constitute a group of convenience into which are put three classes that have little in common except general external appearance. But even in this feature differences of a real character appear on closer examination and the study of internal anatomy fails to show any intimate agreement in the fundamentals of structure. The three classes embraced in this phylum are the Nematoda or true roundworms, the Gordiacea or hairworms, and the Acanthocephala or probos- cis roundworms. All agree in the elongated generally cylindrical form, and in the uniform or monotonous external appearance. The Nematoda show nearly always some taper toward one or both ends, being thus spindle-shaped rather than truly cylindrical, and possess a smooth, glistening, colorless external surface. The Gor- diacea are larger, more uniformly cylindrical with blunt rounded ends and an exterior at least faintly colored in whole or in part. The Acanthocephala show a roughened surface sometimes with imperfect rings around the body, and the form usually like a carrot is always somewhat irregular. These differences are general and subject to exception but with practice one can usually separate members of the three groups at sight, and the structure is so differ- ent that it is wise to consider each group separately in an inde- pendent section of the chapter. Biologically the three classes show certain contrasts. The Nema- toda include many free-living forms and many others purely parasitic, but most of the latter have brief free-living stages during which they achieve the transfer to a new host. The Gordiacea are parasitic during early life and spend the adult existence free in water bodies. The Acanthocephala are among the most highly specialized of parasites as they have no free-living stages at all 506 PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS 507 and as there is no trace of an alimentary canal at any stage of development. In collecting parasites one may find adult Nematoda and Acanthocephala side by side in the same intestine but the latter rarely occur outside the alimentary canal and nematodes often do. The Gordiacea are parasitic in larval stages normally in the body cavity of Insecta and are found only infrequently in other hosts. They are most commonly found as adults in general aquatic col- lecting and are well known even to the casual observer of life in ponds and ditches under the popular designation of "Hair Snakes." The technic of handling the roundworms is not simple. Para- sitic nematodes are collected in the manner already described for parasites in general (p. 368), but owing to the very resistant cutic- ula and delicate structure of these worms great care is necessary to avoid injuring specimens seriously. Those which are loose can be picked up with a fine camePs hair brush. This instrument is most convenient in the handling of small species. Many species are so firmly attached to the intestinal wall that it is difficult to remove them without injury. Gentle manipulation if prolonged will usu- ally loosen the hold, but the body is easily lacerated by grasping it with forceps other than very lightly or the mouth parts are often torn by pulling the worm too hard. Encysted forms should be freed from the cyst under a dissecting lens with fine, sharp needles. A very good needle is made of a glass rod drawn out to a point. Most nematodes are very sensitive to changes in osmotic pressure and are badly disfigured by rapid changes. Living specimens should not be put into distilled water or normal salt solution. Tap water is fairly good and for nematodes from fresh-water fish a 0.3 per cent salt solution is best, but material should not be left in such a fluid longer than absolutely necessary. The resistant cuticula prevents the entrance of cold killing solutions so thoroughly that these worms live even hours in fluids that kill other parasites promptly. Hot fluids coagulate the body proteins and preserve specimens well extended. No successful methods of narcotization have yet been worked out. The killing fluid recommended by Looss is all in all most useful; it is made by adding to alcohol (70 to 85 per cent) from 5 to 10 per cent 508 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY glycerine. This fluid is heated over a flame in a beaker or thin watch glass until it begins to volatilize, or more precisely to a temperature of 560 to 6o° C. The worms in a minimum amount of fluid are dropped into the beaker, whereupon most forms straighten at once. Specimens are preserved permanently in this mixture and by allowing it to evaporate slowly one can bring them gradually into strong glycerine in which they can be studied. This method is especially good for mounting in toto. For histological details nematodes should be killed in a mixture containing equal parts of acetic acid, alcohol, and water, which has been saturated with corrosive sublimate and to which has been added 0.25 per cent osmic acid. Formol can be used to advantage only in the lactophenol quick method. Nematodes are killed in 2 to 5 per cent formol and after lying there 2 hours are gradually transferred to a solution com- posed of 1 part glycerine, 1 part lactic acid, 1 part phenol, and 2 parts water. The transfer should be timed to bring them at the end of 6 hours into the pure solution. Lactophenol specimens are mounted in the same fluid in a pre- pared cell. Glycerine-alcohol material is mounted in strong glycer- ine into which it has been carried gradually by evaporation. When material must be stained and embedded for sectioning, or mounted in balsam, treatment is very difficult and results are uncertain. In general all changes must be gradual and as deliberate as possible. The simplest method is to employ a string siphon made by placing three stender-dishes in a stair-step series, with the worms in the middle dish and the fluid into which they are to be transferred in the top dish while the waste flows into the bottom dish. String siphons lead into and out of the center dish and the amount of the flow is regulated by the size of the string. The differentiator (Fig. 811) is a very valuable aid in nematode technique. Worms are placed in the small tube a and the tube b is filled with the fluid into which they are to be transferred. The very fine tip regulates the flow of the fluid. When in absolute alcohol they can be taken out and brought into a clearing fluid by the siphon method, or the differentiator may safely be used by extending the fine tip e, and leaving out the mixing <^girri aaifcrriiiffi td r;ioL A* gmt DttJaaeuf"* ajanudkaiiyfii, QlSiilS MJ JTiw[pt-tmii»TdiiT, .lawf Miners mozat- fjiwiW jjrn? $3m£ r»suL~i.. Fur yt'TtiiiiTrt zhtt **tf cm* aire aiatHed. laHB- 1 yi?t r:kV i>r -^i.mririmr : a 'MBS' pet be m—aw-nt^ no. bal- sam mr 'iomar. it a wise to pierce the biMfr wail with, i ice aeeile jiaae hdH h necessary to i-wiii hijnry U m-ter^al acaaaa When. jraoBaarrniff r"n«* worms to r"-H haJBaaa pui»:e |jm m parser CUDS JJUi 1 1 ii'nr „i* Trri*f 11 1 m Ho. nffialyae hue them. Sections ire ■:hmonit to make box pcsaihle by the sse or very hard BBraBii and. zreac care hi rn;tirir'ir the transfers. Vj.-rmTTT ^'mixtti'i-g' is betprX m MKOTSPg JOOli BHiEtnuwiL Fir GonShaa the aixci'i-iiycerice method h aseTeaa: on the whoie the oorrosrie subG- ir" Bnjrtnnui*. >.»■*. tnate-a»:eac rrxtrare works best, bat should be *=- y^gw^TV osed warmed no ".: or ic' C. Is other respects SSSffidSttiraS the nistrncEBjOfl air aercaxode technfc orjptv ^Sd"?^ 5™ T^" here alao iU™ 1™i- »nv?J?^, * The Acanthocepbala. are beat killed irai died iSnTaltanm- b£ m. the corrosive »uhiimaxe-acetii: mziture and do not come out well m liycerine-iicocoL In. general Tnetnotfe used for naxwonna work weC with, these forms also, bet for more precise results on any of the roundworms eaim. worker nnrat dereiop i special technir. Compare further Loos. FLon-som. Hagath The foQowina; rEsdiictly artidciil key may be osed to separate the three classes of V^ttt« rh^mmrh.m; it must be sipplemenied by 510 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY reference to the longer discussion in the opening paragraph of this chapter. A (B) With anterior, protrusible proboscis covered with rows of recurved hooks Class Acantbocephala (page 542) B (A) Without proboscis at anterior end C C (D) Adult free-living, aquatic, long, cylindrical, with posterior end bifid or bluntly rounded. Class Gordiacea* (page 535) The family of the Mermithidae (page 534) agrees in some of these particulars with the Gordiacea, although the structure shows that these species are true Nematoda and not Gordiacea; they are readily distinguished by the acutely pointed posterior end and terrestrial habit. D (C) Adult usually spindle-shaped, tapering rather than cylindrical. Pos- terior end never bifid or bluntly rounded, usually acutely pointed, occasionally peculiarly modified in form. Class Nematoda . . E E (F) Free-living during entire life cycle. Adults small, transparent. Free-living Nematoda (page 459) F (£) Parasitic during most or all of the life cycle. Larvae small, transpar- ent; adults variable in size, often more or less opaque. Parasitic Nematoda Parasitic Nematoda The nematodes are easily recognized by their appearance, which has given them the common name of round- or threadworms. Most of them are small, measuring only a few millimeters in length and a fraction of a millimeter in diameter, and resemble a fragment of a violin string. A few of the larger sorts reach a length of several centimeters or even a meter. The external surface is usu- ally smooth and glistening and the body is not divided into joints or segments. In some cases a fine surface striation is present which appears under a lens as delicate circular grooves; the exterior jnay also bear irregular beaded tubercles or fine scales, spines, or hairs. When present these are usually confined to certain regions and the remainder of the surface has the typical nematode appearance. The body tapers slightly towards one or both ends and only very rarely can one find marked differences in diameter or dis- * Some authors designate the class Xexnatomorpoa and rank the Gordiacea as an ader under it. PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS 5" tmguish adjacent regions by other prominent features. As a rule the anterior end is slightly blunter whereas the posterior end is more pointed. The uniformity of external appearance is very charac- teristic of nematodes. This creates an impression of monotony in structure and renders their classification difficult. The smaller forms are somewhat transparent in life but the larger species are opaque. One may also recognize a nematode easily by its peculiar type of movement, which in a liquid medium consists of a more or less rapid and violent coiling and twisting alternately right and left without appreciable progress, but is modified by the presence of solid particles in the fluid into a powerful serpentine movement winding in and out among the debris. This grows in effectiveness as the material becomes more nearly solid and the particles are less readily pushed aside by the twisting of the worm. In external features the parasitic species appear somewhat dif- ferent from the free-living forms. On the whole they are much larger, thicker and more opaque. Few species are as minute as free forms and only these minute types approach the free species in transparency. The external form is also more monotonous since the delicate hairs and scales that distinguish free species are almost entirely wanting. Eyes, amphids. and setose tactile organs such as already described for free-living types are not present in parasitic species. Parasitic nematodes occur in nearly all water-living vertebrates; they are also often found in insects. In crustaceans and worms they are much less frequent and in any other forms their presence is un- usual. While adult forms are found in all hosts, vet the immature stages are more frequent in hosts from the lower groups mentioned and less common in the higher vertebrates. The encysted worms are usually larval forms. The adults frequent commonly the alimentary canal, though some species occur regular!}' in con- nective tissue and rarer types in other parts of the body. Encysted larvae may be found almost anywhere. In structure the parasitic threadworms manifest great similar- ity to the free-living species and in view of the detailed treatment given the latter in the last chapter it will be necessary in the pres- 512 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY ent general discussion to refer prominently only to points of con- trast or to features peculiar to parasitic forms. For further structural details the student should consult that discussion which should be read in connection with the following description. Some parasitic nematodes are apparently indistinguishable from free- living species, others are classed in the same genera or families, but there are also large groups that contain no free-living species and are highly modified for a parasitic existence. In general the smaller transparent species show the greatest similarity to the free- ra the right, X 160. [After Loos.) living species whereas the large opaque forms depart most widely from that type. In general organology, microscopic structure of cells and their arrangement in layers, as well as in fundamental features of reproduction and development, the parasitic nema- todes agree substantially with the free-living forms and manifest their recent differentiation from them. The anterior end or "head" of a nematode is usually slightly truncated or bluntly rounded and shows under a lens the presence of lips, papillae, spines, teeth and other special structures. In reality the numerous modifications of the anterior end may PAJLAsrrrc ROCXDWOUCS 513 be reduced to a few fundamental types (Fig. 812). In the first, the top of the body is unarmed or at most provided with a few minute papillae arranged around the month opening which is a mhmte areolar orifice. In a second, three lips are present, a large dboal and two smanw ventrolateral, which border a *™"gnlar mouth. In a third, the oral aperture is a dorso-ventral sfit guarded by two lateral jaws often called ftps bat very distract in form and function from the triple labia of the second type. In the fourth class one finds a hollow cap-shaped capsule with an entire margin which in lateral aspect resembles the jaws of the third type bat ts very unlike them in general plan. The capsule is a powerful sacking organ, the jaws act as a grasping organ like a vise or pin errs, the lips are weaker and more varied in movement. These main types of oral apparatus are modified in so many directions that it is often drScuIt to comprehend the general type involved ma complicated case. The month cavity may be tubular, farraei shaped, or even ex- panded into a ziobolar or oval capsule or pharynx. Following thfa region comes the esophazus which b either mnscnlar or capcQarv- The maseciar tvae is prirnfa^Tit thick walled, and tri- angnlar in cross sectioG Fig. si;. -1 . with the musde fibers perpen- dicular to the tssea By the contraction, of these fibers the cavity is enlarged azd the • „ organ acts as a pu=p to draw intend- Theesoccagas may be <±5ereztiated rate two regions, ooe deariy ir^s- cutar and the other zrarzi- ka\ or the Hagje Trrjyu"'ar region may have k*R =a3- vary? gland ce£s m its waZ. -*n!""-^— ■ It s frecfceni'y tcscatcd by a spherical bulb wifeh coctars 1 vahrutar apparatus. Is sooe cases ths bulb 5 ekebie. The cavity is Saed by ir. sitsrsed layer of the external ^r-vrr'g which termraales at the bdh. Ths is the type of scccazs kear: 2 free-5rt« kr=s -*e Cbap^er XV. p. if,-. Fat. -fx. . The Fig. b* 5. 4 . caegst; of a sttjtc c 514 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY surrounded by a row of granular cells but without muscle elements. It does not terminate in a bulb though the end of the cell row may be slightly enlarged. The esophagus opens directly into the following region which is commonly termed the intestine. It is the digestive portion of the canal and is without any cuticular lining. The cavity is of con- siderable size and lined by large cells rich in protoplasm. This region changes gradually into the narrow terminal section of the canal, known in the female as the rectum, or in the male as the cloaca, since the duct of the sex gland joins it to form a common passage way. The tail is ordinarily sharply pointed though sometimes the point is short and in other cases long drawn out. The anal open- ing is ventral, a little anterior to the tip of the body. In a few instances the anus is terminal and the tail is rounded or of peculiar form. In several families its true character is obscured in the male because lateral wings or folds of cuticula cover it. These folds may be low, narrow, keel-like ridges along the sides or may have developed into wide semi-circular wings forming together a clasping organ known as the bursa. Protoplasmic strands in the wings appear like ribs of an umbrella; they vary in form and number and are much used in the diagnosis of species. Numerous papillae occur on the ventral surface of the male both in front of and behind the anus. They vary greatly in size and arrangement in different species and constitute another useful feature in the determination of genera and species. A prominent cup-shaped sucker is found on the ventral surface in front of the anus in some species and one can often see in the body behind the anal orifice a few large unicellular structures which are interpreted as glands. Between the head and the tail there are very few external fea- tures to be noted. A minute excretory pore lies in the mid-ventral line not far from the middle of the esophagus. In the female the sexual pore also is found on the ventral surface; in some families it is near the head, in others near the tail, and again in the center of the body. Its location is an important characteristic in defining the various groups. A circumesophageal nerve ring with lateral ganglia is a conspic- .jk t PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS 515 uoas feature in most nematodes. It lies not far from the excretory pore, a short distance behind the anterior end of the esophagus. A cross section of the body shows on the exterior the thick non-cellular cuticula; within it the hypoderm or sub-cuticula which is cellular but without cell walls. This layer is thin except at the median and lateral fields which are visible externally as faint streaks and hence often called "lines"; here it projects inward between the muscle cells. The major part of the body wall con- sists of the muscular layer, a single layer of large cells with longi- tudinal but no circular or cross fibers; these cells have a con- spicuous protoplasmic body on the inner side next the body cavity. The muscle layer is divided into four areas separated by the median and lateral fields of the hypodermis; rarely the presence of sub- median fields makes eight such muscle areas. Each of the four muscle areas may contain many muscle cells (the Polymyaria) or be limited to a longitudinal series of two muscle cells (the Meromyaria). The cuticula of nematodes is usually said to be " chitinous " but as this layer is soluble in alkalis, digested by the action of en- zymes, and contains a very high percentage of nitrogen, it is not chitin; consequently Reichard correctly classes it as a protein. Glycogen occurs in large amount in nematode tissues and is sup- posed to furnish them oxygen and energy. The body cavity is large but not lined by a peritoneal epithe- lium. It is in fact formed by the breaking down of connective tissue cells, the remnants of which may still be observed in well preserved specimens, especially at the anterior end. Both repro- ductive and digestive organs are free in this cavity since mesen- teries are lacking. In full-grown worms the space of the body cavity is almost entirely filled by the greatly enlarged and much convoluted reproductive organs which press upon each other, the alimentary canal, and the body wall so as to leave only small irregular cavities here and there. The reproductive system is exceedingly simple. In both sexes it has the form of a long tube in which the various regions are continuous and only slightly distinguished from each other in form. The fine inner end of the tube produces the reproductive cells, 516 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY eggs or sperm. In the female the fully developed eggs arc pushed into a slightly larger region in which fertilization takes place. Sometimes the fertilized eggs are provided with a heavy shell and arc soon ejected to carry out their development in the outer world. In other cases they are retained in a sac-like uterus until devel- opment is more or less advanced. In certain famflw** the entire development is carried out within the uterus and the female brings forth living young. The organs in these cases differ in length and capacity rather than in fundamental structure. In the male the reproductive system consists of but a single tube, emptying as already stated into the cloaca, whereas the windings of the tube lie in the body in front of tins region. In the female the tube may be single but is most frequently double or Y-shaped. The short stem of the Y connects with the female pore, the branches extend in coils into the body. One branch may pass anteriad and the other posteriad or both may lie nearly parallel in the same part of the body. One branch may be greatly reduced and by its final disappearance give to the system the form of a single tube such as is found in the male. Various intermediate stages occur. In connection with the terminal portion of the male duct arc usually found pieces of cuticula shaped like hooks or needles, and known as the spicules. There may be only one spicule or if two are present they may be equal or unequal. Finally an accessory piece furnishes in some species a link or groove in which the spicules proper are held and through which they are extruded. These spicules are easily seen both on account of their high refractive index and because in many preserved specimens they project conspicuously from the anal opening. In transparent forms the student may detect under the microscope the spicule sac, dorsal to the intestine, in which the spicules are housed and also special sets of muscles by which they are operated. The number, length, and exact shape of these organs serve as features for specific The development of parasitic nematodes introduces all varia- tions from extreme simplicity to some of the most complex fife histories known among animals. The early development is simple. PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS 517 Within the egg-shell is formed in direct fashion a minute worm which on hatching displays the main features of nematode struc- ture. This embryo may require weeks or months for its growth and may wait within the shell for years before it is passively intro- duced into a new host; or it may break out from the shell and spend a period in moist earth or water awaiting the time when in one way or another it is brought into a suitable host. In most cases the embryo of a parasitic nematode spends a brief period at least as a free-living larva, and always in an aquatic environment, but this may be semi-fluid mud as well as open water. Frequently it undergoes in this stage or earlier the first of the four character- istic molts and within the cast cuticula of the embryonic form enters upon a resting stage well protected against drying out. In this condition it may be transported by wind or water, or at- tached to other objects, even such living agents as the feet of reptiles, birds, or mammals, and thus be carried far in attaining the location where by some chance it is introduced into the body of a new host. When this new host is reached it may be the same as the original host in which case further molts bring the worm in a short time to the adult condition. In other instances the larva reaches an intermediate host in which it becomes encysted in muscles or viscera and after a period of growth is ready for transfer to the final host. This change involves the consumption of the flesh with the encysted larva by a suitable final host, whereupon digestion sets the worm free, the active development is resumed, and the adult form reached after a period of growth. Most often the larval parasite is taken into a new host with water or food. In some cases the free-living larva does not depend on chance to carry it but gains entrance by its own activ- ity. Thus the hookworm larva, living in moist earth, when brought suitably in contact with the skin of an available host burrows into it and completes its life history during its devious wanderings in that host As an illustration of the life history of a typical aquatic species may be taken the development of Camallanus locus tr is, formerly often designated Cucullanus elegans. This development was worked out and described by Leuckart somewhat as follows: 5l8 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The female is viviparous and produces myriads of young. The larva at birth (Fig. 814, a) has an awl-shaped tail equal to one-third the total length; no trace of the adult lips are seen; the esophagus is simple, as also the intestine, and a single cell is the only trace of genital organs present. A boring spine lies dorsal to the mouth. luvil jura complete. The larva soon gains entrance to a small aquatic animal (e.g., Cyclops) through the mouth and bores its way into the body cavity where the first molt occurs. After this the worm (6) has grown in size, lost its long tail in part and acquired a bipartite esophagus. A period of growth follows towards the close of which the lips of the adult are laid down (c) and the second molt dis- closes an oral armature (J BBS&. Tioy depend iur their dri*elapmBnt upon lie i^miluritty of 3 (2) Encysted in the -rmxsra 3rrxag iurms. Tbese do nut shear asy aiocr- ot ur\wt\\ aJitans in the bit biflturj. OdJt gnwap ooirljainTj^ anima3 parasites. Family Axoostomidaz Braim 3S05L by bcterugoiij- Otbenrise very much £ae tie AigniHrindaf, and umted to tiena by wukbj aaHiurs. Parasitic generatiun cuntains no Only fjeams recorded for Xoni .\txterica. . AtigiosUmu T>u}ZTdxii 1^15. Reprcseolaitive species in North Annrrira. AniiozUmxi mgrmemmswm fGoexe) 1800. la Jhntr finfjginiiiiaj; lung. District of Coiuxniaa. Luted br Stiles and Hanal under tie as is tie Bureau uf Animal IiidmflTi CoSectiaa. 6 (5) Nematodes Saiger liiJD frec-Ih-in^ species; almost ahrays disiincily leas txuasparesn and often even opaque. Uterus «»!««* T¥r -nTiftTlMfrfiirj t^r>*-^f*"- ** *i~ v*j rr #*,;;' p^"* **** *1— Hr rmn rrrfrd Tie todes nfinca koknr jme aanaBy a^D dnterentiated pa.rasflrs, rryrnfimanne by IjHsm ■! stiitmir nwC present in tie un-ms gruup. They are, ion " '" lie latter cnajr in aeaceal aspect and tie key is opro tododbt in a 522 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 7 {75) Esophagus prominent, muscular, with triradiate lumen. Suborder Myonyringsta . . 8 8 {15) Bursa present in male and conspicuously developed 9 9 (14) Mate with broad bursa traversed by system of rays. Buccal cap- sule usually well developed in both sexes. Superfamily Strongvloidea Weinland 1858 . . ro With the spherical buccal capsule may easily be confused the bivalve oral armature of some of the Spiruroidea. The former presents in cross-section an unbroken circle, or oval. The latter is distinctly composed of two pieces interrupted along lines of division. In the latter the mouth opening is a slit having at opposite points two deep acute angles, A buccal capsule is wanting in the three forms described here. The bursa in the strongyles is a conspicuous broad flaring organ, supported generally by six paired rays and one unpaired median ray, all extending outwards from a common center much like the ribs of an umbrella. Only a very few strongyles have been reported in North America from aquatic hosts and these few are not representative of the majority of the group to which belong the hookworms and other well-known and abundant parasites of land animals. The three species cited here are in truth so unlike typical strongyles that it is difficult to bring them into the key. Since the group is very large and complex and only three species are to be considered here no effort has been made to outline the families or the numerous other subdivisions. The key is merely a convenient way of separating these few species. It is not unlikely that other genera are represented in the same and other aquatic hosts. 10(11) In reptiles and amphibians. . . . Strongylus auricularis Zeder 1800. No buccal capsule; 30 longitudinal ridges on the body. Spicules bifid or triad at the distal Reported by Leidy in 1856 from the intestine of By/a amtneana and Cistudo Carolina in Philadelphia. No other data accompany the record so that it cannot be verified at present. At least two species are included in European records under this name. The genus Strmiytus is grouped by Railliet and Henry under the family Strongyn'dae, sub- family Strongylinae, tribe Stronglyeae. Ransom is uncertain as to the genus in which Zeder's or Schneider's species should be placed but thinks they evidently belong in the family Trkhostrongylidae. Probably Leidy' 3 form will fall in the same group. 1 1 {10) In mammals 12 13 (13) From frontal sinus of aquatic carnivore. Filaroides van Beneden 1858. Railliet and Henry include this genus in the subfamily Metastrongylinae. Only species known . . Filaroides musteiarum van Beneden 1:858. No description of the North American form has been given as yet. Identified as European species from host and effect. In frontal sinuses of various Mustelidae: skunk, weasel, mink, and otter, from northeastern North America. Produces large asymmetrical postorbital swellings. 13 fial From intestine of aquatic rodent. Trichostrongylus fiberius Barker and Noyes 1915. Capsule absent in both sexes. Male 1.8 mm. long, 0.013 to 0.09 mm. broad. Bursa with broad lateral lobes and narrow dorsal lobe. Spicules abort and heavy. Female 4.7 nun. long, 0.03 to 0.135 mm. broad. Vulva near posterior end. Eggs oval, 0.059 by 0.036 mm., shell thick. Intestine of muskrat. Nebraska. The genus JVicAoifrmirydir is type of the subfamily Trl- FlQ. Si 5. TridteilrniatMi tAfuTBark PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS 5*3 14 (9) Hale with bell-shaped bursa encircling posterior end; no supporting ribs in bursa. No buccal capsule. Family Dioctophyicdae Railliet 1915. Month surrounded by one or two circles of iiapulae, 6, n, or iS in Dumber. Esophagus very long, without bulb. One ovary; vagina very Ion*. Vulva near anterior end; anus terminal in female. One long spicule. Eggs with very thick pitted shells. Large worms, in some genera armed with spines near anterior end. Only genus parasitic in North American aquatic hosts. Dioctophyme Collet-Meygret 1803. Anterior end unarmed; mouth surrounded by six papillae. Only species known Diociopkyme renaU (Goeze) 17&2. Color blood red; sir circumoral papulae and 150 along lateral noes. Male up to 40 an. long, 4 to u mm. broad. Anus terminal, surrounded by circular bursa without ribs. Spicule s to 6 mm. long. Female up to 1 m. long, and 12 mm. broad. Anus crescenlic, terminal. Sea pore only 50 to ;o mm. from anterior tip. Uterus single. Eggs oval; shell brown, very thick, deeply pitted eicept at poles. In pelvis of kidney of seal, otter, dog, wolf. etc. Rare in man. Reported from mink and dog in Pennsylvania by Leidy. Found in dogs at Chicago, Illinois. Intermediate host probably a fish. The giant among nematodes; a dangerous and little known parasite. Another form which may belong here was collected in Florida by Wyman from the water-turkey or snake-bird and described as"nearly if not identical with Bustronrytut papillesus Diesing in Ptotus ankinta F1C.S16. DyKbtijm* frolI1 Brazil." The species last mentioned was included in the genus H ^"TXaJwiei Byitrickii by Molin, but as the identification of Wyman was not final andCaandfcr ) il is impossible to enter Hystrichii papiiimut definitely among North American species. 15 (8) Bursa absent or weakly developed in male. True buccal capsule wanting 16 Compare the discussion under a (14) in this key. The caudal alae, often but incorrectly called a bursa, when present consist of long, narrow wings not projecting conspicuously from the body but p»ra|l>l to it and not supported by radiating ribs, but having at most a series of canals at right angles to the body. 16 (51) Very long, slender forms, with or without lips. 17 17 {26) Esophagus slender, simple, no bulb. Super-family Fllarioldea Weinland 185S . . 18 The anterior end is usually plain and no lips are present though in some cases a few minute oral papillae can be recognized. The esophagus has only a single region. The posterior end of the male is rolled into a close spiral of two or more coils. The vulva Lies far anteriad and the forms are usually ovovivi parous. The group as now conceived is much more sharply lim- ited than formerly. t8 (19) Anus wanting in adult; vulva lacking in adult female. Family Dracuncuudae Leiper 1912. The famous guinea-worm of man known since ancient times belongs in this group. After impregnation the sexual pore disappears and no trace of it has been found in the adult. The females grow to a relatively enormous size coincident with the development of great numbers of minute embryos which fill the uterus. The larvae develop in aquatic organisms, prob- ably Copepoda, Ostracoda, etc. Only North American genus Icktkyonema Diesing 1861. Mouth surrounded by four low papillae. No buccal cavity. Esophagus fi origin. One esophageal gland with large nucleus. Poly — * eatvr body, with abort ovary at each end. Embryos dei tnyanan. Ltems broad, traversing ■elop in uterus. No anus, vulva, or 524 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY vagina present in adult. Male much smaller than female; with two spicules and accessory piece. Females parasitic in body cavity of Teleostei. Single North American species recorded. Ichthyonetna cylindraceum Ward and Magath. Male unknown, probably minute. Mature female ioo mm. long, of nearly equal diameter (0.48 mm.) everywhere. Delicate, semi-transparent, and very fragile owing to thin body wall. Lateral lines broad, light colored, conspicuous. No lips or papillae. Esophagus 1.09 mm. long, 0.066 mm. in diameter. Vulva and vagina atrophied, no vestiges discemable. Female unimpregnated; uterus crowded with undeveloped ova rlmost spherical, 44 M in diam- eter. In abdominal cavity of Perca fiavescens; Lake St. Clair. Fig. 817. Ichtkyonema cylindraceum. Anterior end of female. X 35. (After Ward and Magath ) 19 (18) Anus present in adult; vulva persistent in female. Family Filarhdae Claus 1885. A large group not well known and imperfectly subdivided into a number of subfamilies, leaving many other forms still unplaced. Most of the species are connective tissue parasites and the majority inhabit terrestrial hosts. Forms that have not been described from this family exist in North American aquatic hosts. Those recorded are few in number and imperfectly known. The following classification is purely temporary. The genus FUaria has been used as a convenient receptacle for all slender roundworms that did not show conspicuous features of external anatomy adequate to place them definitely elsewhere. Unless the proper location of a species could be determined clearly it has been left under this general heading even though its original location in this genus appears to have been an error. Type genus FUaria 0. F. Miiller 1787 . . 20 Among the forms recorded as "FUaria" are some that have no usable description or in a few cases none at all and must be recognized, if at all, by their host, habit, or geographic location. Such are "FUaria ardearum" Stiles and Hassall 1894, cited from Ardea herodias, in Leidy Collection. FUaria ampkiumae Leidy 1856 encysted in the stomach wall of Ampkiuma means; alcoholic specimens in Philadelphia. FUaria cistudinis Leidy 1856 from the heart of Cistudo Carolina, Pennsylvania. FUaria spec. Leidy 1882, a red worm from the musculature and peritoneum of the black bass. FUaria nUida Leidy 1856 from Rana pipiens; later from fish and reptiles. "Probably young of F. sclUaria. (Two species ?) 20 (25) Anterior end without lips 21 21 (22)' Anterior tip lacks both lips and papillae. FUaria wymani Leidy 1882. No lips or papillae. Female 65 by 0.5 mm., sexual pore pear center (?); viviparous. Eggs 0.02 mm. long; embryos 0.15 mm. Male half as large, with coiled caudal end; one spicule. Coiled on back of cerebrum of Plotus ankinga in Florida. Males rarer than females. Prob- ably not PetecUus (FUaria) kdicinus (Molin i860) with which Leidy later identified it. 22(21) Anterior tip with minute papillae 23 23 (24) Oral papillae in two series of 4 to 6 each. FUaria solitaria Leidy 1856. Body cylindrical, rose-red with more deeply tinged extremities. Length up to i»- From intestine of Amia calm; Lake St. Clair, Michigan, and (After Fairport, Iowa. 33 (32) Mouth with well-developed lips. Male with caudal alae joined anteriorly across ventral surface of body. Physaloptera Rudolphi 1819. Mouth elongated dorsoventrally; bounded by a lateral, thick lips each carrying a toothed process and abroad submedian papillae. Caudal end of male with lateral alae and 10 pain of papillae, of wnich 4 are stalked and in each ala, whereas 6 are sessile and on body. Spicules 1, unlike. Vulva in anterior region. Eggs very thick -shelled. Species reported in North America but not adequately known. 34 (31) Anterior end with sinuous cuticular thickening or cervical frill. Subfamily Acuarhnae Railliet, Henry, and SisorT 191s. Anterior end provided with bands, epaulets, or similar ornaments. Mouth with two simple lateral lips, pharyna and esophagus differentiated into two distinct regions. Caudal end of male with lateral alae; four pairs of preanal papillae; postanals variable. Eggs with thick shell, containing embryos when deposited. Indigestive tract of birds. A numerous and varied group. Only genus yet recorded in North American aquatic hosts. The cervical frill consists of two or four simple or complex loops draped from the tip of the head back over the anterior region ol the body. Vulva in posterior region. Two unequal spicules. In esophagus, crop, or gizzard of birds. Often called Ditpkarapu in records. 35 (36) With trifid cervical papula. . . Acuoria triattwdta (Wright) 1870. Male unknown. Female 10 mm. long, 0.43 mm. broad. With cervical frill; lateral loops 0.18 mm. from anterior end at top and extend 0.40s mm. poatcriad. Cervical papilla a trident spine, at base 0106 mm. from end of frill, and 0x6 mm. long. Eggs aj by 18 ft. Single female taken from t 31 from gizzard of Bdaunu minor in Canada by R. Wright and described as Filaria IriaemcJui. PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS 5^7 3^ (35) No trifid cervical papilla present. Acuaria ardeae (A. J. Smith) 1008. Male unknown. Female 17 by 0.7 mm. Two lateral Hps, each with double papillae From base of each Hp two prominent submedian ridges on surface extend posteriad nearly to center of body, then dorsad and ventrad respectively to join similar fines on opposite side. Esophagus 2 mm. lone, in two sections: anterior narrow region 0.8 by 0.05 to 0.09 mm., posterior wider region 1.2 by 0.2 mm. Anus 0.35 from tip of tail which is bent strongly dorsad. Vulva near center of body ; no eggs developed. In Arde* keroiUt. Described originally as Dispharagus ardeae by A. J. Smith. 37 (30) Preanal papillae in male numerous, grouped in pairs and stalked. Family Thelaztidae Railliet 1916. Head naked or provided with cntinilar thickenings or helmet-like covering. Mouth with 2 to 6 very small tips or without any, followed by a long vestibule or a short buccal capsule. Esophagus composed of two distinct regions. Males with or without lateral alae in caudal region, with a linear row of numerous preanal pa pillar, often paired; postanal pa pillar less 2 spicules, almost always unequal. Female with double uterus; vulva variable numerous; in location. Oviparous or viviparous. Only genus in North American aquatic hosts. Cystidicola Fischer 1797 . No vaBd record exists for the European C. f ononis in North America. 38 (39) In air-bladder of salmonid fishes. 38 Cystidicola stigmatura (Leidy) 1886. Length: male, 12 to 25 mm.; female, 20 to 40 mm. Width: male, 0.25 mm.; female, 0.45 mm. Mouth circular with 2 minute lateral teeth. Buccal capsule tubular, 0.12 to 0.24 mm. long. Anterior region of pharynx 0.5 to 0.6 mm. by 0.054 mm., posterior region 2.1 to 2.4 mm. by 0.1 mm. Male with narrow lateral membranes on caudal end ; 5 pairs of single postanal papulae, 9 pairs of double preanal papulae. Two unlike spicules; one slender 0.8 to 0.9 mm. long, o.oi mm. wide; other trowel-shaped, 0.16 mm. long, 0.18 mm. wide. Female sexual pore near center of body; Ova thin X8s- Fig. 820. Cystidicola stigmatura. Anterior end of female. (After Ward and Magath.) uterus with anterior and posterior branches both well developed and symmetrical. shelled, containing developed embryo when laid, 44 by 27 /*. In air-bladder of Great Lakes trout, white fish, and lake herring. Lake Erie, Lake St. Clair, Lake Michigan, Lake Ontario (Leidy). In half or more of fish examined. Reported by Wright as Ancyracanthus cystidicola and by Leidy as FUatia stigmatura. 39 (38) In heart of white fish Cystidicola serrata (Wright) 1879. Length n mm. With several small teeth around anterior end instead of two as in former species. Only a single specimen found by Ramsay Wright at Toronto. Perhaps an imma- ture specimen, either migrating in blood stream, or accidentally introduced into this peculiar location. 40 (29) Male with conspicuous ventral ridges near posterior end; preanal papillae absent or inconspicuous. Body spinous. Spinitectus Fourment 1883. Mouth without lips or papillae. Except at extreme tip the body is encircled in the ante- rior half or more by rows of spines pointing backward. The ventral surface in the male carries several parallel series of rugosities just anterior to the anus. Representative North American species. Spinitectus gracilis Ward and Magath. Mature female 17 to 19 mm. long, 0.14 broad; male 12 mm. long, 0.075 nun. broad. About 130 rows of spines with 40 to 50 in each row. • Anterior tip free from spines for 0.12 mm. in 528 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY female, o.i in male. Vulva one-fourth total length Irom caudal tip. Spicules two, large, heavy, unequal. Ova 41 by 14*1, thick-walled. In intestine of black ciappie, 9heepshead, and white baas at Fairport, Iowa. Abundant. Fig. 811. Spinittct*! gracilii. Anterior end of female, X 110. (After Ward and Maaath.) 41 (28) Posterior end in female modified to form a sort of sucker by which the parasite is attached to the stomach wall. Hedrurii Nitzsch 1821. Head with 4 lips: 1 lateral, slender, each with 1 papillae; 1 median, thinner, overlapping laterals almost completely. Vulva near anus. Tail of female modified to form with included spine, the caudal tip, an adhesive organ or sucker. Eggs elliptical, with lid-like areas at both pointed poles, contain developed embryos, Male spirally wound around female. Tail strongly compressed laterally: 6 pairs postanal papillae, 1 pair just preanal. Spicules a, similar, very short, apparently grown together. Type species Hedruris andropkoro Nitzsch 1&21. Also recorded Bedruris siredtmis Baird 1858. 43 (27) Anterior end provided with heavy, lateral, valve-shaped lips. . . 43 43 (48) Lips red or brown, very conspicuous. Esophagus with two well differentiated, distinctly separated regions. No preanal sucker in male. Family Camallanidae Railliet and Henry 1915 . . 44 Body nearly cylindrical, with heavy oral armature having the appearance of a bivalve shell, which is really > thick, lateral, valve-like lips probably functioning as jaws and not a buccal cap- sule. Each valve marked by longitudinal ridges terminating at the inner margin of the mouth in minute teeth. Mouth an elongated oval; inner opening of oral cavity to esophagus round, encircled by heavy basal ring of cbjtin. Several (3 to 4) heavy chitinous rods diverge from common center at each side of capsule along sides of body beneath cuticula, forming a fork Esophagus bipartite, anterior region muscular, club-shaped; posterior dark, granular (gland- ular?); valve to intestine. Tail of male surrounded by narrow, poorly developed caudal alae with stalked papillae. A single spicule with accessory piece or two nearly equal spicules. Female sexual pore towards center of body. Viviparous; embryos develop in Crustacea and insect larvae. Parasitic in alimentary canal of fishes and reptiles. Single genus known Camullanus Railliet and Henry igrs. These forms are often cited as Ciuidiaina and Dacnitii. Railliet and Henry have recently deartd. up the confusion previously e listing in tie group. PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS 4 (45) With anterior end bent ventrad. Camattanus ancylodirus Ward and Magath. Mature female is mm. broad. Oral armaiui 0.187 mm. broad; in male 1. long, 0.J6 mm. broad; male 15 mm. long, 0.3B - femalr o.i4i to 0.168 mm. long by 0.18 to 6 mm. long by 0.11 mm. broad. Trident andinmaleo.iSmm. long. Spicules nearly I. Vulva three-fifths of length from anterior end. intestine of German carp. F airport. Iowa. j. 811. Ctmailaami awrsfcaUnw. Head ot male. X Jo. (Alter Ward and 45 (44) With anterior end attenuated, not bent. . 46 (47) Vulva one-third total length from anterior tip. No spines on caudal tip CamaUanus oxycephalies Ward and Magath. Female slenderer than preceding species, 35 mm. long, 0.17 mm. broad, straight through entire length. Oral armature smaller. First esophagus 047 by 0.085 nun.; second 0.57 mm. wide, link unknown. In intestine of white bass and blade crappie. oxyttpkaluM. Anterior part of (After Ward and Magath.) 47 (46) Vulva behind center of body. Three small spines on caudal tip of female Camallanus trtipinosus (Leidy) 1851. Mouth huge, valves with 8 radiating lines on each side of unstriated median band, making 16 rays on each valve. Male 6 mm. long, 0.1 1 to 0.16 mm. broad. Anus 0.08 mm. from caudal tip. Two spicules, 0.1a and 0.43 mm. long. Female 11 mm. long, 0.34 to 0.17 mm. broad. First esophagus 0.38 by 0.11 mm: second 0.46 mm, long. Anus 0.021 mm. from caudal tip which bears three minute points. Vulva with prominent lips. In snafj mtestine ol Emyi guttata. E. rdiiidala, E. tcrpala, Ckdydra terpailimt. Philadel- phia ILbdy). o?body ) Lips not conspicuous: esophageal regions similar in structure, not sharply separated. Male with preanal sucker. Family Cucullanidae Stossich 1808 . . 49 h elliptical, with long axis dono-ventrat, bounded by two lateral valves recalling those "" Esophagus pestle-shaped but without bulb, two regions appear alike in ' " ' ""bout caudal alanj two >t far from center There are in North Ameri 1 numerous species of this genus. Only a * have been described and aanjgnrrr to the Heterakidae. Spicules o.B! 530 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 49 (50) With anterior end bent dorsad. No intestinal cecum present. Cucuttanus 0. F. Muller 1777. Anterior end flexed dorsad 60 to go degrees. Spicules with accessory piece. Ovary double. Representative species in North America. Cucuttanus clitettarius Ward and Magath. Body uniform in diameter except [or clittllar-like swelling 1 mm. long, and 1.5 nun. from anterior tip. On each oral margin three small papillae. Male 10 nun. long by 0.38 mm. broad. Esophagus 1.45 by o.ia to on mm. Spicules gouge-shaped, 1.61 by 0.035 mm.; accessory piece dagger-shaped, 0.06 by 0.015 mm. Two small preanal papillae; 4 pairs of postanal!. Females ii to 17 by 0.5 mm. Esophagus 1.6 by 0.13 to 0.31 mm. Vulva two- thirds of length from anterior end. Uterus and ovary double. Ova 63 by 46(1. In intestine of lake sturgeon; Lake St. Clair. 50 (49) Anterior end straight; well-developed intestinal cecum present. Dacnitoides Ward and Magath. rior tip is not flexed, an accessory U developed. The intestine pos- sesses a prominent cecum extending anteriad to the nerve ring. Representative species in North America. Dacnitoides colylophom Ward and Magath. Male 4 to 6 mm. long, 0.1 nun. broad. Each lateral valve with anterior marginal cuticular thickening bearing 3 papillae. Esophagus 0.5 to 0.6 by 0.06 to 0.11 mm. Boundary between esophageal regions at nerve ring. Spicules 0.89 by 0.005 mm. Caudal papillae: one pair on anterior margin ' it pairs between sucker and anus, a single medial papilla just .us and four pairs postanal. . , to 5.5 mm. long, 0.1B mm. broad. Anus 0.14 from posterior 4 slender spines midway between. Vulva one-eighth of total length behind center of body. Posterior uterine branch has no ovary. Ova 65 by 40 ft. In intestine of yellow perch and wall-eyed pike; Lake St. Clair. Fig. 8iuu Dacniloida Gattfopkora. Head of female, ibowfof oral armature, ajn^iafaal niions. intestine, cecum, and anterior coils of ovary. Xj;. (After Ward and Megaih.) 51 (16) Stout bodied forms with conspicuous lips 53 52 (55) Two heavy lips. Body covered on anterior region at least with dentate or spinous plates. Family Gnathostokotae Railliet 1893. Body covered in whole or part by circles of dentate cuticular plates. Anterior tip enlarged, provided with simple spines, separated by nuchal constriction. Two large fleshy Eps. Esophagus large, muscular: Vulva behind middle of body. Two equal spicules. No buna. In male two pairs of preanal papillae and two postanals. Type genus Gnathostoma Owen 1836 . . 53 Entire body or anterior end covered with abundant spines, often many pointed. Head separated by circular constriction, with circles of simple spines. Two large, fleshy lips. Spic- ules 1, unequal; vulva behind center of body. Male with two piirs of postanal*. Two species reported from North American. 53 (54) Anterior plates palmate with eight spines each. Gnathostoma horridun (Leidy) 1856. Female 66 mm. long. 3 mm. broad. Male unknown. Taken from stomach of Alligator miiiiisippitniis in Georgia and originally described by Leidy as Chciracaathiu korridus. 54 (S3) Anterior plates tridentate. . . . Gnathostoma socialt (Leidy) 1858. Female 30 mm. long, 1.5 mm. broad. Mate 14 mm. long, 1 mm. broad. Taken from stomach of mink (Palatini vision) in Philadelphia and orig Leidy as Cheiratanthui jxiatit. PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS 53* 55 (52) Relatively thick, heavy-bodied forms. Mouth with three lip*, mor* or less conspicuous. Always oviparous. Superfamily Asca&oidea Railliet and Henry 1915 . . 56 dorsal and two smaller ventral tips, right and left erf medial fine; srenndary fin may be intercalated. Buccal capsule never present. Dorsal tip bean regularly and ventral tips one each. lips rarely greatly reduced (or absent?). 57 58 two 56 (68) Polymyaria. Usually arge opaque species. For discussion of term Polymyaria see page 515. 57 (67) lips prominent. No ventral sucker in male. Family Ascarxdae Cobbold 1864 Male usually has two spicules. Female with abruptly conical posterior end. Type genus. Ascaris Linnaeus 1758. No fringes or trntaclrs on the tips. A large and complex group. Differentiated usually on the basis of the form of the lips which present many inorfnvarions in minor drfaih A number of forms have been recorded under the name Axons which are so described that their exact systematic position must depend on their rediscovery and study. Such are: Ascitis Umga Lady 1856 of which a single female specimen was taken from the of the wood ibis in Georgia. Ascmis pemUs Lady 1&86 from the mtntme of the terrapin. Ascitis cyimdriit Lady 1S49 ^roni the mfrsrinr of Hdix dUmaLa m Pennsylvania. Ascmris rwfrswfar Lady 1851 from the lungs of Rama kaUcina, which the description says is "not Ascitis msgmemtsa Zeder ' f — An&aitama nitrovenaiwm q.3.). Ascmis UmmicaUis Rudoiphi iSro, from the stomarh and intestine of AUnstar Mississippi- emsis at encysted on viscera. Reported frequently. Probably most of these do not belong in the genus Aiosris in the strict sense ae*i very Beefy not at the family of the Ascaridae as at present drfinrrf These species are not well knows and often deter mil minn* have evidently been baaed on general factors that are not tnriy 58 (59} Lips relatively small without intermediate lobes; dental plates serrate edges on inner margins. Asearis lanceolate Moim i£6a 59 '£*, 60 64/ 61 '62. 63, Tail of maie wjih 5 pairs o£ postanal papillae Asoz, Male 20 to 25 by 9. 5 am.: female 25 to isbyoJS bwjl Lips mzch 5ke *brj*t 'A Heterskis. IvL 'A maie with oval groove on verbal wcrUrjt. ssA psraflrf lMxa?£admai furrwrs en. dorsum: lateral 21 tbese auererr *r^-rliJ"' Wds wcakiy developed alae ?. . Papulae: a.v^t rj. preaual ssd 12 postanal wan. one vm 'A >jear ja^flTa^ a an arc, Li st.jma.is -^ A£i{jLtr nune»;^nn; Georgia. Fan fix- AscsrislsmoMUU. LnoaixQ 3mer aspect- X fat *ta3rf:na£e- Xi A&crml'aacabj . . 60 Lips well developed: whh cserraediare lobes or zEeriabta. Wxh serrate dental ptees cc irjer Swrder of cpa. . . , Kafie *$ xbs. 5«ur 5»xa> yr v. :/ae am. > fefiy at^esiase aatierirjrir. -Satxr^iT txl&L L , -rery jacpt. texasr-na^- j->>»* iu5&zaczr k&s5aeam T*r7 ima.T Ttd -A mstjt wxa. 5 'pjeja&L taut jubsj ae£* ^rasa**. &ana FSi hr*r Axsne xf it*. 532 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 62 (61, 63) Tail of male with 4 pairs of postanal papillae. Ascaris ardeae Smith 1908. Female up to 80 mm. long and 1.8 mm. broad. Head rounded with 3 prominent lips and well-marked int erlabia. Superior lip with finely denticulate anterior and lateral borders. Tail acutely conical, vulva 30 mm . from head . Ova o. 1 05 to o. 1 1 mm. by 0.096 to o. 1 mm . ; shell colorless marked by thick-set pits. Male 72 mm. by 1.5 mm. Spicules double, equal, brownish, 1 .3 mm. long. Tail incurved, bluntly rounded with small acutely conical tip. Papillae: 2 pairs on conical tip also 2 pairs postanal and 5 pairs or more preanal. In. Ardea herodias. v 0 - . . . t * 1 • Much like i4.$er£en/«/itfRudolphi reported by Leidy «f -nJLw Ja S^^Ti^^lfZ irom ***** host- Probably Leidy 's record concerns this ttft i^&tSSJSC ■«** The true A. serpentulus was collected by A. Ventral surface of male tail. (Note the J- Smith from a European crane in the Philadelphia second pair of papillae from tip of tail as Zoological Gardens, uncertain.) Magnified. (After A. J. Smith.) 63 (6 1, 62) Tail of male with 3 pairs of postanal papillae. Ascaris microcephala Rudolphi 1819. Male 15 to 45 mm., female 45 to 70 mm. long. Body greatly attenuated anteriorly. # Lips quadrangular, with anterior margin concave and angles projecting. Interlabia as long as lips. Cer- vical papillae in dorsal and ventral lines. Tail of male obliquely truncated; papillae small, 3 postanal and 31 preanal. Ova 72 by 59 M- In crop, esophagus, stomach and intestine of various herons, and bittern. Florida to Canada. Fig. 827. Ascaris microcephala. Dorsal view of head. Magnified. (After von Linstow.) 64 (60) Without serrate labial plates 65 65 (66) With interlabia Ascaris hdicina Molin i860. &> Male 6 to 8 by 0.1 to 0.2 mm.; female 13 to 28 by 0.3 to 1 mm. Three interlabia. Lips almost quadrangular with auricles on anterior corners. Tail of male with 5 postanal and 4 large lateral preanal papillae. Vulva an- terior, or almost in center of Dody. In stomach of Alligator mississippienis. Fig. 828. Ascaris hdicina. Dorsal lip, inner aspect. X 55. Tail of male. X85. (After von Drasche.) 66 (65) Neither interlabia nor dental plates in oral armature. Ascaris mucronata Schrank 1790. Length 52 mm., breadth 0.75 mm. Body much attenuated anteriorly. Lateral membrane broad on head, disappears on neck. Greatest breadth of upper lip twice its length; base broader than anterior margin; lateral margins divided into anterior straight and posterior arcuate portion. Tail of male with 2 rows of preanal papillae on each side. From Alligator mississippiensis. Listed by Stiles and Hassall in Leidy Collection. 67 (57) Lips distinct, not large. Male with ventral sucker near anus. Family Heterakjdae Railliet and Henry 191 4. None known from aquatic hosts. Likely to be confused with CucuUanus (cf. page 530) which has a preanal sucker without horny ring. There are in North America numerous species of this genus. PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS S3] 68 (56) Mcromyaria. Small transparent forms 69 For discussion of term Meromyaria see page 515. 69 (70) Without esophageal or intestinal cecum. Family Oxyurjdae Cobbold 1864. The few North American records ca tinction between this family and the n< originally. Among forms recorded from North America which cannot be placed at present owing to imperfect knowledge of their structure are: Oxynrir dubia Leidy 1B56 reported from Bufo amcricanta and Salamondra rubra. Male unknown. North American genus. Spironoura Leidy 1856. Mouth surrounded by circular, papillated lip. Tail of male spiral, acute, tuberculate. Spicules two, curved, ensiform, costate. Tail of female conical, acute. Vulva at posterior third. Type species Spironoura gracile Leidy 1856. with two rows of three papulae on tail. Found Also recorded Spironour a offine Leidy 1858. 70 (69) With cecum on esophagus or intestine, or on both. Family Heterocheixtdae Raiiliet and Henry 1915 . . 71 71 (74) With papillae on tail of male and with ceca on both esophagus and intestine Conlracoecum Raiiliet and Henry 191a. 73 C73) Without circle of spines on tail. Conlracoecum spiadigerum (Rudolphi) 1809. diverticulum at anterior end. Tail ith 7 postanal papillae many (±40) preanals in 1 lateral series. Spicules very OTg, usually well extended, and recurved. Vulva anterior. Ova irregularly reticulate Reported by Leidy in 1856. 1881, and 1S68 __ . _ . .. ,. . . from the stomach of cormorant, white and ^J?»&£Er&&i£^*£S*i"* b^w^pelicans, and water torkey. Florid* 73 (72) With circle of spines on tail. Conlracoecum adunca (Rudolphi) 1809. Male so to 31 mm., female 30 to 6s nun. long. Weak lateral cuticular membranes. Linstow says interlabia are present. Esoph- agus with cecum extending posteriad 0.6 mm., and intestine with similar extension 0.41 mm. anteriad. Tail of male short, conical, coiled; 17 preanal papillae in simple scrip., and 3 postanals. Tip of tail ringed with fine spines. Spicules long (1.91 mm.), equal, some- what enlarged at proximal end. In inte9tine and pyloric appendages of shad. Pennsylvania, *fK' 8j'rimiiT'"1*'^'"3 Maine. Probably of marine ongin though taken from fish in fresh ™" l'' Alter "■*"■ 534 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 74 (71) Without papillae on tail of male and with single intestinal cecum. Hystsrolhylacium Ward and Magath. Anterior tad with narrow lateral wings. Lips three, not prominent. Esophagus long, ■lender, with terminal bulb. Intestine with short simple cecum at interior end, extending posteriad. Males with two equal spicules. Females unknown. Type species. . . Hysterothylacium brockyurum Ward and Magath. . „_ „. ... .. 1, broad; bulb with three U mm. Spicules 0.71 mm. long, 0,045 nun. wide. Pyrifon In stomach of black bass; Lake St. Clair. 75 (7) Esophagus slender, non-muscular; lumen a capillary chitinous tube traversing a row of granular cells. Suborder TrichoByringata . . 76 76 (77) Anus lacking; alimentary canal non-functional in adult. Adults free living Family Mebwteidae Braun 1883. These forma are only distantly related to aquatic biology as the adults occur free in soil, or lets often on plants as the famous "cabbage-snake." The early life is spent as a parasite in the body cavity of some insect or crustacean from which they occasionally escape into an apple or other peculiar environment. They ai , — - -._. r, greatly elongated, threadworms in which the alimentary canal is transformed in the adult into a fat body. The eggs are spherical, with two peculiar stalked. tasselated appendages at the poles. The adults are fully considered in the chapter on Free- living Nematodes (consult page 503). The Mermithidae are often confused with Goidiacea to which they bear a certain superficial resemblance. The differences are discussed later (page 535). 77 (76) Alimentary canal complete and functional. Adults always para- sitic. . . Family Triciclvellidae Stiles and Crane 1910. Esophagus formed by capillary tube traversing chain of cells. Anterior region of body slender, posterior region swollen. Anus terminal. Male with single spicule (or none?). Female with one ovary. Vulva near junction of anterior and posterior body regions. The well known human parasite, Tritkmetla spiralis, commonly called trichina, is included in this group though in another subfamily from the following. Subfamily Twchukdjae Ransom 1011 . . 78 78 (79) Anterior region ol body very slender and much longer than posterior region Trichuris Roederer and Waglcr 1761. In North American aquatic host. Trichuris opaca Barker and Noyes 191 5. Male 11 to 18 mm. long; anterior region 13 to 19 mm, ng, 0.06 to obS mm. thick; posterior region 7 to 9 mm. ng, 0.14 to 0.16 mm. thick. Spicule 1 mm. long; sheath 18 nun, long, 0.07 mm. in diameter. Female 91 to 30 mm. long; anterior region 18 to 19 — by 0.06 to 0.07 mm.; posterior region 10 to 11 mm. 13 to 0.15 mm. Vulva between first and second an- terior eleventh of posterior region . Duodenum of muskrat. Nebraska. Fib. *ji. TricJmri! tpaca. Foaterior end of mak. X so. PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS 535 79 (78) Anterior regno not modi slenderer than posterior region and equal to it in length or shorter. CaptUaria Zeder iSoo. In North American aquatic host. C*ap2iari& ramsrmia Barker and Xoycs 1915. 19 Id jo bb.: oreadtfe of suit 001 to 005 bdl of fcsnafe 0022 to 0065 of sale sanJL wilii 2 b&eral kites. Spicale 1 .56 nniL long. o~ao? sbml broad. V is minim fcnrta of bodv. Eqs ojd? by 0.0: mm. wiiii puBuiirin of GORDIACEA The Gordiacea are familiar to all as the hairwonns or "hair snakes'' frequently found in the country in drinking troughs, springs, brooks, ponds, or indeed any body of water, large or smalL In general appearance these worms are very much like the nema- todes but the more fully their internal organization has become known by study the less they seem to resemble that group in de- tail, and the present tendency is to separate them as an independ- ent class. Some even make the group an independent phylum. The body resembles a bit of fine wire or a tough root fiber in appearance. It is nearly cylindrical, usually with blunt or rounded anterior end and a caudal extremity of modified form, often swollen, lobed, or curled in a loose spiral. Certain nematodes, especially Mermis which occurs free in sofl in the adult stage, resemble the hairworms so much externally that they are often confused with them. The two differ greatly in internal structure and somewhat in less important external fea- tures; but by their pointed anterior end. tapering body, and smooth, finely striated and somewhat transparent cuticula the true nematodes are usually easily distinguished from the Gordi- acea with blunt head, cylindrical body, and roughened, ordinarily also papillate, irregular cuticula. Mermis in particular is most readily distinguished by the pointed posterior end and when alive by the active anterior region. In the Gordiacea a single orifice serves as the common outlet of the reproductive and alimentary systems, alike in both sexes; it is located near the posterior end. There are no lateral lines and the male never possesses spicules. These animals are so opaque that little or no internal structure is visible on examination either with the naked eye or with the 536 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY aid of a microscope. The most of the features on which classifi- cation is based are external and must be regarded as arbitrary and trivial. The internal structure can be studied only with difficulty by complicated technic and may be passed here without description. In one respect the Gordiacea differ from the parasitic worms heretofore considered: the adults are free-living and it is only the young stages which carry on a parasitic existence. Probably the free aquatic stage is merely a reproductive period, even though it is prolonged for several weeks or months. The worm when loaded with eggs is round and plump, but the spent female is often wrinkled and flattened. - Gordius deposits its eggs in a long white or grayish cord which may be several feet long and apparently many times the bulk of the female worm. In some species the cord breaks up into shorter pieces. The worms are often observed in knotted masses, con- sisting of two or more worms coiled together. In some cases at least they are coiled about the egg strings and remain for many days in this position, thus in a sense exercising protection over the developing embryos. It is commonly said that the Gordiacea de- posit their eggs in brooks or other running water, but I have found some species in abundance on water plants and in knotted masses along the shore of Lake St. Clair, Lake Erie, and Lake Michigan. Rarely I have seen a conspicuous windrow of adult worms and egg masses extending for some distance along the water's margin of an inland lake and probably washed up there by wave action. The minute embryo (Fig. 832) which hatches from these eggs after a brief period possesses a conspicuous proboscis and set of hooks at the anterior end. By no. bji. Embroyo of Pafiiiu- this powerful boring apparatus the em- •cnni With Intended piobuKB. X IOOO, c ° # rr f (After Montgomery 1 Drvo forces its way into some aquatic insect, often the mayfly larva. Further changes are not known except that in the body cavity of various adult insects, such as PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS 537 beetles, grasshoppers, and crickets, are found well-grown and nearly mature larvae of the hairworms. On escaping into the water from these insects, the worms become sexually mature and the cycle is completed. Villot denied the necessity of an intermediate host, but others have held that the hairworm undergoes two and per- haps more changes of host during the complete life cycle. When the worm escapes from an insect it swims about actively in the water but even where the capillary esophagus is not closed so that the taking of food is absolutely precluded, the worms probably take no nourishment in the aquatic stage. Hairworms in an early or late larval condition have been re- corded as parasites not only in the insects cited above but also less frequently in spiders, oligochaetes (Lutnbriculus) , snails, and rarely in distomes, fish, and amphibians (?). In the last three types their presence is no doubt purely accidental. Adults in the free-living stage have been reported a number of times as human parasites. Here their presence is also fortuitous and is doubtless due to the ac- cidental swallowing of specimens in water or in food eaten uncooked. The number of species of Gordiacea in North America is not large and thanks to the splendid work of Montgomery the group is well known. The following synopsis is based on his papers. The range of species has been somewhat increased by my own col- lections from regions not represented in his records. I have also been given valuable unpublished data by H. G. May. Even yet there are no records from the southeastern or northwestern United States and only a single record each from Canada and Alaska. The absence of records from any region indicates lack of study in that region rather than scarcity of material. Only three well-marked genera are known: Gordius, Chordodes, and Paragordius, all of which are represented in this continent. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN GORDIACEA 1 (8) Anterior region distinctly attenuated, coming nearly to a point; usu- ally lighter than the rest of the body and without a dark ring Chordodes Creplin 1847 • • 2 Caudal end simple, not lobed; in female somewhat enlarged. External surface complicated; several types of areoles present. Because the males and females are distinctly unlike in external appearance they come out as separate groups in the key. The cross references carry the student back to the other sex in each case. It will be noted that the key line which ultimately determines the species is usually in both 538 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 2 (5) Caudal end slenderer than preceding region of body, with tendency to roll into spiral form (Males of Chordodes) . . 3 The cloacal orifice b ventro-median and the ventral surface possesses a shallow furrow or groove from this orifice to the posterior extremity. 3 (4) Cuticular areoles longer than high; small circular pits upon and be- tween them. . . Chordodes occidentals Montgomery 1898. For female of this species consult 6 in this key. Male up to 255 mm. long, 1.5 mm. broad. Color light brown to black; tip of head yellowish white. A western species; Montana, Wyoming, California, Arizona, Texas, Mexico. An Acridiid is known to serve as host for this species. Fig. 833. Head and surface areoles of Chordodes occidentalis £> . Highly magnified. (After Montgomery.) 4 (3) Cuticular areoles higher than long. Chordodes morgani Montgomery 1898. For female of this species consult 7 in this key. Male 64 to 220 mm. long. Color dull chocolate brown, except anterior end which is always white. Papillae of several types; the most regular conical with short spine, and the highest papillae with a few spines on the summit of each being typical. The species manifests a high degree of individual and sexual variation. Recorded from Pennsylvania, Maryland, Michigan, Ohio, Florida, Iowa, and Nebraska. C. puerilis, origi- nally described from two males, belongs here. A Blattid is known to serve as host for this species. r^HMAAJV^WuvuAj ,*M4*A^V^Wuu%%viJu fUhty Fig. 834. Cutkula of Chordodes morgani 9 in transverse section. Highly magnified. (After Montgomery.) Fig. 835. Cuticula of Chordodes morgani $ in transverse section. Highly magnintd. (After Montgomery.) 5 (2) Caudal end swollen, somewhat knob-shaped; also marked off by a slight constriction. No tendency to roll into a spiral. (Females of Chordodes) . . 6 The females of Gordius, which may easily be confused with these, never have more than a slight swelling at the caudal end and this is not marked off by a constriction. 6 (7) Cuticular areoles longer than high; small circular pits upon and be- tween them . . Chordodes occidentalis Montgomery 1898. For male and range of this species consult 3 in this key. Anterior region much attenuated; head pointed. Areoles low. Color yellowish brown with darker neck ring and black mouth spot. 7 (6) Cuticular areoles higher than long. Chordodes morgani Montgomery 1898. For male and range of this species consult 4 in this key. The variable papillae are also noted there. Female up to 222 mm. long. In the largest females the cuticula in surface view is like that of the males, except that the large papillae are leas numerous. Color averages lighter than in the male. PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS 8 (i) Anterior region very slightly or not at all attenuated. Tip white, visually followed by a distinct dark ring 9 9 (10) Anterior region slightly attenuated, tip obliquely truncate; dark ring very broad Paragardius Camerano 1897. Caudal end bilobed in female and only bilobed in male. All males of Gordius also have the caudal end bilobed. Montgomery rightly emphasized the absence of cloaca! musculature in the male and the exceedingly long cloaca in the female as most significant generic features to which the caudal lobes were subordinate in value. For mere diagnostic purposes the latter are convenient. Only species in North America. . . Paragardius varius 'Leidy) 1851- Males more slender and considerably longer than females; up to 35a mm. long, 0.9 mm. (ride; female up to 130 mm. long, 1 mm. wide. The long trilnbed tail of the female, the long cylindrical caudal lobes in the male, the obliquely truncated head, and the usually very dark-colored ring around the head make its identification Montgomery found the larva only in Adnata abbrcviata {GryUus aiiimUi;). Found by Minnie E. Watson in the same host at Urbana, Illinois, and by H. C. May in the same hast and also in .VnwWii! fasciahu at Douglas Lake, Michigan. From New England to New York, Virginia (and southward?: it is reported from Guatemala); also Kansas and California. I have specimens from Lake Erie, Lake St. Clair, Lake an, and Nebraska. ?tg.B;6. ParaftfUtU poriiu. a, lateral aspect of head. X is k and a, m female. Highly magnified. (Alter Montgomery.) (Original.) b, v itilea.) A. surface 10 (9) Anterior region not attenuated, tip usually rounded. Gordius Linnaeus 1758 . . II Caudal end bilobed in male; simple, not enlarged in female. 11 (33) Caudal end bilobed, spirally inrolled. . (Males of Gordius) , , u 13 (13) Arcuate cuticular ridge anterior and lateral to cloacal pore. Gordius aloscensis Montgomery 1907. Female not known; male no mm. long, slen- der, cylindrical. Head rounded. Caudal lobe) *cules. Areoles irregular, in- r dark brown with darker 54° FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 13 (11) No cuticuIaT ridge anterior and lateral to cloaca! pore 14 14 (15) Behind cloacal pore sharp V-shaped ridge. Carditis villoli Rosa 1883. For female of this species consult 3J in this key. This species was described by Montgomery as G. aquatiius. Several subspecies have been distin- guished. In the typical iorm the cuticuls is marked with large light spots. Male up to 655 mm. long, 1.3 mm. broad, equal in diameter throughout; both ends obtuse; no true areoles present. From Canada, New England, New York to South Carolina; westward to South Dakota, Montana, and California; south to Oklahoma, Texas and Mexico. Various Acridiidae serve as hosts for this species. Also found in Locustidae by H. G. May. Fig. S,S. Carina anterior and posterior (Alter Montgomery.} 15 (14) Cuticula behind cloacal pore without sharp, V-shaped ridge. . r which might be confused here is readily distinguishable by the trun- cated anterior end. 16 (17) On each side of cloacal pore a longitudinal line of hairs. Gordius lintaius Leidy 185 1. For female of this species consult aS in this key. Male up to 17S mm. long, 0.6 mm. broad; very slender. Pale Sllow or buff in color; areoles small. Perhaps only a young ■m of G. villeli. Most of the specimens taken from springs. | New York, Pennsylvania, Maryland, Michigan. (After Montgomery.) 18(21) Conical spicules behind cloacal aperture to 19 {20) Caudal lobes short, thick, and nearly conical. Gordius densareolatus Montgomery 1898. For female of this species consult 39 in this key. Male up to 390mm. long, 1.1 mm. broad. Body robust. Conical spines on ventral surface of caudal lobes. Color deep chocolate, with black ring about cloacal aperture. Wyoming, Montana, California. 30 (10) Caudal lobes nearly cylindrical. Gordius iongareolalus Montgomery 1S98. Female of this species unknown. Male 115 mm. long, 0.5 mm. broad. Longitudi- nally arranged elongate areoles charectejistic and _«JU of rounded-conical form without median groove. ^gjjfc^ No hairs between areoles. Color deepoUve brown; —— * tip of head white. California. 1 J ; bead, tall m n a. Maannwd. (Alt PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS 541 21 (18) No conical spicules behind cloacal aperture; caudal lobes cylin- drical Gordius platycephalus Montgomery 1898. For female of this species consult 30 in this key. Male up to 216 mm. long, 1 mm. broad. The flattened anterior end is characteristic, but Montgomery found one specimen apparently of G. densareoUUus with this feature and could explain it only as a hybrid form. Canada, Pennsyl- vania, and Guatemala. Fig. 843. Gordius platycephalus 2; head and tafl in ventral aspect. Magnified. (After Montgomery.) 22 (n) Caudal end straight, not enlarged nor lobed. (Females of Gordius) . . 23 Compare 5 in key. 23 (24) No elevated cuticular areoles on surface of body. Gordius vtiloti Rosa 1882. For male and range of this species consult 14 in this key. Largest female 705 mm. long, 1.9 mm. broad. One variety (G. villoti difficilis Mont- gomery) has cuticular areoles at the ends of the body only. The other varieties are like the males marked with light spots or plain. Montgomery found some points of difference from the European type, and the American form may prove on further study to be a separate species. 24 (23) Elevated cuticular areoles cover the entire surface of the body. 25 25 (26) Paired dark stripes occur in median lines. Gordius leidyi Montgomery 1898. Male of this species is unknown. Female 295 mm. long, 1.5 mm. broad. Sharply dis- tinguished from all other species in the genus by the peculiar truncated form of the posterior end and the two narrow parallel stripes of intense reddish brown in the median line of the dorsal groove. In the Leidy collection; source unknown. Fig. 843- Gordius leidyi 9 ; head and tafl in dor- sal aspect. Magnified. (After Montgomery.) 26 (25) Dark stripes in median lines are lacking . . 27 The unknown female of Gordius longareolatus probably falls here. 27 (30) Areoles not elongated in long axis of body; head not flattened. . 28 28 (29) Areoles dose-set, tending to produce longitudinal ridges. Gordius lineatus Leidy 1S51. For male and range of this species consult 16 in this key. Female up to 283 mm. long, 0.8 mm. broad; like male very slender. Deeper buff color as against the pale, transparent yellowish white of the male. In the female the cloacal orifice is surrounded by a narrow reddish-brown ring. 29 (28) Areoles more or less confluent, tending to produce transverse rows; head usually cylindrical. Gordius densareoUUus Montgomery 1898. For male and range of this species consult 19 in this key. Female up to 395 mm. long, 1.7 mm. broad. Body robust. Head white, followed by light buff ring and broad reddish brown ring; cloacal pore surrounded by thin black ring and broader circular reddish brown area; body generally chocolate or yellowish brown. Cloacal aperture in a ventral depression. FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Areoles not elongated, usually separated; head usually flattened; interareolar groups of fine hairs. Gordius platycephalus Montgomery 1898. For male and range of this species consult 21 in this key. Female up to 335 mm. long, 1.4 mm. broad. Posterior end slightly enlarged. Color brown; tip of head lighter; dark ring around neck. Fig. 844. Gordius platycephalus Q ; head in dorsal aspect, tail in ventral aspect, and surface view of cuticula. Magnified. (After Montgomery.) ACANTHOCEPHALA The Acanthocephala or proboscis roundworms constitute a most remarkable group both in the extreme adaptation to the parasitic habit which they manifest and in the unique structure which pre- sents little or no parallel to any other type of animal. Most of them are small, measuring only a few millimeters in length although the common parasite of the pig, Gigantorhynchus hirudinaceus (commonly called Echinorhynchus gigas), reaches a length of 15 cm. in the male and 30 to 50 cm. in the female. In form they are elongate, roughly cylindrical, or spindle-shaped but with several distinct regions that give the body an irregular form. These regions are a retractile proboscis armed with hooks, a neck, and a body proper. When examined living the body is often flattened or slightly bent, and displays a surface irregularly roughened or marked by transverse ridges of varying size. When removed to normal salt solution or preserved in other fluids, they tend to assume a smooth rounded form, sometimes with slight regular annulations that suggest segmentation but in fact do not extend beyond the dermal layer. At the anterior end the proboscis, which is retractile and in pre- served specimens often partly or wholly withdrawn into the body, presents a variable form being in various species cylindrical, glo- bose, filiform, spindle-shaped, and even more complex; it may be long or short, straight, oblique, or at right angles to the long axis. The particular form is characteristic of the genus or species and useful in diagnosis. The proboscis bears always a considerable number of PAKASIT1C KOCXDWUUIS 543 reuuinl hooks which are arranged in rows. One can distinguish both longitudinal and circular rows and as the hooks alternate they form a i|uiimnnr pattern. The number, form, and arrange- ment of the hooks are again diagnostic features. Usually the hooks are strongly icuiived but they may be almost straight and often the form varies from tip to base of the proboscis. The form of the root is also subject to variation in different species. In a few cases the hooks differ on the dorsal and ventral sides of the proboscis. In most species a neck intervenes between the proboscis and the body proper. It is nearly always unarmed and usually short. At times it is externally very sharply marked ott from the body or agun difficult to distinguish. Internally a cuticular fold or sep- tum divides the hypoderm of the proboscis and neck completely from that layer in the body. The circular insertion of a retractor muscle at tins point also separates these regions from each other. The body proper forms the major part of the animal. It is usually unarmed but may bear small spines of definite form and arrangement on some portion of the external surface. The body wall has on the exterior a thin cutkula which is not conspicuous as in nematodes. The subjacent hypoderm possesses in one group a few very large and prominent nuclei which were seen by early investigators though their true nature was not divined. These nuclei usually show as swellings or prominences on the sur- face. In most Aranthorrphahj however, the hypoderm has many small nuclei which cannot be seen on casual observation. Two elongate organs, the lexnnisd. are projections of the hypoderm posteriad into the body cavity. They originate at the tine be- tween neck and body proper and vary in size and form in different species. Their function is unknown. The body wall contains a system of lacunae which is conspicuous both in living and pre- served specimens as two longitudinal vessels with smaller anasto- moses usually numerous and irregular. The proboscis sheathr usually a closed muscular sac, is attached at the base of the proboscis, or rarely inside that organ. The pro- boscis can be inverted into the sheath; The brain lies within the sheath concealed between the retractor muscles. Its precise loca- tion may be determined by the retinacula, a pair of nerve cords 544 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY passing from it directly through the sheath and obliquely to the body wall. No trace of an alimentary system has been found in the adult or in any stage of development. Nutrition is thus provided for entirely by absorption. The sexes are separate in all cases. The genital pore in both is at or very near the posterior tip. The male is smaller and more slender than the female and often distinguished externally by a bell-shaped bursa that surrounds the genital pore. This is a mus- cular fold which is held within the body except at coition and may be forced out by the contraction accompanying the preser- vation of the specimen. Two oval testes lie usually in the center of the body one behind the other. Farther back is a group usu- ally of a few large cells, the cement glands. Fie. Bit- Acanlkoufikalm nun. Entire male, br, brain; hi, copulatory bum; « cement glaodi; er , cement receptacle; Mr, invcrtor of neck region; I, lemniaau: fit. proboscis receptacle; fit, posterior tests; re, retinacula; rfir, letractOra °[ proboscis receptacle; i(, suspensory ligament; la. anterior teats. X». (After Van Cleave) In the female a ligament extends through the center of the body cavity from end to end. The ovary, which is present only in the larval stage, produces great numbers of ova that later, surrounded by a heavy covering of three distinct membranes, float free in the body cavity. A complicated apparatus known as the uterine bell, located in the body cavity near the posterior end, performs rhyth- mic contractions that discharge from the body all well-developed embryos and return to the body cavity all that are not sufficiently matured. The life history of Acanthocephala is almost unknown. Those parasitic in terrestrial hosts develop probably without any rela- tion to the aquatic fauna as Giganlorhynchus hirudinaccus of the PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS 545 pig finds its intermediate host in terrestrial beetle larvae. Of forms from aquatic hosts it is inferred that the ripe embryos dis- charged into the water with the feces of the host attain by chance a suitable intermediate host which is probably a crustacean or in- sect and in that develop to the end of the larval stage. When this intermediate host is eaten by the final host the parasite reaches the place in which it can complete its development. Almost no records have been published of Acanthocephala from North American fresh-water hosts. My own collections and re- cent papers by Van Cleave, to whom I am indebted also for valu- able unpublished data, give at best an imperfect survey of the field. The system used, which follows in the main Luhe's work, is also confessedly artificial and incomplete. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN ACANTHOCEPHALA i (10) In hypoderm and lemnisci only a few giant nuclei. Family Neoechinorhynchidae Ward . . 2 Primitive Acanthocephala with hypoderm consisting of a syncytium in which are six giant nuclei, ordinarily arranged so that five lie in the mid-dorsal line and one in the mid-ventral. One lemniscus contains two giant nuclei and the other only one. These nuclei are usually conspicuous on external examination. Proboscis sheath contains only a single layer of muscles. Cement gland a compact mass. Neck lacking. Muscles weakly developed. Lacunar system with simple circular conneo tions. 2 (9) Proboscis globose, or nearly so; with three circles of hooks. Neoechinorhynchus Stiles and Hassall 1905 . . 3 Proboscis short, globose, with few hooks. Hooks of anterior row much larger than those id center and basal rows. Cement gland with eight nuclei. 3 (4) Twelve hooks in each circle. Neoechinorhynchus gracUisentis (Van Cleave) 1913. Body small, tapering slightly toward both ends, bent into a crescent. Mature females 1.7 to 4 mm. long; maximum width 0.38 mm. just anterior to center of body. Males 1.5 to 3 mm. long, maximum breadth 0.3 mm. Proboscis slightly longer than wide with con- striction between second and third row of hooks. Hooks delicate, in anterior row curved, 15 to 17/1 long, in middle row 1 2 to 1 5 n long, in basal row nearly straight, 15 to 20/1 long. Embryos spaidle-shaped, 36 to 40 m long by 10 m broad. Fte.845. Ne^cidLkyuclms gracilis,. nJPj^X "* "" * ^"^ ***' UMnoi8Rhreri Probosm, X9s; hooks and embryo., X October to May. 310. (After Van Cleave.) 4(3) hooks in each aide. $ 546 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 5 (8) Terminal hooks over 90 /* long. Embryos under 50 m long 6 6 (7) Body 8 to 32 mm. long. Embryos very small. Ncoechinorhynchus emydis (Leidy) 1852. Body much elongated, cylindrical. Female 10 to 32 mm. long, 0.7 mm. in maximum width. Male 8 to 1 1 mm. long by 0.7 mm. broad. Proboscis globose, 0.175 mm. long. Hooks large, in anterior row strongly recurved, Q5 to 103 m long, in middle row 49 to 59/1 long, in basal row 35 to 54 // long, nearly straight. Embryos very small, oval, 16 by 11 Ab- originally described by Leidy from the in- testine of various species of Emys from „ „-mT ... . ,. «.. Pennsylvania and Maryland. Frequent in Fig. 84^ Neo^furkynckusemydu. Proboscis, Malacodemmys geograpkicus (Lesueur) and XTS; hook, and embryos, X 230. (After Van Pseudemys j^ ^ from thc ^j, ' River. 7 (6) Body 2 to 13 mm. long. Embryos about 40 // long. Ncoechinorhynchus tenellus (Van Cleave) 19 13. Body small, both ends curved strongly ventrad. Postenor two-thirds of body markedly attenuated. Female 3.5 to 13 mm. long, 0.6 mm. in maximum breadth; males 2 to 8 mm. long, 0.5 mm. broad. Pro- boscis nearly cylindrical, 0.150 mm. long by 0.13s nun. wide. Anterior hooks 90 to 1 10 n long, heavy; middle hooks 38/1 long; basal hooks 27/1 long. Embryos 37 to 45 by 12 to 16 m- Flo. 847. NeoecUnarkynckus tenellus. J^gSfej1 &ZJ2P L* ^ "" Marc*UCttc obosds; X 75; hooks and embryo, near Bemidji, Minnesota. Proboscis, X 75 X 230. (After Van Cleave.) 8(5) Terminal hooks usually less than 00 m long. Embryos over 50 n long. Ncoechinorhynchus cylindratus (Van Cleave) 1913. Large, straight-bodied. Female 10 to 15 mm. long, 0.7 mm. in maximum width, just behind proboscis. Male 4.5 to 8.5 mm. long, 0.5 to 0.7 mm. in maximum breadth near anterior end. Proboscis slightly broader (0.172 mm.) than long (0.15 mm.). Anterior hooks 79 to 97 m long, heavy, strongly recurved, center hooks 37 n long, basal hooks 21 to 25/1 long. Em- bryos 49 to 51 it long by 15 to 21 m broad. Fio. 848. Neoednmorkymkus cylindratus. Pro- ^ intestine cf AticropUrus salanundes (La- boscift. X 75; hooks and embryos, X 830. (After <*p). Pelican Lake Minnesota, and of An- Via CkaveO gmUa ckrysypo, Woods Hole, Massachusetts. PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS 9 (a) Proboscis long. Numerous irregula circles of about six hooks each. Tanaorhampkus Ward. The extreme length of the proboscis and the large □umber of hook* serve to contrast this with the previous closely related genus. Hook* Ul the interior row ire not conspicuously larger than those following. The cement gland has 16 nuclei. Only species known. Taiuutrhamphus longirostris (Van Cleave) 1913. Body robust, posterior end flexed slightly ventrad. Females average 6.1 nun. long, and 0.63 mm. in maximum breadth. Males average 4 mm. long, and 0.47 mm. in maximum breadth. Proboscis cylindrical with slight constriction one-third distance from base to outer end, bent ventrad 60 degrees. Hooks in about 20 circular rows of six lo ten hooks each. Anterior hooks 54 u long, successive books gradually smaller until within a few rows of the base where they become abruptly smaller; basal hooks 16 it long. Embryos oval 17 |i long by 8 to in u broad. la intestine of hickory shad from Illinois River; not abundant but probably most frequent in summer and wanting in January to April. Fig. S41). rasMfkntfau iHcfnufrii. Proboscis. ! (After Van Cleave.) 10(1) In hypodenn many small nuclei, not conspicuous externally. . . n The proboscis sac has a double muscular wall. it {36) Proboscis and neck simple, without bulbous enlargement even in fully developed specimens u 11 (37) Hooks in each circular row all alike; no contrast between different sides of proboscis 13 13 (24) Proboscis sheath attached at posterior end of proboscis 14 14 (ig) Body of parasite entirely free from spines at all points 15 15 (16) Retinacula emerge from proboscis sheath at blind posterior end which contains ganglion. Acanthoccphalus Koelreuter 1771. In marine and fresh-water fishes and Amphibia, larvae in Isopoda. Representative North American species. AcanHwcephalus ratuu (Schrank) 1788. Body elongate, club-shaped, largest near neck. Proboscis short, cylindrical. Twelve rows each with 6 or 7 hooks which are 60. 70, 80 and so n long. Embryos 1 10 n long by 13 it broad. This European species has been identified by Van Cleave who showed that it is apparently rare in this country. From intestine of Diemyclyiiu tiridtscens taken near Baltimore, Maryland. 16 (15) Retinacula emerge from lateral walls of proboscis sheath; ganglion distinctly anterior to blind posterior end of sheath. Ediinorhynchui Zoega 1776 . . 17 Neck wanting or very short; proboscis long, cylindrical, bent ventrad. Hooks numerous, much alike throughout eicept that roots grow shorter and disappear in later rows. [n marine and fresh -water fishes. Nearly every new species described from this continent has been assigned to this genus, many of them erroneously. Several good species in North America. Abundant in whitensh and lake trout from the Great Lakes. 7 (i8) Embryos fmti 85 to 108 it long. qlxBca irar nuc; t. dock mju «cm, i-c. concave sat « pun- q t, books from darad.it.. mm side if pnboKB. X 130- (A*** Embryos from 115 to 165 * long. . Eckinorkynckus sahdini Liulins. FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Echinorhynckus thecatus Linton 1892. Body cylindrical , shgtitly curved ; proboscis curved abo. Female 11 toiomm. long; width 0.5 1 to 0.89, ulteriorly 0.8 to i-i mm. in nmknUM, 0.51 to 1 nun. posteriorly. Male 7 to 1 1 mm. lorm - width 0.39 to 0.69 anteriorly. 0.59 to 0.95 iii minimum 1 0.37 to 0.7; posteriorly. Hooks in 14 to 31 traiu- verse and 1 1 longitudinal rows surrounded by prominent cottars. Embryos 8< to 108 « loos by iSiuii^ broad. (GraybilL! In alimentary canal aod body cavity of Mimfltna ieie- win. AmUfpiUa npatris, Amia caJsu. and K*taa iimaJus. Great Lakes and eastern waters. Male 7 to 9 nun. long, 0.81 1 male 10 to 17 mm. long, 1.1 to I armed with 16 circular rows of 8 hooks each. Hooks alternate in adjacent rows. Basal nooks 39 ti long; hooks in middle and anterior it- — long, those with basal processes 83 ti 1 15 to 165 n long by 10 to 15 ■ wide. From lake trout; Lake Michigan. is 441068* I. Embryos iq (14) Spines on body at some point at least, usually at anterior end. . ao 20 (2,1) Body tapers regularly towards both ends. Proboscis in line with axis of body. Posterior limit of spines alike on dorsal and ventral surfaces. 11 21(33) Cement glands tubular. Peiymtr^kms Lfihe tort. Fine spines on skin of anterior body. Jo* behind the aaaat of these spines a coaarjicsons annular constriction. Type species P. ■■arm- IGoese) from various European water birds. At least one species yet sindescribed from North American Anserif onnes. 33 (21) Cement glands irregularly ovoid. (Hales and some females or young specimens.) f 'QicpOis I41be ton. Compare number 33 ■ this key. IV males, the young females and e™ some adwh Irwuk-i of certain species ha»e a probonn that departs only ssnjhtly from the usual type, beaag a Kttht eKhmjrd bos not epispicwanaty PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS 549 set off from the neck. In the type species, Fiiiroliis anatis, a European form not yet definitely icumled for North America, the adult female has the proboscis enlarged to a thin-walled wphrriral bladder which bears the hooks on its anterior aspect in a series of radiating lines. Representative North American species. FUkoUis botuius Van Cleave 1016. TUs peculiar form found in water birds has been reported from the eider (Simmtrria jrtsstri) from Maine. Although the range of the bird carries it (rarely) as far west as Colorado, yet the particular parasite may not be native to fresh waters. Acanthocephala of this general type have been reported from North American ducks under the name of " Echinmhymnmu Fig. 8m. FiiicoUis botuius. Female with tip of proboscis slightly intoned. X to. Male, neck re- tracted, body spines not shown. X 17- (After Van Cleave.) 23 (20) Body club-shaped, anterior end enlarged. Proboscis bent ventrad, forming an angle with axis of the body. Spines extend further posteriad on ventral surface than on dorsal. Corynosoma Liihe 1004. The peculiar form and the unusual distribution of spines on the body serve to identify the members of this genus which is apparently limited in the adult stage to hsh-eating birds and mammals, chiefly seal. The genus is mainly marine but Van Cleave has a record of a species from birds at Yellowstone Lake. 24 (13) Proboscis sheath attached at center of proboscis. Family Centrorhynchtdae Van Cleave 1016 . . 25 The proboscis sheath starts from near the center of the proboscis wall. The mature forms are parasitic in the intestine of birds. 25 (26) Proboscis receptacle two layered: retractors penetrate its posterior rounded tip Centrorkynckus Luhe 191 1. Three long tubular cement glands. Only North American species. Centrorkynckus spinosus Van Cleave 1016. Female 20 mm. long, 0.6 mm. broad anteriorly, 0.5 mm. posteriorly. Proboscis 0.65 mm. long constricted at insertion of proboscis receptacle with hooks of 2 types in 30 longitudinal rows of about 24 hooks each. In intestine of Herodias egretta from District of Colum- bia (?). Fig. 853. Centrorkynckus spinosus. Proboscis and anterior region of body, showing also insertion of proboscis receptacle and location of the retractors of the receptacle with reference to the wall. X 26. (After Van Cleave. ) 26 (25) Proboscis receptacle single layered; retractors pass through its sides some distance anterior to posterior tip. M ediorhynchus Van Cleave 1916. Nerve ganglion near center of proboscis receptacle. In male 8 round or pyriform cement glands. Proboscis hooks distinctly of two types. Proboscis receptacle not cylindrical in form. Known species mostly in land birds but one record concerns the Carolina rail, P or tana earth- lima, that might have been infected from an aquatic intermediate host. 55° FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 27 (12) Hooks not alike on ventral and dorsal surfaces of proboscis. . . 28 38 (29) Hooks differ in form, especially of root, but not in size. Body uni- formly cylindrical or nearly so. Rkadinorhynchus Luhe 191 1. Hooks of dorsal surface with much shorter root, also slenderer and less curved than those 00 ventral surface. In marine fishes almost exclusively, but present in trout from eastern states. Species yet undescribed. 29 (28) Hooks differ noticeably both in form and size. Body very large and slender, with marked enlargement near anterior end. Arkytkmorkynckus Luhe 1911 . . 30 Body in front of enlargement covered with fine spines. Proboscis very loos, enlarged at center, oblique to body axis. Adults in intestine of birds. 30 (31) Hooks on mid- ventral surface of proboscis conspicuously larger than any others. Arkytkmorkynckus trickocepkalus (R. Leuckart) 1893. Body very slender. Length 5 to 8 cm., mm. behind neck with length of 1.6 to 1.4 swelling many dermal spines 28 to $5 p long. 10 transverse rows of hooks. From Florida; host unknown. 0.5 to 0.8 mm. Ovoid _ and breadth of 0.6 to 1-4 Proboscis with 20 longitudinal *>3 to 2.9 Anterior to 19 or 31 (30) Hooks on mid-ventral surface of proboscis not conspicuously larger than others. 32 3* (33) Large hooks exceed 100* in length. Arktfkmorkynckms uncinatus (Kaiser) 1S93. Length 4 to 6 cm-, diameter itou mm. in front of j>»UEu& prominent dumetcr and covered thickly with small tudmal rows of hooks. From Florida; host unknown. Ovoid swelling about 5 it 1 to 1-4 mm Proboscis with iS 0.6 i.y to 2 n and tS 33(32) hooks not more than 50 * long 34 34 (35> Eighteen k>ngitudinal rows of hooks. At ijrfa mm kym ft u brtns Van Cleave 10,16. 6 to is mm- long, 5 mm. wide. Make 5 to 6 nam. 1 to 1.5 mm. wide. Neck naked. Body fast back «f neck with few small w^mm. taobo*cbojG6$mav long, 0^33 mm. wide at bass. 0.19 nam. at tjp, 034 m bryos76to too* bjr 14 to 10^. MwMfc at each pole. j >n> m n m."* * - _ - _ v \OS4WVl *^^^^^**/9 Ftcif*. 4A*er Via OrreJ X«a. PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS SSI 35 (34) Proboscis with sixteen longitudinal rows of hooks. Arhythmorhynchus pumilirostris Van Cleave 19 16. Female up to 30 mm. long, and 1.5 mm. broad. Proboscis 0.45 mm. long, 0.114 mm. wide at base, 0.095 mm. at tip, 0.18 mm. at center. Embryos 65 to 89 m long, 18 fi broad. Middle shell with evagination at each pole. From bittern (Botaurus lentiginoses); Washington, D. C. Fio. 855. Arhythmorhynchus pumilirostris. Profile, anterior end of body- X 95- (After Van Cleave.) 36 (11) In anterior region of mature specimens prominent bulbous enlarge- ment, separated from body by slender cylindrical neck. 37 The bulb is embedded in the intestinal wall or may even be in the body cavity when the slender region traverses the wall connecting with the body of the parasite in the intestine. In handling such material the proboscis may easily be partly or completely torn off, and the para- site is then difficult to identify as the characteristic bulb at least is gone. 37 (38) Bulb consists of the proboscis. Hooks on the anterior face of the bulb in radial lines. . . (Females of) Filicollis Luhe 191 1. Representative North American species. Filicollis botulus Van Cleave 19 16. In females thus far reported under this name for North America the bulb is wanting; it may be present in older specimens and in fact is described in specimens recorded under the name E. anatis which may belong here. Compare number 22 in key. 38 (37) Bulb consists of anterior part of neck only. Proboscis extends an- te riad from bulb. . . . Pomphorhynchus Mont ice lli 1905. Proboscis long, cylindrical, with many hooks. Neck very long, expanded in anterior region, slender, cylindrical in posterior portion. In intestine of fishes; one of the commonest types in European fresh-water hosts. Not infrequent in North American fresh-water fishes; species not described. IMPORTANT REFERENCES ON NORTH AMERICAN PARASITIC ROUNDWORMS GENERAL WORKS See also list in Chapter XIII, page 452 Hamann, O. 1891. Die Nemathelminthen. Heft 1, 120 pp., 10 pi. 1895. Heft 2, 120 pp., 11 pi. Jena. Leuckart, R. 1876. Die menschliche Parasiten. Vol. 2 [Nematoda, Acanthocephala]. 882 pp., 401 figs. Leipzig. 552 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY NEMATODA Drasche, R. von. 1882-3. Revision der in der Nematoden-Sammlung des K. K. zoologischen Hofcabinetes befindlichen Original-Exemplare Die- sing's und Molin's. Verh. zool.-bot. Ges. Wien, 32: 1 17-138, 4 pi.; 33: 107- 1 18, 3 pi.; 33: 193-2 18, 4 pi. Hagmeier, A. 191 2. Beitragezur KenntnisderMennithiden. Zool.Jahrb., Syst., 32: 521-612, 5 pi. Hall, M. C. 1916. Nematode Parasites of Mammals, etc. Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus., 50: 1-258, 1 pi. Linstow, O. von. 1009. Parasitische Nematoden. Stlsswasserf auna Deutsch- lands, Heft 15, p. 47-81. Magath, T. B. 1916. Nematode Technique. Trans. Amer. Mic. Soc., 35: 245-256. Railuet, A. and Henry, A. 191 5. Sur les Nematodes du genre Camallanus Raill. et Henry, 191 5 (Cucullanus auct., non Mueller, 1777). Bull, soc path, exot., Paris, 8: 446-452. Ransom, B. H. 191 i. The Nematodes Parasitic in the Alimentary Tract of Cattle, Sheep, and other Ruminants. Bur. An. Ind., Bull. 127, 132 pp. Schneider, A. 1866. Monographic der Nematoden. 357 pp. 28 pi. Berlin. Seurat, L. G. 1916. Contribution a l'&ude des formes larvaires des N6ma- todes parasites h£t6rox£nes. Bull. sci. France et Belgique, 49: 297-377. Stossich, M. 1896. II genere Ascaris Linn6. 1897. Filarie e Spiroptere. 1899. Strongylidae. Trieste. Ward, H. B. and Magath, T. B. 1916. Notes on Some Nematodes from Fresh-Water Fishes. Jour. Parasitol., 3: 57-64, 1 pi. GORDIACEA Montgomery, T. H., Jr. 1898. The Gordiacea of Certain American Col- lections. Bull. Mus. Comp. Zool. Harvard, 32: 23-59, 15 pi. 1898a. The Gordiacea, etc. Pt. H. Proc. Cal. Acad. Sci., (3) 1: 333-344, 2 pi. 1899. Synopses of North American Invertebrates. H. Gordiacea (Hair worms). Amer. Nat., 33: 647-652. ACANTHOCEFHALA Luhe, M. 191 1. Acanthocephalen. Stlsswasserf auna Deutschlands, Heft 16, 60 pp., 87 figs. Van Cleave, H. J. 1913. The Genus Neorhynchus in North America. Zool. Anz., 43: 177-190. 191 5. Acanthocephala in North American Amphibia. Jour. Parasitol., 1: I7S-I78. Ifcrft.iL.i1.. CHAPTER XVII THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) By H. S. JENNINGS Professor of Zoology, Johns Hopkins University The Rotatoria or Rotifera are perhaps the most characteristic group of fresh-water animals, and at the same time the most attractive and beautiful. They are everywhere abundant in fresh water, but are rare elsewhere. With their varied and fantastic forms, their brilliant colors and lively manners, they have long been the favorites of amateur microscopists. Some of the older observers have expressed themselves with great enthusiasm in regard to these creatures. Eichhorn (1781) who discovered Steph- anoceros in 1761, calls it the "crown polype," and likens this "in- comparable animal" to a pomegranate blossom. Of Floscularia he says, "Now I come to a very wonderful animal, which has very often rejoiced me in my observations: I call it the Catcher: ex- traordinarily artistic in its structure, wonderful in its actions, rapid in capturing its prey." Eichhorn's account of the capture of prey is excellent: "Its head was a widespread net . . . with points which had little round balls on their tips; so it awaits its prey; when a little animal came into this net or hollow basin, then it convul- sively drew the neck a little together, as if to find out, as it were, whether it had really gotten its booty; then it suddenly folded the net together and pushed the prey into its body, where one could still see it plainly. . . . And I have often seen it exactly as in [Fig.] K; then it looked terrible, no lightning stroke can rush from the clouds into the air so quickly as this little animal fiercely struck together the two hooks when it noticed a prey in its outspread net." The rotifers are minute, chiefly microscopic animals. Their most characteristic feature is the ciliated area at or near the ante- rior end of the body, serving as a locomotor organ or to bring food to the mouth. Taken in connection with the lack of cilia on other parts of the body (save in rare cases at the posterior end), this 553 554 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY ciliated area or corona serves as a rule to distinguish a rotifer at once from any other many-celled animal living in fresh water. The extreme diversity of form and organization in different rotifers, though constituting the greatest charm of their study, makes it almost impossible to give a formal definition of the group. Even the most characteristic feature, — the ciliated corona, — is in a few cases lacking. The form of the body varies extremely, from spherical in Trochosphaera (Fig. 947) to the excessively atten- uated form of Rotifer neptunius (Fig. 960), the flower-like shape of Stephanoceros (Fig. 937), or the spiny, turtle-like figure of Poly- chaetus (Fig. 905). Yet one can give a characterization that will be true for the great majority of the rotifers. The body is as a rule somewhat elon- gated, with the ciliated corona at the anterior end ; it is extended at the posterior end, behind and below the cloacal opening, to form a stalk, or tail-like appendage known as the foot. This frequently ends in two small pointed toes. There is a well-developed ali- mentary canal, with a muscular pharynx, containing complex jaws. There is a simple excretory system, while circulatory and respira- tory systems are lacking. The nervous system consists of a prom- inent brain and of certain nerves and sense organs. The sexes are separate, and the male is usually a minute, degenerate creature, lacking the alimentary canal. Rotifera may be found wherever there is fresh water. Lakes, ponds, and streams harbor them in immense number and variety. Swamps and marshes swarm with them. Wayside pools, drains, and even the dirty water that stands in barnyard holes about manure heaps, are prolific sources of rotifers. The mud of eave- troughs, the bottoms of funeral urns, the cavities found in the axils of the leaves of certain mosses, — all these are famous collecting grounds for the rotifer hunter. A few rotifers are parasitic, some externally, some internally. A few live in salt water, but they are much less abundant in the ocean than in fresh water. In giving an account of the structure and life of the rotifers, it will be well to have in mind at first some representative type; then the variations found in other rotifers may be traced. The typical rotifers, as well as the commonest ones, are those belonging to the •Jk* h. . THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 555 great family of Notommatidae, and there is much reason to believe that all other rotifers have been derived from forms essentially similar to those found in this family. The different members of the Notommatidae are so much alike that it is hardly necessary to select precisely some one species for a type. But it will be well in following this account to have in mind such an animal as Proales (Fig. 856), or Notommata truncate (Fig. 857, A and B), or Copcus pockyurus (Fig. 857, C). For convenience one can refer to any member of the Notommatidae as a notommatid. The notommatids, though the most abundant, are as a rule the least conspicuous of the rotifers. They have usually a nearly cylindrical body, often somewhat swollen behind, and with a slender posterior foot (J) ending in two toes (()• Most of them are found swimming about amid vegetation or creeping over its sur- face. Like all other living things, these rotifers are bundles of activity. They are busily engaged in carrying on many processes, 556 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY internal and external; in meeting and solving the problems which the world presents. And it is almost surprising to note, when the matter is first examined from such a. standpoint, how nearly the objects of the strivings of almost any lower group resemble those of the highest. To get proper food and oxygen; to find or construct a proper place to dwell; to arrange for the production and growth of the young; to protect one's self and one's progeny from ene- mies and from the forces of nature, — these, and the activities growing out of them, form the groundwork of life in the lowest as well as the highest creatures. In studying the rotifers, it will be best to look upon them as living things and to ask: What processes and activities are they carrying on? And what apparatus do they use in these activities? Thus, one is led to take up in order the THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 557 various systems of organs, to notice their variations and modifica- tions, and the uses they serve. Perhaps the chief concern of all organisms is to provide material for carrying on the complicated chemical processes that are going on within, — that is, to get food and oxygen. How does the rotifer accomplish these ends? This is done mainly by the aid of the ciliated surface at the anterior end, — the corona. The cilia of this region are fine, hair- like processes which are in constant motion. They strike back- ward more strongly than forward, so that they cause a current to pass backward from in front of the animal to its mouth, and thence over the surface of the body (Fig.858). In the simplest notommatids jSi--" "„-'^>y''r ''£/' '' * &$L \-~rn the corona is a mere flattish disk on the ventral side of the anterior end, covered uniformly with short cilia (Fig. 859) . In other rotifers there are great variations in the size and arrangement of the cilia; these variations will be taken up later. The water current pro- duced by the corona has a number of different uses: 1. It continually renews the water that bathes the surface of the animal, thus insuring a constant supply of fresh oxygen. The oxygen thus supplied is absorbed by the entire surface of the ani- mal, apparently, for there are no special respiratory organs. 2. The current brings to the mouth any particles of food that 558 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY may be floating in the water, or that are easily washed from sur- rounding objects. The mouth, situated in the posterior part of the corona, opens, and so admits or seizes such food as is adapted to the rotifer. In many rotifers the cilia are the chief direct agents in obtaining food, and in practically all species they are either directly or indirectly of the greatest importance for this function. 3. In place of bringing food and oxygen backward to the rotifer, the cilia may carry the animal forward to new supplies of these necessities. This is the case in all free-swimming rotifers; the cilia are the main organs of locomotion. In thus moving the animate about, the cilia of course play as important a part in food-getting as when they bring the food to the rotifer. In most species the cilia act in both ways at once, bearing the animal forward and the food backward, so that the two meet. 4. The water currents remove the products of respiration and excretion, which the rotifer, like other animals, is continually giving off. Carbon dioxide is doubtless given off over the whole surface of the body, while other waste products are discharged by the contractile vesicle (see p. 561). If these waste products were allowed to accumulate, they would be most injurious. While these are the main uses of the cilia, they assist, in a Dum- ber of rotifers, in other important operations, such as the con- struction of a tube or nest. The further course of the food may now be followed. The mouth, situated in the posterior part of the corona (Fig. 859, m), leads into a cavity with thick, muscular walls, known as the mastax (Figs. 856 and 857, mx). The mastax is armed with a complicated set of jaws, which have little resemblance to jaws found anywhere else in the animal kingdom. They are known as the trophi (Fig. 857, A, ft-). THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 559 The trophi consist of a number of pieces, so arranged that two main parts may be distinguished. There is a middle portion, somewhat fork-shaped, which is known as the incus (Fig. 86o, in)f and two lateral parts known as the mallei (ma). In the middle portion or incus may be distinguished a single basal piece, comparable to the handle of the two-tined fork; this basal piece is known as the fulcrum (fu, Fig. 860). The two blade- like pieces resting on it, i.e, the tines of the fork, are the rami (ra). A B m& Fig. 860. Trophi or jaws of rotifers. A , Malleate type. (From Wesenberg-Lund, after Hudson and Gosse.) B, Forcipate type, from Diglena forcipata Ehr. (After Gosse.) /«, fulcrum; in, incus; ma, mallei; mu, manubrium; ra, ramus; un, uncus. The rami are joined to the fulcrum in such a way that they may move back and forth, like the blades of a pair of shears. They often bear teeth. In the lateral parts or mallei one may likewise distinguish two parts. The basal piece, serving as a sort of handle, is known as the manubrium (Fig. 860, mu). Joined to the top of this, but placed nearly at right angles to it, is the piece known as the uncus (un); the two unci usually lie across the tops of the rami, their points meeting in the middle. Each uncus may bear one or more points, or a number of sharp ridges serving as teeth. The food passes between the teeth of the unci and rami and is cut and ground by them. The jaws are worked by muscles which are attached to the manubria and to other parts of the apparatus; these muscles make up the main part of the mastax. In different rotifers the trophi vary much in the form and rela- tive development of the typical parts; this is true even within the Notommatidae. There are two main lines of divergent develop- ment: (1) In many rotifers the parts of the trophi become thick and stout; the unci are broad plates bearing a number of ridges. Such jaws are used mainly for grinding, and are said to belong to the 560 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY malleate type (Fig. 860, A), on account of the great development of the mallei. (2) In other species all parts of the trophi are long and slender; the unci end in a single sharp point, which may be thrust out of the mouth to seize upon living prey. The two rami like- wise form a pair of strong, blade-like jaws. Such trophi are said to belong to the f orcipate type (Fig. 860, B) ; they are found in active rotifers of predatory habits. There exist many modifications of these two types, and many jaws intermediate between the two. Both types of jaws are found in the Notommatidae. The mastax usually bears near its posterior end a pair of small glands that are known as salivary glands (Fig. 856, sg). From the mastax the food passes into the slender esophagus (Figs. 856 and &57> °)y which leaves the mastax on its dorsal side. Through the esophagus the food reaches the large stomach {si), where digestion takes place. Attached to the anterior end of the stomach are the two large gastric glands (gg). From the stomach the undigested remnants of the food pass back into the straight slender intestine, and thence to the outside at the cloaca! opening (c). This lies on the dorsal side of the body, above the foot The body cavity is enclosed by but a single layer of cells, which form the body wall, so that each cell is bathed on its outer surface by the outer water and on its inner surface by the fluid of the body cavity. By this arrangement the processes of respiration are made very simple. Oxygen doubtless passes from the surround- ing water through the single layer of cells into the body fluid, while the waste carbon dioxide produced within is given off in the same way to the outside. The nitrogenous waste products are not so easily eliminated as is the carbon dioxide; for removing these the rotifers have a set of excretory organs. These consist of fine tubules running through the body cavity at the sides of the alimentary canal (see Fig. 857, ex, and Fig. 861). On each side there are usually two tubes, one with thick walls (a), the other with very thin ones (4). These two are usually connected (c) in the anterior part of the rotifer. They commonly bear at intervals along their course certain minute dub-shaped organs (Figs. 857, B\ 861, /c). These are dosed at their bee ends, and contain within them either a vibrating membrane ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 561 or a bunch of long cilia. The membrane or the bunch of cilia is always in rapid movement, giving the appearance of a minute flame, so that these structures are called name cells. The cilia or membrane doubtless serve to propel a current through the tubes. In many rotifers a transverse tube in the head region unites the thin-walled tubes of right and left sides. Often all the tubes are convoluted in their course. There is reason to believe that the walls of the tubes absorb the nitrogenous waste matter from the fluid of the body cavity. This waste matter passes backward, driven by the flame cells, to the region of the cloaca (Figs. 856, 857, c). Here is found in most rotifers a small sac into which the tubes from both sides enter. This sac opens along with the intestine into a small cavity known as the cloaca. The sac, or contractile vesicle (it), as it is called, contracts at intervals, expelling to the outside the fluid with which the tubes FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY a Fio. 86a mill* r 53kr Spiral path followed br rotifer, at teeo in DiwmU (After Jmnfagi ) swim* have filled it. The contractions take place frequently, so that a large amount of fluid is expelled. Besides its organs for the nutritive processes, the rotifer has of course or- gans for causing and controlling move- ments. The chief organ of locomotion is the ciliated corona. By its aid the rotifer may either creep along over surfaces, or swim freely through the water. When swimming freely the ro- tifer usually revolves on its long axis, so as to follow a spiral course (Fig. 862). Changes of form and movements of parts of the body are brought about by many slender muscles (Fig. 857, C, ms). These muscles are either applied closely to the body wall br pass from the body wall through the body cavity to other parts. The muscles are often striated. An important organ for producing or guiding motion is found in the foot with its toes. The foot of the notom- matid is usually short; it is nothing more than that part of the body be- hind the cloaca. It usually tapers somewhat, but is not clearly marked off from the rest of the body, as it is in some rotifers of other families. At its posterior end it bears side by side the tapering, pointed toes, which are usually small in the Notommatidae. The toes serve as a steering apparatus in swimming, and as points of sup- port and attachment in creeping. For attachment the toes are supplied with A ' Li 'fc.-JiwV'* THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 563 two glands King in the foot (Figs. 856 and 857, mg;; these secrete a sticky, tenacious mucus, which may be discharged either at the tip of the toes, or at their base, so as to flow out over their surface. By this mucus the rotifer may attach itself loosely to objects of various sorts, so that the movements of its dlia may continue to bring food to the mouth without carrying the rotifer away from its anchorage. Often the mucus is drawn out to form a long thread, like that produced by a spider; from this thread the rotifer remains as it were suspended, swinging alyvjt from ade to side at a cttsyaiHT from the point of attachment, let i*X breaking away from it comptady. At times the rotifer =pim oat behind it a thread of mncas as it progresses s*ywh- taroczis the water; this thread «*radir* its course a&d keeps ft tocEected with it.* poet of departure. Tbt foot aiad toes are zztKzfj&Z k. zzazr/ ways in *xi&tr For coESritasg ra^Erx. t£e rotifer r-aa a serrwss rritec: acrf a mnntwT ot sense ocgarj*. Tie ciaef ^art rA tie zettta miesi fa. a large gassStic. kaOTti as the bras. V, , 'rnzsx '*- £ie -iaml a&3e. jost aSwyve tie ?ra.*?aT at the anterior ecrL Frrjd tie Irasa nereis psts at nasty dErectiica tr>- tie txtxcs vn&zs. 'A tie borij, Sercral rSSsrent. kiitfa oc *ecse oosxis are rasui it tie roc&n, la sane part ;c tie anterior eni zscaZr? atzacierf; tr> the braacu tftere are usaatlj one *x tw--> red sunrucitt a&cta: tieae are 3C£p#vKd to be oraaas • jf igfit pertepdrai. ami are kar,nrc aa eje-spota * „ la. a wr cases tiree rx sicti^oc tieae in* xjuiuL .V^merimea theer*e- spzes are ice arra»tieri -ilrvjtrr v> tie brain, but art tminei^eri widi it b*r aeries 5ir esaitioie. it tie isniia JfcicpV . The **7»-acr*£a bear 111 tieir «cer5r>r mrtisutes ieaiisciierfcal tTTstaJine femes. In *«ne rotifer* ev«Miy;c* ars jcbtkfxur Itaxrr rocifera bear sense >r2zma >f 7^rfr>na ifnda 'M. the t# rsot 5or exanu&ie the -sx~xul \i .y-mri&v&i Far. % : . ir >f H vuisxx*. Fo& *ria,i2wt rjiifen. AinuMt ail yycten iucji \ ydr \i lease ">rzans -m. tie viies ^f &e liiwtx behirui the miiiile: these m» -ennw^ is the "atarai in- Xsmskst F% l^ C. l*i FJther inncher annsnnft. -ir 1 ^air if them. » &»ntt£ «w the ^nai urfare if the heart. ;ust iivw» the brain : ate kaosra u ±e dEiu3ai aatenaae F!^l iyi aad i^;. to . 564 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The organs of reproduction are still to be considered. Most of the rotifers commonly seen are females, as the males are very minute and rare. In the Notommatidae, as in most other rotifers, there is a single large reproductive body, commonly spoken of as the ovary, or sometimes as the germarium. This lies ventral to the intestine, in the posterior third of the body (Figs. 856 and 857, ov). It consists of two portions, of different functions. The large part contains a small number of large nuclei, often just eight; this por- tion prepares the yolk for the developing egg, so that it is called the vitellarium. At one end or side of this vitellarium is a small mass containing many minute nuclei. From this part the egg develops, the small nuclei becoming each the nucleus of an egg. This part is known as the germarium, since it produces the egg or germ. From the ovary a thin-walled, sac-like passageway, the oviduct, leads backward to the cloaca; by it the egg is discharged. The oviduct can be seen, as a rule, only with great difficulty. In most rotifers the males are small and degenerate. But in some of the Notommatidae, as well as in a few other species, they are nearly as well developed as the females, and resemble them in structure. In Proaks werneckii (Fig. 856), which lives within Vau- cheria filaments, the male is as large as the female, but the ali- mentary canal is not quite so well developed. In Rkinops vitrea (Fig. 863), the male is smaller than the female but not otherwise degenerate, while in the aberrant rotifers known as the Seisonacea males and females are alike, save for the reproductive organs. In most other rotifers the minute males either lack the alimentary canal entirely or have only vestiges of it (see Fig. 864). In all cases in the male in place of the ovary is found a sac, the sperma- rium (sp), in which many spermatozoa are seen swimming about. The sac extends backward as a large tube, ending in a ciliated opening from which the spermatozoa are discharged. That por- tion of the tube bearing the opening may be protruded as a copu- latory organ. The chief structures of a typical rotifer have now been described, mainly as shown in the Notommatidae. Next, the Rotifera as a whole will be surveyed and the different groups examined rapidly to note how these differ from the notommatids and from one an- THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) S65 other. Such a survey gives strongly the impression that the other rotifers have been derived by various modifications from rotifers having in general the characteristics of the Notommatidae. Space will not permit setting forth in detail the grounds for this impres- sion, nor will it allow describing the many forms transitional be- tween the Notommatidae and other groups. But in giving an Pig. 864. Halt ol Copt*! tadryunu Gome, lowing tbKDce of lUmenttxy caul. irr bnii; co.copulitoryornn; if, ipefmi- rium. Xrio. lAlttr Diion-Nutt.Il.) account of the other rotifers, they will be grouped about the No- tommatidae in the way which appears to be called for by the facts.1 1 This follows mainly We sen berg- Lund (1899), who has developed a classification of the Rotifera based on their origin from Notommatoid forms. While this classifi- cation has not thus far been commonly employed, the same can be said of any other classification that has been proposed. The writer is convinced that the classification given by Wcsenbcrg-Lund is the only really natural one and that its use Is a great aid to an understanding of the Rotifera; he has therefore employed it. It should be noted, however, that the arrangement here given differs in many details from that of Wesenberg-Lund, as the advance of knowledge, or the writer's own experien - to require. No scheme of classification can be completely fixed until kno the organisms to be classified is infinitely more complete than is the present knowlet of the Rotifera. oowledn of ; knowledge 566 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY i. Notommatidae. It will be helpful first to notice some of the chief variations of type among the Notommatidae themselves. The simplest, most undifferentiated rotifiers that exist are those commonly classed in the genus Proales. They have small, soft bodies, nearly cylindrical, and obscurely segmented externally (Fig. 856) . The foot and toes are short. The corona is a uniformly ciliated, nearly plane surface on the ventral side and anterior end (Fig. 859). These rotifiers are small, sluggish creatures, very numer- ous, but not differing greatly among themselves, so that the species are hard to distinguish and students of the rotifiers have paid little attention to them. In other species of the Notommatidae the corona has become differentiated in a peculiar way, forming the so-called auricles; these species are classed mainly in the genus Notommata. The auricles are portions of the ciliated area set off prominently on each side of the corona and bearing stronger cilia (Fig. 857, B) ; they serve to enable the animal to move more rapidly. In the simplest cases the auricles are directly continuous with the rest of the ciliated disk, as in Notommata aurita (Fig. 878). In other cases there is a space without cilia between the disk and the auri- cles (Fig. 881). The auricles are commonly kept contracted when the animal is creeping about, so that their existence would not be suspected. But when the animal prepares to swim through the water it unfurls these auricles and sails away. The species of Notommata are more active than Proales, and there are greater differences among the different members of the genus. 2. Synchaetidae. A line of divergence, consisting essentially in a greater development of those characteristics of Notommata which give it rapidity of movement, leads to the production of what is commonly classed as a different family, — the Synchaetidae (Fig. 880). In Synchaeta the entire corona is very large, occupying the large end of the cone-shaped body, while the auricles are highly developed, forming powerful swimming organs which are set off at a distance from the remainder of the co- rona. By the aid of these auricles the species of Synchaeta dash about with such rapidity that they can hardly be followed with the microscope. (See the monographic study of the Synchaetidae by Rousselet, 1902.) & -a£* !L£-«* THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 567 A further development of this line is seen in Polyartkra (Fig. 882). Here powerful swimming organs have developed in the form of appendages along the sides of the body, while the auricles have dis- appeared. The animal never attaches itself, so that the disap- pearance of the foot is complete. In Anarthra (Fig. 885) we find precisely a Polyartkra that has not yet developed the appendages, or that has lost them (?). Synckaeta and Polyartkra are typical open-water rotifers, consti- tuting important elements of the plankton. To introduce the families of Rotifera next to be considered, it is necessary to return to certain features of the Notommatidae. Many of the species of that family show a very slight tendency to a stiffening of the cuticula, so that the body retains a somewhat definite form, often a little angular. Such notommatids are classed in the genus Furcularia (Fig. 870). These are usually more active than Proales or Notommata, and have longer, stiffer toes. By accentuation of these features of Furcularia, and by further spe- cialization, there are formed several families of free-swimming rotifers: 3. Salpinidae. The cuticula becomes more hardened, and three or four longitudinal furrows are formed, one in the dorsal middle line, one on each side, and sometimes a weak one in the ventral middle line. Thus there is produced a sort of armor or lorica, composed of three or four plates (Figs. 886, 887). Such loricas are seen in most pronounced form in Sal pitta (Fig. 886). But every possible intermediate gradation exists, leading from Furcularia to Salpina. The intermediate steps are mostly classed in the genus Diasckiza (Fig. 887) ; here the cuticula is only slightly stiffened, and the longitudinal clefts are little marked. The species of Diasckiza are many of them hardly distinguishable from Furcularia or even from Notommata; they were formerly classed in these two genera. In Salpina the lorica is strongly developed and bears long spines or teeth, Diplois and Diplax stand between Diasckiza and Salpina, having strong loricas but no teeth. There is thus a continuous series from the Notommatidae to Salpina. The Sal- pinidae are common amid vegetation. (See the Monograph on Diasckiza by Dixon-Nuttall and Freeman, 1903.) 568 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 4. Euchlanidae. Another line of divergence leads from the No- tommatidae, probably likewise through Furcularia, to Distyla, Cathypna, Monostyla, and Euchlanis, — forming the family Euch- lanidae. The first steps in this series are seen in those species of Distyla in which the body is soft, wrinkled, and only a little flat- tened (Fig. 890) . In the extended condition these are hardly to be distinguished from small species of Furcularia. But when re- tracted there is a tendency to form lateral furrows along the side, while a sharp edge is seen in front (Fig. 890, B). In other species of Distyla (Fig. 891) these differentiations are permanent and the cutic- ula forms an evident lorica, consisting of a dorsal and a ventral plate. This line of evolution shows its highest development in Euchlanis (Fig. 893). The Euchlanidae are common among aquatic vegetation. 5. Coluridae. This group resembles the Euchlanidae, but has probably developed from the Notommatidae separately. The hardened cuticula here forms a solid lorica, open at each end for head and foot; sometimes the cuticula is not hardened on the ventral surface. A portion of the lorica extends out over the head as a sort of hood (Fig. 901). Metopidia (Fig. 901), Colurus (Fig. 900), and Stephanops (Fig. 899) are the principal genera; they are all minute, creeping about among plants and debris. 6. Rattulidae. A fifth line of divergence leads from the Notom- matidae to the genera Diurella (Fig. 895) and Rattulus (Figs. 896, 897) . The cuticula of the nearly cylindrical body becomes hardened over nearly the entire surface, so as to form a curved, pipe-like structure, with openings for the protrusion of head and foot. The less differ- entiated Rattulidae (Diurella, Fig. 895) resemble greatly the lower Notommatidae, having the cuticula only a little stiffened and toes differing but little from those of Furcularia. But this line runs into extremely bizarre forms. The animals tend to become unsymmet- rical, the organs of the right side being smaller, while the body becomes in some cases twisted into a segment of a spiral. The right toe becomes enormously extended to form a long rod-like structure, while the left toe nearly disappears (Figs. 896, 897). The right side of the trophi (Fig. 898) becomes smaller than the left. The Rattulidae are common among vegetation. (See the mono- graph of this family by the present writer (Jennings, 1903).) THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 569 7. Dinocharidae. Scandium (Fig. 903) is perhaps essentially a Furcularia which has developed a long foot and long toes, for leap- ing (compare Furcularia longiscta, Fig. 871). Dinocharis (Fig. 904) and Polychaetus (Fig. 905) are perhaps further developments, some- what divergent, along the same line. All these animals are given to springing about wildly by the aid of powerful strokes of the foot and toes; the same habit is found in various species of Furcularia. Next may be taken up a line of divergence from the central Notommatidae that leads to some extraordinary forms. It pro- duces the great families of the Hydatinidae, the Notopsidae, the Ploesomidae, and the Brachionidae, with their relatives. Here de- velopment has proceeded both toward greater strength and activity and toward protective armor, so that the result is to produce some of the most powerful and ferocious rotifers that exist. 8. Hydatinidae. The close connection with the Notommatidae is seen in the Hydatinidae. The well-known rotifer Bydatina senta (Fig. 906) was formerly classed with the Notommatidae. It has a soft, segmented body, small foot and toes, ventral corona, — all as in the primitive genus Proales. But the corona (Fig. 906, B) is large and differentiated in a way that is characteristic for the families making up the present group. Around the outer edge of the corona the cilia form a prominent wreath, while about the mouth is another series of cilia so interrupted as to form three groups, one dorsal and two lateral (Fig. 906, B). In the region between the outer and inner series of cilia are certain prominences (three in Bydatina), on which the cilia have become long, stiff setae, doubtless serving as sense organs. The coronal area between the parts thus far mentioned retains in Bydatina senta a portion of the covering of fine cilia primitively found in Proales; in most other members of this group these fine cilia have quite disappeared. The jaws are of the peculiar type shown in Figure 906, C. 9. Notopsidae. The next step in differentiation is seen in Notops (or Bydatina) brackionus (Fig. 909). The cuticula, while still soft, has become a little stiffened, so that the body tends to hold its form; the foot is more prominent. The next steps seem to be as follows: Notops davulatus (Fig. 912) and Triphylus lacustris (Fig. 908) are rotifers showing still the soft 570 FRESH- WATER BIOLOGY body of the Notommatidae, but approaching the definite permanent form found in Ploesoma. The corona (Fig. 912, B) is much like that of Hydatina, save that the fine ciliation of the general surface has disappeared. Notops pelagicus (Fig. 910) shows a further step in the same direction; the cuticula is here stiffened to form a thin transparent lorica, of sufficient stiffness to form angles and teeth, though with by no means the thickness and solidity found in Ploesoma and Brachionus. From Notops pelagicus it is but a short step in one direction to Gastropus and Ploesoma, in another to Brachionus. 10. Gastropodidae. The transition from Notops to Gastropus is shown by Gastropus hyptopus (Fig. 915), which was originally con- sidered a species of Notops, and which if it stood by itself would still be placed in that genus. The lorica is here soft, the body short and thick. The lorica becomes more marked, and the other peculiarities more pronounced in the other species of Gastropus, Gastropus stylifer (Fig. 917) forming the extreme in this direc- tion. 11. Anapodidae. Probably derived from forms similar to Gas- tropus by a process of reduction are the species of Anapus (Fig. 911), in which the foot is lacking, the corona small and simple. 12. Ploesomidae. The species of Ploesoma (Figs. 918 to 920) are closely related to Notops and Gastropus. Ploesoma truncatum (Fig. 920) shows a lorica only a little stronger than that of Notops pel- agicusy and resembling that of Gastropus hyptopus, though it has many irregular wrinkles. In other species of Ploesoma the lorica becomes stronger and marked in very peculiar ways. Ploesoma lenticulare (Fig. 918) and P. hudsoni (Fig. 919) are among the most active and powerful of the predaceous Rotifera. They tear their way through the water at a furious rate, darting from side to side, and seizing and devouring with their powerful jaws other rotifers with which they come in contact. The Ploesomidae are among the most important plankton organisms. 13. Brackionidae. From Hydatina and Notops to Brachionus the step is perhaps still shorter than to Gastropus and Ploesoma. In Brachionus (Figs. 922, 923) the three prominences that surround the mouth in Hydatina and Notops (see Figs. 906, 910) have become V*j THE WHKF1. ASEirALCTXES (ROTATORIA} 571 modi developed. so that they stand high above the general surface of the corona (Fig. Q25). They partly enclose a sort of funnel* open on. the ventral ade, which leads down to the mouth. In most specks of Brackumus the integument has become very thick and hard, so as to form, a stout Iorica. often bearing spines or teeth (Fig. 921). But Brackumus mollis Hempel vFig. o^>) marks the transition in this respect, the integument being merely a little stiffened and without spines or teeth. In Brackianus. as in Ptoesoma and Gastrapus. the stout foot is marked with rings. The jaws are constructed on much the same plan throughout all these groups* The Brachionidae are among the most numerous of the rotifers found in ponds and pools amid vegetation. Some of the species are extremely variable. 14. Amuraeidae. An of shoot of the Brachionidae is found in the Anuraeidae (Figs. 913, qio). The general organization is the same as in BracJaonus, but the foot has been lost, though in the males (Fig. 913, C) it is retained. The Iorica shows in some species of Notkolca a tendency to run into bizarre forms (Fig. qio). The Anuraeidae are among the commonest of the rotifers of the plank- ton; they vary extremely with seasonal and other changes. 15. Asplanchnidae. The group diverging by way of Hydatima is now left, and another offshoot of the Xotommatidae taken up. In the Asplanchnidae the body remains soft, but becomes large and inflated, while the foot disappears; the jaws are of a remarkable type known as the incudate (Fig. 929, B). and the alimentary canal loses its posterior opening (see Fig. 929. .4). the undigested waste being disgorged through the mouth. But one finds in all these respects forms transitional between the Xotommatidae and the Asplanchnidae. Thus, Asplancknopus (Fig. 927) retains the foot, though it lacks the intestine, and has the characteristic jaws of this family. Harringia (Fig. 928) retains not merely the foot, but like- wise the intestine. Its corona is like that of As plane kna while its jaws (Fig. 928, B) are squarely intermediate between the usual form and the incudate type characteristic of Asplanchna. The typical incudate jaws consist mainly of the very large incus (fulcrum and rami), the mallei having nearly or quite disappeared; but in Har- ringia all the typical parts of the jaws are clearly seen. 572 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The typical Asplanchnas are beasts of prey, the jaws forming a great pair of forceps which can be thrust from the mouth to seize other large animals. As plane hna herrickii de Guerne and A. pri- odonia Gosse (Fig. 929) are important elements of the plankton of lakes. In the Great Lakes they sometimes swarm so densely that a net dipped into the water captures thousands. Other species of the Asplanchnidae live among water plants. 16-18. Floscularida. Now come certain groups of rotifers that seem at first view to differ markedly in almost every respect from the notommatids. The Flosculariidae (Figs. 933 to 936) live attached in tubes. The foot has become a stalk for attachment; there are no toes. The corona is immensely large, forming a great lobed net of thin membrane, which can be spread widely and serves to capture living prey; the mouth lies in the center at the bottom of this net. The cilia about the edge of the corona have become enor- mously long and slender rods or threads, which do not beat as cilia usually do, but may be moved about so as to aid in entangling prey. In connection with the method of feeding on large animals thus cap- tured, the alimentary canal (Fig. 934) has become greatly devel- oped. The upper part of the coronal net forms a great funnel, called the infundibulum (*), partly closed off below by a ring-like fold, the diaphragm ((f), which has about its edge an interrupted cir- clet of cilia. The opening through the diaphragm leads into a second chamber, the vestibulum (i>), at the bottom of which is the mouth (m). From the mouth there hangs the slender esophageal tube (0) ending freely below. The food after passing through this reaches a third large cavity, the proven triculus (pr). It is only at the posterior part of this that the mastax (mx) and jaws are reached; so that all thus far seen corresponds merely to the short mouth cavity lying in front of the jaws in other rotifers. The trophi (Figs. 934 and 933, D) are peculiarly modified, the unci forming a pair of two-tined forks which are the main part of the jaws, though the other typical parts can be distinguished. The Flosculariidae include two genera, Floscularia (Figs. 933 to 936) and Siephanoceros (Fig. 937). The numerous species are found abundantly seated in transparent tubes attached to plants; they are among the most attractive objects known to microscopists THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 573 (cf. p. 553). Of Stephanoceros there is but one species (Fig. 937), while of Floscularia there are many, varying extremely in the form of the corona. A few species have become free and swim about in the open water (Fig. 935). The fact that they bear their tubes with them shows that the free life has been secondarily acquired, after the animals had become adapted to the attached condition. All young Floscularias swim about for a time by means of moving cilia, just as do other rotifers. The males (Fig. 933, B) are free- swimming throughout life. What relationship have the Flosculariidae to the typical rotifers found in the Notommatidae? It must be remembered that not all Flosculariidae have the extraordinary forms shown in Figs. 933 and 937. In some, the borders of the corona are not drawn out into lobes, but are smooth, as in other rotifers (see Fig. 936). In others the cilia of the coronal edge are all, or partly, short and beat regularly, like those of other rotifers; and about the mouth is the same circlet of cilia found in other rotifers. Such Floscularias approach much more nearly to the typical Notommatidae than do the extreme developments along this line seen in Stephanoceros and certain species of Floscularia. Furthermore, among close relatives of the notommatids are cer- tain rotifers that seem to show transitional stages leading to the Flosculariidae.1 In Microcodides and in Microcodon (Fig. 931), the corona is formed on essentially the same plan as in the Floscularias, and there are other peculiarities that seem to show that these are transitional forms. In Microcodon, as in Floscularia, the corona is the broadest part of the body; it has elevated edges, approaching the net formation, and the mouth is in its center, with an inter- rupted circlet of cilia about it. The foot in Microcodon as in Flos- cularia forms a sort of long slender stalk, not ending in toes. But in Microcodon it ends in a sharp point, while in Floscularia it ends in a disk; this is doubtless because the former is still a free animal, while the latter is attached. It is a most suggestive fact that Mi- crocodon frequently places itself in the upright position, with the toe attached by a thread of mucus, and thus remains for a time in a cer- tain spot; such habits might readily lead to permanent attachment. 1 These important considerations are due to Wesenberg-Lund (1899). 574 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY All together, Microcodon seems to form a link between the Flos- culariidae and the Notommatidae. Microcodon itself is closely connected with the Notommatidae by the transitional species be- longing to the genus Microcodides (Fig. 932). These have corona, body, and toes more nearly on the notommatoid plan. The two genera make up the family Microcodonidae. Specialization going even beyond that in the Flosculariidae is seen in Apsilus (Fig. 938) and Atrochus (Fig. 939). In these ex- traordinary rotifers the cilia have been completely lost. The complicated structure of the alimentary canal shows their close relationship to the Flosculariidae. In the young the cilia still exist, and the animals swim about by their aid. 19-22. Melicertida. Another group of extraordinary and at- tractive rotifers is that of which Meliceria (Fig. 948) is the repre- sentative. These were formerly classified with the Flosculariidae, the two forming the group Rhizota. But it is evident that the two families differ widely, and that the group Rhizota is not a natural one. The Melicertidae are found, like the floscules, at- tached to aquatic plants, often in great numbers. Many live in tubes, and the species of Meliceria manufacture their tubes in a most interesting manner, as is well described in Hudson and Gosse (1889). The most important peculiarity of the Melicertidae is perhaps the corona. This is a large disk, bare within, but having around its outer edge a series of strong cilia, just as in many other rotifers. But in this group is found a special peculiarity. This outer wreath is differentiated into two series of cilia, running parallel around the disk (Fig. 865). The inner series has much larger cilia than the outer one, and between the two is found, in most cases, a groove. This groove is often lined with fine cilia. Along the groove small food particles are carried to the mouth, situated on the ventral side. In some genera the disk is drawn out to form two, four, or eight lobes, giving the animal an extraordinary appearance (Fig. 950); in other cases it is nearly circular (Figs. 865, 951, 952). Throughout this group the jaws are of a peculiar type (Fig. 866 ), known as the malleo-ramate. As a rule the animals have two eyes. The more extreme types of this group seem to stand far from THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 575 the typical free-swimming rotifers. Yet again, as in most other cases, free-swimming species form a transition to these extreme types. One finds the same peculiar corona, the same remarkable type of jaws, and various other features in common with the Melicertidae, in a number of free-swimming rotifers. These in- clude the genera Pterodina (Fig. 942) , Potnpholyx, Pedalion (Fig. 946), Fig. 865. Corona of Lacinnlaria socialis Ehr.. to show the two wreaths of cilia. A, Dorsal view. B, Side view. (After Wesenberg-Lund.) Triartkra (Fig. 944), and Tetramastix (Fig. 945). These rotifers are the only ones that have corona and jaws like those of the Meli- certidae, and they agree with them in many other particulars. Thus, all have two eyes, while most other rotifers have but one. In all there is either no foot, or it is a peculiar one, lacking the characteristic toes. In Pterodina the foot ends in a bundle of cilia, and this is likewise true of the young of the Melicertidae. In Flo. 866. MaHeo-ramate jaws. A, Jaws of M dicer Ui ringens Schrank. (After Weber.) B, Jaws of Pterodina caeca Parsons. (After Rousselet.) many Melicertidae there is below the mouth a peculiar fold of in- tegument forming the so-called "chin" which plays a part in the formation of the pellets used for building the tubes. This chin is likewise found, in a slightly less developed condition, in Pedal- ion (Fig. 946, ch) and in Triartkra, while nothing of the sort is found outside the present group. The remarkable similarity of corona, jaws, eyes, and other features seems to demonstrate clearly that all these free-swimming rotifers are closely related to each other and to the Melicertidae. 576 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The free-swimming members of the group have developed a number of striking external peculiarities, due to differences in the mode of life. Pterodina (Fig. 942) has a flat body, protected by a hard cuticula forming a lorica; this shape aids it greatly in swim- ming. Pedalion (Fig. 946) has developed six great limbs which like- wise aid it in swimming. Similar limbs, but in a simpler condition, are seen in Triarthra (Fig. 944) and Tetramastix (Fig. 945). In these genera the function, of the limbs seems to be mainly to protect the animals from being swallowed by such predatory beasts as As- planchna. One often sees an As plane hna attempt to swallow one of these at a gulp, but the prey at once extends its long appendages in all directions, and these frustrate the attempt. The male of Pedalion (Fig. 946, B) has simple appendages and bears a striking resemblance to one of the simpler species of Triarthra (Fig. 944, B). An extraordinary offshoot of the Meticertidae is seen in the spherical rotifer Trochosphaera (Fig. 947). In the corona, the jaws, the lack of a foot, and various other features it agrees essentially with the Melicertidae, though its external form is very different. 23-25. Bdelloida. This, the last group of rotifers, includes mainly the genera Rotifer (Figs. 958, 960), Philodina (Fig. 959), Cattidina (Fig. 961), Microdina (Fig. 962), and Adineta (Fig. 957). They are somewhat worm-like animals, often creeping like leeches, and found in great numbers amid aquatic vegetation. They are specially abundant in Sphagnum and other wet moss or moss-like plants; an immense number of species particularly of Cattidina are found in such places. This group differs widely from the typical rotifers in many points. The typical corona of the Bdelloida is a highly differentiated struc- ture consisting mainly of two flat disks borne on stalks and with cilia about their edges (Fig. 959, etc.). When the cilia are in mo- tion these two disks give the appearance of two revolving wheels. It is to this that the name wheel-animalcule, and the Latin terms rotifer and rotator are due; the Bdelloida were the first rotifers to attract the attention of microscopists. The base of the stalks bearing the disks is often clothed with short cilia. On the dorsal side of the corona there is a long tentacle. The foot ends as a rule in three or four minute projections, by * *.<£-*..$ THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 577 which the animals attach themselves; it bears also a pair of "spurs" on its dorsal side, a short distance from the end. These spun perhaps represent the two toes of other rotifers. The trophi (Fig. 867) present perhaps the most modified type found in the Rotifera; they show clearly that this group is not a primitive one. In most species the trophi are represented by two pieces shaped like a quarter of a sphere and placed side by side (Fig. 867, A). Across the free surface of these pieces extend two or more ridges. These jaws may be opened and closed by the mus- cular mass in which they are imbedded, the ridges fitting together in such a way as to serve as grinding teeth. The two halves of the Mfcwt). £,Jawiof trophi represent the two rami of other rotifers, the remainder of the apparatus having almost completely disappeared. But tran- sitional forms (Fig. 867, B) show clearly how these trophi are de- rived from the typical structure. The point in which the Bdelloida differ most from other rotifer* is in the fact that they have two ovaries in place of one. This peculiarity is shared with the Bdelloida only by a bizarre group of parasitic marine rotifers, the Seisonacea (Fig. 868) which live at- tached to the marine crustacean Nebalia. On account of this pecu- liarity the Bdelloida and Seisonacea are commonly classed apart from all other rotifers as the Digononta, the others being called the Monogononta. The Bdelloida include an immense number of species, the greater part of them belonging to the genus Callidina. The difference between species is often only slight, and the animals change form almost continually, so that their systematic study is perhaps more 578 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY difficult than that of any other group of rotifers; it has been con- fined mainly to specialists in this particular group. Many species of the Bdelloida possess a remarkable power of withstanding dry- ing. Philodina roseola is often found as little pink balls in the dry deposits in the bottoms of urns and eave-troughs. When this material is placed in water, the pink balls quickly swell, take the rotifer form, and continue their inter- rupted life activities where these were stopped. Many species may be ob- tained for study in the living condition from dried moss and other vegetation brought from a distance. No males are known in the Bdelloida. 26. The Seisonacea (Fig. 868) are ex- traordinary rotifers parasitic on marine Crustacea. Their relationships are un- certain, but, having two ovaries, they fic. 868. seiumanm^uaMxujenuXt. are usually placed near the Bdelloida. In the Seisonacea male and female are similar and of equal size. Since they are exclusively marine, these forms are omitted from the synoptic key. The studies thus far made of the rotifers of different regions seem to indicate that in general these animals may be said to be potentially cosmopolitan, any given species occurring wherever the conditions necessary to its existence occur. Whether any given rotifer shall be found in a given body of water depends mainly, not upon the locality of this body of water, but upon the precise conditions there found. Studies on the rotifers of Europe, Asia, Africa, America, and Australia show, not different faunas in these regions, but the same common rotifers found everywhere, with merely a new form here and there, and it is an extraordinary fact that when a new rotifer is described from Africa or Australia, its next occurrence is often recorded from Europe or America. In stagnant swamps all over the world appear to be found the char- .„« THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA^ 579 actezistic rotifers of stagnant water; in clear lake water are found the characteristic limnetic rotifers; in sphagnum swamps every- where, the sphagnum rotifers. Variation in the rotifer fauna of different countries is probably due mainly to differences in the con- ditions of existence in the waters of these countries, rather than to any difficulty in passing from one country to another. The num- ber of different sorts of Rotifera to be found in any given region depends upon the variety of conditions to be found in the waters of this region. Two bodies of water half a mile apart, presenting entirely different conditions, are likely to vary more in their rotifer fauna than two bodies of water 5000 miles apart that present similar conditions. Of course, the tropics will have characteristic species not found in cooler regions, since they present conditions of existence not found elsewhere, and the same may be true of Arctic regions. The problem of the distribution of the Rotifera is then mainly a problem of the conditions of existence rather than of the means of distribution. The ability of the eggs to live in dried mud, which may be carried about on the feet of birds or blown about as dust by the winds, seems to give sufficient opportunities for any species to multiply wherever occur the conditions neces- sary for existence. Most rotifers seem adapted to a rather nar- rowly limited set of conditions. Many species of rotifers vary extremely in the external details of their structure. This is particularly true of loricate rotifers that bear teeth, spines, or other projections. Extreme examples of such variation are seen in Brachionus bakeri Ehr. and in A nuraea cochlearis Gosse (Fig. 913). Lauterborn shows that the variations of Anuraea cochlearis are by no means haphazard, but depend upon the seasons and upon changes in the conditions of existence. In the course of a year this species undergoes a cycle of regular changes from month to month, and this yearly cycle was found to be essen- tially the same during a period of study of twelve years. In the colder months of the year appear individuals of greater size, with smooth loricas and long prominent spines. As the waters become warmer, in spring and summer, the individuals found are smaller in size, the surface of the lorica becomes roughened, and the spines grow shorter, until the caudal one disappears completely. As cold 580 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY weather approaches there is a return to the stouter forms. There results an immense number of different forms, many of which have been described as different species. Apparently these changes are adaptive in character. At the higher temperatures of summer the inner friction of the water decreases much (as Ostwald has shown), so that swimming animals tend to sink more readily than be- fore. The decrease in size of the body, with the roughening of its surface, increases greatly the proportion of body surface to body weight, so that the animals sink less readily; the tendency to sink due to the warmth of the water is compensated. The small, rough forms are therefore adapted to warm weather. But the decrease in size of the spines cannot be accounted for in this way; it must depend on other relations. In the Rotifera the males are usually minute, degenerate crea- tures, — the race being represented mainly by the females ! The males usually have no alimentary canal, and thus during their entire life they never take food. They are, of course, therefore, condemned to an early death. They usually swim about rapidly, often swarming about the females. Fecundation takes place in some cases by the insertion of the copulatory organ of the male into the cloaca of the female; this has been seen in many cases. In other cases apparently the male pierces the body wall of the female, injecting the spermatozoa directly into the body cavity. This takes place in Hydatina. In a few of the Rotifera the males are of the same size and struc- ture as the females (in the Seisonacea). In Proales werneckii the male is of the same size and form as the female, but the alimentary canal, while present, is simplified and reduced in size. In other species, various vestiges of the alimentary canal may be present, but they are not functional. In certain groups no male is known to exist; this is true for the entire suborder of the Bdelloida. In the Rattulidae likewise no males have as yet been seen. Much further study of the existence, structure, and activities of the males is needed. If they are actually non-existent in some groups, then of course the reproduction is throughout by parthenogenesis, — fertilization of the egg not occurring even at long intervals. Most rotifers produce several different sorts of eggs. These are THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 581 the following: (1) large eggs, without a thick shell, from which females are produced; (2) small eggs, similar to the last in ap- pearance but producing males; (3) eggs which have a thick shell, often armed with spines or projections. These are often spoken of as "winter eggs" or "resting eggs." They may apparently live a long time under all sorts of unfavorable conditions, devel- oping when favorable conditions are restored. The relation of these different sorts of eggs to the a, pearance of the males, and to fertilization, has been much discussed and investigated. In Ilyda- iina, according to Maupas, and in As plane hna priodonta, according to Lauterborn, the following is the state of the case. There arc two sorts of females, not distinguishable externally, but one pro- ducing large eggs, the others small ones. The large eggs cannot be fertilized, and they always develop into female rotifers. The small eggs, if not fertilized, develop into male rotifers, but they may be fertilized, and if this occurs they become transformed into the "resting eggs," from which there later develop female rotifers. In Hydatina, according to Maupas, fecundation can occur only when the female is young, before any of the eggs develop, and the female so fecundated produces only resting eggs. But in As- planckna and in various other rotifers the same female produces both male eggs and resting eggs, although only the latter are fertilized. According to Mrazek, in Asplanchna herrickii the same female bears at the same time ordinary female eggs, male eggs, and resting eggs. There is apparently much variation in these rela^ tions among different rotifers. Males and resting eggs are as a rule not found at all times of the year, but appear at certain periods, — the resting eggs of course following the appearance of males. In the pelagic Rotifera, Lauterborn has made a study of the periodical appearance of males and of resting eggs. He finds that these rotifers may be divided into three classes: (i) perennial rotifers, which occur in greater or less numbers all the year round; (2) summer species, found only in summer: (3) winter species, found only in winter. In the perennial species parthenogenetic reproduction continues through- out the year; but males appear as a rule only twice a year, in spring and fall. In the summer rotifers, males appear in the fall, 582 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY and the species is carried over the winter in the resting eggs re- sulting from fertilization by the males. In the winter rotifers, the males appear in the spring, and the species is carried over the sum- mer by the resting eggs. By the greater number of rotifers the eggs are laid as soon as they are completely formed, development taking place outside the body of the mother. But some rotifers are viviparous, the egg being retained in the mother's body until it is partly or completely developed. It is remarkable that the viviparous condition is found in several different groups of rotifers that are not closely related, so that it must have been developed independently several times within the Rotifera. Asplanchna and Rotifer are among the best- known viviparous genera. Phiiodina and Callidina, closely related to Rotifer, as a rule deposit the eggs undeveloped, though certain species in both these genera produce living young. Thus ovi- parity and viviparity, which in some higher animals distinguish grand classes, are among the rotifers both found in the limits of a single genus. It is a rather remarkable fact that the cleavage and early de- velopment of the rotifer egg does not resemble that of the animals to which the rotifers have often been considered the nearest rela- tives. In annelids and lower mollusks the early development shows a remarkable similarity < even in the details of the spiral i cleavage. But in the rotifers the cleavage follows a completely different type (Fig. 869). The developing rotifer forms a solid mass, which contains no cavity until the organs formed within this mass begin to separate, just before the rotifer takes its final form and becomes active. When living the body of the Rotifera is usually transparent and Fig. Etta. Developing eff of * rotifer. Aip hrrriiiii dc Gikik. a. Single rail sti cdb: t, twenty celli; d, ninety-lour cdh ■ectim through embryo formed of r (After Jenniogi) THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 583 all the organs are sharply defined, so that they are readily seen. After death, the transparency and sharpness are as a rule lost, and most methods of killing the rotifers cause them to become strongly contracted, so that the structure is no longer dear. Direct observa- tion of the living animal will therefore always remain one of the most important methods of studying these forms, for whatever purpose. By Rousselet's method, however, it is now as easy to pre- serve most of the Rotifera in natural form as any other lower animals. This method is essentially as follows: The animals are killed uncontracted by the aid of a narcotizing fluid, the essen- tial feature of which is a \ to 1 per cent solution of hydrochlorate of cocaine. The cocaine may be used in a simple watery solution, but better results are reached by using the following mixture: Hydrochlorate of cocaine (2 per cent solution) . . 3 parts Methyl alcohol 1 part Water 6 parts The rotifers are brought into a small volume of water, and a little of this narcotizing fluid is mixed with it. The proper amount must be learned by trial, but it is always best to begin with a very small proportion of the fluid, TV or less> ^d to a(id more as required. This fluid causes the rotifers to swim slowly and gradually to sink to the bottom. They will soon die, and if allowed to die unfixed will be quite worthless for study, destructive changes taking place in the tissues at the moment of death. As soon therefore as the ciliary movement has nearly ceased, as much as possible of the water should be drawn off, and a small amount of 0.25 per cent osmic acid introduced, which kills and fixes the rotifers at once. Now the osmic acid should be drawn off at once and water added or the rotifers removed with a capillary pipette to fresh water; they should be washed several times in distilled water. If the osmic acid is allowed to act too long the rotifers will be blackened. The blackening may, however, be later removed, if necessary, with hydrogen peroxide. After washing, the rotifers should be pre- served in 3 to 6 per cent formalin. They cannot as a rule be pre- served in alcohol without extensive shrinkage, rendering them use- less for further study. 584 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY If desired, the specimens may be permanently mounted in hollow ground slides. The slides should be thin and the concavities shal- low, so that high powers of the microscope may be used. The specimens are transferred to the concavities along with some of the formalin and covered with a circular cover-glass. It is best not to leave any bubbles of air beneath the cover. The superfluous for- malin may be withdrawn from the edge of the cover with a bit of filter paper, and the cover is then sealed by the aid of a revolving stage. It is, of course, necessary to use some sealing material that will not allow water to evaporate through it. Rousselet recommends the following for sealing the mounts: After fixing the cover with a layer composed of a mixture of two-thirds gum damar with one- third gold size, there are added two coats of pure shellac, followed by three or four coats of gold size, allowing twenty-four hours for each coat to dry before another is added. Extensive collections containing many species of Rotifera may be made by travelers and others by the use of the method given above. The rotifers, taken with a net or otherwise, are brought into as small an amount of water as possible, in a watch-glass. Then a considerable quantity of the narcotizing fluid is introduced and the rotifers are watched till most of them have sunk to the bottom. Thereupon the water is removed, so far as possible, and the £ per cent osmic acid added. This is removed as quickly as can be done without taking up too many of the rotifers; they are then washed and preserved in formalin. It is very desirable to kill a certain proportion of every collection in osmic acid without previ- ous narcotization, as some of the loricate rotifers are more easily determined from contracted specimens than from extended ones. A method of mounting Rotifera in the ordinary mounting media, such as Canada balsam, has been given by Zograf . It does not give such perfect results, in most cases, as does Rousselet's method, but it is useful for some species. The rotifers are stupefied and killed in the way given above. After they have been in the osmic acid from two to four minutes, this is removed as far as possible, and a considerable quantity of 10 per cent pyroligneous acid is added. This is allowed to act five or ten minutes; then the rotifers are washed several times in distilled water. As a result of the harden- :*£SiLi, THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 585 ing action of the pyroligneous acid, they may now be passed, like other objects, through successively stronger grades of alcohol till absolute alcohol is reached. They may then be cleared in clove or cedar oil, in the usual way, and mounted in Canada balsam, or gum damar, or they may be mounted in glycerine. In America the systematic work on the Rotifera has consisted largely in the publication of lists of species found in certain regions. While this work undoubtedly has its uses, there are other lines of study which would at the present time be of much greater value even for purely systematic purposes. On account of the very large number of species of Rotifera, their minuteness, and the unsatisfactory work that has been done upon them, it is often almost impossible to determine with certainty even common spe- cies. This can best be remedied by studying carefully circum- scribed groups, such as single genera and families, collecting them extensively, describing and figuring all the species, and going criti- cally over the literature of the group in such a way as to set the synonymy in order. Careful comparative studies of certain organs or sets of organs, such as the corona, the trophi, etc., throughout varied groups, would help much in understanding the interrelationships of the Rotifera. If possible a study of the habits should be made in their relation with the structures, since these matters are closely con- nected. Monographic anatomical studies of certain species are always of value. They would be especially useful if a thorough study of the habit and physiology could be made at the same time. A most important field, and one little cultivated, lies in the study of the activities by which the rotifers respond to their en- vironment. Thorough studies of the movements and habits, the reactions to stimuli, "tropisms," and the like, would be of great interest. Disconnected observations on these matters are of com- paratively little value; definite problems should be taken up and followed to the end. The variations induced in a single species, and in an entire fauna, by changes in seasons, temperatures, and in other features, have received some study and deserve much more. One of the most interesting lines of work for which the rotifers present oppor- 586 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY tunity lies in the study of the various problems connected with reproduction and the diversity of the sexes. Few groups of organ- isms present conditions so favorable for the study of these funda- mental matters. The relationships of the Rotifera to other groups, and their interrelationships among themselves are subjects which have been much discussed and on which there is wide divergence of opinion. As a result, the classification of the group differs greatly with different authors. The classification perhaps most commonly employed is that given in Hudson and Gosse's Monograph of the Rotifera. Wesenberg-Lund's classification, based on that view of the interrelationships of the Rotifera set forth in the foregoing paper, has been little used; yet it appears to be that to which a careful and unprejudiced study of the members of the group leads. Most earlier classifications have found their guiding principles in matters quite extraneous to the Rotifera as such. Led by theo- retical considerations, the primitive rotifers have been looked for among highly specialized species. Huxley compared the two ciliary wreaths of Lacinularia to the two wreaths of certain larvae of other groups, — of echinoderms, annelids, and the like, — thus indicating a possible close relationship between them. This suggestion was eagerly followed up, and the primitive organization of the Rotifera has been sought in such highly differentiated, untypical forms as the Melicertidae, the Philodinidae, and the like. Even that bizarre side-shoot of one of the most highly specialized families, Trocho- sphaera (Fig. 947), has been considered a primitive rotifer of special significance, from its superficial resemblance to the trochophore larvae of annelids, etc. Less popular, but still enjoying consider- able repute, have been the theories which held that such forms as Pedalion (Fig. 946) show a close relationship of the Rotifera with the larvae of Crustacea. Careful comparative study of the Rotifera themselves seems to show clearly that Lacinularia and the Meli- certidae, Trochosphaera and Pedalion are alike terminal twigs of the rotatorian tree — highly specialized forms, whose origin is to be sought in such rotifers as the primitive Notommatidae. NoU. — For recent changes in the names of many rotifers, in accordance with the strict rules of priority, the paper of Harring ('13) should be consulted. j^ui THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 587 KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER ROTATORIA 1 (138) One ovary. Do not creep like a leech. Subclass Manogononta . . 2 This snhdass includes all the rotifers commonly met, save the Kridloina (q.v.), which are by their habit of creeping like leeches. 2 (109) Corona of various types. Where there are two wreaths of cilia, those of outer wreath never shorter than those of inner. ... 3 3 (07) Mouth not near center of corona. . . . Order Hotnmmatida riimiiiiu1, or crcepuig rotifers, hot never deeping like a leech: corona ventral or tw- isting of a disk which is either uniformly dilate or has a wreath of cilia about its rhrnrnference with usually two or more {troops of cilia dose to the mouth, or shows some inter- mediate condition. Where there are two wreaths of cflia, the outer is never shorter than the inner. Month not in the center of the disk. Jaws never ramate (Fig. 867, A > nor mafleo- xzmate (Rg. 866). Foot usually ending in two toes placed side by side: rarely ending in one; ■■nrfiiiwm absent; never forming a dak for attachment nor ending m a bunch of cflia. Lories 4 (00) Jaws not incudate. Intestine and anus present. 5 5 (31, 64) Without lorica. Corona when as broad as other parts of the body, not consisting of an outer wreath, a partial wreath about the mouth and styligerous prominences between. Suborder HotramnKtiiia . . 6 Body usually soft and somewhat segmented. (See also family Hydatxnxdae, 66.) 6 (26) Corona without long antenna-luce bristles and setigerous prominences. Foot present Family Notommatidae . . 7 Soft -bodied rotifers, usually elongated, rati m la more or less distinctly segmented; foot not distinctly mrrkrri of! from the remainder of the body, usually short and ending hi two toes placed sale by side, or rarely but one toe. Corona usually not so wide as the remainder of the Body. Living mainly amid vegetation of the shores and bottom. This fcunfly cannot be sharply marked ofl from others; see particularly Hvdathridae. The of the Notommatidae are likewise not sharply definable: they are merely more or less aubdWisiuos of a group thai would be too unwieldy if taken as a unit. 7 (19) Without auricles 8 NJJ. A dti riff, are often contracted and axe then invisible, 8 (16) With one or more eyes. 9 9(12,15} With a single eye only 10 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Fin. g7o. Fumiiaria Fin. til. FurtuJaria Fro. 8ji. Ditlna wj- Fro. S ]srfc*la Ehr. X joo. twriitti Ehr. X 400. Bala Dixon -Nuttill. item Ebuuu (After Weber.) (After Duon-Nulull.) X jia (After Dixoo- X 166. (After El NatulL) ben.) Fn.ST4-n*tMMMM FW. Stj. A»nUm- Fro. StS. Hn—Hrtt Fin. gjT. : «>imJu Ehrmberg. kwGiM X IIS. iwAWsltn.Xii<. «nnJ»i Xkk (AfWrEhnm- (AfMrGat**.) Ufta Daoo-NmudL) (Afttt W. THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 589 10 (11) Eye in neck region Proalts Saaal, %\m iwii», soft-bodied apedn, with partly fatal corona. Many specks. lte|MPcseiitativespecies(Flg.856,p«^ (Fig. 858, page 557). . . . P. jarrfacfe Gosse. CR«- 859, I**e 558). ... P. tiffida Gossc 11 (10) Eye near front Furadaria Ehienberg. Cntimfa a ittfe Miner, so dial the form is retained; shape at tines a fitde |-m"*1tt; torn loader and staffer than in Pr—ict; active. Species nmneroas. Repiesentative species (Fig. 870). . Furadaria forjUmla Ehienberg. (Fig. 871) F. Umriseta Ehienberg. 12 (o, is) With two eyes. 13 13 (14) Eyes near front Digkna Ehienbag. Strang pmiarioos species with foccipmte jaws; toes usually laige. One or two speocs. Representative species (Fig. S72). . Digfma rostrala Dixon-XultalL (Fig. 860, B, page 559). . D.forcipata Ehienberg. 14 (13) Eyes in neck Distemma Ehienberg. Representative species (Fig. 873). . Distemama sdigermm Ehienberg. 15 (9, 12) With three eyes in a transverse row. . Triopktkalmms Ehienberg. One species only (Fig. 874) Tricfktkalmus dorsmalis. 16 (8) Without eyes. 17 17 (18) Internal parasites. AJbertia Dujardm. Fewspeoks. Representative species (Fig. 875) Albertia uUrusor Gossc. 18 (17) Free, or external parasites. Picurotrocha Ehrenbeig. Fci Representative species (Fig. 876). . . Platrotrocha gramdis Western. 19 (7) With amides. 20 aJ. AmmJb* nviuble when contracted. jo (25) With one eye. 21 21 (24) Smaller, soft-bodied forms. 22 22 (23) Catacula with many transverse folds. .... Tapkrocamfa Gosse. Repiesentative species (Fig. 877). . Tafhrocamfia anmmlosa Gosse. THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 591 23 (22) Cutkuia without many transverse folds. . Notommata Ehrenbeig. limy species. Representative species (Fig. 878). . . Notommata awrtia Ehrenbeig. (Fig. 881) N. tondosia Dujaidin. (Fig. 857, A and B, page 556). N. truncata Jennings. 24 (21) Very large, thick-bodied forms. Copeus Gosse. Corona extending far on ventral surface. Few species. Representative species (Fig. 857, C, page 556, and Fig. 864, page 565). C opens packyurus Gosse. 25 (20) With three eyes. Eospkora Ehrenberg. One large eye on brain; others small, in front. Few species. Representative species (Fig. 879). . . Eosphora digiiata Ehrenberg. 26 (6) Two or four long bristle-like antennae on corona. Foot present or absent Family Sykchaetidae . . 27 Open-water rotifers; bodies short; foot short or absent; corona as broad as the broadest part of the body, consisting mainly of a row of large cilia about the circumference. 27 (28) Auricles present Synchada Ehrenberg. Body usually conical, largest at the head; foot short, rarely absent. About a dozen species. Representative species (Fig. 8&$). . . Synchada stylata Wierzejski. (Fig. 880) 5. tremida Ehrenberg. (Fig. 884) 5. baUica Ehrenberg. 28 (27) Auricles absent No foot 29 29 feo) With lateral oar-like swimming appendages. . Polyarthra Ehrenberg. One species only (Fig. 882). . . . Polyarthra platyptera Ehrenberg. 30(29) Appendages lacking Anarthra Hood. One species only (Fig. 885) Anarthra aptera Hood. 31 (5, 64) Lorica always present. Corona small, not so broad, as a rule, as the broadest part of the lorica. Suborder Loricatina . . 32 Foot present, short, not ringed; ending in two toes, or rarely one. 32 (47) Lorica divided into plates by longitudinal furrows. 33 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY FN. «9o- Distyttimnii Biyra. ^. Dotul virw; 6, coo- Flo. 891. DiiMttUtmiUVtakk. lacted; C, dde viow. X "J- (AKa IMwo-NutUllJ Xl» IAKh JttinimiJ THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 593 33 (40) Lotrica of three or four plates. Furrows are one mid-dorsal, two lateral; sometimes one mid-ventral. Family Salfinidae . . 34 34 (35) Lorica with teeth or spines in front, or behind, or both. Salpina Ehrenberg. Representative species (Fig. 886). . . Salpina spimgcra Ehrenberg. 35 (54) Lorica without teeth or spines. 36 36 (39) One eye present. 37 37 (38) Lorica not strongly marked, the furrows and plates noticeable only on dose examination. Diasckisa Gosse. Representative species (Fig. 887) Diasckisa hoodii Gosse. 38 (37) Lorica distinct and strong. Diphis Gosse. Two species. Representative species (Fig. 888) Diphis davicsiae Gosse. 39 (36) No eye; lorica distinct. Dipiax Gosse. Representative species (Fig. 889) Dipiax videns Levander. 40 (33) Lorica of two plates. Furrows lateral. Family Edghiantdae. . 41 Okie plate dorsal, the other ventral. 41 (46) Two toes. 4* 42 (45) The two plates connected by a membrane which folds into the lateral furrow 43 Snail specie*, not specially dear, lorica often marked in various ways. 43 (44) Lorica narrower. Distyla Eckstein. Many species. Representative species (Fig. 800) Distyla inermis Bryce. Representative species (Fig. 891) D. okioensis Hernck. FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 595 44 (43) Lorica broader Cathypna Gosse. Several species. Representative species (Fig. 892). . . . Cathypna luna Ehrenberg. 45 (42) The two plates not connected by membrane. . Euchlanis Ehrenberg. Large, conspicuous, dear species; lorica not sculptured or otherwise marked. Many species. Representative species (Fig. 893) . . Enchlanis macrura Ehrenberg. 46 (41) One toe Monostyla Ehrenberg. Many species. Representative species (Fig. 894). . Monostyla lunaris Ehrenberg. 47 (32) Lorica undivided, of a single piece 48 48 (51) Lorica somewhat pipe-shaped, often unsymmetrical. Family Rattulidae . . 49 Lorica closed all around, cylindrical, fusiform, ovate, or conical, with an opening at each end for head and foot; often unsymmetrical and with oblique ridges or furrows. Toes bristle- like; sometimes equal, then short; sometimes very unequal, so that but one is noticeable, this then very long. 49 (50) Toes equal, or, if unequal, the shorter one more than one-third the length of the longer Diurella Bory. Many species. Representative species (Fig. 895) Diurella sulcata Jennings. (Fig. 862, page 562) D. tigris Miiller. 50 (49) Toes unequal. The smaller less than one-third length of longer. Rattulus Lamarck. Many species. Representative species (Fig. 896). . . . Ratiulus cylindrirus Imhof. (Fig. 897) R. latus Jennings. (Fig. 808) R. longiseta Schrank. 51 (48) Lorica not pipe-shaped. Symmetrical 52 52 (59) Foot and toes not exceptionally long. No spines. Family Coluridae . . 53 Lorica of a single piece, either covering both dorsal and ventral surfaces, or only the dorsal. 53 (58) Head surmounted by a chitinous shield 54 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY tic. 90}. Scaridmm baft- caelum Ehr. X wo. (Aita DiHB-NuEUU.) Female. B, Mlk. THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) $97 54 (55) Head shield broad, flat, appearing from above like a halo. SUphanops Ehrenberg. Several species. Representative species (Fig. 809). . . SUphanops intermedius Burn. 55 (54) Head shield arched, in side view appearing like a hook. .... 56 56 (57) Lorica arched and laterally compressed Colurus Ehrenberg. Many species. Representative species (Fig. 900) Colurus grallaior Gosse, 57 (56) Lorica flattened, wider than high Metopidia Ehrenberg. Representative species (Fig. 901). . . . Metopidia ekrcribergii Perty. 58 (53) No head shield Cochleare Gosse. Lorica shaped like a coat, covering only the anterior half or less of the dorsal surface. One or two species. Representative species (Fig. 902) Cochleare turbo Gosse. 59 (52) Foot and toes usually long; if not, upper surface of lorica with long spines Family Dinocharidae . . 60 Lorica entire, covering head as well as body. Movements often of a leaping character. w 60 (63) Lorica without spines on dorsal surface. . . 7 . 61 61 (62) Lorica weak, hardly noticeable Scaridium Ehrenberg* No sculpturing of any sort; toes very long. Two species. Representative species (Fig. 903). Scaridium longicaudum Ehrenberg. 62 (61) Lorica rough Dinocharis Ehrenberg Two species. Representative species (Fig. 904). • Dinocharis pocillum Ehrenberg. FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 599 63 (60) Lorica bearing long spines on dorsal surface. . Polyckaetus Perty. Lorica turtle-shaped. Two species. Representative species (Fig. 905). . . . Polychaetus coUinsii Gosse. 64 (5, 31) With or without lorica. Corona usually as broad as broadest part of body and consisting of an outer wreath of cilia and an inner interrupted wreath about the mouth, with sty- ligerous processes between them. Suborder Hydatinina . . 6$ A heterogeneous group in external characters but showing evidence of dose relationship throughout. Corona never a perfect circle of two wreaths, with mouth in center. All loricate forms without foot belong here. In all non-loricate forms foot present and ending in two toes, side by side. In loricate forms foot when present ends in two toes, side by side, save in one species, Gaslropus stylifer, where there is but one toe. The families of this order are greatly in need of a revision based on thorough comparative study of all the species. <*5 (73) Without lorica 66 66 (70) Foot not sharply separated from body. Family Hydattnidae . . 67 Large rotifers, body soft and segmented, of notommatoid characteristics, not greatly swoDen dorsaliy, nor compressed sidewise. Corona of typical form of suborder, or having a large dorsal proboscis that bears two eyes. Foot lying in the body axis, not ventral; ending in two short toes. 67 (68, 69) No eye Hydatina Ehrenberg. Only one species (Fig. 906) Hydatina senta Ehrenberg. 68 (67, 69) One eye Cyrtonia Rousselet Only one species (Fig. 007) Cyrtonia tuba Ehrenberg. 69 (67, 68) Two eyes; corona with dorsal proboscis. . . . Rhinops Hudson. Only one species (Fig. 863, page 565). . Rhinops vitrca Hudson. 70 (66) Foot decidedly set off from remainder of body. Family Notopsidae . . 71 Body much swollen dorsaliy, flatter vent rally; cuticula slightly stiffer so that the body holds its shape, or sometimes forming a weak but evident lorica. Foot forming a prolongation of the ventral surface or extending ventrally; two small toes. 71 (72) Two eyes Tripkyhu Hudson. Only one species (Fig. 908) Tripkylus lacustris Ehrenberg. 598 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Fio. »o&. TriUnku UauMi Ehiabat- X U4- (Aita V«b) THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 6oi 72 (71) One eye Notops Hudson. Slight indication of lorica sometimes. Several spedes. Representative species (Fig. 909). . . Notops brachionus Ehrenberg. (Fig. 912) N. davulaius Ehrenberg. (Fig. 910) N. pdagicus Jennings. 73 (65) Lorica present 74 74 (81) No foot 7 75 (76) Lorica of two convex plates, placed together at their edges. Family Anapodidax. Lorica ovoid or oval. Only one genus Anapus BergendaL One or two spedes. Representative species (Fig. 911) Anapus oralis BergendaL 76 (75) Lorica of a convex dorsal and a flat ventral plate, or sometimes irregular Family Anu&aeidae . . 77 Open in front for head and behind for doaca; usually armed with spines or teeth. 77 (80) Spines or teeth at the anterior or posterior edges of the lorica, or none 78 78 (79) Lorica not longitudinally striated Amtraea Ehrenberg. Representative species (Fig. 913, A and B). Anuraea cochUaris Gosse. Many spedes. Lorica of convex dorsal and flat ventral plate. (Fig. 913, C) A.brevispinaGonc 6oo FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 603 79 (78) Lorica longitudinally striated Notkolca Gosse. Sometimes very long and slender. Three or four species. Representative species (Fig. 916). . . Notkolca longispina Kellicott. 80 (77) Lorica with long bristle-like outgrowths from its surface but not from anterior or posterior borders Eretmia Gosse. Few species, all more or less doubtful. Representative species (Fig. 914) Eretmia trUkrix Gosse. 81 (74) Foot present 8a 82 (85) Foot projects from ventral surface 83 83 (84) Lorica entire, not wrinkled Family Gastropodhme. Lorica flask-shaped with small foot projecting from ventral surface. Foot ringed, ending in one or two toes. One genus only Gastropus Imhof. Several species. Representative species (Fig. 915). . Gastropus hyptopus Ehrenberg. (Fig. 917) G. stylifcr Imhof. 84 (83) Lorica open along mid- ventral line; marked with wrinkles or vesi- cles Family Ploesomtdae. Lorica stout, widely open in front for the large head, and open ventrally for the foot. Foot strong, ringed, ending in two toes. Strong, active rotifers. Only one genus Ploesoma Herrick. Three or four species. Representative species (Fig. 920). . Ploesoma truncatum Levander. (Fig. 918) P. lenticulare Herrick. (Fig. 919) P. kudsoni Imhof . FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY A THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 6o$ 85 (82) Foot projects from posterior end. . Family Brachionidae . . 86 Lorica consisting of a convex dorsal plate and a flat ventral one; usually stout and armed with spines, though not always. Lorica opened behind for the long, strong foot which is often covered with dose rings. Foot either ending in two toes or forked at its free end. 86 (89) Foot not forked 87 87 (88) Lorica very convex dorsally Brachionus Ehrenberg. Many species. Representative species (Fig. 922). . . Brachionus pale Ehrenberg. (Fig. 921, i4) B. punctatus Hempel. (Fig. 921,2?). . . . B. quadratus Rousselet. (Fig. 923) B. angularis Gosse. (Fig. 925) B. mollis Hempel. 88(87) Lorica flat Nolens Ehrenberg. Foot not ringed. Representative species (Fig. 926). . Noteus quadricornis Ehrenberg. 89 (86) Foot forked at its end Schizocerca Daday. Only one species (Fig. 924). . . . Schizocerca diver sicornis Daday. FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 607 90 (4) Jaws incudate, save in Ascomorpka. Intestine and anus lacking, save in Dinops Suborder Sac-shaped rotifers, usually without a foot, though in some cases a small root is present on the posterior part of the ventral surface. One family only Family Asplanghnidab . . 91 91 (94) Foot present. 9a 92 (93) Intestine absent. Asplancknopus de Guerne. Two or three species. Representative species (Fig. 927) Asplancknopus myrmdeo Enrenberg. 93 (92) Intestine present Harringia Beauchamp. Only one species (Fig. 928) Harringia eupoda Gosse. 94 (91) Foot absent. 95 95 (96) Large clear rotifers with incudate jaws. .... Aspianchna Gosse. Many species. * Representative species (Fig. 029). . . Aspianchna priodonta Gosse. (Fig. 869, page 583). . A, kerrickii de Guerne. 9^ (95) Very small rotifers, usually colored or opaque; jaws not incudate. Ascomorpka Perty. . One or two species. Representative species (Fig. 930). . . . Ascomorpka ecaudis Perty. FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 609 97 (3) Mouth nearly in center of -large corona. . Order Fioscolarida . . 08 Gonna areolar or dnwn out into lobes, points, or arms. Foot never ending in two toes placed side by side. Mostly attached or tube-bearing rotifers, the foot forming a disk for attachment; a few free-brimming species in which the foot ends in a single toe, sometimes accompanied fay a dorsal spur. 08 (101) Free swimming; foot ending in a single toe. Family Microdontdae . . 00 Corona circular, with mouth in center, an outer wreath of active cilia; cilia about the mouth larger and bristle-fike. One eye. 00 (100) Foot as long as body Microcolon Ehrcnberg. Body slender, corona with raised borders, slightly bilobed; foot slender, straight, ending in a single toe; no dorsal spur. Only one species (Fig. 931) Microcodon clavus Ehrenberg. 100 (00) Foot not more than half as long as body. . Mkrocodides Bergendal. Body not so slender; foot ending in one toe which is sometimes accompanied by a dorsal Representative species (Fig. 932). . Mkrocodides robustus Glasscott. xoi (08) Attached, or bearing tubes if free swimming 102 102 (105) Cilia around corona. .... Family Flosctjlariidae . . 103 Corona large, forming a net for the capture of prey. Cilia about its edge usually forming long threads or bristles which do not beat like those of other rotifers, though they may move rather slowly. Jaws uncinate (Fig. 933, D). 103 (104) Corona circular, or drawn into lobes, or pointed; its cilia not in whorls or regular groups Flosadaria Oken Many species. Representative species (Fig. 933, A and B). Floscularia proboscidea Ehrenberg. (Fig. 934 and 861, B, page 561). F. campanulatn Dobie. (Fig. 935) F. untloba Wierzewki. (Fig. 936) F. edeniata Collins. FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY ;„,. j I m Fu Mi' PUndm* fitinu Ehr A, Donil view of H" Lctdr. X 11. X us- (AlUr Webtc.) fl, Doral *k* of the milt. the In wraths of THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 6lX 104 (103) Corona drawn out into long pointed arms, which bear cilia arranged in whorls Stephanoceros Ehrenberg. One species only (Fig. 937). . Stephanoceros eichhornii Ehrenberg. 105 (102) No cilia on corona Family Apsilidae . . 106 106 (107, 108) Body short, sac-like Apsilus Metschnikoff. Corona a large sac or chamber; no foot; attached by an adhesive disk. Two or three spedes. Representative species (Fig. 938). . . . Apsilus bucinedax Forbes. 107 (106, 108) Body longer, fusiform, a narrowed neck separating off a conical anterior part Atrochus Wierzcjski. Corona a membranous ring with five short lobes bearing tentacles. Only one species (Fig. 939). . Atrochus tentaculatus Wierzcjski. 108 (106, 107) Body long, with a long, slender, tapering stalk. Acyclus Leidy. Corona with but one large dorsal lobe. Living in colonies of Megalotroeha albojlavkani. Representative species (Fig. 041) Acyclus inquUtus Leidy. 109 (2) Corona surrounded by two parallel wreaths of cilia with a furrow be- tween. Cilia of outer wreath always shorter than those of inner. Order Melkertida . . no Hie furrow between the wreaths of cilia sometimes clothed with short cSia. Jaws mafleo- ramate (Fig. 866). Foot never ending in two toes side by side; sometimes lacking. Eyes two. rarely absent. Fixed or free swimming; the free-swimming species often without foot aoi frequently bearing appendages on the body. 110(121) Free swimming and not in tubes or in colonies, 111 in (120) Not sphericaL in 112(115) With a lorica- Without appendages. Family Piekodlmime , . 113 113 (114) Foot present, long, ringed, ending in a bunch of cOia. Pterodina EhrcnbsTf. Representative species 'Fig. 042). . - Ptaodina patina EhreTiberg, (Fig. 666. B, page 575;. . P 'am Y*r*x*. 114 ^113) Xo foot. Pvmphdyx <****. ■**«. Tw* or thee specie* fegracsttairve species (Fig 9*0;. PtmpkUjs c*mpUmU G FI0.94&- fW^HS nr» RdiIub. A, Veidnl virwrf S™*>, c*. "thin." X 70- (AftcrWtfaw) *. Male. (After W< >kwof fault <* Wohsf-Liuti.) VH.WT. TWhithw !■(*«■(■•. Tkipt Xta- (AbrXwiliU THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 613 n$ (112) Without lorica. With spine-like or limb-like appendages. No foot Family Pedalionidae . . 116 116 (117, 118, 119) Appendages, two, very long Pedetes Gosse. Representative species (Fig. 943) Pedetes saUator Gosse. 117 (116, 118, 119) Appendages, three, spine-like. . Triarthra Ehrenberg. Two or three species. Representative species (Fig. 944, A). . Triarthra longiseta Ehrenberg. (Fig. 944, B) T. brachiata Rousselet. 118 (116, 117, 119) Appendages, four; spines or bristles. Tetramastix Zacharias. One species only (Fig. 945). . . Tetramastix opoliensis Zacharias. 119 (116, 117, 118) Appendages, six, branching, somewhat crustacean-like. Pedalion Hudson. Two species. Representative species (Fig. 946). . • . Pedalion mirum Hudaon. 120(111) Body spherical, no foot Family Troghosfhaeridax. One genus only Trochosphaera Semper. Representative species (Fig. 947). . Trochosphaera solstitialis Thorpe. Fh. 94S. MdiarU rimtiHi Sduuk. A , Aniaul Id iu tube. X fe. (Aim Hud»n wd Gow.) A. -"---•— '■ ' '-■- ..— . 1.. (A(t~ X87- (Afu; HI.™. THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 6l$ i5i (no) Fixed by the tip of the stalk-like foot, or with tubes, or in colonic* Secondarily free in a few cases, then distinguishable by die soft elongated body, without lorica or appendages. Family Meuce&hdae . . x»a 122 (130, 133) Individuals attached, separate, or in branching, non-spherical colonics of few specimens (1-30) 123 123 (124, 125) Corona four lobed Mdicerta Schrank, Two lobes in one species. Living in tubes. Several species. Representative species (Fig. 048 and Fig. 866, .4, page 575). M dicer Ux ringens Schrank. 124 (123, 125) Corona eight lobed OcUUrocka Thorpe. Representative species (Fig. 950). . . . Octotrocha speciosa Thorpe. 125 (123, 124) Corona more or less two lobed. , 126 126 (129) Dorsal antenna minute or absent. 127 127 (128) Corona broad, of two lobes, with a wide dorsal gap. Limnias Schrank. Dorsal antenna minute, ventral antennae long; living in tubes not made with pellets. Sev* era] mwws Representative species (Fig. 949). . . Limnias ceratopkyUi Schrank. 128 (127) Corona a wide oval or nearly circular, indistinctly two lobed. Dorsal gap minute Oecistes Ehrenberg. Dorsal »nt»«w*A inconspicuous or absent. Ventral antennae obvious. Living attached in tubes. Many species. Representative species (Fig. 951) Oecistes brevis Hood. PK. u jG. CcfkaiaiipkM Fin. 9s;. MitalotrxJu iMrnkmu li'nniiai Ehrenhwi. X»So, Ebrrnben. Single indjvidiul. (After Dinm-HWttlL) XSj. (After mm.) THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 617 129 (126) Dorsal antenna very large, with two projections or hooks at its side Cephalosiphon Ehrenberg. Corona nearly circular with a distinct dorsal gap. Ventral antennae small or absent. Representative species (Fig. 956). . Cepkalotiphonlimnias Ehrenberg. 130 (122, 133) Not attached nor forming colonies, save that one adult may be grouped with its young 131 131 (132) Not forming tubes PseudoecisUs Stenrooa. In other respects like Cephalosiphon. One or two species. Representative species (Fig. 954). . . PseudoecisUs rotifer Stenroos. 132 (131) Inhabiting a tube ConockUoides Hlava. Individuals separate or one grouped with its young. One or two species. Representative species (Fig. 953). . . . ConockUoides natans Seligo. 133 (122, 130) In clusters of many individuals, forming usually a spherical colony appearing to the naked eye as a yellowish ball. . 134 *34 (J37) Clusters attached 135 13S (l3&) No tubes Megalotrocha Ehrenberg. Colonies often several millimeters in diameter, attached to plants. Individuals not imbedded in a gelatinous mass; corona broad, kidney shaped. Body usually with two or four opaque warts. Several species. Representative species (Fig. 955). Megalotrocha alboflavicans Ehrenberg. 136(135) Dwelling in transparent gelatinous tubes. . Lacinularia Schweigger. Colony, a mass of some mm. in diameter, often appears to be imbedded in a mass of jelly. Corona heart shaped (Figs. 861, A, and 865). Several species. Representative species (Fig. 861, A, page 561, and Fig. 865, page 575). Lacinularia socialis Ehrenberg, 137(134) Clusters or colonies free swimming. . . . ConochUus Ehrenberg, Two or three species. Representative species (Fig. 952). . ConochUus unicornis Rousselet. tSJBS THE WHEEL ANIMALCULES (ROTATORIA) 619 138 (1) Two ovaries Subclass Digononta. In fresh water; only one group Order Bdelloida . . 139 Free-living. Swimming with the corona or creeping like a leech, or both. Body without lorica, usually nearly cylindrical, dorsal and ventral surfaces not being conspicuously differ- entiated, and composed of rings which may be drawn one within the other in telescopic fashion. A dorsal proboscis behind the corona; jaws ramate (Fig. 867). 139 (146) Corona present 140 140 (145) Corona of two nearly circular disks raised on short stalks, present- ing the appearance of two wheels. Family Phzlodinidae . . 141 141 (144) Eyes, two 14a 142 (143) Eyes in the dorsal proboscis Rotifer Schrank. Several species. Representative species (Fig. 958). . . Rotifer citrinus Ehrenberg. (Fig. 060). . . . R. neptunius Ehrenberg. 143 (142) Eyes in the neck, directly over the brain, just above the jaws. Philodina Ehrenberg. Several species. Representative species (Fig. 959). . . Philodina roseola Ehrenberg. (Fig. 867, A, page 577). . . P. brycei Weber. 144 (141) Eyes, none Callidina Ehrenberg. The genus Callidina when revised will be broken into several genera. Many species. Representative species (Fig. 961). . Callidina angusticollis Murray. 145 (140) Corona a flat surface covered with cilia on the ventral side of the anterior end Family Adinettdae. One genus only Adineta Hudson. Representative species (Fig. 957) Adineta vaga Davis. 146 (139) No corona Family Microdinidae. The mouth has a group of cilia about it. One genus only Microdina Murray. Representative species (Fig. 962 and Fig. 867, B, page 577). Microdina paradoxa Murray. 620 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY IMPORTANT REFERENCES ON FRESH-WATER ROTATORIA Ddcon-Nuttall, F. R., and Freeman, R. 1903. The Rotatorian Genus Diaschiza; a Monographic Study. Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1003: 1-14* 1 29-14 1. Harking, H. K. 1913. Synopsis of the Rotatoria. U. S. Natl. Museum, Bull. 81. 226 pp. (Changes some of the generic names here employed.) Hudson, C. T., and Gosse, P. H. 1889. The Rotifera or Wheel Animalcules. 2 vols. London. Jennings, H. S. 1000. Rotatoria of the United States with especial reference to those of the Great Lakes: Bull. U. S. Fish Com., 1899: 67-104. 1901. Synopsis of North American Invertebrates XVII. The Rotatoria. Amer. Nat., 35: 725-777; 171 figures. 1003. Rotatoria of the United States, II. A monograph of the Rat- tulidae. Bull. U. S. Fish Com., 1902: 273-352. 1004. Reactions to Stimuli in certain Rotifera. Carnegie Institution, Publ. 16: 73-88. Montgomery, T. H. 1003. On the Morphology of the Rotatorian Family Flosculariidae. Proc. Acad. Nat. Sci., Phila., 1003: 363-385. Rousselet, C. F. 1902. The Genus Synchada; a Monographic Study. Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1902: 260-290. Surface, F. M. 1906. The Formation of New Colonies of the Rotifer Mega- lotrocha alboflavicans Ehr. Biol. Bull., n: 182-192. Wesenberg-Lund, C. 1899. Danmarks Rotifera I. Grand traekkene i Roti- ferernes Okologi, Morfologi og Systematik. Kobenhavn. j>2 #'» CHAPTER XVIII GASTROTRICHA By HENRY B. WARD Professor of ZatUf), Unheriity sf Illinois Among the microscopic animals common in fresh water and limited in distribution to that environment are certain minute organisms known as the Gastrotricha. Though limited in variety of species they are so abundant, so widely distributed, and so strik- ing in appearance as to command the attention of every student of aquatic life. They live in numbers among algae and debris and in almost every bottom collection appear in company with the rotifers and protozoans. In movements and habits they resemble closely the ciliate Protozoa, and are easily confused with them. Fhrenberg, who first described in detail the structure of these organisms, placed them among the Rot if era and many later investigators have followed this suggestion. Others incline to regard them as Nematoda trom which they differ most strikingly in pos- sessing cilia which are not known in other worms of that group. In size they are strictly microscopic, varying ltnm 0.54 mm. in maxi- mum length to only one-eighth of that. They constitute a distinctly uniform group not closely related to any other existing types of animal life. Our knowledge of the anatomy of these organisms is due principally to the investigations of Stokes in this country andF^t&b£^^&T£i™ Zelinka in Germany. o, cuptuwui; /. ._ . The general structure of the group is well zJmk».) ' illustrated in the figure of Ckaetonolus maximus taken from Zelinka 's monograph (Fig. g63). While the form of the body approaches a cylinder, there is usually an expanded area in front known as the 622 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY "head," a narrower part just behind it called the "neck" and the larger "rump," or body proper, which constitutes the major portion of the animal. These regions are not sharply limited and sometimes can not be distinguished at all. They do not correspond to any internal structures. The ventral surface is more or less flattened and the dorsal surface arched as is conspicuously seen in side view. The head bears at its tip an opening, the mouth, surrounded by a row of delicate oral bristles which point forward. The sides of the head are often lobed and carry two circles or series of groups of fine sense hairs; those of the anterior series point outward and forward while the others are usually directed backward. Some- times the entire body is smooth, or it may be partly or entirely covered with plates, spines, or hooked bristles. These furnish the criteria for the distinction of species and are carefully described in the key. The posterior end of the body may be bluntly rounded, pointed, or forked. The caudal processes, often spoken of as "toes," carry special bristles and contain cement glands, the secretion of which is expressed through terminal pores and enables the animal to attach itself temporarily to objects in the water. On the ventral surface are two bands of cilia near the median line, extending nearly the entire length of the body. These con- stitute the chief organs of locomotion. The movements of the Gastrotricha are so graceful as to elicit admiration from every observer. In motion they recall the long-necked infusoria, though excelling the latter in speed and variety of movement. By bend- ing the body sharply on itself the animal may instantly reverse its course. Those species possessed of long bristles utilize them in moving by leaps like jumping rotifers. Other species employ the caudal processes in movement, looping the body and attaching the tips of these toes successively in different places. The internal anatomy is simple. From the mouth (Fig. 964, A), a straight alimentary canal traverses the length of the animal terminating in a simple anal orifice just above the posterior end of the body. One can distinguish an anterior muscular region, the esophagus and a posterior portion, the intestine (Fig. 964, C), which is lined by large digestive cells, rich in protoplasm. Small gland GASTROTRTCHA 623 ceDs an the esophagus are designated as salivary in character and other gland cells in a fringe at the beginning of the intestine have been regarded as hepatic or liver cells. The food of the Gastrotricha consists mainly of unicellular algae, the tests of which can often be recognized in the intestine. Six pairs of delicate longitudinal strands constitute the entire muscular system as there are neither circular nor oblique muscles. One pair of muscles extends nearly the entire length of the body; * the others occupy only the ante- rior or the posteriorregion meeting near the center. They lie in the body cavity which is devoid of any special lining epithelium. The head region of the body cavity is almost completely tilled by a B saddle-shaped mass (Fig. 064,^) of nerve cells dorsal and lateral to^ the esophagus which constitutes the brain. From it nerve fibers SfiHT'.i&SiS; m a. ***** u.^h go out to the anterior sense hairs ^«3£^f^ and lateral strands follow the t*™ n&mfwS* My ri^MjMGmthefaT alimentary canal to the posterior p"** 'nr* m, «. ihi upw Mri,„ "?« " r bmilev and ■■ ihr pntt*Hor up »nr rA t^t (fl«i end of the body. Minute pigment ■*» ****** i—i- x«» tAhw %«■*•.) spots which may be designated as eyes certainly occur in some species despite the doubts expressed by Zelinka. Excretory organs are present in the form of a pair of lateral much coiled tubes near the center of the body. The inner end of each tube is closed by a long flame cell and the outer end opens on the ventral surface near the median line and just behind the center of the body. Just behind these coils, in the mature females, lie the large eggs that mark the anterior limit of the simple ovary. These eggs become so large that they extend over one-third to one-half the length of the entire body and increase its normal transverse diameter noticeably so as to modify greatly the form of the gravid female. The large, oval eggs arc laid on algal threads or empty shells of other animals. When deposited they have a uFm.9fi«. 624 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY tough thick shell, often covered with hooks and knobs, that seem to anchor them in place. When the embryo has reached its full development its vigorous movements burst the shell and a full- grown animal emerges. No one has yet described a male and it is uncertain that any other type than the female exists. This form may have a sperm- producing organ yet undiscovered and thus be in reality hermaph- roditic or may reproduce exclusively by parthenogenesis. The Gastrotricha have been studied but little in North America. Of the seventy-five species thus far described only sixteen have been recorded from the United States. Most of these were found and described by Stokes at Trenton, New Jersey. While this dis- tribution appears highly local there is no doubt that search in other places will demonstrate for American species the same wide general distribution that has been shown for European forms. Further study will doubtless result also in the discovery of many other species on this continent, since the evidence thus far secured indicates that, like most minute aquatic organisms, these forms, too, are cosmopolitan in distribution. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER GASTROTRICHA z (31) Caudal end prolonged into two prominent lateral processes. Suborder Euichthydina . . 2 Each caudal process encloses a glandular apparatus and bears a pore at the tip. 2 (11) Body naked, scaled, or covered with rugosities or papillae, but never bearing spines Family Ichthydhdae . . 3 3(6) Body without scales; cuticula smooth. Ichthydium Ehrenberg 1830 . . 4 Seven or eight species described; only two reported from North America. 4 (5) Surface of body entirely smooth, no constant furrows or ridges. Ichthydium podura O. F. M tiller 1786. Total length 0.075 mm.; esophagus 0.0188 mm., caudal process 0.00875 mm. long. Breadth of anterior region 0.0163 mm. The cuticula is thin and is often laid in deep wrinkles, but these are entirely inconstant. The lateral margins show no trace of being flattened. The caudal processes are sharply set off from the body. Eggs smooth. FiO, 965. Ichthydium podura in dorsal view. X 360. (After Zelinka.) GASTROTRICHA 625 S (4) Dorsal and lateral surface with de?p transverse furrows. Posterior region of body narrow and elongated. Ichthydium sulcatum Stokes 1887. Total length o, 107 to 0.187 nun. entire length. The body is unusual ate so flattened that they impart ti esophagus not more than one-sixth the i soil and flexible. The lateral margin) the body the effect of wings. The pot- . longer than in other species. Fie. 966. Pmtcrior region of IcUkyiium nuicolm* in 6 (3) Body covered with smooth scales or with rounded papillae, but without spines Lepidoderma Zelinka 1889 . . 7 Six species described; three reported from North America. 7 (10) Minute soft scales present 8 8 (9) Scales shield-shaped. Lepidoderma squamatum (Dujardin) 1841. Length of body irom o.iiq to 0.1 mm., of esophagus 0.041 to 0.044 mm.; breadth of anterior region 0.033 mm., of posterior body also 0.033 mm. Large smooth scales near the posterior end seen in profile simulate curved bristles or spines. Scales on body and neck in seven alter- nating longitudinal rows; on posterior region eight rows present. New Jersey. (D)DO Fie. 967. Lrfidatmma dorsal bcbIh of head, neck, and (After Zelinka.) 9 (8) Scales rhombic, pointed. . . . Lepidoderma rhomboides (Stokes) 1887. Fvo. 968. UMUtrma viewofhead. B.aud Length 0.1Q5 m 0.046 mm. Bod 000506 mm. long, thickened along the margins. Posterior margin of each scale appears to carry ' --ryscaJe. Caudal pt ; breadth of anterior region lone, slender. Esophagus total length." Scales supplemen ew Jersey. nnarkably long, marked by about 626 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 10 (7) Body covered with hemispherical papillae. Lepidoderma Length 0.096. Body cylindrical. Back and sides covered ■ small naif-round papillae arranged in thick-set obiique rows. smooth, 0.055 mm. long. New Jersey. Fio. 969. Posterior region c X about 11 (3) Body provided with spines either attached to the dermal scales 01 springing directly from the surface. Family Chaetonotoae . . 1a it (30) Caudal process simple; spines attached to dermal scales. Chaetonotus Ehrenberg 1830 . . 13 A large and complicated group; more than forty species already described; ten Species re- ported from North America by Stokes. 13 (10) Dorsal spines nearly uniform in length, at most twice as long on posterior region as on anterior region, and without any marked transition from one size to another 14 14 {15) Dorsal spines with accessory barbs or points. Anterior region sharply set 06 from so-called " neck." Chaetonotus simitis Zelinka 1889. Length of body o.n to 0.31 mm., of esophagus 0.05 nun. Body covered dorsally and laterally with triangular scales carrying spines with accessory point. Oral funnel plicate. Originally described from Trenton, New Jersey, as Ck. maxtmui which it closely resembles in head and body. Under a high magnification differ- .. _ the spines appear. All of them are forked and have fine lateral point near the tip. GASTROTKICHA 637 15(14) Dorsal spina simple; i*., without Lateral barbs or paints. . . . 16 16(17) Anterior region sharply set off from narrow "neck" region. Ckactonetms Jarmtmu Stokes 1887. Length 0-160 am Oral rim omraidy boded. Bead three lobed- Donal in) lateral HpBUfll body aumd with snort, f I i| 11 ~|1 SgM 1 I ■■hniiniiili An* ■ ■- ■ ■ njmjml, in length arana ana-, orhaa. Trenton, New Jersey. 17 (16) Transition from anterior region to body gradual, not sharply marked at any point 18 8 (19) Head rounded. Ckadonelui bnaispttustts Zelinka 1889. Length of body 0.095 to 0.140 nun . Spina torurrwinl canred, rrmarsahfir short, iL. — „ - ..„_ r norfy, ursngrd in eleven rows Head circular in front, whs four t'-A eye-spots. The onJy American spco« reported more than once. fl '4 OrooD, Me., and Trenton, New Jersey. It n the C. Una of Stokes, u vT ( ahn of Frxnald. Fit 9/1. Ctitla*t 1> tsstsUS 19 (18) Head five lobed. Chaetonottu acanthodes Stokes 1887. scale; the latter in the anterior n„.„ , ! just beta™! the middle of the body these tetrui- of larger spina. On each ride near the caudal FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 30 (13) Certain dorsal spines of much greater length than others. imber of European species hive s n c Imaaes the next species amont a ut bifurcate. the latter despite Stokes' positive statement that the 1 (36) Head and neck free from covering of small spines. Large spines on body props'. 22 a (13) Large dorsal spines in longitudinal rows and of approximately equal length Chaelonotus oclonarius Stokes 1887. Length 0.0862 to 0.1034 nun. Breadth of distinctly Gve-iobed head 0.03c* mm. Large spines unequally furcate arranged in two lateral rows of three spines each and a median row with one anterior and one posterior spine. The figures and descriptions given by Stokes and Grunapann do not agree fully and may belong to separate species. Rare; Trenton, New Jersey. X about 580. (Alts Stokes.) 13 (12) Large dorsal spines in two distinct transverse rows, with spines in one row clearly longer than those of the other. .... 34 34 (35) Eight (rarely fewer) large spines in two transverse rows set close together. Chaelonotus Umgupinosus Stokes 1887. Length 0,0736 mm. Large spines usually eight, four in each row, or five in one and three in the other; sometimes only four spines in ill [the others bst?); longer spines in posterior row. The figure i Grunapann is really the neat species. The European fi ai this species is twice a* large. Trenton, New Jersey. Flo. 91*. OaKnihu 'inriiai— nu hi dorsal view. XBio. [ GASTROTRICHA 35 (34) Seven (rarely fewer) large spines in two widely separated transverse rows Ckaetottotus spinulosvs Stokes 1887. Length 0.0675 to 0.08a nun. Usually four large spines in anterior row and three in posterior. Some may be suppressed (or lost?), leav- ing three in front and only one in the oenter behind. Spines of anterior row distinctly longer. Egg 0.0330 nun. long, coveted on one side with short hairs. The embryo escapes in thirty hours and thirty hours later the young individual shows an ovarian egg in which the nucleus becomes conspicuous six hours liter. Spines present 1 head and neck much smaller than those on >, 29) Four transverse rows < of body. Also on- process. .... ' large dorsal spines on posterior region large lateral spine on each side at caudal Ckaetimolus acarJhophursts Stokes 1887. Length 0.10S mm. Head and neck covered with short spines. Large spines on body in four cross rows of five each, not alternating so that they appear also as rive longitudinal rows of four spines each. The last lateral spine at the base of the caudal process is large and much like those in the dorsal rows. Trenton, New Jersey. 38 (37, 39) One transverse row of large spines just in front of the caudal end of the body Ckaetonotus spinijer Stokes 1887. Length 0.1054 mm. Back and sides covered by rounded imbricated scales, each with stout recurved spine minutely furcate at tip. The four spines in a single series immediately in front of the caudal process are much larger and stouter than those on the rest of the body. Egg ornamented with processes varying in length and shape in different specimens. Stokes distinguishes eggs with three separate pattems^resnec- tively, 0.0705, 0-073S, and 00793 mm. long. Trenton, New Jersey. Pic. 97i- Ctaetownu (fnWAr. ^.tpatoK tcala B. por- tion of ear. showing uifid and quadrr&d spawn In prook and surface aspects. Highly roagnnwd. (Attar Stoke..) 630 29 (27i 28) FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Five transverse rows with thirteen large spines. Also two con- spicuous lateral spines on each side near the end. Chaetonotus enormis Stokes 1887. Length 0.0846 mm. Of the thirteen large spines three stand in the ante- rior row, four in the next, one at the extreme on each side in the next, three in the fourth row, and one at the center in the fifth row. On each side near the caudal process are two forked spines easily confused with those of the five rows which they much resemble. Trenton, New Jersey. Fig. 978. . Ckoekmotus enormis in dorsal view. X 530. (After Stokes.) 30 (12) Caudal process branching or notched. A transverse row of large spines near its base. Body surface rough. Chaeturina Ward. Only one species known. Chaeturina capricornia (Metchinkoff) 1864.. A swamp animal not yet reported from North America. 31 (1) No caudal processes. Posterior end simply rounded or lobed, in the latter case provided with long fine spines. Suborder Apodina. Reported from North America Family Dasydytedae. iwo genera described for Europe. Single North American genus Dasydytes Gosse 185 1. Several species listed from Europe. Only species reported from North America. Dasydytes saUUans Stokes 1887. Length 0.085 mm. Head three lobed, distinctly separated from body by slender neck, provided with two rows of cilia which vibrate alternately. Four long heavy spines arise on each side near the neck and cross the back obliquelv. Two long straight spines, and two others long and curved, project from the posterior end. This spedes swims rapidly but also moves by sudden leaps to one side or the other, covering a distance equal to double its length or more in a single jump. Trenton, New Jersey. Fto. 979. DtyiyHs mMmi m donal view. X 4x0. (After Stokes.) GASTROTRICHA 631 IMPORTANT PAPERS ON NORTH AMERICAN GASTROTRICHA Fernald, C. H. 1883. Notes on the CkaeUmotus lams. Amer. Nat., 17: 1217-1220; 2 figs. Interesting biological study on Ch. brcvispinosus. GrOnspann, Th. 1910. Die Susswasser-Gastrotrichen Europas. Ann. BioL Lacustre, 4: 211-365; 61 figs. Stokes, A. C. 1887. Observations on Chaetonotus. The Microscope, 7: I-9> 33-43; 2 pi. Translated in Jour. Microg., 11: 77-85, 150-153, 560- S65; 2 pi. 1887a. Observations on a New Dasydytes and a New Chaetonotus. The Microscope, 7: 261-265; 1 pi. Translated in Jour. Microg., 12: 19-22, 40-51; 1 pi. 1806. Aquatic Microscopy for Beginners. Third edition (Gastrotricha, pp. 178-193). Zeunka, C. 1889. Die Gastrotrichen. Zeit. f. wiss. Zool., 49: 209-384; 5pL CHAPTER XIX AQUATIC EARTHWORMS AND OTHER BRISTLE-BEARING WORMS (CHAETOPODA) By FRANK SMITH Earthworms, with their flexible segmented bodies and four double rows of bristles, or setae, are objects familiar to all students of animal life. Although most species are terrestrial there are also aquatic ones and these are abundantly represented in our fresh waters. Closely related to the earthworms and similar in structure are numerous other worms which are essentially aquatic These abo, with certain exceptions, are provided with setae and are included with earthworms in the group Oligochaetau The setae- bearing worms of the sea (Fohxhaeta) commonly bear die setae on lateral muscular outgrowths of die body wall, the paiapodia* Hie Oligochaeta and PoJychaeta collectively are often referred to as the ;•»* i.» »* Hie Chaetopoda, Hirudinea (leeches), and certain strictly marine worms which are not under consideration here, are included in the phylum Annelida. Fresh-water Polychaeta Although die Folychaeta are essentially marine in habit, a few species in various parts of the worid have become adapted to fresh-water conditions. Mvmeymmkic sperittsa Leidy is loond ia the Schuylkill River and in other fresh-water situations near PhD*- de^hta^ and Johnson has described two fresh-water ^*oes from the mesteui coast region. — Xems HmmiaAe Johnson from Lake Merced, near San Francisoo, and Lycasimdet ettk&bi Johnson from These are stray intruders from the rich, marine faana of this gRMf> in n^jwent salt water, and none have yet been discovered AQUATIC JbARTHWORM- O33 at any great distance irom the sea. r urine:, more careful study oi the hit in oracidsn water estuaries and iresh- water bodies in dose contiguity witn tnc ocean is iikeiy to reveal Uie presence of such ioims in other iocaiitie- IJbLLSH-WATKK ULlOUUiAL':. The OiigochaeUt, including tne eartnworms and related aquatic iorms, arc &egnienuu wornis which have a somewhat extensixe and weii-aennea Dou\ cavrt\ separating tiie ainneiiLary tract irom the bouy wah. Tuev art hermaphrodrd^, with tne reproductive organs iimiteu to * lew uennite segment- o: somites. The bristie- iike setae in tne dog\ wan aid in locomotion, out such setae are absent in tne lamhy Ldscodrhidae whieh are parasitic on the ex- terna* suria-_c- oi crayusnes. The majority of the species are terrestrL.i., an^ tne aquui;- ionn.- an. nearly ad eon fined to iresh water. seven lamina ^ aquat;; GiigochaeU.. are found in the northern neinispneie and are ad abundantly represented in the United state.- Morpnuwguui hciduonj. due genera: ;.»:a* m structure 01 the aquatic iorni; agree- essentia! ".; wit;.- that <-■:" the earthworm. Lxterna* metamerism is indicate 1 iy. tne iransversc grooves and by the segmental arranged seta'., and the corresponding interna' metamerism 1- recognizable 1:. tne sept:., nepnridia. transverse biood vessels, and in the ganglia «»f tne ventrai nerve chain. Tin. pros tumi urn — tiie dorsal par: «■: the anterior somite extending anterior t' the iue*ut: - i. \e-v liexibie and sensitive, and is an important tact!:-, organ wnie: in s«>me specie- if prolonged into a probosch Tig. '.'._. The somite- are numbered consecutively iron; the anterior en^. an : are designated in tnese page? by Roman nu- merals in aceordan-.-.- w::: .. comm^r practice The boundary between two somit*. .- is indicate : \r.ivr X Idl The beta- are usual:;" conspicuous an-., are 0: taxonomic impor- tance. They are commonly grouped into dorsal and ventral bundles. tiie most antcrio: ventrai pairs beini: aiways or. the second somitf Figure, uc-: illustrates some 0:" the more usua. types 01 setae. The nephridia are tne sejrmenta' excretory organs, which typi- cally are paired and are usuaiiy present in ah somites oi the body 634 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY except a few anterior ones and one at the posterior encL Not infre- quently 3ome of the nephridia may fail to develop, when a more or less irregular and asymmetrical distribution results. The reproductive organs of the fresh-water OGgochaeta are simi- lar to those of the terrestrial earthworms. One or two pairs of male gonads (spermaries or testes) are attached to the anterior septa of certain somites and extend freefy posteriad into the cavities of the somites. One or two pairs of ovaries are correspondingly situated m somites posterior to those which contain the spermaries^ The sperm ducts of most species have their internal openings or spermiducal funnels in the somites which contain the spermaries* and the external openings, or spermiducal poresr on some somite posteriad; but in a few species both openings may be in the same somite. In many species the sperm ducts are modified in various ways, givfng rise to prostates, atria and storage chambers (Fig. 990), The internal openings of the oviducts, the oviducal funnels, are in the ovarian samite, and the oviducal pores are either at the posterior boundary of the same somite or, more commonly, on the following one. Accessory reproductive organs are commonly present. Evaginations of the septa of the somites which contain spermaries form sperm sacs in which the sperm cells may complete their development and be temporarily stored before they pass out through the sperm ducts during copulation. Evaginations of the posterior septa of the ovarian somite form ovisacs. Invaginations of the body wall of certain somites produce spermathecae, usually paired, which serve for storage of the sperm cells received during copulation, from another individual. Sexual reproduction occurs in all families of fresh-water OHgo- chaeta at more or less definite seasons of the year. In the two families Naididae and Aeolosomatidae, asexual reproduction by budding is the mode by which the majority of new individuals are produced. Figure 980 exhibits the main features of the process and renders an extended description unnecessary. The body wall thickens anterior to the middle of the budding somite and forms a budding zone, the anterior half of which gives rise to an indefinite number of new somites which form the posterior part of the ante- rior daughter-worm. The posterior half of the budding zone M >»„• * i ' i . iviK'i H \\ ui . ' " (if JSaiuiJar>, wilt*. 11 lorii uu»- a.Uw m..; r;j:: ■„. ji W'TIl.. J. lit: CLiU££iLLi;i-wv!"lui;»I ml .wiv £i|JMi.. .. L11U> 1/iYt Jir. iv v-i... *♦' - *jo^ J. i . A • J U i i1 ■- . .j: » -.■- - t ..*. v.i ,?v: a: ^ LjJV -• *•'>*« -V . »L .. . ■„ i'w. i i v . L - » - . . . * 1 m . ■ ■ Vi« '~ L * * * 1 - '■ ' - k-wl i - V _•> .•.. % • ...."■' i.*. ......... .. ■„ ..'.. .■*».. fc , ., 1" i« * |i-' ■■' ■■ ■ " ■ %^ • • M m w IL » — ^rf te« • . ta • « 4 ■III . . > » , , V.- L--*. « .1 ■ i . k > »' • - •- - . . .1 . .. \ V.'^*. ww. 4.; L»-J*-. ** 1-*:' • 1 v;.. : - * ■ • JL1.... •* . . . Ip % • • « m. ..1m. bl! 'J • ' - v • - 636 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY rapidity that they can extensively populate large masses of mori- bund algae in a very short time, and their activity accounts in part for the speedy disappearance of such masses in the autumn. Although many of these worms will not thrive in polluted water, others are adapted to foul conditions where fermentation is rife, and, in fact, multiply most rapidly in such situations. Some species of this sort feed extensively on the zoogloeic masses which abound where fermentation is active. The food of most Oligo- chaeta consists chiefly of decaying vegetable matter, but worms of a common Naid species, Chaetogaster diaphanus, have a marked preference for Chydarus sphaericus, & Cladoceran species which they capture and devour in large numbers. Worms of the family Dis- codrilidae are parasitic on crayfishes. Certain of the Naididae can swim effectively in open water, but a great majority of the Oligochaeta are limited to crawling move- ments for locomotion. Striking structural adaptations are not numerous in the group, but the peculiar modification of the posterior end in Aulophorus and Dero for purposes of respiration, deserves mention. These worms live chiefly in tubes of their own making or with their bodies almost wholly buried in masses of vegetable material, and respiration is aided by well-developed gill structures (Fig. 985). The Discodrilidae in adaptation to their peculiar mode of life, have become so leech-like in action and external appearance that for- merly it was usual to treat them as belonging to the Hirudinea rather than to the Oligochaeta. Collection and Preservation. The larger specimens may be ob- tained by carefully screening mud from bottoms and shores and from about the roots of coarse plants through fine-meshed nets or sieves. Others may be obtained by carefully pulling to pieces decaying rushes and masses of algae. Smaller specimens often may be obtained from the sides of aquaria in which mud and vege- table material have been allowed to stand for a few days. During the fermentation of such masses large numbers of small worms appear in the surface layers and about the margins. The most successful methods of preservation vary with different species, and must be gained by experiment, but some general hints AQUATIC EARTHWORMS 637 may be given here. Specimens intended for sectioning must be kept in water and material which is free from grit until the alimen- tary tract is cleansed from mud and sand. The methods necessary for securing straight and well-extended specimens for fixation vary greatly with the species. Dilute solutions of the fixing agent when of the right strength will often cause the worms to die in a properly extended condition, and this is especially true of some of the Tubificidae when corrosive sublimate is used. Commonly some means of narcotization is required to secure the relaxation neces- sary for the preparation of well-extended specimens. Good re- sults are often obtained by the gradual addition of a solution of chloretone until the worms no longer respond to stimuli and fail to contract excessively when placed in the fixing fluid. Another common expedient used with success for some species is to immerse the worms in water within a closed vessel and there subject them to the action of the vapor of chloroform, which is put into the same closed vessel but in a separate container. Only the vapor should be allowed to reach the water that contains the worms. When properly narcotized the specimens may be immersed in the fixing agent and kept straight by holding them against any convenient straight edge until they have become sufficiently rigid. A rectangular glass candy-tray is a convenient vessel for fixation purposes since the angles formed by the sides and the bottom furnish good opportunities for keeping the worms straight. It is often advantageous to use a small amount of fixing fluid at first and to keep the worms only partially submerged until they have become stiffened and then completely immerse them. Small speci- mens like tubificids and enchytraeids may be conveniently fixed on a glass plate with the aid of square-edged toothpicks which have been soaked in the fixing agent. A toothpick with the adhering fluid is placed on the glass, an anesthetized worm stretched along one edge of the toothpick, another toothpick placed against the other side of the worm and a second worm stretched along the free edge of the second toothpick. A repetition of this process will enable one to prepare a considerable number of specimens in a brief time. Subsequent treatment is like that for other material of similar nature. 638 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER OLIGOCHAETA i (45) Well-developed setae present on most somites a 2 (24) Reproduction chiefly asexual, by budding; sexual reproduction less frequent. Clitellum, when present, on some somites of V-VIII. Length less than 25 mm. in most species. . 3 3 (4) Setae of ventral bundles as well as dorsal setae capilliform; septa imperfectly developed; prostomium broad and ciliated ven- t rally; integument of most species contains conspicuous colored bodies of some shade of red, green, or yellow. Usu- ally 1-2 mm. long Family Aeolosomatidae. A eolosoma Ehrenberg is the only North American genus and the species of the U. S. nave not been much studied. A . tenebrarum Vejdovsky has pale yellow or greenish integumental bodies. One or two species with colorless bodies are known. A . hemprichi Ehrenberg has salmon-colored bodies. This last named species thrives exceptionally well in hay infusions and in similar cultures from wheat and thus large numbers are readily obtained for experimental purposes. Fig. 981. Aeolostma hemprichi. Lankester.) Xao. (After 4(3) 5(8) 6(7) Ventral setae all uncinate (Fig. 991); septa well developed; do brightly colored integumental bodies. Family Naididae . . 5 No dorsal setae 6 Ventral bundles of setae on III-V as on other somites. SchtnardaeHa Michaelsen 1900. The South American species 5. filiformis (Schmarda) has recently been reported from Lake St Clair (Moore, 1006). 7(6) No setae on III-V. Somite III much elongated. Chaetogaster K. von Baer 1827. F». 982. ChocUKsster limnati. X 40. (After Lanketter.) Several species are known from North America, of which C. limnati K. von Baer, which fives in mollusks, and the large transparent C. diaphanut (Gruithuisen), 10-1$ mm. long; areeaaly isenj, io-is recognited. 8 (5) Setae in both dorsal and ventral bundles. 9 9 (12) No capilliform setae in dorsal bundles. 10 AQOJOTC EAItTHWOKMS %i (ri) Setae nf dossal him riles all imriimte. . Tanmois CarniiHwLy xrJBo, P. Iftwoiij (Matter) iriwrtrri as abundant on the New Rngamri coast and my occur in The fiat drawl setae see an V. (3D) Doxsal setae nearly straight, slightly toothed or snnpte-pointeL Opkidonais Gctvbe X&3&. 0. atrpemiima (Mutter) may be easily Tirngnrard by the small iiragiilaily distributed dorsal setae; by thefouranpe transverse pigmented areas on the anterior TggwFn, and by the Tekstively large size. Length 75-30 mm. Pic. 9B3. Anteriaread of X4D. ( X2 (p) Capillif arm setae present in dorsal him riles . 13 13 (21) First anterior doxsal setae anTar VL 34 24 (iB) Posterior end not modified into a giB-bearing respiratory organ; fest anterior doxsal setae on "VI 15 15 (r6. 17) One or more capillif orm setae of VI mnch longer than those of other somites and equal to three or four times the diameter of the body Shrnna Vejdoroky 1885. 5. afipuMJiiulutu (dTJdekem), nrnimnn in same pares of the United States, has body surface lodrtrri with sensory papillae and with foreign bodies. x6 (15, 17) ProBtamimn elongated to form a proboscis; dorsal setae of VI similar in length to those of other somites. Stylaria Lamarck x&xa. 5. lacustris (Xhmaeus) has proboscis ******* \y$ uiuun- nent lateral prostomial lobes (Figs. o8p and Q&4). S.fof- jaioroLeidy lacks the lateral prostomial lobes (Fig. 084). Hit former is abundant and widely attributed in tie United States while the Jotter s reported on|y very quentty. A.S. B,S.Jasmiuru. X40. (Orj T7 (15, 16) Without proboscis; doxsal setae of XI snnflar in length to those of other wmiftfs JFazs MnUer 1774, ff",|"t without conspicuons dffieieuces ore Teported from the United States W. Mutter is one of the best-known species and K. iummmmu Piguet is very common. 18(14) 29(20) Posterior end modified into a guVbearing inspiratory organ, the branchial area. 10 Ventral margin of the branchial area with a pair of long Aulofkoms Schmarda 1861. A.jwraOm (Oken) has the first dorsal setae on T and has two pairs of well-developed gflk. A. wjostT Leidy amwk or floats about in a tube made from bryosoon statoblaals and bits of vegetation. It bos the first dorsal setae on YI and bos only slightly devel- oped gilk. cad of 640 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 20 (19) Ventral margin of the branchial area without long processes. Dero Oken 1815. D. limosa Leidy is abundant and the best known of the North American species. D. obtusa d'Udekem and a species which prob- ably is D. pcrrieri Bousefield are of frequent occurrence, but a careful study of the North American representatives of this genus, as well as of Nats, is necessary before we can be sure of their exact relation to European species. F10.986. Posterior end of Dero limosa. X >5- (After Bousefield.) 21 (13) First anterior dorsal setae on II 22 22 (23) Dorsal setae of two kinds: capilliform and shorter needle-f6rm setae which commonly have cleft distal ends. Naidium O. Schmidt 1847. N. osborni Walton has been described from Lake Erie (Walton, 1906). This genus is united with Pristina by some writers. 23 (22) Dorsal setae all capilliform, mostly with very fine teeth on convex side; prostomium commonly elongated into a proboscis. Pristina Ehrenberg 1831. / \ Q.8. V.4. P. longiseta var. leidyi Frank Smith has the capilliform setae of III greatly lengthened (.700 mm.) and without serrations. The typical form of this species as found in Europe has extremely minute inconspicuous serrations on the capilliform setae of dorsal bundles of somites other than III. In the variety P. I. leidyi, which is found in the United States and certain other parts of the world, the serrations are coarser and more easily seen. Fid. 987. Pristina longiseta var. leidyi. v. s., ventral seta; X300. d. j., part of seta from dorsal bundle. X 450. (After Smith.) P. fiagdlum Leidy has a very characteristic posterior end. Specimens of this species have been met with by the writer but once and when there was no opportunity for study beyond enough to convince him of the general accu- racy of Leidy's description and that the species really belongs to Pristina. Representatives are sometimes found of certain species in which the dorsal setae of m are not especially elongated but their exact relationship to Eu- ropean species is uncertain. Fid. 988. Posterior end of Pristina ftageUnm. X 16. (After Leidy.) 24 (2) Reproduction sexual, never by budding; clitellum ordinarily poste- rior to VIII 25 25 (34, 35) Ordinarily more than two well-developed setae in each of some or all of the bundles; ventral setae ordinarily cleft (exc. Telma- todrtius: see below); clitellum ordinarily on X or XI and one or more adjacent somites; i pores ordinarily on XI, ex- ceptionally on XII; spermathecal pores on somite anterior to one bearing £ pores (in North American species) ; length commonly more than 25 mm.; blood vessels usually with con- spicuous red contents. . . . Family Tubotcidae . . 26 Accurate identification of species in this family usually requires the aid of careful dissec- tions or of serial sections, and depends largely on a careful study of the reproductive organs. (Fig. 990.) AQUATIC EARTHWORMS 64I Sperm-ducts without definite prostate glands and opening into a common median chamber with single ventral median open- ing on XI; spetmathecal pores on X; setae of dorsal bundles all deft. Rkuodrilus Frank Smith rooo. One species thus far known in North Amelia, R. lochia Frank Smith, found in roots of SofiUorio in Illinois. Has two kinds of genital setae on DC and XI; length 75-ioomm.; whitish in appearance (Smith, igoo). Michaclscn includes this species in UontipyitplvTiu Levinsen. Ftc 5*9. KJamtrilK! Ixlan. 1, ordinary uncinate acta; i and c, genital setae from LX and XL X 150 (After Smith.) Sperm-ducts with definite prostate glands. . 28 Ten or more small definite prostates on each sperm-duct; no capil- liform setae; setae indistinctly cleft and sometimes simple- pointed Tdmoiodrilus Eisen 1879. T. ajiLmiyi Eisen and T. nscrrifm Eisen, are found in Cslifoinia. Sperm-ducts each with one definite prostate gland (Fig. 090). . 30 Dorsal setae all uncinate and similar to ventral setae; penis with chitinous sheath Ltmnodrilus Claparede 1863. Several species have been described from California (Eisen, 1885)- L . gracilii Moore has recently been described from Lake Erie (Moore, 1006). Id L.dapan- diamu Ratzel, an abundant species of wide distribution, the length of the chitinous penis sheath is 8-30 times its diameter. Fio. 99?- I ducal funnel; t, t, sperm-duct; *, pros r, atrium: nl, penis and penis dieath; Xso. (After Mom.) Dorsal bundles ordinarily contain capillifonn setae and also pecti- nate or palmate setae. (Fig. 091.) 3*. 33 (33) Length of atrium and penis combined, at least two-thirds that of the remainder of the sperm-duct. . Ilyodrilui Eisen 1870, Three species described from California (Eisen, 1885). 642 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 33 (32) Atrium and penis combined, much shorter than the remainder of the sperm-duct Tubifex Lamarck 181 6. Several species have been described from North America. T. tubifex (Miiller; is a widely distributed species and abundant both in Europe and the United States. An- other species, T. multisetosus (Frank Smith) from Illinois has large integumental papillae and conspicuous clusters of capilliform setae (Smith, 1900). (Figs. 991 and 992.) Fig. 992. Anterior somites of Tubifex multisetosus. X 13. (Original.) 34 (2S< 35) Ordinarily with more than two setae in each of some or all the bundles; setae simple-pointed and usually nearly straight; clitellum on XII and on more or less of adjacent somites; c? pores ordinarily on XII; spermathecal pores on IV/V. Ordinarily whitish in appearance and seldom more than 25 mm. in length. Both terrestrial and aquatic species abound Family Enchytraeidae . . 35 There are numerous species of this family represented in the fresh waters of North America, which have only recently received attention from the systematists of the group. Eisen (1005) has described several fresh-water species from the Pacific Coast states belonging to Mesenchytraeus Eisen, Enchytraeus Henle and Lumbricillus Oersted. Smith and Welch (1013) have described Marionina forbesae from Illinois and Welch (1914) has described Lumbricillus rutilus from Illinois. 35 (25, 34) Ordinarily with not more than two well-developed setae per bundle, or eight more or less separated setae per somite. ... 36 36 (37, 42) Setae simple-pointed; ' should be stupefied and relaxed by placing a little carbon dioxide \as soda water;, chlorotone, or cocaine in the water. For preservation they should always be first relaxed with similar reagents and extended before fixing. Chromic acid in one-quarter to one-half per cent solutions, picro-sulphuric acici. Gilson's fluid, corrosive-sublimate-acetic mixture and Fleming V fluids are all good nxatives, but great cart should be taken to wash out the acids in order to prevent swelling of the connective tissues. Forma- lin is a good preservative ior general purposes. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER LEECHES 1 (36 Alouth a small port' ii; oral sucker irom which a muscular pro- boscis may be proiruuei! . no jaw> Suborder Rhynchobdeliae . . 2 2 (33) Body not divided into two regions usually much depressed, eyes near median line; stomach usuaHy with well developed lateral ceca Family Glossiphonidaf . . 3 3 (28) Complete somited essentially triannulate 4 4 (13) Epididymis and ejaculatory duct forming a long, open, backward loop, salivary glands di(iu>c; eyes simple; size small; chiefly under stones and on plants in ponds and lakes. Gloss ip)wn id Johnston ibiu . . % 5 (10) Eyes one pair, well separatee. Genitai pores separated by one annulu.- 6 6 (7) A brown chitinoid piatt and underlying nuchal gianc! on dorsum of VH1 Glossiplioni a stagnalis (Linnaeus) 17 5S. 7 (6; No nuchal gland or plate 8 8 (9; Greatly elongated, slender and nearly terete; withou: papillae; very transparent; colorless; gastric ceca one pair. Glossiphonia nephdoidca ^Grafy 1S99. 652 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 9 (8) Relatively short, broad and flat; cutaneous papillae absent or in 1 to 5 series, small or large, often double; deeply pigmented in narrow longitudinal lines, or diffusely with metameric white spots on neural annuli; gastric ceca six pairs, simple. Clossiplionia fuscti Castle 1900. This speck the dorsal cr and limited very variable, especially in the character of ay be scarcely evident segments, or large and ,eof the tire length, or in any intermedial median series are formed of a pair 01 papillae more or less completely coalesced. Usually they are deeply pigmented and contrast strongly with the clear white spots flanking them. Tbe eyes an unusually large and conspicuous. It lives in ponds but also id colder waters than most species of the genus, even in springs, and attaches itself to the larger water snails and more rarely to leeches. The eggs, like those of Ctesnpkenia camptanaia, are laid in a few large gelatinous capsules borne on the venter of the parent leech and midsummer. GUttiphmiajuiL- much less active than Glossipkmia camptanaia and feeds frequently upon worms and larvae, preferring snails. rj(4) « (>7> le orifice; #f, ovary; 1 ejacIuUtorius. X is. (Modified Eyes three pairs 11 Genital pores separated by one annulus; eyes in three groups of two, in a triangular figure; body transparent, with little pigment; no papulae; gastric ceca six pairs, nearly or quite unbranched. . . Glossiphonia kclaodita (Linnaeus) 1758. Genital pores separated by two annuli; eyes in two nearly parallel rows; body rather thick and opaque, usually deeply pig- mented, a pair of dorsal and ventral dark, narrow lines run- ning for nearly entire length; gastric ceca seven pairs, slightly branched. . Glossiphonia tu-wftwitMa (Linnaeus) 17 58. Epididymis more or less complexly and compactly folded in vi- cinity of atrium; salivary glauds usually compact. . . 14 One pair of anterior compound eyes; gastric ceca seven pairs, usually much branched; salivary glands compact; size mod- erate to large. Temporary parasites on water turtles, frogs and fishes; most species also free-living. PlacobdtOa R. Blanchard 1803 . 15 Somites I-V distinctly widened to form a discoid "head." Somites I and II biannulate; dorsum with three strong papilla ted keels. Cm fishes and frogs. . Placobdella mmtfiftra Woartigia. Somites I-V not especially widened, 17 THE LEECHES (HIRliDINEA) 653 Anus at XXIII-XXIV and following somites forming a narrow sucker pedicle. Gastric ceca branched once; very con- tractile; no cutaneous papillae. Nearly permanent parasite on fishes in Minnesota, lakes. Placobddia ptdiadata Hemingway 1008. Anus behind XXVII; posterior segments normal. Placobddia (s. sir,). . , 10 Cutaneous papillae smooth and round- 30 Integuments opaque, deeply pigmented in a conspicuous pattern of olive green and yellow; annulus a* without trace of a secondary furrow; size large. Common on Ckdydra, etc. Placobddia parasitica (Say) 1824. One of the best known of our leechei, most often found Hinging In Urge numbers to the naked akin at the base of the bind legs of the mapping turtle whose blood they luck. Large ludi- e from 3 to 4 inches .—„ ... ^__. extension and are very broad, thin, and foliaceous. When bearing eggs or young they often leave the host and for a time lead a free hie in ponds and streams, feeding c sting sight family of yo crowded family of youngsters actively bending and turning on the venter of the parent, the thin margins of whose body are inrolled to form a protecting fold. The color pattern U rich and striking, the ground color of dull green or olive green standing in sharp con- trast to the bold and characteristic markings of yellow by which it U re- placed to a varying degree. Fio. 99S. PlaceMttta 22 (JO) 23 (26) productive organs, etc. I-XXVli — somites; ml . «, /, m, margins), outer lateral, lateral and median •rmillac re- spectively; far-", pharyngeal glands; phore sac; d, ductus ejsculstorius; at, vtsfcula ■"■<"■''■; 6 and 9, aula and female pores; tic, vas iVlniaw, (, testes; n, ovary. X i. (Redrawn from Whitman.) Integuments translucent, brightly but not deeply pigmented 'with green, orange, and white; a1 of complete somites with a distinct secondary cross-furrow; size medium. Placobddia picia (Verrili) 1873. Cutaneous papillae prominent and rough or pointed 93 No marginal papillae on caudal sucker 34 654 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 34 (35) Much depressed; papillae numerous; no accessory eyes; size large. Placobddla rugosa (Vercill) 1874. 35 (34) Moderately depressed; papillae less numerous; neural annulus with much dark pigment; several pairs of simple accessory eyes succeeding compound eyes; size medium. Placobddla kolknsis (Whitman) 1893. 36 (33) Numerous minute papillae around margin of caudal sucker. Mod- erately depressed; dorsal papillae usually in a median and two paired series, small, acute and pale yellow or brown; a very conspicuous and constant pale band across somite VI; size small Placobddla phaitta (Graf) 1809. a 7 (14) Eyes four pairs, all simple; gastric ceca nine or ten pairs; salivary glands diffuse; body very soft and almost oedemous; genital pores at Xl-XII and XII a* /a*; color green with three series of pale yellow spots. On fishes and free in streams. ProtocUpsis occidetUalis (Verrill) 1S74. This leech and others of the genus are noteworthy among the members of their family for their transparency and activity. No other glosxiphonids creep with any approach to the same speed and none swim so well. So far as has been observed the eastern species is exclusively sanguivorous, pursuing and attacking frags and fishes. Nothing is known of the breeding habits beyond the fact that spermat ophores are formed and attached to the skin. FIC 999. Pmttlefru wHiflii. Do™l view of mutniot Complete somites not triannulate 19 Complete somites of two annuli, the anterior much the larger. Salivary glands compact; gastric ceca seven pairs; epidid- ymis a short, wide, U-shaped sperm-sac; eyes one pair, united; genital pores separated by the large annulus of XII; size small. On salamanders, North Carolina. *Otigobddla biannnlata (Moore) 1000. a. aov. tot MknUm, Moon unoccupied.) An interesting and little known leech taken on only one occasion in a cold mountain stream. Nothing known of breeding habits. Color green. 6ss fjmy 31 \3*} 33W 34(35) 3S(34) cc six unequal annul:, salivary glands diffuse; gastbc coca seven pairs, caudal sucker with marginal circle of glands and papilla*; eyes one pair, united: sbr small. Probaolv nst parasites . AxinobdaZt Moore i^\ . . 31 Slicker papillae and glands about 00: iive series of dorsal papillae. AainobcicZc zrMcctcns Moore :ooi. Sucker papillae and glands about 30: median dorsal series of pa- piUat alone developed. Aainohdcku ukquianm&iiu Moore 1^05. ^\. md 4: Tic ioo:. Aaimmbdtilc tmeqmiam- Annulation. seimuae and aorsal cutaneous papillae of anterior twelve samites. Pos- terior end with sucker tram the side X j-c vArter MoaccO Body divided into a narrow anterior and a wider posterior region; little depressed; eyes when present usually well separated; stomach usually with only a posterior pair of more or less coalesced ceca. . . . Family Ichthyobdfi .LiDAr . . 34 Complete somites of 12-14 very short annuli; no distinct lateral vesicles; eyes one or two pairs; size small. Parasitic on small fishes Piscicolc punctata ^YerrilT 1871. Complete somites of six annuli; strongly divided into two regions; lateral pulsating vesicles in somites XII to XXIII; eyes two pairs; size medium. Parasitic on Fundulus in fresh and salt water Trachelobddla vivida (Verrill) 1872. The anterior region is formed of eleven somites of which the first five comprise the head and the last three the clitellum. which is somewhat sunken into the widened posterior region. A little known leech which has been taken only in southern New England. Fie. ioo.'. Trackelobdella-vivida. Annulution trom dorsum. Somites* at the ends of the body are numbered and the annuli between which the male and female orifices lie are indicated. X .<. (After MoortO 656 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 36 (1) Mouth large, occupying entire cavity of sucker; pharynx not forming a proboscis; jaws often present. Suborder Gcathobdellae . . 37 Eyes typically five pairs on somites II-VT, arranged in a regular sub- marginal arch; complete somites five-ringed; toothed jaws usually present; genital ducts complex, usually with a pro- trusible penis and muscular sheath (atrium) and a vagina of corresponding length ; testes strictly paired, usually nine or ten pairs; stomach with at least one pair of spacious ceca; size generally large Family Hihudinidae , . 38 Jaws prominent, teeth numerous, in one series; ceca along entire length of stomach. True blood-suckers 39 Copulatory gland pores on somites XIII and XIV; penis conical; dorsum with metameric median red and lateral black spots. MacroMetfa Verrill 1873 . . 40 Genital orifices separated by five annuli. MaCTobddla decora (Say) 1824. The specks of Macrobdrlia are (he nearest approach in our fauna to the medicinal letch of Europe but at limes vary the diet of blood with frogs' eggs and worms. II. decora is well- known as a voracious infestet of swimming holes and of drinking places for cattle and has received the name of "blood-sucker. After coitus, during which the copulatory glands function, spongy cocoons are formed and deposited to hatch in the mud by the side of ponds and streams. Widely distributed; reported from Maine to Minnesota and from Pennsylvania to Kansas, northward into Canada. Frequently used by physicians instead of imported leeches for blood-letting. Said to be equally effica- cious of the small*! cupacity, about j (in. It is so powerful that anions result • have followed its attack* on legs of children wading in ita haunts. Fro j »,!. MtatkUUittn. Rnrodin Lnum; ttf. oonulatacy lianas; *V. a iXI-Xiv. ongiii XI toSlV: THE LEECHES (HIRUDINEA) <>57 No copulatory glands; penis filamentous; colors variable, dorsum usually green with six or four brown stripes, sometimes broken. European medicinal leech; introduced. Hirudo medkinaiit Linnaeus 1758. 43 U8) Jaws variable, sometimes rudimentary or absent; teeth when present all or partly in double series; gastric ceca one large posterior pair only. Chiefly predaceous 44 44 (47) Jaws short and high; teeth small, only partly in two series; no penis; genital orifices separated by three or four rings, surrounded by systems of gland pores . PkilobdeMa Verrill 1874. . 45 45 (46) Denticles about 35; narrow median dorsal and broader "mrgipal yellow stripes and a few brown spots. Pkiiobdeiia graciie Moore 1901. PkUebdOla takes the place of U aere- bitOa in the Gulf Stales and has singular habits. It is the native " blotxi -sucker " of that region. genital orinca I 3 . $ i a-ith their re- spective systems of gUnd pores (cgp £ aihd cfj>V): *p. Dcphridiupores; Am, »te.) B, IS- (After Denticles about 20; no median dorsal stripe and no spots; two faint stripes of reddish brown separated by a narrow line of blackish on each side of dorsum. PkHobddla fioridana Verrill 1S74. Jaws rather small and retractile into pits or absent; teeth when present coarse and all in double series; penis filamentous; genital orifices separated by five rings; no copula lory glands. Haemopis Savigny 1820 . . 48 Jaws and teeth present 49 658 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 49 (50) Teeth u-16 pairs; annuli VII a' and VIII a' enlarged, but only slightly subdivided; color variable, usually blotched. Baemopis mormoratis (Say) 1834. Fio. 1006. Hametu ■ ;- — -— - c, cJiuQum; V-XXVI1 , BoroitM; 6, , i,, o,. k, h, tit five Miuuli of somite XV. X ll. (.Onginil.) tmvtii hvwiIIi. Reproductive otm itrium or penis aheotn; dt, tiuctui ejui lididymh; rXI-XVI, gugli* XT-X (n, ilbmmln gkni orifice. X J. (After Moore.} 1, mlbmnin gland; it, Pmtllc glmd : «, on cnc vagina; uJ. TU deferens; J uuilc orifice; ' 50 {49) Teeth 20-25 pairs; annuli VII a' and VTTI a', completely subdivided; color gray or plumbeus with no or few spots, usually a median black and marginal orange stripes; size very large. An aquatic and a terrestrial variety. Haemopis lateralis (Say) 1834. 51 {48) Jans absent or rudimentary; no teeth 59 52 (53) Upper lip relatively narrow and arched; 8 orifice XI V/b\ 9 XII If/h1; protruded penis very slender and straight; ven- tral ground color paler than dorsal; dark blotches always present; size very large. . Haemopi* grandis (Venill) 1874. 53 (53) Lip relatively broad and flat; genital pores near middle of XI 6* and XII £•*; protruded penis very long, rather thick and twisted; ground color nearly uniform; dark blotches fre- quently absent or few; size moderate. Haemopis plumbeus Moore 1911. THE LEECHES (fflRUDINEA) <>59 54 (37) Eyes three or four pairs (rarely absent), usually one or two pain on II and two pairs at aides of mouth on IV; no jaws, no gastric ceca; genital ducts relatively simple, with small atrium produced into a pair of dorsal cornua and no penis; testes numerous, not paired. Predaceoua. Family Hespobdkludae . , 55 Somites strictly five-ringed, none of the annuli obviously enlarged or subdivided, Eyes three pairs, the first largest; genital pores separated by two annuli; atrial cornua simply curved; vasa deferentia. reaching forward to ganglion XI. HerpobdeBo punctata (Lady) 187a The hint, best known *nd mnt widely dirtributed member of the (unity In North Amerim,. The color varies ■ to the amount of black pigment A v. nbh leeches, and «qu*tit insect lirvae. ". ilood wiien opportunity oners. . El ttacbed to UPSSJL etc. Fia. 100S. S»MUbf«M. Atrium udndthborkt putt o( reproductive arjiin* il. ililiun. it. ilm Iim njii ulilKhaj (XI, iucUdo XI; 9 . Itamk orifice; 4, funds of mm «,<*«?; >r«rhl bam. X rf> (AnVifoonJ 56 (55) Annulus b obviously enlarged and subdivided 57 57 (58) Atrial cornua spirally coiled, vasa deferentia with anterior loops reaching to ganglion XI; eyes four pairs; genital orifices separated by two annuli; colors plain or irregularly blotched, Nephdopsis obscura Verrill 1837. ■ Fw. 1009, VajMtM (Mom. DmidudliUnlup*ct>oIatrba 59 (61) Vasa deferentia with anterior loops reaching to ganglion XI. . 60 60 (61) No pigmented eyes; genital pores separated by two annuli; longi- tudinally striped. California. . Dina anoculata Moore 1898. 61 (60) Eyes four pairs; genital pores separated by three to three and one- half annuli; nearly pigmentless. . Diita pana Moore ion. 62 (50) Vasa deferentia not extending anterior to atrium 63 63 (64) Eyes, three pairs; genital pores separated by three annuli; atrial cornua very small; pigment nearly absent. Dma microstoma Moon 1001. 660 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 64 (63) Eyes, three or four pairs; genital pores separated by two annuli; atrial cornua prominent; pigment absent or in scattered flecks. Dinafervida (Venill) 187 1. Fio. 1010. Dinafervida. Reproductive organs except testes, at, atrial cornua; de, ductus ejaculatorius; gXI-XVIII, ganglia XI to XVIII; of, closed end of ovary; Pto. 10x1. Bmnckintdc paludosa,mi\t and female, ai, first antenna; ai, second antenna; d, cercc pods or furcal rami; P, penis; /, telson. X 3. (Alter Packard.), structure, the frontal (or haft) organ, is variously developed in the different groups; in some it is only a sensory area and in others it has a knob-like pediculated form. The head is distinct from the trunk and the number of trunk- somites is variable. Some notostracans have as many as forty-two trunk-somites; the Conchostraca have from thirteen to twenty- eight, and the number in the Anostraca ranges from nineteen to twenty-three. Apart from the head, the trunk of phyllopods shows no differentiation into distinct regions. The terms "thorax" and "abdomen" have been variously used to designate the pre- or post-genital, or the limb-bearing or limbless, regions respectively. But the limits of these regions do not coincide, even approximately, except in the Anostraca; and "thoracic" and "abdominal" are therefore not applicable to the group. The last segment, or telson, usually bears a pair of appendages, the furcal rami or cercopods. The appendages are fairly uniform in character, except as they are modified by sexual dimorphism. The first antennae are always -■•J**.' THE FAIRY SHRIMPS (PIIYLLOPODA) 663 small and often unsegmented. The second antennae are vestigial or absent in the Notostraca; in the male anostracons they form variously modified clasping organs; and in the Conchostraca they are biramous swimming appendages. Male Anostraca often bear frontal organs which may arise from the bases of the second anten- nae or from the front of the head. The trunk-limbs are leaf-tike in form (hence the name Phyllopoda) and are remarkable for hav- ing gnathobases, or "chewing bases," far removed from the mouth. The first or the first and second pair are modified in male Con- chostraca for clasping the female. In female Notostraca the limbs of the eleventh trunk somite are modified to form brood-pouches, or JZT'^SS^i^ "oostegopods," for carrying eggs. The ~^% /l j T\ females of some Conchostraca have ^r I J x. the flabella of two or three limbs near / \ vyy-^ the genital aperture enlarged and the '| ' w ' egg masses are attached to these. In the Anostraca the appendages of the H ' somites on either side of the genital opening are modified for reproduction r'Tx' in both sexes. In addition to the various appendages which serve as accessory reproductive organs, the oviducts unite to form an F"V, 'Sin : ^fT^^^'^r huUFSS? external uterine chamber in the Anos- * traca, and the males of the same suborder have a copulatory organ formed by the fusion of the extremities of the vasa deferentia. All phyllopods are of separate sexes. Males arc much less common than females, in fact some species are known only from female specimens, and the development of several is believed to be usu- ally parthenogenetic The gonads are paired and have a simple tubular structure, except in the Notostraca where they are much ramified. In the Anostraca the eggs are carried in the female's brood-pouch, the uterine portion of the oviduct, sometimes until they hatch. The Notostraca bear the eggs in the special receptacles formed by the eleventh pair of trunk-limbs, and the Conchostraca cany them enclosed in the valves of the shell. Id. loit. Ealuria mctsti. with left ur'lurcul rami; /.'flAt^lla; a, umbo: hSShbS.™ 664 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The alimentary canal of phyllopods consists of a large mastica- tory and glandular atrium produced by an overhanging labrum c in front of the mouth; this is followed by a buccal cavity, a ver- tical esophagus and a small globular stom- ach within the head; and, behind these, is a long straight intestine which terminates in a short rectum at the posterior end of the body. The heart is '$L£& greatly elongated in the Anostraca, oc- cupying nearly all the trunk-somites, with a pair of ostia opening in each somite. In the Notostraca and Conchostraca it is more restricted — and extends through only three or four segments in the latter. There are no definite blood vessels. A maxillary gland (consisting of an end-sac, glandular coiled tube, and short terminal duct) serves as an excretory organ in phyllopods. The ladder-like structure of the ventral nerve chain shows the primitive character of the nervous system. After leaving the egg, all American phyllopods begin their development as a free swimming nauplius or metanauplius (Fig. 1014). Some differences exist even in closely allied forms in regard to the stage of development reached at hatching. The larvae of the Notostraca and Anos- T%H_ traca are typical metanauplei at the time t—^&**v*«>**'***tt of hatching, with an oval body that shows the beginning of several trunk-somites posteriorly and sometimes the rudiments of their appendages. The first antennae are well developed but uniramous, the second antennae have a movable masticatory process and the mandibles are but feebly developed. The earliest conchostracan THE FAIRY SHRIMPS (PHYLLOPODA) 665 larva has no trace of trunk-somites; the first antennae are greatly reduced and the labrum is very large. The trunk-somites and their appendages become differentiated in regular order from before backwards. The single median eye of the larva persists in adult phyllopods. All Phyllopoda, except Artemia, live in small fresh- water pools, especially those that are formed during spring rains and dry up during the summer. In such situations they often occur in enormous numbers. The writer once saw in Nebraska nearly half a bushel of dead Apus bodies on the bottom of a shallow dried-up depression about twenty feet in diameter. The eggs of most genera can re- sist prolonged desiccation; indeed it seems necessary for the develop- ment of many species that eggs should first be dried and afterwards immersed in water. Many eggs float when placed in water and development takes place at the surface. The mud of dried pools often contains large numbers of eggs that may be carried long distances by winds, birds, or by other means. Many exotic species have been reared from dried mud brought home by travelers. On account of the rapid evaporation of the pools in which they live, phyllopods are able to withstand considerable changes in the amount of mineral salts in the water. It is remarkable that, though none of these crustaceans are marine, Artemia salina lives in salt lakes and salt evaporating basins where the salinity far ex- ceeds that of the ocean. One instance has been recorded where the salts in solution were 271 grams per liter, and where the water was of the color and consistency of beer. Artemia salina is subject to marked form variations that are more or less correlated with salinity, and both Kellogg and Artrom have observed that this species tends to assume a reddish color as the water about it grows denser. Phyllopods usually swim on their backs with the ventral surface uppermost. Eubranchipus swims easily about when it is not rest- ing on the bottom; Apus is a graceful swimmer but often creeps on its ventral surface over the bottom and upon vegetation; Estheria commonly burrows in the mud. Food is collected in the ventral food-groove between the post-oral limbs whose gnathobases drive it forward to the mouth. It consists of suspended organic debris, 666 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY together with diatoms, other algae, and Protozoa. Large species, however, are able to gnaw objects, and Apus is said to nibble insect larvae and tadpoles. No parasitic phyllopods are known. The distribution of all species is apt to be local and irregular. A certain pool may swarm with phyllopods, while others near at hand will not possess a single individual. A particular species may be extremely abundant for one season and then be infrequent or entirely absent for several years, or it may appear regularly in a certain spot season after season. ^No Notostraca have been found £ in eastern United States and none of the genus Estheria in the i\(jf^ Conchostraca are found east of the Mississippi River.l The greater part of the North American species are found on the great plains. Collecting phyllopods is usually a simple matter. They are easily captured with a hand net or picked up with the fingers. For ordinary purposes 70 per cent alcohol is a satisfactory preserv- ative; specimens may be kept for future reference by dropping them into it and keeping them in a tightly stoppered bottle. Dilute formol may also be used, but is not as satisfactory as alcohol because it often makes specimens so brittle that they break up easily. These crustaceans are admirable aquarium animals and make attractive objects for a school room or private study. With a few water plants for company they may live for weeks. They should not be put in aquaria with predaceous animals for usually they will be quickly devoured. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER PHYLLOPODA 1(36) Body elongated, without carapace (Fig. ion) . Suborder Anostraca . 2 2 (5) Seventeen to nineteen pairs of pregenital ambulatory limbs. Family Polyartemiidae. Only one genus in America Polyartemidla. . . 3 3 (4) Male frontal appendage tuberculiform; male clasping antenna quadri- ramose Polyartemiella hanseni (Murdoch) 1874. Described from Alaska.. This and the following species are remarkable for the large number of ambulatory limbs which exceeds that of any other anostracan. Apparently common in portions ot Alaska and Yukon Territory that border on the Arctic Ocean. Fro. xois. PdymttmMU kmsmi. Side view of head of male. X 6. (Alter Daday.) THE FAIRY SHRIMPS (PHYLLOraDlO 667 4 (3) Male inmtal appendage wanting: male PoiyaricmieUc judayi Daday 1909. The copuialory appendages at this iorm are thick, spiny, and shaped like a hsb-hook: ihr iemale has a iong median angcr-uke appendage an the ciacsai suriace above the egg sac. Pribyiofi Islands and Alaska. The genus to which this species belongs is entirely arctic in its distribution 5 12- 6 (33) 7 U6> 8 (15) 9 U©» Fig. 1016. fWjTififfrnJMaayt Dotal view ol head of safe. Xs vAfterDadajO Eleven pairs of pregenital ambulatory limbs. 6 Hasping antenna of male biarticulate 7 Head of male unarmed in front, basal segment of rlagpi'^g antenna with- out a laminar appendage. . Family B&anchlxectidae . . 8 Post-genital region o-segmented, apical article of male clasping antenna triangular and falciform Branckinedc . . 9 Basal segment of male clasping antenna serrate on inner margin. Branddneda paludoso (0. F. Muller) 1788. The egg sac of the female is very long and slender. The copuialory appendage of the male is thick and arcuate. This is an arctic species and occurs in northern Europe as well as in Greenland. Labrador, and Alaska, in North America. See also Fig. ion Fie. 101-. Br< paimdesa. Head of male, dorsal view. X 5. v After Dada>o 10 (9) Basal segment of male clasping antenna not serrate on inner margin. 1 1 11 (14) Basal segment of male clasping antenna with a spiny area on inner margin 12 12 (13) Inner margin of basal segment of male clasping antenna with a rounded tubercle near base and a swollen spiny area just proximal to middle. Branckinceta coloradensis Packard 1874. The segmentation and early development take place under the ice in Alpine Lakes. The eggs of this species are much larger than those of others in the genus. This fact may account for the ability to develop so early. Reported from Colorado where it occurs at an altitude of 11,000 ft. The larvae appear as soon as the ice melts in the spring. Fig. ioiS. Branckinecia cobradensis. Head of male, front view. X 7- (After Shantz.) 13 (12) Basal segment of male clasping antenna armed with a large spiny process, one third as long as the segment, which arises just distal to the middle of the inner margin and projects proxi- mally, a prominent finger -like process with a tuberculated tip near inner proximal angle. Branckinecta Packard* Pearse 19 13. The five pregenital segments of female produced laterally into strong spinous processes; these grow larger posteriorly. Collected at La Junta, Colorado. Fie. 1010. Branckinecta pockardi. B*sal tegmeat of jccood antenna of male. 668 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 14 (11) Inner margin of basal segment of male clasping antenna without a tubercle but with a spiny area near proximal end. Branchinecta lindahli Packard 1883. The body is robust; the caudal appendages are comparatively long; the eggs are small, and the ovisac usually contains about fifty of them. A plains species recorded from Kansas, Nebraska, Colorado, and Wyoming. It is known to occur as high as 7500 ft. above sea level. Fig. 1020. Branchinecta lindahli. Head of male, front view. X3. (After Shantz.) 15 (8) Post-genital region 8-segmented, apical article of male clasping antenna compressed Artemia. Only one species. . . . Artemia salina (Linnaeus) 185 1. Connecticut, Utah, California, Lower California. This species is remarkable for its ability to live in extremely saline water. It is frequently found in salt evaporating basins. The form is variable, and several varieties have been described. Fig. 1021. Artemia salina. Head of male, dorsal view. X 4. (After Daday.) 16 (7) Head of male often bearing a frontal appendage or a laminar appendage on the basal segment of the clasping antenna. Family Chirocephalidae . . 17 17 (30) Frontal appendage of male variable, rather short; terminal segment of copula tory organ smooth Eubranchipus . . 18 18 (25) Body segments of male and female all superficially unarmed. . . 19 19 (20) Frontal appendage of male short, about as long as basal joint of sec- ond antenna; lanceolate, margin denticulate. Eubranchipus vernalis Verrill 1869. Massachusetts, New Jersey, Indiana, Michigan. This species appears in small quiet pools soon after the snow disappears in spring, or even in mid-winter, but has not been observed during the summer months. Fxo. 1022. Eubranchipus vernalis. Head of male, side view. X 4. (After Packard.) 20 (19) Frontal appendages of male when extended longer than basal joint of second antenna 21 21 (22) Frontal appendages of male attenuate, middle fourth serrate. Eubranchipus holmani (Ryder) 1879. This species was first discovered in New Jersey and has since been ob- served on Long Island, New York. Packard ('83) confused this species with BranckmeOa gissUri Daday. Fio. xo?j. Bmbranchi^us holmani. Head of male; A, side view; B, front view. 92 (21) Frontal appendages of male broad, lanceolate, lobate on margins. 23 •r^afc. $«ea> o^ &&-Ar*otJ oP Campkcz THE FAIRY SHRIMPS (PHYLLOPODA) 669 23 (24) Terminal segment of male clasping antenna with a small process near base that is one-eighth as long as the segment. Eubranchipus ornatus Holmes ion. This species was de- scribed from specimens taken in Wisconsin. The frontal appendages are re- markably broad. In the left-hand figure the male frontal appendages are rolled up. Fig. 1024. Eubranchipus or- natus. Male. A, posterior view of head; B, frontal organ; C, second antenna. X 10. (After Holmes.) 24 (23) Terminal segment of male clasping antenna armed with a process near its base that is half as long as itself. Eubranchipus iodayi Poaroc 19 13. svMcwyi- STRATUS FbKBES Recorded from eastern Nebraska and Missouri. Some specimens are re- markably transparent. This species appears in small pools during April and May. The females are more reddish than the translucent males. Fig. 1025. Eubranchipus da- dayi. Male. A, posterior view of head; B, frontal organ; C, second antenna. X8. 25 (18) Some body segments produced into lateral processes 26 26 (27) Body segments 9 and 10 of female produced into lateral processes; post-genital segments unarmed. Eubranchipus gclidus (Hay) 1889. svooav* Records from New York, Massachusetts, Indiana, Alaska, and Yukon Territory, Canada. Usually abundant where it is found. The proc- esses on the somites just in front of the egg sac on the female distinguish this species from all others in the genus. The Hay's ('89) hatched the eggs of this anostracan from dried mud, without freezing, and described developmental stages. The wide range is remarkable for a member of this genus. Fig. 1026. Eubranchipus gelidus. A, side view of head of male; B, side view of posterior portion of female. X 4. 27 (26) Body segments 9 and 10 of female not produced laterally; post- genital segments acutely produced on both sides. ... 28 670 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 28 (29) Post-genital region 8-segmented; cercopods ensiform. Eubranchipus serratus Forbes 1876. Described from specimens taken in Illinois. 29 (28) Post-genital region 9-segmented; cercopods dilated with obtuse apices Eubranchipus bundyi Forbes 1876. Described from specimens collected in Wisconsin. 30 (17) Frontal appendage of male either vertical or extending out from the middle of front of head; terminal segment of copula tory organ spiny 31 31 (32) Post-genital segments distinct in both sexes, cylindrical, cercopods always distinct Branchindla. Only one species in North America. . Branchindla gissleri Daday 19 io. This interesting phyllopod has been recently described from specimens collected in New York. Packard ('83) confused it with Eubranchipus hdmanii (Ryder). The male frontal appendages are usually twisted, and coiled together. Fio. 1027. Branckinella gissleri. Dorsal view of head of male. X 5. (After Daday.) 32 (31) Post-genital segments fused in both sexes; cercopods confluent. Thamnoccphalus. Only one species Thamnoccphalus platyurus Packard 1879. A peculiar species that has been recorded from Ellis, Kansas, where it frequented temporary pools in the bottoms of ravines, and from La Junta, Colorado, where it was four*** *u a " cattle pool." Fig. 1028. Thamnocephalus platyurus. Dorsal view of male. X x. (After Packard.) 33 (6) Clasping antenna of male triarticulate. Family Streptocephaudae. Only one genus in America Strcptoccphalus . . 34 34 (35) Anterior digit of male clasping antenna broad, undulate, bifid at tip. Strcptoccphalus tcxanus Packard 187 1. The second antennae of the female scarcely exceed the first in length; her cercopods are stouter than those of the male. The appendages beneath the head of the male are root-like and give the animal a very peculiar appearance. Texas, Kansas, Colorado, Nebraska. This species occurs in the spring or fall in pools on the open prairie. Fio. X020. Streptocephalus tetanus. Head of male. X 4- (After Packard. ) 35 (34) Anterior digit of male clasping antenna nearly straight, linear. Strcptoccphalus scalii Ryder 1879. New Jersey. This spedes has been known to appear twice in the same pool during a summer, in June and August, following rains. Packard described another species, S. Jtoridanus, but the description was not definite enough to differentiate it from other American species. Fio. 103a Streptocepholus ualii. Head of male. X 3. (After Packard.) . *. 2*. _i THE FAIRY SHRIMPS (PHYLLOPODA) 67 1 36 (1) Body with a well-developed carapace 37 37 (52) Body depressed, covered dorsally by a depressed shield. Suborder Notostraca . . 38 38 (45) Telson ending in a long, paddle-shaped outgrowth. . Leindurus . . 39 39 (40) Telson short, obtusely pointed, spiny on edge. Lepidurus glacialis Kroyer 1847. An arctic species recorded from Greenland and Labrador. The carapace is very large and regularly ovate; twelve segments are exposed behind it. IT! Fig. 103 1. Lepidurus glacialis. Telson. X 6. (After Packard.) 40 (39) Telson spatulate 41 41 (42) Telson carinate dorsally; carapace large, leaving only five body seg- ments and telson uncovered. Lepidurus couesii Packard 1875. This species occurs in Utah where it frequents 'prairie pools of various sizes. Fig. 103a. Lepidurus couesii, Telson. X 6. (After Packard.) 42 (41) Telson not carinate dorsally 43 43 (44)~J_Telson long bilobed; carapace short, without spinous crest. Lepidurus bUobatus Packard 1877. This species has not been recorded since the Hayden survey, when it was taken in Colorado. 44 (43) Telson long, not carinate, sometimes bilobed; carapace with a median spinous crest Lepidurus lemmoni Holmes 1894. California. The cercopods are very long in this species. 45 (38) Telson short, cylindrical, simple A pus . . 46 46 (47) Carapace as long as the portion of the abdomen projecting beyond it; telson short with two median and two lateral spines on its dorsal median third. . . . A pus aequalis Packard 187 1. A widely distributed species occurring in Mexico, Lower California, Texas, rera* Nebraska, and Kansas. It jhas 23 segments exposed behind the carapace. Fig. 10 1 2 shows the form of this species. Fio. 1033. A pus aequalis. Telson. X 6, (After Packard.) 47 (46) Carapace shorter than the portion of the abdomen exposed behind it . . 48 48 (49) Telson long, with three median and two lateral spines on its dorsal median third; 29 segments exposed behind carapace. A pus newberryi Packard 187 1. Recorded from Utah and Colorado. The hairs along the cercopods are said to be remarkably fine. Fie. 1034. Apus newberryi. Telson. X 6. (After Packard.) 49 (48) More than 30 segments exposed behind carapace 50 672 5o (50 Si (so) 52 (37) 53 (60) 54 (57) 55 (56) A 56 (55) 57 (54) 58 (59) FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Carapace short, three-fifths as long as exposed abdomen; telson with one (or two) median and two lateral spines on its dorsal median third A pus lucasanus Packard 187 1. Ad abundant and widely distributed species; reported from Lower Cali- fornia and Kansas. Fig. 1035. A pus lucasanus. Telson. X 6. (After Packard.) Carapace even shorter than in A . lucasanus; telson very short with one median and four lateral spines on dorsal median third. A pus longicaudatus Leconte 1846. This form occurs in Colorado, Nebraska, Texas, and along the Yellowstone River. Fig. 1036. A pus longicaudatus. Telson. X 6. (After Packard.) Body compressed, carapace forming two lateral valves which enclose the body Suborder Conchostraca . . 53 Only the first post-cephalic limbs prehensile in the male; carapace spheroidal, without lines of growth; head not included within carapace-chamber Family Limnetidae. Only one genus Limnetis . . 54 Shell subspherical 55 Length, 3 mm.; front of male's head narrow; second antenna 16-seg- B men ted; flabellum very large. . Limnetis gouldii Baird 186 2. A form widely distributed through Massachusetts, New Hampshire, Rhode Island, New York, Illinois, and Canada. It is very hardy and will live for months in aquaria. Fig. 1037. Limnetis gouldii. A, head of male, dorsal view. X ax; B, shape of shell. X 7. (After Packard.) Length, 4.2 mm.; front of male's head very broad; antenna 20-seg- mented Limnetis gracilicornis Packard 1871. This species was described by Packard from specimens collected at Waco, Texas. Fig. 1038. Limnetis gracUicornis. Head of male, dorsal view. X x8. (After Packard.) Shell suboval. 58 Length, 4 mm.; front of male's head broad and square; second an- il tenna 14- and 17-segmented; flabellum very narrow. Limnetis mucronatus Packard 1875. This species has been reported from Montana and Kansas. It is easily recognized by the mucronate, tridentate front. Fig. 1030. Limnetis mucronatus. A , head of male, dorsal view. X 20: Bt shape of shell. X 4- (After Packard.) Length, 4 (to 6) mm.; front of male's head rather broad; second B antenna 20-segmented; flabellum short and broad. Limnetis brcrifrons Packard 1877. This is the largest known species of this genus in North America. It has been observed only at Ellis, Kansas. Fig. 104a Limnetis brtnfrons. A, head of male. X 8. B, shape oftbelL X3. (After Packard.) \ ^iM^kM^mk^- THE FAIRY SHRIMPS (PHYIXOPODA) 673 60 (53) First and second post -cephalic limbs prehensile in the male; carapace distinctly bivalve, enclosing head, with concentric growth lines around a more or less prominent umbo. Family Liknadhdae . . 61 61 (66) With pediculated dorsal organ on front of head 61 63 {63) Shell broad oval, much flattened, subtriangular, with about 18 lines of growth; flagella of second antenna 12- to 13-segmented; 18 to 22 pairs of limbs Limnodia. Only one species Limnodia americana Morse 1875. This species was described from specimens collected at Lynn. Massachusetts. Another possible species, Limnodia toriaaa Halde- man, was collected at Cincinnati and in ditches along the Susquehanna river, but it has not been sufficiently described so that its relationships can be determined. See Packard (1883, pp. 313, 314)- 63 (62) Shell narrow-ovate, rather prominent behind the umbones with 4 to 5 lines of growth; flagella of second antennae g- to 10-seg- mented; 18 pairs of limbs Eulimnadia . . 64 64 (65) Shell narrow-ovate, with 4 lines of growth; telson with 12 pairs of dorsal spinules not including the terminal spine. Eulimnadia agassizii Packard 1874. This small crustacean has only been observed on Penikese Island, Massachusetts. The figure shows the large dorsal organ projecting above the eye. The FlO, 1041. Eulimnadia , 65 (64) Shell narrower than that of Eulimnadia agassizii, with 5 lines of growth; telson with 16 fine teeth above. Eulimnadia ttxana Packard 1877, The valves of the carapace are whitish and rounded oval in shape. This species has been collected in Kansas, Nebraska, and Tesas. It is said to be com- mon in the last locality in early spring. The figure shows only the shape of the shell. FlO. ioij. Sullmitadia Inarm. Shine of shell, side view. X 7. (After Packard.} 66 (61) Shell oval, more or less globose, with 18 to 22 lines of growth, amber colored; no pediculated dorsal-organ on front of head; flagella of second antennae n- to 17 segmented; 24 to 28 pairs of limbs -Estheria . . 67 674 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 67 (70) Umbones one-sixth length of shell from anterior end OS 68 (69) Shell large (16 mm. long), flat; umbones small; flagella of second antenna 13- and 15-segmented. -JSiMwiu californica Packard 1874. OfZ IOJS Thai far this species has been collected at two localities in California. The small size of the umbones is remarkable. Length ol shell, 16 mm.; height, 10 mm; breadth, 4 mm. 69 (68) Like Estkeria californica but umbones more prominent and dorsal edge of shell sloping down to posterior end. Ssiheria newcombii Baird 1866. Possibly the same as trie last" species but as Packard's and Baird's figures appear to differ somewhat the two are separated. It is found only in California. Frc. 1045. Hmmia manMl. Shell, ride view. X ». (After Baird.) C. 70 (67) Umbones more than one-sixth length of shelf from anterior end. . 7 1 71 (7a) Shell long and narrow; umbones small, one-fifth length of shell from anterior end; telson armed with small fine teeth; hands of male short and thick; flagella of second antenna 15- and 14 segmented. . . . Esikaia complexitnanus Packard 1877. Packard reported this species from two localities in Kansas and more recently Richard discovered it in a collection from Lower California. Length of shell, 11 mm.; height, 5.5 mm. Fio. 1S46. — ,„...„ -. ''NrfackatdJ 73 (71) Shell more or less swollen or globose; umbones prominent. ... 73 73 (74) Shell globose, wider than high; umbones prominent and oblique one-fourth length of shell from anterior end, lines of growth not sharply marked Atketitt digueti Richard 1895. Described from Lower California. O^X 1 C US> 74 (73) Lines of growth well marked; shell not wider than high. .... 75 75(78) Flagella of second antennae 15-and ^-segmented 76 76 (77) Shell globose with 34 lines of growth; umbones large and prominent, two-fifths length of shell from anterior end. fttow bdfrogei Packard 1871. ribed by Packard from specimens collected Vaco, Texas. ftW/«(«. SheB.iideTkw. X*. (After Packard.) THE FAIRY SHRIMPS (PHYLLOPODA) 67S 77(76) Shell globose with 13 .lines of growth; umbones prominent, one- third length of shell from anterior end. Retheria setosa Pearse 19 13. This species resembles Estkeria belfraget in many respects but is easily distinguished by the smaller number of lines of growth and the length of the dorsal setae at the anterior edge of the tdson. Collected in eastern Nebraska from small pools. Fio. 1048. -Btikmia ttiosa. Shell, side view. X 3. Flagella of second antenna 17- and 1 6-segmented 78(75) Flagella of second antenna 17- and 1 6-segmented 79 79 (80) Shell swollen; umbones rather prominent, one-fourth length of shell from anterior end; dorsal margin short, suddenly sloping at posterior end; telson with larger teeth interpolated between the smaller ones £stkma mexicana Clans i860. A species of very wide range extending from Lake Winnipeg through Kansas, Nebraska, Kentucky, Ohio, and New Mexico into Mexico. It is rather variable in its structure. Fio. 1049. girttwo mexicana. Shell, side view. X4. (After Packard.) C 80 (79) Shell somewhat globose; umbones more prominent than in Estkeria C mexicana, slightly nearer the anterior end than in Krtkmia C* beljragei Eftktria morsel Packard 1871. South Dakota, Nebraska. Fig. 1049 shows the general structure oithis species. IMPORTANT PAPERS ON FRESH-WATER PHYLLOPODA Calman, W. T. 1009. Crustacea. Lankester's Treatise on Zoology, Pt. VD, Fasc. 3: 20-55. London and New York. Daday, E. 1910. Monographic systematique des Phyllopodes Anostraces. Ann. Sci. Natur., (9) n: 91-492, 84 figs. Hay, O. P., and W. P. 1889. A contribution to the knowledge of the Genus Branchipus. Amer. Natur., 23: 91-95. Packard, A. S. 1883. A Monograph of the Phyllopod Crustacea of North America, with Remarks on the Order Phyllocarida. 12 Ann. Rept. U. S. Geol. Surv.: 295-590, 39 pis., 1 Map. • Pearse, A. S. 1913. Notes on Phyllopod Crustacea. 14 Rept. Michigan Acad. Sci.: 191-197, 3 pis. Shantz, H. L. 1005. Notes on North American Species of Branchinecta and their Habits. Biol. Bull., 9: 249-264; pis. 10-12. \ CHAPTER XXII THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) By EDWARD A. BIRGE Dean, University of Wisconsin When men began to study nature by the aid of the microscope in the seventeenth century the "insects" were among the first ob- jects to be examined. In 1669, the Dutch physician, Swammerdam, described in his history of insects the "ptdex aquaticus arborescens" — the water-flea with branching arms. This was one of the Cladocera, still called Daphnia ptdex, the commonest species in shallow pools. These creatures he described and figured, giving an account of their structure and habits and speaking of their sudden appearance in enormous numbers, and their equally sudden dis- appearance. So the Cladocera made their debut into science along with the microscope. For nearly a century little was added to the knowledge of the group. In 1755, the German, Schaeffer, gave the first really good account of their structure. In 1785, O. F. Mueller, the Danish naturalist, issued the first general systematic work upon Entomo- straca. This described many of the species as we now know them and gave a firm scientific basis for further knowledge of the Clado- cera. In the rapid advance of science during the latter half of the nineteenth century the systematic work of the group was substan- tially done, the Norwegian, G. O. Sars, having contributed more than any other one man. This work showed that the Cladocera constitute the largest group of fresh-water Crustacea in number of species; the most diversified in size, in structure, and in habits. During the opening years of the present century the scientific study of fresh-water life has advanced rapidly and the biology of the Cladocera is receiving much attention. The conditions of variation and the nature of the variants are examined, as well as the conditions of sexual reproduction, the centers of origin and dispersal of species, and other similar matters. The Cladocera are particularly well suited for study by those persons who are interested in observing animals with the micro- 676 ..- *■ . THE WATER FLEAS (tXADQCERA) 677 scope and who cannot command the resources of a university labo- ratory. They are easily collected and preserved and the species may be readily identified, since little or no microscopic dissection is needed to make out the specific characters. Many of the Clado- cera are so transparent that tbe internal organs can be studied in detail when the animal is viewed from the side under the microscope. Man)- of the forms can readily be kept alive in small aquaria, and their habits observed. There is still a great amount of work to be done in this country in finding out the local geographical distribution of the spe- cies and the variation of the variable forms. The suborder is di- vided into twosections so different that few state- ments can be made of them hi common. The first, and byfarthelarger section, the Calypto- mera. have a large, bi- valve shell, which covers the body and legs. The second section, the Gynuiomera, includes two species in our fresh waters. These retain the shell only as a brood sac; the body and legs being free. In the account which follow*, the Calyptomera are kept in mind. The animals belonging to this group range in size from about 0.2 mm. to 3.0 mm., or even more. All have a distinct head, and a body covered by a fold of the skin, which extends backward and down- ward from the dorsal side of the head and constitutes a bivalve shell. The junction of head and body is sometimes marked by a depression, the cervical sinus or notch U'ig— '051, 1073, 1091}.' 1 The figures referred to are designed lo give llit specific character: rather than the naitUmy, which U shown only iuciduuLillv. AP. Jxlwmiifcil iii„.___ . -_ ..... . . . .. ... oH-' *->"«■-'- -.1-'- '.*.'■!!- . ti'\ '■■<'*.»'. 1 ...... *ill] .I.'.cUjT.il.'; CA /:.tJ,-. ■*;:!, Li,:, t ,y. :.i^L.v .,r Idt -i.:V, 11. hcrt w;i),_v,-n, IjkT lu. it * «, J, &x«i tAtu* s*if ; 678 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY In the head is the large compound eye (Fig. 1050). This has nu- merous or few lenses (Figs. 1059, 1076, 1169), and is capable of being rotated by three muscles on each side. It is a most conspicuous organ, by its size, its dark pigment, and its constant motion during life. In the head are also the brain, the optic ganglion, with its numerous nerves to the eye, the ocellus, or pigment spot, the an- tennary muscles, and the anterior part of the digestive tract. The head bears two pairs of appendages: (1) The antennuks (Figs. 1051, 1079, 1 1 14, 1152), which carry sense-rods, the olfactory setae, usually placed at the end, and have also ordinarily one or more lateral sense hairs; (2) the antennae, the main organs of locomotion, large swim- ming appendages, with a stout basal joint bearing two branches or rami, which, in turn, carry long plumose setae. The number of the antennary setae may be expressed by a formula which shows the number of the setae on each joint of each branch of the antenna; the numbers for the dorsal branch occupying the place of the numerator of a fraction. The formula thus constructed reads Daphnia (Fig. 1050), °^>~I 3 ; that for Sida (Fig. 105 1), ^3_7. 1-1-3 1-4 The antennae are moved by powerful muscles, which may occupy a great part of the interior of the head (Fig. 1050). On the size of the antennae, the length and number of the setae, and on the size of the muscles operating them, depends the type of locomotion. Latona (Fig. 1052) leaps suddenly from point to point by single powerful strokes of its broad antennae. The smaller Daphnidae (Fig. 1079) hop, rather than leap, by more numerous and less vigorous strokes. The heavier forms of this family (Fig. 1075), with smaller anten- nae, have a rotating, unsteady motion, produced by rapid strokes. Drepanothrix (Fig. 1104), whose antennae bear saber-like setae, scrambles and pushes itself about, and the mud-haunting Ilyocryptus (Fig. 1 1 10) crawls and pulls itself about among the weeds, rather than swims. The members of the large family of the Chydoridae have small antennae and move them very rapidly; while their progress varies from a rapid whirling-motion, as in Chydorus (Fig. 1 150), to a slower wavering and tottering progress, as in Acroperus (Fig. 1 1 21). In the Macrothriddae and Chydoridae the post- THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 679 abdomen is often an efficient aid to locomotion. It may push the animal along, as in Ilyocryptus (Fig. 1 1 10) and Camptocercus (Fig. 1 1 19). In Dunhevedia (Fig. 11 34) it is peculiarly effective, broad and stout, covered with numerous small spines and setae, and by its aid the animal may execute sudden and vigorous jumps. The head also bears the mouth parts: (1) The mandibles (Figs. 1050, 1068, 1099, and others); stout, strongly chitinized organs, made in one piece and without a palpus. Their opposing faces are toothed and ridged and they grind the food very perfectly. (2) The maxillae, a pair of very minute organs, lying concealed on the ven- tral surface of the body, just behind the mandibles. Each is a small, pointed structure, bearing several curved setae. They work like a pair of hands to push the food between the mandibles. (3) The labium, an impaired structure, attached to the rear of the head and closing the mouth from below. In many of the Mac- rothricidae and Chydoridae this structure bears a keel or projection which is of systematic value (Figs. 1051, 1060, 1106, 1135). The axis of the head may continue that of the body {extended, Fig. 1 100), or it may be bent downward {depressed, Fig. 1087). That part in front of the eye is known as the vertex. There is usually a sort of beak in front of, or between, the antennules, which is known as the rostrum, whose size and shape have systematic value. There is commonly a ridge above the insertion of the antenna, which helps to stiffen the side of the head and to support the pull of the anten- nary muscles. This is the fornix, whose shape and extent may form an important systematic character (Figs. 1063, 1083). The shell, though called bivalve, is really in one piece, bent along the back, but never showing a division or joint at this place. It has very different forms, as seen from the side, nearly square, oval, or round. It may be marked in the most various fashions. It may bear hairs, or spines, along the ventral edge. There may be a single spine on the dorsal side, prolonging the junction of the valves, as in Daphnia, or each valve may have one or more spines at the lower posterior part, the infero-posteal angle (Fig. 1076). This angle in the Chydoridae may be acute or rounded, smooth or toothed, and its characters are of systematic value. The shell is always a duplicative of the skin. Its inner wall is far more 680 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY delicate than the outer, and between the walls the blood circulates and the inner surface serves as a respiratory organ. Just back of the head, on the dorsal side, lies the heart, an oval or elongated sac (Figs. 1050, 105 1, 1089), whose rapid pulsations are easily seen in the living animal. It receives the colorless or yellow blood by one opening on each side and expels it in front. There are no blood vessels, but the circulation passes along definite courses through a complex series of passages all over the body. The movements of the blood corpuscles may be readily seen in trans- parent Cladocera. Respiration is not served by any single organ. The legs and the inside of the valves are the main surfaces for the exchange of gases. In the anterior part of the valves lies an organ whose structure is not readily made out. This is the shell gland (Figs. 1050, 105 1, 1056), a flattened glandular tube in several loops, which probably serves the function of a kidney. The body lies free within the valves and is divided into the main portion, bearing the feet, which is not plainly segmented, and a single unjointed portion, the post-abdomen. Through it runs the intestine, and along the sides of the body lie the simple reproduc- tive organs. To the ventral side are attached the feet, ordinarily five pairs, sometimes six. These are mainly leaf-like structures, each with several parts, bearing numerous hairs and long setae (Figs. 1050, 1 142). Their structure is too complex to describe here. In the first two families all the feet are similar and foliaceous. Their use is to create a current of water through the valves, bringing in oxygen for respiration and particles of food. The latter consists chiefly of algae, though nothing edible is rejected that the current brings in. The food particles collect below the body between the bases of the feet and are fed forward into the mouth. The maxillae push them between the jaws as the labrum opens, the mandibles grind them up, and they pass on into the esophagus. Cladocera are normally eating all of the time. In the Daphnidae and remaining families the feet differ in struc- ture; the first pairs being more or less prehensile and having other functions besides the main one of drawing in water. These THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 68 1 five chiefly among the weeds, and the hooks and spines of the first foot aid them in clinging to plants and also may help to pull off attached algae, etc., for food. In the more transparent species the digestive tract may be seen throughout its full extent. The narrow esophagus (Figs. 1050, 1051, 1096) widens suddenly into the stomach, which lies in the head and whose posterior end passes insensibly into the intestine. Attached to the stomach in many species are two sacs, often long and curved (Figs. 1050, 1053, 1060, 1064, 1 100). These are the hepatic ceca, which no doubt function as a digestive gland. The stomach and intestine have a muscular wall and a lining of dark-colored, glandu- lar cells. The cavity is ordinarily filled with food. The intestine has a direct course in the first four families. In the Macrothricidae it is sometimes direct (Fig. 1106), and sometimes convoluted (Figs. 1 100, 1 1 03). In the Chydoridae it is always convoluted and there is often a cecum attached to the ventral side near the posterior end (Figs. 1 121, 1 141). The terminal part of the intestine, the rectum, is always transparent and the muscles which open and close it can easily be seen. The anus lies either at or near the end of the post- abdomen, as is usually the case in the first five families, or in the Chydoridae and in some forms of the other families (Figs. 1089, 1091, 1 100, 11C9), on the dorsal side. The post-abdomen is ordinarily jointed to the body and is bent forward; hence its dorsal side may come to be the lower one. On the dorsal side it bears two sensory hairs, often very long (Fig. 1090), the abdominal setae. At the end of the post-abdomen are two ter- minal claws, which, in turn, may have spines at their base, the basal spines (Figs. 1123, 1144), or, when numerous, the pecten (Fig. 1066), and the concave side may also have a row of very fine spinules (denticulate). The post-abdomen almost always has more or fewer spines, or teeth, the anal spines. In the Chydoridae there are fre- quently two rows on each side behind the anus, the marginal and lateral denticles (Fig. 1147). These spines and teeth may have the most diverse shape and structure (squamae, fascicles, etc.), and fur- nish important systematic characters. Their main use seems to be to comb the legs and keep them clean and free from foreign matters and from parasites which might otherwise readily attach themselves. 682 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Little study has been given to the senses of the Cladocera, except that of sight. As special organs of touch there are the abdominal setae, which are sometimes very long (Fig. 1090) ; sensory hairs on the basal joint of the antenna near the body (Fig. 1075), or near ^e aPex (Figs. 105 1, 1053, IQ89) J the lateral sense hair of the antennule (Figs. 1089, 1 1 17, 1154); the flagellum on the antennule of the Sididae (Figs. 1051-1057), which is often fringed with fine hairs; and the frontal sense hair of Bosmina (Fig. 1096). Any of the innumerable hairs and setae may also serve this sense, though not specially modi- fied for that purpose. There is no auditory organ. Whether the olfactory setae really give sensations of smell and taste is doubtful, although the structure of the sense rods is such that they may well serve a chemical sense. They lie at the entrance of the valves in the current of water which is coming in under the impulses of the feet, and may take cognizance of the particles of food, etc., which come along with the water. The Cladocera are certainly able to discriminate between different kinds of particles brought in by the legs, eating some and rejecting others. They have decided tastes in the matter of diet, preferring some forms of algae to others. In general, the diatoms are eaten in preference to the blue-green algae. In the selection of food, the Cladocera are aided also by sensations which arise in the mouth, since they may reject particles which have been brought into the mouth and partially chewed. The eye is obviously the visual organ. It is sensitive to light and can no doubt distinguish objects by the shadows which they pro- duce, although its lenses are by no means numerous enough, or perfect enough, to give sensations of form. The constant motions of the eye are for the purpose of moving the lenses so that they will cover the entire field of vision, and the animal no doubt directs its movements by sensations which it receives through the eye. The Cladocera respond differently to light of different intensities and various colors. Most of them react positively to a weak light and negatively to a strong one. There is, however, much difference in this respect. Drepanothrix, for example, is vigorously repelled by the light of a lamp, which will attract all the other Cladocera in the vessel with it. Newly hatched Cladocera are attracted by light which will repel older forms. On a bright, calm day a few inches THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 683 of water at the surface of a lake may be deserted by the Clado- cera. A little deeper may be found young forms, and still deeper, perhaps one or two meters below the surface, the adult animals. The temperature of the water also has much influence on the reac- tion to light. In cold w^ter Cladocera are attracted by a light which will repel them at higher temperatures. The limnetic forms of Daphnia pulex ordinarily remain during the daytime in the cool water immediately beneath the thermocline, though they may rise into the warm water during the night. In the winter, when the lake is skimmed with ice, the same animals may be seen in the bright sunshine immediately below the ice. Practically all of the Cladocera react negatively to the blue rays of the spectrum, are nearly un- influenced by the rays at the red end, and find the yellow rays the most attractive. The ocellus is rarely absent (Diaphanosoma, Daphnia rctrocurva, longirrmis); sometimes rudimentary (many forms of Daphnia); sometimes larger than the eye (Lcydigia, Dadaya); and rarely the sole organ sensitive to light (Monospilus). It is not known in what respects its function differs from that of the eye. This imperfect sketch shows how complex the structure of the Cladocera is, — wonderfully complex, when their small size is con- sidered. The smallest of them are hardly more than one one- hundredth of an inch in length. Yet these have ten complicated legs, besides the numerous other structures named and many which have not been mentioned Probably no other animals of so small size have so complex a structure, yet they must suffer the disgrace of being eaten by Stmtor and so being among the few Metazoa which are swallowed whole by one-celled animals. The reproduction of the Cladocera is noteworthy. During the open season the females produce eggs which develop without being fertilized. These may number only two. the usual number in the Chydoridae, or, in the larger Daphnidae, there may be more than twenty- These eggs are deposited in the cavity bounded by the dorsal part of the valves and the upper side of the body — the brood case. Here they develop and hatch in a form quite like that of the parent and are well grown before they are set free. Heooe there axe no free-firing larval forms of Cladocera, such as 684 FRESH- WATER BIOLOGY are so abundant in the Copepoda. The young are nourished in the brood-cavity, not only by the yolk of the egg, but also by a secretion from the dorsal wall of the sac. The brood case may be closed behind by extensions of the body — the abdominal processes — which have some systematic importance. This parthenogenesis goes on regularly through the favorable season for growth, closing when the pools begin to dry or other unfavorable conditions arise. Several successive broods of females are ordinarily produced in this way, although in Moina, which lives in temporary pools, the second generation may be sexual. Sooner or later true females and males are hatched from the eggs. These females produce one or two eggs, large and opaque, with abundant yolk and thick shell, and which must be fertilized by the male before developing. These eggs pass into the brood sac, whose walls have usually acquired a peculiar structure. In the Chydorinae (Fig. 1159) they are merely thick- ened and darkened. In the Daphnidae (Figs. 1073, 1079, 1093), a semi-elliptical portion of the dorsal region of each valve becomes greatly altered to form the ephippium, so called from its resem- blance to a saddle. In the Chydorinae the sexual egg is deposited in the brood sac and the whole shell is then molted ; the egg remain- ing enclosed in it. Where the ephippium is developed, this separates during the molt from the rest of the shell and closes about the one or two eggs deposited in it. In either case the eggs lie over to the next favorable season before they develop. This process of sexual reproduction occurs at different times in various species. Like the blossoming of flowers, it cannot always be directly correlated with any definite conditions of food or tem- perature. In those species which live in the open waters of lakes, sexual reproduction is often greatly reduced or wholly absent and the species is carried on from year to year by asexual generations. In many species the males are very rarely seen and in none are they abundant. The males are smaller than the females and usually of similar form. They are distinguished by larger antennules; the post-abdomen is usually somewhat modified (Fig. 1144); the first foot is frequently armed with a stout hook which serves to clasp the females. In Moina this function is performed by the very large antennules (Fig. 1092). ■■***_*;.._■. THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 685 Little is known regarding the length of life of the individual Cladocera. It doubtless varies from a few weeks to several months. Limnetic forms probably have a longer life than the littoral, as the food supply and other conditions of life are more constant. Individ- uals from the broods of Daphnia longispina (hyalina) which are bora late in October and in November may survive through the winter and produce one or more broods of young in the spring. The last survivors die in June, weakened by old age and attacked by par- asitic fungi. This is probably about the maximum length of life. The Cladocera are found in all sorts of fresh waters. Lakes and ponds contain a much larger number of forms than do rivers. The shallow, weedy backwaters of a lake whose level is fairly permanent harbor a greater variety of species than does any other kind of locality. Here are found almost all of the Chydoridae and Macrothricidae, as well as most of the representatives of the other families. In such localities are found the best conditions for the life of these animals: warmth, shelter from enemies, and abundant food. It must not be supposed, however, that each square rod of such waters harbors a like population. On the contrary, anyone who collects frequently in one lake will come to know certain places as especially favorable to these creatures, which are present in greater number and variety than in places apparently quite simi- lar and closely adjacent. While by far the greater number of species belong to the littoral region, living among the weeds and feeding on algae and similar organisms, a few species live near the bottom. Several species are commonly found in or near the mud, although not specially adapted to a life in the mud; such are Alona quadrangularis and Drepanotkrix. The genera Ilyocryptus and Memos pilus live regularly on the bottom; their structure is adjusted to a life in the mud and their shells are often overgrown by algae. These forms may and do swim, but more often scramble about on the bottom, pulling with their antennae and pushing with the post- abdomen. In both forms the old shell is not cast off in molting, the new and larger shell appearing beneath it (Figs. 11 10, 1168). The species of Moina are found most commonly in muddy pools, such as those in brick-yards, though not confined to such waters. 686 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY With them are frequently associated members of the Daphnia pulex group. These last are also found in temporary pools of clear and weedy water, and, less frequently, in lakes. Daphnia magna in Europe is found in waters which are slightly brackish and very possibly does not disdain slightly alkaline waters in this country. The limnetic region of the inland lakes has a cladoceran popula- tion, large in number of individuals but not rich in species. Chy- dorus spkaericus is almost the only Chydorid which is ever abun- dant here, though any species may be present as an accidental visitor. The regularly limnetic species belong chiefly to the genera Bosmina, Diaphanosoma, Daphnia, and Holopediutn. These forms are transparent — an obviously protective character. Chydorus is an exception and the size of this species is so small that trans- parency may be unnecessary. Apart from transparency and a general lightness of build, the limnetic forms have generally no peculiar characters. Holopediutn forms a marked exception to this statement, as its globular gelatinous case is wholly unique in the group and indeed in the Crustacea. Certain forms are intermediate in character between the limnetic and the littoral forms. Such is Ophryoxus gracilis (Fig. noo), which paddles about in the open waters between weeds, and such also is Sida crystattina (Fig. 105 1). Both of these forms are trans- parent, but they are never present in large numbers in the open water, nor are they likely to be found far out from the weedy margin. In southern waters, where are found masses of floating plants such as the water hyacinth, the distinction between the littoral and limnetic species quite disappears. The Gymnomera differ widely in structure and habits from 'the Calyptomera. The section includes two species in our fresh waters: Polyphemus pediculus (Fig. 1169), and Leptodora kindtii (Fig. 1 1 70). In both forms the shell is reduced to an egg case and the feet are free, jointed, and provided with stout spines and hairs. In Leptodora the body is long and jointed, while in Polyphemus it is very short. Both animals are predacious, feeding on protozoa, rotifers, and minute Crustacea. Polyphemus lives chiefly in marshes and in the weedy margins of ponds and lakes, but may also be ' ±1*m£1 THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 687 found in the limnetic region and in the Great Lakes. Leptodora is always limnetic in its habits. It is almost perfectly transparent; the dark eye and yellow stomach alone being visible when the animal is viewed by transmitted light. It is by far the largest of the Cladocera, reaching a length of 18 mm. Its winter eggs hatch as nauplii and this is the only species of Cladocera in which this characteristic crustacean larva appears. The Cladocera have great economic value. Together with the Copepoda they constitute the chief agency for converting the smaller algae of fresh water into a form edible by the carnivorous aquatic animals. They are the prey of insect larvae, which are in turn an important item in the bill of fare of the larger fishes. Clado- cera are themselves of great value as food for young fishes and there is a period in the life of almost every lish when it feeds exclusively on Entomostraca. Even the larger fishes do not disdain these animals. The great spoonbill (Polyodon) fills its stomach with Bosminae, or other tiny inhabitants of the water from which it strains its food. The geographical distribution of Cladocera offers little of interest that can be stated in a brief sketch, chiefly because the species are so widely distributed. Some species, like Chydorus sphaericus, are cosmopolitan. A majority of the species found in this country are found also in Europe. Where a species is peculiar to this region it is often but slightly different from the European form. The student of Cladocera should presume that any species is probably intercontinental, though it may prove to be more restricted in its range. The study of our forms has not gone far enough to enable us to speak of the local distribution of each species within the general area which it covers, but it is known that the rare species are very irregularly distributed. On the whole, the fauna of the various regions of the country is strikingly similar, but with some forms peculiar to each region. The southern states contain numer- ous species which are common to them and to South America, but are not found in the northern states. The student of Cladocera will find the cone net (p. 68) the best agent for collecting the littoral forms. The catch should be put into a cup, which should be filled with water, and the debris allowed 688 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY to settle before pouring off the water and the Crustacea through the funnel. As little as possible of the weed and debris should be in- cluded in the catch, since it is a wearisome task to search for the various species in a catch which contains great masses of weed with but few Crustacea. It is well to retain a part of the weed in a separate bottle, so that species which go to the bottom may not be overlooked. It is also well to cover the cup with one's hat, or otherwise, while the debris is settling so that species which fly from the light may not go into the weed at the bottom. Numerous hauls of the net should be made and concentrated so as. to give abundant material. Considerable experience with collections sent me by students of Cladocera has shown me that the chief faults of the collector are including too much debris in the" catch and taking too few hauls of the dredge. The best preservative I have found to be strong, 95 per cent, alcohol. This keeps the shape of the species as well as or better than anything else. Certain soft-bodied forms with strong muscles may be distorted by any fluid which kills and hardens quickly. Such are Pseudosida, Latona, and Latonopsisy and, to a less degree, Moina and Diapkanosoma* For these also we have nothing better for field use than alcohol. If their forms are to be well preserved they should be killed individually by some poison like osmic acid, or chloral hydrate, and then hardened gradually, according to regu- lar microscopic methods. Formalin distorts many species. I have found no better mounting fluid than pure glycerine. I place the animal with a small drop of glycerine in the center of the aSde and support the cover glass by three bits of paper thick enough to permit the cover to press slightly on the specimen. The cover glass is put on carefully so that the glycerine occupies its center only. A hit of soft paraffin (melting point about 50s C.) is placed at the edge of the cover glass, and* on wanning the slide, the paraf- fin melts and runs in. sealing the mount. The cover may after- wards be cemented down by any microscopic cement, and this should be done if the preparation is to be kept; but for purposes of study it is well not to do so. since an advantage of the method is the ease with which the specimen can be unmounted for study or THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 689 KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER CLADOCERA 1 (348) Body and feet covered by a bivalve shell. Feet in general foliaceous, not plainly jointed. . . . Section A. Calyptornera . . a 3 (31) Six pairs of feet, all similar, except the last, and all foliaceous. Tribe I. Ctenopoda . . 3 3 (18) Shell of ordinary type. Antenna biramous in female, rami flattened, the dorsal with numerous setae, both lateral and terminal. Family Sididae Baird . . 4 Head large; cervical sinus present. Antennules large, movable. Antennae with terminal setae only on ventral ramus. Eye large, with numerous lenses; ocellus small or absent. Intes- tine simple, usually with more or less distinct median cecum or enlargement at anterior end; rarely with a hepatic ceca. Heart elongated. Male usually with characteristic antennule; the flagellum united with the base into one structure, long, tapering, with a row of fine spinulea toward apex; usually with grasping organ on first foot and copulatory organs on post-abdomen. 4 (5) Dorsal ramus of Head with targe gland on dorsal side; pointed rostrum; no fornices. Antennules of ? attached to side of rostrum, short, truncate, with short Aageilura. Ventral ramus of antennae a-jointed. Antennules oi J very long; no copulatory organ; first foot with hook. Only one American species. . . S'lda cryslallina (0. F. M tiller) 1785. Fig. 1051. SUc ayHaaaa. (Tnlen otherwise indicated all figures were drawn especially lor tab Color yellowish-hyaline, sometimes with brilliant blue spots. Length, 9. 3.0-4-0 nun.; JT. 1.5-J.0 mm. Common in lakes and ponds among weeds. 5 (4) Dorsal ramus of antenna 3-jointed 6 6 (o) With lateral expansion on basal joint of dorsal ramus of antenna. Latona Straus 1810 . . 7 Large, tongue-shaped projection 00 ventral side of head, its ventral surface concave. Ventral ramus of antennae 3 jointed. Long setae on posterior margin of valves. Eye dorsal, far from optic ganglion, g with copulatory organ ; no hook on first lout. FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 690 7 (8) Antennary expansion very large; Antennules of both sexes alike, bent, wit! continuation of base. Color yellow; not late autumn. Length, ?, a.o-j^nun.; $, 1 among weeds in ponds and lakes. 0 hepatic ceca. Latona setijera (0. F. Mtiller) 1785. large, hairy flagellum set on at angle, looking like ransparent; old 9 often with brilliant colors in 1. 1 .5 mm. Widely distributed, but never abundant. 8(7) Antennary expansion small; hepatic ceca present. Laltma parviremts Birge iqio. Antennule of 9 with basal part and long slender flagellum, like Latotwpsis; of £ very long. like other Sididae. Color yellow. Length, 9. to 1.5 mm.; J, 0.8 mm. Northern Wisconsin, Michigan, Maine; in weedy waters of lake . 9 (6) Without lateral expansion of antenna 10 10(13) No spines on post-abdomen. . Diaphanosoma Fischer 1850 , . 11 No rostrum, fornix, or ocellus. Antennule small, truncated; olfactory setae terminal, with ■lender nagdliim. Dorsal ramus of antennae a-jointcd; ventral j-jointed. Claws with 3 b*»l spines. £ with long antennule; copulatory organ; book on first 'OOt. THE WATER FLEAS (CLAIIOCKRA) d antenna n 13 {10} Spines on post-abdomen 14 14 (17) Eye dorsal, far from insertion of antennuk and optic ganglion. No lustrum. ....... LuUmepsu Sars 1888 . . 15 Ko tongue-shaped jxuveasuo ventral »(k of bead, ut anlaiiiao' e*i*uuh*i Otherwise much filer Lalmu Wwnu Pusietiur margin of valves with ver> luog teui- ioitec kwt). $ with loop intemiulf . rajwlalifr; ufgac. aud book up first lout 15 (16) Shell gland drawn out into very long posterior loop. f'oat-juooraeiJ with about y wiull anal spines. Color jdlowiih'Usuit- parent. Length, V , 10 iJ* hud.: & . mm., besides spine of about o.j mm. Wyoming, Wisconsin; in open waters of This species forms ■ " Fio. 1067. Daphtia at 0.1 MM. i 33 (3*j 32> Ocellus absent; head helmeted. . Dapknia rclrocurva Forbes 1882. As' Body much compressed, pellucid. Eye small, with numerous projecting lenses and little pigment; no ocellus. Spine ordinarily above middle of valves, directed upward. Crest very variable, often enormous. Claws with two s. the distal of 7-0 teeth. Anal spines 7— n. Sum- ordinarily 1; sometimes as many u 6. Length, > mm., besides spine, which may reach o.j mm. Widely distributed in limnetic region of lakes. Shape of head extremely variable; all forms from var. brtmap] B j r g e , where the crest b hardly visible, to the [tension shown by rttro- 1 proper. This species replaces in the United States the European D. cvcvilalo, which is related to D. longi- spiim, much as this form is to Cottier. " una never has the extremely te form of head which cxctdlaJa Very probably study will show that all the pviex forma (31, 31, 33) must be united into one polymorphic species. 34 (i6) Claws without pecten 35 35 (38) Ocellus present, though small. Dapknia longispina (O. F. Mtiller) 1785 . . 36 3J, Spine long; claws without pecten. Male without long papilla on posterior part of body. This species is so variable that almost no characters can be given for it. It is less robust than the pulci forms, ordinarily fairly transparent; often hyaline. This part of the species divides at once Into 1 sections or subspecies, each with numerous varieties which have thoroughly studied in the United States. Fro. 1068. D«*aafa Faa-iote. Dtftm* Uotisfim, (Sa* taw Ht. IB30, p. 6>7.> THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 697 36(37) Head not helmeted; eye close to margin. . Daphnia Iongispina proper. There ire numerous varieties of D. lotttiipina proper; depending on proportion of valves, etc Hie head may be large or small, its ventral margin straight, concave, or convex. The eye may have a large pigment with few leases embedded in it, or it may be smaller with numerous pro- jecting lenses. Found in all regions of the United States. 37 (36) Head helmeted and eye therefore removed from margin. Usually more delicate and transparent than 36. Daphma Iongispina var. kyalina Leydig i860. D. Umpipina var. kyaiina varies conspicuously and greatly in the form and size of the crest and of the ventral and dorsal margins of the head, which may be concave, convex, or straight with any form of crest. The crest may be small and rounded (var. hyalina typica); extended into a broad semi-elliptical form (form meadolat); more or less triangular, with an acute point in front (form laltala); which may be extended into a short spine. An indefinite number of other forms are present, some of which have been studied and described, but not named by Entemann. The form of the crest in specimens from any one lake is fairly uniform (though irielies may be present), changing with the season, being larger in summer than in spring. Adjacent lakes may vary greatly. Deep v have smaller 38(35) Ocellus absent; head helmeted. Daphnia Iongispina var. longiremis Sars 1 Valves broadly oval; spine long and slender. Head small and rounded with crest. Ante very long, reaching well toward posterior margin of valves when renexed. Length, 9, to 1.5 This is the only representative of the European cucullala group as yet seen in this country, doubt other forms will be discovered. Indiana; Wisconsin, in deep water of lakes in soul part of state; in surface waters in northern part. Flo. 1073. Difkm* Imiinmii. 698 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 39 (as) Cervical sinus present. No crest 40 40 (45) Valves transversely striated. Post-abdomen broad, with indenta- tion in which anus opens. Simocephalus Schoedler 1858 . . 41 %■ Body Urge and heavy: shell thick. Head ami rostrum small. Valves large, somewhat quadrate, with rounded angles and sometimes a posterior spine; marked with oblique striae, anastomosing irregularly and with cross-connections Two abdominal processes developed, placed far apart. Post-abdomen large, broad, truncate, posterior end emarginate and bear- ing the anal spines. Claws rather straight, always denticulate, sometimes pectinate. Summer eggs numerous; ephippium large, triangular, with one egg. Antennules of J like ? but with 1 lateral sense- hairs. First foot without flagellum and with small book. Poor swimmer; swims often on its back. Color yellow to yellow Drown. 41 (44) Vertex rounded, smooth. No posterior spine on valves 42 42 (43) Ocellus elongated. Vertex rounded over. Claws denticulate. Simocephalus velulus (0. F. Mtiller) 1776. Ocellus large, elongated, rarely rhom- boids!. No spine on valves, though there may be a blunt posterior angle. Post -abdomen very broad, deeply emarginate; anal spines about ten, de- creasing from the claws; the Larger bent and filiate at the base. Claws long, slender, little curved, denticulate only. Length, ? , to j.o mm.; J , ta. Not very abundant, but found every- where in weedy water. Fie. 1073. Simstipialui KlaJiu , with 43 (42) Ocellus rhomboids! or round. Vertex with obtuse or rounded angle. Claws pectinate. . ■ Simocephalus extpinesMS (Koch) 1841. 8-ij teeth and denticulate. Color and geo- Leiujtil, 9,toj-0iniu.; {.to 1.3 mm. Not common; reported from Massachu- I WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 699 44 (41) Vertex angulated. spinous. Blunt, rounded posterior spine on valves in old individuals. Ocellus rhomboidal or triangular, rarely elongated. . . Simccephaius serrulatus (Koch) 1841. OJMM. — • 45 (40) Valves obscurely reticulated and with some striae. Posterior and ventral margins straight, the latter extended into a point or spine. Scaphokberis Schoedler 1856 . . 46 Body not compressed; shape more or less quadrate. Cervical sinus deep. Fomices and rostrum well develuped. Head small, depressed. Valves almost rectangular, the infero- poatcal angle °' eac^ produced into a longer or shorter spine; ventral margin with short, fine setae. Claws denticulate, not pectinate. One abdominal projection developed. Antennules ■mall, about alike in both sexes, borne behind the rostrum. Summer eggs numerous; one ephippial egg. £ much like ? . hook on hist foot. 46 (47) Color usually dark, often nearly black. Scapholebtris mucrtmaia (0. F. Mliller) 1785. Valves arched doraally in old specimens; posterior and ven- tral margins straight; at their C' inction a spine often short, lit often very long; in var. armala derrick as long as ven- tral margin of valve. Anten- nules very small, almost im- movable, set behind beak. Post-abdomen short and broad. rounded at posterior end; 5-6 anal teeth. Length, 9, 0.8-1.0 The form with frontal spine has never been found in the United States. Common every- where in pools and lakes in weedy water, or swimming 00 Fjq. 1076. SafkiUmii ■»■— 1 its back near or at the surface. 47 (46) Color whitish or greenish; transparent or opaque, not black. Scaphokberis aurita (Fischer) 1849. urn long, lying against rum, conical, large, and es with blunt projection it iufero-posteal angle, obscurely striate and reticulate in front, ind with small elevaUons elsewhere. Length. ? , ca 1.0 mm.; 3,0.5 am. Not common: in weedy pools and margins of lakes. Northern FlC IO?J. SfHulillHil Hi 700 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 48 (24) No rostrum. Cervical sinus present 49 49 {65) Head small and depressed. Antennules small. Valves oval or round. No post-anal extension of post-abdomen. Ceriodaphnia Dana 1853 . . 50 General form rounded or oval; sue small, rarely exceeding 1 nun. Vertex a rounded or annu- lar projection, usually Dearly filled by eye. Valves oval or round to subquadrate, usually ending in a sharp dorsal angle or short spine. Antennules not very freely movable. One abdominal process ordinarily developed. Post-abdomen of various forms, large. Ephippium triangular, with one egg placed longitudinally. Antennules of J with long, stout seta, modi- fication of nagdlum; first foot with book and long fiagellum. Free swimming; motion 50 (51) Head with a short spine or horn. Ceriodapknia rigaudi Richard 1894. Valves reticulated. Head produced in front of antennules into a short, conical, sharp-pointed, hornlike process. Two abdominal proc- esses. Post-abdomen with 5-6 anal spines. Claws smooth or den- ticulate. Antennules rather slender; lateral sense-hair somewhat distal to middle. Length of J, 0.4-Q.5 mm.; J (South American}, ' Pools; Louisiana, Texas. The form with bom on verte mingled with typical C. rigaudi. eluded in C. cornula Sara. Fig. 10/8. CtnadaHuBt ritamU. 51 (50) Head without horn, 53 (53) Claws pectinate. . . Ceriodaphnia reticulata (J urine) 1820. Head obtusely, or not at all, angu- lated in front of antennules. Valves reticulated, ending in spine or angle. Antennules small, with sense-hair near apex. Anal spines 7-10. Claws with pecten of 6-10 teeth and denticulate. Color variable, shades of red and yel- low. Length of ?. 0.6-1.4 ™°>.; of Coinmou, widely distributed. Flo. 1079. Ctritdaflmi* rdialtU. with 53 (S*) Claws not pectinate. 54 THE WATER FLEAS (CXADOCERA) 701 54 (55) Head and valves strongly reticulated and covered with numerous short spinules Ceriodaphnia acantkina Ross 1897. General ihape rotund with well -developed spine. Head much depressed, not angulated in front of antennules or at vertex. Antennules short and thick with sense-hair near apex. Pout- abdomen narrow, much like quadranpda, with J-o anal spines. Clawa denticulate, trie denticle* in the proximal two-fifths of the daw obviously longer than the remainder. Color whitish- transparent to very dark. Length, 5 , to 1.0 mm., g unknown. Manitoba, in weedy slough. Fro. 1081. DetaDsof valve, much enlarged. Fro. 10S0. Cawdaflmia unlMu. 55 (S4) Valves not spinulated 56 56 (57, 61) Post-abdomen abruptly cut into near apex, serrate above, spines below Ceriodaphnia megaiops Sars 1861. Head angulated before antennules; valves striated. Anten- nules with sense-hair near apex. Post-abdomen broad, witb an angle near apex, cut into below angle, finely serrate above and with 7-9 slender anal spines below. Claws not pt Length, f, 1.0-1.5 mm.; g , 0.6-0.8 mm. Widely distributed but not common. Fro. icfla. Ctnoiafhma «tfib». S7(5fi.6a) Post-abdomennotcutinto; of ordinary form 58 58 (59) Fomices projecting into spinous processes. Eye small. Ceriodaphnia lacuslris Birge 1893. Head angulated in front of an- tennule; vertex with fine spinules. Fomices very brood, triangular; with spines at tip. Valves with stout, short posterior spine, some- tiroes divided, but usually with 3-4 spinules. Post-abdomen like C. quadrangvia. 0" unknown. Color yellow, transparent. Length, S, 0.8-0.0 "" Wisconsin, Michigan; limnetic in lakes. Fro. io8j. Cuwdaploua laauku. 702 FSE5H-WATOI BIOLOGY 59 ' 5*'j Frted as larger (1.68 mm.) and may possibly* be a different spe- cies. Herrick had only King's very imperfect description for comparison with his form, and his own description is correspond- ingly imperfect . Sars' figures of M. maclcayii from Brazil show a form identical with that from New Orleans. Fig. i»g. Al virutdaphnia ma.lcayii. 67 (66) Body thick and heavy. Valves somewhat rhomboidal, not wholly covering body. Fornix small. Ocellus absent. Abdominal process represented by horse-shoe shaped fold. Moinu Baird 1S50 . . 68 Cervical sinus present. Valves thin, obscurely reticulated or striated; no posterior spine. Head large, thick, rounded in front; sometimes with deep depression above eye; no rostrum. Antennules long, spindle-shaped, freely movable: lateral sense-hair about middle. No regular abdominal projection, but in old £ a horse-shoe shaped ridge which closes the brood-cavity. Post-abdomen extended into conical post-anal part, bearing ciliated spines and bident. Claws small; abdominal setae very long. Summer eggs numerous; ephippium oval, with 1 or 2 eggs. Antennule of £ very lone and stout, modified into clasping organ; denticulate, with small recurved hooks at apex. First foot with hook. The species of Atoina ordinarily inhabit muddy pooi> and similar places. They are soft- bodied, weak creatures; liable to be much distorted by preserving fluids. The species are much •like and often bard to distinguish unless £ and ephlppial 9 are present. FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 68 (69) Post-anal spines fewer than S. Animal small, about 0.5 mm. long. Uoina mtkmra Kuiz 1874. Small, transparent; hod retttivery very IHmnti. Arkansas, L 69(68) Po*t-anal spines 8 or more. Animallarger.abouti.omm.ormoFe. . 70 70 (75) Supra-ocular depression present; claws pectinate; no flagellum on first foot of male 71 71(73) Two ephippial eggs Body flout, heavy; greenish, not transparent. Head ordinarily much depressed, so that 'a often lie* almost on level ol ventral margin of valves. Deep supra-ocular depression. .... .... t. . , _ .. i_._!j__ l.j _.. , - crinite. Antes.- ; J unknown in ; antennules of male with sense seta in middle. Minna brachiala (Jurine) 1830. Head ordinarily much depressed, so that ESo. loot. HW— IrTHrtr. 71 (71) One ephippial egg 73 THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 705 Valves smooth; cphippium reticulated around edges, smooth in middle; antennules of male with sense seta near middle. Moina nctirostris (Leydig) i860. [ with bluish cast Head extended or little depressed; deep cervical and supra- ocular depressions Pott-abdomen with long — — pojection nad 10-1.5 post-anal spines mod trident. Claws pectinate. Antennules of $ Fig. 109 j. laak Fig. loot. F.phippiuiB A.lltima U ud It alter LBlte- 74 (73) Valves striate; ephippium reticulated all over; antennules of male with sense seta near base. . . . Moina ajfinis Bilge 1893. vMMMi ■ Much like U. rettiroHns, from which the young 9 an hardly distinguishable- Anten- nules of $ broad, fringed with fine hairs on inner margin; 4-6 hooks at end. Length, 9 , Fig. 1094. Kmu aJSmii. apex of peal 75(70) No supra-ocular depression; claws not pectinate; antennules of male with sense seta in middle or below; first foot of male with long flagellum. . Moina macrocopa Straus 1820. Not very transparent: yellowish or greenish. Head extended. Terminal part of post-abdomen long, with 10-13 spines besides bident . Two ephippisJ eggs. $ with elongated head ; 5-6 hooks on antennule- Length, $7 to 1.8 mm.; $ . 0.5-0-6 mm. Pools, Wisconsin, Nebraska, Colorado, N. Dakota; doubtless widely distributed Tins species is M. paradaxa Weismann and M. fia&Uela Hu- 7o6 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY j6 (2$, 83) Six pairs of feet. Antennules of female large, fixed. Intestine simple; no ceca Family BosHtMlDAE Sars . . 77 Body sliori and high often oval 01 77 (8a) Antennules of female approximately parallel to each other, curving backward, fixed to head; olfactory setae on side, usually near base Bosmina Baird 1845 . . 78 Animal usually hyaline ; valves thin; infero-posteal angle with spine — tbe miuro. Antennules of O immovably fixed to head; olfactory setae on side, with small triangular plate above them: distal position of antennules looks segmented. Antennae with 3- and 4- jointed ramus. Post- abdomen somewhat quadrate; anus terminal; spines small and inconspicuous; daws set on a cylindrical process. $ smaller than ?, with short, blunt rostrum; large free antennules; hook and long Sagellum on first foot. Little work has been done in this country on this very difficult genus; but it is certain there . are not so many species nor so great an amount of variation here as in Europe. 78 (79) Claws with two series of spinules. Bosmina Imgtrostris (O. F. Mtiller) 1785. Two series of spinules on daws, the basal increasing in length distally, contin- ued by very fine denticles lo tip of claw. Frontal sense-hair about midway between eye and junction of antennules. Antennules moderate or short (var. bmiamii) ; sometimes re- curved at apei (var. Mr- t tiMla). Transparent or — --'yj dear yellowish. Length, 9. 0.3-o.s mm.; S , 0.15-0.4 Very common and very variable. In open water of lakes, in weedy rnar- '-- In pools and marshes. C ft, var. ftnaiunli. Claws with basal series of spinules only. . THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 707 80 (81) Mucro shorter than claws and process bearing them. Bosmina obiusirostris Sars 1861. Frontal sense-hair near junction of antennules. Antennules shorter than length ol valves. Shell reticulated or smooth. Length, 9. 0.3-0.5 mm. FlC*. 1097, 1097, ». Beiwuua rtbUuiTOitni. 81 (80) Mucro longer than claws and process. Bosmina longispina Leydig i860. Frontal sense-hair near junction of antennules, Mucro and antennules long. Shell striated, marks especially plain on head. Transparent. Length. 9, ca. 0.4 mm. Rare, in lakes. Flo. 1098. BojwiiM bueufiiu. Antennules united at base, and diverging at apex; numerous long olfactory setae on their ventral side. Bosminopsis Richard 1895. Sole American species Bosminopsis dtitersi Richard 1805. In general much like Bos- mina. Basal pan of anten- nules united with each other and head to form very long rostrum; diverging laterally near apex, with long, strag- gling, olfactory setae. Anten- na with 3 -join ted rami. Post- abdomen tapering to point at daws; 1 large spine near claws and several very mi- nute spinules anterior to it. $ with large movable a tennules; short foot with book and Bagelli Length, 9 , ca. 0.35 mm.; 708 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 83 (23, 76) Antennules of female long, freely movable, usually inserted at anterior end of ventral surface of head. Rami of antennae 3- and 4 -join ted. Intestine simple or convoluted. Hepatic ceca usually wanting. Five or six pairs of feet. Family Macrothricidae Norman and Brady . . 84 Abdominal process usually absent; rarely present (Ilyocrypius). Feet, 5 or 6 pairs, the first two prehensile; the last, if present, rudimentary. Post-abdomen marked off from body, usually large, often bilobed; anus terminal or lateral. Labium usually with keel or marked projection. Valves often crested Fornices well developed. The members of this family are so various in form that it is hard to find many common characters; yet the general appearance is always characteristic. The size and position of the antennules will show the membership of every genus except Ilyocrypius; and there is no trouble in recognizing that genus as belonging to the family. 84 (95) Intestine convoluted 85 85 (86) Valves with spine at supero-posteal angle. Small hepatic ceca. Ophryoxus Sars 1801. Sole species Ophryoxus gracilis Sars 1861. General form elongated, some- what daphnid. Antennules long, slender, fringed with numerous hairs behind, lateral sense-hair near base; olfactory setae unequal. Antennae long, weak. Six pairs of feet. Post-abdomen long, taper- ing at apex, anus dorsal, post-anal Sortion large with numerous short, lunt, ciliated spines, the proximal mere elevations bearing fine spi- nules. Claws straight, with (usu- ally) two stout basal spines. In- testine with convolution in middle of body: 2 small hepatic ceca. Antennules of $ longer than 9 : sense-hairs longer. Vasa deferen- tia open on ventral (anterior) side of post-abdomen about middle. Strong hook on first foot. Color transparent, last foot often purple in old 9 • Length, 9 » to 2,0 mm.; a, 1.0 mm. Widely distributed in lakes among weeds. Swims with constant but rather feeble paddling motion. Spine longer in young than adult. 86 (85) No such spine 87 87 (92) Hepatic ceca present 88 88(89) Antennarysetae9,^=2::i; S , °~°"<)""3 ; valves narrowed behind and 0-0-3 1-1-3 prolonged into short tube. . Par ophryoxus Doolittle 1909. Sole species Parophryoxus tubulatus Doolittle 1009. Form elongated oval; narrow crest on head and valves. Head rounded, rostrum well marked; cervical sinus present. Valves thin, transparent; unmarked or faintly reticulated; prolonged behind into a sort of tube, best seen from above; ventral margin with moderate Post-abdomen elongated, triangular; post-anal part long and slender, narrowed toward OJMM ^_* Fig. 1 100. Ophryoxus gracilis. apex somewhat as in Ophryoxus; bearing a few very small spines. Claws long, rather straight; with 2 basal spines. Antennules cylindrical, slender; with basal sense-hair and three conspicu oosly long olfactory setae. Antennae long, slender; basal joint annulated; setae not conspicu- ously dissimilar. Feet, 6 pairs; the last rudimentary. Eye moderate, with few lenses; ocellus -»- ! -• THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) Urge, some distance from J] Z with book on first foot: transparen t -y ellostisb , Maine. Nrw Hampshire; among weeds in lakes. The difference in antennary setae of 3 and O hold* for all n >-:.!-.--. Fig. iioi. Pantkymi luMalui. (After DmlinkJ 89(88) Setae- , animal small, spherical. . Streblocerus Sara 1862 . . 90 Body round-ova), not compressed or crested. Labium with large, senate, acute process. Antennules large, flat, bent, or rather twisted, broadened in distal part; with lateral sense- hair near base, several hairs on posterior face, rows of fine hairs, and subequal olfactory setae. Post-abdomen bilobed; the pre-anal part compressed, semi -circular; the anal part rounded, with fine spines or hairs. Claws small, curved, with several equal minute denticles on con- cave edge. Five pairs ol feet. Intestine convoluted, with small bepatic ceca. & (European, of S. ierTica*datits) small, triangular, much like 9 ; first foot without hook. go (91) Dorsal margin of valves smooth. Streblocerus serricaudatus (Fischer) 1849. Pre-anal part of post-abdo- men with senate margin and bearing rows of fine bain. Anterior margin of antennula somewhat toothed. Color whitish -opaque Length. J. ca Rare but widely distributed in weedy pools and nuugta of lakes. Reported from New England, Wisconsin, Nebraska, Louisiana, Colorado, Califor- 91 (90) Valves reticulated, the edges of the reticulations making scale-like ridges, which give the dorsal margin a serrate appearance. Streblocerus pygmoeus Sars toot. Pre-anal part of post-abdomen not serrate, with a-j row* of fine hairs- Color grayish white, opaque, to nearly black En epcjppial $ . £ unknown. Length, O, 0.1-0.15 nun. The smallest member of the family and one of the smallest of the group. Louisiana, in weedy pools, with 5. itrriiamdaiui. Fo-iiQ). JwaHaa— Ijrsini FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 92 (87) No hepatic ceca; setae — * 93 93 (94) Convolution of intestine in middle of body. Valves crested, with strong tooth on crest Drepanolhrix Sars 1S61. Sole species Drepanolhrix dentata (Euren) 1S61. Valves reticulated ; dorsal margin arched, crested, with conspicuous, short, backward- pointing tooth about middle. Antennules broad. Bat, twisted, though not so much as in Slrtbloterus; post-abdomen compressed but not extended into a thin edge; almost quadrate as seen from side. Margin with 3 rows of small spines, about ao, and with several rows of hairs besides scattered groups; apex truncate, eraarginate, with anus in depression. Claws short, broad, crescentic, smooth, or denticulate; 5 pairs of feet. J much like young 9 ; hook on first foot; post-abdomen without spines; vasa deferentia open in front of daws. Color whitish to yellowish; opaque or transparent. Length, 9 , ca. 0.7 mm.; J , ca. 0.4 mm. Not commonly collected though widely distributed and probably not very rare in shallow waters of lakes, on bottom or among weeds, Maine, Michigan, Wisconsin, Minnesota, Colorado. DrttmitMt tmiiit. 94 (93) Convolution of intestine in hind part of body and in post-abdomen. No dorsal tooth AcanthoUberU Lilljeborg 1853. Sole species Aeanthokberis curvirostris (O. F. Mtlller) 1776. Form in general angu- d! valve im with long, slender, conical process. Anten- nules large, flat, somewhat curved, expanded toward a pei. Post-abdomen large, moderately broad, not hairy, with 30 or more small dorsal spines in each row; onus terminal. Claws short, stout, broad, curved, denticulate, and with 2 small basal spines tet tide x pairs of feet. Intestine without ceca, convoluted, the loops lying in great part in en. $ resembling young 9 , antennulea with a proximal sense-hairs; first loot inconspicuous hook, post-abdomen emarginate dorsally; vasa deferentia open Color yellow, not transparent. Length, 9 , to 1 8 mm .; J, 0.5-0. 7m 95 (84) Intestine simple. THE KATES FLEAS {CLADCCERA) 711 5* '99 Hcpntk «jcb pctr*;w : post -abdomen bilubed; anieanary setae PoBi-aUkmiec vcr> iittgr. wfiti few spines. . Grimddimx Richard 1892. Safe a|jcdei Crimjidin^ hmssai Richard 1892. Body u-mprcsjcd somewhat rarjpilar. with all mart-ins ol ' slightl} '.on™ PoM-abdomen mou>. uiucf: compressed, rounblv ellijjiica! ii. form' the pre ana) p divided bv s notch into im pa which the anterior i- the imaJ Lrj spine in thf iiouh which ; jurictlur uf anal nod pn anal pati denticulate, with 1 a;-chami e££-chamber* reniforin » Odor reddish - » c, mm ■ J . Posi-abuorui-r. muacrale: Soie Amrri.-.i-. iptQl'r- u kinixiiitiaii Birgv 1910 pfrssri Valves crated i mm Marf^. a: Kir,irtin.. Maan.'bs. ertion CUws tn.aU basil t pairs, ol ted; FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY too (107, 116) Antennary setae - Sole American species. Fie. 110B. Bamafs mrtkmiuk. Bunops Bilge 1893. Bunops serricoudota (Daday) 1888. General form rounded, much compressed; high ke«l 00 dorsal side. Front of head flat, somewhat kite-shaped, with boss or umbo over eye. Strung triangular keel on la- bium. Valves faintly reticulated, produced behind into rounded projection; ventral margin gaping in front, indexed behind, hair and two pairs of sense setae near apex; olfactory setae somewhat unequal. Post-ab- domen much like Slrebloeerui; bilobed, pre- anal portion flattened, semi-circular, with 7-8 notches or teeth on the dorsal margin and 3-4 rows of fine hairs; anal portion with hairs and 3-4 spines. Color transpar tinged with yellow. $ unknown. Lengtn ot 9 to 1.0 mm. Maine. Wisconsin; very local in distribution, but not rare when present. 102 (tot) Vertex of head forming sharp angle in front of insertion of anten- nules. Dorsal crest of valves absent or small. Post-abdo- men very large, with numerous long spines. Ilyocryptus Sars 1861 . . 103 General form oval -triangular, the head forming the apex of the triangle, while the enormously dilated ventral and posterior edges of the valves round into each other; these have long, dose- let, fixed setae, usually branched and fringed. Antennules long, freely movable, i-jointed, basal joint very small, attached to ventral side of head behind vertex: olfactory setae unequal. Antennae short, powerful; basal joint annulated nearly to apex: with long sense setae; motor setae not plumose, smooth, or with sparse hairs. Abdominal process long, tongue-shaped, hairy. Post-abdomen large, broad, compressed; anus on side or near apex; many spines on dorsal margin; numerous, long, curved, lateral spines and setae; fine spinulex near base of daws. Claws long, straight, denticulate, and with 1 slender basal spines. Intestine simple, no ceca, but enlarged near rectum. Six pairs of feet. S with larger antennules than $ , bearing a sense-hairs; no book on first foot. In most species the old shells are not cast off in molting but overlie the youngest in several layers. The species live in mud, creep about among weeds, though they can and do swim; are often greatly loaded with mud and vegetable growths, nearly concealing structure. 103 (106) Anus opening on dorsal margin of post-abdomen; molting imper- fect 104 104 (105) Eight or more pre-anal spines; antennary setae short. Ilyocryptus sordidus (LieVen) 1848. Post-abdomen emarginate where anus opens; 8-14 pre- anal marginal spines; lateral postanal spines about 8-10; maisfl—J row of numerous smaller spines. Ocellus a. 1100. Bjiujaiai itriiim. a out widely distributed in weeds or eye. Six to eight summer Color red, but often so loaned with debris aa to be opaque. Length, 9, c». 10 , THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 713 MS (104) Five to seven pre-anal spines; antennary setae ordinarily very long. Ilyocryptus spinifer Herrick 1884. dorasl margin of post-abdomen: 5-7 pre-anal spines; 4-8 jxhA mud lateral opines in outer row. An- tiines equaling length of vita*; in some uprrfmmi they in short, apparently bemuse of weir. Eight to tea summer egg*; true ephlp- piurn formed and cut off (Sin) $ unknown. Color yellow or red- dish. Length, 9, to 0.8 mm. This spedes is /. Itntirami Sin; /. kalyi Brady. Miine to Luke S of Mexico. Proh__ of United States. X end of post-abdomen; molting complete. Ilyocryptus acutifrons San 186a. Post-abdomen not emirgtnite; about 8 small spines near daws, shortest next daw; about 6 long, curved, literal spines, shout 8 marginal spines corresponding to jpre-anilt of other species; the proximal two diirctrd for- ward ; from distal spine of this set ■ series of very small marginals to anus. Antennule dub- shaped, hairy. Ocellus nearer tion of intennules. Claws si Ilyecryflia aculifron Color reddish r yellowishT '. ■alnYt Length, 9, ca. Rhode Island, Colorado 107 (100, t 16) Antennary setae ■ ; basal seta of 3-jointed ramus Btout and stiff Matrolhrix Baird 1S43 . . 10S Shape oval or rotund, somewhat compressed, with dorsal crest. Head large, ordinarily not depressed; vertex evenly or abruptly rounded; rostrum short. Ventral margin of vitas ordinarily with long, stout, movable spines, which project in several directions. Anteunules large; lateral sense-hsir near base. Antennae large; the proiimal seta ol 3-jointed ramus long, stiff, and spinous; the others sparsely plumose or partly spinous. Five pain of feet. No ab- dominal process. Post-abdomen large; often bilobed. Claws small. Intestine simple, no cem. o" with large antcnnules; hook on first foot. 8(115) Dorsal margin of head evenly rounded 109 100 {114) Head extended; rostrum far from margin of valves. Antcnnules. enlarged near distal end. lie 714 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY no (in) Post-abdomen not bilobed. . Macrothrix latkornis (Jurine) i8ao. Form round-ovate. Valves crested, the dorsal edge senate with fine teeth- Head evenly rounded. Labnun with large triangular process. Antcnnule broader distally; a setiferous projec- tion on posterior margin near apex; anterior margin with several fine in- cisions and clusters or rows of hairs; olfactory setae conspicuously unequal. ..... .l. . .:.,- g^ spines and hairs; anus terminal. Claws small Color grayish white or yellowish. Length, y, 0,5-0.7 nun.; Widely distributed; found in alt parts of the country but nowhere very abundant. t (no) Post-abdomen bilobed. 2 (113) Conspicuous fold or Folds of shell of head at cervical sinus. Macrothrix monUina Birge 1004. Antennulea stout, large, enlarged n< or cross-rows of hairs, and 3-4 stoute Dry setae unequal. Post-abdomen bibb Claws hardly 1 spines. Color transparent, in preserved ■peel- unknown. Length, 9 . ca. 0.5s mm. Fro. iiij. ilaaoUira m. 113 (iia) No such folds. Macrothrix hirsutkontis Norman and Brady 1867. Form broadly ovate, Antennules broad, flat, b distally; with 6-8 rows c stout setae on posterior side; olfactory setae unequal. Poet-abdo- men large, broad, bilobed; prc-anal part not flattened nor with projection for abdominal setae; numerous small spines and hairs ■anal parts. J unknown. Length, O, 0.55 ejection New England, Colorado. Jfocntfrn kiriatUnmil. THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCEKA) 715 114 (109) Head much depressed; rostrum close to margin of valves. Anten- nules slender, not enlarged near distal end. Macrotkrix borystkenica Matile 1890. Dorsal margin of bead evenly rounded over into that of valves without sinus. Front of bead recurved ao that ros- trum in very close to valves. Antennulea with a few scat- tered fine hairs; olfactory setae small, equal. Post-abdomen elongated, bibbed; with numerous fine spinulei and hairs on both lobes. Claws small. Eye moderate; ocellus at rostrum. Color transparent. Length, ?• to 1.1 nun. Albuquerque, New Mexico [Herrici). 115 (108) Dorsal margin of head curved abruptly in front of eye, Antennulea slender. Macrotkrix rosea (Jurine) 1830. iculated, crested, not serrate. Head large; lb dorsal mar- terior margin. Antennulea long, slender, not enlarged near n small elevation; olfactory setae unequal. Post-abdomen ich abdominal setae are borne; pre -anal part semi-elliptical, „ 'a edge and many fine hairs: anal part with several small spines. Claws small, smooth. Summer eggs numerous: ephippium well-developed, with > eggs. Antennules of £ Ions, curved. Post-abdomen terminating in long, fleshy projection 00 which the vasa deferentia open. Hook of first foot serrate at tip. Color transparent to yellowish or sometimes a ruddy linge. Length, 9. ca. 0.7 mm.; S, 04 mm. Common everywhere in marshy pc»>ls and margins of lakes. if. tcnuicornis Kurz is a variety of this species All $ $ found in America agree with it. tlttani Sara. Form broadly ovate. Valvi gin rounding over abruptly ini apex: lateral sense-hair near b extended into blunt process, 01 716 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 07) Antennary setae 0-1-1-3 I-1-3 1 all similar and plumose. Lathonura Lilljeborg 1853. Sole species Lathonura rectirostris (O. F. Mliller) 1785. General form long-oval, not com- pressed. Valves unmarked; the ventral margin with short, dose-set, smooth, lancet-shaped, or spatulate spines. Antennules straight, with sense-hair near base; 3 pairs of sense setae in distal half. Post-abdomen very small, extended behind into a long conical process, which bears the very long abdominal setae; covered with fine spines and setae. Claws small, smooth, or denticulate. Sum- mer eggs, 3 to 10; 1 ephippial egg. $ like young 9, with larger anten- nules; 2 lateral sense-hairs, the addi- tional one — tbe distal — the larger; olfactory setae longer. First foot with hook. Vas deferens opens at yell. Color Widely distributed __ clear Length, 9, to 117 (33) Fornices extended so as to cover antennules in whole or in part, and uniting with the rostrum into a beak, projecting ventrally in front of antennules. . Family Chydortdae Stabbing . . 118 Antennae small, rami j-jointed; setae -^^* or =". Labrum with large keel. Fiveorsii pairs of feet. No true abdominal processor ephippium. Post-abdomen compressed, jointed to body. Intestine convoluted. Ocellus always present. J* with hook on first foot; large auten- □ule; short rostrum. 3 (ng) Anus terminal. 3 hepatic ceca. Summer and ephippial eggs numerous Subfamily Eurycexonae Eura. Sole genus Eurycercus Baird 1843. THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) Only one American species. Eurycercus lamtihius (0. F. MUller) 1785. Body stout, heavy. PoM-abdomen very Urge, flatteried, general form quadrangular; anus terminal, in depression; dorsal margin, with very numeroui — over 100 — saw-like teeth. Clawa on ninllerDDi projection, with 1 bud spines and denticulate. Six pairs ol feet. Intestine with hepatic ccca and con- volution. & hke young? ; hook on Grit foot; vai deferens opens at base of daw on ventral (anterior) side. Color yellowish-brown, opaque. Length, J, to 30 mm. or more; t . to 1.4 mm. The Largest member ol the family. Found everywhere; in pei- 119 (118; Anus on dorsal side of post-abdomen, whose post-anal portion bears denticles. No hepatic ceca. Two summer eggs; one ephippial egg. $ with strong hook, on first foot. Subfamily Ceydorinae . . lao 120 (247) Eye present hi 1 21 {246) Eye and ocellus of ordinary size; antennules do not project beyond rostrum, though olfactory setae may in 122 (171) Pnatprinr margin nf v»Ww nnt greatly lCM trianmiiTiimniiFHi'gfit U3 No species of PIrurosui belong in this section, though some individuals of igc and log may 123(135) Body compressed; claws with secondary tooth in middle. .'. 134 124 (129, 132) Crested; post-abdomen narrow,1 with marginal and lateral denticles 135 1 Terms denoting ri which they occur. e to be understood with reference to the section in 718 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 135(128) Crest on head and valves. . Camptoctrcus Baird 1843 . . 126 Form oval; greatly cnomrftd. with ant an bead and back. Valves with angles rounded; snail teeth at in/ero-posteil angle; longitudinally striated. Post abdomen very nag, deader, with Dumeroai marginal denudes and lateral squamae. Claws long, straight, with 1 banal ■pine; a aeries of small denticles terminating in a larger one about tbe middle of daw ; extremely fine teeth thence to apex. Five pain ol feet. 136 (127) Post-abdomen with 15-17 marginal denticles. Camptocercus rtctirostris Schoedler 1862. Head at ended or de- pressed. Z without denticles on post-abdo- men. Color yellow- transparent. Length, Common everywhere among weeds in mar gins of lakes, etc. Host of tbe «p— ""*"■ from the United States are of tbe variety buerralm. Fig 1 117 (126) Post-abdomen with 30-30 marginal denticles. Camptocercus macrurus (0. F. Miiller) 1785. Much like tbe preceding. Very rare, but reported (ram most regions in the United States. Undoubtedly the preceding species has been mistaken for this by some observers. 128(135) Crest on valves only. . Kurziu Dybowski and Grochowski 1804. This genus is Alottepsis (part) of older authors; PieudaioHa Sara, Sole American species Kurzia lotissima (Kurz) 1874. General form aubquadrate; greatly compressed; but with onlv slight crest on back, none on head. Head small, the rostrum reaching not much below middle of valves, though longer than antennules. Post-abdomen long, slender; lower angle usually produced into a lobe; 10-12 marginal denticles. Clawi of Camptoctrctu type. $ like 5 1 rostrum shorter; post- abdomen with small denticles; vaa deferens opens on ventral (upper) aide; strone book on first foot. Color yellowish, transparent. Length, J, 0,6 mm.; £ , 0.4 mm. Found in all regions amonf weeds In pools or lakes. 119 (124, 131) Crest on head and valves; post-abdomen broad, without marginal denticles. . . . Acroferus Baird 1843 . . 130 Body thin, compressed: crest on head and back. Valves subquadrate, obliquely striated; infero postcal angle rounded or acute, usually with teeth. Post-abdomen large, compressed; without marginalden tides but with lateral row of squamae. Claws long, straight, with r basal spineandsecondarydenlicles,muchasin Cwmptvctrcui. Intestine with Urge mtcstinal cecum. Eye larger than oceDua, Color yelsow-tnnaparent. THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 719 130 (131) Dotal mugm much arched. . . . Aaopems harpat Baud 1835. ?. to 0.8 mm . _. .. _ Common everywhere, among wends, in relatively opeu water; not in muddy 131 (130) Dorsal and ventral margins nearly straight. Acropems anguslatus Sais t Crest larger th*n in A. katpar; eye ud ocellus removal from margin and rostrum obtuse. Length. ?, to o.o mm.: $. 0.6 Common in similar situations to preced- log specks. Transition forms between these species may be found and very probably they should be united. 132 (114, iao) No crest 133 133 (134) Valves not tumid; post-abdomen broad. Aiormpsis Sars 1862 . . 133a General form resembling Acropcnu but less oom- pressedandwithoutoeit. Keel of labram moderate or small, almost triangular. Valves obliquely striated but striae often inconspicuous. Post -abdomen long, broad; with well -developed marginal denticles. Sii pairs of feet, the last very small. J with usual characters. Color yellow. cr LWiltk. •330(133*) 15-17 marginal denudes Ahnapsis dongaia Sars 1861. 1336(1330) About 1 1 marginal denticles. . Alonopsti aureola Doolittle ign. No lateral fascicles cr infero-posteal tooth. Length. 9 ca. 1.11 mm.: J unknown. Both weeds. Rare; reported only from Maine. 720 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY >34 ('33) Valves tumid id anterior part; post -abdomen narrow. Euryalona Sara 1901. Sole American species. Euryafona occideidalu Sais 1901. General form n WinK Kicraa, bul compressed; no c ■J-'} I 1*£>5v Vilvesppinc in front, ^v J ?^?JL^ tumid m nifaoantc- ^ __>-:, — '-^SaC "^ ™don: muted "^i---^-^ \. '^g^^V,, obscurely with en 'TpS ^s~ trie Enes; dorsal mar- gin arched. Kcd of tabnun angled behind but not prolonged. j MM. a. ^ Post-abdomen very long, slender, lobed at apex; with about » marginal and vay fine lateral denticles. Fic.hu- gfjufat Ktilrmiiiii Sara. Claws straight, aimed ■bout *s in Campio- urau. Five pairs of Feet; hook on first foot of 9 - S with strong hook; vas deferens opens on upper (ventral) side of post- abdomen about middle. Color dark brown-yellow. Length,?, to Florida, Louisiana, Texas; not uncommon in weedy pools and lakes. '35 ('33) Body not greatly compressed; claws with 1 basal spine, or rarely none 136 For all species with two spine* on terminal claw, see 171 ff. 136 (168) Rostrum not greatly exceeding antennules 137 137 (167) Rostrum pointed. 138 130(150) Infero-posteal angle rounded, without teeth 139 I39(i44.i47) Post-abdomen with marginal and lateral denticles. . . . 140 140 (143) Post-abdomen relatively long and narrow; marginal denticles numerous, longer distally. Basal spine stout and long. Oxyurdla Dybowski and Grochowski 1804 . . 141 In general like Alma. Post-abdomen long, slender; with marginal and lateral denticles, the former numerous and ending in a group of targe den tides at angle of post-abdomen. Termi- nal daw straight, with one large basal spine, attached some way distal to base of daw. Color yellow or yellow-brown. This genus is the same as OdoMlalma Birge. 141(141) u-15 marginal denticles. . . . Oxyurella tenukaudts (Sars) 1863. yaqpraal denticles very small near anus; the distal 4-5 much larger; the penulti- mate largest. Length, y, ca. 0.5 mm.; $ . ou mm. Widdy distributed but not abundant anywhere. New England and Wisconsin to Gulf of Mexico. This spedes is A lana leiuicaudis Sars. »iri. iiuvM ' THE WATER FLEAS (CT.AnOfERA) 731 143 (141) About 16 marginal denticles. . Oxyurdla longkaudis (Birge) toio. Between .Una n.l F manrinal drniirlcs. larger distally; the pe- nultimate much larger, and the ultimate larger still and serrate on concave side. Hiiil spine siniit, attached about one- third way from base of daw. & unknown. Lenn!h.0.o.s-o.6mm. Knthcr rare anion* weeds. Lake Charles, La. Fin. nryvrrlh 1. 143 (140) Post-abdomen not noticeably narrow; distal denticles not conspicu- ously larger. Basal spine small. Alona (most species) ..151 Tike up the key at the number indicated where the genus is discussed as a unit. 144 (139, 147) Post-abdomen with marginal denticles only 145 145(146) Post-abdomenlarge,denticlesv(Tjsmall. Alonttla diaphana . . 236 Turn to the key at the number indicated where (he species named is discussed. 146 (14s) Post-abdomen of moderate size; denticles of usuat size. Alona guttata . , 156 Turn to the key at the number indicated where the species named is discussed. 147 (139, 144) Post-abdomen with numerous clusters of large spines. Leytligia Kurz 1S74 . . 148 General shape oval, much compressed hut not crested. Head small, extended; ked of labrum rhomboidal with ancles blunt or rounded. Pint -abdomen very force compressed, semi -elliptical in form; post-anal [art much expanded, with numerous clusters of spine*; spines in distal clusters very long. Claws lone ,in under the bead. Post-abdomen stout, y ^^ thick, bent at anus, truncate at apex; •\ with about four rather stout ""T^"!!! denticles near apex, and a lateral series, continued nearly to anus, of very fine spinulea in an unbroken row. Intestine with cecum, g (European) with long rostrum, bilobed sit apex; post-abdomen tapering and armed with hairs only; ordi- nary hook on first foot. Color yel low or THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 725 171 (122) Posterior margin of valves considerably less than maximum height. 171 All species °f Pitwfxus belong here; also Alonslla eicita and erigua. 172(204) Body elongated, form not spherical 173 173 (i74, I7S) Lower part of posterior margin excised or crenulated. Alondla excise, A, exigua . . 244,245 Turn to the key at the numbers indicated where two spedes are discussed. 174 (i73, 175) Posterior margin with numerous teeth along whole length. Pkuroxus procurvatus, P. Iruncalus . . 188, 101 Turn to the key at the numbers indicated where two species are discussed. *75 (i73, *74) Teeth (if any) only at infero-posteal angle 176 176(179) Infero-posteal angle well marked, ordinarily with teeth. . . 177 177(178) Rostrum long Pleuroxus moat species . . 186 Take up the key at the number indicated where the genus is discussed as a unit. 178(177) Rostrum short AlontUa detttifera . . J33 Take up the key at the number indicated where the genus is discussed as a unit. N.B. If the rostrum is broad, semi-circular at end, see 167. 179 (176) Infero-posteal angle rounded 180 180 (185) With well-marked tooth or teeth 181 i8r (182) Rostrum long, recurved Pleuroxus striates . . 195 Turn to the key at the number indicated where the spedes named is discussed. 182 (181) Rostrum short Dunhevedia King 1853 . . 183 General shape rounded. Valves tumid, gaping below; obscurely reticulated; infero-posteal angle rounded, with 1 or 1 teeth on ventral margin in front of angle. Post -abdomen bent abruptly behind anus; post-anal part thick, somewhat foot-shaped as seen from side, it* dorsal (lower) margin lying parallel to ventral margin of valves; with many fine denticles and setae. Claws short, curved, with 1 basal spine. J with usual characters; post-abdomen same shape as 9. with fine hairs only. 183 (184) Form short and high, as dorsal margin is much arched. Dunhevedia stligera (Birge) 1877. Keel of labrum produced into a somewhat tongue-like form, its ventral margin smooth. Color yellow. Length, ?, to 0.5 mm.; d", ca. 0.36 mm. New England and Wisconsin to Colorado, Louisiana, andTexas. Not common; nmong weeds. Perhaps identi- cal with D. craiia King. 726 184(183) FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Form more elongated, as dorsal margin is little arched. Dunhevedia serrata Daday 1898. Usually a teeth at infero-posteal angle, a very small posterior and a larger anterior one. Keel of labium serrate in anterior part, smooth be- hind; about 10-12 serrations, pointing backward. £ unknown. Color yel- low. Length, 9 > <*• °*7 mm. Louisiana, Texas; in pools and lakes 1 among weeds; not abundant. Fig. 1 135. Dunhevedia serrata. a, labium; b, post-abdomen. 0.1 MM. 185 (180) Infero-posteal angle without teeth, or tooth very small ; rostrum long or short 186 186 (203) Claws with 2 basal spines. Pleuroxus Baird 1843 187 Rostrum long and pointed, rarely bent forward. Dorsal margin much arched; posterior margin short, usually less than one-half height, rarely toothed along entire length; infero- posteal angle rarely rounded, usually sharp and toothed. Keel of labrum large, usually tongue- shaped; posterior angle prolonged. Post-abdomen with marginal denticles only, o* smaller than 9 » with usual characters; post-abdomen varies in different species. Three types of form are distinguishable in the genus: (1) relatively long and low species: striatus type (P. slriatus, has talus, hamulatus); (2) short, high-arched forms: denticulatus type (P. denticulatus, aduncus, trigoneUus, truncalus); (3) the second form with rostrum bent forward: (P. procurvatus, uncinatus). All species littoral. 187 (190) Rostrum bent up in front 188 188 (189) Rostrum bent sharply into hook; teeth along whole posterior margin of valves Pleuroxus procurvatus Birge 1878. General form and markings like P. denticulatus. Posterior margin of valves with 7-8 teeth along the whole length. Post-abdomen like P. denticulatus but slightly more broad- ened behind anus, d unknown. Color yellowish, transpar- ent or opaque. Length, 9 > <*• °-5 mm- Northern states, common in weedy waters. Fig. i 136. Pleuroxus procurvatus. 02MM.h *4 189 (188) Rostrum merely curved forward; teeth at infero-posteal angle only. Pleuroxus uncinatus Baird 1850. Infero-posteal angle with 2-4 rather long, curved teeth, sometimes branched. Rostrum long, acute, bent forward. Post-abdomen like P. trigoneUus. broad, somewhat tapered toward apex; about 13 good-sized marginal denticles. Color dirty gray, or with green or yellow tinge. Length, 9, 0.7-0.9 mm.; $ (European), 0.56 mm. Nebraska (Fordyce). The species is very close to P. trigoneUus, separated by procurved rostrum and Urge teeth at infero-posteal angle. Fm. XZ37. Plvmosm vmcmaku. European (UMM. TOE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 737 190 (187) Rostrum not bent forward 191 191 (193) Numerous teeth along whole posterior margin. PUuroxus Iruncatus (O. F. Muller) 1785. Posterior margin with numerous (mote than so) dose- set teeth; valves striated, the striae on middle of valvei neatly longitudinal, the others oblique. Post-abdo- men much like P. trigoneUus, slightly tapering toward apej. angle rounded; 13-14 marginal denticles, increas- ing in size distally. Color yellow-brown. Length, 9, ca. 0.6 mm.; if {European), 0.4s nun. Nebraska (Fordyce). 193 (191) Teeth at infero-posteal angle only 193 193 (196) Post-abdomen long, slender, conve* on ventral (upper) side. . 194 *94 (195) Supero-posteal angle sharp but not projecting; infero-posteal angle a sharp point Pkuroxvs hastalus Sars 1862. inded, Pleuroxus striaius Schoedler 1863. General shape much like P. kaslaim but never so high arched aa this may be. Valves obviously striated. Post-abdomen long, slender, with to, or more, marginal denticles. Color dark, especially opaque on dorsal side, often nearly black. Length, J>, ca. 0.8 mm.; d", ca. 0.6 mm. In all parts of United States; common This species is P. pacilit Hudendorf; F. mufflis Dirge. Pic 1140. Plmrami it 728 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY >9* {193) Post -abdomen of moderate length; ventral (upper) margin straight, or nearly so; greatest width behind anus. 197 197 (100) Angle of post-abdomen sharp, with cluster of spines at apex . 108 ) (199) Teeth at infero-posteal angle of valves; no book on first foot of female Pteuraxus dmticulatus Bilge 1877. Infero-posteal angle with small tooth- like spines. Post -abdomen moderately long, straight, very little narrowed toward apex; length of post-ar1 " " truncate; with duster of foe, straight denticles it apex and 8-11 anterior to these. Color greenish or yellowish, usu- ally transparent. Length, 9. o-S-o-* mm.; g , a jh mm. Common everywhere in weedy water. ion (toS) Infero-posteal angle rounded; first foot of female with stout hook, Pleuroxus kamulatus Bilge iqio. Infero-posteal angle rounded, without teeth; valves reticulated; also marked by very fine Striae, which run nearly longitudinally. Rostrum long, recurved. Keel of labrum anal, rounded, prolonged. Post-abdomen much reported from north M» (197) Angle of potrt-abdoosea rounded. UC -A- s rcn . » ** v •— « •« -» -..-..- - % JOT (JO?) -.i*ri»»* •"»' i tor^J^-l - -.: i * ,1 VlAtMAM ,.„}-. « . 1 '*.'.*■''' ' f "'»**-S*-lll J* 11' V M**' ^ v^ •«»..■ ^ t m(f -f ... , small : h »ii»n ...4l. «„.„ , , . Aantinff. i ;».;) ii,^ •. ....;• a- • inn"..:. ; hli! .real • -■■■ i-H'-' \ r..'P ■ ...... fl.r h,ju'i.f! •;- »! * » fi: :: :ci •:-, r?: . ■ «!r . • .. i... ...| >...v. fj !t,. i | |lst|> fJ|^ 1 "-«** J. /! r:-: :ih.f..i.-. n * ki-ii. . »irf.:L ■ 1U:{j .h!||l| p 1>Ie ' " *" ! 'if«! r tr. h ■ iru* »M-i i.n.- ii.- i»|tf-s: r-t!I.IV tl.-l fnwrirt |#»_ '* .ii- . ixiMPii;-. rjcnuur ra. . t*>Hnn ... m. .!••»-• i. •■ ljh!r: - . ji.-rt. ! •• ■ ft. •?..<. .-J ... y •ffM..-* i eemnii /■ it ant.JU.. • miiii'ijt a.; luiJova: v.»v«. «ffi..f«y» . J i.*i.-i-.-:«! • Ktc !•«.!: ::v : -ifhi .it i. th p.«i. Ill—- -■ iriiyr, »hi; J12f r*.! n..,sf_.mal .. -, ijr r.«" r, . - 73° FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY aoS (105) No spine at infero-posteal angle 309 909 (210) Valves with conspicuous projection on an tero ventral margin. Anchislropus Sara 1861. Sole American species Anchislropus minor Birge 189.5. Form globular. Ventral region tumid interiorly and ventral margin of valves beat sharply away from each other about one-third way from front and the valve folded out into a hollow groove and tooth, which contains the strong hook of the first loot. Head large, bulging over eye. the fornices broad and forming a sort of Hup like rostrum, which can be closely pressed to the valves. Post-abdomen broad at base, pnr-anal angle overhanging; rapidly narrow- ing toward apex, which is prolonged into a lobe; a few marginal spines. Claws with long, slender basal spine, denticulate or smooth. First foot of J with strong hook, toothed on concave side, which lies in groove formed by folding of valves. In A. minor, groove for hook of first foot near anterior part of valves; hook not large. Colorbrown- yellow. 5 unknown. Length, ? , ca. 0.35 mm. Maine, Michigan, Wisconsin, Louisiana. Fio. 114G. Amekutnpmi minor. 310(309) No such projection 311 311 (330) Post-abdomen ordinarily short with prominent pre-anal angle. Ckydorus Leach 1843 . . jij Shape spherical or ovate. Posterior angles little marked; infero-posteal angle usually un- armed. Antennules short and thick. Rostrum long and acute. Post-abdomen usually short, broad, rarely long and narrow (C. fltbaiui); apex rounded; with marginal denticles only or (C. ffocora) with very fine lateral fascicles. Claws with s basal spines, the proximal often very minute, rarely absent. £ with short rostrum, thick antennule, book on first foot, post-abdomeL often very narrow. 3ia (313) Post-abdomen, long, narrow, PUwoxus-Wk. Chydorus globosus Baird 1850. Almost spherical; valves smooth or reticulated, 9 striated in front. Post-abdomen with small pre-anal angle; numerous marginal denticles and very fine lateral fascicles. Claws with a basal spines, the distal very long and slender. Color bright yellow to dark brown, usually with dark spot in center of valve. Length, 9. to 0.8 mm.; $ , 0.6 mm. Everywhere; in lakes and ponds, among weeds, but never present in very large numbers. C. nboenu might well be type of a separate genus. The other species fall into j groups: (i) The ipkatrkw group or Ckyttenu proper (C. iphatricus, riWiu, pita. JsAu, matit); {>) The Jauformil group, similar to (1) but with greatly developed curic- urar structures (C. fatiformis, biiarntUui), (3) The barreisi group, with toothed labrum; denticles of post-abdomen shortest in middle of row (C. borreiii. kyoritUu, poppet). THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 731 •13(212) Post -abdomen short, broad; pre-anal angle marked 314 314 (J,S. 3,6> Shell covered with deep polygonal cells. Ckydonu ftmfontit Birge 1893. Much Eke ipkatTKus m form and siae. t unknown. Color yellow to light brownish. Length, 9,o.s-o.6mm- New England, Wisconsin, Michigan, Louist- Fic. ..,!- Ti>A>nu/a^«wi,«t>hca. ai5 (Ji4, *i6) Shell with deep polygonal cells and cuticular ridges. Chyttcrus bkornutui Doolittle 1009. Like forifarmii in having deep polygonal vclopnrat of an extraordinary and complex system of thin cuticular ridges, which extend far beyond the onlinaiy cells. A long been extends laterally from the middle dorsal region of each valve, from which radiate some of the ridges, J unknown. Color yellow. Length, Maine, New Hampshire, and New Jersey. Fig. 1149. OfcasWsH ttorMtati. (Aba Doolkilc.) 216 (214, 215) Shell of ordinary type 217 217(225) Ventral edge of keel of labrum smooth 318 2 rS (219) Antero-dorsal surface of valves and head flattened. Chydonu gibbus Lilljeborg 1880. The curve of the dorsal surface somewhat flattened, both in front and behind, making a sort of bump in tenter of dorsal margin. Valves reticulated. Head small; rostrum projects from valves in way. Post-abdomen with 8-10 margin Color yellowish lo brown. Length, 9,0. Lake Superior. Wisconsin, Michigan; n This specks is C. rutaletut Forbes, 732 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 219 (218) Dorsal surface not flattened; form usually spherical or broadly ovate 320 220 (223, 224) Small forms not exceeding 0.5 mm., usually less. ... 221 221 (222) Fornices gradually narrowing into rostrum. All olfactory setae on end of antennule. Ckydorus spkacricus (0. F. Muller) 1785. 01 MM smooth (var. nilidus Schoedler), punctate (var. punclaius Hdlich), or with elevn. codaius Schoedler). Post-abdomen with 8-9 marginal denticles. Claws small; proximal basal spine very minute. S with post-abdomen much cmarginate. Color light yellow to dart brown. Length, 9,0.3-0.5 mm.; $, 0.1 mm. Small limnetic forms constitute var. minor Lilljeboig. The commonest of all Cladocera; found all over the . Chyienu 1 ft— Hem. 333 (221) Fornices abruptly narrowed into rostrum. Two olfactory setae on side of antennule Ckydorus piger Sara 1862. General form much like C tpkatriau. Ventral margin of valves densely ciliated; valves ordinarily marked by oblique striae, sometimes smooth. Fornices abruptly narrowed at rostrum. Antennule with usual lateral sense seta and two olfactory setae on side. Post-abdomen with *-« rather long marginal denticles. Claws with 2 basal spines, the proximal one minute. 3 -abdomen narrow, but not excavated. Color light to dark yellow. Length, 9, ca. 0.4 Rare; reported only from Maine. A 1.1151. C.kydmu piitr. Entire npedasan and lower ride ol rostrum with anteaniuea, >, 224) Larger forms, to 0.8 mm. Antennules short and thick with all olfactory setae terminal. . . . Ckydorus talus Sars 1862. Much like spkacricui, but target-. Mandible attached some way back of junction of head and valve. Denti dea of post-abdomen 10-11. Claws sometimes with only 1 basal spine. Odor dark yellow brown. Length, 9 . to 0.7-0.8 mm. Rare; Canada, near Lake Erie. Fan. rtjj. Ckydinu Mas. THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 733 224 (220, 233) About 0.5 mm. Antennuk with oik olfactory seta proximal to duster at end. Ckydoms aialis Km* 187*. abdomen with rounded apex; ii-is yellow, transparent. Length, 9, Is d.6 mm.; cT (Europauii. o.< nun. Rue; Nehn.sk*. 225 (217) Ventral edge of keel of labrum with one o e teeth. . . , 236 226 (227, 228) With several teeth ; short spine at infero-posteal angle of valves. Ckydorus barroisi (Richard) 1&04. Form u.ud size much like iptutriau, though ventral margin is less curved. Reel of U- brum ■""■'«■■' behind ; serrate, with four or more teeth. Pe«-*hdoxnen with well-devel- oped pre -una! ingle; I shortest in middle of row. Coior brown-yel- low. Length, 9 , c*. u mm. Rue; Lake Charles, Louisiana. With one tooth; infero posteal spine present. Ckydorus kybridtts Daday 1905. Flo. iij6. Ckyitnu tytriim. 128(236, 227) Witho FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY n labium; no spine on valves. Chydorus poppet Richard 1897. Low l. California; Very probably the last two (pedes should be listed as varieties of barraiii. These species were first placed in Plmronu, but have no very close affinity with either Pltunmu or Ckydorui; might well be made a separate genus. F10. iijj. Ckyianu feffL easily separable. There are 3 sections which nugl (1) AlontMa proper. Rostrum long, slender, abdomen with marginal denticles only; daws with 1 basal spine. (3) Paralmdla. Rostrum si as; not assignable elsewhere and not onstitute separate genera: ■ed; usually conspicuously so; post- ilrala, dodoyi, nules; post-abdomen with abdomen with marginal denticles only: daws with a basal wines, ffcwonu-like. A. 330 (235) Rostrum short; post abdomen with marginal and lateral denticles. 231 (334) Valves with infero-posteal angle toothed 23a 933 (.233) About 3 fine teeth; valves striated. . Alondia karua (King) 1833. General shape like Alma and easily taken for a member of that genus. (See 153.) Valves with oblique striae; infero- posteal angle with 1-4 minute teeth. Post-abdomen broad, expanded behind anus; apei rounded; with about 8 minute marginal denticles and as many lateral fasddes, much larger. Claws with 1 small basal spine. Color yellow, trans- parent. Length, 9,0.45mm; £ (South America), 0.1 1 m ■ ■■ l. Tex, Fie. It S>. AlmlU In THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 735 133 ('$') One to three rather strong teeth, valves reticulated. Alontlla dentifera Sais 1901. Back high arched; infero-posteal angle acute, with 1-3 fairly strong teeth. Rostrum reaches nearly to ventral margin of valves. Post-abdomen targe, broad, somewbat expanded behind anus; apex rounded; with about n minute marginal denticles, and as many very minute lateral Fascicles. Claws with 1 very long basal vine. Color yellow-brown. Length, ? a. 04 mm.; J.ojsmm. Louisiana and Texas; not rare in pools and lakes. Frc r 119. AUmtUa dentiftr*, with oavclooiac rphippium. 334(331) No infero-posteal teeth; form rotund. Alondla gtobutosa Daday 189S. Small; shape oval-rotund; head reaching about to middle of valves. Valves striated; all margins rounded and without teeth. Post-abdomen long, narrow; broadest near anus: about a minute marginal denticles and as many slender lateral fasdcles. Keel of labnim with 3 notches. Color yellow -brown. Length, 9 • Lake Charles, Louisiana, among ■ This species is A. ictdpta Sara. *3S (a3°) Post-abdomen with marginal denticles only. 33,6 (237) Denticles minute; post-abdomen large, bent behind anus; no in- fero-posteal tooth on valves. Alondla diaphana (King) 1853. Head short, rostrum not reach- ing more than two-thirds distance toward ventral margin. Valves striated, sometimes passing into slightly enlarged behind anus; with den tides and no other spines. Claws Long; i basal spine. Length, Re. nii. Jl— all ■aaahsna, 736 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 337(336) Denticles of ordinary size; infero-posteal tooth present. . . 238 338 (143) Claws with one basal spine. 239 339 (341) Rostrum long, recurved. 240 340 (341) Shape elongated oval; valves striated. AloneUa rostrate (Koch) 1841. Genera! form Dot unlike s Fleuroxus of the itriatus type. Valves Striated or reticulated; infero-posleal angle rounded and with minute tooth, sometimes «t> scot. Rostrum long, slender, recurved. Post-ab- domen moderately long, somewhat tapering toward apex; angle rounded; o-u small marginal denticles. Claws with 1 minute basal spine. Color yellow or brown, usually rather dark. Length, J. ca. 0.5 mm.; Rather rare; reported from New England, Michi- gan, Wisconsin. Minnesota; probably to be found In all regions. This species is Plewoxiu 341 (340) Shape short oval; valves strongly reticulated. AloneUa dadayi Birge 1910. Shape oval-rotund. Valves strongly reticulated all over; infero-posteal angle rounded, with sev- eral minute teeth. Rostrum long, pointed, re- curved. Keel of labrum acuminate behind and its margin with 1 projection. Post-abdomen short, wide; pre-anal angle strongly marked, as in Cliydottu; with numerous small denticles; apes rounded. Claws with 1 basal spine. Color yellow to brown, often opaque. Length, 9> 0.15-0.3 mm.; S (South America), 0.1 mm. Louisiana, Texas; pot rare in weedy pools. This species is Lrplorkynchus denlifer Daday, whose specific name has to be changed on remov- ing to A laneBa, as San' species A . dtniifera pre- occupies the name. Fto. n6j. AlentOn iadoyi. 343 (139) Rostrum short or moderate; shape globose; valves conspicuously striated AloneUa nana (Baird) 1850. Rostrum varies, usually rather long, recurved, consider- ably exceeding antennules. Post-abdomen abort; pre- anal angle strongly projecting; apex rounded; about 6 marginal denticles. Claws with 1 small spine. Color brownish, usually Opaque. Length, O, 0.3-0.38 mm.; Pie. "64. Altutlkm THE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCEKA) 737 *43 (338) Claws with 1 basal spines; posterior margin of valves excised near inf ero-posteal angle 244 244 (245) Post-abdomen fairly long; angled at apex; valves reticulated and with fine striae AlontDa rxcisa (Fischer) 1854- General appearance Pttm- reuu-Iike. Roetrum moder- longed as in A. nitrate nor recurved: longer in southern apex angled; with about o- 10 siudl m.r^n.l denticles. Color yellow to brown. Length. ° ■ to 0.5 mm.; $ , Not uncornroan in all lo- 245 (244) Post-abdomen short; rounded at apex; valves without fine striae. Alondia txigua (Lilljeborg) 1853. Length. 9.O.; Maine, Wiao Modi Eke preceding species but smaller. About 6-8 small margina] denticles- Color yellow, not * " .m.; o" , 0.28 nun. FW-IlSe. jUiwaHnrifa. OJ MM. 1 ■ » 346 (121) Eye and ocellus very large; antennules project far beyond rostrum. Dadaya Sars 1001. Sole species. Dadaya macrops (Daday) 1808. Form rounded-ova] ; not compressed. Head small, much depressed; tumid above eye; ros- trum short and broad. Antennules long, mod- erately stout, projecting far beyond rostrum. Post-abdomen of moderate size, compressed. somewhat broadened behind anus, sHghtiy narrowing toward apex; angle rounded; about 14-18 marginal denticles. Claws small, one small basal spine. Eye very large, with few lenses; ocellus nearly as large, crowded down into rostrum. X unknown. Color dark brown. Length, ?, ca. o.j mm. A single specimen of this species was found in a collection from a weedy pool at Smith- viHe. Texas. Fro. it6;. Dmdty mairaf- 738 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 347 (la°) No eve; ocellus only Momspilus Sars 1861. Sole species MonospUus dispar Sars 1S61. Form oval or round. Shell not cast in molting, as in Ilyocryptiu. Valves nearly round with fine setae along ventral edge. Head very small, depressed, movable- Keel of labrum with about a scallops on ventral edge. Post-abdomen broad, short, with about 5-7 marginal denticles and numerous clusters of fine hairs. Eye lack- ing; ocellus large. Antennules short, not reaching apex of rostrum, j with hook on first foot; post-abdomen tapering, triangular, somewhat resembling that of Grap- lotebtris. Color brown-yellow. Length, $ , ca. 0.5 nun.; o*,ca. 0.4 mm. New England, Wisconsin, Minnesota; rare. FlO.1168. IftHUaHlui ditfa. 348 (1) Body and feet not covered by shell. Feet subcylindrical or flattened, jointed, prehensile. . . . Section B. Gymnomexa . . 349 No foraices. Rami of antennae 3- to 4- jointed. Feet, 4 to 6 pairs, Jointed, prehensile. 249 (350) Four pairs of feet, stout, compressed, with claw-like spines and branchial appendages. Tribe I. Onychopoda. Sole family Polyphemtdae Baud. Body rery short. Shell converted into large globular brood-sac. Caudal process long, ■lender, with 9 long caudal stylets or setae. Rami of antennae with 3 and ^ joints. Eye very large; no ocellus. Labium large. Two small hepatic ceca. One genus Polyphemus 0. F. Mfiller 1785. Sole species. Polyphemus pediculus (Linnf) 1761. v\^, A 1 \ jt Brood-sac globular, with \\\ \\W . 4aUkV ..... , _.. face of head. Head large, filled in front by huge movable eye. Antennae FTiL. ^-*rZ^Zx&=, with 7 setae on each ramus. Feet stout, with strong daws, and branchial ap- pendage; fourth pair, very small. Length, J, meai- • v\\ /MY J^>Cj — -Jf-i ured *° b"* o( brood-sac, ^^yJS&X. /BJ i -A/ to i.j mm.; $. 0.8 mm. Common in northern United States in lakes, pools, and marshes. PoiyfitmmfMe- TOE WATER FLEAS (CLADOCERA) 730 sgo (249) Six pairs of feet, cylindrical, first pair very tons; without branchial appendages- '. Tribe 11. ITaalnantl. Sole family Leptodoudaf. Liujcboq;. Head ekmaated, slender; eyr fillhw interior end. Body 4-joinmi, the firm pan bearisf t)* 0 fact mid A™J brood-nc; tbc .(-jointed ibckna ends in > shall «tylr«i or rbin. Anted vable. Autaiiur with vrty Utrt hmal joint; rum *-}ointed, with unmet- s long, slender, pointed, with ^ spines near um. Ksnrihasw wry kmav _ ._. y «Ht h vwy long sntennuk*. The yuan* from winter Sole genus with characters of family Ltptodora Lilljebotg. Sole species. Ltptodora kimdtii (Fockc) 1S44. This beautiful, tnuispsrenl enxtun U the hrRsst of the CtadoOETa, thr 0 reaching a ln*th of ,s mm. kapaooos. tSoujrti its west mandibles prevent il from brine formidable to the 11 ' _~ TCtraca; nocturnal in coming to the surface- is northern United State*; not rare. Flo. 1170. UfltitrtM IMPORTANT REFERENCES ON NORTH AMERICAN H-ADOOKRA. Bibge, E. A. 1891. Notes on Cladoccra II. List of Cladoccra from Madi- son, Wis. Trans. Wis. Acad., 8: 379-.J08; > !>!• 1893. Notes on Cladoccra III. Descriptions of new and rare «|wim. Trans. Wis. Acad., 9: 375-317; 1 pi. 1910. Notes on Cladoccra IV. Description*, of New and Rare Spectra Chiefly Southern. Trans. Wis. Acad., 16: 1018-1066; 5 pi. Hekkick, C. L. 1895. Synopsis of the EntomostracA of Minnesota. Second Report of State Zoologist; 337 pp., 81 pi. Contain* much information and many flcurea original ami from vsrlmii soure* m«— '*' is not very carefully or critically handled. 74© FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Keilhack, L. 1910. PhyUopoda. In Brauer's Slisswasserfauna Deutsch- lands, pt. 10; 112 pp., 265 text figs. An admirable account of the Cladocera of Germany, most of which are found in this country also. It should be the first book procured by any one who can read German. Lilljeborg, W. 1900. Cladocera Sueciae. Upsala. 701 pp., 87 pi. Latin keys and diagnoses; otherwise German. Indispensable for a critical study of the group. Richard, J. 1894. Revision des Cladoc&res. Part I. Sididae. Ann. Sci. Nat., Zool., (7) 18: 270-389, 2 pi. 1896. Part II. Daphnidae. Ann. Sci. Nat., Zool. (8) 2: 187-363; 6 pi. Invaluable for the families which they cover. Sars, G. O. i 00 i. Contributions to the Knowledge of the Freshwater Ento- mostraca of South America. Part I. Cladocera. Arch. Math. Nat. Kristiana, Bd. 23, no. 3, 102 pp., 12 pi. Necessary for the study of southern cladocera, but not needed for the northern states. Note. — All illustrations for this chapter have been drawn especially for it, and all are made from the actual specimens, except in a few cases, which are indicated. -4 . -ji*. CHAPTER XXm COPEPODA By C. DWIGHT MARSH United States Department of Agriadtun Op all animals encountered in fresh water, perhaps none are more likely to arouse interest than the Copepoda. While many of them are large enough to be seen and watched with the naked eye, yet they are so small that a microscope is needed to get a clear understanding of their form and structure. In company with the Cladocera, they are almost universally distributed, and can be collected in nearly any body of water. Unlike the Cladocera, which show many erratic and bizarre species, the Copepoda are graceful and symmetrical in their forms, with a beauty of structure that is very attractive to the amateur student. Some are wonder- fully transparent, while others are strikingly and in some cases gorgeously colored. Copepoda have been studied ever since the microscope was first used. It is said that the first mention of these animals was made by Stephen Blankaart in 1688. O. F. Miiller in 1785 is credited with having given the first scientific description of this group. In 1820 Jurine published his famous "Histoire des monocles qui se trouve aux environs de GenSve." Some of the species which he described are still recognized as valid, largely, however, by the courtesy of succeeding writers; for Jurine made his distinctions on insufficient grounds like color, and it is only through his figures that one can conjecture what species he had in hand. No really serious study of this group was made until the middle of the nine- teenth century, when the publication of Baird's " Natural History of the British Entomostraca,, in 1850 and the various papers of Claus a few years later were the beginning of exact work on these forms. The work of Claus was of first importance. In North America articles were published regarding some forms in the early part of the century, but nothing recognizable appeared until S. A. 741 742 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Forbes commenced his series of papers. Although these papers were not extensive, they were exact and carefully worked out, and to Forbes may be given the credit of laying the foundation for all subsequent work in this country. Though attractive in form, the Copepoda are complex in their structure, and accurate classification can only be attained by care- ful and laborious dissection, so that study of the order has been neglected. With the exception of the Harpacticidae, all the free-swimming Copepoda are characterized by a distinct division of the body into cephalothorax and abdomen, the former being composed of five or six segments and the latter of from three to five. The appendages are as follows, commencing with the front of the animal: First pair ol antctmie. Second pair ul antennae M untitles. First m Second rniiAill.u-. • Millipedes. : pair of Mrfntming feet. Second pair of shimming feet. Third pair of nmiim feet. Fourth psirof swimming feet Fifth feet. Furcal rami. ic figure of * fault COPEPODA 743 All of these appendages are built on the same plan, which is typically represented in the swimming feet of Cyclops (Fig. 1221). Each foot consists of two basal segments, and attached to the outer or distal of these are two branches or rami, each of three segments. The outer ramus is known as the exopodite and the inner as the endopodite. This typical plan may be very much modified but, in most cases the fundamental structure can be recognized. Of these appendages, the first antennae are very characteristic. They are so modified that one of the rami has entirely disappeared, and the one remaining is made up of a considerable number of segments, varying from six to twenty-five. In the same species the number of segments in the antennae is ordinarily invariable. In some of the species of Cyclops the antennae are very short, in others they may exceed the length of the cephalothorax, while in the other genera they may equal or exceed the length of the whole body. The segments of the antennae are armed with hairs which are definite in number and location. They have also sensory structures arranged in definite places on the segments. The club- shaped sensory appendage of the twelfth antennal segment of some of the species of Cyclops is one of the important means of identification. Some of the species of Cyclops have circlets or crowns of spines on certain antennal segments which give them a peculiarly ornate appearance. In some of the species of Cyclops there is a thin hyaline lamella extending longitudinally along cer- tain of the segments, being especially marked on the last two. This is particularly noticeable in Cyclops fuscus (Fig. 1223). In the Cydopidae the antennae are symmetrical and, in the male, are modified to form grasping organs. In the Centropagidae it is only the right antenna of the male that is so modified. In many of the species of Diaptomus the antepenultimate seg- ment of the right antenna of the male has a distinctive form. This may be a hyaline lamella extending the length of the segment, or it may be an extension of one side of the segment in a process which varies from a blunt projection to a hook or, in some cases, a long, slender digitiform extension. The armature of this segment is constant and is one of the important characteristics used in distinguishing species. 744 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The fifth feet in Cyclops are very rudimentary structures. . In Diaptomus the fifth feet take on interesting forms. In the female they are symmetrical, but not so well developed as the preceding swimming feet. But in the male, the right fifth foot differs from the left, and is modified so as to make a grasping orgafl. The figures in the synoptical key show the form of these appendages. The modifications are constant in a given species, so that the fifth feet in this genus furnish the most important means of specific identification. In Epischura the fifth feet are modified more profoundly, and this modification is accompanied by a peculiar development of the segments of the abdomen, which also serves as a grasping organ. , -i- Fio ii7j. NuipUuioiCreb^ fourth pair of appcndagei in KnudEiriKOKUe. (After In their growth from the egg up, the Copepoda pass through a complicated series of forms. On issuing from the egg the young animal is a flat, oval creature, without any division of the body into cephalothorax and abdomen, and with only three pairs of appendages, the first three of the mature animal, namely, the first and second antennae and the mandibles. These are all used, in this, stage of the animal, as swimming organs. This is known as the nauplius stage (Fig. 1172). A series of molts follows. In the COPEPODA 745 second stage (Fig. 1173^ a fourth pair of appendages is added, which later are known as the maxillae. In a later stage three more pairs of appendages are added, — the maxillipedes, and the first two pairs of swimming feet: this is known as the mctanauplius stage. The following stage is the first Cyclops stage; in this there is a dis- tinct division of the body into cephalothorax and abdomen, and the third and fourth swimming feet are present in a rudimentary form. In this stage, too, the anterior appendages have developed into forms more similar to those in the mature animal. The process of development is thus accompanied by a continued increase in the number of appendages beginning at the anterior extremity, in the number of segments of the cephalothorax and abdomen, and in the complexity of the appendages, until the mature forms are reached. Some of the parasitic forms do not pass through all these stages. There are some that never acquire the third and fourth swimming feet; in others, by a progress of regression, the lirst and second feet may disappear. Some parasitic forms jump the whole series of nauplius stages and almost immediately after leaving the egg appear in the first Cyclops stage. Hardly any body of water is without its copepod inhabitants, although running waters have a less abundant population than lakes. Frequently standing pools swarm with the individuals of one or a few species of this order. Temporary pools in the spring, which are formed in the same place in successive years, will some- times be almost literally filled with Copepoda, which are strictly seasonal in their life habits; for, as the pools disappear, the cope- pods disappear, their eggs sink in the mud of the bottom, and remain until the waters of the next season bring about favorable conditions for their generation. The lakes produce an exceedingly abundant copepod fauna, which has an important practical interest, for the ultimate food of fish is composed almost entirely of these organisms; that is, the small fish of our most abundant species feed entirely upon Ento- mostraca, of which Copepoda form the greater part, and, in many cases, the mature fish also feed entirely on these same minute creatures. 746 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Similar conditions prevail in the ocean, where Copepoda form an essential part of the plankton, which there, too, is an important element in the food, not only of fishes, but of some of the great ocean mammals. Our fresh-water Copepoda are descendants of salt-water forms, and the elucidation of the lines of descent forms a most interesting problem, towards the solution of which very little has been done. The distribution of the Copepoda in our lakes is a matter of great interest. Certain species are characteristic of distinct regions of the lakes. For example, Cyclops bicuspidatus, Diaptomus sicilis, Diaptomus minutus, and Diaptomus ashlandi are characteristic of the limnetic regions of the Great Lakes. Cyclops prasinus is espe- cially characteristic of limnetic regions, Cyclops albidus and Cyclops fuscus are more commonly littoral, while Cyclops tricolor and Cyclops phaleratus are more usually found in pools. Others, especially at certain seasons, may be found only in the deeper waters, or are "abyssal" in habitat. This is true of Limnocalanus macrurus, which is rarely found at the surface in the summer season, but almost entirely in the region below the thermocline. Generally speaking, the Diaptomi in lakes are characteristic of the limnetic regions, but it does not follow that all Diaptomi are limnetic; for there are many species that confine themselves strictly to the extremely shallow waters of pools, like Diaptomus sanguineus, which occurs widely through the temperate regions in the temporary pools of spring. It should not be inferred, however, that these distinctions between littoral, limnetic, abyssal, etc., are absolute. In many cases, species commonly littoral may adapt themselves to a limnetic habitat, or those commonly found in limnetic regions may become littoral, and flourish in those regions, thus forming part of what is sometimes known as the tycholimnetic or tycholittoral fauna. Cyclops bicuspidatus, for example, while ordinarily limnetic, may become a part of the littoral fauna. In other cases, species like Diaptomus oregonensis and Diaptomus minutus may seem to live equally well in deep or shallow waters. Deep lakes and shallow lakes have their characteristic copepod faunas, but this distinction does not always hold rigidly; for frequently the species show a great deal of elasticity in adapting themselves to changed conditions. COPEPODA 747 "There is a marked difference in form and structure between the Copepoda living in the open water and those that are limnetic in their habit. Those that live among the weeds alongshore, or in pods, axe relatively short and stout, and frequently deeply colored. A food example of this is Cyclops ater, which has received its name because of its dark color. It is to be presumed that Cyclops viridis also received its name from its color, for man}* of these shore forms show a distinctly green coloration. These colors, doubtless, are pro- tective, for, because of them, the animals are almost invisible when stationary upon a background of bottom mud or of the stems of aquatic plants. The limnetic species have long and slender bodies, Limnoca- lanus macrurus being an especial!}* good type. Some species of Cyclops live either as limnetic or as littoral inhabitants; in these cases one finds the same differences in form, the littoral variety being short and stout, and the limnetic long and slender. This is especially well shown in the varieties of Cyclops viridis and Cyclops serrulatus. The figures in the systematic discussion of these species show these differences which are especially well marked in the furcal rami (Figs. 12 14, 12 15). The littoral species have short and stout furcal rami, whereas in the limnetic species these structures are long and slender. The limnetic species are ordinarily colorless, their transparent bodies making beautiful objects for examination under low magnifying powers; for much of the internal anatomy of the animal can be observed, while the animal is still alive: the movements of the alimentary canal can be followed, and the beat- ings of the heart observed. This lack of color is doubtless an adaptation to the environment, for in open waters colorless animals are much less conspicuous. Occasionally the Copepoda are of a marked red color. This is sometimes due to oil globules, and is especially marked in some of the species appearing in the early spring, or living in the cold waters of lakes at great altitudes. In other cases, and this is markedly true of some of the Diaptomi, the integument may be deeply colored in reds, blues, and purples. Diaptomus slwshonc, a large species found in the mountain regions of the West, is an espe- cially good example of a highly colored copepod. 74& FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY As already noted, certain species appear in temporary pook only in the spring season. In those that occur in lakes, there is some- times a pronounced seasonal distribution. For example, in Green Lake, Wis., on which extended studies have been made, Diapiowtus sicUis is common in the winter, but rarely found in the summer, while most forms, as would be expected from the favorable food conditions, are more abundant in the summer months. Excepting the few winter forms, the maximum numbers of any species occur in the months from May to September or early November. Sometimes there are two maxima, one in the spring and one in the fall. Generally speaking, the maximum develop- ment occurs when the waters reach their highest temperature, but other factors may modify the time. Generally speaking, also, the maximum development in numbers is somewhat later in deep lakes than that in shallow lakes, corresponding to the general law for the development of the total plankton. The great controlling factor in the distribution of the Copepoda is, without doubt, temperature. That Diaptomus sicUis should be found in Green Lake only in the winter is a matter of temperature, for it is found in the cold waters of the Great Lakes throughout the summer. Limnocalanus macrurus, which, in small, deep lakes, is found during the summer only below the thermocline, comes to the surface in the winter months when the surface water is colder. In Wisconsin, Cyclops bicuspidatus is a common limnetic species in the deeper lakes, but is rarely found in the shallower lakes except in the winter season. It is evident that it prefers the colder waters. On the other hand, Epischura lacustris and Diaptomus oregonensis are distinctly summer forms, disappearing, for the most part, in the winter months. Partial studies have been made which have disclosed some very interesting facts in regard to the vertical distribution of Copepoda in our lakes. In general it may be said that most of these forms are confined to the upper waters, above the thermocline, some having very distinct vertical migrations, caused by changing con- ditions of light and temperature. It has long been known that not only are the open waters of our lakes peopled with myriads of these minute creatures, which can readily be collected by a tow- COPEPODA 749 net dragged behind a boat, but that collections made in the night were much more successful than those in the daytime. It was at first inferred from these collections that the animals shunned the light, and sank beneath the surface during the day, to rise again at night. Careful studies of the subject, however, show that the migration of these animals is by no means so simple a matter as had been thought, and that very complex forces are at work con- trolling their movements. While some of them are sensitive to the influence of light, it appears that temperature is much the stronger factor, and that, generally speaking, they move up or down as the result of changes of temperature rather than because they seek or avoid the light. This, without doubt, explains the fact that Limnocalanus remains in the deeper waters in the summer and gradually rises higher as the waters cool off in the fall. On the other hand, Cyclops prasinus has a marked preference for warmer waters. During the summer it is found in the upper ;layers of water, but in the winter it is inclined to avoid the imme- diate surface and seek the deeper and warmer waters. Epischura lacustris is a very interesting species in its vertical distribution; for it is large and a strong swimmer, and changes its location from hour to hour during the day. It likes warm water, but dislikes the light, and its vertical migrations both daily and seasonal are the resultant of these two forces, so that its move- ments sometimes seem quite erratic. It is a curious fact that the Copepoda differ in the character of the habitat they like best at different times of their lives. Most of the larval forms are found close to the surface in the daytime, while the maturer animals are found at a greater or less depth. It seems probable that the movements of the nauplii and larval Copepoda are caused by comparatively slight changes of tempera- ture, and that a somewhat elaborate determination of the changes of temperature in the upper layers of water may explain their movements, which now seem rather strange. Through the study of the geographical distribution one may hope ito get some knowledge of the evolution of the species and genera of the Copepoda, and it is on this account that this phase of the study of any group of animals is especially interesting to 750 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY the zoologist. Many of the species of the Cyclopidae are almost if not quite cosmopolitan in their distribution; for example, Cyclops leuckarti not only occurs all over North America, but in Europe, Asia, and Africa, and without any variations that are character- istic of the different regions. It seems very remarkable that an animal as delicately organized as Cyclops should not show the effect of change of location in its structure. Most of the recog- nized American species of Cyclops are identical with those found in other continents; and it is even possible that, when the genus is known more thoroughly than at present, many of the species which are now considered peculiar to our continent may be found to be either identical with foreign species or at most only varia- tions of those forms. So our common species of Litnnocalanus, L. macrurus, is identical with the European form. On the other hand, not only the species but the genera of Osphranticum and Epischura are peculiar to North America. The genera of the Harpacticidae have never been thoroughly worked over, and, while some of our species are undoubtedly European, it seems probable, from what we now know, that many of them are peculiar to this continent. Eurytemora is world-wide in its distribution. Of the Diaptomi there are now recognized thirty-nine species in North America, and all of these are peculiar to this continent. Not only are they peculiar to the continent, but many are peculiar to certain regions. In a broad way, they illustrate very forcibly what has been said before, — that Copepoda are controlled in their distribution by temperature conditions. This can well be illus- trated by a brief discussion of the geographical distribution of the more common species. Diaptotnus minulus is found from Green- land and Iceland south to the northern tier of states in the United States, but does not occur south of 420 to 430 N. L. Diaptotnus sicilis is confined to the northern tier of states. Diaptotnus sici- loides is found in a band farther to the south, being limited roughly to the region between the thirty-sixth and forty-third parallels. These three species are closely related to each other in structure, and presumably are of the same line of descent. It will be seen that their distribution, taken in a broad way, is one of latitude. A similar relation exists between Diaptotnus oregonensis, Diapto- . ■:.'* . COPEPODA 751 mus ndssissippiensis, and Diaptomus paUidus. Diaptomus orego- nensis is the more northern species. It is found from one side of the continent to the other, as far north as the Saskatchewan region, and as far south as Illinois and Indiana. Diaptomus paUidus is a Mississippi Valley species, having been found from Minnesota to Louisiana, and as far west as Colorado. Diaptomus mississippiensis is a strictly southern species, being confined, so far as known, to the Gulf States. It is evident that this distribution again is con- trolled by temperature conditions. The group which centers around Diaptomus atbuquerquensis is confined to the south, the most southern species being limited to the island of Cuba. The group centering about Diaptomus signi- cauda is confined to the mountain regions of the West, where a number of rather closely related species have been developed. Probably the greatest number of species is found in this mountain region of the West, where the lakes are separated from each other, and isolation has led to the development of new species. It will thus be seen that the one great controlling factor in the distribu- tion of the Diaptomi is temperature. It may perhaps be assumed that most of our North American species are descended from the same ancestors as those of the other continents; that as the result of the glacial period the north- ern forms were forced far to the south; and that, on the retreat of the ice, some followed after the ice, while others remained behind, but changed their form as the result of the changed environment. Thus the more primitive forms would be found to the north. In the south we would find specialized forms due to the various fac- tors which have come into play in the evolution of these animals. It is a peculiar fact that in this change of conditions the Cyclo- pidae should have succeeded in adapting themselves without change of structure, while the Diaptomi all suffered changes. The differ- ence in the behavior of these two families is a matter that is not at all understood, but it seems possible that the Cyclopidae have more efficient means of distribution, so that the development of new species from isolation would not be as probable as in the case of the Diaptomi. As a matter of fact, very little is known of the life histories of these animals. 752 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Mention has been made of the fact that new species may arise because of isolation. But the question arises, how do the ancestors of any form first reach a given body of water? By what means are these animals distributed from one place to another? Certain species occur in bodies of water from one side of the continent to the other; in some cases the same forms are found even in widely separated continents. How have they reached these places? Eggs are formed which fall into the mud of the floor of the lakes and pools and retain their vitality, sometimes from one season to another, even if the bodies of water disappear and the mud becomes dry. Many species have been seen for the first time by rearing them from eggs found in dried mud. It is natural to infer from this that anything that would move the mud would also move the eggs of the animals. Dried mud, in the form of dust, may be widely disseminated, and thus the eggs might be carried to very distant places. Water birds, too, carry mud on their feet from one body of water to another, and in this way may easily transport the eggs of Copepoda and possibly the living animals. Inasmuch as these birds sometimes make long flights, it is clear that the species of Copepoda may be planted in places far apart. There is no doubt that in both these ways the distribution of the Copepoda has been effected, but these are not the principal ways. It seems evident, for many reasons, that they go from one place to another mainly by direct water carriage. For example, Diaptomus sici- loides has been found in only one lake in Wisconsin. If it were readily carried by birds, one would expect to find it in other bodies of water which seem to have the same kind of an environment. On the other hand, in Lake St. Clair, although it is a very shallow body of water, occur the Copepoda that are characteristic of the deeper waters of the Great Lakes. In this case there seems to be no doubt that these deep-lake forms have been carried into an en- vironment where one would not expect to find them. It is notice- able that in connecting bodies of water we find the same forms of Copepoda. Irrigating ditches and ponds are almost entirely with- out Copepoda. They are peculiarly unprofitable collecting places although the environment would seem to be favorable for the propa- gation of these forms. For some reason, it is evident that the .J!Jtri W *1 «wngfe ars- mat pfim&sf rihm». IE tie esgs of Cocroeda w*» cfis- omnmiQsd m> any . menLH at right antenna 01 male- feet of suae. X 110. {Original.) 768 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 53 (49) Terminal segment of right exopodite of male fifth feet of usual length, lateral spine terminal. ...... 54 54 (55) Inner surf ace of left endopodite of male fifth foot rugose, terminal spines of endopodites of female fifth f eer) very long. % Diaptomus stagnalis Forbes 1882. A very large species found in the Mississippi Valley in the spring. Length of female, 4 to 4.5 mm. Length of male, 3.5 to 4 mm. Fig. x 199- Diaptomtu slognalis. A. fifth foot of female. (After Forbes.) B, fifth feet of male. (After Herrick and Turner.) 55 (54) In male, segments of right fifth foot short and broad, terminal hook long and strongly curved, lateral spine long and straight; in female, dorsal process on fifth cephalothoracic segment, endopodites of fifth feet short and one-segmented. Diaptomus saltUlinus Brewer 1898. Found in Nebraska. Length of female, 1.5 mm. Length of male, 1.25 mm. • s lal segment female. (OrigiaaL) id COPEPODA 769 $6 (48, 6$) Right endopodite of fifth foot of male distinctly longer than first segment of ezopodite. $7 57 (60) Second segment of right csopodite of male fifth foot has oblique ridge on posterior surface. 58 58 (59) First segment of right ezopodite of male fifth foot has transverse ridge on the posterior surface. Diaptomus asymmdricus Marsh 1907. B Fig. x2oi. male. X 103 (Original.) asymmdricus. A. fifth feet of B, abdomen of female. X 79- In the male spine of the about one-half meat; the first abdomen has a the right side. Length of Length of fifth foot the lateral terminal segment is as long as the sec- segment of the female prominent swelling on Found in Cuba, female, 1.30 mm. male, 1.16 mm. 59 (58) First segment of right ezopodite of male fifth foot has two curved processes on posterior surface. Diaptomus darsalis Marsh 1907. In the male fifth foot the lateral spine of the terminal segment equals or exceeds in length the segment; the fifth cephalothoracic segment of the female is armed with two dorsal processes. Found in Louisiana and Florida and probably in other states bordering on the Gulf of Mexico. Length of female, 1.13 mm. Length of male, 1.069 mm. FlC 1*02. Diapicmmt darsalis. A. fifth feet of B, profile dorsal surface of cephalothorax of (Original.) XI45- X3S. FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 60 (57) Second segment of right exopodite of fifth foot of male does not have oblique ridge on posterior surface 61 Lateral spine of terminal segment of right exopodite of male fifth foot terminal, endopodites distinctly two-segmented. Diapiomus bakeri Marsh 1907. In the female fifth foot the eropodiles are distinctly three-segmented, the endopoditem distinctly tvo-segmented. Found in Caii- Length of female, i.aj mm. Length of nude, 1.114 mm. Xi9J- {Ori«in»10 Lateral spine of terminal segment of right exopodite of male fifth foot situated on distal third of segment, right endopodite indistinctly two-segmented, left one-segmented. Diaptomus ■washinglonensis Marsh 1907. on the right posterior Waalnngtoa. Length of female. s or only slightly «- 64 64 (65) Terminal segment of right exopodite of male fifth foot has oblique ridge on posterior surface, lateral spine exceeds segment in length Diaptomus albtufttcrquauu Henick 1895. The fiftli cephaltfthondc segment of the female . feet in commonly two-segmented. Found in 1 Mexico and Colo.*do. As the name indt- s. this farm in originally described by Her . from material collected in Aiboquerqw. X. it. 1 lonud, however, from Cokmdo to the City of MericD, and seems to be a typical form of the 65 (64) Terminal segment of right exopodite of nude fifth foot does not have oblique ridge on posterior surface; lateral spine short, ibout one-half length of segment. Diaptomus motamtexkaiuu Herrick 1895. 66 (47) Terminal processes of left exopodite of fifth feet of male digit* form, right endopodite shorter than first segment of exopo- dite, 67 772 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 67 (70) First segment of exopodite of male fifth foot without hyaline appendage. . 68 68 (69) Right endppodite of male fifth foot triangular in form, first ab- dominal segment of female has digitiform process on right posterior border Diaptomus nudus Marsh 1904. Found in lakes near Pike's Peak, Colorado. Length of female, 1.13a mm. Length of male, 1.115 mm- Fio. iao7. Diaptomus nudus. A, fifth feet of male. X 105. B, abdomen of female. X 105. (Original.) 69 (68) In male fifth foot, second basal segment with hyaline appendage on inner margin, first segment of right exopodite with trans- verse ridge, second segment with oblique ridge and hyaline process near the outer margin. Diaptomus purpureas Marsh 1907. f -1 Found in Cuba. This is a conspicuous species, both on account of the large size and the purple color of the f urcae, f ureal setae, and distal ends of the antennae. Length of female, 2.56 mm. Length of male, a. 34 mm. Fig. I3o8. Fifth feet of male Diaptomus pur p* reus. X 76. (Original.) COFETODA 773 70(67) Flat af right rwipoditr of Bait fifth fee* has hymtme 71 71 (72) Hyaline appendage of first segment of exopodite of mak fifth foot distal angk, endopodite of right foot about equal* of exopodite. Diaptomus signicamda Lilljeborg 1SS0, at first A, ftuQOOBB of female. X 118. B, fifth feet of mak. XX74- (Qngmmlj The first segment of the abdomen of the female has a dtetftona proem on the right posterior border. Found in mountain regions of western United States. It represents a group of species that are found in the mountain regions of the western part of the United States. The peculiar appendage of the first ment of the female abdomen has given the name to the species, and is charac- teristic of the groups CoUections in the Rocky Mountains and farther Kkery to contain this or allied species. Length of female, 0.04 mm. Length of mak. 0.0 mm. 72 (71) Hyaline appendage of first segment of exopodite of male fifth foot on inner distal half, endopodite of right fifth foot much shorter than first segment of exopodite. Diapiomus sictioides Lilljeborg 1880, Found in the Mississippi Valley and west to California. At D. -,^ emsis is typical of the Northern States, so D. siciMdes may be considered as typical of a region a little farther to the south. It has been found from Long Island on the east to the Rocky Mountains on the west, and. while not the exclusive form, is more apt to be seen than any other, especially along the Ohio River. Length of female, 1.06 to 1.225 mm. Length of male, 1.01 to 1.1x25 bb. ol mak DSm -jftfwato COrigmsU). '^XMtw.' X' xn» ■ \j . > «. .. 73 (3t 8) : - findopodites of first swimming feet composed of three segments. 74 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Endopodites of all swimming feet composed of three segments, antennae of 33 segments (according to Henick 34), furca short Only one species. OsphrantUum labronectum Forbes 1882. Found widely distributed in the United States, mora frequently in the Mississippi Valley but never in luge numbers, so that it is comparatively rare in collections. Length ol female, 1.7 mm. Length of male, 1.36 mm. 75 (74) Endopodites of ail swimming feet composed of three segments, antennae of 35 segments, furca long. Limnocalanus macrurus Sais l86a. Found only species of the in deep lakes. It is especially interesting, as It ia the only Centropagidae found in both Europe and America. It is ited in northern Europe and Asia ami is found In salt water considered a representative of the "fauna re- _, .. water form which has become adapted to the . of fresh water. Length of female, 1.4 mm. Length of male, 2.1 mm. 76 (a) Antennae jhort, never longer than cephalothorai. generally much shorter, and composed of From 311 to seventeen segments; ^"tSnae gfjjjjjjjj "symmetrically "geniculate; fifth feet nidi- m'entary, composed of from one to three segments. Family Cycmmtdae. Only one genus. Cyclops . 77 COPEPODA 775 The main points to be noted in the specific determination of the genus are: length and number of segments in the antenna of the female; armature of the antenna! segments, especially of the terminal segments; form of the abdomen, especially the form and armature of the Furcal rami; form and armature of the rudimentary fifth feet; structure of the second antennae, of the mazillipedes, and of the swimming feeU These last structures are of less importance. 77 (98) Antennae composed of twelve or more segments. 78 78 (92, 93) Antennae composed of seventeen segments 79 79 (80) Fifth feet composed of one segment armed with one spine and two long setae Cyclops ater Herrick 1882. It is a large dark-colored spedes, rather rare, probably distributed very widely, and growing in shallow water. In spite of its wide distribution, however, it is a rare form. Length of female, 1.77 to 2.88 mm. Fio. 1 213. Fifth foot of Cyclops aler. X 296. (Original.) 80 (79) Fifth feet composed of two segments 81 81 (84, 89) Second segment of fifth feet armed with seta and short spine. 82 82 (83) Spine of second segment of fifth feet small and near end of seg- ment; last three segments of female antenna without hya- line membrane Cyclops viridis Jurine 1820. Fio. 1 2 14. Abdomen of fe- male Cyclops viridis, var. americanus. X 77- (Origi- nal.) Fio. 12 15. Abdomen of female Cyclops viridis, var. bretrisptnosus. X 66. (Original.) Fio. 1216. Fifth foot of Cvclo)s viridis. X 2x8. (Original.) A widely distributed species, being found both in pools and lakes. It varies greatly in its form and general appearance, so that it has received a number of different specific names, which are now reduced to varieties, since it has been found that there are intermediate forms showing all the stages between the extremes. When living in pools it is apt to be deeply colored, while its relatives living in the open waters of our lakes are colorless and almost trans- parent. Especially noticeable is the difference in the form of the furcal rami, as shown in Figs. 1 214 and 1 2 1 5. The forms found in pools generally have comparatively short and stout furcal rami; on the other hand, the forms in deep waters have long and slender furcal rami. Even in the limnetic forms there is wide variation. In typical viridis there is a short seta on the outer angle of the furcal ramus. This is replaced in the form which Herrick called brtvi- spinosus by a short broad spine. This variety is a common limnetic form in some classes of lakes; a form with the furca armed at its outer angle with a seta like typical nitidis, but differing from viridis in the structure of the swimming feet and of the fifth feet, called americanus, is common in shallow waters, and is the variety that is most frequently seen in the waters of the United States. Wherever a collection is made one is likely to get some form of viridis, and generally it will be americanus. Length of female, 1.25 to 1.5 mm. 776 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 83 (82) Spine of second segment of fifth foot stout, located at about middle of segment; last three segments of female antenna with delicate pectinate hyaline membrane. Cyclops strenuus Fischer 185 1. It is one of the most common forms on the continent of Europe, but has been found in America in only one locality, — a pond in the Adirondack*. It is probable, of course, that it will be found in other localities, but it is a curi- ous fact that hitherto it has been found only in a single collection. In its general form it closely resembles viridis. Length of female, 1.35 mm. Fig. 1217. Fifth foot of Cyclops strenuus. X 358. (Original.) 84 (81, 89) Second segment of fifth feet armed with two setae 85 85(86) Second segment of fifth feet elongate, inner setae spine-like, much shorter than outer. . . . Cyclops bicuspidatus Claus 1857. Flo. 1 a 18. Abdo- men <* Cyclops bi- cuspidaku. X 76. (Original.) Fig. 1 219. Abdo- men of Cyclops W- cuspidahu, var. navus. X 62. (Original.) Fig. 1220. Fifth foot of Cyclops bicuspi- datus. X 227. (Original.) The furca of this species is very characteristic. It not only has a lateral seta at a little more than one-half its length, but it has a little depression armed with minute spines on its outer margin at a little less than one-fourth of its length. These characteristics — the position of the lateral seta, the lateral depression with the elongated furca — are presumptive evidence that a species with seventeen segmented antennae is bicuspidatus. If, in addition, one can make out tbf two terminal setae on the second segment of the fifth feet, he can be pretty certain of his identification. Cyclops bicuspidatus is most commonly a limnetic species, and is the Cyclops which may be considered as characteristic of the Great Lakes. While the form described and figured is the common one, this species has varieties similar to those noted for viridis, and we sometime* find in pools a form agreeing in general structure with the typical forms, but with a short furca. This modification was named navus by Herrick, and the name can be well retained as a varietal distinction. Navus, however, is not so common in pools as the corresponding variety of viridis. Fig. 1 218 shows the typical form of furca in bicuspidatus, and Fig. 1 219 the form in the variety navus. Length of female, 1.1 mm. 86 (85) Second segment of fifth feet short, armed with two nearly equal 87 **» 5. * W&1M* ■ Setae of fifth feet very elongate, last antennal segment armed with serrate hyaline plate; common. Cycinps leuckarti Claus 1857. --„_- has this characteristic form of short rami, with the ■■tend setae placed at about midway of its length. If one can make out the structure of the fifth feet (Fig. I»lj, he can be quite sure of the id eat i Station; for no other American species has this form, with the eicep- tioo of tenuis, and, so far, tenuis has been (bund in only one locality. This species, as has been noted in another place, is peculiarly interesting; for it is almost world-wide in its distribution, having been found in all continents. Moreover, the little variations which are found ill details of structure are also world-wide, so that change of location seems to have no effect on the species. Length of female, 1.14 mm. Setae of fifth feet of moderate length, last antennal segment with- out hyaline plate Cyclops tenuis Marsh 1910. Fifth loot o( Cyclops Itmtii. X U». (Original.) t, 84) Second segment of fifth feet armed with three setae. .... 00 i) With sensory club on twelfth antennal segment, hyaline plate of seventeenth antennal segment smooth or serrate, egg sacs standing out from abdomen. . Cydops albidus J urine 1820. 778 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 91 (90) With sensory hair on twelfth antennal segment, hyaline plate of seventeenth antennal segment deeply notched, egg sacs lying close to abdomen. . . . Cyclops fuscus Jurine 1820. Cyclops fuscus and C. albidus resemble each other very closely, and it is only by a careful examination that they can be distinguished. They are very com- mon, especially in pond collections, Cyclops albidus being found much the more frequently. They are much larger than C. leuckarti and the furcal armature dif- fers in that the lateral seta is placed near the end of the ramus (Fig. 1 223). The form of the fifth feet and of the furcal rami will readily serve to show when we have one of these two species, and in most cases it will prove to be Cyclops albidus. Length of female, about 2 mm. Fio. 1224. Antennal segments of female Cyclops fuscus. X 137. (Original.) 92 (78, 93) Antennae composed of sixteen segments, fifth feet of three seg- ments Cyclops modestus Herrick 1883. This species is comparatively rare altho it has been found in a con- siderable number of places. It occurs as far east as Pennsylvania, as far west as Wyoming, while its northern and southern limits are Wis- consin and Alabama. Length of female, 1.2 to 1.25 mm. Fig. 1225. Cyclops modestus. A, abdomen of female. X 170. B, fifth foot. X 448. (Original.) 93 (78, 92) Antennae composed of twelve segments, fifth feet of one segment. 94 94 (97) Fifth feet armed with three setae, swimming feet composed of three segments. 95 .l£j U«i_ .' . COPEPODA 779 95 (0) Furcae of variable length, armed externally with a row of fine spines; very common. . . Cyclops serrulatus Fischer 1851. The long twelve-segmented antennae and the fer- rate margined furcal rami terve to distinguish this species. The figure of the abdomen shows the char- acteristic structure of the furcal rami. There it a good deal of variation in the form of the furca. When serrulatus is limnetic in habitat, the furcal rami are long and slender; this form is known as variety elegant Herrick. When it lives in pools or B littoral waters, the furcal rami are short and stout; this form is known as variety montanug Brady. The abdomen figured may be considered as typical ofserrv- Fio. 1 aa6. CydcPs serrulatus A abdo- Uuus* elegans being much longer, and montanus corre- men of female/ X 67. B, fifth foot of spondingiy shorter. Found everywhere the world over. X 213. (Original.) Length of female, 0.8 to x.25 mm. Furcae short, without lateral row of spines. Cyclops prasinus Fischer i860. 0(95) It is a minute limnetic form. It resembles serrulatus in \Vk long twelve- segmented antennae, but its abdomen is very different. The furcal rami resemble leuckarti in the fact that the lateral seta is placed at about mid- way of the length, but the species is distinguished at a glance, not only by its smaller size, but by the fact that the antennae are composed of twelve segments. Cyclops prasinus is widely distributed, especially in the larger bodies of water. It is common in the Great Lakes. Length of female, 0-4& mm. Fig. 1227. Abdomen of female Cycltpi prasinus. X 137. 'Original.) Fifth feet armed with one seta, swimming feet of two segments. Cyclops varicans Sars 1862. 97(94) CycUps taricsus occurs in Panama and Guatemala, but there are no authentic records of iU occurrence in the United States. 98 (77) Antennae composed of eleven segments or less. 99 99 fi02. 103) Antennae composed of eleven segments. 100 100 f 101 Rami of swimming feet composed of three segments. Cyclops pkaUralus Koch 1S38. This stont. dark-oJorerl *jnri« \\ nr/t •2nffMT.mr*n in *h*rV/v Uk** \rA stagnant nook, and is rea/fily ncfxrnuer! by the character* given in the key. Ltxugth 'A female, 1.2 mm. a — fc tisX. A&dooKa fA. 1*jPCf#^? ^MpsTI X *>- ffjri 780 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 101 (ioo) Rami of swimming feet composed of two segments. Cyclops tricolor Sars 1863. ^ — • It is not common, but is occasionally seen. The only species with ^^— ^^ which it is likely to be confused is phaleraius, and the difference in the V segmentation of the swimming feet makes the distinction easy, as the >/^>C\. rami have only two segments, while in phaleratus they have three. The — ^ ^, fifth foot consists of a single segment and bears one spine. X Length of female, 0.5 mm. \ Fie. 1229. Fifth foot of Cyclops bkclor. X 450. (Original) X02 (99, 103) Antennae composed of eight segments. Cyclops fimbriatus Fischer 1853. Is the only species with antennae of eight segments, and, if found, can easily be recognized by this characteristic if one is sure that he is examining mature forms. Length of female, 0.7 to 0.84 mm. 103 (99, 102) Antennae composed of six segments. Cyclops aequoreus Fischer i860. Found only in brackish water. It has been found in America in waters connected with the Gulf of Mexico, and those connected with the Pacific Ocean in Panama. Flo. 1230. Abdomen and fifth feet of female Cyclops aequomu. X 73' (Original.) 104 (1) Cephalothorax and abdomen not distinctly separated, so that the whole body is somewhat worm-like; antennae short, never composed of more than eight segments. Family Harpacticidae . . 105 AD species of Harpacticidae are very minute. Only a few species have been described and those very inadequately. Probably there are many undescribed species and other genera than those mentioned. 105 (108) Antennae composed of six segments, endopodites of all swimming feet composed of two segments, segments of endopodite of fourth foot fused so as to appear as one, endopodite of first foot slightly elongate; found in fresh and brackish waters, in New Mexico Marshia . . 106 106 (107) Furca of female two and one-half times as long as broad, furca of male four times as long as broad, median furcal setae fused at base, Marshia albuquerquensis Herrick 1895. 107 (106) Furcae of female and male twice as long as broad, median furcal setae not fused at base. . Marshia brencaudata Herrick 1895. 108 (105) Antennae composed of eight segments, endopodites of swimming ^ ~"~ feet composed of two or three segments, endopodite of third "" foot usually much longer than exopodite. endopodite of male foot always^ tfi^ segments. Canthocamptus . . 109 JM COPEPODA 781 109 (120) Anal plate without spines, or spines are simple, i.e., do not have two points no no (113) Sides of last abdominal segment have spine-like prolongation caudad. in in (112) Spines of anal plate few in number, not exceeding five or six. Canthocamptus staphylinoidcs Pearse 1905. "** Fig. 1231. Anal pUtc and furca of Canthocamptus stapkyiimaiies. X 153. (After Pearse.) 112 (in) Spines of anal plate numerous. Canthocamptus stapkylinus (Jurine) 1820. Fxc. 1232. Last segment and furcae of male Camthocamptms stapkylmms. (After SchmeiL) 113 (no) Sides of last abdominal segment do not have spine-like prolongation caudad 114 114 (115) Furca long and slender, nearly four times as long as wide. Canthocamptus idahoensis Marsh 1903. Fig. 1233. Furcae of female Canikocampitu idakomsis. X 120. (Original) 115 (114) Furca short, its length not exceeding twice its width. ... 116 116(119) Furca with two setae 117 117 (118) Anal plate with spines. . Canthocamptus Ulinoisensis Forbes 1876. 1 18 (117) Anal plate without spines. . Canthocamptus hiemalis Pearse 1905. ^ Fig. 1234. Anal plate of female Canthocamptus hiemalis. X 144- (After Pearse.) 782 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 119(116) Furca with three setae. . Canihacam ptus nortkumbricus BmdyiSSo, This is probably, next to mtmUus, the most widdy distributed species in North America. 1 20 (109) Spines of anal plate bifid. . . Canthocamptus minutus Claus 1863. This is the most common species and is found everywhere in the north- ern continents. Fig. 1235. The last segment and hucae of male C (After Schmefl.) SlPHONOSTOMATA The parasitic Copepoda pass all or a part of their lives as para- sites upon fish and other animals. They are exceedingly numer- ous in both salt and fresh water, and very interesting because of the strange forms which many of them assume, — forms which would appear to be in no way related to the structure of a copepod. Many of them would be taken for worms. Some bore into the tissues of their hosts, others dwell in the gills, and still others in the nasal cavities. One species is very abundant on the sheeps- head of the Central States. The appendages are profoundly modified to adapt them to their parasitic existence. The swimming feet are more or less rudimen- tary. The appendages about the mouth are modified into sucking or prehensile organs. The antennae are similarly modified. In some the second antennae are armed at the end with hooks to enable the animal to retain its hold on its host. In some that are semiparasitic, the appendages from the opposite sides are joined together in a sucker. Sometimes the segmentation of the body disappears entirely. The appendages in some are reduced to mere protuberances, or may be like roots penetrating the body of the host. And yet all these forms are free-swimming in their early stages. When hatched from the egg they have the typical nauplius form COPEPODA 7*3 of the true copepods. and go through a process of degeneration later. In some the male dies immediately after reaching the Cydips stage; in others, the male, while highly organized, is very small and fives as a parasite on the body of the female. The parasitic Copepoda are much more numerous in salt water than in fresh. In an ordinary examination of fresh-water collec- tions one is not apt to find them, although the male of ErgasUms is occasionally seen. An examination of almost any group of fish. however, will show that thev are not at all rare. It is a most fascinating study to compare the structure of these degenerate forms with the highly organized free-swimming species, thus finding evidence of the true copepod structure in animals that at first sight would seem to be far removed from the copepods. The structural relationships of these peculiar forms are only im- perfectly understood, so that no satisfactory classification has been made. and. pending more thorough knowledge, all are grouped together, in a somewhat unscientific way, under the term " Siphono- stomata/" Although it is well known that these forms are very numerous in the fresh waters of America, the family of the Erga- silidae is the onlv one winch has been studied from a systematic standpoint. Almost total ignorance prevails in regard to the spe- cies of the other families. From the studies in other countries something is known of these families, and it may be assumed that representatives of all of them can be found in American waters. For the sake of completeness of record these families, six in aU, will be characterized brieflv. i. Ergasffidac. These resemble very closely the free-swimming copepods. the general form being much Hke that of the Cydopidae. The second antennae are armed at the ends with hooks. On the ventral side of the body of the male there are ordinarily patches of pigment of a deep steel-blue color. The males are free-swimming through the whole period of their Hves. The synopsis of the EigasQidae is adapted from C. B. Wilson. ErgasUms is the only genus of this family, and specimens are not ^frequently taken in limnetic collections. They have been found in nearly all parts of the United States. a. Calipdac. The body is flat, the caudal part of the l I I ' i r .1 784 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY much reduced. The antennae of the second pair are armed with hooks at the ends, but they are much shorter than in the Ergasilidae. 3. Dichelestidae. The body is elongated, the thoracic segments distinct, the abdomen rudimentary except for the elongated genital segment. At least the last two pairs of swimming feet are rudi- mentary. The maxillipedes are armed with hooks. 4. Lernaeidae. The body is worm-like and unsegmented, and the abdomen rudimentary. Processes growing from the head serve to attach the animal to the host. The four swimming feet are either very small or entirely lacking. A represen- tative of this family is found on the sheepsheads of the Mississippi Valley. 5. Lernaeopodidae. The head is distinct, the rest of the body sac-shaped, and generally unsegmented. The second maxillipedes are very large, and, arch- ing over the head, are joined together to form an organ for attachment to the host. The swimming feet are entirely lacking. 6. Chondracanthidae. The body is indistinctly segmented, and the abdomen rudimentary. The first two pairs of swimming feet are rudimentary, the others lacking. The second antennae bear hooks. The male is small, distinctly segmented, and lives as a parasite on the female. Flo. 1236. Lemaeo- foda beam Wflaon, round on rainbow trout and Quinnat |(After WU- KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER ERGASILIDAE 1(8) Head completely fused with first thoracic segment, with no indi- cation of union; carapace elongate, much longer than wide, and more than half entire length 2 « (5) Anterior margin of carapace evenly rounded, first antennae hardly reaching end of first segment of second pair _. 3 3(4) Basal large Second antennae one-third entire length. Ergasilus funduli Krdyer 1863. of second antennae much swollen and widened distally; second segment with on its outer border. Found on the gills of Fundulus oaUaris. 785 4 (3) Second antennae half the entire length. Ergasiius labraea Krttyer 1863. Ho. 11J7. EiiaUmi Uracil. (After WfbonJ 5 (a) Anterior margin of the carapace projecting strongly at the center in a rounded knob, first antennae much longer than in a. . 6 6 (7) Terminal claw of second antennae simple. Ergasiius centrarekidanm Wright 188a. Both rami of fourth feet three- segmented- Found on the family Centrarxhidae, the redeye, AmbtuplUri mptitrii, small- mouth black bass, ilitrepttrut dolumitu, etc. Fig. ij.t». P.rtasilui antrtrctUanm. 7 (6) Terminal claw toothed on the inner margin. Ergasiius cQtmleus Wilson 191 1. FM. 1330. fi'lasil'; 786 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 8 (z) Head fused with first thoracic segment, but fusion indicated by distinct indentations on lateral margins; carapace half en- tire length and violin-shaped 9 9 (10) Second antennae as long as carapace. Ergasilus versicolor Wilson 191 1. Found upon species of catfish. Flo. z 240. Ergasilus versicolor. (After WOaon.) 10 (9) Second antennae only one-half length of carapace. Ergasilus chautauquaensis Fellows 1887. Suborder Branchiura There is but one family in this suborder, — the Argulidae. They are ectoparasites upon fish, and are commonly known as fish lice. They have compound eyes, four or five pairs of swimming feet, and the first maxillipedes are modified into a pair of sucking disks. In connection with the mouth is a true stinging organ which pene- trates the skin of the host. They are found most abundantly in the branchial chamber of the host, but may attach themselves to other parts of the body. It is a matter of interest in this connec- tion, as has been noted by Wilson, that they attach themselves in such a way as to place the long axis of the body parallel to that of the host, so that they will be less likely to be brushed off in its move- ments. To this end, too, the under side of the body of the Argulus is armed with backward-pointing spines, which aid in keeping it in place. Argulus is strictly dependent on the blood of its host for food, but can and does frequently swim about freely. Inas- much as the eggs are laid attached to stones and similar objects, it must leave the host at the breeding season. They are not con- COPEPODA 787 fined to a single species of fish for a host, but seem able to make use of a great variety, and may even attach themselves to other aquatic animals, like tadpoles. Some of them can live almost equally well in both salt and fresh water. The following key to the species of Argulus which have been described from the fresh waters of America is adapted from Wilson's paper on the Argulidae. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER ARGULIDAE 1 (4, 9) Carapace lobes overlap base of abdomen a 3 (3) Diameter of sucking disks 0.25 mm. Argulus cotostomi Dana and Herrick 1837. i on antennae reduced in number, small and weak; n small and orbicular; found on lucker, CaioiU- imtrsoni, and chub lucker, Erimytn iwcsfta •>- . ArpAu amibmL (After WfcoaJ 3 (i) Diameter of sucking disks 0.13 mm. Argulus americanus Wilson 1003. Spines on anlenmc large and strong, reenlorced,' abdomen large and broadly cordate. Found en mudfish, Amia calva. 4(1,9) Carapace lobes just reach base of abdomen 5 5 (8) Carapace orbicular, wider than long 6 6 (7) Analsinusnarrowandslit-likc. Argulus versicolor Wilson 1003, male, 7 (6) Anal sinus broadly triangular. . Argulus maculosus Wilson 1903.' Anal (latWUar laical: bases "f antennae widely separated; found upon the muacallonge, 8 (s) Carapace orbicular, longer than wide. Argulus appendiculosus Wilson 1007. 9 (1. 4) Carapace lobes do not reach abdomen 10 10(16) Swimming legs with flagella n 11 (13) Carapace orbicular, wider than long is FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Abdomen medium, oval, anal sinus short, slit-like, papillae sub- terminal. .... Argulus versicolor Wilson 1903, female. Attuhu verikehr, fcmilt. (After Wfln .) 13 (11) Carapace elliptical, longer than wide 14 14 (is) flagella o anterior swimming legs. Argulus kpidoilei KeUicott 1877. Carapace elliptical, longer than wide, its lobes very short, barely covering two pairs of legs; abdomen broad, triangu- lar, cut to the center or beyond with acute lobes; found on the gar pike, Lcpidastau una. Artulmi UpHosUi. {After Wilson.) Flagella on all four pairs of swimming legs. Argulus ingots Wilson 1012. 16(10) No flagella on swimming legs. . . Argulus sf iiosf e/Ai Kellicott 1880. IMPORTANT PAPERS ON FRESH-WATER COPEPODA Van Dotjwe, C, and Neresheiher, E. 1909. Copepoda. Die fauna Deutschlands. Heft 11. Forbes, Ernest B. 1897. A Contribution to a Knowledge of North Ameri- can Fresh-water Cyclopidae, Bull. 111. State Lab. Nat Hist. 5: 27-81; 13 P.- COPEPODA 789 Giesbrecht, W., and Schmeil, O. 1898. Copepoda. I. Gymnoplea. Das Tierreich, t> Lief. Guerne, J. de, et Richard, J. 1889. Revision des Calanides d'eau douce. Mem. Soc. Zool. France, n: 53-181; 4 pi. Herrick, C. L., and Turner, C. H. 1895. Synopsis of the Entomostraca of Minnesota. Geol. and Nat. Hist. Survey Minn., Zool. Series II; 525 pp., 81 pi. Marsh, C. D. 1893. On the Cyclopidae and Calanidae of Central Wisconsin. Trans. Wis. Acad., 9: 189-224; 5 pi. 1895. On the Cyclopidae and Calanidae of Lake St. Clair, Lake Michigan, and certain of the inland lakes of Michigan. Bull. Mich. Fish Com. No. 5; 24 pp., 9 pi. 1897. The Limnetic Crustacea of Green Lake. Trans. Wis. Acad., n : 163- 168; 10 pi. 1003. The Plankton of Lake Winnebago and Green Lake. Bull. Wis. Geol. and Nat. Hist. Survey, 12: 1-94; 22 pi. 1907. A Revision of the North American Species of Diaptomus. Trans. Wis. Acad., 15: 381-516; 15 pi. 1910. A Revision of the North American Species of Cyclops. Trans. Wis. Acad., 16: 1067-1135; 10 pi. Schacht, F. W. 1897. The North American Species of Diaptomus. Bull. 111. State Lab. Nat. Hist, 5: 97-207; 15 pi. 1898. The North American Centropagidae belonging to the Genera Oj- phranticum, Limnocalanus, and Epischura. Bull. 111. State Lab. Nat. Hist., 5: 225-269. Schmeil, Otto. 1892. Deutschlands freilebende Siisswasser-Copepoden. L Cyclopidae; 192 pp., 8 pi. 1893. Deutschlands freilebende Siisswasser-Copepoden. H. Harpacticidae; 100 pp., 8 pi. 1896. Deutschlands freilebende Siisswasser-Copepoden. HI. Centropagi- dae; 144 pp., 12 pi. Wilson, C. B. 1903. North American Parasitic Copepods of the Family Argulidae. Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus., 25: 635-742; 20 pi. 191 1. North American parasitic Copepods Belonging to the Family Erga- silidae. Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus., 39: 263-400; 20 pi. CHAPTER XXIV THE OSTRACODA By R. W. SHARPE Instructor in Biology, Dewitt Clinton High School, New York City An early author says of the Ostracoda, "these little creatures are enclosed in a bivalve shell of lime and seem to be very lively in their native element, being almost constantly in motion by the action of their antennae, or walking upon plants and other solid bodies floating in the water." Also "by opening and closing then- valves, they enjoy light and move at their will, sometimes burying themselves in the mud, sometimes darting through the water, the humid air of their sphere. If they meet with any unforeseen object, they conceal themselves all at once in their shells and shut the valves, so that force and address seek in vain to open them." The Ostracoda are found abundantly in all kinds of fresh and salt waters. They owe their name to the possession of a two- valved limy shell, which is hinged dorsally, and encloses the entire body. They are commonly more or less bean-shaped (Fig. 1244), and seen from above (Fig. 1255 J) are usually oval or egg-shaped. In many cases the shells overlap each other, or there may be a ventral flange present. They average about 1 millimeter in length. The body of these little creatures is not segmented, and is com- pletely enclosed in its bivalved shell, which is hinged along the dorsal margin by means of a hinge ligament, somewhat as with the molluscan bivalves. These valves are kept closed by adductor muscles, their points of attachment being indicated by a number of lucid spots about the middle of each valve (Fig. 1255 a). These are called "muscle impressions" and may often be of sys- tematic value. At the anterodorsal end of the body is a single eye, although it may occasionally be double. Most commonly the shells of the sexes are of the same size and shape, although second- ary sexual characters may appear here. For instance, the males of the genus Candona are larger and of a different shape (Fig. 1300), while in Cypris and Notodromas the females are the larger. 7QO «* .••-& "'-> «•> THE OSTRACODA 791 Baker, in 1753, is said to be the first author who sufficiently de- scribed any of these small forms so that the description could be recognized as referring to a Cypris. In the work "Employment for the Microscope' ' an anonymous correspondent describes an insect with a bivalve shell, somewhat resembling a fresh-water mussel, and gives a figure of it lying on its back. Linnaeus, in his "Systema Naturae," in 1748, mentions a species under the name "Monoculus concha pedata." For many years the general term "Monoculus" was in use for all en- tomostraca until finally, in 1776, 0. F. Muller, in his "Zoologiae Danicae Prodromus, " first established the genus Cypris, as well as a number of other genera of the entomostraca. In 1894 G. W. Muller published his masterly work on the Ostra- coda of the Gulf of Naples. His descriptions and figures are most carefully and accurately made, and in connection with his similar work on the fresh-water Ostracoda of Germany, published in 1900, may well form the best published basis for future work. He de- scribes about 125 species from the Gulf of Naples and some 65 for Germany. Structure. — It is not uncommon for the extremities and ventral edges of the shell of Cypris to exhibit a number of subparallel canals (Fig. 1 271) which radiate outwards, and are called "pore canals." The same regions may be tuberculate, the right valve alone with tubercles as in the subgenus Cyprinotus (Fig. 1270), or the left valve alone similarly tuberculate as with the subgenus Heterocypris. Various species of other groups may thus be simi- larly marked. Occasionally the shell may show a series of longi- tudinal markings, as Ilyodromus (Fig. 1259) or a network of anastomosing and parallel lines, as Cypria exsculpta. Exclusive of the abdominal appendages, called the furca, there are seven pairs of appendages in the Cyprididae. These may be enumerated as follows: first antenna, second antenna, mandible, first maxilla, second maxilla, first leg, and second leg, naming one of each pair (Fig. 1244). The anterior lip or labrum (Fig. 1 244) forms a prominence pro- jecting between the bases of the second antennae and anteriorly covering the oral orifice. The posterior lip or labium (Fig. 1 245) 792 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY forms a thin membrane, reenforced by a pair of very strong chitinous rods, each expanded into a transverse plate armed at their extremi- ties with a series of about seven strong teeth. Posteriorly the lip joins a stemumlike vaulted plate, carinated along the middle, and placed between the bases of the first pair of maxillae. Branchial JTatr of Jf.n. d idle Branchial tela* Fig. 1144. General The mandibles (Fig. 1 245) are each composed of a chitinous elon- gate body, and a well-developed pediform palp (Fig. 1245 V). They are located on either side of the body immediately behind the base of the second antennae with its upper acuminate extremity (Fig. 1245 V) articulated to the inner surface of the corresponding valve just in front of the adductor muscle impressions, whereas the lower incurved extremity is wedged in between the lips. The greater part of the body (Fig. 1245 &*) is hollowed to receive the powerful adductor biting muscles. The cutting edge (Fig. 1245 &4) is divided into several strong, bifurcate teeth. The palp (Fig. 12456*) forms a thick, fleshy, somewhat pediform jointed stem, curving downwards, and bears on its outer side a narrow plate, a so-called branchial appendage (Fig. 1245 61) which is provided with a number of plumose setae. THE OSTRAOOIM 793 The first pair of nariDae (Fig. 1245 c) is formed of a thick, mus- cular, basal part, from the extremities of which four digitiform processes originate. The larger of these prominences (Fig. 1245 **) is jointed and movable and must evidently be regarded as a palp, whereas the three remaining form the immediate continuation of the basal part and are the true masticatory' lobes. The first one of these is usually armed with two strong spines (Fig. 1245 c* and Fig. 1270 c) which may or may not be toothed, and are regarded as of specific importance. To the outer side of the basal part a large semilunar lamella (Fig. 1245 c3) is attached, which is generally called the branchial plate. This plate may be seen to move rhythmically in the living animal, and is for the purpose of renewing the supply of fresh oxygen-laden water within the shell cavity. It is directed obliquely upwards and exhibits along the posterior edge a series of dense and regular finely plumose setae, from 16 to 20 in number. The second pair of maxillae (Fig. 1245(f) consists of the same principal parts as the first, though different in appearance. The basal part (Fig. 1 245 d1) is much smaller, not divided at the end, and terminating in a single masticatory lobe. The branchial lamella (Fig. 1245 d*) are usually semicircular and provided with a few plu- mose setae, while the palps (Fig. 1245

A 700 feted waters, although this fact has not received the attention it should Even though in general they seem to be no more sensitive to their sarnnmdnfgs than the Qadocera or the Copepoda, yet there is no doubt that the amount of light, of pressure, of varia- tions in temperature and composition of the water, the rate of flow of the same, the nature of the bottom, and the presence or absence of algae, etc, must certainly exert a real or intrinsic in- fluence on the prosperous development of all these Entomostraca. Direct or intense light certainly accelerates all their life processes, as may be evidenced in the fact that all free and actively swim- ming forms are quite likely to turn towards a source of light, or, in other words, are positively heliotropic Shady areas in pools are not nearly so likely to contain the free swimming forms such as Cypris, Cypria, Cydocypris, and Xotodromas except occasionally or sporadically, while the lighter and sunnier areas of the same body will contain them in abundance; in other words, the more uniform the distribution of light, the more nearly uniform becomes the distribution of any certain form. On the other hand, it seems a general rule that the less able these forms are to swim, the greater the certainty that they are confined to the deeper and darker areas, in the ooze and slimy debris of the bottom. It also appears that some species may be affected but little by depth, and there- fore light and pressure; Cypridopsis vidua has been found in all depths from 1 centimeter to fully 300 meters. Experience teaches that practically no forms are found in pure spring water or in well water. Even so, we find practically none in waters that have been polluted with dyes, or by chemical means, although many different degrees of power of resistance in this regard may be found. Some species may be enclosed in the smaller glass aquaria and live almost indefinitely without change of water, even though the water becomes quite foul. For example, Cypria opthalmica has been known to survive in such aquaria long after the larger forms have died. Cyclocypris laevis will also live many months in water that has not been freshened. Some few forms have been known to exist in sulphur waters, others in hot springs and even in sewer drains. Cypris incongruens has been found in a pond fed by the drainage from a barnyard manure 800 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY heap. This species really seems to be indifferent to any variation in the pollution of the swampy water in which they normally live, variations and situations that would be fatal to most other Ostra- coda. These forms have also been found in more or less perma- nent ponds fed in part from the drainage from cesspools and from leaky sewers. Many bodies of water of different degrees of swiftness are like- wise determinative of different forms. Brooks and rivers are not especially good habitats, as plant life there is not abundant, and most free-swimming Ostracoda seemingly delight to hang to such supports. However, most forms may be occasionally or adven- titiously found in such waters, as well as in quieter waters. Nokh dramas is typically an inhabitant of pure, fresh pools, although it is a good swimmer, and has the curious habit of trying to support itself on the surface film. Among those forms depending upon the Ostracoda in part for food, one must certainly include the young of many fishes, and even the adult Coregonus or whitefish has been found with Candona in the stomachs. Some of the larger marine fishes seek Ostracoda in the mud. Even aquatic birds may include them in their bill of fare, as, for example, the shoveler or spoonbill duck has been found with Ilyodromus and Cypria in its stomach. Owing to the variations in habitat, and the vicissitudes to which most fresh-water Ostracoda are subject, and because of the vari- able and inconstant nature of their surroundings, it is almost im- possible to work out their exact distribution. CydocypHs laevis, Cypria opthalmica, Cypria exsculpta, and Cypridopsis vidua seem to be cosmopolites in temperate zones, and the most indifferently distributed of any, as they are found in all pools, ponds, swamps, lakes, and rivers of both mountainous and level areas. Their small size permits them to be readily carried about, and their power of adaptation and scavenger habits permit them to thrive in almost any apparently adverse situation. Notodromas, as already stated, appears only in pure standing waters, and mostly in immense numbers. Less abundantly, but still very widely distributed, may be found various species of Candona, Cypris fuscata, and Her- petocypris reptans. :*i& '■'- * THE OSTRACODA 8oi The vertical distribution of these forms has not been fully worked out. Various species of Candona, Ilyocypris, as well as Cypridopsis vidua and Cyclocypris laevis have been found at depths of at least 300 meters, while a few have been reported from depths of fully 2500 meters. The constancy of color, form, and size of most of these species is still an open question, and yet requires much careful work. Be- cause of differences in methods of measuring and the chance that undeveloped or sexually immature individuals become described, it is certain that there exist many discrepancies as to published descriptions, and therefore of reports on distribution. Despite these discrepancies and uncertainties, it is likely that local varieties exist in many quite restricted areas, that in many cases are so far divergent that one would be disposed to ascribe them to different species. On this account, if for no other, it is advisable to be very careful concerning the establishment of new species. In all cases the appendages should be very critically examined, and if these show differences and the shells are constant in general markings and form, then only should a new species be created. Of course, very exact and minute descriptions are indispensable. The distribution of Ostracoda seems to be both actively and passively brought about. The creeping forms may be said to be actively distributed, while the free-swimming forms are passively distributed. Those that creep must actively exert themselves if in deep water, often against the force of the stream, to prevent themselves from being buried in the mud. Passively, the swim- mers may be distributed by high water or by direct means of transport. The amount of water is of more consequence than the flow of water. Even though the amount of water is great, they still can remain in the place of their temporary abode, while in brooks or rivers they are carried away by the force of the current, and may become lost. In rainy seasons, therefore, the natural increase may be very scanty, while in drier periods many indi- viduals of both sexes find one another, and the eggs deposited always have a sufficient opportunity of finding necessary moisture for development. 802 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Migration from one region to another may be brought about by swimming beetles such as Belostotna, Gyrina, etc. Cyclocypris has been observed hanging to the legs of such beetles, even though the beetles were actively using their legs. Birds may also be of great importance as carriers of both the minute flora and fauna of a region. The eggs of Ostracoda, and even the animals themselves, may be carried about on the bills and feet of aquatic birds, and even fishes may act as a means of transport from one region to another. The Ostracoda belong to the plankton. In common with certain other organisms, such as Rhizopods, Diatoms, Hydra, etc., they appear in the plankton under certain conditions of temperature and food, and hence are said to belong to the adventitious plank- tonts, in distinction to such forms as Cyclops, which are always in the plankton, and therefore called continuous planktonts, or those that appear periodically, as Daphnia and some Rotifera, when they are called periodic planktonts. For evident reasons the creeping or burrowing forms rarely occur in ordinary plankton catches. According to their habitat and mode of locomotion, the ostracod adventitious planktonts may be classified as follows: A. Free swimming. i. Limnetic, with surface habits, as Notodromas monacha. 2. Free swimming, below the surface, as Cypris laevis, C. incongruenSy C. vidua, etc. B. Creeping or burrowing. i. Creeping on water plants or ooze, as Ecrpetocypris rcp- tans. 2. Burrowing in the slime or ooze, as Candona Candida, and Limnicythere. Little is surely known of the duration of life of special forms. Some species are present the entire year. They live over the winter, and are also found in different developmental stages under the ice. It is an easy matter to collect mud under ice in midwinter, place it in a small aquarium jar and set in a moderately warm place, and very shortly find plenty of Cypris, Cypria, and Candona. THE OSTRACODA 803 Notodromas appears purely as a summer form. It winters in different "egg stages," develops in April or May, and by Septem- ber has entirely disappeared. Cypridopsis vidua and Cypris in- congruens appear in early spring and last until late autumn. The spring forms appear to have a much shorter life history. These forms may be collected in great variety and abundance by drawing a Birge or cone net through submerged plants present in ponds, slow streams, and lakes, and by stirring up the bottom ooze and slime, and drawing the weighted net to and fro over the bottom. In thi* manner not only the free-swimming forms may be cap- tured, such as Cypris, Cypridopsis, etc., but typically bottom forms such as Candona. Hcrpetocypris. etc.. may also be included. By emptying the mud and all other accumulations in a beaker of water, and stirring welL it will usually result in many of the Ostra- coda getting air caught between their valves, thus causing them to float on the surface, from which thev mav be readilv removed with a "medicine dropper*9 or pipette. The use of a small hand lens is advisable in determining whether or not Ctetraooda are surely present. In any case, the " catch ?r may now be concen- trated by carefully pouring on the contents of the beaker from the sediment in the bottom into a small dip net made of Sim or bolting doth. After washing out as much of the soluble or other matter as is possible, the recsainder may be emptied into a Syracuse nidi gbss or other shallow rts&d cxxitaining bet a assail quantity of water. Thra the casds i* omden***! to sads balk as may now be casEx caiaskra&d so ansaZ viafe Side view, X S» (Alter Marshall.) 6 (5) Not parasitic. Crawlers or bummers. Terminal claws of legs with not more than two teeth, or plain (Fig. 1260 d). Limnicylkere Brady 1868 . . 7 7 (8) Shell decidedly reticulate, with two lateral furrows. Furca blunt. about three times as long as wide (Fig. 1 250 a). Limnicythere reticulata Sharpe 1897. j ^fcKSSsojggjgSg/ T-engtho.Wtoo.70mm.ando.15mm.wide. Grayish j*\j I' ^qjjggggffiagy white. Shell conspicuously marked with a boneycomb- ^^~^*~- |jke network of polygonal reticulations, and deep lateral furrows (Fir. 12506). Furca (Fig. 1950a) cylindrical, thick and blunt, about three times as long as wide, with two small setae. Posterior dorsal partof carapace tapers to a point. Muddy bottom of ponds. Illinois, ApriL Fro. ia 50. THE OSTRAOODA 807 8 (7) Shell faintly reticulate, with one lateral furrow. Furca tapering to * set* like extremity (Fig. 1351 b). Lmmcytkvt illimoisensis Sharpe 1807 mm., and width o.»g m gi»yi»h white. FUceUvm ti._ ■cmncDtod Furca cylindrical, about acven timet a* long a* wid* (Fig. ijsit). Male gnwpinfi or- gans unusually well developed. Terminal daw <4 Kawluitw of mile aimed with j or 4 nroe* teeth at tip. Sandy bottom*. lUinaa River, bayou*, and lake dure*. May. Liwrnicytkin iBimumrii. (a) D» Ml new; (t) Fura; 7) 17(16) 18 (ig) be With two distinct eyes (Fig. 1355 6) 18 With eyes fosed, or none apparent (Fig. 1258 c) 21 First maxflUry process with sis spines. Furca with three long setae and do spines (Fig. 1255 c-d) 20 19 (18) First maxillary process with six spines. Furca with four long setae and 110 spines ( Fig. 1 3 56 c) 21 Second antenna six segmented in both sexes. Second leg terminat- ing in three setae, one of which is reflexed. Nolodromas Lilljeborg 1853. Only one species in North America. Nolodromas monacha (O. F. M tiller) 1785. Active the (ladocera in many move aurface him c>[ w»tn, Back dvwn. as Cypfati. Permanent [reabpundairitbalgae. North- vif». X yr. . Mn Jury ipina. X too. J; Furca of femaV. X to; «) End of mod leg. X no. THE OSTRACODA 809 21 Second antenna five-segmented in both sexes. Second leg termi- nating in one daw and one reflexed seta (Fig. 1256 6). Cyprois Zenker 1854. Only one species found in North America. Cyprois marginata Strauss 1821. Length 1.53 mm., breadth 0.75 mm., height 0.06 mm. Uniformly vellowish in color. An active, rest- less swimmer, and at times tries hanging to the surface film of water. Somewhat resembling N. monaeha in its swimming move- ments. May also creep on bot- tom debris. Grassy pools which later dry up. Sexual. Furca stout, slightly curved; dorsal seta uncom- monly long. April to Jury. Chi- cago, SI. (Jackson Park), April May, June. 22 (23) Natatory setae of the second antennae entirely lacking (Fig. 1298 c). Subfamily Candoninae . . 91 23 (22) Natatory setae of the second antennae very evident, usually extend- ing at least to tips of terminal claws (Figs. 1268 e and 1290c) 24 24 (25) Terminal segment of second leg with three long setae and no claws, — one seta reflexed (Fig. 1258 b). Ilyocypris Brady and Norman 1889 . . 26 25 (24) Terminal segment of second leg with at least one claw (Fig. 1 268 b), — and usually beak-shaped 28 26 (27) Shell with many prominent tubercles, knobs, and furrows. Nata- tory setae reaching to tips of terminal daws, or slightly beyond Ilyocypris gibba Ramdohr 1808. Length 0.85 to 0.05 mm. Shell much tuberculato anteriorly and posteriorly, and decidedly furrowed anterodorsally. Two prominent tubercles just back of the eye-spot. Poor swimmers. Furca nearly straight, its terminal claws nearly equal in length, and plain. Terminal seta of furca about two-fifths length of terminal claw. Swampy regions, in mud, during the spring months. In company with /. bradyi, usu- ally. Colorado, March. Fio. xa<7. Ilyocypris gibba. (a) Side view, X 45! (6) Dorsal view, X 4$. 8lO FRESH-WATER BIQLOGY 37 (16) Shell with weak tubercles, knobs, and furrows. Natatory setae reaching scarcely to tips of terminal claws. Ilyocypris bradyi Sars 1800. Length about a* /. tibia. Height of female 0.45 to o.j mm., breadth 0.3; to 0.5 mm. Male slightly larger. Scarcely free swimming, but creeps or burrows. Shell weakly tuberculate and not furrowed posterodorsally. Habitat and occurrence a* /. gibba. Furca strong curved, and much broad- ened at base. About ten times as long as width in middle. Dorsal seta plu- mose and bent near tip. Distal half of dorsal part of furca dilate. These two species are quite variable, ihus causing much confusion in diagnosis. Both species are also found in Britain and Germany. llyocyfrii bradyi. (a) Fura End of second leg. X ifo vi™,X«; W SiJevkw, 28 (tg) Natatory setae of the second antenna shortened, no swimmers. Second leg with a beak-like end segment and a daw (Fig. 1368 6) Subfamily H esp etocyphid in a k . . 30 39 (28) Natatory setae of the second antenna long, reaching at least to tips of terminal claws. Second leg as above. Subfamily Cypbhunae . . 43 30 (31) Furca abnormal, with three claws, — the usual dorsal seta being replaced by a claw. Shell faintly longitudinally striated (Fig. 1359) Ilyodromus Sara 1894. Only one species known in America. Ilyodromus peclinatus Sharpe 1908. Length1.10t01.18mm. Shellwith reticulate patterns anteriorly and posteriorly. Posterior edge of furca deddedly pectinate. The only known species of the genua with a " ;™> 1 streams, with Tjtka, Iris, C THE 06TRACGDA 8ll 31(30) Forca normal, with two spines and two setae (Fig. 1364 b). . . 32 33 (33) Second segment of first leg with two setae on anterior margin (Fig. i2(tad). Three spines on first mmUaiy process CUamydttketa Saussure 185S . . 34 33 (33) Second segment of first leg with one seta on anterior p^'gir (Fig. 1277 b). Two spines on first mamillary process. Herpetocypris Brady and Norman 1880 . . 38 34 (35) Shell plain, no special markings of any sort. Seen from above, the shell is decidedly wedge-shaped anteriorly (Fig. 1260). Chiamydotiieca aiteka Saussure 1858. Length ,i-.io nun., height s.oo mm., breadth iJso mm. Yellowish gray. Ope of the largest ipedes of tbe genus known. teach to tips of lamina] claws. No males known. Seen from above, tbe shell is much more wedge-shaped anteriorly than C. Knuiu. It also lacks the greenish stripes in the shell- Furcaaknoat straight. about 18 times as long as wide, and faintly pectinate on the dorsal margin. Texas, Meiiu> Ditches and pools. Oc- tober. CUmmydcUnci tUckc (a)' Side view, > Ik) tkmal view; if) Tool, XiwWI) 35 (34) Shell with semicontorted and radially arranged colored bands. Shell more tumid from above (Fig. i;6t) 36 36 (37) Shell with at least sis sinuous radiating dark green bands on its sides Chiamydolheca herricki Turner 1895. Length 3.00 mm., height 1.70 mm., width 1-43 mm. Light ground color with sinuous and radially arranged dark-green bands. Claws of first mandibular process, smooth. Terminal claw of first leg almost as long as entire leg. Furca straight, onr- half the dorsal margin pectinate, about twenty times as long as wide. Shallow CUtmyJMhno iwTkti. i.) Side v FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 37 (36) Shell with but three such bands. 38 (30) Length about four mm. Length 1.75 mm., height i.JS nun., width i.fjo.mm. No males yet found. Two or three narrow greenish bands irregularly arranged on sides of shell. Furca straight, about twenty- three times as long as wide and faintly toothed on about one-naif of dorsal margin. Ponds; Septem- ber. Durango, Mexico. Ucrpetocypris barbatus Forbes 1893. Width 1.60 mm., height 2.00 mm. Shell fairly full, but not plump. Large, hairy, yel- lowish brown in alcohol, with reddish patches on either side. One of the largest of the freshwater ostracoda. Valves equal. Furca ng as wide, slightly tr, Wyoming. July, Eapoocyfrii Sortefw. (a) Side view with shell removal; (») Furca. (After Forba.) 30 (38) Length less than three mm 40 40 (41) Dorsal edge of furca. with five combs of coarse teeth (Fig. 1264 6). Herpelocyprii replant Baud 1850. Length 2.00 mm. to i.jomm., height 0.80 mm. Brownish yellow. Furca about shrteen times as long as wide. slightly curved; its dorsal edge armed with five combs of coarse talk. Furca daws coarsely toothed. Muddy bot- toms, ponds; April f California. THE OSTRAOODA 813 Dorsal edge of furca plain (Fig. 126; 6). Htrpetocypris Ustttdinaria Cushman 1908. Length j.io mm, nun., width 080 mm extra spine by tobtai Fun» about fourteen tunes u mj s wide, its daws plain, hods. May. Wrmttmi U1 Ea \2 (43) Natatory setae of second antenna reach to tips of terminal daws, or slightly beyond. Second leg with a beak-like end segment and a daw (Fig. 12686,*). . Subfamily Cypudinae . . 44 43 (4>) Natatory setae of the second antenna reach beyond tips of terminal daws by about one-half their length. Second leg with three terminal setae of different lengths, two of them re- flexed, the other short and daw-like (Fig. 1200c, /). Subfamily Cyclqcymudmax . . 75, 44 (45) Testes, if present, originating in anterior part of shell in form of concentric circles or hall circles (Fig. 1166). Spirocypris Sharpe 1903 . . 46 45 (44) Testes, if present, not originating in anterior part of shell in form of concentric circles or half circles (Fig. 1371 b). CyprisO. F. MuUeri78s . . 48 46 (47) Shell not tuberculate, excessively hairy (Fig. 1266 a). Spirocypris passaica Sharpe 1903. height 0.80 mm., breadth 081mm. Brownish nith dark-blue patches later- ally and dorsally. Nita- beyoud tips of terminal claws. Terminal daw of second leg one and one- half times length of ter- minal segment. Furca about one-half length of shell, about twenty-three spring months. Mas! chusetts. New Jeney. 814 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 47 (46) Shell very tuberculate, sparsely hairy and unusually plump (Fig. 1367 c) Spirocypris tuberculaia Sharpe 1908. Length oloj mm, bright 0.5 j nun., width 0.70 mm. Purplish brawn, with one or two dccsil transverse tighter bands. Right valve shghtly overlaps the left antenody. Natatory setae extend but slightly beyond the ter- minal daws. Fares about thirty-two time* as long as wide. Shallow, weedy, and swampy ponds; spring. Chicago and northern In- SfirBCJfril lutxrculala. 48 (49) First leg four-segmented, third and fourth segments united (Fig. 1368 c). . . Subgenus Eurycypris G. W. Mtiller 1808. Only one species in this subgenus. Cypris (Eurycypris) pubera O. F. Mtiller 1785. Length a. 10 mm., height 1. IS mm., breadth 1. jo mm. Greenish in color. A dark patch at its highest and cen- tra! part as seen Irom the side. Shell sparsely hairy. Anterior and jxstero-ventral margins with prominent orterna! tuber- cles. Two prominent tuber- cles at postero-ventr*] part of shell. Tnis character alone is sufficient to identify this aperies of cypris. First leg four-seg- mented. Furca nearly straight, about twenty-four times as long aswide. Ponds; April to June. IH End of ■ecood leg; (0 First teg; 49 (4*0 First leg plainly five-segmented (Fig. 1277 b), third and fourth seg- ments not united 50 50 (51) Inner anterior edge of right shell thickly tuberculate (Fig. 1370 a). Subgenus Cyprinotus Brady 1885 . . 5a THE OSTRACODA 815 ! of right shell plain (Fig. 1278 c) 61 53 (53) Dorsal seta of furca man than ouc-half loigtli of sublerruinal daw (Fig. 1270 c) 54 53 (51) Dorsal seta of f [lira not more than one-half length of sub terminal daw (Fig. 1273 c) 58 54 (55) Left shell larger than the right, and its edges not tuberculate (Fig. irjob) 56 55 (54) Left shell smaller than the right, and with a row of scattered tubercles along the inner margin (Fig. 1269 b, e). Cypris (CyprinotusjptUiitida Sh&rpe 1807. Shell unusually tmnv lnrrat, and covered with ol dotted lines. Length low pood* and pools; April to September UE- m (*) Donal ££' 10 nafct ahdU WlF™ Wlnw mancai «f kit 56 (57) Kight-sheD margin tuberculate only at anterior and posteroventral margins Shell about four-sevenths as high as long (Fig. 1270a). . Cyprit (Cyprinotw ) inamgrvens Ramdohr 1808. Left valve overlaps right Fl wide. Spina of first process toothed. Quite troughs. Florida, Otrio, watering trot* Pennsylvania. Cj*fii(C)Jiimtlmii imxmtnmv. it) KMht starf. X:.|; (l)DoHalTi sllmiak, X a*£ (el Funa J ssafc. X sK ufi Feck. X 100: 8i6 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 57 (56) Right shell margins unusally tuberculate, as in Fig. 1371 6. Shell not more than one-half as high as long (Fig. 1371a). Cypris (Cyprinotus) dentata Sharpe 1910. Shell brownish yellow and translucent in alco- hol. Length 1.35' to 1.60 mm., and height not more Shell pointed pt ttalm-.,, „_. atemthemale.bi; straight with the female. Natatory setae reaching well beyond the terminal daws. Males common. Furca gently curved. about sixteen times aa long as wide. Spines of first " " . . _ _. Temporary ponds. Stamford, Ne- F10. I17I. Cy}ni [CyttimMu) antata. iilun, X jo; (c) Furca, X ioj. (a) Left (hell from within, X 30; ») Right shell In 58 (59) Dorsal seta of furca less than width of furca from sub terminal daw (Fig.i272c). . Cypris (Cyprinottts) burlingtottensisTxuntr 1&94. Length 1.50 mm., height 0.70 mm., width 0.70 mm. Yellowish brown with bluish black longitudinal stripes on dorsum and sides. Hairy. Natatory setae extend slightly beyond tips of tenninal claws. Maxillary spines toothed. Furca slender and straight, about eighteen times as long as wide. Dorsal seta closetosubterminatclaw. Shallow, temporary, grassy pools. Ohio, Georgia, Delaware. 59 (58) Dorsal seta of furca more than width of furca from subterminal claw 60 60 (tii) Shell with no markings, translucent. Right valve the larger. Cypris (Cyprinotus) amerkanus Cushman 1005. Length 1.50 mm., breadth 0.70 mm , height 0.80 mm. Colorless. Natatory setae reach to tips of terminal daws. Fourth segment of first leg with four short extra spines. Terminal segment of second leg constricted in the middle, and with two longitudinal rows of minute spines extending from the constriction to the tip. Furca nearly straight and about twenty times aa long aa wide. Ponds and ditches. Nantucket, Mass. CMrfafCj FlO. I: 30; <*) Donalview: fc) [A End of first leg si THE OSTRACODA 8x7 61 (60) Shell reticulated, thin, the spermaries showing through. Equivalve. Cypris (Cyprinotus) crena Turner 1803. j«*> ■ ' —j..^ Shell equi valve from above, wedge-shaped anteriorly. jQ?! 3fc» Binge line annate. Length 1.14 to 1.33 mm., height 0,6a to ftTT -:.'(h o.bs nun., widtho 50 to 0.60 mm. Yellowish green. Maril- fbg^^- r^j lary (pine smooth. Fourth segment of first leg not with four ^Sag^- .-.:•-;■ ?,- -:■ .jifc extra short spines. Furca curved, about ~gMr»" times u * wide. Mais common. Abundant in small weedy /^=^ ponds and canal basins. Ohio. Cyfris (CyfrimUu) on 62 (63) Furca normal, with two spines and two setae (Fig. 12780?). Subgenus Cypris . . 64 63 (62) Furca abnormal, the terminal seta missing (Fig. 1280c}. Paracypris New Subgenus . . 73 64 (65) Both spines of first maxillary process smooth 66 65 (64) Both spines of first maxillary process toothed (Fig. 1270 s). . . 68 66 (67) Shell bluish black, with two yellowish areas in region of eye-spot {Fig. 1275 a) Cypris (Cypris) virens Jurine i&2Q. Length 1.70 to 5.00 mm., height 0.00 to 1.00 mm. Shell covered with short hairs, and left valve slightly overlapping the right. Ventral edge flanged anteriorly. Natatory setae reach to tips of terminal daws. Dark to yellowish green. Furca. weakly S-shaped to straight and from eighteen to twenty times as long as average width, and its dorsal margin smooth. Very variable. Weedy poods; April to July. Massachusetts, Mexico, Ohio, Wisconsin. Cyfris (Cyfris) 67 (66) Shell bright, deep green, smooth, with minute punctures. Cypris (Cypris) altissima Chambers 1877. Length 0.80 mm., height 040 mm. Furca sinuous, its two terminal claws nearly same length. Pond fed by melt- ing snow, Mt. Elbert, Colorado. Altitude 12,000 feet. fas. 11)6. Cyfris (Cyfris) altiuima. Furca. 63 (60) Terminal three segments of first leg longer than two-thirds of its terminal claw (Fig. 1277 6) 70 69 (68) Terminal three segments of first leg shorter than two-thirds of its terminal claw 73 818 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 70 (71) Shell thin, and dirty to ocherous yellow. Cypris (Cypris) testudtnaria Sharpe 1807. Length 1.15 mm., height 0.7s mm., width 0.6s mm. Natatory setae just natch tips of terminal claws. Terminal diw of first leg one-sixth looser than the but three segments. Temriii J cluw of second leg Furca slightly curved, its dorsal edge ser- rate two-thirds its length, and sixteen to eighteen times as long u wide. Dona] ■eta two-thirds as long as terminal one, and width of ramus from subterminal claw. Terminal seta fully one-half as long as the terminal daw. Ejaculatory duct five times as long as wide, with spines thickly set ova the entire surface (Fig. 1177 c), instead of in wreaths, as is common. Ponds in woods. 7 1 (70) Shell dart green to chestnut brown with transverse lighter patches dor- solateral^ (Fig. 1278 a-*). Cy^rti (Cypris) fuscata Jurine 1820. Length 1.30 mm., height 0.80 to 0.05 mm., width 0.80 to o.Ss mm. Right shell overlaps left. Sparsely hairy. Terminal claws of first leg less than one-third longer than the last three segments. Furca weakly S-shaped to nearly straight, and from eighteen to twenty times as long as wide- Terminal seta of furca weak, not more than one- third as long as terminal claw; dorsal seta less than width of furca from subterminal claw and about one-half as long as the terminal seta. Sexual- Common everywhere in shallow, grassy ponds and swamps; April to June. variety major ; (a) Fnros, 1. ms. (OVariet: Shell dark green with two light patches in region of the eyes (Fig. 1279a) Cypris (Cyprii) reticulata Zaddich 1844. Length 1. 10 to 1.30 mm., height 0.73 mm., width Shell usually reticulate or tessriated. niperficialfy resembling Cyprii luteals major. Natatory setae reach slightly beyond the terminal claws. Furca straight, weakly hent near the end. and from ten to twelve tiroes as long as wide, and faintly toothed along the dorsal margin. Terminal seta, slender and of the same length as the dorsal one, which is situated about width of furca from subter- pools. Illinois, Massachusetts, ' New York, New Jersey. Dcjwdviiw, X n|i (*) Facta, X ij»t THE OSTRACODA 819 73 (74) Posterior margin of furca pectinate (Fig. 1280 c). Cyprts (Paracypris) perclegans Herrick 1887. Length 3.60 mm., height 1.72 mm., width 1.40 mm. Color dear pale yellow, with a sigmoid pattern in dear brown. Seen from above, the shell is acutely wedge-shaped anteriorly. From the side the upper and lower margins are nearly parallel, with a large projecting tooth postero- ventrally . Terminal segment of second leg with two small claws and one seta. Dorsal seta spine like. Weedy ponds. Alabama. Fig. 1280. Cyprts (Paracypris) perclegans. (a) Side view, X V (h) lxjrsal view; if) Furca. Posterior margin of furca plain (Fig. 1281c). Cyprts (Paracypris) grandis Chambers 1877. 74 (73) Length 3.60 mm., height 2.09 mm., width 1.30 mm. From above, shell regularly elliptical. Bluish white to pale greenish. Ponds along the Arkansas River, Colorado. Altitude 8000 feet. A doubtful form. Fig. 1281. CyPris (Paracypris) gramdis. (a) Side view, X 4; (0) Dorsal view; (c) Furca; id) Marillary palps of male. (After Chambers.) 75 (76) Terminal segment of second leg small, with two short claws, and a long reflexed seta (Fig. 1282 d). Second antenna of male with two sense organs on fourth segment. Cypria Zenker 1854 . . 77 76 (75) Terminal segment of second leg long and narrow, with short claw, and two long reflexed setae (Fig. 1200/). Second antenna of male without sense organs on the fourth segment. Cyclocypris Brady and Norman 1889 • • 89 77 (78) Right-valve margin not crenulate anteriorly. Valves about the same size (Fig. 12840-6). . . . Subgenus Cypria . . 79 78 (77) Right-valve margin crenulate anteriorly. Valves of decidedly differ- ent sizes (Fig. 1287 a-b). Subgenus Physocypria Vavra 1891 . . 87 79 (80) Terminal claws of second leg approximately equal (Fig. 1 282 d) . . 81 80 (79) Terminal claws of second leg evidently unequal (Fig. 1285 J). . . 8^ 820 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 8 1 (82) Terminal claws of furca not more than one-half as long as furca (Fig. 1283 b) 83 82 (81) Terminal claws of furca three-fifths as long as furca or longer (Fig. 1282 c) Cypria (Cypria) detUifera Sharpe 1897. Length 0.69 mm., height 0.38 mm., width 0.26 mm. Brownish yellow, with dark brown markings and reddish blotches. Right valve overlaps left anteriorly. Left- valve margins crenulate, anteriorly. Natatory setae reach length of antennae beyond tips of terminal daws. Terminal short claws of second leg approximately equal and as long as the terminal seg- ment. Furca stout, ten times as long as wide, its subterminal daw with a comb of remarkably long teeth. Males common. Algae- rich ponds. Illinois, Ohio, New York, New Jersey. Fig. 1282. . . , „ ,.»-.-• Cypria (Cypria) denti/era. («) Side view of left valve, X 30; (*) Dorsal view; (c) Furca; (d) End of second leg. 83 (84) Shell covered with a close reticulum of longitudinally subparallel lines (Fig. 1283 c). Abdomen without processes. Cypria (Cypria) exsctdpta Fischer 1855. Length 0.60 to 0.75 mm., height 0.38 to 0.42 mm., width 0.25 to 0.28 mm. Shell thin, covered with anasto- mosing subparallel lines. Color dear chestnut brown. Common in streams and ponds everywhere. Also com- mon in bottom tows in river chan- nels, lake and river shores. Caudal rami short, stout and much curved; both terminal claws smooth; dorsal setae situated slightly beyond middle of ramus. Distribution world wide. This spedes may be at once identi- fied by means of the reticulum of anastomosing subparallel lines on the valves. These may be readily with a two-thirds-inch objective. Fig. 128, HG. I2M. Cypria (Cypria) txsadpl*. (c) Dorsal view, X 45; (*) Furca; (c) Striatfans on shell; (4) Spfay cylinder of cjaculatory duct, to sack. THE OSTRACODA 821 84 (83) Shell plain, with small puncti. Abdomen with two cylindrical processes Cypria (Cypria) opthalmica Jurine 1820. Length 0.56 to 0.60 mm., height 0.36 to 0.40 mm., width 0.3 2 to 0.36 mm. Shell compressed, clear brown, with dark-brown patches ante- riorly and posteriorly and just back of eye-spot. Natatory setae very long, reaching beyond terminal claws by more than the entire length of the antenna. Furca about eight times as long as wide. Surface and bottom tows in river channels and lakes, and their shores; February to October. Also common in ponds and ditches where there is little or no vegeta- tion. Georgia, Illinois, Minnesota, Oregon. Fig. 12S4. Cypria (Cypria\ opthalmica. (a) Side view, X 4p; lb) Dorsal view; (c) Furca, X 137 J; (<*) Penis, X XQO- 85 (86) Shell clear to brownish yellow, with a few scattered puncta. Cypria (Cypria) obesa Sharpe 1897. Length 0.78 mm., height 0.48 mm., width 0.33 mm. Plump. Furca bent, about nine times as long as wide, its dorsal seta three times width of ramus from subterminal claw, and as long as the terminal seta. Males com- mon. In tow of .sandy lake shore; May. Illinois. Fig. 1285. Cypria (Cypria) obesa. (a) Dorsal view, X 45j (b) Furca; (c) Maxillary palps of male; (4) Second leg. 86 (85) Shell white, smooth, and shining, with numerous almost confluent puncta Cypria {Cypria) mons Chambers 1877. e Length 0.70 mm. A doubtful form, not well described. Colorado, Mt. Elbert. Altitude 1 1,000 feet Fig. 1286. Cypria {Cypria) mons. (a) Dorsal view; (6) Side view, X 16. (After Chambers.; 87 (88) Left shell higher than right. Terminal short setae of second leg about twice as long as the terminal segment (Fig. 1287). Cypria (Physocypria) pustulosa Sharpe 1897. Length 0.51 mm„ height 0.39 mm., width 0.22 mm. Clear brownish with dark patches. Extremities of shell hairy'- A decided dorsal flange on left valve (Fig. 12S7 a). Natatory setae three times as long as the distance be- tween the place of their insertion and tins of terminal claws. Furca two and two-fifth? length of terminal claw. Dorsal seta weak and situated about middle of furca. Bottom tow- in river channels, surface and bottom tows in lakes, and lake and river shores; April tc September. Illinois. 3>~ Fig. 1287 Cypria (Pkysacypria) pustulosa (a) Left valve, X 36; (b) Right' valve; (c) Fust kg; (0) Furca; («) Second lee. 22 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 3 (87) Left shell same height as right, but longer. Terminal short setae of second leg about as long as terminal segment. Cypria (Pkysocypria) inequivalva Turner 1893. Length 0.41 to 0.55 mm., height 0.3s to 0.38 mm., width 0.1b to 0.38 mm. Shell with irregular cross-shaped spots dorsoanttriorly and posteriorly. Furca curved, slender, its doraal seta rudimen- tary or absent. Mtles common. Amongst algae of shallow ponds. Ohio, Georgia. < 44) V) Dcnal view; <() Furca. Cypria iPhywcypria) intqttivalva. 89 (90) Dorsal seta of furca rudimentary or absent (Fig. 1289 c), Cydocypris laevis 0. F. Muller 1785. Length 0.4; >-JS 11 8 mm., width 0.14 to 0.1S mm.. Color lemon yellow to chestnut p, and left shell overlapping the red or horn bi _ _.__,. r,— «. .._. . right anteriorly. Furca stout, nearly straight, six times as long as wide. Terminal seta more than one-half length of terminal claw. Common in weedy streams, ponds, and swampy regions; April to November. Delaware, Indi- ana, Illinois, New York, New Jersey. Cyclecypris latetl. (a) DoimI vi fc; (»} Sid*vfew,X4j; 90 (89) Dorsal seta of furca plainly well developed. Terminal claws of furca strong, and much bent at tip (Fig. 1290 e). Cydocypris Jorbesi Sharpe 1897. Length 0.55 mm., width 0.36 nun., height 0.30 mm. A small form. Plump and sepia brown in alcohol. Natatory ' alcohol. Natatory setae four times length of terminal daws. Penulti- mate segment of second antenna with but one seta. Terminal seg- ment of second leg three-eighth* as long as the preceding segment (Fig. 1390/). Furca about eight times as long as wide. Both ter- minal daws strongly bent at tip, nearly smooth. Eight palp of sec- ond maxilla of male larger than the left one. Terminal seta about as long as width of furca. Males common. Ponds in woods; ApffL Illinois. (^^^^ SE CytUcyfrit farbtii. W Side view, * '- lb) Dorsal view; (c) Second — (fl MaiDUry parja of THE OSTRACODA 823 91 Terminal segment of second leg with three unlike setae, one of which is relleied (Fig. 1291 rf). . Subfamily C and on in ae . . 92 oa (94) Shell reticulate, very tumid. Small, plump forms, not more than 0.80 mm. long. Second antenna of both sexes five-segmented. Paracondma Hartwig 1899 . . 93 Shell profusely ornamented with polygonal areas and tubercles (Fig. i2oi a). Paracandona tupkctdla Brady and Norman 1889. Length 0.56 to 0.58 mm., height o_ mm., width 0.32 to 0.34 mm. Male «... larger. One terminal daw of mandibular palp fused to terminal segment (Fig. 1391 «). Furca stout, six times as long as wide. Dorsal seta about length of sub terminal claw. Terminal seta weak, scarcely evident. No other Can dona- like ostra- cod shows the ornamentation of polygonal areas and tubercles. The specific name very happily refers to the striking external appean low, swampy n~~~~ ~ J _J ' wlnu mtUdtU*. [»> Side view, X so; tb) Dor- view: ic) Furca; W Second leg; {«) Maodibulai 95 (96) Furca abnormal, terminal seta absent (Fig. uga 6). Typhlotypris Vejdovsky 188a . 96 (95) Furca normal, with 2 claws and a setae (Fig. 1294 b). Candona Haird 1850 . 97 (08) Furca nearly straight. Dorsal-valve margins evenly curved (Fig. 119a a-b) Typhhcypris peircei Taiaei 189s. Length 0.7010 0.79 mm., width o.ji too.31 mm., height 0.33 to 0.37 mm. Color white, tinged with yellow. Shell smooth, much compressed. Furca nearly straight, and about twelve times as bog as wide. Subtenninal claw more than two-thirds length of terminal one. Sexual. Ejaculatoryductof seven wborls of chitinous spines. Shallow, weedv ponds; June. Georgia. Fio. 1 824 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 98 (97) Furca decidedly curved. Dorsal-valve margins " humped " (Fig. 1293 a). ... Typhlocypris delawarensis Turner 1895. Length 0.95 mm., width 0.43 mm., height 0.54 mm. Color greenish yellow with brown blotches. Maxillary spines plain. Terminal claws of furca slender and plain. Furca slender and much curved. Creeks; March. Delaware. (A doubtful form, not well described.) Fig. Tyfhlocypris ddawarensis. (a) Side view, X 15; (b) Furca. Viidt 99 (100) Shorter seta of terminal segment of second leg outwardly flexed (Fig. 129401) Candona rcfiexa Sharpe 1897. Shell twice as long as high, cine- reous. Second leg five-segmented, its terminal segment as wide as long, and about one-third as long as the penultimate segment. Furca eight times as long as wide and slightly curved. Dorsal seta as long as sub- tenninal daw. This is the only Candona known with the peculiar, partly refkxed seta of the second foot, and it may be a characteristic of a young stage. Tows along lake shores along the bottom; April to November. Illinois. Fig. 1294. Candona refiexa. (a) Second leg; (6) Furca; (c) First leg. 100 (99) Shorter seta of terminal segment of second leg not outwardly flexed (Fig. 1296 b) 101 101 (102) Length of shell more than 1.50 mm. Candona crogmani Turner 1894. Length 1.52 mm., height 0.76 mm., width 0.58 mm. Shell thin, pellucid, inequivalve, greenish yellow. Max- illary spines plain. Second leg indistinctly segmented. Furca straight, ten times as long as average width, its terminal claws pectinate. Dorsal seta one-third length of furca from subterminal daw. Shallow, temporary ponds; December. Georgia. Fig. 1395. Candona crogmani. (a) Side view, X 15; (*) Dorsal view; (c) Furca. 102 (101) Length of shell not more than 1.50 mm 103 103 (104) Length of shell less than one mm 105 • i 104 (103) Length of shell more than one mm. 108 :v :.ti...i*»- THE OSTRACODA fc> 103 ;io6 Soofceaninai ciaw oi iurca ckooediy S-&hapcvi vlig- ijo6 a\ ip&mi Sharpe 1697. "si/ 1 1 1 irrb 0.75 mm-, awght cs.u mm., width 0.90 mrr. Yefiowish white. Lei: valve overlaps the ngh:. Upper and tower valve margin* nearly parallel Furca curved stouu seven times as long as wide with the subterminal ciaw acoekdry S-shapeL — i mariec character. Dorsal seta twice width of furci tram subusmmal cu«. and two-thirds its length. Bottom forms oi lakes and iiver shores, and ponds; spring and autumn. Hanoi:- Fim. i jot pumi. \a> Sidevw. X *?. ^- Secoodkc; ic; ieoond antenna; i*" Furca. io5 (105; 107 108 (109) IOQ (108) HO (ill) Siibterminai daw not S-shaped (Fig. 1297 c) 107 Shell with dorsal and ventral margins nearly parallel ^Fig. 1 jo: a). Candomi p%traUdc G. W. MUller 1900. Length 0.7S to 0.85 mm., height 0^2 to 0-40 mm., width 0.35 to 0.42 mm. Height to length about as 1 to 1 S. Furca straight, about seven times as long as wide, its terminal seta rudimentary, and its terminal claws doubly pectinate with unusual teeth. Dorsal seta about twice width of furca from subterminal claw. Second leg five-segmented. Swamp)' ponds; May. Colorado. Fig. ijqt. Cambmo pmntkia ia^ Side view. X 37); (*>) Second leg; (c) Furca; \4) Terminal daws of iurca. Furca plainly curved (Fig. 1301 b) 112 Furca not plainly curved, approximately straight (Fig. 1 298 d) . no Both claws of furca plainly S-shaped (Fig. 120S d). Candona sigmoides Sharpc 1807. Length of male 1..25 mm., height 1.03 mm. Second leg five-segmented. Furca long and straight, about twelve times as wide as average width. Dorsal seta about four times width of furca from subterminal claw. Fe- male not known. Lake and river shores; May and October. Illinois. Fig. ijqs L*md '. r dJBur^ vcgcu»ac:. iui La*:> art present pc&cuc&i.v ewwftcr:., jjdu :u xho^ uoair^ ■-■: \i\ii.:. ever: small «&v.i. u^c :t »rvrr«l ion::* n*~y i-c expeciec :».■ oar-: Certain jom*- .imnu*±:*j; traWiaao utt uvc jl* op*.m wa.isr. du: duitow in uirgruur.j, gvi:*£ uo>i. \o t:,r. ^ruj:»w-wuivr. uitir presence i- inCUCateO :t> pi:ra vi nil. j l>I\>U£i.l i»^l vl ;:it Hu;r- uxrcui fr^*c»:^. prdk.u.:tt.,y fc-lA u»rr ;:*c \vjr.«, iL..iLici:*4 i:.c ArctL. dui niiiura:.j» *.rc i*.A .l uuuuuuv* a: i:.t irup::- .1 nimirjcr <->: >;r«>u:jn *iifc o2aunv.:.y viu*ivu.ie!i&:.„v. o: icMajer^ic uuziiit^, di^a ;.: ics-Vi o-rtr kpjui. ^cii-:? s,^u*^.;u. crayit^, ;_- reaenre it? hignt>; utfvr«j»pni?:ii :Tk ^ot'.a -rUiicri... iLert Ju^^costTii... art iounc trvcrvwacri -. -: aafcr!"\ .;i i:iv uiicrej: jum;. wiu: :is srreal anc UiveraiLtTCi its'.: >w>ic: . ■ '1 i:~; ix^uiac n-U-er sLar-^ ol i:it wt>'.- trru iuojJi* c:fca ^ iv- ar.w r-j^T^., :.•-: i.rv j..i entire /* missing Uier-. 'ihv •u.-^'Jl-. *w;:.^ -;•- a**ipi^ iu uiiiert'^i surrounding; aur!*c prtit: *c4.r^c i.* •.■-.■., oUivra Lrcrt^t «jr pojiu^. ji sm-L pooi>. spring, fc-^v* c» t« n*> j LcrruJaf^ii wairr.- Tcey Ucxw:i^ 1^ »t-ry ca-acirui groups *.>: tiic subaati Maiaa^- ird.-. Tiit i^:icj: :*u:. jeva uivjueu. xl iiic mure recent svstemr. ii*iu ifx» ozut-r.-.. aru l»: iLiv^ Au^: pu2*e-r representaiive> in our r re *>u w^rir - ■: : jl a-jpu .. a -iiii pi*4 ju _ a . 1* I \ A^ a 'j 'j ^ . a i rU L> t* c aj >oci l» . Tiicst- cii!*-: ■»•.-.' j jj.:..i. Il li.v-j ^^ir; iciL.:-:;. i:. genera. shaiK- oi uo-jy. ?ii*-.. .yjv:. uii'- uei^i-- _•; lijorpiiviv^j . ^o in^: it i^ ban: ixj ^ivt u aii^ri ^"itt-r^- u.>u:" iv:. «..c:»U:iiv;-r.- a::., dwt. I;. u-t sniaiicr forms, the coiur i: gerier^i/. iir.'jii^»i.^'.ii.a. wiut^;. ..: gr^yi^. c»fien more or iesr iraii^purcM. !';,•. i^r^'er ionii- ^ti- ■. r4i.»n- di>iir:c: colors, whicii may :.»cn.»n\'- -jJa urila^;:; iiA ceri^ii. i>art> o: the hodv: the large Liaw.- o: 1;/. ^e::U.- Fiiljenw: pra\v:>" ari . ir. the male sex, oit'-ii *e^: :ji^'- ',r purj^'w. Tii'. cr;tyi^he> are. ii4 genera",, of preen- i.-ii '■: urowiu^ oL,- u:.*.-, [i.:i a- a ruie adult male- ;4re more viviiii^ ^uiurv — iiiu i:. ^uiit- apedes the aduh maic assumes a color 830 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY entirely different from the greenish female and young: lighter or darker red. At least two species are remarkable for their striking color in both sexes: one is red, the other is beautifully blue. The morphological characters of the Malacostraca are the follow- ing: The body is enclosed in a comparatively hard shell, which is articulated, forming a number of successive segments or somites, which have a very constant number. Each somite may be com- pared to a ring, which, however, is not completely circular, but the upper part, called tergum or tergite, is convex, while the lower, sternum or sternite, is rather flat. The two unite on each side, the tergite projecting over the sternite, and this projecting part is called the pleuron. All these parts (as well as the appendages) consist of a hornlike substance, called chitin, very often reinforced by a considerable amount of calcareous matter. In the anterior part of the body we have a headpiece, to which are added several more or less obscure somites that are chiefly indi- cated by their appendages. As the foremost appendage we may regard the eyes (e in Fig. 1303). These, however, may not be true appendages. Then follow two pairs of feelers, called antennulae (antf) and antennae (ant); one pair .of mandibles (mand), and two pairs (first and second) of maxillae (max). Behind these parts the segmented body begins, including fifteen somites, which all (barring reductions) bear appendages, with the exception of the last, the telson (t). According to the appendages, HIGHER CRUSTACEANS (MALACOSTRACA) $51 the body is distinctly divided into two parts: the anterior, thorax or trunk (tk), comprising the first eight somites; the posterior, abdomen (oW), with the six following (to which the telson is added). The appendages of the thorax are called thoracic limbs. Some or all of the first three of them are in many cases specialized as maxillipeds (maxp), and in this case the following five are called peraeopods {pcrp). The abdominal appendages are called pleopods {pip), but those of the last (sixth) pair are often differentiated in a peculiar way, so as to form with the telson a caudal fan, and in this case the name uropods (urp) is used for them. The detail-structure of the appendages of the different regions of the body is very different. The eyes (only doubtfully regarded as appendages) may be entirely sessile, or may be elevated upon short, subcylindrical, more or less movable eye-stalks. The an- tennulae have an articulated base, with one or two terminal, articu- lated branches (flagella). The antennae have an articulated basal part, with one terminal, articulated flagellum, and often the basal part has a lateral scalelike process: the antennal scale or scapho- cerite. The mandible consists of a more or less solid part, to which an articulated palpus may be attached. The maxillae are of various shapes, and are probably to be regarded as modified anterior thoracic appendages. They consist of an inner and an outer branch (endopodite and exopodite), which, however, are often augmented by certain parts belonging originally to the gill appa- ratus. The most marked difference is between the thoracic and the ab- dominal appendages. The former consist originally of a larger, seven-jointed inner branch (endopodite), and a smaller, articu- lated outer branch (exopodite), but the latter may be absent. The seven joints of the endopodite are rather constant, although some of them may become united, or others may be subdivided. They have received separate names, which are, from the proximal to the distal end: coxa, basis, ischium, merus, carpus, propodus, dactylus (or coxopodite, basipodite, etc.). In certain thoracic limbs, the last two joints (propodus and dactylus) assume a pecu- liar position, forming a chela (pinchers, claws) . 832 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The typical pleopods consist of a simple basal part, with two sub- equal, terminal, articulated branches. But in many cases differen- tiations and reductions are observed, the most important being that of the uropods, referred to above, and the transformation of certain pleopods into copulatory organs in the male. In certain forms (Mysidacea and Decapoda) the dorsal shell of the most anterior part of the body (head) is produced backward, and covers more or less the thoracic somites in the shape of a shield, curved down over the sides, which is called the cephalothorax or carapace (car). Very often the carapace has a median anterior projection, called the rostrum (r). The branchial apparatus of the Isopods is formed by the pleo- pods. In all other groups special appendages (gills) of the thoracic somites assume this function; they may be attached to the sides of the thorax, or to the basal parts of the thoracic limbs. The genital openings of the male are always originally on the coxopodite of the eighth trunk-leg (or fifth peraeopod), those of the female on the sixth (or third peraeopod), but in certain cases either one of these may shift to the sternite. All Malacostraca of the fresh water have separate sexes, and very often the males are distinguished by secondary sexual char- acters (size, color, development of claws). Copulation, or rather conjugation, seems to take place in all of them, although this has been observed in detail only in very few forms: it is best known in the crayfishes. Propagation is by eggs. In the smaller forms (Isopoda, Amphi- poda, Mysidacea), very little is known about propagation and development, and with regard to the North American forms of these groups investigations are altogether lacking. But from what is known of exotic, chiefly European, forms it is probable that in all the eggs are carried by the female for a certain period, before the young are set free. In the Isopods, the female develops during ' the breeding season peculiar lamellae at the base of some thoracic legs (four pairs in Asellus), which serve to cover and to hold the eggs. In the Amphipods and Mysidacea similar, but greatly variable, de- vices are present. In the Decapods, no such apparatus is known, «'r»'jf ■^■S^VAi." HIGHER CRUSTACEANS (MALACOSTRACA) 833 but here the eggs are attached to the pleopods and are carried under the abdomen of the mother till the young are ready to hatch. Within these brood-pouches the embryonal development takes place. After the young have reached a more or less advanced stage, they leave the egg, but always remain a certain time in the brood-room of the mother. In the Isopods (Asdlus) the young leave the egg at a rather early stage, and they have yet to undergo considerable changes; in the other groups the larva hatches in a more advanced stage, and the subsequent changes are slight. In none of our fresh-water crustaceans are free swimming larvae known, but these might be present in the families Atyidae and Palaemonidae, in which such have been observed in their allied marine forms. Of the life history of the Isopods, Amphipods, Mysidacea, and most of the Decapods, practically nothing is known. However, in the Decapod-genus Cambarus (crayfishes) more complete informa- tion is at hand. After hatching, the young crayfishes remain for a short time with the mother, but soon leave her, and grow in the beginning at a rather rapid rate, each increase in size being connected with a moulting of the shell. Later, they grow less rapidly, and, after the first summer, we may distinguish, in general, a spring and an autumn moult. The total length of life seems to be several years: four, five, or even more. Sexual maturity may be reached within the first year, at least in some species. Males and females attain about the same size, but in most species (except the burrowing) the male possesses much stronger chelae than the female. A very peculiar difference is found among the males, which at first was believed to be dimorphism, but has now been recognized as alternating conditions in the life of the same individual. Males of the first form have been distinguished from males of the second form; the former is the fully developed and sexually potent form, while the latter is an impotent form. Generally speaking the first form is assumed by the male in autumn, and lasts through the winter (copulating season), while the other is assumed in spring, and lasts through the summer. Young males, in their first summer, are always of the second form. The difference between these two forms is seen in the sexual organs : in the .nales of the second form 834 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY these organs are softer, the homy tips are undeveloped, and the copulatory hooks on the ischiopodites of the peraeopods are small. According to the general rule, that the males assume the first form in autumn, the copulating season falls in the autumn, and copulation may be repeated in the winter months. The male seizes the female and holds it, sternites against sternites, chiefly by the aid of the hooks of the ischiopodites of the peraeopods. The sperm is discharged and stored in the female's annulus ven- tralis, a pocket on the thoracic sternum, which thus serves as receptaculum seminis. Oviposition takes place later, generally in spring. This seasonal cycle, as described, is not observed in all species, but there are some, in which the alternation of the two forms of the male is irregular and not connected with the seasons, and where copulation and oviposition are also irregular. It has been found that regularity of the annual cycle is connected with a habi- tat in water which is subject to regular and considerable seasonal changes of temperature (species living in rivers and ponds), while irregularity of the life-cycle is found among those which live pref- erably in water with slight temperature changes and that at the same time is rather cool (species of mountain streams and of cool springs or groundwater). The fresh-water Malacostraca depend entirely upon the presence of water, and cannot leave the water as a rule. This holds good for the Isopoda; Amphipoda, and Mysidacea, and also for the Atyidae and Palaemonidae among the Decapoda. In the water, the Isopods (except the parasitic forms) crawl around on the bottom, under stones, or climb among water weeds, but do not move by swimming. The Amphipods are very lively in their movements, which consist chiefly of swimming, often lying upon the side. The swimming is often done in jerks, by curving and stretching the compressed body. They move also by climbing among water weeds, but hardly ever by crawling. All Mysidacea are distinctly swim- ming forms, and so are the Atyidae and Palaemonidae among the Decapods, while the movements of the crayfishes are of various kinds, but fall under two main heads: crawling and swimming. The first is the general mode of locomotion. It is not very rapid *. . -;.Jftfell5jteitfi. HIGHER CRUSTACEANS (MALACOSTRACA) 855 M>H may take place in all three directions: forward, backward, and sideward. More rarely the crayfishes move by swimming, and chiefly so when alarmed and trying to escape; this swimming is always backward, and is effected by quickly repeated strokes of the abdomen. This kind of locomotion, however, is kept up only for short distances. With regard to the habitat, not much detail is known in the iso- pods and amphipods. They seem to prefer more quiet bodies of water, small streams and springs, to the larger rivers. Some of them are not very particular as to their habitat, and consequently possess a very wide geographical distribution, while others are very restricted, possibly on account of special habitat preferences. The only Mysidacean found in North America (My sis rdida) inhabits the Great Lakes to a considerable depth (as do two species of the Amphipod-genus Panioporeia). The genus Palaemon of the Deca- pods is known only from our largest rivers (Mississippi and Ohio). In the genus Cambarus, very complex conditions are observed and the different species differ considerably in their ecology. Al- though they all need water for their existence, it is a general rule that all crayfishes are able to leave the water temporarily, and some may stay out of the water for a considerable time, and do so habitually. Of course, in order to moisten their gills, they always have to return to the water. In the water, the crayfishes try to hide, either under rocks, logs, water weeds, etc., or they construct artificial hiding places (holes and burrows). The latter tendency is, as will be seen, especially developed in certain ecological groups. In connection with this tendency to hide probably is the fact that the crayfishes seem to be more or less nocturnal. With regard to their ecological preferences, different types have been distinguished in the genus Cambarus, These are the fol- lowing: 1. Species living in quiet waters: slowly running, large rivers, ponds, lakes. To this group belongs chiefly the subgenus Cam- bar us y and its distribution over the coastal plains and the interior basin expresses this ecological habit, since here such conditions are pre-eminently found. But certain species of the subgenus Faxomus 836 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY also prefer these surroundings. These species are content with hiding under other objects, and make holes only incidentally. 2. Species living preferably in water with a rather strong current. (a) Species of the larger rivers. The subgenus Faxonius is typi- cal for this habitat, and the location of its center of distribution in the central basin with its large rivers expresses this. (b) Species living in small streams of the uplands. The repre- sentatives of this habitat belong chiefly to the subgenus Bartonius, and its distribution over the Appalachian Mountains and the Alle- gheny and Cumberland Plateau clearly indicates this. Of course, there are all transitions between habitats (a) and (6), as many of the river species go well up into the head-waters, and vice versa. Yet the original differentiation in the habitat of the subgenera Faxonius and Bartonius is very evident. All these spe- cies in running water are good burrowers, and they generally ex- cavate holes under protecting stones, etc. In some of the species from the mountain streams this faculty of burrowing is rather highly developed, and leads us to the next ecological type. . 3 . Burrowing species (' ' chimney builders ' ') . These species have retired from the open water into the ground water, and one may understand the origin of this peculiar habit by imagining that forms in the small upland streams, with well-developed burrowing faculties, were forced, in periods of draught, when the streams in- habited by them began to dry up, to dig down in the bed into the gravel and mud, to reach the water. Or one may imagine, that they ascended in the streams up to the sources, and went under ground, where the water appears in the shape of springs. In a number of species this tendency has been carried to an extreme, and it is known that these live habitually under the surface of the earth, in the ground-water, where they excavate more or less com- plex systems of holes, burrows, or tunnels, which open upon the surface in one or mor^ openings. These burrows are built by the crayfish, by using the chelae in digging (hence the similarity of the chelae in both sexes), and the material removed, mud, clay, etc., is carried to the surface, where it is piled up. around the mouth of the burrow in irregular or regular piles, generally known by the name of "mud chimneys. " These burrows and chiefly the mud HIGHER CRUSTACEANS (MALACOSTRACA) 837 chimneys have attracted much attention, and the idea has been advanced that the chimneys are constructed by the crayfish for a certain definite (useful) purpose. But recent investigations seem to point to the conclusion that the regular shape of the chimneys, when present, is accidental, and the mud piles are nothing but the natural product of the burrowing, disposed of in the most con- venient way (around the mouth of the hole) . The burrows them- selves are rather irregular, more or less complex, and consist of simple tunnels, often branching, and one or more pockets, or widen- ings of the tunnel. They go down into the ground from one to several feet, but always deep enough as to contain ground-water, at least at the bottom. Burrowing species are found chiefly in the subgenus Bartonius, and form a very well defined morphological group, and it is just this group of this subgenus, which has spread out from the original territory (the mountains), and has descended into the plains. On the western and southwestern plains is found another group of burrowers which belong to the subgenus Cambarus. Another special ecological group should not be forgotten. These are the cave species. With the exception of the Mysidacea, all our fresh-water Malacostraca have developed certain forms which are adapted to the life in subterranean waters, and live in caves, springs, artesian wells, etc. This peculiar habitat has affected their structure greatly, and the most important and interesting feature is the loss of the eyes. Some of these forms are entirely blind, having lost the visual elements of the eyes (cornea and pig- ment), while in others the reduction is only partial. Among the Isopods, the only North American fresh-water form, belonging to the Cirolanidae, is a blind subterranean form (Ciro- lanides texensis, Fig. 1304). Of the Asellidae, some live in caves and have suffered the loss of the eyes. This is especially true of the genus Caecidotea, the species of which have been found in caves of Virginia, Georgia, Tennessee, Kentucky, Indiana, Illinois, and in subterranean waters in Texas. Mancasellus, which possesses eyes, has often been found in caves or in streams issuing from caves; it also lives in the Great Lakes. 838 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The fresh-water Amphipods are remarkable for the development of eyeless cave forms; in fact, there is a strong tendency among them toward underground life. Of the 20 species known, 10 or 11 seem to be inhabitants of caves, wells, or springs. Not all of them have the eyes reduced, but the species of the geneTa.Crangonyx,Stygonectes9 and Apocrangonyx are actually blind, and there is a blind species in each of the genera Eucrangonyx and Gammarus, while the other species of these two genera show all transitional stages from well- developed eyes to more or less reduced eyes. The correlation be- tween subterranean life and reduction of the eyes is very evident in this group. The only species of the decapod-family Atyidae found in the United States, Palaemonias ganteri (Fig. 13 11), is a blind cave-form, and it was discovered only recently (1901) in the waters of Mam- moth Cave in Kentucky. This form has eye-stalks, but the visual elements of the eye are gone. This is an extremely interesting form on account of its primitive structure as well as its geographical relations. Most of the members of this family, which is strictly a fresh-water group, are found in the tropical and subtropical regions of both hemispheres, but a form very closely allied to the American is known from caves in Carniola, Austria. In the family Palaemonidae is included Palaemonetes antrorum, which was discovered in an artesian well in Texas. Also this species is provided with eye-stalks, but the eyes themselves are obliterated. Within the genus Cambarus of the family Potamobiidae, five cave species are known. They are all blind, but the eye-stalks re- main. These species belong to different subgenera, and the best known is the famous blind crayfish of Mammoth Cave in Ken- tucky (Cambarus pellucidus), which is also found in other caves in Kentucky and in Indiana. It belongs to the subgenus Fax- onius, and represents a rather ancient type, so that we are jus- tified in regarding it as an old immigrant into the subterranean waters. Three species (C. hamukUus, C. setosus, and C. ayersi) belong to the subgenus Bartonius, representing a primitive section of it. The first of these is found in Nickajack Cave in eastern Tennessee, while the two others are from caves in the Ozark region in Missouri. These three species also must be old immigrants into ■s-*%M**,& HIGHER CRUSTACEANS (MALACOSTRACA) 839 the caves. The fifth of the blind species is C. ac her otitis, found in caves in Florida. This belongs to the subgenus Cambarus, and is a member of a rather highly advanced section of the subgenus which is common on the coastal plain, and is to be regarded as a more recent addition to the cave fauna. The economic value of the fresh-water Malacostraca is very different in the different groups. While the isopods, amphipods, and Mysidacea are small, the decapods are larger, but also of these the Atyidae and certain Palaemonidae attain only a medium size. These groups naturally have only an inferior value for man, and are generally overlooked and neglected. Of the larger forms, certain species of P (daemon (prawns, also called shrimps) , and the crayfishes have attracted attention, and are used by man, pri- marily as food. Although this is generally the case in Europe and with a number of tropical forms, in North America they are not very popular, and are only occasionally eaten; yet there is no doubt that Poiamobius and Cambarus are to be regarded as part of the natural food supply of this country. Other uses, for instance as fish bait, should be mentioned incidentally. On the other hand, some kind of damage or injury done to man or man's work has also been noticed in so far as certain burrowing species are liable to damage dams or levees, or to interfere with farming operations. The latter species are also reported to be injurious to crops, chiefly to sprouting plants. In the general economy of nature, all the higher crustaceans perform a twofold task. First, on account of their general habit of devouring masses of decaying vegetable and animal matter, they are to be counted among the scavengers, and second, they themselves serve as food for other animals. They are most impor- tant as fish-food, and even the larger forms are eaten by the larger fishes. In addition, a number of other creatures feed upon them (amphibians, water snakes, birds, and certain mammals). Collecting Malacostraca is comparatively easy: the chief thing is to ascertain their whereabouts. This is done along the banks of streams, ponds, or lakes by turning over stones or logs, by investigating overhanging banks, or examining bunches of water 840 FRESfi-WATER BIOLOGY weeds. The smaller forms may be taken in numbers by transfer- ting water weeds, dead leaves or other rubbish found on the bottom into tubs or dishes, and picking out the specimens with a pair of pincers. The larger forms must be caught by hand, or with a small dip-net (minnow netting). For many forms the seine is a very successful implement. In collecting the burrowing crayfishes special efforts are neces- sary. It sometimes happens that the crayfish can be induced to come to the mouth of its hole by destroying the entrance. But generally the collector should not hesitate to go after the crayfish by digging it out Of course, a spade or shovel is most efficient, although often too heavy to be carried along, but a strong garden- ers' trowel is very convenient: the best tool is a so-called pioneers' bayonet. With this the ground should be loosened around the hole, and the dirt be taken out with the hands, care being taken always to follow the direction of the hole. By digging deep enough (1 to 3 feet), finally the pocket will be reached, in which the cray- fish lives, and then it may be taken out. Preservation should always be in alcohol. Formalin should be avoided, except in cases of necessity.' Even then the specimens should never be left in the formalin for a long time: it hardens them too much, makes all the appendages brittle, and renders them unfit for safe handling. The best results are obtained by lulling them in weak alcohol and transferring them into stronger (2 to 3 changes), until they finally are in 75 to 80 per cent alcohol: when so treated all appendages remain soft and flexible as in life. For scientific study no special work is required in the case of the larger forms, and all systematic characters may be seen with the bare eyes or by the use of a hand-lens. In the smaller forms it is necessary to study the appendages separately. They should be teased out under a dissecting microscope (using two pairs of pincers) and mounted in the usual way upon microscopic slides. Care should be taken that the appendages are taken out in the proper order, so that they do not become mixed. For the micro- scopic investigation a very low power is sufficient. 1 ■-* - HIGHER CRUSTACEANS (MALACOSTRACA1 841 KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER MALACOSTRACA 1 {26 Without carapace bu: hrs* thoracic j»omiu- coalesced with the head. Eyes ^wiicii present, aessik-. Thoracic limbs without exopo- diic- urs: pair modiiiec: a^ maxillipeut . . 2 2 (11; Body depressed. l,icopod> birarnou^. uniform in shape, with excep- tion o: tht uropodb and the anterior pairb of the male. Order Isopoda 3 3 (4 Uropods lateral, iorming with the teL>on a laii-fan. Familv Cikolanidae. Only one genus and one species in the United States. Cirolanidts texctisis Benedict 1896. This i? a blind lorn., which ha*, beeu found in un arte- I sia: wel! i: TcXu.- Al! other representatives of this > iamiiv an ma rim Many of them are ectoparasites un \ fio. i.jo,. Ciroianiut: uxtn>u Benedict. X 4. (After RkharcL»on.N 4 (3) Uropods inserted at the posterior end of the telson, not iorming a tail- ian. 5 5 (10) Pleopods covered by a thin opercular plate, the modihed hrst pair. Body symmetrical. Free hying. Family Asei.i.idal . . 6 This ^ a typical fresh- water iamih . 6 (7/ Mftpriihl^ without a palp. Last six pairs of thoracic legs with dacty- - lus biunguicuiaie. . Mancascllus Harger. Five species, living in springs and cavei, some in river:* and lake?. Eyes present in all. but small. 7 (6 J Mandibles with a three-jointed palp. Last six pairs of thoracic legs with dactylus uniunguiculate 8 8 (q^ Eyes present. Head narrower than the hrst thoracic segment. Telson not longer than broad Ascllus Geofiroy. . y^ Seven species in rivers, creeks, ponds, ditches. springs, lake- Some a^ Asellus communis Say^ widely distributer!, other- mure local. Common in pond', ditche.-. etc.. li'.nu: amung decaying vegeta- ble matter. lie. 1305. Aicllu: communis Say. X -. (Alter South.) */ ■}^.r ■'-■ $42 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 9 (8) Eyes wanting. Head not narrower than the first thoracic segment. Telson much longer than broad. . . Caecidotea Packard. Four spedes, in caves, springs issuing from caves, and artesian wells. io (5) Pleopods not covered by an opercular plate. Body of female pecu- liarly deformed, unsymmetrical, that of the male more or less normal and symmetrical. Parasitic upon higher crus- taceans Family Bopyridae. Only one genus in the North American fresh waters. Probopyrus Giard and Bonnier. known from the fresh water of North America, enters with its hosts, bang fount! parasitic upon the gills and in the gill cav- ities of Decapods of the genera Paiaemo- tules and Palatum*. Three species are known, and are found along the Atlantic coast from New Banaphtra to Florida, and in the Mississippi River in Louisiana. (3) Body compressed. Pleopods divided into two sets, the first three pairs with multiarticular^ rami, the last two pairs generally similar to the uropods, with unsegmented rami. No sexual modification of pleopods in the male. Order Amphipoda . . is Antennulae with secondary flagellum. Telson cleft or entire. . . 13 13 (14) Fifth peraeopods shorter than the preceding. Second maxillipeds smaller than the first. Uropods with two nearly equal rami Family Lysianassidae. Only one fresh-water genus in North America. . Pontoporria Kroyer. the lakes at the clow of the (Aha Smith.) 14 (13) Fifth peraeopods longer than the preceding. Second maxillipeds generally larger than the first. Uropods with two unequal rami or without rami. . . . Family Gahmakidae. . 15 A family represented both in the sea and in fresh water, and containing a great number of 15 (30) Telson cleft Uropods biramous 16 HIGHER CRUSTACEANS (MALACOSTRACA) 843 17 (18) Outer ramus of third uropods uniarticulate. Eutrangonyx Stubbing. Five spedes in known, living in ponds, springs, and wrJIa. Eye* either well developed or more or M rudimentary. One species is blind. 18 (17) Outer ramus of third uropods biarticulate Nipharpa Hay. A «inglc species in caves in Tennessee, with Che eyes wanting or very rudimentary. ig (16) Inner ramus of uropods not rudimentary, one-half or three-fourths as long as the outer. Telson cleft to the base or nearly so. Gammarus Fabririiis. s, two of them (C. ji ■nou 'Smith), rather at s, and smaller bodies of water. The other species are more local. Eyes (Alter Smith.) 10(15) Telson entire 21 21 {24) Third uropods with rami 23 22 (23) Third uropods uniramus. Telson short and broad. Crangonyx Bate. Three species are known, all without eyes, living in caves and wells, and with very local distribution {Kentucky, Indiana, Connecticut, Wisconsin). 23 {22) Third uropods biramous, inner ramus rudimentary, outer uniarticu- lar. Telson long Stygonectes Hay. Only one blind species, found in an artesian well in Texas. 24 (21) Third uropods without rami Apocranganyx Stebbing. One species, blind, from a welt in Illinois. 25 (12) Antennulae without secondary flagellum. Telson entire. Third uro- pods uniramous Family Orchesthdae. Tins family is abundantly represented in the sea. Only one genus and species in the fresh water of North America. Hyaielia knickerbocktri (Bate) 1862. This species possesses a very wide range, and is found in rivers, ponds and lakes from Maine to Florida and Cali- fornia (and extends southward into Cen- tral America). This genus (ffvoMla) is remarkable for the (act that all its spe- cies are found exclusive! v in fresh water and are restricted to North and South Fie. ijog. Hyoldla faucterSKfcri Bate. 36 (1) With a carapace. Eyes upon movable eye-stalks. Thoracic limbs with or without eiopodites, one, two, or three of the ante- d as maxillipeds 37 844 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 27 (28) Carapace coalesced dorsally with not more than three of the thoracic somites. Thoracic limbs with natatory exopodites, first pair modified as maxillipeds. Pleopods more or less re- duced and greatly different in the two sexes. Eggs carried in a brood pouch at the base of the thoracic legs. Order Mysidacea. This order forms part of the old division Schizopoda. The Mysidacea live chiefly in salt water. The system of this group needs a thorough revision, and no satisfactory division into larger groups (families) has been published. Only species in North America. . . . Mysis relicia Lov6n 1862. Fig. 13 10. Mysis relic'.a Loven. X 2. (After Smith.) Very few Mysidacea are known from the fresh water, and the present is identical with a species living in lakes in northern Europe (Ireland, Scandinavia, Russia). It is found, in North America, under similar conditions, in the lakes Superior and Michigan, down to a considerable depth (150 fathoms). In Europe, this form has been much discussed, and, as the name indicates, was supposed to point to a former connection between the sea and the lakes in which it lives. It was Delieved that these lakes were cut off from the sea and became fresh-water lakes, but retained part of the original marine fauna adapted to the fresh-water conditions: these animals were called "marine relics," and Mysis relicia was taken for one of the most prominent examples of this kind. How- ever, this theory has been greatly shaken recently, and, as far as it concerns the North American stock of Mysis r dicta, there is no reason to assume that it is a marine relic, but we are to regard it as an immigrant into the Great Lakes in glacial times (as Lysianassa). 28 (27) Carapace coalesced dorsally with all of the thoracic somites. Tho- racic limbs rarely with exopodites, the first three pairs modi- fied as maxillipeds. Pleopods not much reduced, and not very different in the two sexes, except the anterior ones. Eggs carried under the abdomen, attached to the pleopods. Order Decapoda . . 29 20 (34) Body and rostrum compresssed. Pleura of second abdominal somite overlapping those in front. First two pairs of perae- opods chelate. Anterior pleopods of the male not trans- formed into copulating organs 30 HIGHER CRUSTACEANS (MALACOSTRACA) 845 30 (31) Chelae of peraeopods weak, subequal, fingers with terminal hair- tufts Family Atyidae. Only species in North America. . . Palaemonias garUeri Hay 1903. A typical and char- acteristic fresh-water group, abundant in the tropics, but certain forms are found in tern- perate regions, and their distribution is quite peculiar, they being found at rather isolated localities, re- mote from each other. This discontinuity is a mark of antiquity of the group. One of _ D . , .„ w /*fa tt x these isolated forms is Fig. 131 1. Palaemomas gantert Hay. X 1. (After Hay.) found in North Amer- ica, Palaemonias gmmkri Hay, and is blind, living in Mammoth Cave in Kentucky. The nearest place where related forms are found is in the West Indies. 31 (30) Chelae of peraeopods inequal, the second pair larger, often much larger, than the first, and very strong. Fingers without terminal hair-tufts. . . . Family Palaemonidae . . 32 A family abundant in the sea, but also of great importance in the fresh water. All transi- tional stages between life in the sea and in fresh water are found here. 32 (ii) Mandible without palpus. Second pair of peraeopods only slightly larger than the first, both of them rather weak. Size of body medium Palaemonetes Heller. Contains a number of species which live in salt and brackish water. One of them {P. vulgaris Say) is found along our Atlan- tic coast. Other species have become true fresh-water forms: Two have been described from the United States: P. paludos* Gibbes and P. exUipes Stimp- Fic. m 1 2 . ralaemoncks exUipes Stimpson. X i . (After Smith.) son, both from Carolina, but they are supposed to be identical. This form has al>o been found in Florida, in the Illinois River, and in Lake Erie. 33 (32) Mandible with palpus. Second pair of peraeopods, in the male, excessively developed, very long (often longer than the whole body), with strong chelae. Size of body considerable. Palaemon Fabridus. This genus (sometimes, but erroneously, called Bitkynis) is extremely abundant in the fresh water of the tropics. Only one species is recorded from the United States: £^jMUU9 Smith, ••■^ which is found in the Mississippi and lower Ohio Rivers (up to Cannelton. Ind.). Little j more is known about this species than that it exists and that ft is locally used as food. (Not / even a figure of it has been published.) / MacEOI ft*CMiUl*t OMIOH 846 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 34 (30) Body subcylindrical in its anterior part, abdomen depressed. Ros- trum depressed. Pleura of second abdominal segment not overlapping those in front. First three pairs of peraeopods chelate, the first pair much larger than the others. Family Potamobiidae . . 35 Ad delusive fresh-water family of old age, and the most important group of higher crusta- ceans in the fresh waters of North America. Its general distribution includes Europe, north- eastern Asia, North and Central America. Id the United States two genera are found: one, containing a few species, is believed to be identical with the European genus (Polamobiui); the other (Cambanu) is restricted to America, and has very many species. The differences of these genera are found chiefly in the sexual apparatus. In the southern hemisphere, in Australia, New Zealand, South America, and Madagascar this family is represented by an allied one, Parastacidae while iu the tropical belt similar forms are missing. This peculiar distribution has given origin to much speculation, and chiefly the close affinity of the southern forms has been introduced as evidence for the former connection of the southern continen ts. Through Huxley's book (1880) this family has become a standard group for biological study. 35 (36) Male copulatory organs rather simple. Peraeopods of male without hooks on the ischiopodite. Female without receptaculum seminis. A plcurobrancbia present on the last thoracic somite. Potomobius Leach. called Astacus. .. r ,., — _ _ North America, the range of which is on the western Pacific slope, from California to British Columbia. One species (P. gambdi Girard), has crossed the continental divide in the region of Yellowstone Park, and is found od both sides in the drainages of the upper Columbia River and of the upper Missouri. The European species (about six) have frequently been subjects of systematic, ana- tomical, biological, and cmbryologicat studies. The heat known species Is the common crayfish of Central Europe, Polo. mobim aitaciu [Linnaeus). HIGHER CRUSTACEANS (MALAOOSTRACA) 847 36 (35) Male copulatory organs more or less complex. Some peraeopods of the male with hooks on the ischiopodite. Female with receptaculum semims (annulus ven traits) upon the sternum of the thorax. No pleurobrancbiae present. Cambarus Erichson . . 37 . s between seventy and eighty spedes, which fill into six sub- genera, four of which are represented in the United States. The geographical distribution of the ■ '"■ of Cambana is very interesting, : habit-preferences of the s Besides the four subgenera t rested here, two others have been distinguished {Para- cambanu sod Precambanu), but they do not possess represents lives in the United States. 37 (44) Sexual organs of male with more than two tips 38 38 (43) Third, or third and fourth, peraeopods of the male with hooks on the ischiopodite. Sexual organs of male blunt or truncated, with one soft tip, and several short, homy teeth. Subgenus Cambarus Ortmann . . 39 Distribution: Chiefly southern and southwestern in the United States. 3Q {43) Male with hooks on third peraeopods 40 40 {41) Areola narrow. Chelae elongated. Section of Cambarus simulans Faxon 1884. The mb k the posterior, median di bound the lateral (branchial) lespou. Tl Two species in the southwestern United States and Mexico. 41 (40) Areola obliterated in the middle. Chelae short and broad. Section of Cambarus gracilis Bundy 1 848 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 42 (39) Male with hooks on the third and fourth peraeopods. Chelae elon- gated. . . . Section of Cambarus Uandingi Harlan 1830. About seventeen species, falling into four groups, distributed over the Atlantic and Gulf coastal plain, and passing up the Mississippi valley into the interior basin. C. Uandingi (Harlan) is the type species of this group and of the whole genus. Its distribution covers practically all of the range of the section. The other species are more local, and some of them are probably mere local races. The blind species, C ackerontis Loennberg, from Florida, belongs here. Species of lakes, ponds, or sluggish rivers, avoiding strong current. Fig. 1315. Cmmbams (Cambarus) Uandingi Harlan. Copulatory organ of male. X 4- (After Faxon.) In other species, the horny tips of these organs are more or less different, and furnish important specific characters. 43 (38) Second and third peraeopods of the male with hooks on the ischiopo- dite. Sexual organs of male with one soft, and two horny, elongated points Subgenus CambarcUus Ortmann. Only one species is found in the United States: C. shufeldti Faxon, from Louisi- ana; a few more species are known from Mexico. This species appears to be geographically isolated from its related forms (in Mexico). Fig. 13 16. Cmmbams (Cambardhu) SkufddH Faxon. Copulatory organ of male. X 4. (After Faxon.) 44 (37) Sexual organs of male with two tips, one soft, the other horny. 45 45 (50) Sexual organs rather slender, the terminal tips more or less elongated, straight or gently curved. Ischiopodite of third peraeopods of male with hooks, rarely also that of fourth. Subgenus Faxonius Ortmann . . 46 Distribution: Pre-eminently in the large rivers of the central basin (Mississippi and Ohio, and their tributaries). Very few species have reached the Atlantic drainage system. 46 (47) Sexual organs of male with the tips free only for a short distance. Hooks on third, or on third and fourth, peraeopods. Section of Cambarus limosus Rafinesque 1817. Fire species, of which C. limosus (Rafinesque) (very generally called C. ajfinis Say, which name, however, is a synonym) is the best known: it is found on the Atlantic side of the Alle- ghenies in rivers, ponds, canals, from New York and Pennsylvania to Virginia. The allied species are found at a great distance from this in Kentucky, Indiana, and Missouri, and among them is the blind cave-species C. peUucidus (Tellkampf). 47 (46) Sexual organs of male with the free tips longer. Hooks on third peraeopods only 48 ^■3 f fat. iJHf, HIGHER CRUSTACEANS (MALACOSTRACA) 849 48 (49) Tips of sexual organs rather straight. Section of Cambarus propinquus Girard 1852. About ten species belong here, but some of them are mere local races. The most important ones are C. propinquus Girard, and C. rusticus Girard, both found in the larger and smaller rivers of the interior basin. The other forms also belong to these river systems, but extend also into the lower Mississippi drainage, to the Atlantic side in Georgia and South Carolina, and to the Great Lakes and the St. Lawrence system. Fio. 131 7. Cambarus (Faxonius) rusticus Girard. Copulatory organ of male. X 4- (After Faxon.) A species characteristic for the lower Ohio and its tributaries. In other species the copulatory organs are more or less different. 49 (48) Tips of sexual organs gently, but distinctly, curved. Section of Cambarus virilis Hagen 1870. Twelve species are known, but again some may be only local forms. C. virilis Hagen pos- sesses a wide range in the rivers of the central basin from Arkansas and Kansas to Canada. A very abundant species is C. immunis Hagen, which prefers stagnant, often temporary, pools of the western prairies. The other species are found chiefly in the lower Mississippi drainage in Mississippi, Arkansas, Kansas, Oklahoma. 50 (45) Sexual organs rather stout, terminal tips rather short, strongly re- curved. Ischiopodite of third peraeopods of male with hooks Subgenus Bartonius Ortmann . . 51 Distribution: Chiefly in and near the Appalachian Mountains, but some species on the coastal plain and the western plateau. 51(52) Eyes rudimentary. Chelae subelongated. Carapace subcylindrical. Section of Cambarus hamulatus Cope and Packard 1881. Three cave species belong here (see p. 837). 52 (51) Eyes present. Chelae subovate. Carapace more or less ovate. . 53 53 (54) Rostrum with marginal spines. Section of Cambarus extraneus Hagen 1870. Three species, rather local in Kentucky, Tennessee, Northern Alabama, and Northern Georgia. 54 (53) Rostrum without marginal spines 55 55 (56) Areola wide, or a little narrower. Section of Cambarus bartoni Fabricius 1798. About four species, distributed over the Appalachian Mountains, where they live in mountain streams, descending more or less toward the lowlands. The best- known form is C. bartoni (Fabricius) (Figs. 13 14 and 13 18), which covers the whole range of the section, and has developed a number of more or less well defined local races. Fig. 13 18. Cambarus {Bartonius) bartoni Fabricius. Copulatory organ of male. X 4. (After Hagen.) In this subgenus, the shape of this organ is rather uniform in all species, which is in strong contrast to the variability seen in the other subgenera. 850 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 56 (55) Areola very narrow, linear, or entirely obliterated. Section of Cambarus diagenes Girard 1852. Five species, all burrowing forms and chimney builders. Some (the more primitive forms) are found in the Appalachian Mountains and upon the Allegheny and Cumberland Plateau; others have descended to the Atlantic coastal plain,, and have spread over the interior basin, and westward to the Rocky Mountains* so, for nwranrr, C. diagenes Girard. Again other species are local forms of the lowlands. IMPORTANT PAPERS ON NORTH AMERICAN HIGHER CRUSTACEA Andrews, E. A. 1904. Breeding Habits of Crayfish. Amer. Nat., 38: 165- 206. Embody, G. C. 19 12. Distribution, Food and Reproductive Capacity of Same Fresh -Water Amphipods. Int. Rev. ges. Hydrobiol., BioL Suppl. IH. 27 pp. Faxon, W. 1885. A Revision of the Astaddae. Mem. Mus. Comp. Zool. Harvard, 10: 1-186. Hagen, H. A. 1870. Monograph of the North American Astaddae. 111. Cat. Mus. Comp. Zool. Harvard, No. 3; 109 pp. Harris, J. A. 1003. An Ecological Catalogue of the Crayfishes belonging to the Genus Cambarus. Kansas Univ. Science Bull., 2: 51-187. Hay, W. P. 1896. The Crawfishes of the State of Indiana. Rep. Indiana Geol. Surv., 20: 475-506. 1809. Synopsis of North American Invertebrates. VI. The Astaddae of North America. Amer. Nat., 33: 957-966. Huxley, T. J. 1880. The Crayfish. The International Sdentific Series. New York. Kingsley, J. S. 1809. Synopsis of North American Invertebrates. HI. The Caridea of North America. Amer. Nat., 33: 700-719. Ortmann, A. E. 1005. The Mutual Affinities of the Spedes of the Genus Cambarus, and their Dispersal over the United States. Proc. Amer. Philos. Soc., 44: 91-136. 1906. The Crawfishes of the State of Pennsylvania. Mem. Carnegie, Mus., 2:343-523. Packard, A. S. 1886. The Cave Fauna of North America. Mem. Nat. Acad. Sd., 4: 1-156. Pearsx, A. S. 1 9 10. The Crawfishes of Mirhigan Mich. State Biol. Surv., 1:0-22. Richardson, H. 1005. A Monograph on the Isopods of North America. Bull. U. S. Nat. Mus.; 54^27 pp. Surra, S. I. 1874. The Crustacea of the Fresh Waters of the United States. Rep. U. S. Comm. Fish., 2: 637-665. Steele, M. 1002. The Crayfish of Missouri Bull. Univ. Cincinnati, No. 10; 54 pp., 6 pi. Wecxel, Ada L. 1907. The Fresh-water Amphipoda of North America. Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus., 32: 25-58. CHAPTER JXXVI THt WATER-M1TKS (HYDRACARINA) Combrcuot* among aquatic s a considerable plant growth Titere in the vegetation < >f the bottom and the shore they live, clambering about over the surface of the plants, swim- ming across from one stem or leai Vj another, and feeding on Crustacea, inject larvae or ouk-f aniuiais wiiich they may be able to overpower and capture. A lew species are pelagic, spending most oi their time in the open water vi tiie lake or pond, while other fornix, as Tyrrcllia, are iounu wandering over the moss and debris which accumulate? a*ong a *wainpy portion of the shore. Feltria is a gentle containing oinail forms that arc found only in the mountain streams of JLuroj*. ■: yet in general water-mites are not abundant in flowing stream* except in bhejtered piaces where there i» a growth oi vegetation wiiich protects them irom tiie rapid cur- rent. Two genera arc parasitic in fresh- water mussed, and the larvae and pupa*, oi others attach thein&eivcb to aquatic insects or other animaii. $lo>i c-i them are fresh-water forms, but a very lew have been described wiiich arc marine and a few others have accustomed themseives Ln certain idealities to life in brackish water. Hydradenitis are generally distributed over the worid but seem to reach the greates: abundance in the ciear, cool waters of the spring-fed iakes and pools, rich in plant life, which are so charac- teristic of all temperate latitudes, and which dot our northern states 6U 852 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY and Canada. An interesting occurrence was the finding of a spe- cies of Leber tia, a genus usually found in alpine and more northern waters, in a spring at Omaha, Nebraska, the only record of the genus in a state where bodies of water of that character are almost lacking. At present about seventy genera are known, containing several hundred described species, the number of which is fast increasing. The water-mites are found at all seasons of the year, even under the ice in winter. Certain ones, especially of the red mites, are abundant in pools in early spring, but the greatest number of species appear as adults during the latter part of the summer or in the fall. They are small forms usually from 1 to 2 millimeters long, rarely exceeding a length of 5 millimeters, but on the other hand, in the adult condition, rarely measuring less than half a millimeter. The color varies greatly, but is most frequently either some shade of red or green; the same species may at the same locality and at the same time be both red and different shades of green or bluish green. The color is partly due to pigment deposited in the epidermal cells, but from above or beneath blackish, brownish or greenish spots are seen, which vary in size and intensity and are due to the stomach* and its blind diverticula seen through other more superfi- cial structures. A whitish, yellowish, or reddish Y-shaped dorsal mark, or markings of various form seen on the dorsal, lateral, or posterior surfaces, are due to the presence of excretory matter in the so-called Malpighian vessels, and thus are very variable in number and extent. Hence while color is a clue to identification which may be of service to the experienced observer, it cannot be relied upon, and is of little or no value in the discrimination of species. As seen in the water the hydrachnids appear at first glance like small water spiders, possessing, as they do, four pairs of legs and a pair of palpi corresponding to the pedipalps of spiders. But they can at once be referred to the mites when it is noted that there is no trace of segmentation or of division of the body into regions. The body is compact and usually more or less globular, ellip- soidal, or ovoidal, though in some cases compressed dorso-ventrally HUE \Y*?£k-MIXE5 -VHYJURACARIXA> *& nr iaierfahv . uoc ii: cm vainer vr certain ^pecie^ u; Ar.rMnurus pro- hmget puHvet:ivH:»A iuu a cuciv»ur iuvndit-iuu «tppciiuagc. The form i mure trcimiu ir tin mguer iuru^ iim. \u tho* which accm most ■primitive. Tut ikii: ii *v#iu«. iunur i- >uk ajjc: iht dixriau- smooth. but mim tiaualit r ^ uuxxaml u\ uia. *ixu*. likx ih<. line.- on the patir u: tin luiui aiic. a tn<. iower iv>rm. i\ i^ oiuu granuiated or papibaieti -jUjc* speOer po^iea- cfliuu^u; piuic which may be lev obl sjukil i/' ;aiger axit. jjlh>u jjomwou. ajuci may ever com- p^t-eiy cuca** Ijli*. lmj> #; < i»^r- o: .arxuor- Tiie** cammou- piales cix not e*eej; i« man. otae' mghc or iuwc type- au<: occur in difkrejo: iaj.fl.Uier Uiduua- vn-v-u-iiex'- c uir. eau* caj- b*. aeei. 01. dose exttuhu&Uo: i • u« uuuoi- an' ir &oni> uloc.-- Ui« iw u: each side art Msparca* Iik «a- o om mjucro. in bou»«- o1 tii*. iuwc u»jiu . i. ' sair. ir media; ey. i: lu* inecua? iiii*- UtLWeelt Ui«. Otiii:J Tii'. iou* pau o ic£ «fci«. «*ruc- UUiie.. i a: »Ji±%iL iiuJlilA:' of CtX&la pixiLc . «'I upiXucJL. lncc. ai'_ ircqueniij mor-., *.>" icc-» lu^e'", xuay even ion: a u &iiigje »*LgK initio ^v».:- ma1' OiS y CXlcH i uj> 0:l lii^ o1U<.\j o a^ near i v i, ciiw*o^'j Ute ooo * , ^s i* I rvntij/oui* ooiaeUm«.o Ujt uuoy i.. UiUbCricie^ a^uw; lu^ piai- , ^^^tr u> li)'- aiuuiL i:-. ia.u;rL. viv^. Ui-. appcariUii ^ r ■; a ^»: oa u-*-: o *\\ut ^ -^i ;. or iat-ua^ec jui^.-*i Uit *c^ apiui^li;. epimerci* p*ai- -tijr al^.. u.:-^ crs «.inw]Tii: extreme modi - fias*!^ of 'ii* hjt pii* rt' tegs in tne nv.'> . L'Tj4 ?!..i*-r »'■ ^>ne aid*, only; .;: sot sh-:-wr 'Modit^d froai pa.;: no tUcaL: • :!i iciigi:., ii* the iurm ox iadivxuual aegmea-, djaa iu Ui^ ciutiacLc: ui uit apiaes, 854 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY bristles and hairs which they bear. They are usually terminated by two movable claws, but there may be only one, or rarely the leg may end in a spine or bristle. The more active and the pelagic forms have longer legs with fewer and longer spines and bristles, the less active shorter, stouter legs with more thickly set and shorter bristles. In some cases a number of long hairs in a close-set row on the outer segments of the leg seem to aid in swimming and so are called swim- ming-hairs; while in other cases curiously modified leg segments and spines characterize the male and serve as accessory organs in pairing (Fig. 1319). The genital opening is situated behind or between the epimera and is usually flanked by plates which bear characteristic cup-like or knob-like structures known as acetabula, the exact nature and function of which is unknown. There may be in addition movable flaps, which may or may not cover the acetabula, and in some cases such flaps, by fusion with the genital plates, seem to have become immovable. Between the anterior epimera is a plate, which has been termed, from its. form, the maxillary shield, and which is the ventral side of a chitinous box called the camerostom, which encloses the mouth- parts. To this are articulated the five- jointed palpi; at its anterior end is the mouth-opening, through which project the stiletto-like or sabre-like mandibles; and on its dorsal surface are the two stigmata, leading by air-tubes into two air-sacs placed above the pharynx, from which a system of tracheal tubes runs through- out the body. In the forms parasitic on the fresh-water mussels these tubes are lacking. The maxillary shield is frequently pro- longed posteriorly into a kind of ancoral process, and the anterior ventral angle of the camerostom may be produced into a sort ol rostrum. All these structures together are termed the capitulum. The sexes are separate, sexual dimorphism being a common phe- nomenon, and all species lay eggs. These may, rarely, be laid free in the water, but are more usually deposited singly or in mass, surrounded by a gelatinous envelope, on water plants or other submerged objects. The embryo undergoes considerable develop- ment before escaping from the egg membranes at which time it becomes an active six-legged larva (Fig. 1320). This larva after a THE WATER-MITES (HYDRA CARINA) 855 short free existence becomes a parasite either on an aquatic insect which remains habitually in the water or on one which leaves the water and becomes aerial. Other species place the eggs singly in the tissues of fresh -water mussels, or in masses between the gills, it («ch figure ihowiu the 1 w at one rid* only). *,; 7 • unit ".hi tied by tin io&s o: the nymphai appendages and the develop- ment, of a new aet. and tat skin may be cast all ai once or in several portions. Instances have been described in which the nymph was produced directly from tit egg in the egg-mass. These water-inites. like most aquatic animal >. spend much of their time ir. active motiur.. swimming with comparative- rapidity through tht open water or mort siowiy walking over the bottom or climbing about on plants or other objects. At times they stop and remain stationary, clinging to whatever object they may rest upon, but a touch iron, another animal send- then, whirling on again with rapid leg movements. When prey is secured they stop to suck tht juices from tht bod}' of tht victim, casting aside the carcass when it has been drained. Aside iroir. tht sense of touch, which httm^ quilt acute tht senses ar*. poorly developed, or at least appear to be iitut used. They rarely feign death, but almost invariably attempt to escape a threatened danger by rapid flight. Tht less uniiorn. ratt of motion thev exhibit i.-> of aid in distin- guishinK then: iron, other iorins, especially ostracod-, with which they may be confused. The leg movement aiso aids in their dis- crimination. Attractive as the h}'drachnid> are to the student of iresh- water life and to the biologist, they art of economic importance only as they aflord an element in the food of hshes. Lxarninatioiis of the contents of hsh stornach> frequently show that they have been eaten, and their abundance at times would seem to indicate that under such circumstances they might make up no inconsiderable portion of the food. But they seeni to gu to pieces very quickly and so art rarely reported in any numbers in the results of exami- nations of such stomach contents In collecting these little ieliows one needs a net, a number of wide-mouthed bottles or jars, a pipette, and, in case he is not to examine his collections within a few hours, a bottu of formalin. The most serviceable net is the 'cone'" or "Birge" net (see page 68 . The net may be Used from boat or shore and the mate- rial, after being run into a wide-mouthed bottle or jar, be pre- served in tola at once by adding directiy a little strong formalin and shaking thorough!}*, or it may be carried home in the fresh 858 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY state. Frequently mites may be collected along shore by the use of the pipette, being picked up individually as they swim about in sight. The material, if preserved in formalin, may be put aside for future examination. If not, it should be poured soon into a flat dish, from which the mites may be picked out by means of a pipette. The dish should be looked over several times, as some tend to hide in the debris at the bottom, and stirring after the material has once settled often reveals hidden specimens. Five per cent formalin, into which they may be put directly, is likely to make them brittle, and the catch is better preserved in a mixture of glycerine, 2 parts by volume; pure water, 3 parts by vol- ume; 2 per cent acetic acid, 2 parts by volume; absolute alcohol, 1 part by volume. If the mites are to be kept alive for observation their cannibal- istic instincts make it necessary that different genera be segregated and kept in separate dishes, with a small amount of some water plant and a few Crustacea or non-predatory insect larvae as food. Crowding should be guarded against. The activity of water-mites makes them difficult objects to study alive, but by the cautious addition of water saturated with chloro- form vapor they may be narcotized, and, after being examined, will come out from under the influence of the chloroform apparently uninjured. The author has subjected specimens to this treatment on several successive occasions without evident harm. In the study of specimens it is necessary to make use of slide mounts. The mouth-parts may be dissected and mounted sepa- rately upon slides, and the palpi and legs may also be removed and mounted. If the specimens have been kept in a solution contain- ing some glycerine an opening may be made in the body-wall through which the contents of the body can be pressed out, and in that way transparent mounts of the complete individual secured. The thickness of the body makes it difficult to secure a transparent mount from material preserved in alcohol or formalin mixtures, but the specimens may be successfully softened in some cases by a weak potash solution or else must be mounted as opaque objects. In the identification of water-mites care must be used, as the /vtf* THE WATER-MITES (HYDRACARINA) 859 general resemblance between them is close. But the characters also seem to be very constant and few species are subject to marked variation. The accompanying synopsis will aid in placing speci- mens in the proper genus. The statements as to the numbers of species refer to North America only. The legs and the corresponding epimera are designated by Roman numerals, beginning with the most anterior, and the palpal and leg segments are referred to by Arabic numerals, numbering from the base outward. Thus, ep. Ill is the third epimeron, leg seg. IV 4, the fourth segment of the fourth leg, and pal. seg. 5 the distal segment of the palpus. In most illustrations are shown the ven- tral surface, only the legs of one side, and the palpus, detached and more highly magnified; these are the characters most important and most readily observed. The arrangement of genera and higher groups here used is the same as adopted in a previous paper (Wolcott, 05). It is not in all respects satisfactory, but such a difference of opinion exists among students of the group in this regard that the author is not willing to accept any other system since proposed without himself working the whole matter over again. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER HYDRACARINA 1 (6) Lateral eyes of the two sides close together in the median line and borne on a common eye-plate a 2 (5) Pal. seg. 5 deeply set into 4, eye-plate long and narrow. Family Limnocharidae . . 3 3(4) Without swimming-hairs Limnochares L&treiUt 1796. A very large clumsy red mite with soft body, variable in form but in general rectangular, found in pools in bogs and swamps. Length 4.5-4 mm. One species, generally distributed and common at times. Fio. 133a. Linmochans aptaHcus (Lin- naeus). Ventral surface, female. Xq. Inner surface, right palpus. X 95- (Mod- ified from Piersig.) 4 (3) With swimming-hairs Cyclothrix Wolcott 1005. Also red, but oval and more constant in form and recognized at once by the swimming-hairi. One species found also in ponds and lakes with boggy or swampy shores, and known from several northern states. Somewhat smaller than preceding genua. 860 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 5 (2) Pal. seg. 5 free, eye-plate broad, consisting of two lateral portions connected by a transverse middle piece. Family Eylaidae. One genus only Eylais Latreille 1796. A red mite with body circular in outline and usually smooth; with palpi slender in form and richly supplied with hairs and spines, many of them feathered; hind legs without swimming-hairs and allowed to trail motionless behind in swimming. Several species, very closely allied and gen- erally distributed and often very abundant. Varying in size from about 2 to 5 mm. Fig. 1323. Eylais extendens (M Oiler), a Euro- pcan species. Ventral surface of female. X 7. Inner side of right palpus. X 69. Eye-plat*. X 50. (Modified from Piersig.) 6 (1) Lateral eyes of the two sides widely separated and in no case borne on a common eye-plate 7 7 (18) Distal extremity of pal. seg. 4 produced beyond the point of inser- tion of seg. 5, the two segments together resembling a pair of shears 8 8 (9) Mandible one-segmented, the terminal portion straight and stiletto- like Family Hydrachnidae. One genus only. Hydrachna Latreille 1796. Mites of some shade of red or brown, and sometimes spotted with black, with the body glob- ular, soft, and usually papilla ted; capitulum produced into a snout. Species numerous, occurring in swamps, lakes and ponds every- where and usually common. Varying from z to even 8 mm. in length. Fig. 1334. Hydrachna teopopkica (MQller), a European species, also found in New England. The largest described hydrachnid. Ventral sur- face, female. X 4. Palpus. X 16. (Modified from Piersig.) 9(8) Mandible two-segmented, the terminal segment curved and daw- like. Family Hydryphantidae, . , 10 THE WATER-MITES (HYDRACARINA) 10 fn) Lateral eyes of each side separate and not enclosed In a c Subfamily Diplodontinax. One genus only. Diplodontus Dugea 1834. A luge, brownish-red mite with body broad, soft, sud surface papil- la ted; capitulum forming ■ snout; palpi very mull; legs slender, with long swimming-bain. One cosmo- politan species, generally distributed Flo. ijij. Dipie&ml Fig. 1337. Aturus scaber (Kramer), a European spe- cies. Ventral surface of male. X 61. Outer side of palpus, female. X 150. (Modified from Piersig.) 36 (31) Suture open anteriorly, the two ends passing around on to the ven- tral surface 37 37 (38) Genital area with 4 acetabula on each side . . A xonopsis Piersig 1893. A very small, brightly-colored mite about 0.45 mm. in length, with a median cleft in the posterior margin of the oval body; the anterior epimera extended beyond the capitulum; few swimming- hairs. One North American species, rare, in northern lakes, apparently the same as the European A. complanata (MOller). Fig. 1338. Axanotois complanata (Mailer). Ventral surface of female. X50. Outer side, right palpus. X 123* (Modified from ■•.y.v, THE WATER-MITES (HTORACARINA) 867 38 (37) Genital area with numerous axetabula on each side. Aibio Thon 1899. A mite of medium a of medium rdie, averumf m. in length, with eWptfcal, impresseabody; swimming- " ™— th American es of northern « only Euro- hair* present. One North American (pedes, lather rare, in lakes of northern states, frequently pale greenish in color. This is identical with the or'- " — pean spedes, A. sla " very closely related. F10. 1339. A&U& tral surface, laatlt. Xji. O palpui, female, (After Than.) 39 (34) Body highly arched, in some cases laterally compressed, with no such dorsal and ventral plate. Subfamily Lebehtiinae. . 40 Legs with swimming-hairs eicept in certain spedes of Libtrtia, Medium-stied mites, varying in length from o.S to 1.5 mm., with ovoidal body, the surface of which is soft or hard. In tome cases with small flecks of chitin, usually striate, but rarely papillate; capitulum developed more or leas into a snort snout. A genus of frequent occurrence in colder waters, represented by several closely allied spedes which have only been recently recognised as distinct. P10.1UD. Uto^fcw-taJrsta(Lebcrt),o(vtrlous authon, L. dubia Titan. Trus (pedes wai referred to North America by Koenlke in iSos, but he baa re- cendy identified three sp«ia in the material he irk, palpus, tale. Xig. C (Modified from air) i (40) Leg IV without claws at the tip, ending in a sharp point, epimem completely fused 4? 868 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 41 (43) Body laterally compressed, epimeral plate extending up on the lat- eral surface, leaving only a dorsal median furrow. Prontipoda Koenike 1891. A mite of medium size, somewhat less than 1 mm. long, looking curioualy like a very flat elliptical seed, emaigioate at the hilum where the legs are bunched together; usually of a ) color. One species, frequent ii northern lakes and apparently identical with the rrally distributed Euro] • (Miiller). e generally (Modified bom P1bs%.) 43 (41) Body not so decidedly compressed, epimeral plate not extending upward on the lateral surface. ... Oxus Kramer 1877. A form of medium site, different species vary- ing in length from 0.64 to 1.4 mm., with body elongate in form; legs crowded toward the an- terior end. Known in North America only from Wisconsin, where the one ipedea seems to be rare. This is undescribed. but is similar to O. natii (Mailer) and O. itrifHa (Muller) the common European forms. 44 (.*3) Epimera arranged in groups, in the female always clearly separate from one another, in the male closer together but distinct, only in tare cases in contact or tending in a slight degree to fuse. 45 45 (64) Epimera in four groups, in the male in some cases only a narrow, interval between them. 46 THE WATER-MITES (HVDRACARINA) 8$9 46 (53) Genital area usually lying far forwards, at least between epp. TV, and the epimeral groups often separated by a considerable interval, no ancoral process on the maxillary shield. Subfamily Sperchoninae . 47 47 (52) Genital acetabula borne on a plate, no flaps present 48 48 (49) Acetabula numerous Lmnaiopsts Pieraig 1897, A Urge hydrachnid, about s the surface of the body beset wit ■pedes, L. anemaia (Koenike) , described from Canada. tod generally distributed in northern lakes but 110- 49 (48) Acetabula few, large 50 50 (51) Leg IV with terminal claws, no swimming-hairs. TyrreSia Koenike 1895. - Body almost circular, papilla ted with one of two dorsal cbitinoua plates; mouth-opening in the middle of a disk-tike surface at the anterior end of the capatuium, resembling the condition seen in the Hydrypbanbdae; » sluggish, dark-brown mile of medium sue averaging 1.1 mm. in length, known from Canada and found abundantly some years since at Seed's lake, near Grand Rapids. Michigan, where it was picked up singly with the pipette in the debrisat the margin of the water in dose prox- imity to a swampy portion of the take shore. Very rare in Birge net hauls at the tame place. Two species taken, one apparently the same as T. drat- larii Koenike, previously described. FIO-IJ4 Ventral u E£a*T 870 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY St (50) Leg IV ending in a point, a long hair a little back from the tip, swim- ming-hairs present Limnesia Koch 1837. . . _ . . Q length, with 0 body, surface striata, sometimes papilloae, and even developing ■ ehitinons meshwork; two eyes on coca tide separate. Handsome mite* with bright red spots, very active, mod among the moat powerful and voradoua of •11. Ten North American species; generally distributed and found under very varied con- thenoatw&dr art, il» toumf t , North American sp throughout Europe, Ventral *u nale. X 16. Outer side, palpus, ienul (laoduud hum Pienof.) 1 (47) Genital acetabula. along the margin of the deft, covered laterally by flaps; without swimming -haira. Sperchon Kramer 1877. Body oval, rarely with small ( plales, smooth, or papillate; capitulum very movable. A genus found in northern and mountain bikes and streams. Three spades recorded from Canada. Spades small to medium in size, in length 0.5 to 1.5 mm. ■pedes recorded bat- Venlnl surface, female, palpus, female. Xm< O 53 (46) Genital area lying posterior to epp. IV, at most only its anterior end lying between their emarginate posterior angles; an ancoral process present. , . Subfamily Pioninae. . 54 jaJiTimT THE WATER-MITES (HYDRACARINA) 54 (61) Posterior margin of ep. IV rounded or transverse . , 87I 55 55 (58) With swimming-hairs 56 56 (57) Transverse diameter of ep. IV the greater, suture between epp. Ill and IV complete; no prominent papillae on pal. seg. 4, acetabula very numerous Neumania Lebert 1879. Mites of small to medium size, varying in length from 0.5 to 1 .6 mm., with soft body, tending more or less to develop chitinous plates or beset with chitinous points, rarely smooth: leg IV usually with feathered spines. Brightly colored, red or bluish forms, active, but not markedly voracious. Several North American species, common, and widely dis- tributed. Fio. 1347. Neumania stinipts (M Oiler), a European species represented in this country by a closely allied form. Ventral surface, male. X 40. Outer side, palpus, male. X 7a (Modified from Piersig.) * 57 (56) Longitudinal diameter of ep. IV at least equal to the transverse, suture between epp. Ill and IV incomplete medially; pal. seg. 4 usually with prominent papillae; 5 or 6 acetabula on each side on one or two plates. (Non-parasitic species) Unionicola Haldeman 1842. 5& (55) Without swimming-hairs. ..»...«. SO 87a FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 59 (60) Posterior margin of ep. IV rounded; genital tret midway between epp. IV and the posterior end of the body, genital plates elongated transversely Najadicoia Piersig 1807. A Urge mite, 15 "> t-5 n™ 1°>«- the gravid female often very large, reaching a length of even 6 mm., living in fresh-water mussels nod laying eggs in masses between the gills. Hortey- yellow in color, more or lent distinctly finely vennicolnte with white Ere. One North American spi Fie. liiS- NtjmiiaU iqifi (Koenike) . X is- (After Koniike.) Inner aide, pal- pus, male. X So. (After Wotcott.) 60 (59) Posterior margin of ep. IV straight; genital area at the posterior end of the body, genital plates not elongated transversely. (Parasitic species) Unionkola Haldeman 1842. Varying from small to lane in sue, or from 0.4 to r . o mm. in length. Some ■re active, free-swimming miles with long legs, with swimming-hairs, and leg I frequently with movable, dagger- like spines. Others are mussel para- swimming- hairs, leg IV in some cases being characteristically -"■■*■ ft"* in the male sen. In both types strong spines adjacent to the genital opening serve together aa an ovipositor. Cer- tain free-swimming forms are regularly pelagic and very transparent; the para- sitic forms are dull-colored. Species numerous and widely distributed, many of them very abundant, especially the parasitic forms. The latter are usually mussel parasites though one species has been recorded from a South American univalve. Fra.1349- r/nNufamuffutMouer). ■ common and widely-distributed, rnc- Amrrica id3 Europe. Ventral surlier, female. X u. Palpus. outeriid*.feiii«k. X 63. {Modified tram Piertig.j 61 (54) Posterior margin of ep. IV with a prominent acute angle. THE WATER MITES {HYDRACAJUNA) 873 6a (63) Medial margin of ep. IV reduced to merely a medial angle which forms a common angle with the medic-posterior angle of ep. Ill; leg segs. IV 5 and IV 6 of male modified. Tiphys Koch 1S37. Rather small m with swimrning-hairs and tl . strikingly modified. Few North A rare, in uur northern lakes, a* yi " " 63 (6s) Medial margin of ep. IV not reduced, and, owing to the angle on the posterior margin, ep. IV more or less clearly five-sided. Fiona Koch 1837. Oval or elliptical forms of lung, of ten brightly colored, with swimming-hairs, and with char- acteristic modifications of teg segs. Ill 6 and IV 4 in the male, the latter serving to assist in grasping the female in pairing, the former to carry the semen to the female genital opening. Hardy, active mites, adapting ' " ' " a great variety of American species, generally dfav European species. female. X 11. Out female. X 77- ( 04 (45) Eplmera in three groups, epp, I being fused together behind the capitulum, the groups also often close together in the male. Subfamily Hygrobatinae . . 65 874 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 65 (66) Leg segs. I 5 and I 6 modified. Atractides Koch 1837. Small to medium-sized mites, vary- ing in length from 0.48 to 1.5 mm. with surface soft and striate, or with a flexible or hard porous covering; swimming-hairs present. Species few in this country, rare, in northern lakes. Fig. 1353. Atractides spinipes Koch, a species common to Europe and America. Ventral surface, female. X 35. Outer side of left palpus, female. X XQ3. (Modified from Piersig.) 66 (65) Leg segs. I 5 and I 6 normal HygrobaUs Koch 1837. Mites varying in size from small to even large, or 0.5 to 2.5 mm., brightlv colored in many cases, with- out swimming-hairs, but active, and certain spedes frequently, if not regu- larly, pelagic Several species of gen- eral distribution in northern United States and Canada. FlO. 1353. EyfrobaUs IcntiPalpis (Hermann) , a specie* found in North America, Europe and Western Asia. Ventral surface, female. X 13. Outer side, palpus, female. X 125- (Modified from Piersig.) In collecting water-mites with the Birge net one will almost always find in the collection specimens of another mite of small size, brown in color, with short legs, with the body indistinctly separated into cephalothoraz and ab- domen and with a horny body-covering. This belongs to the horny mites or Oribatidae, probably to the genus Notaspis, and is a vegetable feeder living on aquatic plants beneath the surface of the water. It can not swim, and will either cling to objects at the bottom of the dish or float on the surface. Sev- eral species occur and are generally distributed. The spedes increase in sire and number to the southward. THE WATER-MITES (HYDRACARINA) 875 IMPORTANT PAPERS ON NORTH AMERICAN FRESH- WATER MITES Koentxe, F. 1895. Nordamerikanische Hydrachniden. Abh. des Natur* wiss. Ver. zu Bremen, 13: 167-226. Also separate Bremen, 1S95, 191 2. A Revision of my " Nordamerikanische H>xlrachnidcn." Transl. by E. M. Walker. Trans. Can. Inst., 191 2: 281-206. Marshall, Ruth. 1903. Ten Species of Arrenuri belonging to the Subgenus Megalurus Thon. Trans. Wis. Acad. Sci., 14: 145-172. 1904. A New Arrenurus and Notes on Collections made in 1003. Trans. Wis. Acad. Sci., 14: 520-526. 1908. The Arrhenuri of the United States. Trans. Amcr. Micr. Soc, 28: 85-140. 1910. New Studies of the Arrhenuri. Trans. Amcr. Micr. Soc., 29: 97-110. Ptersig, R. 1 901. Hydrachnidae. Das Ticrrcich, Lief. 13. Wolcott, R. H. 1809. On the North American Species of the Genus Atax (Fabr.) Bruz. Trans. Amer. Micr. Soc., 20: 193-259. 1900. New Genera and Species of North American Hydrachnidae. Trans. Amer. Micr. Soc, 21: 177-200. 1901. Description of a New Genus of North American Watcr-mitcs, with Observations on the Classification of the Group. Trans. Amcr. Micr. Soc, 22: 105-117. 1902. The North American Species of Curvipes. Trans. Amcr. Micr. Soc, 23: 201-256. 1903. The North American Species of Limnesia. Trans. Amcr. Micr. Soc, 24: 85-107. 1905. A Review of the Genera of the Watcr-mitcs. Trans. Amcr. Micr. Soc, 26: 161-243. CHAPTER XXYII AQUATIC INSECTS By JAMES G. NEEDHAH Insects are essentially terrestrial animals. Their organisation fits them for exposure to the air. On land they are numerically dominant, and it is a comparatively small portion of the group that is to be found in the water. But the lesser portion of a group so large is in itself a host, including a very great variety of forms. That insects are primarily terrestrial and that they have been secondarily adapted to aquatic life is evidenced in many ways. Their complete armor of impervious chitin and their respiratory apparatus, consisting of internal branching chitin-lined air tubes (tracheae), opening to the outside for the intake of air through spiracles, speak strongly against an aquatic origin. It would be hard to imagine an organization more unsuited to getting air when in the water. Furthermore, all adult insects, even those that Kve constantly in the water, have preserved the terrestrial mode of respiration: they all breathe air directly, instead of breathing the air that is dissolved in the water. They have merely acquired means of carrying air from the surface down into the water with them for use there. They are no more aquatic in their mode of respiration than is a man in a diving bell. It is only the more plastic immature stages that have acquired a strictly aquatic type of respiratory apparatus. Again, it is only isolated and rather small groups of insects that inhabit the water. A few of the smaller orders, like the stone- flies, Mayflies, dragonflies and caddisflies are practically all aquatic in their immature stages; but the larger orders are not so. There is abundant evidence of the independent adaptation of the various groups. Practically all the adult insects found in the 876 x& AQUATIC INSECTS 877 water are either bugs or beetles. Of those aquatic insects having complete metamorphosis, the pupa is strictly aquatic in caddisdies only. The adaptations of the immature stages have chiefly to do with their respiratory apparatus, and this is most extraordinarily diverse. This will be discussed iater. Sufice it here to say that gills of several sorts may be developed upon either the outer or inner surfaces of the bodv, ;ind those on the outside mav be dorsal or ventral, and may be developed upon the head or on any seg- ment of the thorax or abdomen: thus they bear ail the usual signs of independent ;uid adaptive origin. Finallv, it is to be noted that insects liave not invaded the water very far. Nearly all of them have stopped at the shores or in shoal water; only a few liave established homes for themselves in deep water. Only the phantom larvae of Corethra liave become free swimming and are regular plankton constituents; possibly a few others also, for a limited distribution-period immediately follow- ing their hatching from die egg. The press - >i life on land result- ing from the evolution of the liighly successful hexapod type of organization, with great adaptability, brief life cycle and excellent reproductive capacity, may have resulted in the crowding into the water of those moisture-loving forms whose structures were best adapted to meet the new conditions. The severity of the competi- tion on land is most evident to the careful observer; every nook and corner has its insect inhabitants ;ind every ->crap of nutritious food is eagerly sought by a host of competitors. It is easy to conceive that a great variety of forms ;iircady accustomed to living by the water side, rinding food more ibundant in the water than out of it. might, if adaptable, become modified for entering the water for a greater or .ess depth and for remaining there a greater or less lime. And. as a matter of fact, adaptation of die adults has proceeded oniv a little wnv. Some adult insects, .is certain nsf antlv ;n *he vater but maintain corrrrmimcatic^ - n ml the surface V means »f 1 "ona: respiratory ~ube. is toes- .7/«-a. -- The most nearly aquatic of adult insects are th& hasp 878 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY have developed oar-like hind feet and have become good swimmers; these enter the water to depths of several feet and spend most of their time near the bottom in shoal waters, but they must come to the surface at intervals for air which they carry down with them beneath their wing covers or adherent to the pile of their bodies. A few adult insects also have taken to walking or running on the surface of the water, but these are naturally the most minute forms, as springtails, or those of slenderer build, like little Diptera and water striders; and of this last-mentioned group, some wander far from shore, even upon the surface of the ocean. But there are few adult insects to be found far from the shelter of vegetation, and it remains true that the great press of insect life is at the shore line. The case is only slightly different with insect larvae. Most of these have remained near shore. As compared with the adults, their smaller size, less chitinized skin and greater plasticity have allowed much more complete adaptation to aquatic life. There are some larvae, like those of beetles and of many flies, that take air at the surface as do the adult beetles, and there are a few others, that, descending the stems, tap the air spaces of plants far beneath the surface and get oxygen from that unusual source; but there are also very many that are capable of a truly aquatic respiration, being able to utilize the air that is dissolved in the water. Most of these larvae when newly hatched absorb the oxygen directly through their skins; and a few of them, especially such as five in well aerated water, acquire no better means than this during their larval existence, but most of them develop 'gills of some sort These gills are delicate outgrowths of the thinnest integument of the body. Two types of gills are usually distinguishable, blood gills, and tracheal gills. The former are more like the gills of other aquatic animals; the latter are peculiar to insects. The blood gills are simple outgrowths of the body wall into which the blood flows. The interchange of gases which constitutes the respiratory process takes place between the blood within the gill and the water outside it by means of direct diffusion through the thin membranous wall. Such gills are very commonly developed in dipterous larvae as paired and retractile appendages of the pos- 'jiy^aiy tisnnr era£ a£ tba alimentary canal, Inn: timy .iltti urciir < w ) ^kvrtus. *r: b*v ;naj; ik* lium-r^ ami; sitn|)kt. lirancht*i • ir ;.uitc*L ..i&.-in.:iiaar.itftar 'ttrmxi \xicrt\i*tr swr.-ri 'tracheal gill ttie^^-aika *'uijfr-4ril,r iiNtr^HofiMi>jJrrccl^' from : be jirmbnriuic -miracits ^n tsrndn liiiK-r&.a: be:tfwtwmi>bwtf' '** -jwrw. ."c uasHir^ tai: lotr x Lks- w^ttocvMif^ iW*l Ilmi^H^iifcw ■ * toe ^uurxtLxv < . xiaxir. ap. . .rrrraatrei^ f44j?c^ iwtsn pH*AUi*i, It -fctt* char -jrrcKjB be jsc£li..\> j>r hv\ i. La^* wj^er. 880 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY condition; it indicates only that, in these relatively primitive forms, structures developed to a considerable extent upon the immature stages have, in the rapid and incomplete transformation these under- go, been carried over in rudimentary form into adult life. Among aquatic insects are many beautiful and interesting forms. The keys and figures in the following pages should enable anyone who has learned the parts of the body of a grasshopper, or who has mastered such elementary knowledge of insect anatomy as every textbook of zoology or of entomology affords, to identify most of the insects he will find in the water. There are many gaps in our knowledge of all the groups; even the adult insects are not well known except in the showier groups, which have always been more attractive to the collector; and so many immature forms are still unknown, it has been found impracticable to attempt to give keys even to the genera in two orders, Plecoptera and Trichoptera. Limitations of space have compelled restriction to the larger groups among the Diptera. In most of the groups having com- plete metamorphosis, the characterizations of the immature stages have been adapted from the accounts of European writers, very little having as yet been done on them in America. Here is an attractive field in which the amateur and the isolated student may still find pioneer work to do. It is the purpose of this chapter to assist the student toward acquaintance with such insects as he may find in the water. The limitations of space allow but brief notice of the natural history of any of the groups and restrict the keys to dealing with families and genera. The aim is to supplement the general works on entomology and not to duplicate any part of them. Keys to the orders of adult insects are available in a number of manuals and textbooks, hence there is need here only to point out the readier recognition marks of those orders which commonly occur in the water, and to give a key to the immature stages. Recognition Characters There are but nine orders of insects commonly found in water in any stage: Plecoptera, Odonata, Ephemerida, Hemiptera, Xeu- roptera, Trichoptera, Leptdoptera, Cokoptera and Diptera. AQUATIC INSECTS 88l The Odonata are distinguished by the venation of the wings, especially by the possession of a distinct nodus and stigma of the type shown in Fig. 1388. The Ephemerida are distinguished by the venation of the wings (Fig. 1387), and by their proportions and their extensive corruga- tion. The Hemiptera are distinguished by the possession of a jointed, sucking proboscis, directed backward beneath the head and thorax. The Trichoptera are distinguished by the hairy covering of their wings, the absence of jaws and proboscis (palpi are pres- ent) and by a type of venation of wings similar to that shown in Fig. 139 1. The Lepidoptera are distinguished by their covering of powdery scales, and by the possession of a coded sucking proboscis. The Coleoptera are distinguished by the hardened fore wings (elytra) meeting in a straight line down the middle of the back. The Diptera are distinguished by the possession of a single pair of wings, with very few cross-veins in them (Fig. 1378). The other two orders, Plecoptera and Neuroptera, lack the above combinations of characters and may be readily recognized by their general likeness to figures published in the following paragraphs devoted to them. Besides these nine orders, there are three others, of slight impor- tance in the life of the water, that are deliberately ignored. These are: (1) The Thysanura, or springtails, common on the surface of water, but not living in it. They will be readily recognizable, if collected, by their very minute size, entire absence of wings, mouth parts retracted within the head, and the forked spring beneath the abdomen by means of which they jump freely. (2) The Orthoptera, of which some of the grouse locusts (family Tettigidae) , living by the water side, occasionally jump in and take a swam. (3) The Hymenoptera, of which a few minute egg parasites, enter the water as adults to find the eggs of their aquatic victims, and these swim with their wings (Polyncma, etc.)- 882 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Stoneflies (Order Plecoptera) The stoneflies constitute a small and primitive group of insects of inconspicuous coloration and rather secretive habits. They are found almost exclusively about rapidly flowing water. Every spring brook will furnish a few of the smaller grayish or brownish species, and every larger rocky stream is the home of some of the larger forms. During the winter months the small black Capnias appear, often in great abundance on the surface of the snow, Capnia necydaloides appearing usually in December, and Capnia pygmaea, in March. Several species of Taeniopieryx appear also in March, and may often be seen on mild, sunshiny days by the borders of creeks, slowly and laboriously flying along the banks on warm afternoons. Species of Nemoura appear in April, emerging from the waters of cold brooks, and making short flights from one gray tree trunk to another. All through the summer the larger species are emerging from rocky streams, but these are very se- cretive in habits. They may be beaten from the bushes along the stream side, but are of tenest seen in numbers about street lamps and are easiest collected when attracted to lights. The green stoneflies (Chloroperla, etc.) fly mainly in midsummer, and frequent the fresh foliage, in the midst of which they are quite incon- spicuous. Rudimentary wings occur in a number of the genera, Capnia, Taeniopieryx, Pteronarcella, Perla, etc., and, of course, the wingless species are to be found near the waters from which they emerge on transformation — in fact, not farther therefrom than they are able to run or climb. The males alone are wingless in most cases. The eggs of the females are practically mature at transformation. While there is dearth of observations as to the feeding habits of the adults, it is certain that they will lap up water and other fluid substances, and the small grayish species eat dead grass leaves and other solid food. The mandibles of the larger forms are weak and rudimentary. The adult life, therefore, is probably very brief. Concerning the egg-laying habits also, there is dearth of actual observation. Females of many species may be taken when carry- ing egg masses extruded at the tip of the abdomen; but just AQUATIC INSECTS 883 where these are deposited, and when and how, axe matters not yet established. One species of Capnia, an undetermined, late appearing species that occurs in Lake Forest, 111. in May, is viviparous. The nymphs of stoneflies are much easier to find and to collect than are the adults. By lifting stones or other obstructions out of the bed of rapid permanent streams, and quickly turning them over to look on the under side, the nymphs may usually be seen lying flat, outspread, with widely extended legs clutching the sur- face. They are always associated — with Mayfly nymphs of similar ap- pearance, but are easily distinguished by the presence of two claws on the tip of each foot, where the Mayfly nymphs have but one, and by the lack of gills upon the dorsal side of the abdomen. The nymphs of larger species, as Perla (Fig. 1354), are not easily managed in ordinary aquaria. They cannot live long in still water, and soon after being placed in it, they manifest their discomfort, by a vigorous swaying of the body up and down. This motion brings their tufted gills into better contact with the water. Running water aquaria are essential for their maintenance. Their transformation may often be easily observed where it occurs naturally out of doors. It always takes place near to the edge of the water. Often rocks that project but a few inches above the surface are favorite places of emergence, and the exposed sur- faces of these may sometimes be found covered several layers deep with the skins of the nymphs that have come from the bed of the adjacent parts of the stream. Transformation usually occurs at night, but early and late stragglers may often be found by morn- ing or evening light. The change from nymph to adult is, for insects, comparatively slight: wings and accessory reproductive organs are , The nymph of i stontfly, Perla. 884 FRESH WATER BIOLOGY perfected, and regressive development of gills, external armor, and feeding apparatus occurs, but the change of form and of proportions of the body is slight. The nymphs of stoneflies are, so far as known, carnivorous: they feed on the nymphs of Mayflies, on the larvae of caddisflies grown nymph. and small dipt era and perhaps on the young of other stoneflies. They are themselves the food of the trout and of other fishes that frequent swift waters. Hudson has demonstrated the importance of stoneflies as rish food in the mountain streams of New Zealand. Adults and nymphs arc equally serviceable for bait in all our mountain streams. While no keys to the genera of the nymphs of stoneflies have yet been published, if the adults arc known, the nymphs may be readily determined by comparison, for the wing venation is fully AQUATIC INSECTS 885 developed in the wing pads of the nymph and is comparable in close detail with that of the adult. It is only necessary to remove, as with a sharp razor, the wing pads from a well-grown nymph, young enough so that the wings will not be already crumpled within their sheaths, mount, and examine with the microscope. Since, however, it is easier to get nymphs than adults, and nymphs only will often be available, the following hints may be of assistance in their recognition. Pteronarcys (Figs. 1355 and 1356) alone has gills upon the first two segments of the abdomen. Taeniopteryx alone has three-jointed, telescopic gill filaments attached singly at the base of the coxae. Peltoperla alone has conic-pointed gill filaments, ir a few small clusters, concealed under the flaring, overarched mar- gins of the thoracic segments. Per la and its allies have copious tufts of fine gill filaments before and behind the bases of all legs. Chloroperla and its allies, and Capnia and Leuctra altogether lack gills. Mayflies (Order Ephemerida) The Mayflies constitute a small group of very fragile insects, all of which are aquatic in their earlier stages. They abound in all fresh waters, both swift and stagnant. Some of the larger May- flies are very well known, indeed, from their habit of transforming all at one time and appearing in great swarms along shores of lakes (Fig. 1357) and banks of the larger streams. They fly to lights at night, and sometimes, under the arc lamps in city streets, they accumulate in such heaps as to require removal in wagons. Such concerted appearance of the adults of a single species gives some conception of the abundance of individuals that may live and grow up together in a restricted area; but it is to be borne in mind that there are scores of other species living in the same waters, the adults of which are rarely seen in numbers, of which the individuals are probably quite as numerous. When their period of trans- formation is extended through the summer season and their habits are not gregarious, but solitary and secretive, they may entirely escape the notice of the casual observer. Mayflies are famed for their ephemeral existence — for living as adults but a day. They are peculiar among insects, in that they FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY moult their external chitinous skin once again after they transform from the nymphal form to that of the adult. It is chiefly these callow and immature adults (known to the books as sub-imagos, and to British fishermen as duns) that fly to lights. Emerging from a rent in the back of the old nymph skin, they spread their newly expanded wings and rise feebly into the air, and if a light be near, they swarm to it; otherwise they settle upon any conven- ient tree or building, and sit stiffly (Fig. 1358) with uplifted wings until -ready for their final moulting. This may occur within a few iAQUATIC.' INSECTS ,8*7 s. .as.an Cams, -or it may bo delayed twenry-fonr Jmaaa or mcffc.AsinsiWEi. «£>ODrisrger Bpeoti. Cowaii probohlylliwes nu&a f«w hours .afirr -.iexving the water; hut Ihe larger forms iivo through tamiriay^ ftWHrtranfiinrmlirinn ■frmrl thn mrmph ocCDJirin nnemght, their final moult the next night, and their period of adult activity and egg-laying and their death the nest evening. Theadulw&re peculiar in thevenathin of their -wings {Fig. ijSyl and in the extent of the longitudinal furrowing of the same, in the lack of iunotional month parts and in the buoyant function assumed by the alimentary canal, which, being no longer used for food, is filled with air. While highly specialized in most respects, one very generalized character has been retained in the group: the openings of the oviducts of the female are paired and separate. The males of most species indulge in graceful ante-nuptial flights, that to the observer appear most delightful and exhilarating. They assemble in little companies and dance op and down, alter nately rising and falling, flying upward and falling down again on outspread wings in long vertical hnt-. Tbe crepuscular species such as Ephemera and Hexagema. that compose the well-known *wanas. fly out over the surface of the water, where the females meet the males, and afterwards settle down noon the surface of the water to nlwrate their eggs. Caau s swarms over the edge of the 888 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY water just as darkness falls. Some of the less nocturnal species, as Leptophlebia and Choroterpes, swarm out in the sunlight in sheltered places of late afternoons, or dance up and down among the mixed shadows and sunlight beneath the canopied crowns of tall stream-side forest trees. The females of Baetis creep beneath stones at the surface of the water and deposit their eggs in single-layered patches just beneath the surface. The adult life of Mayflies is truly ephemeral and is concerned wholly with reproduction; and the struggle for existence is transferred largely to the immature stages. The nymphs are highly and independently specialized. They are adapted to all sorts of aquatic situations. A few, like Hexagenia, Ephemera, and Polymitarcys (Fig. 1359), are burrowers beneath the bottom silt. A few, like Caenis and Ephemerella, are of seden- tary habits and Kve rather inactively on the Fm- Kgia^f32,h fll bottom, and on silt-covered stems. Many are active climbers among green vegetation; such are Callibaetis and Blasturus; and some of these can swim and dart about by means of synchronous strokes of tail and gills with the swiftness of a minnow. The species of Leptophlebia love the beds of slow-flowing streams, and all the flattened nymphs of the Heptageninae live in swiftly mov- ing water, and manifest various degrees of adaptation to withstand- ing the wash of strong currents. The form is depressed, and margins of the head and body are thin and flaring, and can be appressed closely to the stones to deflect the current. So diverse are the nymphs in form that the genera may be distinguished among them by a beginner more easily than among the adult Mayflies. Mayfly nymphs feed largely on dead vegetable substances — the decaying stems and leaves of aquatic plants. They are of first importance in the food of fishes. But we are as yet largely in ignorance of the conditions that make for their abundance. The study of this group has been greatly neglected by entomol- ogists and our Mayfly fauna is very insufficiently known. The ecology of the immature stages is especially in need of investigation. AQUATIC 1NSKCTS H8f) Dragoxplies and D\msk,i,kuf,s Order Odonata) This is another isolated .group of inserts, larger in size and of stronger build. All our representatives of the group are aquatic in their earlier stages, but there are a few Hawaiian damselflieq whose nymphs live out of the water. on moist ^oil under :he ieaveq of liliaceous plants. All members of ihe order .tre ■ Hrnivorous in all stages. They are indeed among the most important of < -Hrni- vorous forms about the shores of all fresh water*. The wings of the adults are strongly lev-eloped ind iwvp ,i peculiar venation Fig. ;^88K The leers ;t.re not \erching; '.o facilitate 'wrching m -ertirnl ^pms, thev are set far forward and -graduated in ,t»ngth. -o ih;it :hey hold the body when it re«;t in a more or c»ss horizon tal :>o^ition This facilitates mick -topping ind -tarring s.gain '\>rre<;pondingly the wings ire -hifteri far 'wick ward, tnd n'lted inward it ;heir fore margins, and 4he -ide *)ieres i.f :he thorax .ire ;i*kew The males are :>emiiar -Iso Lmone he irder; in having the ;icccssorv organs of reproduction :opulatorv inpamtu«) developed unon 'he ventral ^ide »f he -erond :lv!ominal egment :ar re- moved from the owning of : he -nerm flu cm upon the ninth segment. The i.*ves ire ■•pp" highlv developed. « l n rl : he antennae ,ire minute and -etaceous. In ■ his i hey resembl :he preceding i>rr\t*T Kphem- •?rida. but the two «_rroiins as :hev -xist to-fjav .-ire highly fiitTpr^n ti- nted from -ach >ther. -.it hough nore »r «»ss ntermediate fossil forms ?>oint tr> their ■ ^mmon « nthn i:i : he ;,ast. Among 'he ira eon flies :re -^anv unern k'ers j"he -need on •he wing of i'rnwpn i.nd \nnr. nuals .md rteir igilitv yrped^. 'hat <-f .-wallow*:. Thev ..|| . anture iieir rev ,i light .md *?*» iependent on :heir vines »r retting .: ivmg. lint ;he habfr of flight :.s verv ji*Tpr.*rJ ;■> ;ifferer,t -rouns *nlv i. c*w .f ?H* ■trongest form* "oam he ;nper :.ir t nil. 'her? -■; *i r,f*t of /eantiful nen'es *-np -^immpr; r [ jbethiliriae ( F17. >6o* l1*** ;iover« r^wr »)or*d*« '■? V orison t;i.i *Mght ; ne ! irger v-r7«-« r n t tv* •* Wngs. keeping t.^ *■'"»*» •'ighe'' I »v-.»ic H-.e stronger f " v[n~ ' r**-1- .our^e along vtr*»r*m* ' n ^iore ..r *i»«u r»gu!ar t".efl.i.i»- -^t 1 planes aiv iess ^on«tantly »)n :iie winer. :ivirwr ..uwii' 890 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY sallies from one resting place to another, and alighting of tener on stones or other flat surfaces than on vertical stems. The damselflies are not such good flyers. The common black- wing Calopteryx (Fig. 1361) may usually be seen fluttering gaily about the borders of creeks, but most damsemies are little in evidence, and confine their locomotion to flitting from stem to stem amid the shelter of vegetation. The dragonflies eat other insects in vast numbers and in great variety. A large part of their food consists of small diptera: and because many of these small diptera are noxious species, mos- quitos, etc., an extended inquiry was once made as to the feasibility of using dragonflies to remove these pests: it appeared that dragon- flies are not at all discriminating in their feeding, and will as readily eat useful as noxious species. Then, too, they eat other dragonflies, apparently preferring forms that are only a little smaller than them- selves. Eagenius, for example, eats Gomfhus, and Gomphus eats Mesothcmis, and Mesothemis eats Lestes, and Lesles eats Argia, and Argia eats Ischnura, and so on from the greatest even unto the least of them. Many dragonflies are eaten by birds and other animals at their transformation, before they are able to fly and escape; and some of those that are not very strong-flying are eaten habitually by birds — the smaller Libellulines by king-birds, and the smaller damselflies by swallows. But it is doubtful whether anything that files la able to capture in flight one of the swiftest dragonflies. AQUATIC INSECTS 891 There is much diversity of egg-laying habits in the order. All the damselflies and many dragonflies, especially Aeschnidae, are provided with an ovipositor, by means of which punctures are made in the stems of aquatic plants, in logs, in wet mud, etc., for the reception of the eggs. The eggs are placed singly in the punc- tures, and usually just below the surface of the water; but a few damselflies descend the stems to place them deeper, and some species of Lesles place them habitually in the stems above the sur- face. Here they are subject to the attack of egg parasites. The females of those dragonflies that lack a well-developed ovipositor drop their eggs upon the surface of the water while in flight (usually descending to touch the surface, and thus to wash them free), whereupon the eggs scatter and fall to the bottom; or, they settle on some plant stem at the surface and hang them in gelatinous masses about the stem. In certain of the Cordulinae these masses are long gelatinous strings, containing many hundreds of eggs. It is easy to get the eggs of most Libellulines for study. When a fe- male is seen tipping the surface of the water with her abdomen while in flight, if she be captured uninjured and held by the tips of the fore wings (leaving the hind wings free) and dipped against the surface of the water in a glass, in imitation of her own motion while at large, she will usually liberate eggs in great abundance in the water. These require about three weeks for hatching, and the nymphs begin to eat each other early in life. There are nymphs of Odonata in all sorts of fresh water. Those of some of the larger active species clamber about freely among water weeds, and even chase their prey, creeping stealthily upon it until within range. Most damselflies (Fig. 1361) clamber about 892 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY among green stems, where they are quite inconspicuous. But nearly all dragonfly nymphs get their living by waiting in hiding for the approach of their prey, and comparatively few of them roam freely about in the water. Most of the Libeltulidae are bottom sprawlers (Fig. 1362) ; most of the Gomphines are burrowers beneath Fin. ijGl. Tht sprawling nymph of Didymofs the bottom silt, and the nymphs of Cordttlegaster are expert ambuscaders, scratching a hole in the sand of the bottom and getting into it, kicking the sand up over their backs until covered excepting the th» of the eyes and of the respiratory orifice at the end of the abdomen, and lying in wait until some unsuspecting little animal suitable for food wanders within reach. The chief organ for capturing prey in the nymphs of all the Odonata is the remarkably developed labium (Fig. 1389-4), which has become elongated, hinged in the middle and folded back under the thorax. It has acquired a formidable array of grappling hooks and spines at its tip. It is often longer than the fore legs when extended and possesses muscles capable of extending it with light- ning-like' speed. It is thrown forward and opened by a single movement, and when it closes on its victim it is withdrawn again instantly, dragging the struggling captive back under the jaws, which then come into play. The problem of getting air has been solved in two ways in the nymphs of the two suborders of Odonata. In the damselflies AQUATIC INSECTS 803 (Fig- I3^3)t there are developed three more or less leaflike gills upon the tip of the abdomen, and these are traversed by fine tracheae, and doubtless assist in getting air, although not entirely mwi^I to that end. In the larger dragonfly nymphs there is developed within the abdomen a respiratory chamber made out of the hinder portion of the modified alimentary canal Through the action of the abdominal muscles, the water is alternately drawn into this and expelled again. This chamber is lined with multitudes of tracheal gills, and abundantly supplied with tracheae, constitut- ing the most perfect aquatic respiratory apparatus developed in insects. Transformation occurs in most Odonata very close above the sur- face of the water. The larger species transform for the most part at night: the damselflies, at any time. The period of half an hour or more required for drying the wings before sustained flight is possible is a time of great peril in the life of the dragonflies. It is a time of opportunity, however, for the collector of life history material. Water Bugs (Order Bemptera) A small part of this great order is aquatic; a number of families are well adapted for life in the water; a few run over the surface and a few others live habitually on the wet shores and forage in the flotsam and drift of the waves. Adults and nymphs are of similar habits and are generally sufficiently alike in structure for ready identification, the metamorphosis being slight. All are distin- guished from the members of other groups by the possession of a jointed puncturing and sucking proboscis that is directed backward beneath the head. The families are so diverse in structure that 894 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY here again is given evidence of independent adaptation to aquatic life, and nowhere could be found more complete intergradation of habits between terrestrial and shore-loving forms and those that dwell in the water. The shore bugs (Acanthiidae) and toad bugs (Pelogonidae) are essentially terrestrial; the marsh treaders (Hydrometridae), water striders, skaters, etc. (Veliidae and Gerridae), have passed out upon the surface, a few of them having acquired the ability to dive and swim. The Nepidae and Belostomatidae are fairly adapted forms that do not depart far or long from the surface of the water, and only the Corixidae and Notonectidae have acquired very highly specialized apparatus for swimming and for carrying down a copious air supply. There are no tracheal gills developed in this order. Nymphs and adults alike must come to the surface for air. They are easily collected by sweeping aquatic vegetation with a dip net. The Corixidae stick more closely to the bottom than do other forms. AQUATIC INSECTS 89S Transformation occurs in the water, and is only a little more of a change than are the earlier nymphal moults. The adults of many genera fly from one body of water to another, and a few of the largest forms (Fig. 1364) have a habit so well known of firing to electric lights at night that they have been denominated "electric light bugs. " These immense bugs are among the most powerful members of the order; the largest of the dragon fly nymphs are no match for them; they will frequently attack and kill frogs, and they have even been found preying on woodpeckers, presumably encountered in flight. Their weapon of offense is the stout beak, the left) und i backnrlmma (it the ifeht), which is capable of making painful wounds. Even the smaller forms of Notonecta (Fig. 1365) can puncture the fingers of the collector if carelessly handled. The eggs of the more strictly aquatic members of the family are fairly well known. Those of Benacus (Fig. 1366) and Amorgius are deposited on the vertical stems of Typha, etc., above the surface of the water; these are among the largest of insect eggs. Those of the Nepidae, Nepa and Ranatra, are distinguished by long appendages at the micropylar end, and are inserted into the soft tissues of plants — into rotten, water-soaked wood, or into 896 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY green herbs. Those of Notonecta are deposited singly on the sides of plant stems under water, and those of Corixa are deposited in similar places or stuck on to the back of crawfishes. The surface-haunting forms are characteristically of scavenger habits, eating the insects of all sorts that fall upon the surface of the water; while the more strictly aquatic bugs are truly predatory with the possible exception of the minute Plea, which is believed not to be carnivorous at all. The highly specialized Corbridae are able to remain wholly submerged for long periods. They clamber about amid the debris of the pond bottom, and when they come to the surface for air, they do not remain there, but quickly descend again to the shelter of the bottom trash. Of all Hemiptera these are the ones most commonly eaten by fishes. AQKMHir INSECTS 897 Dcmsows. Fish Flies Spongilla Fues (Gwirr Vmro^era Bni tap© families of tin- |mt and .heterogeneous order, as now unnmwih restricted, are aquatic, and these in their larval stapes only. The larvae of all the members of the small iamih* Siahdidar Ait* free-ranging carnivorous, aquatic iorms. and in the family ficmerofaudae. there are 2 lew genera whose larvae live in the -water. These two families are so very different in even' respect that the}' are better considered separately. Siaudzdae. Heft belong a few of the most primitive of insects having complete metamorphosis: the orl flies, fish flies, dobsons. etc. They are mostly of large size, and are provided with ample wings, which, however, serve but rather poorly ior flight. The dobsons are among the largest of insects, and their larvae, known to the fishermen as hellgrammites, are famous as bait for black bass. They are found in swift streams beneath the stones, where thev cling securely by means of their stout legs, aided by a pair of stout- clawed processes at the end of the body. They areTprovided at the sides of the abdomen with paired lateral fleshy processes, and at the base of each of these there is a large tuft of fine tracheal gills. The>' are blackish, ugly-looking crawlers, of slow growth, requiring apparent]}' several years to develop. When grown the}' crawl out on shore and seek a suitable place beneath a log or stone; for the pupae are not aquatic. The adult female lays her eggs in broad flat masses on stones or timbers above the edge of the water, and covers them over with a chalky white incrustation. The eggs are piled several layers deep and are very numerous. On hatching the young fall into the water, and begin at once their predator}* existence. But one species of dobson is found in the eastern United States, the common Corydalis carnuia L. The fish flies (Chauliodes) are insects of similar appearance and habits, about half as large as the dobsons. having an expanse of wing of about one and a half inches. Their larvae usually fre- quent still water, where the}' clamber over and under logs. A rotten log on shore furnishes the favorite place for the excavation of a pupal chamber. The eggs are laid above the water in naked patches of one or more layers on either dead wood or green leaves. 898 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The orl flies (Sialis) are still smaller having an expanse of wing of an inch or less. They are plain, blackish in color, and rather secretive in habits. Sometimes they occur in such numbers as to blacken the herbage about the pond border. The larvae (Fig. 1367) live among the stones and gravel in the bed of brooks, and in the borders of ponds, and transform in the wet sand on shore. They are readily distinguished from other larvae by the long tail-like prolongation of the last seg- ment of the body. The female lays her eggs (Fig. 1368) in broad, single layered, blackish patches on some stick or timber above the surface of the water. The lateral filaments of the abdomen in Sialis are thin-skinned, and contain tracheae, and it is possible that they serve as organs of respiration; . there are no additional clusters of fine gills at their bases. Un- , like the foregoing, these larvae descend into the bottom silt and burrow through it, and their long ab- dominal filaments are close laid on the back, as are the gills of the burrowing Mayfly nymphs. There is a striking general similarity be- tween the larvae of the Sialididae and those of the more generalized carnivorous Coleoptera. Hemerobiidae. Only two genera in this large family of attrac- tive insects are aquatic in our fauna, Climacia and Sisyra (Fig. 1369). These are small insects, half an inch or less in expanse of wing, ie t> 01 Uh 4 Fin. 1569. A spongilU IV, Sisyrt. the former yellow and brown in color, the latter, plain brown. Nothing is known of the feeding habits of the adults. Their larvae MgXMCm rHfiHKIJf *QD BSf-rgm cert \.if}nc:hs&*«nur,'30na^&.ai^Ih%v«hbiiE-;.)*cf)BCC^- oios. flfiHeaane. . iriii-. itpmswiufc. ac briStt-rrar 4:: fo^EKMagKrauute 'THk? inmrtirat rin- -tissn o: rtas neoner mti tattr more ectwrwfc auixmp month: :?ttTfc Has Maim: atmmmps- *: 'tifcc tfcrtanriaaii «piwm. ^iwii- mipiiimir iiMwrmah h» *im\ aat: OmaOBSfcy anjoiaaecc "ber- a**- norm: isefit amc tanum mtir - tttac ameer- mittm: Jnutt^t&ie- "rbrotki*. jbl tife wttrsrom .mw. b* ttnmm. twoHp-. Bttst ttorcr jam . tn ■ tmwt^L tite jetsttr ■pttomrik-. mnnsn: v. wr ttt-. jwtttfwr «*r. tf: t*. dimstruar. taenJL aae.ifU aevwsaiS* . ibt* tef t* faK'KtlHW:.MU. «.# reemiw; ADC Lb- mataui.: iwnwtiw. Mb. & t*o*- «hs»;. WfeHn.gpww- he-: jimct jasv«s fees wtMtr' -,*ad tfcttM^ fr> otww hkl.u.Io'. as4«*wti«ig -n wa*K , aw j njaRianit'i His - ,»pj*MWi«i;#«-. £ «&k fiMMVr-' WC M*tflf...»HC ftwi.,ii- bwnr- MtMK aBHMH •axww- CAiwww*; *>Kew- to. .uiir- £»**««£• ir it tWafiftw iOKUfflBOaa.' jitter, wic" .<£**: :#wKitt.. JlitAluttv. i-.Juoam.£ .«sy mlot- penucuitrs -neap- siuit .(•- hi*ti«ic j* TfrttfjUwwK , ^tcaapj , ar- ipaaain^ . that she jmmafte euros' ^ftbt*&ir';8B(itts f^ Wmoraotwciet , ftw jaitwieto , she-earns «mwwft*»g >w ;***»#■. WJttfswrttttttw's* vt l&r iamu>\ are «s yet .WMUtUHir'- 906 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The Caddisflies {Order Trichoptero) The caddisflies constitute a large group of insects, nearly all of which are aquatic in their immature stages. Among the adults are many pretty species of soft colors and great elegance of form. Having rudimentary mouth, parts they are short-lived. They are chiefly nocturnal in habits and fly to lights, often in great num- bers. Some are diurnal and hover over water in long sustained horizontal flight; others dance up and down in companies under the shelter of streamside trees. No insects are more common about the wharf lights on the shores of our great lakes. The larvae exhibit great diversity of structure and habits. Much excellent work, has been done on them in Europe, but our American forms are little known. The most familiar larvae are the well known "caddisworms" that construct portable cases (Fig. 1371), in which to live, and carry them about on their backs. These cases are made out of a great variety of materials: sticks, small stones, sand grains, bits of shell, of leaves or of bark; in short, almost any solid material suitably small and available. In many species the construction of the cases is so uniform in pattern and materials that the larvae may be known by the houses which they drag about. The larvae of the Phrygeaneidae construct cylindrical cases made of bits of stems, grass, etc., placed lengthwise in a continu- AtJEATTT IKSECT? oo snirai bond, fist sstvl of Seuoamsymr amid* an: o: ssnc ^xjobs & sumdiv aucKC sas&. saaj«c fiiet ± saaL shell. Tjat Tnamia^ of lot taat art aiirays succa: aajgetber by xqgih> o: tbi secretion 4>: fiszttirc&r} gsaitnz "Dmaliy tot: caaesare crrnrirmcAliDni: sometimes iiisy aR maagusr ir tquaR n_ rros.— eectiaL Dsoaliy tbt- sticks usee art praxc ttsjgrlinnrii*: ini: sonaenme:* crosssrist .a> ii. stick oinrmrrvs. u ma&t lit tnifcv anr" czmorrsount crvtiQins-- of samt i V V. o: ti^linmtp&hiiidat . Smneiirrrei. or. tur other hanc . they art* oco*- smtrirt: i>\ iigh: aac tnir. a? u o5er iitlk 'rrinrtranct- u fret joo- motim. . am: £. *ew 43^^-- iriti it^^isvedapec swimming nirare^ or. their doof uarBk.- i*e: srar. freeiy about. Jn tit *ja**L- iha: are oa&- strucus: iiv nrc»s; iarva-: of tilt two m iam&tts Hyaroptiiiua-. [Fij: ijju ami Kitvav-optdlid^ 21c ■gxrraneaar materia^ ai^ u*cc bir. oaiv thr Br- cretiwt of tit salivary giamir : theet v&ste art tirr-rior-: tic. ant parci- naca;-jik't. 3'ios: jja«Bbr!> of tht £rea: iajxtiiy K>Tirop>.v:raaat make IK- ponabit t2U*cr a: al irj: onh* ruiiwavi- h. tit vrcvit*^ between tht SLox*euuc L\ *rv*rrv sxvii: Str-taUT.. tfpsU. W*JJr O: Oj>C.r. mtai: ILK*. te..i>»--.:iK:tftrrii3~.iiww .u. MMir mater jpoacb. mictua lis rnnwnm ohl su-eair. tsati:r 0: tieir LiiiM:^ tr runways: tieariy. tfai> i> ior the purport of uaiciuiii* «ui> Jiitk- oj^aiiism> se: aoiii; ir. tin- stream. Tiese art xaaimv v^riim»R»i^ i^rt'ac. man' mc3iiber> 0:' other iwm"^ iutv> l mixeci die: of vtrgeiahii anL anima iooci. bui a guudiy juumi*cr <*ii cJ&dr irrbivorou^. Tbert arc caddisfi^ iar\r*c ior al! sort? of waters, and ior wet situations, or moa&>v Uia,nk^. A icw speiier. accnmDanvuxc the "biuuQ worxo>. iiavc migraitc iar uul un thr bottoms of our iaiger faff . 903 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY lakes into deep water. The gills of the caddisfly larvae are always of the filamentous type, never lamelliform. They are wanting in members of several families, and are variously disposed about the body, singly or in clusters, in many others; their number, form, and arrangement furnish group recognition characters. The more typical caddisworms, having their gill filaments along the sides of the abdomen completely inclosed within the case, keep water flow- ing through by means of continual undulating motion of the abdo- men; three tubercles at the base of the abdomen and a pair of stout prolegs at its apex serve to keep the walls properly spaced for the admission and the flow of the water. The case is always large enough so the larva can entirely withdraw itself inside. By this means it doubtless escapes from many enemies. But some of the larger fishes, as, for example, brook trout, eat case and all. The pupa of caddisflies is peculiar in that it also is aquatic. It is formed within the larval case or tube, the larva closing the apertures with a perforate web of silk before its final moulting; this web admits water for respiration, but keeps out enemies. True tracheal gills, of the same type as those possessed by the larvae, are present on the pupae of many caddisflies. AH the pupae are more or less active; some maintain constant undulating move- ments of the abdomen to keep the water circulating, and at the close of the pupal stage all work their way out of the larval case, and swim to the surface of the water to undergo their final trans- formation. In the case of species that inhabit swift waters and transform in the current, this takes place very quickly, the adult emerging instantly on reaching the sur- ^^ ^^mf face and flying away at once. Although ^^^^tt/^^^ the adults have jaws of the most rudi- l^i^^l mentary sort- the mandibles of the pupa ^L^ 1 are often large and conspicuous; they are 6 ' supposed to be of use in cutting a way pw-tsn- hi imiIu in.. out of the larval case. The eggs of caddisflies are hud in various ways and places. Some are dropped in the surface of still pools while in flight. The females of some of the Hydro- AQUATIC INSECTS 903 psychidae crawl beneath the water and spread their eggs in a single layer over the lee side of stones in the gentler currents. The big forms of Phryganea fasten their pretty green eggs in a gelatinous ring (Fig. 1373) on the stem of some aquatic plant. Aquatic Moths (Order Lepidoptera) Of this great order of insects, only a few moths of the family Pyralidae are aquatic. Many moths live as larvae on plants by the waterside, and a few burrow in the tissues of submerged aquatic plants, obtaining their air from the airspaces of the plant stems. The aquatic caterpillars, like their terrestrial relatives, are distin- guished from larvae of other orders by the possession of a brown chitinous shield covering the prothoracic segment, by bristle-bear- ing tubercles regularly disposed over the body and by fleshy grasp- ing prolegs beneath the abdomen. There are three types of aquatic larvae found commonly in our fresh waters, two in ponds and one in rapid streams. The larvae of Nymphula (Hydrocampd) are destitute of gills, and greatly resemble pale terrestrial caterpillars. They live in flat cases composed of two pieces cut out from green leaves of river- weed or water-lily, and fastened together and lined with silk. They live near the surface of the water. During the pupal stage the cases are often found floating. The eggs are laid on or under floating leaves. The larvae of Paraponyx are provided with abundant branching gills, which surround the body like a white fringe. These larvae live in similar cases or between leaves in sheltering crevices that are lined with silk. The larvae of Elophila fulicalis, as recently described by Lloyd from Ithaca, N. Y., live on the stones in rapid streams, protected by an irregular shelter of thin-spun silk. They are in form strongly depressed, and have unbranched gills arranged in two longitudinal lateral rows. They feed mainly on such green algae as grow near at hand. Each larva when grown fashions a broadly dome-shaped pupal shelter or half-cocoon under some portion of the larval shelter, with a row of marginal openings at either side to permit free circulation of water and air through it. 904 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Beetles (Order Coleoptera) Of this great group of insects only a few families are wholly aquatic, and a few others are partially so. The order as a whole is predominantly terrestrial, and the aquatic families show unmistak- able signs of having been developed from terrestrial ancestors. All the adults and pupae are strictly terrestrial in their mode of respiration, and nearly all the larvae likewise get their air supply from above the surface of the water. The pupae of all are formed either on land, or in direct communication with the air. The families that are strictly aquatic are the Dytiscidae, Haliplidae, Parnidae and Amphizoidae; those that show complete intergrada- tion in habits are the Hydrophilidae and Dascyllidae. The Chrys- omelidae are scarcely to be called aquatic at all in any proper sense, although two of the subfamilies live on water plants. There is such great diversity of habits and structure in water beetles that the families may be best considered separately. We begin with those that are least aquatic in habit. Two small groups of leaf beetles of the great family Chrysomelidae feed upon water plants; the Galerucellinae, upon the floating leaves of members of the water-lily family. These dingy little beetles lay their yellow eggs in small clusters on the upper surfaces of the leaves, and the black-banded larvae, hatching therefrom, feed upon the tissues, quite as their more familiar relatives feed upon land plants. The other subfamily, the Donaciinae, or long-horned leaf- beetles, is much more interesting. The larvae feed upon the roots of aquatic plants, far beneath the surface of the water. They are provided with a pair of spiracles near the end of the body and these spiracles are armed with sharp corneous processes, capable of being thrust into plant stems, of reaching the air spaces on the inside, and of obtaining the air, rich in oxygen, contained therein. Thus the larvae, while destitute of gills, and strictly air breathers, get their air supply through the medium of the plants, while living always beneath the water. The pupal stage likewise is passed in the place where the larva lived on the roots, but the pupa is inclosed in a water-tight cocoon, attached to the plant tissue and containing air in free communication with that in the air spaces of -tr . * ■• - AQUATIC INSECTS 905 the plant. The adult beetles spend their lives among the leaves of the plants, flying actively about when disturbed. They are of shining, metallic coloration, blue or green. Those that live on water lilies deposit their eggs through holes eaten in the leaves, arranging them in a curve around the opening on the under side . They are able to place them thus through the possession of a long extensile ovipositor. The family Hydrophilidae is in part terrestrial and in part aquatic, and the aquatic members show all degrees of adaptation to water lift. A few of the larger forms are expert swimmers, but many of the smaller ones are fitted only for dabbling around in the mud at the waters edge. The best-known member of the family is perhaps the big black Eydropkilus, with finely fringed swimming legs and with keeled sternum. It is attracted to electric lights in vast numbers in the spring, where it falls beneath them and flounders around in the dust of the street, giving a fine illustration of the use- lessness of its specialization when in an unsuitable environment. The larva of this beetle is commonly taken in ponds, not swimming, but clinging to stems at the surface, its squat, hairy body not well fitted for getting through the water, but with immense rapacious jaws, very- capable of seizing large Mayfly nymphs and adult Bu- branckipus when these swim within reach. Another hydrophilid which often swarms into trap lanterns set over streams is Berosus, whose aquatic larva is provided with lateral paired abdominal ap- pendages somewhat like those of the neuropterous genus Stalls. The eggs of Eydrophilus are laid in a white membranous capsule attached to plant stems and leaves at the surface of the water. The Amphizoidae and Parnidae are found as adult beetles clinging to logs and stones in clear flowing streams. The former family contains but a few far western species; the latter is widely dis- tributed, and contains numerous genera and species. The name "Riffle beetles'' is applied to them to indicate the seat of their greatest abundance. They are mostly of small size and their coloration is usually inconspicuous, although some of them are striped with red or yellow. The adults sun themselves on the stones that protrude from the water, and fly readily from one rest- ing place to another. Many of the larvae, especially the larger 906 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY ones, are strongly depressed in form, and have flaring lateral mar- gins to the body segments that fit down closely against a stone, limpet-like, to withstand the wash of the current; hence, these are able to maintain a footing in the swiftest waters. The common "water penny/ ' the larva of Psephenus lecontei, illustrates the extreme of flattening; this larva has developed abundant tracheal gills from the thin membrane between the body segments, and these are completely covered over by the projecting lateral margins of the body segments. The adult female Psephenus crawls down on the lee side of a stone and deposits her yellow eggs in broad one- layered patches on its surface. The Gyrinidae or whirligig beetles constitute a small group of strictly aquatic forms, very peculiar in structure and habits. They are well known to every one as shining black beetles of oval form, that gather in companies upon the surface of brooks and ponds and glide about in irregular curves with a speed which the eye can hardly follow. When captured they exude a whitish repugnatorial fluid, having a rather disagreeable odor. They hibernate as adult beetles in the mud and in their season of activity they spend much time beneath the water, in which they can dive and swim dextrously. Their fore feet bear hooked claws with which they can cling to the bottom when desiring to remain beneath the surface. They are at once distinguishable from other water beetles by the unusual brevity and peculiar formation of the hind legs, and by the possession of divided eyes, there appearing to be one pair above for vision of objects in air when the beetle lies on the surface, and one below, presumably, for seeing things in the water. The larva of the gyrinids is elongate and slender, and possesses at the tip of the abdomen two pairs of backwardly directed grap- pling hooks, and long slender paired filaments arranged segmentally along its sides somewhat like those of the Neuropterous genus Sialis. Both larvae and adults are carnivorous. The larvae possess long perforate sickle-shaped mandibles well adapted for punctur- ing the skins of soft midge or other dipterous larvae, etc., and for sucking out the fluid content of their bodies. The pupae of the Gyrinidae are formed in thin cocoons attached to the side of verti- cal plant stems above the water. AQUATIC INSECTS 907 The little family of Haliplidae contains two genera of pretty little beetles of brown color spotted with yellow, Haliplus and Pdiody* tes. These are easily distinguished from other beetles by the sternal plates that broadly overlap the bases of the hind legs. These beetles abound amid thick shore vegetation, and their larvae adhere very closely to the trash, and are most commonly found in floating mats of Spirogyra and other filamentous algae. They are among the most inactive of creatures, and in coloration and in form show a high degree of protective resemblance. They are easier overlooked than discovered even by the collector searching for them. The stick-like larva of Haliplus is shown in Fig. 1374; Pdtodytes is strikingly different superficially, being covered all over its body by very long jointed slender bristle-like processes. Matheson has recently shown that the larvae feed upon filamentous algae, sucking out the contents of the cells, one by one, and that the eggs are deposited by the adult beetles within the coarser algal filaments. The dominant family of water beetles is the Dytiscidae, commonly known as diving beetles. These abound in all fresh-water ponds. All are aquatic in both larval and adult stages, but all take air at the surface of the water, with the exception of some of the smaller larvae which seem to be able to absorb their oxygen from the water without having developed any special apparatus therefor. All are carnivorous, and in all the pupa is formed on shore. In fitness for swimming, the adult beetles differ greatly. Some of the larger forms like Cybister are possessed of long oar-like hind legs provided with close- uril^J'ndt e • 1111 1 tlu%- (I,raWn set swimming fringes, and the long regular synchronous j* Mi* vAn* strokes of the legs drive the body forward with great ease and swiftness; whereas, some of the lesser and more general- ized forms, like Bidessus, with scanty swimming fringes, and with legs otherwise little modified, either in structure or in movement, from what is useful in walking, swim very poorly. These do more 008 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY climbing than swimming, and, consequently, they keep nearer to shore and to the shelter of submerged trash. In an aquarium beetles of the size of Coptotomus and Laccophilus may be seen feed- ing in groups on the bodies of dragonfly nymphs and tadpoles much larger than themselves, which they have overpowered. Their own exceed- ingly hard chitinous armor doubtless protects them from being eaten by the majority of aquatic carnivorous animals. Egg-laying appears to have been observed hitherto only in DyUscus, which deposits its eggs singly in punctures made in the green stems of aquatic plants. The larvae are voracious creatures, armed with long sickle- shaped mandibles, like those of the larvae of the families just men- tioned, each mandible with so deep a groove on the inner side that it amounts to a perforation opening at the tip and the base. The Fig. nit. Side (Drawing by Mrs. Hd< ng beetle. Byinpmu. basal aperture lies just within the mouth-opening when the tips of the mandible are brought together. Nearly all the larvae of this group capture only living prey, but a few like Eydropoms (Fig. 1376) will eat pieces of animals that have been killed for them. Mhejt <»xiHJi! ri "tut 3iKi'.-f iri coimrumti in pivt- tqyE ftv *tifc -gcwttn wt Ut>^dsnuft JwaUig -UraK imiag wj' numennK gio FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Fig. 1378. Typical wing venation in the aquatic families of the Diptera. a, Psychodidae Moth flies k, Tabanidae Horse-flies 6, Tipulidae Crane-flies i, Stratiomyidae Soldier flies c, Blephoceridae Net-winged midges j, Leptidae Snipe-flies d, Dixidae Dixa-midges *, Dotichopodidae Doiichopods e, Culicklae Mosquitoes /, Empidiaae The empids /, Chironomidae Midges m, Syrphidae Syrphus flies g, Simuliidae Black-flies n, Musddae (*, lot.) in the Chironomidae, Tipulidae, etc., or even to enter into detailed statements as to their habits. A few of the families are compara- tively small and unimportant. The moth flies (Psychodidae) are very minute, being among the smallest of flies, and live as larvae s..- AQUATIC INSECTS 911 in the scum and about the edges of all sorts of fresh water, while their adults swarm in thickets about the shores of pools. The Ptychopteridae inhabit swales, their larvae living in the rotting trash at the edge of the water, and the adults fluttering about the tops of the adjacent herbage. The dixa midges (Dbridae) inhabit spring brooks and clear pools, and their larvae (Fig. 1379), with bodies bent double, slide out upon the surfaces of wet leaves and stones, or edge off into the water and whirl about in short curves ; the adults dance in companies above the surface of the water. Some larvae of the Rhyphidae likewise inhabit pools, and the adults sometimes assemble and dance in the shelter of forest trees at some dis- tance from the water. The few known aquatic members of the Leptidae live as larvae in streams and cling with the well- developed claws of their stout muscular #^ abdominal prolegs to the surfaces of stones; the adults flit about the shore, FK.11T9. u™ ho u*- the mouth. This is an aboriginal plankton apparatus. Simulium larvae play in the rapids, spinning silken threads in the water, and swinging on them from place to place. Occasionally the threads thus spun in the troughs of fish hatcheries have been sufficiently numerous to entangle and kill newly hatched trout. These threads are spun from the salivary glands; a final use for the secretion of these glands is the making of the open-meshed half-cornucopia- shaped cocoon in which, attached to the sides of the rocks or tim- bers, the pupal stage is passed; a branched prolongation of the tracheal lining of the prothoracic spiracles constitutes the so-called "tube gills, " by means of which the black-fly pupa is able to get its air supply while wholly submerged. The soldier flies (Stratiomyiidae) live as larvae on the surface of Still water. They float stiff and rigid and stick-like, with a circlet of water-repellent bristles surrounding the. terminal spiracles, keep- ing open the way to the air. The pupa is formed within the larval skin, without further outward indication of the change than a slight angulation of the latter posteriorly. The adult soldier flies hover familiarly about the arrow heads on shore at egg- laying time, and at other times frequent flowers to feed on their nectar. 9X4 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY There remain three large families of the diptera of very great im- portance. Two of these, the Culicidaeand theTabanidae.are impor- tant because of the damage they do, and the other, the Chironomidae, because of the food it furnishes to fishes. The mosquitoes (Culi- cidae), since the discovery of their importance to man as agents for the dissemination of the germs of malarial and other fevers, have suddenly become well known. A number of good books are now available containing descriptions, figures, and detailed accounts of the habits and life histories of the economic species. Some of the most interesting members of the family are not included in these books among the pests, since the adults do not bite. Corelhra, whose phantom larvae are a part of the plankton, is one of these, and Pelorempis, the large culicid inhabitant of cold springs is another. The biting adults of the large horse-flies (Tabanidae) are like- wise serious pests of the domesticated animals. Their naked translucent larvae, tapering to either end and ringed with fleshy tubercles, arc carnivorous, and are found in the trash of the bottom in all shoal fresh waters. But two genera, Tabanus and Chrysops, are of much importance in our fauna. The midges (Chironomidac, Fig. 1383) constitute undoubtedly jygu.m.. ISSETTS **5 tBtjsaps: amp)-, amgn-:. c. itaaLAi. Xontet- Tar> «-.:.iJ«K. maeoc. U1-- tyjitci. ccna^ ^nr a: tiati-enc c: lb-- Atr-oaiatc . mill, xoc-pane; win: -ocafaui: iwtier thai "nib: ?oh; ' proiruec^ irot in-. nrccnntc*3 5Uxku~k--- *re abi- •-■ Uvt- i:. &21 wucft iron-, springs to tsiacaar.: nooi- niTn? JlOBi rili- v o«a iaii; bottom:. Tee; -j: cracn; ucriiivomu^ an., are o: vrr jrca: imiiortaiic-.- i: furnishing th; 100. o: ... niu!tiliifh- ni tat larger ftniyna.]- including nsFw-- . To*, larva* construct ior thenu*lv«s some sort oi shelter, iastenini: the materials their «ivi- roim.civ.. oilers together with tii*.* silk-like secretion oi thta;1 salivary glands oorin in rapid streams build case-- oi! tin stones; other*, on the lake bottom, build sol: lioccuknt tube* oi silt (Fiji. i.^.O- 916 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY These latter larvae are red in color and are known as "blood worms." The color is due to haemoglobin in the blood plasma; the capacity of this substance for oxygen gathering seems to enable these blood worms to live in water that is poor in oxygen. In the preceding pages the principal groups of aquatic insects are briefly characterized, and typical forms are figured. Hints are given for the recognition of the nymphs of Plecoptera on page 885, and of the larvae of aquatic Lepidoptera on page 903. In the fol- lowing pages keys are given for determining the adults of Trichop- tera and Hemiptera, and for both adults and immature stages of the other orders. An understanding of the venation of the wings is essential to the study of adult insects of most orders, and the following figure (Fig. 1386) is given to illustrate the wing venation and explain the terminology used. Fig. 1386. The venation of the wings of a stonefly, CUoropeHa. The designation of veins is given here for all succeeding wing figures: C, Costa If, Media Sc, Subcosta Cm, Cubitus R, Radius A, Anal veins. The radius has a main stem (Rt) and a principal branch (Rs) on the posterior side. Media is often twice forked, and Cubitus once forked; the recognisable branches are numbered from front to rear: three anal veins are likewise recognized. :**-*• -• AQUATIC INSECTS 917 KEY TO THE ORDERS OF AQUATIC INSECT LARVAE 1 (8) Larvae with wings developing externally (called nymphs in this chapter) and no quiescent pupal stage 2 2 (7) With biting mouth parts 3 3 (6) With long, filamentous caudal setae; labium not longer than the head, and not folded on itself like a hinge 4 4 (5) Gills mainly under the thorax; tarsal claws two: caudal setae two. (Stoneflies; see page 883) . . . Plecoptera. 5 (4) Gills mainly on the sides of the abdomen; tarsal claws single; caudal setae generally three. (Mayflies ; see page 921).. Bphemerida. 6 (3) Caudal setae represented by three broad, leaf-like respiratory plates traversed by tracheae, or by small spinous appendages; labium when extended much longer than the head; at rest, folded like a hinge, extending between the bases of the fore legs. (Dragonflies and damselflies; see page 928) . . Odonata. 7 (2 ) Mouth parts combined into a jointed beak, which is directed beneath the head backward between the fore legs. (Bugs; see page 933) . . . Hemlptera. 8 (1) Larvae proper, with wings developing internally, and invisible till the assumption of a quiescent pupal stage 9 9 (18) With jointed thoracic legs xo 10 (11) With slender, decurved, piercing mouth parts, half as long as the body; small larvae, living on fresh-water sponges. Family Hemerobudae (see page 934) of . . Neuroptera. 11 10) With biting mouth parts 12 12 (15) With a pair of prolegs on the last segment only (except in Sialis, Fig. 1367, which has a single long median tail-like process at the end of the abdomen) these directed backward, and armed each with one or two strong hooks or claws. . . 13 13 (14) Abdominal segments each with a pair of long, lateral filaments. Family Sialididae (see page 935) of . . Neuroptera. 14 (13) Abdominal segments without long, muscular, lateral filaments, often with minute gill filaments: cylindric larvae, generally living in portable cases. (Caddisflies; see page 936) . . Trichoptera. 15 (12) Prolegs, when present, on more than one abdominal segment; if present on the last segment, then not armed with single or double claws (except in gyrinid beetle larvae, which have paired lateral abdominal filaments), often entirely want- ing 16 16 (17) With five pairs of prolegs, and with no spiracles at the apex of the abdomen. . . (Moths; see page 903) . . Lepidoptera. 17 (16) Generally without prolegs; never with five pairs of them; usually with terminal spiracles; long, lateral filaments often present on the abdominal segments. (Beetles, adults; seep. 937; larvae; see p. 943) . Coleoptera. 18 (9) Without jointed thoracic legs; with abdominal prolegs, or entirely legless (Flies, etc.; see page 043) . . Diptem. 918 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN MAYFLIES Ihagos i (13) The cubital and first anal veins strongly divergent at the base (Fig. jlydi tlyri 1387). Venation never greatly reduced. 1 (3) The posterior fork of the median vein very deep, almost reaching the wing base; two long simple intercalaries between the first and second anal veins Campsurus. 3 (2) The posterior fork of the median vein ( Mr M ,) forked for not more than three-fourths of its length 4 F10. 138J. The wings ol Ef turners. (Drawn by Di 4 (5) Between the first and second anal veins is a bunch of three or four long straight intercalaries, conjoined basally before their attach- ment to the principal veins; the second anal vein nearly straight and unbranched Polymtiarcys. 5 (4; Between the first and second anal veins are only shorter, sinuate, and sometimes forking. intercalaries, attached directly to the first anal; the second anal vein sinuate and often branched (Fig. 1387) 6 6 (7) The posterior fork of the median vein forked two-thirds to three-fourths its length; vein Cui not more strongly bent at base than the first anal Euthyplocia. 7 (6) This fork of the median vein occupying not more than half its length; vein Cut more strongly bent at base than is the first anal (Fig. 1387) 8 8 (12) The third anal vein simple, but attached to the hind margin by a number of cross veins; in the narrow posterior fork of the median vein there are one or more cross veins before the origin of the intercalary; male forceps four-jointed 9 0 (10, 1 1) Caudal setae three in both male and female; fore tarsus of female imago three-fourths as long as the tibia. . . . Ephemera. 10 (9, 11) Cauda] setae two in the male and three in the female; fore tarsus of the female two-thirds as long as the tibia. . Penlagenia. n (9, 10) Caudal setae two in male and female; fore tarsus of female as long as the tibia. Hexagenia. AQUATIC INSECTS 919 12 (8) The third anal vein with a simple terminal fork and unattached to the hind margin, although a few isolated short intercalaries lie between; in the wider posterior fork of the median vein there is no cross vein before the origin of the intercalary; male forceps three-jointed Potamattikus. 13 (1) The cubital and first anal veins parallel at base (in a few forms with reduced and scanty venation, appearing a little diverg- ent) 14 14 (15) Hind tarsi with five freely movable segments; eyes of the male simple and remote; venation never greatly reduced; intercalary veins between the first and second anal veins unattached basally and in two pairs, of which the pair nearer the hind angle is the longer Heptagenia. 15 (14) Hind tarsi usually with but four freely movable segments, the basal segment being more or less completely consolidated with the tibia; eyes of the male enlarged, often approximated on the dorsal side and divided into superior and lateral portions with corneal facets of different size; venation various, sometimes greatly reduced; intercalary veins between the first and second anal never as above 16 16 (17) The three anal veins nearly parallel to the hind margin of the wing and to each other, ending in the outer margin; in the hind wing the branches of the radial vein are strongly unilateral on the anterior side Baetisca. 17 (16) Anal veins strongly divergent distally, usually both the second and the third ending in the hind margin; forks of the radial vein in the hind wing more symmetrical 18 18 (39) The posterior division of the median vein with a normal posterior fork; hind wings, when present, usually but little longer than broad and with a copious venation 19 19 (32) The intercalariefi between the first and second anal veins variable, but usually more or less independent, and not directly dependent from the first anal; three well-developed caudal setae (except in Bias turns, in our fauna) 20 20 (31) Hind wings present. 21 21 (28) Bisector of the posterior fork of the median vein and bisector of the cubital fork unattached basally; between the latter and vein Cuj no intercalaries; vein Cuj in the hind wing rarely preserved; caudal setae generally much longer than the body; penultimate segment of the male forceps shorter than the antepenultimate 22 22 (27) In the hind wing the subcostal vein reaches nearly to the wing apex; male forceps three-jointed 23 23 (26) Hind wing with a slight concavity at the middle of costal margin; five to six longitudinal veins between Mi and Ms; veinlets numerous about the wing margins and cross veins numerous in the hind wings 24 24 (25) Third anal vein of the hind wing wanting; caudal setae of about equal length. LtpiophUbia. 920 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 25 (24) Third anal vein of the hind wing present, and often followed by one or two additional intercalaries; median caudal seta dis- tinctly shorter than the others Bias turns. 26 (23) Hind wing with an angular lobe projecting forward from the middle of the costal margin; four longitudinal veins between Mi and Mi; wing margins free from veinlets, and few cross veins in hind wing Habrophlebia. 27 (22) In the hind wing the subcostal vein terminates in the costa at hardly more than half the length of the wing, just beyond the obtuse angulation having a thickened margin; forceps of male more or less distinctly four-jointed. . . Choroterpes. 28 (21) Bisectors of the posterior fork of the median vein and of the cubital fork both tending to attach themselves to the posterior branch of their respective forks; between the latter and vein Cuj are generally some short intercalaries (the cubital region thus being better developed than in group 21); caudal setae about as long as the body; penultimate segment of the male forceps longer than the antepenultimate 29 29 (30) Veins Cu* and 1st A separate to base Ephemeretta. 30 (29) Veins Cu2 and 1st A fused toward the base Drunclla. 31 (20) Hind wings absent Caenis. 32 (19) The intercalaries between the first and second anal veins represented by a series of veinlets, often sinuous or forking, extending directly from the first anal to the wing margin; costal angulation of hind wing close to the base; but two well- developed caudal setae, the median one being rudimentary or wanting; basal joint of hind tarsi evident but not well developed 33 33 (36) Median caudal seta a distinctly segmented rudiment (Fig. 1354); for- ceps of male three- jointed; posterior prolongation of sternum of ninth segment of abdomen of female bifid at tip. . . 34 34 (35) Basal segment of fore tarsus of male shortest; claws of each tarsus unlike each to each; hind wing with the costal angulation acute, and the posterior fork of the median vein occupying two-thirds the length of that vein Cohburus. 35 (34) Basal segment of fore tarsus of the male longest; claws of each tarsus alike; hind wing with the costal angulation obtuse, and the posterior division of the median vein forked through one-third its length Chirotonetes. 36 (33) Median caudal seta more rudimentary or wanting; forceps of the male distinctly four- jointed; posterior prolongation of the sternum of the ninth abdominal segment in the female entire at tip 37 37 (38) Claws of each tarsus alike; caudal setae at least one-half longer than the body Siphlurus. 38 (37) Claws of each tarsus unlike; caudal setae about as long as the body in both sexes AmeUtus. 39 (18) Posterior fork of the median vein apparently simple, M4 being de- tached and appearing as an intercalary; hind wings when present at least twice as long as wide, and provided with but 1-3 longitudinal veins. 40 ■A AQUATIC INSECTS 92 1 40 (45) Hind wings present 41 41 (42) Fore wings with numerous costal cross veins before the bulla; hind wings with a moderate number of cross veins. . Calliboetis. 42 (41) Fore wings without costal cross veins before the bulla; hind wings without cross veins or with but 1-3 of them 43 43 (44) Marginal intercalary veinlets in pairs; hind wings oblong, with a short costal angulation Baetis. 44 (43) Marginal intercalary veinlets of the fore wing single; hind wings linear, with a spur-like costal angulation . Centroptilum. 45 (40) Hind wings absent Cloeon. Nymphs 1 (11) Mandibles with an external tusk-like ramus, visible from above; gills on abdominal segments 1-7 (often rudimentary on 1), double, flattened, linear, the margins fringed with respira- tory filaments 2 2 (9, 10) Mandibular tusks longer than the head (burrowing species) . . 3 3 (6) With no frontal prominence 4 4 (5) Legs increasing in length posteriorly; gills of the first abdominal seg- ment simple; labrum longer than wide; maxillary palpus two- join ted Polymitarcys. 5 (4) Legs decreasing in length posteriorly; labrum wider than long; maxil- lary palpus three-jointed Euihyplocia. 6 (3) With a conspicuous frontal prominence 7 7 (8) Frontal prominence rounded Hexagenia. 8 (7) Frontal prominence bifid at tip Ephemera. 9 (2, 10) Mandibular tusks shorter than the head, inconspicuous, only their tips visible from above Potamanthus. 10 (2, 9) Unknown Campsurus and Pentagenia. 11 (1) Mandibles without projecting tusk-like ramus; gills not as in 1. 12 12(13) Eyes dorsal; body strongly depressed; tarsal claws with lateral teeth; dwellers in rapid streams and on wave-beaten shores adapted to clinging to flat surfaces of rocks, timbers, etc. Heptagenia. 13 (12) Eyes lateral; claws smooth or toothed below 14 14 (15) Gills completely concealed under an enormously enlarged, four- spined dorsal thoracic shield Baetisca. 15 (14) Gills exposed; thoracic dorsum normal 16 16 (31) Outer caudal setae fringed on both sides 17 17 (24) Gills on abdominal segments 1-7 double 18 18 (21) Gills filamentous 19 19 (20) Each a pair of simple filaments LeptophUbia. 20 (19) Each a pair of clusters of slenderer filaments. . . . Habrophkbia. 21 (18) Gills lamelliform, at least on the middle segments 22 22 (23) lamellae of each gill similar Bias turns. 23 (22) Lamellae of each gill markedly differing in form at tip. Choroterpes. 022 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 24(17) Gilk absent from one or more of segments 1^7; one pair more or less dytroid, covering those behind it. 25 25 (28) GiUs present on the seventh abdominal segment, dytroid on the third or fourth segment; a pair of tubercles on the apical margin of each segment beside the middorsal line. 26 26 (27) Head smooth above. EpkemereOa. 27 (26) Head armed above with a pair of erect occipital tubercles. DruneUa. 28 (25) GiDs absent from the seventh abdominal segment, dytroid on the second segment; no dorsal abdominal tuberdes. ... 29 29 (50) Dytroid gill cover subquadrate. Qmus. 30 (29) Dytroid gill cover subtriangular Tricorytkus. 31 (16) Outer caudal setae fringed only on the inner side $2 32 (37) Posterolateral angles of the hinder abdominal segments prolonged into thin, flat, sharp lateral spines ^ 33 (34) Pore legs conspicuously fringed with long hairs; gill tufts present upon the base of maxillae and front coxae and at bases of lamdlae on abdomen. CkirotoncUs. 34 (33) Fore legs without conspicuous fringes; no maxillary or coxal gals; no gill tufts at base of lamellae on abdomen. 35 35 (36) GUIs double on the basal abdominal segments; end of maxilla fringed with simple hairs. Siphlurus. 36 (35) Gul lamdlae all single; end of maxilla fringed with pectinated hooks. AmcUtus. 37 (32) Posterolateral angles of the hinder abdominal segments hardly more than acute — not prolonged in thin flat lateral spines. . 38 38 (41) Gill lamdlae simple 39 39 (40) lamellae obtuse at apex; maxillary palpus rounded at the apex. Baeiis- 40 (39) Lamellae acute at apex; end of maxillary palpus truncated. Centroptilum* 41 (38) Gill lamellae double, at least on some of the anterior abdominal segments 42 42 (43) Antennae shorter than the body; tracheae of gill lamellae pinnatdy branched Callibaetis. 43 (42) Antennae longer than the body; tracheae of gill lamellae palmatdy branched. Cloeon. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN DRAGONFLIES Imagos 1 (21) Fore and hind wings similar, usually held vertically in repose (damsel- flies) Suborder Zygoptera . . 2 2 (5) Quadrangle (Fig. 1388) of the wings divided by a number of cross veins; antenodal cross veins numerous; pterostigma lacking a special brace vein; wings rather broad 3 3 (4) Basal space (space before the arculus) in all wings free from cross veins. Calopteryx. AQUATIC INSECTS 933 4 (3) Basal space of all wings traversed by cross veins Helaerina, 5 (2) Quadrangle without cross veins; antenodal cross veins but two in each wing; pterostigma with a brace vein at its proximal end in the space behind vein Ri; wings narrower 6 6 (o) Vein M> arising (i.e., separating from vein Mi+j) nearer the arculus than the nodus 7 AJf CJ. f®^ ?3^^ c Fig. 13R8. WlnR venation in the Odonata: fa) a (iraKonfly. Car dvleraslrr. (I) ■ dairatlfly. Atria; (c) tbe rcgioD of the stigma, if. with its brace vein. s, ar. arculus; a/, iiul Loop; brr bridge; *. nodiu,; d. oblique vein; (. triangle; f, sublriangle; e, quadrannle; 10, jubquidrangle; t, basal subcostal ctom TOOKI.VdDlUlDfuI. IjS6. j (8) \'ein Mi separating from vein Mt at a distance of several cells beyond the subnodal cross vein Ltstts. 8 (7) Vein Mi separating from vein Mi close to the subnodal cross vein, less than the distance of one cell beyond it. Archilesies. 9 (6) Vein M, arising nearer the nodus than the arculus 10 10 (11) Spines on the tibiae very long, twice as long as the intervals between them Argia. 11 (10) Spines of the tibiae hardly longer than the intervals between them. 12 12 (16) No pale postocular spots on the top of the head; sexes similarly colored 13 13 (14, 15) Colors of dorsum blue and black; yellow beneath the thorax. Chromagrion. >4 (73. is) Colors of dorsum red and black; stout species. . Amphiagrion. 15 ('3. 14) Dorsum bronzy green; slender species. . . . NehaUtnnio. 16(11) With round or ovoid postocular spots on the head 17 17 (18) Sexes with a general similarity in color, the female often of a lighter shade; the superior abdominal appendages of the male not strongly directed downward and inward. . . EnaUagma. 924 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 1 8 (17) Sexes strikingly unlike in color; a bifid process arising from the apical margin of the 10th abdominal segment in the male and the superior abdominal appendages strongly directed downward and inward 19 19 (20) Males chiefly green and black, with normal rhomboidal stigma; females with the orange of the abdomen covering something less than the three basal segments (becoming wholly densely pruinose with age) Ischnura. ^o (19) Males yellow or orange, with ovoid stigma which does not reach the costal vein; females with the four basal segments of the abdomen yellow or orange Anomalagrion. 21 (1) Fore and hind wings dissimilar, the latter broader at the base (dragonflies proper) Suborder Anisoptera . . 22 22 (49) Triangle (Fig. 1388) about equally distant from arculus in fore and hind wing; stigma with a brace vein at its inner end (except in Cordulegaster) 23 23 (24) Stigma unbraced Cordulegaster. 24 (23) Stigma braced at its inner end against an inclined cross vein in the space below it (Fig. 1362) 25 25 (36) Eyes widely separated on the top of the head 26 26 (27) Basal subcostal cross vein (Fig. 1388, b) present; a linear or spatula te, median, sternal process on the first abdominal segment; legs very short, the hind femora hardly reaching the apex of the first abdominal segment Progomphus. 27 (26) Basal subcostal cross vein usually wanting; no median sternal process on the first abdominal segment; legs longer, the hind femora reaching or surpassing the middle of the second abdominal segment 28 28 (3 1) Hind wings with a distinct anal loop (Fig. 1 388, a) consisting of several cells 29 29 (30) Anal loop normally consisting of three cells; first and fifth antenodal cross veins matched in position and hyper trophied; stigma broad with both sides convex; triangles not traversed by cross veins Ophiogomphus. 30 (29) Anal loop consisting normally of four cells; first and seventh antenodal cross veins matched in position and hypertrophied; stigma long and narrow with parallel sides; each triangle divided by a cross vein Hagenius. 31 (28) Hind wings with no distinct anal loop, or with one consisting of a single cell 32 32 (33) Triangle of the fore wing one- third shorter than that of the hind wing; generally a single cell between the bases of veins At and A, Lanthus. 33 (32) Triangle of the fore wing less than one-fourth shorter than that of the hind wing; generally, two or more cells between At and As at their origin 34 34 (35) Hind femora naked, or with numerous short spines. . . Gompkus. 35 (34) Hind femora with five to seven long, strong spines. . Dromogomphus. * ■' AQUATIC INSECTS 925 36 (25) Eyes approximated on the top of the head 37 37 (42) The radial sector (Rs, Fig. 1388, a) simple 3 3 38 (39) But two cubi to-anal cross veins; vein Mi undulate; supratriangle without cross veins; but one cross vein under the stigma. Gomphaeschna. 39 (38) With three or more cubito-anal cross veins; vein M2 not undulate; supratriangle divided by cross veins; several cross veins under the stigma 40 40 (41) Basal space traversed by cross veins Boyeria. 41 (40) Basal space open Basiaeschna. 42(37) Radial -sector bearing an apical fork 43 43 (48) Sectors of the arculus (veins Mi-8 and M4) separating from the arculus at or below its middle 44 44 (47) The radial sector symmetrically forked: between it and the supple- mentary vein below it, one or two rows of cells 45 45 (46) Face strongly produced above, the upper margin of the frons very acute; the veins Mi and M2 parallel to the level of the stigma; radial sector and the supplementary vein below it separated by a single row of cells Nasiaeschna. 46 (45) Face vertical, not sharply angulate at upper edge of frons; veins Mi and M2 approximated at the stigma; the radial sector and the supplementary vein below it separated by two rows of cells Epiaeschna. 47 (44) The radial sector strongly deflected toward the stigma at the base of its fork, unsymmetric; between it and the supplementary vein below it, three to seven rows of cells. . . . Aeschna. 48 (43) Sectors of the arculus springing from above the middle of the arcu- lus Anax. 49 (22) Triangle in the hind wing much nearer the arculus than in the fore wing; stigma without brace vein 50 5° (53) The triangle of the hind wing placed considerably beyond the arcu- lus; the anal loop well developed and hardly longer than broad; more than two cubito-anal cross veins 51 51 (52) Dorsal surface of the head with the occiput larger than the vertex; subtriangle of the fore wings usually divided by a cross vein; four to six cross veins in the space above the bridge (Fig. 1388) . Dtdymops. 52 (51) Dorsal surface of the head with the occiput much smaller than the vertex; subtriangle of the fore wings generally open; two or three cross veins in the space above the bridge. Macromia. 53 (50) The triangle of the hind wing retracted to the level of the arculus, or even passing it a little sometimes; the anal loop, greatly elongated (except in Nannothemis) and becoming foot- shaped; one or two cubito-anal cross veins 54 926 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 54 (67) Sectors of the arculus (veins Mi-, and M4) distinctly separate at their departure from the arculus; anal loop elongate, but not distinctly foot-shaped, the toe part being little or not at all developed; the last antenodal cross vein extending from the costal to the radial veins (except in D. lintneri, in which it generally extends only from the costal to the subcostal); colors often metallic blue or green on thorax and abdomen. 55 55 (56) Veins M4 and Cui in the fore wing parallel or a little divergent apically, the number of rows of cells between them increasing toward the margin of the wing Neurocordulia. 56 (55) Veins M4 and Cui in the fore wing approximated toward the margin of the wing 57 57 (58) With large brown spots on all wings at nodus and apex. Epicordulia. 58 (57) No brown spots at nodus and apex 59 59 (60) Four (rarely five) antenodal cross veins in the hind wing. Tetragoneuria. 60 (59) Usually more than five antenodal cross veins in the hind wing. . 61 61 (62) Stigma very narrowly diamond-shaped, with the ends of it meeting the sides by an angle of 30 to 350 Helocordulia. 62 (61) Stigma broader, less pointed 63 63 (64) Triangle of fore wings open Dorocordulia. 64 (63) Triangle of fore wings divided by a cross vein 65 65 (66) Inferior appendage at end of male abdomen bifurcated. Cordulia. 66 (65) Inferior appendage simple Somatochlora. 67 (54) The sectors of the arculus in close apposition or completely fused for a little way beyond the arculus; anal loop generally dis- tinctly foot-shaped, with well-developed "toe"; the last antenodal cross vein often discontinuous at the subcostal vein 68 68 (69) Triangle of the fore wings four-sided; anal loop poorly developed, not foot-shaped Nannothemis. 69 (68) Triangle of the fore wing fully differentiated, three-sided; anal loop well developed and foot-shaped 70 70 (71) Triangle of the fore wing with its front and inner sides meeting by an angle of about ioo°; the sub triangle without cross veins; the vein which bisects the anal loop straight. . . Perithcmis. 71 (70) Triangle of the fore wing with its front and inner sides meeting by an angle of about oo°; subtriangle divided into three or more cells; bisector of the anal loop sinuous 72 72 (89) Triangle of the fore wing not placed distinctly beyond the level of the apex of the triangle in the hind wing; pterostigma with its ends parallel or not distinctly divergent 73 73 (84) The sectors of the arculus (veins Mi-3 and M4) in the fore wing more or less completely fused for a short distance beyond the arculus; the triangle of the fore wing not greatly produced posteriorly, and (except in Celithemis) normally containing but a single cross vein, and followed by two or three rows of cells 74 J eutA.JRX^ici AQUATIC INSECTS 927 74 (79) Vein Cut of the hind wing departing from the triangle at the hind angle 75 75 (76) Sectors of the arculus (veins Mi_s and M4) contiguous, but incom- pletely fused for a distance beyond the arculus; wings generally conspicuously spotted with yellow or reddish brown. Celithemis. 76 (75) Sectors of the arculus in the hind wing distinctly fused for a distance beyond the arculus 77 77 (78) Stigma short and thick, about twice as long as wide; anal loop with a big heel, there being generally four cells between the bi- sector and the heel point; face pure white. . . Leucorkinia. 78 (77) Stigma more than three times as long as wide; anal loop generally with but two cells between the bisector and the heel point. Sympctrum. 79 (74) Vein Cui of the hind wing migrated a little way up the outer side of the triangle, separating itself at a distance from the hind angle 80 80 (81) With a single cross vein under the stigma, and a long vacant space before that cross vein Packydiplax. 81 (80) With two cross veins under the stigma and the adjacent spaces more normal 82 82 (83) With a single row of cells between veins Mj and R*. . . Mesothemis. 83 (82) With two rows of cells for a distance between veins Mj and R«. Micrathyria. 84 (73) Sectors of the arculus in the fore wing contiguous, but not completely fused beyond the point of their departure from the arculus; radial sector distinctly undulate (except in Ladona) ; triangle of the fore wing very much elongated posteriorly and narrow and generally traversed by two or more parallel cross veins, and followed by three to seven rows of cells 85 85 (86) Vein Mia arising under the proximal fourth of the stigma; fore wings with the sub triangle consisting of three cells, and the tri- angle followed by three rows of cells Ladona. 86 (85) Vein M/a arising under the middle of the stigma; fore wings with the sub triangle consisting of four to eleven cells, and the triangle usually followed by four to six rows of cells 87 87 (88) Male with no ventral hooks on the first abdominal segment; female with the hind tibia a little longer than the hind femur; the sexes alike in wing pattern Libellula. 88 (87) Male with a pair of ventral hooks on the first abdominal segment; female with the hind femur and tibia of equal length; wings dissimilarly colored in the two sexes Plathemis. 89 (72) Triangle of the fore wing placed beyond the level of the apex of the triangle of the hind wing; stigma with its inner end per- pendicular, its outer end very oblique to the bordering veins; wings broad at base and pointed at apex 90 90 (91) Radial sector regularly curved; hind wings with a broad, basal colored band Tratnea. 91 (90) Radial sector distinctly undulate; hind wings not covered at base by a broad colored band Pattiala. 928 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Nymphs i (22) Three large leaflike respiratory plates at the apex of the slender abdo- men, and with the body tapering posteriorly from the head (damselflies) Suborder Zygoptera . . 2 2 (5) Basal segment of the antenna very large, as long as the other six to- gether; median lobe of the labium with a very deep cleft; gills thick, the lateral ones triquetral 3 3 (4) Median deft of labium very deep, extending far beneath the level of the base of the lateral lobes. Caloptcryx. 4 (3) Median deft of the labium extending only to the levd of the base of the lateral lobes Hctaerina. 5 (2) Basal segment of antenna not longer than succeeding single segments; labium with a very shallow dosed median deft or no deft at all; gills thin, lamelliform 6 6 (9) Median lobe of labium with a short, dosed, median deft; lateral lobe trifid at end; movable hook bearing raptorial setae; gills showing transverse segmentation 7 7 (8) Lateral lobe of the labium terminating in three teeth, between the middle and external of which is situated a truncated and serrated lobe LesUs. 8 (7) Three teeth only, terminating the lateral lobe of the labium, no trun- cated and serrated lobe between them. . . . ArchiUsUs. 9 (6) Median lobe of labium entire; lateral lobe bifid at end; hook naked; gills various 10 10 (11) Labium with no raptorial setae on the men turn within; gills broad, thick, dark colored, oval or oblong in shape and obtuse at apex Argia. 11 (10) Labium with mental setae; gills thinner, more pointed and nar- rower 12 12 (15) Hind angles of the head strongly angulate 13 13 (14) Gills widest beyond the middle; body slender; head half as long as wide Chromagrion. 14 (13) Gills widest across the middle; body stouter; head nearly as long as wide Amphiagrion. 15 (12) Hind angles of the head rounded 16 16 (17) Labium with one mental seta (and a rudimentary second one) each side; antennae six- jointed; lateral lobe of the labium with the distal end above the end hook hardly denticulated. NehaUcnnia. 17 (16) Labium with three to five mental setae each side (one may be smaller than the others), and end of lateral lobe denticulated dis- tinctly; antennae seven-jointed (with the possible exception of EnaUagma anUnnatum) 18 18 (21) Gills more than half as long as the abdomen, lanceolate; third seg- ment of antennae less than a third longer than the second. 19 19 (20) Labium with four to six lateral setae, generally with five, and with three (rarely four) mental setae each side; gills often with a definite color pattern. Enallagma. ..'.*—■ -1 AQUATIC INSECTS 9*9 20 (19) Labium with five or six lateral setae, and with four mental setae each side; gills generally with no distinct pattern. . . Isckmtra. 21 (18) Gills less than half as long as the abdomen, narrower and with a long tapering point; third segment of antenna more than a third longer than the second Anomalagrion. 22 (1) Without external respiratory plates, but with a respiratory chamber inside the wide abdomen; body less slender, and not widest across the head. (Dragonflies; proper.) Suborder Anisoptera . . 23 23 (47) Labium flat or nearly so (the edges of the lateral lobes slightly up- turned in Tachopteryx), without raptorial setae 24 24 (35, 46) Labium with its median lobe entire; antennae four-jointed, the fourth joint rudimentary; fore tarsi two- jointed: burrow- ing nymphs 25 Fig. 1389. Recognition characters of dragonfly nymphs. A, inner aspect of the labium; m, mentum: sm, submentum; ml, median lobe; U, lateral lobe; ms. mental setae; Is, lateral setae; k, end hook. B. end of the abdomen as seen from above: 7, 8, 9, i<>, abdominal segments; d, dorsal hooks; t, lateral spinet; s, superior appendage; /, paired lateral appendages; c, inferior appendages (oerd). 25 (26) Middle legs more approximate at the base than are the fore legs; fourth segment of the antenna slender, erect, about as long as the third segment is wide; the tenth abdominal segment about as long as the ninth Progomphus. 26 (25) Middle legs not more (usually less) approximate than the fore legs at base; the fourth segment of the antenna a mere rudiment, orbicular or discoid, much shorter than the third segment is wide; the tenth abdominal segment much shorter than the ninth 27 27 (28) Wing cases strongly divergent on the two sides; lateral lobe of labium blunt at apex Opkiogomphus. 28 (27) Wing cases laid closely parallel along the back; lateral lobe of labium ending in a sharp, incurved hook 29 29 (30) Abdomen very thin and flat, circular in outline as seen from above* third segment of antenna flat and subcircular. . Hagenius. 30 (29) Abdomen less depressed, ovate to lanceolate in outline, at least twice as long as wide 31 31 (32) Third joint of antenna very flat, thin, and in outline circular or broadly oval Lantimi. 930 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 32 (31) Third joint of antenna elongate, linear, little flattened. ... 33 33 (34) Dorsum of the ninth abdominal segment rounded, or with a low, obtuse, median longitudinal ridge Gomphus. 34 (33) Ninth abdominal segment with a sharp mid-dorsal ridge, ending in a straight apical spine Dromogomphus. 35 (24, 46) Labium with a short median cleft; antennae seven- jointed, setaceous; tarsi three- jointed; climbing nymphs, with eyes at sides of head 36 36 (39) Hind angles of the head, viewed from above, sharply angulate. . 37 37 (38) Lateral lobe of labium squarely truncate on apex Boyeria. 38 (37) Lateral lobe of labium with taper-pointed apex. . . . Basiaeschna. 39 (36) Hind angles of the head obtusely rounded 40 40 (45) With lateral spines on abdominal segments 4-, 5-, or 6-9. . . 41 41 (44) With lateral spines on segments 4-, or 5-9 42 42 (43) With dorsal hooks on abdominal segments 7-9. . . Nasiaeschna. 43 (42) With no dorsal hooks on abdomen Epiacschna. 44 (41) With lateral spines on abdominal segments 6-9 Aeschna. 45 (40) With lateral spines on abdominal segments 7-9 Anax. 46 (24, 35) Labium with a shallow median cleft; antennae seven- jointed; short; squatting nymphs, with face vertical, and eyes on anterolateral angles; depressed; hairy; tarsi three-jointed. Tachopteryx. 47 (23) Labium mask-shaped or spoon-shaped, when closed, covering the face up to the bases of the antennae, armed with raptorial setae 48 48 (49) The prominent median lobe of the labium cleft into two variously formed teeth at apex Cordulcgaster. 49 (48) The median lobe of the labium entire 50 50 (53) Head with a prominent pyramidal frontal horn; abdomen flat and almost circular in outline as seen from above; legs long, giving a spiderlike aspect to these big nymphs; the tenth abdominal segment well exposed, not telescoped in the apex of the ninth segment; teeth on the lateral lobes of the labium with deep incisions between them 51 51 (52) Head hardly as wide across the eyes as across the bulging hind angles; lateral spines not incurved, those of the ninth abdominal segment hardly surpassed by the tips of the appendages; dorsum of the tenth abdominal segment with no trace of a dorsal hook. Didymops. 52 (51) Head widest across the eyes; spines of the ninth abdominal segment shorter, not nearly reaching the level of the apices of the ap- pendages; dorsum of the tenth segment with a very rudi- mentary dorsal hook Macromia. 53 (5c) Head without pyramidal frontal horn; abdomen less flattened, more elongate; teeth on the lateral lobes of the labium much wider than high 54 • 1 AQUATIC INSECTS 93 1 54 (65) Lateral appendages of the abdomen more than half as long as the inferiors; hind femora longer than the head is wide; when the lateral spines arc long, then there is a full series of big, cultriform dorsal hooks on the abdomen 55 55 (56) Lateral setae four or five; men turn about as long as wide. Epicordulia. S^ (55) Lateral setae seven; mentum of labium longer than wide. . . 57 57 (62) Abdomen with large, laterally flattened, generally cultriform dorsal hooks 58 58 (59) Lateral spines of the ninth segment longer than half the length of that segment; dorsal hooks on segments 3-9, highest on 6, cultriform, and sharp Tetragoneuria. 59 (58) Lateral spines of the ninth segment shorter than half of that segment; dorsal hooks less developed 60 60 (61) Dorsal hooks on segments 4-9 laterally flattened, but not cultriform. Somatochlora. 61 (60) Dorsal hooks on segments 6-9, longest on 8 and cultriform. Helocordulia. 62 (57) Abdomen with no dorsal hooks, or with these rudimentary, not flattened laterally or cultriform, but small obtuse or pointed prominences 63 63 (64) Hind angles of the head rounded; lateral spines of the ninth abdominal segment one-fifth as long as that segment. . . . Cordulia. 64 (63) Hind angles of the head angulate superiorly; spines of the ninth abdominal segment one-third as long as that segment. Dorocordulia. 65 (54) Lateral abdominal appendages generally less than half the length of the inferiors; hind femora generally as long as the head is wide; often when the lateral spines of the abdomen are long the dorsal hooks are wanting or reduced 66 66 (67) With large, cultriform dorsal hooks on abdominal segments 3-9; eyes small and situated on the mid-lateral margin of the head and directed laterally Perithemis. 67 (66) With no dorsal hook on the ninth abdominal segment; eyes over- spreading more or less the anterolateral margins of the head 68 68 (85) Basal segment of the hind tarsus more than half as long as the second segment; lateral appendages of the abdomen not more than half as long as the inferiors (except in Libellula quadri- maculata) ; superior abdominal appendage regularly tapering to a point 69 69 (70) Abdomuml appendages strongly decurved; lateral spines wanting or extremely rudimentary Mcsothemis. 70 (69) Abdominal appendages straight or very slightly declined; lateral spines evident on abdominal segments 8 and 9 71 71 (74) With no dorsal hooks at all 72 932 FRESH- WATER BIOLOGY 72 (73) Abdomen smooth, depressed; head twice as wide as long, with eyes very prominent laterally; lateral spines large and straight; superior appendage one-third shorter than the inferiors. Pachydiplox. 73 (72) Abdomen hairy at the apex; lateral spines small and sharply in- curved; superior appendage as long as the inferiors. Nannothemis. 74 (71) Dorsal hooks present, at least on the middle abdominal segments. 75 75 (80) Abdomen ovate in outline, rather abruptly narrowed to the posterior end; hind margin of the eyes behind the middle of the head 76 76 (77) Lateral spines long and straight; abdomen not narrowed posteriorly before the eighth segment Celithemis. 77 (76) Lateral spines shorter and more or less incurvate; the abdomen more or less narrowed before the eighth segment. ... 78 78 (79) Dorsal hooks as long as the segments which bear them. Lcucorhinia. 79 (78) Dorsal hooks shorter than the segments which bear them. Sympetrum. 80 (75) Abdomen lanceolate in outline, slowly narrowed to the pointed posterior end; eyes capping the prominent anterolateral angles of the head, their hind margin generally before the middle of the top of the head; body generally hairy. . 81 81 (82) The tenth abdominal segment with subcarinate lateral margins; appendages very long; lateral setae 0-3 Ladona. 82 (81) The tenth abdominal segment shorter, cylindric; appendages shorter; lateral setae 5-10 83 83 (84) Head a little narrowed behind the eyes; front border of the median lobe of the labium entire Libdlula* 84 (83) Head not narrowed behind the eyes to the hind angles; front border of the median labial lobe crenulate Plathemis. 85 (68) Basal segment of the hind tarsus half as long as the second segment; lateral appendages of the abdomen at least three-fourths as long as the inferiors; lateral setae 10 or more; superior appendage of the abdomen suddenly contracted at its basal third, the dorsal two-thirds forming a long slender point. 86 86 (87) Movable hook of labium long and slender, setiform; teeth much broader than high; spines of the eighth segment one-half longer than the ninth segment; superior abdominal append- age shorter than the inferiors. Tramca. 87 (86) Movable hook of the labium short, hardly longer than the teeth; teeth higher than broad; spines of the eighth segment as long as the ninth segment; superior appendage equaling the inferiors Pantala. AQUATIC INSECTS 933 KEY TO AQUATIC AND SEMI-AQUATIC HEMIPTERA 1 (8) Antennae longer than the head, free. Forms that walk on the water. 2 2 (5) Last segment of tarsi split, claws inserted before the apex. ... 3 3 (4) Beak four-jointed; intermediate and posterior legs extremely long and slender; body widest back of the pro thorax. Family Gerridae. 4 (3) Beak three- jointed; none of the legs extremely long and slender; body widest across the prothorax Family Veliidae. 5 (2) Last segment of tarsi entire, claws inserted at the apex 6 6 (7) Body linear; head as long as thorax; legs extremely long and slender; beak not reaching anterior coxae. Family Hydrometridae. 7 (6) Body oval ; head shorter than thorax ; legs not extremely long and slender ; beak reaching intermediate coxae. . Family Acanthddae. 8 (1) Antennae shorter than the head, nearly or quite concealed beneath the margin of the head, or in a cavity beneath the eyes. . 9 9 (12) Ocelli two; anterior coxal cavities open behind; antennae four- jointed, simple. (Live near the water) 10 10 (n) Fore legs slender, fitted for running; eyes triangular. Family Pelogonidae. 11 (10) Fore legs stout, fitted for grasping; eyes projecting, subglobose. Family Nerthriidae. 12 (9) Ocelli none; anterior coxal cavities open or closed behind; antennae three or four-jointed, simple or with some of the segments produced into a lateral hook. (Live in the water). . . 13 13 (32) Anterior coxal cavities closed behind; antennae four-jointed, simple or hooked 14 14 (15) Antennae simple; no caudal appendages; fore legs fitted for grasping, middle and hind legs for walking. . . Family Naucoridae. 15 (14) Second and third (sometimes fourth) joint of antennae produced into lateral hooks; end of abdomen with a pair of caudal append- ages; fore legs fitted for grasping, middle and hind legs for walking or swimming 16 16 (29) Antennae four- join ted; caudal appendages short, strap-shaped, re- tractile; middle and hind legs flattened, fitted for swimming; tarsi two- jointed. . . . Family Belostomatidae . . 17 17 (18) Fore tarsus with two claws Hydrocirius. 18 (17) Fore tarsus with a single claw 19 19 (22) Mesothorax with a strong mid-ventral keel 20 20 (21) An internal tooth borne upon both joints two and three of the an- tenna; all the ventral surface of the body hairy. Serphus. 21 (20) An internal tooth borne upon joints two, three and four of the antennae; venter hairy only in the middle. . . . Abedus. 22(19) Mesothorax without mid-ventral keel; antennae four-jointed. '. . 23 23 (26) Furrow of the membrane of the fore wing regularly curved; an acute internal tooth on antenna! segments two and three, the fourth simple and pointed. 24 14 (25) Membrane of the fore wing small; the reentrant angle seen at either side of the front of the head when viewed from above is wholly in the front Pcdinocoris* 934 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 25 (24) Membrane large; reentrant angle bordered externally by the eye itself (Zaitha of most of our literature). . . . Belostoma. 26 (23) Furrow of wing membrane S-shaped; a recurved internal tooth borne on antennal segments two, three and four. ... 27 27 (28) Front femora grooved internally for the reception of the tibia (JBdos- toma of most of our literature) Amor gins. 28 (27) Front femora not grooved internally Benacus. 29 (16) Antennae three- jointed; caudal appendages long, filiform, grooved; middle and hind legs fitted for walking; tarsi one-jointed. Family Nepidae . . 30 30 (31) Body oval; legs not extremely long and slender; prothorax much broader than head; anterior femora but little longer than tibiae Nepa. 31 (30) Body linear; legs extremely long and slender; prothorax but little broader than head; anterior femora more than twice as long as tibiae Ranatra. 32 (13) Anterior coxal cavities open behind; antennae three or four- jointed, without lateral hooks 33 33 (38) Head inserted in the prothorax; antennae four-jointed; beak three or four- jointed, not retractile; anterior tarsi one or two- jointed, of the usual form, with two claws. Family Notonectidae . . 34 34 (37) Antennae inserted in cavity beneath eyes, second joint thickest; hind legs flattened, ciliated, fitted for swimming; abdomen keeled and hairy. (Size larger) 35 35 (36) Last joint of antenna less than half as long as the third, which is fringed with capitate hairs. Hind tarsi without claws. (Body stouter) Notonecta. 36 (35) Last joint of antenna fringed with capitate hairs, and many times longer than the third, which is very small and inconspicuous. Hind tarsi with claws. (Body more slender). . . Buenoa. 37 (34) Antennae inserted beneath the margin of the head, third joint longest and thickest; hind legs like the middle legs, tarsi with claws; abdomen not keeled or hairy. (Size smaller, not over 3 mm. long) Plea. 38 (33) Head overlapping the prothorax; antennae three or four- jointed; beak short, un jointed, retractile; anterior tarsi one-seg- mented, flattened, with a fringe of hairs on the edge, and without claws Family Cordudae. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN AQUATIC NEUROPTERA Adults 1 (4) Veins of the wing disc all ending in a succession of symmetrical forks, the terminal forks forming a distinct peripheral zone; antennae moniliform. . . Family Hemerobddae . . a a (3) The median vein repeatedly forked; some of the branches of vein Cut again forked Sisyro. AQUATIC INSECTS 935 3 (2) The median vein but once forked; the branches of vein Cui all simple. Climacia. 4 (1) Veins of the wing disc extending outward in straighter lines, forks fewer and less symmetrical; antennae cylindric serrate, or pectinate Family Sialididae . . 5 5 (6) Fourth segment of the tarsus bilobed; posterior branch of the radial sector forked. No ocelli Sialis, Fig. 239a Fore wings of two neuropterous insects, Sialis (above) and Climaeia (below). A, humeral cross-vein; st, stigma; designations of principal veins as in Fig 1386. 6 (5) Fourth segment of the tarsus simple, cylindric; posterior branch of the radial sector simple. Three ocelli 7 7 (8) Hind angles of the head rounded; the median vein two-branched; antennae with segments enlarged distally. . . Chauliodes. 8 (7) Hind angles of the head bearing a sharp angulation or tooth; median vein three-branched; segments of the antennae cylindric. Corydalis. Larvae 1 (4) Mouth parts adapted for piercing and sucking, prolonged to half the length of the body; living on fresh-water sponges. ... a 2 (3) Setae on the dorsum of the thorax pedunculate (i.e., the setigerous tubercles elevated considerably above the level of the integ- ument) ; the outer covering of the pupal case spun by the larva is of a beautiful hexagonal mesh Climaeia. 3 (2) Thoracic setae sessile; the outer covering of the pupal case is close woven. Sisyra. 4 (1) Mouth parts adapted for biting 5 5 (6) The last abdominal segment produced in a long, median, laterally fringed tail-like process; a pair of lateral filaments on abdominal segments 1-7. • 9j6 FRESH-WATER BIC&OGY 6 (5) Last abdominal segment bifurcated, the fleshy {oris each hcauisfc a pair of hooks and a minute, external, lateral filament; con- spicuous lateral filaments on abdominal segments 1-8. . 7 7 (8) Lateral filaments with no tuft of fine tracheal gills at their bases. Ckautiodes. $ (7) Lateral filaments each with a tuft of fine tracheal gifts at its base. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN CADDISFLIES 1 (2) Micro-caddisflies; very small, mothlike, hairy, the fore wings bearing numerous erect clavate hairs; the marginal fringe of the wings longer than their greatest breadth; form of wings narrowly lanceolate; antennae rather stout and not longer than fore wings Family Hydropiujdae. a (1) Larger caddisflies, with broader wings; marginal fringes never as long as the wings are broad; antennae usually longer than the fore wings 3 3 (26) Maxillary palpus five-jointed 4 4 (19) Last joint of the maxillary palpus simple, and not longer than the other joints 5 5 (10) Ocelli present 6 6 (9) Front tibiae with two or three spurs, middle tibiae with four spurs. 7 7 (8) The first two joints of the maxillary palpus short and thick, the third joint much longer and thinner. . Family Rhyacofhilidae, 8 (7) The second joint of the maxillary palpus much longer than the first. Females Family Phryganeidae. 9 (6) Front tibiae with a single spur, or with none; middle tibiae with only two or three spurs. Females. . . . Family Limnophilidae. 10 (5) Ocelli wanting n 11(12) A closed cell in the principal fork of the median vein in the fore wings. Family Calamoceratidae. 12(11) No closed cell in the median fork 13 13 (18) A closed cell in the first fork of the radial sector (£,) 14 14 (17) Both branches of the radial sector forked 15 15 (16) Veins Ri and Ri confluent apically or connected by an apical cross vein in the fore wing. Females. . Family Odontoceridae. 16 (15) Veins Rt and Ri not connected apically. Family Sericostomatidae. 17 (14) Only the anterior branch of the radial sector forked. Family Leptoceridae^ 18 (13) No closed cell in the first fork of the radial sector. Family Molannidae.. 19 (4) Last joint of the maxillary palpus usually much longer than the others* twisted! and divided imperfectly into subsegments. . . 20' so(ai) Ocelli present Family Pbilopoxamidae. AQUATIC INSECTS 937 9i (30) Ocelli wanting. 32 32(13) Front tibia? with three spurs Family Polycentbopidae 33 (ai) Spurs of the front tibiae fewer than three 34 34 (35) Anterior branch of the radial sector in the fore wing forked. Family HvofiOPSveamAE. 35 (34) Anterior branch of the radial sector simple. Family Psychowyiidae. Fig. ijdi. The winp of j mddisfly, HydrofiycM. 36 (3) Maxillary palpi with fewer than five joints 37 37 (28) Maxillary palpi with four joints; ocelli present. Males. Family Phhyganeidae. 38 (17) Maxillary palpi with two or three joints 39 29 (30) Maxillary palpi filiform with cylindric smooth joints; fore tibiae with a single spur. Males Family Limnophilidae. 30 (39) Maxilary palpi hairy or scaly, appressed against and often covering the face; fore tibiae with two spurs. Males. Family Sekicostoiutidaf,. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN AQUATIC BEETLES Adults 1 (3) Hind tarsi with the antepenultimate segment broadly bibbed, and receiving the rudimentary penultimate segment (which is closely fused with the base of the last segment) in its apical notch Family Chkysomeudae. 3 (1) Hind Ursi with the last three segments free and similar in form. . . 3 3 (8) Hind legs shorter than the fore; eyes four, two above and two on the under surface of the head. . . . Family Gyminidae . . 4 4 (7) Last abdominal segment rounded posteriorly and smooth below. . . 5 5 (6) Wingof the metastemum (ic, Fig. 1393) broadly triangular. . Dinettlti. 6 (5) Wing of the metastemum narrow, elongate, widened only at its extreme outer end Gyrimm. 938 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 7 (4) Lost abdominal segment elongate pyramidal, and furnished with a inid- ventral line of hairs Gyreles. 8 (3) Hind legs longer than the fore; eyes two. 9 {14) Base c 1° (13) " (n) f the hind legs covered by broad overlapping coxal plates. Family Haliplidal . . 10 Coxa] plates concealing only the three basal segments of the abdomen; last segment of palpi shorter than the preceding segment. 1 1 Pronotum widest before the middle. BrycUus. Pronotum widest at the rear end. Saliplus. 13 (10) Coxal plates concealing all but the last of the ventral abdominal seg- ments; last segment of palpi longer than the preceding seg- ment I'tltodyles. 14 (9) Base of the hind legs exposed .... 15 15 (48) Antennae shorter than the palpi; legs usually with swimming fringes. Family Hydeophilidae . . 16 16 (23) Scutellum wanting or indistinct or very small and scalelike. Posterior femora subcylindrical and not noticeably widened in the mid- dle; pro thorax narrowed behind, narrower than the elytra. The ' species are small, elongate, middiTiegsriCiibilTp^™ eyp roughly sculptured, greyish or J.nariiiery p»ipi; r. EmJ mugm nearly black, and usually tinged the wing own (dyt™); i, p™- with bronze and metallic col- ^^/"""ij^j"?^*™'^!1 ors 1 7 Lu; t. Ihc con] pram and t, the 17 (to) Scutellum indistinct, or apparently want- ^^ft^Tfthg f^ ing; if at all evident it is twuiot five joints; i.».j.*. i,6, distinctly triangular and acute. Xrte^T^in^^S 'L£ ' Species from 1-2 mm. long. 18 tow si, respectively; w/wingof the a 1 \ tv >.i . . ■ •„ a ■ metutenum; hi, epiYlenum. ind 18 (19) Pronotum without striae; maxillary palpi ».rpimrrou of the mc™™ ih«- as long as the head and thorax g^ erte»*BK bri^rta 1 together, the ultimate segment the aruA, snathe "™*». •rt of the oc - " — longer than the penultimate; •*1?! S*, *. „- t ■ - iJ^ -77^ .1 . ' milked OB literally by the posterior elytra with more than ten rows end of the cml lime, of punctures. . . . Eydrama. 19 (18) Pronotum bearing from one to five longitudinal striae or abbreviated grooves; the maxillary palpi much shorter than the head and thorax together, the ultimate segment shorter than the penultimate; elytra with only ten rows of punctures. AQUATIC INSECTS 939 20 (17) Scutellum appearing as a very small but distinct scale, shaped like the last joint of one's thumb; the ultimate segment of labial palpus longer than the penultimate. Species from 3 -6 mm. long at 21 (22) The pronotum bearing five longitudinal striae; labial palpi moderately large Ntbpkorus, 22 (21) The pronotum coarsely punctured but without longitudinal striae; labial palpi short Nydroikus. 2$ (16) Scutellum distinct, moderately large. Posterior femora flattened and distinctly widened at their middle; pro thorax not narrowed posteriorly, as wide as the elytra at their base. The species arc small or large, of oval, elliptical or even hemispherical form, with not very coarse sculpture, and are commonly pitchy black, often more or less testaceous, very occasionally with metallic tinges 34 24 (43) Metasternum not prolonged into a spine; tarsi not compressed. The species of this group arc all smaller than those of the next, less than 9 mm. long t$ 25 (26) Fifth ventral segment with a deep notch in the middle of its apical border; middle and posterior tibiae and tarsi l)caring a close* set fringe of long silky setae; scutellum elongate, acute. Btrosus. 26 (25) Fifth ventral segment not notched; tibiae and tarsi not fimbri- ate 17 27 (28) First two ventral segments concealed by whitish translucent plates. one on each side, upon which arc a numl>er of long anprcsseu setae. The species arc very convex, have a tendency to partially roll up like a sow-bug, and arc from 1 a mm, In length ChnrUtrthria, 28 (27) No such plates over the first ventral segments 39 29 (30) Posterior tibiae incurved, small at base and considerably enlarged at their apex Istfcobiui. 30 (29) Posterior tibiae straight; little or not at all thickened at their apex, 31 31 (32) Abdomen with apparently eight ventral segments. The single species is xj mm. long; of a black color with pale legs, IJmnfMut, 32 (31) Abdomen with five ventral segments, the tip of the sixth often visible ,j.| 33 (40) Terminal segment of the maxillary palpus rarely as long an, usually shorter than, the preceding segment. ........ 44 34 (35) Elytra deeply longitudinally striate; tarsi of the middle and fws- terior legs with only four segments. .... Ilfioumhui, 35 (34) Elytra not striate , , . .0 36 (39) Mesosternum with a feeble transverse carina or simple 47 37 (38) Mesosternum with a feeble transverse carina; Ursi of the middle and posterior legs with four segments. . . CymHodytn* 58 (37) Mesosternum simple; all tarsi with fwv segments, tin? first usually triangular U clitoris, 94° FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 39 (36) Mesosternum with a longitudinal carina; all tarsi with five segments, the first one small PhUhydrus. 40 (33) Terminal segment of maxillary palpi distinctly longer than the penultimate 41 41 (42) Large species 6.5-8.5 mm.; the elytra distinctly striate or stria to- punctate Hydrobius. 42 (41) Small species 1.5-3.5 mm.; the elytra not striate but with confused punctuation Creniphilus. 43 (24) Metasternum prolonged into an acute spine; tarsi compressed so as to be oarlike. The color is always pitchy black, occasion- ally with yellow margins. The size varies from 9 to 35 mm 44 44 (45) Metasternum produced into a short spine never projecting as far as the posterior margin of the first ventral segment. Pro- sternum acutely carinate but not grooved for the reception of the mesosternal carina Hydrocharis. 45 (44) Metatarsal spine very long and acute, extending always beyond the posterior margin of the first ventral segment. Presternum with a keel-shaped process which is deeply grooved for the reception of mesosternal carina, thus locking pro- and meso- thorax together 46 46 (47) Length about 10 mm. Terminal segment of maxillary palpi as long as or longer than the preceding; the antepenultimate seg- ment straight; claws simple Tropisternus. 47 (46) Length about 35 mm. Terminal segment of maxillary palpi much shorter than the preceding; the antepenultimate segment arcuate; claws toothed Hydrophilus. 48 (15) Antennae longer than the palpi (equaling them in a few riffle beetles). 49 49 (90) Hind coxae broadly flattened out and solidly fused with the meta- sternum 50 50 (51) Metasternum divided by a transverse suture which separates a short sclerite before the base of the hind coxae. Family Amphizoidae. A single genus from western mountain streams. Amphizoa. 51(50) Metasternum not thus divided Family Dyxisctdae . . 52 52 (61) Scutellum invisible 53 53 (54) Third and fourth segments of the fore and middle tarsi not greatly different from the others; prosternal process acute posteriorly. Laecophilus. 54 (53) Third segment of the fore and middle tarsi deeply bilobed, the fourth segment rudimentary or wanting 55 55 (56) Base of thorax united to the elytra by a short impressed line on each side, continued without interruption across the border of each; hind margin of the posterior coxae grown solidly coherent with the first ventral segment of the abdomen, which is considerably enlarged; form elongate; very small. Ridessus. 56 (55) Base of thorax and elytra without a continuous impressed line. . 57 AQUATIC INSECTS 941 57 (58) Hind margin of the posterior coxae grown solidly coherent with the first segment of the abdomen, which is considerably enlarged; form round and very convex; shining; small. Dcsmopachria. 58 (57) Hind margin of the posterior coxae overlapping but not coherent with the first segment of the abdomen, which is not espe- cially enlarged. Form various, but never so round and convex as Desmopachriaf nor so small and elongate as Bidessus 59 59 (60) Hind coxal processes each divided by a deep posterior notch, the inner ramus appressed against the first abdominal segment. Hydrovatus. 60 (59) Hind coxal process not so formed Hydroporus. (In the broader sense, as used here this genus includes Coelambus, Deronectes.) 61 (52) Scutellum visible 62 62 (63) Clypeal suture entire Dytiscus. 63 (62) Clypeal suture incomplete 64 64 (65) More than 30 mm. long; inferior spur of hind tibiae much dilated, bifid, much broader than other spur Cybister. 65 (64) Less than 20 mm. long; the two spurs of the hind tibiae of equal or nearly equal breadth 66 66 (73) Distal margin of each segment of the hind tarsi beset with a trans- verse row of minute appressed bristles; anterior tarsi of male with dilated segments forming a round disc. . . 67 67 (68) Spurs of hind tibiae acute at tip; claws of hind tarsi unequal, the inner one sometimes obsolete Hydaticus. 68 (67) Spurs of hind tibiae emarginate at tip; claws of hind tarsi equal or nearly so 69 69 (70) Elytra closely punctate, usually four-sulcate; female. . . Acilius. 70 (69) Elytra not punctate, partly aciculate in female 71 71 (72) Middle femora beset with elongate setae; female. . ThertnonecUs. 72(71) Middle femora beset with short and stout setae. . . . Graphoderes. 73 (66) Hind tarsi without such appressed bristles; anterior tarsi of female with dilated segments forming an oval disc 74 74 (79) A linear group of minute setae present upon the postero-external angle of the hind femora 75 75 (76) Claws of the hind tarsus unequal; the tarsal segments produced posteriorly in overlapping lobes Ilybius. 76 (75) Claws of the hind tarsus equal and segments simple 77 77 (78) Wing of the metasternum very narrow and deflexed around the front border of the external lamina of the hind coxa. Ilybiosoma. 78 (77) Wing of the metasternum wedge-shaped, less noticeably deflexed. Agabus. 79 (74) No such linear group of setae on the postero-external angle of the hind femora 80 80 (81, 82, 83) Surface of the elytra reticulate Scutopterus. 942 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Si (80, 82, 83) Surface of the elytra transversely aciculate. . . CclymbeUs. 82 (80, 81, 83) Surface of the elytra with eight to ten longitudinal striae. Copelatus. 83 (80, 81, 82) Surface of the elytra otherwise sculptured or plain. . . 84 84 (85) Prosternum plainly longitudinally sulcate; species reddish brown. Matus. 85 (84) Prosternum not sulcate 86 86 (87) Apical segment of each palpus distinctly emarginate. Coptotomus. 87 (86) Apical segments of palpi obtuse or truncate 88 88 (89) Claws of the hind tarsus equal AgabeUs. 89 (88) Claws of the hind tarsus unequal Rhantus. 90 (49) Hind coxae free 91 91 (no) Claws large; the three basal ventral segments of the abdomen fused together, obliterating the sutures. Family Parnidae . . 92 92 (93) Ventral abdominal segments (see Fig. 1392) seven in number. Psephenus. 93 (92) Ventral abdominal segments five in number 94 94 (103) Fore coxae transversely elongated 95 95 (102) Sternum of the prothorax prolonged forward beneath the head in a flat rounded lobe; head retracted within the front of the prothorax; the two basal segments of the antennae dis- tinctly enlarged 96 96 (97) Body rounded in outline Lutrochus. 97 (96) Body oblong, elongate 98 98 (99) Antennae approximate, the terminal segments pectinate. Pelonomus. 99 (98) Antennae distant at base 100 100 (101) Antennae slender Throscinus. 101 (100) Antennae short and thick, the second joint triangularly dilated, the close-set distal segments lamellate Dry ops. 102 (95) Sternum of prothorax not greatly produced forward; head free; antennae long and serrate (California) Lara. 103 (94) Fore coxae rounded 104 104 (109) Sternum of prothorax produced forward in a flat rounded lobe; head retracted within the front of the prothorax. . . . 105 105 (108) Antennae eleven-jointed 106 106 (107) Fore tibiae pubescent internally Elmis. 107 (106) Fore tibiae bare internally Stenelmis. 108 (105) Antennae six- jointed Macronychus. 109 (104) Sternum of prothorax not produced forward; head free. Ancyronyx. no (91) Claws of moderate size; basal ventral segments free. Family Dascyludae. AQUATIC INSECTS 943 Larvae 1 (4) Herbivorous larvae with short, broad inconspicuous mandibles. Family Chrysoiikudae . . a 2 (3) Feeding exposed on the floating leaves of water lilies, etc.; elongate brownish larvae of sluggish habits Galerucella. 3 (2) Short arcuate grublike larvae, white and translucent, feeding on the submerged roots of aquatic plants Donacia. 4 (1) Carnivorous larvae, with prominent mandibles 5 5 (12) Mandibles sickle-shaped without internal teeth, but with an internal groove or perforation extending almost from base to apex. 6 6 (7) End of the abdomen with two pairs of strong claws, and the middle segments bearing single pairs of long lateral filaments. Family Gyrinidae. 7 (6) No claws at end of abdomen 8 8 (11) Eyes in groups of five; one claw on each tarsus. Family Haupudae . . 9 9 (10) Body nearly smooth, ending in a long tail Haliplus, 10 (9) Body bearing numerous very long and conspicuous bristlelike fila- ments; no tail Pellodytes. 11 (8) Eyes in groups of six; two claws on each tarsus. Family Dytiscidae. 12 (5) Mandibles toothed internally, at base or in the middle 13 13 (14) Tarsi with two claws Amphizoa. 14(13) A single claw on each tarsus 15 15 (16) Antennae as long as or longer than the thorax. Family Dascyludae. 16(15) Antennae shorter than the thorax 17 17 (18) Larvae depressed; end of the abdomen with short cerci; gills, when present, ventral in position Family Paknidae. 18 (17) Body little depressed; cerci wanting; gills rarely present (and then lateral in position, Bcrosus). . . Family Hydrophilidae. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN AQUATIC DIPTEROUS LARVAE 1 (65) Head chitinous, free, or retracted within the front of the prothorax. Pupa usually free; when concealed in the old larval skin, that skin splits on emergence of the imago in a longitudinal I- or T-shaped cleft. . . . Suborder Orthorrhapha . . a 2 (58) Mandibles opposed to each other, or inclined obliquely downward and opposed to a strongly chitinized labial border. Nematocera . . 3 3 (4) Body strongly depressed, and with a row of six ventral suckers for attachment to the rock bed of rapid streams. Family Blephaeoceeidak 4 (3) Body cyiindric, and usually lacking ventral suckers; when ventral suckers are developed they are more than fix. . .... 5 944 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 5 (6) Head imperfectly chitinized in the rear, and wholly retracted within the pro thorax; posterior spiracles situate upon a respiratory disc Family Tipuledae. 6 (5) Head fully developed and usually free 7 7 (35) No prolegs developed upon the prothorax 8 8 (11) Prolegs developed upon some of the anterior segments of the ab- domen 9 9 (10) The body terminates in a very long and conspicuous respiratory tube. Family Ptychopteridae. zo (9) Without respiratory tube, body U-shaped in locomotion. Family Dixidae. 11 (8) Body without prolegs 12 12 (31) Thorax thickened, the outline of its constituent segments more or less confluent; a fin of swimming hairs developed beneath the end of the abdomen, and often a respiratory tube on the dorsal side Family Culicidae . . 13 13 (26) The last abdominal segment with a single dorsal breathing tube, through which may be seen a pair of large tracheae. . . 14 14 (15) Antennae fold back against head and terminate in two or three claws. Coretkretta. 15 (14) Antennae usually only with a few small erect bristles and one or two pointed processes, or pendent and raptorial 16 16 (23) With brush of hairs projecting forward from the mouth, vibratile. 17 17 (22) Antennae not pendent and raptorial 18 18 (19) No ventral brush or rudder on last abdominal segment beyond air tube; small species, one of which is found in water in pitcher plant Wyeomyia. 19 (18) Last segment with ventral brush 20 20 (21) Head with thick spines; with four blood gills; with stellate hairs on the abdomen. Small species. Uranotaenia. 21 (20) Head without stout spines in addition to the usual setae. Culex (sens. lat). 22 (17) Antennae pendent and raptorial : . . . . Mochlonyx. 23 (16) Mouth brush folded outward, raptorial, not vibratile 24 24 (25) A plate on the side of eighth abdominal segment. . . Megarhinus. 25 (24) A patch of small scales on the side of the eighth abdominal segment. Psorophora. 26 (13) Last segment without long breathing tube 27 27 (30) Last segment dorsally with a flat area in which may be seen two spiracles 28 28 (29) Large species with the anal segment bladderlike. Mandibles strongly developed Pelorempis. 99 (28) Species of medium size with anal segment cylindrical. . . Anopheles* AQUATIC INSECTS 945 30 (27) Last segment usually with hooks, no spiracles apparent. Lara transparent Cordhra. 31 (12) Body cylindric, or depressed fusiform 33 32 (33, 34) Body ending in two fleshy points Family Rhyjhidae. 33 (3*> 34) Body ending in a tapering segment tipped with a tuft or circlet of hairs Ceratopogtmiat of Chxronomidae. 34 (32, 33) Body ending in a strongly chitiniaed terminal segment, usually produced in chitinous respiratory tube. . . Psychodidae. 35 (7) Prothorai with one or two pro-legs. 36 36 (57) A pair of prolegs beneath the prothorax. and another pair at the end of the abdomen. .... Family CfflRONOMDAE . . 37 37 (38) Abdomen with prominent rounded elevations or cushions, with rows of teeth on the inferio-anterior angles of the segments. Psamatkiomyia. 36 (37) Abdominal segments without cushions 39 39 (40) With retractile antennae, the latter often quite long, long stiltlike legs, the caudal tufts of hair mounted on cylindrical processes. Tanypus. 40 (39) Not with all the above characters 41 41 (44) With the two caudal hair tufts mounted on cylindrical projections. 4s 42 (43) With blood gills on venter of eleventh segment. . . Eydrobacnus. 43 (42) With blood gills only at end of twelfth segment. . . Idctriocnemus. 44 (41) Caudal tufts on small rounded papillae 45 45 (48) Antennae elongate, at least one-half as long as and often as long as or longer than the head. 46 46 (47) Antenna with one or two sense organs at tip of second segment. (Rendered visible in preserved material by soaking in water) Tony tarsus. 47 (46) Antenna at most with a seta at tip of second segment at side of the third segment Corytumcura. 48 (45) Antennae short 49 49 (50) Larvae usually blood red; eleventh body segment with two pairs ol blood gills Chironomus (in part). 50 (49) Larvae greenish, yellowish, or whitish 51 51 (52) The maxilliary palpus usually noticeably longer than broad. Larva in pools, pond water, or slow streams .... Chironomus. 52 (51) Palpus about as long as broad 53 53 (54) Full-grown larva not over 6 mm. long, green or bluish-green in color. Anterior abdominal segments of greater diameter than the posterior ones. Mandibles often transversely wrinkled; the anterior prolegs usually with pectinate setae. Cricotopus, Qrtkodadius. 54 (53) FuH-grown larva over 6 mm. in length; mandible not transveriely wrinkled 55 55 (56) Labium with teeth all rounded Diamesa. jf> (55) Labium with middle tooth broadly truncate. .... Thalassomyi*. 946 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 57 (36) A single median proleg on the prothorax and a terminal sucking disc upon the abdomen, serving for attachment to stones in rapid streams; abdomen broadened posteriorly. Family Simuliidae. 58 (2) Mandibles decurved, parallel, their motion vertical, or nearly so. Brachycera . . 59 59 (64) Posterior spiracles placed together within a terminal cleft. ... 60 60 (63) Terminal cleft vertical; head retractile. Family Tabanidae . . 61 61 (62) Last antennal segment much longer than the one preceding; dorsal areas striated like those of the abdomen. . . . Chrysops. 62 (61) Last antennal segment not longer, usually much shorter, than the one preceding; dorsal areas smooth or striated, but those of the thorax nearly or quite free from striae Tabanus. 63 (60) Terminal cleft transverse; head not retractile. Family Stratiomyiidae. 64 (59) Posterior spiracles separate Family Leptidae. 65 (1) Head membranous, very imperfectly developed, often apparently wanting. Pupa formed in the hardened and contracted larval skin (puparium), which opens by a circular cap or lid. Suborder Cyclorhapha. This group includes many of the higher aquatic Diptera (Syrphidae Sciomyzidae, etc.) still too insufficiently known to admit of the construction of a satisfactory key. Note: Acknowledgment is hereby made of help generously given in the preparation of the foregoing keys in parts as follows: in Hemiptera by Mr. C. R. Plunkett; in Coleoptera by Dr. J. C. Bradley; in Diptera by Dr. O. A. Johannsen. IMPORTANT REFERENCES ON NORTH AMERICAN AQUATIC INSECTS. Comstock, J. H. 19 17. Manual for the Study of Insects. 14th Ed. Ithaca. Kellogg, V. L. 1905. American Insects. New York. Folsom, J. W. 19 13. Entomology, with Reference to its Biological and Economic Aspects, ad Ed. Philadelphia. Howard, L. O. iooi. The Insect Book. New York. Miall, L. C. 1903. Natural History of Aquatic Insects. 1 «v. CHAPTER XXYm MOSS ANIMALCULES (BRYOZOA) By CHARLES B. DAVENPORT Dwtetm 0f Um S**mjm Fxfrrmmmfl Fmhrtitm, C«tf Sprimg Emrim. Lone ltim*, K.T. Prominent among the animals commonly discovered in fresh water are the Bryozoa, or moss animalcules, also called Polyzoa, They are forms of exceedingly delicate and attractive appearance, often so transparent that under favorable circumstances the entire structure may be made out under the microscope. Almost all species form colonies composed of many individual animals (zooids) united together and the whole mass is not only easily visible but often conspicuous, whereas the separate zooids are so minute that they can ordinarily be detected only with a hand lens. These colonies take the form of branching threads spread on the surface of stones, sticks, submerged plants or other objects in the water. Others produce a thick crust, while still others form solid jelly-Eke masses which in one species reach the size of the closed fist and not infrequently surpass that (Fig. 1401). The bulk of this mass con- sists of transparent or faintly tinged gelatinous material from which the individual zooids project into the water as they also do from the filamentous colonies previously mentioned. The expanded "head" (lophophore) of the zooid with its crown of tentacles is difficult to see since the animals are exceedingly timid and respond to the slightest disturbance by retreating instantly within their protective covers where they remain even long after the water has become quiet again. Continuous study of the colony in a dish of fresh fic 1393. Cristatoa mmc**,- colony. .... t natural siic. (After Altaian.) water is rewarded by the appearance of the spreading disks or heads, until the surface of the colony blossoms with abundant groups of delicate tentacles. (Fig. 1393.) All are essentially sessile, but a few, like CriskUella and Pectina- telle, have the capacity for a slight movement of the colony on 947 948 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY the substratum. The nature of the colony formation is variable: sometimes close, forming a corm of zooids fused into one mass, as in Cristaiella; sometimes loose, each zooid being distinct, as in UrnateUa. Each zooid has a structure not unlike that of a rotifer. It secretes a resistant outer covering. This is calcareous in some of the marine forms, but is generally chitinous or gelatinous in those of fresh water. So prominent and variable is this cuticula (con- stituting the "zooecium," or "cell") that its form is frequently used as a means of distinguishing species. The body wall is very thin, having relinquished its protective function in favor of the cuticula. It is separated from the viscera by a relatively enor- mous body cavity. In the case of species whose zooids are fused together the body cavities are confluent. The alimentary tract is relatively simple. It consists of a U-shaped tube whose only glands are localized in the epithelium of its walls. The mouth end of the tube is furnished with a corona of numerous ciliated tentacles which create a vortex at the mouth. The mouth is, in one order of fresh-water species (Phylactolaemata), provided with an "epistome" or protecting flap. A long esophagus leads to the capacious stomach and this to the flask-shaped rectum. The anus lies near the mouth either outside or inside the corona of tentacles. For protection, the tentacles can be retracted quickly undsr the shelter of the body cuticula like the proboscis of certain polychaetes. There are numerous long slender muscles effecting the retraction. The nervous system is simple. A brain lies between esophagus and rectum and sends nerves to tentacles and alimentary tract. Circulation is effected by the general fluid of the body cavity. Well defined excretory tubules seem to be missing if we except the doubtful case of certain Phylactolaemata. In the Gymnolaemata the viscera periodically degenerate into a brownish mass, a new alimentary tract regenerates, and the degenerated mass passes through the wall of the gut and is expelled by the anus. Eggs are formed on the body wall and, in Phylactolaemata, the sperm on the mesentery ("funiculus"). In the marine species the embryos early become free-swimming, but in Phylactolaemata they develop in a sort of uterus until they are young colonies.1 These ' * The fresh-water form. Putinatdla. magnified, produces a small free swimming spherical lanra which settks to the bottom almost immediately and there by budding gives rise to a colony. ■ \» * , -jSaf MOSS ANIMALCULES (BRYOZOA) 949 are then set free, and, after a time, settle and affix themselves. Like other sessile forms, Bryozoa have gained a variety of methods of reproduction. Ordinary sexual reproduction and budding have been already mentioned. In some Phylactolaemata — PecHfuUeOa and CristaieUa — the colonies occasionally undergo fission and move apart, and the same process occurs regularly in UrnaieUa. Statoblast formation, which occurs on the funiculus in Phylacto- laemata, is mentioned below. The fresh-water Bryozoa do not constitute a natural group erf animals, but have descended from ancestors belonging to widely distinct families. There can be no question that these ancestors were marine animals. Excepting the suborder Phylactolaemata, all fresh-water Bryozoa belong to groups most of whose representa- tives are marine. The fresh-water forms seem to have made their way up estuaries and rivers to lakes and ponds. Here they acquired the capacity of forming statoblasts or hibernacula. by virtue of which the species was enabled, on the one hand, to survive the winter and, on the other, to be carried bv waterfowl and winds over divides from one drainage basin to another. Thus the fresh- water species have become nearly cosmopolitan. Plumaidla princeps has been found in North and South America, through- out Europe, in Molucca, Japan, and Australia — i.e., in all but one of the great geographical divisions of the land areas of the globe. The fresh-water Brvozoa live in all kinds of fresh waters and are indeed among the most ubiquitous of aquatic animals. They are found in stagnant pools and in rushing rivers, although particular species favor special habitats. The different species of Pluma- tella occur in varied habitats. Paludicella and PectinaieUa favor running water and Lopkopus. CristaieUa. and Plumatclla polymorpka favor quiet ponds. The fresh-water Bryozoa feed on microscopic organisms which are caught in the vortex created by their ciliated tentacles. Diatoms are especially conspicuous objects in their alimentary tracts. Since diatoms require light for their construc- tive metabolism, they are found chiefly in the upper strata of the water, and consequently Bryozoa are usually not found at great depths. However, in a mass of material dredged by Professor H. B. Ward from the Middle Ground, Traverse Bay, Lake Michigan, 950 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY at a depth of 23 to 36 meters, Paludicella ehrenbergii and Frederi- cella sultana were abundant. Although Cristatella is usually found on the underside of floating lily pads or in other situations near the surface, I have obtained it from the still waters of Trinity Lake, Westchester County, New York, at a depth of 2 to 3 meters. Asper records dredging Fredericella sultana in certain Swiss lakes at a depth of 50 to 80 meters. Little light penetrates to such a depth, and we may conclude that light is not at all directly neces- sary for the development of fresh-water Bryozoa. Indeed, masses of Paludicella are sometimes obtained from water pipes where they flourish to an alarming extent. The Bryozoa have become adapted to life in ponds by forming statoblasts at certain seasons of the year. The entire significance of the statoblasts has not been determined. Typically, they winter over and one may find the shores strewn with them in the early spring. They hatch out in New England late in May or early in June. So the statoblasts have come to be regarded as winter buds, or adaptations to preserve the race from being killed off by freezing of the water. They often begin to develop early in the summer, and I have observed what has been seen by European observers, that some statoblasts hatch in nature even in September. Also Fr. Muller has informed Kraepelin that the fresh-water Bryozoa of Blumenbau, Brazil, which experience no winters, nevertheless form statoblasts. It seems fair to conclude that there are other functions performed by the statoblasts than resistance to winter. For instance, they serve to maintain the species during drought, or they aid in distribution by clinging to the waterfowl or resisting the action of digestive fluids. The wide distribution of the species of fresh-water Bryozoa indicates the value of the statoblast in the process of dispersion. For a detailed account of the distribution of the fresh- water species in the United States see Davenport (1904). Preserving. — The chief difficulties in the way of preserving fresh-water Bryozoa arise, first, from the rapid contraction of the polypides into the conn, and, secondly, in the case of the gelatin* ous forms, from the large amount of water in the body; for, if the specific gravity of the killing or preserving medium is very differ- ent from that of the water, distortion will occur. MOSS ANIMALCULES (BRYOZOA) 951 To kill expanded it is necessary first to narcotize. Chloral hydrate is used, added slowly in crystals until the polypides do not react to touch. To preserve in the natural form, the animals may be plunged directly into 4 per cent formaldehyde (formalin, 10 per cent) . The classification of fresh-water Bryozoa has been in a state of great confusion owing to the great variability in the form of the colony. The form of the colony depends very largely upon external factors, such as food supply, form of substratum, and crowding. The statoblast has a form that is quite independent of external factors, and upon it, consequently, great stress is laid in systematic work. The form of the statoblast is, however, not wholly uncor- rected with that of the stock, so the form of the stock is to be considered. In the following classification that proposed by Kraepelin has been adopted entire. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH-WATER BRYOZOA 1 (2) Anus opening inside the tentacular corona; tentacles incapable of complete retraction Subclass Endoproctm. Only one species known in North America. Urnatella gracilis Leidy 185 1. Stock consisting of a basal plate, from which there usually arise two segmented stems termi- nating in the polypide. More rarely one or more than two stems arise from the disk. Habit, running water. From Schuylkill River, Pa,; Scioto River, O.; Illinois River, III. Fig. i«9j. Umsidlc twill*, (a) Colony from n tt HS Illinois River at Havana. XU- (After Daven- tSL l**1-) (6) Single polyp. (After LeMy.) b 2 (1) Anus opening outside the tentacular corona, which is capable of being retracted Subclass Ectoprocta . . 3 3 (6) Zooecia sharply separated from each other; no cpistome. Order Gymnoltemata . . 4 4 (5) Stock consists of stolons from which at intervals an erect cylindrical, hyaline single sooid arises, having a terminal aperture. PoUxieUa erectn Potts 1884. Lophophorc circular, 20 (19 to 21) tentacle*. Habitat, photophil; on upper nurface of «*tone* in rapid*: sometime* penetrating incruittlng apongf* (RpkydtNn Wrfyi). From Taoony Creek, Montgomery Co., Pennsylvania. Fio. 1395. iVfeMtti enria. X t% (Fmm KroepHIn** figure of t PMntytvanla specimen.) 952 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 5 (4) Stock composed of zooids that are sharply separated from one another by partitions; sparsely, usually oppositely branched; with a chitinous cuticula. The zooids are dub-shaped and have a lateral, quadrangular aperture near the larger, distal end. PaludiceUa ekrenbergii van Beneden 1848. Zooids about 2 mm. long; lateral bods partly repent, portly erect; about 16 tentacles. Habitat, flowing streams; occasionally in water pipes. From Massachusetts, Penn- sylvania, Illinois, and Lake Michigan. Fig. 1396. Palmdicdla ekrenbergii. (a) Colony, haH natural size. (b) Portion of same enlarged. X 5. (After Kraepelin.) 6 (3) Zooecia confluent; epistome present. . Order Phylactolaemata. . 7 7 (14, 15) Statoblasts without hooks, rounded at ends 8 8 (9) Stock branched in form of antlers; more rarely massed with recumbent and elevated tubes; mostly brown or incrusted with algae and grains of sand; rarely hyaline. Fredericella sultana Blumenbach 1774. Tubes cylindrical, the older ones mostly keeled. Without complete dissepiments. Apertures terminal at the broadened or bind ends of tubes. Polypide very long and slender; tentacles arranged in a nearly circular corona. Few tentacles, not exceeding 24. Statoblasts dark brown, bean-shaped or elliptical, without float, and with smooth upper surface. Habitat on wood, stones and water plants in standing and slowly flowing waters. From Maine to Penn- sylvania, westward to Wisconsin and even Flathead Lake, Montana. Common in the Great Lakes. Fie. 1397. FredericeUa sultana, («) Portion of branch, natural size, (b) Polyp magnified. (After Hyatt.) (c) Statoblast. (After Kraepelin.) 9 (8) Colonies consist of cylindrical tubes, which are either branched or form massive clumps or run over the substratum as hyaline, lobed tubes Plumaiella Lamarck. . 10 Partitions rudimentary or absent, cuticula brown to hyaline, often incrusted. Tentacular corona markedly horseshoe-shaped, with 40 to 60 tentacles. Intertentacular membrane present. Statoblasts without hooks; either free, elliptical, with broad float, or (in the horizontal tubes) without float, of large size and irregular shape. The commonest genus of our fresh-water Bryozoa. Has been reported from all continents ex- cept Africa. Uvea in the most diverse habitats, in ponds or streams, usually not in the UgLt. 10 (13) Colony with vertical as well as horizontal branches, 11 MOSS AMMALCULES (BBYOZOA) 953 11 (is Lubniia iluct and brown, with a keel that broadens at aperture. Fiee sutfobiasts dongaled; proportions 1 : 1.53 to t : 2.8. PJmmalcila frmceps Kraepciin 1887. Tubes openly branched, repent, with short lateral branches, antler- like Var. a, emargmali. Coluny robust, branched often ris- ing f rom subtratum. Keel little de- veloped. Statoblasts elongated. Var. 6, fnUiaoa. Vertical branches predominate, funning an intertwined mass. Var. y, mucosa. Vertical tubes fused into a mass from which only the aperture rises fret'. . , Var. A, spongioid *"im^3i' 13 (n) Culicula titeh- browned or keeled. Free staloblasts nearly circular, 1 : 1 to 1 : 1.5. . yitimrtclkt poiymerpka Kxaepelin 1887. Tubes creeping with short vertical aide branches. Culicula semi-transparent ; but variable; keel not evident. Var. a.refens (-f.-ur«*b«a Hyatt). Tubes repent, branching or thickly inter- twined, covering the substratum Few or no vertical branches. Culicula lightly colored to transparent Var. fl. opprrssa Tubes repent, with many elongated and branched vertical rami. Culicula semi-opaque, do evident keel Var. y. cacspiusa. Tube* repent. Vertical branches dose to- gether, even fuaed. forming great sohdness. Cuticula brown, aperture hyaline, slightly elongated . Var. t. /*m|*io FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Horizontal branches only. Cuticula delicate, colorless, hyaline. Elevated aperture-cone wrinkled and besprinkled with white. Free statoblasts nearly circular. J'lumatelta punctata Hancock 185a. Stock repent and open, forming long hyaline tubes that give rise to only a lew, likewise repent, lateral tubes. . , . Var. a, prostrate. From Maine, Pennsylvania, Illinois, and Lake Erie. Stock repent, very thickly branched, completely cover- ing the substratum, which seems enveloped in thick layer of gelatinous vesicles. Var. 0, deiua. FlC. 1400. PlumattUe punctata. 14 (7, 15) Statoblasts, large, elliptical, but at each end drawn out into a sharp apex; broad float, hooks absent. Lopkopus crislaliinus Pallas 1766. Colony shaped like a sack; erect, sometimes more or less lobed by indentation.! of margin, looking then sometimes like a dove. Outer cuticula layer delicate and hyaline, more intrusted at base. Polypides scattered, a group of them rising from each lobe. Lopbophores with about 60 tentacles. The colony may divide along the constrictions between tbe lobes. Habitat, chiefly standing water, such as pools, or, rarely, slowly flowing water. Chiefly attached to plant stems. From Schuylkill and Illinois rivers. >S (?. 14) Statoblasts with hooks. 16 16 (18) Colonies hyaline, in the form of a rosette, lobed, with horizontal tubes only PeetinaleUa Leidy . . 17 They secrete a great gelatinous base which is common to many colonies. Aperture slightly elevated above common coenecium. Statoblasts large and circular in subrect angular, with broad bent float and one marginal row of anchor-shaped books. 17 Polypides scattered or in double row along eachlobe, the gelatinous baseoften 10 to 20 centimeters thick. Putinatetia magnijUa Leidy 1851. Tentacles 60 to 84 in number. Statoblasts about 1 mm. in diameter, provided with n to IX hooka from 0.15 to 0.15 mm. long. Habitat, submerged branches or twigs of trees, wooden (take*, gates of dams, walla of reservoirs or stones in brooks. Shady situations, such as south walls of reservoirs, or wood-covered streams. From Maine to Mississippi. ANiMAi.rmjs; fttK-vtttthO OTlly S«rt*4*v, Uwf. rtuwlm wtMi Itnftl -ami -a -fir utf. IUjoit\ tir.ERti' ioiui»> SMtnMattv with »ki liibiut in ituuiuu: nr akm-tWiv w»r*r. - TT Buk-O] h"lv-pt£l>. -UUI DTl Athf r ^QUAtk' T*Uf>N tbai\ i urn in di«R*iri twnt-. nr rlnna: wf. i. I*W> 'Slymw. l.oiy)o« Davenport, C. B. 1800. Crotatclla : Thr OiRin »wt PHylftrinlft-lmM. Communicationa Euex Institute, 4: 107 jjH, y d} m», m- i'Vi, (04 23a. 956 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Kraepelin, K. 1887. Die Deutschen Susswasser-Bryozoen. Eine Mono- graphic I, Anatomisch-Systematischer Teil. Abhandl. Naturw. Verein, Hamburg, 10: 1-168. Landacre, F. iooi. Sponges and Bryozoa of Sandusky Bay. Ohio Nat., 1: 96-7. Leidy, J. 1883. Urnatella gracilis. Jour. Acad. Nat So., Phila., 9: 5-16. .*-« CHAPTER XXEX THE MOLLUSCA By BRYANT WALKER, Dkwht, Mm. For the purposes of this treatise and in order to differentiate the group from the other great phyla of the animal kingdom repre- sented in our fresh-water fauna, the Moilusca may be defined as animals with a soft body encased in a hard shell, which may be either in one piece (univalve) or in two pieces (bivalve). In the univalve moilusca or Gastropoda, commonly called snails, the shell may be coiled either obliquely or horizontally or may be a simple uncoiled, conical, tent-shaped secretion on the back of the animal. In this class, the animal possesses a distinct head, with a pair of contractile tentacles, at the base of which are placed the eyes. On the lower side of the head, between the tentacles, is the mouth, which, on its inner, upper margin, is usually provided with a chi- tinous jaw of from one to three pieces. In the lower part of the mouth is the radula, a muscular ribbon covered with minute teeth. The fresh-water Gastropoda are divided into two main groups or subclasses according as they breathe the free air by means of a lung or are provided with a gill for subaqueous respiration. As the name implies, these animals progress by crawling on the ven- tral surface of the body, which is modified to form a flat, muscular disk called the foot. The bivalve moilusca or Lamellibranchia, usually known as clams or mussels, have the body protected by two symmetrical, opposing valves, which are united above by an elastic tissue called the ligament. They have no head and have, accordingly, been called the Acephala. They have no tentacles, eyes, jaws, or radula. The mouth is simply an orifice at the anterior end of the body, on each side of which is a flap or palpus, which assists in guiding the food to the mouth. The foot is an axe-shaped mass of muscular tissue (hence the name of Pelecypoda often used for the class), which may be extended from the anterior portion of the shell and, 957 958 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY by effecting a lodgment in the bottom, drag the animal slowly forward. The lamellibranchs breathe by means of two gills sus- pended on each side of the body, which are divided into a series of water tubes by septa or lamellae, through which the water circu- lates by means of cilia. The whole body is enclosed in a soft mantle, which secretes the shell along its outer margins. Poste- riorly the mantle has two openings, through the lower of which the water enters the shell, passes forward, aerating the gills and carrying food to the mouth, and then flows out through the upper opening. A more detailed account of the structure of the two classes rep- resented in our fauna will be found under the head of classification. The North American Fauna As would naturally be expected from the vast extent of the ter- ritory included in the United States and British America and the great diversity both in the climatic and physical conditions prev- alent in different portions of the continent, the fresh-water fauna of North America is not only one of great abundance, both in species and individuals, but also of great diversity in character; and a very large proportion of the genera represented are peculiar to it. While but one of the eighteen families represented in our fauna is peculiar to the continent, that one, the Pleuroceratidae, is extraor- dinarily developed both in genera and species and, where found, its members usually occur in great abundance. On the other hand, of the eighty-six genera recognized at the present time, no less than forty-nine, or five-ninths, are peculiar to North America, while of the many hundred of described species, it is safe to say that more than ninety per cent are not found else- where. Indeed, barring the comparatively small number of cir- cumpolar species in the north, and the somewhat larger represen- tation of tropical or subtropical forms found on our southern borders, practically the whole of our molluscan fauna may be said to be distinctively North American. The distribution of the various families, genera, and species represented in our fauna varies greatly in the different sections of the continent. AM^L THE MOLLUSCA 959 Most of the families have representatives in all portions of the country where suitable conditions of environment are to be found. But there are some notable exceptions. Thus the Viviparidae, which form one of the most conspicuous elements of the fauna of the Eastern States, are not found west of the Mississippi Valley. The Ampullaridae, which replace the Viviparidae in the tropics, are only found in Florida and Southern Georgia; while the great family of the Pleuroceratidae, the one family peculiar to our fauna, is not found west of the Mississippi Valley drainage, except for a few isolated species that occur in the northern Pacific states. Many of the genera have a general distribution in all parts of the continent. That is, some representatives of such genera will be found practically every place where suitable conditions obtain. But it is to be borne in mind that comparatively few species have a general distribution. Many of them have, so far as known, a very limited habitat, while others range over a large extent of territory. Many of the genera are likewise restricted to certain portions of the continent and particularly to certain drainage systems, while others are confined to a very limited area. The Coosa River in Alabama, in this respect, has a most remarkable fauna. No less than six genera and very many species are known to occur only in it and its tributaries. But while, in a general way, it is true that our fauna as a whole is well known, and its distinctive characters recognized, yet the sum total of our present knowledge, large as it may seem, is very small and inadequate when compared with what we might and would like to know about it. But a very small portion of the continent has been collected over with any sort of thoroughness, and there are undoubtedly very many new types, both generic and specific, yet to be discovered. While, of course, the mere description of new species is the least important part of the work of the conchologist, yet the accurate knowledge of all the species found within our borders is the basis for the solution of the larger problems of distribution and evolution, which are of great importance. The exact range of very few, if any, even of our most common species is exactly known. It is very desirable that lists of the species occurring in all the states 960 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY and counties of the country should be compiled. Such local lists, when the specimens are correctly determined, are of great value and interest and are always acceptable contributions to scientific literature.1 The life history and habits of the different species form a subject of great interest, and as yet but little is known about them. Then, too, very little is known of the internal anatomy of our species, much less, indeed, than of the land mollusca. In all these lines of work and study there is a fruitful and unreaped field of investi- gation, which cannot fail to yield both pleasure and profit to the student who will undertake to study the common forms of mollus- can life, which are to be found so abundantly in all parts of our country. Collection and Preparation of Specimens Nearly every permanent body of water has its mollusks, varying according to its character. Some species are found only in rapidly flowing water, and others only in ponds and still water. Ditches and other stagnant waters are usually good collecting ground for Pisidia and other small species. The low places in the woods, which dry up in the summer time, have a number of species that are not found elsewhere, and which bury themselves in the mud when the water disappears. Sand banks in rivers and lakes are favorite resorts of many of the smaller species. The under side of the lily pads should be scrutinized, while the Ancyli should be looked for on stones and dead clam shells. The distribution of the different species in all the states and territories being of prime importance, the collector should always bear in mind: First, that a dead shell is better than none at all; Second, that dead shells should not be taken, if live ones can be had, and that careful search will usually discover them in the immediate vicinity. Third, that all the species are extremely variable in their abun- dance from year to year, and so it is a safe rule, "when you're getting, to get a plenty." 1 The writer wfll gladly aid students in the identification of their specimens without charge. Address 45 Alfred St., Detroit, Mich. . , t>. * . ■ THE MOLLUSCA 961 The apparatus tor collecting is very simple. It is nnrngmy to iiave a dipper and, if possible, a small dredge. The dipper is made irom an ordinary tin one by removing the bottom and substituting one of fine wire doth. By removing the end of the handle, the dipper can be slipped on the aid of a cane or poie when in use. This is useful not only for reaching the larger specimens from the shore or boat, but especially for sifting the mud and sand from the bottom, where a multitude of small species live, which otherwise would not be found. It will be found more con- venient to empty the contents of the dipper, when thoroughly washed out. into a pail or small bag. and carry the whole mass home before undertaking to pick out the shells. If attempted in the held, many of the smaller and more desirable things are apt to be overlooked. By spreading the mass out in the sun for a short time, it will become dry and friable so that the shells can be easily separated and picked out. An ordinary reading glass is very useful for the detection of the more minute forms in sorting over such material. Many desirable species live in water too deep for the convenient use of the dipper, and for these it is necessary to have a small dredge. One with an aperture of 9 by 6 inches is as large as can be used satisfactorily by a single person in a boat. Several small bags and a number of wide-mouthed bottles and small vials should be carried, so that the specimens from different localities may be kept separate. Care must be taken to keep the more fragile species separate from the heavier ones, otherwise they are likely to be damaged in moving about. For the same reason it is better to fill the bottles partially with water while in the field, as the mollusks then attach themselves to the glass and are less likely to be broken. It is not necessary to take alcohol into the field. Specimens to be kept for anatomical purposes may be preserved in alcohol, which at first should be greatly diluted, not stronger than 25 per cent; after a day or two the specimens should be re- moved to 50 per cent alcohol, and later to the undiluted. Formal- dehyde, 2 per cent dilution, is an admirable preservative for ma- terial of this kind. It should not, however, be used when it is 962 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY desired to keep the shells as specimens, as it destroys those left in it any length of time. With the exception of the larger species of Planorbis, which are more easily cleaned by boiling, it is practically immaterial whether the fluviatile univalves are boiled, or put directly into diluted alco- hol for a day or two. In either case there is no difficulty in ex- tracting the animals. The curved points of the collecting forceps are convenient for this purpose, and hooks of various sizes can be made from safety pins. By tying these on small wooden handles very effective instruments can be made. Small hooks or "probes" of various sizes fitting into an adjustable handle are most convenient and can be obtained from any dealer in dental instruments. A small, fine-pointed dental syringe is indispensable for this work. When the animal is completely extracted, the interior of the shell should be thoroughly washed out with the syringe. A small piece of sponge on the end of a fine copper wire, which can be bent in any direction, is very useful for removing the mucus, which is apt to adhere to the interior. This should always be carefully attended to; if not it will greatly disfigure the specimen when dried. The exterior should then be thoroughly scrubbed with a soft tooth or nail brush. When perfectly clean, inside and out, the water should be carefully emptied out and the shell put aside in the air, but not in the sun, to dry. It is not desirable to attempt to clean the minute species by removing the animal. They should be put directly into 25 per cent alcohol for a day or two. If to be left longer in the alcohol, the strength should be increased. Twenty-four hours, however, in the alcohol is all that is necessary. Then they can be dried in the air without leaving any offensive odor. Either before or after drying they can be cleaned, if necessary, by putting them in a bottle of water, with some fine, clean sand, and shaking them together until all the dirt has been removed by the sand. In the operculate species, it is desirable to retain the opercula of, at least, part of the specimens. While it adds to the labor, it increases the value of the specimen if it is always done. These are easily removed from the animal and, after being cleaned, should be put inside the shell and the aperture plugged with cotton. All the foreign matter both *L. *?*-.**•&. THE MOLLUSCA 963 inside and outside of the shell should be removed by thorough washing. All the water species are apt to be more or less incrusted with deposits of lime or oxide of iron. These can be removed by immersing them in oxalic acid. Care should be taken not to pro- long the operation, or the texture of the shell may be injured. Elbow grease is the most effective agent for making good specimens. When that fails, use the acid. The Ancyli are always more or less coated in this way, and can easily be cleaned by floating them for a few minutes on the acid, upside down, and then gently brushing them off with a soft brush while held on the tip of the finger. The larger bivalves should be well washed and, if necessary, scraped off with the knife as soon as taken, care being taken not to injure the epidermis. They can be boiled, if desired, when the shells will open and the animals easily removed. But, as a rule, it is more convenient, unless collected in large quantities, to cut the muscles, which hold the valves together, with a thin-bladed knife and scrape the animal out. Care should be taken not to break the edge of the fragile species when inserting the knife. All traces of the animal matter should be removed, and after a thorough washing the valves tied together with a string until thoroughly dried. Never use colored twine for this purpose, as it is apt to stain the shells. Any surface incrustation can be removed either with oxalic or muriatic acid. The latter is more convenient for the larger species, and can be applied with a small brush. To avoid trouble, it is safer to wear rubber gloves, if a large quantity of material is to be cleaned. Care must be exercised in using the acid and the specimens frequently washed, lest damage be done to the shell. The smaller bivalves, the Sphaeria and Pisidia, are best treated by putting into diluted alcohol for a day or two and then drying them. If left too long the shells are apt to open, which interferes with the looks of the specimens. The larger species of Sphaerium are better with the animal removed. This can be done after boiling, or a few days in alcohol. As these are usually too small to be easily tied together to keep the valves from gaping, each specimen, while the hinge is flexible, should be closely wrapped up in a small piece of tissue paper until completely dry. 964 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY While it is not usually desirable to keep "dead" shells for the cabinet, occasionally it is necessary. In such cases, the color can be in some measure restored by applying a solution of paraffin and gasoline (a cubic inch of the former in half a pint of the latter). "Dead" Unionidae can be improved in appearance and the bril- liancy of the nacre measurably restored by applying muriatic acid. A good collection is characterized by two essentials: First, the careful selection and preparation of the specimens themselves; Second, absolute accuracy in the matter of the localities from which they came. There is little excuse for having poor and ill-cleaned specimens. There is none at all for failure to keep accurate records of the col- lector's fieldwork. A drawer of any common species, without any indication of whence they came, even if well cleaned, would be absolutely without value. Such a drawer of any of our species from fifty or one hundred different localities, definitely indicated, would be a valuable contribution to the conchology of any state. Specific names can be supplied or corrected any time, but a mis- taken cr erroneous locality can never be corrected. The collector, therefore, should be careful never to trust to memory for facts of this kind. Both in collecting and cleaning, the specimens from each locality should be kept carefully separated and labeled. Too much importance cannot be given to this point. The study of the geographical distribution of the mollusca is one of the most im- portant branches of conchological work, and, to be of any value, this must be based on absolutely accurate work on the part of the collector. TJie manner of casing and arranging the collection is largely one of individual preference. A catalogue, however, is essential, and it is better to begin systematically in this particular and thus avoid the necessity of doing it all over again when the collection begins to assume considerable size. There should be a serial catalogue and a card catalogue. Each addition to the collection should be numbered as soon as received and entered in the serial catalogue, which should be a book ruled in as many columns as the collector desires. THE M0LLQ9C& 96$ The card catalogue is convenient in a small collection. It be- comes absolutely necessary in a large one. Hie cards should be of uniform axe for convenience in handling. If it is desired to have a card for every entry, they can be smaller than if it is desir- able for economy of space to have as many entries as possible on one card. In the latter case a convenient size is that of the ordinary library card, which can be ruled to hold twenty entries. The name of the species is written on die top, and the number of each entry of that species and the locality are entered below. Such a card as this enables the collector to see at a glance not only whether any given species is represented in his collection, but also from what localities, and saves a large amount of time which would otherwise be spent in turning over the leaves of a serial catalogue. The cards can be kept in drawers or boxes of proper size and can be arranged alphabetically under the different genera and families. Guide cards slightly higher than the ordinary card, indicating the genera, can be inserted in their proper places. In collections intended for public exhibition, it is usually neces- sary to have the specimens mounted on cards or blocks. But in private collections such an arrangement is a mistake, not only on account of the greater room required for the collection, but particularly because it prevents the handling of the specimens for purposes of study. Specimens under an inch in diameter are most conveniently kept in glass vials. These can be obtained from any wholesale druggist. They should be without a neck and of standard sizes. The length will depend upon the standard size of the tray adopted. For my own collection I use three sizes, J, J, J inch in diameter. As these vials are rather fragile, the pressure of the cork is apt to break them. The cork should therefore be softened by rolling or crushing. A pair of plumber's burner pliers is useful for this purpose. The serial number should be put on the cork or on a small piece of paper inside. Specimens too large for the vials should have the number on the shell in ink. Then, if a drawer happens to be overturned, the specimens can be sorted out again without difficulty. When numbered, the vials and specimens should be placed to 966 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY trays. For these a standard size should be adopted, so that they will conveniently fit into the drawers of the cabinet. In the National Museum at Washington, the unit is i by 2 inches, and the larger sizes are all multiples of that unit. In the Academy of Natural Sciences at Philadelphia, the unit is ij by 3. There is one advantage in the use of the larger unit where space is a serious question. For the small species the vials may be used only ij inches in length, and two vials can be put into one tray, thus dou- bling the capacity of the drawer. The trays should be of the same depth. One-half inch is sufficient for most of the univalve species. For the larger species, such as the Unionidae, requiring trays of good size, f inch is better. These trays can be had of any paper- box manufacturer, or can be easily cut out of cardboard by the collector, the corners being fastened together by strips of gummed paper. The character of the cases for a collection is determined by the means and inclination of the collector. Any case of shallow drawers will do. If, however, cases are to be made, they should be made of a standard size with interchangeable drawers. Each tray should have a neat label giving the serial number, the name, and the locality of the specimens it contains. A box, bottom side up, can be used for separating the genera and species in every drawer. Small labels of convenient size for designating them can be had, already gummed, at any bookseller's. In packing shells, small specimens should not be mixed with large ones, as they are apt to get lost; nor should fragile shells be put in with stronger ones, as they are likely to be broken. The minute specimens can be put into gelatin capsules, small vials, quills, or paper tubes made by rolling writing paper around a lead pencil, gumming down the edge and stopping the ends with cotton. Do not mix shells from different localities. Write the locality on a label and wrap it up with each vial or package. Use plenty of cotton in packing fragile shells. Pill boxes and match boxes are convenient for packing purposes. Wrap up each vial or box sepa- rately, then, if a smash does occur, there is a fair chance of saving some of the specimens and no danger of mixing the contents of different packages. Do not send paper boxes by mail. Pack in a wooden box. THE MOLLUSC* 967 pnpOBCS OS GHBBCXKB1 OtoCT IFCSIi OT uOOQOQC .SpmillCPS may be used, live fyrrimms may be killed by plunging diem into bailing mater for a few seconds. The animal can thus be Meinuvod from the shell in the usual way, using great care not to Tmrrifarfr* it with the hook; or the shell, if not too heavy, can be carefully broken away with the forceps. Preserved specimens are frequently difficult to extract from the shell, in which ca9e the did must be removed either by breaking or, if too thick, by dissolving it in muriatic add * 1 Two pairs of fine scissors will be necessary, one pair with straight points, the other with curved points; one or more fine scalpels, and two pairs of fine forceps, one straight and the other curved. Dis- secting needles are also necessary. These can be made by forcing the heads of fine needles, by means of a pair of pliers, into the end of a round stick of small diameter. The point of one of these needles should be bent so as to form a hook, first heating the end of the needle to a white heat/' "In dissecting the animal, a circular china dish about 4 indies in diameter and 2 in depth will be necessary; also a piece of sheet cork as large as will lie at the bottom of the dish, fastened to a thin sheet of lead with either string or rubber bands. It is best to have the lead of the same size as the cork. This leaded cork is to be placed in the bottom of the dish, and the dish filled with alcohol. If the animal has once been placed in alcohol, all dissec- tions should be made in alcohol, but freshly killed specimens may be dissected in water, and many of the organs at this time present a much more natural appearance than when acted on by alcohol. Place the animal on the cork and fasten it down with small pins, or better yet, with very fine, short needles inserted through the margin of the foot. Then with a fine pair of scissors, commencing at the head, cut through the integument along the center of the back, taking care not to injure any of the organs below. The integument is now to be removed from the dorsal part, turned back and fastened to the cork, removing the needles from the margin of the foot and putting them through the edges of the integument. All the organs of the anterior part of the snail axe 968 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY thus brought into view, and further dissection of the organs can be intelligently made/'1 The method of preparing the jaws and lingual membrane for examination is as follows: "On opening the head (of the snail) from above, one readily notices at the extreme anterior part, close against the outer integu- ment, a prominent, oval body. This is called the buccal mass. It is easily cut away from the animal, and will be found to contain both jaw and lingual membrane. These can be removed by fine scissors or knives from the buccal mass in the larger species, but in the smaller species, the method usually employed is putting the whole buccal mass in a watch crystal, full of a strong solution of caustic potash. Allowing it to remain for several hours, the potash will destroy all of the buccal mass, and leave the jaw and lingual membrane perfectly clean and ready for examination. They must be well rinsed in clean water, in another watch crystal, before examination. Another more expeditious process, is to place the whole buccal mass in a test tube with the solution of potash, and boil it for a few seconds over a spirit lamp. Pouring the con- tents of the tube into a watch crystal, the lingual membrane at- tached to the jaw will be readily seen by a pocket lens. If the species be small, its whole body may be thrown into the solution. Still more minute species, may be treated in this way; crush the whole shell between the glass slides; wash the particles of broken shell in a few drops of water, still keeping the body of the animal on the slide; when clean, drop on it the caustic potash and boil it by holding the slide itself over the spirit lamp. "For purpose of examination, the jaw and lingual membrane may be simply mounted in water and covered with thin glass. One must be sure in spreading out the lingual membrane not to have its upper side down, and it is well to cut it transversely in several 1 No detailed instructions for the dissection of the fresh-water moilusks have beeii published in this country. For an admirable, fully illustrated paper on the dissection of the land snail, which can be easily adapted for the use of the student, see Simpson, Bull. N. y. State Museum, viii, p. 241 (xooi). The same author has published an excellent study, fully illustrated, of the anatomy of Anodokt^ which should be in the hands of every student. See Rep. N. Y., State Mus. of Nat. Hist., 35, p. 169. ..t?*dtt*jfe THE MOLLUSCA 969 places, as the teeth are beautifully shown and often stand detached on the edges of the cut. "For preservation for future study, the glycerin preparations sold by the opticians will be found useful, though they have the great disadvantages of deliquescing in warm weather." * The radula may also be mounted in Canada balsam. In this case it should be stained with carmine or chromic acid, as otherwise the specimens will in time become transparent. Measurement and Descriptive Terms The length or height of a univalve shell is the distance from the apex to the basal edge of the lip, measured along a line drawn through the axis. The greater diameter is the greatest width, including the lip, measured on a line drawn at right angles to the axis. The lesser diameter is measured on the same plane, but on a line at right angles to the greater diameter. Shells are dextral or sinistral, accordingly as the aperture is on the right or left of the axis, when held, apex uppermost, with the aperture facing the observer. In bivalve shells, the length is the distance from the anterior to the posterior extremity; the height is the distance at right angles between two parallel lines so drawn as to touch the highest dorsal and lowest basal points; the width is the greatest diameter measured in a line at right angles to the basal line. The 'remainder of the terms in common use are sufficiently indi- cated on the following diagrams. 1 W. G. Binney, Mao. Am. Land Sheik, p 44. the preparation of the radulae of the minute species, tropical Society, 1888, p. 7. s. Up. i-s. Htiftn. 7 -g. Grettst dimmettr. For Full instructions in regard to Reedier. Journal N V. Mkjo- FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY JO 1 7 Fio. 1404. The «lwJI of m bi vilvf . Hin«c. 6. Scai of prolnctor pcdb. B™>. 7. PelHil line. PkuiJo-< srdinib. S. Sci. ot poBrrior udducttir. Sur o(> intcrlcr rrtrnciot. 0. Sen of poilerior retractor. St»rof ■ .nterior adductor, is. Literal teeth. Classification Of the several classes into which the subkingdom of the Mollusca is divided, but two, the Gastropoda and Lamellibranchia, are represented in the fresh-water fauna of North America. The for- mer includes all the univalve species commonly called snails or periwinkles, and the latter, all the bivalve forms usually known as clams or mussels. The class Gastropoda, as the name implies, are mollusks in which the ventral portion of the body is developed into a fleshy, more or less expanded, creeping disk, called the foot, by the muscular contractions of which the animal progresses. When fully expanded, the animal is seen to have a distinct head, with a pair of tentacles, at the base of which are placed the eyes. In the center of the head, below and between the tentacles, is the mouth, in which, on the upper surface, are situated the jaws, from one to three, and, on the lower side, the lingual ribbon or radula, THE MOLLUSCA 97 1 the surface of which is covered with numerous rows of small chitin- ous teeth. The Gastropoda are either ovoviviparous or oviparous. The sexes are separate in some groups (Dioecia) and united in the same indi- vidual mothers (Monoecia). All of the fresh-water gastropods are provided with an external shell, which covers the animal completely when retracted, and which is spiral, discoidal, or conical in shape. Owing to the torsion of the body, caused by the spiral shape of the shell, the animal of all the fresh-water gastropods, while externally bilaterally symmetrical, is internally asymmetrical. There is but one lung or one functional gill, as the case may be, and the termina- tions of the digestive and genital systems, instead of being posterior and central, corresponding to the mouth, are on the side near the respiratory chamber. The Gastropoda are further divided into subclasses, accordingly as the torsion of the viscera has or has not been accompanied by a similar twisting of the visceral nerve loop. In the Euthyneura, the visceral nerve loop lies beneath the intestinal canal, and was consequently not affected by the torsion to which that organ was subjected, while in the Streptoneura, the visceral nerve loop lies above the intestines and became involved in the twisting of the viscera and was consequently made to assume the form of the figure 8. The aquatic Euthyneura, which comprise practically all our air-breathing or pulmoniferous fluviatile mollusks, are included in the order Pulmonata; while the Streptoneura comprise all the gill-breathing or branchiferous species, which are furnished with a peculiar chitinous or calcareous structure attached to the upper surface of the posterior extremity called the operculum, and which, when the animal retires within the shell, completely closes the aperture. Species thus provided are termed operculate. The Pulmonata, on the other hand, have no operculum, and are there- fore called inoperculate. The Pulmonata are divided into two suborders: the Stylomma- tophora, in which the eyes are borne on the extremities of retractile tentacles, and which are all terrestrial species; and the Basom- matophora, in which the eyes are placed at the base of contractile tentacles, and which are aquatic or amphibious in habit. 972 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The Basommatophora are subdivided into three superfamilies based mainly on the general character of their habitat: I. Terrestrial or semiamphibious, living in damp places or near the margin of the sea, but not in the water, — AkteophHa. II. Aquatic, living in fresh water and usually coming occasionally to the surface for air, — Limnophila. III. Aquatic, living in salt or brackish water along the seashore in the littoral zone, — Petrophila. The Strep toneura are divided into two orders: I. The Aspidobranchia, in which the nerve centers are not closely concentrated, and the original bilateral symmetry has not wholly disappeared, there being two auricles to the heart and two kidneys. II. The Pectinibranchia, in which all trace of bilateral symmetry in the circulatory, respiratory, and execretory systems has disap- peared and the nervous system is more concentrated. The fresh-water aspidobranchs all belong to the suborder Rhipido- glossa, in which the radula has very numerous marginal teeth arranged like the sticks of a fan. The Pectinibranchia are divided into two suborders, of which only one, the Taenioglossa, in which the radula has but one lateral and two marginal teeth on each side of the central tooth, is repre- sented in our fluviatile fauna. The fresh-water Taenioglossae are all included in the superf amily Platypoda, in which the foot is flat- tened ventrally for creeping purposes. The several superfamilies of the Euthyneura and Streptoneura are subdivided into families, of which thirteen are represented in the North American fauna. The class Lamellibranchia, so called from the form of the gills, comprises all the fresh-water bivalve shells commonly called clams or mussels. The name Pelecypoda is frequently applied to this class from the hatchet-like shape of the foot. The lamelli- branchs are aquatic mollusks, without a distinct head and with the mantle divided into two lobes, which secrete a bivalve shell united by a ligament, which covers the entire animal. The lobes of the mantle are united by one or two transverse muscles, which are attached to the inner surface of the valves and by their con- «. THE MOLLUSCA 973 traction close the shell. They are destitute of jaws or radula, and the cephalic region is furnished only with a pair of labial palps on each side. They feed by ciliary action and breathe by gills sus» pended on each side of the body. The digestive system consists of a stomach, a liver, and a more or less convoluted intestinal canal with its oral and anal extremities at the opposite ends of the body. The edges of the mantle lobes in the fresh-water forms are usually united between exhalent and inhalent orifices, and in some families the posterior margins are extended in one or two siphons. The foot is ventral, usually compressed, hatchet-shaped, and adapted for burrowing. The nervous system consists of three principal groups of ganglia (cerebral, pedal, and visceral), united by nerves. They are monoecious or dioecious. The following diagram represents the classification of the fresh- water Gastropoda as thus briefly outlined. Class GASTROPODA Subclass Order I Streptoneura i i Pectinibranchia Aspidobranchia Suborder Taenioglossa Rhipidoglossa lDiac Superfamily Platypoda Euthyneura Pulmonata Basommatophora Limnophila Petrophila Akteophila J 1 Viviparidae Ncritidac Lymnaeidae Siphonariidae Auriculidae Ampullariidac Planorbidae Gadiniidae Valvatidae Ancylidae Assimeniidae Physidae Amnicolidae Pleuroceratidae The Radula As the radula of the gastropod mollusca is very important as a basis for classification, the following series of typical forms is given, which should be used in connection with the key. 974 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY AURICULIDAE Fig. L Carycktum exipmm Say. SlPHONARIIDAE Fto.IL Siphonaria alternate Say. Gadiniidae fte. m. Gadinia reticulata Say. Lymnaeidae #7 {jUltoW OOWOiJLi^ Fto. IV. LyaiMas stagnalis L. Planorbedae l Fn. V. Planafbis trttttait Say* 14 U THE MOLLUSCA 075 Physidae Fta. VI. Pkys* kmmert* Gld. Ancyudas Fig. VTL Gum&ackia meckiana Stfanp. Ampullarhdae Flo. VHL Ampullar* paludosa Say. VlVIPARIDAE Fio. DC. V imparts ittrUxtms Sip. Valvatidae Ite. X. Vshf triaHm* Stf . 976 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY ASSIMENHDAE Fto. XL Assimenia grayana Leach. Amnicolidae Fto. XII. Amnicola porata Say. Pleuroceratidae FlO. XUI. AnadosadissimUis Say. Nerttidae Flo. XIV. Neritkta reclnoio Say. The classification of the Lamellibranchia is based primarily on the structure of the gill. Each gill consists of "a hollow vascular axis bearing on each face a row of more or less flattened filaments which are nothing more than simple expansions of the axis." The Lamellibranchia are divided into four orders, according as these filaments are flat and non-reflected (Protobranchia) or parallel, ventrally directed and reflected (Filibranchia), or are united at THE MOLLUSCA 977 regular intervals by vascular junctions (Eulamellibranchia), or are entirely absent (Septibranchia). All of the North American fresh-water lamellibranchs belong to the order Eulamellibranchia. This order is divided into nine sub- orders, of which only one is represented in our fauna. The suborder Submytilacea consists of "Eulamellibranchia, in which the mantle is only slightly closed, generally there is only a single suture. Siphons absent or very short. Gills smooth. Nearly always dimy- arian (with two adductor muscles). Shell equi valve with an exter- nal ligament." The Submytilacea are divided into a large number of families of which seven are represented in the North American fauna: Margaritinidae Sphaeriidae Unionidae Cyrenidae Dreissensiidae Cyrenellidae Rangiidae. KEY TO NORTH AMERICAN FRESH- AND BRACKISH-WATER MOLLUSCA. 1 (103) Animal with a distinct head, bearing, usually, contractile tentacles. Shell univalve Class Gastropoda . . 2 2 (63, 100) Animal inoperculate, pulmoniferous. . Order Pulmonata . . 3 3 (17, 22) Animal terrestrial or semiamphibious. Shell spiral, columella plicate at the base; outer lip usually dentate or Urate. Family Auriculidae . . 4 4 (9) Foot entire, not divided transversely. . Subfamily Aumcuunae . . 5 5 (6, 7) Shell minute, pupaeform, outer lip thickened, reflected, or expanded. Carychium Midler. A group of small species of general distribution from the Atlantic to the Pacific. The only genus in the family found at a distance from the seashore. Found in damp places under dead leaves, pieces of bark, etc. They are usually included among the terrestrial species and are included here rather on account of their systematic position than as belonging strictly to the fresh-water fauna. Example, C. exiguum Say, (Fig. 1405; X 10), from the Eastern States. Fto. 1405.1 1 Unless otherwise indicated, the figures are of natural size. In other cases, the amount of enlargement or reduction is indicated. To obtain the actual size of any species, divide the length of the figure in millimeters by the index. FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Shell oval; lip thickened but not reflected; smooth within; no callous deposit Auricula Lamarck. The typical Auriculae are not represented in our fauna. A single species, A. peUucens Mke. (Fig. 1406), belonging to the subgenus Auriculastrum Fischer, is found along the southern Florida coast and keys. Flo. 1406. 7 (5» 6) Shell oval; lip thickened, with a single strong ridge revolving longi- tudinally into the aperture Tralia Gray . . 8 A single species, T. pusitta Gmel., (Fig. 1407; X 1 ft), found along the Florida coast and "easily recognized by its pure brown color, three plaits and the single ridge on the inside of the impressed outer lip " (DaU.). Fig. 1407. 8 Shell oblong-ovate; lip thickened by a ridge of callus, simple or denticulate, within the edge; no lirae or longitudinal ridges. Subgenus Phytia Gray. This group has been usually known as Alexia Gray, but that name is preoccupied and inadmissible. A single species, T. mysotis Dr., (Fig. 1408; X af), locally intro- duced from Europe on both the Atlantic and Pacific coasts. The west coast form is usually known as Alexia setifer Cooper. Flo. 1408. 9 (4) Foot divided transversely by a sulcus. Subfamily Melampinae . 10 10 (11, 16) Shell globose-conic; lip sharp, with a dentate or nodulous callus within Pedipes Adanson. Several species are found on the southern Floridan and Californian coasts and are easily distinguished by their globular form and unusually large parietal tooth. Example, P. unisukatus Cpr., (Fig. 1409; X 2I) from California. Flo. 1409. xi (10, 16) Shell ovate-conic, oblong, or subfusiform; outer lip sharp, usually Urate within Melampus Montfort . . 12 Four subgenera: 12, 13, 14, 15. 12 (13) Shell ovate-conoid; spire short; body-whorl very large, broadest above and tapering to the base; lip Urate within. Subgenus Melampus s.s. The species of this group are abundantly found in the salt marshes and brackish water of both the eastern and western coasts. The shape of the shell and the apertural armature are eminently characteristic. Example, M.limatu$ Say, (Fig. 14 10; X i|), from the Atlantic coast. Fta. 1410. THE MOLLUSCA 979 13 (14) Shell ovate-oblong; spire produced, pointed; outer lip thickened. sometimes with one denticle on the callus. Subgenus Ovaidla Bivona. A single European species, Melampus bidentata Mont., (Fig. 141 1 ; X 2 J), intro- duced on the coast of New England. "The shell, except for its smoother epidermis and obsolete parietal denticle, is almost exactly like the lighter-colored forms of Tralia mysotis, a fact which has led to much confusion " (Dall.). In living examples, this species is easily distinguished by the transversely divided foot. Flo. 141 1. 14 (15) Shell elongated, solid, rounded to a point at both ends; outer lip Urate within Subgenus Detracia Gray. A single species, Melampus buliaides Mont., (Fig. 14*2; X 2V), is found along the Florida coast and keys. Fig. 1412. 15 (12) Shell small, thin, subfusiform; spire elevated; columella twisted to form one strong, spiral ridge entering the volutions; outer lip thin, sharp, without internal lirae, thickening or denticu- lations Subgenus Sayella Dall. Only two minute species are known, both of which occur on the Florida coast. Example, Melampus hemphUli Dall. (Fig. 1413; X 5.) Fig. 1413* 16 (10, 11) Shell small, sinistral, elongate; lip slightly thickened, smooth within Blauneria Shuttleworth. A single species, B. httcrodita Mont., (Fig. 1414; X3i)# occurs on the Florida coast. It is easily distinguished by its sinistral shape. Fig. 1414. 1 7 (3 1 22) Animals marine or semi-amphibious, living on rocks where they are immersed at high tide. Head without tentacles. ... 18 18 (21) Shell patelliform, with a subcentral apex. Animal with a jaw and both lung and gill Family Sifhonashdae. Only one genus Siphonaria Sowerby . . 19 19 (20) Shell solid, porcellanous; surface with more or less elevated ribs ex- tending to the margin Subgenus Siphonaria bjb. W&" ' y/.v Two species only, found on the east coast of Florida. F.umplf, 5. tftor- nata Say, (Fig. 1415). FIB. 1415- FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY o (19) Shell thin, horny, smooth, or with fine radiating lines, which do not interrupt the margin Subgenus Liriota Dull. m the west coast. Eimnplc, Siplumaria i (tS) Shell patelliform, obliquely conical. Animal with a lung only; no gill; no jaw Family Gamnhdae. Only one genus Cadinia Gray. *'1 (3, ''/) Animal aquatic, inhabiting fresh water 23 Four families: 33, 31, 50, 53. 33 (32) Shell spiral, dextral; spire more or less elongated; tentacles flattened, triangular Family Lymnaeidae. Only one genus Lynmaea Lamarck . . 94 Eight subgenera: n, 15, 16, 57, 38, 19, 30, 31. / 34 (35) Shell large, thin; spire slender and acute; body-whorl large, inflated; columella strongly twisted; axis pervious. Subgenus Lymnaea s.s. opprtua Say, (Fig. 1418; X f). d American form ia known u L. ttapwlii 35 (26) Shell large, solid, bulimiform; spire short; body-whorl large, inflated; a ii< impervious. .... Subgenus Bulimnaea Haldeman. THE MOLLUSCA & 26 (27) Shell thin; spire short, acute; body-whorl large, inflated; lip expanded. Subgenus Radix Montfort. The typical species, Lymnaea auricularia L. (Fig. 1420), is European, but has been locally introduced in several of the Eastern States. Fig. 1420. 27 (28) Shell thin; spire short; body- whorl large, elongated, not inflated; sur- face sculptured with spiral incised lines. Subgenus Pseudosuccinea Baker. The typical species, Lymnaea columella Say, (Fig. 1421), has a general distribu- tion throughout the eastern United States and Canada. Fig. 1421. 28 (29) Shell very long and slender; spire elongated, acute; body-whorl long and narrow; columella smooth. Subgenus Acelia Haldeman. A single species, Lymnaea haldemani "Desh." W. G. Binn., (Fig. 1422). occurs in the St. Lawrence drainage system and the upper part of the Mississippi River. Fig. 1422. 29 (30) Shell varying from elongate to short ovate; outer lip (usually) what thickened within; columella somewhat twisted and plicate; surface with strong, spirally impressed lines. Subgenus Stagnkda Leach. The typical species, Lymnaea palustris Mull., (Fig. 1423), is a drcum- boreal and is usually the most common species in the Northern States and Canada. Ftss. 14J3. 30 (31) Shell as in Stagnkolo, but with the surface longitudinally cottate. Subgenus Pdyrhytis Meek. The only recent species known, Lymnaea uiakenris CaiL, (Fig. 1434)* is (torn Utah. FS9.1444. 982 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 31 (24) Shell small, turreted; spire somewhat elevated; spiral sculpture * wanting or subobsolete; columella not twisted; inner lip jSJJL usually reflected over the umbilicus. /f\\\j) Subgenus Galba Schrank. 2 (50) Shell discoidal, sinistral, or dextral, or spiral with a very low spire Animal sinistral; tentacles cylindrical. Family Planorbidae . The dextral species of this family present the apparent anomaly of a sinistral animal with a tleitrally-coiled shell. Such shells are not true deitral shells, but represent the condition of hypertrophy, so called, in which the spiral growth of the shell, instead of being from the apex downward, as is usually the case, is, as it were, from the apex upward, the result being at. ently dextral shell with a sinistral animal. Such shells ace also called ultndextral. In the formation of the key to the subdivisions of the family, the shells are treated with reference to their apparent mode of spiral growth. 33 (47) Shell discoidal Subfamily Pianorbinae . . 34 34(46) Aperture edentate Planor bis Mtllkr . . 35 Sit subgenera: 35, 36, 30, 40, 41, 41. 3&(36) Shell sinistral, large; whorls rounded above and below, gradually in- ' creasing; aperture but slightly expanded; lip simple and sharp Subgenus PlanorbU s.s. ®5 F10. (416. 36 (39) Shell dextral or sinistral, few whorled; the whorls carinate above and rapidly enlarging; base funicular; aperture suddenly ex- ,.. pauded and lip thickened. Subgenus Belisoma Swainson . . 37 --37 (38) Shell dextra], carinated above and below; spire and base funicular. Section Bettsomo s-s. ^a»»«^"*-~ The ty /Tir*Tmii Padfie 00 THE MOLLUSCA 983 38 (37) Shell sinistral; early whorls flattened and carinate above; base funic- ular Section Pierosoma DalL This group includes nearly all the larger North American Planorbes and is represented by numerous apecies found in all parts of the country . Type, Planorbis trimhis Say, (Fig. 1428). Fie. 14*8. 39 (40) Shell sinistral; aperture campanula te; lip thickened. Subgenus Planorbtlla Haldeman. The typical form, Planorbis campanulatus Say, (Fig. 1429; X ii), is of common occurrence and wide distribution in eastern Canada and the United States north of Tennessee. Fig. 1429. 40 (41) Shell dextral, much depressed; upper surface convex, base flattened; body-whorl carinate; lip simple. Subgenus Tropidiscus Stein. A single species. Planorbis cullratus Orb.. (Fig. 1430; X 2), of this (in America) tropical group has been collected in Texas and Florida. /r Fig. 1430. 41 (42) Shell small, dextral; periphery carina ted; base convex; aperture oblique; lip simple Subgenus Hippuetis Agasaiz. A group of small species of general distribution through the Northern States and Canada. All of our species belong to the section Memeku H. & A. Adams, of which the type is Planorbis operations Gld., (Fig. 1431; X 3), from California. Fig. 1 43 i. 42 (35) Shell small, depressed; body- whorl rounded or obtusely angulated; lip simple Subgenus Gyraulus Agassiz . . 43 43 (44, 45) Surface spirally striate and hispid. Section Gyraulus s.s. A few, small species, not uncommon in the eastern Northern States and Canada. The group is not represented on the Pacific coast. Ex- ample, Planorbis ktrsuius Gld., (Fig. 1432; X 3)- Fao. 1433. 984 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 44 (43, 45) Surface smooth or finely striate Section Torquis DalL This group of small species is ot general distribution from the At- lantic to the Pacific. Type, Planorbis partus Say, (Fig. 1433; X 4|). rio. 1433. 45 (43 1 44) Shell minute; surface costate. . . Section Armiger Hartmann. The typical species only, Planorbis crista L., (Fig. 1434; X 7), repre- sents this group in our fauna and has been recorded from Maine to Illi- nois and northward. F10. 1434. 46 (34) Aperture with one or more sets of laminae or teeth behind the margin. Segmentina Fleming. The typical Segment inae are not represented in our fauna. All of the American species belong to the subgenus Planorbula Haldeman. The type S. armigera Say, (Fig. 1435; X 2) is common in the northern Eastern States and Canada. Flo* 1435. 47 (33) Shell spiral, dextral, flattened above and convex below; body-whorl very large Subfamily Pompholiginae . . 48 48 (49) Shell imperforate Pompholyx Lea. •-ntt vs^v -j^q or three species only are known from California. Type, P. tfusa i) Lea.. (Fig. 1436; X 2§). Fia 1436. 40 (48) Shell deeply umbilicate Carinifex W. G. Binney. 1 • -'* x The typical species, C. mwUrryi Lea., (Fig. 1437)* » from Cali- fornia. F».I437. 5^ iS& Shell spiral, sinistraL Animal sinistral; tentacles slender, cylindrical. Family Physidab . . 51 THE MOLLUSCA 485 51 (52) Shell with body-whorl usually inflated. Inner edge of mantle digitate or lobed, extending partly over the shell. Pkysa J>raparnau the Factuc. Fjc. 1439- 53 (23) Shell patelliform or depressed, dextrally spiral, nehtiform or planorbi- form. Animal sinistral or dextral; tentacles short, blunt, cylindrical Family Ancyudae . . 54 Five genera: 54. sg. 60. 61. 62. 54 (59) Shell patelliform, small, thin; apex posterior, slightly inclined to one side Ancylus .M tiller . . 55 55 (58) Apex inclined to the right Subgenus Ancylus ss . . 56 56 (57) Apex subacute, radially striate Section Ferrissia Walker. Numerous species and of general distribution, usually found adhering to stones, etc., in running water. Type, Ancylus ritmlaris Say, (Fig. 1440; X 3). Fie. 1440. 57 (56) Apex depressed, smooth Section Lacvapex Walker. The bpeties of this group are usual] y found in quiet water and are, as a rule, larger, thinner, and more depressed than the Ferrissias. Type, Ancylus itafkanui Hald , (Fig. 1441; X 2j). Fig. 1441. 58 (55) Apex inclined to the left Subgenus Acroloxus Beck. *@i Only one American species, Ancylus mtUallii Hald., (Fig. 1442; X a), (com Oregon, has been referred to this group, but its -f^tifrpy is un- known and its generic position is very doubtful. Fia.2443. 986 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 59 (6o) Shell large, thick and solid; apex smooth Lanx Clessin. This genus is restricted to the Pacific coast and is distinguished by the large size and thick solid shells. Type, L. naoberryiLea^ (Fig. 1443). Fig. 1443. 60 (61) Shell ancyliform, small, thin, with a septum across the apical portion of the interior Gundlochia Pfeiffer. This very remarkable and peculiar genus has a general but very local distribution from the Atlantic to the Pacific. Example, G. mukiana Stimp., (Fig. 1444; X 6), from the Eastern States. Fig. 1444. 61 (62) Shell small, spiral, dextral, neritoid, or crepidula-like, with a broad, thin, columellar plate projecting across the end of the aper- ture next to the spire Ampkigyra Pilsbry. Only a single species, A. alabamensis Pils., (Fig. 1445; X 10), from the ■W ///X/\ Coosa River, Alabama, is known. F10.1445. 62 (54) Shell very minute, dextral, spiral, subdiscoidal; columellar margin broadly dilated Neoplanorbis Pilsbry. l//i? &?/ \ Four species of this genus have been recently described from the Coosa J /* tZ^ ^s River, Alabama, and are among the smallest mollusks known in our fauna. Type, N. tamtiUus Pils., (Fig. 1446; X 10). k\> ■ ■ Fro. 1446. 63 (2, 100) Animal operculate, branchiferous (except Assimema). Radula with seven rows of teeth. Order Pectinibrmnchiata. . Suborder Taenioglossa . . 64 Six families: 64, 65, 66, 71, 72, 90. 64 (65) Shell small, spiral, dextral, conical; operculum spiral. Animal pul- moniferous Family Assimeniidae. Only a single genus Assimenia Leach. fiMl nilU The Assimenias live in brackish water in the upper part of the littoral lone. l\ i$M Two species occur on the Florida keys and two on the coast of California. Ex* ample, A . cakfantUa Tryon, (Fig. 1447; X 4)- 1447. "«:£■■ v« , THE MOIXUSCA 987 65 (66) Shell large, globose-turbinate; umbilicate; operculum comeus, con- centric Animal with the respiratory chamber divided into two parts, one being the lung and the other containing a gQL Family Ahpullabudax. Only a single genus. AmpuOaria L The AmpuDuui in the largest of our f resh- water snails. Two or three spedei occur in Georgia and Florida. p"mi^-. A. |«Uui Say, (Flf . <«8). 66 (71) Shell of moderate size, dextral, turbinate, imperforate, or subperfbnte; operculum comeus. Animal branchiferous. Family Viwabidae . . 67 Four genera: 67, 68, 60, jo 67 (68) Shell rather thin; operculum concentric, inner margin simple. Animal with foot of moderate size, not produced beyond the snout. Teeth of the radula multicuspid. . . Vimfanu MontforL Several ipedes are found in the Mississippi Valley and from Ohio and Indiana south to the Gull. They are usually to be distinguished from the Campelomae by the thinner and more globose shells and convex whorls. Ex- ample, V. inlerlcxtui Say, (Fig- 14*9; X r|). 988 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY -> 68 (69) Shell thick and solid ; operculum concentric, inner edge simple. Animal with the foot very large, much produced beyond the snout. Teeth of the radula simple or only minutely crenulate. CaMpdoma Rafincsque. This genua is peculiar to North America rod the seven] Sscits are usually very Abundant, when found. Though norm- y dextral, sinistral examples are not uncommoo. They lange from the Mississippi Valley east to the Atlantic and from the St. Lawrence Valley south to the Gulf. Example, C. svbstlida Anta, (Fig. 1450). , 6g (70) Shell turreted; operculum with a subspiral nucleus. Liopiqx Troschel. 70 (67) Shell (typically) large, solid, imperforate; spire elevated; operculum concentric, with the inner margin reflected, forming an ele- vated, marginal fold Tulotomo V ' ' This genus is peculiar to North America and is restricted to the Alabama River and its tributaries in Alabama. The two leading species are remarkable for their heavy, nodulous, or tuberculated shell. Type, T. macmfci Con.. {Fig. 14SJ). 1 (72) Shell small, spiral, dextral, turbinate, or subdiscoidal; aperture entire, circular; operculum round, multispiral. No basal denticles on the central tooth of the radula. . Family Valvatujae. Only one genus Vohola Mailer. THE MQUMSCA 989 72 (go) Shell small, spiral, dtrxt/aJ. Central loodb of ike radula with one or ray^e basal denticle*. . . Family Amswou&m . . 73 Five MiUauoailie*: 74, 74, £2, a* £9 73 (74) Operculum calcareous, cooccairu Subfamily Byihixinae. Only one genus Byihinia Cray. A single huroottto »occite. U uhluuLuj I. . '.Fi/. 1454: X i/. ha* LccD intro- duced by lofuiQcru: irocn the Hmiawfc RiVcr. ak»zj^ thr iixic of the Erie Canal, add tow the Gccat Laiu= ae Lu* *c*t a= Cfcka*^ Fjl. u>;. 74 (&?. Operculum corneu&, paucispirai. Shell thin: columelia liot thickened. Foot simple bubtamiiy AmmcoulnaJi . 75 Stf gvtMrra 75 77 ft ;<, ac. 61 . 75 '.76 Sbel! smooth, usually tubglobo*.-. Genual tooth of tha radula multi- cuspid, with a tojjgut-sijaped procc:** projectijug or. the aii te- nor surface ajad beyond tue Laac aid with several basal den ikies . . . AumUala Gould ajud HaidcmaL . 76 • ^ ti*«; ius*i>. ttv«s»i(«.i'. aj>x*v:> Apptwu: J}tuud^tJrin^ , bu*. a: u rait the sLell is more C giuu««.. »tv. ^ Uturur «pa< T/Ot ^.itNi/^^)' {Fjg. 1455: X 4*- Fio. 14$;. 76 Kadutu iuoi» iruuai' ai*d iu*. UeiiUcuiaUoi^ of toe cu*p< of the teeth lUicr auti biMif per bubgeivua CitiCinn^iUj Hkbry. 'li*», »ujj(44Vik^a it Uu'i wimJi.) en tu<- LUarutUir of tue LijgwiaL teeth. The *ueK cUMixOu ai< li**** "i" Amnioubi Tjj* AmmooU ^;1* MnJMkr ;«; Atoned:-, but more blender au- ii"-. ^i»_-- «*'*. iiuu*tiu>4. iu>cl i*ui#e frwo tiic Atlantic to the Fa- lio. 1457 7fr i'77.' ^iurll ca;;^iU':, u*iicU«;, Aougiiudiiutiay riboe'i or plicate. Tryunia Stimpson. li.v t>j>. ««.;. ^j*0 -ytuo, / .iUihtuUi i3UUii»., Um;. i45*; X2l/,i> found ll. avtltUui* C*tiiXvr^i^ diitl l»»iU|i iu Nt'V4*/l«i Fie. 1^5 =. 99° FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 79 (80) Shell elongated, strongly carinated on the periphery. Pyrgulopsis Call and Pilsbry. The typical species, P. nevadensis Stearns (Fig. 1459; X 3), is from Nevada. Others have been described from the Mississippi and Tennessee valleys. Fro. 1459. 80 (81) Shell ovate-conic; whorls shouldered and usually coronated with spines Potamopyrgus Stimpson. Two species from Florida and Texas, respectively, are represented in our fauna. Typically spinose, all the species are dimorphic, having both an angu- late, spinose form and a smooth, ecarinate one. Example, P. coronatus Pifr. (Fig. 1460; X3|). Fid. 1460. 81 (75) Shell subpyramidal, rather solid, smooth; body-whorl subangulated at the periphery. . . . Littoridina Eydoux and Souleyet. A South American genus. A single species from Florida, L. monroensis, Frfld. (Fig. 1461 ; X 7), has been doubtfully assigned to it. Fio. 1461. 82 (88) Shell with a large body- whorl and short spire; columella usually callously thickened; operculum corneus, subspiral. Foot simple. Central tooth of the radula with several basal denticles Subfamily Lythoglyphinae . . 83 Five genera: 83, 84* 85. 86, 87. 83 (84) Shell depressed-conic; base concave, widely and deeply umbilicated. Cochliopa Stimpson. A Central American genus, of which one spedes, C. riograndensis P. and F. (Fig. 1462; X 6), has been found in Texas and another (doubtfully) in California. Fio. 1462. 84 (85) Shell minute, globose- turbinate, narrowly but deeply umbilicated; columellar lip thin; operculum corneus, paucispiral; nuclear whorls large, slowly and regularly increasing. Clappia Walker. Only a single species, C. chppii Walker (Fig. 1463; X6i), from the Coosa River, Alabama, is known. It somewhat resembles Somaiogyrus in shape, but can be easily distinguished by its deep umbilicus and peculiar operculum. Fio. 1463. THE MOLLUSCA 991 85 (86 Shell obliquely ovaU, thick- solid, imperforate ; caiumdia flattened abfi talioufctd; lip siAuou^. erTu»e. and projecting anteriorly. Verge wiftged FluviinkataSiimpsQn. „\ u*ac*u*r*fcb'- ***♦ umt' &-u*- In 6iu;i! cutfiutcr?. ii i* Quite *imi- \ »r w 5vMdti.>+/rm t uw' oiu*-j iotlluiuy iu auiLuuuiAi <2etaiL> iflc is widely *cj*U4i&: ti. lAhgi. T>j*-, /•'. tittUtUidUii Lea. (Kg. 14^4; X i). F10. 14;. tt6(>7- Sbdi u&uaJiy Laic*: wk1 i»olio. imperforate or Loirowly perforate; Duuv-Aiirf *'J'. uu'f u*ablcs tfcr spedes 67 1*6 boSi. no' very thio:. iutpurlumu . Uxiy-wiiurl Ur#:. Miir<' short, periuecn^ umliJiw/us <:i Ui<. oojju', pLim. , columella. ;>uircel> ifift^tue^: \ «-fgt M/i4pu' C'fft7>i { oiiwgwu: L)o&ru* GUI. « v ^j^:^*^ "V*x*hLU?*: ^i^*--. '■- /Srt^«*-»- ai**u«.~ x*aU*ut'j :t/ tin* AlwiilJ'. u»a>t slates EmsHj ula^fcoiaUodLrj JU. u^cTlJL.:: T^^:, L. puj>triuiu* Cl'J. vFig- 14^71 Xt>. £10.140- i»9 W a;j*; . t*c»*.u. r u»jliv.j;- . ^pu-vUm!1* >Uwi*p*p: J v«'f- divided by a fc Gi..#. v;»c ^;*^ lJoMiUiop$i$ Try on. / ' j** ' • '' ,i: - ■•; -''. .v:i\.rli ;-.. .: iuU.*.' w:.r:.*»:i)phi?ji^Ub in habit, •'*'<.' - '•■■'. - ' •■■• *-■ ■i' i. .. «'. '.-i '!._ ..^... • I":,i •jjvi'JijQ foot i« ven* pc- f 'v ' ■'/>* .': ■ " » : '.:' .•"■ ** -" '■» -: - ;. ^"^^^ L/ ii series w steps. j . go v,-: i:uc. -.a. all p rp. 1. . *:u' r.f aj*^fc, ^io^-,f or tuui.jju.u-d; operculum v^:- . .c - -. , 6 u ->pp .j ■ ■ ' /x:i JTitl rt i lI*u u 1 ui* Lilt rnai verge . Cen- isvet^caa*. v:, ^-. •>;, >/. y;, y:. y, 09* FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 91 (92) Shell large, fusiform; base of aperture prolonged in a long canal. Example, /. spinosa Lea (Fig. 1469). 9a (94) Shell globose-conic; columella callously thickened above and below; aperture shortly channeled below. Lithasia Haledman . . 93 The Lithasiac form a very distinct group characterized by the colu- mella thickened by deposits of callus above and below and the abort canal at its base. With the exception of three species, which eilend as far north as the Wabash River, Indiana, the group is restricted to Ken- tucky, Tennessee, and Alabama. Type, /.. tenicvlata Con. (Fig. 147c). Lithasia, but with the basal canal more produced. Section AngUrema Haledman. s Lithasia with la. Type, Utkotio armitcra Say '94 (95) Shell obovate, thick, solid; spire short; body-whorl large; columella callously thickened above, incurved below and subtruncate. F.urycodon Lea, — when restricted V the riven of the Ten Budd (Fig. i47»>. THE MOLLUSCA 993 95 (97) Shell elongated, conic, or cerithilonn; aperture subrhomboicUI, pro- longed into a ihort canal below; columella twisted, not callously thickened. . . . PUuroctra Raonesque . . 96 Numerous s 5 have ib species ha _ _ _ . ....__ of Kentucky. Tennessee, and Alabama. lew specks eiiend north 10 the Great Lilies and west lu the Mississippi Valley. The specie: van greatly in cuntuur, rangin*; frutrt long, slender, and ralbei thin lip large, heavy, and broadly conic. Lmnplti P. cajiaJicn- (aliun Say (i'ig. n7 jj. Shell smooth; spire obtusely conical; body-whorl subcyUndrica) ; aper- ture subquadrate; columella thickened below, twisted and drawn back, base subcaualiculalc; lip very sinuous. Section Stttplwbasis Lea. .97 (98) Shell ovate-conic to elongate; smooth, plicate, striate, or lubcrculate; aperture subrhomboitbtl, huUuij^kr at the base, but not canaliculate; columella simple, smooth. . . Gvnuihasis Lea. This genus comprises about Ibree-lilUis u( all the Species ol the family and is enormously developtd in the riun of Tennessee and Alabama. A few species esicnd uoiih tu the St. Lawrence Valley and west to Texas and the western tributaries ru the Athu This remarkable genus is confined to tbr Coosa River, Alabama, where it is represented by a considerable number of described species. The sutural slit is characteristic and is either direct, narrow, and deep, 01 ob- lique, short, and wide. Example, G. duniisum Lea (Fit; 1*76). 994 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 99(9i) FtekX477* Shell thick, solid, subglobose, with a very short spire, or thinner and conical; aperture oval or subcircular, entire below; columella callously thickened Anculosa Say. This group differs from all of the genera of the family by the entire aperture. The heavy, subglobose species range from the Ohio River south into Alabama and Georgia but are not found in the northern Atlantic States nor in the Mississippi Valley. The thin, conical species are characteristic of the Atlantic drainage from New York southward. Type, A. praerosa Say (Fig. 1477). ICO (2, 63) Radula with numerous rows of teeth, consisting of a central tooth, 2-5 laterals, and numerous marginals arranged like the sticks of a fan. Order Aspidobranchia . . Suborder Rhipidoglossa. Represented by a single family. . . Neritidae . . 101 101 (102) ftD.1478. Shell globose, imperforate, very thick and solid; aperture semi- ovate, columellar region expanded, flattened, and thick- ened; operculum calcareous, edge with projecting processes (apophyses), articulating with the columella. Neritina Lamarck. A few species of this characteristic tropical genus are found in the fresh and brackish waters of Florida and the Gulf coast. Example, N. reclivata Say (Fig. 1478). 102 (101) Shell small, thin, corneus; columella concavely flattened, calloused; operculum corneus, paucispiral, without apophyses. Lepyrium Dall. Fio. 1479. This genus was created for a single small species, known only from the Coosa and Cahawba rivers in Alabama and is peculiar in the character of the operculum. Type, L. showalteri Lea (Fig. 1479; X 3i). 103 (i) Animal acephalous. Shell consisting of two opposing, symmetrical valves united by a ligament. Class Lamellibranchia . . 104 Represented by a single order, EulamelUbranchia 104 Seven families: 105, 106, 166, 167, i73» I74J in two groups: 104, 165. 104 (165) Two Shell equivalve; interior nacreous; ligament external; hinge with or without teeth, but never with true cardinal teeth; when present, the modified anterior lateral teeth are known as pseudocardinals and the posterior teeth as laterals. . . 105 : 105, xo6. ■.jStf^-w. pseudocardinals ; laterals, when present, very obscure. without water tubes and with scattered interlameilar con- nections, which in certain plates form irregular diagonal rows. Family Makgajltiamdae. Only one genus Uareoritatta Schumacher. :>;xij, U diaunbonal, but ir louad oily in the northern Atlantic did Pacific states, bong unknuwn. with one pontile eicep- tiou, Iruoi tile whole interior portion of tbe continent. Another apetiei L, iuund in tbe Ten —B ud Ohia draiMgf lyatecas. and two mure have been ueaciibed iiota the Cull drainage. Shell subrircular, oval, subt.ri angular, or elongated; hinge edentulous or with pseudocardinals only or with both pseudocardinals and lateral*. Uills with water lubes and distinct., contin- uous interiamelkr aepta, running parallel to the filaments. Family UMKINDMIC . . 107 107 (in, 140) Maxsupium formed by all (our gills or by the outer gills only; edge of manupium always aharp and not distending; water tubes simple in the gravid female. Subfamily Umioninae . . 108 Five Bcaera: 406, hj, 114, 115, 117 108 (113) All four gills serving as nureupia. Shell alike in both aeses, tri- angular, quadrate or rhomboida], solid, inflated, beaks usually prominent, sculptured with a few coarse, aubpanlle! ridges, which are inflated where they cross the posterior ridge; posterior ridge ordinarily well developed; hinge com- plete, with strong teeth; hinge plate wide; beak cavities deep and aunprcasexl Quainda Ratinescjue . . 109 Four sectiocn: iog. 110, 111, 11 j 996 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 109(110) Surface plicate Section Crenodonta Schluter. culpture of the valves the Southern States fro no (m) Surface pusUdose, with a radial furrow above the posterior ridge, usually painted with triangular spots or chevron-shaped lines Section Quadrula s.s. The typioU spedes. Q. cylindrica Say (Fig. 14S1; X I), ranges through the 1 Cumberland, and Tennessee river systems and west to Arkansas. A few other. Its sped rs are found u ~ THE MOLLUSCA 997 in (112) Surface pustulose; no radial furrow above the posterior ridge; unicolored or rayed, never painted as in Quadrula s.s. Section Thctiderma Swainson. This section comprises three well-marked groups: first, that of the typical species. Quadrula lochrymasa Lea (Fig. 1483), having a quadrate or rhomboid shell with a wide, shallow radial furrow in (rant of the posterior ridge; second, that of Q. pwlulosa Lea, with a rounded, quad- rate shell withno radial furrow; third, two small species from Georgia and Florida, rounded. rhomboid in shape, without the furrow and with the surface covered with a Most of the species are found only in the Southern States, but the Bret two [ '' a ranging north to Michigan and Minnesota. 113(109) Surface smooth Section Fusconaia Simpson. While the majority of the species of this section are found in the Southern States, it is well represented as far north as Michigan and the upper Mississippi. Type, Quadrula nu- dum Bar. (Fig. 1484). 99$ FRESB-W ATE* BIOLOGY iii Iiiai A3 foar pUs Krviag » ■nawpfa Ski biff, dd, emon unocUcd pcswnoriy bt the not doagMBd, nAii posterior i idee. sese» rtimmilir in *fcape. ike poairior i betag rounded and MfaanapnaKd in ike ftnnle; hiaae ptete, *arf*ce pMMtot, except aa the a tfdnl p tbtb THE MOLLOSCA 999 :is) Outer gills only serving as niarsupia. Shell rounded; beaks sculp- (ured with numerous fine irregular corrugations; hinge com- plete; nacre violet Rotundaria Rafinesque. 115 (117) Outer gills only serving as marsupia. Shell alike in both sexes; triangular to rhomboid, usually with a prominent umbonal region; beaks at or near the anterior end; beak cavities shal- low; hinge complete; surface smooth, brown to yellow, usually not very dark, frequently rayed. Pleurobema Rafinesque . . 116 This is a Urge group, of which more than seventy species are known. With the exception of ■ few species found in the Ohio and Mississippi drainage, it is confined to the streams of the Southeastern States from Tennessee and Georgia to the Mississippi. The shells of this genua are easily distinguished from the Quadrulae, which they olten resemble by the uniformly shallow beak cavities. Type, P. data Lam. (Fig. 1487). FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Shell large, irregularly oval, inflated; large, scattered tubercles. . . & urface with a number of :lion Pletkobasus Simpson. Fie. 1 4 88. 117 (108) Outer gills only serving as marsupia. Shell alike in both sexes; ovate to elongate, rounded in front, pointed or biangulate behind; beaks nearer to the middle than to the anterior end; hinge complete; surface usually smooth, dark brown to black, often indistinctly rayed Unto Re tzius . . 118 itS (119, 120) Shell elongated, rhomboid or oval, more or less biangulated behind; surface smooth or feebly corrugated; beak sculpture consisting of a few rather strong ridges, which are nearly parallel to the growth lines or slightly double-looped. Section FMiptio Rafinesque. in of this genus is restricts! to the Old World. The section Fllip tin is the onidae represented in our fauna. More than ninety species aie recognized. "' ; Southeastern States, but representatives ate found in all The typical secti largest group of Ur The metropolis of — „ _.. of the Eastern, Southern, and Central States. Type, Unio crastidau Lam. (Fig. 1489; XI). THE MOLLCSCA Tic tvjici] am! only girriw, Ri vh. Georgia, ud is one of the mot rpsnirtibie L'nx* known. In ibr atJutfiDU}' devdop- Thr ryr»r»J species, t~u> Jiemlm— Siv .Fi£. i«ai : X i I. hu a wide met A f r* other sjeoes bit found in Gflapi udFlucid*. i2i (107. 140) Xlarsupium formed by the entire outer gills, d versely, when charged; water tubes in the gravid female divided longitudinally into three tubes, of which only the center one if used as an ovisac. Hinge rarely complete, the laterals or both the pseudocardinals and laterals being often entirely wanting; sexual differences in the shell very rarely present Subfamily Anodovttxae . . laa Eleren genera: in, 113, 124, 115, ud, 137. siS. iso. ijo. >M- ISB- I2i {123) Hinge with lateral teeth wanting and only rudimentary pseudo- cardinals; beak sculpture consisting of a few strong, coo- centric ridges. Ovisac of each water tube subdivided into a number of compartments running crosswise to the gill. Strcpktiis Rafinesque. era Sulci. IV species figured. 5. einOdms S»v iFlg. 14a;; xl), nu a cidr tmtrr from Nr* Eafbad IB North Carolina nod wot 10 Mnme- 1002 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 123 (124) Shell thin; hinge edentulous; beak sculpture consisting of several more or less doubly -looped parallel ridges, often slightly nod- ulous on the loops AnodonUi Lamarck. This genus is the only one of the North American Naiades that has a general distribution from the Atlantic to the Pacific. Numerous species arc recognized. They are easily distin- guished by the edentulous hinge and double loop of the beak sculpture. Example, A . graadii Say (Fig. 1403: Xi). 124(115) Shell smooth, elongated, rather thin, inequilateral, compressed; epidermis shining, often rayed; a single, imperfect pseudo- cardinal in each valve and sometimes vestiges of laterals. — ^— --. Lastena Rafinesque. Only a single species is known. L. lata Raf. (Fig. 1 41*; XI). and is found in the Ohio, Cumberland, and Ten- nessee river systems- US (126) Shell smooth, elongated, sub triangular, with usually a high, sharp posterior ridge; binge with a rudimentary pseudocardinal and lateral in each valve Gonidta Conrad. .. isually found, is . able for the sharp posterior ridge and more or less flattened posterior region. It is a characteristic west coast species and ranges from central California north to British Columbia, THE MOLLUSCA (27) Shell smooth, elliptical; hinge edentulous; beak sculpture consisting of a few fine, concentric ridges. . . Anodonloides Simpson. general distribution in the St. Lawrence, Ohio, and Mis- sissippi drainage areas. The concentric undulations of the 127 (118) Shell small, solid, thick in front, with two radial ridges extending from the beaks to the biangulated posterior end. Pseudo- cardinals solid; laterals wanting Pegias Simpson. 128 (119) Shell large, inflated, subrhomboidal, with two radiating rows of knobs; beak sculpture coarse, continuous with that of the surface which consists of oblique folds and wrinkles; pseudo- cardinals large; laterals short and blurred. Arcidens Simpson. 1004 FRESH WATER BKXjOGY 199 (130J Shell large, solid, inflated. ■obrotimd; beak sculpture weak, not continuous with the surface sculpture, which consists of oblique folds, hinge strong and complete. Artansia Ortmann and Walker. 13° (134) Shell elliptic- rhomboid, compressed; pseudocai dinals well developed; laterals more or less imperfect or subobsolete. Symphynola Lea . . 131 131 (13), 133) Shell smooth, shining, rayed; teeth delicate; laterals moderately developed. Subgenus Symphynola s.s. Th*type,S.£om/™iaLea(Pig. 1500; X t),ii one of the common species of the Northern States, iuf (ram New Yurk weu 10 Nebraaka and south to Arkansas. Several other jpeciei are d In the Atlantic drainage from New York to South Carolina and in eastern Tenoeaaee and rinafni from New York found In the Attain'- '- northern Alabama. THE MOIXUSCA 133 (tji, 133) Shell siibrtiomboid, compressed, posterior slope corrupted; lateral teeth subobsolete. Subgenus Lasmigoma Rafmesqae. Tbf type and only species, Sympkyuiita cottatt Raf. (Fig. 1 501 133 (131. I31) Shell large, ovate-rhomboid, subcompressed, smooth; very heavy; lateral teeth imperfectly developed. Subgenus Pterosygtm C 134 (139) Shell rhomboida). inflated, with a well-developed posterior ridge; pseudocardiiials well developed; laterals subobsolete at wanting Alasmidonta Say . . tJ5 : lii, 136, 131. «l ioo6 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY l3S (*30) Shell ovate-rhomboid, solid, inflated; beak sculpture very coarse and heavy; pseudocardi rials large, solid; laterals very im- perfect or wanting Subgenus Alasmidonta s.s. The type and only species, A. tmdulala Say (Fig. 15a): X II. is a characteristic shell of the Atlantic states south to North Caro- lina, but is not found wot of central New York. 136 (137) Shell small, decidedly rhomboid; beak sculpture slightly corrugated; ied Subgenus Prcssodon Simpson. The typical species, Alasmidimla caluola Lea (Fig. 1504), has a wide distribution through the Northern States from the Mississippi eastward. Several other species occur in the Atlantic and Southeastern States. One species, A. iM*a Con., is remarkable for having one or more small spines near the center of each valve. 137 (138) Shell elongated, rhomboid, inflated, posterior slope slightly corru- gated; pseudocardinals imperfect; laterals wanting. Subgenus Rugifera Simpson. The type, Alaimidotita morgimila Say (Fig. 150s), ranges from New York and South Caro- lina west to the Mississippi Valley. Another species is found only in " ' " '" berland river systems. THE MOLLUSCA IO07 r38 (J3S) Shell thin, triangular, greatly inflated, with a high, sharp posterior ridge; pseudocardinals compressed, reflexed; laterals want- ing. Subgenus Bulle.Ua Simpson. in South Carolina and Georgia. 139 (122) Shell small, thin, elongate-elliptical; beak sculpture consisting of fine parallel ridges, looped up in the middle; a high, irregular, compressed pseudocardinal in each valve; laterals nearly or quite lacking Hcmilastena A The type and only species, //. ombigua Say {Fig. 1507), occurs in the Ohio river system, ranging north (o Michigan, west to Iowa, south to Arkansas, and cast to Tennessee. 140 (107, i3i) Marsupium formed from the outer gill alone and usually from the posterior portion only; edge of marsupium, when charged, distending and bulging out beyond the original edge of the gill; water tubes simple in the gravid female. Hinge com- plete; male and female shells usually quite different. Subfamily Lajipsiunae . . 141 Twelve genera: 141, 146. >5<. '5>. '5.1. '5*. 150, 160, 161, 161, 163, 164. ioo8 FXESH-WATEK BIOLOGY 141 {146 j Male and female sheik different; female shell with a decided mfia- tioe ill the poet-basal region, which is tlrinwr than lie reat of tilt shell, of difiereul texture, often toothed, and osuaBy xadiatdv sculptured ; hinge complete; m&rsupium occupying tb* ooBterior part of the gill only. 1 <« 7 natriUa Ranneaune . 142 14^ (143) Hale shell smooth, so radial groove m front of the posterior ridge. Fornix with a high posterior ridge, posterior slope Battened. Subgenus TrmmdBa s.s. Male (hell with a wide, radiating, shallow depression in front of the posterior ridge. Female with a small, rounded, weU-dehned radial post-basal swelling. . - Subgenus ScaUnaria Agassiz. * River north to THE MOLLUSCA IOOQ 144 (145) Male shdl with a posterior and central radiating ridge with a furrow between. Female with a greatly produced inflation a little behind the center at the base. Subgenus Dymomia Agassix. Th»k 145 (141) Male shell with a wide, shallow, radiating depression in front of the posterior ridge. Female with a rounded, foliaceooa swelling at the posterior base. . . Subgenus PUea Simpson. 146 (151) Male and female shell different. Shell orate to elliptical, smooth; hinge complete. Female shell more or less expanded in the post-basal region, but the expansion does not differ in texture from the rest of the shell. Marstrpium occupying the posterior part of the outer gill. Lamps&s Rafinesque . . 147 IOIO FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 147 (150) Beak sculpture consisting of coarse parallel ridges, scarcely looped or fine and doubly looped. Subgenus Lcmpsiiis s.s. . . 148 148 (149) Shell often very large, usually rather thin, inflated, shining, fre- quently rayed. Beak sculpture consisting of coarse parallel ridges, scarcely looped Section Lampsilis s.s. THE MOLLUSCA 149 (148) Shell oval to oblong; beak sculpture consisting of fine, doubly looped ridges Section Eurynta Rafinesquc. [his group has many species and is of general distribution from Manitoba to tward. Type, Lampsilis rtcla Lam. (Fig. 1513; X 1). 150 (147) Shell small, inflated, oval to obovate; male usually more or less pointed posteriorly; female truncated obliquely on the post- base; beak sculpture consisting of rather strong concentric ridges Subgenus Carunculina Simpson. A well-niarked group of small, dark-colored species easily distinguished by the peculiar beak sculpture. Most of (he species are confined to the Southern States from Georgia to Texas, but two or three range north to Illinois and southern Michigan. Type, Lampsilii k (Fig. ISUJXI). IOI2 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 151 (152) Male and female shells alike. Whole outer gill serving as marsu- pium, its edge thrown into a number of folds. Shell elon- gate-triangular, solid and thick; hinge complete; hinge plate wide and flat Ptychobranckus Simpson. The typical species, P. pkastdm Hud. (Fig. 151s; X 1), is common, ranging from Michigan south to Alabama and Louisiana. Five other species are known, four in Alabama and one in Fro. ij.s. i (153) Male and female shells alike. Marsupium occupying nearly the whole of the outer gill and, when fully developed, folded. Shell solid, round-triangular; hinge complete; hinge plate wide and flat; surface sculptured by irregular ridges and humps, painted with undulating, radiating, broken hair- lines or maculations. Dromus Simpson. 153 ('56) Male and female shells different, the Litter being slightly inflated in the post-basal region. Shell short oval, rounded, or retuse. Marsupium occupying the posterior portion of the outer gills and projecting far below the rest of the branchiae, dolabriform or kidney-soaped. Obovaria Raiin«iquc . . 154 THE MOLLTJSCA 1013 154 U55) Shell retrorse to short oval; beaks high and central. Subgenus Oboearia s.s. A small group of species mostly found in the Southern Slates from Alabama The type, O. relusa Lam. (Fig. 15 17), occurs in the Ohio, Tennessee, and Cumberland ir cs north to southern '" ' *$i ('54) Shell elliptical; beaks anterior. . . Subgenus Pseudoon Simpson. Two species only. The type, Obovaria ellipsis Lea {Fig. 1518; X I). ranges from the upper Mississippi and lower Great Lakes south to Tennessee and Arkansas. The other U found from 156 ('59) Male and female shells different, the latter being more or lest; inflated in the post-basal region. Shell triangular ovate, with a distinct, often sharp posterior ridge; hinge complete. Marsupium kidney-shaped, occupying the posterior portion of the outer gills, but not extending quite to the hinder end. Plagiala Agaasiz . . 157 ioi4 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 157 (158) Hinge heavy and strong; hinge plate wide and flat. Subgenus Plagiola s.s. The type and only species, P.sccuris Lea (Fig. 1519; Xi), occurs abundantly in the Ohio and Mississippi systems and south to Alabama. 158 (157) Hinge delicate; hinge plate narrow. Subgenus Amygdalonaias Crosse and Fischer. A group of only three species character, ized by the sharp posterior ridge and arrow- shaped pattern of the epidermis. Two of them occupy the Mississippi drainage, ex- tending into southern Michigan and south to Alabama and Texas. The third is peculiar to Texas. Example, Plagiola defaiu Lea {Fig. .510; xl). 159 (160) Male and female shells alike; oval-solid, inflated, with a row of Large knobs running from the beaks to the center of the base; hinge complete. Marsupium consisting of a few dis- tinctly marked ovisacs situated just behind the center of the outer gill and projecting far below the rest of the branchiae. OUiquaria Rafinesque. The typical and only species, 0. rtfltm Raf. (Fig. isii], ranges from Michigan aouthto"- THE MOLLUSCA IO15 160 (161) Male and female shells alike; very thick and solid, inflated, rounded- triangular; surface nodular, radiately wrinkled, or lachry- mous; epidermis painted with delicate green mottling on a light ground. Marsupium consisting of several long purple ovisacs pendent from near the central base of the outer gills and formed into a close coil with the ends turned inward. Cyprogenia Agassis. The typical species, C. ittorata Lea (Fig. 1511 Tennessee river systems. One other species occu Missouri to Oklahoma. 161 (162) Male and female shells different, that of the latter being slightly swollen behind the middle of the base. Shell rather small, elongated, dorsal slope plicately or nodulously wrinkled; hinge complete. Marsupium occupying the central portion of the outer gill Medionidus Simpson. A small group of species characterized by their elongate shape and plicate dorsal slope. It is restricted to the waters of Tennessee, Alabama, Georgia, and Florida. Type, St. uma&cui Lea (Fig. 1513). ioi6 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY i6z (163) Male and female shells much alike, but the latter b usually some- what inflated in the post-basal region. Shell large, ovate, usually lather thin, but in some species quite solid, gaping at the anterior edge and on the dorsal slope ; normally winged on the dorsal slope, but the wing b often lost in the adult; hinge complete. Marsupium occupying the posterior portion of the outer gills. Glochidia celt-shaped, with two spines on each valve and with gaping margins . . Proptera Rafinesque. Thin group is well characterized by the luge, usually thin shell, which is more or less slate in the dons! region. It occurs throughout the St. Lawrence ud Mueiaaipra systems and extends south to Texas and Alabama. Type. P. alaUt Say (Fig. 1514; X t). THE MOLLUSCA 1017 163 (164) Male and female shells not greatly different, the Utter twlng wme- what more inflated and expanded In the |MMt-baaal region. Shell thin, rather compressed, and winged mi the dorsal slope; hinge complete, but the [jacudocurdinaU are reduced to mere tubercles often nearly wanting. Mantuplum M in Proptera. Glochidiu semicircular, very amall, without spines Paraptern Ortnwiin. of the great belong to It, P. graciiii Bar. (Fig. is»S;X|). Alabama and weal to the Miuiuippl Valley. hat a wide rang* Ir 164 (u«) Male and female shells different, (he Utter being swollen in th* port-basal region. Marsupial charactera unknown. tin*!! ahort-eUipUcaJ, solid, much inflated; iMeudocardinala divided into irregularly radiating, granular lamina*-; hing* ijaU reduced to a mere rounded line behind (Ik irfwiif*r4uuU. fjUtiute i'staru4. >:■/<•■/ tj,r«US»f«« n>tiUu,m**m .. it* im.uW bug*, hitir it i>ri*ii -A Us * aad lurlha kdyfM»l*jD it gnatly tv bt 4*uvvi, sepuiaJJr Xu IOl8 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 165 (104) Interior of shell non-nacreous or porcellanous, or the whole shell of a prevailing prismatic substance 166 Five families: 166, 167, 168, 173, 174. 166 (167) Shell of a prevailing prismatic substance, mytiliform, very in- equilateral; beaks compressed, terminal; ligament subster- nal; anterior adductor and pedal protractor muscles inserted on a septum in the beak. Byssiferous. Family Dreissensddae. Only one genus Congeria Partsch. Represented in our fauna by ti Iriuepkatata Con. (Fig. 1517; Xi coast from Maryland to Florida. Fig. 151 167 (16S) Shell porcellanous, sub trigonal, thick, and solid; ligament external; hinge with true cardinal teeth and with both anterior and posterior laterals; pallial line with a distinct sinus. Family Cyrenidae. Only a single genus Cyretta Lamarck. Represented in our fresh-water fauna by a single species '■Kuril Bust (Fig. 1518), found in streams and brackish wt the coast f run South Carolina to Texas, 168 (173) Shell non-nacreous, usually small and thin; hinge with cardinal and both anterior and posterior lateral teeth; no hinge plate; pallial line simple. . . . Family Sphaerhdae . . 169 Four genera: i6g, 170, 171, 171. 169 (170) Shell oval, equilateral; beaks nearly subcentral; nepeonic valves not distinctly separated from the subsequent growth of the shell; cardinal teeth two in each valve. . -Sp kaerium Scopoli. This group cnarsnrM the largest species of the family and is easily dhtfaMntshea from Mtucuiium by the thicker, striate shell and noncalyculate beaks. The species are numerous and of general diitrihu lion. Example, S. natib Say (Fif. 15*01 X 1 J). THE MOLLTJSCA IO19 170 (171) Shell thin and delicate, suborbicular to oblong; beaks prominent, usually retaining the nepeonic valves; cardinal teeth minute, often obsolete; anterior and posterior laterals present. Musculium Link. This group has a general distribution. The prominent beaks with the distinctly marked nepeonic shell are the distinctive feature, but in some species these are lacking. The thin, rounded, polished shell is, however, quite characteristic. Example, M. parkumemm Say (Fig. I5i°; X2). Fig. 1550. 171 (172) Shell subrhomboidal, thin, moderately inflated, with the posterior side longer; cardinal teeth feeble, only one in each valve. Eupera Bourguignat. A tropical group, of which two or three species occur in Florida, Ala- bama, and Texas. The rhomboidal shape is characteristic. The shells appear to be mottled and are usually so described, but according to Dr. W. H. Dall these ''spots'1 are caused by a parasitic infusorian that attacks the interior of the shell. Example, E. singkyi Pils. (Fig. 1531; X3). Fig. 1531. 172 (169) Shell small, rounded, oval, or obliquely cuneiform, inequilateral, anterior side longer; beaks sub terminal; cardinal teeth double in each valve Pisidium C. Pfeiffer. The Pisidia are of general distribution and a great number of species have been described. They are easily distinguished from the allied genera by the very inequilateral shell, the hinge being on the shorter side. Example, P. virginkum Bgt. (Fig. 1532; X 2). Fig. 1532- 173 (i74) Shell rounded, inflated, thin; beaks forward; surface smooth or slightly concentrically sculptured; cardinal teeth, two in the right and one in the left valve; no lateral teeth. Family Cyrenet.tidae. Only one genus CyreneUa Deshayes. Fig. 1533* Represented in our fauna by a single species, C. fioridana Dall (Fig. 1 5 M ; X 1 J), from Florida. It is easily distinguished by the lack of lateral teeth. 1020 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY 174 (166) Shell thick, oval, sub trigonal, ventricose, smooth; beaks prominent; ligament inclosed in a pit and invisible externally; hinge with cardinal and both anterior and posterior lateral teeth; pallial line sinuous Family Rangodae. Only one genus Rangia Des Moulins. The typical spedes, R. cvntala Gray (Fig. IS34I X A), is found in great abundance in the brackish waters of the Gulf coast from Alabama to Mexico. IMPORTANT PAPERS ON FRESH-WATER MOLLUSCA. Bakek, F. C. 1898. The Mollusca of the Chicago Area. Part I, Pelecypoda. looa. Part II, Gastropoda. ion. The Lymnaeidae of North and Middle America. Binney, W. G. 1865. Land and Fresh-water Shells of North America, Part II. Smithsonian Misc. Coll., v. 7, No. 143, 171 pp. Part III, No. 144, 128 pp. Haldemak, S. S. 1842. Monograph of the Fresh-water Univalve Mollusca of the United States. Continued by G. W. Tyron, Jr., 1870. Oktuann, A. E. ion. A Monograph of the Najades of Pennsylvania. Mem. Carnegie Mus., 4 : 279-347- 1912. Notes upon the Families and Genera of the Najades. Ann. Car- negie Mus., 8 : 222-364. PsaiE, Temple. 1865. Monograph of American Corbiculidae. Smithsonian Misc. Coll., v. 7, No. 145, 192 pp. Simpson, C. T. 1914. A Descriptive Catalogue of the Naiades or Pearly Fresh- water Mussels. Printed by Bryant Walker, Detroit, Mich. 1540 pp. Sttmpson, William. 1865. Researches upon the Hydrobiinae and Allied Forms. Smithsonian Misc. Coll., v. 7, No. 201, 64 pp. Tsyon, G. W., Jr. 1873. Land and Fresh-water Shells of North America. Part IV, Strepomatidae. Smithsonian Misc. Coll., v. 16, No. 253, 435 pp. CHAPTER XXX THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES By C. H. EIGENMANN Professor of Zoology in Indiana University, and Curator of Fishes in the Carnegie Museum, Pittsburgh, Pa, INTRODUCTORY The chief object in the life of any animal is to leave another like it in its place when it dies. To accomplish this object it must find a range in which it may secure its food and itself escape be- coming food; it must secure a mate and a home in which its young may be reared to the point of self-dependence. The world con- tains a great variety of animals adapted to all possible environ- ments. Either the greatly diverse characters of these animals have arisen to adapt them to their different ranges and homes, or the greatly diverse environments have been selected because they were adapted to the otherwise and elsewhere acquired characters of different animals. Certainly when new water or land areas arise the latter will be the origin of its adopted fauna. The vast territory containing the majority of the innumerable lakes and streams with whose fauna and flora we are concerned, extending from the Arctic regions south to the region of the Ohio River, was a few thousand years ago covered with a continuous sheet of ice. The fauna and flora of this area are composed of immigrants, of animals and plants that moved in as the ice moved out and selected the places adapted to their requirements. While no doubt many of them have become modified since their advent into this area, there can be no doubt that their fundamental adaptations were elsewhere acquired and that in their case it has been a selection of environments to suit these adaptations. Fresh waters may be and are used first, for ranges; second, for homes; or third, for both purposes by various animals. One finds animals which breed on land but are adapted to utilize fresh waters Z02I 1022 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY daily or seasonally for ranges; others that range on land but visit the water during breeding seasons to make therein their homes and to enable their young to grow up in it. Still other animals utilize fresh waters both as a range and a home, — rarely, or never, leave it or even are incapable of leaving it. Roughly speaking, mam- mals, birds, and reptiles, in so far as they are aquatic, belong to the first of this ecological group. Batrachians belong to the sec- ond, a few batrachians and all fishes to the third. The first of these groups is composed of more or less perfect readaptations of land animals to water. The second is composed of originally aquatic animals as yet imperfectly adapted to the land, while the members of the third group are, and at all times have been, the aquatic animals par excellence. While the visitors or inhabitants of fresh water may be sharply distinguished from the non-aquatic, the relations and adaptations of aquatic animals to the different regions of the water are very diverse. Mammals The aquatic mammals are but imperfectly adjusted to some part of the aquatic habitat and confine themselves to shallow water and the shore. None of them could live in an enclosed space filled with water. The number of truly aquatic mammals is small. Most mammals only visit the water to drink. Others, as the moose, seek the water to browse on the marginal vegetation or to escape enemies. Others less inclined to enter water secure part of their food from it. The raccoon fishes along the margins of streams for crayfishes. A dexterous tomcat, proverbially wary of wetting his feet, one memorable night neatly cleaned out two aquaria, one stocked with rare blind fishes and one with still rarer axolotls. None of the above dive. The mink secures most of its food on land but it catches both fishes and muskrats in the water into which it does not hesitate to dive to escape an enemy or to secure food. The more distinctly aquatic mammals are the star-nosed mole, the muskrat, the beaver, and the otter. All of these use the water as a range, making their homes in very close proximity to the water if not actually in it. Of these the otter is a carnivore, the THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES IO23 rest plant feeders, though sometimes eating animal food. They have been so reduced in numbers, — in some places entirely exter- minated, — that they have become almost a negligible part of the aquatic vertebrate fauna. Only the muskrat must be considered as an ecological element in all eastern fresh waters. The muskrat is abundant along most of the eastern streams and lakes. It is a shallow-water animal and affects its environment in a specific way. It builds lodges of sod and cat-tail stalks, twigs and vegetable debris. It gathers lily roots, on which it feeds, but its most specific action is on various mussels. The muskrat lodge is always surrounded by shells of dead bivalves, and at Winona Lake it has been found by Headlee that the muskrat sets a bound- ary to the shoreward migration of mussels as the soft bottom of the pelagic area sets a limit to their migration toward deep water. The activities of the muskrat are more restricted in winter than in summer, but they do not hibernate. Beavers have disappeared from thickly-settled regions. They are, in some of their habits, larger editions of the muskrat. They build lodges not unlike those of the muskrat. They cut and gather twigs and stems for food but the action for which beavers are conspicuous, is the building of dams, and creating of ponds. They thus add to the extent of the aquatic environment. The seal-like otter is no longer a part of the aquatic environment in well settled parts of America. They are the most aquatic of the fresh-water mammals. As swimmers, they are more expert than fishes, which they catch and eat. They also prey upon muskrats and aquatic birds. Of the star-nosed mole, Stone says: "The star-nosed mole is a creature almost as well fitted for a partially aquatic life as the otter and mink, and, as a matter of fact, does pass most of its time about the water; pushing extensive tunnels through the black, peaty soil of swamps and along the borders of little brooks and ponds. The soft, black loam is thrown up in frequent heaps a foot, more or less, in diameter; the opening of the burrow being under the bank, and as often beneath the water as above. The tunnel itself must frequently be flooded to the great discomfort of its inmates. 1024 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY "But the old ones show no fear of the water; I have frequently seen them swimming both under water and on the surface, even where the current was pretty strong, and have always observed them to be perfectly confident and unf lightened at such times." Birds In cold and temperate regions birds are seasonal, robbing, visi- tors of the water. Only one-fourth to one-fifth of our entire bird fauna is in any sense aquatic.1 The passerine birds are dominant now and of this group none are strictly aquatic. One hundred and twenty-nine of the 215 species of birds of Monroe County, Indiana, are passerine. Of these only the red-winged blackbird, the six species of swallows, the water thrushes, and the long-billed marsh wren are, even re- motely, related to the water. Taking all the birds that range in or about the water — for none of them can be said to home in the water — one finds a graduated series, from those more to those less aquatic in their habits. More than this, birds show the most complete series of adaptations to different aquatic zones. The swallows must, by courtesy, be mentioned as forming the first of this series of ecological groups. They are never found upon or in the water, but skim over its surface, occasionally just touching it in their search for food. Mosquitoes and other minute aquatic insects are the attraction for them and they are, therefore, very definitely related to the aquatic fauna. They remain in the latitude of the Ohio River from early April to September. A second ecological group is formed by the kingfisher, the terns, gulls, and (for fresh waters rarely) the pelicans. The kingfisher, from his perch over a stream, dives into the water beneath him for fishes. He is largely a shore fisher. The terns, gulls, and pelicans dive from an aerial poise into the pelagic region of the lake and secure fishes near the surface. The terns and gulls also alight to pick the refuse floating on the surface for they are scavengers as 1 Out of 99 birds observed during the summer about one of the northern Indiana lakes, 19 are more or less related to the water. Out of 215 birds observed at all seasons of the year about Bloomington, Indiana, 55 are related to the water. THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES IO25 well as robbers. The kingfisher is a poor swimmer, but the terns, gulls, and pelicans rest gracefully on the surface. In the latitude of 'the Ohio the kingfisher is found between early March and No- vember, rarely even in December. The terns migrate to the northern lakes in summer and the pelicans are but stray visitors. The terns, gulls, and pelicans have certainly acquired the adapta- tion to the water at the ocean. The third ecological group is formed by the grebes and loons. They are pelagic birds, swimmers par excellence, both upon the surface and in the water. The term diving ought not to be ap- plied to the performance of both kingfisher and loon. The fourth ecological group is formed by the bottom-feeding ducks, the mudhen, geese, and swans. They are littoral or abys- mal forms securing their food in the mud at the bottom, largely about the margins of ponds or lakes in water not too deep to pre- vent them from reaching the bottom when "tipping." Many of the ducks are good swimmers under water, and the bay and sea ducks are said to reach the bottom at a depth of 100 to 150 feet. The fifth ecological group is formed by the herons, cranes, and bitterns. These range in much the same zone as most of the ducks, but their food, for the most part, is different. They stalk cau- tiously, without jerk or sudden motion, or stand in water of a depth not too great for their long legs. Their spearlike bill im- pales fish or frog. The sixth and last of the ecological groups of aquatic forms con- tains the rails and snipes. These are shore birds, wading in the shallowest water or along the wet shores, frequently moving with the advancing and retreating waves, picking the stranded animals from the surface or probing for their prey in the soft beaches. All of the groups except the first, the swallows, nest as near the water as possible. Less strictly aquatic are the swamp black- bird and long-tailed marsh wren which build their nests in cat- tails; likewise the song and marsh sparrows, so abundant along margins of stream or pond. From the nature of the case the waters of northern and temperate zones are a closed book to all the birds in winter. Hence, birds are not perennial elements of the aquatic 1026 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY fauna. Birds derive their food from the water. The few that, as carrion, serve as food for other aquatic animals or that may be captured by fish, otter, or alligator are a negligible quantity. Reptiles Reptiles, like mammals, are shallow-water and littoral forms, largely in summer. As with mammals, a gradual gradation is found from species living exclusively on land, — like the turtles and snakes of the Mojave desert or the land tortoise and green snakes of the Mississippi valley, — through those which do not ordinarily go into the water but will enter it without hesitation if circumstances demand, — like the black snake and garter snake, — to such as the water snakes, leather snakes, geographic turtle, painted turtle, and snapping turtle that bask on the margins of lakes and streams but take to the water for food or at the slightest sign of danger; and lastly, to the alligators, musk turtles, and soft-shelled turtles which give the final gradation to adaptations for life in water. Of these, the soft-shelled turtle, which can utilize the oxygen dis- solved in the water, has probably reached the highest adjustment to aquatic existence. But no hard and fast line can be drawn. The habits of different species overlap so neatly that one finds a shading from reptiles with a purely aquatic range to those with an entirely terrestrial range. All of them have their homes on land in so far as they have homes at all. Some secure only a part, others all of their food from the water. Of those that obtain it from the water some feed on fishes (purely aquatic food) ; others like the alligators, which catch water birds, utilize the water to secure terrestrial visitors in part. Others may seek both sorts of food. Snakes take to the margin of water in part for fishes, in part for frogs, etc. The water snakes give birth to living young. Since the young may be liberated in the water these snakes, in one sense, are the most aquatic of the reptiles. But since they cannot utilize the oxygen in the water the soft-shelled turtles exceed them in adap- tation to an aquatic existence in this respect. All the turtles, as well as the alligators, are compelled to make their homes or nests on ,**■* THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES 1027 land. The soft-shelled turtles usually lay their eggs in sandy beaches, sometimes in harder banks near the water. The painted turtles and snapping turtles dig holes more remote from the water's edge. The musk turtles lay their eggs in muck, in decaying stumps or logs, or accumulations of decaying weeds on the margins of lakes. No one would seriously doubt that the mammalian and rep- tilian faunas of fresh waters have both been derived from terres- trial ancestors. The adjustment to water conditions consists largely in an adaptation of the limbs and tail to swimming and diving. Both are organs primarily used for land progression. Further adaptations in reptiles, such as the utilization of the oxygen in the water by the turtles, are much more rare, and found only in extreme adaptations to an aquatic sojourn. The paths of turtles may readily be seen among fields of Chora in shallow water. A painted, geographic, or a musk turtle may be seen basking in the sun on the surface, the neck curved up, the nose out of water. If disturbed it dives into the Chara and soon disappears in one of its innumerable paths. A curious commen- salism is reported between the soft-shelled turtle and the black bass. The bass is said to follow the turtle, which, nosing about under rocks and in crannies scares out some of the crayfishes and other denizens of such places. These are then easily captured by the attending black bass. There is a peculiar correlation between the disposition of turtles and the degree of their armature. The soft- shelled turtle is the least protected by bony plates. Next in order comes the snapping turtle, with only a cross-shaped, ventral plate, most of the ventral surface being open to attack. This is followed by the musk turtle, the painted and the geographic turtle, Bind- ing's turtle and finally the box turtle. The highest degree of pro- tection is found in the terrestrial box turtle, whose plastron is hinged and can be closed in front and behind. Correlated with the defective armature in the soft-shelled turtle we find the extreme of pugnacity. A soft-shelled turtle will snap and bite on suspicion from the time it is half way out of its shell. The disposition of the snapping turtle, with exposed ventral surface, is proverbial. The musk turtle will bite, as anyone who has collected their eggs can testify. On the other hand, the well-protected painted, geo- 1028 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY graphic, and Blanding's turtles, and above all, the terrestrial and perfectly-armored box turtle, are the gentlest of creatures which no amount of provocation will induce to bite. Although the correla- tion between armature and disposition is very striking there may be no causal relation between the two. The character of the food may be the cause of the disposition. Batrachians The batrachians, as a group, are aquatic to a much greater degree than the mammals or reptiles. In North America they are summer and especially spring members of the aquatic fauna. Some of them, with all their ancestry, have been strictly aquatic. They are autochthons, products of evolution in fresh water. Such aquatic forms have gills and a tail throughout life. The Siren and the mud puppy, of deadly repute, belong to this group and so does the blind salamander of Texas. Whereas in the reptiles and the mammals gradations from pure terrestrials to less or more aquatics have been noted, in the batrachians one finds gradations from the purely aquatic to the more or less terrestrial, and none have reached the possibility of living in deserts in dry places. So many of the batrachians lay their eggs in water that those that do not are accounted remarkable. In a small pond near Indiana University, which has been examined at all seasons of the year, it has been found that a salamander, Ambly stoma jefersonianum, begins to lay as soon as the ice disappears after December. Sometimes this happens early in January or it may not until March. After the spawning of jeffersonianum comes that of Amblystoma punctatum. Both deposit their eggs in jellylike clumps. Hyla pickeringii and Acris gryllus spawn in the same pond between early March and late May. During late spring and early summer the newt, Diemictylus viridescens, spawns here. Very frequently this pond dries up in summer, and then there is an opportunity to see how any of the aquatic batrachians may become terrestrial. Late in summer Am- blystoma opacum spawns in this pond. Usually the pond is dry at the time, whereupon the salamander lays its eggs under leaves or under a board, coiling itself about the eggs. The hatching of such THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES 1029 eggs may be delayed much beyond the normal time and will then occur at once with the first rain. The young still require a pond for their growth from hatching to the metamorphosis. Toads and frogs have evidently become adapted to range on land without losing their ancestral habit of making their home in water. Whether their webbed toes and swimming legs are in their original condi- tion, or whether they are readaptations to water may be left in abeyance. The batrachians play an important part in the economy of small pools, a less important one in small streams, and are a negligible quantity in waters of any size. To the rule that their abundance is in inverse proportion to the size of the body of water, the perenni- branchs form the only exception. In early spring nearly every puddle contains hundreds or thousands of toad eggs and larvae. The tadpoles act as scavengers for a short time and then pass out of the life of the puddle. Every pond of greater permanence serves the frogs as the puddles and ponds do the toad. Frog tad- poles are scavengers and mud eaters, with elongate, alimentary canal. They remain in the water much longer than young toads and when they become adult may pass out of the life of the puddle or pond as completely as the adult toad, or may remain more or less closely identified with the birthplace. When the adult frogs remain about the water, they bear a different relation to the aquatic life from the young. The alimentary canal has become shortened and the frog is an eater of live food, insects, and fishes. In its turn the frog serves as food for fishes, snakes, and birds. Fishes The chief and perennial vertebrate elements of the aquatic fauna are the fishes. They, with a few batrachians and possibly a turtle, are the only members of the fauna that have both their home and their range in the water. They alone of the vertebrates are so adjusted to an aquatic existence that they could be hermetically 6ealed in a balanced aquarium. There are fishes, big and little, thick and thin, long and short, deep, and of little elevation, sharp-nosed and blunt-snouted, tooth- FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES 1031 less and fanged, naked and scaled, barbeted and not, nocturnal and diurnal, bottom sitters and top skimmers, riffle inhabitants and pool dwellers, mud-puddlers and mountaineers, round-bellied and serrate-edged. They are adapted, in short, to all conditions of 1 environment. The same gamut of size, shape, and habit is found in the fresh waters of South America and North America though the twc continents have nc fishes in common. The members of different families have thus independently become convergently and divergently adapted. Fresh-water hshes do not form a group by themselves. Various marine families have contributed to the fauna. But the larger per cent of the fresh-water hshes belong to the single superorder Ostariophysi. Of the 600 fresh-water species of North America, 307, or over half, belong to this group. IO32 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The fresh-water fishes of North America, exclusive of Mexico, are distributed among the following families, of which those of undoubted recent marine origin are printed in italics. Lamprey* 8 Salmon 28 Sunfish 37 Paddlefish 1 Trout perch 1 Perch 72 Sturgeon 7 Blind fish 8 Bass 4 Garpike 3 KUlifisk 52 Drum 1 Bowfin 1 Mud minnow 2 Surf fish 1 Characins 1 Pike 5 Cichlid* .• 2 Carp 230 Alaska Blackfish 1 Goby 6 Sucker 51 Eel 1 Sculpin 21 Catfish 25 Stickleback 7 Cod 1 Mooneye 3 Silver side 2 Sole 1 Herring 5 Pirate perch 2 Gizzard shad 1 Elassoma 2 . Few localities, even among the most favored, contain more than 50 species of the 600 found in North America. The entire Missis- sippi basin harbors about 200 species, the Great Lakes with their tributaries, 152,3 the state of Indiana, 163. Eel River in Indiana (85 miles long), with all of its tributary lakes and streams, harbors 76 species. White River of Arkansas, 84; the Maumee basin, 87. Bean Blossom Creek, about 25 miles long, harbors 44 species in less than two miles near its middle. Lake Ontario with all of its tributaries is inhabited by 73 species; Lake Champlain and its tributaries by 54; Lake Chautauqua with its tributaries by 31; the Winnipeg System, Canada, by 44; the St. Lawrence River, by 63 and 8 marine. Winona Lake of Kosciusko County, Indiana, exclusive of its tributaries, harbors 23 species, Turkey Lake with- out its tributaries, 29 species. The outlet of Turkey Lake, for a mile of its length, harbors an equal number. There is a vast difference in the number of species found in equal areas of streams and lakes. Other things equal a given area of surface water or a given cubic quantity of water of a small stream harbors more individuals and greater diversity of species than the same area and bulk of either a large river or lake. The places in America from which the greatest diversity of fish life has been reported are: 1 These are fully described and many of them figured in Jordan and Evermann's Fishes of North and Middle America, Bull. U. S. Fish Com., and also in Jordan's " Guide to the Study of Fishes," Henry Holt and Co. f Immigrants from South America. * Of these 27 are peculiar to the Great Lakes basin. THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES 1033 Saline and Washita, J mile above Arkadelphia, Arkansas 47 l Fort Smith and neighborhood 50 Bean Blossom Creek, Indiana 44 Cypress Creek, Alabama 42 Obeys River, Tennessee 39 Tuscaloosa, Alabama 32 Mammoth Spring, Arkansas 37 Washita, Arkansas 36 In contrast with these the following poor faunas are recorded: Connecticut River 18 Clear Lake, California 13 Klamath basin, California 15 The entire Yellowstone Park 10 San Luis River, California 4 Kicking Horse River, Canada 2 Salt Lake basin 14 Sevier River, Utah 7 Columbia River System 37 Colorado basin 33 Pennamaguan Lake, Washington County, Maine 10 Meddybemp Lake and Dennys River, Washington County, Maine 9 Western Grand Lake System, Washington County, Maine 14 St. Croix River basin, Washington County, Maine 8 Perkins Lake, Idaho 7 Alturas Lake, Idaho 4 San Diego County, California 4 Of these the Connecticut, Klamath, Yellowstone, San Luis, the Maine lakes and streams, and Alturas Lake each have entirely distinct faunas and the Columbia and Colorado have only a few species each in common with the Salt Lake basin. It is quite evi- dent from an inspection of these lists, that a general consideration of the fresh-water fauna of North America applicable to all cases is quite out of the question. There are a number of quite distinct faunas. A few general observations may be supplemented with an analysis of a few typical localities to get at the nature of the fish fauna. Jordan2 summarizes a long experience of gathering fishes in many waters of North America as follows: "Some of the conditions most favorable to the existence in any stream of a large number of species of fishes are the following, the most important of which is the one mentioned first: Connection with a large hydrographic basin; a warm climate; clear water; a moderate current; a bottom of gravel, preferably covered by a 1 Two localities are included in this and several in the total of 50 in the next. 1 "A Guide to the Study of Fishes," p. 307. 1034 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY growth of weeds; little fluctuation during the year in the volume of the stream or in the character of the water. "Limestone streams usually yield more species than streams flowing over sandstone, and either more than the streams of regions having metamorphic rocks. Sandy bottoms usually are not favor- able to fishes. In general, glacial drift makes a suitable river bottom, but the higher temperature usual in regions beyond the limits of the drift gives to certain southern streams conditions still more favorable. These conditions are all well realized in the Washita River in Arkansas, and in various tributaries of the Ten- nessee, Cumberland, and Ohio; and in these, among American streams, the greatest number of species has been recorded. "The isolation and the low temperature of the rivers of New England have given to them a very scanty fish fauna as compared with the rivers of the South and West." Agassiz says concerning New England: "In this isolated region of North America, in this zoological island of New England, as we may call it, we find neither Lepidosteus, nor Amia, nor Poliodon, nor Amblodon, nor Grystes, nor Centrarchusy nor Pomoxis, nor Ambloplites, nor Calliurus, nor Carpiodes, nor Hyodony nor indeed any of the characteristic forms of North American fishes so com- mon everywhere else, with the exception of two Pomotis, one Boleosoma, and a few Catostomus." Continuing, Jordan says: "Of the six hundred species of fishes found in the rivers of the United States, about two hundred have been recorded from the basin of the Mississippi. From fifty to one hundred of these species can be found in any one of the tributary streams of the size, say, of the Housatonic River or the Charles. In the Connecti- cut River there are but eighteen species permanently resident; and the number found in the streams of Texas is not much larger.** "The waters of the Great Basin are not rich in fishes, the species now found being evidently an overflow from the Snake River when in late glacial times it drained Lake Bonneville. This postglacial lake once filled the present basin of the Great Salt Lake and Utah Lake, its outlet flowing northwest from Ogden into Snake River. The same fishes are now found in the upper Snake River and the THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES IO35 basins of Utah Lake and of Sevier Lake. In the same fashion Lake Lahonton once occupied the basin of Nevada, the Humboldt and Carson sinks, with Pyramid Lake. Its drainage fell also into the Snake [Klamath?] River, and its former limits are shown in the present range of species. These have almost nothing in com- mon with the group of species inhabiting the former drainage of Lake Bonneville. Another postglacial body of water, Lake Idaho, once united the lakes of southeastern Oregon. The fauna of Lake Idaho, and of the lakes Malheur. Warner, Goose, etc., which have replaced it, is also isolated and distinctive. The number of species now known from this region of these ancient lakes is about 125. This list is composed almost entirely of a few genera of suckers, minnows, and trout. None of the catiishes. perch, darters, or sunfishes, moon-eyes, pike, kfllifisbes, and none of the ordinary eastern types of minnows have passed the harrier of the Rocky Mountains. " West of the Sierra Nevada the fauna is still more scanty, only about seventy species being enumerated. This fauna, except for certain immigrants from the sea. is of the same general character as that of the Great Basin, though most of the species are different. . . . The rivers of Alaska contain but few species, barely a dozen in all, most of these being found also in Siberia and Kamchatka. In the scantiness of its fauna] list, the Yukon agrees with the Mac- kenzie River, and with Arctic rivers generally." The fauna of the Great Lakes and of the Red River of the north is essentially like that of the Mississippi Valley. The Origin of the Fresh-untier Fishes. — Many of the fresh-water fishes of North America have been more remotely or more recently derived from the sea. Some of them, as the eel, still come from the sea during each generation; to find in fresh water their range; others are but seasonal visitors, entering the fresh waters from the ocean as the salamanders enter them from the land, to find homes. These various anadromous fishes will be considered later.-1 Still 3 71k anadromous habit may be of double origin. Toe various salmons, many of wthose relatives live in fresh water, may bt fresh- water species contributed to the oceaa. The shad and striped perch, on the other hand, what* relatives live in the oceaL. have become anadromous through the general habit of many oceank fishes to ueek the shore sad shallow water as the breeding season approaches. IO36 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY others, with both range and home in fresh water, belong to present marine families and have evidently comparatively recently become members of the fresh-water fauna. A notable example of a fish comparatively recently contributed by the sea to fresh water is Hysterocarpus traski Gibbons. It is a viviparous fish of the rivers of cehtral California. All of its rela- tives live in the Pacific Ocean from which it is an undoubted immigrant. The sea basses furnish several illustrative examples. The striped bass, Roccus lineatusy is an oceanic fish entering rivers to spawn, while its nearest relative, Roccus chrysops, the white bass, is con- fined to the Great Lakes and upper Mississippi Valley. Closely related to these are the yellow bass, Morone interrupta, of the lower Mississippi Valley, and the white perch, Morone americana, in salt and fresh water from Nova Scotia to South Carolina. The ninety other American members of this family are all marine. Various species of Robalos (Centropomus) enter fresh water. The Mugilidae have added various species to the fresh waters south of the United States. The Atherinidae have contributed the skipjack to our rivers and lakes, and south of us this marine family, whose eggs are provided with threads, has contributed and is con- tributing to the fresh waters all the way from Mexico to Patagonia. Fta. 1538. Skipjack, Labidestes siculus (Cope) . Actual size, 05 mm. long. The sticklebacks and killifishes help to bridge the gap, if such exists, between the fresh waters and the ocean. Even the pipe- fishes and flounders have a tendency to colonize fresh waters, and the flounders at least have succeeded in South America. The Sciaenidae, a marine family, has contributed the thunder- pumper or white perch to the Great Lakes and Mississippi Valley, and several other species to the streams of South America. Some of its marine species occasionally run up streams. The large family of the Cottidae has added the miller's-thumb. THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES »J7 Others of undoubted marine origin have -entered fresh water at such remote periods that they have set op distinct fresh-water families, .as the sunhshes. the perches, and the Cichudac. Finally, we have the dominant fresh-water groups of chaxacms, minnows, caips. suckers, and cathshes whose origin from the sea is so remote that the orders and superorders embracing all of these dominant members of the fresh-water fauna, with the excep- tion of Arius and related genera, are peculiar to fresh water. Fie iS39. Miltei s Thumb, Cmw ittainpi (KrfrapK). Dispersal of Fresh-water Fishes. — No fishes have been or are being permanently contributed to the land. The eel is capable of moving over short stretches of land, and Periophthaimus may leave the water in search of loud. In the South American fresh waters a relative of the catfish is said to be able to move from pond to pond, and in the Congo and in South American rivers live fishes that temporarily fly over the water. But all these spe- cies are adapted to the water and can live for longer periods only in connection with it. The two factors that more than others are responsible for the abundance or paucity of the faunas are accessibility and tempera- ture. The latter will be considered more at length later. Acces- sibility demands some attention now. A locality is accessible to fishes if ii is connected with an inhab- ited locality by a permanent or seasonal waterway. There are fishes that apparently defy this general rule and that skip or lure IO38 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY skipped in a tantalizing way, from mountain stream to mountain stream, appearing wherever conditions are favorable. Here, as elsewhere, the mystery will probably dissolve when all the facts are in. The catfishes and darters have not been able to cross to the Pacific slope in the United States, but in Mexico they have accomplished this feat. A tilting of the land, or change in relative rainfall, or some other reason has enabled some of the Pacific slope streams to capture some of the former tributaries of the Rio Grande. With the tributary went the darters, the catfishes, and other fishes it contained. A freshet or a cave-stream may some- times be responsible for an apparently mysterious distribution. Salt water is sometimes a barrier to the migration of fresh-water fishes. Jordan * says of the streams of San Luis Obispo County, California, of which the San Luis Creek mentioned before is one: "The county of San Luis Obispo lies along the coast of Califor- nia, midway between Monterey and Santa Barbara. It is com- posed of two or three isolated valleys opening out to the sea, and surrounded on all sides by high and barren mountains. These mountains have served as a barrier, shutting off all access of fishes to the streams of the region from the larger basins of the north and east. The valleys of San Luis Obispo are traversed by clear, swift, cold streams rising in mountain springs. In these streams very few species of fishes are found, and these few, except in one case (Agosia nubila), are species which have come into the fresh waters by way of the sea. None of the characteristic types of the San Joaquin and Sacramento valleys are found in San Luis Obispo County. This is evidently not due to any character of the waters, but simply to the fact that these fishes cannot reach San Luis Obispo except by descent to the sea." But there is also evidence that the ocean is not invariably a barrier. To quote again from Jordan:2 "The passage of species from stream to stream along the Atlantic slope deserves a moment's notice. It is under present conditions impossible for any mountain or upland fish, as the trout or the miller's thumb, to cross from the Potomac River to the James, or 1 Bull. U. S. Fish Com. for 1894, p. 141. * "Guide to the Study of Fishes," pp. 312 and 313. THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES 1039 from the Neuse to the Santee, by descending to the lower courses of the rivers, and thence passing along either through the swamps or by way of the sea. The lower courses of these streams, warm and muddy, are uninhabitable by such fishes. Such transfers are, however, possible farther north. From the rivers of Canada and from many rivers of New England the trout does descend to the sea and into the sea, and farther north the white fish does this also. Thus these fishes readily pass from one river basin to another. As this is the case now everywhere in the north, it may have been the case farther south in the time of the glacial cold. We may, I think, imagine a condition of things in which the snow fields of the Allegheny chain might have played some part in aiding the diffusion of cold-loving fishes. A permanent snow field on the Blue Ridge in western North Carolina might render almost any stream in the Carolinas suitable for trout, from its source to its mouth. An increased volume of colder water might carry the trout of the head streams of the Catawba and the Savannah as far down as the sea. We can even imagine that the trout reached these streams in the first place through such agencies, though of this there is no positive evidence. For the presence of trout in the upper Chattahoochee we must account in some other way .... "With the lowland species of the southern rivers it is different. Few of these are confined within narrow limits. The streams of the whole South Atlantic and Gulf Coast flow into shallow bays, mostly bounded by sand pits or sand bars which the rivers them- selves have brought down. In these bays the waters are often neither fresh nor salt; or, rather, they are alternately fresh and salt, the former condition being that of the winter and spring. Many species descend into these bays, thus finding every facility for transfer from river to river. There is a continuous inland passage in fresh or brackish waters, traversable by such fishes, from Chesapeake Bay nearly to Cape Fear; and similar con- ditions exist on the coasts of Louisiana, Texas, and much of Florida." Adaptations to the Main Object in Life. — Fishes either lay eggs that are fertilized in the water, retain eggs that have been internally fertilized to the time of hatching or in a few species give t'Af, MOSB-w'STac MfMJXn twtii V» 3faw% rvuxd! w&db hum twtw ocTiw iw 1 A- ifi$r4Um, A* t&t Epawnrog Maum a^n^acif*. iiies ancler- talte * #**«d mignitorr a»/ir«n«3t- TV aJgCMfaa may be ©# Cmit or vwj luxated csusl The Exmaaatt e is gnwrai one of g> *»{ uf*tr«us »// wxaJJ U'/At and sbonrvanl lo shallow water. In v/oiK ta**» th* na^rati* may mean the movement for a Irw fc*t 'x/ly V*n*r mimv/vfc and darters move to a favorably -placed r<*.k '*f w**d. The tlupjack m our small takes ioais to the anc of jw iu-rd »wl* near ithore. The Hintebes. black bass, and many other* move *uor ewar d to shallow water. Some minnows move to riffle* from neighboring pools. The upstream movement of suckers Ik jmwcrful In California, and has become proverbial in Illinois and neighboring water*. The limit in the extent of migratory movements upstream is reached by the Pacific coast salmons. The quinnat salmon of the Pacific coast fs the king of the migrants. It enters the Columbia Klver at the age of four years, in March and April. The entire Hummer In taken up, without food, in ascending to its spawning grounds. It spawns a thousand miles and more from the ocean, or in Alaska two thousand miles from the sea, in shallow riffles of small streams at the headwaters of the streams it ascends. Alturas LiiIcl', near one of its spawning places, has an elevation of 7,335 feet. After spawning the adult dies. It never succeeds in regaining the ocean. The Atlantic slope salmon (Salmo solar) ascends from the ocean to the headwaters of streams north of Cape Cod. The relative of the salmons, the cisco of Tippecanoe Lake, in December ascends its tributary streams to spawn. The marine lamprey as- cendi streams from the Atlantic Ocean. The landlocked lamprey (Pttr omyvm marittus unicolor) of central New York migrates eight to tan :mQe& foam Carnga Laie up lie streams to quacm. The ritaer lywyjwHi >uf 13k- MaBatsagagi Valley asaentfc small iarwjfe n tifae ^pining. On lift- Pairiifit slope lie Padfic lamprey ssqhb& tJ-nramfr in ihsnge mrmberE. At La Grange. Idaia. I ioxmd i*fly sbbbt caBEi?esict-t?d Wlyw- a TrnMam -winch titer i&d not been aide to ascend. Tift' sturgeons ice lite must past Bring in the bol &fa» ascend stsszazra to spawn. WHkr many spede* uf f tribes ia*pe Hat iabirt <£ fTrtterrmp foefib ms&ssr utien liey agjipru&ch lipenef*. lift* -eel alone, -of the -fishes - prwati litar Jul! sine, in aliout iour ytzxh. tibey descend lie Btrtacm* to lie *uung -eelt vhida a,scend &tiwa& suci as ticar jsuKaote imve descended two 3*^20% previuiffihr. lite all fffihes, 1042 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY such as the lampreys and salmon, which make very elaborate preparations to produce their young at a great Hist^n^ from their range, the eels never regain their range, and probably all die after the first reproductive period. It is not improbable that in some landlocked lakes eels mature and reproduce in fresh water, but no eels with ripe eggs, nor eggs, nor larval eels, have been found in fresh water. Homes of Fishes. — Emphasis has been laid on the fact that the ultimate fate of all fresh water is locomotion, and that usually currents exist between fresh-water lakes and the ocean. All fresh- water fishes are adapted to this condition and make provision to anchor their eggs or give birth to living young. There is but one fresh-water fish known to me that has pelagic eggs, the eel. It has not become adapted to rear its young in fresh water, but enters the sea before the reproductive period. This suggests that the adaptation of fresh-water fishes to resist currents did not arise after they had entered the fresh water, but that such oceanic candidates for fresh-water existence as had eggs adapted to resist the currents gained a permanent lodgment; while, on the contrary, none of those with pelagic eggs have been able to establish perma- nent homes in fresh waters. All anadromous and fresh-water fishes either have eggs heavier than water which lodge in gravel, or produce attachable eggs. Many marine fishes have pelagic eggs, and none of these have become permanent residents in fresh water. Others have adhesive eggs, that at the moment of being laid will adhere to foreign substances; others have cohesive eggs that will become attached to each other, but not to foreign substances. Of the adhesive eggs some are simply sticky all over and others have mushroom-shaped processes that have sticky heads (stickleback). The eggs of still other fishes have filaments that coil about foreign substances. All of these types are found in fresh waters. The fundamental adaptation, that to flowing water, was acquired by the ancestors of fresh-water fishes before they were able to leave the ocean. Along with this adaptation against currents, we have in the fresh-water fishes elaborate brooding habits that in part, at least, are an adaptation to another fresh-water condition, i.e., the settling THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES 1043 of sediment. A very brief survey of the nature of the eggs and the brooding habits as far as known is instructive. Amia, the sunfishes, and the black bass build their nests in shallow water with little or no current. The nest is either pre- pared in weed-covered patches or on the sand. Amia prefers weed-covered patches but is not exclusive in its selections. The nest, prepared by the male with the snout and fins, consists simply of an area from which the vegetation has largely been removed, or it may be but a saucer-shaped pit in sand. The eggs of Amia are adhesive and are attached to the sides and bottoms of the nest. The mate remains over or near the nest until the eggs hatch, occasionally fanning away sediment, and always while near the nest ready to drive out intruders. . The male accompanies the school of young until they reach a length of 100 mm. The sunfishes and black bass build their nests preferably in gravel or sand, but not to the entire exclusion of the localities preferred by Amia. Their eggs are quite small and also adhesive, and are found at the sides or bottom of a nest. The male of the small-mouthed black bass builds the nest. There are no secondary sexual characters. " Each ' male tests the bottom in several places by rooting into it with his snout and fan- ning away the overlying mud or sand with his tail. If he does not find gravel after going down three or four inches, he seeks another place. Having found a suitable place, he cleans the sand and mud from the gravel by sweeping it with his tail. He then turns over the stones with his snout and continues sweeping until the gravel over a circular spot, some two feet in diameter, is clean. The sand is swept toward the edge of the nest and there forms a few inches 1 From LydeU, Bull. U. S. Fish Com., m: 30. 1044 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY high, leaving the center of the nest concave like a saucer. The nest is usually located near a log or large rock so as to be shielded from one side. If the bank is sheer and the water deep enough, the nest may be bifilt directly against the bank." . . . After spawning the male drives the female away. "The male, and the male only, now continues to guard the nest, fanning sedi- ment from the eggs and repelling enemies. At 66° F. the eggs hatch in five days and the young fishes swarm up from the bottom in twelve to thirteen days from the day of hatching. " Shortly after the young small-mouthed bass rise from the nest they scatter out over a space four or five rods across — not in a definite school with all the fish moving together, but as a loose swarm, moving independently or in small groups. The fry may be at the surface or on the bottom, in weeds or clear water, and are attended by the male until they are ij inches long. The swarm then gradually disperses and the young fry, which were previ- ously black, take on the color of the old fish." Other fishes having adhesive eggs attach them to the lower surfaces of rocks and boards. Several of our darters have this habit, as well as several minnows. The eggs of some species of darters are attached to the upper surfaces of rocks. Other fishes suspend their eggs from aquatic plants, with or without nest building. The goldfish, which has adhesive eggs, attaches them singly to aquatic plants, as the fish swims about. The skipjack probably does the same, though in this species, as in the case of its marine relatives, the egg is supplied with long, thread-like fila- ments. I have seen pairs of these fishes wind in and out near the surface among water plants, and once saw a pair of gar pikes late in June going through the same performance. The yellow perch provides similarly for its eggs. They are laid in long strings which are suspended from aquatic plants. The eggs of the stickle- backs have mushroom-shaped processes that are adhesive. The lampreys, salmon, trout, some suckers, and some minnows have eggs which are heavier than water. These fishes deposit their eggs among the gravel of swift-flowing water where little sediment falls. Some of our catfishes and the miller's-thumb have cohesive, agglutinating eggs. These are laid under boards i.\ * THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES 1045 or in other protected places and guarded by the male. The male Noturus not infrequently proceeds to swallow the eggs he guards when they are uncovered. "Both1 parents of the yellow catfish are a pale yellow color, the number of eggs deposited was estimated at two thousand. The incubatory period was five days in a mean water temperature of 770 F., the lowest temperature being 75 degrees and the highest 80 degrees. "During the entire hatching period both parents were incessant in their efforts to prevent the smothering of the eggs, to keep them clean, and to guard against intruders. The eggs were kept con- stantly agitated and aerated by a gentle fanning motion of the lower fins, and foreign particles, either on the bottom of the nest or floating near the eggs, were removed in the mouth or by the fins. The most striking act in the care of the eggs was the sucking of the egg masses into the mouth and the blowing of them out, this being repeated several times with each cluster before another lot was treated. "The male was particularly active in watching for intruders, and savagely attacked the hands of the attendant who brought food; he also rushed at sticks or other objects introduced into the aquarium. Practically the entire work of defence was assumed by the male, although the female occasionally participated. "During the time the fry were on the bottom the attentions of the parents were unrelaxed, and, in fact, were increased, for the tendency of the different lots to become scattered had to be cor- rected, and the dense packing of the young in the corners seemed to occasion much concern. The masses of fry were constantly stirred, as the eggs had been, by a flirt of the fins, which often sent dozens of them three or four inches upward, to fall back on the pile. "The very young fry were also taken into the mouths of the parents and blown out, especially those which became separated from the main lot and were found in the sand and sediment. The old fish would take in a mouthful of fry and foreign particles, retain them for a moment, and expel them with some force. After 1 From Smith & Harron, Bull. U. S. Fish Com., 22: 151. 1046 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY the young began to swim and became scattered, the parents con- tinued to suck them in and mouth them, and, as subsequently developed, did not always blow them out. "An interesting habit of the parents, more especially the male, observed during the first few days after hatching, was the mixing and stirring of the masses of young by means of the barbels. With the chin on the bottom, the old fish approached the corners where the fishes were banked, and with the barbels all directed forward and flexed where they touched the bottom, thoroughly agitated the mass of fry, bringing the deepest individuals to the surface. This act was usually repeated several times in quick succession. The care of the young may be said to have ceased when they began to swim freely, although both parents continued to show solicitude when the attendant approached the aquarium from the rear." , In contrast to the nest-building habits are the habits of those fishes seeking a definite sort of locality where to deposit their eggs. The dace (Semotilus), stone roller (Catnpostoma), and rainbow darter (Eihesostoma caeruleutn) select gravelly bottom on shallow riffles above a pool. The habits of the darter have recently been made the subject of exhaustive study by Miss Cora D. Reeves.1 These fishes spawn when the temperature reaches about 6o° F. The males select holdings which they guard and from which they drive rival males by a display of color and by blows delivered with head and tail. The female buries herself partly in the gravel, the male taking a position over her, other males crowding in. A few eggs and milt are extruded at a time and the spawning act oft repeated. The eggs are adhesive and stick to the gravel. The adaptation to currents in fresh water thus consists in various devices to anchor the eggs. The adaptation against sediment is found in the guarding and fanning habit of the male, the deposit of eggs to the lower surface of rocks or boards and on riffles, and the suspension of eggs from water weeds. To these groups of more or less adaptive habits we must add the peculiar brooding habits of some catfishes, Cichlids, and the blind fishes, and Cyprin- odonts. Some of the South American catfishes have the habit of carrying their eggs in the mouth. Some of them, Aspredo, carry 1 BioL Bull, 14 : 35. THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES 1047 them attached to the ventral surface. Several African and South American Cichlids carry the eggs and young in their mouths and gill chambers. The so-called myth, that a given fish leads about his brood and guards them in his mouth when danger approaches, is not a myth for some of these species. The blind fishes of North America carry their eggs in their gill chambers. In these fishes the oviduct has moved forward ho that it tfHft| Kjiali/. [iirri. Pj1k,,p>m* opens just behind the isthmus. The young an: carried for a month or two until they have reached a length of 10 mm. In a group of Cyprinodonts reaching as far a* Indiana, but increasing in diver- sity of species and numbers of individuals southward, the egg* are retained by the female until the yolk Is absorb**! by the growing young fish, and sometime* for a much longer period. In the blind fishes « Cuba the yvjrig are iwjt ar. inch in length at the time ■->£ birth and :n the Calirorr.U. wirf-f^rcs they may !se twice S&md-ir} Stomal dwisJUri. — Surji fettuna v/^tt in wze dBposrion. color « stricture. Lsrafc di:Jef*r.ce* i.-. *T, '^ these are raxari in the kiV.inahea. In vx-jt of these ij«*ie* the rr.a.e ia minute axd prvoVierf with an anal in rrxdiied scia a lance- 1048 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY like blade. This is not an intromittent organ but is apparently used as a momentary clasper as the male darts at the female with the lance directed forward and upward, liberating the spermatozoa in spcrmatophores as the tip of the lance comes in contact with the female. A single impregnation may furnish the female with spermatozoa for several broods of young. The male of Atnia has a caudal ocellus. In Rivuius it is the female that possesses the caudal ocellus. The differences in disposition in the black bass, in which no other secondary sexual differences exist, are mentioned elsewhere. Fig. 1544. Blunt-Noted Minnow, Fimtpkaia The greatest display of secondary sexual colors is seen in the sun- fishes and especially in the little darters and in Ckrosomus whose brilliant coloration is scarcely surpassed by that of the humming birds. The greatest display of secondary sexual color takes place just before the breeding season. It may be used as a sex recog- nition mark, a battle flag, as in the rainbow darter, or as a lure to the female. In many males small excrescences appear on the sides, on the fins, or on the head during the breeding season. The anal fin is often provided with hooklets in suckers. The male of Camposloma becomes covered with tubercles. Pimepkaies develops short, warty horns on the head and the homed dace {SemotUus atromacuiatus) large, long ones. Some of these are used as excitants for the fe- male, others undoubtedly to enable the male to cling to the female during the spawning act. Physical Environment and Adaptations to it. With the excep- tions noted, fishes are always found in water. The character of the water, i.e., the per cent of salt and other chemicals in solution, determines the three major ecological divisions of fishes: I, the marine fishes; II, the brackish water fishes; and TTT, the inland, THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES IO49 fresh-water fishes. The first two groups are beyond the scope of this chapter. The inland fishes, according to the physical character of the environments selected by them, may be divided into the following groups, in part suggested by Cope and Jordan. 1. Lowland fishes: the bowfin, pirate perch, large-mouthed black bass, sunfishes, mud-minnow, and some catfishes. 2. Channel fishes, ranging from lowland to upland: the channel catfish, the moon-eye, gar pike, buffalo fishes, and drum. 3. Upland fishes: many of the darters, shiners, and suckers, and the small-mouthed black bass. 4. Mountain fishes: the brook trout, and many of the darters and minnows. 5. Lake fishes, inhabiting only waters which are deep, clear, and cold: the various species of whitefish and the Great Lake trout. 6. Anadromous fishes, or those which run up from the sea to spawn in the fresh water: the salmon, sturgeon, shad, and striped bass. 7. Catadromous fishes, that descend to the ocean to spawn: the eel. 8. Cave fishes, found exclusively in cave streams: the Ambly- opsidae. Many of the species are found in more than one of the areas mentioned. Inland waters vary greatly in the amount of the solids in solu- tion or suspension. In the Great Salt Lake and the alkali lakes of the west the amount of solids in solution is prohibitive to fish life. In all other waters, however small, if accessible, fishes are found. Even temporary ponds are colonized by catfishes and sunfishes if they are at all accessible. Sediment is present in variable amounts and some fishes, depending exclusively upon sight to detect their prey, are found only in water free from sediment. Under given conditions in moving water, the amount of oxygen in solution is tolerably constant. When a body of fresh water freezes over, or after the summer thermocline is formed, the oxygen may become reduced in quantity or disappear altogether in the deeper IO50 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY portions of a lake. Through the reduction in oxygen fishes may be either killed in large numbers or compelled to emigrate. Fishes being exclusive water animals are especially adapted to utilize the oxygen in the water. The gills are the universally present res- piratory organs but in special cases the fins and part of the ali- mentary canal may be forced into service. In the gar-pike the air-bladder serves as a lung, at least for the elimination of CO2. Various other fishes have cellular air-bladders connected with the alimentary canal that suggest respiration. Tower found that in fishes dying of asphyxiation the ratio of CO2 to O in the air- bladder increases. During the breeding season when the gill chambers are full of eggs much of the respiration of the blindfishes is probably forced on the fins and general surface. In the surf -fish, to which the Sac- ramento Hysterocarpus belongs, the young are born fully devel- oped.1 In their earliest development in the ovary the general surface of the larva must act as a respiratory organ, later the ali- mentary canal functions as such. A continuous stream of ovarian fluid passes in at the gill-opening and out at the anus at this time. Finally the fins become hypertrophied into enormous sheets super- abundantly supplied with blood vessels. In the Cuban blindfishes, in which the young reach a length of an inch at the time of birth, vascular lobes are developed in the ovary, which the young take into their mouths and to which they cling, possibly both for food and oxygen. It is very probable that those fishes that are capable of living out of water for a time carry on respiration through their moist skin. Temperature and Adjustment to it. — In nearly all fresh waters of the temperate region there is a fluctuation in the water be- tween 3 20 to 8o° F. The extreme fluctuation is found only on the surface of the water. In the bottom of lakes eighty feet deep, the annual fluctuation ranges perhaps between 390 and 6o° F. Fishes can always escape the extreme fluctuations by seeking deeper water. That they are adjusted to live through extreme cold is shown by the fact that some species may be frozen in ice and re- 1 The life history of this species has not been traced, but that of some of its marine relations has. THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES 1051 vive when thawed out. The adjustment in this respect probably increases as one goes northward. Turner says of the Alaskan Dallia: "When taken from the traps the fish are immediately put into these baskets and taken to the village, where the baskets of fish are placed on stages out of the way of dogs. The mass of fish in each basket is frozen in a few minutes, and when required to take them out they have to be chopped out with an axe or beaten with a club to divide them into pieces of sufficient size to feed the dogs. "The vitality of these fish is astonishing. They will remain in those grass baskets for weeks, and when brought into the house and thawed out they will be as lively as ever. The pieces which are thrown to the ravenous dogs are eagerly swallowed, the ani- mal heat of the dog's stomach thaws the fish out, whereupon its movements cause the dog to vomit it up alive.' ' The lower temperature limit is set to fish life by the freezing point of the medium, 320 F. for fresh water, below this for salt water. The upper observed limit in ponds is somewhere near 100 degrees.1 If the water is suddenly raised to this point, fishes survive but a few seconds. While the upper limit may be set by the effect of the increased heat on the protoplasm, its effect may be indirect and operate through the reduction in the amount of O held in suspension by the warm as compared with the cold water. That fishes will attempt any temperature is evidenced by the fact that they occasionally enter water in the National Park hot enough to boil them. The adaptability of fishes to different temperatures is well shown by Rhinichthys dulcis which is found in the streams coming from the warm springs at Banff in the Canadian National Park, and also in the icy waters of Vermilion Creek at the same place. The same individuals are adjustable within wide limits, and the same species is sometimes found over a long north and south range. Nevertheless, temperature has doubtless played an important part in setting a northern limit to the migration of species, as they followed the retreating ice of the glacial period. In North 1 Jordan and Richardson (Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus., 33 : 310-321) record Lucania browni from a hot spring with a temperature of 1 280 F. 1052 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY America a southward migration has probably not taken place since that time. Fishes of cold waters are primarily members of the families of salmon and trout, whitefish, miller's-thumb, and blackfishes. The check by cold has not been placed on any individual migration or limits set to the adult. Rkinickthys dulcis and the many species adapted to the great range of variation in the temperature in any of our temperate lakes shows this. The temperature factor de- termining distribution is set rather by the adaptation of the eggs to warm or cold water. Our trout, salmon, and whitefishes breed largely in winter when the temperature is low. The rate of de- velopment of their eggs, like that of all cold-water eggs, is slow. The warm-water species are warm-water species not because their individuals are incapable of entering cold water, for many of them do, but because their eggs will not develop in anything but water much warmer than that in which the eggs of cold-water species develop. Their eggs are of rapid development. They are ad- justed to fluctuations in temperature and they respond to such fluctuations in temperature by hastening or slowing their rate of development.1 The point of attack of temperatures is on the eggs and young, not on the adult, and temperature controls distribu- tion through its influence on the eggs. In all cold waters of the United States accessible to them, trout, salmon, and whitefish are found. Some of them, the brook trout, Rocky mountain whitefish, Coulter's whitefish and salmon, are adjusted to swift currents; others, the lake trout and many white fishes, to the stagnant waters of lakes. Some of the latter are littoral or abysmal or pelagic, depending on the nature of their food. The elevation of a stream has probably primarily nothing to do with the distribution of its inhabitants, but because elevated waters are usually cold (and frequently swift) all accessible moun- tain waters are inhabited by cold-water species. The number of species adjusted to cold waters is not as great and their affinities 1 The cod eggs which hatch in thirty days at a temperature of from 0.0-20 C. hatch in thirteen days in a temperature of 6-7.00. Herring eggs which require forty days at a temperature of 2-3.00 C. hatch in eleven at a temperature of 10-11.00; the shad which hatches in eleven days at a temperature of 13.50 hatches in three to five days in a temperature of from 20-230. j»u$; THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES 1053 are not as varied as those adjusted to the warmer, more accessible waters of the central and southern lowlands. The latter arc the homes of the black bass, sunfishes, catfishes, gar pikes, and others. So called warm-water species are capable of a wide range of adjustment to differing climates. Wherever a north and south river connects warmer with colder areas in which the species are otherwise different, the easy route of migration induces some species to extend their range into otherwise shunned areas. The Missis- sippi has induced a southward migration of several species beyond their normal range, the Nile has extended the equatorial African fauna to its mouth. But the most notable example is offered by the Madeira and Tapajos to Paraguay and La Plata waterway. It extends from the equator south to a latitude equal to that of Memphis. Nearly all of the fishes of Buenos Aires belong to Ama- zonian genera or even species. Only one or two Amazonian genera have succeeded in reaching the borders of the United States, Fifty Amazonian genera have reached the La Plata basin that have not succeeded in going an equal distance south on the Atlantic coast where they did not have the facilities or inducement of a continuous waterway. Current and Adjustment to It. — The major adaptation of all fresh-water fishes is to the locomotion of water. Most fishes stand head upstream, a position that makes the respiratory move- ment easiest in a current. Different fishes, and in some cases the same fishes at different seasons of the year, are adjusted to the entire range of variation in the intensity of the locomotion. Water- fails only are not inhabited by fishes, but even these are ascended or descended if not too high. Different specks of the Sabnonidae give as examples of the entire range of adjustment to current*. Some of them live only in the stagnant water of deep lakes. Other* live only in swift mountain brooks. The member* of the gemxt Cvrezamui usually Sve in the stagnant water* of Cakes, bat Cere- grmms cemtttri is found in a frwontain torrent, and the Tippe£aiK>e Cisco, which lives in the atagnaftt water of the lake dtrring the greater part of the year, runs op the tributaries in December. Other whftenshes and troat ha;ve the *ame habit. Liferent fishes are eroa adjusted to the dttfereoces m the same uaall stream m 1054 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY which quiet pools alternate with swift-flowing ripples. In the Mississippi Valley the riffles are occupied by darters, in Cuba by gobies, in South America by characins, and, although belonging to widely different families, they greatly resemble each other. Light and Adjustments to It. — In the shallower parts of clear water the fluctuations in light from day to night are but little less than in the air. Various fishes are variously adjusted to the Flo. 1545. Uog Sucker, Caloiltmiu nitritam Lc Sueur. Actual tat, 30s mm. long. light. Some are nocturnal, remaining hidden during the day, as the common catfish. Some combine stereotropism with their neg- ative heliotropism, and take shelter in crevices and under rocks. The light-shunning habit on the part of their ancestors doubtless accounts for the cave-inhabiting blindfishes of to-day. Some diurnal fishes habitually stay in the shade of some tree, or log, or pier, while others are found in the open. There seems to be a complete gradation between the blindfishes, which always live in Fro. 1S46. Hog Sucker, Catoitamu mtpkam Le Sueur. Actual Ac, 81 mm. lomj. total darkness, and those fishes, like some sunfishes, that live in total light, as far as this exists. The eye is not the only light-perceiving organ of aquatic verte- brates. The skin is sensitive to light in many cases. The blind- fishes, whose eyes are not functional and may be entirely removed, nevertheless appreciate the difference between light and dark. The young after having their eyes removed are as sensitive to THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES IO55 light as those with eyes, and the entire skin seems equally sensitive to light. The sight of the nocturnal fishes is worse than that of owls, and their eyes are but little used. The sight of the posi- tively heliotropic fishes, on the other hand, is good, their eyes are large and they depend on their eyesight for food. They capture living food and are frequently pelagic in habit. Small-mouthed fishes depending on their eyes for food will not take food that is at rest. Small fragments of meat falling through the water will readily be seized but will not be picked up from the bottom. The great variety of artificial flies and gyrating baits are man's adapta- tions to the fact that some large-mouthed fishes also select their food by sight. Depth and the Bottom, and Adjustments to Them. — No system- atic study of the bottoms of our lakes has been made and it is hence unknown how extensive the abysmal fauna is. In fishes ranging in deep water the adjustment is probably due not so much to the depth itself, as to the things that go with depth. Pressure increases one atmosphere with each thirty feet in depth, plants disappear beyond a few feet, and with the plants necessarily disap- pear all the animals (fish food for the most part), that are associ- ated with the plants. The character of the bottom is not a simple element like tem- perature, light, or current. There is a graduation from mud to gravel and rock and each of these may be weed-covered or bare. But whether the bottom is* mud, gravel, or rock depends on cur- rent. That certain species are found principally on one bottom or another is certain, but that the adjustment is to the character of the bottom and not to the current and food that go with it is doubtful. The Biological Environment and Adjustment to It. — Food is the controlling factor in the local distribution of fishes within any unit, as chemical composition and temperature are controlling factors in the geographical distribution among the different units. Food itself is dependent on other food and this ultimately on depth, nature of bottom, current, and the other elements of the physical environment. For the most part the food of the young in essentially different from the food of the adult of the same species, 1056 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY and consists of the organisms composing the plankton, largely Entomostraca. The members of a local fish fauna are distrib- uted in the following ecological: groups: pelagic, littoral (bottom fishes, all predacious fishes), and nocturnal. To these should be added abysmal fishes, but nothing is known of these in America except that Triglopsis is found in deeper water of the Great Lakes. Pelagic, abysmal, littoral, and nocturnal forms are such as find their food in those regions or times. Their adaptations are but secondary adjustments to the region in which their foocl is found. Everything eatable is food for some fishes though few have such omnivorous tastes as to take the entire bill of fare. The skipjack (Lapidestes) is a surface ranger and occupies as definite a position under the surface of the pelagic area of our lakes as the swallows do over it. Insects and all other minute terrestrial organic mat- ters reaching the surface of the water find a lodgment in their stomachs. Frequently the fish darts out of the water as the swallow dips into it to secure its food. Its food is not confined to terrestrial strays, but it also takes Entomostraca and Chironomus larvae. Zygonectes and Fundulus also range near the surface but nearer the shores. In the mountain lakes in which the skipjack is not found, the half -grown whitefish (Coregonus williamsoni) occu- pies the same ecological niche. In Lake Tahoe on June evenings individuals nine inches long rise to gnats blown into the lake, and they can then be caught with a minute hook baited with a fly. In the American tropics a killifish with half its eyes adapted to seeing in air and the other half adapted to seeing in water also ranges on the surface. Larger objects reaching the surface of the water are secured by black bass, trout, and other fishes that range and poise in deeper water and "rise" to their prey near the sur- face as the kingfisher dives for his. All fishes that rise to arti- ficial bait, grasshoppers, etc., belong to this group. Some trout rise more readily to a mouse but for esthetic reasons this cannot be recommended for bait. Another series of pelagic fishes is formed by the plankton feeders. There are several sorts of these. The young of most fishes, the sunfishes and minnows and some whitefishes, see their minute THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES IO57 prey and deliberately pick it from the water. Such are provided with teeth either in their mouths or in their gullets. Another series probably including the spoonbill catfish take in large quanti- ties of water and strain the plankton from it. They have weak teeth or none .and specially-adapted gill rakers for straining the water. The various darters, a peculiar American product, are all lit- toral. They rest on their pectorals on the bottom in shallow water. With head erect and eyes protruding they are ready for anything that moves within their range of vision. They are found among weeds and gravel, chiefly in flowing water so shallow that FlC. 1547. Johnny Darter, Battel the surface is rippled. Associated with them, or in places similar to these, in favorable localities, are miller's-thumbs. The pirate perch and trout perch should probably also be placed here. Other bottom fishes with sucker mouth and elongate alimentary canal are found over mud bottoms. These include Campostoma, suckers, carp, and sturgeon in North America. In tropical America their place is taken by peculiar armored relatives of the catfishes, the Loricariidae. Lastly, the large, predacious fishes treat the smaller fishes as they in their turn treat the plankton. Here be- long the muscalonge, the pickerels, salmon trout, and the basses. Our nocturnal catfishes and the ubiquitous eel are omnivorous. They take what they can. Everything that tastes or moves and is within reach is food for the nocturnal catfish. Some blindfishes planted in a pool had a way of disappearing that was mysterious, until the pool was drained and the sardonic catfish, lurking under a rock and found in possession of the last blindfish partly digested, solved the mystery. Fishes are adapted to their food in structure as well as habit. IO58 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY The dentition varies from none at all to the crushing apparatus of the white perch, the cutting incisors of some of the killifishes and the rasplike patches of the teeth of the muscalonge. The mouth varies in position, shape, and size according to the food, from the ventrally-placed sucker mouth to the upward-pointing mouth of Zygonectes; from the small mouth of the cisco to the capacious maw of the muscalonge. The gill-rakers vary from none to the com- plicated strainers of the spoonbill catfish. The alimentary canal also varies with the food from the short canal of the flesh eaters to the convoluted tube many times as long as the fish in the mud eaters. That fishes are a very adaptable group is shown by the fact that in South America a single family, the characins, have the widest range of adaptation in the alimentary canal to different food. Forbes has pointed out that the minnows of North America are adjusted to a great variety of food. He distinguishes four groups: (1) Intestine two to nine times as long as the fish, pharyn- geal teeth not hooked, with grinding surf ace. (2) Intestine one to one and two-thirds times as long as the fish, pharyngeal teeth hooked, with grinding surface. (3) Intestine somewhat shorter than the fish, teeth hooked, with grinding surface. (4) Intestine usually shorter than the head and body, teeth hooked, without grinding surface. Concerning the relation of these structures Forbes says: "It is consequently from a comparison of the ratios of these groups that we shall derive the most interesting facts relating to the correspondence of food and structure. The most conspicuous result is the great preponderance of mud in the intestines of the fishes of the first group, characterized by an extraordinarily elon- gate intestine, and by pharyngeal teeth destitute of hooks and pro- vided with a broad grinding surface. Here, as already noted, mud, sand, and gravel amount to about three-fourths of the mat- ter ingested, while in the third and fourth groups only trivial and accidental quantities occurred. In the second group, on the other hand, with intestines intermediate in length, mud was still abundant, but much less so than in the first, averaging less than half the whole. If we exclude this indigestible matter, however, we shall find the first group still further distinguished by the predominance of vegetation as compared with animal matter, the latter being THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES 1059 only about one-third the former, while in groups three and four, on the other hand, vegetation amounts to about one-third the animal food. The groups last mentioned, distinguished from each other as they are only by the presence of a masticatory surface on the pharyngeal teeth in the first, and its absence in the second, differ scarcely at all in their general food characters, and this structural feature seems therefore to be of little significance. In both the animal ratio amounts to seventy-five per cent, and vege- tation stands in each at twenty-five; while insects are respectively fifty and sixty-one/ ' Recently Putter has maintained that fishes absorb food in solu- tion in the water. He found that a goldfish lived for forty-one days in tap water which contained no organized food and the oxygen consumed substantially accounted for the loss in weight. When organic substances were dissolved in the tap water, the goldfish survived for seventy-eight days, and the oxygen consumed greatly exceeded the amount that would account for the loss in weight. Food according to its nature may be detected by sight, perception of vibrations, touch, smell, or taste. . Food is detected by sight in most fishes. Many fishes will seize an object that is in motion without discrimination as to what it is provided it is the right size. If it is suitable for food that fact is discovered by touch or taste, or both, in the mouth and the object is swallowed. If it is not fit for food it is rejected. It is evident that in such cases sight only locates the moving object, other senses distinguish its nature. Neither friend nor foe of the fishes discloses his presence by sound, but frequently does so by vibrations of lower frequency. It is extremely doubtful whether any sound produced over water is heard by fishes in the water. The sounds of the air are scarcely capable of passing the surface of the water to an extent to be per- ceived by an ear under water as highly developed as that of man. The ears of fishes are much more simple than those of man. The ability on the part of fishes to hear at all has been disputed, but Parker l has recently made experiments that show conclusively that fishes hear sounds produced under water. 1 Bull. U. S. Fish Corn., 22 : 45-64. 1060 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY In over half of our fresh-water fishes the air bladder is connected by a chain of ossicles with the ear. In some of them the air bladder comes in contact with the skin in an area just behind the head. The intercostal muscles are not developed at this place and a form of tympanum is thus produced. It has been suggested that this Weberian apparatus, as it is called, is in reality an auditory organ; that it is a static apparatus controlling the rising and sink- ing of the fish in water; that it is a manometer acquainting the fish with the degree of pressure that is exerted by the gases in the air bladder against its walls; that it is a barometer acquainting the fish with the variations in the atmospheric pressure; that it is a sound producer. Judged by its structure alone, in some forms the air bladder is divided into two small lateral parts connected with the ossicles, the rest of the air bladder having disappeared, it seems more than probable that it is an organ for the perception of sound. Vibrations of lower frequency than those producing sound, such as may be produced by waves or bodies falling into the water, are perceived by the lateral line organs of fishes. The lateral line organs of the head of the blindfishes are greatly exaggerated and their ability to perceive vibrations enables these fishes to secure living prey with precision. The lateral line organs of the head take the place of the eyes of pelagic fishes in detecting food. Fer- nandus Payne succeeded in getting an Atnblyopsis to respond to the water dripping into its aquarium. It would rise to the point where the drop of water struck and would try to seize it by snap- ping at it. Perception of vibrations by the lateral line organs of the head enabled it to locate the point of impact of the water. Touch, taste, or smell could have nothing to do with it. These fishes may touch recently-crushed amphipods on which they feed without paying any attention to them unless a stray leg is still moving. They will readily take meat attached to a string held in the hand to give it motion. Many fishes are conscious of the presence of food by perceiving it either through the sense of smell, touch, or taste. Parker has demonstrated that the catfish can detect minced earthworms by its sense of smell. The elaborate experiments of Herrick with THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES Io6l codfishes have shown that their sense of smell gives them but vague information, while the senses of touch and taste, whose organs are found over the entire body, enable the catfish to detect and secure any food coming in contact with any part of the body. In contrast to the blindfishes (Amblyopsis) of the Ohio Valley caves, the Point Loma blindfish secures its food through touch and taste. A hungry Point Loma blindfish with a stroke of the fins brings the mouth in position for operations as soon as any portion of its skin, especially of the head, comes in contact with food. Fish Enemies. — The enemies of fishes are the mink, otter, an occasional raccoon and cat among the mammals; the kingfisher, herons, ducks, loons, and terns among birds; an occasional bull- frog and possibly Necturus among batrachians; several snakes, and many fishes, spawn eaters, fry catchers, lampreys, and adult- eating, predacious fishes. The otter as a fish enemy has been practically eliminated. The occasional fish caught by the mink and raccoon will form but a small annual total. In fact, by the changes incident to advancing civilization, all but the aquatic enemies of the fishes have been reduced to a point where their depredations can have but little selective value. Fishes evidently could avoid terns and kingfishers by living below the few inches penetrated by these divers. But the advantages of food near the surface evidently outweigh the danger of being caught, as long as a sudden dive or a dart forward will enable the fish to escape. Herons and ducks are avoided by selecting water too deep for these enemies. Color and swiftness are probably other adapta- tions to the same enemies. The darter sits with outspread pec- torals on the bottom of a stream or lake within easy reach of a heron. A sudden motion of the powerful pectorals and he sits as composedly somewhere else. The dart-like motion which gives the darter its name is an adaptation to secure food and avoid enemies. Swiftness, inconspicuousness, or ability to enter retreats are the means of defense against the loon and his ilk. However, none of the devices are always efficient. The greatest enemy of fishes is the spawn stealer. At Lake 1062 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY Tahoe the dead trout eggs from the hatchery were daily thrown into the lake. While no fish might be in evidence a handful of trout eggs was sure to bring a bullhead (Cottus beldingi) from under every rock. The same thing happened when the young trout fry were planted in the brooks. The adaptations of the black bass, sunfish, and Amia against depredations in their nests have already been given. No doubt many young fishes are eaten by minnows and sunfishes. A half-starved sunfish captured in a cave began to pick out the larval blindfishes in his pail, with neat- ness and dispatch, as soon as there was light enough for it to see them. The herding or schooling of their young by many fishes, as an adaptation against enemies, has been described before. Against their predacious neighbors strength, agility, endurance, and color are the adjustments. The dispersal of a school and the leap out of the water, reaching its maximum in the flight of the flying fish, are all adaptations to escape specific attacks. Aside from these general adaptations in the habit, structural adaptations against fish-eating enemies are also found. The stickleback has divergent, erectile spines that can be locked when erected. This arrangement is altruistic rather than egoistic. While it does not prevent a duck or other animal from eating an occasional stickleback the duck is not likely to be tempted by a second stickleback. More effective weapons are the erectile dorsal and pectoral spines of the catfishes. In the stone cats the spine is surrounded by glandular tissue producing poison. The spine in entering an opponent pierces the gland and carries some of the poison into the wound. Color must be looked upon as an adjustment to light in the presence of enemies. The amount of color on the surface of a fish is proportionate to the intensity of the light in the environment. The arrangement of the color is conditioned by the surroundings. Its presence is an adaptation to the physical environment and its arrangement is an adaptation to the biological environment. All animals living for generations in caves become bleached and finally lose all pigment. Nocturnal fishes are in large measure black. Bottom fishes, like the darters, hog sucker, miller's-thumb, are mottled and crossbarred. Weed-inhabiting species are barred (yel- THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES IO63 low perch), striped (black bass), or mottled (pickerels, sunfishes, etc.). Large size and strength are the best adaptations against existing fish enemies. Small size and insignificance are advan- tageous for other reasons. Between these, alertness, with power of quick movement, and protective color are the most efficient means of escaping enemies. But all of these adaptations are not always sufficient. The most insidious of the fish enemies is the lamprey. So perfect is its means of attachment to its prey, that such a hard-scaled and vigorous fish as Amia calva can rarely prevent the attachment and adhesion, although the most violent efforts be made. If a lamprey is attached to a stone of moderate size, the stone is fre- quently brought out with the fish if the animal is jerked up sud- denly. In letting go its hold all that is necessary is to fill the disc with water from the respiratory bronchus, whereupon suction ceases and the animal is free. In feeding, the sharp teeth pressed against the skin of the animal to which it is attached naturally call the blood to the place. This hyperaemia is caused even more by the suction. At the same time the piston-like tongue with its powerful muscles and the saw-like teeth soon rasp a hole through the skin. The blood is then sucked from the fish and swallowed. The whole operation is something like the extraction of blood by a leech. The lamprey may remain upon a fish so long as the latter supplies sufficient nutriment. Sometimes the fish becomes ex- ceedingly pale and weak so that it floats near the surface. In such a case, the fishermen know immediately that there is a lam- prey attached to the fish, and, with a dip net, usually have no great trouble in catching both. The birds of prey also make this their opportunity and frequently carry off the floating fish, the lamprey sometimes remaining attached until it has been carried a consid- erable distance into the air. That the injury to the food fishes is very great may be inferred from the fact that sometimes out of fifteen catfish caught on a set line in one night, ten to twelve have great raw sores where lampreys have attacked them. In the spring, too, when the suckers (Catosto- mus) run up to spawn, very many of them carry a lamprey, and naturally by the great drain of blood it causes, the fish must be IO64 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY weakened, so that obstacles on the way to the spawning ground are less liable to be surmounted than if the fish were in full Vigor. In South America small catfishes live in the gills of larger catfishes. Origin of Adapted Faunas. — It has been shown that the major adaptations of fresh-water fishes were acquired by their ancestors before they were eligible to a fresh-water existence. The origin and modification of the cave fauna gives us a con- crete example of the change of location, resulting from predestined adaptation and of subsequent minor adaptations. Caves are at the present time being colonized by the immigration of salamanders of the genus Spelerpes and other animals that have become adapted to a cave existence through their habit of living in the dark under rocks, bark, and other similar places. The adaptation to the con- ditions of cave existence in this case determines the change of location when the opportunity arises. That minor adaptations will occur in these after they have become exclusively cave forms, is shown by the structure of the permanent cave salamanders of Missouri and Texas. These have in large measure lost their color and have degenerate eyes. A somewhat more complex example is furnished by the history of the Horse Cave River. At Horse Cave, Kentucky, a wide valley extends north and south. Tributary valleys come from the east and west. The hills bordering these valleys are limestone capped with sandstone. The north and south valley was formed by the Horse Cave River that originally flowed over sandstone like that capping the bordering hills. No doubt it had a fauna as varied as that of any surface stream. The stream cut first through the sandstone, then through the limestone. When it had reached the easily dis- solving limestone of the Kentucky caves and Green River had cut some distance below the surface of this, some part of its water, later more and more, found its way to the Green River by under- ground channels. To-day not a sign is seen on the surface of the streams that are responsible for the valley about Horse Cave. At least one of them rushes through lofty chambers one hundred eighty-five feet beneath the streets of Horse Cave City. With this change in the environment, with the disappearance of Horse THE AQUATIC VERTEBRATES 1065 Cave River from the surface, its inhabitants had to migrate. They moved in two directions to adapted environments. The shore fishes and channel fishes moved out to the Green River where their descendants live to the present day. The negatively heliotropic, nocturnal, or stereotropic fishes moved into the holes dissolved in the bottom of the river. Their descendants live, at the present time, in the stream below or within the valley. They are colorless and all but eyeless, and have, no doubt, acquired this exaggerated adaptation to their present abode since their immi- gration. But the major adaptation to the cave existence they possessed before the formation of the caves, and it was responsible for their migration to their present habitat. As was pointed out in the opening paragraphs, the fauna of the glaciated region of North America has similarly been derived by immigration from the south and possibly the ocean and Siberia to the north and west. The Great Lake Basin has but twenty-seven of its one hundred fifty-two species peculiar to itself; five are but varieties of more southern species and the remaining twenty-o«e more than represent the extent to which iu fauna has become adapted in this area for some of them 'eigjit Salmonidae and eight Cottidaej are cold-water species that may have fc>een crowded out of the region south of the basin by the encroaching heat after the passing of the glacial epoch. The selective migration to adapted locations must be added to the factors contributing to the origin of adapted faunas. This factor, "change of location." is as important to the origin of adapted faunas as the 'change of function" to the origin of adaptive structure*. Innumerable minor adaptations to heat, sediment. light. xcsA. and to the peculiar o->mbinarions found in each, selected locality have no doubt arisen in such localities. io66 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY IMPORTANT WORKS ON AQUATIC VERTEBRATES General Cambridge Natural History, edit, by S. F. Harmer and A. E. Shipley. Volumes: vn, Fishes; vm, Amphibia; v, Reptilia; DC, Birds; x, Mam- mals. London. Scharff, R. F. 191 2. Distribution and Origin of Life in America. New York. Bulletin of the U. S. Bureau of Fisheries; Washington, D. C. (Contains many articles on Fishes, Birds, and Reptiles.) Mammals Ingersoll, Ernest. 1007. The Life of Animals. The Mammals. New York. Seton, E. T. 1009. Life Histories of Northern Animals. 2 vols. New York. Stone, Wither, and Cram. 1002. American Animals. New York. Birds Chapman, F. M. 191 2. Birds of Eastern North America. New York. Coues, Elliott. 1003. Key to North American Birds. Boston. Ridgway, Robert. Birds of North and Middle America. Bulletin U. S. Nat. Mus., No. 50. Part I, 1001; Part II, 1002; Part III, 1904; Part IV, 1907; Part V, 191 1. Reptiles Cope, E. D. 1898. Crocodilians, Lizards, and Snakes of North America. Ann. Rep. Smithsonian Inst., pp. 153-1270. Ditmars, R. L. 1907. Reptile Book. New York. Amphibia Cope,E. D. 1889. The Batrachia of North America. Bull. U. S. Nat. Mus., 34: 1-525. Dickerson, Mary C. 1006. Frog Book. New York. Fishes Jordan, D. S. 1005. Guide to the Study of Fishes. New York. Jordan, D. S., and Evermann, B. W. 1896-1000. The Fishes of North and Middle America. Bull. U. S. Nat. Mus., No. 47. 4 Parts. 1902. American Food and Game Fishes. New York. A number of admirable state lists have been published on Mammals, Birds, and Fishes. Nominally confined to a single sUte, they are useful over a much wider territory. CHAPTER XXXI TECHNICAL AND SANITARY PROBLEMS By GEORGE C. WHIPPLE Pnftn* ef Smmtmry Engimmmg, Hmnmrd Ummtrsity There are several very practical problems of fresh-water biology which deserve consideration, and which will be treated briefly in this chapter. They relate chiefly to some of the smallest organisms found in fresh water, — the bacteria and the plankton. There are other problems, to be sure, which have to do with larger organisms, but most of these have been referred to in the various chapters which have gone before. First and foremost is the problem of disease transmission. Patho- genic bacteria are not normally present in natural fresh waters, but rivers and lakes in inhabited regions are subject to pollution with the excrement of animals and human beings and such excre- mentitious substances are liable to contain the germs of disease. The adoption of the water carriage system of sewerage about the middle of the nineteenth century greatly increased these chances of fresh-water contamination. Water which contains excrementi- tious matter or bacteria of fecal origin may be said to be con- taminated; if bacteria are actually present the water is said to be infected. The most noteworthy diseases which are water-borne are typhoid fever, Asiatic cholera, and dysentery, but there arc other water-borne diseases, for contaminated water may contain the spores of other bacteria, molds, and the ova of parasitic worms. Fresh water also may serve as a medium within which mosquito larvae grow and from which mosquitoes emerge. Special kinds of mosquitoes [day an important part in the transmission of yellow fever and certain other diseases. Then there may be indirect as well as direct relations between man and the microorganisms found in water. Microscopic organisms form the basis of the food supply of fjglip* and thus indirectly contribute to human sustenance. Oysters 1067 1068 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY feed chiefly upon diatoms. The smaller Crustacea feed upon bacteria and minute algae and protozoa, and are, in turn, devoured by larger organisms. In the public water supplies the appearance of algae and proto- zoa in large numbers is the occasion of complaint by the water consumers, for these organisms make the water unsightly and ill smelling. They also clog filters and increase the cost of water purification. Water as a Conveyor of Disease Germs. There are few if any bacteria pathogenic to human beings which are naturally found in fresh waters. Trouble comes only when waters become infected with pathogenic bacteria derived from other human beings or from animals. Such bacteria do not thrive and multiply in natural waters so far as is now known but are merely mechanically trans- ported by water. Furthermore, instead of multiplying in water pathogenic bacteria tend to decrease in numbers after the time of infection. This is an important practical matter as it greatly affects the safety of all public water supplies. For example, a rapidly flowing stream may convey infection for long distances in a short time, while, on the other hand, a lake or public reservoir may store the water for so long a time that there is opportunity for dangerous bacteria to die. The longevity of pathogenic bacteria in water depends upon many things among which may be included the original character of the bacteria themselves, the temperature of the water, the oppor- tunities for sedimentation and destruction by other organisms, the effect of sunlight, etc. Using general figures it may be said that under average conditions about 70 per cent of typhoid fever bac- teria will disappear the first week, 90 per cent during the first two weeks, and 99 per cent during six weeks. They will live longer in cold water than in warm water.* That is why most of the water-borne typhoid fever epidemics have occurred during the cold months of the year. The spirillum of Asiatic cholera is known to behave in a similar manner but less is known in regard to the rate at which it dies. There is some reason to believe that it has a shorter life in water than the typhoid fever bacillus. There is a group of bacteria presumably of intestinal origin which give TECHNICAL AND SANITARY PROBLEMS IO69 rise to dysentery and various diarrhoeal disturbances. Presumably these bacteria behave in the same manner as the typhoid fever bacillus. The routine methods of bacteriology at the present time do not permit of a trustworthy determination of the above-mentioned pathogenic bacteria. It is true that in some instances such have been isolated from water but the process is a difficult one and nega- tive results are of little value. This being the case, modern sani- tarians do not attempt to determine the safety of water by searching for these pathogenic organisms. Instead they make tests to determine the presence and abundance of an organism which is commonly found in the intestines of man and warm blooded flninralf generally known as bacillus coli. This test can be made with a fair degree of reliability and it is much used. B. Coli as an Index oj Contamination. Unpolluted ground waters contain practically no B. coli but in proportion as waters are subject to contamination with excremental substances the numbers of B. coli increase. All surface waters are likely to contain these germs, but in unpolluted sources, such as uninhabited woodland areas, the numbers are very small indeed. Even the broad waters of the Great Lakes contain B. coli in small numbers though very often they are absent from the quantities usually used in the test. Rivers which drain farm lands contain B. coli in larger numbers; streams and fresh waters which receive sewage contain them in still larger numbers. B. coli, therefore, may be fairly regarded as a valuable index of fecal contamination. This is so far true that the U. S. government has established bacteriological standards for drinking water served by interstate carriers which includes a permissible limit for the number of B. coli. As stated by the U. S. Public Health Service, waters in which B. coli are absent from two out of five portions of 10 cc. may be used, but waters in which B. coli is found in three or more out of five to cc. portions would be con- demned. The dividing line apparently comes at a figure which is about 150 B. coli per liter of water. The whole subject of B. coli in water, the methods of its determination, and the interpretation of its results is one which is now going through a series of evolu- tionary changes. The reader is therefore referred to current 1070 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY scientific bacteriological literature and especially to the papers which appear in the American Journal of Public Health. Numbers of Bacteria in Water. There are two general methods used for determining the numbers of bacteria in water. By the first method nutrient gelatine is used as the culture medium and the period of incubation is 48 hours at 200 C. According to the second the media is nutrient agar and the period of incubation is 24 hours at 370 C. Both of these methods are useful but the gela- tine method has been used more than the other. Neither metnod gives absolute results; the figures are relative in both cases. The numbers of bacteria as determined by the gelatine count vary all the way from less than 100 in relatively clean waters to many thousands in waters which are dirty and polluted. For drinking purposes it is generally considered that the number of bacteria determined by this method should be less than 100 per cc. The numbers of bacteria in streams vary greatly according to the rainfall. Very heavy rains wash the surface of the ground and increase the numbers of bacteria in the drainage water. The sew- age of cities contains anywhere from a few hundred thousand to several million bacteria per cc. These bacteria are of many sorts, but most of them are saprophytic in character and in water which contains organic matter, even in small amounts, they are likely to multiply enormously in the course of a day or two. Hence bac- terial counts mean nothing unless the samples are examined im- mediately after collection. They also mean little unless the bacteriologist has a knowledge of the character of the waters. Removal of Bacteria from Water. The best method of removing bacteria from water is the process of filtration. There are two general methods in use at the present time, slow sand filtration and mechanical filtration. In the former process the water is filtered slowly downward through a bed of sand at such a rate that the water above the sand descends ten to twenty feet in the course of a day. By sedimentation within the pores of the sand bed and by the adhesion of the bacteria to the sand grains at or just below the surface of the filter the bacteria are removed from the water. The process is partly physical, partly biological. The method is capable of removing upwards of 99 per cent of bacteria from moderately *& TECHNICAL AND SANITARY PROBLEMS 1071 polluted waters and experience has shown that the waters are thereby rendered entirely safe for drinking. By the mechanical system of filtration the water is first coagu- lated by the use of chemicals and then filtered rapidly through a small bed of relatively coarse sand at rates which are 20 and 40 times as great as in the case of slow sand filtration. This process is likewise effective in the removal of bacteria. The choice of the two systems depends upon the amount of turbidity and color of the water and upon its hardness and upon various local conditions of an engineering character. After water has been filtered it must be stored in the dark; other- wise algae and other microscopic organisms are likely to develop and become troublesome. Bacteria in water may be killed by the use of liquid chlorine, bleaching powder, ozone, and similar substances. These are poison- ing processes. The quantities of chemicals used are so small that they may be used with entire safety but it is necessary that the chemicals be thoroughly and quickly mixed with water in order to assure efficient sterilization. These processes are especially valuable in cases of emergency and are not to be regarded as substitutes for filtration. Swimming pools should be disinfected regularly in order to prevent the transfer of pathogenic bacteria from person to person. Sewage may be treated in various ways to remove bacteria and other objectionable substances. The processes used are screening, sedimentation, chemical precipitation, intermittent sand filtration, contact beds, trickling filters, and disinfection. There are many biological problems involved in these processes and especially in intermittent sand filters and trickling filters. Bacteria play an important part in the disintegration and ultimate absorption of putresdble organic matter while in trickling filters worms and various larvae assist in the process. Tastes and Odors in Water Supplies. Water supplies derived from surface sources and stored in reservoirs frequently develop tastes and odors that are very unpleasant. These are largely due to the growth of algae and other microscopic organisms. The matter is one of very considerable importance to waterworks superintend- IO72 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY ents, and much attention has been given to the study of these growths during recent years. This study has resulted in success- ful measures for destroying the organisms by the use of chemicals and for removing the organisms and the odors produced by them by aeration and filtration. Very little success, however, has been achieved in preventing the organisms from growing. Chemically pure water is free from taste and odor. Water con- taining certain substances, as for example sugar or salt, may have a decided taste but no odor. On the other hand water may con- tain substances, like vanilla, that have a strong odor but no taste. The two senses, though distinct, are closely related to each other. Most of the bad tastes observed in drinking waters are due to organisms that produce odors rather than tastes. Most surface waters contain some organic matter and have a vegetable or earthy odor. When decomposing organic matter is present the odors may be foul and disagreeable. These odors may be classified in three general groups: — (i) those caused by organic matter other than living organisms; (2) those caused by the de- composition of organic matter; and (3) those caused by living organisms. Observation of Odor. The odor of cold water is best observed by shaking a partly filled bottle of the water and immediately remov- ing the stopper and applying the nose. The odor of hot water is ob- tained by heating a portion of it in a tall beaker covered with a watch glass to a point just short of boiling. When sufficiently cooled the cover is slipped aside and the observation quickly made. The intensity of odors is commonly indicated by numbers as follows: — o, no odor; 1, a very faint odor that would not be ordinarily de- tected by a person drinking the water; 2, a faint odor that might be detected by the consumer but that would not attract any spe- cial attention; 3, a distinct odor that would be readily detected; 4, a decided odor, strong enough to make the water unpalatable^ 5, a very strong odor that would make the water unfit for use. The character of the odor is usually indicated by a letter which stands for a descriptive adjective. For purposes of record the two are combined. Thus $f indicates a distinct fishy odor; 2V, a faint vegetable odor; 4m, a decided moldy odor. Heating usually TECHNICAL AND SANITARY PROBLEMS 1073 intensifies an odor. In water analysis it is common to report the odor of both hot and cold water. Cause of Odors. The odors are caused by aromatic oils that are produced during the growth of the microscopic organisms. After disintegration the oily substances are scattered through the water. In many instances the oils are characteristic of the organisms and the presence of organisms in water can sometimes be determined merely by the 9dor. They cannot always be thus recognized, however, for the quality of an odor changes with its intensity. Cer- tain organisms present in small numbers impart to the water an odor that might be termed aromatic, but when the same organisms are present in larger numbers the odor might be more properly de- scribed as fishy. The amount of oily matter required to produce a noticeable odor is very small. The oily substance that gives Synura its odor is recognizable when diluted to the extent of one part in twenty-five million parts of water. This is not surpris- ing, however, as the oil of peppermint can be recognized in a dilution of one part in fifty million parts of water. The odors of organisms are intensified by heating, by mechanical agitation, by a change in the density of the water, by pressure, and by any other cause that tends to rupture the cell walls and liberate the oil globules. The following table gives the natural odor of a number of the common microscopic organisms. For convenience they may be grouped around three general terms, aromatic, grassy, and fishy. The aromatic odors are due chiefly to diatoms, one of the strongest being that produced by AsUrwneUa. Some of the green algae produce sweetish, grassy odors, and this is even more true of the blue-green algae. Anabaena produce an odor that varies greatly according to its dilution, and various epithets have !>een applied to it- The fishy odors are the most disagreeable of any observed in drinking water, and that produced by Uroglena is j>erliaps the worst. The water that contains this organism in large numbers may have an odor resembling that of cod liver oil. 'I 'he odor of Synura is almost as bad and even more common. When organisms decay moldy or musty odors may be produced. But these odors of de- composition are less characteristic than the odors of growth. Some 1074 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY of the blue-green algae have odors suggestive of the pig pen, doubt- less because of their high nitrogen content. Group Aromatic Odor Grassy Odor Fishy Odor Organism DlATOMACEAE Asterionella Cyclotella Diatoma Meridiem Tabellaria Protozoa Cryptomonas Mallomonas Cyanophyceae Anabaena Rivularia Clathrocystis Coelosphaerium Aphankomenon Chlorophyceae Volvox Eudorina Pandorina Dictyosphaerium Protozoa Uroglena Synura Dinobryon Bursana Peridinium Glcnodinium Natural Odor Aromatic — geranium — fishy Faintly aromatic Faintly aromatic Aromatic Aromatic. Candied violets Aromatic — violets — fishy Grassy and moldy — green-corn — nas- turtiums, etc. Grassy and moldy Sweet, grassy Sweet, grassy Grassy Fishy Faintly fishy Faintly fishy Faintly fishy Fishy and oily Ripe cucumbers — bitter and spicy taste Fishy, like rockweed Irish moss — salt marsh — fishy Fishy, like clam-shells Fishy Prevention of Growths of Algae. Various means have been used to prevent the growth of algae in reservoirs and standpipes. Some of these, such as the exclusion of sunlight, are snecessful but most of them afford only a partial remedy. Soil Stripping of Reservoir Sites. The removal of the vegetation and top-soil from the ground that forms the floor of a reservoir tends to reduce the amount of the organic and mineral matter available for the food supply of the organisms and thus tends to diminish their number. In a number of instances, notably the reservoirs that supply the city of Boston, the soil has been carefully removed from the reservoir sites before the reservoirs were filled. This has tended to reduce the growths of algae during the first few TECHNICAL AND SANITARY PROBLEMS 1075 years after construction, but it has been found t' at the effect of this "soil stripping" is not always permanently successful and that in the course of a few years heavy growths of organisms have some- times occurred. Where the reservoir sites are not thus cleaned growths of algae are likely to be heavy during the first few years after construction, diminishing, however, with time. The benefits from soil stripping occur chieliy during the tirst few years after con- struction. Whether or not there is economy in removing the soil from the bottom of the reservoir depends upon local conditions. Often it is advisable. In some cases it will be found cheaper not to strip the reservoir bottom but to apply the money that would be thus expended towards a hlter plant. Swamp Drainage. The presence of swamps on a catchment area tends to foster the growth of algae and similar organisms. If these are located above a reservoir they may seed the reservoir and thus increase the number of organisms likely to be found there. The quality of the water may be improved in some instances by draining the swamps, thus diminishing the chances of the reservoir becoming seeded and decreasing the amount of organic food supply in the water. When reservoirs are constructed it not infrequently happens that pools are left with no outlet. Organisms may develop rapidly in such pools and be washed into the reservoir after a rain. So far as possible reservoirs should be self-draining. Elimination of Siwliow Flowagc. In the construction of reservoirs efforts should be made to reduce the area over which the water stands with a depth of less than ten feet. Kor in these areas of shallow flowage aquatic plants are likely to become seated and may serve as a nidus for various organisms that ultimately become scattered through the reservoir and give trouble. Cases occur where it is wise to strip the soil from the areas of shallow flow- age without attempting to strip the soil from the entire reservoir bottom. Prevention of Pollution. Like other plants the algae in water grow best when fertilized. Nitrogen, potash, phosphates, and sim- ilar substances stimulate their growth. Polluted waters are. there- fore, more likely to develop objectional growths of algae than the same waters unpolluted. The elimination of pollution from a 1076 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY catchment area is desirable not only for sanitary reasons but also for lessening the growths of algae. Aeration. One of the elements of food supply required by algae is carbonic acid, which is present to some extent in all surface waters but is likely to be especially abundant in swampy and pol- luted waters, and wherever organic matter is undergoing decay. The stagnant water at the bottom of a reservoir, for example, usu- ally contains large amounts of carbonic acid. The amounts of carbonic acid may be considerably in excess of saturation, so that when the water is exposed to the air the gas escapes. Thus the process of aeration tends to reduce the likelihood of the occurrence of heavy growths of algae. Aeration also tends to reduce the odors of the water as the exposure of the water to the air gives opportunity for the escape or volatilization of the essential oils. Sometimes natural conditions of aeration exist and are very beneficial, when water flows rapidly over the rocky bed of a stream. Chemical Treatment. With our present knowledge little can be done in the way of treating the water chemically to prevent the growth of algae. It is possible that the application of lime to reduce the free carbonic acid in the water would be of some benefit but this has never been practically used. Chemical treatment has been successful in destroying organisms as referred to below. Exclusion of Light. The exclusion of light from a reservoir is an effective remedy in preventing the growth of algae. This can- not be done in large reservoirs but in small reservoirs and in stand- pipes it has proved very successful. In cases where ground water that contained large amounts of plant food has been exposed in open reservoirs algae growths have been very troublesome, and it has been found that covering the reservoir or standpipe in which the water is stored completely prevents the trouble. It has become an axiom, therefore, among waterworks men that ground waters should not be stored in the light. Methods of Kitting Algae. Various methods have been suggested for killing algae in reservoirs, such as copper sulphate, bleaching powder, ozone, and creosote. Of these copper sulphate has proved to be by far the most effective. Quantities as small as one part in one million by weight, and sometimes even smaller quantities, have TECHNICAL AND SANITARY PROBLEMS 1077 been found sufficient to destroy the algae. The amount required depends upon the kind of organisms present, and the amount and character of the other organic matter. Copper sulphate is applied to a reservoir by putting crystals of the salt in a gunnysack, or coarse bag, and dragging it around the reservoir after a boat, letting it dissolve in the water as it will. Preferably this should be done while the wind is blowing, and when the water is in a state of some agitation, so as to obtain a rapid dissemination of the solution through the water of the reservoir. Unless care is exercised in this regard there is danger that fish may be killed, and in any case there is always danger that some fish may be killed. The method, there- fore, is one that should not be used by one whose experience and judgment is insufficient. The copper sulphate treatment is not always entirely successful* Sometimes after one kind of an organism has been destroyed by its use some other organism will appear and be more troublesome than the first. A single treatment of a reservoir with copper sul- phate therefore does not always suffice, and when a second dose is required it is usually necessary to use larger quantities than the first time. Purification of Water Containing A I gat. Water that contains algae may be purified by filtration, though the ordinary processes may require some modification, depending upon the number and char- acter of the organisms present. One of the essential elements of successful filtration is that the water shall always contain a sufficient quantity of oxygen throughout the process. Aeration, therefore, may be necessary before or after filtration or both. It may be accomplished by spraying the water into the air so that it falls in drops, or by exposing it in thin films as it passes over a weir with a considerable fall through the air. Generally speaking an exposure from one to two seconds is necessary and sufficient As an illustration of successful purification of a water heavily laden with algae may be mentioned the old Ludlow supply of Spring- field, Massachusetts, which during the summer contained very heavy growths of Anabaena. The method employed was inter- mittent sand filtration, similar to that commonly used for the treat- ment of sewage. The water was first a£raUxl and allowed to spread IO78 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY over the sand filter, which was built without cover as it was used only during warm weather. After rapid percolation through the sand it was collected in well ventilated under-drains. After the water had passed through the sand the beds were allowed to stand exposed to the air so that they themselves became well aerated. This method almost completely did away with the obnoxious odors that had previously existed in the water supply of the city. In this instance the part played by aeration was very important as experi- ments had shown that the water could not have been filtered satis- factorily by the ordinary processes of slow sand filtration. Mechanical filtration is also sometimes employed for the treat- ment of algae laden water. Used in connection with aeration this method may prove reasonably satisfactory, but special care must be given to maintaining conditions of aeration throughout the process. Sand filters are capable of satisfactorily removing the algae and their accompanying tastes and odors if the growths are not too heavy. The presence of algae in water tends to clog both sand filters and mechanical filters to an unusual extent and increases the loss of head, and, therefore, shortens the period of service and in general increases the cost of filtration. Where water is stored before filtration, or where it passes through settling basins copper sul- phate is sometimes used as an auxiliary process antecedent to filtration. Self-Purification of Streams. Various microscopic organisms play an important part in the self-purification of streams. It has long been known that rivers polluted by sewage and other waste substances regain their purity to a considerable extent during their subsequent flow. Various influences combine to bring about this result, such as the natural death of pathogenic bacteria in an un- favorable environment, the effect of sunlight, sedimentation of suspended matter, oxidation of organic matter brought about with the assistance of bacteria, and, what is of interest here, by the effect of microscopic organisms. The cycle of changes by which nitroge- nous matter is broken down by bacterial action and by which the bacteria are destroyed by protozoa and other larger organisms, the protozoa being devoured by rotifers and Crustacea, and these in :-« ■ ■■*» TECHNICAL AND SANITARY PROBLEMS 1079 turn being devoured by fish, is a biological phenomenon of great practical importance. In this way natural streams succeed in cleansing themselves so that waters once foul become clear and attractive in appearance. An excellent illustration of these biological changes is the Genesee river below the city of Rochester. This river now receives practi- cally all of the sewage of the city at a point about six miles distant from Lake Ontario. Below this point the river receives few acces- sions. Studies made during the summer of 191 2 showed that the effect of the discharge of the sewage into the river was to increase the number of bacteria and reduce the number of green algae. Im- mediately below the sewer there was a further increase in bacteria and a reduction of the dissolved oxygen in the water. A mile or two down stream the bacteria began to decrease and protozoa in- creased. At the mouth of the river the rotifers disappeared but Crustacea were found in abundance in the lake water around the river mouth. Beyond one-quarter of a mile from the river mouth, however, the Crustacea also showed a noticeable decrease. The chemical changes that accompanied these biological conditions were equally interesting. Below the entrance of the sewage the dissolved oxygen in the water almost disappeared but later increased. As the dissolved oxygen decreased the carbonic acid in the water increased. At the river mouth there was an under run of the lake water back into the river due to the lower temperature of the water in the lake. Algae also assist in self purification of streams and lakes by liber- ating dissolved oxygen. Sometimes the growth of algae is so rapid and the quantity of oxygen produced is so large that supersatura- tion occurs. This commonly takes place in lakes in the region of the thermocline, as Birge and Juday have well shown. How great a factor this oxygen production may be is probably not yet realized by sanitarians to its full extent. Microscopic organisms in streams are also useful in removing the effects of pollution by manufacturing wastes. On the other hand some kinds of trade wastes are of such a character that they tend to destroy microscopic life; such are acid or strongly alkaline wastes, and wastes containing arsenic, copper, and other poisonous 1080 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY substances. Even the wastes containing inert suspended mattti may interfere with microscopic life along the shores by smothering the tiny vegetable and animal cells. Oily wastes, such as the wastes from gas works, may produce films upon the surface of a stream; they then interfere with the absorption of oxygen by the water from the air and thus exert a prejudicial influence on the natural agencies of purification. It is for these reasons that the discharge of trade wastes into streams is a matter that is seriously in need of regulation. The wastes from manufacturing establish- ments are often more objectionable even than domestic sewage. Perhaps the worst conditions arise when streams are polluted both with domestic sewage and with trade wastes. Identification of the Source of Water. Another practical applica- tion of the microscopical examination of water is that of determin- ing the origin of certain waters. One of the studies made in con- nection with the celebrated Chicago drainage canal case was a series of microscopical examinations of water from Lake Michigan down the Illinois and Mississippi rivers to St. Louis. It was found that certain varieties of organisms were present in the water of Lake Michigan that could not be found in any of the tributary streams, and the argument was made that as these same organisms were found in the water supply of St. Louis taken from the Missis- sippi river they must have been derived from Lake Michigan, showing that some of the water supplied to St. Louis came from Lake Michigan through the Chicago drainage canal and the rivers men- tioned. The studies made at Rochester in 191 2 showed that the water near the surface of Lake Ontario contained various microscopic organisms that could be readily identified but that these were absent from the lower strata. Serial studies made at the shore of the lake sometimes showed the presence of these organisms but at certain times they were absent. The inference was that on these days the water at the shore was that which had been drawn shoreward from the deep strata. This finding corroborated the temperature obser- vations and the wind records, and proved that the effect of a strong off-shore wind was to blow the surface water away from the shore and draw in the cold deep water from the lake. ■*■»■*»■ TECHNICAL AND SANITARY PROBLEMS Io8l Ground waters normally do not contain microscopic organisms, and when these are found in ground waters a natural inference is that a ground water has been contaminated with surface water. Thus the microscopical examination of ground water is sometimes useful in determining questions of pollution. Organisms in Pipes of Water Systems. When surface water which contains algae and other microscopic organisms is allowed to flow through pipes, as in the distribution systems of public water supplies, it frequently happens that the pipes become more or less choked with what is popularly called pipe-moss. Sometimes this pipe-moss acquires a thickness of several inches and forms a mat upon the inside of the pipes which materially reduces their carrying capacity. The organisms which give trouble of this character are chiefly the Polyzoa, Plumatella, Paludicella, and PectinaieUa. Fresh- water sponges are also found in pipes and masonry aqueducts. Snails, worms, and various Crustacea may be found associated with these moss growths. Dr. Thresh of London has described the occurrence of fresh-water mussels in a thirty-six inch pipe which attained such a growth that the bore was reduced to nine inches. It is evident that the pipe dwelling organisms depend upon the plankton for their food supply. The above-mentioned growths do not occur in pipes which carry water which has been filtered or ground water, which contains no microscopic organisms. There is another organism sometimes found in ground waters which contain salts of iron and magnesia, namely Crenotkrix. There are three distinct varieties of this organism. One of these deposits manganese in its gelatinous sheath, another deposits iron, while the other deposits alumina. All of them grow best in waters somewhat deficient in dissolved oxygen. Crencthrix grows on the walls of the pipes in tufts of filaments. The filaments become attached and are found in the water discharged from the faucets. The iron which impregnates the gelatinous sheaths that surround the cells causes trouble in laundries. Clothes washed in such water acquire rusty stains difficult to remove. Crenothrix is sometimes found associated with the pipe-moss above mentioned. Pipe-moss may be removed from a distribution system of a water supply by flushing, but the best practice is to prevent the growths IO82 FRESH-WATER BIOLOGY from forming by using filtered water instead of water laden with plankton. Plankton and Fish Life. The occurrence of plankton in natural waters has a definite and direct bearing upon the occurrence of fish life. Algae and protozoa and such organisms play an important part in the cycle of changes which extend from the decomposition of organic matter by bacteria to the food supply of man. This cycle may be followed through the several elements of organic matter, namely, nitrogen, carbon, sulphur, and phosphorus. The proteid products of metabolism are consumed by bacteria; bacteria are eaten by protozoa and the nitrate formed by bacterial action in the presence of oxygen is utilized as food by algae; algae and proto- zoa are consumed by rotifers and Crustacea and these latter form the basis of the food of many fish. Some fish are provided with special mechanisms for straining the plankton from the water, a notable instance of this being the menhaden, a salt-water fish which swims with its mouth open. The water enters through the mouth and passes out through the gills, while the organisms that are thus removed are carried to the stomach. The late Professor Peck showed by experiments at Woods Hole that the abundance and size of the menhaden are closely related to the abundance of plankton. Similarly oysters have been shown to be dependent upon the occurrence of diatoms in the waters which flow over the oyster beds. Experiments made by the writer in the Great South Bay, Long Island, showed that the best oyster beds were located near mud flats where diatom life abounded. Intimately connected with the occurrence of the plankton and the bacteria associated with decomposition of organic matter is the presence or absence of dissolved oxygen and carbonic acid in the water of lakes at different depths, and fluctuations in the occur- rence of these gases profoundly affect fish life. If the amount of organic matter at the bottom of a lake or pond is large the water below the thermocline may lose most of its oxygen during periods of stagnation. It is impossible for fish to live under such conditions, so that lakes and ponds which undergo stagnation are not likely to contain such fish as naturally seek the colder water found only at great depths during the summer. Thus it is seen that plankton .»■.,».. it. TECHNICAL AND SANITARY PROBLEMS 1083 studies and determinations of the amount of oxygen and carbonic acid in stagnation may be a valuable guide to a fish commission in determining the advisability of stocking certain lakes with certain fish. The study of limnology is a matter of great practical impor- tance to the human race. INDEX All technical terms and all scientific names are included, but only major references to are given. Important cross icfcreuces are grouped together after other entries under a given term. All figures refer to text pages. Sped tic names are printed in italics and follow in alphabetic order the name of the genus to which the species belong; the generic name is printed in italics only when it occurs exclu- sively in a binomial combination and no reference is made to the genus alone. Abedus, 933 Abothrium, 431; crass mm, 431 Acanthiidae, 933 Acanthocephala, 16, 365, 416. 506-510, 542- 551; key, 545-SSi: lemnisci, 543- bi« history, 544, proboscis. 542. p.- sheath, 543, references, 552: see Gordiacea; Nema- tode (Parasitic); Parasitic Roundworms Acanthocephalus, 547; ramac, 547 Acanthochasmtdat:, 391 Aamthochasmus oonmarium, 391 Acanthocirrus, 445 Acanthocystis, 236; ckactophora, 236 Acantholeberis, 710; curvirostris, 710 Acella, 981 Acetabular 425 Achnanthaceae, 130 Achnanthes, 130; exilis, 130 Achromadora, 490; minima, 490 Acilius, 941 Acineta, 300; fiuviaiUis, 300 Acinetactis, 244; mirabtiis, 244 AcmosUmutm crenulaium, 361, 364 Acoletdae, 447 Acoleus, 447 ; ormolus, 447 Acrobeles, 495 Acrodactyla, 396 Acrolichanus, 396; linioni, 396, petalosa, 396 Acroloxus. 985 Acroperus, 718, angustaius. 719. karpac, 719 Actinastrum, 159; kantzsckii, 159 Actinobdella, 655; anmectens, 655, inequian- nuiaia, 655 Actinobolus, 271; radians, 271 Actinolaimus, 485; radiaius, 485 Actinolophus, 234; minutus, 234 Actinomonas, 243; vernalis, 243 Actinophrys, 234; sol, 217. 234 Actinopoda, 234 Actinosphaerium. 234; eichkomii, 213. 234 Acuaria, 526; ordcae. 527, triaenucha, 52G Aciiariinae, 526 Acydus, 61 1 ; mguieius, Gi 1 Adaptations of aquatic animals, 1022 Adineta, 619; vaga, 619 Aeolosoma, 638: kempricki, 638. ttnebrarmm, 638 Aeolosomatidae. 638 Aerobes, obligatory: see Bacteria Aeronemum. 164; poiymarpimm, 164 Aeschna (imago). 925. (nymph), 930 Agabetes (adult). 942 Agabus (adult J. 941 Agamodistomum, 411; apodis, 411 Agamodistomum stage of Cercaria rubra, 420 Agamomermis. 520 Agamonema, 520; capsularia. 521, papH- Uterum, 521. piscium, 521 Age aeries of ponds, 49 Akinete. 1x8 Alaimus. 499: simplex, 499 Alasmidonta. 1005; arcmia, 1007. caimin, 1006. margmata, 1006. undulata, 1006 Alasmidonta s. s.. 1006 Albertiu. 589: inirusor. 589 Albia. 867; siaiionis. 867 Alexia, 978; seiifer, 978 Algae. 13: methods of killing, 1076. preven- tion of growths. 1074. purification of water containing. 1077; see Algae. Blue-Green; Algae, Fresh-Water, excl. of Blue-Green Algae, Blue-Green (Cyanophyceae). Fresh- Water. 100-114; color. 102. cyanophycin granules, 102. heterocysts. 103. key. 104- 114, phycocyanin, 102. 117. references. 114, thermal springs, life of. 101 , vacuoles. 103, "water-bloom." 114; see Algae; Algae. Fresh-Water, excl. of Blue-Green Algae. Fresh-Water, excl. of Blue-Green. 115- 177; abundance. 121. akinete. 118. art- theridium. 119. antherozoid. 119. aplano- spores. 118, centric forms. 126, chromato- phores. 11G. cultures, 123, and mediums of. 124. diatomin. 117, disc -shaped chroma- tophores. 11G. filamentous. 121. forms. 115, gametes. 119. key. 125-177. lift- history. 122, occurrence. 122. oogonium. 119. oospore, 119. pahnella condition. 115. phycocyanin, 0B5 io86 INDEX 117, phycoery thrin, 117, phycophaein, 117, pyrenoid, 116, references, 177, reproduc- tion, physiology of, 120, zoosporangium. 119, zoospores, 118; see Algae; Algae, Blue- Green; Bacillariaceae; Chlorophyceae; Pha- eophyceae; Rhodophyceae Allassostoma, 387; magnum, 387, parvun, 387 Allocreadiidae, 394 Allocreadiinae, 394 Allocreadium, 395; commune, 395, lobaium, 395 Alloeocoela, 354 Alona, 722; a finis, 723, costata, 723, guttata, 721, 722, intermedia, 724, monacantha, 722, quadrangularis, 723, rectangula, 723, tenui- caudis, 720 Alonella, 724, 734; dadayi, 736, dentifera, 735, diaphana, 721, 735, exigua, 737. excisa, 737, globulosa, 73S, karua, 724, 734, nana, 736, rostrata, 736, sculpta, 735 Alonopsis, 719; aureola, 719, elongata, 719 Amabilia, 448; lamelligera, 448 Amabiliidae, 448 Ambly plana cockereUi, 360 Ambloplitls rupestris, 1030 Ameletus (imago), 920, (nymph), 922 Ammonia in natural waters, 39 Amnicola, 989; cincinnaUensis, 989, limosa, 989 Amnicolidae, 989 Amnicolinae, 989 Amoeba, 219; guttula, 220, Umax, 220, />ro- feju, 219, radios a, 220, striata, 220, twrw- awa, 220 Amoebea, 219 Amoebidae, 219 Amoeboid protozoa; see Sarcodina Amoebotaenia, 445; cuneata, 445 Amorgius, 934 Amphiagrion (imago), 923, (nymph), 928 Amphibia, see Batrachia Amphibious plants, see Plants, amphibious Amphids, 466 Amphigyra, 986; alabamensis, 986 Amphileptus, 275; gutta, 275, meleagris, 294 Amphilina, 430 Amphimonas, 250; globosa, 250 Amphipoda, 829, 842; see Malacostraca Amphiprora, 130 Amphiproraceae, 130 Amphisia, 288 Ampkistoma grande, 386, subtriquetrum, 386 Amphistomata, 385 Amphistome cercariae, 413 Amphitrema, 232; fiavum, 232, wrigkHanum, 233 Amphizoa (adult), 940, (larva), 943 Amphizoidae, 940 Amphora, 128; oralis, 128 Axnpullaria, 987; paludosa, 987 Ampullariidae, 987 Amygdalonaias, 1014 Anabaena, no; circinalis, 1 10, flos-aquae, no Anaerobes, facultative and obligatory; see Bacteria Anaerobic respiration, 38 Anapodidae, 570, 601; see Rotatoria Anapus, 601; ovalis, 601 Anarthra, 591; aptera, 591 Anax, 925, 930 Anchistropus, 730; minor, 730 Anculosa, 994, praerosa, 994 Ancylidae, 985 Ancybstoma duodenale, 513, 521 Ancylus, 985; diaphanus, 985, nuttallii, 985, rivularis, 985 Ancylus s. s., 985 Ancyracanthus cystidicola, 527 Ancyrocephalus, 375 Ancyronyx, 942 Angiostoma, 521; nigrovenosum, 521 Angiostomidae, 521 Angitrema, 992 Anguillulidae, 521 Animal communities; see Communities, ani- mal Animalcules, moss; see Bryozoa wheel; see Rotatoria Animals, aquatic, food relations of, 53, 54 Anisonema, 257; acinus, 257 Anistoptera, 924, 929 Ankistrodesmus, 155 Annelida; see Hirudinea Anodonta, 1002; grandis, 1002 Anodontinae, 1001 Anodontoides, 1003; ferussaciana, 1003 Anomalagrion (imago), 924, (nymph), 929 • Anomopoda (adult), 694 Anomotaenia, 446; constricta, 446 Anonchus, 502; monkystera, 502 Anopheles, 944 Anoplocephalidae, 444 Anortha gracilis, 334 Anostraca, 666 Antheridium, 119 Antherozoid, 119 Anthophysa, 248; vegetans, 248 Anuraea, 601; brevispina, 601, cocMUaris, 601 Anuraeidae, 571, 601 Aorchis, 385; extensus, 385 Aphanizomenon, in; jtos-aquoe, in Aphanocapsa, 106; grevillei, 106 Aphinochaete, 169 Aphanolaimus, 498; spiriferus, 498 Aphanothece, 104; microscopic*, 104 Aphelenchus, 483; microlaimus, 483 Aphrothorarida, 234 Apiocystis, 147; braumana, 147 Aplanospore, 118 Aplexa, 98s; kypnorum, 98s 1*.* .1 W*1 - INDEX IO87 Apftopanksis, 443; filum, 443 Apocrangonyx, 843 Apodina, 630 Apparatus and Methods, 61 ; references, 88, 89 Apsflidae, 611 Apsihis, 611; bucinedax, 611 Aptogonum, 137; baileyi, 137 Apus, 671; aequalis, 663, 671, longicaudatus, 672, lucasamus, 672, newberryi, 671 Aquatic animals, birds, earthworms, etc.; see Animals, Birds, Earthworms, etc., aquatic Arachnida, 17 Arcella, 221; deutala, 222, discoides, 222, vulgaris, 222 Arcellidae, 220 Arckermia boltoni, 144 Archigetes, 430 Archilestes (imago), 923, (nymph), 92S Arcidens, 1003; confragosa, 1003 Argia (imago), 923, (nymph), 928 Argulidae, 786-788; key, 787, 788; srr Cnpc- poda; Siphonostomata Argulus, 787; americanus, 787, apprndiru'o- sus, 787, caiostomi, 787, ingens, 788. Itpido- slei, 788, maadosus, 787, stizostelhi, 788, versicolor, 787, 788 Arhythmorhynchus, 550; brevis, 550. pumili- rostris, 551, trichocephalus, 550, uncinatus, 550 Arkansia, 1004; wkeeleri, 1004 Armiger, 984 Arrhenurinae, 863 Arrhenurus, 863; albalor, &f>.\tforpualus> 863, globaior, 863, maculator, 863 j4rfe*wa fa/tfia, 668 Arthrodesmus, 141; convergens, 141 Arthropoda, 17 Arthrospira, 108; jenneri, 108 Ascaridae, 531 Ascaris, 531; ardeae, 532, rylindrira, 531, entomelas, 531, helicina 532, lanrfMata, sm. longa, 531, lumbricoides, 512, micrtH-rphala, 532, mucronoJa, 532. mzroxrnosa, 531, penita, 531, serpentulus, 532, sulcata, 531, lenuicollis, 531 Ascaroidea, 531 Ascoglena, 252 Ascomorpha, 607; ecaudis, 607 Asellidae, 841 Asellus, 841; coavflMMM, 841 Aspidisca, 291; cosUtia, 291 Aspidobranchia, 994 Aspidocotylea, 379 Aspidogaster, 380; conchicola, 380 Aspidogastridae, 379 Asplanchna, 607; kerrickii, 582, 607, priodonta, 607 Asplanchnidae, 571, 607 Aspianchnina, 607 Asplanchnopus, 607; fwynaWw, 607 Asaimcnia, 986; califftmica, 986 Assimeniidac, 986 Association, coefficient of, 54 Assulina, 230; mtaw, 230, jr*W«*/wf*, 250 Astacus, 846 Astasia, 254; trickopkora, 254 Astasidac, 253 Astcrionella, 133; gracillima, 133 Asteromcycnia, 311; piumosa, 312, rarfie- spiculaUi, 3 1 2 Asymphylodora, larva of, 423 Atractidcs, 874; spinipes, 874 Atraotoncma, 254; tortuosa, 254 Atrochus, 611; tmtaculatus, 611 Alurinac, 864 Atunis, 866; mirabilis, 866, scaber, 866 Atyidac, 845 Aulophorus, 639; furcatus, 639, tvi^wj, 639 Auricula, 978; ptUurtm, 978 Auriculidac, 977 Auriculinac, 977 Auridistomum. 397; cMydrae, 397 AuxosporcH. 125 Awcrinaewm, 927-, cychstofiMta. 227 Axonop*iH, 866; romplanaUt, 866 Azygia, 392; lurii, 392, wbago, .171, Irrttirolte, 302 Azygiidac, 392 Barillariaceae (diatom*). 12$ 134; key, 135 134: .w Algae, |*'rr«h Water, excl. of Blm- (Ireen Bacteria, 13, 90 90; at*rol>e*, obligatory, 93, anaerobe*, facultative and obligatory, 93, 94, bar4llu\ rdi a* Index of contamination, 1069, clarification, no, form*, 91, metarhro mafic granule*. 9?, microftrganlam, 94, movement, 9?, number, 94, In natural watrr*. 96, 1070, reference*, 99, aporea, 93, Mrucfurc, 91 Harti* (imago), 0*1, (nymph), «>?* Hnrti*ca (imago), 919, (nymph), 921 Biilleya, 1 7fi Halladlna, »H8 Bangia, 177; air* purpura, 177 Bartoniu*. 840 Ba*iae*< linn (imago), t\>%, (nymph), 910 BaMiana. 407; rrMn, 4*17 Bathymrrmi*. v*\ Halrachin (Amphibia), in>H, mil); refer encea, 1066, \ff Vrrtcbrnta, agnatic Batrachoaprrmum, 176, grt.j|ihuroafe 168 Chaetopoda [earthworms), aquatic, 16, 633- 645; set Oligochaeta Chaetosphaeridium, 170; pritgiheimii, 170 Chaeturina, 630; capricamio, 63° Cli.iliir^lKiracB, 335 Chimacsiphonaceae, 107 Chamaesiphon. 10J tHcru Chanlransia, 176; chalybta, 176 Chara, 174; coronala, 174,/njgiJu Characeae, 171 Characiopsis, 158 Characiuni, 158; longipes, 158 C ha rales, 171 Chareae, 174 Chauliotiea (adult). 935. (larva), 936 ChciracaHihu: horridus, 5.10, sennits, 53a Chilodon, 376; aituliulus, 176 Chilodonopsis. 276; rrtntila, 17(1 Chilomanos, 561 Paramecium, a6i Chirm iT-lnlidae, 668 Chironomidae, 914, 94s; Ceratopogoniae of, Chironomus (Una). 945, in part, 94s Chirouraetes (imago), 910, (nymph), gai Chlamydomonas. us. 1441 365; ahioeiuis, 144 pultiiculus, ifij n;l.iinvil'i|iKora, 334 Chlamydotheca, 8n; aifeia, 811. herricti, Sn.iMritMfl.Sia ChloranKium, 147, 166; sttntoritmm, 166 strntorum, 14; Chlorclla, 153 Chlorellaceae, 153 Chlorobotrys, 151; regularis, isi Chlorochytrium, 157; Uiiiiku, 157 ChoanonageUata, 157 Cboanotaenia, 446; infundiindum, 446. pu- Mia, 447 Cbodatella, 155 Chondracanthidae, 784; see Copcpoda Chorda ta, iS Cbordodes, 537, 538; morgani, 538, oiciirn- lalh, 538 rh'irutiTiK'S fimapin), 910, (nymph), 931 ■ hl-.n.-i.,.jfn ><> .(lukin, .•.'. Chlwuagellida. 364 Chlorogonium, 14]; CTttttervm, 143 CbloropellK 751; kiipiJiJa, iji ChtorophycMP, 117, 134; key, 134-174; «e Algae, Fresh Water. e*d. of Blue-Green Chlorosphaern, 15S; iacuslris, 158 Chlorosphaeraceae, 158 nilurrtylium. ififi; caiaratMntm, 166 Chromadora. 490; mmmt, 490 Chromagrion (imago), 933, (nymph), 91ft Chromatophores of algae, 116 Chronogaster, 493; gracilis, 493 Chroococcus, 106; tigatUtus, 106 ClL;....l.|iiiJeae, 170 ChiyMilkudlids, 359 L'hr\somdi.JLiii 1 adult), 937, (larva), 943 Chrysojis (larva), 946 Chrysopyiis, J63; uretoiata, 163 Chydoridae, 716 Chydorinae, j(j i "...1 '!■■■.. Jjo; barroisi, 733. biarrnului, 731, fariformii, Us, gibbus, 731, jJoJojhj, 730, hybridus, 733, &fcu, 737, otwtt), 733, *i*CT, 732, poppei, 734, rn«!iiojui, 731, ipkatricm, 73J '38. 139; i« Infusoria Glials. 171 Ciliate protozoa; j« Infusoria Cinrinnatia. 989 Cinetochilum, 383; rxargaritarrum CTijncu- - 1 1 i ■ -■ : 1 uf K-.ilct in l.ii;cs, :;: 3.8, hypotimnion. 38, 38, Ihermodine, 78, 38, waves and their action, iS Ciroianidae,84i Cirol&niiln Itxrmis, 841 Cladocera (Water Fleas). Fresh-Water, 676- 740; digestive tract, 681, distribution, 687, key, 689-739, method of study, 688, oc- currence, 685, references, 739-740, repro- duction, 683, shell, 679, structure, 677; set Crustacea Cladwopa, Sou Clappia, 990; clappia, 990 Clathrocystia, 106; aeruginosa, 106 Clathnilina, J.tfi; eltgaru, 136 Climacia (adult), 935, (larva), 93s I'Kmi'.L.-Liimum, 185 Climate and fresh- water life, 9 Cluiostotnum, 408; marginatum, 40 Clock pump, 80 Clocon (imago), 911, (nymph). 9ai Cbmntm mmk m Closterium, 137; mouili/erum var. '$7 Clostonema, >ss; lociaiis, ass Coccogoneae, 104 Coccomonas, 166 Cocconridaceae, 119 Cocconeis, 119; pediaiiiu, 119 CoccoQona, 119; tsmteialtm, 119 Cochleare, 597; turbo, J97 Cochltopa. 990; riogriiaJttuii, 990 ('..ilili.ij/viium. in; hiimbestim, 11 (''.*!• Hi' >i Udium. j;arra, 659 Dinamoeba, 219; mirabilis, 219 Dineutes (adult), 937 Dinobryon, 264; sertularia, 264 Dinocharidae, 569, 597 Dinocharis, 597; pociUum, 597 Dinoflagellida, 269 Dinomonas, 248; wax, 248 Dinops, 607 Dioctophyme, 523; refiafe, 523 Dioctophymidae, 523 Dioicocestus, 448; paronai, 448 Diorchis, 443; acuminata, 443, amcricana, 443 Diphyllobothriidae, 431 Diphyllobothriinae, 432 Diphyllobothrium, 432; Ai/fim, 432 Diplax, 593; wfau, 593 Diplobothrium, 378; armatum, 378 Diplocardia, 643 Diplochlamys, 220; fragilis, 220, timida, 221 Diplodiscus, 387; temper atus, 387, 413 Diplodisdnae, 387 Diplodontinae, 861 Diplodontus, 861; despiciens, 861 Diplogaster, 488; Jfcfor, 488 Diplogonoporus, 433; grandis, 433, 434 Diplois, 593; daviesiae, 593 Diplophallus, 448; polymorphus, 448 Diplophrys, 233; archeri, 233 Diploposthe, 446; lomj, 447 Diplostomulum, 411, 424; cuticola, 411, tof- tww, 411 Dip nets, 67 Dipteta (two-winged flies), aquatic, 909-916, 9i7. 943-946; black-flies (Simuliidae), 913, key, 917, 943-946, larvae, 917, midges (Chironomidae), 914, wing venation, 910, 916; jee Chironomidae, Insecta, Simuliidae Dipylidiidae, 440 Discodrilidae, 644 Disease germs, water as conveyor of, 1068, transmission of, 1068 Dispersal of fresh-water life (biology), 13 Dispharagus, 526, ardeae, 527 Distemma, 589; setigerum, 589 Distigma, 254; Proteus, 254 Distoma dendriticum, 408, helicis, 423, lance- datum, 408, oricola, 408, poly ore his, 397, wj£ Rnraanoaafc. 44* 19£-S* 1> cicnas. rsr;.. v.- Iudr_ 3054. V*- vnnpg.ig.irft. xsyt. dispersal »r 7. r.L. k<^ imrng. i^.^- togn tot axrf ira Ife, is&x. x&rt Fa. life. puaMZOMb tad. y&x Facsfe. *;£ fjacsdaae ^jfcanfcr aor XjaCap-j£orjsfc Fjaearaui ^T^tudbsaiclfcet^ :^_ fcw-lT- «ck: aw ?ieiflicr. fl*eanca» Fjbhl raac*-„ iwr CMurjasa TjaasMif^va. rrc. tf'na^aaaa l r-* Flf* vara.- aw Iimrz* sui Sttmfiidbr; iaii: aw kumrZ*. mti JEfflF-jgCatt; tm>- faMCtfaro. -fa*- ^a«»<*aaa£«i4 fjfcs. toju. Fnc-Irraic nenaludcE; XflmeBmzs bxmS Xrmictrrfb, Irsr- Froe-Irriap ILmmdwunziK: jar XenslzdzL, ir»- Fieafe-woer hfcnr, Indbc. He. fflf : J» JU- Frjxe^Kjd^ K»: ■■imTot. MA F U! L'JICB CUP Lgg|A!l*f 423 FurnuhtniL s&i; far^nafla, $Sfc, TaagMrtf, £&9 Fxacumxxt. 5^7 Gu&xuaSae. >?o am.>. 5#4j >urL duajKto'sdsB IV2B or t75» i*> r^i U3 -C^* 1096 INDEX Glenodinium, 270; pulvis cuius, 270 Gloeocapsa, 106; polydermatica, 106 Gloeocystis, 150; vcsiculosus, 150 Gloeotaenium, 152; louelsbergerianum, 152 Gloeothece, 104; confluent, 104 Gloeotrichia, 114; pisum, 114 Glossiphonia, 651; complanata, 652, fusca, 652, hcteroclita, 652, nepheloidea, 651, stagnalis, 651 Glossiphonidae, 651 Glypthelmins, 404; quicta, 404 Gnathobdellae, 656 Gnathostoma, 530; horridum, 530, sociale, 530 Gnathostomata, 755-782; key, 755-782; see Copepoda Gnathostomidae, 530 Golenkinia, 154; radiata, 154 Gomphaeschna (imago), 925 Gomphonema, 129; acuminatum, 129 Gomphonemaceae, 129 Gomphosphaeria, 105; aponina, 105 Gomphus (imago), 924, (nymph), 930 Gonatonema, 143; tentricosum, 143 Gonatozygon, 135; ralfsii, 135 Gonidea, 1002; angulala, 1002 Gordiacea, 16, 365, 506-510, 535-542; devel- opment, 536, key, 537~542» references, 551, 552; see Acanthocephala, Nematoda (Para- sitic), Parasitic Roundworms • Gordius, 539; alascensis, 539, densarealatus, 540, 541, leidyi, 541, lineatus, 54<>i 54i, longarcolatus, 540, plaiycephalus, 541, 542, PuerUis, 538, villoli, 540, 541 Gorgodera, 399; minima, 399 Gorgoderidae, 398 Gorgoderina, 399; aUenuata, 399 Gorgoderinae, 398, 421 Goniobasis, 993; virginica, 993 Gonium, 145, 266; pectorale, 145, 266, so- ciale, 266 Graphoderes (adult), 941 Grapple, 68 Graptoleberis, 724; testudinaria, 724 Grimaldina, 711; brasxai, 711 Gromia, 233; fiuviatilis, 233, terricola, 233 Gryporhynchus, 445, 451 ; cheilancristrotus, 445 Gundlachia, 986; meekiana, 986 Gymnamoebida, 219 Gymnocephala, 415 Gymnocephalous cercariae, 415 Gymnodinium, 270; juscum, 270 Gymnolaemata, 951 Gymnomera, 738 Gymnostomina, 271 Gymnozyga, 135; bribissonU, 135 Gyratriddae, 353 Gyratrix hermapkrodiius, 353 Gyraulus, 983; s. s., 983 Gyretes (adult), 938 Gyrinidae (adults), 937, (larvae), 943 Gyrinus (adult), 937 Gyrocoelia, 447 Gyrodactylidae, 374 Gyrodactylus, 374 Gyrotoma, 993; demissum, 993 Habrophlebia (imago), 920, (nymph), 921 Haemopis, 657; grandis, 658, lateralis, 658, marmoratis, 658, plumbeus, 658 Haemotococcus, 266 Hagenius (imago), 924, (nymph), 929 Hair snakes; see Gordiacea Hairworms; see Gordiacea Halipegus, 408; occidualis, 408 Haliplidae (adults), 938, (larvae), 943 Haliplus (adult), 938, (larva), 907, 943 Halteria, 286; grandinella, 286 Hapalosiphon, 113; kibemicus, 113 Haplobothriinae, 432 Haplobothrium, 432; globuliforme, 432 Haplonema, 526; immutatum, 526 Haplopoda, 739 Haplotaxidae, 642 Eaplotaxis emissarius, 642 Harpacticidae, 780 Harringia, 607; eupoda, 607 Hassallius, 392 Hasstilesia, 409; tricolor, 409 Hastatella, 292; radians, 292 Hedruris, 528; androphora, 528, siredonit, 528 Heleopera, 227; picta, 227, rosea, 227 Heliozoa 213, 234 Helisoma, 982; s. s., 982 Helminthes, 365; see Parasitic Worms Helochares (adult), 939 Hclocombus (adult), 939 Helocordulia (imago), 926, (nymph), 931 Helodrilus (Eiseniella), 643; tetraedrus, 643, forma pupa, 643 Helophorus (adult), 939 Hemerobiidae (dobson and fish flies), 898- 899; (adults), 934; see Insecta and Neurop- tera Hemidplostyla, 287 Hemidium, 269 Hemilastena, 1007; ambigua, 1007 Hemiptera (water bugs), aquatic and semi- aquatic, 893-896, 917, 933-934; key, 917, 933-934; sc* Insecta Hemistomidae, 409 Hemistomum, 4x0; (larva), 424; craterum, 410, denUculatum, 411 Hemiums, 392 Heptagenia (imago), 919, (nymph), 921 Herpetocypridinae, 810 Herpetocypris, 8xx; barbatus, 8x2, reptans, 8x2, testudinaria, 813 Heronimkiae, 384 Heronimus, 384; chdydrae, 384 EerpobdeUa punctata, 659 J HcrpobdelfeUe. 6» _ BB^tdion. >6» o>*Wfa. 169 Hetaerina (im**o>. 9JJ. ("jm"*). 9»S Heicnkidae. ; i- JMerMffcr* *™«-™, '9' Heterocheil»dac' 533 Heterocysls. 103 Heteromastipda, *** HrteromastisidM. **° Hoeyeai*, 3«, 3'4i «rry™,™o, 3t3. „,3i3,1«fcn.Jll 56; ocul. 256 35; myrivfvJa, 235 jicLirotriclw, tSj Bergenia »■** 9'8' t1"™*1 9": * lincaia, 887 Hewmitfc W «***« . «■> Uootiicha, Ml fW«*'77 HibemaoiU. 191. 949 Hippue4is, 9S3 Hinnidium, 259; »»••*■ ?» , . . „ Hirudinea (ieecbe.1, Frenh-witer, 16, 646-660; key 651-460, methodi of study, 651, ne- phridia. 64B. occurence, 649. rtfereace*, 660, reproduction, 64T. 650 Hirudinidae. 656 Hiruic Mcdici*aiis, 65J Histriu. iuo; irdhiilitus. 190 », 69J , 693; 693. I**- Hobphrya, : . Hotostkha, 288; rerWir. a&8 Holostomala, 409 Holostome cercariae. 413 HoJostomum, 4"=: *&&*». ♦» Holotricha, 2 J ll,..rrr.iilium. l6i; fliMU. 17a Hormospora, 163; WMtaWiu, 163 Uomoatyla, 2S7 1 <#»**"*. "87 Hyrmogoneae, 1O7 llonnoiila, 148; ■m«««kj. 14B Host, intermediate. 371. primary, 37'. second- ary. 3?" llyoltUa knickrrbacktri, S43 Hyalodiscus, 119; mUaadnt, 119 tiyolelampt /rwrtrafa, 23s Hyalosphenia, ny, ctawHa, Uj,«!ffMf, 113, aapifa, 113 Hyalolbeca, us: iiuibat, 13s Hydaticat (adult), 941 Hydatid, 599: »™M, 599 llv,!.,ii:iid:U'. ^59.599 Hydalinina. 599 Hydra, 316-321: development, 317, habitat, 318, key, 320-321, method*. 319, structure, 316; ctrjld, 3»t, /ukj. 311, jtum, 32a, J"» KS97 <*•**&. 3»c ttt idpet, 321, *l,t*.jn, •"»**. MO. arHfuniod, 3*0, --'j-fr. aao; '« Hydroaoa Hydracarina (water-mites), Freab-wafcr, i7, 851-875; development, S55. key, 859-874. methods 0/ study. 857, occurrence, 851, references. 875, structure. 851 Hydrachna, 860; tea&afkitu, 860 Hydrachnidae, 86a Hydrsena, 938 ilydn.biicnus (larvs), 945 Hydrobius (adult), 0.40 Hydrocampa, 903 ]lydri»:harii (adult), 940 Hydrucmii ladulti, .19 Hydrocirjus, 933 Hydrocoleum. 109: htmoeolndmm, 109 liydrodictyaceae, t6o 1 lydr..»litty...Li. ifo. -eticuIalMm, 100 Hydrogen sulphide in streams, 39 Hydrography, 1 ; ut Limnology, OceanoloKv Rheology Uydromennis, 505 Hydrometridae, 933 llyd'i.I.hii;J.LtiJduli),9j8,{huTFa),o4j Hydroporus tlarva), 941, (Urva and pupa). 90S Hydropsychidae, 937 Hydrcplilidae, 936 Hydrosphere, 1 Hydrovatu* (adult). 9*1 Hydrozoa, Fresh cater, 316-321; kejr, jao- i». medusae, 318, references, 321; Mi Hydra Hydryphantes, 861; mbtr.&bi Hydryphantidae, S60 Hydryphantinae, 86 1 ilygrobaleit, 874: dmeiSW/ii. 874 lly>.-r..l,Jtjdae.86t HygmbalLnae. 873 I lynn n..|i-| ji.ii. [.,.■, 441 Hymenolepia, 44J; ompruta, 441,/unu, 441, mttolepi, 441 liymenosioma, aSt Hypolimnion, 18, 38 Hypotricha. 186 ily^ttr.jplioia, 333, 361 iK^iiTuihvUcium, 334; I IlystrUhis papitlost KhUlyo),kllklal..6S5 Ichthyonema. 323; cylind lleoncma. 171; diipor, 27 Ilybiosoma (adult), 941 llybius (adult), 94> 1098 INDEX Ilyocryptus, 712; aeutifrons, 713, halyi, 713, longiremis, 713, sordidus, 712, spinifer, 713 Ilyocypris, 809; bradyi, 810, gibba, 809 Ilyodrilus, 641 Ilyodromus, 810; pectinatus, 810 Incrustation on aquatic plants, 185; car- bonate of lime, 187, gelatinous covering, 187 Inemgiata, 149 Infusoria (Ciliate Protozoa), Fresh-water, 14, 238-243, 271-300; cilia, 238, 239, ciliate protozoa, 238, conjugation, 242, key, 271-300, methods of study, 242, physiolog- ical processes, 241, references, 300, repro- duction, 241, structure, 239; see Protozoa Insecta, aquatic, 17, 876-946; adaptation to water, 876, of larvae to aquatic life, 878, keys, 917-946; of adults, 934"935, 937-94*; of imagos, 918-921, 922-927; of larvae, 9i7. 935-936, 943-946; of nymphs, 921-922, 928-932; recognition of characters, 880, references, 946, wing venation, 916; see Coleoptera, Diptera, Ephemerida, Hemip- tera, Lepidoptera, Neuroptera, Odonata, Plecoptera, Trichoptera Intermediate host; see Host Investigators in Fresh- Water Biology, 11 Io, 992; spinosa, 992 Iota, 482; octangular e, 482 Ironus, 486; americanus, 486 Ischnura (imago), 924, (nymph), 929; verti- caiis, 893 Isopoda, 829, 841; see Malacostraca Jaws (trophi) of rotatoria, 559 Jensenia, 348; pinguis, 348 Journals on Fresh- Water Biology, 20 Kerona, 287; pediculus, 287 Keys to Fresh-Water Biology; Algae, Blue- Green (Cyanophyceae), 104-114, Algae, exd. of Blue-Green, 125-177, Acanthoceph- ak. 545-551, Animalcules, 587-619* 95*- 955, Argulidae, 787-788, Bacillariaceae, 125-134, Bryozoa, 951-955. Chlorophyceae, 134-174, Cestoda, 429-451, Cladocera, 689- 739, Copepoda, 755-782, 784-786, 787-788, Coleoptera, 937"943, Diptera, 943-946, Ephemerida, 918-922, Ergasilidae, 784-786, Gastrotricha, 624-630, Gnathostomata, 755-782, Gordiacea, 537-54*, Hemiptera, 933-934, Hirudinea, 651-660, Hydra, 320- 322, Hydracarina, 859-874, Hydrozoa, 320-322, Infusoria, 271-300, Insecta, 917- 946, Mollusca, 977-1020, Malacostraca, 841-850, Mastigophora, 243-270, Nema- toda, Free-Living, 482-505, Nematoda, Parasitic, 520-535, Neuroptera, 934-936, Odonata, 922-932, Oligochaeta, 638-644, Ostracoda, 806-827, Phaeophyceae, 174- 175, Porifera, 306-315, Protozoa, 219-236, 243-300, Phyllopoda, 666-675, Rhodo- phyceae, 175-177, Rotatoria, 587-619, Sarcodina, 219-236, Trichoptera, 936-937, Trematoda, 374-424, Turbellaria, 333-364 Kirchneriella, 151; obesa, 152 Koenikea, 865; concava, 865 Krendowskija, 863; ovata, 863 Kurzia, 718; latissima, 718 Labidestes siculus, 1036 Laccobius (adult), 939 Laccophilus (adult), 940 Lacinularia, 617; socialis, 561, 575, 617 Lacrymaria, 274; olor, 274 Ladona (imago), 927, (nymph), 932 Laevapex, 985 Lagenophrys, 297; vaginocola, 297 Lagerheimia, 154; genevensis, 154 Lakes, 2, 4, 5; age series, 49, circulation of water in, 27, conditions of existence in, 23, in Lake Michigan, 35, epilimnion, 28, hypo- limnion, 28, 38, thermocline, 28, 38, waves and their action, 28 Lamellibranchia, 970, 994; see Mollusca Lamprothamnus, 174 Lampsilinae, 1007 Lampsilis, 1009; ovata, ioxo, recta, ion, texasensis, ion; s. s., 1010 Land planarians; see Turbellaria Lanthus (imago), 924, (nymph), 929 Lanx, 986; newberryi, 986 Lara (adult), 942 Lasmigona, 1005 Lastena, 1002; lata, 1002 Lateriporus, 444 Lathonura, 716; rectirostris, 716 Latona, 689; parviremis, 690, setifera, 690 Latonopsis, 691; fasciculata, 692; oceiden- talis, 691 Lebertia, 867; dubia, 867, tau-insignita, 867 Lebertiinae, 867 Lechriorchis, 407; elongatus, 407, primus, 407 Lecithophora, 340, 361 Lecquereusia, 222; epistomium, 223, modesta, 222, spiralis, 223 Leeches; see Hirudinea Lemanea, 175; torulosa, 175 Lembadion, 281: buUinum, 281 Lemna, 178; minor, 192 Lemnisci, 543 Lepidoderma, 625; concinnum, 626, rhom- boides, 625, squamaium, 625 Lepidoptera (moths), 903, 917; see Insecta Lepidurus, 671; bilobatus, 671, coutsii, 671, glacialis, 671, Ummoni, 671 Lepocindis, 253 Lepodermatidae, 402 Lepomis megabits, 103 1 T^ptidae (larvae), 946 Leptoceridae, 936 Leptodora, 739; kindlii, 739 J.ipl.K.li'nfliie, 739 LeplophWii;. (imiiR'vi. 919, (nymph), 931 Ltplorkynckiis dtalifcr, 736 Leptoiosma, 135; catenulala, 135 Lepyrium, 994; shoaallrri, 994 Lernacidae, 784; see Copepoda Lcrnaeopodiilai;. 784; iff Copepoda I.tsU-s (iraae'i). 9-'.;. [nymph) 891,918 LouriTuthrus, 39'. 4°7 micropteri, 39" Leu™ hWiilium. 409. 423 Leucophrys, 17S; patula. 178 Leucorhinia (imago), 927, (nymph), 932 Leydigia, 721; acanlkocercoides, 721, quadran- gxlaris, 72. Liln-tiuh 'im.nvi. 927, (nymph), 931, 931 I.it'berkiihnhi, 233; magencri, 233 Life, distribution of, 35; see Existence, con- ditions of Life, Fresh-water: see Biology, Fresh-water Light, intensity uf, 32, penetration in water of, 29, 30, vs. migration, 31 LigoJa,4j[ Ligulinae, 431 Limnadia, 673; aiatricana, 673, coriocta, 673 Limrtadiidac. 673 Limnrlrius (adult!, 939 Limnesia, S;o; tiiitrionka, 870 Limnesiopsis. Siwk anomala, 869 Limnetidae, 671 Limnetis, 672; bmifrons, 672, gouldii, 672, tracilicornis, 672, mucronatus, 762 Limnias. 615; ctratsphytli, 61s Limnicythere, 806; Ulinaisensh, 807, retku- /ofa.Bofi Limnoctiida, 321; <>»d«o, 322, rhodciia, 322, J.iMyiiiiyi'i-.i'.'. .;: ; jrs Hydrozoa Limnodrilus, 641; daparedianus, 641, gracilis, Limnt'-philiiiar, 936, 937 Limnoplankton. 6; jee Plankton Uonotopsis. 175: am", *75 Lionotus, 176; twieinifftcjiiii 276 Liopla*, 988; snbcarinala, g88 Liporbynchia, 340, 361 Liriola, 980 *, '43 Littoridina, 1.. Lophophore, 947 Lopkopus cristaliinus, 954 Loricatina, 591 Loxocephalus, 280; grwutam, 280 Loiodes, 174; rostrum, 174 Lomgcnes, 400: arcanum, 400 Loxophyllum, JJS; roslrattim, 275 Lucius vtrmiculalui, 1031 Lumbridlligs, 1142; miifm, 643 Lumbrkulidac, 641 Lumbritulns, 64!: inamslans, 645 Lnlruiliu* rinjillt), 942 983. , 98a; aurieularia, 981, columella, (■/. "i ,',.'. '.Si.niffaioiiio, 980, eJouja, duslris, 981, slagnolis, 980, ulakensii Lymnaddae, 980 I-yniiliy.i, 108; mo/nr, 108 Lyngbyeae, 107 Lyogyrinae, 991 t-yogytus. 991 pupoideia, 991 i.y-i.ini"iihio, 841 Lythoglyphinae, 990 Macrobdella, 656; decora, 656, sestrrtie, 656 Ifsuromia fjmago), 925, (nymph), 930 Macronychus (adult), 942 Macrostominae, 338 Macrostomum, sjS; apptndituiatum, 338, Ayjffil, 338, scmilimm, 339 Min.T'>ihriiidac,7o8 MaLTothrin, J 3; rWyriftfiuVa. 715, details, Malacostracn (Higher' Crustacea), 828-850; cave species, S37, development, 832, habi- tat, 83s key 841-850, nu-ihixl of study, B40, occurrence. 3i$, references. 850, struc- ture, 830; see Crustacea Mallomonas, 260 Mammals, aquatic, 1012-1024; references, ioofj; see Vertebrata Man the modifying agent in fresh-water life, Manayutikia speciosa, 632 Mancasellus, 84 1 Margaritana, 99s; martarilifera, 995 Marionina Jerbcsae, 641 Marl and marl lakes, aquatic plants factors in formation of, 207 Marshia, 780; albuquerquensis, 780, brevicau- dala, 780 Mastai, 55 8, 560 Mastigamoeba, 143; lontifilum, 243 Mastigophora (Flagellate Protozoa), Fresh- water, 14, 338-370, 300; conjugation, 143, 1 100 INDEX flagella, 238, key, 243-270, methods of study, 242, pseudopodia, 238, physiologi- cal processes, 241, references, 300, repro- duction, 241, structure, 238; see Protozoa Mastogloia, 128; smiikii, 128 Matter, cycle of, 207 Matus (adult), 942 Mayflies, aquatic; see Ephemerida; Insecta Mazocraes, 375 Meadow, aquatic, 197 Medionidus, 1015; conr adieus, 10x5 Mediorhynchus, S49 Medusae of Hydrozoa, 318 Megadistomum, 392 Megalotrocha, 617; alboflamcasu, 61 1, 617 Megalurous cercariae, 4x6 Megarhinus (larva), 944 Melampinae, 978 Melampus, 978; bidentata, 979, buUaides, 979, hemphilli, 979, lineatus, 978; s. s., 978 Melicerta, 615; ringens, 575, 615 Melicertida, 574, 611 Melicertidae, 615 Melosira, 126; various, 126 Melosiraceae, 126 Menoidium, 255; pellucidum, 255 Meridion, 132; constriclum, 132 Meridionaceae, 132 Merismopedia, 105; elegans, 105 Mermis, 505 Mermithidae, 503, 510, 534 Meromyaria, 51s Mesenchytraeus, 642 Mesocarpeae, 142 Mesocestoides, 440 Mesocestoididae, 440 Mesodinium, 272; index, 272 Mesomermis, 503; nrginiama, 503 Mesostoma, 352; ehrenbergii, 352, Poller soni, 361, 362, widalum, 350, nviparum, 350 Mesostomatini, 351 Mesotaenium, 138; endlickerianum, 138 Mesothemis (imago), 927, (nymph), 931 Metabolism, temperature vs., 33 Metanema, 257 Mrtastrongylinac, 522 Methods of Collecting, 61-85; bottom, 70, by pyramid dredge, 71, by runner net, 70, by triangle dredge, 71; fish, 61, by fyke net, 63, by gill net, 64, by net, 61-66, by seine, 61, by trammel, 62, by trap, 65, by turtle net, 66; invertebrates, in littoral vegetation, 67, by Birge net, 68, by cone dredge, 68, by dip net, 67, by grapple, 68, by plankton pomp, 70; in open water, qualitative, 72, by plankton cylinders, 73, by townet, 72; in open water, quantitative, 74, by dock pump, 80, by dosable plankton net, 77, 78, by plankton pump, 78, by quantita- tive plankton net, 74, by thresher tank- pump, 80, by water-bottle, 80; references, 88-89; special methods, 85 Methods of Photographing, 86-88; under- water, 86, by screen, 86, through water glass, 87; references, 88-89 Metopidia, 597; ehrenbergii, 597 Metopus, 284; sigmaides, 284 Metorchis, 393; ampkxut, 393 Metriocnemus (larva), 945 Meyeninae, 308 Micrasterias, 140; papillifero, 140 Micrathyria (imago), 927 Microcercous cercariae, 419 Microchlamys, 221; patella, 221 Microcodides, 609; rabushu, 609 Microcodon, 609; clavus, 609 Microcoleus, 109; delicatulus, 109 Microcotylae, cercariae, 416 Microcotyle, 375 Microcotylidae, 375 Microcystis, 105 Microdina, 619; paradoxa, 577, 6x9 Microdinidae, 6x9 Microdonidae, 609 Microgromia, 233; socialis, 233 Microhydra, 318, 319, 322; rydtri, 322; see Hydrozoa Microlaimus, 491; fluvialilis, 491 Microorganism, anaerobic, 94 Microphallinae, 401 Microphallus, 401; apacus, 370, 401 Microspore, 164; amaena, 164 Microstomidae, 337 Microstominae, 337 Microstomum, 337; caudahtm, 338, lituare, 337, philadelpkicum, 36 l, variable, 361 Microthamnion, 170; hUtmngionum, 170 Microthorax, 283; sukatus, 283 Micro-trichoptera, 901 Mideopsis, 865; orbicularis, 865 Midges; see Chironomidar; Tn*rcta Migrations, daily depth, 32, light va*, 31 Mimoriisaonmm, 392 Miraddium,37i Mjschococms, 148; canfervicola, 148 Mochlonyz (larva), 944 Moina, 703; ajitus, 705, brachial*, 704, ftagaUala, 705, raoarocapa, 70$, micrura, 704, paradoxa, 705, rectkostris, 705 Moinodaphnia, 703; alabamensis, 703, mac- ieayii, 703 Molannidae, 936 Moilusca, Fresh and Brackish-water, 18, 957- 1020; Hasainnirinn, 970, coUection and preparation of specsmeaa, 960, distribution, 959, jaws and lingual membrane, 968, key, 977-1020, measurement and descriptive terms, 969, radula, 973, references, 1020; sat Gastropoda; LameUibranchia Monadkla, 243 IIOI IfoBodfia, 164 374 ramnfra, $8y MnwuJuML, 486; faqjiar, 4B6 MoDopHtfaoootyka, 374 MoDOiykphoni^ 641 Monopybdiiim, 446 JianoBga, 258; Mate, 256 ItanospQufi, 738; Hspar, 736 C 382. 382, as per j mm, 382, /oia. 384, iMMMi^ra, 382. 382, 382, 412 spatulatum, 382 Monoatamata, 382 J&OBOStOflMr ceecao Monostroma, i6x; iafl«*w, 161 Monostyla, 595: Imnaris, 595 Monazoak ' ■^■■d— _ 439 Moss aninukiila; jar AnrmaW~nies; Bry- Moths, aquatic; jar Tnarrfa; Lepidoptera Mougeotia. 138, 145 Musrufiurn. 20x9: partummmm, 1019 Myooklcaceac 171 Myosvrxngata. 522 MyriopkyUwm spicalum. 162 Mysidacea, 829; jar MatacaatEaca Mysidacea. 844 Mysis rdiaa, 844 Myxonema. 168: lubricum. xfi8 Myxopbyceae; jot Algae, BfaavGmen ,639 Saias jUxSis, 291. tacjpr, 193 Xairiidar. 636 NaKuuxn. €40! aakaraa, €40 Xais. 639: communis. 639. Xajadicola. 672; mgrmt, 872 Xannophi n klna. 6, 7* 84: ecu ti if nee, 84. Sedfrwick-ftafter and filter, 85. study. 84. i Quantitative). B3: see PtaaJdon NannatacBni (imaac;. 926. 'jrjrmpbi. 932 Xasiaeschna imae: '. 925. nymph). 930 Xassula. 77^; oraote. 276 Natural water*, bacteria m. 96 Xaucorkiae, 933 Xaufaius of cjreftapa. 744 Xavicula, 128; rmyuckpcepkala, 126 Xaviculaceae, 127 Xebda. 226: colioh:. 226. 4r mugi»mt. 227. fabdlmm. 226. lagemiformis. 226 XehaDexmia Imago » 923. ' nymph t. 928 Xdumbo. 282 X« iiialai'lmatfhrs 't«andSpaonfti. 15. 506; set Acantbocephala; Gcrdiacea: X< toda Xrmalorrra Qaxva), 943 Xematoda 'free-fivinf: and worms i. Fresb-Water 1*. 3*5: toda. Free-Living: Xematoda. Xematoda. Frcc4J 466, bursa, 476. mtinila 463. 464, digfaaivc system. 467. 1 470. formula, 4S1. haratati, 459- key. 505. kmiuwaau 478. number. 460. ences. 505. reuette, 470* roimdsporms. 459* sexual organs. 47:. spicam, 47S- ■tructnre, 461. 462. tnreadwarxns. 459; Jar Xema- loda Xematoda. Parasitic, 536-510: 510-535: bursa. 524. development. 5x6. esophagus, 523. key, 520-555. in"' mstory. 527. 519. movement, 521. arai appaxmtu*. 513. refer- ences, 552-552. reproductive igrstem. 51 ti, structure, 511. tall 5:4. tzseadwacms. 521: see Acanthi* rphaui : Gordiacea: Xematoda XrmaUiidntm imtrgumemd iumkriemm' iaaan, Xexnatomarpha. 530 Xexnatotaenia. 450: dispar. 45s Xematorarniidar. 449 Xemertina fXemertca&si. Fresb-Water. 15, 454-458: aVvelcpment. 457. hahitarv 454. occurrence, 457. references, 458. struc- ture. 455 Xeoeczuuui'iiy ucsauac, 545 Xeoechinorbyiichus. 54?: ryttmrnmms. 54S. rmydis, 546. rracaueaftu. 545. fraafiar. 546 Xeoxnerxnis. 503 Xeoplanorbis. 9B6: ttmwHws. 986 Xepa. 954 Sepmelopsis pbsrura. 659 Xepnrocytium, 252; Nepidac, 934 Nerds iaanuou. 632 153 Xeritma. 994: iiiwali. 994 Xerthriidiit. 055 Net pamklnn € Xetrium. 25^: »amr2,rr»tm. 138 Xets, 6:: Birpe. 68. care of. 66. clos&ble plankton. 77- dip. 67. errors of piankum. 78, fyke. 63. gill. 6a. quantitative raankrnr. 74. runner, 70* tov. 72. trammel, 62. turtle, 66 Neumanxa, S71: spmipa. 871 Neuroccrdulia imago . 926 Xenroptera -dobsoc nsn. and spongiua mes". Fresb-Water. 807-809- ; ke>-&. adults . 934- 935. 'larvae 1. 927. 955-93-: *« Hemero- bodae: lssecta: StaHrhriar Xipbanpis. 843 Xitella. 273 XxteDeae, 275 Nrt2achia, : 30: iaaavv, 130, mviaaat, 374 Xrtiarhianeae, 130 II02 INDEX Nodularia, m Nostoc, no; commune, no Nostoceae, no Nostochopsis, 113; lob at a, 113 Notaspis, 874 Noteus, 605; quadricornis, 605 Notholca, 603; longispina, 603 Notocotylidae, 382 Notocotylus, 383; quinqueserialis, 383 Notodromas, 808; monacha, 798, 808 Notommata, 591; aurila, 591, torxdosia, 591, truncate, 556, 591 Notommatida, 587 Notommatidae, 587 Notommatina, 587 Notonecta, 934 Notonectidae, 934 Notops, 601; brachionus, 601, clavulalus, 601, pelagicus, 601 Notopsidae, 569, 599 Notosolenus, 257; orbicularis, 257 Notostraca, 671 Nuclearia, 233; simplex, 233 Nudocotyle novicia, 383 Nuphar, 193 Nupharetum, 196 Nylandera, 171; tentaculaia, 171 Nymphula, 903 Obliquaria, 1014; reflexa, 1014 Obovaria, 1012; ellipsis, 1013, relusa, 10x3; s. s., 1013 Oceanology, 1; pelagic region, 4 Ochromonas, 260 Octhebius (adult), 938 Oclobolhrium sagiUatum, 375 Octocotylidae, 375 Octotrocha, 615; speciosa, 615 Odonata (damselflies, dragonflies), Fresh- Water, 889-893, 917, 922-932; damselfly nymphs, 89 1 , keys, 917; dragonflies (imagos) , 922-927, (nymphs), 928-932; see Insecta Odontalona, 720 Odontidium, 132; mutabile, 132, tabeUaria, 132 Odontoceridae, 936 Odors, cause of, 1073, observation of, 1072 Occistes, 615; brevis, 615 Oedogoniaceae, 167 Oedogonium, 167; crenulalo-coslatum, 167 Oikomonas, 244; steinii, 244 OligobdeUa biannulata, 654 Oligochaeta (earthworms), Fresh- Water, 633- 645; biology, 635, excretory organs, 633, key, 638-644, locomotion, 636, methods of study, 636, occurrence, 632, references, 645, reproduction, 634, structure, 633; see Chaetopoda Oligorchis, 441 OHsthaneUa, 349; caeca, $49 Ohsthanellini, 349 Oncholaimellus, 487; heterurus, 487 Oncholaimus, 487, pundatus, 487 Onchosphere, 427 Onychodromopsis flexilis, 289 Onychodromus, 289; grandis, 289 Onychonema, 136; laeve, 136 Onychopoda, 738 Oocardium, 141; stratum, 141 Oocystis, 151; solitaria, 151 Oogonium, 119 Oospore, 119 Open-water collecting; see Methods of Collect- ing Opercularia, 295; plicatUis, 295 Ophidonais, 639; serpentina, 639 Ophiocytium, 157; cochleare, 157 Ophiogomphus (imago), 924, (nymph), 929 Ophiotaenia, 438; jilaroides, 425, 438, grandis, 439. lonnbergii, 438, perspicua, 439 Ophridinopsis, 296 Ophrydium, 296; eichhornii, 296 Ophryocotyle, 441; Proteus, 441 Ophryoglena, 278; atra, 278 Ophryoxus, 708; gracilis, 708 Opisthodon, 276 Opisthorchiidae, 393 Opistorchis, 393; pseudofelineus, 393 Opisthotricha, 289 Opistomum, 340 Organisms, water; effect of pressure, 34, en- vironment, 9, fluctuations, 54 Orchestiidae, 843 Oribatidae, 874 Ornatae, cercariae, 419 Orthodadius (larva), 94s Orthorrhapha (larva), 943 Orthosira, 126; orichalcea, 126 Oscillatoria, 108; limosa, 108, prolifica, 108 Oscillatoriceae, 107 Ospkranticum labronectum, 774 Ostracoda, 790-827; development, 797, dis- tribution, 801, genital organs, 795, key, 806-827, methods of study, 803, occur- rence, 799, references, 827, structure, 791; see Crustacea Ovatella, 979 Oxus, 868; oralis, 868, strigaius, 868 Oxytricha, 289; peUioneUa, 289 Oxyurella, 720, 722; longicaudis, 721, tenui- caudis, 720 Oxyuridae, 533 Oxyuris dubia, 533 Pachydiplax (imago), 927, (nymph), 932; longipennis, 890 Palaemon, 84s; ohionis, 845 Palaemonetes, 845; exilipes, 845, patudosa, 845, vulgaris, 845 Palaemonias ganieri, 845 Palaemonidae, 845 INDEX 1 103 Palraella, 150 Palmella condition, 115 Palmellaceae, 147 Palmellococcus, 153 Palmodactylon, 148 Palmodictyon, 149; viridis, 149 Paludestrina, 989; nickliniana, 989 Paludicclla ehrenbergii, 952 Paludicola, 354 Pamphagus, 228; kyalinus, 228, mulabilis, 228 Pandorina, 145, 267; morum, 145, 267 Panisus, 862, cataphr actus, 862 Pantala (imago), 927, (nymph), 932 Paracandona, 823; euplecteUa, S23 Paracypris, 817; grandis (Cypris), 819, perele- gans (Cypris), 819 Paragonimus, 390; kellicoUi, 390, wester- manii, 390 Paragordius, 539; varius, 539, embryo of, 536 Paralonella, 734 Paramermis, 505 Paramoecium, 281; caudotum, 281 Parampkistoma cervis, 413 Paramphistomidae, 385 Paramphistominae, 385 Paranais, 639; liloralis, 639 Paraponyx, 903 Paraptera, 1017; gracilis, 10 17 Parasitic Copepoda, 782-788; see Argulidae; Copepoda; Ergasilidae; Siphonostomata Parasitic Flatworms, 365-453; adaptability, 366, external, 367, methods of study, 368, number, 365, period of free existence, 366; see Cestoda; Parasitic Worms; Trematoda Parasitic Roundworms, 506-552; differen- tiator, 508, references, 551, technic, 507; see Acanthocephala; Gordiacea; Nematoda, Parasitic; Parasitic Worms Parasitic Worms, 365-369. 452; adaptations, 365, external, 367, methods of study, 368, period of free existence, 366, references, 452; see Acanthocephala; Cestoda; Gordi- acea; Nematoda, Parasitic; Parasitic Flat- worms; Parasitic Roundworms; Trema- toda Parmulina, 221; cyaihus, 221 Parnidae (adults). 942, (larvae), 943 Parophryoxus, 708; lubulatus, 708 Pectinatella, 954; magnified, 948, 954 Pectinibranchiata, 986 Pedalion, 613; mirum, 613 Pedalionidae, 613 Pedetes, 613; salialor, 613 Pediastrum, 160; boryanum, 160 Pedipes, 978; unisulcatus, 97S Pedinocoris, 933 Pegias, 1003; fabula, 1003; Pegosomum, 391 Pelagic region, 4 PeUcilus helicinus, 524 Pelogonidae, 933 Pelomyxa, 219; carolinensis, 219, palustris, 219 Pelonomus (adult), 942 Pelorempis (larva), 944 Peltodytes (adult), 938, (larva), 943 Penium, 138; cucurbUinum, 138 Pentagenia (imago), 918, (nymph), 921 Peranema, 255; trichophorum, 255 Peranemidae, 255 Peridinium, 270; tabulatum, 270 Perispira, 273; slrephosoma, 273 Pcrithemis (imago), 926, (nymph), 931 Peritricha, 291 Perla, 883 Petalomonas, 256; pUurosigma, 256 Phacus, 253; longicaudus, 253, pleuronectes, 253 Phaenocora, 348; agassizi, 348 Phaeophyceae, 174-175; key, 174-175; see Algae, Fresh- Water, excl. of Blue-Green Phagocata, 359; gracilis, 359 Phalansterium, 258; digilatum, 258 Phanerogams, aquatic, 198 Phascolodon, 277 Phialonema cyclostomum, 256 Philhydrus (adult), 940 Philobdella, 657; fioridana, 657, gracile, 657 Philodina, 619; bryceit 577, 619, roseola, 6x9 Philodinidae, 619 Philopotamidae, 936 Phormidium, 108; subfuscum, 108 Photographing, Methods of, 86-88; see Methods of Photographing Photography, under- water, 86; see Methods of Photographing Photokinesis, 328 Phragmitetum, 196 Phreoryctes (Ha plot axis emissarius), 642 Phryganea, 902 Phryganeidae, 936, 937 Phryganella, 227; hemisphaerica, 228, nidulus, 227 Phycochromophyceae; see Algae, Blue-Green Phycoerythrin, 117 Phycophaein, 117 Phylactolaemata, 952 Phyllodistomum, 399; americanum, 399, fo- lium, 414, 421 Phyllomitus, 248; amylophagus, 248 Phyllopoda (fairy shrimps), 661-675; col- lecting, 666, development, 664, key, 666- 675, occurrence, 661, 665, references, 675, structure, 662; see Crustacea Phyllosiphon, 172; arisari, 172 Physa,985; gyrina, 985 Physaloptera, 526; conslricia, 526, contorta, 526 Physidae, 984 Physiography, 22 no4 INDEX Physocypria, 819; inequivalva (Cypria), 822, Pustutosa (Cypria), 821 Physomonas, 247; elongate, 247 Phytia,978 Phytoflagellata, 259 Phytomastigida, 249 Phytomastigophora, 259 Pierosoma, 983 Pilea, 1009 Pimephales nolalus, 1048 Pinnularia, 127; viridis, 127 Piona, 873; censtricte, 873, rufa, 873 Pionacertus leuckarti, 853 Pioninae, 870 Pipette, piston, 82 Piscicola punctata, 655 FfsiiBiuu, 1019; virginicum, 1019 Piston pipette, 82 Pithophora, 166; kewensis, 166 PlacobdeDa, 652; hoUensis, 654, montifera, 652, parasitica, 653, pcdiadata, 653, pha- Ura, 654. Picta, 653, rugosa, 654; s. str.f 653 Placoccphalns kewense, 360 Placodsta, 231; spinas a, 231 Plagiola, 1013; elegans, 1014, securis, 1014; s. s., 1014 Plagioporus, 394; serotinus, 394 Plagiopyxis, 225; caUida, 226, labiate, 226 Plegiorchitdae, 402 Plagiorcbiinae, 403 Plagiorchis, 404, proximus, 404 Plagiosloma (?) planum, 361, 364 Planarta, 355; ogtffr, 357, dorotocephate, 357, Joremanii, 35s, fuliginosus, 359, gonocepk- ata, 356, Hgubris, 355, maculate, 356, m*r- fotif, 358, simplex, 358, simptissima, 355, truncate, 358, unionicote, 358, fefato, 358 Planarians; je« Turbellaria rianarfidae, 354 Planktology, 6 Plankton, 4, 6, character of organism, 7, dwarf, 6, fish Hfe and, 1082, limnoplank- ton, 6, nannoplankton, 6, 7, quantitative study, 8r, by piston pipette, 82, quantity, 47, 48, Sedgewick-Raftcr cell, 82, size, 7, specimens shown in bolting cloth, 7; see Nannoplankton Plankton pump, 70, 78; cylinders, 73, quantitative plankton net, 74, quanti- tative double plankton net, 77 Ptanktonema, 163, 164; teuterbornn, 164 PkasorbeHa, 983 Ptanorbidae, 982 Planorbinae, 982 Planorbis, 9S2; antrosuz, 982, csmpanutatus, 983, crista, 984, cuHratus, 983, gtebratus, 983, kirsutus, 983, operc uteris, 983, Parvus, 984, Involvis, 983; s. s., 982 Planorbula, 984 Plant societies, succession of, 197 Plants, amphibious, 183; succession of so- cieties, 197 Plants, aquatic, 179, 180; distribution, 194, factors in formation of marl and marl lakes, 207, floating, 178, groups, 197, growing in soil, 202 , 203, hibernacula (winter buds), 192, incrustation, mineral, 185, carbonate of lime, 186, gelatinous, 187, leaves, 180, submerged, 182, phanerogams, 198, refer- ences, 209, reproduction, by runners, 189, by pollination under water, 189, stomata on submerged leaves, 184, submerged leaves, 182, succession of societies, 197, zones, 196; see Vegetation, Larger (Higher) Plants, water; see Plants, aquatic Plathemis (imago), 927, (nymph), 932 Platoum, 228; parvum, 228 Platycola, 297; decumbens, 297 Platycopa, 806 Platydorina, 145, 268; caudala, 145, 268 Platyhelminthes (Flat worms); see Cestoda; Flatworms; Nemertina; Trematoda; Tur- bellaria Platytrichotus, 288; opisihoboius, 288 Plea, 934 Plecoptera (stoneflSes), 882-885, 917; nymphs, 883; jielnsecta Plectanocotyle, 375 Plectonema, in; woUci, in Plectus, 492; tuoifer, 492 Pleodorina, 146, 268; calif arnica, 268, 3H- neisensis, 146, 268 Pleorchis, 397; mollis, 397 Plerocercoid, 427, 451 Plethobasus, 1000 Pleurobema, 999; aesopkus, rooo, cUxa, 999 Pleurocera, 993; canalicutetum, 993, plena, 993 Pleurocera tidae, 991 Pleurococcaceae, 152 Pleurococcus, 152; vulgaris, 152 Pleurogcnetinae, 400 Pleuromonas, 249; jaculans, 249 Pleuronema, 281; chrysalis, 281 Pleurosigma, 127; aUenuatum, 127 Pleurotaeniopsis, 138; turgiius, 138 Pleurotaenfum, 138, 139; nodutesum, 139 Pleurotricha, 269; lanceolate, 289 Pleurotrocha, 589; grandis, 589 Pleuroxalonella, 734 Pleuroxus, 726; atutkostris, 736, aduncus, 729, denticulatus, 728, gracffis, 727, komu- latus, 728, hastetm, 727, procurvatus, 736, striatus, 725, 727, tripmeUus, 729, trumatm, 727, uncinatus, ji&t uwidens, 727 Ploesoma, 603; kudsoni, 603, kntkulare, 603, truncatum, 603 Ploesomidae, 570, 603 Plnmatdla, 952; arethusa, 953, 953* primceps, 953, punctata, 954 INDEX 1 105 Paeumatophilus, 406; tariabUis, 406 Pneumobttes, 4015; breviplexus, 403, Umgi- Pnmmonocces, 403; coloradensi*, 403 Podocopa,8o6 Podophrya, 398; Jixa, 298 Pnltinatra under water, 189 Polhitioa, prevention of, 1075 Folyadeaous cercariae, 416 PoiyartcmicOa, 666; kanseni, 666, judayi, 667 Polyartemiidae, 666 PoJyarthia, 591; pUtyptera, 591 Polycelis, 359; coronate, 359 Pbiycentropidae, 937 Pdtychaeta, 632 Polychaetus, 599; collmsii, 599 Polycotyle, 410; omata, 410 Polycystididae, 353 Poiycystia, 353; gaeUi, 353, roosevelti, 353 Polymitarcys (imago), 918, (nymph), 921; alba, 888 Poiymorphus, 548; mimuhtt, 548 Folyopisthocotylea, 375 Polyphemidae, 738 Polyphemus, 738; pediculus, 738 Potyrhytis, 981 Poiystoma, 376; imtegerrimmm, 376 Polystomidae, 375 Polystomoides, 376; coronaium, 376, hassalli, 376, wugacotyU, 377, microcotyle, 377, opacum, 378, obUmgmm, 377, orbiculare, 377 Polytoma, 265; uvclla, 265 Poiyzoa; see Bryoaoa Pomatiopsinae, 991 Pomatiopsis, 991; lapidaria, 991 Pompholiginae, 984 Pomphnlyx, 611, 984; complanta, 611, ejfusa, 984 Pompholyxophrya, 235; punicca, 235 Pomphorhynchus, 551 Ponds, 2; age series, 49 Pontigulasia, 225; spectabilis, 225 Pontoporeia, 84a; koyi, 842 Pools, 3 Porifera (sponges), Fresh- Water, 15, 301-315; collecting, 304, development, 303, habits, 302, key, 306-315, methods of study, 305, references, 315, structure,' 301 Porphyridium, 106 Potamanthus (imago), 919, (nymph), 921 Potamobiidae, 846 Potamobrua, 846; astacus, 846, gambcli, 846, Irowbridgei, 846 Potamocypris, 808; smaragdina, 808 Potamogeton, 181; crispus, 189, 192, densus, 185, heteropkyUus, 183, 195, lucens, 193, nutans, 182, pectinatus, 182, 185, 191, PerfoKotus, 181, 191, 192, robbmsii, 191 Potamogetonetum, 196 Potamopyrgus, 990; PottsieUa erecta, 951 Prasiola, 161; crispa, 161 Prawns, 828; tee Malacostraca Pressodon, 1006 Pressure in water, 34; effect upon 34 Primary host; see Host, primary Prismatolaimus, 499; siemtrus, 499 Pristina, 640; Jfogellum, 640, longwts, var. leidyi, 640 Proales, 589; sordid*, 589, iigrida, 589, werneckii, 555, 589 Problems, Technical and Sanitary, 1067- 1083; algae, methods of killing, 1076, pre- vention of growths of, 1074, purification of water containing, 1077; bacteria, in water, 1070, bacillus coli as index of contami- nation, 1069; disease, transmission of, 1067, water as conveyor of germs, 1068; drainage of swamps, 1075; odors, cause of, 1073, observation of, 1072; organisms in pipes of water systems, 1081; plankton and fish Kfe, 1082; prevention of pollution, 1075; soil stripping of reservoir sites, 1074; streams and self-purification, 1078; water, identification of source of, 1080, tastes and odors in, 107 1 Probopyrus, 842; pandalicola, 842 Proboscis, 542; sheath, 543 Proglottids, 424 Progomphus (imago), 924, (nymph), 929 Proptera, 1016; alata, 1016 Prorhynchidae, 339 Prorhynchus, 339; appUtuUus, 340, stagnate, 339 Prorodon, 274; ovum, 274 Prosthogoniminae, 402 Prosthogonimus, 402 Pro stoma marginatum, 363 Prostomatous cercariae, 4x2 Prosostomata, 379 Protenes, 394; kpius, 394, angnstus, 394 Protenteron, 401 ; diaphanum, 401 Proteocephalidae, 434 Proteocephalus, 434; amblopliUs, 436, exigums, 437, macrocephalus, 435, Perplexus, 435, pinguis, 437, pusiUus, 437, singularis, 435 Proteomyxa, 233 Proterospongia, 258; haecktli, 258 Protoclepsis occidentalism 654 Protococcaceae, 156 Protococcales, 143 Protosiphon, 156; botry aides, 156 Protozoa, 14, 210-300; see Infusoria; Masti- gophora; Sarcodina Psamathiomyia (larva), 945 Psephenus (adult), 942 Pseudalona, 7x8 PseudodifHugia, 229; gracilis, 229 Pseudoecistes, 617; roii/er, 617 no6 INDEX Pseudomermis, 505 Pseudoon, 10x3 Pseudophyllidea, 430; larvae of, 450 Pseudo-pleurococcus, 153; vulgaris, 153 Pseudopodia, 238 Pseudosida, 692; bidentala, 692 Pseudosuccinea, 981 Pseudulvella americana, 171 Psilonemateae, 107 Psorophora (larva), 944 Psychodkiae (larvae), 945 Psychomyiidae, 937 Pterodina, 611; casca, 611, patina, 611 Pterodinidae, 61 1 Pterodrilus, 644; akiconus, 644, distUhus, 644 Pteronarcys dorsata, 884 Pterosygna, 1005 Ptychobothriidae, 430 Ptychobranchus, 1012; phascolus, 1012 Ptycboptcridae (larvae), 944 Pulmonata, 977 Pump; plankton, 70, 78, dock, 80, Fordyce, 79, thresher-tank, 80 Purification of water containing algae, 1077 Pyralidae, 903 Pyramid dredge, 71 Pyrenoid, 116 Pyrgulopsis, 990; nevadenris, 990 Pyxicola, 297; carteri, 297 Pyxidicula, 222; cymbalum, 222 Pyridium, 293; ramosum, 293 Quadrula, 995; eylindrica, 996, lachrymosa, 997, pUcaia, 996» pustulosa, 997, undata, 997; s. s., 996 Quadrulella, 226; symmetrica, 226 Qualitative methods of collecting, 72; see Methods of Collecting Quantitative plankton net, 74 Quantitative study; of nannoplankton, 83; see Nannoplankton; of net plankton, 81; see Plankton Radiofilum, 163; flavescens, 163 Radiosphaera, 156 Radix, 981 Radula, 973 Ramosonema, 247; laxum, 247 Ranatra, 934 Rangia, 1020; cuneata, 1020 Rangiidae, 1020 Ranunculus aquatUis, 182, 183, 191, 193, 201 Raphkliophrys, 235; eUgans, 235, viridis, 235 Rattenkbmgcercarien, 414 Rattulidae, 568, 595 Rattulus, 595; cyUmdricus, 595. fa*ffc 595. Redia,37i References on Fresh-Water Biology, 18-20; Acanthocephala, 551-552. Algae, Blue- Green (Cyanophyceae), 114, Algae, excl. of Blue-Green, 177, Amphibia (Batrachia), 1066, Animalcules, 620, 955-9561 Appa- ratus and Methods, 88-89, Bacteria, 99, Batrachia (Amphibia), 1066, Birds, 1066, Bryozoa, 955-956, Cestoda, 452-453. Cladocera, 739"740, Copepoda, 788-789, Crustacea, Higher (Malacostraca), 850, Cyanophyceae (Algae, Blue-Green), 114, Existence, Conditions of, 60, Fishes, 1066, Gastrotricha, 631, Gordiacea, 551-552, Hirudinea, 660, Hydra, 322, Hydracarina, ^75. Hydrozoa, 322, Infusoria, 300, Insecta, 946, Malacostraca, 850, Mammals, 1066, Mastigophora, 300, Mollusca, 1020, Nema- toda, Free-Living, 505, Nematoda, Para- sitic, 551-552, Nemertina (Nemerteans), 458, Oligochaeta, 645, Ostracoda, 827, Parasitic Worms, 452, 551, Plants, Higher (Larger), 209, Phyllopoda, 675, Porifera, 315, Protozoa, 236-237, 300, Reptiles, 1066, Rotatoria, 620, Sarcodina, 236-237, Trema- toda, 452-453, Turbellaria, 364, Vegetation, Larger (Higher), 209, Vertebrata, 1066; see Investigators in Fresh-Water Biology; Journals on Fresh- Water Biology Renette, 470 Renifer, 405; cUiplicus, 405, ekngatus, 407, megasorckis, 407, variabilis, 406 Reniferinae, 405 Reproduction, physiology of, 120; see also the specific subjects Reptiles, Fresh- Water, 1026-1028; references 1066; see Vertebrata Reservoir sites, soil stripping of, 1074, pre- vention of algae growths in, 1074 Rhabditis, 493; eylindrica, 493 Rhabdocoela, 333 Rhabdocoelida, 333, 361 Rhabdocoelous cercariae, 412 Rhabdolaimus, 494; minor, 494 Rkabdonema nigrovenosum, 521 Rhabdostyia, 293; vernalis, 293 Rhadinorhynchus, 550 Rhantus (adult), 942 Rheology, z; evolution of stream, 5 Rhinops, 599; vitrea, 565, 599 Rhipidendron, 262; splendidum, 262 Rhipidogfossa, 994 Rhizodonium, 166; hieroglypkkum, 166 Rhizodrilus, 641; lacteus, 641 Rhizomastigidae, 243 Rhizopoda, 219 Rhixosoknia, 127; eriensis, 127 Rhizosoleniaceae, 127 Rhodophyceae, 175-177; key, 175-W; «• Algae, Fresh- Water, exd. of Blue-Green Rhnfcntphanh, 129; cmnata, 129 INDEX 1 107 Rhopaloccrca tardigrada, 421 Rhopalocercous cercariae, 421 Rhyacophilidae, 936 Rhyncheta, 299 Rhynchobdellae, 651 Rhynchodemidae, 360 Rhynchodemus atrocyaneus, 360, sylvaiicus, 360 Rhynchomcsostoma, 349; rostratum, 349 Rhynchomonas, 246; nasula, 246 Rhynchoprobolus papillosus, 361, 363 Rhynchoscolex, 337; simplex, 337, vcjdovski, 337 Rhynchotalona, 724; falcaia, 724 Rhyphidac (larvae), 945 Rhythms of fresh- water organisms, 43; daily depth migrations vs., 43 Rhyzota, 574 Richteriella, 154; bo try aides, 154, globosa, 154 Rivularia, 114; minuttda, 114 Rivulariaceae, 113 Rostcllum, 424 Rotatoria (wheel animalcules), Fresh- Water, 16, 553-620; body, 554, corona, 554, 557, the chief organ of locomotion, 562, cosmo- politan characteristics, 578, development, 582, eggs, 580, excretory organs, 560, foot, 554. Jaws (trophi), 558, 559. key, 587-619. mastax, 558, 560, methods of study, 583, minute males, 580, nervous system, 563, Xotommatidae as example, 555, occurrence, 554, references, 620, relationships, 586, reproduction, 564, species (perennial), 581, (summer), 581, (winter), 581, structure, 554, 579, trophi, 558, 559, variations of type among Anapodidae, 570, Anuraedac, 571, Asplanchnidae, 571, Bdclloida, 576, Branch- ionidae, 570, Coluridae, 568, Dinocharidac, 569, Euchlanidae, 568, Floscularida, 572, Flosculariidae, 572, Gastropodidae, 570, Hydatinidae, 569, Mclicertida, 574, Notom- matidac, 566, Notopsidae, 569, Ploe- somidac, 570, Rattulidae, 568, Rhizota, 574, Salpinidae, 567, Scisonacea, 577, 578, Sy'nchaetidae, 566 Rotifer, 619; ciirinus, 619, neplunius, 619 Rotifera; see Rotatoria Rotundaria, 999; iubercidala, 999 Roundworms (Nemathclminthes), Fresh- water, 15; free-living; see Nematoda, Free-Living; parasitic; see Acanthoceph- ala; Gordiacea; Nematoda, Parasitic; Parasitic Roundworms; Parasitic Worms Rugifera, 1006 Sagittaria chinensis, 183, nutans, 183 Salpina, 593; spinigera, 593 Salpingocca, 258; convallaria, 258 Salpinidae, 567, 593 Sanitary Problems, Technical and, 1067- 1083; see Problems, Technical and Sanitary Saprophilus, 279; agitans, 279 Sarcodina (amoeboid protozoa), 14, 210-237; conjugation, 217, food, 212, 215, habitats, 211, key, 219-236, metabolism, 216, meth- ods of study, 218, references, 236-237, reproduction, 216, shells, 214, structure, 211; see Protozoa Sayella, 979 Scalenaria, 1008 Scapholeberis, 699; aurita, 699, mmronaia, 699 Scandium, 597; longicaudum, 597 Scenedesmus, 159; quadricaudo, 159 Sciadium, 158; arbuscula, 158 Scirpctum, 196 Schistocephalus, 432 Schistosomatidae, 409 Schistotaenia, 448; macrorkyncka, 448 Schizamphistominae, 387 Schizocanthum, 141; armatum, 141 Schizocerca, 605; diversicomis, 605 Schizochlamys, 150; gclatinosa, 150 Schizomeris, 162; leibMnii, 163 Schizonema, 128 Schizomycetes; see Bacteria Schizothrix, 109; rubella, 109 Schizophyceae; see Algae, Blue-Green Schmardaella, 638; filiformis, 638 Scolex, 424 Scotinosphaera, 157; paradoxa, 157 Scuds, 828; see Malacostraca Scutopterus (adult), 941 Scyphidia, 292; JromenteUii, 292 Scytonema, 112; mirabile, 112 Scytonemaceac, m Seasonal succession of fresh-water life (biol- ogy), 10 Seasonal temperature changes, 33 Secondary host; see Host, secondary Sedgewick-Rafter cell, 82, sand filter, 83 Scgmentina, 984; armigera, 984 Seines, 61 Seison annul atus, 578 Scisonacea, 577, 578 Selenastrum, 159; gractie, 159 Sepedon, 913 Sericostomatidae, 936, 937 Serphus, 933 Sctiferous cercariae, 423 Shore zone, 3 Shrimps, 828; see Malacostraca Shrimps, fairy; see Crustacea; Phyllopoda Sialididae (spongilla flies), 897-898; adults, 935; su Insects; Neuroptera Sialis (adult), 935* (larva), 935; infumaia, 898 Sida, 689; crystalline, 689 Sididae, 689 Simocephalus, 698; exspinosus, 698, serru- tatus, 699, vetulus, 698 Simuliidae (black-flies), 913; larvae, 946; Mi Diptera; Insecta noS INDEX Stpnltiru* 'imago), 920, (nymph), 922 Stpbonaria, 979; aUemata, 979, peUoides, 980; •.•-,979 StpBOfianjdae, 979 Stpfcoooftomata (Parasitic Copcpoda), 782- 788; structure, 783; mt Argutidae; Cope- poda; Ergaaflidar Stsyra (adult), 934* 'larva), 899, 935 Sterina, 639; appendicnlata, 539 Soknopbrya, J99; Jer«, 399 Somatochlora (imago), 926, (nymph), 931 Somatogyrua, 991; mbghbesui, 991 Soraatrum, 159; tpinulcium, 159 Sow-bug*, 828; #« MaUcoitraca Spwganophilua, 643; benkams, 643, euati, 643, /a***i, 643 Sparganum, 434; mamom, 433. 434. ^»- liferum, 434# i***f», 434 Spathidium, 273; spatknla, 273 Sperchon, 870; gfandmUnus, 870 Sperchoninae, 869 Sphaerella, 144; nivalis, 144, pluviaUs, 144 Sphaeriidae, 1018 Sphaerium, 1018; simile, 1018 Sphaerocyatts, 151; sckraeteri, 151 Sphaerophrya, 299; magna, 299 Sphaeroplea, 165; annulina, 165 Sphaeropleaceae, 165 Sphaeroftoma, 406 Sphaerozoama, 136; pvUhntm Tar. infiatum, 136, verlebratum, 136 Sphenoderia, 229; dentate, 229, fen/a, 230, macroUpiSt 230 Sphenonionas, 254; quadrangularis, 254 Sphyranura, 378; oxArn', 378 Spiciila, 475 Spilophora, 489; canadensis, 489 Spinitectua, 527; graciHs, 527 Spirocypria, 813; passaica, 813, tubercniata, 814 Spirogyra, 142; crassa, 142 Sptromonaa, 249; angusta, 249 Spironoura, 533; «^*r, 533, graeile, 533 Spiroatomum, 284; ambiguum, 184 Spirotaenia, 137; mmmio, 137 Spirulina, 107; mq/or, 107 Spiruridae, 525 Spirurinae, 525 Spiruroidea, 525 Spondylomorura, 144, 267; pMrfentflWsm, 144. 267 Spondyloaium, 136; paptlaswm, 136 Sponges; 100 Porifera Spongilla, 306, 311; aspmesa, 306, baOeji, 311* fragilis, 307, iglovifotmis, 3<>7» laautris, 306, novae-terrae, 307, paupercnh, 306, wagneri, 308 Spongina-JHefl, 897; fa* Hemerobiidae; In- aecta; Neuroptera Spongmaooas, 262; msscsu, sfo Sporadoporus, 862; aamafw Spores of bacteria, 92; aee Sporocyst, 371 Sporozoa, 14 Stagnirofa, 981 Stations, fresh-water baolagy, 12 Statobtast, 949 Stauraatram, 139; trrnmlt SUurogema, 160 Stanroneta, 126; anceps, 126 Stauroptera, 127 Stendmia (adult), 942 Stenostomum, 334; agsk, 336, cciuker, 337, grand*, 336, lencops, 335, spetiasum, 335, lenuicauda, 336 Stentor, 285; coeruleus, 285, pdynwrptna, 285 Stephanoceros, 61 1 ; eickkornn, 61 1 Stephaaodiacus, 127; niagartoe, 127 Stephanoprora, 391; gilbert, 391 Stephanops, 597; intermedins, 597 Stephanoaphaera, 145, 266; piuvialis, 145, 200 Stichococcus, 152; baeUlaris, 152 Stichorchis, 386, subtriquetrms, 386 SHckostewma asensariatusn, 457. rajftmaa, 455» 45« Stkhotricha, 287; secunda, 287 Stigonema, 112; ntmutvm, 112, oce&atwm, 112 Stigonemaceae, 112 Stomata on submerged leaves, 184 Stoneffies; jee Insecta; Piecoptera Stratification of aquatic organisms, 10 Stratiomyiidae (larvae), 946 Streams; bottom materials, 24, bottoms, differentiation in, 25, current strength, 23, evolution, 5, hydrogen sulphide, 39, rate of flow, 27, self-purification, 1078, tem- perature of water, 32 Streblocerus, 709; pygmaeus, 709, serricau- dalus, 709 Strephobaais, 993 Streptocephafidae, 670 Streptocephalua, 670; Jforidanus, 670, seaiii, 670, tetanus, 670 Strigea, 410; cornu, 410 Strobila, 424 Strombidium, 286; daporidU, 286 Strongyieae, 522 Strongyfidae, 522 Strongyimae, 522 Strongyloidea, 522 StrongyMdes siercoralis, 521 Strongyloatoma, 350; gonocepkaUtm, 350, radiatum, 350 Strongylus, 522; amricnlaris, 522 Strophitus, 1001; edenttdus, 1001 Stygonectea, 843 Strbria, 639; fmtdam, 639. tamt*b, 635. 659 INDEX 1109 416 Stylobryon, 245; petidutum, 245 atytoaedra, 297 Styfeoychia, 390; nwtapkma, 290 Styphlodora, 405; kunmiemii, 405 Submerged leaves, 182; stomal* on, 184 Suctoda, 298 SwireBa, 131 Surireuaceae, 130 Swtroa, 642; alpesmHs, 642, rastrata, 642 Sympetrum (imago), 927, (nymph), 932 Swamp, 3, s, 59; drainage of. 1075 Symphynota, 1004; campianata, 1005, pressa, 1004, costal*, 1005; s. s., 1004 Symploca, 109; lucifnga, 109 Synchaeta, 591; tallica, 591, styiata, 591, tremula, 591 Synchaetidae, 591; see Rotatoria Synechococcus, 105; ar ragi— j*i, 105 Synedra, 132; salina, 132 Synplecta pendula, 528 Synura, 262; ircdZa, 262 Tabanidae Oarvae), 946 Tabanos (larva), 946 Tabellaria, 133; fenestrate, 133 TabeDariaceae, 133 Tacbopteryx (nymph), 929, 950 Tachysoma, 290; parvistyU, 290 Taenia, 440, 447; crassicaBis, 447, J&/«m*, 44*. pnlcheUa, 450, sadopendra, 449 Taeniidae, 447 Taenioglossa, 986 Tanaognathus, 864; spmipes, 864 Tanaorhamphus, 547; hngirostris, 547 Tank -pump, 80 Tanyfus carmen*, 914, (larva), 94s Tanytarsus (larva), 945 Tapeworms, 15; *« Cestoda; Parasitic Flat- worms; Parasitic Worms Taphrocampa, 589; amnulnu, 589 TanKgrada, 17 Tatria, 449; biremis, 449 Technical and Sanitary Problems, 1 067-1083; see ProMrms, Technical and Sanitary Tefanatodrilus, 641 ; mcgre&ri, 641, vejdankyi, 641 Teferchmae, 393 Tefercms, 394; medius, 394 Temperature of water, 32; and mctabonsvi, 33, in streams, 32, reaction of animals, 34, seasonal changes, 33 Tentaculata, 17; see Bryozoa Teratocepbalus, 496; csrnmitu, 496 Terricota, 359 Terriginous bottom, 26, 45 Testacea, 220 Tetmemoru*. 138; granulosus, 138 Tetrabothriidae, 440 Tetrabothrius, 440; maerocrphalns, 440 Tetracoccns, 149 Tetracotyle, 411; lyfica, 411 Tetracotyle form, 424 Tetracydus, 133; locus tris, 133 Tetradesmus, 160; rotiwifim, 16b Tetraedron, 155; enarme, 155 Tetragoneuria (imago), 926, (aymnm), 951 Tetramastix, 613; opdiensis, 613 Tetramitus, 251; variabilis, 251 Tetrapedia, 105 Tetraphylltdea, 434 Tetrasehnis, 264; limnesu, 264 Tetraspora, 147; expianata, 147 Tetrasporaceae, 146 Tetrastemma aquarium dnicium, 457; jw Nemertina Tetrastrmn, 160 Thalassomyia, 945 Thallasironus, 486 Thamnocephalus, 670; pUtyums, 670 Tbelaziidae, 527 Thermal springs, life of, 101 Thermocline, 28 Theliderma, 997 Thermonectes (adalt), 941 Tborea, 175; ramosissima, 175 Threadworms; see Xematoda, Parasitic Thresher tank-pump, 80 Throscinus (adult), 942 Thuricola, 296; valvata, 296 Thurjcolopsis, 296 Thyas, 861; venusla, 861 Tintinnidium, 286; JtunatUis, 286 Tintinnus, 286 Tiphys, 873; liliaceus, 873 Tipulidae (larvae), 944 Tolypella, 173; nidijica, 173 Tolypothriz, 112; lanats, 112 Torquis, 984 Torrenticola, 864; anamdu, 864 Tow net, 72 Trachelitis, 275; ovum, 275 TracheiabdeBa vivid*, 655 Trachelmonas, 252; hispid*, 252, Iggfifld, 252, volvocina, 252 Trachelophyllum, 273; tacky blast mm. 273 Tralia, 978; mysolis, 979, pusilla, 978 Tramea (imago), 927, (nymph), 932 Trammel net, 62 Transmission, disease, 1067 Traps, 65 Trematoda (flukes). Fresh- Water, 15, 365. 369-424, 452-453; cercaria, 371, 372, as plankton organism, 372, degree of infection, 373, development, 371, intermediate hast, 371, key, 374-424, mrraririinm, 371, primary host, 372, redia, 371, references, 45*-453t sporocyst, 371, structure. 369, 370; see Para- sitic Flatworms; Parasitic Worms Tfcntipohha, 170; unxmoi, 170 IIIO INDEX Trentonia, 265; fiageUata, 265 Trepomonas, 249; ogilis, 249 Triaenophorinae, 433 Triaenophorus, 433 Triangle dredge, 71 Triarthra, 613; brachiaia, 613, longiseta, 613 Tribonema, 164; minor, 164 Trickinetta spiralis, 534 Trichinellidae, 534 Trichocephaloides, 444 Trichoda, 279; pur a, 279 Trichodina, 291; pediculus, 291 Trichogaster, 286 Trichomastix, 250 Trichophoreae, 113 Trichophrya, 299; sinuosa, 299 Trichoptera (caddisflies), Fresh-Water, 900- 903. 9i7» 93&-937I cases, 900, key, 936-937, pupa, 902; see Insecta Tricorythus (nymph), 922 Trichosoma contortum, 513 Trichostomina, 277 Trichostrongylidae, 522 Trichostrongylinae, 522 Trichostrongylus, 522; fiberius, 522 Trichosyringata, 534 Trichurinae, 534 Trichuris, 534; opaca, 534 Tridadida, 333, 354, 361 Trilobus, 501; longus, 501 Trinema, 231; camplanatum, 231, enchelys, 232, Uneare, 232 Triophthalmus, 589; dorsualis, 589 Triphylus, 599; locus tris, 599 Triploceras, 139; gracile, 139 Tripyla, 498; lata, 498 Tristomidae, 374 Tritigonia, 998; tuberculoid, 998 Trochelminthes, 16 Trochiscia, 154; vestitus, 154 Trochosphaera, 613; sols tibialis, 613 Trochosphaeridae, 613 Trochospongilla, 308; horrida, 308, leidyi, 308 Troglotrematidae, 390 Tropidiscus, 983 Tropidoscyphus, 254, 257 Tropisternus (adult), 940 Truncilla, 1008; foUata, 1009, personate, 1009, sulcata, 1008, triquttra, 1008; s. s., 1008 Tryonia, 989; clathrata, 989 Trypanorhyncha, 434, 450 Tubefla, 313; pennsylvanica, 313 Tubifex, 642; multiselosus, 641, 642, tubifex, 641,642 Tubificidae, 640 Tulotoma, 988; magnifica, 988 Tuomeya, 176; Jluviatalis, 176 TurbeUaria (free-living flat worms), Fresh- Water, is; 323-364; culturesl-33i, digestive apparatus, 325. habitat, 329, key, 333-364, land planarians, 330, methods of study, 331, movement, 325, photokinesis, 328, references, 364, reproduction, 326, respon- siveness to stimuli, 328 Turbidity of fresh water, 29, 36 Turtle nets, 66 Two-winged flies; sec Diptera; Insecta Tylenchus, 483; devastatrix, 483, dips act, 483 Types of fresh- water life, 13 Typhlocypris, 823; delawarensis, 824, peircei, 823 Typhloplana, 350; viridata, 350 Typhloplanid from Canandaigua Lake, 361, 362; from Irondequoit, 361, 362 Typhloplanidae, 348, 361 Typhloplanini, 349 Tyrrellia, 869; circularis, 869 Ulothriz, 162; sonala, 162 Ulothrichaceae, 161 Ulvaceae, 160 Ulvella, 171; americana, 171 Under- water photography, 86; see Methods of Photographing Uniformity of fresh-water life (biology), 13 Unio, 1000; crassidens, 1000, spinosus, 1001, tetralasmus, 1001, uniomerus, 1001 Unionicola (non-parasitic species), 871 Unionicola (parasitic species), 872; crassipes, 872 Unionidae, 995 Unioninae, 995 Univalve, 957; see Mollusca Uranotaenia (larva), 944 Urceolaria, 292 Urceolopsis, 256; sabulosa, 256 Urceotus, 256; cydoslomum, 256 UrnaleUa gracilis, 951 Urnula, 299 Urocentrum, 277; turbo, 277 Uroglena, 261; americana, 261 Uroleptus, 288; thus cuius, 288 Uronema, 279; marinum, 279 Urosoma, 290 Urostyla, 287; grandis, 287, trichogaster, 287 Urotricha, 273; farcta, 273 Utricularia, 188; infiata, x88, minor, z88 Vacuoles, 103 Vaginarieae, 109 Vaginicola, 296; leptosoma, 296 Vallisneria, 181, 190; spiralis, 181, 185, 189, 190 Valvata, 988; tricarinata, 988 Varvatidae, 988 Vampyrella, 234; lateriHa, 234 Vanheurckia, 128; rhomboides, 128 Variety of fresh-water life (biology), 11 Vaucheria, 172; re pens, 172 Vegetation, amount, 50 INDEX xxxx Vegetation, Larger (Higher), Fresh-Water, 178-209; cycle of matter, 207, evolution, 198, references, 209, zones, 196; see Plants, aquatic Veliidae. 933 Venation, wing, 916; of stoneflies, 916; see Insecta Vertebrata, 102 1-1066; adaptations, 1022, references, 1066; see Amphibia (Batrachia); Birds; Fishes; Mammals; Reptiles Viviparidae, 987 Viviparus, 987; inter tcxlus, 987 Volvocaceae, 143 Volvox, 146, 269; aureus, 269, globaior, 269, perglobalor, 269, spermaiosphara, 269 Vortex, 340 Vortex (?) cavicoiens, 361, 363 Vorticella, 293; campanula, 293 Wardius, 386; xdbeikicus, 386 Water; acid or alkaline characteristics of, 40, ammonia in, 39, bacteria found in natural, 96, number in, 96, 1070, biological con- ditions in, 46, carbon dioxide in, 39, chemical factors, 36, circulation, 27, in lakes, 27, conveyor of disease, 1068, current strength in streams, 23. daily depth migra- tions, 32, 43, density. 22, distribution of gases, 37, of life, 35, expansion in freezing, 21, gases dissolved in, 36, general solvent, 22, identification of source of, 1080, index of suitability, 46, influence of currents in, 28, odors in, 1071, 1072, oxygen content, 37, penetration of light, 29, 30, physical conditions of, 22, physical environment of organisms in, 9, pressure in, 34, quantity of life in, 46, of plankton in, 47, 48, reser- voirs, purification of, 1074, 1076, 1077, rhythms of organisms, 43, seasonal changes, 33, solubility of gases in, 37, tastes in, 1071, temperature, 32, in streams, 32, terriginous bottom, 45, thermal properties, 21, tur- bidity, 29, 36 Water Biology, Fresh-; see Biology, Fresh- water "Water-bloom," 100 Water bodies, physical features of, 8 Water bottle, 80 Water glass, 87 Water Life, Fresh-; see Biology, Fresh-Water Water organisms, physical environment of, 9 Water plants and vegetation; see Plants. aquatic; Vegetation, aquatic Water supplies, tastes and odors in, 1071 Water systems, organisms in pipes of, 1081 Waters, flowing, 2 Waves and their action, 28 Wheel animalcules; see Rotatoria Whirligig beetles, 906; see Coleoptera; Insecta Wilsonema, 495 Wing venation, 916 Winter buds (hibernacula), 192 Wlassicsia, 711; kinistinensis, 711 Wollea, 110; saccata, 1x0 Worms, earth; see Chaetopoda; Oiigochaeta Worms, free -living; see Nematoda; Nemer- tina (Nemerteans) ; TurbeUaria Worms, parasitic; see Acanthocephala; Ces- toda; Gordiacea; Nematoda, Parasitic; Parasitic Worms; Trematoda Wyeomyia (larva), 944 Xanthidium, 141; jasciculatum, 141 Xiphidiocercariae, 416 Xystonotus, 865: as per, 865 Zannichellia, 189; repens, 185, palustris, 190 Zeugorchis, 407; aeauatus, 407 Zoethamnium, 294; adamsi, 294 Zone, shore, 3 Zones of vegetation, 196; characctum, 196, nupharetum, 196, phragmitetum, 196 potamogetonetum, 196, scirpetum, 196 Zoochlorella, 153 Zooecium, 948 Zoophytes, 301 Zoosporangium, 119 Zoospores, 118 Zoster a nana, 185 Zygnema, 142 Zygnemaceae, 141 Zygncmeac, 142 Zygocotyle, 388; cerates a, 388 Zygocotylinac, 388 Zygoptera (imago), 922, (nymph), 928 Zygospore, 119 i- *«.■'* "»*^.